Skip to main content

Full text of "Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders (5th ed.)"

See other formats


DENG NIONIIGWNNIDESIL AUIS IILOra\s 
MANUAL OF 
NAV NPN eB) SS@) 1D) es) 


Pe Tals 13 1B)1) UO S 


DSM-5" 


AMERICAN PSYCHIATRIC ASSOCIATION 


DIAGNOSTIC AND STATISTICAL 
MANUAL OF 
MENTAL DISORDERS 


DSM-5" 


American Psychiatric Association 


Officers 2012-2013 
PRESIDENT DILIP V. JESTE, M.D. 
PRESIDENT-ELECT JEFFREY A. LIEBERMAN, M.D. 
TREASURER DAVID FASSLER, M.D. 
SECRETARY ROGER PEELE, M.D. 


Assembly 
SPEAKER R. SCOTT BENSON, M.D. 
SPEAKER-ELECT MELINDA L. YOUNG, M.D. 


Board of Trustees 
JEFFREY AKAKA, M.D. 
CAROL A. BERNSTEIN, M.D. 
BRIAN CROWLEY, M.D. 
ANITA S. EVERETT, M.D. 
JEFFREY GELLER, M.D., M.P.H. 
MARC DAVID GRAFF, M.D. 
JAMES A. GREENE, M.D. 
JUDITH F. KASHTAN, M.D. 
MOLLY K. McVoy, M.D. 
JAMES E. NININGER, M.D. 
JOHN M. OLDHAM, M.D. 
ALAN F. SCHATZBERG, M.D. 
ALIK S. WIDGE, M.D., PH.D. 


ERIK R. VANDERLIP, M.D., 
MEMBER-IN-TRAINING TRUSTEE-ELECT 


DIAGNOSTIC AND STATISTICAL 
MANUAL OF 
MENTAL DISORDERS 


DSM-5" 


ot ATRy Cc 
QU ‘ 


* 


ee 


Norry0™” 


Washington, DC 
London, England 


Copyright © 2013 American Psychiatric Association 


DSM and DSM-5 are trademarks of the American Psychiatric Association. Use of these terms 
is prohibited without permission of the American Psychiatric Association. 


ALL RIGHTS RESERVED. Unless authorized in writing by the APA, no part of this book may 
be reproduced or used in a manner inconsistent with the APA’s copyright. This prohibition 
applies to unauthorized uses or reproductions in any form, including electronic applications. 


Correspondence regarding copyright permissions should be directed to DSM Permissions, 
American Psychiatric Publishing, 1000 Wilson Boulevard, Suite 1825, Arlington, VA 22209- 
3901. 


Manufactured in the United States of America on acid-free paper. 
ISBN 978-0-89042-554-1 (Hardcover) 2nd printing June 2013 
ISBN 978-0-89042-555-8 (Paperback) 2nd printing June 2013 


American Psychiatric Association 
1000 Wilson Boulevard 
Arlington, VA 22209-3901 
www.psych.org 


The correct citation for this book is American Psychiatric Association: Diagnostic and Statisti- 
cal Manual of Mental Disorders, Fifth Edition. Arlington, VA, American Psychiatric Associa- 
tion, 2013. 


Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data 
Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disorders : DSM-5. — 5th ed. 
p-;cm. 
DSM-5 
DSM-V 
Includes index. 
ISBN 978-0-89042-554-1 (hardcover : alk. paper) — ISBN 978-0-89042-555-8 (pbk. : alk. paper) 
I. American Psychiatric Association. II. American Psychiatric Association. DSM-5 Task Force. 
Ill. Title: DSM-5. IV. Title: DSM-V. 
[DNLM: 1. Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disorders. 5th ed. 2. Mental Disorders— 
classification. 3. Mental Disorders—diagnosis. WM 15] 
RC455.2.C4 
616.89'075—dc23 
2013011061 


British Library Cataloguing in Publication Data 
A CIP record is available from the British Library. 


Text Design—Tammy J. Cordova 
Manufacturing—R.R. Donnelley 


Contents 


DSM-5 Classification... 2... 0.00 cee eee ees xiii 
Pr@Ta CO eins fictesctinied aed cid dapat gach ca tothe oie terest lui ead ean woah eke a xli 
Section | 
DSM-5 Basics 
Introduction io Pow ce aie a ee Re ee 5 
Use. of the: Mamtlall ci nd io cece cept alee ed ice alana ee eed eee 19 
Cautionary Statement for Forensic Use of DSM-5............ 25 


Section Il 
Diagnostic Criteria and Codes 


Neurodevelopmental Disorders ...........00000e scene eeees 31 
Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders...... 87 
Bipolar and Related Disorders ..........00ee eee eeneeeneee 123 
Depressive Disorders ........0 ccc cece e eee eee 155 
Anxiety DisOrder ss esis scis iar sles eee Risa al dace wee es 189 
Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders ............. 235 
Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders............++..+5 265 
Dissociative Disorders ..........000c cece eee eee 291 
Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders ..............+.. 309 
Feeding and Eating Disorders ..........00000 eee eee eens 329 
Elimination Disorders ...........00 cece ee ee eee 355 
Sleep-Wake Disorders. .......000 cece eee eee ees 361 
Sexual DySfUNCtiONS cca e cca eiecc nse Se eee eee eee ee we 423 


Gender Dysphoria .........00 0c ee eee eee eee 451 


Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders ........ 
Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders ..............: 
Neurocognitive Disorders. ........22..00ec eee e eee eeeeeee 
Personality Disorders .......000 ccc eee e eee eee 
Paraphilic Disorders .......000 ccc eee eee 
Other Mental Disorders ...........00 cece eee eee eee 


Medication-Induced Movement Disorders 
and Other Adverse Effects of Medication ..............::. 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention. . 


Section Ill 
Emerging Measures and Models 
Assessment Measures ....... 000 c eee eee eee 
Cultural Formulation a scise ina os ee teia ieee wee was a eae as 
Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders ......... 
Conditions for Further Study .........0000 eee e eee e eens 


Appendix 
Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5............. 
Glossary of Technical Terms ...........000 0c eee eee eee 
Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress................5 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes 
(ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM)............00 ccc cece eee eee 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes 
(IGD:9-CM) i ccccitoce ure hwi arn. de eels Cees awanwes 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes 
(IGD=10-CM) s.c.nc seer ede tt Oise eee ae 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors ...........2.2008: 


DSM-5 Task Force 


DAVID J. KUPFER, M.D. 
Task Force Chair 


DARREL A. REGIER, M.D., M.P.H. 
Task Force Vice-Chair 


William E. Narrow, M.D., M.P.H., 
Research Director 


Dan G. Blazer, M.D., Ph.D., M.P.H. 
Jack D. Burke Jr., M.D., M.P.H. 
William T. Carpenter Jr., M.D. 

F. Xavier Castellanos, M.D. 

Wilson M. Compton, M.D., M.P.E. 
Joel E. Dimsdale, M.D. 

Javier I. Escobar, M.D., M.Sc. 

Jan A. Fawcett, M.D. 

Bridget F. Grant, Ph.D., Ph.D. (2009-) 
Steven E. Hyman, M.D. (2007-2012) 
Dilip V. Jeste, M.D. (2007-2011) 
Helena C. Kraemer, Ph.D. 

Daniel T. Mamah, M.D., M.P.E. 
James P. McNulty, A.B., Sc.B. 
Howard B. Moss, M.D. (2007-2009) 


Susan K. Schultz, M.D., Text Editor 
Emily A. Kuhl, Ph.D., APA Text Editor 


Charles P. O’Brien, M.D., Ph.D. 

Roger Peele, M.D. 

Katharine A. Phillips, M.D. 

Daniel S. Pine, M.D. 

Charles F. Reynolds III, M.D. 

Maritza Rubio-Stipec, Sc.D. 

David Shaffer, M.D. 

Andrew E. Skodol II, M.D. 

Susan E. Swedo, M.D. 

B. Timothy Walsh, M.D. 

Philip Wang, M.D., Dr.P.H. (2007-2012) 
William M. Womack, M.D. 

Kimberly A. Yonkers, M.D. 

Kenneth J. Zucker, Ph.D. 

Norman Sartorius, M.D., Ph.D., Consultant 


APA Division of Research Staff on DSM-5 


Darrel A. Regier, M.D., M.P.H., 
Director, Division of Research 

William E. Narrow, M.D., M.P.H., 
Associate Director 

Emily A. Kuhl, Ph.D., Senior Science 
Writer; Staff Text Editor 

Diana E. Clarke, Ph.D., M.Sc., Research 
Statistician 


Lisa H. Greiner, M.S.S.A., DSM-5 Field 
Trials Project Manager 

Eve K. Moscicki, Sc.D., M.P.H., 
Director, Practice Research Network 

S. Janet Kuramoto, Ph.D. M.H.S., 
Senior Scientific Research Associate, 
Practice Research Network 


Amy Porfiri, M.B.A. 
Director of Finance and Administration 


Jennifer J. Shupinka, Assistant Director, 
DSM Operations 

Seung-Hee Hong, DSM Senior Research 
Associate 

Anne R. Hiller, DSM Research Associate 

Alison S. Beale, DSM Research Associate 

Spencer R. Case, DSM Research Associate 


Joyce C. West, Ph.D., M.P.P., 
Health Policy Research Director, Practice 
Research Network 

Farifteh F. Duffy, Ph.D., 
Quality Care Research Director, Practice 
Research Network 

Lisa M. Countis, Field Operations 
Manager, Practice Research Network 


Christopher M. Reynolds, 
Executive Assistant 


APA Office of the Medical Director 


JAMES H. SCULLY JR., M.D. 
Medical Director and CEO 


Editorial and Coding Consultants 


Michael B. First, M.D. 


Maria N. Ward, M.Ed., RHIT, CCS-P 


DSM-5 Work Groups 


ADHD and Disruptive Behavior Disorders 
DAVID SHAFFER, M.D. 


Chair 


F. XAVIER CASTELLANOS, M.D. 


Paul J. Frick, Ph.D., Text Coordinator 


Glorisa Canino, Ph.D. 
Terrie E. Moffitt, Ph.D. 
Joel T. Nigg, Ph.D. 


Co-Chair 


Luis Augusto Rohde, M.D., Sc.D. 
Rosemary Tannock, Ph.D. 

Eric A. Taylor, M.B. 

Richard Todd, Ph.D., M.D. (d. 2008) 


Anxiety, Obsessive-Compulsive Spectrum, Posttraumatic, 
and Dissociative Disorders 


KATHARINE A. PHILLIPS, M.D. 
Chair 


Michelle G. Craske, Ph.D., Text 
Coordinator 

J. Gavin Andrews, M.D. 

Susan M. Bégels, Ph.D. 

Matthew J. Friedman, M.D., Ph.D. 

Eric Hollander, M.D. (2007-2009) 


Roberto Lewis-Fernandez, M.D., M.T.S. 


Robert S. Pynoos, M.D., M.P.H. 


Scott L. Rauch, M.D. 

H. Blair Simpson, M.D., Ph.D. 
David Spiegel, M.D. 

Dan J. Stein, M.D., Ph.D. 
Murray B. Stein, M.D. 

Robert J. Ursano, M.D. 
Hans-Ulrich Wittchen, Ph.D. 


Childhood and Adolescent Disorders 
DANIEL S. PINE, M.D. 


Ronald E. Dahl, M.D. 

E. Jane Costello, Ph.D. (2007-2009) 
Regina Smith James, M.D. 

Rachel G. Klein, Ph.D. 


Chair 


James F. Leckman, M.D. 
Ellen Leibenluft, M.D. 
Judith H. L. Rapoport, M.D. 
Charles H. Zeanah, M.D. 


Eating Disorders 
B. TIMOTHY WALSH, M.D. 


Stephen A. Wonderlich, Ph.D., 
Text Coordinator 

Evelyn Attia, M.D. 

Anne E. Becker, M.D., Ph.D., Sc.M. 

Rachel Bryant-Waugh, M.D. 

Hans W. Hoek, M.D., Ph.D. 


Chair 


Richard E. Kreipe, M.D. 

Marsha D. Marcus, Ph.D. 

James E. Mitchell, M.D. 

Ruth H. Striegel-Moore, Ph.D. 
G. Terence Wilson, Ph.D. 
Barbara E. Wolfe, Ph.D. A.P.R.N. 


Mood Disorders 
JAN A. FAWCETT, M.D. 


Ellen Frank, Ph.D., Text Coordinator 
Jules Angst, M.D. (2007-2008) 
William H. Coryell, M.D. 

Lori L. Davis, M.D. 

Raymond J. DePaulo, M.D. 

Sir David Goldberg, M.D. 

James S. Jackson, Ph.D. 


Chair 


Kenneth S. Kendler, M.D. 
(2007-2010) 

Mario Maj, M.D., Ph.D. 

Husseini K. Manji, M.D. (2007-2008) 

Michael R. Phillips, M.D. 

Trisha Suppes, M.D., Ph.D. 

Carlos A. Zarate, M.D. 


Neurocognitive Disorders 
DILIP V. JESTE, M.D. (2007-2011) 


Chair Emeritus 
DAN G. BLAZER, M.D., PH.D., M.P.H. 


Chair 
RONALD C. PETERSEN, M.D., PH.D. 
Co-Chair 
Mary Ganguli, M.D., M.P.H., Igor Grant, M.D. 


Text Coordinator 
Deborah Blacker, M.D., Sc.D. 
Warachal Faison, M.D. (2007-2008) 


Eric J. Lenze, M.D. 
Jane S. Paulsen, Ph.D. 
Perminder S. Sachdev, M.D., Ph.D. 


Neurodevelopmental Disorders 
SUSAN E. SWEDO, M.D. 


Gillian Baird, M.A., M.B., B.Chir., 
Text Coordinator 

Edwin H. Cook Jr., M.D. 

Francesca G. Happé, Ph.D. 

James C. Harris, M.D. 

Walter E. Kaufmann, M.D. 

Bryan H. King, M.D. 

Catherine E. Lord, Ph.D. 


Chair 


Joseph Piven, M.D. 

Sally J. Rogers, Ph.D. 

Sarah J. Spence, M.D., Ph.D. 
Rosemary Tannock, Ph.D. 

Fred Volkmar, M.D. (2007-2009) 
Amy M. Wetherby, Ph.D. 

Harry H. Wright, M.D. 


Personality and Personality Disorders! 
ANDREW E. SKODOL, M.D. 


Chair 


JOHN M. OLDHAM, M.D. 


Robert F. Krueger, Ph.D., Text 
Coordinator 

Renato D. Alarcon, M.D., M.P.H. 

Carl C. Bell, M.D. 

Donna S. Bender, Ph.D. 


'The members of the Personality and Personality Disorders Work Group are responsible for the 
alternative DSM-5 model for personality disorders that is included in Section III. The Section II 
personality disorders criteria and text (with updating of the text) are retained from DSM-IV-TR. 


Co-Chair 


Lee Anna Clark, Ph.D. 


W. John Livesley, M.D., Ph.D. (2007-2012) 


Leslie C. Morey, Ph.D. 
Larry J. Siever, M.D. 
Roel Verheul, Ph.D. (2008-2012) 


Psychotic Disorders 


WILLIAM T. CARPENTER JR., M.D. 
Chair 

Deanna M. Barch, Ph.D., Text Dolores Malaspina, M.D., M.S.P.H. 

Coordinator Michael J. Owen, M.D., Ph.D. 
Juan R. Bustillo, M.D. Susan K. Schultz, M.D. 
Wolfgang Gaebel, M.D. Rajiv Tandon, M.D. 
Raquel E. Gur, M.D., Ph.D. Ming T. Tsuang, M.D., Ph.D. 
Stephan H. Heckers, M.D. Jim van Os, M.D. 


Sexual and Gender Identity Disorders 
KENNETH J. ZUCKER, PH.D. 


Chair 
Lori Brotto, Ph.D., Text Coordinator Martin P. Kafka, M.D. 
Irving M. Binik, Ph.D. Richard B. Krueger, M.D. 
Ray M. Blanchard, Ph.D. Niklas Langstrém, M.D., Ph.D. 
Peggy T. Cohen-Kettenis, Ph.D. Heino F.L. Meyer-Bahlburg, Dr. rer. nat. 
Jack Drescher, M.D. Friedemann Pfafflin, M.D. 
Cynthia A. Graham, Ph.D. Robert Taylor Segraves, M.D., Ph.D. 


Sleep-Wake Disorders 
CHARLES F. REYNOLDS III, M.D. 


Chair 
Ruth M. O’Hara, Ph.D., Text Coordinator Kathy P. Parker, Ph.D., R.N. 
Charles M. Morin, Ph.D. Susan Redline, M.D., M.P.H. 
Allan I. Pack, Ph.D. Dieter Riemann, Ph.D. 


Somatic Symptom Disorders 
JOEL E. DIMSDALE, M.D. 


Chair 
James L. Levenson, M.D., Text Michael R. Irwin, M.D. 
Coordinator Francis J. Keefe, Ph.D. (2007-2011) 
Arthur J. Barsky III, M.D. Sing Lee, M.D. 
Francis Creed, M.D. Michael Sharpe, M.D. 


Nancy Frasure-Smith, Ph.D. (2007-2011) Lawson R. Wulsin, M.D. 


Substance-Related Disorders 
CHARLES P. O'BRIEN, M.D., PH.D. 


Chair 
THOMAS J. CROWLEY, M.D. 
Co-Chair 
Wilson M. Compton, M.D., M.P.E., Thomas R. Kosten, M.D. (2007-2008) 
Text Coordinator Walter Ling, M.D. 
Marc Auriacombe, M.D. Spero M. Manson, Ph.D. (2007-2008) 
Guilherme L. G. Borges, M.D., Dr.Sc. A. Thomas McLellan, Ph.D. (2007-2008) 
Kathleen K. Bucholz, Ph.D. Nancy M. Petry, Ph.D. 
Alan J. Budney, Ph.D. Marc A. Schuckit, M.D. 
Bridget F. Grant, Ph.D., Ph.D. Wim van den Brink, M.D., Ph.D. 


Deborah S. Hasin, Ph.D. (2007-2008) 


DSM-5 Study Groups 


Diagnostic Spectra and DSM/ICD Harmonization 


STEVEN E. HYMAN, M.D. 
Chair (2007-2012) 


William T. Carpenter Jr., M.D. William E. Narrow, M.D., M.P.H. 
Wilson M. Compton, M.D., M.P.E. Charles P. O’Brien, M.D., Ph.D. 
Jan A. Fawcett, M.D. John M. Oldham, M.D. 

Helena C. Kraemer, Ph.D. Katharine A. Phillips, M.D. 
David J. Kupfer, M.D. Darrel A. Regier, M.D., M.P.H. 


Lifespan Developmental Approaches 


ERIC J. LENZE, M.D. 
Chair 


SUSAN K. SCHULTZ, M.D. 
Chair Emeritus 


DANIEL S. PINE, M.D. 
Chair Emeritus 


Dan G. Blazer, M.D., Ph.D., M.P.H. Daniel T. Mamah, M.D., M.P.E. 
F. Xavier Castellanos, M.D. Andrew E. Skodol II, M.D. 
Wilson M. Compton, M.D., M.P.E. Susan E. Swedo, M.D. 


Gender and Cross-Cultural Issues 


KIMBERLY A. YONKERS, M.D. 
Chair 


ROBERTO LEWIS-FERNANDEZ, M.D., M.T.S. 
Co-Chair, Cross-Cultural Issues 


Renato D. Alarcon, M.D., M.P.H. Leslie C. Morey, Ph.D. 

Diana E. Clarke, Ph.D., M.Sc. William E. Narrow, M.D., M.P.H. 
Javier I. Escobar, M.D., M.Sc. Roger Peele, M.D. 

Ellen Frank, Ph.D. Philip Wang, M.D., Dr.P.H. (2007-2012) 
James S. Jackson, Ph.D. William M. Womack, M.D. 

Spiro M. Manson, Ph.D. (2007-2008) Kenneth J. Zucker, Ph.D. 


James P. McNulty, A.B., Sc.B. 


Psychiatric/General Medical Interface 
LAWSON R. WULSIN, M.D. 


Chair 
Ronald E. Dahl, M.D. Richard E. Kreipe, M.D. 
Joel E. Dimsdale, M.D. Ronald C. Petersen, Ph.D., M.D. 
Javier I. Escobar, M.D., M.Sc. Charles F. Reynolds III, M.D. 
Dilip V. Jeste, M.D. (2007-2011) Robert Taylor Segraves, M.D., Ph.D. 


Walter E. Kaufmann, M.D. B. Timothy Walsh, M.D. 


Impairment and Disability 
JANE S. PAULSEN, PH.D. 


Chair 
J. Gavin Andrews, M.D. Hans W. Hoek, M.D., Ph.D. 
Glorisa Canino, Ph.D. Helena C. Kraemer, Ph.D. 
Lee Anna Clark, Ph.D. William E. Narrow, M.D., M.P.H. 
Diana E. Clarke, Ph.D., M.Sc. David Shaffer, M.D. 


Michelle G. Craske, Ph.D. 


Diagnostic Assessment Instruments 
JACK D. BURKE JR., M.D., M.P.H. 


Chair 
Lee Anna Clark, Ph.D. Helena C. Kraemer, Ph.D. 
Diana E. Clarke, Ph.D., M.Sc. William E. Narrow, M.D., M.P.H. 
Bridget F. Grant, Ph.D., Ph.D. David Shaffer, M.D. 


DSM-5 Research Group 
WILLIAM E. NARROW, M.D., M.P.H. 


Chair 
Jack D. Burke Jr., M.D., M.P.H. David J. Kupfer, M.D. 
Diana E. Clarke, Ph.D., M.Sc. Darrel A. Regier, M.D., M.P.H. 
Helena C. Kraemer, Ph.D. David Shaffer, M.D. 


Course Specifiers and Glossary 


WOLFGANG GAEBEL, M.D. 


Chair 
Ellen Frank, Ph.D. Dan J. Stein, M.D., Ph.D. 
Charles P. O’Brien, M.D., Ph.D. Eric A. Taylor, M.B. 
Norman Sartorius, M.D., Ph.D., David J. Kupfer, M.D. 
Consultant Darrel A. Regier, M.D., M.P.H. 


Susan K. Schultz, M.D. 


DSM-5 
Classification 


Before each disorder name, ICD-9-CM codes are provided, followed by ICD-10-CM codes 
in parentheses. Blank lines indicate that either the ICD-9-CM or the ICD-10-CM code is not 
applicable. For some disorders, the code can be indicated only according to the subtype or 
specifier. 

ICD-9-CM codes are to be used for coding purposes in the United States through Sep- 
tember 30, 2014. ICD-10-CM codes are to be used starting October 1, 2014. 

Following chapter titles and disorder names, page numbers for the corresponding text 
or criteria are included in parentheses. 

Note for all mental disorders due to another medical condition: Indicate the name of 
the other medical condition in the name of the mental disorder due to [the medical condi- 
tion]. The code and name for the other medical condition should be listed first immedi- 
ately before the mental disorder due to the medical condition. 


Neurodevelopmental Disorders (31) 


Intellectual Disabilities (83) 


eee Cee | Intellectual Disability (Intellectual Developmental Disorder) (33) 
Specify current severity: 


317  (F70) Mild 

318.0 (F71) Moderate 

318.1 (F72) Severe 

318.2 (F73) Profound 

315.8 (F838) Global Developmental Delay (41) 

319  (F79) Unspecified Intellectual Disability (Intellectual Developmental 


Disorder) (41) 


Communication Disorders (41) 
315.32 (F80.2) Language Disorder (42) 
315.39 (F80.0) Speech Sound Disorder (44) 


315.35 (F80.81) | Childhood-Onset Fluency Disorder (Stuttering) (45) 


Note: Later-onset cases are diagnosed as 307.0 (F98.5) adult-onset fluency 
disorder. 


315.39 (F80.89) Social (Pragmatic) Communication Disorder (47) 
307.9 (F80.9) Unspecified Communication Disorder (49) 


xiii 


xiv DSM-5 Classification 


Autism Spectrum Disorder (50) 


299.00 (F84.0) Autism Spectrum Disorder (50) 

Specify if: Associated with a known medical or genetic condition or envi- 
ronmental factor; Associated with another neurodevelopmental, men- 
tal, or behavioral disorder 

Specify current severity for Criterion A and Criterion B: Requiring very 
substantial support, Requiring substantial support, Requiring support 

Specify if: With or without accompanying intellectual impairment, With 
or without accompanying language impairment, With catatonia (use 
additional code 293.89 [F06.1]) 


Attention-Deficit/Hyperactivity Disorder (59) 
_. (__._) = Attention-Deficit/ Hyperactivity Disorder (59) 


Specify whether: 
314.01 (F90.2) Combined presentation 
314.00 (F90.0) Predominantly inattentive presentation 
314.01 (F90.1) Predominantly hyperactive/impulsive presentation 


Specify if: In partial remission 
Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


314.01 (F90.8) Other Specified Attention-Deficit /Hyperactivity Disorder (65) 
314.01 (F90.9) Unspecified Attention-Deficit/ Hyperactivity Disorder (66) 


Specific Learning Disorder (66) 


ee ere Specific Learning Disorder (66) 
Specify if: 

315.00 (F31.0) With impairment in reading (specify if with word reading 
accuracy, reading rate or fluency, reading comprehension) 

315.2 (F81.81) With impairment in written expression (specify if with spelling 
accuracy, grammar and punctuation accuracy, clarity or 
organization of written expression) 

315.1 (F81.2) With impairment in mathematics (specify if with number sense, 
memorization of arithmetic facts, accurate or fluent 
calculation, accurate math reasoning) 

Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


Motor Disorders (74) 
315.4 (F82) Developmental Coordination Disorder (74) 


307.3 (F98.4) Stereotypic Movement Disorder (77) 
Specify if: With self-injurious behavior, Without self-injurious behavior 
Specify if: Associated with a known medical or genetic condition, neuro- 
developmental disorder, or environmental factor 
Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 
Tic Disorders 
307.23 (F95.2) Tourette's Disorder (81) 
307.22 (F95.1) Persistent (Chronic) Motor or Vocal Tic Disorder (81) 
Specify if: With motor tics only, With vocal tics only 


DSM-5 Classification xv 


307.21 (F95.0) Provisional Tic Disorder (81) 
307.20 (F95.8) Other Specified Tic Disorder (85) 
307.20 (F95.9) Unspecified Tic Disorder (85) 


Other Neurodevelopmental Disorders (86) 
315.8 (F838) Other Specified Neurodevelopmental Disorder (86) 
315.9 (F89) Unspecified Neurodevelopmental Disorder (86) 


Schizophrenia Spectrum 
and Other Psychotic Disorders (87) 


The following specifiers apply to Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 

where indicated: 

Specify if: The following course specifiers are only to be used after a 1-year duration of the dis- 
order: First episode, currently in acute episode; First episode, currently in partial remission; 
First episode, currently in full remission; Multiple episodes, currently in acute episode; Mul- 
tiple episodes, currently in partial remission; Multiple episodes, currently in full remission; 
Continuous; Unspecified 

> Specify if: With catatonia (use additional code 293.89 [F06.1]) 

“Specify current severity of delusions, hallucinations, disorganized speech, abnormal psycho- 
motor behavior, negative symptoms, impaired cognition, depression, and mania symptoms 


301.22 (F21) Schizotypal (Personality) Disorder (90) 


297.1 (F22) Delusional Disorder® © (90) 
Specify whether: Erotomanic type, Grandiose type, Jealous type, Persecu- 
tory type, Somatic type, Mixed type, Unspecified type 
Specify if: With bizarre content 
298.8 (F23) Brief Psychotic Disorder” ¢ (94) 
Specify if: With marked stressor(s), Without marked stressor(s), With 
postpartum onset 
295.40 (F20.81) | Schizophreniform Disorder” ¢ (96) 
Specify if: With good prognostic features, Without good prognostic fea- 
tures 


295.90 (F20.9)  Schizophrenia® >< (99) 


4 (__._) — Schizoaffective Disorder” » © (105) 


Specify whether: 
295.70 (F25.0) Bipolar type 
295.70 (F25.1) Depressive type 


eee (ee Substance /Medication-Induced Psychotic Disorder‘ (110) 
Note: See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures for 
substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 
Specify if: With onset during intoxication, With onset during withdrawal 


_ 2% (i =e) Psychotic Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition‘ (115) 
Specify whether: 

293.81 (FO6.2) With delusions 

293.82 (FO6.0) With hallucinations 


xvi 


293.89 (FO6.1) 


293.89 (FO6.1) 
293.89 (FO6.1) 


298.8 (F28) 


298.9 (F29) 


DSM-5 Classification 


Catatonia Associated With Another Mental Disorder (Catatonia 
Specifier) (119) 

Catatonic Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition (120) 

Unspecified Catatonia (121) 


Note: Code first 781.99 (R29.818) other symptoms involving nervous and 
musculoskeletal systems. 


Other Specified Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic 
Disorder (122) 


Unspecified Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic 
Disorder (122) 


Bipolar and Related Disorders (123) 


The following specifiers apply to Bipolar and Related Disorders where indicated: 

Specify: With anxious distress (specify current severity: mild, moderate, moderate-severe, severe); 
With mixed features; With rapid cycling; With melancholic features; With atypical features; 
With mood-congruent psychotic features; With mood-incongruent psychotic features; With 
catatonia (use additional code 293.89 [F06.1]); With peripartum onset; With seasonal pattern 


ee eens (oe | 
= 65 (Ene) 
296.41 (F31.11) 
296.42 (F31.12) 
296.43 (F31.13) 
296.44 (F31.2) 
296.45 (F31.73) 
296.46 (F31.74) 
296.40 (F31.9) 
296.40 (F31.0) 
296.45 (F31.71) 
296.46 (F31.72) 
296.40 (F31.9) 
pst es (es) 
296.51 (F31.31) 
296.52 (F31.32) 
296.53 (F31.4) 
296.54 (F31.5) 
296.55 (F31.75) 
296.56 (F31.76) 
296.50 (F31.9) 
296.7 (F31.9) 


296.89 (F31.81) 


Bipolar I Disorder* (123) 

Current or most recent episode manic 
Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 
With psychotic features 
In partial remission 
In full remission 
Unspecified 

Current or most recent episode hypomanic 
In partial remission 
In full remission 
Unspecified 

Current or most recent episode depressed 
Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 
With psychotic features 
In partial remission 
In full remission 
Unspecified 

Current or most recent episode unspecified 


Bipolar II Disorder* (132) 

Specify current or most recent episode: Hypomanic, Depressed 

Specify course if full criteria for a mood episode are not currently met: In 
partial remission, In full remission 

Specify severity if full criteria for a mood episode are currently met: 
Mild, Moderate, Severe 


DSM-5 Classification 


301.13 (F34.0) 


ee ee ee 


293.83 (__._) 


(F06.33) 
(F06.33) 
(F06.34) 


296.89 (F31.89) 
296.80 (F31.9) 


xvii 


Cyclothymic Disorder (139) 
Specify if: With anxious distress 


Substance /Medication-Induced Bipolar and Related Disorder (142) 
Note: See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures for 
substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 
Specify if: With onset during intoxication, With onset during withdrawal 
Bipolar and Related Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 
(145) 

Specify if: 

With manic features 

With manic- or hypomanic-like episode 

With mixed features 
Other Specified Bipolar and Related Disorder (148) 


Unspecified Bipolar and Related Disorder (149) 


Depressive Disorders (155) 


The following specifiers apply to Depressive Disorders where indicated: 

“Specify: With anxious distress (specify current severity: mild, moderate, moderate-severe, 
severe); With mixed features; With melancholic features; With atypical features; With mood- 
congruent psychotic features; With mood-incongruent psychotic features; With catatonia 
(use additional code 293.89 [F06.1]); With peripartum onset; With seasonal pattern 


296.99 (F34.3) 


wee (es) 
5 Sie (A em 5) 
296.21 (F32.0) 
296.22 (F32.1) 
296.23 (F32.2) 
296.24 (F32.3) 
296.25 (F32.4) 
296.26 (F32.5) 
296.20 (F32.9) 
25.3, (in) 
296.31 (F33.0) 
296.32 (F33.1) 
296.33 (F33.2) 
296.34 (F33.3) 
296.35 (F33.41) 
296.36 (F33.42) 
296.30 (F33.9) 


300.4 (F34.1) 


Disruptive Mood Dysregulation Disorder (156) 


Major Depressive Disorder* (160) 
Single episode 
Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 
With psychotic features 
In partial remission 
In full remission 
Unspecified 
Recurrent episode 
Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 
With psychotic features 
In partial remission 
In full remission 
Unspecified 


Persistent Depressive Disorder (Dysthymia)* (168) 

Specify if: In partial remission, In full remission 

Specify if: Early onset, Late onset 

Specify if: With pure dysthymic syndrome; With persistent major depres- 
sive episode; With intermittent major depressive episodes, with current 


xviii 


625.4 (N94.3) 
aoe =, Ces) 


293.83 (_._) 
(F06.31) 
(F06.32) 
(F06.34) 

311 (F32.8) 

311 (F32.9) 


DSM-5 Classification 


episode; With intermittent major depressive episodes, without current 
episode 
Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


Premenstrual Dysphoric Disorder (171) 


Substance /Medication-Induced Depressive Disorder (175) 
Note: See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures for 
substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 

Specify if: With onset during intoxication, With onset during withdrawal 
Depressive Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition (180) 
Specify if: 

With depressive features 

With major depressive-like episode 

With mixed features 
Other Specified Depressive Disorder (183) 


Unspecified Depressive Disorder (184) 


Anxiety Disorders (189) 


309.21 (F93.0) 
313.23 (F94.0) 


300.29 (__._) 


(F40.218) 
(F40.228) 


(__._) 

(F40.230) 
(F40.231) 
(F40.232) 
(F40.233) 


(F40.248) 
(F40.298) 


300.23 (F40.10) 


300.01 (F41.0) 
—.  (_.) 
300.22 (F40.00) 
300.02 (F41.1) 


Sut he) 


Separation Anxiety Disorder (190) 
Selective Mutism (195) 


Specific Phobia (197) 
Specify if: 
Animal 
Natural environment 
Blood-injection-injury 
Fear of blood 
Fear of injections and transfusions 
Fear of other medical care 
Fear of injury 
Situational 
Other 
Social Anxiety Disorder (Social Phobia) (202) 
Specify if: Performance only 
Panic Disorder (208) 
Panic Attack Specifier (214) 
Agoraphobia (217) 
Generalized Anxiety Disorder (222) 


Substance/Medication-Induced Anxiety Disorder (226) 

Note: See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures for 
substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 

Specify if: With onset during intoxication, With onset during withdrawal, 
With onset after medication use 


DSM-5 Classification xix 


293.84 (F06.4) 
300.09 (F41.3) 
300.00 (F41.9) 


Anxiety Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition (230) 
Other Specified Anxiety Disorder (233) 
Unspecified Anxiety Disorder (233) 


Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders (235) 


The following specifier applies to Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders where indicated: 
“Specify if: With good or fair insight, With poor insight, With absent insight /delusional beliefs 


300.3 (F42) 
300.7 (F45.22) 
300.3 (F42) 


312.39 (F63.3) 


698.4 (L98.1) 
oe =) 
294.8 (F06.8) 
300.3 (F42) 
300.3 (F42) 


Obsessive-Compulsive Disorder* (237) 

Specify if: Tic-related 

Body Dysmorphic Disorder* (242) 

Specify if: With muscle dysmorphia 

Hoarding Disorder (247) 

Specify if: With excessive acquisition 
Trichotillomania (Hair-Pulling Disorder) (251) 
Excoriation (Skin-Picking) Disorder (254) 


Substance /Medication-Induced Obsessive-Compulsive and 
Related Disorder (257) 

Note: See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures for 
substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 

Specify if: With onset during intoxication, With onset during withdrawal, 
With onset after medication use 

Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder Due to Another 

Medical Condition (260) 

Specify if: With obsessive-compulsive disorder-like symptoms, With 
appearance preoccupations, With hoarding symptoms, With hair- 
pulling symptoms, With skin-picking symptoms 

Other Specified Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder 

(263) 


Unspecified Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder (264) 


Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders (265) 


313.89 (F94.1) 


313.89 (F94.2) 


309.81 (F43.10) 


308.3 (F43.0) 


Reactive Attachment Disorder (265) 

Specify if: Persistent 

Specify current severity: Severe 

Disinhibited Social Engagement Disorder (268) 

Specify if: Persistent 

Specify current severity: Severe 

Posttraumatic Stress Disorder (includes Posttraumatic Stress 
Disorder for Children 6 Years and Younger) (271) 

Specify whether: With dissociative symptoms 

Specify if: With delayed expression 


Acute Stress Disorder (280) 


XX 


ny eee 


309.0 (F43.21) 
309.24 (F43.22) 
309.28 (F43.23) 
309.3 (F43.24) 
309.4 (F43.25) 
309.9 (F43.20) 
309.89 (F43.8) 


309.9 (F43.9) 


DSM-5 Classification 


Adjustment Disorders (286) 
Specify whether: 
With depressed mood 
With anxiety 
With mixed anxiety and depressed mood 
With disturbance of conduct 
With mixed disturbance of emotions and conduct 
Unspecified 
Other Specified Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorder (289) 
Unspecified Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorder (290) 


Dissociative Disorders (291) 


300.14 (F44.81) 
300.12 (F44.0) 


300.13 (F44.1) 
300.6 (F48.1) 
300.15 (F44.89) 
300.15 (F44.9) 


Dissociative Identity Disorder (292) 


Dissociative Amnesia (298) 
Specify if: 
With dissociative fugue 


Depersonalization/Derealization Disorder (302) 
Other Specified Dissociative Disorder (306) 
Unspecified Dissociative Disorder (307) 


Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders (309) 


300.82 (F45.1) 


300.7 (F45.21) 


300.11 (_._) 


(F44.4) 
(F44.4) 
(F44.4) 
(F44.4) 
(F44.5) 
(F44.6) 
(F44.6) 
(F44.7) 


Somatic Symptom Disorder (311) 

Specify if: With predominant pain 

Specify if: Persistent 

Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


Illness Anxiety Disorder (315) 
Specify whether: Care seeking type, Care avoidant type 
Conversion Disorder (Functional Neurological Symptom 
Disorder) (318) 
Specify symptom type: 
With weakness or paralysis 
With abnormal movement 
With swallowing symptoms 
With speech symptom 
With attacks or seizures 
With anesthesia or sensory loss 
With special sensory symptom 


With mixed symptoms 
Specify if: Acute episode, Persistent 
Specify if: With psychological stressor (specify stressor), Without psycho- 
logical stressor 


DSM-5 Classification xxi 


316 = (F54) Psychological Factors Affecting Other Medical Conditions (322) 
Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe, Extreme 


300.19 (F68.10) Factitious Disorder (includes Factitious Disorder Imposed on Self, 
Factitious Disorder Imposed on Another) (324) 
Specify Single episode, Recurrent episodes 


300.89 (F45.8) Other Specified Somatic Symptom and Related Disorder (327) 
300.82 (F45.9) Unspecified Somatic Symptom and Related Disorder (327) 


Feeding and Eating Disorders (329) 


The following specifiers apply to Feeding and Eating Disorders where indicated: 
“Specify if: In remission 

> Specify if: In partial remission, In full remission 

“Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe, Extreme 


307.52 (__._ +) Pica® (329) 
(F98.3) In children 
(F50.8) In adults 


307.53 (F98.21) | Rumination Disorder? (332) 
307.59 (F50.8) Avoidant/Restrictive Food Intake Disorder® (334) 
307.1 (__._) Anorexia Nervosa?’ ¢ (338) 


Specify whether: 
(F50.01) Restricting type 
(F50.02) Binge-eating / purging type 


307.51 (F50.2) Bulimia Nervosa?’ ¢ (345) 

307.51 (F50.8) — Binge-Eating Disorder’ ¢ (350) 

307.59 (F50.8) Other Specified Feeding or Eating Disorder (353) 
307.50 (F50.9) Unspecified Feeding or Eating Disorder (354) 


Elimination Disorders (355) 


307.6 (F98.0) Enuresis (355) 
Specify whether: Nocturnal only, Diurnal only, Nocturnal and diurnal 


307.7 (F98.1) Encopresis (357) 
Specify whether: With constipation and overflow incontinence, Without 
constipation and overflow incontinence 


som s Ge) Other Specified Elimination Disorder (359) 
788.39 (N39.498) With urinary symptoms 


787.60 (R15.9) With fecal symptoms 
ee ee Unspecified Elimination Disorder (360) 
788.30 (R32) With urinary symptoms 


787.60 (R15.9) With fecal symptoms 


xxii 


DSM-5 Classification 


Sleep-Wake Disorders (361) 


The following specifiers apply to Sleep-Wake Disorders where indicated: 
“Specify if: Episodic, Persistent, Recurrent 

>specify if: Acute, Subacute, Persistent 

“Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


307.42 (F51.01) 


307.44 (F51.11) 


= I) 


347.00 (G47.419) 
347.01 (G47.411) 
347.00 (G47.419) 


347.00 (G47.419) 
347.10 (G47.429) 


Insomnia Disorder* (362) 
Specify if: With non-sleep disorder mental comorbidity, With other 
medical comorbidity, With other sleep disorder 


Hypersomnolence Disorder” ¢ (368) 
Specify if: With mental disorder, With medical condition, With another 
sleep disorder 


Narcolepsy‘ (372) 

Specify whether: 
Narcolepsy without cataplexy but with hypocretin deficiency 
Narcolepsy with cataplexy but without hypocretin deficiency 
Autosomal dominant cerebellar ataxia, deafness, and 

narcolepsy 

Autosomal dominant narcolepsy, obesity, and type 2 diabetes 
Narcolepsy secondary to another medical condition 


Breathing-Related Sleep Disorders (378) 


327.23 (G47.33) 
ebay rhe a} 


327.21 (G47.31) 
786.04 (RO6.3) 
780.57 (G47.37) 


= fs) 


327.24 (G47.34) 
327.25 (G47.35) 
327.26 (G47.36) 


LenS (Meee! | 
307.45 (G47.21) 
307.45 (G47.22) 


307.45 (G47.23) 
307.45 (G47.24) 


Obstructive Sleep Apnea Hypopnea‘ (378) 


Central Sleep Apnea (383) 

Specify whether: 
Idiopathic central sleep apnea 
Cheyne-Stokes breathing 
Central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid use 
Note: First code opioid use disorder, if present. 
Specify current severity 

Sleep-Related Hypoventilation (387) 

Specify whether: 
Idiopathic hypoventilation 
Congenital central alveolar hypoventilation 
Comorbid sleep-related hypoventilation 
Specify current severity 


Circadian Rhythm Sleep-Wake Disorders (390) 
Specify whether: 
Delayed sleep phase type (391) 
Specify if: Familial, Overlapping with non-24-hour sleep-wake type 
Advanced sleep phase type (393) 
Specify if: Familial 
Irregular sleep-wake type (394) 
Non-24-hour sleep-wake type (396) 


DSM-5 Classification xxiii 


307.45 (G47.26) 
307.45 (G47.20) 


Shift work type (397) 
Unspecified type 


Parasomnias (399) 


ee ee 


307.46 (F51.3) 


307.46 (F51.4) 
307.47 (F51.5) 


327.42 (G47.52) 
333.94 (G25.81) 


ties Mag) 


780.52 (G47.09) 
780.52 (G47.00) 
780.54 (G47.19) 
780.54 (G47.10) 
780.59 (G47.8) 
780.59 (G47.9) 


Non-Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Arousal Disorders (399) 
Specify whether: 
Sleepwalking type 
Specify if: With sleep-related eating, With sleep-related sexual 
behavior (sexsomnia) 


Sleep terror type 

Nightmare Disorder” ¢ (404) 

Specify if: During sleep onset 

Specify if: With associated non-sleep disorder, With associated other 
medical condition, With associated other sleep disorder 

Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Behavior Disorder (407) 


Restless Legs Syndrome (410) 


Substance /Medication-Induced Sleep Disorder (413) 

Note: See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures for 
substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 

Specify whether: Insomnia type, Daytime sleepiness type, Parasomnia 
type, Mixed type 

Specify if: With onset during intoxication, With onset during discontinua- 
tion/withdrawal 


Other Specified Insomnia Disorder (420) 
Unspecified Insomnia Disorder (420) 

Other Specified Hypersomnolence Disorder (421) 
Unspecified Hypersomnolence Disorder (421) 
Other Specified Sleep-Wake Disorder (421) 
Unspecified Sleep-Wake Disorder (422) 


Sexual Dysfunctions (423) 


The following specifiers apply to Sexual Dysfunctions where indicated: 
“Specify whether: Lifelong, Acquired 

> Specify whether: Generalized, Situational 

“Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


302.74 (F52.32) 
302.72 (F52.21) 
302.73 (F52.31) 


302.72 (F52.22) 
302.76 (F52.6) 


Delayed Ejaculation” >’ ¢ (424) 
Erectile Disorder” > ¢ (426) 


Female Orgasmic Disorder” b,¢ (429) 
Specify if: Never experienced an orgasm under any situation 


Female Sexual Interest / Arousal Disorder” >’ ¢ (433) 


Genito-Pelvic Pain/Penetration Disorder” © (437) 


XXxiv 


302.71 (F52.0) 
302.75 (F52.4) 


oe eee 


302.79 (F52.3) 
302.70 (F52.9) 


DSM-5 Classification 


Male Hypoactive Sexual Desire Disorder® > ¢ (440) 

Premature (Early) Ejaculation” b,c (443) 

Substance /Medication-Induced Sexual Dysfunction‘ (446) 

Note: See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures for 
substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 


Specify if: With onset during intoxication, With onset during withdrawal, 
With onset after medication use 


Other Specified Sexual Dysfunction (450) 
Unspecified Sexual Dysfunction (450) 


Gender Dysphoria (451) 


og, Gag 
302.6 (F64.2) 


302.85 (F64.1) 


302.6 (F64.8) 
302.6 (F64.9) 


Gender Dysphoria (452) 
Gender Dysphoria in Children 
Specify if: With a disorder of sex development 
Gender Dysphoria in Adolescents and Adults 
Specify if: With a disorder of sex development 
Specify if: Posttransition 
Note: Code the disorder of sex development if present, in addition to 
gender dysphoria. 


Other Specified Gender Dysphoria (459) 
Unspecified Gender Dysphoria (459) 


Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders (461) 


313.81 (F91.3) 


312.34 (F63.81) 
eer eee eee 


312.81 (F91.1) 
312.82 (F91.2) 
312.89 (F91.9) 


301.7 (F60.2) 
312.33 (F63.1) 
312.32 (F63.2) 
312.89 (F91.8) 


312.9 (F91.9) 


Oppositional Defiant Disorder (462) 
Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


Intermittent Explosive Disorder (466) 
Conduct Disorder (469) 
Specify whether: 
Childhood-onset type 
Adolescent-onset type 


Unspecified onset 
Specify if: With limited prosocial emotions 
Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


Antisocial Personality Disorder (476) 
Pyromania (476) 
Kleptomania (478) 


Other Specified Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct 
Disorder (479) 


Unspecified Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorder 
(480) 


DSM-5 Classification XXV 


Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders (481) 


The following specifiers and note apply to Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders where 

indicated: 

“Specify if: In early remission, In sustained remission 

> Specify if: In a controlled environment 

“Specify if: With perceptual disturbances 

The ICD-10-CM code indicates the comorbid presence of a moderate or severe substance use 
disorder, which must be present in order to apply the code for substance withdrawal. 


Substance-Related Disorders (483) 
Alcohol-Related Disorders (490) 


__. (__._) — Alcohol Use Disorder” © (490) 
Specify current severity: 

305.00 (F10.10) Mild 

303.90 (F10.20) Moderate 

303.90 (F10.20) Severe 


303.00 (_. ) Alcohol Intoxication (497) 
(F10.129) With use disorder, mild 
(F10.229) With use disorder, moderate or severe 
(F10.929) Without use disorder 


291.81 (__._) — Alcohol Withdrawal 4 (499) 
(F10.239) Without perceptual disturbances 
(F10.232) With perceptual disturbances 


eee eee | Other Alcohol-Induced Disorders (502) 
291.9 (F10.99) Unspecified Alcohol-Related Disorder (503) 


Caffeine-Related Disorders (503) 

305.90 (F15.929) Caffeine Intoxication (503) 

292.0 (F15.93) Caffeine Withdrawal (506) 

aera (ne oa} Other Caffeine-Induced Disorders (508) 
292.9 (F15.99) Unspecified Caffeine-Related Disorder (509) 


Cannabis-Related Disorders (509) 


_. (__._) ~~ Cannabis Use Disorder* > (509) 
Specify current severity: 

305.20 (F12.10) Mild 

304.30 (F12.20) Moderate 

304.30 (F12.20) Severe 


Xxvi 


292.89 (__._) 


(F12.129) 
(F12.229) 
(F12.929) 


(F12.122) 
(F12.222) 
(F12.922) 


292.0 (F12.288) 
wets An 2) 
292.9 (F12.99) 


DSM-5 Classification 


Cannabis Intoxication‘ (516) 
Without perceptual disturbances 
With use disorder, mild 
With use disorder, moderate or severe 
Without use disorder 
With perceptual disturbances 
With use disorder, mild 
With use disorder, moderate or severe 
Without use disorder 
Cannabis Withdrawal‘ (517) 
Other Cannabis-Induced Disorders (519) 


Unspecified Cannabis-Related Disorder (519) 


Hallucinogen-Related Disorders (520) 


ee ee ee 


305.90 (F16.10) 
304.60 (F16.20) 
304.60 (F16.20) 


eget (ae) 


305.30 (F16.10) 
304.50 (F16.20) 
304.50 (F16.20) 


292.89 ( ._) 
(F16.129) 
(F16.229) 
(F16.929) 


292.89 (_._) 
(F16.129) 
(F16.229) 
(F16.929) 


292.89 (F16.983) 
esteet Cnet} 
a Eaten As oe) 
292.9 (F16.99) 
292.9 (F16.99) 


Phencyclidine Use Disorder® > (520) 
Specify current severity: 

Mild 

Moderate 

Severe 
Other Hallucinogen Use Disorder” » (523) 


Specify the particular hallucinogen 
Specify current severity: 


Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 


Phencyclidine Intoxication (527) 
With use disorder, mild 
With use disorder, moderate or severe 
Without use disorder 
Other Hallucinogen Intoxication (529) 
With use disorder, mild 
With use disorder, moderate or severe 
Without use disorder 
Hallucinogen Persisting Perception Disorder (531) 
Other Phencyclidine-Induced Disorders (532) 
Other Hallucinogen-Induced Disorders (532) 
Unspecified Phencyclidine-Related Disorder (533) 
Unspecified Hallucinogen-Related Disorder (533) 


Inhalant-Related Disorders (533) 


Jae, (oe) 


305.90 (F18.10) 


Inhalant Use Disorder® © (533) 
Specify the particular inhalant 
Specify current severity: 


Mild 


DSM-5 Classification XXvii 


304.60 (F18.20) Moderate 
304.60 (F18.20) Severe 


292.89 (__._) Inhalant Intoxication (538) 
(F18.129) With use disorder, mild 
(F18.229) With use disorder, moderate or severe 
(F18.929) Without use disorder 
wits I} Other Inhalant-Induced Disorders (540) 
292.9 (F18.99) Unspecified Inhalant-Related Disorder (540) 


Opioid-Related Disorders (540) 


__._ (__._) — Opioid Use Disorder* (541) 
Specify if: On maintenance therapy, In a controlled environment 
Specify current severity: 


305.50 (F11.10) Mild 
304.00 (F11.20) Moderate 
304.00 (F11.20) Severe 


292.89 (__. _) Opioid Intoxication‘ (546) 
Without perceptual disturbances 


(F11.129) With use disorder, mild 
(F11.229) With use disorder, moderate or severe 
(F11.929) Without use disorder 

With perceptual disturbances 
(F11.122) With use disorder, mild 
(F11.222) With use disorder, moderate or severe 
(F11.922) Without use disorder 


292.0 (F11.23) Opioid Withdrawal‘ (547) 
eer ee) (eee Other Opioid-Induced Disorders (549) 
292.9 (F11.99) Unspecified Opioid-Related Disorder (550) 


Sedative-, Hypnotic-, or Anxiolytic-Related Disorders (550) 


ee Si 29) Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Use Disorder” b (550) 
Specify current severity: 

305.40 (F13.10) Mild 

304.10 (F13.20) Moderate 

304.10 (F13.20) Severe 


292.89 (__._) Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Intoxication (556) 
(F13.129) With use disorder, mild 
(F13.229) With use disorder, moderate or severe 
(F13.929) Without use disorder 


292.0 (__._) Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Withdrawal” d (557) 
(F13.239) Without perceptual disturbances 
(F13.232) With perceptual disturbances 


XXViii 


ep Ve) 


292.9 (F13.99) 


DSM-5 Classification 


Other Sedative-, Hypnotic-, or Anxiolytic-Induced Disorders 
(560) 


Unspecified Sedative-, Hypnotic-, or Anxiolytic-Related Disorder 
(560) 


Stimulant-Related Disorders (561) 


—-— (_._) 


a aes MG <4) 
305.70 (F15.10) 
305.60 (F14.10) 
305.70 (F15.10) 
ees eee 
304.40 (F 15.20) 
304.20 (F 14.20) 
304.40 (F 15.20) 
ees eee 
304.40 (F15.20) 
304.20 (F 14.20) 
304.40 (F15.20) 


292.89 (__._) 
292.89 (__._) 


(F15.129) 
(F15.229) 
(F15.929) 
292.89 ( ._) 
(F14.129) 
(F14.229) 
(F14.929) 
292.89 (_._) 


(F15.122) 
(F15.222) 
(F15.922) 


292.89 ( ._) 
(F14.122) 
(F14.222) 
(F14.922) 


292.0 (_._) 
(F15.23) 


(F14.23) 
_. (_._) 


Stimulant Use Disorder® © (561) 
Specify current severity: 
Mild 
Amphetamine-type substance 
Cocaine 
Other or unspecified stimulant 
Moderate 
Amphetamine-type substance 
Cocaine 
Other or unspecified stimulant 
Severe 
Amphetamine-type substance 
Cocaine 
Other or unspecified stimulant 


Stimulant Intoxication‘ (567) 
Specify the specific intoxicant 
Amphetamine or other stimulant, Without perceptual 
disturbances 

With use disorder, mild 
With use disorder, moderate or severe 
Without use disorder 

Cocaine, Without perceptual disturbances 
With use disorder, mild 
With use disorder, moderate or severe 
Without use disorder 

Amphetamine or other stimulant, With perceptual 

disturbances 

With use disorder, mild 
With use disorder, moderate or severe 
Without use disorder 

Cocaine, With perceptual disturbances 
With use disorder, mild 
With use disorder, moderate or severe 
Without use disorder 


Stimulant Withdrawal® (569) 

Specify the specific substance causing the withdrawal syndrome 
Amphetamine or other stimulant 
Cocaine 


Other Stimulant-Induced Disorders (570) 


DSM-5 Classification xxix 


292.9 (_. ) Unspecified Stimulant-Related Disorder (570) 
(F15.99) Amphetamine or other stimulant 
(F14.99) Cocaine 


Tobacco-Related Disorders (571) 
__.  (__._) Tobacco Use Disorder* (571) 


Specify if: On maintenance therapy, In a controlled environment 
Specify current severity: 
305.1 (272.0) Mild 


305.1 (F17.200) Moderate 
305.1 (F17.200) Severe 


292.0 (F17.203) Tobacco Withdrawal‘ (575) 
came er (a Other Tobacco-Induced Disorders (576) 
292.9 (F17.209) Unspecified Tobacco-Related Disorder (577) 


Other (or Unknown) Substance-Related Disorders (577) 


__. (__._) — Other (or Unknown) Substance Use Disorder® » (577) 
Specify current severity: 

305.90 (F 19.10) Mild 

304.90 (F19.20) Moderate 

304.90 (F19.20) Severe 


292.89 (__._) Other (or Unknown) Substance Intoxication (581) 
(F19.129) With use disorder, mild 
(F19.229) With use disorder, moderate or severe 
(F19.929) Without use disorder 


292.0 (F19.239) Other (or Unknown) Substance Withdrawal4 (583) 
ee eee Other (or Unknown) Substance—Induced Disorders (584) 
292.9 (F19.99) Unspecified Other (or Unknown) Substance—Related Disorder (585) 


Non-Substance-Related Disorders (585) 


312.31 (F63.0) Gambling Disorder* (585) 
Specify if: Episodic, Persistent 
Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe 


Neurocognitive Disorders (591) 


es ee (ee | Delirium (596) 
“Note: See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures for 
substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 


Specify whether: 
wean, (ies os} Substance intoxication delirium? 
ao, (ee) Substance withdrawal delirium? 
292.81 (__._) Medication-induced delirium? 


293.0 (FO5) Delirium due to another medical condition 


XXX DSM-5 Classification 


293.0 (FO5) Delirium due to multiple etiologies 
Specify if: Acute, Persistent 
Specify if: Hyperactive, Hypoactive, Mixed level of activity 


780.09 (R41.0) Other Specified Delirium (602) 
780.09 (R41.0) Unspecified Delirium (602) 


Major and Mild Neurocognitive Disorders (602) 

Specify whether due to: Alzheimer’s disease, Frontotemporal lobar degeneration, Lewy body 
disease, Vascular disease, Traumatic brain injury, Substance / medication use, HIV infection, 
Prion disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s disease, Another medical condition, Mullti- 
ple etiologies, Unspecified 

“Specify Without behavioral disturbance, With behavioral disturbance. For possible major neuro- 
cognitive disorder and for mild neurocognitive disorder, behavioral disturbance cannot be coded but 
should still be indicated in writing. 

> Specify current severity: Mild, Moderate, Severe. This specifier applies only to major neurocogni- 
tive disorders (including probable and possible). 

Note: As indicated for each subtype, an additional medical code is needed for probable major 

neurocognitive disorder or major neurocognitive disorder. An additional medical code should 

not be used for possible major neurocognitive disorder or mild neurocognitive disorder. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Alzheimer’s Disease (611) 


__. (__._) Probable Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Alzheimer’s 
Disease? 
Note: Code first 331.0 (G30.9) Alzheimer’s disease. 
294.11 (FO2.81) With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 
331.9 (G31.9) Possible Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Alzheimer’s 
Disease® > 


331.83 (G31.84) Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Alzheimer’s Disease* 


Major or Mild Frontotemporal Neurocognitive Disorder (614) 


__._ (__._) — Probable Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Frontotemporal 
Lobar Degeneration? 
Note: Code first 331.19 (G31.09) frontotemporal disease. 
294.11 (FO2.81) With behavioral disturbance 


294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 


331.9 (G31.9) Possible Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Frontotemporal 
Lobar Degeneration” > 


331.83 (G31.84) Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Frontotemporal Lobar 
Degeneration* 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder With Lewy Bodies (618) 

__._ (__._) Probable Major Neurocognitive Disorder With Lewy Bodies 
Note: Code first 331.82 (G31.83) Lewy body disease. 

294.11 (F0O2.81) With behavioral disturbance 

294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 


DSM-5 Classification Xxxi 


331.9 (G31.9) Possible Major Neurocognitive Disorder With Lewy Bodies” » 
331.83 (G31.84) Mild Neurocognitive Disorder With Lewy Bodies* 


Major or Mild Vascular Neurocognitive Disorder (621) 


__. (__._) Probable Major Vascular Neurocognitive Disorder? 
Note: No additional medical code for vascular disease. 
290.40 (F01.51) With behavioral disturbance 


290.40 (FO1.50) Without behavioral disturbance 
331.9 (G31.9) Possible Major Vascular Neurocognitive Disorder® > 
331.83 (G31.84) Mild Vascular Neurocognitive Disorder* 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Traumatic Brain Injury (624) 


__. (__._) — Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Traumatic Brain Injury? 
Note: For ICD-9-CM, code first 907.0 late effect of intracranial injury without 
skull fracture. For ICD-10-CM, code first S06.2X9S diffuse traumatic brain 
injury with loss of consciousness of unspecified duration, sequela. 


294.11 (FO2.81) With behavioral disturbance 

294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 

331.83 (G31.84) Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Traumatic Brain Injury* 
Substance/Medication-Induced Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder® (627) 

Note: No additional medical code. See the criteria set and corresponding recording procedures 


for substance-specific codes and ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM coding. 
Specify if: Persistent 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to HIV Infection (632) 


—_. (__._) = Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to HIV Infection? 
Note: Code first 042 (B20) HIV infection. 

294.11 (F0O2.81) With behavioral disturbance 

294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 


331.83 (G31.84) Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to HIV Infection* 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Prion Disease (634) 


2 feta l’x Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Prion Disease? 
Note: Code first 046.79 (A81.9) prion disease. 

294.11 (F02.81) With behavioral disturbance 

294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 


331.83 (G31.84) Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Prion Disease* 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Parkinson’s Disease (636) 


__._ (__._) = Major Neurocognitive Disorder Probably Due to Parkinson’s 
Disease? 
Note: Code first 332.0 (G20) Parkinson’s disease. 
294.11 (F02.81) With behavioral disturbance 


294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 


XXxii DSM-5 Classification 


331.9 (G31.9) | Major Neurocognitive Disorder Possibly Due to Parkinson’s 
Disease® 


331.83 (G31.84) Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Parkinson’s Disease* 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Huntington’s Disease (638) 


__. (__._) = Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Huntington’s Disease? 
Note: Code first 333.4 (G10) Huntington’s disease. 

294.11 (F02.81) With behavioral disturbance 

294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 


331.83 (G31.84) | Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Huntington’s Disease* 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition (641) 


re ee Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Another Medical 


Condition? 
Note: Code first the other medical condition. 
294.11 (F0O2.81) With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 
331.83 (G31.84) | Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Another Medical 
Condition* 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Multiple Etiologies (642) 


__._ (__._) Major Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Multiple Etiologies? 
Note: Code first all the etiological medical conditions (with the exception 
of vascular disease). 


294.11 (F0O2.81) With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 (FO2.80) Without behavioral disturbance 


331.83 (G31.84) Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Multiple Etiologies* 


Unspecified Neurocognitive Disorder (643) 
799.59 (R41.9) Unspecified Neurocognitive Disorder* 


Personality Disorders (645) 


Cluster A Personality Disorders 

301.0 (F60.0) Paranoid Personality Disorder (649) 
301.20 (F60.1) Schizoid Personality Disorder (652) 
301.22 (F21) Schizotypal Personality Disorder (655) 


Cluster B Personality Disorders 

301.7 (F60.2) Antisocial Personality Disorder (659) 
301.83 (F60.3) Borderline Personality Disorder (663) 
301.50 (F60.4) Histrionic Personality Disorder (667) 
301.81 (F60.81) Narcissistic Personality Disorder (669) 


DSM-5 Classification 


XXxiii 


Cluster C Personality Disorders 


301.82 (F60.6) 
301.6 (F60.7) 
301.4 (F60.5) 


Avoidant Personality Disorder (672) 
Dependent Personality Disorder (675) 


Obsessive-Compulsive Personality Disorder (678) 


Other Personality Disorders 


310.1 (F07.0) 


301.89 (F60.89) 
301.9 (F60.9) 


Personality Change Due to Another Medical Condition (682) 
Specify whether: Labile type, Disinhibited type, Aggressive type, Apathetic 
type, Paranoid type, Other type, Combined type, Unspecified type 


Other Specified Personality Disorder (684) 
Unspecified Personality Disorder (684) 


Paraphilic Disorders (685) 


The following specifier applies to Paraphilic Disorders where indicated: 
Specify if: In a controlled environment, In full remission 


302.82 (F65.3) 
302.4 (F65.2) 


302.89 (F65.81) 
302.83 (F65.51) 


302.84 (F65.52) 
302.2 (F65.4) 


302.81 (F65.0) 


302.3 (F65.1) 


302.89 (F65.89) 


Voyeuristic Disorder* (686) 


Exhibitionistic Disorder® (689) 

Specify whether: Sexually aroused by exposing genitals to prepubertal 
children, Sexually aroused by exposing genitals to physically mature 
individuals, Sexually aroused by exposing genitals to prepubertal chil- 
dren and to physically mature individuals 


Frotteuristic Disorder* (691) 

Sexual Masochism Disorder® (694) 

Specify if: With asphyxiophilia 

Sexual Sadism Disorder (695) 

Pedophilic Disorder (697) 

Specify whether: Exclusive type, Nonexclusive type 

Specify if: Sexually attracted to males, Sexually attracted to females, Sexu- 
ally attracted to both 

Specify if: Limited to incest 

Fetishistic Disorder* (700) 

Specify: Body part(s), Nonliving object(s), Other 

Transvestic Disorder® (702) 

Specify if: With fetishism, With autogynephilia 

Other Specified Paraphilic Disorder (705) 


302.9 (F65.9) Unspecified Paraphilic Disorder (705) 
Other Mental Disorders (707) 

294.8 (FO06.8) Other Specified Mental Disorder Due to Another Medical 
Condition (707) 

294.9 (FO9) Unspecified Mental Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 
(708) 

300.9 (F99) Other Specified Mental Disorder (708) 

300.9 (F99) Unspecified Mental Disorder (708) 


XXXiV 


DSM-5 Classification 


Medication-Induced Movement Disorders and 
Other Adverse Effects of Medication (709) 


332.1 (G21.11) 
332.1 (G21.19) 
333.92 (G21.0) 
333.72 (G24.02) 
333.99 (G25.71) 
333.85 (G24.01) 
333.72 (G24.09) 
333.99 (G25.71) 
333.1 (G25.1) 
333.99 (G25.79) 


coer ry ee a 


995.29 (T43.205A) 
995.29 (T43.205D) 
995.29 (T43.205S) 


ne ee 


995.20 (T50.905A) 
995.20 (T50.905D) 
995.20 (T50.905S) 


Neuroleptic-Induced Parkinsonism (709) 

Other Medication-Induced Parkinsonism (709) 

Neuroleptic Malignant Syndrome (709) 

Medication-Induced Acute Dystonia (711) 

Medication-Induced Acute Akathisia (711) 

Tardive Dyskinesia (712) 

Tardive Dystonia (712) 

Tardive Akathisia (712) 

Medication-Induced Postural Tremor (712) 

Other Medication-Induced Movement Disorder (712) 

Antidepressant Discontinuation Syndrome (712) 
Initial encounter 


Subsequent encounter 
Sequelae 


Other Adverse Effect of Medication (714) 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 
Sequelae 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus 


of Clinical Attention (715) 


Relational Problems (715) 


Problems Related to Family Upbringing (715) 


V61.20 (262.820) 
V61.8 (262.891) 
V61.8 (262.29) 
V61.29 (262.898) 


Parent-Child Relational Problem (715) 

Sibling Relational Problem (716) 

Upbringing Away From Parents (716) 

Child Affected by Parental Relationship Distress (716) 


Other Problems Related to Primary Support Group (716) 


V61.10 (263.0) 
V61.03 (263.5) 
V61.8 (Z63.8) 
V62.82 (263.4) 


Relationship Distress With Spouse or Intimate Partner (716) 
Disruption of Family by Separation or Divorce (716) 
High Expressed Emotion Level Within Family (716) 


Uncomplicated Bereavement (716) 


DSM-5 Classification XXXV 


Abuse and Neglect (717) 

Child Maltreatment and Neglect Problems (717) 

Child Physical Abuse (717) 

Child Physical Abuse, Confirmed (717) 

995.54 (T74.12XA) Initial encounter 

995.54 (T74.12XD) Subsequent encounter 

Child Physical Abuse, Suspected (717) 

995.54 (T76.12XA) Initial encounter 

995.54 (T76.12XD) Subsequent encounter 

Other Circumstances Related to Child Physical Abuse (718) 

V61.21 (Z69.010) Encounter for mental health services for victim of child abuse 
by parent 

V61.21 (Z69.020) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental 
child abuse 

V15.41 (Z62.810) Personal history (past history) of physical abuse in childhood 

V61.22 (Z69.011) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental 
child abuse 

V62.83 (Z69.021) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonparental child abuse 

Child Sexual Abuse (718) 

Child Sexual Abuse, Confirmed (718) 

995.53 (T74.22XA) Initial encounter 

995.53 (T74.22XD) Subsequent encounter 

Child Sexual Abuse, Suspected (718) 

995.53 (T76.22XA) Initial encounter 

995.53 (T76.22XD) Subsequent encounter 

Other Circumstances Related to Child Sexual Abuse (718) 

V61.21 (Z69.010) Encounter for mental health services for victim of child sexual 
abuse by parent 

V61.21 (Z69.020) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental 
child sexual abuse 

V15.41 (262.810) Personal history (past history) of sexual abuse in childhood 

V61.22 (Z69.011) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental 
child sexual abuse 

V62.83 (Z69.021) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonparental child sexual abuse 

Child Neglect (718) 

Child Neglect, Confirmed (718) 

995.52 (T74.02XA) Initial encounter 

995.52 (T74.02XD) Subsequent encounter 


XXXVI DSM-5 Classification 


Child Neglect, Suspected (719) 
995.52 (T76.02XA) Initial encounter 
995.52 (T76.02XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Child Neglect (719) 
V61.21 (Z69.010) Encounter for mental health services for victim of child neglect 


by parent 

V61.21 (Z69.020) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental 
child neglect 

V15.42 (262.812) Personal history (past history) of neglect in childhood 

V61.22 (Z69.011) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental 
child neglect 


V62.83 (Z69.021) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonparental child neglect 


Child Psychological Abuse (719) 

Child Psychological Abuse, Confirmed (719) 
995.51 (T74.32XA) Initial encounter 
995.51 (T74.32XD) Subsequent encounter 


Child Psychological Abuse, Suspected (719) 

995.51 (T76.32XA) Initial encounter 

995.51 (T76.32XD) Subsequent encounter 

Other Circumstances Related to Child Psychological Abuse (719) 

V61.21 (Z69.010) Encounter for mental health services for victim of child 
psychological abuse by parent 

V61.21 (Z69.020) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental 
child psychological abuse 

V15.42 (262.811) Personal history (past history) of psychological abuse in 
childhood 

V61.22 (Z69.011) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental 
child psychological abuse 

V62.83 (Z69.021) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonparental child psychological abuse 


Adult Maltreatment and Neglect Problems (720) 


Spouse or Partner Violence, Physical (720) 

Spouse or Partner Violence, Physical, Confirmed (720) 

995.81 (T74.11XA) Initial encounter 

995.81 (T74.11XD) Subsequent encounter 

Spouse or Partner Violence, Physical, Suspected (720) 

995.81 (T76.11XA) Initial encounter 

995.81 (T76.11XD) Subsequent encounter 

Other Circumstances Related to Spouse or Partner Violence, Physical (720) 


V61.11 (Z69.11) Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or 
partner violence, physical 


DSM-5 Classification XXXVii 


V15.41 (Z91.410) Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, 
physical 

V61.12 (Z69.12) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse 
or partner violence, physical 


Spouse or Partner Violence, Sexual (720) 

Spouse or Partner Violence, Sexual, Confirmed (720) 
995.83 (T74.21XA) Initial encounter 

995.83 (T74.21XD) Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or Partner Violence, Sexual, Suspected (720) 
995.83 (T76.21XA) Initial encounter 
995.83 (T76.21XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Spouse or Partner Violence, Sexual (720) 

V61.11 (Z69.81) Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or 
partner violence, sexual 

V15.41 (Z91.410) Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, 
sexual 

V61.12 (Z69.12) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse 
or partner violence, sexual 


Spouse or Partner, Neglect (721) 


Spouse or Partner Neglect, Confirmed (721) 
995.85 (T74.01XA) Initial encounter 
995.85 (T74.01XD) Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or Partner Neglect, Suspected (721) 
995.85 (T76.01XA) Initial encounter 
995.85 (T76.01XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Spouse or Partner Neglect (721) 

V61.11 (Z69.11) Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or 
partner neglect 

V15.42 (Z91.412) Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner neglect 

V61.12 (Z69.12) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse 
or partner neglect 


Spouse or Partner Abuse, Psychological (721) 

Spouse or Partner Abuse, Psychological, Confirmed (721) 
995.82 (T74.31XA) Initial encounter 

995.82 (T74.31XD) Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or Partner Abuse, Psychological, Suspected (721) 

995.82 (T76.31XA) Initial encounter 

995.82 (T76.31XD) Subsequent encounter 

Other Circumstances Related to Spouse or Partner Abuse, Psychological (721) 


V61.11 (Z69.11) Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or 
partner psychological abuse 


XXXViii DSM-5 Classification 


V15.42 (Z91.411) Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner 
psychological abuse 

V61.12 (Z69.12) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse 
or partner psychological abuse 


Adult Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner (722) 

Adult Physical Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Confirmed (722) 
995.81 (T74.11XA) Initial encounter 

995.81 (T74.11XD) Subsequent encounter 

Adult Physical Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Suspected (722) 
995.81 (T76.11XA) Initial encounter 

995.81 (T76.11XD) Subsequent encounter 

Adult Sexual Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Confirmed (722) 
995.83 (T74.21XA) Initial encounter 

995.83 (T74.21XD) Subsequent encounter 

Adult Sexual Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Suspected (722) 

995.83 (T76.21XA) Initial encounter 

995.83 (T76.21XD) Subsequent encounter 

Adult Psychological Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Confirmed (722) 
995.82 (T74.31XA) Initial encounter 

995.82 (T74.31XD) Subsequent encounter 

Adult Psychological Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Suspected (722) 
995.82 (T76.31XA) Initial encounter 

995.82 (T76.31XD) Subsequent encounter 

Other Circumstances Related to Adult Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner (722) 


V65.49 (Z69.81) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonspousal 
adult abuse 


V62.83 (Z69.82) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonspousal adult abuse 


Educational and Occupational Problems (723) 


Educational Problems (723) 
V62.3  (Z55.9) Academic or Educational Problem (723) 


Occupational Problems (723) 
V62.21 (Z56.82) Problem Related to Current Military Deployment Status (723) 
V62.29 (Z56.9) Other Problem Related to Employment (723) 


Housing and Economic Problems (723) 


Housing Problems (723) 
V60.0 (Z59.0) Homelessness (723) 
V60.1 (259.1) Inadequate Housing (723) 


DSM-5 Classification 


V60.89 (259.2) 
V60.6 (259.3) 


XXXiX 


Discord With Neighbor, Lodger, or Landlord (723) 
Problem Related to Living in a Residential Institution (724) 


Economic Problems (724) 


V60.2 
V60.2 
V60.2 
V60.2 
V60.9 


(Z59.4) 
(Z59.5) 
(Z59.6) 
(Z59.7) 
(Z59.9) 


Lack of Adequate Food or Safe Drinking Water (724) 
Extreme Poverty (724) 

Low Income (724) 

Insufficient Social Insurance or Welfare Support (724) 


Unspecified Housing or Economic Problem (724) 


Other Problems Related to the Social Environment (724) 


V62.89 (Z60.0) 
V60.3 (Z60.2) 
V62.4 (Z60.3) 
V62.4 (Z60.4) 
V62.4 (Z60.5) 
V62.9 (Z60.9) 


Phase of Life Problem (724) 

Problem Related to Living Alone (724) 

Acculturation Difficulty (724) 

Social Exclusion or Rejection (724) 

Target of (Perceived) Adverse Discrimination or Persecution (724) 


Unspecified Problem Related to Social Environment (725) 


Problems Related to Crime or Interaction With the Legal System (725) 


V62.89 (Z65.4) 
V62.5 (Z65.0) 


V62.5 
V62.5 
V62.5 


(Z65.1) 
(Z65.2) 
(Z65.3) 


Victim of Crime (725) 


Conviction in Civil or Criminal Proceedings Without 
Imprisonment (725) 


Imprisonment or Other Incarceration (725) 
Problems Related to Release From Prison (725) 
Problems Related to Other Legal Circumstances (725) 


Other Health Service Encounters for Counseling and Medical Advice (725) 


V65.49 (Z70.9) 
V65.40 (Z71.9) 


Sex Counseling (725) 
Other Counseling or Consultation (725) 


Problems Related to Other Psychosocial, Personal, and Environmental 
Circumstances (725) 


V62.89 (265.8) 
V61.7 (264.0) 
V61.5 (Z64.1) 
V62.89 (264.4) 


V62.89 (265.4) 
V62.22 (265.5) 
V62.89 (265.8) 
V62.9 (Z65.9) 


Religious or Spiritual Problem (725) 
Problems Related to Unwanted Pregnancy (725) 
Problems Related to Multiparity (725) 


Discord With Social Service Provider, Including Probation 
Officer, Case Manager, or Social Services Worker (725) 


Victim of Terrorism or Torture (725) 
Exposure to Disaster, War, or Other Hostilities (725) 
Other Problem Related to Psychosocial Circumstances (725) 


Unspecified Problem Related to Unspecified Psychosocial 
Circumstances (725) 


xl 


DSM-5 Classification 


Other Circumstances of Personal History (726) 


V15.49 (291.49) 
V15.59 (291.5) 
V62.22 (291.82) 
V15.89 (291.89) 
V69.9 (272.9) 
V71.01 (272.811) 
V71.02 (272.810) 


Other Personal History of Psychological Trauma (726) 
Personal History of Self-Harm (726) 

Personal History of Military Deployment (726) 

Other Personal Risk Factors (726) 

Problem Related to Lifestyle (726) 

Adult Antisocial Behavior (726) 

Child or Adolescent Antisocial Behavior (726) 


Problems Related to Access to Medical and Other Health Care (726) 


V63.9 (Z75.3) 
V63.8 (275.4) 


Unavailability or Inaccessibility of Health Care Facilities (726) 
Unavailability or Inaccessibility of Other Helping Agencies (726) 


Nonadherence to Medical Treatment (726) 


V15.81 (291.19) 
278.00 (E66.9) 
V65.2 (Z76.5) 
V40.31 (291.83) 
V62.89 (R41.83) 


Nonadherence to Medical Treatment (726) 
Overweight or Obesity (726) 

Malingering (726) 

Wandering Associated With a Mental Disorder (727) 


Borderline Intellectual Functioning (727) 


Preface 


The American Psychiatric Association’s Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of 
Mental Disorders (DSM) is a classification of mental disorders with associated criteria de- 
signed to facilitate more reliable diagnoses of these disorders. With successive editions 
over the past 60 years, it has become a standard reference for clinical practice in the mental 
health field. Since a complete description of the underlying pathological processes is not 
possible for most mental disorders, it is important to emphasize that the current diagnos- 
tic criteria are the best available description of how mental disorders are expressed and 
can be recognized by trained clinicians. DSM is intended to serve as a practical, functional, 
and flexible guide for organizing information that can aid in the accurate diagnosis and 
treatment of mental disorders. It is a tool for clinicians, an essential educational resource 
for students and practitioners, and a reference for researchers in the field. 

Although this edition of DSM was designed first and foremost to be a useful guide to 
clinical practice, as an official nomenclature it must be applicable in a wide diversity of 
contexts. DSM has been used by clinicians and researchers from different orientations (bi- 
ological, psychodynamic, cognitive, behavioral, interpersonal, family/systems), all of 
whom strive for a common language to communicate the essential characteristics of men- 
tal disorders presented by their patients. The information is of value to all professionals 
associated with various aspects of mental health care, including psychiatrists, other 
physicians, psychologists, social workers, nurses, counselors, forensic and legal special- 
ists, occupational and rehabilitation therapists, and other health professionals. The criteria 
are concise and explicit and intended to facilitate an objective assessment of symptom pre- 
sentations in a variety of clinical settings—inpatient, outpatient, partial hospital, consul- 
tation-liaison, clinical, private practice, and primary care—as well in general community 
epidemiological studies of mental disorders. DSM-5 is also a tool for collecting and com- 
municating accurate public health statistics on mental disorder morbidity and mortality 
rates. Finally, the criteria and corresponding text serve as a textbook for students early in 
their profession who need a structured way to understand and diagnose mental disorders 
as Well as for seasoned professionals encountering rare disorders for the first time. Fortu- 
nately, all of these uses are mutually compatible. 

These diverse needs and interests were taken into consideration in planning DSM-5. 
The classification of disorders is harmonized with the World Health Organization’s Inter- 
national Classification of Diseases (ICD), the official coding system used in the United States, 
so that the DSM criteria define disorders identified by ICD diagnostic names and code 
numbers. In DSM-5, both ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes (the latter scheduled for adop- 
tion in October 2014) are attached to the relevant disorders in the classification. 

Although DSM-5 remains a categorical classification of separate disorders, we recog- 
nize that mental disorders do not always fit completely within the boundaries of a single 
disorder. Some symptom domains, such as depression and anxiety, involve multiple di- 
agnostic categories and may reflect common underlying vulnerabilities for a larger group 
of disorders. In recognition of this reality, the disorders included in DSM-5 were reordered 
into a revised organizational structure meant to stimulate new clinical perspectives. This 
new structure corresponds with the organizational arrangement of disorders planned for 
ICD-11 scheduled for release in 2015. Other enhancements have been introduced to pro- 
mote ease of use across all settings: 


xli 


xlii Preface 


¢ Representation of developmental issues related to diagnosis. The change in chapter 
organization better reflects a lifespan approach, with disorders more frequently diag- 
nosed in childhood (e.g., neurodevelopmental disorders) at the beginning of the man- 
ual and disorders more applicable to older adulthood (e.g., neurocognitive disorders) 
at the end of the manual. Also, within the text, subheadings on development and course 
provide descriptions of how disorder presentations may change across the lifespan. 
Age-related factors specific to diagnosis (e.g., symptom presentation and prevalence 
differences in certain age groups) are also included in the text. For added emphasis, 
these age-related factors have been added to the criteria themselves where applicable 
(e.g., in the criteria sets for insomnia disorder and posttraumatic stress disorder, spe- 
cific criteria describe how symptoms might be expressed in children). Likewise, gender 
and cultural issues have been integrated into the disorders where applicable. 

¢ Integration of scientific findings from the latest research in genetics and neuroimag- 
ing. The revised chapter structure was informed by recent research in neuroscience and 
by emerging genetic linkages between diagnostic groups. Genetic and physiological 
risk factors, prognostic indicators, and some putative diagnostic markers are high- 
lighted in the text. This new structure should improve clinicians’ ability to identify di- 
agnoses in a disorder spectrum based on common neurocircuitry, genetic vulnerability, 
and environmental exposures. 

¢ Consolidation of autistic disorder, Asperger’s disorder, and pervasive developmen- 
tal disorder into autism spectrum disorder. Symptoms of these disorders represent a 
single continuum of mild to severe impairments in the two domains of social commu- 
nication and restrictive repetitive behaviors /interests rather than being distinct disor- 
ders. This change is designed to improve the sensitivity and specificity of the criteria for 
the diagnosis of autism spectrum disorder and to identify more focused treatment tar- 
gets for the specific impairments identified. 

¢ Streamlined classification of bipolar and depressive disorders. Bipolar and depres- 
sive disorders are the most commonly diagnosed conditions in psychiatry. It was there- 
fore important to streamline the presentation of these disorders to enhance both clinical 
and educational use. Rather than separating the definition of manic, hypomanic, and 
major depressive episodes from the definition of bipolar I disorder, bipolar II disorder, 
and major depressive disorder as in the previous edition, we included all of the com- 
ponent criteria within the respective criteria for each disorder. This approach will facil- 
itate bedside diagnosis and treatment of these important disorders. Likewise, the 
explanatory notes for differentiating bereavement and major depressive disorders will 
provide far greater clinical guidance than was previously provided in the simple be- 
reavement exclusion criterion. The new specifiers of anxious distress and mixed fea- 
tures are now fully described in the narrative on specifier variations that accompanies 
the criteria for these disorders. 

¢ Restructuring of substance use disorders for consistency and clarity. The categories 
of substance abuse and substance dependence have been eliminated and replaced with 
an overarching new category of substance use disorders—with the specific substance 
used defining the specific disorders. “Dependence” has been easily confused with the 
term “addiction” when, in fact, the tolerance and withdrawal that previously defined 
dependence are actually very normal responses to prescribed medications that affect 
the central nervous system and do not necessarily indicate the presence of an addiction. 
By revising and clarifying these criteria in DSM-5, we hope to alleviate some of the 
widespread misunderstanding about these issues. 

e Enhanced specificity for major and mild neurocognitive disorders. Given the explo- 
sion in neuroscience, neuropsychology, and brain imaging over the past 20 years, it was 
critical to convey the current state-of-the-art in the diagnosis of specific types of disor- 
ders that were previously referred to as the “dementias” or organic brain diseases. Bi- 
ological markers identified by imaging for vascular and traumatic brain disorders and 


Preface xliii 


specific molecular genetic findings for rare variants of Alzheimer’s disease and Hun- 
tington’s disease have greatly advanced clinical diagnoses, and these disorders and 
others have now been separated into specific subtypes. 

¢ Transition in conceptualizing personality disorders. Although the benefits of a more 
dimensional approach to personality disorders have been identified in previous edi- 
tions, the transition from a categorical diagnostic system of individual disorders to one 
based on the relative distribution of personality traits has not been widely accepted. In 
DSM-5, the categorical personality disorders are virtually unchanged from the previous 
edition. However, an alternative “hybrid” model has been proposed in Section III to 
guide future research that separates interpersonal functioning assessments and the ex- 
pression of pathological personality traits for six specific disorders. A more dimensional 
profile of personality trait expression is also proposed for a trait-specified approach. 

¢ Section III: new disorders and features. A new section (Section III) has been added to 
highlight disorders that require further study but are not sufficiently well established to 
be a part of the official classification of mental disorders for routine clinical use. Dimen- 
sional measures of symptom severity in 13 symptom domains have also been incorpo- 
rated to allow for the measurement of symptom levels of varying severity across all 
diagnostic groups. Likewise, the WHO Disability Assessment Schedule (WHODAS), a 
standard method for assessing global disability levels for mental disorders that is based 
on the International Classification of Functioning, Disability and Health (ICF) and is ap- 
plicable in all of medicine, has been provided to replace the more limited Global As- 
sessment of Functioning scale. It is our hope that as these measures are implemented 
over time, they will provide greater accuracy and flexibility in the clinical description of 
individual symptomatic presentations and associated disability during diagnostic as- 
sessments. 

¢ Online enhancements. DSM-5 features online supplemental information. 
Additional cross-cutting and diagnostic severity measures are available online 
(www.psychiatry.org/dsm5), linked to the relevant disorders. In addition, the Cul- 
tural Formulation Interview, Cultural Formulation Interview—Informant Version, and 
supplementary modules to the core Cultural Formulation Interview are also included 
online at www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 


These innovations were designed by the leading authorities on mental disorders in the 
world and were implemented on the basis of their expert review, public commentary, and 
independent peer review. The 13 work groups, under the direction of the DSM-5 Task 
Force, in conjunction with other review bodies and, eventually, the APA Board of Trust- 
ees, collectively represent the global expertise of the specialty. This effort was supported 
by an extensive base of advisors and by the professional staff of the APA Division of Re- 
search; the names of everyone involved are too numerous to mention here but are listed in 
the Appendix. We owe tremendous thanks to those who devoted countless hours and in- 
valuable expertise to this effort to improve the diagnosis of mental disorders. 

We would especially like to acknowledge the chairs, text coordinators, and members of 
the 13 work groups, listed in the front of the manual, who spent many hours in this vol- 
unteer effort to improve the scientific basis of clinical practice over a sustained 6-year pe- 
riod. Susan K. Schultz, M.D., who served as text editor, worked tirelessly with Emily A. 
Kuhl, Ph.D., senior science writer and DSM-5 staff text editor, to coordinate the efforts of 
the work groups into a cohesive whole. William E. Narrow, M.D., M.P.H., led the research 
group that developed the overall research strategy for DSM-5, including the field trials, 
that greatly enhanced the evidence base for this revision. In addition, we are grateful to 
those who contributed so much time to the independent review of the revision proposals, 
including Kenneth S. Kendler, M.D., and Robert Freedman, M.D., co-chairs of the Scien- 
tific Review Committee; John S. McIntyre, M.D., and Joel Yager, M.D., co-chairs of the 
Clinical and Public Health Committee; and Glenn Martin, M.D., chair of the APA Assem- 


xliv Preface 


bly review process. Special thanks go to Helena C. Kraemer, Ph.D., for her expert statistical 
consultation; Michael B. First, M.D., for his valuable input on the coding and review of cri- 
teria; and Paul S. Appelbaum, M.D., for feedback on forensic issues. Maria N. Ward, 
M.Ed., RHIT, CCS-P, also helped in verifying all ICD coding. The Summit Group, which 
included these consultants, the chairs of all review groups, the task force chairs, and the 
APA executive officers, chaired by Dilip V. Jeste, M.D., provided leadership and vision in 
helping to achieve compromise and consensus. This level of commitment has contributed 
to the balance and objectivity that we feel are hallmarks of DSM-5. 

We especially wish to recognize the outstanding APA Division of Research staff— 
identified in the Task Force and Work Group listing at the front of this manual—who 
worked tirelessly to interact with the task force, work groups, advisors, and reviewers to 
resolve issues, serve as liaisons between the groups, direct and manage the academic and 
routine clinical practice field trials, and record decisions in this important process. In par- 
ticular, we appreciate the support and guidance provided by James H. Scully Jr., M.D., 
Medical Director and CEO of the APA, through the years and travails of the development 
process. Finally, we thank the editorial and production staff of American Psychiatric Pub- 
lishing—specifically, Rebecca Rinehart, Publisher; John McDuffie, Editorial Director; Ann 
Eng, Senior Editor; Greg Kuny, Managing Editor; and Tammy Cordova, Graphics Design 
Manager—for their guidance in bringing this all together and creating the final product. It 
is the culmination of efforts of many talented individuals who dedicated their time, exper- 
tise, and passion that made DSM-5 possible. 


David J. Kupfer, M.D. 
DSM-5 Task Force Chair 


Darrel A. Regier, M.D., M.P.H. 
DSM-5 Task Force Vice-Chair 
December 19, 2012 


SECTION I 
DSM-5 Basics 


Introduction 
Use of the Manual 


Cautionary Statement for Forensic Use of DSM-5 


This page intentionally left blank 


This Section is a basic orientation to the purpose, structure, content, and 
use of DSM-5. It is not intended to provide an exhaustive account of the evo- 
lution of DSM-5, but rather to give readers a succinct overview of its key ele- 
ments. The introductory section describes the public, professional, and expert 
review process that was used to extensively evaluate the diagnostic criteria 
presented in Section II. Asummary of the DSM-5 structure, harmonization with 
ICD-11, and the transition to a non-axial system with a new approach to as- 
sessing disability is also presented. “Use of the Manual” includes “Definition of 
a Mental Disorder,” forensic considerations, and a brief overview of the diag- 
nostic process and use of coding and recording procedures. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Introduction 


The creation of the fifth edition of Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders 
(DSM-5) was a massive undertaking that involved hundreds of people working toward a 
common goal over a 12-year process. Much thought and deliberation were involved in 
evaluating the diagnostic criteria, considering the organization of every aspect of the man- 
ual, and creating new features believed to be most useful to clinicians. All of these efforts 
were directed toward the goal of enhancing the clinical usefulness of DSM-5 as a guide in 
the diagnosis of mental disorders. 

Reliable diagnoses are essential for guiding treatment recommendations, identifying 
prevalence rates for mental health service planning, identifying patient groups for clinical 
and basic research, and documenting important public health information such as mor- 
bidity and mortality rates. As the understanding of mental disorders and their treatments 
has evolved, medical, scientific, and clinical professionals have focused on the character- 
istics of specific disorders and their implications for treatment and research. 

While DSM has been the cornerstone of substantial progress in reliability, it has been well 
recognized by both the American Psychiatric Association (APA) and the broad scientific com- 
munity working on mental disorders that past science was not mature enough to yield fully 
validated diagnoses—that is, to provide consistent, strong, and objective scientific validators 
of individual DSM disorders. The science of mental disorders continues to evolve. However, 
the last two decades since DSM-IV was released have seen real and durable progress in such 
areas as cognitive neuroscience, brain imaging, epidemiology, and genetics. The DSM-5 Task 
Force overseeing the new edition recognized that research advances will require careful, iter- 
ative changes if DSM is to maintain its place as the touchstone classification of mental disor- 
ders. Finding the right balance is critical. Speculative results do not belong in an official 
nosology, but at the same time, DSM must evolve in the context of other clinical research ini- 
tiatives in the field. One important aspect of this transition derives from the broad recognition 
that a too-rigid categorical system does not capture clinical experience or important scientific 
observations. The results of numerous studies of comorbidity and disease transmission in fam- 
ilies, including twin studies and molecular genetic studies, make strong arguments for what 
many astute clinicians have long observed: the boundaries between many disorder “catego- 
ries” are more fluid over the life course than DSM-IV recognized, and many symptoms as- 
signed to a single disorder may occur, at varying levels of severity, in many other disorders. 
These findings mean that DSM, like other medical disease classifications, should accommo- 
date ways to introduce dimensional approaches to mental disorders, including dimensions 
that cut across current categories. Such an approach should permit a more accurate description 
of patient presentations and increase the validity of a diagnosis (i.e., the degree to which diag- 
nostic criteria reflect the comprehensive manifestation of an underlying psychopathological 
disorder). DSM-5 is designed to better fill the need of clinicians, patients, families, and re- 
searchers for a clear and concise description of each mental disorder organized by explicit di- 
agnostic criteria, supplemented, when appropriate, by dimensional measures that cross 
diagnostic boundaries, and a brief digest of information about the diagnosis, risk factors, as- 
sociated features, research advances, and various expressions of the disorder. 

Clinical training and experience are needed to use DSM for determining a diagnosis. The 
diagnostic criteria identify symptoms, behaviors, cognitive functions, personality traits, phys- 
ical signs, syndrome combinations, and durations that require clinical expertise to differenti- 
ate from normal life variation and transient responses to stress. To facilitate a thorough 


6 Introduction 


examination of the range of symptoms present, DSM can serve clinicians as a guide to identify 
the most prominent symptoms that should be assessed when diagnosing a disorder. Although 
some mental disorders may have well-defined boundaries around symptom clusters, scien- 
tific evidence now places many, if not most, disorders on a spectrum with closely related dis- 
orders that have shared symptoms, shared genetic and environmental risk factors, and 
possibly shared neural substrates (perhaps most strongly established for a subset of anxiety 
disorders by neuroimaging and animal models). In short, we have come to recognize that the 
boundaries between disorders are more porous than originally perceived. 

Many health profession and educational groups have been involved in the development 
and testing of DSM-5, including physicians, psychologists, social workers, nurses, counselors, 
epidemiologists, statisticians, neuroscientists, and neuropsychologists. Finally, patients, fam- 
ilies, lawyers, consumer organizations, and advocacy groups have all participated in revising 
DSM-5 by providing feedback on the mental disorders described in this volume. Their moni- 
toring of the descriptions and explanatory text is essential to improve understanding, reduce 
stigma, and advance the treatment and eventual cures for these conditions. 


A Brief History 


The APA first published a predecessor of DSM in 1844, as a statistical classification of in- 
stitutionalized mental patients. It was designed to improve communication about the 
types of patients cared for in these hospitals. This forerunner to DSM also was used as a 
component of the full U.S. census. After World War II, DSM evolved through four major 
editions into a diagnostic classification system for psychiatrists, other physicians, and 
other mental health professionals that described the essential features of the full range of 
mental disorders. The current edition, DSM-5, builds on the goal of its predecessors (most 
recently, DSM-IV-TR, or Text Revision, published in 2000) of providing guidelines for di- 
agnoses that can inform treatment and management decisions. 


DSM-5 Revision Process 


In 1999, the APA launched an evaluation of the strengths and weaknesses of DSM based on 
emerging research that did not support the boundaries established for some mental disor- 
ders. This effort was coordinated with the World Health Organization (WHO) Division of 
Mental Health, the World Psychiatric Association, and the National Institute of Mental 
Health (NIMH) in the form of several conferences, the proceedings of which were published 
in 2002 ina monograph entitled A Research Agenda for DSM-V. Thereafter, from 2003 to 2008, 
a cooperative agreement with the APA and the WHO was supported by the NIMH, the Na- 
tional Institute on Drug Abuse (NIDA), and the National Institute on Alcoholism and Alco- 
hol Abuse (NIAAA) to convene 13 international DSM-5 research planning conferences, 
involving 400 participants from 39 countries, to review the world literature in specific diag- 
nostic areas to prepare for revisions in developing both DSM-5 and the International Classi- 
fication of Diseases, 11th Revision (ICD-11). Reports from these conferences formed the basis 
for future DSM-5 Task Force reviews and set the stage for the new edition of DSM. 

In 2006, the APA named David J. Kupfer, M.D., as Chair and Darrel A. Regier, M.D., 
M.P.H., as Vice-Chair of the DSM-5 Task Force. They were charged with recommending 
chairs for the 13 diagnostic work groups and additional task force members with a mullti- 
disciplinary range of expertise who would oversee the development of DSM-5. An addi- 
tional vetting process was initiated by the APA Board of Trustees to disclose sources of 
income and thus avoid conflicts of interest by task force and work group members. The full 
disclosure of all income and research grants from commercial sources, including the phar- 
maceutical industry, in the previous 3 years, the imposition of an income cap from all com- 
mercial sources, and the publication of disclosures on a Web site set a new standard for the 


Introduction 7 


field. Thereafter, the task force of 28 members was approved in 2007, and appointments of 
more than 130 work group members were approved in 2008. More than 400 additional 
work group advisors with no voting authority were also approved to participate in the pro- 
cess. A clear concept of the next evolutionary stage for the classification of mental disorders 
was central to the efforts of the task force and the work groups. This vision emerged as the 
task force and work groups recounted the history of DSM-IV’s classification, its current 
strengths and limitations, and strategic directions for its revision. An intensive 6-year pro- 
cess involved conducting literature reviews and secondary analyses, publishing research 
reports in scientific journals, developing draft diagnostic criteria, posting preliminary 
drafts on the DSM-5 Web site for public comment, presenting preliminary findings at pro- 
fessional meetings, performing field trials, and revising criteria and text. 


Proposals for Revisions 


Proposals for the revision of DSM-5 diagnostic criteria were developed by members of the 
work groups on the basis of rationale, scope of change, expected impact on clinical man- 
agement and public health, strength of the supporting research evidence, overall clarity, 
and clinical utility. Proposals encompassed changes to diagnostic criteria; the addition of 
new disorders, subtypes, and specifiers; and the deletion of existing disorders. 

In the proposals for revisions, strengths and weaknesses in the current criteria and no- 
sology were first identified. Novel scientific findings over the previous two decades were 
considered, leading to the creation of a research plan to assess potential changes through 
literature reviews and secondary data analyses. Four principles guided the draft revisions: 
1) DSM-5 is primarily intended to be a manual to be used by clinicians, and revisions must 
be feasible for routine clinical practice; 2) recommendations for revisions should be guided 
by research evidence; 3) where possible, continuity should be maintained with previous 
editions of DSM; and 4) no a priori constraints should be placed on the degree of change 
between DSM-IV and DSM-5. 

Building on the initial literature reviews, work groups identified key issues within 
their diagnostic areas. Work groups also examined broader methodological concerns, 
such as the presence of contradictory findings within the literature; development of a re- 
fined definition of mental disorder; cross-cutting issues relevant to all disorders; and the 
revision of disorders categorized in DSM-IV as “not otherwise specified.” Inclusion of a 
proposal for revision in Section II was informed by consideration of its advantages and 
disadvantages for public health and clinical utility, the strength of the evidence, and the 
magnitude of the change. New diagnoses and disorder subtypes and specifiers were sub- 
ject to additional stipulations, such as demonstration of reliability (i.e., the degree to which 
two clinicians could independently arrive at the same diagnosis for a given patient). Dis- 
orders with low clinical utility and weak validity were considered for deletion. Placement 
of conditions in “Conditions for Further Study” in Section III was contingent on the 
amount of empirical evidence generated on the diagnosis, diagnostic reliability or valid- 
ity, presence of clear clinical need, and potential benefit in advancing research. 


DSM-5 Field Trials 


The use of field trials to empirically demonstrate reliability was a noteworthy improvement in- 
troduced in DSM-III. The design and implementation strategy of the DSM-5 Field Trials rep- 
resent several changes over approaches used for DSM-III and DSM-IV, particularly in 
obtaining data on the precision of kappa reliability estimates (a statistical measure that assesses 
level of agreement between raters that corrects for chance agreement due to prevalence rates) 
in the context of clinical settings with high levels of diagnostic comorbidity. For DSM-S, field 
trials were extended by using two distinctive designs: one in large, diverse medical-academic 
settings, and the other in routine clinical practices. The former capitalized on the need for large 
sample sizes to test hypotheses on reliability and clinical utility of a range of diagnoses in a 


8 Introduction 


variety of patient populations; the latter supplied valuable information about how proposed 
revisions performed in everyday clinical settings among a diverse sample of DSM users. It is 
anticipated that future clinical and basic research studies will focus on the validity of the re- 
vised categorical diagnostic criteria and the underlying dimensional features of these disor- 
ders (including those now being explored by the NIMH Research Domain Criteria initiative). 

The medical-academic field trials were conducted at 11 North American medical-academic 
sites and assessed the reliability, feasibility, and clinical utility of select revisions, with priority 
given to those that represented the greatest degree of change from DSM-IV or those potentially 
having the greatest public health impact. The full clinical patient populations coming to each 
site were screened for DSM-IV diagnoses or qualifying symptoms likely to predict several spe- 
cific DSM-5 disorders of interest. Stratified samples of four to seven specific disorders, plus a 
stratum containing a representative sample of all other diagnoses, were identified for each site. 
Patients consented to the study and were randomly assigned for a clinical interview by a cli- 
nician blind to the diagnosis, followed by a second interview with a clinician blind to previous 
diagnoses. Patients first filled out a computer-assisted inventory of cross-cutting symptoms in 
more than a dozen psychological domains. These inventories were scored by a central server, 
and results were provided to clinicians before they conducted a typical clinical interview (with 
no structured protocol). Clinicians were required to score the presence of qualifying criteria on 
acomputer-assisted DSM-5 diagnostic checklist, determine diagnoses, score the severity of the 
diagnosis, and submit all data to the central Web-based server. This study design allowed the 
calculation of the degree to which two independent clinicians could agree on a diagnosis (us- 
ing the intraclass kappa statistic) and the agreement of a single patient or two different clini- 
cians on two separate ratings of cross-cutting symptoms, personality traits, disability, and 
diagnostic severity measures (using intraclass correlation coefficients) along with information 
on the precision of these estimates of reliability. It was also possible to assess the prevalence 
rates of both DSM-IV and DSM-5 conditions in the respective clinical populations. 

The routine clinical practice field trials involved recruitment of individual psychiatrists 
and other mental health clinicians. A volunteer sample was recruited that included gener- 
alist and specialty psychiatrists, psychologists, licensed clinical social workers, counselors, 
marriage and family therapists, and advanced practice psychiatric mental health nurses. 
The field trials provided exposure of the proposed DSM-5 diagnoses and dimensional mea- 
sures to a wide range of clinicians to assess their feasibility and clinical utility. 


Public and Professional Review 


In 2010, the APA launched a unique Web site to facilitate public and professional input into 
DSM-5. All draft diagnostic criteria and proposed changes in organization were posted on 
www.dsm5.org for a 2-month comment period. Feedback totaled more than 8,000 submis- 
sions, which were systematically reviewed by each of the 13 work groups, whose members, 
where appropriate, integrated questions and comments into discussions of draft revisions 
and plans for field trial testing. After revisions to the initial draft criteria and proposed 
chapter organization, a second posting occurred in 2011. Work groups considered feedback 
from both Web postings and the results of the DSM-5 Field Trials when drafting proposed 
final criteria, which were posted on the Web site for a third and final time in 2012. These 
three iterations of external review produced more than 13,000 individually signed com- 
ments on the Web site that were received and reviewed by the work groups, plus thousands 
of organized petition signers for and against some proposed revisions, all of which allowed 
the task force to actively address concerns of DSM users, as well as patients and advocacy 
groups, and ensure that clinical utility remained a high priority. 


Expert Review 


The members of the 13 work groups, representing expertise in their respective areas, col- 
laborated with advisors and reviewers under the overall direction of the DSM-5 Task 


Introduction 9 


Force to draft the diagnostic criteria and accompanying text. This effort was supported by 
a team of APA Division of Research staff and developed through a network of text coor- 
dinators from each work group. The preparation of the text was coordinated by the text 
editor, working in close collaboration with the work groups and under the direction of the 
task force chairs. The Scientific Review Committee (SRC) was established to provide a sci- 
entific peer review process that was external to that of the work groups. The SRC chair, 
vice-chair, and six committee members were charged with reviewing the degree to which 
the proposed changes from DSM-IV could be supported with scientific evidence. Each 
proposal for diagnostic revision required a memorandum of evidence for change pre- 
pared by the work group and accompanied by a summary of supportive data organized 
around validators for the proposed diagnostic criteria (i.e., antecedent validators such as 
familial aggregation, concurrent validators such as biological markers, and prospective 
validators such as response to treatment or course of illness). The submissions were re- 
viewed by the SRC and scored according to the strength of the supportive scientific data. 
Other justifications for change, such as those arising from clinical experience or need or 
from a conceptual reframing of diagnostic categories, were generally seen as outside the 
purview of the SRC. The reviewers’ scores, which varied substantially across the different 
proposals, and an accompanying brief commentary were then returned to the APA Board 
of Trustees and the work groups for consideration and response. 

The Clinical and Public Health Committee (CPHC), composed of a chair, vice-chair, and 
six members, was appointed to consider additional clinical utility, public health, and log- 
ical clarification issues for criteria that had not yet accumulated the type or level of evi- 
dence deemed sufficient for change by the SRC. This review process was particularly 
important for DSM-IV disorders with known deficiencies for which proposed remedies 
had neither been previously considered in the DSM revision process nor been subjected to 
replicated research studies. These selected disorders were evaluated by four to five exter- 
nal reviewers, and the blinded results were reviewed by CPHC members, who in turn 
made recommendations to the APA Board of Trustees and the work groups. 

Forensic reviews by the members of the APA Council on Psychiatry and Law were con- 
ducted for disorders frequently appearing in forensic environments and ones with high 
potential for influencing civil and criminal judgments in courtroom settings. Work groups 
also added forensic experts as advisors in pertinent areas to complement expertise pro- 
vided by the Council on Psychiatry and Law. 

The work groups themselves were charged with the responsibility to review the entire re- 
search literature surrounding a diagnostic area, including old, revised, and new diagnostic cri- 
teria, in an intensive 6-year review process to assess the pros and cons of making either small 
iterative changes or major conceptual changes to address the inevitable reification that occurs 
with diagnostic conceptual approaches that persist over several decades. Such changes in- 
cluded the merger of previously separate diagnostic areas into more dimensional spectra, such 
as that which occurred with autism spectrum disorder, substance use disorders, sexual dys- 
functions, and somatic symptom and related disorders. Other changes included correcting 
flaws that had become apparent over time in the choice of operational criteria for some disor- 
ders. These types of changes posed particular challenges to the SRC and CPHC review pro- 
cesses, which were not constructed to evaluate the validity of DSM-IV diagnostic criteria. 
However, the DSM-5 Task Force, which had reviewed proposed changes and had responsi- 
bility for reviewing the text describing each disorder contemporaneously with the work 
groups during this period, was in a unique position to render an informed judgment on the sci- 
entific merits of such revisions. Furthermore, many of these major changes were subject to field 
trial testing, although comprehensive testing of all proposed changes could not be accommo- 
dated by such testing because of time limitations and availability of resources. 

A final recommendation from the task force was then provided to the APA Board of 
Trustees and the APA Assembly’s Committee on DSM-5 to consider some of the clinical 
utility and feasibility features of the proposed revisions. The assembly is a deliberative 


10 Introduction 


body of the APA representing the district branches and wider membership that is com- 
posed of psychiatrists from throughout the United States who provide geographic, prac- 
tice size, and interest-based diversity. The Committee on DSM-5 is a committee made up 
of a diverse group of assembly leaders. 

Following all of the preceding review steps, an executive “summit committee” session 
was held to consolidate input from review and assembly committee chairs, task force 
chairs, a forensic advisor, and a statistical advisor, for a preliminary review of each disor- 
der by the assembly and APA Board of Trustees executive committees. This preceded a 
preliminary review by the full APA Board of Trustees. The assembly voted, in November 
2012, to recommend that the board approve the publication of DSM-5, and the APA Board 
of Trustees approved its publication in December 2012. The many experts, reviewers, and 
advisors who contributed to this process are listed in the Appendix. 


Organizational Structure 


The individual disorder definitions that constitute the operationalized sets of diagnostic 
criteria provide the core of DSM-5 for clinical and research purposes. These criteria have 
been subjected to scientific review, albeit to varying degrees, and many disorders have un- 
dergone field testing for interrater reliability. In contrast, the classification of disorders (the 
way in which disorders are grouped, which provides a high-level organization for the man- 
ual) has not generally been thought of as scientifically significant, despite the fact that judg- 
ments had to be made when disorders were initially divided into chapters for DSM-III. 

DSM is a medical classification of disorders and as such serves as a historically deter- 
mined cognitive schema imposed on clinical and scientific information to increase its com- 
prehensibility and utility. Not surprisingly, as the foundational science that ultimately led 
to DSM-III has approached a half-century in age, challenges have begun to emerge for cli- 
nicians and scientists alike that are inherent in the DSM structure rather than in the de- 
scription of any single disorder. These challenges include high rates of comorbidity within 
and across DSM chapters, an excessive use of and need to rely on “not otherwise specified” 
(NOS) criteria, and a growing inability to integrate DSM disorders with the results of ge- 
netic studies and other scientific findings. 

As the APA and the WHO began to plan their respective revisions of the DSM and the 
International Classification of Disorders (ICD), both considered the possibility of improving 
clinical utility (e.g., by helping to explain apparent comorbidity) and facilitating scientific 
investigation by rethinking the organizational structures of both publications in a linear 
system designated by alphanumeric codes that sequence chapters according to some ra- 
tional and relational structure. It was critical to both the DSM-5 Task Force and the WHO 
International Advisory Group on the revision of the ICD-10 Section on Mental and Behav- 
ioral Disorders that the revisions to the organization enhance clinical utility and remain 
within the bounds of well-replicated scientific information. Although the need for reform 
seemed apparent, it was important to respect the state of the science as well as the chal- 
lenge that overly rapid change would pose for the clinical and research communities. In 
that spirit, revision of the organization was approached as a conservative, evolutionary di- 
agnostic reform that would be guided by emerging scientific evidence on the relationships 
between disorder groups. By reordering and regrouping the existing disorders, the re- 
vised structure is meant to stimulate new clinical perspectives and to encourage research- 
ers to identify the psychological and physiological cross-cutting factors that are not bound 
by strict categorical designations. 

The use of DSM criteria has the clear virtue of creating a common language for com- 
munication between clinicians about the diagnosis of disorders. The official criteria and 
disorders that were determined to have accepted clinical applicability are located in Sec- 
tion II of the manual. However, it should be noted that these diagnostic criteria and their 


Introduction 11 


relationships within the classification are based on current research and may need to be 
modified as new evidence is gathered by future research both within and across the do- 
mains of proposed disorders. “Conditions for Further Study,” described in Section III, are 
those for which we determined that the scientific evidence is not yet available to support 
widespread clinical use. These diagnostic criteria are included to highlight the evolution 
and direction of scientific advances in these areas to stimulate further research. 

With any ongoing review process, especially one of this complexity, different viewpoints 
emerge, and an effort was made to consider various viewpoints and, when warranted, ac- 
commodate them. For example, personality disorders are included in both Sections I and 
III. Section II represents an update of the text associated with the same criteria found in 
DSM-IV-TR, whereas Section III includes the proposed research model for personality dis- 
order diagnosis and conceptualization developed by the DSM-5 Personality and Personality 
Disorders Work Group. As this field evolves, it is hoped that both versions will serve clin- 
ical practice and research initiatives. 


Harmonization With ICD-11 


The groups tasked with revising the DSM and ICD systems shared the overarching goal of 
harmonizing the two classifications as much as possible, for the following reasons: 


e The existence of two major classifications of mental disorders hinders the collection and 
use of national health statistics, the design of clinical trials aimed at developing new 
treatments, and the consideration of global applicability of the results by international 
regulatory agencies. 

¢ More broadly, the existence of two classifications complicates attempts to replicate sci- 
entific results across national boundaries. 

e Even when the intention was to identify identical patient populations, DSM-IV and 
ICD-10 diagnoses did not always agree. 


Early in the course of the revisions, it became apparent that a shared organizational 
structure would help harmonize the classifications. In fact, the use of a shared framework 
helped to integrate the work of DSM and ICD work groups and to focus on scientific is- 
sues. The DSM-5 organization and the proposed linear structure of the ICD-11 have been 
endorsed by the leadership of the NIMH Research Domain Criteria (RDoC) project as con- 
sistent with the initial overall structure of that project. 

Of course, principled disagreements on the classification of psychopathology and on 
specific criteria for certain disorders were expected given the current state of scientific 
knowledge. However, most of the salient differences between the DSM and the ICD classi- 
fications do not reflect real scientific differences, but rather represent historical by-products 
of independent committee processes. 

To the surprise of participants in both revision processes, large sections of the content 
fell relatively easily into place, reflecting real strengths in some areas of the scientific lit- 
erature, such as epidemiology, analyses of comorbidity, twin studies, and certain other ge- 
netically informed designs. When disparities emerged, they almost always reflected the 
need to make a judgment about where to place a disorder in the face of incomplete—or, 
more often, conflicting—data. Thus, for example, on the basis of patterns of symptoms, co- 
morbidity, and shared risk factors, attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) was 
placed with neurodevelopmental disorders, but the same data also supported strong ar- 
guments to place ADHD within disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorders. 
These issues were settled with the preponderance of evidence (most notably validators ap- 
proved by the DSM-5 Task Force). The work groups recognize, however, that future dis- 
coveries might change the placement as well as the contours of individual disorders and, 
furthermore, that the simple and linear organization that best supports clinical practice 


12 Introduction 


may not fully capture the complexity and heterogeneity of mental disorders. The revised 
organization is coordinated with the mental and behavioral disorders chapter (Chapter V) 
of ICD-11, which will utilize an expanded numeric-alphanumeric coding system. How- 
ever, the official coding system in use in the United States at the time of publication of this 
manual is that of the International Classification of Diseases, Ninth Revision, Clinical Modifica- 
tion (ICD-9-CM)—the U.S. adaptation of ICD-9. International Classification of Diseases, Tenth 
Revision, Clinical Modification (ICD-10-CM), adapted from ICD-10, is scheduled for imple- 
mentation in the United States in October 2014. Given the impending release of ICD-11, it 
was decided that this iteration, and not ICD-10, would be the most relevant on which to focus 
harmonization. However, given that adoption of the ICD-9-CM coding system will remain 
at the time of the DSM-5 release, it will be necessary to use the ICD-9-CM codes. Further- 
more, given that DSM-5’s organizational structure reflects the anticipated structure of 
ICD-11, the eventual ICD-11 codes will follow the sequential order of diagnoses in the 
DSM-5 chapter structure more closely. At present, both the ICD-9-CM and the ICD-10-CM 
codes have been indicated for each disorder. These codes will not be in sequential order 
throughout the manual because they were assigned to complement earlier organizational 
structures. 


Dimensional Approach to Diagnosis 


Structural problems rooted in the basic design of the previous DSM classification, con- 
structed of a large number of narrow diagnostic categories, have emerged in both clinical 
practice and research. Relevant evidence comes from diverse sources, including studies of 
comorbidity and the substantial need for not otherwise specified diagnoses, which repre- 
sent the majority of diagnoses in areas such as eating disorders, personality disorders, and 
autism spectrum disorder. Studies of both genetic and environmental risk factors, whether 
based on twin designs, familial transmission, or molecular analyses, also raise concerns 
about the categorical structure of the DSM system. Because the previous DSM approach 
considered each diagnosis as categorically separate from health and from other diagnoses, 
it did not capture the widespread sharing of symptoms and risk factors across many dis- 
orders that is apparent in studies of comorbidity. Earlier editions of DSM focused on ex- 
cluding false-positive results from diagnoses; thus, its categories were overly narrow, as is 
apparent from the widespread need to use NOS diagnoses. Indeed, the once plausible goal 
of identifying homogeneous populations for treatment and research resulted in narrow di- 
agnostic categories that did not capture clinical reality, symptom heterogeneity within dis- 
orders, and significant sharing of symptoms across multiple disorders. The historical 
aspiration of achieving diagnostic homogeneity by progressive subtyping within disorder 
categories no longer is sensible; like most common human ills, mental disorders are het- 
erogeneous at many levels, ranging from genetic risk factors to symptoms. 

Related to recommendations about alterations in the chapter structure of DSM-5, mem- 
bers of the diagnostic spectra study group examined whether scientific validators could 
inform possible new groupings of related disorders within the existing categorical frame- 
work. Eleven such indicators were recommended for this purpose: shared neural sub- 
strates, family traits, genetic risk factors, specific environmental risk factors, biomarkers, 
temperamental antecedents, abnormalities of emotional or cognitive processing, symptom 
similarity, course of illness, high comorbidity, and shared treatment response. These indi- 
cators served as empirical guidelines to inform decision making by the work groups and 
the task force about how to cluster disorders to maximize their validity and clinical utility. 

A series of papers was developed and published in a prominent international journal 
(Psychological Medicine, Vol. 39, 2009) as part of both the DSM-5 and the ICD-11 develop- 
mental processes to document that such validators were most useful for suggesting large 
groupings of disorders rather than for “validating” individual disorder diagnostic criteria. 
The regrouping of mental disorders in DSM-5 is intended to enable future research to en- 


Introduction 13 


hance understanding of disease origins and pathophysiological commonalities between 
disorders and provide a base for future replication wherein data can be reanalyzed over 
time to continually assess validity. Ongoing revisions of DSM-5 will make it a “living doc- 
ument,” adaptable to future discoveries in neurobiology, genetics, and epidemiology. 

On the basis of the published findings of this common DSM-5 and ICD-11 analysis, it 
was demonstrated that clustering of disorders according to what has been termed internal- 
izing and externalizing factors represents an empirically supported framework. Within both 
the internalizing group (representing disorders with prominent anxiety, depressive, and 
somatic symptoms) and the externalizing group (representing disorders with prominent 
impulsive, disruptive conduct, and substance use symptoms), the sharing of genetic and 
environmental risk factors, as shown by twin studies, likely explains much of the system- 
atic comorbidities seen in both clinical and community samples. The adjacent placement of 
“internalizing disorders,” characterized by depressed mood, anxiety, and related physio- 
logical and cognitive symptoms, should aid in developing new diagnostic approaches, in- 
cluding dimensional approaches, while facilitating the identification of biological markers. 
Similarly, adjacencies of the “externalizing group,” including disorders exhibiting antiso- 
cial behaviors, conduct disturbances, addictions, and impulse-control disorders, should en- 
courage advances in identifying diagnoses, markers, and underlying mechanisms. 

Despite the problem posed by categorical diagnoses, the DSM-5 Task Force recognized 
that it is premature scientifically to propose alternative definitions for most disorders. The 
organizational structure is meant to serve as a bridge to new diagnostic approaches with- 
out disrupting current clinical practice or research. With support from DSM-associated 
training materials, the National Institutes of Health other funding agencies, and scientific 
publications, the more dimensional DSM-5 approach and organizational structure can fa- 
cilitate research across current diagnostic categories by encouraging broad investigations 
within the proposed chapters and across adjacent chapters. Such a reformulation of re- 
search goals should also keep DSM-5 central to the development of dimensional approaches 
to diagnosis that will likely supplement or supersede current categorical approaches in 
coming years. 


Developmental and Lifespan Considerations 


To improve clinical utility, DSM-5 is organized on developmental and lifespan consider- 
ations. It begins with diagnoses thought to reflect developmental processes that manifest 
early in life (e.g., neurodevelopmental and schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic 
disorders), followed by diagnoses that more commonly manifest in adolescence and 
young adulthood (e.g., bipolar, depressive, and anxiety disorders), and ends with diagno- 
ses relevant to adulthood and later life (e.g., neurocognitive disorders). A similar approach 
has been taken, where possible, within each chapter. This organizational structure facili- 
tates the comprehensive use of lifespan information as a way to assist in diagnostic deci- 
sion making. 

The proposed organization of chapters of DSM-5, after the neurodevelopmental disor- 
ders, is based on groups of internalizing (emotional and somatic) disorders, externalizing 
disorders, neurocognitive disorders, and other disorders. It is hoped that this organization 
will encourage further study of underlying pathophysiological processes that give rise to 
diagnostic comorbidity and symptom heterogeneity. Furthermore, by arranging disorder 
clusters to mirror clinical reality, DSM-5 should facilitate identification of potential diag- 
noses by non—mental health specialists, such as primary care physicians. 

The organizational structure of DSM-5, along with ICD harmonization, is designed to 
provide better and more flexible diagnostic concepts for the next epoch of research and to 
serve as a useful guide to clinicians in explaining to patients why they might have received 
multiple diagnoses or why they might have received additional or altered diagnoses over 
their lifespan. 


14 Introduction 


Cultural Issues 


Mental disorders are defined in relation to cultural, social, and familial norms and values. 
Culture provides interpretive frameworks that shape the experience and expression of the 
symptoms, signs, and behaviors that are criteria for diagnosis. Culture is transmitted, re- 
vised, and recreated within the family and other social systems and institutions. Diagnostic 
assessment must therefore consider whether an individual’s experiences, symptoms, and 
behaviors differ from sociocultural norms and lead to difficulties in adaptation in the cul- 
tures of origin and in specific social or familial contexts. Key aspects of culture relevant to di- 
agnostic classification and assessment have been considered in the development of DSM-5. 

In Section III, the “Cultural Formulation” contains a detailed discussion of culture and 
diagnosis in DSM-5, including tools for in-depth cultural assessment. In the Appendix, the 
“Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress” provides a description of some common cul- 
tural syndromes, idioms of distress, and causal explanations relevant to clinical practice. 

The boundaries between normality and pathology vary across cultures for specific types 
of behaviors. Thresholds of tolerance for specific symptoms or behaviors differ across cul- 
tures, social settings, and families. Hence, the level at which an experience becomes prob- 
lematic or pathological will differ. The judgment that a given behavior is abnormal and 
requires clinical attention depends on cultural norms that are internalized by the individual 
and applied by others around them, including family members and clinicians. Awareness of 
the significance of culture may correct mistaken interpretations of psychopathology, but cul- 
ture may also contribute to vulnerability and suffering (e.g., by amplifying fears that main- 
tain panic disorder or health anxiety). Cultural meanings, habits, and traditions can also 
contribute to either stigma or support in the social and familial response to mental illness. 
Culture may provide coping strategies that enhance resilience in response to illness, or sug- 
gest help seeking and options for accessing health care of various types, including alterna- 
tive and complementary health systems. Culture may influence acceptance or rejection of a 
diagnosis and adherence to treatments, affecting the course of illness and recovery. Culture 
also affects the conduct of the clinical encounter; as a result, cultural differences between the 
clinician and the patient have implications for the accuracy and acceptance of diagnosis as 
well as for treatment decisions, prognostic considerations, and clinical outcomes. 

Historically, the construct of the culture-bound syndrome has been a key interest of 
cultural psychiatry. In DSM-5, this construct has been replaced by three concepts that offer 
greater clinical utility: 


1. Cultural syndrome is a cluster or group of co-occurring, relatively invariant symptoms 
found in a specific cultural group, community, or context (e.g., ataque de nervios). The 
syndrome may or may not be recognized as an illness within the culture (e.g., it might 
be labeled in various ways), but such cultural patterns of distress and features of illness 
may nevertheless be recognizable by an outside observer. 

2. Cultural idiom of distress is a linguistic term, phrase, or way of talking about suffering 
among individuals of a cultural group (e.g., similar ethnicity and religion) referring to 
shared concepts of pathology and ways of expressing, communicating, or naming es- 
sential features of distress (e.g., kufungisisa). An idiom of distress need not be associated 
with specific symptoms, syndromes, or perceived causes. It may be used to convey a 
wide range of discomfort, including everyday experiences, subclinical conditions, or 
suffering due to social circumstances rather than mental disorders. For example, most 
cultures have common bodily idioms of distress used to express a wide range of suf- 
fering and concerns. 

3. Cultural explanation or perceived cause is a label, attribution, or feature of an explanatory 
model that provides a culturally conceived etiology or cause for symptoms, illness, or 
distress (e.g., maladi moun). Causal explanations may be salient features of folk classi- 
fications of disease used by laypersons or healers. 


Introduction 15 


These three concepts (for which discussion and examples are provided in Section III 
and the Appendix) suggest cultural ways of understanding and describing illness experi- 
ences that can be elicited in the clinical encounter. They influence symptomatology, help 
seeking, clinical presentations, expectations of treatment, illness adaptation, and treat- 
ment response. The same cultural term often serves more than one of these functions. 


Gender Differences 


Sex and gender differences as they relate to the causes and expression of medical conditions 
are established for a number of diseases, including selected mental disorders. Revisions to 
DSM-5 included review of potential differences between men and women in the expression 
of mental illness. In terms of nomenclature, sex differences are variations attributable to an 
individual’s reproductive organs and XX or XY chromosomal complement. Gender differ- 
ences are variations that result from biological sex as well as an individual’s self-represen- 
tation that includes the psychological, behavioral, and social consequences of one’s 
perceived gender. The term gender differences is used in DSM-5 because, more commonly, 
the differences between men and women are a result of both biological sex and individual 
self-representation. However, some of the differences are based on only biological sex. 

Gender can influence illness in a variety of ways. First, it may exclusively determine 
whether an individual is at risk for a disorder (e.g., as in premenstrual dysphoric disor- 
der). Second, gender may moderate the overall risk for development of a disorder as 
shown by marked gender differences in the prevalence and incidence rates for selected 
mental disorders. Third, gender may influence the likelihood that particular symptoms of 
a disorder are experienced by an individual. Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder is 
an example of a disorder with differences in presentation that are most commonly expe- 
rienced by boys or girls. Gender likely has other effects on the experience of a disorder that 
are indirectly relevant to psychiatric diagnosis. It may be that certain symptoms are more 
readily endorsed by men or women, and that this contributes to differences in service pro- 
vision (e.g., women may be more likely to recognize a depressive, bipolar, or anxiety dis- 
order and endorse a more comprehensive list of symptoms than men). 

Reproductive life cycle events, including estrogen variations, also contribute to gender 
differences in risk and expression of illness. Thus, a specifier for postpartum onset of mania 
or major depressive episode denotes a time frame wherein women may be at increased risk 
for the onset of an illness episode. In the case of sleep and energy, alterations are often nor- 
mative postpartum and thus may have lower diagnostic reliability in postpartum women. 

The manual is configured to include information on gender at multiple levels. If there 
are gender-specific symptoms, they have been added to the diagnostic criteria. A gender- 
related specifier, such as perinatal onset of a mood episode, provides additional informa- 
tion on gender and diagnosis. Finally, other issues that are pertinent to diagnosis and gen- 
der considerations can be found in the section “Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues.” 


Use of Other Specified and Unspecified Disorders 


To enhance diagnostic specificity, DSM-5 replaces the previous NOS designation with two 
options for clinical use: other specified disorder and unspecified disorder. The other specified 
disorder category is provided to allow the clinician to communicate the specific reason 
that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific category within a diagnos- 
tic class. This is done by recording the name of the category, followed by the specific rea- 
son. For example, for an individual with clinically significant depressive symptoms 
lasting 4 weeks but whose symptomatology falls short of the diagnostic threshold for a 
major depressive episode, the clinician would record “other specified depressive disorder, 
depressive episode with insufficient symptoms.” If the clinician chooses not to specify the 


16 Introduction 


reason that the criteria are not met for a specific disorder, then “unspecified depressive 
disorder” would be diagnosed. Note that the differentiation between other specified and 
unspecified disorders is based on the clinician’s decision, providing maximum flexibility 
for diagnosis. Clinicians do not have to differentiate between other specified and unspec- 
ified disorders based on some feature of the presentation itself. When the clinician deter- 
mines that there is evidence to specify the nature of the clinical presentation, the other 
specified diagnosis can be given. When the clinician is not able to further specify and de- 
scribe the clinical presentation, the unspecified diagnosis can be given. This is left entirely 
up to clinical judgment. 

For a more detailed discussion of how to use other specified and unspecified designa- 
tions, see “Use of the Manual” in Section I. 


The Multiaxial System 


Despite widespread use and its adoption by certain insurance and governmental agencies, 
the multiaxial system in DSM-IV was not required to make a mental disorder diagnosis. A 
nonaxial assessment system was also included that simply listed the appropriate Axis I, II, 
and III disorders and conditions without axial designations. DSM-5 has moved to a nonax- 
ial documentation of diagnosis (formerly Axes I, II, and III), with separate notations for 
important psychosocial and contextual factors (formerly Axis IV) and disability (formerly 
Axis V). This revision is consistent with the DSM-IV text that states, “The multiaxial dis- 
tinction among Axis I, Axis II, and Axis III disorders does not imply that there are funda- 
mental differences in their conceptualization, that mental disorders are unrelated to 
physical or biological factors or processes, or that general medical conditions are unrelated 
to behavioral or psychosocial factors or processes.” The approach of separately noting di- 
agnosis from psychosocial and contextual factors is also consistent with established WHO 
and ICD guidance to consider the individual's functional status separately from his or her 
diagnoses or symptom status. In DSM-5, Axis III has been combined with Axes I and II. 
Clinicians should continue to list medical conditions that are important to the understand- 
ing or management of an individual’s mental disorder(s). 

DSM-IV Axis IV covered psychosocial and environmental problems that may affect the 
diagnosis, treatment, and prognosis of mental disorders. Although this axis provided 
helpful information, even if it was not used as frequently as intended, the DSM-5 Task 
Force recommended that DSM-5 should not develop its own classification of psychosocial 
and environmental problems, but rather use a selected set of the ICD-9-CM V codes and 
the new Z codes contained in ICD-10-CM. The ICD-10 Z codes were examined to deter- 
mine which are most relevant to mental disorders and also to identify gaps. 

DSM-IV Axis V consisted of the Global Assessment of Functioning (GAF) scale, repre- 
senting the clinician's judgment of the individual’s overall level of “functioning on a hy- 
pothetical continuum of mental health-illness.” It was recommended that the GAF be 
dropped from DSM-5 for several reasons, including its conceptual lack of clarity (i.e., in- 
cluding symptoms, suicide risk, and disabilities in its descriptors) and questionable psy- 
chometrics in routine practice. In order to provide a global measure of disability, the WHO 
Disability Assessment Schedule (WHODAS) is included, for further study, in Section III of 
DSM-5 (see the chapter “Assessment Measures”). The WHODAS is based on the Interna- 
tional Classification of Functioning, Disability and Health (ICF) for use across all of medicine 
and health care. The WHODAS (version 2.0), and a modification developed for children/ 
adolescents and their parents by the Impairment and Disability Study Group were in- 
cluded in the DSM-5 field trial. 


Introduction 17 


Online Enhancements 


It was challenging to determine what to include in the print version of DSM-5 to be most 
clinically relevant and useful and at the same time maintain a manageable size. For this 
reason, the inclusion of clinical rating scales and measures in the print edition is limited to 
those considered most relevant. Additional assessment measures used in the field trials 
are available online (www.psychiatry.org/dsm5), linked to the relevant disorders. The 
Cultural Formulation Interview, Cultural Formulation Interview—Informant Version, and 
supplementary modules to the core Cultural Formulation Interview are also available on- 
line at www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 

DSM- 5 is available as an online subscription at PsychiatryOnline.org as well as an e- 
book. The online component contains modules and assessment tools to enhance the diag- 
nostic criteria and text. Also available online is a complete set of supportive references as 
well as additional helpful information. The organizational structure of DSM-5, its use of 
dimensional measures, and compatibility with ICD codes will allow it to be readily adapt- 
able to future scientific discoveries and refinements in its clinical utility. DSM-5 will be an- 
alyzed over time to continually assess its validity and enhance its value to clinicians. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Use of the Manual 


The introduction contains much of the history and developmental process of the 
DSM-5 revision. This section is designed to provide a practical guide to using DSM-5, par- 
ticularly in clinical practice. The primary purpose of DSM-5 is to assist trained clinicians 
in the diagnosis of their patients’ mental disorders as part of a case formulation assess- 
ment that leads to a fully informed treatment plan for each individual. The symptoms con- 
tained in the respective diagnostic criteria sets do not constitute comprehensive 
definitions of underlying disorders, which encompass cognitive, emotional, behavioral, 
and physiological processes that are far more complex than can be described in these brief 
summaries. Rather, they are intended to summarize characteristic syndromes of signs and 
symptoms that point to an underlying disorder with a characteristic developmental his- 
tory, biological and environmental risk factors, neuropsychological and physiological cor- 
relates, and typical clinical course. 


Approach to Clinical Case Formulation 


The case formulation for any given patient must involve a careful clinical history and con- 
cise summary of the social, psychological, and biological factors that may have contrib- 
uted to developing a given mental disorder. Hence, it is not sufficient to simply check off 
the symptoms in the diagnostic criteria to make a mental disorder diagnosis. Although a 
systematic check for the presence of these criteria as they apply to each patient will assure 
a more reliable assessment, the relative severity and valence of individual criteria and 
their contribution to a diagnosis require clinical judgment. The symptoms in our diagnos- 
tic criteria are part of the relatively limited repertoire of human emotional responses to in- 
ternal and external stresses that are generally maintained in a homeostatic balance without 
a disruption in normal functioning. It requires clinical training to recognize when the com- 
bination of predisposing, precipitating, perpetuating, and protective factors has resulted 
in a psychopathological condition in which physical signs and symptoms exceed normal 
ranges. The ultimate goal of a clinical case formulation is to use the available contextual 
and diagnostic information in developing a comprehensive treatment plan that is in- 
formed by the individual's cultural and social context. However, recommendations for the 
selection and use of the most appropriate evidence-based treatment options for each dis- 
order are beyond the scope of this manual. 

Although decades of scientific effort have gone into developing the diagnostic criteria 
sets for the disorders included in Section II, it is well recognized that this set of categorical 
diagnoses does not fully describe the full range of mental disorders that individuals ex- 
perience and present to clinicians on a daily basis throughout the world. As noted previ- 
ously in the introduction, the range of genetic /environmental interactions over the course 
of human development affecting cognitive, emotional and behavioral function is virtually 
limitless. As a result, it is impossible to capture the full range of psychopathology in the 
categorical diagnostic categories that we are now using. Hence, it is also necessary to in- 
clude “other specified/unspecified” disorder options for presentations that do not fit 
exactly into the diagnostic boundaries of disorders in each chapter. In an emergency de- 
partment setting, it may be possible to identify only the most prominent symptom ex- 
pressions associated with a particular chapter—for example, delusions, hallucinations, 


19 


20 Use of the Manual 


mania, depression, anxiety, substance intoxication, or neurocognitive symptoms—so that 
an “unspecified” disorder in that category is identified until a fuller differential diagnosis 
is possible. 


Definition of a Mental Disorder 


Each disorder identified in Section IT of the manual (excluding those in the chapters enti- 
tled “Medication-Induced Movement Disorders and Other Adverse Effects of Medica- 
tion” and “Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention”) must meet the 
definition of a mental disorder. Although no definition can capture all aspects of all dis- 
orders in the range contained in DSM-5, the following elements are required: 


A mental disorder is a syndrome characterized by clinically significant distur- 
bance in an individual’s cognition, emotion regulation, or behavior that reflects 
a dysfunction in the psychological, biological, or developmental processes un- 
derlying mental functioning. Mental disorders are usually associated with signif- 
icant distress or disability in social, occupational, or other important activities. 
An expectable or culturally approved response to a common stressor or loss, 
such as the death of a loved one, is not a mental disorder. Socially deviant be- 
havior (e.g., political, religious, or sexual) and conflicts that are primarily be- 
tween the individual and society are not mental disorders unless the deviance 
or conflict results from a dysfunction in the individual, as described above. 


The diagnosis of a mental disorder should have clinical utility: it should help clinicians 
to determine prognosis, treatment plans, and potential treatment outcomes for their pa- 
tients. However, the diagnosis of a mental disorder is not equivalent to a need for treat- 
ment. Need for treatment is a complex clinical decision that takes into consideration 
symptom severity, symptom salience (e.g., the presence of suicidal ideation), the patient’s 
distress (mental pain) associated with the symptom(s), disability related to the patient’s 
symptoms, risks and benefits of available treatments, and other factors (e.g., psychiatric 
symptoms complicating other illness). Clinicians may thus encounter individuals whose 
symptoms do not meet full criteria for a mental disorder but who demonstrate a clear need 
for treatment or care. The fact that some individuals do not show all symptoms indicative 
of a diagnosis should not be used to justify limiting their access to appropriate care. 

Approaches to validating diagnostic criteria for discrete categorical mental disorders 
have included the following types of evidence: antecedent validators (similar genetic mark- 
ers, family traits, temperament, and environmental exposure), concurrent validators (simi- 
lar neural substrates, biomarkers, emotional and cognitive processing, and symptom 
similarity), and predictive validators (similar clinical course and treatment response). In 
DSM-5, we recognize that the current diagnostic criteria for any single disorder will not nec- 
essarily identify a homogeneous group of patients who can be characterized reliably with all 
of these validators. Available evidence shows that these validators cross existing diagnostic 
boundaries but tend to congregate more frequently within and across adjacent DSM-5 chap- 
ter groups. Until incontrovertible etiological or pathophysiological mechanisms are identi- 
fied to fully validate specific disorders or disorder spectra, the most important standard for 
the DSM-5 disorder criteria will be their clinical utility for the assessment of clinical course 
and treatment response of individuals grouped by a given set of diagnostic criteria. 

This definition of mental disorder was developed for clinical, public health, and re- 
search purposes. Additional information is usually required beyond that contained in the 
DSM-5 diagnostic criteria in order to make legal judgments on such issues as criminal re- 
sponsibility, eligibility for disability compensation, and competency (see “Cautionary 
Statement for Forensic Use of DSM-5” elsewhere in this manual). 


Use of the Manual 21 


Criterion for Clinical Significance 


There have been substantial efforts by the DSM-5 Task Force and the World Health Orga- 
nization (WHO) to separate the concepts of mental disorder and disability (impairment in 
social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning). In the WHO system, the In- 
ternational Classification of Diseases (ICD) covers all diseases and disorders, while the In- 
ternational Classification of Functioning, Disability and Health (ICF) provides a separate 
classification of global disability. The WHO Disability Assessment Schedule (WHODAS) 
is based on the ICF and has proven useful as a standardized measure of disability for men- 
tal disorders. However, in the absence of clear biological markers or clinically useful mea- 
surements of severity for many mental disorders, it has not been possible to completely 
separate normal and pathological symptom expressions contained in diagnostic criteria. 
This gap in information is particularly problematic in clinical situations in which the pa- 
tient’s symptom presentation by itself (particularly in mild forms) is not inherently path- 
ological and may be encountered in individuals for whom a diagnosis of “mental 
disorder” would be inappropriate. Therefore, a generic diagnostic criterion requiring dis- 
tress or disability has been used to establish disorder thresholds, usually worded “the dis- 
turbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning.” The text following the revised definition of a mental 
disorder acknowledges that this criterion may be especially helpful in determining a pa- 
tient’s need for treatment. Use of information from family members and other third parties 
(in addition to the individual) regarding the individual’s performance is recommended 
when necessary. 


Elements of a Diagnosis 
Diagnostic Criteria and Descriptors 


Diagnostic criteria are offered as guidelines for making diagnoses, and their use should be 
informed by clinical judgment. Text descriptions, including introductory sections of each 
diagnostic chapter, can help support diagnosis (e.g., providing differential diagnoses; de- 
scribing the criteria more fully under “Diagnostic Features”). 

Following the assessment of diagnostic criteria, clinicians should consider the applica- 
tion of disorder subtypes and/or specifiers as appropriate. Severity and course specifiers 
should be applied to denote the individual’s current presentation, but only when the full 
criteria are met. When full criteria are not met, clinicians should consider whether the 
symptom presentation meets criteria for an “other specified” or “unspecified” designa- 
tion. Where applicable, specific criteria for defining disorder severity (e.g., mild, moder- 
ate, severe, extreme), descriptive features (e.g., with good to fair insight; in a controlled 
environment), and course (e.g., in partial remission, in full remission, recurrent) are pro- 
vided with each diagnosis. On the basis of the clinical interview, text descriptions, criteria, 
and clinician judgment, a final diagnosis is made. 

The general convention in DSM-5 is to allow multiple diagnoses to be assigned for 
those presentations that meet criteria for more than one DSM-5 disorder. 


Subtypes and Specifiers 


Subtypes and specifiers (some of which are coded in the fourth, fifth, or sixth digit) are 
provided for increased specificity. Subtypes define mutually exclusive and jointly exhaus- 
tive phenomenological subgroupings within a diagnosis and are indicated by the instruc- 
tion “Specify whether” in the criteria set. In contrast, specifiers are not intended to be 
mutually exclusive or jointly exhaustive, and as a consequence, more than one specifier 
may be given. Specifiers are indicated by the instruction “Specify” or “Specify if” in the cri- 
teria set. Specifiers provide an opportunity to define a more homogeneous subgrouping of 


22 Use of the Manual 


individuals with the disorder who share certain features (e.g., major depressive disorder, 
with mixed features) and to convey information that is relevant to the management of the 
individual’s disorder, such as the “with other medical comorbidity” specifier in sleep- 
wake disorders. Although a fifth digit is sometimes assigned to code a subtype or specifier 
(e.g., 294.11 [F02.81] major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, with be- 
havioral disturbance) or severity (296.21 [F32.0] major depressive disorder, single episode, 
mild), the majority of subtypes and specifiers included in DSM-5 cannot be coded within 
the ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM systems and are indicated only by including the subtype or 
specifier after the name of the disorder (e.g., social anxiety disorder [social phobia], per- 
formance type). Note that in some cases, a specifier or subtype is codable in ICD-10-CM 
but not in ICD-9-CM. Accordingly, in some cases the 4th or 5th character codes for the sub- 
types or specifiers are provided only for the ICD-10-CM coding designations. 

A DSM-5 diagnosis is usually applied to the individual’s current presentation; previ- 
ous diagnoses from which the individual has recovered should be clearly noted as such. 
Specifiers indicating course (e.g., in partial remission, in full remission) may be listed after 
the diagnosis and are indicated in a number of criteria sets. Where available, severity spec- 
ifiers are provided to guide clinicians in rating the intensity, frequency, duration, symptom 
count, or other severity indicator of a disorder. Severity specifiers are indicated by the in- 
struction “Specify current severity” in the criteria set and include disorder-specific defini- 
tions. Descriptive features specifiers have also been provided in the criteria set and convey 
additional information that can inform treatment planning (e.g., obsessive-compulsive 
disorder, with poor insight). Not all disorders include course, severity, and/or descriptive 
features specifiers. 


Medication-Induced Movement Disorders and Other 
Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 


In addition to important psychosocial and environmental factors (see “The Multiaxial Sys- 
tem” in the “Introduction” elsewhere in this manual), these chapters in Section II also con- 
tain other conditions that are not mental disorders but may be encountered by mental 
health clinicians. These conditions may be listed as a reason for clinical visit in addition to, 
or in place of, the mental disorders listed in Section II. A separate chapter is devoted to 
medication-induced disorders and other adverse effects of medication that may be as- 
sessed and treated by clinicians in mental health practice such as akathisia, tardive dyski- 
nesia, and dystonia. The description of neuroleptic malignant syndrome is expanded from 
that provided in DSM-IV-TR to highlight the emergent and potentially life-threatening na- 
ture of this condition, and a new entry on antidepressant discontinuation syndrome is pro- 
vided. An additional chapter discusses other conditions that may be a focus of clinical 
attention. These include relational problems, problems related to abuse and neglect, prob- 
lems with adherence to treatment regimens, obesity, antisocial behavior, and malingering. 


Principal Diagnosis 

When more than one diagnosis for an individual is given in an inpatient setting, the prin- 
cipal diagnosis is the condition established after study to be chiefly responsible for occa- 
sioning the admission of the individual. When more than one diagnosis is given for an 
individual in an outpatient setting, the reason for visit is the condition that is chiefly re- 
sponsible for the ambulatory care medical services received during the visit. In most cases, 
the principal diagnosis or the reason for visit is also the main focus of attention or treat- 
ment. It is often difficult (and somewhat arbitrary) to determine which diagnosis is the 
principal diagnosis or the reason for visit, especially when, for example, a substance- 
related diagnosis such as alcohol use disorder is accompanied by a non-substance-related 
diagnosis such as schizophrenia. For example, it may be unclear which diagnosis should 


Use of the Manual 23 


be considered “principal” for an individual hospitalized with both schizophrenia and al- 
cohol use disorder, because each condition may have contributed equally to the need for 
admission and treatment. The principal diagnosis is indicated by listing it first, and the re- 
maining disorders are listed in order of focus of attention and treatment. When the prin- 
cipal diagnosis or reason for visit is a mental disorder due to another medical condition 
(e.g., major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, psychotic disorder due to 
malignant lung neoplasm), ICD coding rules require that the etiological medical condition 
be listed first. In that case, the principal diagnosis or reason for visit would be the mental 
disorder due to the medical condition, the second listed diagnosis. In most cases, the dis- 
order listed as the principal diagnosis or the reason for visit is followed by the qualifying 
phrase “(principal diagnosis)” or “(reason for visit).” 


Provisional Diagnosis 


The specifier “provisional” can be used when there is a strong presumption that the full 
criteria will ultimately be met for a disorder but not enough information is available to 
make a firm diagnosis. The clinician can indicate the diagnostic uncertainty by recording 
“(provisional)” following the diagnosis. For example, this diagnosis might be used when 
an individual who appears to have a major depressive disorder is unable to give an ade- 
quate history, and thus it cannot be established that the full criteria are met. Another use of 
the term provisional is for those situations in which differential diagnosis depends exclu- 
sively on the duration of illness. For example, a diagnosis of schizophreniform disorder re- 
quires a duration of less than 6 months but of at least 1 month and can only be given 
provisionally if assigned before remission has occurred. 


Coding and Reporting Procedures 


Each disorder is accompanied by an identifying diagnostic and statistical code, which is 
typically used by institutions and agencies for data collection and billing purposes. There 
are specific recording protocols for these diagnostic codes (identified as coding notes in 
the text) that were established by WHO, the U.S. Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Ser- 
vices (CMS), and the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention’s National Center for 
Health Statistics to ensure consistent international recording of prevalence and mortality 
rates for identified health conditions. For most clinicians, the codes are used to identify the 
diagnosis or reason for visit for CMS and private insurance service claims. The official 
coding system in use in the United States as of publication of this manual is ICD-9-CM. Of- 
ficial adoption of ICD-10-CM is scheduled to take place on October 1, 2014, and these 
codes, which are shown parenthetically in this manual, should not be used until the offi- 
cial implementation occurs. Both ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes have been listed 1) pre- 
ceding the name of the disorder in the classification and 2) accompanying the criteria set 
for each disorder. For some diagnoses (e.g., neurocognitive and substance /medication- 
induced disorders), the appropriate code depends on further specification and is listed 
within the criteria set for the disorder, as coding notes, and, in some cases, further clarified 
in a section on recording procedures. The names of some disorders are followed by alter- 
native terms enclosed in parentheses, which, in most cases, were the DSM-IV names for 
the disorders. 


Looking to the Future: 
Assessment and Monitoring Tools 


The various components of DSM-5 are provided to facilitate patient assessment and to aid 
in developing a comprehensive case formulation. Whereas the diagnostic criteria in Sec- 
tion II are well-established measures that have undergone extensive review, the assess- 


24 Use of the Manual 


ment tools, a cultural formulation interview, and conditions for further study included in 
Section III are those for which we determined that the scientific evidence is not yet avail- 
able to support widespread clinical use. These diagnostic aids and criteria are included to 
highlight the evolution and direction of scientific advances in these areas and to stimulate 
further research. 

Each of the measures in Section III is provided to aid in a comprehensive assessment of 
individuals that will contribute to a diagnosis and treatment plan tailored to the individ- 
ual presentation and clinical context. Where cultural dynamics are particularly important 
for diagnostic assessment, the cultural formulation interview should be considered as a 
useful aid to communication with the individual. Cross-cutting symptom and diagnosis- 
specific severity measures provide quantitative ratings of important clinical areas that are 
designed to be used at the initial evaluation to establish a baseline for comparison with rat- 
ings on subsequent encounters to monitor changes and inform treatment planning. 

The use of such measures will undoubtedly be facilitated by digital applications, and 
the measures are included in Section III to provide for further evaluation and develop- 
ment. As with each DSM edition, the diagnostic criteria and the DSM-5 classification of 
mental disorders reflect the current consensus on the evolving knowledge in our field. 


Cautionary Statement for 
Forensic Use of DSM-5 


Althoug h the DSM-5 diagnostic criteria and text are primarily designed to assist 
clinicians in conducting clinical assessment, case formulation, and treatment planning, 
DSM- 5 is also used as a reference for the courts and attorneys in assessing the forensic con- 
sequences of mental disorders. As a result, it is important to note that the definition of 
mental disorder included in DSM-5 was developed to meet the needs of clinicians, public 
health professionals, and research investigators rather than all of the technical needs of the 
courts and legal professionals. It is also important to note that DSM-5 does not provide 
treatment guidelines for any given disorder. 

When used appropriately, diagnoses and diagnostic information can assist legal deci- 
sion makers in their determinations. For example, when the presence of a mental disorder 
is the predicate for a subsequent legal determination (e.g., involuntary civil commitment), 
the use of an established system of diagnosis enhances the value and reliability of the de- 
termination. By providing a compendium based on a review of the pertinent clinical and 
research literature, DSM-5 may facilitate legal decision makers’ understanding of the rel- 
evant characteristics of mental disorders. The literature related to diagnoses also serves as 
a check on ungrounded speculation about mental disorders and about the functioning of a 
particular individual. Finally, diagnostic information about longitudinal course may im- 
prove decision making when the legal issue concerns an individual’s mental functioning 
at a past or future point in time. 

However, the use of DSM-5 should be informed by an awareness of the risks and lim- 
itations of its use in forensic settings. When DSM-5 categories, criteria, and textual descrip- 
tions are employed for forensic purposes, there is a risk that diagnostic information will be 
misused or misunderstood. These dangers arise because of the imperfect fit between the 
questions of ultimate concern to the law and the information contained in a clinical diagno- 
sis. In most situations, the clinical diagnosis of a DSM-5 mental disorder such as intellec- 
tual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), schizophrenia, major neurocognitive 
disorder, gambling disorder, or pedophilic disorder does not imply that an individual 
with such a condition meets legal criteria for the presence of a mental disorder or a speci- 
fied legal standard (e.g., for competence, criminal responsibility, or disability). For the latter, 
additional information is usually required beyond that contained in the DSM-5 diagnosis, 
which might include information about the individual's functional impairments and how 
these impairments affect the particular abilities in question. It is precisely because impair- 
ments, abilities, and disabilities vary widely within each diagnostic category that assign- 
ment of a particular diagnosis does not imply a specific level of impairment or disability. 

Use of DSM 5 to assess for the presence of a mental disorder by nonclinical, nonmed- 
ical, or otherwise insufficiently trained individuals is not advised. Nonclinical decision 
makers should also be cautioned that a diagnosis does not carry any necessary implica- 
tions regarding the etiology or causes of the individual’s mental disorder or the individ- 
ual’s degree of control over behaviors that may be associated with the disorder. Even 
when diminished control over one’s behavior is a feature of the disorder, having the diag- 
nosis in itself does not demonstrate that a particular individual is (or was) unable to con- 
trol his or her behavior at a particular time. 


25 


This page intentionally left blank 


SECTION II 


Diagnostic Criteria and Codes 


Neurodevelopmental Disorders. ......... 0000 ees 31 
Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders ............ 87 
Bipolar and Related Disorders. .............2.2-00 2c eee eee eee 123 
Depressive Disorders ........-..0 000 e eee 155 
Anxiety: DISOrdeIs. s.i05. Soe cht eect al ek se ctats Stivarhat Seared Saath a eats 189 
Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders...............00005 235 
Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders ............+0000eee eee 265 
Dissociative Disorders .............2222 22 eee ee 291 
Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders ............00020e0eee- 309 
Feeding and Eating Disorders ..........-2...22220 02 e ee eee eee 329 
Elimination Disorders ...............202 eee eee 355 
Sleep-Wake Disorders .........- 0-000 eee eee 361 
Sexual DYSTUNCTIONS ii vce arti oie re ae swe d Pence end Se ead es 423 
Gender Dysphoria...........00 0 0c e eee eee ee 451 
Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders............... 461 
Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders ................-++-+- 481 
Neurocognitive Disorders. ..............2202 02 eee eee 591 
Personality Disorders ...........--0..0 eee eee 645 
Paraphilic Disorders..............202 2c eee 685 
Other Mental Disorders ............. 00000 e eee eee 707 
Medication-Induced Movement Disorders and 

Other Adverse Effects of Medication..............-..-.-+-++05- 709 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention......... 715 


This page intentionally left blank 


This Section contains the diagnostic criteria approved for routine clinical 
use along with the ICD-9-CM codes (ICD-10 codes are shown parenthetically). 
For each mental disorder, the diagnostic criteria are followed by descriptive 
text to assist in diagnostic decision making. Where needed, specific recording 
procedures are presented with the diagnostic criteria to provide guidance in 
selecting the most appropriate code. In some cases, separate recording pro- 
cedures for ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM are provided. Although not considered 
as Official DSM-5 disorders, medication-induced movement disorders and other 
adverse effects of medication, as well as other conditions that may be a focus 
of clinical attention (including additional ICD-9-CM V codes and forthcoming 
ICD-10-CM Z codes), are provided to indicate other reasons for a clinical visit 
such as environmental factors and relational problems. These codes are adapted 
from ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM and were neither reviewed nor approved as 
official DSM-5 diagnoses, but can provide additional context for a clinical for- 
mulation and treatment plan. These three components—the criteria and their 
descriptive text, the medication-induced movement disorders and other ad- 
verse effects of medication, and the descriptions of other conditions that may 
be a focus of clinical attention—represent the key elements of the clinical di- 
agnostic process and thus are presented together. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Neurodevelopmental 
Disorders 


The neurod evelopmental disorders are a group of conditions with onset in the 
developmental period. The disorders typically manifest early in development, often be- 
fore the child enters grade school, and are characterized by developmental deficits that 
produce impairments of personal, social, academic, or occupational functioning. The 
range of developmental deficits varies from very specific limitations of learning or control 
of executive functions to global impairments of social skills or intelligence. The neurode- 
velopmental disorders frequently co-occur; for example, individuals with autism spec- 
trum disorder often have intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), and 
many children with attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) also have a specific 
learning disorder. For some disorders, the clinical presentation includes symptoms of ex- 
cess as well as deficits and delays in achieving expected milestones. For example, autism 
spectrum disorder is diagnosed only when the characteristic deficits of social communi- 
cation are accompanied by excessively repetitive behaviors, restricted interests, and insis- 
tence on sameness. 

Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) is characterized by deficits 
in general mental abilities, such as reasoning, problem solving, planning, abstract thinking, 
judgment, academic learning, and learning from experience. The deficits result in impair- 
ments of adaptive functioning, such that the individual fails to meet standards of personal 
independence and social responsibility in one or more aspects of daily life, including com- 
munication, social participation, academic or occupational functioning, and personal inde- 
pendence at home or in community settings. Global developmental delay, as its name 
implies, is diagnosed when an individual fails to meet expected developmental milestones 
in several areas of intellectual functioning. The diagnosis is used for individuals who are 
unable to undergo systematic assessments of intellectual functioning, including children 
who are too young to participate in standardized testing. Intellectual disability may result 
from an acquired insult during the developmental period from, for example, a severe head 
injury, in which case a neurocognitive disorder also may be diagnosed. 

The communication disorders include language disorder, speech sound disorder, so- 
cial (pragmatic) communication disorder, and childhood-onset fluency disorder (stutter- 
ing). The first three disorders are characterized by deficits in the development and use of 
language, speech, and social communication, respectively. Childhood-onset fluency dis- 
order is characterized by disturbances of the normal fluency and motor production of 
speech, including repetitive sounds or syllables, prolongation of consonants or vowel 
sounds, broken words, blocking, or words produced with an excess of physical tension. 
Like other neurodevelopmental disorders, communication disorders begin early in life 
and may produce lifelong functional impairments. 

Autism spectrum disorder is characterized by persistent deficits in social communica- 
tion and social interaction across multiple contexts, including deficits in social reciprocity, 
nonverbal communicative behaviors used for social interaction, and skills in developing, 
maintaining, and understanding relationships. In addition to the social communication 
deficits, the diagnosis of autism spectrum disorder requires the presence of restricted, re- 
petitive patterns of behavior, interests, or activities. Because symptoms change with de- 
velopment and may be masked by compensatory mechanisms, the diagnostic criteria may 


31 


32 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


be met based on historical information, although the current presentation must cause sig- 
nificant impairment. 

Within the diagnosis of autism spectrum disorder, individual clinical characteristics 
are noted through the use of specifiers (with or without accompanying intellectual impair- 
ment; with or without accompanying structural language impairment; associated with a 
known medical/genetic or environmental/acquired condition; associated with another 
neurodevelopmental, mental, or behavioral disorder), as well as specifiers that describe 
the autistic symptoms (age at first concern; with or without loss of established skills; sever- 
ity). These specifiers provide clinicians with an opportunity to individualize the diagnosis 
and communicate a richer clinical description of the affected individuals. For example, many 
individuals previously diagnosed with Asperger’s disorder would now receive a diagnosis 
of autism spectrum disorder without language or intellectual impairment. 

ADHD is a neurodevelopmental disorder defined by impairing levels of inattention, dis- 
organization, and/or hyperactivity-impulsivity. Inattention and disorganization entail inabil- 
ity to stay on task, seeming not to listen, and losing materials, at levels that are inconsistent 
with age or developmental level. Hyperactivity-impulsivity entails overactivity, fidgeting, in- 
ability to stay seated, intruding into other people’s activities, and inability to wait—symptoms 
that are excessive for age or developmental level. In childhood, ADHD frequently overlaps 
with disorders that are often considered to be “externalizing disorders,” such as oppositional 
defiant disorder and conduct disorder. ADHD often persists into adulthood, with resultant 
impairments of social, academic and occupational functioning. 

The neurodevelopmental motor disorders include developmental coordination disor- 
der, stereotypic movement disorder, and tic disorders. Developmental coordination dis- 
order is characterized by deficits in the acquisition and execution of coordinated motor 
skills and is manifested by clumsiness and slowness or inaccuracy of performance of mo- 
tor skills that cause interference with activities of daily living. Stereotypic movement dis- 
order is diagnosed when an individual has repetitive, seemingly driven, and apparently 
purposeless motor behaviors, such as hand flapping, body rocking, head banging, self- 
biting, or hitting. The movements interfere with social, academic, or other activities. If the 
behaviors cause self-injury, this should be specified as part of the diagnostic description. 
Tic disorders are characterized by the presence of motor or vocal tics, which are sudden, 
rapid, recurrent, nonrhythmic, sterotyped motor movements or vocalizations. The dura- 
tion, presumed etiology, and clinical presentation define the specific tic disorder that is di- 
agnosed: Tourette’s disorder, persistent (chronic) motor or vocal tic disorder, provisional 
tic disorder, other specified tic disorder, and unspecified tic disorder. Tourette’s disorder 
is diagnosed when the individual has multiple motor and vocal tics that have been present 
for at least 1 year and that have a waxing-waning symptom course. 

Specific learning disorder, as the name implies, is diagnosed when there are specific defi- 
cits in an individual's ability to perceive or process information efficiently and accurately. This 
neurodevelopmental disorder first manifests during the years of formal schooling and is 
characterized by persistent and impairing difficulties with learning foundational academic 
skills in reading, writing, and/or math. The individual’s performance of the affected academic 
skills is well below average for age, or acceptable performance levels are achieved only with 
extraordinary effort. Specific learning disorder may occur in individuals identified as intellec- 
tually gifted and manifest only when the learning demands or assessment procedures (e.g., 
timed tests) pose barriers that cannot be overcome by their innate intelligence and compensa- 
tory strategies. For all individuals, specific learning disorder can produce lifelong impairments 
in activities dependent on the skills, including occupational performance. 

The use of specifiers for the neurodevelopmental disorder diagnoses enriches the clin- 
ical description of the individual's clinical course and current symptomatology. In addi- 
tion to specifiers that describe the clinical presentation, such as age at onset or severity 
ratings, the neurodevelopmental disorders may include the specifier “associated with a 
known medical or genetic condition or environmental factor.” This specifier gives clini- 


Intellectual Disability (Intellectual Developmental Disorder) 33 


cians an opportunity to document factors that may have played a role in the etiology of the 
disorder, as well as those that might affect the clinical course. Examples include genetic 
disorders, such as fragile X syndrome, tuberous sclerosis, and Rett syndrome; medical con- 
ditions such as epilepsy; and environmental factors, including very low birth weight and 
fetal alcohol exposure (even in the absence of stigmata of fetal alcohol syndrome). 


Intellectual Disabilities 


Intellectual Disability 
(Intellectual Developmental Disorder) 


Diagnostic Criteria 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) is a disorder with onset during 
the developmental period that includes both intellectual and adaptive functioning deficits 
in conceptual, social, and practical domains. The following three criteria must be met: 

A. Deficits in intellectual functions, such as reasoning, problem solving, planning, abstract 
thinking, judgment, academic learning, and learning from experience, confirmed by 
both clinical assessment and individualized, standardized intelligence testing. 

B. Deficits in adaptive functioning that result in failure to meet developmental and socio- 
cultural standards for personal independence and social responsibility. Without ongo- 
ing support, the adaptive deficits limit functioning in one or more activities of daily life, 
such as communication, social participation, and independent living, across multiple 
environments, such as home, school, work, and community. 

C. Onset of intellectual and adaptive deficits during the developmental period. 


Note: The diagnostic term intellectual disability is the equivalent term for the ICD-11 diag- 
nosis of intellectual developmental disorders. Although the term intellectual disability is 
used throughout this manual, both terms are used in the title to clarify relationships with 
other classification systems. Moreover, a federal statute in the United States (Public Law 
111-256, Rosa’s Law) replaces the term mental retardation with intellectual disability, and 
research journals use the term intellectual disability. Thus, intellectual disability is the 
term in common use by medical, educational, and other professions and by the lay public 
and advocacy groups. 
Specify current severity (See Table 1): 

317 (F70) Mild 

318.0 (F71) Moderate 

318.1 (F72) Severe 

318.2 (F73) Profound 


Specifiers 

The various levels of severity are defined on the basis of adaptive functioning, and not IQ 
scores, because it is adaptive functioning that determines the level of supports required. 
Moreover, IQ measures are less valid in the lower end of the IQ range. 


TABLE 1 Severity levels for intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) 


Severity 


level Social domain Practical domain 


ve 


Conceptual domain 


For preschool children, there 
may be no obvious conceptual 
differences. For school-age 
children and adults, there are 
difficulties in learning aca- 
demic skills involving reading, 
writing, arithmetic, time, or 
money, with support needed 
in one or more areas to meet 
age-related expectations. In 
adults, abstract thinking, exec- 
utive function (i.e., planning, 
strategizing, priority setting, 
and cognitive flexibility), and 
short-term memory, as well as 
functional use of academic 
skills (e.g., reading, money 
management), are impaired. 
There is a somewhat concrete 
approach to problems and 
solutions compared with 
age-mates. 


Compared with typically developing age- 
mates, the individual is immature in social 
interactions. For example, there may be diffi- 
culty in accurately perceiving peers’ social 
cues. Communication, conversation, and lan- 
guage are more concrete or immature than 
expected for age. There may be difficulties reg- 
ulating emotion and behavior in age-appropri- 
ate fashion; these difficulties are noticed by 
peers in social situations. There is limited 
understanding of risk in social situations; 
social judgment is immature for age, and 
the person is at risk of being manipulated 
by others (gullibility). 


The individual may function age-appropriately in 
personal care. Individuals need some support with 
complex daily living tasks in comparison to peers. In 
adulthood, supports typically involve grocery shop- 
ping, transportation, home and child-care organiz- 
ing, nutritious food preparation, and banking and 
money management. Recreational skills resemble 
those of age-mates, although judgment related to 
well-being and organization around recreation 
requires support. In adulthood, competitive 
employment is often seen in jobs that do not empha- 
size conceptual skills. Individuals generally need 
support to make health care decisions and legal 
decisions, and to learn to perform a skilled vocation 
competently. Support is typically needed to raise a 
family. 


sJepsosiq je]uswdojeAepoineNn 


TABLE 1 Severity levels for intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) (continued) 


Severity 


level Conceptual domain 


Moderate | All through development, the 
individual’s conceptual skills 
lag markedly behind those of 
peers. For preschoolers, lan- 
guage and pre-academic skills 
develop slowly. For school-age 
children, progress in reading, 
writing, mathematics, and 
understanding of time and 
money occurs slowly across 
the school years and is mark- 
edly limited compared with 
that of peers. For adults, aca- 
demic skill development is 
typically at an elementary 
level, and support is required 
for all use of academic skills in 
work and personal life. Ongo- 
ing assistance on a daily basis 
is needed to complete concep- 
tual tasks of day-to-day life, 
and others may take over these 
responsibilities fully for the 
individual. 


Social domain 


The individual shows marked differences from 


peers in social and communicative behavior 
across development. Spoken language is typi- 
cally a primary tool for social communication 
but is much less complex than that of peers. 
Capacity for relationships is evident in ties to 
family and friends, and the individual may 
have successful friendships across life and 
sometimes romantic relations in adulthood. 
However, individuals may not perceive or 
interpret social cues accurately. Social judg- 
ment and decision-making abilities are lim- 
ited, and caretakers must assist the person 
with life decisions. Friendships with typically 
developing peers are often affected by com- 
munication or social limitations. Significant 
social and communicative support is needed 
in work settings for success. 


Practical domain 


The individual can care for personal needs involving 
eating, dressing, elimination, and hygiene as an 
adult, although an extended period of teaching and 
time is needed for the individual to become indepen- 
dent in these areas, and reminders may be needed. 
Similarly, participation in all household tasks can be 
achieved by adulthood, although an extended 
period of teaching is needed, and ongoing supports 
will typically occur for adult-level performance. 
Independent employment in jobs that require lim- 
ited conceptual and communication skills can be 
achieved, but considerable support from co-work- 
ers, supervisors, and others is needed to manage 
social expectations, job complexities, and ancillary 
responsibilities such as scheduling, transportation, 
health benefits, and money management. A variety 
of recreational skills can be developed. These typi- 
cally require additional supports and learning 
opportunities over an extended period of time. 
Maladaptive behavior is present in a significant 
minority and causes social problems. 


(Jepuosiq jejusudojenggq jenyoeyjequy) Aujiqesiq jenjoe||e1u| 


ce 


TABLE 1 Severity levels for intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) (continued) 


Severity 


level Conceptual domain 


Attainment of conceptual skills 
is limited. The individual gen- 
erally has little understanding 
of written language or of con- 
cepts involving numbers, 
quantity, time, and money. 
Caretakers provide extensive 
supports for problem solving 
throughout life. 


Profound | Conceptual skills generally 
involve the physical world 
rather than symbolic pro- 
cesses. The individual may use 
objects in goal-directed fashion 
for self-care, work, and recre- 
ation. Certain visuospatial 
skills, such as matching and 
sorting based on physical char- 
acteristics, may be acquired. 
However, co-occurring motor 
and sensory impairments may 
prevent functional use of 
objects. 


Social domain 


Spoken language is quite limited in terms of 
vocabulary and grammar. Speech may be sin- 
gle words or phrases and may be supple- 
mented through augmentative means. Speech 
and communication are focused on the here 
and now within everyday events. Language is 
used for social communication more than for 
explication. Individuals understand simple 
speech and gestural communication. Relation- 
ships with family members and familiar others 
are a source of pleasure and help. 


The individual has very limited understanding 
of symbolic communication in speech or ges- 
ture. He or she may understand some simple 
instructions or gestures. The individual 
expresses his or her own desires and emotions 
largely through nonverbal, nonsymbolic com- 
munication. The individual enjoys relation- 
ships with well-known family members, 
caretakers, and familiar others, and initiates 
and responds to social interactions through 
gestural and emotional cues. Co-occurring 
sensory and physical impairments may pre- 
vent many social activities. 


Practical domain 


The individual requires support for all activities of 
daily living, including meals, dressing, bathing, and 
elimination. The individual requires supervision at 
all times. The individual cannot make responsible 
decisions regarding well-being of self or others. In 
adulthood, participation in tasks at home, recre- 
ation, and work requires ongoing support and assis- 
tance. Skill acquisition in all domains involves long- 
term teaching and ongoing support. Maladaptive 
behavior, including self-injury, is present in a signif- 
icant minority. 


The individual is dependent on others for all aspects of 
daily physical care, health, and safety, although he or 
she may be able to participate in some of these activi- 
ties as well. Individuals without severe physical 
impairments may assist with some daily work tasks at 
home, like carrying dishes to the table. Simple actions 
with objects may be the basis of participation in some 
vocational activities with high levels of ongoing sup- 
port. Recreational activities may involve, for example, 
enjoyment in listening to music, watching movies, 
going out for walks, or participating in water activi- 
ties, all with the support of others. Co-occurring 
physical and sensory impairments are frequent 
barriers to participation (beyond watching) in home, 
recreational, and vocational activities. Maladaptive 
behavior is present in a significant minority. 


9€ 


sJepsosiq je]JusudojeAeposneNn 


Intellectual Disability (Intellectual Developmental Disorder) 37 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) are 
deficits in general mental abilities (Criterion A) and impairment in everyday adaptive 
functioning, in comparison to an individual’s age-, gender-, and socioculturally matched 
peers (Criterion B). Onset is during the developmental period (Criterion C). The diagnosis 
of intellectual disability is based on both clinical assessment and standardized testing of 
intellectual and adaptive functions. 

Criterion A refers to intellectual functions that involve reasoning, problem solving, 
planning, abstract thinking, judgment, learning from instruction and experience, and 
practical understanding. Critical components include verbal comprehension, working 
memory, perceptual reasoning, quantitative reasoning, abstract thought, and cognitive ef- 
ficacy. Intellectual functioning is typically measured with individually administered and 
psychometrically valid, comprehensive, culturally appropriate, psychometrically sound 
tests of intelligence. Individuals with intellectual disability have scores of approximately 
two standard deviations or more below the population mean, including a margin for mea- 
surement error (generally +5 points). On tests with a standard deviation of 15 and a mean 
of 100, this involves a score of 65-75 (70 + 5). Clinical training and judgment are required 
to interpret test results and assess intellectual performance. 

Factors that may affect test scores include practice effects and the “Flynn effect’ (i.e., 
overly high scores due to out-of-date test norms). Invalid scores may result from the use of 
brief intelligence screening tests or group tests; highly discrepant individual subtest scores 
may make an overall IQ score invalid. Instruments must be normed for the individual's so- 
ciocultural background and native language. Co-occurring disorders that affect communi- 
cation, language, and/or motor or sensory function may affect test scores. Individual 
cognitive profiles based on neuropsychological testing are more useful for understanding 
intellectual abilities than a single IQ score. Such testing may identify areas of relative 
strengths and weaknesses, an assessment important for academic and vocational planning. 

IQ test scores are approximations of conceptual functioning but may be insufficient to 
assess reasoning in real-life situations and mastery of practical tasks. For example, a per- 
son with an IQ score above 70 may have such severe adaptive behavior problems in social 
judgment, social understanding, and other areas of adaptive functioning that the person’s 
actual functioning is comparable to that of individuals with a lower IQ score. Thus, clinical 
judgment is needed in interpreting the results of IQ tests. 

Deficits in adaptive functioning (Criterion B) refer to how well a person meets community 
standards of personal independence and social responsibility, in comparison to others of sim- 
ilar age and sociocultural background. Adaptive functioning involves adaptive reasoning in 
three domains: conceptual, social, and practical. The conceptual (academic) domain involves 
competence in memory, language, reading, writing, math reasoning, acquisition of practical 
knowledge, problem solving, and judgment in novel situations, among others. The social do- 
main involves awareness of others’ thoughts, feelings, and experiences; empathy; interper- 
sonal communication skills; friendship abilities; and social judgment, among others. The 
practical domain involves learning and self-management across life settings, including personal 
care, job responsibilities, money management, recreation, self-management of behavior, and 
school and work task organization, among others. Intellectual capacity, education, motivation, 
socialization, personality features, vocational opportunity, cultural experience, and coexisting 
general medical conditions or mental disorders influence adaptive functioning. 

Adaptive functioning is assessed using both clinical evaluation and individualized, 
culturally appropriate, psychometrically sound measures. Standardized measures are 
used with knowledgeable informants (e.g., parent or other family member; teacher; coun- 
selor; care provider) and the individual to the extent possible. Additional sources of infor- 
mation include educational, developmental, medical, and mental health evaluations. 
Scores from standardized measures and interview sources must be interpreted using clin- 
ical judgment. When standardized testing is difficult or impossible, because of a variety of 


38 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


factors (e.g., sensory impairment, severe problem behavior), the individual may be diag- 
nosed with unspecified intellectual disability. Adaptive functioning may be difficult to 
assess in a controlled setting (e.g., prisons, detention centers); if possible, corroborative in- 
formation reflecting functioning outside those settings should be obtained. 

Criterion B is met when at least one domain of adaptive functioning—conceptual, so- 
cial, or practical—is sufficiently impaired that ongoing support is needed in order for the 
person to perform adequately in one or more life settings at school, at work, at home, or in 
the community. To meet diagnostic criteria for intellectual disability, the deficits in adap- 
tive functioning must be directly related to the intellectual impairments described in Cri- 
terion A. Criterion C, onset during the developmental period, refers to recognition that 
intellectual and adaptive deficits are present during childhood or adolescence. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Intellectual disability is a heterogeneous condition with multiple causes. There may be 
associated difficulties with social judgment; assessment of risk; self-management of behav- 
ior, emotions, or interpersonal relationships; or motivation in school or work environments. 
Lack of communication skills may predispose to disruptive and aggressive behaviors. Gull- 
ibility is often a feature, involving naiveté in social situations and a tendency for being easily 
led by others. Gullibility and lack of awareness of risk may result in exploitation by others 
and possible victimization, fraud, unintentional criminal involvement, false confessions, 
and risk for physical and sexual abuse. These associated features can be important in crim- 
inal cases, including Atkins-type hearings involving the death penalty. 

Individuals with a diagnosis of intellectual disability with co-occurring mental disor- 
ders are at risk for suicide. They think about suicide, make suicide attempts, and may die 
from them. Thus, screening for suicidal thoughts is essential in the assessment process. Be- 
cause of a lack of awareness of risk and danger, accidental injury rates may be increased. 


Prevalence 


Intellectual disability has an overall general population prevalence of approximately 1%, 
and prevalence rates vary by age. Prevalence for severe intellectual disability is approxi- 
mately 6 per 1,000. 


Development and Course 


Onset of intellectual disability is in the developmental period. The age and characteristic 
features at onset depend on the etiology and severity of brain dysfunction. Delayed motor, 
language, and social milestones may be identifiable within the first 2 years of life among 
those with more severe intellectual disability, while mild levels may not be identifiable un- 
til school age when difficulty with academic learning becomes apparent. All criteria (in- 
cluding Criterion C) must be fulfilled by history or current presentation. Some children 
under age 5 years whose presentation will eventually meet criteria for intellectual disabil- 
ity have deficits that meet criteria for global developmental delay. 

When intellectual disability is associated with a genetic syndrome, there may be a char- 
acteristic physical appearance (as in, e.g., Down syndrome). Some syndromes have a 
behavioral phenotype, which refers to specific behaviors that are characteristic of particular 
genetic disorder (e.g., Lesch-Nyhan syndrome). In acquired forms, the onset may be 
abrupt following an illness such as meningitis or encephalitis or head trauma occurring 
during the developmental period. When intellectual disability results from a loss of pre- 
viously acquired cognitive skills, as in severe traumatic brain injury, the diagnoses of in- 
tellectual disability and of a neurocognitive disorder may both be assigned. 

Although intellectual disability is generally nonprogressive, in certain genetic disor- 
ders (e.g., Rett syndrome) there are periods of worsening, followed by stabilization, and in 


Intellectual Disability (Intellectual Developmental Disorder) 39 


others (e.g., San Phillippo syndrome) progressive worsening of intellectual function. After 
early childhood, the disorder is generally lifelong, although severity levels may change 
over time. The course may be influenced by underlying medical or genetic conditions and 
co-occurring conditions (e.g., hearing or visual impairments, epilepsy). Early and ongoing in- 
terventions may improve adaptive functioning throughout childhood and adulthood. In 
some cases, these result in significant improvement of intellectual functioning, such that 
the diagnosis of intellectual disability is no longer appropriate. Thus, it is common practice 
when assessing infants and young children to delay diagnosis of intellectual disability un- 
til after an appropriate course of intervention is provided. For older children and adults, 
the extent of support provided may allow for full participation in all activities of daily liv- 
ing and improved adaptive function. Diagnostic assessments must determine whether im- 
proved adaptive skills are the result of a stable, generalized new skill acquisition (in which 
case the diagnosis of intellectual disability may no longer be appropriate) or whether the 
improvement is contingent on the presence of supports and ongoing interventions (in 
which case the diagnosis of intellectual disability may still be appropriate). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Prenatal etiologies include genetic syndromes (e.g., se- 
quence variations or copy number variants involving one or more genes; chromosomal 
disorders), inborn errors of metabolism, brain malformations, maternal disease (including 
placental disease), and environmental influences (e.g., alcohol, other drugs, toxins, terato- 
gens). Perinatal causes include a variety of labor and delivery-related events leading to 
neonatal encephalopathy. Postnatal causes include hypoxic ischemic injury, traumatic 
brain injury, infections, demyelinating disorders, seizure disorders (e.g., infantile spasms), 
severe and chronic social deprivation, and toxic metabolic syndromes and intoxications 
(e.g., lead, mercury). 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Intellectual disability occurs in all races and cultures. Cultural sensitivity and knowledge 
are needed during assessment, and the individual's ethnic, cultural, and linguistic back- 
ground, available experiences, and adaptive functioning within his or her community and 
cultural setting must be taken into account. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Overall, males are more likely than females to be diagnosed with both mild (average 
male:female ratio 1.6:1) and severe (average male:female ratio 1.2:1) forms of intellectual 
disability. However, gender ratios vary widely in reported studies. Sex-linked genetic fac- 
tors and male vulnerability to brain insult may account for some of the gender differences. 


Diagnostic Markers 


A comprehensive evaluation includes an assessment of intellectual capacity and adaptive 
functioning; identification of genetic and nongenetic etiologies; evaluation for associated 
medical conditions (e.g., cerebral palsy, seizure disorder); and evaluation for co-occurring 
mental, emotional, and behavioral disorders. Components of the evaluation may include 
basic pre- and perinatal medical history, three-generational family pedigree, physical exam- 
ination, genetic evaluation (e.g., karyotype or chromosomal microarray analysis and testing 
for specific genetic syndromes), and metabolic screening and neuroimaging assessment. 


Differential Diagnosis 


The diagnosis of intellectual disability should be made whenever Criteria A, B, and C are 
met. A diagnosis of intellectual disability should not be assumed because of a particular 


40 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


genetic or medical condition. A genetic syndrome linked to intellectual disability should 
be noted as a concurrent diagnosis with the intellectual disability. 


Major and mild neurocognitive disorders. Intellectual disability is categorized as a neu- 
rodevelopmental disorder and is distinct from the neurocognitive disorders, which are 
characterized by a loss of cognitive functioning. Major neurocognitive disorder may co- 
occur with intellectual disability (e.g., an individual with Down syndrome who develops 
Alzheimer’s disease, or an individual with intellectual disability who loses further cogni- 
tive capacity following a head injury). In such cases, the diagnoses of intellectual disability 
and neurocognitive disorder may both be given. 


Communication disorders and specific learning disorder. These neurodevelopmental 
disorders are specific to the communication and learning domains and do not show defi- 
cits in intellectual and adaptive behavior. They may co-occur with intellectual disability. 
Both diagnoses are made if full criteria are met for intellectual disability and a communi- 
cation disorder or specific learning disorder. 


Autism spectrum disorder. Intellectual disability is common among individuals with 
autism spectrum disorder. Assessment of intellectual ability may be complicated by so- 
cial-communication and behavior deficits inherent to autism spectrum disorder, which 
may interfere with understanding and complying with test procedures. Appropriate as- 
sessment of intellectual functioning in autism spectrum disorder is essential, with reas- 
sessment across the developmental period, because IQ scores in autism spectrum disorder 
may be unstable, particularly in early childhood. 


Comorbidity 


Co-occurring mental, neurodevelopmental, medical, and physical conditions are frequent 
in intellectual disability, with rates of some conditions (e.g., mental disorders, cerebral 
palsy, and epilepsy) three to four times higher than in the general population. The prognosis 
and outcome of co-occurring diagnoses may be influenced by the presence of intellectual 
disability. Assessment procedures may require modifications because of associated disor- 
ders, including communication disorders, autism spectrum disorder, and motor, sensory, 
or other disorders. Knowledgeable informants are essential for identifying symptoms 
such as irritability, mood dysregulation, aggression, eating problems, and sleep problems, 
and for assessing adaptive functioning in various community settings. 

The most common co-occurring mental and neurodevelopmental disorders are atten- 
tion-deficit/hyperactivity disorder; depressive and bipolar disorders; anxiety disorders; 
autism spectrum disorder; stereotypic movement disorder (with or without self-injurious 
behavior); impulse-control disorders; and major neurocognitive disorder. Major depres- 
sive disorder may occur throughout the range of severity of intellectual disability. Self- 
injurious behavior requires prompt diagnostic attention and may warrant a separate di- 
agnosis of stereotypic movement disorder. Individuals with intellectual disability, partic- 
ularly those with more severe intellectual disability, may also exhibit aggression and 
disruptive behaviors, including harm of others or property destruction. 


Relationship to Other Classifications 


ICD-11 (in development at the time of this publication) uses the term intellectual develop- 
mental disorders to indicate that these are disorders that involve impaired brain functioning 
early in life. These disorders are described in ICD-11 as a metasyndrome occurring in the 
developmental period analogous to dementia or neurocognitive disorder in later life. 
There are four subtypes in ICD-11: mild, moderate, severe, and profound. 

The American Association on Intellectual and Developmental Disabilities (AAIDD) 
also uses the term intellectual disability with a similar meaning to the term as used in this 


Global Developmental Delay 41 


manual. The AAIDD’s classification is multidimensional rather than categorical and is 
based on the disability construct. Rather than listing specifiers as is done in DSM-5, the 
AAIDD emphasizes a profile of supports based on severity. 


Global Developmental Delay 
315.8 (F88) 


This diagnosis is reserved for individuals under the age of 5 years when the clinical severity 
level cannot be reliably assessed during early childhood. This category is diagnosed when 
an individual fails to meet expected developmental milestones in several areas of intellec- 
tual functioning, and applies to individuals who are unable to undergo systematic assess- 
ments of intellectual functioning, including children who are too young to participate in 
standardized testing. This category requires reassessment after a period of time. 


Unspecified Intellectual Disability 
(Intellectual Developmental Disorder) 


319 (F79) 


This category is reserved for individuals over the age of 5 years when assessment of the 
degree of intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) by means of locally 
available procedures is rendered difficult or impossible because of associated sensory or 
physical impairments, as in blindness or prelingual deafness; locomotor disability; or pres- 
ence of severe problem behaviors or co-occurring mental disorder. This category should 
only be used in exceptional circumstances and requires reassessment after a period of time. 


Communication Disorders 


Disorders of communication include deficits in language, speech, and communication. 
Speech is the expressive production of sounds and includes an individual’s articulation, 
fluency, voice, and resonance quality. Language includes the form, function, and use of a 
conventional system of symbols (i.e., spoken words, sign language, written words, pic- 
tures) in a rule-governed manner for communication. Communication includes any verbal 
or nonverbal behavior (whether intentional or unintentional) that influences the behavior, 
ideas, or attitudes of another individual. Assessments of speech, language and communi- 
cation abilities must take into account the individual's cultural and language context, 
particularly for individuals growing up in bilingual environments. The standardized mea- 
sures of language development and of nonverbal intellectual capacity must be relevant for 
the cultural and linguistic group (i.e., tests developed and standardized for one group may 
not provide appropriate norms for a different group). The diagnostic category of commu- 
nication disorders includes the following: language disorder, speech sound disorder, 
childhood-onset fluency disorder (stuttering), social (pragmatic) communication disor- 
der, and other specified and unspecified communication disorders. 


42 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Language Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 315.32 (F80.2) 


A. Persistent difficulties in the acquisition and use of language across modalities (i.e., 
spoken, written, sign language, or other) due to deficits in comprehension or produc- 
tion that include the following: 


1. Reduced vocabulary (word knowledge and use). 

2. Limited sentence structure (ability to put words and word endings together to form 
sentences based on the rules of grammar and morphology). 

3. Impairments in discourse (ability to use vocabulary and connect sentences to ex- 
plain or describe a topic or series of events or have a conversation). 


B. Language abilities are substantially and quantifiably below those expected for age, re- 
sulting in functional limitations in effective communication, social participation, aca- 
demic achievement, or occupational performance, individually or in any combination. 

C. Onset of symptoms is in the early developmental period. 

D. The difficulties are not attributable to hearing or other sensory impairment, motor dys- 
function, or another medical or neurological condition and are not better explained by in- 
tellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) or global developmental delay. 


Diagnostic Features 


The core diagnostic features of language disorder are difficulties in the acquisition and use 
of language due to deficits in the comprehension or production of vocabulary, sentence 
structure, and discourse. The language deficits are evident in spoken communication, 
written communication, or sign language. Language learning and use is dependent on 
both receptive and expressive skills. Expressive ability refers to the production of vocal, ges- 
tural, or verbal signals, while receptive ability refers to the process of receiving and com- 
prehending language messages. Language skills need to be assessed in both expressive 
and receptive modalities as these may differ in severity. For example, an individual's ex- 
pressive language may be severely impaired, while his receptive language is hardly im- 
paired at all. 

Language disorder usually affects vocabulary and grammar, and these effects then 
limit the capacity for discourse. The child’s first words and phrases are likely to be delayed 
in onset; vocabulary size is smaller and less varied than expected; and sentences are 
shorter and less complex with grammatical errors, especially in past tense. Deficits in com- 
prehension of language are frequently underestimated, as children may be good at using 
context to infer meaning. There may be word-finding problems, impoverished verbal def- 
initions, or poor understanding of synonyms, multiple meanings, or word play appro- 
priate for age and culture. Problems with remembering new words and sentences are 
manifested by difficulties following instructions of increasing length, difficulties rehears- 
ing strings of verbal information (e.g., remembering a phone number or a shopping list), 
and difficulties remembering novel sound sequences, a skill that may be important for 
learning new words. Difficulties with discourse are shown by a reduced ability to provide 
adequate information about the key events and to narrate a coherent story. 

The language difficulty is manifest by abilities substantially and quantifiably below 
that expected for age and significantly interfering with academic achievement, occupa- 
tional performance, effective communication, or socialization (Criterion B). A diagnosis of 
language disorder is made based on the synthesis of the individual’s history, direct clinical 
observation in different contexts (i.e., home, school, or work), and scores from standard- 
ized tests of language ability that can be used to guide estimates of severity. 


Language Disorder 43 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A positive family history of language disorders is often present. Individuals, even chil- 
dren, can be adept at accommodating to their limited language. They may appear to be shy 
or reticent to talk. Affected individuals may prefer to communicate only with family mem- 
bers or other familiar individuals. Although these social indicators are not diagnostic of a 
language disorder, if they are notable and persistent, they warrant referral for a full lan- 
guage assessment. Language disorder, particularly expressive deficits, may co-occur with 
speech sound disorder. 


Development and Course 


Language acquisition is marked by changes from onset in toddlerhood to the adult level of 
competency that appears during adolescence. Changes appear across the dimensions of 
language (sounds, words, grammar, narratives/expository texts, and conversational 
skills) in age-graded increments and synchronies. Language disorder emerges during the 
early developmental period; however, there is considerable variation in early vocabulary 
acquisition and early word combinations, and individual differences are not, as single 
indicators, highly predictive of later outcomes. By age 4 years, individual differences in 
language ability are more stable, with better measurement accuracy, and are highly pre- 
dictive of later outcomes. Language disorder diagnosed from 4 years of age is likely to be 
stable over time and typically persists into adulthood, although the particular profile of 
language strengths and deficits is likely to change over the course of development. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Children with receptive language impairments have a poorer prognosis than those with 
predominantly expressive impairments. They are more resistant to treatment, and diffi- 
culties with reading comprehension are frequently seen. 


Genetic and physiological. Language disorders are highly heritable, and family mem- 
bers are more likely to have a history of language impairment. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normal variations in language. Language disorder needs to be distinguished from nor- 
mal developmental variations, and this distinction may be difficult to make before 4 years 
of age. Regional, social, or cultural/ethnic variations of language (e.g., dialects) must be 
considered when an individual is being assessed for language impairment. 


Hearing or other sensory impairment. Hearing impairment needs to be excluded as the 
primary cause of language difficulties. Language deficits may be associated with a hearing 
impairment, other sensory deficit, or a speech-motor deficit. When language deficits are in 
excess of those usually associated with these problems, a diagnosis of language disorder 
may be made. 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder). Language delay is often the 
presenting feature of intellectual disability, and the definitive diagnosis may not be made 
until the child is able to complete standardized assessments. A separate diagnosis is not 
given unless the language deficits are clearly in excess of the intellectual limitations. 


Neurological disorders. Language disorder can be acquired in association with neuro- 
logical disorders, including epilepsy (e.g., acquired aphasia or Landau-Kleffner syndrome). 


Language regression. Loss of speech and language ina child younger than 3 years may 
bea sign of autism spectrum disorder (with developmental regression) or a specific neuro- 
logical condition, such as Landau-Kleffner syndrome. Among children older than 3 years, 
language loss may be a symptom of seizures, and a diagnostic assessment is necessary to 
exclude the presence of epilepsy (e.g., routine and sleep electroencephalogram). 


44 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Comorbidity 


Language disorder is strongly associated with other neurodevelopmental disorders in 
terms of specific learning disorder (literacy and numeracy), attention-deficit/hyperactiv- 
ity disorder, autism spectrum disorder, and developmental coordination disorder. It is 
also associated with social (pragmatic) communication disorder. A positive family history 
of speech or language disorders is often present. 


Speech Sound Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 315.39 (F80.0) 


A. Persistent difficulty with speech sound production that interferes with speech intelligi- 
bility or prevents verbal communication of messages. 

B. The disturbance causes limitations in effective communication that interfere with social 
participation, academic achievement, or occupational performance, individually or in 
any combination. 

C. Onset of symptoms is in the early developmental period. 

D. The difficulties are not attributable to congenital or acquired conditions, such as cere- 
bral palsy, cleft palate, deafness or hearing loss, traumatic brain injury, or other medi- 
cal or neurological conditions. 


Diagnostic Features 


Speech sound production describes the clear articulation of the phonemes (i.e., individual 
sounds) that in combination make up spoken words. Speech sound production requires both 
the phonological knowledge of speech sounds and the ability to coordinate the movements of 
the articulators (ie., the jaw, tongue, and lips,) with breathing and vocalizing for speech. Chil- 
dren with speech production difficulties may experience difficulty with phonological knowl- 
edge of speech sounds or the ability to coordinate movements for speech in varying degrees. 
Speech sound disorder is thus heterogeneous in its underlying mechanisms and includes pho- 
nological disorder and articulation disorder. A speech sound disorder is diagnosed when 
speech sound production is not what would be expected based on the child’s age and devel- 
opmental stage and when the deficits are not the result of a physical, structural, neurological, 
or hearing impairment. Among typically developing children at age 4 years, overall speech 
should be intelligible, whereas at age 2 years, only 50% may be understandable. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Language disorder, particularly expressive deficits, may be found to co-occur with speech 
sound disorder. A positive family history of speech or language disorders is often present. 

If the ability to rapidly coordinate the articulators is a particular aspect of difficulty, 
there may be a history of delay or incoordination in acquiring skills that also utilize the 
articulators and related facial musculature; among others, these skills include chewing, 
maintaining mouth closure, and blowing the nose. Other areas of motor coordination may 
be impaired as in developmental coordination disorder. Verbal dyspraxia is a term also 
used for speech production problems. 

Speech may be differentially impaired in certain genetic conditions (e.g., Down syn- 
drome, 22q deletion, FoxP2 gene mutation). If present, these should also be coded. 


Development and Course 


Learning to produce speech sounds clearly and accurately and learning to produce con- 
nected speech fluently are developmental skills. Articulation of speech sounds follows a 


Childhood-Onset Fluency Disorder (Stuttering) 45 


developmental pattern, which is reflected in the age norms of standardized tests. It is not 
unusual for typically developing children to use developmental processes for shortening 
words and syllables as they are learning to talk, but their progression in mastering speech 
sound production should result in mostly intelligible speech by age 3 years. Children with 
speech sound disorder continue to use immature phonological simplification processes 
past the age when most children can produce words clearly. 

Most speech sounds should be produced clearly and most words should be pronounced 
accurately according to age and community norms by age 7 years. The most frequently mis- 
articulated sounds also tend to be learned later, leading them to be called the “late eight” (1, r, 
s, Z, th, ch, dzh, and zh). Misarticulation of any of these sounds by itself could be considered 
within normal limits up to age 8 years. When multiple sounds are involved, it may be appro- 
priate to target some of those sounds as part of a plan to improve intelligibility prior to the age 
at which almost all children can produce them accurately. Lisping (i.e., misarticulating sibi- 
lants) is particularly common and may involve frontal or lateral patterns of airstream direc- 
tion. It may be associated with an abnormal tongue-thrust swallowing pattern. 

Most children with speech sound disorder respond well to treatment, and speech dif- 
ficulties improve over time, and thus the disorder may not be lifelong. However, when a 
language disorder is also present, the speech disorder has a poorer prognosis and may be 
associated with specific learning disorders. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normal variations in speech. Regional, social, or cultural/ethnic variations of speech 
should be considered before making the diagnosis. 


Hearing or other sensory impairment. Hearing impairment or deafness may result in 
abnormalities of speech. Deficits of speech sound production may be associated with a 
hearing impairment, other sensory deficit, or a speech-motor deficit. When speech deficits 
are in excess of those usually associated with these problems, a diagnosis of speech sound 
disorder may be made. 


Structural deficits. Speech impairment may be due to structural deficits (e.g., cleft palate). 


Dysarthria. Speech impairment may be attributable to a motor disorder, such as cerebral 
palsy. Neurological signs, as well as distinctive features of voice, differentiate dysarthria 
from speech sound disorder, although in young children (under 3 years) differentiation 
may be difficult, particularly when there is no or minimal general body motor involve- 
ment (as in, e.g., Worster-Drought syndrome). 


Selective mutism. Limited use of speech may be a sign of selective mutism, an anxiety 
disorder that is characterized by a lack of speech in one or more contexts or settings. Se- 
lective mutism may develop in children with a speech disorder because of embarassment 
about their impairments, but many children with selective mutism exhibit normal speech 
in “safe” settings, such as at home or with close friends. 


Childhood-Onset Fluency Disorder (Stuttering) 
Diagnostic Criteria 315.35 (F80.81) 


A. Disturbances in the normal fluency and time patterning of speech that are inappropri- 
ate for the individual’s age and language skills, persist over time, and are characterized 
by frequent and marked occurrences of one (or more) of the following: 

1. Sound and syllable repetitions. 
2. Sound prolongations of consonants as well as vowels. 


46 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Broken words (e.g., pauses within a word). 

Audible or silent blocking (filled or unfilled pauses in speech). 
Circumlocutions (word substitutions to avoid problematic words). 
Words produced with an excess of physical tension. 
Monosyllabic whole-word repetitions (e.g., “I-I-l-l see him”). 


Noo w 


B. The disturbance causes anxiety about speaking or limitations in effective communica- 
tion, social participation, or academic or occupational performance, individually or in 
any combination. 

C. The onset of symptoms is in the early developmental period. (Note: Later-onset cases 
are diagnosed as 307.0 [F98.5] adult-onset fluency disorder.) 

D. The disturbance is not attributable to a speech-motor or sensory deficit, dysfluency as- 
sociated with neurological insult (e.g., stroke, tumor, trauma), or another medical con- 
dition and is not better explained by another mental disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of childhood-onset fluency disorder (stuttering) is a disturbance in 
the normal fluency and time patterning of speech that is inappropriate for the individual’s 
age. This disturbance is characterized by frequent repetitions or prolongations of sounds 
or syllables and by other types of speech dysfluencies, including broken words (e.g., 
pauses within a word), audible or silent blocking (i.e., filled or unfilled pauses in speech), 
circumlocutions (i-e., word substitutions to avoid problematic words), words produced 
with an excess of physical tension, and monosyllabic whole-word repetitions (e.g., “I-I-I-I 
see him”). The disturbance in fluency interferes with academic or occupational achieve- 
ment or with social communication. The extent of the disturbance varies from situation to 
situation and often is more severe when there is special pressure to communicate (e.g., giv- 
ing a report at school, interviewing for a job). Dysfluency is often absent during oral read- 
ing, singing, or talking to inanimate objects or to pets. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Fearful anticipation of the problem may develop. The speaker may attempt to avoid dys- 
fluencies by linguistic mechanisms (e.g., altering the rate of speech, avoiding certain 
words or sounds) or by avoiding certain speech situations, such as telephoning or public 
speaking. In addition to being features of the condition, stress and anxiety have been 
shown to exacerbate dysfluency. 

Childhood-onset fluency disorder may also be accompanied by motor movements 
(e.g., eye blinks, tics, tremors of the lips or face, jerking of the head, breathing movements, 
fist clenching). Children with fluency disorder show a range of language abilities, and the 
relationship between fluency disorder and language abilities is unclear. 


Development and Course 


Childhood-onset fluency disorder, or developmental stuttering, occurs by age 6 for 80%- 
90% of affected individuals, with age at onset ranging from 2 to 7 years. The onset can be 
insidious or more sudden. Typically, dysfluencies start gradually, with repetition of initial 
consonants, first words of a phrase, or long words. The child may not be aware of dysflu- 
encies. As the disorder progresses, the dysfluencies become more frequent and interfering, 
occurring on the most meaningful words or phrases in the utterance. As the child becomes 
aware of the speech difficulty, he or she may develop mechanisms for avoiding the dys- 
fluencies and emotional responses, including avoidance of public speaking and use of 
short and simple utterances. Longitudinal research shows that 65%-85% of children re- 


Social (Pragmatic) Communication Disorder 47 


cover from the dysfluency, with severity of fluency disorder at age 8 years predicting re- 
covery or persistence into adolescence and beyond. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. The risk of stuttering among first-degree biological rela- 
tives of individuals with childhood-onset fluency disorder is more than three times the 
risk in the general population. 


Functional Consequences of 
Childhood-Onset Fluency Disorder (Stuttering) 


In addition to being features of the condition, stress and anxiety can exacerbate dysflu- 
ency. Impairment of social functioning may result from this anxiety. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Sensory deficits. Dysfluencies of speech may be associated with a hearing impairment 
or other sensory deficit or a speech-motor deficit. When the speech dysfluencies are in ex- 
cess of those usually associated with these problems, a diagnosis of childhood-onset flu- 
ency disorder may be made. 


Normal speech dysfluencies. The disorder must be distinguished from normal dysflu- 
encies that occur frequently in young children, which include whole-word or phrase rep- 
etitions (e.g., “I want, I want ice cream”), incomplete phrases, interjections, unfilled 
pauses, and parenthetical remarks. If these difficulties increase in frequency or complexity 
as the child grows older, a diagnosis of childhood-onset fluency disorder is appropriate. 


Medication side effects. Stuttering may occur as a side effect of medication and may be 
detected by a temporal relationship with exposure to the medication. 


Adult-onset dysfluencies. If onset of dysfluencies is during or after adolescence, it is an 
“adult-onset dysfluency” rather than a neurodevelopmental disorder. Adult-onset dysflu- 
encies are associated with specific neurological insults and a variety of medical conditions 
and mental disorders and may be specified with them, but they are nota DSM-5 diagnosis. 


Tourette’s disorder. Vocal tics and repetitive vocalizations of Tourette’s disorder 
should be distinguishable from the repetitive sounds of childhood-onset fluency disorder 
by their nature and timing. 


Social (Pragmatic) Communication Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 315.39 (F80.89) 


A. Persistent difficulties in the social use of verbal and nonverbal communication as man- 
ifested by all of the following: 


1. Deficits in using communication for social purposes, such as greeting and sharing 
information, in a manner that is appropriate for the social context. 

2. Impairment of the ability to change communication to match context or the needs of 
the listener, such as speaking differently in a classroom than on a playground, talk- 
ing differently to a child than to an adult, and avoiding use of overly formal language. 

3. Difficulties following rules for conversation and storytelling, such as taking turns in 
conversation, rephrasing when misunderstood, and knowing how to use verbal and 
nonverbal signals to regulate interaction. 


48 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


4. Difficulties understanding what is not explicitly stated (e.g., making inferences) and 
nonliteral or ambiguous meanings of language (e.g., idioms, humor, metaphors, 
multiple meanings that depend on the context for interpretation). 


B. The deficits result in functional limitations in effective communication, social participa- 
tion, social relationships, academic achievement, or occupational performance, indi- 
vidually or in combination. 

C. The onset of the symptoms is in the early developmental period (but deficits may not 
become fully manifest until social communication demands exceed limited capacities). 

D. The symptoms are not attributable to another medical or neurological condition or to low 
abilities in the domains of word structure and grammar, and are not better explained by 
autism spectrum disorder, intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), 
global developmental delay, or another mental disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


Social (pragmatic) communication disorder is characterized by a primary difficulty with 
pragmatics, or the social use of language and communication, as manifested by deficits in 
understanding and following social rules of verbal and nonverbal communication in nat- 
uralistic contexts, changing language according to the needs of the listener or situation, 
and following rules for conversations and storytelling. The deficits in social communica- 
tion result in functional limitations in effective communication, social participation, devel- 
opment of social relationships, academic achievement, or occupational performance. The 
deficits are not better explained by low abilities in the domains of structural language or 
cognitive ability. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The most common associated feature of social (pragmatic) communication disorder is lan- 
guage impairment, which is characterized by a history of delay in reaching language mile- 
stones, and historical, if not current, structural language problems (see “Language Disorder” 
earlier in this chapter). Individuals with social communication deficits may avoid social inter- 
actions. Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD), behavioral problems, and specific 
learning disorders are also more common among affected individuals. 


Development and Course 


Because social (pragmatic) communication depends on adequate developmental progress 
in speech and language, diagnosis of social (pragmatic) communication disorder is rare 
among children younger than 4 years. By age 4 or 5 years, most children should possess 
adequate speech and language abilities to permit identification of specific deficits in social 
communication. Milder forms of the disorder may not become apparent until early ado- 
lescence, when language and social interactions become more complex. 

The outcome of social (pragmatic) communication disorder is variable, with some chil- 
dren improving substantially over time and others continuing to have difficulties persist- 
ing into adulthood. Even among those who have significant improvements, the early 
deficits in pragmatics may cause lasting impairments in social relationships and behavior 
and also in acquisition of other related skills, such as written expression. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. A family history of autism spectrum disorder, communica- 
tion disorders, or specific learning disorder appears to increase the risk for social (prag- 
matic) communication disorder. 


Unspecified Communication Disorder 49 


Differential Diagnosis 


Autism spectrum disorder. Autism spectrum disorder is the primary diagnostic con- 
sideration for individuals presenting with social communication deficits. The two disor- 
ders can be differentiated by the presence in autism spectrum disorder of restricted/ 
repetitive patterns of behavior, interests, or activities and their absence in social (prag- 
matic) communication disorder. Individuals with autism spectrum disorder may only dis- 
play the restricted /repetitive patterns of behavior, interests, and activities during the early 
developmental period, so a comprehensive history should be obtained. Current absence of 
symptoms would not preclude a diagnosis of autism spectrum disorder, if the restricted 
interests and repetitive behaviors were present in the past. A diagnosis of social (prag- 
matic) communication disorder should be considered only if the developmental history 
fails to reveal any evidence of restricted/repetitive patterns of behavior, interests, or ac- 
tivities. 

Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Primary deficits of ADHD may cause impair- 
ments in social communication and functional limitations of effective communication, so- 
cial participation, or academic achievement. 


Social anxiety disorder (social phobia). The symptoms of social communication disor- 
der overlap with those of social anxiety disorder. The differentiating feature is the timing 
of the onset of symptoms. In social (pragmatic) communication disorder, the individual 
has never had effective social communication; in social anxiety disorder, the social com- 
munication skills developed appropriately but are not utilized because of anxiety, fear, or 
distress about social interactions. 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) and global developmental 
delay. Social communication skills may be deficient among individuals with global de- 
velopmental delay or intellectual disability, but a separate diagnosis is not given unless 
the social communication deficits are clearly in excess of the intellectual limitations. 


Unspecified Communication Disorder 
307.9 (F80.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of communication 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for com- 
munication disorder or for any of the disorders in the neurodevelopmental disorders diag- 
nostic class. The unspecified communication disorder category is used in situations in 
which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for com- 
munication disorder or for a specific neurodevelopmental disorder, and includes presen- 
tations in which there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis. 


50 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Autism Spectrum Disorder 


Autism Spectrum Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 299.00 (F84.0) 


A. Persistent deficits in social communication and social interaction across multiple con- 
texts, as manifested by the following, currently or by history (examples are illustrative, 
not exhaustive; see text): 


1. Deficits in social-emotional reciprocity, ranging, for example, from abnormal social 
approach and failure of normal back-and-forth conversation; to reduced sharing of 
interests, emotions, or affect; to failure to initiate or respond to social interactions. 

2. Deficits in nonverbal communicative behaviors used for social interaction, ranging, 
for example, from poorly integrated verbal and nonverbal communication; to abnor- 
malities in eye contact and body language or deficits in understanding and use of 
gestures; to a total lack of facial expressions and nonverbal communication. 

3. Deficits in developing, maintaining, and understanding relationships, ranging, for ex- 
ample, from difficulties adjusting behavior to suit various social contexts; to difficulties 
in sharing imaginative play or in making friends; to absence of interest in peers. 


Specify current severity: 
Severity is based on social communication impairments and restricted, re- 
petitive patterns of behavior (seeTable 2). 


B. Restricted, repetitive patterns of behavior, interests, or activities, as manifested by at 
least two of the following, currently or by history (examples are illustrative, not exhaus- 
tive; see text): 


1. Stereotyped or repetitive motor movements, use of objects, or speech (e.g., simple 
motor stereotypies, lining up toys or flipping objects, echolalia, idiosyncratic 
phrases). 

2. Insistence on sameness, inflexible adherence to routines, or ritualized patterns of 
verbal or nonverbal behavior (e.g., extreme distress at small changes, difficulties 
with transitions, rigid thinking patterns, greeting rituals, need to take same route or 
eat same food every day). 

3. Highly restricted, fixated interests that are abnormal in intensity or focus (e.g., 
strong attachment to or preoccupation with unusual objects, excessively circum- 
scribed or perseverative interests). 

4. Hyper- or hyporeactivity to sensory input or unusual interest in sensory aspects of 
the environment (e.g., apparent indifference to pain/temperature, adverse re- 
sponse to specific sounds or textures, excessive smelling or touching of objects, 
visual fascination with lights or movement). 

Specify current severity: 

Severity is based on social communication impairments and restricted, re- 
petitive patterns of behavior (see Table 2). 

C. Symptoms must be present in the early developmental period (but may not become 
fully manifest until social demands exceed limited capacities, or may be masked by 
learned strategies in later life). 

D. Symptoms cause clinically significant impairment in social, occupational, or other im- 
portant areas of current functioning. 


Autism Spectrum Disorder 51 


E. These disturbances are not better explained by intellectual disability (intellectual devel- 
opmental disorder) or global developmental delay. Intellectual disability and autism 
spectrum disorder frequently co-occur; to make comorbid diagnoses of autism spec- 
trum disorder and intellectual disability, social communication should be below that ex- 
pected for general developmental level. 


Note: Individuals with a well-established DSM-IV diagnosis of autistic disorder, Asperger’s 
disorder, or pervasive developmental disorder not otherwise specified should be given the 
diagnosis of autism spectrum disorder. Individuals who have marked deficits in social 
communication, but whose symptoms do not otherwise meet criteria for autism spectrum 
disorder, should be evaluated for social (pragmatic) communication disorder. 
Specify if: 
With or without accompanying intellectual impairment 
With or without accompanying language impairment 
Associated with a known medical or genetic condition or environmental factor 
(Coding note: Use additional code to identify the associated medical or genetic condition.) 
Associated with another neurodevelopmental, mental, or behavioral disorder 
(Coding note: Use additional code[s] to identify the associated neurodevelopmental, 
mental, or behavioral disorder{s].) 
With catatonia (refer to the criteria for catatonia associated with another mental dis- 
order, pp. 119-120, for definition) (Coding note: Use additional code 293.89 [F06.1] 
catatonia associated with autism spectrum disorder to indicate the presence of the co- 
morbid catatonia.) 


Recording Procedures 


For autism spectrum disorder that is associated with a known medical or genetic condition 
or environmental factor, or with another neurodevelopmental, mental, or behavioral dis- 
order, record autism spectrum disorder associated with (name of condition, disorder, or 
factor) (e.g., autism spectrum disorder associated with Rett syndrome). Severity should be 
recorded as level of support needed for each of the two psychopathological domains in 
Table 2 (e.g., “requiring very substantial support for deficits in social communication and 
requiring substantial support for restricted, repetitive behaviors”). Specification of “with 
accompanying intellectual impairment” or “without accompanying intellectual impair- 
ment” should be recorded next. Language impairment specification should be recorded 
thereafter. If there is accompanying language impairment, the current level of verbal func- 
tioning should be recorded (e.g., “with accompanying language impairment—no intelligi- 
ble speech” or “with accompanying language impairment—phrase speech”). If catatonia is 
present, record separately “catatonia associated with autism spectrum disorder.” 


Specifiers 
The severity specifiers (see Table 2) may be used to describe succinctly the current symp- 
tomatology (which might fall below level 1), with the recognition that severity may vary by 
context and fluctuate over time. Severity of social communication difficulties and re- 
stricted, repetitive behaviors should be separately rated. The descriptive severity categories 
should not be used to determine eligibility for and provision of services; these can only be 
developed at an individual level and through discussion of personal priorities and targets. 
Regarding the specifier “with or without accompanying intellectual impairment,” un- 
derstanding the (often uneven) intellectual profile of a child or adult with autism spectrum 
disorder is necessary for interpreting diagnostic features. Separate estimates of verbal and 
nonverbal skill are necessary (e.g., using untimed nonverbal tests to assess potential 
strengths in individuals with limited language). 


TABLE 2 Severity levels for autism spectrum disorder 


Severity level 


Level 3 
“Requiring very substantial support” 


Level 2 
“Requiring substantial support” 


Level 1 
“Requiring support” 


Social communication 


Severe deficits in verbal and nonverbal social com- 
munication skills cause severe impairments in func- 
tioning, very limited initiation of social 
interactions, and minimal response to social over- 
tures from others. For example, a person with few 
words of intelligible speech who rarely initiates 
interaction and, when he or she does, makes 
unusual approaches to meet needs only and 
responds to only very direct social approaches. 


Marked deficits in verbal and nonverbal social com- 
munication skills; social impairments apparent 
even with supports in place; limited initiation of 
social interactions; and reduced or abnormal 
responses to social overtures from others. For 
example, a person who speaks simple sentences, 
whose interaction is limited to narrow special inter- 
ests, and who has markedly odd nonverbal com- 
munication. 


Without supports in place, deficits in social communi- 
cation cause noticeable impairments. 
Difficulty initiating social interactions, and clear 
examples of atypical or unsuccessful responses to 
social overtures of others. May appear to have 
decreased interest in social interactions. For example, 
a person who is able to speak in full sentences and 
engages in communication but whose to-and-fro con- 
versation with others fails, and whose attempts to 
make friends are odd and typically unsuccessful. 


Restricted, repetitive behaviors 


Inflexibility of behavior, extreme difficulty coping 
with change, or other restricted /repetitive behav- 
iors markedly interfere with functioning in all 
spheres. Great distress/difficulty changing focus 
or action. 


Inflexibility of behavior, difficulty coping with 
change, or other restricted /repetitive behaviors 
appear frequently enough to be obvious to the 
casual observer and interfere with functioning 
in a variety of contexts. Distress and/or difficulty 
changing focus or action. 


Inflexibility of behavior causes significant interfer- 
ence with functioning in one or more contexts. Dif- 
ficulty switching between activities. Problems of 
organization and planning hamper independence. 


es 


sJepsosiq je]uswdojeAeposneNn 


Autism Spectrum Disorder 53 


To use the specifier “with or without accompanying language impairment,” the cur- 
rent level of verbal functioning should be assessed and described. Examples of the specific 
descriptions for “with accompanying language impairment” might include no intelligible 
speech (nonverbal), single words only, or phrase speech. Language level in individuals 
“without accompanying language impairment” might be further described by speaks in 
full sentences or has fluent speech. Since receptive language may lag behind expressive 
language development in autism spectrum disorder, receptive and expressive language 
skills should be considered separately. 

The specifier “associated with a known medical or genetic condition or environmental fac- 
tor” should be used when the individual has a known genetic disorder (e.g., Rett syndrome, 
Fragile X syndrome, Down syndrome), a medical disorder (e.g. epilepsy), or a history of envi- 
ronmental exposure (e.g., valproate, fetal alcohol syndrome, very low birth weight). 

Additional neurodevelopmental, mental or behavioral conditions should also be noted 
(e.g., attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder; developmental coordination disorder; dis- 
ruptive behavior, impulse-control, or conduct disorders; anxiety, depressive, or bipolar 
disorders; tics or Tourette’s disorder; self-injury; feeding, elimination, or sleep disorders). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of autism spectrum disorder are persistent impairment in reciprocal 
social communication and social interaction (Criterion A), and restricted, repetitive pat- 
terns of behavior, interests, or activities (Criterion B). These symptoms are present from 
early childhood and limit or impair everyday functioning (Criteria C and D). The stage at 
which functional impairment becomes obvious will vary according to characteristics of 
the individual and his or her environment. Core diagnostic features are evident in the 
developmental period, but intervention, compensation, and current supports may mask 
difficulties in at least some contexts. Manifestations of the disorder also vary greatly de- 
pending on the severity of the autistic condition, developmental level, and chronological age; 
hence, the term spectrum. Autism spectrum disorder encompasses disorders previously re- 
ferred to as early infantile autism, childhood autism, Kanner’s autism, high-functioning 
autism, atypical autism, pervasive developmental disorder not otherwise specified, child- 
hood disintegrative disorder, and Asperger’s disorder. 

The impairments in communication and social interaction specified in Criterion A are 
pervasive and sustained. Diagnoses are most valid and reliable when based on multiple 
sources of information, including clinician’s observations, caregiver history, and, when 
possible, self-report. Verbal and nonverbal deficits in social communication have varying 
manifestations, depending on the individual's age, intellectual level, and language ability, 
as well as other factors such as treatment history and current support. Many individuals 
have language deficits, ranging from complete lack of speech through language delays, 
poor comprehension of speech, echoed speech, or stilted and overly literal language. Even 
when formal language skills (e.g., vocabulary, grammar) are intact, the use of language for 
reciprocal social communication is impaired in autism spectrum disorder. 

Deficits in social-emotional reciprocity (i.e., the ability to engage with others and share 
thoughts and feelings) are clearly evident in young children with the disorder, who may 
show little or no initiation of social interaction and no sharing of emotions, along with re- 
duced or absent imitation of others’ behavior. What language exists is often one-sided, 
lacking in social reciprocity, and used to request or label rather than to comment, share 
feelings, or converse. In adults without intellectual disabilities or language delays, deficits 
in social-emotional reciprocity may be most apparent in difficulties processing and re- 
sponding to complex social cues (e.g., when and how to join a conversation, what not to 
say). Adults who have developed compensation strategies for some social challenges still 
struggle in novel or unsupported situations and suffer from the effort and anxiety of con- 
sciously calculating what is socially intuitive for most individuals. 


54 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Deficits in nonverbal communicative behaviors used for social interaction are mani- 
fested by absent, reduced, or atypical use of eye contact (relative to cultural norms), ges- 
tures, facial expressions, body orientation, or speech intonation. An early feature of autism 
spectrum disorder is impaired joint attention as manifested by a lack of pointing, showing, 
or bringing objects to share interest with others, or failure to follow someone’s pointing or 
eye gaze. Individuals may learn a few functional gestures, but their repertoire is smaller 
than that of others, and they often fail to use expressive gestures spontaneously in com- 
munication. Among adults with fluent language, the difficulty in coordinating nonverbal 
communication with speech may give the impression of odd, wooden, or exaggerated 
“body language” during interactions. Impairment may be relatively subtle within indi- 
vidual modes (e.g., someone may have relatively good eye contact when speaking) but 
noticeable in poor integration of eye contact, gesture, body posture, prosody, and facial ex- 
pression for social communication. 

Deficits in developing, maintaining, and understanding relationships should be 
judged against norms for age, gender, and culture. There may be absent, reduced, or atyp- 
ical social interest, manifested by rejection of others, passivity, or inappropriate ap- 
proaches that seem aggressive or disruptive. These difficulties are particularly evident in 
young children, in whom there is often a lack of shared social play and imagination (e.g., 
age-appropriate flexible pretend play) and, later, insistence on playing by very fixed rules. 
Older individuals may struggle to understand what behavior is considered appropriate in 
one situation but not another (e.g., casual behavior during a job interview), or the different 
ways that language may be used to communicate (e.g., irony, white lies). There may be an 
apparent preference for solitary activities or for interacting with much younger or older 
people. Frequently, there is a desire to establish friendships without a complete or realistic 
idea of what friendship entails (e.g., one-sided friendships or friendships based solely on 
shared special interests). Relationships with siblings, co-workers, and caregivers are also 
important to consider (in terms of reciprocity). 

Autism spectrum disorder is also defined by restricted, repetitive patterns of behavior, 
interests, or activities (as specified in Criterion B), which show a range of manifestations 
according to age and ability, intervention, and current supports. Stereotyped or repetitive 
behaviors include simple motor stereotypies (e.g., hand flapping, finger flicking), repeti- 
tive use of objects (e.g., spinning coins, lining up toys), and repetitive speech (e.g., echola- 
lia, the delayed or immediate parroting of heard words; use of “you” when referring to 
self; stereotyped use of words, phrases, or prosodic patterns). Excessive adherence to rou- 
tines and restricted patterns of behavior may be manifest in resistance to change (e.g., dis- 
tress at apparently small changes, such as in packaging of a favorite food; insistence on 
adherence to rules; rigidity of thinking) or ritualized patterns of verbal or nonverbal be- 
havior (e.g., repetitive questioning, pacing a perimeter). Highly restricted, fixated interests 
in autism spectrum disorder tend to be abnormal in intensity or focus (e.g., a toddler 
strongly attached to a pan; a child preoccupied with vacuum cleaners; an adult spending 
hours writing out timetables). Some fascinations and routines may relate to apparent hy- 
per- or hyporeactivity to sensory input, manifested through extreme responses to specific 
sounds or textures, excessive smelling or touching of objects, fascination with lights or 
spinning objects, and sometimes apparent indifference to pain, heat, or cold. Extreme re- 
action to or rituals involving taste, smell, texture, or appearance of food or excessive food 
restrictions are common and may be a presenting feature of autism spectrum disorder. 

Many adults with autism spectrum disorder without intellectual or language disabili- 
ties learn to suppress repetitive behavior in public. Special interests may be a source of 
pleasure and motivation and provide avenues for education and employment later in life. 
Diagnostic criteria may be met when restricted, repetitive patterns of behavior, interests, 
or activities were clearly present during childhood or at some time in the past, even if 
symptoms are no longer present. 


Autism Spectrum Disorder 55 


Criterion D requires that the features must cause clinically significant impairment in so- 
cial, occupational, or other important areas of current functioning. Criterion E specifies that 
the social communication deficits, although sometimes accompanied by intellectual disabil- 
ity (intellectual developmental disorder), are not in line with the individual’s developmental 
level; impairments exceed difficulties expected on the basis of developmental level. 

Standardized behavioral diagnostic instruments with good psychometric properties, 
including caregiver interviews, questionnaires and clinician observation measures, are 
available and can improve reliability of diagnosis over time and across clinicians. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Many individuals with autism spectrum disorder also have intellectual impairment and/or 
language impairment (e.g., slow to talk, language comprehension behind production). Even 
those with average or high intelligence have an uneven profile of abilities. The gap between 
intellectual and adaptive functional skills is often large. Motor deficits are often present, in- 
cluding odd gait, clumsiness, and other abnormal motor signs (e.g., walking on tiptoes). Self- 
injury (e.g., head banging, biting the wrist) may occur, and disruptive/challenging behav- 
iors are more common in children and adolescents with autism spectrum disorder than 
other disorders, including intellectual disability. Adolescents and adults with autism spec- 
trum disorder are prone to anxiety and depression. Some individuals develop catatonic-like 
motor behavior (slowing and “freezing” mid-action), but these are typically not of the mag- 
nitude of a catatonic episode. However, it is possible for individuals with autism spectrum 
disorder to experience a marked deterioration in motor symptoms and display a full cata- 
tonic episode with symptoms such as mutism, posturing, grimacing and waxy flexibility. 
The risk period for comorbid catatonia appears to be greatest in the adolescent years. 


Prevalence 


In recent years, reported frequencies for autism spectrum disorder across U.S. and non- 
U.S. countries have approached 1% of the population, with similar estimates in child and 
adult samples. It remains unclear whether higher rates reflect an expansion of the diag- 
nostic criteria of DSM-IV to include subthreshold cases, increased awareness, differences 
in study methodology, or a true increase in the frequency of autism spectrum disorder. 


Development and Course 


The age and pattern of onset also should be noted for autism spectrum disorder. Symptoms 
are typically recognized during the second year of life (12-24 months of age) but may be seen 
earlier than 12 months if developmental delays are severe, or noted later than 24 months if 
symptoms are more subtle. The pattern of onset description might include information 
about early developmental delays or any losses of social or language skills. In cases where 
skills have been lost, parents or caregivers may give a history of a gradual or relatively 
rapid deterioration in social behaviors or language skills. Typically, this would occur be- 
tween 12 and 24 months of age and is distinguished from the rare instances of developmen- 
tal regression occurring after at least 2 years of normal development (previously described 
as childhood disintegrative disorder). 

The behavioral features of autism spectrum disorder first become evident in early 
childhood, with some cases presenting a lack of interest in social interaction in the first 
year of life. Some children with autism spectrum disorder experience developmental pla- 
teaus or regression, with a gradual or relatively rapid deterioration in social behaviors or 
use of language, often during the first 2 years of life. Such losses are rare in other disor- 
ders and may be a useful “red flag” for autism spectrum disorder. Much more unusual 
and warranting more extensive medical investigation are losses of skills beyond social 
communication (e.g., loss of self-care, toileting, motor skills) or those occurring after the 


56 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


second birthday (see also Rett syndrome in the section “Differential Diagnosis” for this 
disorder). 

First symptoms of autism spectrum disorder frequently involve delayed language de- 
velopment, often accompanied by lack of social interest or unusual social interactions (e.g., 
pulling individuals by the hand without any attempt to look at them), odd play patterns 
(e.g., carrying toys around but never playing with them), and unusual communication 
patterns (e.g., knowing the alphabet but not responding to own name). Deafness may be 
suspected but is typically ruled out. During the second year, odd and repetitive behaviors 
and the absence of typical play become more apparent. Since many typically developing 
young children have strong preferences and enjoy repetition (e.g., eating the same foods, 
watching the same video multiple times), distinguishing restricted and repetitive behav- 
iors that are diagnostic of autism spectrum disorder can be difficult in preschoolers. The 
clinical distinction is based on the type, frequency, and intensity of the behavior (e.g., a 
child who daily lines up objects for hours and is very distressed if any item is moved). 

Autism spectrum disorder is not a degenerative disorder, and it is typical for learning 
and compensation to continue throughout life. Symptoms are often most marked in early 
childhood and early school years, with developmental gains typical in later childhood in 
at least some areas (e.g., increased interest in social interaction). A small proportion of in- 
dividuals deteriorate behaviorally during adolescence, whereas most others improve. 
Only a minority of individuals with autism spectrum disorder live and work indepen- 
dently in adulthood; those who do tend to have superior language and intellectual abilities 
and are able to find a niche that matches their special interests and skills. In general, indi- 
viduals with lower levels of impairment may be better able to function independently. 
However, even these individuals may remain socially naive and vulnerable, have difficul- 
ties organizing practical demands without aid, and are prone to anxiety and depression. 
Many adults report using compensation strategies and coping mechanisms to mask their 
difficulties in public but suffer from the stress and effort of maintaining a socially accept- 
able facade. Scarcely anything is known about old age in autism spectrum disorder. 

Some individuals come for first diagnosis in adulthood, perhaps prompted by the diagno- 
sis of autism ina child in the family or a breakdown of relations at work or home. Obtaining de- 
tailed developmental history in such cases may be difficult, and it is important to consider self- 
reported difficulties. Where clinical observation suggests criteria are currently met, autism 
spectrum disorder may be diagnosed, provided there is no evidence of good social and com- 
munication skills in childhood. For example, the report (by parents or another relative) that the 
individual had ordinary and sustained reciprocal friendships and good nonverbal communi- 
cation skills throughout childhood would rule out a diagnosis of autism spectrum disorder; 
however, the absence of developmental information in itself should not do so. 

Manifestations of the social and communication impairments and restricted/repeti- 
tive behaviors that define autism spectrum disorder are clear in the developmental period. 
In later life, intervention or compensation, as well as current supports, may mask these dif- 
ficulties in at least some contexts. However, symptoms remain sufficient to cause current 
impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


The best established prognostic factors for individual outcome within autism spectrum 
disorder are presence or absence of associated intellectual disability and language impair- 
ment (e.g., functional language by age 5 years is a good prognostic sign) and additional 
mental health problems. Epilepsy, as a comorbid diagnosis, is associated with greater in- 
tellectual disability and lower verbal ability. 


Environmental. A variety of nonspecific risk factors, such as advanced parental age, low 
birth weight, or fetal exposure to valproate, may contribute to risk of autism spectrum dis- 
order. 


Autism Spectrum Disorder 57 


Genetic and physiological. Heritability estimates for autism spectrum disorder have 
ranged from 37% to higher than 90%, based on twin concordance rates. Currently, as many 
as 15% of cases of autism spectrum disorder appear to be associated with a known genetic 
mutation, with different de novo copy number variants or de novo mutations in specific 
genes associated with the disorder in different families. However, even when an autism 
spectrum disorder is associated with a known genetic mutation, it does not appear to be 
fully penetrant. Risk for the remainder of cases appears to be polygenic, with perhaps hun- 
dreds of genetic loci making relatively small contributions. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Cultural differences will exist in norms for social interaction, nonverbal communication, 
and relationships, but individuals with autism spectrum disorder are markedly impaired 
against the norms for their cultural context. Cultural and socioeconomic factors may affect 
age at recognition or diagnosis; for example, in the United States, late or underdiagnosis of 
autism spectrum disorder among African American children may occur. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Autism spectrum disorder is diagnosed four times more often in males than in females. In 
clinic samples, females tend to be more likely to show accompanying intellectual disabil- 
ity, suggesting that girls without accompanying intellectual impairments or language 
delays may go unrecognized, perhaps because of subtler manifestation of social and com- 
munication difficulties. 


Functional Consequences of Autism Spectrum Disorder 


In young children with autism spectrum disorder, lack of social and communication abil- 
ities may hamper learning, especially learning through social interaction or in settings 
with peers. In the home, insistence on routines and aversion to change, as well as sensory 
sensitivities, may interfere with eating and sleeping and make routine care (e.g., haircuts, 
dental work) extremely difficult. Adaptive skills are typically below measured IQ. Ex- 
treme difficulties in planning, organization, and coping with change negatively impact 
academic achievement, even for students with above-average intelligence. During adult- 
hood, these individuals may have difficulties establishing independence because of con- 
tinued rigidity and difficulty with novelty. 

Many individuals with autism spectrum disorder, even without intellectual disability, 
have poor adult psychosocial functioning as indexed by measures such as independent 
living and gainful employment. Functional consequences in old age are unknown, but so- 
cial isolation and communication problems (e.g., reduced help-seeking) are likely to have 
consequences for health in older adulthood. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Rett syndrome. Disruption of social interaction may be observed during the regressive 
phase of Rett syndrome (typically between 1-4 years of age); thus, a substantial proportion 
of affected young girls may have a presentation that meets diagnostic criteria for autism 
spectrum disorder. However, after this period, most individuals with Rett syndrome im- 
prove their social communication skills, and autistic features are no longer a major area of 
concern. Consequently, autism spectrum disorder should be considered only when all di- 
agnostic criteria are met. 


Selective mutism. In selective mutism, early development is not typically disturbed. 
The affected child usually exhibits appropriate communication skills in certain contexts 
and settings. Even in settings where the child is mute, social reciprocity is not impaired, 
nor are restricted or repetitive patterns of behavior present. 


58 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Language disorders and social (pragmatic) communication disorder. In some forms 
of language disorder, there may be problems of communication and some secondary so- 
cial difficulties. However, specific language disorder is not usually associated with abnor- 
mal nonverbal communication, nor with the presence of restricted, repetitive patterns of 
behavior, interests, or activities. 

When an individual shows impairment in social communication and social interactions 
but does not show restricted and repetitive behavior or interests, criteria for social (prag- 
matic) communication disorder, instead of autism spectrum disorder, may be met. The di- 
agnosis of autism spectrum disorder supersedes that of social (pragmatic) communication 
disorder whenever the criteria for autism spectrum disorder are met, and care should be 
taken to enquire carefully regarding past or current restricted /repetitive behavior. 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) without autism spectrum 
disorder. Intellectual disability without autism spectrum disorder may be difficult to 
differentiate from autism spectrum disorder in very young children. Individuals with in- 
tellectual disability who have not developed language or symbolic skills also present a 
challenge for differential diagnosis, since repetitive behavior often occurs in such individ- 
uals as well. A diagnosis of autism spectrum disorder in an individual with intellectual 
disability is appropriate when social communication and interaction are significantly im- 
paired relative to the developmental level of the individual’s nonverbal skills (e.g., fine 
motor skills, nonverbal problem solving). In contrast, intellectual disability is the appropri- 
ate diagnosis when there is no apparent discrepancy between the level of social-commu- 
nicative skills and other intellectual skills. 


Stereotypic movement disorder. Motor stereotypies are among the diagnostic charac- 
teristics of autism spectrum disorder, so an additional diagnosis of stereotypic movement 
disorder is not given when such repetitive behaviors are better explained by the presence 
of autism spectrum disorder. However, when stereotypies cause self-injury and become a 
focus of treatment, both diagnoses may be appropriate. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Abnormalities of attention (overly focused or 
easily distracted) are common in individuals with autism spectrum disorder, as is hy- 
peractivity. A diagnosis of attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) should be 
considered when attentional difficulties or hyperactivity exceeds that typically seen in in- 
dividuals of comparable mental age. 


Schizophrenia. Schizophrenia with childhood onset usually develops after a period of 
normal, or near normal, development. A prodromal state has been described in which so- 
cial impairment and atypical interests and beliefs occur, which could be confused with the 
social deficits seen in autism spectrum disorder. Hallucinations and delusions, which are 
defining features of schizophrenia, are not features of autism spectrum disorder. How- 
ever, clinicians must take into account the potential for individuals with autism spectrum 
disorder to be concrete in their interpretation of questions regarding the key features of 
schizophrenia (e.g., “Do you hear voices when no one is there?” ”Yes [on the radio]”). 


Comorbidity 


Autism spectrum disorder is frequently associated with intellectual impairment and struc- 
tural language disorder (i.e., an inability to comprehend and construct sentences with proper 
grammar), which should be noted under the relevant specifiers when applicable. Many in- 
dividuals with autism spectrum disorder have psychiatric symptoms that do not form part of 
the diagnostic criteria for the disorder (about 70% of individuals with autism spectrum dis- 
order may have one comorbid mental disorder, and 40% may have two or more comorbid 
mental disorders). When criteria for both ADHD and autism spectrum disorder are met, both 
diagnoses should be given. This same principle applies to concurrent diagnoses of autism 
spectrum disorder and developmental coordination disorder, anxiety disorders, depressive 


Attention-Deficit/Hyperactivity Disorder 59 


disorders, and other comorbid diagnoses. Among individuals who are nonverbal or have 
language deficits, observable signs such as changes in sleep or eating and increases in chal- 
lenging behavior should trigger an evaluation for anxiety or depression. Specific learning dif- 
ficulties (literacy and numeracy) are common, as is developmental coordination disorder. 
Medical conditions commonly associated with autism spectrum disorder should be noted 
under the “associated with a known medical/ genetic or environmental/acquired condition” 
specifier. Such medical conditions include epilepsy, sleep problems, and constipation. 
Avoidant-restrictive food intake disorder is a fairly frequent presenting feature of autism 
spectrum disorder, and extreme and narrow food preferences may persist. 


Attention-Deficit/Hyperactivity 
Disorder 


Attention-Deficit/Hyperactivity Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A persistent pattern of inattention and/or hyperactivity-impulsivity that interferes with 
functioning or development, as characterized by (1) and/or (2): 


1. Inattention: Six (or more) of the following symptoms have persisted for at least 
6 months to a degree that is inconsistent with developmental level and that nega- 
tively impacts directly on social and academic/occupational activities: 

Note: The symptoms are not solely a manifestation of oppositional behavior, defi- 
ance, hostility, or failure to understand tasks or instructions. For older adolescents 
and adults (age 17 and older), at least five symptoms are required. 


a. Often fails to give close attention to details or makes careless mistakes in 
schoolwork, at work, or during other activities (e.g., overlooks or misses details, 
work is inaccurate). 

b. Often has difficulty sustaining attention in tasks or play activities (e.g., has diffi- 
culty remaining focused during lectures, conversations, or lengthy reading). 

c. Often does not seem to listen when spoken to directly (e.g., mind seems else- 
where, even in the absence of any obvious distraction). 

d. Often does not follow through on instructions and fails to finish schoolwork, 
chores, or duties in the workplace (e.g., starts tasks but quickly loses focus and 
is easily sidetracked). 

e. Often has difficulty organizing tasks and activities (e.g., difficulty managing se- 
quential tasks; difficulty keeping materials and belongings in order; messy, dis- 
organized work; has poor time management; fails to meet deadlines). 

f. Often avoids, dislikes, or is reluctant to engage in tasks that require sustained 
mental effort (e.g., schoolwork or homework; for older adolescents and adults, 
preparing reports, completing forms, reviewing lengthy papers). 

g. Often loses things necessary for tasks or activities (e.g., school materials, pen- 
cils, books, tools, wallets, keys, paperwork, eyeglasses, mobile telephones). 

h. Is often easily distracted by extraneous stimuli (for older adolescents and 
adults, may include unrelated thoughts). 

i. Is often forgetful in daily activities (e.g., doing chores, running errands; for older 
adolescents and adults, returning calls, paying bills, keeping appointments). 


60 


Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


2. Hyperactivity and impulsivity: Six (or more) of the following symptoms have per- 
sisted for at least 6 months to a degree that is inconsistent with developmental level 
and that negatively impacts directly on social and academic/occupational activities: 
Note: The symptoms are not solely a manifestation of oppositional behavior, defi- 
ance, hostility, or a failure to understand tasks or instructions. For older adolescents 
and adults (age 17 and older), at least five symptoms are required. 


a. Often fidgets with or taps hands or feet or squirms in seat. 

b. Often leaves seat in situations when remaining seated is expected (e.g., leaves 
his or her place in the classroom, in the office or other workplace, or in other 
situations that require remaining in place). 

c. Often runs about or climbs in situations where it is inappropriate. (Note: In ad- 
olescents or adults, may be limited to feeling restless.) 

d. Often unable to play or engage in leisure activities quietly. 

e. Is often “on the go,” acting as if “driven by a motor” (e.g., is unable to be or un- 
comfortable being still for extended time, as in restaurants, meetings; may be 
experienced by others as being restless or difficult to keep up with). 

f. Often talks excessively. 

g. Often blurts out an answer before a question has been completed (e.g., com- 
pletes people’s sentences; cannot wait for turn in conversation). 

h. Often has difficulty waiting his or her turn (e.g., while waiting in line). 

i. Often interrupts or intrudes on others (e.g., butts into conversations, games, or 
activities; may start using other people’s things without asking or receiving per- 
mission; for adolescents and adults, may intrude into or take over what others 
are doing). 


Several inattentive or hyperactive-impulsive symptoms were present prior to age 
12 years. 


. Several inattentive or hyperactive-impulsive symptoms are present in two or more set- 


tings (e.g., at home, school, or work; with friends or relatives; in other activities). 


. There is clear evidence that the symptoms interfere with, or reduce the quality of, so- 


cial, academic, or occupational functioning. 

The symptoms do not occur exclusively during the course of schizophrenia or another 
psychotic disorder and are not better explained by another mental disorder (e.g., mood 
disorder, anxiety disorder, dissociative disorder, personality disorder, substance intox- 
ication or withdrawal). 


Specify whether: 


314.01 (F90.2) Combined presentation: If both Criterion A1 (inattention) and Crite- 
rion A2 (hyperactivity-impulsivity) are met for the past 6 months. 

314.00 (F90.0) Predominantly inattentive presentation: If Criterion A1 (inattention) 
is met but Criterion A2 (hyperactivity-impulsivity) is not met for the past 6 months. 
314.01 (F90.1) Predominantly hyperactive/impulsive presentation: If Criterion A2 (hy- 
peractivity-impulsivity) is met and Criterion A1 (inattention) is not met for the past 6 months. 


Specify if: 


In partial remission: When full criteria were previously met, fewer than the full criteria 
have been met for the past 6 months, and the symptoms still result in impairment in 
social, academic, or occupational functioning. 


Specify current severity: 


Mild: Few, if any, symptoms in excess of those required to make the diagnosis are 
present, and symptoms result in no more than minor impairments in social or occupa- 
tional functioning. 

Moderate: Symptoms or functional impairment between “mild” and “severe” are present. 


Attention-Deficit/Hyperactivity Disorder 61 


Severe: Many symptoms in excess of those required to make the diagnosis, or several 
symptoms that are particularly severe, are present, or the symptoms result in marked 
impairment in social or occupational functioning. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) is a persistent 
pattern of inattention and/or hyperactivity-impulsivity that interferes with functioning or 
development. Inattention manifests behaviorally in ADHD as wandering off task, lacking 
persistence, having difficulty sustaining focus, and being disorganized and is not due to 
defiance or lack of comprehension. Hyperactivity refers to excessive motor activity (such as 
a child running about) when it is not appropriate, or excessive fidgeting, tapping, or talk- 
ativeness. In adults, hyperactivity may manifest as extreme restlessness or wearing others 
out with their activity. Impulsivity refers to hasty actions that occur in the moment without 
forethought and that have high potential for harm to the individual (e.g., darting into the 
street without looking). Impulsivity may reflect a desire for immediate rewards or an in- 
ability to delay gratification. Impulsive behaviors may manifest as social intrusiveness 
(e.g., interrupting others excessively) and/or as making important decisions without con- 
sideration of long-term consequences (e.g., taking a job without adequate information). 

ADHD begins in childhood. The requirement that several symptoms be present before 
age 12 years conveys the importance of a substantial clinical presentation during child- 
hood. At the same time, an earlier age at onset is not specified because of difficulties in es- 
tablishing precise childhood onset retrospectively. Adult recall of childhood symptoms 
tends to be unreliable, and it is beneficial to obtain ancillary information. 

Manifestations of the disorder must be present in more than one setting (e.g., home and 
school, work). Confirmation of substantial symptoms across settings typically cannot be 
done accurately without consulting informants who have seen the individual in those set- 
tings. Typically, symptoms vary depending on context within a given setting. Signs of the 
disorder may be minimal or absent when the individual is receiving frequent rewards for 
appropriate behavior, is under close supervision, is in a novel setting, is engaged in espe- 
cially interesting activities, has consistent external stimulation (e.g., via electronic screens), 
or is interacting in one-on-one situations (e.g., the clinician's office). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Mild delays in language, motor, or social development are not specific to ADHD but often co- 
occur. Associated features may include low frustration tolerance, irritability, or mood lability. 
Even in the absence of a specific learning disorder, academic or work performance is often im- 
paired. Inattentive behavior is associated with various underlying cognitive processes, and in- 
dividuals with ADHD may exhibit cognitive problems on tests of attention, executive 
function, or memory, although these tests are not sufficiently sensitive or specific to serve as di- 
agnostic indices. By early adulthood, ADHD is associated with an increased risk of suicide at- 
tempt, primarily when comorbid with mood, conduct, or substance use disorders. 

No biological marker is diagnostic for ADHD. As a group, compared with peers, chil- 
dren with ADHD display increased slow wave electroencephalograms, reduced total 
brain volume on magnetic resonance imaging, and possibly a delay in posterior to anterior 
cortical maturation, but these findings are not diagnostic. In the uncommon cases where 
there is a known genetic cause (e.g., Fragile X syndrome, 22q11 deletion syndrome), the 
ADHD presentation should still be diagnosed. 


Prevalence 


Population surveys suggest that ADHD occurs in most cultures in about 5% of children 
and about 2.5% of adults. 


62 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Development and Course 


Many parents first observe excessive motor activity when the child is a toddler, but symp- 
toms are difficult to distinguish from highly variable normative behaviors before age 4 
years. ADHD is most often identified during elementary school years, and inattention be- 
comes more prominent and impairing. The disorder is relatively stable through early ad- 
olescence, but some individuals have a worsened course with development of antisocial 
behaviors. In most individuals with ADHD, symptoms of motoric hyperactivity become 
less obvious in adolescence and adulthood, but difficulties with restlessness, inattention, 
poor planning, and impulsivity persist. A substantial proportion of children with ADHD 
remain relatively impaired into adulthood. 

In preschool, the main manifestation is hyperactivity. Inattention becomes more prom- 
inent during elementary school. During adolescence, signs of hyperactivity (e.g., running 
and climbing) are less common and may be confined to fidgetiness or an inner feeling of 
jitteriness, restlessness, or impatience. In adulthood, along with inattention and restless- 
ness, impulsivity may remain problematic even when hyperactivity has diminished. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. ADHD is associated with reduced behavioral inhibition, effortful con- 
trol, or constraint; negative emotionality; and/or elevated novelty seeking. These traits 
may predispose some children to ADHD but are not specific to the disorder. 


Environmental. Very low birth weight (less than 1,500 grams) conveys a two- to three- 
fold risk for ADHD, but most children with low birth weight do not develop ADHD. Al- 
though ADHD is correlated with smoking during pregnancy, some of this association 
reflects common genetic risk. A minority of cases may be related to reactions to aspects of 
diet. There may bea history of child abuse, neglect, multiple foster placements, neurotoxin 
exposure (e.g., lead), infections (e.g., encephalitis), or alcohol exposure in utero. Exposure 
to environmental toxicants has been correlated with subsequent ADHD, but it is not 
known whether these associations are causal. 


Genetic and physiological. ADHD is elevated in the first-degree biological relatives of 
individuals with ADHD. The heritability of ADHD is substantial. While specific genes 
have been correlated with ADHD, they are neither necessary nor sufficient causal factors. 
Visual and hearing impairments, metabolic abnormalities, sleep disorders, nutritional de- 
ficiencies, and epilepsy should be considered as possible influences on ADHD symptoms. 

ADHD is not associated with specific physical features, although rates of minor phys- 
ical anomalies (e.g., hypertelorism, highly arched palate, low-set ears) may be relatively 
elevated. Subtle motor delays and other neurological soft signs may occur. (Note that 
marked co-occurring clumsiness and motor delays should be coded separately [e.g., de- 
velopmental coordination disorder].) 


Course modifiers. Family interaction patterns in early childhood are unlikely to cause 
ADHD but may influence its course or contribute to secondary development of conduct 
problems. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Differences in ADHD prevalence rates across regions appear attributable mainly to differ- 
ent diagnostic and methodological practices. However, there also may be cultural varia- 
tion in attitudes toward or interpretations of children’s behaviors. Clinical identification 
rates in the United States for African American and Latino populations tend to be lower 
than for Caucasian populations. Informant symptom ratings may be influenced by cul- 
tural group of the child and the informant, suggesting that culturally appropriate practices 
are relevant in assessing ADHD. 


Attention-Deficit/Hyperactivity Disorder 63 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


ADHD is more frequent in males than in females in the general population, with a ratio of 
approximately 2:1 in children and 1.6:1 in adults. Females are more likely than males to 
present primarily with inattentive features. 


Functional Consequences of 
Attention-Deficit/Hyperactivity Disorder 


ADHD is associated with reduced school performance and academic attainment, social re- 
jection, and, in adults, poorer occupational performance, attainment, attendance, and 
higher probability of unemployment as well as elevated interpersonal conflict. Children 
with ADHD are significantly more likely than their peers without ADHD to develop con- 
duct disorder in adolescence and antisocial personality disorder in adulthood, conse- 
quently increasing the likelihood for substance use disorders and incarceration. The risk of 
subsequent substance use disorders is elevated, especially when conduct disorder or an- 
tisocial personality disorder develops. Individuals with ADHD are more likely than peers 
to be injured. Traffic accidents and violations are more frequent in drivers with ADHD. 
There may be an elevated likelihood of obesity among individuals with ADHD. 

Inadequate or variable self-application to tasks that require sustained effort is often in- 
terpreted by others as laziness, irresponsibility, or failure to cooperate. Family relation- 
ships may be characterized by discord and negative interactions. Peer relationships are 
often disrupted by peer rejection, neglect, or teasing of the individual with ADHD. On av- 
erage, individuals with ADHD obtain less schooling, have poorer vocational achievement, 
and have reduced intellectual scores than their peers, although there is great variability. In 
its severe form, the disorder is markedly impairing, affecting social, familial, and scholas- 
tic/occupational adjustment. 

Academic deficits, school-related problems, and peer neglect tend to be most associ- 
ated with elevated symptoms of inattention, whereas peer rejection and, to a lesser extent, 
accidental injury are most salient with marked symptoms of hyperactivity or impulsivity. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Oppositional defiant disorder. Individuals with oppositional defiant disorder may re- 
sist work or school tasks that require self-application because they resist conforming to 
others' demands. Their behavior is characterized by negativity, hostility, and defiance. 
These symptoms must be differentiated from aversion to school or mentally demanding 
tasks due to difficulty in sustaining mental effort, forgetting instructions, and impulsivity 
in individuals with ADHD. Complicating the differential diagnosis is the fact that some 
individuals with ADHD may develop secondary oppositional attitudes toward such tasks 
and devalue their importance. 


Intermittent explosive disorder. ADHD and intermittent explosive disorder share high 
levels of impulsive behavior. However, individuals with intermittent explosive disorder 
show serious aggression toward others, which is not characteristic of ADHD, and they do 
not experience problems with sustaining attention as seen in ADHD. In addition, intermit- 
tent explosive disorder is rare in childhood. Intermittent explosive disorder may be diag- 
nosed in the presence of ADHD. 


Other neurodevelopmental disorders. The increased motoric activity that may occur in 
ADHD must be distinguished from the repetitive motor behavior that characterizes stereo- 
typic movement disorder and some cases of autism spectrum disorder. In stereotypic 
movement disorder, the motoric behavior is generally fixed and repetitive (e.g., body rock- 
ing, self-biting), whereas the fidgetiness and restlessness in ADHD are typically general- 
ized and not characterized by repetitive stereotypic movements. In Tourette’s disorder, 


64 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


frequent multiple tics can be mistaken for the generalized fidgetiness of ADHD. Prolonged 
observation may be needed to differentiate fidgetiness from bouts of multiple tics. 


Specific learning disorder. Children with specific learning disorder may appear inat- 
tentive because of frustration, lack of interest, or limited ability. However, inattention in 
individuals with a specific learning disorder who do not have ADHD is not impairing out- 
side of academic work. 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder). Symptoms of ADHD are 
common among children placed in academic settings that are inappropriate to their intel- 
lectual ability. In such cases, the symptoms are not evident during non-academic tasks. A 
diagnosis of ADHD in intellectual disability requires that inattention or hyperactivity be 
excessive for mental age. 


Autism spectrum disorder. Individuals with ADHD and those with autism spectrum 
disorder exhibit inattention, social dysfunction, and difficult-to-manage behavior. The so- 
cial dysfunction and peer rejection seen in individuals with ADHD must be distinguished 
from the social disengagement, isolation, and indifference to facial and tonal communica- 
tion cues seen in individuals with autism spectrum disorder. Children with autism spec- 
trum disorder may display tantrums because of an inability to tolerate a change from their 
expected course of events. In contrast, children with ADHD may misbehave or have a tan- 
trum during a major transition because of impulsivity or poor self-control. 


Reactive attachment disorder. Children with reactive attachment disorder may show 
social disinhibition, but not the full ADHD symptom cluster, and display other features 
such as a lack of enduring relationships that are not characteristic of ADHD. 


Anxiety disorders. ADHD shares symptoms of inattention with anxiety disorders. Indi- 
viduals with ADHD are inattentive because of their attraction to external stimuli, new 
activities, or preoccupation with enjoyable activities. This is distinguished from the inat- 
tention due to worry and rumination seen in anxiety disorders. Restlessness might be seen 
in anxiety disorders. However, in ADHD, the symptom is not associated with worry and 
rumination. 


Depressive disorders. Individuals with depressive disorders may present with inabil- 
ity to concentrate. However, poor concentration in mood disorders becomes prominent 
only during a depressive episode. 


Bipolar disorder. Individuals with bipolar disorder may have increased activity, poor 
concentration, and increased impulsivity, but these features are episodic, occurring sev- 
eral days at a time. In bipolar disorder, increased impulsivity or inattention is accompa- 
nied by elevated mood, grandiosity, and other specific bipolar features. Children with 
ADHD may show significant changes in mood within the same day; such lability is dis- 
tinct from a manic episode, which must last 4 or more days to be a clinical indicator of bi- 
polar disorder, even in children. Bipolar disorder is rare in preadolescents, even when 
severe irritability and anger are prominent, whereas ADHD is common among children 
and adolescents who display excessive anger and irritability. 


Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder is 
characterized by pervasive irritability, and intolerance of frustration, but impulsiveness 
and disorganized attention are not essential features. However, most children and adoles- 
cents with the disorder have symptoms that also meet criteria for ADHD, which is diag- 
nosed separately. 


Substance use disorders. Differentiating ADHD from substance use disorders may be 
problematic if the first presentation of ADHD symptoms follows the onset of abuse or fre- 
quent use. Clear evidence of ADHD before substance misuse from informants or previous 
records may be essential for differential diagnosis. 


Other Specified Attention-Deficit/Hyperactivity Disorder 65 


Personality disorders. In adolescents and adults, it may be difficult to distinguish ADHD 
from borderline, narcissistic, and other personality disorders. All these disorders tend to 
share the features of disorganization, social intrusiveness, emotional dysregulation, and 
cognitive dysregulation. However, ADHD is not characterized by fear of abandonment, 
self-injury, extreme ambivalence, or other features of personality disorder. It may take 
extended clinical observation, informant interview, or detailed history to distinguish im- 
pulsive, socially intrusive, or inappropriate behavior from narcissistic, aggressive, or dom- 
ineering behavior to make this differential diagnosis. 


Psychotic disorders. ADHD is not diagnosed if the symptoms of inattention and hyperac- 
tivity occur exclusively during the course of a psychotic disorder. 


Medication-induced symptoms of ADHD. Symptoms of inattention, hyperactivity, or 
impulsivity attributable to the use of medication (e.g., bronchodilators, isoniazid, neuro- 
leptics [resulting in akathisia], thyroid replacement medication) are diagnosed as other 
specified or unspecified other (or unknown) substance-related disorders. 


Neurocognitive disorders. Early major neurocognitive disorder (dementia) and/or 
mild neurocognitive disorder are not known to be associated with ADHD but may present 
with similar clinical features. These conditions are distinguished from ADHD by their late 
onset. 


Comorbidity 


In clinical settings, comorbid disorders are frequent in individuals whose symptoms meet 
criteria for ADHD. In the general population, oppositional defiant disorder co-occurs with 
ADHD in approximately half of children with the combined presentation and about a 
quarter with the predominantly inattentive presentation. Conduct disorder co-occurs in 
about a quarter of children or adolescents with the combined presentation, depending on 
age and setting. Most children and adolescents with disruptive mood dysregulation dis- 
order have symptoms that also meet criteria for ADHD; a lesser percentage of children 
with ADHD have symptoms that meet criteria for disruptive mood dysregulation disor- 
der. Specific learning disorder commonly co-occurs with ADHD. Anxiety disorders and 
major depressive disorder occur in a minority of individuals with ADHD but more often 
than in the general population. Intermittent explosive disorder occurs in a minority of 
adults with ADHD, but at rates above population levels. Although substance use disor- 
ders are relatively more frequent among adults with ADHD in the general population, the 
disorders are present in only a minority of adults with ADHD. In adults, antisocial and 
other personality disorders may co-occur with ADHD. Other disorders that may co-occur 
with ADHD include obsessive-compulsive disorder, tic disorders, and autism spectrum 
disorder. 


Other Specified Attention-Deficit/ 
Hyperactivity Disorder 


314.01 (F90.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of attention- 
deficit/hyperactivity disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in so- 
cial, occupational or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the 
full criteria for attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder or any of the disorders in the neuro- 
developmental disorders diagnostic class. The other specified attention-deficit/hyperactiv- 
ity disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate 


66 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for attention-deficit/ 
hyperactivity disorder or any specific neurodevelopmental disorder. This is done by re- 
cording “other specified attention-deficit/nyperactivity disorder” followed by the specific 
reason (e.g., “with insufficient inattention symptoms’). 


Unspecified Attention-Deficit/ 
Hyperactivity Disorder 


314.01 (F90.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of attention- 
deficit/hyperactivity disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in so- 
cial, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the 
full criteria for attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder or any of the disorders in the neuro- 
developmental disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified attention-deficit/hyperactivity 
disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the rea- 
son that the criteria are not met for attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder or for a specific 
neurodevelopmental disorder, and includes presentations in which there is insufficient in- 
formation to make a more specific diagnosis. 


Specific Learning Disorder 


Specific Learning Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Difficulties learning and using academic skills, as indicated by the presence of at least 
one of the following symptoms that have persisted for at least 6 months, despite the 
provision of interventions that target those difficulties: 


1. Inaccurate or slow and effortful word reading (e.g., reads single words aloud incor- 
rectly or slowly and hesitantly, frequently guesses words, has difficulty sounding 
out words). 

2. Difficulty understanding the meaning of what is read (e.g., may read text accurately 
but not understand the sequence, relationships, inferences, or deeper meanings of 
what is read). 

3. Difficulties with spelling (e.g., may add, omit, or substitute vowels or consonants). 

4. Difficulties with written expression (e.g., makes multiple grammatical or punctua- 
tion errors within sentences; employs poor paragraph organization; written expres- 
sion of ideas lacks clarity). 

5. Difficulties mastering number sense, number facts, or calculation (e.g., has poor 
understanding of numbers, their magnitude, and relationships; counts on fingers to 
add single-digit numbers instead of recalling the math fact as peers do; gets lost in 
the midst of arithmetic computation and may switch procedures). 

6. Difficulties with mathematical reasoning (e.g., has severe difficulty applying math- 
ematical concepts, facts, or procedures to solve quantitative problems). 


Specific Learning Disorder 67 


B. The affected academic skills are substantially and quantifiably below those expected 
for the individual’s chronological age, and cause significant interference with academic 
or occupational performance, or with activities of daily living, as confirmed by individu- 
ally administered standardized achievement measures and comprehensive clinical 
assessment. For individuals age 17 years and older, a documented history of impairing 
learning difficulties may be substituted for the standardized assessment. 

C. The learning difficulties begin during school-age years but may not become fully man- 
ifest until the demands for those affected academic skills exceed the individual’s lim- 
ited capacities (e.g., as in timed tests, reading or writing lengthy complex reports for a 
tight deadline, excessively heavy academic loads). 

D. The learning difficulties are not better accounted for by intellectual disabilities, uncor- 
rected visual or auditory acuity, other mental or neurological disorders, psychosocial 
adversity, lack of proficiency in the language of academic instruction, or inadequate 
educational instruction. 


Note: The four diagnostic criteria are to be met based on a clinical synthesis of the indi- 
vidual’s history (developmental, medical, family, educational), school reports, and psycho- 
educational assessment. 
Coding note: Specify all academic domains and subskills that are impaired. When more 
than one domain is impaired, each one should be coded individually according to the fol- 
lowing specifiers. 
Specify if: 
315.00 (F81.0) With impairment in reading: 
Word reading accuracy 
Reading rate or fluency 
Reading comprehension 
Note: Dys/exia is an alternative term used to refer to a pattern of learning difficulties 
characterized by problems with accurate or fluent word recognition, poor decoding, 
and poor spelling abilities. If dyslexia is used to specify this particular pattern of dif- 
ficulties, it is important also to specify any additional difficulties that are present, 
such as difficulties with reading comprehension or math reasoning. 
315.2 (F81.81) With impairment in written expression: 


Spelling accuracy 

Grammar and punctuation accuracy 

Clarity or organization of written expression 
315.1 (F81.2) With impairment in mathematics: 


Number sense 

Memorization of arithmetic facts 
Accurate or fluent calculation 
Accurate math reasoning 


Note: Dyscalculia is an alternative term used to refer to a pattern of difficulties char- 
acterized by problems processing numerical information, learning arithmetic facts, 
and performing accurate or fluent calculations. If dyscalculia is used to specify this 
particular pattern of mathematic difficulties, it is important also to specify any addi- 
tional difficulties that are present, such as difficulties with math reasoning or word rea- 
soning accuracy. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Some difficulties learning skills in one or two academic domains, but of mild enough 
severity that the individual may be able to compensate or function well when provided with 
appropriate accommodations or support services, especially during the school years. 


68 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Moderate: Marked difficulties learning skills in one or more academic domains, so that 
the individual is unlikely to become proficient without some intervals of intensive and 
specialized teaching during the school years. Some accommodations or supportive 
services at least part of the day at school, in the workplace, or at home may be needed 
to complete activities accurately and efficiently. 

Severe: Severe difficulties learning skills, affecting several academic domains, so that 
the individual is unlikely to learn those skills without ongoing intensive individualized 
and specialized teaching for most of the school years. Even with an array of appropri- 
ate accommodations or services at home, at school, or in the workplace, the individual 
may not be able to complete all activities efficiently. 


Recording Procedures 


Each impaired academic domain and subskill of specific learning disorder should be re- 
corded. Because of ICD coding requirements, impairments in reading, impairments in writ- 
ten expression, and impairments in mathematics, with their corresponding impairments in 
subskills, must be coded separately. For example, impairments in reading and mathematics 
and impairments in the subskills of reading rate or fluency, reading comprehension, accu- 
rate or fluent calculation, and accurate math reasoning would be coded and recorded as 
315.00 (F81.0) specific learning disorder with impairment in reading, with impairment in 
reading rate or fluency and impairment in reading comprehension; 315.1 (F81.2) specific 
learning disorder with impairment in mathematics, with impairment in accurate or fluent 
calculation and impairment in accurate math reasoning. 


Diagnostic Features 


Specific learning disorder is a neurodevelopmental disorder with a biological origin that is 
the basis for abnormalities at a cognitive level that are associated with the behavioral signs 
of the disorder. The biological origin includes an interaction of genetic, epigenetic, and en- 
vironmental factors, which affect the brain’s ability to perceive or process verbal or non- 
verbal information efficiently and accurately. 

One essential feature of specific learning disorder is persistent difficulties learning key- 
stone academic skills (Criterion A), with onset during the years of formal schooling (i.e., the de- 
velopmental period). Key academic skills include reading of single words accurately and 
fluently, reading comprehension, written expression and spelling, arithmetic calculation, and 
mathematical reasoning (solving mathematical problems). In contrast to talking or walking, 
which are acquired developmental milestones that emerge with brain maturation, academic 
skills (e.g., reading, spelling, writing, mathematics) have to be taught and learned explicitly. 
Specific learning disorder disrupts the normal pattern of learning academic skills; it is not sim- 
ply a consequence of lack of opportunity of learning or inadequate instruction. Difficulties 
mastering these key academic skills may also impede learning in other academic subjects (e.g., 
history, science, social studies), but those problems are attributable to difficulties learning the 
underlying academic skills. Difficulties learning to map letters with the sounds of one’s lan- 
guage—to read printed words (often called dyslexia)—is one of the most common manifesta- 
tions of specific learning disorder. The learning difficulties manifest as a range of observable, 
descriptive behaviors or symptoms (as listed in Criteria A1—A6). These clinical symptoms may 
be observed, probed by means of the clinical interview, or ascertained from school reports, rat- 
ing scales, or descriptions in previous educational or psychological assessments. The learning 
difficulties are persistent, not transitory. In children and adolescents, persistence is defined as 
restricted progress in learning (i.e., no evidence that the individual is catching up with class- 
mates) for at least 6 months despite the provision of extra help at home or school. For example, 
difficulties learning to read single words that do not fully or rapidly remit with the provision of 
instruction in phonological skills or word identification strategies may indicate a specific 


Specific Learning Disorder 69 


learning disorder. Evidence of persistent learning difficulties may be derived from cumulative 
school reports, portfolios of the child’s evaluated work, curriculum-based measures, or clinical 
interview. In adults, persistent difficulty refers to ongoing difficulties in literacy or numeracy 
skills that manifest during childhood or adolescence, as indicated by cumulative evidence 
from school reports, evaluated portfolios of work, or previous assessments. 

A second key feature is that the individual’s performance of the affected academic skills is 
well below average for age (Criterion B). One robust clinical indicator of difficulties learning 
academic skills is low academic achievement for age or average achievement that is sustain- 
able only by extraordinarily high levels of effort or support. In children, the low academic skills 
cause significant interference in school performance (as indicated by school reports and 
teacher’s grades or ratings). Another clinical indicator, particularly in adults, is avoidance of 
activities that require the academic skills. Also in adulthood, low academic skills interfere with 
occupational performance or everyday activities requiring those skills (as indicated by self-re- 
port or report by others). However, this criterion also requires psychometric evidence from an 
individually administered, psychometrically sound and culturally appropriate test of aca- 
demic achievement that is norm-referenced or criterion-referenced. Academic skills are dis- 
tributed along a continuum, so there is no natural cutpoint that can be used to differentiate 
individuals with and without specific learning disorder. Thus, any threshold used to specify 
what constitutes significantly low academic achievement (e.g., academic skills well below age 
expectation) is to a large extent arbitrary. Low achievement scores on one or more standard- 
ized tests or subtests within an academic domain (i.e., at least 1.5 standard deviations [SD] be- 
low the population mean for age, which translates to a standard score of 78 or less, which is 
below the 7th percentile) are needed for the greatest diagnostic certainty. However, precise 
scores will vary according to the particular standardized tests that are used. On the basis of 
clinical judgment, a more lenient threshold may be used (e.g., 1.0-2.5 SD below the pop- 
ulation mean for age), when learning difficulties are supported by converging evidence 
from clinical assessment, academic history, school reports, or test scores. Moreover, since 
standardized tests are not available in all languages, the diagnosis may then be based in 
part on clinical judgment of scores on available test measures. 

A third core feature is that the learning difficulties are readily apparent in the early 
school years in most individuals (Criterion C). However, in others, the learning difficulties 
may not manifest fully until later school years, by which time learning demands have in- 
creased and exceed the individual's limited capacities. 

Another key diagnostic feature is that the learning difficulties are considered “spe- 
cific,” for four reasons. First, they are not attributable to intellectual disabilities (intellec- 
tual disability [intellectual developmental disorder]); global developmental delay; 
hearing or vision disorders, or neurological or motor disorders) (Criterion D). Specific 
learning disorder affects learning in individuals who otherwise demonstrate normal lev- 
els of intellectual functioning (generally estimated by an IQ score of greater than about 70 
[+5 points allowing for measurement error]). The phrase “unexpected academic under- 
achievement” is often cited as the defining characteristic of specific learning disorder in 
that the specific learning disabilities are not part of a more general learning difficulty as 
manifested in intellectual disability or global developmental delay. Specific learning dis- 
order may also occur in individuals identified as intellectually “gifted.” These individuals 
may be able to sustain apparently adequate academic functioning by using compensatory 
strategies, extraordinarily high effort, or support, until the learning demands or assess- 
ment procedures (e.g., timed tests) pose barriers to their demonstrating their learning or 
accomplishing required tasks. Second, the learning difficulty cannot be attributed to more 
general external factors, such as economic or environmental disadvantage, chronic absen- 
teeism, or lack of education as typically provided in the individual’s community context. 
Third, the learning difficulty cannot be attributed to a neurological (e.g., pediatric stroke) 
or motor disorders or to vision or hearing disorders, which are often associated with prob- 
lems learning academic skills but are distinguishable by presence of neurological signs. 


70 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Finally, the learning difficulty may be restricted to one academic skill or domain (e.g., read- 
ing single words, retrieving or calculating number facts). 

Comprehensive assessment is required. Specific learning disorder can only be diagnosed 
after formal education starts but can be diagnosed at any point afterward in children, adoles- 
cents, or adults, providing there is evidence of onset during the years of formal schooling (i.e., 
the developmental period). No single data source is sufficient for a diagnosis of specific learn- 
ing disorder. Rather, specific learning disorder is a clinical diagnosis based on a synthesis of 
the individual’s medical, developmental, educational, and family history; the history of the 
learning difficulty, including its previous and current manifestation; the impact of the diffi- 
culty on academic, occupational, or social functioning; previous or current school reports; 
portfolios of work requiring academic skills; curriculum-based assessments; and previous or 
current scores from individual standardized tests of academic achievement. If an intellectual, 
sensory, neurological, or motor disorder is suspected, then the clinical assessment for specific 
learning disorder should also include methods appropriate for these disorders. Thus, compre- 
hensive assessment will involve professionals with expertise in specific learning disorder and 
psychological/cognitive assessment. Since specific learning disorder typically persists into 
adulthood, reassessment is rarely necessary, unless indicated by marked changes in the learn- 
ing difficulties (amelioration or worsening) or requested for specific purposes. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Specific learning disorder is frequently but not invariably preceded, in preschool years, by 
delays in attention, language, or motor skills that may persist and co-occur with specific 
learning disorder. An uneven profile of abilities is common, such as above-average abili- 
ties in drawing, design, and other visuospatial abilities, but slow, effortful, and inaccurate 
reading and poor reading comprehension and written expression. Individuals with spe- 
cific learning disorder typically (but not invariably) exhibit poor performance on psycho- 
logical tests of cognitive processing. However, it remains unclear whether these cognitive 
abnormalities are the cause, correlate, or consequence of the learning difficulties. Also, al- 
though cognitive deficits associated with difficulties learning to read words are well doc- 
umented, those associated with other manifestations of specific learning disorder (e.g., 
reading comprehension, arithmetic computation, written expression) are underspecified 
or unknown. Moreover, individuals with similar behavioral symptoms or test scores are 
found to have a variety of cognitive deficits, and many of these processing deficits are also 
found in other neurodevelopmental disorders (e.g., attention-deficit/hyperactivity disor- 
der [ADHD], autistic spectrum disorder, communication disorders, developmental coor- 
dination disorder). Thus, assessment of cognitive processing deficits is not required for 
diagnostic assessment. Specific learning disorder is associated with increased risk for sui- 
cidal ideation and suicide attempts in children, adolescents, and adults. 

There are no known biological markers of specific learning disorder. As a group, indi- 
viduals with the disorder show circumscribed alterations in cognitive processing and 
brain structure and function. Genetic differences are also evident at the group level. But 
cognitive testing, neuroimaging, or genetic testing are not useful for diagnosis at this time. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of specific learning disorder across the academic domains of reading, writ- 
ing, and mathematics is 5%-15% among school-age children across different languages 
and cultures. Prevalence in adults is unknown but appears to be approximately 4%. 


Development and Course 


Onset, recognition, and diagnosis of specific learning disorder usually occurs during the 
elementary school years when children are required to learn to read, spell, write, and learn 


Specific Learning Disorder 71 


mathematics. However, precursors such as language delays or deficits, difficulties in 
rhyming or counting, or difficulties with fine motor skills required for writing commonly 
occur in early childhood before the start of formal schooling. Manifestations may be be- 
havioral (e.g., a reluctance to engage in learning; oppositional behavior). Specific learning 
disorder is lifelong, but the course and clinical expression are variable, in part depending 
on the interactions among the task demands of the environment, the range and severity of 
the individual’s learning difficulties, the individual’s learning abilities, comorbidity, and 
the available support systems and intervention. Nonetheless, problems with reading flu- 
ency and comprehension, spelling, written expression, and numeracy skills in everyday life 
typically persist into adulthood. 

Changes in manifestation of symptoms occur with age, so that an individual may have 
a persistent or shifting array of learning difficulties across the lifespan. 

Examples of symptoms that may be observed among preschool-age children include a lack 
of interest in playing games with language sounds (e.g., repetition, rhyming), and they may 
have trouble learning nursery rhymes. Preschool children with specific learning disorder may 
frequently use baby talk, mispronounce words, and have trouble remembering names of let- 
ters, numbers, or days of the week. They may fail to recognize letters in their own names and 
have trouble learning to count. Kindergarten-age children with specific learning disorder may 
be unable to recognize and write letters, may be unable to write their own names, or may use 
invented spelling. They may have trouble breaking down spoken words into syllables (e.g., 
“cowboy” into “cow” and “boy”) and trouble recognizing words that rhyme (e.g., cat, bat, hat). 
Kindergarten-age children also may have trouble connecting letters with their sounds (e.g., let- 
ter b makes the sound /b/) and may be unable to recognize phonemes (e.g., do not know 
which in a set of words [e.g., dog, man, car] starts with the same sound as “cat”). 

Specific learning disorder in elementary school-age children typically manifests as 
marked difficulty learning letter-sound correspondence (particularly in English-speaking 
children), fluent word decoding, spelling, or math facts; reading aloud is slow, inaccurate, 
and effortful, and some children struggle to understand the magnitude that a spoken or 
written number represents. Children in primary grades (grades 1-3) may continue to have 
problems recognizing and manipulating phonemes, be unable to read common one-sylla- 
ble words (such as mat or top), and be unable recognize common irregularly spelled 
words (e.g., said, two). They may commit reading errors that indicate problems in con- 
necting sounds and letters (e.g., “big” for “got”) and have difficulty sequencing numbers 
and letters. Children in grades 1-3 also may have difficulty remembering number facts or 
arithmetic procedures for adding, subtracting, and so forth, and may complain that read- 
ing or arithmetic is hard and avoid doing it. Children with specific learning disorder in the 
middle grades (grades 4-6) may mispronounce or skip parts of long, multisyllable words 
(e.g., say “conible” for “convertible,” “aminal” for “animal”) and confuse words that 
sound alike (e.g., “tornado” for “volcano”). They may have trouble remembering dates, 
names, and telephone numbers and may have trouble completing homework or tests on 
time. Children in the middle grades also may have poor comprehension with or without 
slow, effortful, and inaccurate reading, and they may have trouble reading small function 
words (e.g., that, the, an, in). They may have very poor spelling and poor written work. 
They may get the first part of a word correctly, then guess wildly (e.g., read “clover” as 
“clock”), and may express fear of reading aloud or refuse to read aloud. 

By contrast, adolescents may have mastered word decoding, but reading remains slow 
and effortful, and they are likely to show marked problems in reading comprehension and 
written expression (including poor spelling) and poor mastery of math facts or mathemat- 
ical problem solving. During adolescence and into adulthood, individuals with specific 
learning disorder may continue to make numerous spelling mistakes and read single 
words and connected text slowly and with much effort, with trouble pronouncing multi- 
syllable words. They may frequently need to reread material to understand or get the main 
point and have trouble making inferences from written text. Adolescents and adults may 


72 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


avoid activities that demand reading or arithmetic (reading for pleasure, reading instruc- 
tions). Adults with specific learning disorder have ongoing spelling problems, slow and 
effortful reading, or problems making important inferences from numerical information 
in work-related written documents. They may avoid both leisure and work-related activ- 
ities that demand reading or writing or use alternative approaches to access print (e.g., 
text-to-speech/speech-to-text software, audiobooks, audiovisual media). 

An alternative clinical expression is that of circumscribed learning difficulties that per- 
sist across the lifespan, such as an inability to master the basic sense of number (e.g., to 
know which of a pair of numbers or dots represents the larger magnitude), or lack of pro- 
ficiency in word identification or spelling. Avoidance of or reluctance to engage in activi- 
ties requiring academic skills is common in children, adolescents, and adults. Episodes of 
severe anxiety or anxiety disorders, including somatic complaints or panic attacks, are 
common across the lifespan and accompany both the circumscribed and the broader ex- 
pression of learning difficulties. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Prematurity or very low birth weight increases the risk for specific 
learning disorder, as does prenatal exposure to nicotine. 


Genetic and physiological. Specific learning disorder appears to aggregate in families, 
particularly when affecting reading, mathematics, and spelling. The relative risk of spe- 
cific learning disorder in reading or mathematics is substantially higher (e.g., 4-8 times 
and 5-10 times higher, respectively) in first-degree relatives of individuals with these 
learning difficulties compared with those without them. Family history of reading diffi- 
culties (dyslexia) and parental literacy skills predict literacy problems or specific learning 
disorder in offspring, indicating the combined role of genetic and environmental factors. 

There is high heritability for both reading ability and reading disability in alphabetic and 
nonalphabetic languages, including high heritability for most manifestations of learning abil- 
ities and disabilities (e.g., heritability estimate values greater than 0.6). Covariation between 
various manifestations of learning difficulties is high, suggesting that genes related to one 
presentation are highly correlated with genes related to another manifestation. 


Course modifiers. Marked problems with inattentive behavior in preschool years is pre- 
dictive of later difficulties in reading and mathematics (but not necessarily specific learn- 
ing disorder) and nonresponse to effective academic interventions. Delay or disorders in 
speech or language, or impaired cognitive processing (e.g., phonological awareness, 
working memory, rapid serial naming) in preschool years, predicts later specific learning 
disorder in reading and written expression. Comorbidity with ADHD is predictive of 
worse mental health outcome than that associated with specific learning disorder without 
ADHD. Systematic, intensive, individualized instruction, using evidence-based interven- 
tions, may improve or ameliorate the learning difficulties in some individuals or promote 
the use of compensatory strategies in others, thereby mitigating the otherwise poor out- 
comes. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Specific learning disorder occurs across languages, cultures, races, and socioeconomic 
conditions but may vary in its manifestation according to the nature of the spoken and 
written symbol systems and cultural and educational practices. For example, the cognitive 
processing requirements of reading and of working with numbers vary greatly across or- 
thographies. In the English language, the observable hallmark clinical symptom of diffi- 
culties learning to read is inaccurate and slow reading of single words; in other alphabetic 
languages that have more direct mapping between sounds and letters (e.g., Spanish, Ger- 
man) and in non-alphabetic languages (e.g., Chinese, Japanese), the hallmark feature is 


Specific Learning Disorder 73 


slow but accurate reading. In English-language learners, assessment should include con- 
sideration of whether the source of reading difficulties is a limited proficiency with Eng- 
lish or a specific learning disorder. Risk factors for specific learning disorder in English- 
language learners include a family history of specific learning disorder or language delay 
in the native language, as well as learning difficulties in English and failure to catch up 
with peers. If there is suspicion of cultural or language differences (e.g., as in an English- 
language learner), the assessment needs to take into account the individual’s language 
proficiency in his or her first or native language as well as in the second language (in this 
example, English). Also, assessment should consider the linguistic and cultural context in 
which the individual is living, as well as his or her educational and learning history in the 
original culture and language. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Specific learning disorder is more common in males than in females (ratios range from 
about 2:1 to 3:1) and cannot be attributed to factors such as ascertainment bias, definitional 
or measurement variation, language, race, or socioeconomic status. 


Functional Consequences of 
Specific Learning Disorder 


Specific learning disorder can have negative functional consequences across the lifespan, 
including lower academic attainment, higher rates of high school dropout, lower rates of 
postsecondary education, high levels of psychological distress and poorer overall mental 
health, higher rates of unemployment and under-employment, and lower incomes. School 
dropout and co-occurring depressive symptoms increase the risk for poor mental health 
outcomes, including suicidality, whereas high levels of social or emotional support predict 
better mental health outcomes. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normal variations in academic attainment. Specific learning disorder is distinguished 
from normal variations in academic attainment due to external factors (e.g., lack of edu- 
cational opportunity, consistently poor instruction, learning in a second language), be- 
cause the learning difficulties persist in the presence of adequate educational opportunity 
and exposure to the same instruction as the peer group, and competency in the language of 
instruction, even when it is different from one’s primary spoken language. 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder). Specific learning disorder 
differs from general learning difficulties associated with intellectual disability, because the 
learning difficulties occur in the presence of normal levels of intellectual functioning (i.e., 
IQ score of at least 70 + 5). If intellectual disability is present, specific learning disorder can 
be diagnosed only when the learning difficulties are in excess of those usually associated 
with the intellectual disability. 


Learning difficulties due to neurological or sensory disorders. Specific learning dis- 
order is distinguished from learning difficulties due to neurological or sensory disorders 
(e.g., pediatric stroke, traumatic brain injury, hearing impairment, vision impairment), be- 
cause in these cases there are abnormal findings on neurological examination. 


Neurocognitive disorders. Specific learning disorder is distinguished from learning 
problems associated with neurodegenerative cognitive disorders, because in specific 
learning disorder the clinical expression of specific learning difficulties occurs during the 
developmental period, and the difficulties do not manifest as a marked decline from a for- 
mer state. 


74 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Specific learning disorder is distinguished from 
the poor academic performance associated with ADHD, because in the latter condition the 
problems may not necessarily reflect specific difficulties in learning academic skills but 
rather may reflect difficulties in performing those skills. However, the co-occurrence of 
specific learning disorder and ADHD is more frequent than expected by chance. If criteria 
for both disorders are met, both diagnoses can be given. 


Psychotic disorders. Specific learning disorder is distinguished from the academic and 
cognitive-processing difficulties associated with schizophrenia or psychosis, because with 
these disorders there is a decline (often rapid) in these functional domains. 


Comorbidity 


Specific learning disorder commonly co-occurs with neurodevelopmental (e.g., ADHD, 
communication disorders, developmental coordination disorder, autistic spectrum disor- 
der) or other mental disorders (e.g., anxiety disorders, depressive and bipolar disorders). 
These comorbidities do not necessarily exclude the diagnosis specific learning disorder 
but may make testing and differential diagnosis more difficult, because each of the co- 
occurring disorders independently interferes with the execution of activities of daily liv- 
ing, including learning. Thus, clinical judgment is required to attribute such impairment to 
learning difficulties. If there is an indication that another diagnosis could account for the 
difficulties learning keystone academic skills described in Criterion A, specific learning 
disorder should not be diagnosed. 


Motor Disorders 


Developmental Coordination Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 315.4 (F82) 


A. The acquisition and execution of coordinated motor skills is substantially below that ex- 
pected given the individual’s chronological age and opportunity for skill learning and 
use. Difficulties are manifested as clumsiness (e.g., dropping or bumping into objects) 
as well as slowness and inaccuracy of performance of motor skills (e.g., catching an 
object, using scissors or cutlery, handwriting, riding a bike, or participating in sports). 

B. The motor skills deficit in Criterion A significantly and persistently interferes with activ- 
ities of daily living appropriate to chronological age (e.g., self-care and self-mainte- 
nance) and impacts academic/school productivity, prevocational and vocational 
activities, leisure, and play. 

C. Onset of symptoms is in the early developmental period. 

D. The motor skills deficits are not better explained by intellectual disability (intellectual devel- 
opmental disorder) or visual impairment and are not attributable to a neurological condi- 
tion affecting movement (e.g., cerebral palsy, muscular dystrophy, degenerative disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnosis of developmental coordination disorder is made by a clinical synthesis of the 
history (developmental and medical), physical examination, school or workplace report, and 
individual assessment using psychometrically sound and culturally appropriate standardized 
tests. The manifestation of impaired skills requiring motor coordination (Criterion A) varies 


Developmental Coordination Disorder 75 


with age. Young children may be delayed in achieving motor milestones (i.e., sitting, crawling, 
walking), although many achieve typical motor milestones. They also may be delayed in de- 
veloping skills such as negotiating stairs, pedaling, buttoning shirts, completing puzzles, and 
using zippers. Even when the skill is achieved, movement execution may appear awkward, 
slow, or less precise than that of peers. Older children and adults may display slow speed or in- 
accuracy with motor aspects of activities such as assembling puzzles, building models, playing 
ball games (especially in teams), handwriting, typing, driving, or carrying out self-care skills. 

Developmental coordination disorder is diagnosed only if the impairment in motor 
skills significantly interferes with the performance of, or participation in, daily activities in 
family, social, school, or community life (Criterion B). Examples of such activities include 
getting dressed, eating meals with age-appropriate utensils and without mess, engaging 
in physical games with others, using specific tools in class such as rulers and scissors, and 
participating in team exercise activities at school. Not only is ability to perform these ac- 
tions impaired, but also marked slowness in execution is common. Handwriting compe- 
tence is frequently affected, consequently affecting legibility and/or speed of written output 
and affecting academic achievement (the impact is distinguished from specific learning 
difficulty by the emphasis on the motoric component of written output skills). In adults, 
everyday skills in education and work, especially those in which speed and accuracy are 
required, are affected by coordination problems. 

Criterion C states that the onset of symptoms of developmental coordination disorder 
must be in the early developmental period. However, developmental coordination disorder is 
typically not diagnosed before age 5 years because there is considerable variation in the age at 
acquisition of many motor skills or a lack of stability of measurement in early childhood (e.g., 
some children catch up) or because other causes of motor delay may not have fully manifested. 

Criterion D specifies that the diagnosis of developmental coordination disorder is 
made if the coordination difficulties are not better explained by visual impairment or at- 
tributable to a neurological condition. Thus, visual function examination and neurological 
examination must be included in the diagnostic evaluation. If intellectual disability (intel- 
lectual developmental disorder) is present, the motor difficulties are in excess of those ex- 
pected for the mental age; however, no IQ cut-off or discrepancy criterion is specified. 

Developmental coordination disorder does not have discrete subtypes; however, indi- 
viduals may be impaired predominantly in gross motor skills or in fine motor skills, in- 
cluding handwriting skills. 

Other terms used to describe developmental coordination disorder include childhood 
dyspraxia, specific developmental disorder of motor function, and clumsy child syndrome. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Some children with developmental coordination disorder show additional (usually sup- 
pressed) motor activity, such as choreiform movements of unsupported limbs or mirror 
movements. These “overflow” movements are referred to as neurodevelopmental immaturities or 
neurological soft signs rather than neurological abnormalities. In both current literature and 
clinical practice, their role in diagnosis is still unclear, requiring further evaluation. 


Prevalence 

The prevalence of developmental coordination disorder in children ages 5-11 years is 5%— 
6% (in children age 7 years, 1.8% are diagnosed with severe developmental coordination 
disorder and 3% with probable developmental coordination disorder). Males are more of- 
ten affected than females, with a male:female ratio between 2:1 and 7:1. 


Development and Course 


The course of developmental coordination disorder is variable but stable at least to 1 year 
follow-up. Although there may be improvement in the longer term, problems with coor- 


76 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


dinated movements continue through adolescence in an estimated 50%-70% of children. 
Onset is in early childhood. Delayed motor milestones may be the first signs, or the disor- 
der is first recognized when the child attempts tasks such as holding a knife and fork, but- 
toning clothes, or playing ball games. In middle childhood, there are difficulties with 
motor aspects of assembling puzzles, building models, playing ball, and handwriting, as 
well as with organizing belongings, when motor sequencing and coordination are re- 
quired. In early adulthood, there is continuing difficulty in learning new tasks involving 
complex /automatic motor skills, including driving and using tools. Inability to take notes 
and handwrite quickly may affect performance in the workplace. Co-occurrence with 
other disorders (see the section “Comorbidity” for this disorder) has an additional impact 
on presentation, course, and outcome. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Developmental coordination disorder is more common following pre- 
natal exposure to alcohol and in preterm and low-birth-weight children. 


Genetic and physiological. Impairments in underlying neurodevelopmental processes— 
particularly in visual-motor skills, both in visual-motor perception and spatial mentalizing— 
have been found and affect the ability to make rapid motoric adjustments as the complexity of 
the required movements increases. Cerebellar dysfunction has been proposed, but the neural 
basis of developmental coordination disorder remains unclear. Because of the co-occurrence of 
developmental coordination disorder with attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD), 
specific learning disabilities, and autism spectrum disorder, shared genetic effect has been pro- 
posed. However, consistent co-occurrence in twins appears only in severe cases. 


Course modifiers. Individuals with ADHD and with developmental coordination dis- 
order demonstrate more impairment than individuals with ADHD without developmen- 
tal coordination disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Developmental coordination disorder occurs across cultures, races, and socioeconomic 
conditions. By definition, “activities of daily living” implies cultural differences necessi- 
tating consideration of the context in which the individual child is living as well as 
whether he or she has had appropriate opportunities to learn and practice such activities. 


Functional Consequences of 
Developmental Coordination Disorder 


Developmental coordination disorder leads to impaired functional performance in activ- 
ities of daily living (Criterion B), and the impairment is increased with co-occurring con- 
ditions. Consequences of developmental coordination disorder include reduced 
participation in team play and sports; poor self-esteem and sense of self-worth; emotional 
or behavior problems; impaired academic achievement; poor physical fitness; and re- 
duced physical activity and obesity. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Motor impairments due to another medical condition. Problems in coordination may 
be associated with visual function impairment and specific neurological disorders (e.g., 
cerebral palsy, progressive lesions of the cerebellum, neuromuscular disorders). In such 
cases, there are additional findings on neurological examination. 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder). If intellectual disability is 
present, motor competences may be impaired in accordance with the intellectual disabil- 


Stereotypic Movement Disorder 77 


ity. However, if the motor difficulties are in excess of what could be accounted for by the 
intellectual disability, and criteria for developmental coordination disorder are met, de- 
velopmental coordination disorder can be diagnosed as well. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Individuals with ADHD may fall, bump into 
objects, or knock things over. Careful observation across different contexts is required to 
ascertain if lack of motor competence is attributable to distractibility and impulsiveness 
rather than to developmental coordination disorder. If criteria for both ADHD and devel- 
opmental coordination disorder are met, both diagnoses can be given. 


Autism spectrum disorder. Individuals with autism spectrum disorder may be uninter- 
ested in participating in tasks requiring complex coordination skills, such as ball sports, 
which will affect test performance and function but not reflect core motor competence. Co- 
occurrence of developmental coordination disorder and autism spectrum disorder is com- 
mon. If criteria for both disorders are met, both diagnoses can be given. 


Joint hypermobility syndrome. Individuals with syndromes causing hyperextensible 
joints (found on physical examination; often with a complaint of pain) may present with 
symptoms similar to those of developmental coordination disorder. 


Comorbidity 


Disorders that commonly co-occur with developmental coordination disorder include 
speech and language disorder; specific learning disorder (especially reading and writing); 
problems of inattention, including ADHD (the most frequent coexisting condition, with 
about 50% co-occurrence); autism spectrum disorder; disruptive and emotional behavior 
problems; and joint hypermobility syndrome. Different clusters of co-occurrence may be 
present (e.g., a cluster with severe reading disorders, fine motor problems, and handwriting 
problems; another cluster with impaired movement control and motor planning). Presence 
of other disorders does not exclude developmental coordination disorder but may make 
testing more difficult and may independently interfere with the execution of activities of 
daily living, thus requiring examiner judgment in ascribing impairment to motor skills. 


Stereotypic Movement Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.3 (F98.4) 


A. Repetitive, seemingly driven, and apparently purposeless motor behavior (e.g., hand 
shaking or waving, body rocking, head banging, self-biting, hitting own body). 

B. The repetitive motor behavior interferes with social, academic, or other activities and 
may result in self-injury. 

C. Onset is in the early developmental period. 

D. The repetitive motor behavior is not attributable to the physiological effects of a sub- 
stance or neurological condition and is not better explained by another neurodevel- 
opmental or mental disorder (e.g., trichotillomania [hair-pulling disorder], obsessive- 
compulsive disorder). 

Specify if: 

With self-injurious behavior (or behavior that would result in an injury if preventive 
measures were not used) 
Without self-injurious behavior 

Specify if: 

Associated with a known medical or genetic condition, neurodevelopmental dis- 
order, or environmental factor (e.g., Lesch-Nyhan syndrome, intellectual disability 
[intellectual developmental disorder], intrauterine alcohol exposure) 


78 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Coding note: Use additional code to identify the associated medical or genetic 
condition, or neurodevelopmental disorder. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Symptoms are easily suppressed by sensory stimulus or distraction. 
Moderate: Symptoms require explicit protective measures and behavioral modification. 
Severe: Continuous monitoring and protective measures are required to prevent seri- 
ous injury. 


Recording Procedures 


For stereotypic movement disorder that is associated with a known medical or genetic 
condition, neurodevelopmental disorder, or environmental factor, record stereotypic 
movement disorder associated with (name of condition, disorder, or factor) (e.g., stereo- 
typic movement disorder associated with Lesch-Nyhan syndrome). 


Specifiers 

The severity of non-self-injurious stereotypic movements ranges from mild presentations 
that are easily suppressed by a sensory stimulus or distraction to continuous movements 
that markedly interfere with all activities of daily living. Self-injurious behaviors range in se- 
verity along various dimensions, including the frequency, impact on adaptive functioning, 
and severity of bodily injury (from mild bruising or erythema from hitting hand against 
body, to lacerations or amputation of digits, to retinal detachment from head banging). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of stereotypic movement disorder is repetitive, seemingly driven, 
and apparently purposeless motor behavior (Criterion A). These behaviors are often 
rhythmical movements of the head, hands, or body without obvious adaptive function. 
The movements may or may not respond to efforts to stop them. Among typically devel- 
oping children, the repetitive movements may be stopped when attention is directed to 
them or when the child is distracted from performing them. Among children with neuro- 
developmental disorders, the behaviors are typically less responsive to such efforts. In 
other cases, the individual demonstrates self-restraining behaviors (e.g., sitting on hands, 
wrapping arms in clothing, finding a protective device). 

The repertoire of behaviors is variable; each individual presents with his or her own in- 
dividually patterned, “signature” behavior. Examples of non-self-injurious stereotypic 
movements include, but are not limited to, body rocking, bilateral flapping or rotating 
hand movements, flicking or fluttering fingers in front of the face, arm waving or flapping, 
and head nodding. Stereotyped self-injurious behaviors include, but are not limited to, re- 
petitive head banging, face slapping, eye poking, and biting of hands, lips, or other body 
parts. Eye poking is particularly concerning; it occurs more frequently among children 
with visual impairment. Multiple movements may be combined (e.g., cocking the head, 
rocking the torso, waving a small string repetitively in front of the face). 

Stereotypic movements may occur many times during a day, lasting a few seconds to 
several minutes or longer. Frequency can vary from many occurrences in a single day to 
several weeks elapsing between episodes. The behaviors vary in context, occurring when 
the individual is engrossed in other activities, when excited, stressed, fatigued, or bored. 
Criterion A requires that the movements be “apparently” purposeless. However, some 
functions may be served by the movements. For example, stereotypic movements might 
reduce anxiety in response to external stressors. 

Criterion B states that the stereotypic movements interfere with social, academic, or 
other activities and, in some children, may result in self-injury (or would if protective mea- 
sures were not used). If self-injury is present, it should be coded using the specifier. Onset 


Stereotypic Movement Disorder 79 


of stereotypic movements is in the early developmental period (Criterion C). Criterion D 
states that the repetitive, stereotyped behavior in stereotypic movement disorder is not at- 
tributable to the physiological effects of a substance or neurological condition and is not 
better explained by another neurodevelopmental or mental disorder. The presence of 
stereotypic movements may indicate an undetected neurodevelopmental problem, espe- 
cially in children ages 1-3 years. 


Prevalence 


Simple stereotypic movements (e.g., rocking) are common in young typically developing chil- 
dren. Complex stereotypic movements are much less common (occurring in approximately 
3% 4%). Between 4% and 16% of individuals with intellectual disability (intellectual develop- 
mental disorder) engage in stereotypy and self-injury. The risk is greater in individuals with 
severe intellectual disability. Among individuals with intellectual disability living in res- 
idential facilities, 10%-15% may have stereotypic movement disorder with self-injury. 


Development and Course 


Stereotypic movements typically begin within the first 3 years of life. Simple stereotypic move- 
ments are common in infancy and may be involved in acquisition of motor mastery. In chil- 
dren who develop complex motor stereotypies, approximately 80% exhibit symptoms before 
24 months of age, 12% between 24 and 35 months, and 8% at 36 months or older. In most typ- 
ically developing children, these movements resolve over time or can be suppressed. Onset of 
complex motor stereotypies may be in infancy or later in the developmental period. Among 
individuals with intellectual disability, the stereotyped, self-injurious behaviors may persist 
for years, even though the typography or pattern of self-injury may change. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Social isolation is a risk factor for self-stimulation that may progress to 
stereotypic movements with repetitive self-injury. Environmental stress may also trigger 
stereotypic behavior. Fear may alter physiological state, resulting in increased frequency 
of stereotypic behaviors. 


Genetic and physiological. Lower cognitive functioning is linked to greater risk for stereo- 
typic behaviors and poorer response to interventions. Stereotypic movements are more fre- 
quent among individuals with moderate-to-severe / profound intellectual disability, who by 
virtue of a particular syndrome (e.g., Rett syndrome) or environmental factor (e.g., an environ- 
ment with relatively insufficient stimulation) seem to be at higher risk for stereotypies. Repet- 
itive self-injurious behavior may be a behavioral phenotype in neurogenetic syndromes. For 
example, in Lesch-Nyhan syndrome, there are both stereotypic dystonic movements and self- 
mutilation of fingers, lip biting, and other forms of self-injury unless the individual is re- 
strained, and in Rett syndrome and Cornelia de Lange syndrome, self-injury may result from 
the hand-to-mouth stereotypies. Stereotypic behaviors may result from a painful medical con- 
dition (e.g., middle ear infection, dental problems, gastroesophageal reflux). 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Stereotypic movement disorder, with or without self-injury, occurs in all races and cultures. 
Cultural attitudes toward unusual behaviors may result in delayed diagnosis. Overall cultural 
tolerance and attitudes toward stereotypic movement vary and must be considered. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normal development. Simple stereotypic movements are common in infancy and early 
childhood. Rocking may occur in the transition from sleep to awake, a behavior that usu- 


80 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


ally resolves with age. Complex stereotypies are less common in typically developing 
children and can usually be suppressed by distraction or sensory stimulation. The indi- 
vidual’s daily routine is rarely affected, and the movements generally do not cause the 
child distress. The diagnosis would not be appropriate in these circumstances. 


Autism spectrum disorder. Stereotypic movements may be a presenting symptom of 
autism spectrum disorder and should be considered when repetitive movements and be- 
haviors are being evaluated. Deficits of social communication and reciprocity manifesting 
in autism spectrum disorder are generally absent in stereotypic movement disorder, and 
thus social interaction, social communication, and rigid repetitive behaviors and interests 
are distinguishing features. When autism spectrum disorder is present, stereotypic move- 
ment disorder is diagnosed only when there is self-injury or when the stereotypic behav- 
iors are sufficiently severe to become a focus of treatment. 


Tic disorders. Typically, stereotypies have an earlier age at onset (before 3 years) than 
do tics, which have a mean age at onset of 5-7 years. They are consistent and fixed in their 
pattern or topography compared with tics, which are variable in their presentation. Ste- 
reotypies may involve arms, hands, or the entire body, while tics commonly involve eyes, 
face, head, and shoulders. Stereotypies are more fixed, rhythmic, and prolonged in dura- 
tion than tics, which, generally, are brief, rapid, random, and fluctuating. Tics and stereo- 
typic movements are both reduced by distraction. 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. Stereotypic movement disorder is dis- 
tinguished from obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD) by the absence of obsessions, as 
well as by the nature of the repetitive behaviors. In OCD the individual feels driven to per- 
form repetitive behaviors in response to an obsession or according to rules that must be ap- 
plied rigidly, whereas in stereotypic movement disorder the behaviors are seemingly 
driven but apparently purposeless. Trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder) and excoria- 
tion (skin-picking) disorder are characterized by body-focused repetitive behaviors (i.e., 
hair pulling and skin picking) that may be seemingly driven but that are not apparently 
purposeless, and that may not be patterned or rhythmical. Furthermore, onset in tricho- 
tillomania and excoriation disorder is not typically in the early developmental period, but 
rather around puberty or later. 


Other neurological and medical conditions. The diagnosis of stereotypic movements 
requires the exclusion of habits, mannerisms, paroxysmal dyskinesias, and benign he- 
reditary chorea. A neurological history and examination are required to assess features 
suggestive of other disorders, such as myoclonus, dystonia, tics, and chorea. Involuntary 
movements associated with a neurological condition may be distinguished by their signs 
and symptoms. For example, repetitive, stereotypic movements in tardive dyskinesia can 
be distinguished by a history of chronic neuroleptic use and characteristic oral or facial 
dyskinesia or irregular trunk or limb movements. These types of movements do not result 
in self-injury. A diagnosis of stereotypic movement disorder is not appropriate for repet- 
itive skin picking or scratching associated with amphetamine intoxication or abuse (e.g., 
patients are diagnosed with substance /medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and re- 
lated disorder) and repetitive choreoathetoid movements associated with other neurolog- 
ical disorders. 


Comorbidity 


Stereotypic movement disorder may occur as a primary diagnosis or secondary to another 
disorder. For example, stereotypies are a common manifestation of a variety of neuro- 
genetic disorders, such as Lesch-Nyhan syndrome, Rett syndrome, fragile X syndrome, 
Cornelia de Lange syndrome, and Smith-Magenis syndrome. When stereotypic move- 
ment disorder co-occurs with another medical condition, both should be coded. 


Tic Disorders 81 


Tic Disorders 


Diagnostic Criteria 


Note: A tic is a sudden, rapid, recurrent, nonrhythmic motor movement or vocalization. 


Tourette’s Disorder 307.23 (F95.2) 


A. Both multiple motor and one or more vocal tics have been present at some time during 
the illness, although not necessarily concurrently. 

B. The tics may wax and wane in frequency but have persisted for more than 1 year since 
first tic onset. 

C. Onset is before age 18 years. 

D. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., co- 
caine) or another medical condition (e.g., Huntington’s disease, postviral encephalitis). 


Persistent (Chronic) Motor or Vocal Tic Disorder 307.22 (F95.1) 


A. Single or multiple motor or vocal tics have been present during the illness, but not both 
motor and vocal. 

B. The tics may wax and wane in frequency but have persisted for more than 1 year since 
first tic onset. 

C. Onset is before age 18 years. 

D. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., co- 
caine) or another medical condition (e.g., Huntington’s disease, postviral encephalitis). 

E. Criteria have never been met for Tourette’s disorder. 

Specify if: 
With motor tics only 
With vocal tics only 


Provisional Tic Disorder 307.21 (F95.0) 


A. Single or multiple motor and/or vocal tics. 

B. The tics have been present for less than 1 year since first tic onset. 

C. Onset is before age 18 years. 

D. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., co- 
caine) or another medical condition (e.g., Huntington’s disease, postviral encephalitis). 

E. Criteria have never been met for Tourette’s disorder or persistent (chronic) motor or 
vocal tic disorder. 


Specifiers 
The “motor tics only” or “vocal tics only” specifier is only required for persistent (chronic) 
motor or vocal tic disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


Tic disorders comprise four diagnostic categories: Tourette’s disorder, persistent (chronic) 
motor or vocal tic disorder, provisional tic disorder, and the other specified and unspecified 
tic disorders. Diagnosis for any tic disorder is based on the presence of motor and/or vocal 
tics (Criterion A), duration of tic symptoms (Criterion B), age at onset (Criterion C), and ab- 
sence of any known cause such as another medical condition or substance use (Criterion D). 
The tic disorders are hierarchical in order (i.e., Tourette’s disorder, followed by persistent 
[chronic] motor or vocal tic disorder, followed by provisional tic disorder, followed by the 


82 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


other specified and unspecified tic disorders), such that once a tic disorder at one level of the 
hierarchy is diagnosed, a lower hierarchy diagnosis cannot be made (Criterion E). 

Tics are sudden, rapid, recurrent, nonrhythmic motor movements or vocalizations. An 
individual may have various tic symptoms over time, but at any point in time, the tic rep- 
ertoire recurs in a characteristic fashion. Although tics can include almost any muscle group 
or vocalization, certain tic symptoms, such as eye blinking or throat clearing, are common 
across patient populations. Tics are generally experienced as involuntary but can be vol- 
untarily suppressed for varying lengths of time. 

Tics can be either simple or complex. Simple motor tics are of short duration (i.e., milli- 
seconds) and can include eye blinking, shoulder shrugging, and extension of the extrem- 
ities. Simple vocal tics include throat clearing, sniffing, and grunting often caused by 
contraction of the diaphragm or muscles of the oropharynx. Complex motor tics are of lon- 
ger duration (i.e., seconds) and often include a combination of simple tics such as simul- 
taneous head turning and shoulder shrugging. Complex tics can appear purposeful, such 
as a tic-like sexual or obscene gesture (copropraxia) or a tic-like imitation of someone else’s 
movements (echopraxia). Similarly, complex vocal tics include repeating one’s own sounds 
or words (palilalia), repeating the last-heard word or phrase (echolalia), or uttering socially 
unacceptable words, including obscenities, or ethnic, racial, or religious slurs (coprolalia). 
Importantly, coprolalia is an abrupt, sharp bark or grunt utterance and lacks the prosody 
of similar inappropriate speech observed in human interactions. 

The presence of motor and/or vocal tics varies across the four tic disorders (Criterion 
A). For Tourette’s disorder, both motor and vocal tics must be present, whereas for per- 
sistent (chronic) motor or vocal tic disorder, only motor or only vocal tics are present. For 
provisional tic disorder, motor and/or vocal tics may be present. For other specified or un- 
specified tic disorders, the movement disorder symptoms are best characterized as tics but 
are atypical in presentation or age at onset, or have a known etiology. 

The 1-year minimum duration criterion (Criterion B) assures that individuals diag- 
nosed with either Tourette’s disorder or persistent (chronic) motor or vocal tic disorder 
have had persistent symptoms. Tics wax and wane in severity, and some individuals may 
have tic-free periods of weeks to months; however, an individual who has had tic symp- 
toms of greater than 1 year’s duration since first tic onset would be considered to have per- 
sistent symptoms regardless of duration of tic-free periods. For an individual with motor 
and/or vocal tics of less than 1 year since first tic onset, a provisional tic disorder diagnosis 
can be considered. There is no duration specification for other specified and unspecified tic 
disorders. The onset of tics must occur prior to age 18 years (Criterion C). Tic disorders 
typically begin in the prepubertal period, with an average age at onset between 4 and 6 
years, and with the incidence of new-onset tic disorders decreasing in the teen years. New 
onset of tic symptoms in adulthood is exceedingly rare and is often associated with expo- 
sures to drugs (e.g., excessive cocaine use) or is a result of a central nervous system insult 
(e.g., postviral encephalitis). Although tic onset is uncommon in teenagers and adults, it is 
not uncommon for adolescents and adults to present for an initial diagnostic assessment 
and, when carefully evaluated, provide a history of milder symptoms dating back to child- 
hood. New-onset abnormal movements suggestive of tics outside of the usual age range 
should result in evaluation for other movement disorders or for specific etiologies. 

Tic symptoms cannot be attributable to the physiological effects of a substance or an- 
other medical condition (Criterion D). When there is strong evidence from the history, 
physical examination, and/or laboratory results to suggest a plausible, proximal, and 
probable cause for a tic disorder, a diagnosis of other specified tic disorder should be used. 

Having previously met diagnostic criteria for Tourette’s disorder negates a possible di- 
agnosis of persistent (chronic) motor or vocal tic disorder (Criterion E). Similarly, a previ- 
ous diagnosis of persistent (chronic) motor or vocal tic disorder negates a diagnosis of 
provisional tic disorder or other specified or unspecified tic disorder (Criterion E). 


Tic Disorders 83 


Prevalence 


Tics are common in childhood but transient in most cases. The estimated prevalence of 
Tourette’s disorder ranges from 3 to 8 per 1,000 in school-age children. Males are more 
commonly affected than females, with the ratio varying from 2:1 to 4:1. A national survey 
in the United States estimated 3 per 1,000 for the prevalence of clinically identified cases. 
The frequency of identified cases was lower among African Americans and Hispanic 
Americans, which may be related to differences in access to care. 


Development and Course 


Onset of tics is typically between ages 4 and 6 years. Peak severity occurs between ages 10 
and 12 years, with a decline in severity during adolescence. Many adults with tic disorders 
experience diminished symptoms. A small percentage of individuals will have persis- 
tently severe or worsening symptoms in adulthood. 

Tic symptoms manifest similarly in all age groups and across the lifespan. Tics wax and 
wane in severity and change in affected muscle groups and vocalizations over time. As 
children get older, they begin to report their tics being associated with a premonitory 
urge—a somatic sensation that precedes the tic—and a feeling of tension reduction follow- 
ing the expression of the tic. Tics associated with a premonitory urge may be experienced 
as not completely “involuntary” in that the urge and the tic can be resisted. An individual 
may also feel the need to perform a tic in a specific way or repeat it until he or she achieves 
the feeling that the tic has been done “just right.” 

The vulnerability toward developing co-occurring conditions changes as individuals 
pass through the age of risk for various co-occurring conditions. For example, prepubertal 
children with tic disorders are more likely to experience attention-deficit/hyperactivity 
disorder (ADHD), obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD), and separation anxiety disorder 
than are teenagers and adults, who are more likely to experience the new onset of major 
depressive disorder, substance use disorder, or bipolar disorder. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Tics are worsened by anxiety, excitement, and exhaustion and are better 
during calm, focused activities. Individuals may have fewer tics when engaged in schoolwork 
or tasks at work than when relaxing at home after school or in the evening. Stressful/exciting 
events (e.g., taking a test, participating in exciting activities) often make tics worse. 


Environmental. Observing a gesture or sound in another person may result in an indi- 
vidual with a tic disorder making a similar gesture or sound, which may be incorrectly 
perceived by others as purposeful. This can be a particular problem when the individual is 
interacting with authority figures (e.g., teachers, supervisors, police). 


Genetic and physiological. Genetic and environmental factors influence tic symptom 
expression and severity. Important risk alleles for Tourette’s disorder and rare genetic 
variants in families with tic disorders have been identified. Obstetrical complications, 
older paternal age, lower birth weight, and maternal smoking during pregnancy are as- 
sociated with worse tic severity. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Tic disorders do not appear to vary in clinical characteristics, course, or etiology by race, 
ethnicity, and culture. However, race, ethnicity, and culture may impact how tic disorders 
are perceived and managed in the family and community, as well as influencing patterns 
of help seeking, and choices of treatment. 


84 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Males are more commonly affected than females, but there are no gender differences in the 
kinds of tics, age at onset, or course. Women with persistent tic disorders may be more 
likely to experience anxiety and depression. 


Functional Consequences of Tic Disorders 


Many individuals with mild to moderate tic severity experience no distress or impairment 
in functioning and may even be unaware of their tics. Individuals with more severe symp- 
toms generally have more impairment in daily living, but even individuals with moderate 
or even severe tic disorders may function well. The presence of a co-occurring condition, 
such as ADHD or OCD, can have greater impact on functioning. Less commonly, tics dis- 
rupt functioning in daily activities and result in social isolation, interpersonal conflict, 
peer victimization, inability to work or to go to school, and lower quality of life. The indi- 
vidual also may experience substantial psychological distress. Rare complications of Tou- 
rette’s disorder include physical injury, such as eye injury (from hitting oneself in the face), 
and orthopedic and neurological injury (e.g., disc disease related to forceful head and neck 
movements). 


Differential Diagnosis 


Abnormal movements that may accompany other medical conditions and stereotypic 
movement disorder. Motor stereotypies are defined as involuntary rhythmic, repetitive, 
predictable movements that appear purposeful but serve no obvious adaptive function or 
purpose and stop with distraction. Examples include repetitive hand waving/rotating, 
arm flapping, and finger wiggling. Motor stereotypies can be differentiated from tics based 
on the former’s earlier age at onset (younger than 3 years), prolonged duration (seconds to 
minutes), constant repetitive fixed form and location, exacerbation when engrossed in ac- 
tivities, lack of a premonitory urge, and cessation with distraction (e.g., name called or 
touched). Chorea represents rapid, random, continual, abrupt, irregular, unpredictable, 
nonstereotyped actions that are usually bilateral and affect all parts of the body (ie., face, 
trunk, and limbs). The timing, direction, and distribution of movements vary from mo- 
ment to moment, and movements usually worsen during attempted voluntary action. Dys- 
tonia is the simultaneous sustained contracture of both agonist and antagonist muscles, 
resulting in a distorted posture or movement of parts of the body. Dystonic postures are of- 
ten triggered by attempts at voluntary movements and are not seen during sleep. 


Substance-induced and paroxysmal dyskinesias. Paroxysmal dyskinesias usually oc- 
cur as dystonic or choreoathetoid movements that are precipitated by voluntary move- 
ment or exertion and less commonly arise from normal background activity. 


Myoclonus. Myoclonus is characterized by a sudden unidirectional movement that is 
often nonrhythmic. It may be worsened by movement and occur during sleep. Myoclonus 
is differentiated from tics by its rapidity, lack of suppressibility, and absence of a premon- 
itory urge. 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. Differentiating obsessive-compulsive 
behaviors from tics may be difficult. Clues favoring an obsessive-compulsive behavior in- 
clude a cognitive-based drive (e.g., fear of contamination) and the need to perform the ac- 
tion in a particular fashion a certain number of times, equally on both sides of the body, or 
until a “just right” feeling is achieved. Impulse-control problems and other repetitive be- 
haviors, including persistent hair pulling, skin picking, and nail biting, appear more goal 
directed and complex than tics. 


Other Specified Tic Disorder 85 


Comorbidity 

Many medical and psychiatric conditions have been described as co-occurring with tic disor- 
ders, with ADHD and obsessive-compulsive and related disorders being particularly com- 
mon. The obsessive-compulsive symptoms observed in tic disorder tend to be characterized 
by more aggressive symmetry and order symptoms and poorer response to pharmacotherapy 
with selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors. Children with ADHD may demonstrate disrup- 
tive behavior, social immaturity, and learning difficulties that may interfere with academic 
progress and interpersonal relationships and lead to greater impairment than that caused by a 
tic disorder. Individuals with tic disorders can also have other movement disorders and other 
mental disorders, such as depressive, bipolar, or substance use disorders. 


Other Specified Tic Disorder 
307.20 (F95.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a tic disorder 
that cause Clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other im- 
portant areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for a tic disorder 
or any of the disorders in the neurodevelopmental disorders diagnostic class. The other 
specified tic disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to com- 
municate the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for a tic disor- 
der or any specific neurodevelopmental disorder. This is done by recording “other specified 
tic disorder” followed by the specific reason (e.g., “with onset after age 18 years”). 


Unspecified Tic Disorder 
307.20 (F95.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a tic disorder 
that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other im- 
portant areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for a tic disorder 
or for any of the disorders in the neurodevelopmental disorders diagnostic class. The un- 
specified tic disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to 
specify the reason that the criteria are not met for a tic disorder or for a specific neurode- 
velopmental disorder, and includes presentations in which there is insufficient information 
to make a more specific diagnosis. 


86 Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Other Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Other Specified Neurodevelopmental Disorder 
315.8 (F388) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a neurodevel- 
opmental disorder that cause impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas 
of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of the disorders in the 
neurodevelopmental disorders diagnostic class. The other specified neurodevelopmental 
disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the 
specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific neurode- 
velopmental disorder. This is done by recording “other specified neurodevelopmental dis- 
order” followed by the specific reason (e.g., “neurodevelopmental disorder associated with 
prenatal alcohol exposure”). 

An example of a presentation that can be specified using the “other specified” desig- 
nation is the following: 

Neurodevelopmental disorder associated with prenatal alcohol exposure: Neu- 

rodevelopmental disorder associated with prenatal alcohol exposure is characterized 

by a range of developmental disabilities following exposure to alcohol in utero. 


Unspecified Neurodevelopmental Disorder 
315.9 (F89) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a neurodevel- 
opmental disorder that cause impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas 
of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of the disorders in the 
neurodevelopmental disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified neurodevelopmental dis- 
order category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason 
that the criteria are not met for a specific neurodevelopmental disorder, and includes pre- 
sentations in which there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis 
(e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Schizophrenia Spectrum and 
Other Psychotic Disorders 


Schizo p hrenia s PectrumM and other psychotic disorders include schizophrenia, 
other psychotic disorders, and schizotypal (personality) disorder. They are defined by ab- 
normalities in one or more of the following five domains: delusions, hallucinations, disor- 
ganized thinking (speech), grossly disorganized or abnormal motor behavior (including 
catatonia), and negative symptoms. 


Key Features That Define the Psychotic Disorders 


Delusions 


Delusions are fixed beliefs that are not amenable to change in light of conflicting evidence. 
Their content may include a variety of themes (e.g., persecutory, referential, somatic, reli- 
gious, grandiose). Persecutory delusions (i.e., belief that one is going to be harmed, harassed, 
and so forth by an individual, organization, or other group) are most common. Referential 
delusions (i.e., belief that certain gestures, comments, environmental cues, and so forth are 
directed at oneself) are also common. Grandiose delusions (i.e., when an individual believes 
that he or she has exceptional abilities, wealth, or fame) and erotomanic delusions (i.e., when 
an individual believes falsely that another person is in love with him or her) are also seen. 
Nihilistic delusions involve the conviction that a major catastrophe will occur, and somatic 
delusions focus on preoccupations regarding health and organ function. 

Delusions are deemed bizarre if they are clearly implausible and not understandable to 
same-culture peers and do not derive from ordinary life experiences. An example of a bi- 
zarre delusion is the belief that an outside force has removed his or her internal organs and 
replaced them with someone else’s organs without leaving any wounds or scars. An ex- 
ample of anonbizarre delusion is the belief that one is under surveillance by the police, de- 
spite a lack of convincing evidence. Delusions that express a loss of control over mind or 
body are generally considered to be bizarre; these include the belief that one’s thoughts 
have been “removed” by some outside force (thought withdrawal), that alien thoughts have 
been put into one’s mind (thought insertion), or that one’s body or actions are being acted on 
or manipulated by some outside force (delusions of control). The distinction between a de- 
lusion and a strongly held idea is sometimes difficult to make and depends in part on the 
degree of conviction with which the belief is held despite clear or reasonable contradictory 
evidence regarding its veracity. 


Hallucinations 


Hallucinations are perception-like experiences that occur without an external stimulus. 
They are vivid and clear, with the full force and impact of normal perceptions, and not 
under voluntary control. They may occur in any sensory modality, but auditory halluci- 
nations are the most common in schizophrenia and related disorders. Auditory hallucina- 
tions are usually experienced as voices, whether familiar or unfamiliar, that are perceived 
as distinct from the individual’s own thoughts. The hallucinations must occur in the con- 
text of a clear sensorium; those that occur while falling asleep (hypnagogic) or waking up 


87 


88 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


(hypnopompic) are considered to be within the range of normal experience. Hallucinations 
may be a normal part of religious experience in certain cultural contexts. 


Disorganized Thinking (Speech) 


Disorganized thinking (formal thought disorder) is typically inferred from the individual's 
speech. The individual may switch from one topic to another (derailment or loose associa- 
tions). Answers to questions may be obliquely related or completely unrelated (tangential- 
ity). Rarely, speech may be so severely disorganized that it is nearly incomprehensible and 
resembles receptive aphasia in its linguistic disorganization (incoherence or “word salad”). 
Because mildly disorganized speech is common and nonspecific, the symptom must be se- 
vere enough to substantially impair effective communication. The severity of the impair- 
ment may be difficult to evaluate if the person making the diagnosis comes from a 
different linguistic background than that of the person being examined. Less severe dis- 
organized thinking or speech may occur during the prodromal and residual periods of 
schizophrenia. 


Grossly Disorganized or Abnormal Motor Behavior 
(Including Catatonia) 


Grossly disorganized or abnormal motor behavior may manifest itself in a variety of ways, 
ranging from childlike “silliness” to unpredictable agitation. Problems may be noted in 
any form of goal-directed behavior, leading to difficulties in performing activities of daily 
living. 

Catatonic behavior is a marked decrease in reactivity to the environment. This ranges 
from resistance to instructions (negativism); to maintaining a rigid, inappropriate or bi- 
zarre posture; to a complete lack of verbal and motor responses (mutism and stupor). It can 
also include purposeless and excessive motor activity without obvious cause (catatonic 
excitement). Other features are repeated stereotyped movements, staring, grimacing, 
mutism, and the echoing of speech. Although catatonia has historically been associated 
with schizophrenia, catatonic symptoms are nonspecific and may occur in other mental 
disorders (e.g., bipolar or depressive disorders with catatonia) and in medical conditions 
(catatonic disorder due to another medical condition). 


Negative Symptoms 

Negative symptoms account for a substantial portion of the morbidity associated with 
schizophrenia but are less prominent in other psychotic disorders. Two negative symp- 
toms are particularly prominent in schizophrenia: diminished emotional expression and 
avolition. Diminished emotional expression includes reductions in the expression of emo- 
tions in the face, eye contact, intonation of speech (prosody), and movements of the hand, 
head, and face that normally give an emotional emphasis to speech. Avolition is a decrease 
in motivated self-initiated purposeful activities. The individual may sit for long periods of 
time and show little interest in participating in work or social activities. Other negative 
symptoms include alogia, anhedonia, and asociality. Alogia is manifested by diminished 
speech output. Anhedonia is the decreased ability to experience pleasure from positive 
stimuli or a degradation in the recollection of pleasure previously experienced. Asociality 
refers to the apparent lack of interest in social interactions and may be associated with avo- 
lition, but it can also be a manifestation of limited opportunities for social interactions. 


Disorders in This Chapter 


This chapter is organized along a gradient of psychopathology. Clinicians should first con- 
sider conditions that do not reach full criteria for a psychotic disorder or are limited to one 


Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 89 


domain of psychopathology. Then they should consider time-limited conditions. Finally, 
the diagnosis of a schizophrenia spectrum disorder requires the exclusion of another con- 
dition that may give rise to psychosis. 

Schizotypal personality disorder is noted within this chapter as it is considered within 
the schizophrenia spectrum, although its full description is found in the chapter “Person- 
ality Disorders.” The diagnosis schizotypal personality disorder captures a pervasive pat- 
tern of social and interpersonal deficits, including reduced capacity for close relationships; 
cognitive or perceptual distortions; and eccentricities of behavior, usually beginning by 
early adulthood but in some cases first becoming apparent in childhood and adolescence. 
Abnormalities of beliefs, thinking, and perception are below the threshold for the diagno- 
sis of a psychotic disorder. 

Two conditions are defined by abnormalities limited to one domain of psychosis: delu- 
sions or catatonia. Delusional disorder is characterized by at least 1 month of delusions but 
no other psychotic symptoms. Catatonia is described later in the chapter and further in this 
discussion. 

Brief psychotic disorder lasts more than 1 day and remits by 1 month. Schizophreni- 
form disorder is characterized by a symptomatic presentation equivalent to that of schizo- 
phrenia except for its duration (less than 6 months) and the absence of a requirement for a 
decline in functioning. 

Schizophrenia lasts for at least 6 months and includes at least 1 month of active-phase 
symptoms. In schizoaffective disorder, a mood episode and the active-phase symptoms of 
schizophrenia occur together and were preceded or are followed by at least 2 weeks of de- 
lusions or hallucinations without prominent mood symptoms. 

Psychotic disorders may be induced by another condition. In substance /medication- 
induced psychotic disorder, the psychotic symptoms are judged to be a physiological con- 
sequence of a drug of abuse, a medication, or toxin exposure and cease after removal of the 
agent. In psychotic disorder due to another medical condition, the psychotic symptoms 
are judged to be a direct physiological consequence of another medical condition. 

Catatonia can occur in several disorders, including neurodevelopmental, psychotic, bi- 
polar, depressive, and other mental disorders. This chapter also includes the diagnoses 
catatonia associated with another mental disorder (catatonia specifier), catatonic disorder 
due to another medical condition, and unspecified catatonia, and the diagnostic criteria for 
all three conditions are described together. 

Other specified and unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disor- 
ders are included for classifying psychotic presentations that do not meet the criteria for 
any of the specific psychotic disorders, or psychotic symptomatology about which there is 
inadequate or contradictory information. 


Clinician-Rated Assessment of Symptoms and 
Related Clinical Phenomena in Psychosis 


Psychotic disorders are heterogeneous, and the severity of symptoms can predict impor- 
tant aspects of the illness, such as the degree of cognitive or neurobiological deficits. To 
move the field forward, a detailed framework for the assessment of severity is included in 
Section III “Assessment Measures,” which may help with treatment planning, prognostic 
decision making, and research on pathophysiological mechanisms. Section II “Assess- 
ment Measures” also contains dimensional assessments of the primary symptoms of psy- 
chosis, including hallucinations, delusions, disorganized speech (except for substance/ 
medication-induced psychotic disorder and psychotic disorder due to another medical 
condition), abnormal psychomotor behavior, and negative symptoms, as well as dimen- 
sional assessments of depression and mania. The severity of mood symptoms in psychosis 
has prognostic value and guides treatment. There is growing evidence that schizoaffective 


90 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


disorder is not a distinct nosological category. Thus, dimensional assessments of depres- 
sion and mania for all psychotic disorders alert clinicians to mood pathology and the need 
to treat where appropriate. The Section III scale also includes a dimensional assessment of 
cognitive impairment. Many individuals with psychotic disorders have impairments in a 
range of cognitive domains that predict functional status. Clinical neuropsychological as- 
sessment can help guide diagnosis and treatment, but brief assessments without formal 
neuropsychological assessment can provide useful information that can be sufficient for 
diagnostic purposes. Formal neuropsychological testing, when conducted, should be ad- 
ministered and scored by personnel trained in the use of testing instruments. If a formal 
neuropsychological assessment is not conducted, the clinician should use the best avail- 
able information to make a judgment. Further research on these assessments is necessary 
in order to determine their clinical utility; thus, the assessments available in Section II 
should serve as a prototype to stimulate such research. 


Schizotypal (Personality) Disorder 


Criteria and text for schizotypal personality disorder can be found in the chapter “Person- 
ality Disorders.” Because this disorder is considered part of the schizophrenia spectrum of 
disorders, and is labeled in this section of ICD-9 and ICD-10 as schizotypal disorder, it is 
listed in this chapter and discussed in detail in the DSM-5 chapter “Personality Disorders.” 


Delusional Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 297.1 (F22) 


A. The presence of one (or more) delusions with a duration of 1 month or longer. 

B. Criterion A for schizophrenia has never been met. 
Note: Hallucinations, if present, are not prominent and are related to the delusional 
theme (e.g., the sensation of being infested with insects associated with delusions of 
infestation). 

C. Apart from the impact of the delusion(s) or its ramifications, functioning is not markedly 
impaired, and behavior is not obviously bizarre or odd. 

D. If manic or major depressive episodes have occurred, these have been brief relative 
to the duration of the delusional periods. 

E. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance or an- 
other medical condition and is not better explained by another mental disorder, such 
as body dysmorphic disorder or obsessive-compulsive disorder. 


Specify whether: 
Erotomanic type: This subtype applies when the central theme of the delusion is that 
another person is in love with the individual. 
Grandiose type: This subtype applies when the central theme of the delusion is the 
conviction of having some great (but unrecognized) talent or insight or having made 
some important discovery. 
Jealous type: This subtype applies when the central theme of the individual’s delusion 
is that his or her spouse or lover is unfaithful. 
Persecutory type: This subtype applies when the central theme of the delusion in- 
volves the individual’s belief that he or she is being conspired against, cheated, spied 
on, followed, poisoned or drugged, maliciously maligned, harassed, or obstructed in 
the pursuit of long-term goals. 
Somatic type: This subtype applies when the central theme of the delusion involves 
bodily functions or sensations. 


Delusional Disorder 91 


Mixed type: This subtype applies when no one delusional theme predominates. 
Unspecified type: This subtype applies when the dominant delusional belief cannot 
be clearly determined or is not described in the specific types (e.g., referential delu- 
sions without a prominent persecutory or grandiose component). 

Specify if: 

With bizarre content: Delusions are deemed bizarre if they are clearly implausible, not 
understandable, and not derived from ordinary life experiences (e.g., an individual’s be- 
lief that a stranger has removed his or her internal organs and replaced them with some- 
one else’s organs without leaving any wounds or scars). 

Specify if: 

The following course specifiers are only to be used after a 1-year duration of the disorder: 
First episode, currently in acute episode: First manifestation of the disorder meet- 
ing the defining diagnostic symptom and time criteria. An acute episode is a time pe- 
riod in which the symptom criteria are fulfilled. 

First episode, currently in partial remission: Partial remission is a time period dur- 
ing which an improvement after a previous episode is maintained and in which the de- 
fining criteria of the disorder are only partially fulfilled. 

First episode, currently in full remission: Ful! remission is a period of time after a 
previous episode during which no disorder-specific symptoms are present. 

Multiple episodes, currently in acute episode 

Multiple episodes, currently in partial remission 

Multiple episodes, currently in full remission 

Continuous: Symptoms fulfilling the diagnostic symptom criteria of the disorder are 
remaining for the majority of the illness course, with subthreshold symptom periods be- 
ing very brief relative to the overall course. 

Unspecified 

Specify current severity: 

Severity is rated by a quantitative assessment of the primary symptoms of psychosis, 
including delusions, hallucinations, disorganized speech, abnormal psychomotor be- 
havior, and negative symptoms. Each of these symptoms may be rated for its current 
severity (most severe in the last 7 days) on a 5-point scale ranging from 0 (not present) 
to 4 (present and severe). (See Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom 
Severity in the chapter “Assessment Measures.”) 

Note: Diagnosis of delusional disorder can be made without using this severity specifier. 


Subtypes 


In erotomanic type, the central theme of the delusion is that another person is in love with 
the individual. The person about whom this conviction is held is usually of higher status 
(e.g., a famous individual or a superior at work) but can be a complete stranger. Efforts to 
contact the object of the delusion are common. In grandiose type, the central theme of the de- 
lusion is the conviction of having some great talent or insight or of having made some im- 
portant discovery. Less commonly, the individual may have the delusion of having a 
special relationship with a prominent individual or of being a prominent person (in which 
case the actual individual may be regarded as an impostor). Grandiose delusions may 
have a religious content. In jealous type, the central theme of the delusion is that of an un- 
faithful partner. This belief is arrived at without due cause and is based on incorrect infer- 
ences supported by small bits of “evidence” (e.g., disarrayed clothing). The individual 
with the delusion usually confronts the spouse or lover and attempts to intervene in the 
imagined infidelity. In persecutory type, the central theme of the delusion involves the in- 


92 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


dividual’s belief of being conspired against, cheated, spied on, followed, poisoned, mali- 
ciously maligned, harassed, or obstructed in the pursuit of long-term goals. Small slights 
may be exaggerated and become the focus of a delusional system. The affected individual 
may engage in repeated attempts to obtain satisfaction by legal or legislative action. Indi- 
viduals with persecutory delusions are often resentful and angry and may resort to vio- 
lence against those they believe are hurting them. In somatic type, the central theme of the 
delusion involves bodily functions or sensations. Somatic delusions can occur in several 
forms. Most common is the belief that the individual emits a foul odor; that there is an in- 
festation of insects on or in the skin; that there is an internal parasite; that certain parts of 
the body are misshapen or ugly; or that parts of the body are not functioning. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of delusional disorder is the presence of one or more delusions that 
persist for at least 1 month (Criterion A). A diagnosis of delusional disorder is not given if 
the individual has ever had a symptom presentation that met Criterion A for schizophre- 
nia (Criterion B). Apart from the direct impact of the delusions, impairments in psychoso- 
cial functioning may be more circumscribed than those seen in other psychotic disorders 
such as schizophrenia, and behavior is not obviously bizarre or odd (Criterion C). If mood 
episodes occur concurrently with the delusions, the total duration of these mood episodes 
is brief relative to the total duration of the delusional periods (Criterion D). The delusions 
are not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., cocaine) or another 
medical condition (e.g., Alzheimer’s disease) and are not better explained by another men- 
tal disorder, such as body dysmorphic disorder or obsessive-compulsive disorder (Crite- 
rion E). 

In addition to the five symptom domain areas identified in the diagnostic criteria, the 
assessment of cognition, depression, and mania symptom domains is vital for making crit- 
ically important distinctions between the various schizophrenia spectrum and other psy- 
chotic disorders. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Social, marital, or work problems can result from the delusional beliefs of delusional dis- 
order. Individuals with delusional disorder may be able to factually describe that others 
view their beliefs as irrational but are unable to accept this themselves (i.e., there may be 
“factual insight” but no true insight). Many individuals develop irritable or dysphoric 
mood, which can usually be understood as a reaction to their delusional beliefs. Anger and 
violent behavior can occur with persecutory, jealous, and erotomanic types. The individ- 
ual may engage in litigious or antagonistic behavior (e.g., sending hundreds of letters of 
protest to the government). Legal difficulties can occur, particularly in jealous and eroto- 
manic types. 


Prevalence 

The lifetime prevalence of delusional disorder has been estimated at around 0.2%, and the 
most frequent subtype is persecutory. Delusional disorder, jealous type, is probably more 
common in males than in females, but there are no major gender differences in the overall 
frequency of delusional disorder. 


Development and Course 


On average, global function is generally better than that observed in schizophrenia. Al- 
though the diagnosis is generally stable, a proportion of individuals go on to develop 


Delusional Disorder 93 


schizophrenia. Delusional disorder has a significant familial relationship with both 
schizophrenia and schizotypal personality disorder. Although it can occur in younger age 
groups, the condition may be more prevalent in older individuals. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


An individual’s cultural and religious background must be taken into account in evaluat- 
ing the possible presence of delusional disorder. The content of delusions also varies 
across cultural contexts. 


Functional Consequences of Delusional Disorder 


The functional impairment is usually more circumscribed than that seen with other psy- 
chotic disorders, although in some cases, the impairment may be substantial and include 
poor occupational functioning and social isolation. When poor psychosocial functioning is 
present, delusional beliefs themselves often play a significant role. A common character- 
istic of individuals with delusional disorder is the apparent normality of their behavior 
and appearance when their delusional ideas are not being discussed or acted on. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. If an individual with obsessive-compul- 
sive disorder is completely convinced that his or her obsessive-compulsive disorder beliefs 
are true, then the diagnosis of obsessive-compulsive disorder, with absent insight/delu- 
sional beliefs specifier, should be given rather than a diagnosis of delusional disorder. 
Similarly, if an individual with body dysmorphic disorder is completely convinced that 
his or her body dysmorphic disorder beliefs are true, then the diagnosis of body dysmor- 
phic disorder, with absent insight/ delusional beliefs specifier, should be given rather than 
a diagnosis of delusional disorder. 


Delirium, major neurocognitive disorder, psychotic disorder due to another medical con- 
dition, and substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder. Individuals with these 
disorders may present with symptoms that suggest delusional disorder. For example, sim- 
ple persecutory delusions in the context of major neurocognitive disorder would be di- 
agnosed as major neurocognitive disorder, with behavioral disturbance. A substance / 
medication-induced psychotic disorder cross-sectionally may be identical in symptom- 
atology to delusional disorder but can be distinguished by the chronological relationship 
of substance use to the onset and remission of the delusional beliefs. 


Schizophrenia and schizophreniform disorder. Delusional disorder can be distinguished 
from schizophrenia and schizophreniform disorder by the absence of the other character- 
istic symptoms of the active phase of schizophrenia. 


Depressive and bipolar disorders and schizoaffective disorder. These disorders may 
be distinguished from delusional disorder by the temporal relationship between the mood 
disturbance and the delusions and by the severity of the mood symptoms. If delusions oc- 
cur exclusively during mood episodes, the diagnosis is depressive or bipolar disorder with 
psychotic features. Mood symptoms that meet full criteria for a mood episode can be su- 
perimposed on delusional disorder. Delusional disorder can be diagnosed only if the total 
duration of all mood episodes remains brief relative to the total duration of the delusional 
disturbance. If not, then a diagnosis of other specified or unspecified schizophrenia spec- 
trum and other psychotic disorder accompanied by other specified depressive disorder, 
unspecified depressive disorder, other specified bipolar and related disorder, or unspeci- 
fied bipolar and related disorder is appropriate. 


94 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Brief Psychotic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 298.8 (F23) 


A. Presence of one (or more) of the following symptoms. At least one of these must be 
(1), (2), or (3): 
1. Delusions. 

2. Hallucinations. 

3. Disorganized speech (e.g., frequent derailment or incoherence). 

4. Grossly disorganized or catatonic behavior. 


Note: Do not include a symptom if it is a culturally sanctioned response. 

B. Duration of an episode of the disturbance is at least 1 day but less than 1 month, with 
eventual full return to premorbid level of functioning. 

C. The disturbance is not better explained by major depressive or bipolar disorder with 
psychotic features or another psychotic disorder such as schizophrenia or catatonia, 
and is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, 
a medication) or another medical condition. 

Specity if: 

With marked stressor(s) (brief reactive psychosis): If symptoms occur in response to 
events that, singly or together, would be markedly stressful to almost anyone in similar 
circumstances in the individual’s culture. 

Without marked stressor(s): If symptoms do not occur in response to events that, 
singly or together, would be markedly stressful to almost anyone in similar circum- 
stances in the individual’s culture. 

With postpartum onset: If onset is during pregnancy or within 4 weeks postpartum. 

Specify if: 

With catatonia (refer to the criteria for catatonia associated with another mental dis- 
order, pp. 119-120, for definition) 


Coding note: Use additional code 293.89 (F06.1) catatonia associated with brief 
psychotic disorder to indicate the presence of the comorbid catatonia. 


Specify current severity: 

Severity is rated by a quantitative assessment of the primary symptoms of psychosis, 
including delusions, hallucinations, disorganized speech, abnormal psychomotor be- 
havior, and negative symptoms. Each of these symptoms may be rated for its current 
severity (most severe in the last 7 days) on a 5-point scale ranging from 0 (not present) 
to 4 (present and severe). (See Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom 
Severity in the chapter “Assessment Measures.”) 

Note: Diagnosis of brief psychotic disorder can be made without using this severity 
specifier. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of brief psychotic disorder is a disturbance that involves the sudden 
onset of at least one of the following positive psychotic symptoms: delusions, hallucina- 
tions, disorganized speech (e.g., frequent derailment or incoherence), or grossly abnormal 
psychomotor behavior, including catatonia (Criterion A). Sudden onset is defined as 
change from a nonpsychotic state to a clearly psychotic state within 2 weeks, usually with- 
out a prodrome. An episode of the disturbance lasts at least 1 day but less than 1 month, 
and the individual eventually has a full return to the premorbid level of functioning (Cri- 


Brief Psychotic Disorder 95 


terion B). The disturbance is not better explained by a depressive or bipolar disorder with 
psychotic features, by schizoaffective disorder, or by schizophrenia and is not attributable 
to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a hallucinogen) or another medical condi- 
tion (e.g., subdural hematoma) (Criterion C). 

In addition to the five symptom domain areas identified in the diagnostic criteria, the 
assessment of cognition, depression, and mania symptom domains is vital for making crit- 
ically important distinctions between the various schizophrenia spectrum and other psy- 
chotic disorders. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with brief psychotic disorder typically experience emotional turmoil or over- 
whelming confusion. They may have rapid shifts from one intense affect to another. 
Although the disturbance is brief, the level of impairment may be severe, and supervision 
may be required to ensure that nutritional and hygienic needs are met and that the indi- 
vidual is protected from the consequences of poor judgment, cognitive impairment, or act- 
ing on the basis of delusions. There appears to be an increased risk of suicidal behavior, 
particularly during the acute episode. 


Prevalence 


In the United States, brief psychotic disorder may account for 9% of cases of first-onset 
psychosis. Psychotic disturbances that meet Criteria A and C, but not Criterion B, for brief 
psychotic disorder (i.e., duration of active symptoms is 1-6 months as opposed to remis- 
sion within 1 month) are more common in developing countries than in developed coun- 
tries. Brief psychotic disorder is twofold more common in females than in males. 


Development and Course 


Brief psychotic disorder may appear in adolescence or early adulthood, and onset can oc- 
cur across the lifespan, with the average age at onset being the mid 30s. By definition, a 
diagnosis of brief psychotic disorder requires a full remission of all symptoms and an 
eventual full return to the premorbid level of functioning within 1 month of the onset of the 
disturbance. In some individuals, the duration of psychotic symptoms may be quite brief 
(e.g., a few days). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Preexisting personality disorders and traits (e.g., schizotypal person- 
ality disorder; borderline personality disorder; or traits in the psychoticism domain, such 
as perceptual dysregulation, and the negative affectivity domain, such as suspiciousness) 
may predispose the individual to the development of the disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


It is important to distinguish symptoms of brief psychotic disorder from culturally sanc- 
tioned response patterns. For example, in some religious ceremonies, an individual may 
report hearing voices, but these do not generally persist and are not perceived as abnormal 
by most members of the individual’s community. In addition, cultural and religious back- 
ground must be taken into account when considering whether beliefs are delusional. 


Functional Consequences of Brief Psychotic Disorder 


Despite high rates of relapse, for most individuals, outcome is excellent in terms of social 
functioning and symptomatology. 


96 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other medical conditions. A variety of medical disorders can manifest with psychotic 
symptoms of short duration. Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition or a de- 
lirium is diagnosed when there is evidence from the history, physical examination, or lab- 
oratory tests that the delusions or hallucinations are the direct physiological consequence 
of a specific medical condition (e.g., Cushing’s syndrome, brain tumor) (see “Psychotic 
Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition” later in this chapter). 


Substance-related disorders. Substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder, sub- 
stance-induced delirium, and substance intoxication are distinguished from brief psychotic 
disorder by the fact that a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication, exposure to a toxin) 
is judged to be etiologically related to the psychotic symptoms (see “Substance /Medication- 
Induced Psychotic Disorder” later in this chapter). Laboratory tests, such as a urine drug 
screen or a blood alcohol level, may be helpful in making this determination, as may a care- 
ful history of substance use with attention to temporal relationships between substance in- 
take and onset of the symptoms and to the nature of the substance being used. 


Depressive and bipolar disorders. The diagnosis of brief psychotic disorder cannot be 
made if the psychotic symptoms are better explained by a mood episode (i.e., the psychotic 
symptoms occur exclusively during a full major depressive, manic, or mixed episode). 


Other psychotic disorders. If the psychotic symptoms persist for 1 month or longer, the 
diagnosis is either schizophreniform disorder, delusional disorder, depressive disorder 
with psychotic features, bipolar disorder with psychotic features, or other specified or un- 
specified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder, depending on the other 
symptoms in the presentation. The differential diagnosis between brief psychotic disorder 
and schizophreniform disorder is difficult when the psychotic symptoms have remitted be- 
fore 1 month in response to successful treatment with medication. Careful attention should 
be given to the possibility that a recurrent disorder (e.g., bipolar disorder, recurrent acute ex- 
acerbations of schizophrenia) may be responsible for any recurring psychotic episodes. 


Malingering and factitious disorders. An episode of factitious disorder, with predomi- 
nantly psychological signs and symptoms, may have the appearance of brief psychotic 
disorder, but in such cases there is evidence that the symptoms are intentionally produced. 
When malingering involves apparently psychotic symptoms, there is usually evidence 
that the illness is being feigned for an understandable goal. 

Personality disorders. In certain individuals with personality disorders, psychosocial 
stressors may precipitate brief periods of psychotic symptoms. These symptoms are usu- 
ally transient and do not warrant a separate diagnosis. If psychotic symptoms persist for at 
least 1 day, an additional diagnosis of brief psychotic disorder may be appropriate. 


Schizophreniform Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 295.40 (F20.81) 


A. Two (or more) of the following, each present for a significant portion of time during a 
1-month period (or less if successfully treated). At least one of these must be (1), (2), 
or (3): 

Delusions. 

Hallucinations. 

Disorganized speech (e.g., frequent derailment or incoherence). 

Grossly disorganized or catatonic behavior. 

Negative symptoms (i.e., diminished emotional expression or avolition). 


Clee: NS 


Schizophreniform Disorder 97 


B. An episode of the disorder lasts at least 1 month but less than 6 months. When the 
diagnosis must be made without waiting for recovery, it should be qualified as “provi- 
sional.” 

C. Schizoaffective disorder and depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features have 
been ruled out because either 1) no major depressive or manic episodes have occurred 
concurrently with the active-phase symptoms, or 2) if mood episodes have occurred dur- 
ing active-phase symptoms, they have been present for a minority of the total duration 
of the active and residual periods of the illness. 

D. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition. 


Specify if: 
With good prognostic features: This specifier requires the presence of at least two 
of the following features: onset of prominent psychotic symptoms within 4 weeks of the 
first noticeable change in usual behavior or functioning; confusion or perplexity; good 
premorbid social and occupational functioning; and absence of blunted or flat affect. 
Without good prognostic features: This specifier is applied if two or more of the 
above features have not been present. 


Specify if: 
With catatonia (refer to the criteria for catatonia associated with another mental disor- 
der, pp. 119-120, for definition). 


Coding note: Use additional code 293.89 (F06.1) catatonia associated with schizo- 
phreniform disorder to indicate the presence of the comorbid catatonia. 


Specify current severity: 

Severity is rated by a quantitative assessment of the primary symptoms of psychosis, 
including delusions, hallucinations, disorganized speech, abnormal psychomotor be- 
havior, and negative symptoms. Each of these symptoms may be rated for its current 
severity (most severe in the last 7 days) on a 5-point scale ranging from 0 (not present) 
to 4 (present and severe). (See Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom 
Severity in the chapter “Assessment Measures.”) 

Note: Diagnosis of schizophreniform disorder can be made without using this severity 
specifier. 


Note: For additional information on Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis, Develop- 
ment and Course (age-related factors), Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues, Gender-Related 
Diagnostic Issues, Differential Diagnosis, and Comorbidity, see the corresponding sec- 
tions in schizophrenia. 


Diagnostic Features 


The characteristic symptoms of schizophreniform disorder are identical to those of schizo- 
phrenia (Criterion A). Schizophreniform disorder is distinguished by its difference in du- 
ration: the total duration of the illness, including prodromal, active, and residual phases, is 
at least 1 month but less than 6 months (Criterion B). The duration requirement for schizo- 
phreniform disorder is intermediate between that for brief psychotic disorder, which lasts 
more than 1 day and remits by 1 month, and schizophrenia, which lasts for at least 6 months. 
The diagnosis of schizophreniform disorder is made under two conditions. 1) when an ep- 
isode of illness lasts between 1 and 6 months and the individual has already recovered, 
and 2) when an individual is symptomatic for less than the 6 months’ duration required for 
the diagnosis of schizophrenia but has not yet recovered. In this case, the diagnosis should 
be noted as “schizophreniform disorder (provisional)” because it is uncertain if the indi- 
vidual will recover from the disturbance within the 6-month period. If the disturbance per- 
sists beyond 6 months, the diagnosis should be changed to schizophrenia. 


98 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Another distinguishing feature of schizophreniform disorder is the lack of a criterion 
requiring impaired social and occupational functioning. While such impairments may po- 
tentially be present, they are not necessary for a diagnosis of schizophreniform disorder. 

In addition to the five symptom domain areas identified in the diagnostic criteria, the 
assessment of cognition, depression, and mania symptom domains is vital for making crit- 
ically important distinctions between the various schizophrenia spectrum and other psy- 
chotic disorders. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


As with schizophrenia, currently there are no laboratory or psychometric tests for schizo- 
phreniform disorder. There are multiple brain regions where neuroimaging, neuropa- 
thological, and neurophysiological research has indicated abnormalities, but none are 
diagnostic. 


Prevalence 


Incidence of schizophreniform disorder across sociocultural settings is likely similar to 
that observed in schizophrenia. In the United States and other developed countries, the in- 
cidence is low, possibly fivefold less than that of schizophrenia. In developing countries, 
the incidence may be higher, especially for the specifier “with good prognostic features”; 
in some of these settings schizophreniform disorder may be as common as schizophrenia. 


Development and Course 


The development of schizophreniform disorder is similar to that of schizophrenia. About 
one-third of individuals with an initial diagnosis of schizophreniform disorder (provi- 
sional) recover within the 6-month period and schizophreniform disorder is their final di- 
agnosis. The majority of the remaining two-thirds of individuals will eventually receive a 
diagnosis of schizophrenia or schizoaffective disorder. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Relatives of individuals with schizophreniform disorder 
have an increased risk for schizophrenia. 


Functional Consequences of 
Schizophreniform Disorder 


For the majority of individuals with schizophreniform disorder who eventually receive a 
diagnosis of schizophrenia or schizoaffective disorder, the functional consequences are 
similar to the consequences of those disorders. Most individuals experience dysfunction in 
several areas of daily functioning, such as school or work, interpersonal relationships, and 
self-care. Individuals who recover from schizophreniform disorder have better functional 
outcomes. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders and medical conditions. A wide variety of mental and medical 
conditions can manifest with psychotic symptoms that must be considered in the differ- 
ential diagnosis of schizophreniform disorder. These include psychotic disorder due to 
another medical condition or its treatment; delirium or major neurocognitive disorder; 
substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder or delirium; depressive or bipolar 
disorder with psychotic features; schizoaffective disorder; other specified or unspecified bi- 
polar and related disorder; depressive or bipolar disorder with catatonic features; schizophre- 


Schizophrenia 99 


nia; brief psychotic disorder; delusional disorder; other specified or unspecified schizo- 
phrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder; schizotypal, schizoid, or paranoid 
personality disorders; autism spectrum disorder; disorders presenting in childhood with 
disorganized speech; attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder; obsessive-compulsive dis- 
order; posttraumatic stress disorder; and traumatic brain injury. 

Since the diagnostic criteria for schizophreniform disorder and schizophrenia differ 
primarily in duration of illness, the discussion of the differential diagnosis of schizophre- 
nia also applies to schizophreniform disorder. 


Brief psychotic disorder. Schizophreniform disorder differs in duration from brief psy- 
chotic disorder, which has a duration of less than 1 month. 


Schizophrenia 
Diagnostic Criteria 295.90 (F20.9) 


A. Two (or more) of the following, each present for a significant portion of time during a 
1-month period (or less if successfully treated). At least one of these must be (1), (2), or (3): 
1. Delusions. 

Hallucinations. 

Disorganized speech (e.g., frequent derailment or incoherence). 

Grossly disorganized or catatonic behavior. 

Negative symptoms (i.e., diminished emotional expression or avolition). 


OV oN 


B. Fora significant portion of the time since the onset of the disturbance, level of function- 
ing in one or more major areas, such as work, interpersonal relations, or self-care, is 
markedly below the level achieved prior to the onset (or when the onset is in childhood 
or adolescence, there is failure to achieve expected level of interpersonal, academic, 
or occupational functioning). 

C. Continuous signs of the disturbance persist for at least 6 months. This 6-month period 
must include at least 1 month of symptoms (or less if successfully treated) that meet Cri- 
terion A (i.e., active-phase symptoms) and may include periods of prodromal or residual 
symptoms. During these prodromal or residual periods, the signs of the disturbance may 
be manifested by only negative symptoms or by two or more symptoms listed in Criterion 
A present in an attenuated form (e.g., odd beliefs, unusual perceptual experiences). 

D. Schizoaffective disorder and depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features 
have been ruled out because either 1) no major depressive or manic episodes have 
occurred concurrently with the active-phase symptoms, or 2) if mood episodes have 
occurred during active-phase symptoms, they have been present for a minority of the 
total duration of the active and residual periods of the illness. 

E. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition. 

F. If there is a history of autism spectrum disorder or a communication disorder of child- 
hood onset, the additional diagnosis of schizophrenia is made only if prominent delu- 
sions or hallucinations, in addition to the other required symptoms of schizophrenia, 
are also present for at least 1 month (or less if successfully treated). 

Specify if: 

The following course specifiers are only to be used after a 1-year duration of the disorder 

and if they are not in contradiction to the diagnostic course criteria. 

First episode, currently in acute episode: First manifestation of the disorder meet- 
ing the defining diagnostic symptom and time criteria. An acute episode is a time pe- 
riod in which the symptom criteria are fulfilled. 


100 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


First episode, currently in partial remission: Partial remission is a period of time 
during which an improvement after a previous episode is maintained and in which the 
defining criteria of the disorder are only partially fulfilled. 
First episode, currently in full remission: Ful! remission is a period of time after a 
previous episode during which no disorder-specific symptoms are present. 
Multiple episodes, currently in acute episode: Multiple episodes may be deter- 
mined after a minimum of two episodes (i.e., after a first episode, a remission and a 
minimum of one relapse). 
Multiple episodes, currently in partial remission 
Multiple episodes, currently in full remission 
Continuous: Symptoms fulfilling the diagnostic symptom criteria of the disorder are 
remaining for the majority of the illness course, with subthreshold symptom periods be- 
ing very brief relative to the overall course. 
Unspecified 

Specify if: 
With catatonia (refer to the criteria for catatonia associated with another mental disorder, 
pp. 119-120, for definition). 


Coding note: Use additional code 293.89 (F06.1) catatonia associated with 
schizophrenia to indicate the presence of the comorbid catatonia. 


Specify current severity: 

Severity is rated by a quantitative assessment of the primary symptoms of psychosis, 
including delusions, hallucinations, disorganized speech, abnormal psychomotor be- 
havior, and negative symptoms. Each of these symptoms may be rated for its current 
severity (most severe in the last 7 days) on a 5-point scale ranging from 0 (not present) 
to 4 (present and severe). (See Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom 
Severity in the chapter “Assessment Measures.”) 

Note: Diagnosis of schizophrenia can be made without using this severity specifier. 


Diagnostic Features 


The characteristic symptoms of schizophrenia involve a range of cognitive, behavioral, and 
emotional dysfunctions, but no single symptom is pathognomonic of the disorder. The di- 
agnosis involves the recognition of a constellation of signs and symptoms associated with 
impaired occupational or social functioning. Individuals with the disorder will vary sub- 
stantially on most features, as schizophrenia is a heterogeneous clinical syndrome. 

At least two Criterion A symptoms must be present for a significant portion of time 
during a 1-month period or longer. At least one of these symptoms must be the clear pres- 
ence of delusions (Criterion A1), hallucinations (Criterion A2), or disorganized speech 
(Criterion A3). Grossly disorganized or catatonic behavior (Criterion A4) and negative 
symptoms (Criterion A5) may also be present. In those situations in which the active- 
phase symptoms remit within a month in response to treatment, Criterion A is still met if the 
clinician estimates that they would have persisted in the absence of treatment. 

Schizophrenia involves impairment in one or more major areas of functioning (Crite- 
rion B). If the disturbance begins in childhood or adolescence, the expected level of func- 
tion is not attained. Comparing the individual with unaffected siblings may be helpful. The 
dysfunction persists for a substantial period during the course of the disorder and does not 
appear to be a direct result of any single feature. Avolition (i-e., reduced drive to pursue 
goal-directed behavior; Criterion A5) is linked to the social dysfunction described under 
Criterion B. There is also strong evidence for a relationship between cognitive impairment 
(see the section “Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis” for this disorder) and func- 
tional impairment in individuals with schizophrenia. 


Schizophrenia 101 


Some signs of the disturbance must persist for a continuous period of at least 6 months 
(Criterion C). Prodromal symptoms often precede the active phase, and residual symp- 
toms may follow it, characterized by mild or subthreshold forms of hallucinations or 
delusions. Individuals may express a variety of unusual or odd beliefs that are not of de- 
lusional proportions (e.g., ideas of reference or magical thinking); they may have unusual 
perceptual experiences (e.g., sensing the presence of an unseen person); their speech may 
be generally understandable but vague; and their behavior may be unusual but not grossly 
disorganized (e.g., mumbling in public). Negative symptoms are common in the pro- 
dromal and residual phases and can be severe. Individuals who had been socially active 
may become withdrawn from previous routines. Such behaviors are often the first sign of 
a disorder. 

Mood symptoms and full mood episodes are common in schizophrenia and may be con- 
current with active-phase symptomatology. However, as distinct from a psychotic mood dis- 
order, a schizophrenia diagnosis requires the presence of delusions or hallucinations in the 
absence of mood episodes. In addition, mood episodes, taken in total, should be present for 
only a minority of the total duration of the active and residual periods of the illness. 

In addition to the five symptom domain areas identified in the diagnostic criteria, the 
assessment of cognition, depression, and mania symptom domains is vital for making crit- 
ically important distinctions between the various schizophrenia spectrum and other psy- 
chotic disorders. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with schizophrenia may display inappropriate affect (e.g., laughing in the ab- 
sence of an appropriate stimulus); a dysphoric mood that can take the form of depression, 
anxiety, or anger; a disturbed sleep pattern (e.g., daytime sleeping and nighttime activity); 
and a lack of interest in eating or food refusal. Depersonalization, derealization, and so- 
matic concerns may occur and sometimes reach delusional proportions. Anxiety and pho- 
bias are common. Cognitive deficits in schizophrenia are common and are strongly linked 
to vocational and functional impairments. These deficits can include decrements in declar- 
ative memory, working memory, language function, and other executive functions, as well 
as slower processing speed. Abnormalities in sensory processing and inhibitory capacity, 
as well as reductions in attention, are also found. Some individuals with schizophrenia 
show social cognition deficits, including deficits in the ability to infer the intentions of 
other people (theory of mind), and may attend to and then interpret irrelevant events or 
stimuli as meaningful, perhaps leading to the generation of explanatory delusions. These 
impairments frequently persist during symptomatic remission. 

Some individuals with psychosis may lack insight or awareness of their disorder (i.e., 
anosognosia). This lack of “insight” includes unawareness of symptoms of schizophrenia 
and may be present throughout the entire course of the illness. Unawareness of illness is 
typically a symptom of schizophrenia itself rather than a coping strategy. It is comparable 
to the lack of awareness of neurological deficits following brain damage, termed anoso- 
gnosia. This symptom is the most common predictor of non-adherence to treatment, and it 
predicts higher relapse rates, increased number of involuntary treatments, poorer psycho- 
social functioning, aggression, and a poorer course of illness. 

Hostility and aggression can be associated with schizophrenia, although spontaneous 
or random assault is uncommon. Aggression is more frequent for younger males and for 
individuals with a past history of violence, non-adherence with treatment, substance 
abuse, and impulsivity. It should be noted that the vast majority of persons with schizo- 
phrenia are not aggressive and are more frequently victimized than are individuals in the 
general population. 

Currently, there are no radiological, laboratory, or psychometric tests for the disorder. 
Differences are evident in multiple brain regions between groups of healthy individuals 


102 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


and persons with schizophrenia, including evidence from neuroimaging, neuropatholog- 
ical, and neurophysiological studies. Differences are also evident in cellular architecture, 
white matter connectivity, and gray matter volume in a variety of regions such as the pre- 
frontal and temporal cortices. Reduced overall brain volume has been observed, as well as 
increased brain volume reduction with age. Brain volume reductions with age are more 
pronounced in individuals with schizophrenia than in healthy individuals. Finally, indi- 
viduals with schizophrenia appear to differ from individuals without the disorder in eye- 
tracking and electrophysiological indices. 

Neurological soft signs common in individuals with schizophrenia include impairments 
in motor coordination, sensory integration, and motor sequencing of complex movements; 
left-right confusion; and disinhibition of associated movements. In addition, minor phys- 
ical anomalies of the face and limbs may occur. 


Prevalence 


The lifetime prevalence of schizophrenia appears to be approximately 0.3%-—0.7%, al- 
though there is reported variation by race/ethnicity, across countries, and by geographic 
origin for immigrants and children of immigrants. The sex ratio differs across samples and 
populations: for example, an emphasis on negative symptoms and longer duration of dis- 
order (associated with poorer outcome) shows higher incidence rates for males, whereas 
definitions allowing for the inclusion of more mood symptoms and brief presentations 
(associated with better outcome) show equivalent risks for both sexes. 


Development and Course 


The psychotic features of schizophrenia typically emerge between the late teens and the 
mid-30s; onset prior to adolescence is rare. The peak age at onset for the first psychotic ep- 
isode is in the early- to mid-20s for males and in the late-20s for females. The onset may be 
abrupt or insidious, but the majority of individuals manifest a slow and gradual develop- 
ment of a variety of clinically significant signs and symptoms. Half of these individuals 
complain of depressive symptoms. Earlier age at onset has traditionally been seen as a pre- 
dictor of worse prognosis. However, the effect of age at onset is likely related to gender, 
with males having worse premorbid adjustment, lower educational achievement, more 
prominent negative symptoms and cognitive impairment, and in general a worse out- 
come. Impaired cognition is common, and alterations in cognition are present during de- 
velopment and precede the emergence of psychosis, taking the form of stable cognitive 
impairments during adulthood. Cognitive impairments may persist when other symptoms 
are in remission and contribute to the disability of the disease. 

The predictors of course and outcome are largely unexplained, and course and outcome 
may not be reliably predicted. The course appears to be favorable in about 20% of those 
with schizophrenia, and a small number of individuals are reported to recover completely. 
However, most individuals with schizophrenia still require formal or informal daily living 
supports, and many remain chronically ill, with exacerbations and remissions of active 
symptoms, while others have a course of progressive deterioration. 

Psychotic symptoms tend to diminish over the life course, perhaps in association with 
normal age-related declines in dopamine activity. Negative symptoms are more closely re- 
lated to prognosis than are positive symptoms and tend to be the most persistent. Further- 
more, cognitive deficits associated with the illness may not improve over the course of the 
illness. 

The essential features of schizophrenia are the same in childhood, but it is more diffi- 
cult to make the diagnosis. In children, delusions and hallucinations may be less elaborate 
than in adults, and visual hallucinations are more common and should be distinguished 
from normal fantasy play. Disorganized speech occurs in many disorders with childhood 
onset (e.g., autism spectrum disorder), as does disorganized behavior (e.g., attention-deficit/ 


Schizophrenia 103 


hyperactivity disorder). These symptoms should not be attributed to schizophrenia with- 
out due consideration of the more common disorders of childhood. Childhood-onset cases 
tend to resemble poor-outcome adult cases, with gradual onset and prominent negative 
symptoms. Children who later receive the diagnosis of schizophrenia are more likely to 
have experienced nonspecific emotional-behavioral disturbances and psychopathology, 
intellectual and language alterations, and subtle motor delays. 

Late-onset cases (i.e., onset after age 40 years) are overrepresented by females, who 
may have married. Often, the course is characterized by a predominance of psychotic 
symptoms with preservation of affect and social functioning. Such late-onset cases can still 
meet the diagnostic criteria for schizophrenia, but it is not yet clear whether this is the 
same condition as schizophrenia diagnosed prior to mid-life (e.g., prior to age 55 years). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Season of birth has been linked to the incidence of schizophrenia, in- 
cluding late winter/early spring in some locations and summer for the deficit form of the 
disease. The incidence of schizophrenia and related disorders is higher for children grow- 
ing up in an urban environment and for some minority ethnic groups. 


Genetic and physiological. There is a strong contribution for genetic factors in deter- 
mining risk for schizophrenia, although most individuals who have been diagnosed with 
schizophrenia have no family history of psychosis. Liability is conferred by a spectrum of 
risk alleles, common and rare, with each allele contributing only a small fraction to the to- 
tal population variance. The risk alleles identified to date are also associated with other 
mental disorders, including bipolar disorder, depression, and autism spectrum disorder. 

Pregnancy and birth complications with hypoxia and greater paternal age are associated 
with a higher risk of schizophrenia for the developing fetus. In addition, other prenatal 
and perinatal adversities, including stress, infection, malnutrition, maternal diabetes, and 
other medical conditions, have been linked with schizophrenia. However, the vast major- 
ity of offspring with these risk factors do not develop schizophrenia. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Cultural and socioeconomic factors must be considered, particularly when the individual 
and the clinician do not share the same cultural and socioeconomic background. Ideas that 
appear to be delusional in one culture (e.g., witchcraft) may be commonly held in another. 
In some cultures, visual or auditory hallucinations with a religious content (e.g., hearing 
God’s voice) are a normal part of religious experience. In addition, the assessment of dis- 
organized speech may be made difficult by linguistic variation in narrative styles across 
cultures. The assessment of affect requires sensitivity to differences in styles of emotional 
expression, eye contact, and body language, which vary across cultures. If the assessment 
is conducted in a language that is different from the individual’s primary language, care 
must be taken to ensure that alogia is not related to linguistic barriers. In certain cultures, 
distress may take the form of hallucinations or pseudo-hallucinations and overvalued 
ideas that may present clinically similar to true psychosis but are normative to the pa- 
tient’s subgroup. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


A number of features distinguish the clinical expression of schizophrenia in females and 
males. The general incidence of schizophrenia tends to be slightly lower in females, par- 
ticularly among treated cases. The age at onset is later in females, with a second mid-life 
peak as described earlier (see the section “Development and Course” for this disorder). 
Symptoms tend to be more affect-laden among females, and there are more psychotic 
symptoms, as well as a greater propensity for psychotic symptoms to worsen in later life. 


104 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Other symptom differences include less frequent negative symptoms and disorganization. 
Finally, social functioning tends to remain better preserved in females. There are, how- 
ever, frequent exceptions to these general caveats. 


Suicide Risk 


Approximately 5%-6% of individuals with schizophrenia die by suicide, about 20% attempt 
suicide on one or more occasions, and many more have significant suicidal ideation. Suicidal 
behavior is sometimes in response to command hallucinations to harm oneself or others. 
Suicide risk remains high over the whole lifespan for males and females, although it may be 
especially high for younger males with comorbid substance use. Other risk factors include 
having depressive symptoms or feelings of hopelessness and being unemployed, and the 
risk is higher, also, in the period after a psychotic episode or hospital discharge. 


Functional Consequences of Schizophrenia 


Schizophrenia is associated with significant social and occupational dysfunction. Making 
educational progress and maintaining employment are frequently impaired by avolition 
or other disorder manifestations, even when the cognitive skills are sufficient for the tasks 
at hand. Most individuals are employed at a lower level than their parents, and most, par- 
ticularly men, do not marry or have limited social contacts outside of their family. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Major depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic or catatonic features. The distinc- 
tion between schizophrenia and major depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic 
features or with catatonia depends on the temporal relationship between the mood distur- 
bance and the psychosis, and on the severity of the depressive or manic symptoms. If de- 
lusions or hallucinations occur exclusively during a major depressive or manic episode, 
the diagnosis is depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features. 


Schizoaffective disorder. A diagnosis of schizoaffective disorder requires that a major 
depressive or manic episode occur concurrently with the active-phase symptoms and that 
the mood symptoms be present for a majority of the total duration of the active periods. 


Schizophreniform disorder and brief psychotic disorder. These disorders are of shorter 
duration than schizophrenia as specified in Criterion C, which requires 6 months of symp- 
toms. In schizophreniform disorder, the disturbance is present less than 6 months, and in 
brief psychotic disorder, symptoms are present at least 1 day but less than 1 month. 


Delusional disorder. Delusional disorder can be distinguished from schizophrenia by 
the absence of the other symptoms characteristic of schizophrenia (e.g., delusions, prom- 
inent auditory or visual hallucinations, disorganized speech, grossly disorganized or cata- 
tonic behavior, negative symptoms). 


Schizotypal personality disorder. Schizotypal personality disorder may be distinguished 
from schizophrenia by subthreshold symptoms that are associated with persistent person- 
ality features. 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder and body dysmorphic disorder. Individuals with 
obsessive-compulsive disorder and body dysmorphic disorder may present with poor or 
absent insight, and the preoccupations may reach delusional proportions. But these 
disorders are distinguished from schizophrenia by their prominent obsessions, compul- 
sions, preoccupations with appearance or body odor, hoarding, or body-focused repeti- 
tive behaviors. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder. Posttraumatic stress disorder may include flashbacks that 
have a hallucinatory quality, and hypervigilance may reach paranoid proportions. Buta trau- 


Schizoaffective Disorder 105 


matic event and characteristic symptom features relating to reliving or reacting to the event 
are required to make the diagnosis. 


Autism spectrum disorder or communication disorders. These disorders may also have 
symptoms resembling a psychotic episode but are distinguished by their respective defi- 
cits in social interaction with repetitive and restricted behaviors and other cognitive and 
communication deficits. An individual with autism spectrum disorder or communication 
disorder must have symptoms that meet full criteria for schizophrenia, with prominent 
hallucinations or delusions for at least 1 month, in order to be diagnosed with schizophre- 
nia as a comorbid condition. 


Other mental disorders associated with a psychotic episode. The diagnosis of schizo- 
phrenia is made only when the psychotic episode is persistent and not attributable to the 
physiological effects of a substance or another medical condition. Individuals with a de- 
lirium or major or minor neurocognitive disorder may present with psychotic symptoms, 
but these would have a temporal relationship to the onset of cognitive changes consistent 
with those disorders. Individuals with substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder 
may present with symptoms characteristic of Criterion A for schizophrenia, but the sub- 
stance/medication-induced psychotic disorder can usually be distinguished by the chron- 
ological relationship of substance use to the onset and remission of the psychosis in the 
absence of substance use. 


Comorbidity 


Rates of comorbidity with substance-related disorders are high in schizophrenia. Over 
half of individuals with schizophrenia have tobacco use disorder and smoke cigarettes 
regularly. Comorbidity with anxiety disorders is increasingly recognized in schizophre- 
nia. Rates of obsessive-compulsive disorder and panic disorder are elevated in individuals 
with schizophrenia compared with the general population. Schizotypal or paranoid per- 
sonality disorder may sometimes precede the onset of schizophrenia. 

Life expectancy is reduced in individuals with schizophrenia because of associated 
medical conditions. Weight gain, diabetes, metabolic syndrome, and cardiovascular and 
pulmonary disease are more common in schizophrenia than in the general population. 
Poor engagement in health maintenance behaviors (e.g., cancer screening, exercise) in- 
creases the risk of chronic disease, but other disorder factors, including medications, life- 
style, cigarette smoking, and diet, may also play a role. A shared vulnerability for 
psychosis and medical disorders may explain some of the medical comorbidity of schizo- 
phrenia. 


Schizoaffective Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 


A. An uninterrupted period of illness during which there is a major mood episode (major 
depressive or manic) concurrent with Criterion A of schizophrenia. 
Note: The major depressive episode must include Criterion A1: Depressed mood. 

B. Delusions or hallucinations for 2 or more weeks in the absence of a major mood epi- 
sode (depressive or manic) during the lifetime duration of the illness. 

C. Symptoms that meet criteria for a major mood episode are present for the majority of 
the total duration of the active and residual portions of the illness. 

D. The disturbance is not attributable to the effects of a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, 
a medication) or another medical condition. 


106 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Specify whether: 
295.70 (F25.0) Bipolar type: This subtype applies if a manic episode is part of the pre- 
sentation. Major depressive episodes may also occur. 
295.70 (F25.1) Depressive type: This subtype applies if only major depressive epi- 
sodes are part of the presentation. 

Specity if: 
With catatonia (refer to the criteria for catatonia associated with another mental disorder, 
pp. 119-120, for definition). 


Coding note: Use additional code 293.89 (F06.1) catatonia associated with 
schizoaffective disorder to indicate the presence of the comorbid catatonia. 


Specity if: 

The following course specifiers are only to be used after a 1-year duration of the disorder 

and if they are not in contradiction to the diagnostic course criteria. 
First episode, currently in acute episode: First manifestation of the disorder meet- 
ing the defining diagnostic symptom and time criteria. An acute episode is a time pe- 
riod in which the symptom criteria are fulfilled. 
First episode, currently in partial remission: Partial remission is a time period dur- 
ing which an improvement after a previous episode is maintained and in which the de- 
fining criteria of the disorder are only partially fulfilled. 
First episode, currently in full remission: Ful! remission is a period of time after a 
previous episode during which no disorder-specific symptoms are present. 
Multiple episodes, currently in acute episode: Multiple episodes may be deter- 
mined after a minimum of two episodes (i.e., after a first episode, a remission and a 
minimum of one relapse). 
Multiple episodes, currently in partial remission 
Multiple episodes, currently in full remission 
Continuous: Symptoms fulfilling the diagnostic symptom criteria of the disorder are 
remaining for the majority of the illness course, with subthreshold symptom periods be- 
ing very brief relative to the overall course. 
Unspecified 

Specify current severity: 
Severity is rated by a quantitative assessment of the primary symptoms of psychosis, 
including delusions, hallucinations, disorganized speech, abnormal psychomotor be- 
havior, and negative symptoms. Each of these symptoms may be rated for its current 
severity (most severe in the last 7 days) on a 5-point scale ranging from 0 (not present) 
to 4 (present and severe). (See Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom 
Severity in the chapter “Assessment Measures.”) 
Note: Diagnosis of schizoaffective disorder can be made without using this severity 
specifier. 


Note: For additional information on Development and Course (age-related factors), Risk 
and Prognostic Factors (environmental risk factors), Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues, 
and Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues, see the corresponding sections in schizophrenia, 
bipolar I and II disorders, and major depressive disorder in their respective chapters. 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnosis of schizoaffective disorder is based on the assessment of an uninterrupted 
period of illness during which the individual continues to display active or residual symp- 
toms of psychotic illness. The diagnosis is usually, but not necessarily, made during the 
period of psychotic illness. At some time during the period, Criterion A for schizophrenia 


Schizoaffective Disorder 107 


has to be met. Criteria B (social dysfunction) and F (exclusion of autism spectrum disorder 
or other communication disorder of childhood onset) for schizophrenia do not have to be 
met. In addition to meeting Criterion A for schizophrenia, there is a major mood episode 
(major depressive or manic) (Criterion A for schizoaffective disorder). Because loss of in- 
terest or pleasure is common in schizophrenia, to meet Criterion A for schizoaffective dis- 
order, the major depressive episode must include pervasive depressed mood (i.e., the 
presence of markedly diminished interest or pleasure is not sufficient). Episodes of de- 
pression or mania are present for the majority of the total duration of the illness (i.e., after 
Criterion A has been met) (Criterion C for schizoaffective disorder). To separate schizoaf- 
fective disorder from a depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features, delusions 
or hallucinations must be present for at least 2 weeks in the absence of a major mood epi- 
sode (depressive or manic) at some point during the lifetime duration of the illness (Cri- 
terion B for schizoaffective disorder). The symptoms must not be attributable to the effects 
of a substance or another medical condition (Criterion D for schizoaffective disorder). 

Criterion C for schizoaffective disorder specifies that mood symptoms meeting criteria 
for a major mood episode must be present for the majority of the total duration of the ac- 
tive and residual portion of the illness. Criterion C requires the assessment of mood symp- 
toms for the entire course of a psychotic illness, which differs from the criterion in DSM-IV, 
which required only an assessment of the current period of illness. If the mood symptoms 
are present for only a relatively brief period, the diagnosis is schizophrenia, not schizoaf- 
fective disorder. When deciding whether an individual’s presentation meets Criterion C, 
the clinician should review the total duration of psychotic illness (i.e., both active and re- 
sidual symptoms) and determine when significant mood symptoms (untreated or in need 
of treatment with antidepressant and/or mood-stabilizing medication) accompanied the 
psychotic symptoms. This determination requires sufficient historical information and 
clinical judgment. For example, an individual with a 4-year history of active and residual 
symptoms of schizophrenia develops depressive and manic episodes that, taken together, 
do not occupy more than 1 year during the 4-year history of psychotic illness. This presen- 
tation would not meet Criterion C. 

In addition to the five symptom domain areas identified in the diagnostic criteria, the 
assessment of cognition, depression, and mania symptom domains is vital for making crit- 
ically important distinctions between the various schizophrenia spectrum and other psy- 
chotic disorders. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Occupational functioning is frequently impaired, but this is not a defining criterion (in 
contrast to schizophrenia). Restricted social contact and difficulties with self-care are as- 
sociated with schizoaffective disorder, but negative symptoms may be less severe and less 
persistent than those seen in schizophrenia. Anosognosia (i.e., poor insight) is also com- 
mon in schizoaffective disorder, but the deficits in insight may be less severe and perva- 
sive than those in schizophrenia. Individuals with schizoaffective disorder may be at 
increased risk for later developing episodes of major depressive disorder or bipolar disor- 
der if mood symptoms continue following the remission of symptoms meeting Criterion A 
for schizophrenia. There may be associated alcohol and other substance-related disorders. 

There are no tests or biological measures that can assist in making the diagnosis of 
schizoaffective disorder. Whether schizoaffective disorder differs from schizophrenia 
with regard to associated features such as structural or functional brain abnormalities, 
cognitive deficits, or genetic risk factors is not clear. 


Prevalence 


Schizoaffective disorder appears to be about one-third as common as schizophrenia. Life- 
time prevalence of schizoaffective disorder is estimated to be 0.3%. The incidence of 


108 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


schizoaffective disorder is higher in females than in males, mainly due to an increased in- 
cidence of the depressive type among females. 


Development and Course 


The typical age at onset of schizoaffective disorder is early adulthood, although onset can 
occur anywhere from adolescence to late in life. A significant number of individuals diag- 
nosed with another psychotic illness initially will receive the diagnosis schizoaffective dis- 
order later when the pattern of mood episodes has become more apparent. With the 
current diagnostic Criterion C, it is expected that the diagnosis for some individuals will 
convert from schizoaffective disorder to another disorder as mood symptoms become less 
prominent. The prognosis for schizoaffective disorder is somewhat better than the prog- 
nosis for schizophrenia but worse than the prognosis for mood disorders. 

Schizoaffective disorder may occur in a variety of temporal patterns. The following is 
a typical pattern: An individual may have pronounced auditory hallucinations and per- 
secutory delusions for 2 months before the onset of a prominent major depressive episode. 
The psychotic symptoms and the full major depressive episode are then present for 3 months. 
Then, the individual recovers completely from the major depressive episode, but the psy- 
chotic symptoms persist for another month before they too disappear. During this period 
of illness, the individual’s symptoms concurrently met criteria for a major depressive ep- 
isode and Criterion A for schizophrenia, and during this same period of illness, auditory 
hallucinations and delusions were present both before and after the depressive phase. The 
total period of illness lasted for about 6 months, with psychotic symptoms alone present 
during the initial 2 months, both depressive and psychotic symptoms present during the 
next 3 months, and psychotic symptoms alone present during the last month. In this in- 
stance, the duration of the depressive episode was not brief relative to the total duration of 
the psychotic disturbance, and thus the presentation qualifies for a diagnosis of schizoaf- 
fective disorder. 

The expression of psychotic symptoms across the lifespan is variable. Depressive or 
manic symptoms can occur before the onset of psychosis, during acute psychotic episodes, 
during residual periods, and after cessation of psychosis. For example, an individual 
might present with prominent mood symptoms during the prodromal stage of schizo- 
phrenia. This pattern is not necessarily indicative of schizoaffective disorder, since it is the 
co-occurrence of psychotic and mood symptoms that is diagnostic. For an individual with 
symptoms that clearly meet the criteria for schizoaffective disorder but who on further fol- 
low-up only presents with residual psychotic symptoms (such as subthreshold psychosis 
and/or prominent negative symptoms), the diagnosis may be changed to schizophrenia, 
as the total proportion of psychotic illness compared with mood symptoms becomes more 
prominent. Schizoaffective disorder, bipolar type, may be more common in young adults, 
whereas schizoaffective disorder, depressive type, may be more common in older adults. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Among individuals with schizophrenia, there may be an in- 
creased risk for schizoaffective disorder in first-degree relatives. The risk for schizoaffec- 
tive disorder may be increased among individuals who have a first-degree relative with 
schizophrenia, bipolar disorder, or schizoaffective disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Cultural and socioeconomic factors must be considered, particularly when the individual 
and the clinician do not share the same cultural and economic background. Ideas that ap- 
pear to be delusional in one culture (e.g., witchcraft) may be commonly held in another. 
There is also some evidence in the literature for the overdiagnosis of schizophrenia com- 


Schizoaffective Disorder 109 


pared with schizoaffective disorder in African American and Hispanic populations, so 
care must be taken to ensure a culturally appropriate evaluation that includes both psy- 
chotic and affective symptoms. 


Suicide Risk 


The lifetime risk of suicide for schizophrenia and schizoaffective disorder is 5%, and the 
presence of depressive symptoms is correlated with a higher risk for suicide. There is ev- 
idence that suicide rates are higher in North American populations than in European, 
Eastern European, South American, and Indian populations of individuals with schizo- 
phrenia or schizoaffective disorder. 


Functional Consequences of Schizoaffective Disorder 


Schizoaffective disorder is associated with social and occupational dysfunction, but dys- 
function is not a diagnostic criterion (as it is for schizophrenia), and there is substantial 
variability between individuals diagnosed with schizoaffective disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders and medical conditions. A wide variety of psychiatric and med- 
ical conditions can manifest with psychotic and mood symptoms that must be considered 
in the differential diagnosis of schizoaffective disorder. These include psychotic disorder 
due to another medical condition; delirium; major neurocognitive disorder; substance/ 
medication-induced psychotic disorder or neurocognitive disorder; bipolar disorders 
with psychotic features; major depressive disorder with psychotic features; depressive or 
bipolar disorders with catatonic features; schizotypal, schizoid, or paranoid personality 
disorder; brief psychotic disorder; schizophreniform disorder; schizophrenia; delusional 
disorder; and other specified and unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic 
disorders. Medical conditions and substance use can present with a combination of psy- 
chotic and mood symptoms, and thus psychotic disorder due to another medical condition 
needs to be excluded. Distinguishing schizoaffective disorder from schizophrenia and 
from depressive and bipolar disorders with psychotic features is often difficult. Criterion 
C is designed to separate schizoaffective disorder from schizophrenia, and Criterion B is 
designed to distinguish schizoaffective disorder from a depressive or bipolar disorder 
with psychotic features. More specifically, schizoaffective disorder can be distinguished 
from a depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features due to the presence of prom- 
inent delusions and/or hallucinations for at least 2 weeks in the absence of a major mood 
episode. In contrast, in depressive or bipolar disorders with psychotic features, the psy- 
chotic features primarily occur during the mood episode(s). Because the relative propor- 
tion of mood to psychotic symptoms may change over time, the appropriate diagnosis 
may change from and to schizoaffective disorder (e.g., a diagnosis of schizoaffective dis- 
order for a severe and prominent major depressive episode lasting 3 months during the 
first 6 months of a persistent psychotic illness would be changed to schizophrenia if active 
psychotic or prominent residual symptoms persist over several years without a recurrence 
of another mood episode). 


Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition. Other medical conditions and 
substance use can manifest with a combination of psychotic and mood symptoms, and 
thus psychotic disorder due to another medical condition needs to be excluded. 


Schizophrenia, bipolar, and depressive disorders. Distinguishing schizoaffective dis- 
order from schizophrenia and from depressive and bipolar disorders with psychotic fea- 
tures is often difficult. Criterion C is designed to separate schizoaffective disorder from 
schizophrenia, and Criterion B is designed to distinguish schizoaffective disorder from a 


110 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features. More specifically, schizoaffective 
disorder can be distinguished from a depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features 
based on the presence of prominent delusions and/or hallucinations for at least 2 weeks in 
the absence of a major mood episode. In contrast, in depressive or bipolar disorder with 
psychotic features, the psychotic features primarily occur during the mood episode(s). Be- 
cause the relative proportion of mood to psychotic symptoms may change over time, the 
appropriate diagnosis may change from and to schizoaffective disorder. (For example, a 
diagnosis of schizoaffective disorder for a severe and prominent major depressive episode 
lasting 3 months during the first 6 months of a chronic psychotic illness would be changed 
to schizophrenia if active psychotic or prominent residual symptoms persist over several 
years without a recurrence of another mood episode.) 


Comorbidity 

Many individuals diagnosed with schizoaffective disorder are also diagnosed with other 
mental disorders, especially substance use disorders and anxiety disorders. Similarly, the 
incidence of medical conditions is increased above base rate for the general population 
and leads to decreased life expectancy. 


Substance/Medication-Induced 
Psychotic Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Presence of one or both of the following symptoms: 


1. Delusions. 
2. Hallucinations. 


B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of both 
(1) and (2): 


1. The symptoms in Criterion A developed during or soon after substance intoxication 
or withdrawal or after exposure to a medication. 

2. The involved substance/medication is capable of producing the symptoms in Crite- 
rion A. 


C. The disturbance is not better explained by a psychotic disorder that is not substance/ 
medication-induced. Such evidence of an independent psychotic disorder could in- 
clude the following: 


The symptoms preceded the onset of the substance/medication use; the symptoms 
persist for a substantial period of time (e.g., about 1 month) after the cessation of 
acute withdrawal or severe intoxication; or there is other evidence of an indepen- 
dent non-substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder (e.g., a history of recur- 
rent non-substance/medication-related episodes). 

D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 

E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 

tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

Note: This diagnosis should be made instead of a diagnosis of substance intoxication or 

substance withdrawal only when the symptoms in Criterion A predominate in the clinical 

picture and when they are sufficiently severe to warrant clinical attention. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Psychotic Disorder 111 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance/medica- 
tion]-induced psychotic disorders are indicated in the table below. Note that the ICD-10- 
CM code depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance use disorder present 
for the same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is comorbid with the sub- 
stance-induced psychotic disorder, the 4th position character is “1,” and the clinician should 
record “mild [substance] use disorder” before the substance-induced psychotic disorder 
(e.g., “mild cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced psychotic disorder”). If a moderate or 
severe substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance-induced psychotic disor- 
der, the 4th position character is “2,” and the clinician should record “moderate [substance] 
use disorder” or “severe [substance] use disorder,” depending on the severity of the co- 
morbid substance use disorder. If there is no comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after 
a one-time heavy use of the substance), then the 4th position character is “9,” and the cli- 
nician should record only the substance-induced psychotic disorder. 


ICD-10-CM 
With use 
With use disorder, Without 
disorder, moderate use 
ICD-9-CM mild or severe disorder 
Alcohol 291.9 F10.159 F10.259 F10.959 
Cannabis 292.9 F12.159 F12.259 F12.959 
Phencyclidine 292.9 F16.159 F16.259 F16.959 
Other hallucinogen 292.9 F16.159 F16.259 F16.959 
Inhalant 292.9 F18.159 F18.259 F18.959 
Sedative, hypnotic, or 292.9 F13.159 F13.259 F13.959 
anxiolytic 
Amphetamine (or other 292.9 F15.159 F15.259 F15.959 
stimulant) 
Cocaine 292.9 F14.159 F14.259 F14.959 
Other (or unknown) substance 292.9 F19.159 F19.259 F19.959 


Specify if (see Table 1 in the chapter “Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders” for diag- 
noses associated with substance class): 
With onset during intoxication: If the criteria are met for intoxication with the sub- 
stance and the symptoms develop during intoxication. 
With onset during withdrawal: If the criteria are met for withdrawal from the sub- 
stance and the symptoms develop during, or shortly after, withdrawal. 


Specify current severity: 

Severity is rated by a quantitative assessment of the primary symptoms of psychosis, 
including delusions, hallucinations, abnormal psychomotor behavior, and negative 
symptoms. Each of these symptoms may be rated for its current severity (most severe 
in the last 7 days) on a 5-point scale ranging from 0 (not present) to 4 (present and 
severe). (See Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom Severity in the chap- 
ter “Assessment Measures.”) 

Note: Diagnosis of substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder can be made 
without using this severity specifier. 


112 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Recording Procedures 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, dexamethasone) that is presumed to be causing 
the delusions or hallucinations. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in 
the criteria set, which is based on the drug class. For substances that do not fit into any of 
the classes (e.g., dexamethasone), the code for “other substance” should be used; and in 
cases in which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of sub- 
stance is unknown, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder is followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during in- 
toxication, onset during withdrawal). Unlike the recording procedures for ICD-10-CM, 
which combine the substance-induced disorder and substance use disorder into a single 
code, for ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is given for the substance use disorder. For 
example, in the case of delusions occurring during intoxication in a man with a severe co- 
caine use disorder, the diagnosis is 292.9 cocaine-induced psychotic disorder, with onset 
during intoxication. An additional diagnosis of 304.20 severe cocaine use disorder is also 
given. When more than one substance is judged to play a significant role in the development 
of psychotic symptoms, each should be listed separately (e.g., 292.9 cannabis-induced psy- 
chotic disorder with onset during intoxication, with severe cannabis use disorder; 292.9 
phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder, with onset during intoxication, with mild 
phencyclidine use disorder). 


ICD-10-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, dexamethasone) that is presumed to be causing 
the delusions or hallucinations. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in 
the criteria set, which is based on the drug class and presence or absence of a comorbid 
substance use disorder. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., dexa- 
methasone), the code for “other substance” with no comorbid substance use should be 
used; and in cases in which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific 
class of substance is unknown, the category “unknown substance” with no comorbid sub- 
stance use should be used. 

When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) 
is listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the substance-induced 
psychotic disorder, followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during intoxication, 
onset during withdrawal). For example, in the case of delusions occurring during intoxi- 
cation in a man with a severe cocaine use disorder, the diagnosis is F14.259 severe cocaine 
use disorder with cocaine-induced psychotic disorder, with onset during intoxication. A 
separate diagnosis of the comorbid severe cocaine use disorder is not given. If the sub- 
stance-induced psychotic disorder occurs without a comorbid substance use disorder 
(e.g., after a one-time heavy use of the substance), no accompanying substance use disor- 
der is noted (e.g., F16.959 phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder, with onset during in- 
toxication). When more than one substance is judged to play a significant role in the 
development of psychotic symptoms, each should be listed separately (e.g., F12.259 severe 
cannabis use disorder with cannabis-induced psychotic disorder, with onset during intox- 
ication; F16.159 mild phencyclidine use disorder with phencyclidine-induced psychotic 
disorder, with onset during intoxication). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder are prominent 
delusions and/or hallucinations (Criterion A) that are judged to be due to the physiolog- 
ical effects of a substance /medication (i.e., a drug of abuse, a medication, or a toxin expo- 
sure) (Criterion B). Hallucinations that the individual realizes are substance /medication- 
induced are not included here and instead would be diagnosed as substance intoxication 


Substance/Medication-Induced Psychotic Disorder 113 


or substance withdrawal with the accompanying specifier “with perceptual disturbances” 
(applies to alcohol withdrawal; cannabis intoxication; sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
withdrawal; and stimulant intoxication). 

A substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder is distinguished from a primary 
psychotic disorder by considering the onset, course, and other factors. For drugs of abuse, 
there must be evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of 
substance use, intoxication, or withdrawal. Substance/medication-induced psychotic 
disorders arise during or soon after exposure to a medication or after substance intoxica- 
tion or withdrawal but can persist for weeks, whereas primary psychotic disorders may 
precede the onset of substance /medication use or may occur during times of sustained ab- 
stinence. Once initiated, the psychotic symptoms may continue as long as the substance/ 
medication use continues. Another consideration is the presence of features that are atyp- 
ical of a primary psychotic disorder (e.g., atypical age at onset or course). For example, the 
appearance of delusions de novo in a person older than 35 years without a known history 
of a primary psychotic disorder should suggest the possibility of a substance /medication- 
induced psychotic disorder. Even a prior history of a primary psychotic disorder does not 
rule out the possibility of a substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder. In contrast, 
factors that suggest that the psychotic symptoms are better accounted for by a primary 
psychotic disorder include persistence of psychotic symptoms for a substantial period of 
time (i.e., a month or more) after the end of substance intoxication or acute substance with- 
drawal or after cessation of medication use; or a history of prior recurrent primary psy- 
chotic disorders. Other causes of psychotic symptoms must be considered even in an 
individual with substance intoxication or withdrawal, because substance use problems are 
not uncommon among individuals with non-substance/medication-induced psychotic 
disorders. 

In addition to the four symptom domain areas identified in the diagnostic criteria, the 
assessment of cognition, depression, and mania symptom domains is vital for making crit- 
ically important distinctions between the various schizophrenia spectrum and other psy- 
chotic disorders. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Psychotic disorders can occur in association with intoxication with the following classes of 
substances: alcohol; cannabis; hallucinogens, including phencyclidine and related sub- 
stances; inhalants; sedatives, hypnotics, and anxiolytics; stimulants (including cocaine); 
and other (or unknown) substances. Psychotic disorders can occur in association with with- 
drawal from the following classes of substances: alcohol; sedatives, hypnotics, and anxio- 
lytics; and other (or unknown) substances. 

Some of the medications reported to evoke psychotic symptoms include anesthetics 
and analgesics, anticholinergic agents, anticonvulsants, antihistamines, antihypertensive 
and cardiovascular medications, antimicrobial medications, antiparkinsonian medica- 
tions, chemotherapeutic agents (e.g., cyclosporine, procarbazine), corticosteroids, gastro- 
intestinal medications, muscle relaxants, nonsteroidal anti-inflammatory medications, 
other over-the-counter medications (e.g., phenylephrine, pseudoephedrine), antidepres- 
sant medication, and disulfiram. Toxins reported to induce psychotic symptoms include 
anticholinesterase, organophosphate insecticides, sarin and other nerve gases, carbon 
monoxide, carbon dioxide, and volatile substances such as fuel or paint. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence of substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder in the general popula- 
tion is unknown. Between 7% and 25% of individuals presenting with a first episode of 
psychosis in different settings are reported to have substance/medication-induced psy- 
chotic disorder. 


114 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Development and Course 


The initiation of the disorder may vary considerably with the substance. For example, 
smoking a high dose of cocaine may produce psychosis within minutes, whereas days or 
weeks of high-dose alcohol or sedative use may be required to produce psychosis. Alco- 
hol-induced psychotic disorder, with hallucinations, usually occurs only after prolonged, 
heavy ingestion of alcohol in individuals who have moderate to severe alcohol use disorder, 
and the hallucinations are generally auditory in nature. 

Psychotic disorders induced by amphetamine and cocaine share similar clinical fea- 
tures. Persecutory delusions may rapidly develop shortly after use of amphetamine or a 
similarly acting sympathomimetic. The hallucination of bugs or vermin crawling in or un- 
der the skin (formication) can lead to scratching and extensive skin excoriations. Cannabis- 
induced psychotic disorder may develop shortly after high-dose cannabis use and usually 
involves persecutory delusions, marked anxiety, emotional lability, and depersonalization. 
The disorder usually remits within a day but in some cases may persist for a few days. 

Substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder may at times persist when the offend- 
ing agent is removed, such that it may be difficult initially to distinguish it from an indepen- 
dent psychotic disorder. Agents such as amphetamines, phencyclidine, and cocaine have been 
reported to evoke temporary psychotic states that can sometimes persist for weeks or longer 
despite removal of the agent and treatment with neuroleptic medication. In later life, poly- 
pharmacy for medical conditions and exposure to medications for parkinsonism, cardiovas- 
cular disease, and other medical disorders may be associated with a greater likelihood of 
psychosis induced by prescription medications as opposed to substances of abuse. 


Diagnostic Markers 


With substances for which relevant blood levels are available (e.g., blood alcohol level, 
other quantifiable blood levels such as digoxin), the presence of a level consistent with tox- 
icity may increase diagnostic certainty. 


Functional Consequences of 
Substance/Medication-Induced Psychotic Disorder 


Substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder is typically severely disabling and 
consequently is observed most frequently in emergency rooms, as individuals are often 
brought to the acute-care setting when it occurs. However, the disability is typically self- 
limited and resolves upon removal of the offending agent. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Substance intoxication or substance withdrawal. Individuals intoxicated with stimu- 
lants, cannabis, the opioid meperidine, or phencyclidine, or those withdrawing from alco- 
hol or sedatives, may experience altered perceptions that they recognize as drug effects. If 
reality testing for these experiences remains intact (i.e., the individual recognizes that the 
perception is substance induced and neither believes in nor acts on it), the diagnosis is not 
substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder. Instead, substance intoxication or 
substance withdrawal, with perceptual disturbances, is diagnosed (e.g., cocaine intoxica- 
tion, with perceptual disturbances). “Flashback” hallucinations that can occur long after 
the use of hallucinogens has stopped are diagnosed as hallucinogen persisting perception 
disorder. If substance /medication-induced psychotic symptoms occur exclusively during 
the course of a delirium, as in severe forms of alcohol withdrawal, the psychotic symptoms 
are considered to be an associated feature of the delirium and are not diagnosed sepa- 
rately. Delusions in the context of a major or mild neurocognitive disorder would be di- 
agnosed as major or mild neurocognitive disorder, with behavioral disturbance. 


Psychotic Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 115 


Primary psychotic disorder. A substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder is 
distinguished from a primary psychotic disorder, such as schizophrenia, schizoaffective 
disorder, delusional disorder, brief psychotic disorder, other specified schizophrenia 
spectrum and other psychotic disorder, or unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other 
psychotic disorder, by the fact that a substance is judged to be etiologically related to the 
symptoms. 


Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition. A substance/medication-induced 
psychotic disorder due to a prescribed treatment for a mental or medical condition must 
have its onset while the individual is receiving the medication (or during withdrawal, if 
there is a withdrawal syndrome associated with the medication). Because individuals with 
medical conditions often take medications for those conditions, the clinician must con- 
sider the possibility that the psychotic symptoms are caused by the physiological conse- 
quences of the medical condition rather than the medication, in which case psychotic 
disorder due to another medical condition is diagnosed. The history often provides the 
primary basis for such a judgment. At times, a change in the treatment for the medical con- 
dition (e.g., medication substitution or discontinuation) may be needed to determine em- 
pirically for that individual whether the medication is the causative agent. If the clinician 
has ascertained that the disturbance is attributable to both a medical condition and sub- 
stance/medication use, both diagnoses (i.e., psychotic disorder due to another medical 
condition and substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder) may be given. 


Psychotic Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Prominent hallucinations or delusions. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the 
disturbance is the direct pathophysiological consequence of another medical condi- 
tion. 

C. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder. 

D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 

E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


Specify whether: 
Code based on predominant symptom: 
293.81 (F06.2) With delusions: If delusions are the predominant symptom. 
293.82 (F06.0) With hallucinations: If hallucinations are the predominant symptom. 


Coding note: Include the name of the other medical condition in the name of the mental 
disorder (e.g., 293.81 [FO6.2] psychotic disorder due to malignant lung neoplasm, with de- 
lusions). The other medical condition should be coded and listed separately immediately 
before the psychotic disorder due to the medical condition (e.g., 162.9 [C34.90] malignant 
lung neoplasm; 293.81 [F06.2] psychotic disorder due to malignant lung neoplasm, with 
delusions). 


Specify current severity: 
Severity is rated by a quantitative assessment of the primary symptoms of psychosis, 
including delusions, hallucinations, abnormal psychomotor behavior, and negative 
symptoms. Each of these symptoms may be rated for its current severity (most severe 
in the last 7 days) on a 5-point scale ranging from 0 (not present) to 4 (present and 


116 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


severe). (See Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom Severity in the chap- 
ter “Assessment Measures.”) 

Note: Diagnosis of psychotic disorder due to another medical condition can be made 
without using this severity specifier. 


Specifiers 

In addition to the symptom domain areas identified in the diagnostic criteria, the assess- 
ment of cognition, depression, and mania symptom domains is vital for making critically 
important distinctions between the various schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic 
disorders. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of psychotic disorder due to another medical condition are promi- 
nent delusions or hallucinations that are judged to be attributable to the physiological ef- 
fects of another medical condition and are not better explained by another mental disorder 
(e.g., the symptoms are not a psychologically mediated response to a severe medical con- 
dition, in which case a diagnosis of brief psychotic disorder, with marked stressor, would 
be appropriate). 

Hallucinations can occur in any sensory modality (i.e., visual, olfactory, gustatory, tac- 
tile, or auditory), but certain etiological factors are likely to evoke specific hallucinatory 
phenomena. Olfactory hallucinations are suggestive of temporal lobe epilepsy. Hallucina- 
tions may vary from simple and unformed to highly complex and organized, depending 
on etiological and environmental factors. Psychotic disorder due to another medical con- 
dition is generally not diagnosed if the individual maintains reality testing for the hallu- 
cinations and appreciates that they result from the medical condition. Delusions may have 
a variety of themes, including somatic, grandiose, religious, and, most commonly, perse- 
cutory. On the whole, however, associations between delusions and particular medical 
conditions appear to be less specific than is the case for hallucinations. 

In determining whether the psychotic disturbance is attributable to another medical 
condition, the presence of a medical condition must be identified and considered to be the 
etiology of the psychosis through a physiological mechanism. Although there are no 
infallible guidelines for determining whether the relationship between the psychotic distur- 
bance and the medical condition is etiological, several considerations provide some guidance. 
One consideration is the presence of a temporal association between the onset, exacerba- 
tion, or remission of the medical condition and that of the psychotic disturbance. A second 
consideration is the presence of features that are atypical for a psychotic disorder (e.g., 
atypical age at onset or presence of visual or olfactory hallucinations). The disturbance must 
also be distinguished from a substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder or an- 
other mental disorder (e.g., an adjustment disorder). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The temporal association of the onset or exacerbation of the medical condition offers the 
greatest diagnostic certainty that the delusions or hallucinations are attributable to a med- 
ical condition. Additional factors may include concomitant treatments for the underlying 
medical condition that confer a risk for psychosis independently, such as steroid treatment 
for autoimmune disorders. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence rates for psychotic disorder due to another medical condition are difficult to es- 
timate given the wide variety of underlying medical etiologies. Lifetime prevalence has 


Psychotic Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 117 


been estimated to range from 0.21% to 0.54%. When the prevalence findings are stratified 
by age group, individuals older than 65 years have a significantly greater prevalence of 
0.74% compared with those in younger age groups. Rates of psychosis also vary according 
to the underlying medical condition; conditions most commonly associated with psy- 
chosis include untreated endocrine and metabolic disorders, autoimmune disorders (e.g., 
systemic lupus erythematosus, N-methyl-D-aspartate (NMDA) receptor autoimmune en- 
cephalitis), or temporal lobe epilepsy. Psychosis due to epilepsy has been further differ- 
entiated into ictal, postictal, and interictal psychosis. The most common of these is postictal 
psychosis, observed in 2%-7.8% of epilepsy patients. Among older individuals, there may 
be a higher prevalence of the disorder in females, although additional gender-related fea- 
tures are not clear and vary considerably with the gender distributions of the underlying 
medical conditions. 


Development and Course 


Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition may be a single transient state or it 
may be recurrent, cycling with exacerbations and remissions of the underlying medical 
condition. Although treatment of the underlying medical condition often results in a res- 
olution of the psychosis, this is not always the case, and psychotic symptoms may persist 
long after the medical event (e.g., psychotic disorder due to focal brain injury). In the con- 
text of chronic conditions such as multiple sclerosis or chronic interictal psychosis of epi- 
lepsy, the psychosis may assume a long-term course. 

The expression of psychotic disorder due to another medical condition does not differ 
substantially in phenomenology depending on age at occurrence. However, older age 
groups have a higher prevalence of the disorder, which is most likely due to the increasing 
medical burden associated with advanced age and the cumulative effects of deleterious 
exposures and age-related processes (e.g., atherosclerosis). The nature of the underlying 
medical conditions is likely to change across the lifespan, with younger age groups more 
affected by epilepsy, head trauma, autoimmune, and neoplastic diseases of early to mid- 
life, and older age groups more affected by stroke disease, anoxic events, and multiple sys- 
tem comorbidities. Underlying factors with increasing age, such as preexisting cognitive 
impairment as well as vision and hearing impairments, may incur a greater risk for psy- 
chosis, possibly by serving to lower the threshold for experiencing psychosis. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Course modifiers. Identification and treatment of the underlying medical condition has 
the greatest impact on course, although preexisting central nervous system injury may 
confer a worse course outcome (e.g., head trauma, cerebrovascular disease). 


Diagnostic Markers 


The diagnosis of psychotic disorder due to another medical condition depends on the clin- 
ical condition of each individual, and the diagnostic tests will vary according to that con- 
dition. A variety of medical conditions may cause psychotic symptoms. These include 
neurological conditions (e.g., neoplasms, cerebrovascular disease, Huntington's disease, 
multiple sclerosis, epilepsy, auditory or visual nerve injury or impairment, deafness, 
migraine, central nervous system infections), endocrine conditions (e.g., hyper- and hypo- 
thyroidism, hyper- and hypoparathyroidism, hyper- and hypoadrenocorticism), metabolic 
conditions (e.g., hypoxia, hypercarbia, hypoglycemia), fluid or electrolyte imbalances, 
hepatic or renal diseases, and autoimmune disorders with central nervous system involve- 
ment (e.g., systemic lupus erythematosus). The associated physical examination findings, 
laboratory findings, and patterns of prevalence or onset reflect the etiological medical 
condition. 


118 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Suicide Risk 


Suicide risk in the context of psychotic disorder due to another medical condition is not 
clearly delineated, although certain conditions such as epilepsy and multiple sclerosis are 
associated with increased rates of suicide, which may be further increased in the presence 
of psychosis. 


Functional Consequences of Psychotic Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


Functional disability is typically severe in the context of psychotic disorder due to another 
medical condition but will vary considerably by the type of condition and likely improve 
with successful resolution of the condition. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Delirium. Hallucinations and delusions commonly occur in the context of a delirium; 
however, a separate diagnosis of psychotic disorder due to another medical condition is 
not given if the disturbance occurs exclusively during the course of a delirium. Delusions 
in the context of a major or mild neurocognitive disorder would be diagnosed as major or 
mild neurocognitive disorder, with behavioral disturbance. 


Substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder. If there is evidence of recent or 
prolonged substance use (including medications with psychoactive effects), withdrawal 
from a substance, or exposure to a toxin (e.g., LSD [lysergic acid diethylamide] intoxica- 
tion, alcohol withdrawal), a substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder should be 
considered. Symptoms that occur during or shortly after (i.e., within 4 weeks) of substance 
intoxication or withdrawal or after medication use may be especially indicative of a sub- 
stance-induced psychotic disorder, depending on the character, duration, or amount of 
the substance used. If the clinician has ascertained that the disturbance is due to both a 
medical condition and substance use, both diagnoses (i.e., psychotic disorder due to an- 
other medical condition and substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder) can be 
given. 


Psychotic disorder. Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition must be distin- 
guished from a psychotic disorder (e.g., schizophrenia, delusional disorder, schizoaffective 
disorder) or a depressive or bipolar disorder, with psychotic features. In psychotic disor- 
ders and in depressive or bipolar disorders, with psychotic features, no specific and direct 
causative physiological mechanisms associated with a medical condition can be demon- 
strated. Late age at onset and the absence of a personal or family history of schizophrenia 
or delusional disorder suggest the need for a thorough assessment to rule out the diagno- 
sis of psychotic disorder due to another medical condition. Auditory hallucinations that 
involve voices speaking complex sentences are more characteristic of schizophrenia than 
of psychotic disorder due to a medical condition. Other types of hallucinations (e.g., vi- 
sual, olfactory) commonly signal a psychotic disorder due to another medical condition or 
a substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder. 


Comorbidity 


Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition in individuals older than 80 years is 
associated with concurrent major neurocognitive disorder (dementia). 


Catatonia Associated With Another Mental Disorder (Catatonia Specifier) 119 


Catatonia 


Catatonia can occur in the context of several disorders, including neurodevelopmental, 
psychotic, bipolar, depressive disorders, and other medical conditions (e.g., cerebral folate 
deficiency, rare autoimmune and paraneoplastic disorders. The manual does not treat 
catatonia as an independent class but recognizes a) catatonia associated with another men- 
tal disorder (i-e., a neurodevelopmental, psychotic disorder, a bipolar disorder, a depres- 
sive disorder, or other mental disorder), b) catatonic disorder due to another medical 
condition, and c) unspecified catatonia. 

Catatonia is defined by the presence of three or more of 12 psychomotor features in the 
diagnostic criteria for catatonia associated with another mental disorder and catatonic dis- 
order due to another medical condition. The essential feature of catatonia is a marked psy- 
chomotor disturbance that may involve decreased motor activity, decreased engagement 
during interview or physical examination, or excessive and peculiar motor activity. The 
clinical presentation of catatonia can be puzzling, as the psychomotor disturbance may 
range from marked unresponsiveness to marked agitation. Motoric immobility may be se- 
vere (stupor) or moderate (catalepsy and waxy flexibility). Similarly, decreased engage- 
ment may be severe (mutism) or moderate (negativism). Excessive and peculiar motor 
behaviors can be complex (e.g., stereotypy) or simple (agitation) and may include echola- 
lia and echopraxia. In extreme cases, the same individual may wax and wane between de- 
creased and excessive motor activity. The seemingly opposing clinical features and 
variable manifestations of the diagnosis contribute to a lack of awareness and decreased 
recognition of catatonia. During severe stages of catatonia, the individual may need care- 
ful supervision to avoid self-harm or harming others. There are potential risks from mal- 
nutrition, exhaustion, hyperpyrexia and self-inflicted injury. 


Catatonia Associated With Another 
Mental Disorder (Catatonia Specifier) 


293.89 (FOG. 1) 


A. The clinical picture is dominated by three (or more) of the following symptoms: 


1. Stupor (i.e., no psychomotor activity; not actively relating to environment). 
2. Catalepsy (i.e., passive induction of a posture held against gravity). 
3. Waxy flexibility (i.e., slight, even resistance to positioning by examiner). 
4. Mutism (i.e., no, or very little, verbal response [exclude if known aphasia]). 
5. Negativism (i.e., opposition or no response to instructions or external stimuli). 
6. Posturing (i.e., spontaneous and active maintenance of a posture against gravity). 
7. Mannerism (i.e., odd, circumstantial caricature of normal actions). 
8. Stereotypy (i.e., repetitive, abnormally frequent, non-goal-directed movements). 
9. Agitation, not influenced by external stimuli. 
10. Grimacing. 
11. Echolalia (i.e., mimicking another's speech). 
12. Echopraxia (i.e., mimicking another’s movements). 
Coding note: Indicate the name of the associated mental disorder when recording the 
name of the condition (i.e., 293.89 [FO6.1] catatonia associated with major depressive dis- 
order). Code first the associated mental disorder (e.g., neurodevelopmental disorder, brief 


120 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


psychotic disorder, schizophreniform disorder, schizophrenia, schizoaffective disorder, 
bipolar disorder, major depressive disorder, or other mental disorder) (e.g., 295.70 [F25.1] 
schizoaffective disorder, depressive type; 293.89 [FO6.1] catatonia associated with 
schizoaffective disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 

Catatonia associated with another mental disorder (catatonia specifier) may be used when 
criteria are met for catatonia during the course of a neurodevelopmental, psychotic, bipo- 
lar, depressive, or other mental disorder. The catatonia specifier is appropriate when the 
clinical picture is characterized by marked psychomotor disturbance and involves at least 
three of the 12 diagnostic features listed in Criterion A. Catatonia is typically diagnosed in 
an inpatient setting and occurs in up to 35% of individuals with schizophrenia, but the ma- 
jority of catatonia cases involve individuals with depressive or bipolar disorders. Before 
the catatonia specifier is used in neurodevelopmental, psychotic, bipolar, depressive, or 
other mental disorders, a wide variety of other medical conditions need to be ruled out; 
these conditions include, but are not limited to, medical conditions due to infectious, met- 
abolic, or neurological conditions (see “Catatonic Disorder Due to Another Medical Con- 
dition”). Catatonia can also be a side effect of a medication (see the chapter “Medication- 
Induced Movement Disorders and Other Adverse Effects of Medication”). Because of the 
seriousness of the complications, particular attention should be paid to the possibility that 
the catatonia is attributable to 333.92 (G21.0) neuroleptic malignant syndrome. 


Catatonic Disorder Due to 
Another Medical Condition 


Diagnostic Criteria 293.89 (FO6.1) 


A. The clinical picture is dominated by three (or more) of the following symptoms: 


1. Stupor (i.e., no psychomotor activity; not actively relating to environment). 
2. Catalepsy (i.e., passive induction of a posture held against gravity). 
3. Waxy flexibility (i.e., slight, even resistance to positioning by examiner). 
4. Mutism (i.e., no, or very little, verbal response [Note: not applicable if there is an 
established aphasia). 
5. Negativism (i.e., opposition or no response to instructions or external stimuli). 
6. Posturing (i.e., spontaneous and active maintenance of a posture against gravity). 
7. Mannerism (i.e., odd, circumstantial caricature of normal actions). 
8. Stereotypy (i.e., repetitive, abnormally frequent, non-goal-directed movements). 
9. Agitation, not influenced by external stimuli. 
10. Grimacing. 
11. Echolalia (i.e., mimicking another's speech). 
12. Echopraxia (i.e., mimicking another’s movements). 
B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the 
disturbance is the direct pathophysiological consequence of another medical condition. 
C. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder (e.g., a manic episode). 
. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


is) 


Unspecified Catatonia 121 


Coding note: Include the name of the medical condition in the name of the mental disor- 
der (e.g., 293.89 [FO6.1]) catatonic disorder due to hepatic encephalopathy). The other 
medical condition should be coded and listed separately immediately before the cata- 
tonic disorder due to the medical condition (e.g., 572.2 [K71.90] hepatic encephalopathy; 
293.89 [F06.1] catatonic disorder due to hepatic encephalopathy). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of catatonic disorder due to another medical condition is the presence 
of catatonia that is judged to be attributed to the physiological effects of another medical 
condition. Catatonia can be diagnosed by the presence of at least three of the 12 clinical fea- 
tures in Criterion A. There must be evidence from the history, physical examination, or 
laboratory findings that the catatonia is attributable to another medical condition (Crite- 
rion B). The diagnosis is not given if the catatonia is better explained by another mental 
disorder (e.g., manic episode) (Criterion C) or if it occurs exclusively during the course of 
a delirium (Criterion D). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A variety of medical conditions may cause catatonia, especially neurological conditions 
(e.g., neoplasms, head trauma, cerebrovascular disease, encephalitis) and metabolic con- 
ditions (e.g., hypercalcemia, hepatic encephalopathy, homocystinuria, diabetic ketoacido- 
sis). The associated physical examination findings, laboratory findings, and patterns of 
prevalence and onset reflect those of the etiological medical condition. 


Differential Diagnosis 


A separate diagnosis of catatonic disorder due to another medical condition is not given if 
the catatonia occurs exclusively during the course of a delirium or neuroleptic malignant 
syndrome. If the individual is currently taking neuroleptic medication, consideration 
should be given to medication-induced movement disorders (e.g., abnormal positioning 
may be due to neuroleptic-induced acute dystonia) or neuroleptic malignant syndrome 
(e.g., catatonic-like features may be present, along with associated vital sign and/or labo- 
ratory abnormalities). Catatonic symptoms may be present in any of the following five 
psychotic disorders: brief psychotic disorder, schizophreniform disorder, schizophrenia, 
schizoaffective disorder, and substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder. It may 
also be present in some of the neurodevelopmental disorders, in all of the bipolar and de- 
pressive disorders, and in other mental disorders. 


Unspecified Catatonia 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of catatonia 
cause Clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other impor- 
tant areas of functioning but either the nature of the underlying mental disorder or other 
medical condition is unclear, full criteria for catatonia are not met, or there is insufficient 
information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Coding note: Code first 781.99 (R29.818) other symptoms involving nervous and muscu- 
loskeletal systems, followed by 293.89 (F06.1) unspecified catatonia. 


122 Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Other Specified Schizophrenia Spectrum and 
Other Psychotic Disorder 


298.8 (F28) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a schizophre- 
nia spectrum and other psychotic disorder that cause clinically significant distress or im- 
pairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but 
do not meet the full criteria for any of the disorders in the schizophrenia spectrum and other 
psychotic disorders diagnostic class. The other specified schizophrenia spectrum and oth- 
er psychotic disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to com- 
municate the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any 
specific schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder. This is done by recording “oth- 
er specified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder” followed by the specific 
reason (e.g., “persistent auditory hallucinations”). 

Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 

1. Persistent auditory hallucinations occurring in the absence of any other features. 

2. Delusions with significant overlapping mood episodes: This includes persistent 
delusions with periods of overlapping mood episodes that are present for a substantial 
portion of the delusional disturbance (such that the criterion stipulating only brief mood 
disturbance in delusional disorder is not met). 

3. Attenuated psychosis syndrome: This syndrome is characterized by psychotic-like 
symptoms that are below a threshold for full psychosis (e.g., the symptoms are less 
severe and more transient, and insight is relatively maintained). 

4. Delusional symptoms in partner of individual with delusional disorder: In the 
context of a relationship, the delusional material from the dominant partner provides 
content for delusional belief by the individual who may not otherwise entirely meet cri- 
teria for delusional disorder. 


Unspecified Schizophrenia Spectrum and 
Other Psychotic Disorder 


298.9 (F29) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a schizophre- 
nia spectrum and other psychotic disorder that cause clinically significant distress or im- 
pairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but 
do not meet the full criteria for any of the disorders in the schizophrenia spectrum and oth- 
er psychotic disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and oth- 
er psychotic disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to 
specify the reason that the criteria are not met for a specific schizophrenia spectrum and 
other psychotic disorder, and includes presentations in which there is insufficient informa- 
tion to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Bipolar and 
Related Disorders 


Bi polar and related disorders are separated from the depressive disorders in 
DSM-5 and placed between the chapters on schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic 
disorders and depressive disorders in recognition of their place as a bridge between the 
two diagnostic classes in terms of symptomatology, family history, and genetics. The di- 
agnoses included in this chapter are bipolar I disorder, bipolar II disorder, cyclothymic 
disorder, substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disorder, bipolar and relat- 
ed disorder due to another medical condition, other specified bipolar and related disor- 
der, and unspecified bipolar and related disorder. 

The bipolar I disorder criteria represent the modern understanding of the classic 
manic-depressive disorder or affective psychosis described in the nineteenth century, dif- 
fering from that classic description only to the extent that neither psychosis nor the lifetime 
experience of a major depressive episode is a requirement. However, the vast majority of 
individuals whose symptoms meet the criteria for a fully syndromal manic episode also 
experience major depressive episodes during the course of their lives. 

Bipolar II disorder, requiring the lifetime experience of at least one episode of major de- 
pression and at least one hypomanic episode, is no longer thought to be a “milder” condition 
than bipolar I disorder, largely because of the amount of time individuals with this con- 
dition spend in depression and because the instability of mood experienced by individuals 
with bipolar II disorder is typically accompanied by serious impairment in work and social 
functioning. 

The diagnosis of cyclothymic disorder is given to adults who experience at least 2 years 
(for children, a full year) of both hypomanic and depressive periods without ever fulfilling 
the criteria for an episode of mania, hypomania, or major depression. 

A large number of substances of abuse, some prescribed medications, and several 
medical conditions can be associated with manic-like phenomena. This fact is recognized 
in the diagnoses of substance /medication-induced bipolar and related disorder and bipo- 
lar and related disorder due to another medical condition. 

The recognition that many individuals, particularly children and, to a lesser extent, ad- 
olescents, experience bipolar-like phenomena that do not meet the criteria for bipolar I, bi- 
polar II, or cyclothymic disorder is reflected in the availability of the other specified 
bipolar and related disorder category. Indeed, specific criteria for a disorder involving 
short-duration hypomania are provided in Section III in the hope of encouraging further 
study of this disorder. 


Bipolar | Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 


For a diagnosis of bipolar | disorder, it is necessary to meet the following criteria for a manic 
episode. The manic episode may have been preceded by and may be followed by hypo- 
manic or major depressive episodes. 


123 


124 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Manic Episode 

A. A distinct period of abnormally and persistently elevated, expansive, or irritable mood 
and abnormally and persistently increased goal-directed activity or energy, lasting at 
least 1 week and present most of the day, nearly every day (or any duration if hospi- 
talization is necessary). 

B. During the period of mood disturbance and increased energy or activity, three (or 
more) of the following symptoms (four if the mood is only irritable) are present to a sig- 
nificant degree and represent a noticeable change from usual behavior: 


Inflated self-esteem or grandiosity. 

Decreased need for sleep (e.g., feels rested after only 3 hours of sleep). 

More talkative than usual or pressure to keep talking. 

Flight of ideas or subjective experience that thoughts are racing. 

Distractibility (i.e., attention too easily drawn to unimportant or irrelevant external 

stimuli), as reported or observed. 

6. Increase in goal-directed activity (either socially, at work or school, or sexually) or 
psychomotor agitation (i.e., purposeless non-goal-directed activity). 

7. Excessive involvement in activities that have a high potential for painful conse- 

quences (e.g., engaging in unrestrained buying sprees, sexual indiscretions, or 

foolish business investments). 


SIP Nuc 


C. The mood disturbance is sufficiently severe to cause marked impairment in social or 
occupational functioning or to necessitate hospitalization to prevent harm to self or oth- 
ers, or there are psychotic features. 

D. The episode is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug 

of abuse, a medication, other treatment) or to another medical condition. 
Note: A full manic episode that emerges during antidepressant treatment (e.g., medi- 
cation, electroconvulsive therapy) but persists at a fully syndromal level beyond the 
physiological effect of that treatment is sufficient evidence for a manic episode and, 
therefore, a bipolar | diagnosis. 

Note: Criteria A-D constitute a manic episode. At least one lifetime manic episode is re- 

quired for the diagnosis of bipolar | disorder. 


Hypomanic Episode 

A. A distinct period of abnormally and persistently elevated, expansive, or irritable mood 
and abnormally and persistently increased activity or energy, lasting at least 4 consec- 
utive days and present most of the day, nearly every day. 

B. During the period of mood disturbance and increased energy and activity, three (or 
more) of the following symptoms (four if the mood is only irritable) have persisted, rep- 
resent a noticeable change from usual behavior, and have been present to a significant 
degree: 


1. Inflated self-esteem or grandiosity. 

2. Decreased need for sleep (e.g., feels rested after only 3 hours of sleep). 

3. More talkative than usual or pressure to keep talking. 

4. Flight of ideas or subjective experience that thoughts are racing. 

5. Distractibility (i.e., attention too easily drawn to unimportant or irrelevant external 
stimuli), as reported or observed. 

6. Increase in goal-directed activity (either socially, at work or school, or sexually) or 
psychomotor agitation. 

7. Excessive involvement in activities that have a high potential for painful conse- 
quences (e.g., engaging in unrestrained buying sprees, sexual indiscretions, or 
foolish business investments). 


Bipolar | Disorder 125 


The episode is associated with an unequivocal change in functioning that is uncharac- 
teristic of the individual when not symptomatic. 

The disturbance in mood and the change in functioning are observable by others. 
The episode is not severe enough to cause marked impairment in social or occupa- 
tional functioning or to necessitate hospitalization. If there are psychotic features, the 
episode is, by definition, manic. 

The episode is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug 
of abuse, a medication, other treatment). 

Note: A full hypomanic episode that emerges during antidepressant treatment (e.g., 
medication, electroconvulsive therapy) but persists at a fully syndromal level beyond 
the physiological effect of that treatment is sufficient evidence for a hypomanic episode 
diagnosis. However, caution is indicated so that one or two symptoms (particularly in- 
creased irritability, edginess, or agitation following antidepressant use) are not taken 
as sufficient for diagnosis of a hypomanic episode, nor necessarily indicative of a bi- 
polar diathesis. 


Note: Criteria A-F constitute a hypomanic episode. Hypomanic episodes are common in 
bipolar | disorder but are not required for the diagnosis of bipolar | disorder. 


Major Depressive Episode 


A. 


B. 


C. 


Five (or more) of the following symptoms have been present during the same 2-week 
period and represent a change from previous functioning; at least one of the symptoms 
is either (1) depressed mood or (2) loss of interest or pleasure. 

Note: Do not include symptoms that are clearly attributable to another medical condi- 
tion. 


1. Depressed mood most of the day, nearly every day, as indicated by either subjec- 
tive report (e.g., feels sad, empty, or hopeless) or observation made by others (e.g., 
appears tearful). (Note: In children and adolescents, can be irritable mood.) 

2. Markedly diminished interest or pleasure in all, or almost all, activities most of the 
day, nearly every day (as indicated by either subjective account or observation). 

3. Significant weight loss when not dieting or weight gain (e.g., a change of more than 
5% of body weight in a month), or decrease or increase in appetite nearly every 
day. (Note: In children, consider failure to make expected weight gain.) 

4. Insomnia or hypersomnia nearly every day. 

5. Psychomotor agitation or retardation nearly every day (observable by others; not 
merely subjective feelings of restlessness or being slowed down). 

6. Fatigue or loss of energy nearly every day. 

7. Feelings of worthlessness or excessive or inappropriate guilt (which may be delu- 
sional) nearly every day (not merely self-reproach or guilt about being sick). 

8. Diminished ability to think or concentrate, or indecisiveness, nearly every day (ei- 
ther by subjective account or as observed by others). 

9. Recurrent thoughts of death (not just fear of dying), recurrent suicidal ideation with- 
out a specific plan, or a suicide attempt or a specific plan for committing suicide. 

The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 

tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


The episode is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance or another 
medical condition. 


Note: Criteria A-C constitute a major depressive episode. Major depressive episodes are 
common in bipolar | disorder but are not required for the diagnosis of bipolar | disorder. 

Note: Responses to a significant loss (e.g., bereavement, financial ruin, losses from a 
natural disaster, a serious medical illness or disability) may include the feelings of intense 


126 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


sadness, rumination about the loss, insomnia, poor appetite, and weight loss noted in Cri- 
terion A, which may resemble a depressive episode. Although such symptoms may be un- 
derstandable or considered appropriate to the loss, the presence of a major depressive 
episode in addition to the normal response to a significant loss should also be carefully 
considered. This decision inevitably requires the exercise of clinical judgment based on 
the inalvialials history and the cultural norms for the expression of distress in the context 
of loss. 


Bipolar | Disorder 

A. Criteria have been met for at least one manic episode (Criteria A-D under “Manic Ep- 
isode” above). 

B. The occurrence of the manic and major depressive episode(s) is not better explained 
by schizoaffective disorder, schizophrenia, schizophreniform disorder, delusional dis- 
order, or other specified or unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic 
disorder. 


Coding and Recording Procedures 

The diagnostic code for bipolar | disorder is based on type of current or most recent epi- 
sode and its status with respect to current severity, presence of psychotic features, and 
remission status. Current severity and psychotic features are only indicated if full criteria 
are currently met for a manic or major depressive episode. Remission specifiers are only 
indicated if the full criteria are not currently met for a manic, hypomanic, or major depres- 
sive episode. Codes are as follows: 


Current or Current or Current or Current or 
most recent most recent most recent most recent 
episode episode episode episode 
Bipolar | disorder manic hypomanic* depressed unspecified** 
Mild (p. 154) 296.41 NA 296.51 NA 
(F31.11) (F31.31) 
Moderate (p. 154) 296.42 NA 296.52 NA 
(F31.12) (F31.32) 
Severe (p. 154) 296.43 NA 296.53 NA 
(F31.13) (F31.4) 


lIn distinguishing grief from a major depressive episode (MDE), it is useful to consider that in 
grief the predominant affect is feelings of emptiness and loss, while in MDE it is persistent 
depressed mood and the inability to anticipate happiness or pleasure. The dysphoria in grief is 
likely to decrease in intensity over days to weeks and occurs in waves, the so-called pangs of 
grief. These waves tend to be associated with thoughts or reminders of the deceased. The 
depressed mood of a MDE is more persistent and not tied to specific thoughts or preoccupations. 
The pain of grief may be accompanied by positive emotions and humor that are uncharacteristic 
of the pervasive unhappiness and misery characteristic of a major depressive episode. The 
thought content associated with grief generally features a preoccupation with thoughts and 
memories of the deceased, rather than the self-critical or pessimistic ruminations seen in a MDE. 
In grief, self-esteem is generally preserved, whereas in a MDE, feelings of worthlessness and self- 
loathing are common. If self-derogatory ideation is present in grief, it typically involves per- 
ceived failings vis-a-vis the deceased (e.g., not visiting frequently enough, not telling the 
deceased how much he or she was loved). If a bereaved individual thinks about death and dying, 
such thoughts are generally focused on the deceased and possibly about “joining” the deceased, 
whereas in a major depressive episode such thoughts are focused on ending one’s own life 
because of feeling worthless, undeserving of life, or unable to cope with the pain of depression. 


Bipolar | Disorder 


127 


Current or Current or Current or Current or 
most recent most recent most recent most recent 
episode episode episode episode 
Bipolar | disorder manic hypomanic* depressed unspecified** 
With psychotic 296.44 NA 296.54 NA 
features*** (F31.2) (F31.5) 
(p. 152) 
In partial 296.45 296.45 296.55 NA 
remission (p. 154) (F31.73) (F31.71) (F31.75) 
In full remission 296.46 296.46 296.56 NA 
(p. 154) (F31.74) (F31.72) (F31.76) 
Unspecified 296.40 296.40 296.50 NA 
(F31.9) (F31.9) (F31.9) 


‘Severity and psychotic specifiers do not apply; code 296.40 (F31.0) for cases not in remission. 
Severity, psychotic, and remission specifiers do not apply. Code 296.7 (F31.9). 

“Tf psychotic features are present, code the “with psychotic features” specifier irrespective of epi- 
sode severity. 
In recording the name of a diagnosis, terms should be listed in the following order: bipolar 
| disorder, type of current or most recent episode, severity/psychotic/remission specifiers, 
followed by as many specifiers without codes as apply to the current or most recent epi- 
sode. 
Specify: 

With anxious distress (p. 149) 

With mixed features (pp. 149-150) 

With rapid cycling (pp. 150-151) 

With melancholic features (p. 151) 

With atypical features (pp. 151-152) 

With mood-congruent psychotic features (p. 152) 

With mood-incongruent psychotic features (p. 152) 

With catatonia (p. 152). Coding note: Use additional code 293.89 (F06.1). 

With peripartum onset (pp. 152-153) 

With seasonal pattern (pp. 153-154) 


Diagnostic Features 

The essential feature of a manic episode is a distinct period during which there is an ab- 
normally, persistently elevated, expansive, or irritable mood and persistently increased 
activity or energy that is present for most of the day, nearly every day, for a period of at 
least 1 week (or any duration if hospitalization is necessary), accompanied by at least three 
additional symptoms from Criterion B. If the mood is irritable rather than elevated or ex- 
pansive, at least four Criterion B symptoms must be present. 

Mood in a manic episode is often described as euphoric, excessively cheerful, high, or 
“feeling on top of the world.” In some cases, the mood is of such a highly infectious quality 
that it is easily recognized as excessive and may be characterized by unlimited and hap- 
hazard enthusiasm for interpersonal, sexual, or occupational interactions. For example, 
the individual may spontaneously start extensive conversations with strangers in public. 
Often the predominant mood is irritable rather than elevated, particularly when the indi- 
vidual’s wishes are denied or if the individual has been using substances. Rapid shifts in 
mood over brief periods of time may occur and are referred to as lability (ie., the alterna- 


128 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


tion among euphoria, dysphoria, and irritability). In children, happiness, silliness and 
“goofiness” are normal in the context of special occasions; however, if these symptoms are 
recurrent, inappropriate to the context, and beyond what is expected for the developmen- 
tal level of the child, they may meet Criterion A. If the happiness is unusual for a child (i.e., 
distinct from baseline), and the mood change occurs at the same time as symptoms that 
meet Criterion B for mania, diagnostic certainty is increased; however, the mood change 
must be accompanied by persistently increased activity or energy levels that are obvious 
to those who know the child well. 

During the manic episode, the individual may engage in multiple overlapping new 
projects. The projects are often initiated with little knowledge of the topic, and nothing seems 
out of the individual’s reach. The increased activity levels may manifest at unusual hours of 
the day. 

Inflated self-esteem is typically present, ranging from uncritical self-confidence to marked 
grandiosity, and may reach delusional proportions (Criterion B1). Despite lack of any partic- 
ular experience or talent, the individual may embark on complex tasks such as writing a novel 
or seeking publicity for some impractical invention. Grandiose delusions (e.g., of having a 
special relationship to a famous person) are common. In children, overestimation of abilities 
and belief that, for example, they are the best at a sport or the smartest in the class is normal; 
however, when such beliefs are present despite clear evidence to the contrary or the child at- 
tempts feats that are clearly dangerous and, most important, represent a change from the 
child’s normal behavior, the grandiosity criterion should be considered satisfied. 

One of the most common features is a decreased need for sleep (Criterion B2) and is 
distinct from insomnia in which the individual wants to sleep or feels the need to sleep but 
is unable. The individual may sleep little, if at all, or may awaken several hours earlier than 
usual, feeling rested and full of energy. When the sleep disturbance is severe, the individ- 
ual may go for days without sleep, yet not feel tired. Often a decreased need for sleep her- 
alds the onset of a manic episode. 

Speech can be rapid, pressured, loud, and difficult to interrupt (Criterion B3). Individ- 
uals may talk continuously and without regard for others’ wishes to communicate, often 
in an intrusive manner or without concern for the relevance of what is said. Speech is 
sometimes characterized by jokes, puns, amusing irrelevancies, and theatricality, with 
dramatic mannerisms, singing, and excessive gesturing. Loudness and forcefulness of 
speech often become more important than what is conveyed. If the individual’s mood is 
more irritable than expansive, speech may be marked by complaints, hostile comments, or 
angry tirades, particularly if attempts are made to interrupt the individual. Both Criterion 
A and Criterion B symptoms may be accompanied by symptoms of the opposite (i.e., de- 
pressive) pole (see “with mixed features” specifier, pp. 149-150). 

Often the individual’s thoughts race at a rate faster than they can be expressed through 
speech (Criterion B4). Frequently there is flight of ideas evidenced by a nearly continuous flow 
of accelerated speech, with abrupt shifts from one topic to another. When flight of ideas is se- 
vere, speech may become disorganized, incoherent, and particularly distressful to the individ- 
ual. Sometimes thoughts are experienced as so crowded that it is very difficult to speak. 

Distractibility (Criterion B5) is evidenced by an inability to censor immaterial external 
stimuli (e.g., the interviewer’s attire, background noises or conversations, furnishings in 
the room) and often prevents individuals experiencing mania from holding a rational con- 
versation or attending to instructions. 

The increase in goal-directed activity often consists of excessive planning and partici- 
pation in multiple activities, including sexual, occupational, political, or religious activi- 
ties. Increased sexual drive, fantasies, and behavior are often present. Individuals in a manic 
episode usually show increased sociability (e.g., renewing old acquaintances or calling or 
contacting friends or even strangers), without regard to the intrusive, domineering, and 
demanding nature of these interactions. They often display psychomotor agitation or rest- 
lessness (i.e., purposeless activity) by pacing or by holding multiple conversations simulta- 


Bipolar | Disorder 129 


neously. Some individuals write excessive letters, e-mails, text messages, and so forth, on 
many different topics to friends, public figures, or the media. 

The increased activity criterion can be difficult to ascertain in children; however, when 
the child takes on many tasks simultaneously, starts devising elaborate and unrealistic 
plans for projects, develops previously absent and developmentally inappropriate sexual 
preoccupations (not accounted for by sexual abuse or exposure to sexually explicit mate- 
rial), then Criterion B might be met based on clinical judgment. It is essential to determine 
whether the behavior represents a change from the child’s baseline behavior; occurs most 
of the day, nearly every day for the requisite time period; and occurs in temporal associa- 
tion with other symptoms of mania. 

The expansive mood, excessive optimism, grandiosity, and poor judgment often lead 
to reckless involvement in activities such as spending sprees, giving away possessions, 
reckless driving, foolish business investments, and sexual promiscuity that is unusual for 
the individual, even though these activities are likely to have catastrophic consequences 
(Criterion B7). The individual may purchase many unneeded items without the money to 
pay for them and, in some cases, give them away. Sexual behavior may include infidelity 
or indiscriminate sexual encounters with strangers, often disregarding the risk of sexually 
transmitted diseases or interpersonal consequences. 

The manic episode must result in marked impairment in social or occupational func- 
tioning or require hospitalization to prevent harm to self or others (e.g., financial losses, il- 
legal activities, loss of employment, self-injurious behavior). By definition, the presence of 
psychotic features during a manic episode also satisfies Criterion C. 

Manic symptoms or syndromes that are attributable to the physiological effects of a 
drug of abuse (e.g., in the context of cocaine or amphetamine intoxication), the side effects 
of medications or treatments (e.g., steroids, L-dopa, antidepressants, stimulants), or an- 
other medical condition do not count toward the diagnosis of bipolar I disorder. However, 
a fully syndromal manic episode that arises during treatment (e.g., with medications, elec- 
troconvulsive therapy, light therapy) or drug use and persists beyond the physiological ef- 
fect of the inducing agent (i.e., after a medication is fully out of the individual’s system or 
the effects of electroconvulsive therapy would be expected to have dissipated completely) 
is sufficient evidence for a manic episode diagnosis (Criterion D). Caution is indicated so 
that one or two symptoms (particularly increased irritability, edginess, or agitation follow- 
ing antidepressant use) are not taken as sufficient for diagnosis of a manic or hypomanic 
episode, nor necessarily an indication of a bipolar disorder diathesis. It is necessary to 
meet criteria for a manic episode to make a diagnosis of bipolar I disorder, but it is not re- 
quired to have hypomanic or major depressive episodes. However, they may precede or 
follow a manic episode. Full descriptions of the diagnostic features of a hypomanic epi- 
sode may be found within the text for bipolar II disorder, and the features of a major de- 
pressive episode are described within the text for major depressive disorder. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


During a manic episode, individuals often do not perceive that they are ill or in need of treat- 
ment and vehemently resist efforts to be treated. Individuals may change their dress, makeup, 
or personal appearance to a more sexually suggestive or flamboyant style. Some perceive a 
sharper sense of smell, hearing, or vision. Gambling and antisocial behaviors may accompany 
the manic episode. Some individuals may become hostile and physically threatening to others 
and, when delusional, may become physically assaultive or suicidal. Catastrophic conse- 
quences of a manic episode (e.g., involuntary hospitalization, difficulties with the law, serious 
financial difficulties) often result from poor judgment, loss of insight, and hyperactivity. 

Mood may shift very rapidly to anger or depression. Depressive symptoms may occur 
during a manic episode and, if present, may last moments, hours, or, more rarely, days (see 
“with mixed features” specifier, pp. 149-150). 


130 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence estimate in the continental United States was 0.6% for bipolar I 
disorder as defined in DSM-IV. Twelve-month prevalence of bipolar I disorder across 11 
countries ranged from 0.0% to 0.6%. The lifetime male-to-female prevalence ratio is ap- 
proximately 1.1:1. 


Development and Course 


Mean age at onset of the first manic, hypomanic, or major depressive episode is approxi- 
mately 18 years for bipolar I disorder. Special considerations are necessary to detect the di- 
agnosis in children. Since children of the same chronological age may be at different 
developmental stages, it is difficult to define with precision what is “normal” or “ex- 
pected” at any given point. Therefore, each child should be judged according to his or her 
own baseline. Onset occurs throughout the life cycle, including first onsets in the 60s or 
70s. Onset of manic symptoms (e.g., sexual or social disinhibition) in late mid-life or late- 
life should prompt consideration of medical conditions (e.g., frontotemporal neurocogni- 
tive disorder) and of substance ingestion or withdrawal. 

More than 90% of individuals who have a single manic episode go on to have recurrent 
mood episodes. Approximately 60% of manic episodes occur immediately before a major 
depressive episode. Individuals with bipolar I disorder who have multiple (four or more) 
mood episodes (major depressive, manic, or hypomanic) within 1 year receive the speci- 
fier “with rapid cycling.” 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Bipolar disorder is more common in high-income than in low-income 
countries (1.4 vs. 0.7%). Separated, divorced, or widowed individuals have higher rates of 
bipolar I disorder than do individuals who are married or have never been married, but 
the direction of the association is unclear. 


Genetic and physiological. A family history of bipolar disorder is one of the strongest and 
most consistent risk factors for bipolar disorders. There is an average 10-fold increased risk 
among adult relatives of individuals with bipolar I and bipolar II disorders. Magnitude of 
risk increases with degree of kinship. Schizophrenia and bipolar disorder likely share a ge- 
netic origin, reflected in familial co-aggregation of schizophrenia and bipolar disorder. 


Course modifiers. After an individual has a manic episode with psychotic features, subse- 
quent manic episodes are more likely to include psychotic features. Incomplete inter- 
episode recovery is more common when the current episode is accompanied by mood- 
incongruent psychotic features. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Little information exists on specific cultural differences in the expression of bipolar I dis- 
order. One possible explanation for this may be that diagnostic instruments are often 
translated and applied in different cultures with no transcultural validation. In one U.S. 
study, 12-month prevalence of bipolar I disorder was significantly lower for Afro-Carib- 
beans than for African Americans or whites. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Females are more likely to experience rapid cycling and mixed states, and to have patterns of 
comorbidity that differ from those of males, including higher rates of lifetime eating disor- 
ders. Females with bipolar I or II disorder are more likely to experience depressive symptoms 
than males. They also have a higher lifetime risk of alcohol use disorder than are males and a 
much greater likelihood of alcohol use disorder than do females in the general population. 


Bipolar | Disorder 131 


Suicide Risk 


The lifetime risk of suicide in individuals with bipolar disorder is estimated to be at least 
15 times that of the general population. In fact, bipolar disorder may account for one-quar- 
ter of all completed suicides. A past history of suicide attempt and percent days spent de- 
pressed in the past year are associated with greater risk of suicide attempts or completions. 


Functional Consequences of Bipolar | Disorder 


Although many individuals with bipolar disorder return to a fully functional level be- 
tween episodes, approximately 30% show severe impairment in work role function. Func- 
tional recovery lags substantially behind recovery from symptoms, especially with respect 
to occupational recovery, resulting in lower socioeconomic status despite equivalent lev- 
els of education when compared with the general population. Individuals with bipolar I 
disorder perform more poorly than healthy individuals on cognitive tests. Cognitive im- 
pairments may contribute to vocational and interpersonal difficulties and persist through 
the lifespan, even during euthymic periods. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Major depressive disorder. Major depressive disorder may also be accompanied by hy- 
pomanic or manic symptoms (i.e., fewer symptoms or for a shorter duration than required 
for mania or hypomania). When the individual presents in an episode of major depression, 
one must depend on corroborating history regarding past episodes of mania or hypoma- 
nia. Symptoms of irritability may be associated with either major depressive disorder or 
bipolar disorder, adding to diagnostic complexity. 


Other bipolar disorders. Diagnosis of bipolar I disorder is differentiated from bipolar II 
disorder by determining whether there have been any past episodes of mania. Other spec- 
ified and unspecified bipolar and related disorders should be differentiated from bipolar I 
and II disorders by considering whether either the episodes involving manic or hypo- 
manic symptoms or the episodes of depressive symptoms fail to meet the full criteria for 
those conditions. 

Bipolar disorder due to another medical condition may be distinguished from bipolar 
land II disorders by identifying, based on best clinical evidence, a causally related medical 
condition. 


Generalized anxiety disorder, panic disorder, posttraumatic stress disorder, or other 
anxiety disorders. These disorders need to be considered in the differential diagnosis as 
either the primary disorder or, in some cases, a comorbid disorder. A careful history of 
symptoms is needed to differentiate generalized anxiety disorder from bipolar disorder, 
as anxious ruminations may be mistaken for racing thoughts, and efforts to minimize anx- 
ious feelings may be taken as impulsive behavior. Similarly, symptoms of posttraumatic 
stress disorder need to be differentiated from bipolar disorder. It is helpful to assess the ep- 
isodic nature of the symptoms described, as well as to consider symptom triggers, in mak- 
ing this differential diagnosis. 


Substance/medication-induced bipolar disorder. Substance use disorders may mani- 
fest with substance.medication-induced manic symptoms that must be distinguished 
from bipolar I disorder; response to mood stabilizers during a substance /medication- 
induced mania may not necessarily be diagnostic for bipolar disorder. There may be sub- 
stantial overlap in view of the tendency for individuals with bipolar I disorder to overuse 
substances during an episode. A primary diagnosis of bipolar disorder must be estab- 
lished based on symptoms that remain once substances are no longer being used. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. This disorder may be misdiagnosed as bipolar 
disorder, especially in adolescents and children. Many symptoms overlap with the symp- 


132 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


toms of mania, such as rapid speech, racing thoughts, distractibility, and less need for 
sleep. The “double counting” of symptoms toward both ADHD and bipolar disorder can 
be avoided if the clinician clarifies whether the symptom(s) represents a distinct episode. 


Personality disorders. Personality disorders such as borderline personality disorder 
may have substantial symptomatic overlap with bipolar disorders, since mood lability 
and impulsivity are common in both conditions. Symptoms must represent a distinct ep- 
isode, and the noticeable increase over baseline required for the diagnosis of bipolar dis- 
order must be present. A diagnosis of a personality disorder should not be made during an 
untreated mood episode. 


Disorders with prominent irritability. In individuals with severe irritability, particularly 
children and adolescents, care must be taken to apply the diagnosis of bipolar disorder 
only to those who have had a clear episode of mania or hypomania—that is, a distinct time 
period, of the required duration, during which the irritability was clearly different from 
the individual’s baseline and was accompanied by the onset of Criterion B symptoms. 
When a child’s irritability is persistent and particularly severe, the diagnosis of disruptive 
mood dysregulation disorder would be more appropriate. Indeed, when any child is being 
assessed for mania, it is essential that the symptoms represent a clear change from the 
child’s typical behavior. 


Comorbidity 


Co-occurring mental disorders are common, with the most frequent disorders being any 
anxiety disorder (e.g., panic attacks, social anxiety disorder [social phobia], specific pho- 
bia), occurring in approximately three-fourths of individuals; ADHD, any disruptive, im- 
pulse-control, or conduct disorder (e.g., intermittent explosive disorder, oppositional 
defiant disorder, conduct disorder), and any substance use disorder (e.g., alcohol use dis- 
order) occur in over half of individuals with bipolar I disorder. Adults with bipolar I dis- 
order have high rates of serious and/or untreated co-occurring medical conditions. 
Metabolic syndrome and migraine are more common among individuals with bipolar dis- 
order than in the general population. More than half of individuals whose symptoms meet 
criteria for bipolar disorder have an alcohol use disorder, and those with both disorders 
are at greater risk for suicide attempt. 


Bipolar Il Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 296.89 (F31.81) 


For a diagnosis of bipolar II disorder, it is necessary to meet the following criteria for a cur- 
rent or past hypomanic episode and the following criteria for a current or past major de- 
pressive episode: 


Hypomanic Episode 

A. A distinct period of abnormally and persistently elevated, expansive, or irritable mood 
and abnormally and persistently increased activity or energy, lasting at least 4 consec- 
utive days and present most of the day, nearly every day. 

B. During the period of mood disturbance and increased energy and activity, three (or more) 
of the following symptoms have persisted (four if the mood is only irritable), represent a no- 
ticeable change from usual behavior, and have been present to a significant degree: 

1. Inflated self-esteem or grandiosity. 
2. Decreased need for sleep (e.g., feels rested after only 3 hours of sleep). 
3. More talkative than usual or pressure to keep talking. 


Bipolar II Disorder 133 


4. Flight of ideas or subjective experience that thoughts are racing. 

5. Distractibility (i.e., attention too easily drawn to unimportant or irrelevant external 
stimuli), as reported or observed. 

6. Increase in goal-directed activity (either socially, at work or school, or sexually) or 
psychomotor agitation. 

7. Excessive involvement in activities that have a high potential for painful conse- 
quences (e.g., engaging in unrestrained buying sprees, sexual indiscretions, or 
foolish business investments). 


C. The episode is associated with an unequivocal change in functioning that is uncharac- 

teristic of the individual when not symptomatic. 

The disturbance in mood and the change in functioning are observable by others. 

The episode is not severe enough to cause marked impairment in social or occupa- 

tional functioning or to necessitate hospitalization. If there are psychotic features, the 

episode is, by definition, manic. 

F. The episode is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug 
of abuse, a medication or other treatment). 
Note: A full hypomanic episode that emerges during antidepressant treatment (e.g., 
medication, electroconvulsive therapy) but persists at a fully syndromal level beyond 
the physiological effect of that treatment is sufficient evidence for a hypomanic episode 
diagnosis. However, caution is indicated so that one or two symptoms (particularly in- 
creased irritability, edginess, or agitation following antidepressant use) are not taken 
as sufficient for diagnosis of a hypomanic episode, nor necessarily indicative of a bi- 
polar diathesis. 


mo 


Major Depressive Episode 

A. Five (or more) of the following symptoms have been present during the same 2-week 
period and represent a change from previous functioning; at least one of the symptoms 
is either (1) depressed mood or (2) loss of interest or pleasure. 
Note: Do not include symptoms that are clearly attributable to a medical condition. 


1. Depressed mood most of the day, nearly every day, as indicated by either subjec- 
tive report (e.g., feels sad, empty, or hopeless) or observation made by others (e.g., 
appears tearful). (Note: In children and adolescents, can be irritable mood.) 

2. Markedly diminished interest or pleasure in all, or almost all, activities most of the 
day, nearly every day (as indicated by either subjective account or observation). 

3. Significant weight loss when not dieting or weight gain (e.g., a change of more than 
5% of body weight in a month), or decrease or increase in appetite nearly every 
day. (Note: In children, consider failure to make expected weight gain.) 

4. Insomnia or hypersomnia nearly every day. 

5. Psychomotor agitation or retardation nearly every day (observable by others; not 
merely subjective feelings of restlessness or being slowed down). 

6. Fatigue or loss of energy nearly every day. 

7. Feelings of worthlessness or excessive or inappropriate guilt (which may be delu- 
sional) nearly every day (not merely self-reproach or guilt about being sick). 

8. Diminished ability to think or concentrate, or indecisiveness, nearly every day (ei- 
ther by subjective account or as observed by others). 

9. Recurrent thoughts of death (not just fear of dying), recurrent suicidal ideation with- 
out a specific plan, a suicide attempt, or a specific plan for committing suicide. 

B. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

C. The episode is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance or another 
medical condition. 


134 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Note: Criteria A-C above constitute a major depressive episode. 


Note: Responses to a significant loss (e.g., bereavement, financial ruin, losses from a nat- 
ural disaster, a serious medical illness or disability) may include the feelings of intense sad- 
ness, rumination about the loss, insomnia, poor appetite, and weight loss noted in Criterion 
A, which may resemble a depressive episode. Although such symptoms may be under- 
standable or considered appropriate to the loss, the presence of a major depressive episode 
in addition to the normal response to a significant loss should be carefully considered. This 
decision inevitably requires the exercise of clinical judgment based on the individual’s history 
and the cultural norms for the expression of distress in the context of loss. ! 


Bipolar II Disorder 

A. Criteria have been met for at least one hypomanic episode (Criteria A-F under “Hypo- 
manic Episode” above) and at least one major depressive episode (Criteria A-C under 
“Major Depressive Episode” above). 

B. There has never been a manic episode. 

C. The occurrence of the hypomanic episode(s) and major depressive episode(s) is not 
better explained by schizoaffective disorder, schizophrenia, schizophreniform disor- 
der, delusional disorder, or other specified or unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and 
other psychotic disorder. 

D. The symptoms of depression or the unpredictability caused by frequent alternation be- 
tween periods of depression and hypomania causes clinically significant distress or im- 
pairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 


Coding and Recording Procedures 

Bipolar II disorder has one diagnostic code: 296.89 (F31.81). Its status with respect to cur- 
rent severity, presence of psychotic features, course, and other specifiers cannot be 
coded but should be indicated in writing (e.g., 296.89 [F31.81] bipolar II disorder, current 
episode depressed, moderate severity, with mixed features; 296.89 [F31.81] bipolar II dis- 
order, most recent episode depressed, in partial remission). 


Specify current or most recent episode: 
Hypomanic 
Depressed 

Specity if: 
With anxious distress (p. 149) 
With mixed features (pp. 149-150) 


lIn distinguishing grief from a major depressive episode (MDE), it is useful to consider that in grief 
the predominant affect is feelings of emptiness and loss, while in a MDE it is persistent depressed 
mood and the inability to anticipate happiness or pleasure. The dysphoria in grief is likely to 
decrease in intensity over days to weeks and occurs in waves, the so-called pangs of grief. These 
waves tend to be associated with thoughts or reminders of the deceased. The depressed mood of a 
MDE is more persistent and not tied to specific thoughts or preoccupations. The pain of grief may 
be accompanied by positive emotions and humor that are uncharacteristic of the pervasive unhap- 
piness and misery characteristic of a MDE. The thought content associated with grief generally fea- 
tures a preoccupation with thoughts and memories of the deceased, rather than the self-critical or 
pessimistic ruminations seen in a MDE. In grief, self-esteem is generally preserved, whereas in a 
MDE feelings of worthlessness and self-loathing are common. If self-derogatory ideation is present 
in grief, it typically involves perceived failings vis-a-vis the deceased (e.g., not visiting frequently 
enough, not telling the deceased how much he or she was loved). If a bereaved individual thinks 
about death and dying, such thoughts are generally focused on the deceased and possibly about 
“joining” the deceased, whereas in a MDE such thoughts are focused on ending one’s own life 

because of feeling worthless, undeserving of life, or unable to cope with the pain of depression. 


Bipolar II Disorder 135 


With rapid cycling (pp. 150-151) 
With mood-congruent psychotic features (p. 152) 
With mood-incongruent psychotic features (p. 152) 
With catatonia (p. 152). Coding note: Use additional code 293.89 (F06.1). 
With peripartum onset (pp. 152-153) 
With seasonal pattern (pp. 153-154): Applies only to the pattern of major depressive 
episodes. 
Specify course if full criteria for a mood episode are not currently met: 
In partial remission (p. 154) 
In full remission (p. 154) 


Specify severity if full criteria for a mood episode are currently met: 
Mild (p. 154) 
Moderate (p. 154) 
Severe (p. 154) 


Diagnostic Features 


Bipolar II disorder is characterized by a clinical course of recurring mood episodes con- 
sisting of one or more major depressive episodes (Criteria A-C under “Major Depressive 
Episode”) and at least one hypomanic episode (Criteria A-F under “Hypomanic Epi- 
sode”). The major depressive episode must last at least 2 weeks, and the hypomanic epi- 
sode must last at least 4 days, to meet the diagnostic criteria. During the mood episode(s), 
the requisite number of symptoms must be present most of the day, nearly every day, and 
represent a noticeable change from usual behavior and functioning. The presence of a 
manic episode during the course of illness precludes the diagnosis of bipolar II disorder 
(Criterion B under “Bipolar II Disorder”). Episodes of substance /medication-induced de- 
pressive disorder or substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disorder (repre- 
senting the physiological effects of a medication, other somatic treatments for depression, 
drugs of abuse, or toxin exposure) or of depressive and related disorder due to another 
medical condition or bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition do not 
count toward a diagnosis of bipolar II disorder unless they persist beyond the physiolog- 
ical effects of the treatment or substance and then meet duration criteria for an episode. In 
addition, the episodes must not be better accounted for by schizoaffective disorder and are 
not superimposed on schizophrenia, schizophreniform disorder, delusional disorder, or 
other specified or unspecified schizophrenia spectrum or other psychotic disorders (Cri- 
terion C under “Bipolar II Disorder”). The depressive episodes or hypomanic fluctuations 
must cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other 
important areas of functioning (Criterion D under “Bipolar IT Disorder”); however, for hy- 
pomanic episodes, this requirement does not have to be met. A hypomanic episode that 
causes significant impairment would likely qualify for the diagnosis of manic episode and, 
therefore, for a lifetime diagnosis of bipolar I disorder. The recurrent major depressive ep- 
isodes are often more frequent and lengthier than those occurring in bipolar I disorder. 

Individuals with bipolar II disorder typically present to a clinician during a major de- 
pressive episode and are unlikely to complain initially of hypomania. Typically, the hy- 
pomanic episodes themselves do not cause impairment. Instead, the impairment results 
from the major depressive episodes or from a persistent pattern of unpredictable mood 
changes and fluctuating, unreliable interpersonal or occupational functioning. Individu- 
als with bipolar II disorder may not view the hypomanic episodes as pathological or dis- 
advantageous, although others may be troubled by the individual’s erratic behavior. 
Clinical information from other informants, such as close friends or relatives, is often use- 
ful in establishing the diagnosis of bipolar II disorder. 


136 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


A hypomanic episode should not be confused with the several days of euthymia and re- 
stored energy or activity that may follow remission of a major depressive episode. Despite the 
substantial differences in duration and severity between a manic and hypomanic episode, bi- 
polar II disorder is not a “milder form” of bipolar I disorder. Compared with individuals with 
bipolar I disorder, individuals with bipolar II disorder have greater chronicity of illness and 
spend, on average, more time in the depressive phase of their illness, which can be severe and / 
or disabling. Depressive symptoms co-occurring with a hypomanic episode or hypomanic 
symptoms co-occurring with a depressive episode are common in individuals with bipolar I 
disorder and are overrepresented in females, particularly hypomania with mixed features. In- 
dividuals experiencing hypomania with mixed features may not label their symptoms as hy- 
pomania, but instead experience them as depression with increased energy or irritability. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A common feature of bipolar II disorder is impulsivity, which can contribute to suicide at- 
tempts and substance use disorders. Impulsivity may also stem from a concurrent person- 
ality disorder, substance use disorder, anxiety disorder, another mental disorder, or a 
medical condition. There may be heightened levels of creativity in some individuals with 
a bipolar disorder. However, that relationship may be nonlinear; that is, greater lifetime 
creative accomplishments have been associated with milder forms of bipolar disorder, and 
higher creativity has been found in unaffected family members. The individual’s attach- 
ment to heightened creativity during hypomanic episodes may contribute to ambivalence 
about seeking treatment or undermine adherence to treatment. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence of bipolar II disorder, internationally, is 0.3%. In the United 
States, 12-month prevalence is 0.8%. The prevalence rate of pediatric bipolar II disorder is 
difficult to establish. DSM-IV bipolar I, bipolar IL, and bipolar disorder not otherwise spec- 
ified yield a combined prevalence rate of 1.8% in U.S. and non-U.S. community samples, 
with higher rates (2.7% inclusive) in youths age 12 years or older. 


Development and Course 


Although bipolar II disorder can begin in late adolescence and throughout adulthood, av- 
erage age at onset is the mid-20s, which is slightly later than for bipolar I disorder but ear- 
lier than for major depressive disorder. The illness most often begins with a depressive 
episode and is not recognized as bipolar II disorder until a hypomanic episode occurs; this 
happens in about 12% of individuals with the initial diagnosis of major depressive disor- 
der. Anxiety, substance use, or eating disorders may also precede the diagnosis, compli- 
cating its detection. Many individuals experience several episodes of major depression 
prior to the first recognized hypomanic episode. 

The number of lifetime episodes (both hypomanic and major depressive episodes) 
tends to be higher for bipolar II disorder than for major depressive disorder or bipolar I 
disorder. However, individuals with bipolar I disorder are actually more likely to experi- 
ence hypomanic symptoms than are individuals with bipolar I] disorder.The interval 
between mood episodes in the course of bipolar II disorder tends to decrease as the indi- 
vidual ages. While the hypomanic episode is the feature that defines bipolar II disorder, 
depressive episodes are more enduring and disabling over time. Despite the predomi- 
nance of depression, once a hypomanic episode has occurred, the diagnosis becomes bi- 
polar II disorder and never reverts to major depressive disorder. 

Approximately 5%—15% of individuals with bipolar II disorder have multiple (four or 
more) mood episodes (hypomanic or major depressive) within the previous 12 months. If 


Bipolar II Disorder 137 


this pattern is present, it is noted by the specifier “with rapid cycling.” By definition, psy- 
chotic symptoms do not occur in hypomanic episodes, and they appear to be less frequent 
in the major depressive episodes in bipolar II disorder than in those of bipolar I disorder. 

Switching from a depressive episode to a manic or hypomanic episode (with or with- 
out mixed features) may occur, both spontaneously and during treatment for depression. 
About 5%-15% of individuals with bipolar II disorder will ultimately develop a manic ep- 
isode, which changes the diagnosis to bipolar I disorder, regardless of subsequent course. 

Making the diagnosis in children is often a challenge, especially in those with irritabil- 
ity and hyperarousal that is nonepisodic (i.e., lacks the well-demarcated periods of altered 
mood). Nonepisodic irritability in youth is associated with an elevated risk for anxiety dis- 
orders and major depressive disorder, but not bipolar disorder, in adulthood. Persistently 
irritable youths have lower familial rates of bipolar disorder than do youths who have bi- 
polar disorder. For a hypomanic episode to be diagnosed, the child’s symptoms must ex- 
ceed what is expected in a given environment and culture for the child’s developmental 
stage. Compared with adult onset of bipolar II disorder, childhood or adolescent onset of 
the disorder may be associated with a more severe lifetime course. The 3-year incidence 
rate of first-onset bipolar II disorder in adults older than 60 years is 0.34%. However, dis- 
tinguishing individuals older than 60 years with bipolar II disorder by late versus early 
age at onset does not appear to have any clinical utility. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. The risk of bipolar II disorder tends to be highest among rel- 
atives of individuals with bipolar II disorder, as opposed to individuals with bipolar I dis- 
order or major depressive disorder. There may be genetic factors influencing the age at 
onset for bipolar disorders. 


Course modifiers. A rapid-cycling pattern is associated with a poorer prognosis. Return 
to previous level of social function for individuals with bipolar II disorder is more likely 
for individuals of younger age and with less severe depression, suggesting adverse effects 
of prolonged illness on recovery. More education, fewer years of illness, and being mar- 
ried are independently associated with functional recovery in individuals with bipolar 
disorder, even after diagnostic type (I vs. II), current depressive symptoms, and presence 
of psychiatric comorbidity are taken into account. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Whereas the gender ratio for bipolar I disorder is equal, findings on gender differences in 
bipolar II disorder are mixed, differing by type of sample (i.e., registry, community, or 
clinical) and country of origin. There is little to no evidence of bipolar gender differences, 
whereas some, but not all, clinical samples suggest that bipolar II disorder is more com- 
mon in females than in males, which may reflect gender differences in treatment seeking 
or other factors. 

Patterns of illness and comorbidity, however, seem to differ by gender, with females 
being more likely than males to report hypomania with mixed depressive features and a 
rapid-cycling course. Childbirth may be a specific trigger for a hypomanic episode, which 
can occur in 10%-20% of females in nonclinical populations and most typically in the early 
postpartum period. Distinguishing hypomania from the elated mood and reduced sleep 
that normally accompany the birth of a child may be challenging. Postpartum hypomania 
may foreshadow the onset of a depression that occurs in about half of females who expe- 
rience postpartum “highs.” Accurate detection of bipolar II disorder may help in estab- 
lishing appropriate treatment of the depression, which may reduce the risk of suicide and 
infanticide. 


138 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Suicide Risk 


Suicide risk is high in bipolar II disorder. Approximately one-third of individuals with bi- 
polar II disorder report a lifetime history of suicide attempt. The prevalence rates of life- 
time attempted suicide in bipolar II and bipolar I disorder appear to be similar (32.4% and 
36.3%, respectively). However, the lethality of attempts, as defined by a lower ratio of at- 
tempts to completed suicides, may be higher in individuals with bipolar II disorder com- 
pared with individuals with bipolar I disorder. There may be an association between 
genetic markers and increased risk for suicidal behavior in individuals with bipolar dis- 
order, including a 6.5-fold higher risk of suicide among first-degree relatives of bipolar II 
probands compared with those with bipolar I disorder. 


Functional Consequences of Bipolar II Disorder 


Although many individuals with bipolar II disorder return to a fully functional level be- 
tween mood episodes, at least 15% continue to have some inter-episode dysfunction, and 
20% transition directly into another mood episode without inter-episode recovery. Func- 
tional recovery lags substantially behind recovery from symptoms of bipolar II disorder, 
especially in regard to occupational recovery, resulting in lower socioeconomic status de- 
spite equivalent levels of education with the general population. Individuals with bipolar 
II disorder perform more poorly than healthy individuals on cognitive tests and, with the 
exception of memory and semantic fluency, have similar cognitive impairment as do in- 
dividuals with bipolar I disorder. Cognitive impairments associated with bipolar II disor- 
der may contribute to vocational difficulties. Prolonged unemployment in individuals 
with bipolar disorder is associated with more episodes of depression, older age, increased 
rates of current panic disorder, and lifetime history of alcohol use disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Major depressive disorder. Perhaps the most challenging differential diagnosis to con- 
sider is major depressive disorder, which may be accompanied by hypomanic or manic 
symptoms that do not meet full criteria (i.e., either fewer symptoms or a shorter duration 
than required for a hypomanic episode). This is especially true in evaluating individuals 
with symptoms of irritability, which may be associated with either major depressive dis- 
order or bipolar II disorder. 


Cyclothymic disorder. In cyclothymic disorder, there are numerous periods of hypo- 
manic symptoms and numerous periods of depressive symptoms that do not meet symp- 
tom or duration criteria for a major depressive episode. Bipolar II disorder is distinguished 
from cyclothymic disorder by the presence of one or more major depressive episodes. If a 
major depressive episode occurs after the first 2 years of cyclothymic disorder, the addi- 
tional diagnosis of bipolar II disorder is given. 


Schizophrenia spectrum and other related psychotic disorders. Bipolar II disorder must 
be distinguished from psychotic disorders (e.g., schizoaffective disorder, schizophrenia, 
and delusional disorder). Schizophrenia, schizoaffective disorder, and delusional disor- 
der are all characterized by periods of psychotic symptoms that occur in the absence of 
prominent mood symptoms. Other helpful considerations include the accompanying 
symptoms, previous course, and family history. 


Panic disorder or other anxiety disorders. Anxiety disorders need to be considered in 
the differential diagnosis and may frequently be present as co-occurring disorders. 


Substance use disorders. Substance use disorders are included in the differential diag- 
nosis. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) 
may be misdiagnosed as bipolar II disorder, especially in adolescents and children. Many 


Cyclothymic Disorder 139 


symptoms of ADHD, such as rapid speech, racing thoughts, distractibility, and less need 
for sleep, overlap with the symptoms of hypomania. The double counting of symptoms to- 
ward both ADHD and bipolar II disorder can be avoided if the clinician clarifies whether 
the symptoms represent a distinct episode and if the noticeable increase over baseline re- 
quired for the diagnosis of bipolar II disorder is present. 


Personality disorders. The same convention as applies for ADHD also applies when 
evaluating an individual for a personality disorder such as borderline personality disor- 
der, since mood lability and impulsivity are common in both personality disorders and bi- 
polar II disorder. Symptoms must represent a distinct episode, and the noticeable increase 
over baseline required for the diagnosis of bipolar IT disorder must be present. A diagnosis 
of a personality disorder should not be made during an untreated mood episode unless 
the lifetime history supports the presence of a personality disorder. 


Other bipolar disorders. Diagnosis of bipolar II disorder should be differentiated from 
bipolar I disorder by carefully considering whether there have been any past episodes of 
mania and from other specified and unspecified bipolar and related disorders by confirm- 
ing the presence of fully syndromal hypomania and depression. 


Comorbidity 


Bipolar II disorder is more often than not associated with one or more co-occurring mental 
disorders, with anxiety disorders being the most common. Approximately 60% of individ- 
uals with bipolar II disorder have three or more co-occurring mental disorders; 75% have 
an anxiety disorder; and 37% have a substance use disorder. Children and adolescents 
with bipolar II disorder have a higher rate of co-occurring anxiety disorders compared 
with those with bipolar I disorder, and the anxiety disorder most often predates the bi- 
polar disorder. Anxiety and substance use disorders occur in individuals with bipolar II 
disorder at a higher rate than in the general population. Approximately 14% of individuals 
with bipolar II disorder have at least one lifetime eating disorder, with binge-eating dis- 
order being more common than bulimia nervosa and anorexia nervosa. 

These commonly co-occurring disorders do not seem to follow a course of illness that 
is truly independent from that of the bipolar disorder, but rather have strong associations 
with mood states. For example, anxiety and eating disorders tend to associate most with 
depressive symptoms, and substance use disorders are moderately associated with manic 
symptoms. 


Cyclothymic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.13 (F34.0) 


A. For at least 2 years (at least 1 year in children and adolescents) there have been nu- 
merous periods with hypomanic symptoms that do not meet criteria for a hypomanic 
episode and numerous periods with depressive symptoms that do not meet criteria for 
a major depressive episode. 

B. During the above 2-year period (1 year in children and adolescents), the hypomanic 
and depressive periods have been present for at least half the time and the individual 
has not been without the symptoms for more than 2 months at a time. 

C. Criteria for a major depressive, manic, or hypomanic episode have never been met. 

D. The symptoms in Criterion A are not better explained by schizoaffective disorder, 
schizophrenia, schizophreniform disorder, delusional disorder, or other specified or un- 
specified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder. 

E. The symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition (e.g., hyperthyroidism). 


140 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


F. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


Specity if: 
With anxious distress (see p. 149) 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of cyclothymic disorder is a chronic, fluctuating mood disturbance 
involving numerous periods of hypomanic symptoms and periods of depressive symp- 
toms that are distinct from each other (Criterion A). The hypomanic symptoms are of 
insufficient number, severity, pervasiveness, or duration to meet full criteria for a hypo- 
manic episode, and the depressive symptoms are of insufficient number, severity, perva- 
siveness, or duration to meet full criteria for a major depressive episode. During the initial 
2-year period (1 year for children or adolescents), the symptoms must be persistent (pres- 
ent more days than not), and any symptom-free intervals last no longer than 2 months 
(Criterion B). The diagnosis of cyclothymic disorder is made only if the criteria for a major 
depressive, manic, or hypomanic episode have never been met (Criterion C). 

If an individual with cyclothymic disorder subsequently (i.e., after the initial 2 years in 
adults or 1 year in children or adolescents) experiences a major depressive, manic, or hy- 
pomanic episode, the diagnosis changes to major depressive disorder, bipolar I disorder, 
or other specified or unspecified bipolar and related disorder (subclassified as hypomanic 
episode without prior major depressive episode), respectively, and the cyclothymic disor- 
der diagnosis is dropped. 

The cyclothymic disorder diagnosis is not made if the pattern of mood swings is better 
explained by schizoaffective disorder, schizophrenia, schizophreniform disorder, delu- 
sional disorder, or other specified and unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other 
psychotic disorders (Criterion D), in which case the mood symptoms are considered asso- 
ciated features of the psychotic disorder. The mood disturbance must also not be attribut- 
able to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication) or 
another medical condition (e.g., hyperthyroidism) (Criterion E). Although some individ- 
uals may function particularly well during some of the periods of hypomania, over the 
prolonged course of the disorder, there must be clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning as a result of the 
mood disturbance (Criterion F). The impairment may develop as a result of prolonged pe- 
riods of cyclical, often unpredictable mood changes (e.g., the individual may be regarded 
as temperamental, moody, unpredictable, inconsistent, or unreliable). 


Prevalence 


The lifetime prevalence of cyclothymic disorder is approximately 0.4%-1%. Prevalence in 
mood disorders clinics may range from 3% to 5%. In the general population, cyclothymic 
disorder is apparently equally common in males and females. In clinical settings, females 
with cyclothymic disorder may be more likely to present for treatment than males. 


Development and Course 


Cyclothymic disorder usually begins in adolescence or early adult life and is sometimes 
considered to reflect a temperamental predisposition to other disorders in this chapter. 
Cyclothymic disorder usually has an insidious onset and a persistent course. There is a 
15%-50% risk that an individual with cyclothymic disorder will subsequently develop bi- 
polar I disorder or bipolar II disorder. Onset of persistent, fluctuating hypomanic and de- 
pressive symptoms late in adult life needs to be clearly differentiated from bipolar and 


Cyclothymic Disorder 141 


related disorder due to another medical condition and depressive disorder due to another 
medical condition (e.g., multiple sclerosis) before the cyclothymic disorder diagnosis is as- 
signed. Among children with cyclothymic disorder, the mean age at onset of symptoms is 
6.5 years of age. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Major depressive disorder, bipolar I disorder, and bipolar II 
disorder are more common among first-degree biological relatives of individuals with cyclo- 
thymic disorder than in the general population. There may also be an increased familial risk of 
substance-related disorders. Cyclothymic disorder may be more common in the first-degree 
biological relatives of individuals with bipolar I disorder than in the general population. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition and depressive disorder 
due to another medical condition. The diagnosis of bipolar and related disorder due to 
another medical condition or depressive disorder due to another medical condition is 
made when the mood disturbance is judged to be attributable to the physiological effect of 
a specific, usually chronic medical condition (e.g., hyperthyroidism). This determination 
is based on the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings. If it is judged that the 
hypomanic and depressive symptoms are not the physiological consequence of the med- 
ical condition, then the primary mental disorder (i.e., cyclothymic disorder) and the med- 
ical condition are coded. For example, this would be the case if the mood symptoms are 
considered to be the psychological (not the physiological) consequence of having a chronic 
medical condition, or if there is no etiological relationship between the hypomanic and de- 
pressive symptoms and the medical condition. 


Substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disorder and substance/medica- 
tion-induced depressive disorder. Substance/medication-induced bipolar and related 
disorder and substance/medication-induced depressive disorder are distinguished from 
cyclothymic disorder by the judgment that a substance/ medication (especially stimu- 
lants) is etiologically related to the mood disturbance. The frequent mood swings in these 
disorders that are suggestive of cyclothymic disorder usually resolve following cessation 
of substance /medication use. 


Bipolar | disorder, with rapid cycling, and bipolar Il disorder, with rapid cycling. 
Both disorders may resemble cyclothymic disorder by virtue of the frequent marked shifts 
in mood. By definition, in cyclothymic disorder the criteria for a major depressive, manic, 
or hypomanic episode has never been met, whereas the bipolar I disorder and bipolar II 
disorder specifier “with rapid cycling” requires that full mood episodes be present. 


Borderline personality disorder. Borderline personality disorder is associated with 
marked shifts in mood that may suggest cyclothymic disorder. If the criteria are met for 
both disorders, both borderline personality disorder and cyclothymic disorder may be di- 
agnosed. 


Comorbidity 


Substance-related disorders and sleep disorders (i.e., difficulties in initiating and main- 
taining sleep) may be present in individuals with cyclothymic disorder. Most children 
with cyclothymic disorder treated in outpatient psychiatric settings have comorbid mental 
conditions; they are more likely than other pediatric patients with mental disorders to 
have comorbid attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. 


142 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Substance/Medication-Induced 
Bipolar and Related Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A prominent and persistent disturbance in mood that predominates in the clinical picture 
and is characterized by elevated, expansive, or irritable mood, with or without depressed 
mood, or markedly diminished interest or pleasure in all, or almost all, activities. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of both 
(1) and (2): 


1. The symptoms in Criterion A developed during or soon after substance intoxication 
or withdrawal or after exposure to a medication. 

2. The involved substance/medication is capable of producing the symptoms in Crite- 
rion A. 


C. The disturbance is not better explained by a bipolar or related disorder that is not sub- 
stance/medication-induced. Such evidence of an independent bipolar or related disor- 
der could include the following: 


The symptoms precede the onset of the substance/medication use; the symptoms per- 
sist for a substantial period of time (e.g., about 1 month) after the cessation of acute 
withdrawal or severe intoxication; or there is other evidence suggesting the existence 
of an independent non-substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disorder 
(e.g., a history of recurrent non-substance/medication-related episodes). 


D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance/medication]- 
induced bipolar and related disorders are indicated in the table below. Note that the ICD-10- 
CM code depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance use disorder present for 
the same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance- 
induced bipolar and related disorder, the 4th position character is “1,” and the clinician should 
record “mild [substance] use disorder’ before the substance-induced bipolar and related dis- 
order (e.g., “mild cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced bipolar and related disorder’). If a 
moderate or severe substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance-induced bipolar 
and related disorder, the 4th position character is “2,” and the clinician should record “moder- 
ate [substance] use disorder” or “severe [substance] use disorder,” depending on the severity 
of the comorbid substance use disorder. If there is no comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., 
after a one-time heavy use of the substance), then the 4th position character is “9,” and the 
clinician should record only the substance-induced bipolar and related disorder. 


ICD-10-CM 
With use 
With use disorder, Without 
disorder, moderate use 
ICD-9-CM mild or severe disorder 
Alcohol 291.89 F10.14 F10.24 F10.94 
Phencyclidine 292.84 F16.14 F16.24 F16.94 


Other hallucinogen 292.84 F16.14 F16.24 F16.94 


Substance/Medication-Induced Bipolar and Related Disorder 143 


ICD-10-CM 
With use 
With use disorder, Without 
disorder, moderate use 
ICD-9-CM mild or severe disorder 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 292.84 F13.14 F13.24 F13.94 
Amphetamine (or other 292.84 F15.14 F15.24 F15.94 
stimulant) 
Cocaine 292.84 F14.14 F14.24 F14.94 
Other (or unknown) substance 292.84 F19.14 F19.24 F19.94 


Specify if (see Table 1 in the chapter “Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders” for di- 
agnoses associated with substance class): 
With onset during intoxication: If the criteria are met for intoxication with the sub- 
stance and the symptoms develop during intoxication. 
With onset during withdrawal: If criteria are met for withdrawal from the substance 
and the symptoms develop during, or shortly after, withdrawal. 


Recording Procedures 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disor- 
der begins with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, dexamethasone) that is presumed to 
be causing the bipolar mood symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the table in- 
cluded in the criteria set, which is based on the drug class. For substances that do not fit 
into any of the classes (e.g., dexamethasone), the code for “other substance” should be 
used; and in cases in which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific 
class of substance is unknown, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder is followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during in- 
toxication, onset during withdrawal). Unlike the recording procedures for ICD-10-CM, 
which combine the substance-induced disorder and substance use disorder into a single 
code, for ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is given for the substance use disorder. For 
example, in the case of irritable symptoms occurring during intoxication in a man with a 
severe cocaine use disorder, the diagnosis is 292.84 cocaine-induced bipolar and related 
disorder, with onset during intoxication. An additional diagnosis of 304.20 severe cocaine 
use disorder is also given. When more than one substance is judged to play a significant 
role in the development of bipolar mood symptoms, each should be listed separately (e.g., 
292.84 methylphenidate-induced bipolar and related disorder, with onset during intoxi- 
cation; 292.84 dexamethasone-induced bipolar and related disorder, with onset during in- 
toxication). 


ICD-10-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disor- 
der begins with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, dexamethasone) that is presumed to 
be causing the bipolar mood symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the table in- 
cluded in the criteria set, which is based on the drug class and presence or absence of a co- 
morbid substance use disorder. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., 
dexamethasone), the code for “other substance” should be used; and in cases in which a 
substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance is un- 
known, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) 
is listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the substance-induced 


144 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


bipolar and related disorder, followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during in- 
toxication, onset during withdrawal). For example, in the case of irritable symptoms oc- 
curring during intoxication in a man with a severe cocaine use disorder, the diagnosis is 
F14.24 severe cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced bipolar and related disorder, 
with onset during intoxication. A separate diagnosis of the comorbid severe cocaine use 
disorder is not given. If the substance-induced bipolar and related disorder occurs without 
a comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one-time heavy use of the substance), no 
accompanying substance use disorder is noted (e.g., F15.94 amphetamine-induced bipolar 
and related disorder, with onset during intoxication). When more than one substance is 
judged to play a significant role in the development of bipolar mood symptoms, each 
should be listed separately (e.g., F15.24 severe methylphenidate use disorder with meth- 
ylphenidate-induced bipolar and related disorder, with onset during intoxication; F19.94 
dexamethasone-induced bipolar and related disorder, with onset during intoxication). 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic features of substance /medication-induced bipolar and related disorder are es- 
sentially the same as those for mania, hypomania, or depression. A key exception to the diag- 
nosis of substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disorder is the case of hypomania 
or mania that occurs after antidepressant medication use or other treatments and persists be- 
yond the physiological effects of the medication. This condition is considered an indicator of 
true bipolar disorder, not substance /medication-induced bipolar and related disorder. Simi- 
larly, individuals with apparent electroconvulsive therapy—induced manic or hypomanic ep- 
isodes that persist beyond the physiological effects of the treatment are diagnosed with 
bipolar disorder, not substance /medication-induced bipolar and related disorder. 

Side effects of some antidepressants and other psychotropic drugs (e.g., edginess, ag- 
itation) may resemble the primary symptoms of a manic syndrome, but they are funda- 
mentally distinct from bipolar symptoms and are insufficient for the diagnosis. That is, the 
criterion symptoms of mania/hypomania have specificity (simple agitation is not the same 
as excess involvement in purposeful activities), and a sufficient number of symptoms 
must be present (not just one or two symptoms) to make these diagnoses. In particular, the 
appearance of one or two nonspecific symptoms—irritability, edginess, or agitation during 
antidepressant treatment—in the absence of a full manic or hypomanic syndrome should 
not be taken to support a diagnosis of a bipolar disorder. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Etiology (causally related to the use of psychotropic medications or substances of abuse 
based on best clinical evidence) is the key variable in this etiologically specified form of bi- 
polar disorder. Substances/ medications that are typically considered to be associated 
with substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disorder include the stimulant 
class of drugs, as well as phencyclidine and steroids; however, a number of potential sub- 
stances continue to emerge as new compounds are synthesized (e.g., so-called bath salts). 
A history of such substance use may help increase diagnostic certainty. 


Prevalence 


There are no epidemiological studies of substance /medication-induced mania or bipolar 
disorder. Each etiological substance may have its own individual risk of inducing a bipo- 
lar (manic/hypomanic) disorder. 


Development and Course 


In phencyclidine-induced mania, the initial presentation may be one of a delirium with af- 
fective features, which then becomes an atypically appearing manic or mixed manic state. 


Bipolar and Related Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 145 


This condition follows the ingestion or inhalation quickly, usually within hours or, at the 
most, a few days. In stimulant-induced manic or hypomanic states, the response is in min- 
utes to 1 hour after one or several ingestions or injections. The episode is very brief and 
typically resolves over 1-2 days. With corticosteroids and some immunosuppressant 
medications, the mania (or mixed or depressed state) usually follows several days of in- 
gestion, and the higher doses appear to have a much greater likelihood of producing bi- 
polar symptoms. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Determination of the substance of use can be made through markers in the blood or urine 
to corroborate diagnosis. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disorder should be differentiated 
from other bipolar disorders, substance intoxication or substance-induced delirium, and 
medication side effects (as noted earlier). A full manic episode that emerges during anti- 
depressant treatment (e.g., medication, electroconvulsive therapy) but persists at a fully 
syndromal level beyond the physiological effect of that treatment is sufficient evidence for 
a bipolar I diagnosis. A full hypomanic episode that emerges during antidepressant treat- 
ment (e.g., medication, electroconvulsive therapy) but persists at a fully syndromal level 
beyond the physiological effect of that treatment is sufficient evidence for a bipolar II di- 
agnosis only if preceded by a major depressive episode. 


Comorbidity 

Comorbidities are those associated with the use of illicit substances (in the case of illegal 
stimulants or phencyclidine) or diversion of prescribed stimulants. Comorbidities related 
to steroid or immunosuppressant medications are those medical indications for these 
preparations. Delirium can occur before or along with manic symptoms in individuals in- 
gesting phencyclidine or those who are prescribed steroid medications or other immuno- 
suppressant medications. 


Bipolar and Related Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Aprominent and persistent period of abnormally elevated, expansive, or irritable mood 
and abnormally increased activity or energy that predominates in the clinical picture. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the dis- 
turbance is the direct pathophysiological consequence of another medical condition. 

. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder. 

. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 

. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning, or necessitates hospitalization to pre- 
vent harm to self or others, or there are psychotic features. 


moog 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code for bipolar and related disorder due to another medical 
condition is 293.83, which is assigned regardless of the specifier. The ICD-10-CM code 
depends on the specifier (see below). 


146 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Specify if: 
(F06.33) With manic features: Full criteria are not met for a manic or hypomanic ep- 
isode. 
(F06.33) With manic- or hypomanic-like episode: Full criteria are met except Crite- 
rion D for a manic episode or except Criterion F for a hypomanic episode. 
(F06.34) With mixed features: Symptoms of depression are also present but do not 
predominate in the clinical picture. 


Coding note: Include the name of the other medical condition in the name of the mental 
disorder (e.g., 293.83 [F06.33] bipolar disorder due to hyperthyroidism, with manic fea- 
tures). The other medical condition should also be coded and listed separately immedi- 
ately before the bipolar and related disorder due to the medical condition (e.g., 242.90 
[E05.90] hyperthyroidism; 293.83 [F06.33] bipolar disorder due to hyperthyroidism, with 
manic features). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition are 
presence of a prominent and persistent period of abnormally elevated, expansive, or irri- 
table mood and abnormally increased activity or energy predominating in the clinical pic- 
ture that is attributable to another medical condition (Criterion B). In most cases the manic 
or hypomanic picture may appear during the initial presentation of the medical condition 
(i.e., within 1 month); however, there are exceptions, especially in chronic medical condi- 
tions that might worsen or relapse and herald the appearance of the manic or hypomanic 
picture. Bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition would not be diag- 
nosed when the manic or hypomanic episodes definitely preceded the medical condition, 
since the proper diagnosis would be bipolar disorder (except in the unusual circumstance 
in which all preceding manic or hypomanic episodes—or, when only one such episode has 
occurred, the preceding manic or hypomanic episode—were associated with ingestion of 
a substance/medication). The diagnosis of bipolar and related disorder due to another 
medical condition should not be made during the course of a delirium (Criterion D). The 
manic or hypomanic episode in bipolar and related disorder due to another medical con- 
dition must cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning to qualify for this diagnosis (Criterion E). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Etiology (i.e., a causal relationship to another medical condition based on best clinical ev- 
idence) is the key variable in this etiologically specified form of bipolar disorder. The list- 
ing of medical conditions that are said to be able to induce mania is never complete, and 
the clinician’s best judgment is the essence of this diagnosis. Among the best known of the 
medical conditions that can cause a bipolar manic or hypomanic condition are Cushing’s 
disease and multiple sclerosis, as well as stroke and traumatic brain injuries. 


Development and Course 


Bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition usually has its onset acutely 
or subacutely within the first weeks or month of the onset of the associated medical con- 
dition. However, this is not always the case, as a worsening or later relapse of the associ- 
ated medical condition may precede the onset of the manic or hypomanic syndrome. The 
clinician must make a clinical judgment in these situations about whether the medical con- 
dition is causative, based on temporal sequence as well as plausibility of a causal relation- 


Bipolar and Related Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 147 


ship. Finally, the condition may remit before or just after the medical condition remits, 
particularly when treatment of the manic/hypomanic symptoms is effective. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Culture-related differences, to the extent that there is any evidence, pertain to those asso- 
ciated with the medical condition (e.g., rates of multiple sclerosis and stroke vary around 
the world based on dietary, genetic factors, and other environmental factors). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Gender differences pertain to those associated with the medical condition (e.g., systemic 
lupus erythematosus is more common in females; stroke is somewhat more common in 
middle-age males compared with females). 


Diagnostic Markers 


Diagnostic markers pertain to those associated with the medical condition (e.g., steroid 
levels in blood or urine to help corroborate the diagnosis of Cushing’s disease, which can 
be associated with manic or depressive syndromes; laboratory tests confirming the diag- 
nosis of multiple sclerosis). 


Functional Consequences of Bipolar and Related 
Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 


Functional consequences of the bipolar symptoms may exacerbate impairments associ- 
ated with the medical condition and may incur worse outcomes due to interference with 
medical treatment. In general, it is believed, but not established, that the illness, when in- 
duced by Cushing’s disease, will not recur if the Cushing’s disease is cured or arrested. 
However, it is also suggested, but not established, that mood syndromes, including de- 
pressive and manic/hypomanic ones, may be episodic (i.e., recurring) with static brain in- 
juries and other central nervous system diseases. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Symptoms of delirium, catatonia, and acute anxiety. It is important to differentiate 
symptoms of mania from excited or hypervigilant delirious symptoms; from excited cata- 
tonic symptoms; and from agitation related to acute anxiety states. 


Medication-induced depressive or manic symptoms. An important differential diag- 
nostic observation is that the other medical condition may be treated with medications 
(e.g., steroids or alpha-interferon) that can induce depressive or manic symptoms. In these 
cases, clinical judgment using all of the evidence in hand is the best way to try to separate 
the most likely and/or the most important of two etiological factors (i.e., association with 
the medical condition vs. a substance /medication-induced syndrome). The differential di- 
agnosis of the associated medical conditions is relevant but largely beyond the scope of the 
present manual. 


Comorbidity 

Conditions comorbid with bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition 
are those associated with the medical conditions of etiological relevance. Delirium can oc- 
cur before or along with manic symptoms in individuals with Cushing’s disease. 


148 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Other Specified Bipolar and Related Disorder 
296.89 (F31.89) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a bipolar and 

related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 

tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any of the disorders in the bipolar and related disorders diagnostic class. The other 
specified bipolar and related disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician 
chooses to communicate the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the cri- 
teria for any specific bipolar and related disorder. This is done by recording “other speci- 
fied bipolar and related disorder” followed by the specific reason (e.g., “short-duration 
cyclothymia”). 

Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 

1. Short-duration hypomanic episodes (2-3 days) and major depressive episodes: A 
lifetime history of one or more major depressive episodes in individuals whose presenta- 
tion has never met full criteria for a manic or hypomanic episode but who have experienced 
two or more episodes of short-duration hypomania that meet the full symptomatic criteria 
for a hypomanic episode but that only last for 2-3 days. The episodes of hypomanic symp- 
toms do not overlap in time with the major depressive episodes, so the disturbance does 
not meet criteria for major depressive episode, with mixed features. 

2. Hypomanic episodes with insufficient symptoms and major depressive epi- 
sodes: A lifetime history of one or more major depressive episodes in individuals 
whose presentation has never met full criteria for a manic or hypomanic episode but 
who have experienced one or more episodes of hypomania that do not meet full symp- 
tomatic criteria (i.e., at least 4 consecutive days of elevated mood and one or two of 
the other symptoms of a hypomanic episode, or irritable mood and two or three of the 
other symptoms of a hypomanic episode). The episodes of hypomanic symptoms do 
not overlap in time with the major depressive episodes, so the disturbance does not 
meet criteria for major depressive episode, with mixed features. 

3. Hypomanic episode without prior major depressive episode: One or more hypo- 
manic episodes in an individual whose presentation has never met full criteria for a ma- 
jor depressive episode or a manic episode. If this occurs in an individual with an 
established diagnosis of persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia), both diagnoses 
can be concurrently applied during the periods when the full criteria for a hypomanic 
episode are met. 

4. Short-duration cyclothymia (less than 24 months): Multiple episodes of hypomanic 
symptoms that do not meet criteria for a hypomanic episode and multiple episodes of de- 
pressive symptoms that do not meet criteria for a major depressive episode that persist 
over a period of less than 24 months (less than 12 months for children or adolescents) 
in an individual whose presentation has never met full criteria for a major depressive, 
manic, or hypomanic episode and does not meet criteria for any psychotic disorder. Dur- 
ing the course of the disorder, the hypomanic or depressive symptoms are present for 
more days than not, the individual has not been without symptoms for more than 2 months 
at a time, and the symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment. 


Unspecified Bipolar and Related Disorder 149 


Unspecified Bipolar and Related Disorder 
296.80 (F31.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a bipolar and 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any of the disorders in the bipolar and related disorders diagnostic class. The unspec- 
ified bipolar and related disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician choos- 
es not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for a specific bipolar and related 
disorder, and includes presentations in which there is insufficient information to make a 
more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Specifiers for Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Specify if: 
With anxious distress: The presence of at least two of the following symptoms during 
the majority of days of the current or most recent episode of mania, hypomania, or de- 
pression: 

. Feeling keyed up or tense. 

. Feeling unusually restless. 

. Difficulty concentrating because of worry. 

. Fear that something awful may happen. 

. Feeling that the individual might lose control of himself or herself. 


ahWOND — 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Two symptoms. 
Moderate: Three symptoms. 
Moderate-severe: Four or five symptoms. 
Severe: Four or five symptoms with motor agitation. 


Note: Anxious distress has been noted as a prominent feature of both bipolar and 
major depressive disorder in both primary care and specialty mental health set- 
tings. High levels of anxiety have been associated with higher suicide risk, longer 
duration of illness, and greater likelihood of treatment nonresponse. As a result, it 
is clinically useful to specify accurately the presence and severity levels of anxious 
distress for treatment planning and monitoring of response to treatment. 

With mixed features: The mixed features specifier can apply to the current manic, hy- 

pomanic, or depressive episode in bipolar | or bipolar II disorder: 


Manic or hypomanic episode, with mixed features: 


A. Full criteria are met for a manic episode or hypomanic episode, and at least 
three of the following symptoms are present during the majority of days of the 
current or most recent episode of mania or hypomania: 


1. Prominent dysphoria or depressed mood as indicated by either subjective 
report (e.g., feels sad or empty) or observation made by others (e.g., ap- 
pears tearful). 

2. Diminished interest or pleasure in all, or almost all, activities (as indicated by 
either subjective account or observation made by others). 

3. Psychomotor retardation nearly every day (observable by others; not merely 
subjective feelings of being slowed down). 


150 


Bipolar and Related Disorders 


4. Fatigue or loss of energy. 

5. Feelings of worthlessness or excessive or inappropriate guilt (not merely 
self-reproach or guilt about being sick). 

6. Recurrent thoughts of death (not just fear of dying), recurrent suicidal ide- 
ation without a specific plan, or a suicide attempt or a specific plan for com- 
mitting suicide. 

B. Mixed symptoms are observable by others and represent a change from the 
person’s usual behavior. 

C. For individuals whose symptoms meet full episode criteria for both mania and 
depression simultaneously, the diagnosis should be manic episode, with mixed 
features, due to the marked impairment and clinical severity of full mania. 

D. The mixed symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a sub- 
stance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication, other treatment). 


Depressive episode, with mixed features: 
A. Full criteria are met for a major depressive episode, and at least three of the fol- 


lowing manic/hypomanic symptoms are present during the majority of days of 
the current or most recent episode of depression: 


Elevated, expansive mood. 

Inflated self-esteem or grandiosity. 

More talkative than usual or pressure to keep talking. 

Flight of ideas or subjective experience that thoughts are racing. 

Increase in energy or goal-directed activity (either socially, at work or school, 

or sexually). 

6. Increased or excessive involvement in activities that have a high potential 
for painful consequences (e.g., engaging in unrestrained buying sprees, 
sexual indiscretions, or foolish business investments). 

7. Decreased need for sleep (feeling rested despite sleeping less than usual; 

to be contrasted with insomnia). 


aPfPoONns> 


B. Mixed symptoms are observable by others and represent a change from the 
person’s usual behavior. 

C. For individuals whose symptoms meet full episode criteria for both mania and 
depression simultaneously, the diagnosis should be manic episode, with mixed 
features. 

D. The mixed symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a sub- 
stance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication, or other treatment). 


Note: Mixed features associated with a major depressive episode have been found 
to be a significant risk factor for the development of bipolar | or bipolar || disorder. 
As a result, it is clinically useful to note the presence of this specifier for treatment 
planning and monitoring of response to treatment. 


With rapid cycling (can be applied to bipolar | or bipolar II disorder): Presence of at 
least four mood episodes in the previous 12 months that meet the criteria for manic, 
hypomanic, or major depressive episode. 


Note: Episodes are demarcated by either partial or full remissions of at least 2 months 
or a switch to an episode of the opposite polarity (e.g., major depressive episode to 
manic episode). 

Note: The essential feature of a rapid-cycling bipolar disorder is the occurrence of 


at least four mood episodes during the previous 12 months. These episodes can 
occur in any combination and order. The episodes must meet both the duration and 


Specifiers for Bipolar and Related Disorders 151 


symptom number criteria for a major depressive, manic, or hypomanic episode and 
must be demarcated by either a period of full remission or a switch to an episode 
of the opposite polarity. Manic and hypomanic episodes are counted as being on 
the same pole. Except for the fact that they occur more frequently, the episodes that 
occur in a rapid-cycling pattern are no different from those that occur in a non-rapid- 
cycling pattern. Mood episodes that count toward defining a rapid-cycling pattern 
exclude those episodes directly caused by a substance (e.g., cocaine, corticoste- 
roids) or another medical condition. 


With melancholic features: 
A. One of the following is present during the most severe period of the current episode: 


1. Loss of pleasure in all, or almost all, activities. 
2. Lack of reactivity to usually pleasurable stimuli (does not feel much better, even 
temporarily, when something good happens). 


B. Three (or more) of the following: 


1. Adistinct quality of depressed mood characterized by profound despondency, 
despair, and/or moroseness or by so-called empty mood. 

Depression that is regularly worse in the morning. 

Early-morning awakening (i.e., at least 2 hours before usual awakening). 
Marked psychomotor agitation or retardation. 

Significant anorexia or weight loss. 

Excessive or inappropriate guilt. 


Oy O1 Go 


Note: The specifier “with melancholic features” is applied if these features are pres- 
ent at the most severe stage of the episode. There is a near-complete absence of 
the capacity for pleasure, not merely a diminution. A guideline for evaluating the 
lack of reactivity of mood is that even highly desired events are not associated with 
marked brightening of mood. Either mood does not brighten at all, or it brightens 
only partially (e.g., up to 20%—40% of normal for only minutes at a time). The “dis- 
tinct quality” of mood that is characteristic of the “with melancholic features” speci- 
fier is experienced as qualitatively different from that during a nonmelancholic 
depressive episode. A depressed mood that is described as merely more severe, 
longer lasting, or present without a reason is not considered distinct in quality. Psy- 
chomotor changes are nearly always present and are observable by others. 

Melancholic features exhibit only a modest tendency to repeat across episodes 
in the same individual. They are more frequent in inpatients, as opposed to outpa- 
tients; are less likely to occur in milder than in more severe major depressive epi- 
sodes; and are more likely to occur in those with psychotic features. 


With atypical features: This specifier can be applied when these features predomi- 
nate during the majority of days of the current or most recent major depressive epi- 
sode. 


A. 


B. 


Mood reactivity (i.e., mood brightens in response to actual or potential positive 
events). 
Two (or more) of the following features: 


1. Significant weight gain or increase in appetite. 

2. Hypersomnia. 

3. Leaden paralysis (i.e., heavy, leaden feelings in arms or legs). 

4. A long-standing pattern of interpersonal rejection sensitivity (not limited to epi- 
sodes of mood disturbance) that results in significant social or occupational 
impairment. 


152 


Bipolar and Related Disorders 


C. Criteria are not met for “with melancholic features” or “with catatonia” during the 


same episode. 


Note: “Atypical depression” has historical significance (i.e., atypical in contradis- 
tinction to the more classical agitated, “endogenous” presentations of depression 
that were the norm when depression was rarely diagnosed in outpatients and al- 
most never in adolescents or younger adults) and today does not connote an un- 
common or unusual clinical presentation as the term might imply. 

Mood reactivity is the capacity to be cheered up when presented with positive 
events (e.g., a visit from children, compliments from others). Mood may become 
euthymic (not sad) even for extended periods of time if the external circumstances 
remain favorable. Increased appetite may be manifested by an obvious increase in 
food intake or by weight gain. Hypersomnia may include either an extended period 
of nighttime sleep or daytime napping that totals at least 10 hours of sleep per day 
(or at least 2 hours more than when not depressed). Leaden paralysis is defined as 
feeling heavy, leaden, or weighted down, usually in the arms or legs. This sensation 
is generally present for at least an hour a day but often lasts for many hours at a 
time. Unlike the other atypical features, pathological sensitivity to perceived inter- 
personal rejection is a trait that has an early onset and persists throughout most of 
adult life. Rejection sensitivity occurs both when the person is and is not depressed, 
though it may be exacerbated during depressive periods. 


With psychotic features: Delusions or hallucinations are present at any time in the 
episode. If psychotic features are present, specify if mood-congruent or mood-incon- 
gruent: 


With mood-congruent psychotic features: During manic episodes, the con- 
tent of all delusions and hallucinations is consistent with the typical manic 
themes of grandiosity, invulnerability, etc., but may also include themes of sus- 
piciousness or paranoia, especially with respect to others’ doubts about the in- 
dividual’s capacities, accomplishments, and so forth. 

With mood-incongruent psychotic features: The content of delusions and 
hallucinations is inconsistent with the episode polarity themes as described 
above, or the content is a mixture of mood-incongruent and mood-congruent 
themes. 


With catatonia: This specifier can apply to an episode of mania or depression if cata- 
tonic features are present during most of the episode. See criteria for catatonia asso- 
ciated with a mental disorder in the chapter “Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other 
Psychotic Disorders.” 

With peripartum onset: This specifier can be applied to the current or, if the full crite- 
ria are not currently met for a mood episode, most recent episode of mania, hypoma- 
nia, or major depression in bipolar | or bipolar II disorder if onset of mood symptoms 
occurs during pregnancy or in the 4 weeks following delivery. 


Note: Mood episodes can have their onset either during pregnancy or postpartum. 
Although the estimates differ according to the period of follow-up after delivery, be- 
tween 3% and 6% of women will experience the onset of a major depressive epi- 
sode during pregnancy or in the weeks or months following delivery. Fifty percent 
of “postpartum” major depressive episodes actually begin prior to delivery. Thus, 
these episodes are referred to collectively as peripartum episodes. Women with 
peripartum major depressive episodes often have severe anxiety and even panic 
attacks. Prospective studies have demonstrated that mood and anxiety symptoms 
during pregnancy, as well as the “baby blues,” increase the risk for a postpartum 
major depressive episode. 


Specifiers for Bipolar and Related Disorders 153 


Peripartum-onset mood episodes can present either with or without psychotic 
features. Infanticide is most often associated with postpartum psychotic episodes 
that are characterized by command hallucinations to kill the infant or delusions that 
the infant is possessed, but psychotic symptoms can also occur in severe postpar- 
tum mood episodes without such specific delusions or hallucinations. 

Postpartum mood (major depressive or manic) episodes with psychotic features 
appear to occur in from 1 in 500 to 1 in 1,000 deliveries and may be more common 
in primiparous women. The risk of postpartum episodes with psychotic features is 
particularly increased for women with prior postpartum mood episodes but is also 
elevated for those with a prior history of a depressive or bipolar disorder (especially 
bipolar | disorder) and those with a family history of bipolar disorders. 

Once a woman has had a postpartum episode with psychotic features, the risk 
of recurrence with each subsequent delivery is between 30% and 50%. Postpartum 
episodes must be differentiated from delirium occurring in the postpartum period, 
which is distinguished by a fluctuating level of awareness or attention. The postpar- 
tum period is unique with respect to the degree of neuroendocrine alterations and 
psychosocial adjustments, the potential impact of breast-feeding on treatment plan- 
ning, and the long-term implications of a history of postpartum mood disorder on sub- 
sequent family planning. 

With seasonal pattern: This specifier applies to the lifetime pattern of mood episodes. 
The essential feature is a regular seasonal pattern of at least one type of episode (i-e., 
mania, hypomania, or depression). The other types of episodes may not follow this pat- 
tern. For example, an individual may have seasonal manias, but his or her depressions 
do not regularly occur at a specific time of year. 


A. There has been a regular temporal relationship between the onset of manic, hypo- 
manic, or major depressive episodes and a particular time of the year (e.g., in the 
fall or winter) in bipolar | or bipolar II disorder. 


Note: Do not include cases in which there is an obvious effect of seasonally related 
psychosocial stressors (e.g., regularly being unemployed every winter). 


B. Full remissions (or a change from major depression to mania or hypomania or vice 
versa) also occur at a characteristic time of the year (e.g., depression disappears 
in the spring). 

C. Inthe last 2 years, the individual’s manic, hypomanic, or major depressive episodes 
have demonstrated a temporal seasonal relationship, as defined above, and no 
non-seasonal episodes of that polarity have occurred during that 2-year period. 

D. Seasonal manias, hypomanias, or depressions (as described above) substantially 
outnumber any nonseasonal manias, hypomanias, or depressions that may have 
occurred over the individual's lifetime. 


Note: This specifier can be applied to the pattern of major depressive episodes in 
bipolar | disorder, bipolar Il disorder, or major depressive disorder, recurrent. The 
essential feature is the onset and remission of major depressive episodes at char- 
acteristic times of the year. In most cases, the episodes begin in fall or winter and 
remit in spring. Less commonly, there may be recurrent summer depressive epi- 
sodes. This pattern of onset and remission of episodes must have occurred during 
at least a 2-year period, without any nonseasonal episodes occurring during this 
period. In addition, the seasonal depressive episodes must substantially outnum- 
ber any nonseasonal depressive episodes over the individual's lifetime. 

This specifier does not apply to those situations in which the pattern is better ex- 
plained by seasonally linked psychosocial stressors (e.g., seasonal unemployment 
or school schedule). Major depressive episodes that occur in a seasonal pattern 


154 Bipolar and Related Disorders 


are often characterized by prominent energy, hypersomnia, overeating, weight 
gain, and a craving for carbohydrates. It is unclear whether a seasonal pattern is 
more likely in recurrent major depressive disorder or in bipolar disorders. However, 
within the bipolar disorders group, a seasonal pattern appears to be more likely in 
bipolar II disorder than in bipolar | disorder. In some individuals, the onset of manic 
or hypomanic episodes may also be linked to a particular season. 

The prevalence of winter-type seasonal pattern appears to vary with latitude, 
age, and sex. Prevalence increases with higher latitudes. Age is also a strong pre- 
dictor of seasonality, with younger persons at higher risk for winter depressive epi- 
sodes. 

Specify if: 
In partial remission: Symptoms of the immediately previous manic, hypomanic, or 
depressive episode are present, but full criteria are not met, or there is a period lasting 
less than 2 months without any significant symptoms of a manic, hypomanic, or major 
depressive episode following the end of such an episode. 
In full remission: During the past 2 months, no significant signs or symptoms of the 
disturbance were present. 


Specify current severity: 
Severity is based on the number of criterion symptoms, the severity of those symptoms, 
and the degree of functional disability. 


Mild: Few, if any, symptoms in excess of those required to meet the diagnostic criteria 
are present, the intensity of the symptoms is distressing but manageable, and the 
symptoms result in minor impairment in social or occupational functioning. 

Moderate: The number of symptoms, intensity of symptoms, and/or functional impair- 
ment are between those specified for “mild” and “severe.” 

Severe: The number of symptoms is substantially in excess of those required to make 
the diagnosis, the intensity of the symptoms is seriously distressing and unmanage- 
able, and the symptoms markedly interfere with social and occupational functioning. 


Depressive 
Disorders 


Depressive disorders include disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, major 
depressive disorder (including major depressive episode), persistent depressive disorder 
(dysthymia), premenstrual dysphoric disorder, substance/medication-induced depres- 
sive disorder, depressive disorder due to another medical condition, other specified de- 
pressive disorder, and unspecified depressive disorder. Unlike in DSM-IV, this chapter 
“Depressive Disorders” has been separated from the previous chapter “Bipolar and Re- 
lated Disorders.” The common feature of all of these disorders is the presence of sad, 
empty, or irritable mood, accompanied by somatic and cognitive changes that signifi- 
cantly affect the individual’s capacity to function. What differs among them are issues of 
duration, timing, or presumed etiology. 

In order to address concerns about the potential for the overdiagnosis of and treatment 
for bipolar disorder in children, a new diagnosis, disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, 
referring to the presentation of children with persistent irritability and frequent episodes 
of extreme behavioral dyscontrol, is added to the depressive disorders for children up to 
12 years of age. Its placement in this chapter reflects the finding that children with this 
symptom pattern typically develop unipolar depressive disorders or anxiety disorders, 
rather than bipolar disorders, as they mature into adolescence and adulthood. 

Major depressive disorder represents the classic condition in this group of disorders. It 
is characterized by discrete episodes of at least 2 weeks’ duration (although most episodes 
last considerably longer) involving clear-cut changes in affect, cognition, and neurovege- 
tative functions and inter-episode remissions. A diagnosis based on a single episode is 
possible, although the disorder is a recurrent one in the majority of cases. Careful consid- 
eration is given to the delineation of normal sadness and grief from a major depressive ep- 
isode. Bereavement may induce great suffering, but it does not typically induce an episode 
of major depressive disorder. When they do occur together, the depressive symptoms and 
functional impairment tend to be more severe and the prognosis is worse compared with 
bereavement that is not accompanied by major depressive disorder. Bereavement-related 
depression tends to occur in persons with other vulnerabilities to depressive disorders, 
and recovery may be facilitated by antidepressant treatment. 

A more chronic form of depression, persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia), can be 
diagnosed when the mood disturbance continues for at least 2 years in adults or 1 year in 
children. This diagnosis, new in DSM-5, includes both the DSM-IV diagnostic categories of 
chronic major depression and dysthymia. 

After careful scientific review of the evidence, premenstrual dysphoric disorder has 
been moved from an appendix of DSM-IV (“Criteria Sets and Axes Provided for Further 
Study”) to Section II of DSM-5. Almost 20 years of additional of research on this condition 
has confirmed a specific and treatment-responsive form of depressive disorder that begins 
sometime following ovulation and remits within a few days of menses and has a marked 
impact on functioning. 

A large number of substances of abuse, some prescribed medications, and several 
medical conditions can be associated with depression-like phenomena. This fact is recog- 
nized in the diagnoses of substance /medication-induced depressive disorder and depres- 
sive disorder due to another medical condition. 


155 


156 Depressive Disorders 


Disruptive Mood Dysregulation Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 296.99 (F34.8) 


A. Severe recurrent temper outbursts manifested verbally (e.g., verbal rages) and/or be- 
haviorally (e.g., physical aggression toward people or property) that are grossly out of 
proportion in intensity or duration to the situation or provocation. 

B. The temper outbursts are inconsistent with developmental level. 

C. The temper outbursts occur, on average, three or more times per week. 

D. The mood between temper outbursts is persistently irritable or angry most of the day, 
nearly every day, and is observable by others (e.g., parents, teachers, peers). 

E. Criteria A-D have been present for 12 or more months. Throughout that time, the indi- 
vidual has not had a period lasting 3 or more consecutive months without all of the 
symptoms in Criteria A-D. 

F. Criteria A and D are present in at least two of three settings (i.e., at home, at school, 
with peers) and are severe in at least one of these. 

G. The diagnosis should not be made for the first time before age 6 years or after age 18 
years. 

H. By history or observation, the age at onset of Criteria A-E is before 10 years. 

|. There has never been a distinct period lasting more than 1 day during which the full 
symptom criteria, except duration, for a manic or hypomanic episode have been met. 
Note: Developmentally appropriate mood elevation, such as occurs in the context of a 
highly positive event or its anticipation, should not be considered as a symptom of ma- 
nia or hypomania. 

J. The behaviors do not occur exclusively during an episode of major depressive disorder 

and are not better explained by another mental disorder (e.g., autism spectrum disor- 
der, posttraumatic stress disorder, separation anxiety disorder, persistent depressive 
disorder [dysthymia)]). 
Note: This diagnosis cannot coexist with oppositional defiant disorder, intermittent ex- 
plosive disorder, or bipolar disorder, though it can coexist with others, including major 
depressive disorder, attention-deficit/nhyperactivity disorder, conduct disorder, and 
substance use disorders. Individuals whose symptoms meet criteria for both disruptive 
mood dysregulation disorder and oppositional defiant disorder should only be given the 
diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. If an individual has ever experi- 
enced a manic or hypomanic episode, the diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation 
disorder should not be assigned. 

K. The symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance or to an- 
other medical or neurological condition. 


Diagnostic Features 


The core feature of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder is chronic, severe persistent ir- 
ritability. This severe irritability has two prominent clinical manifestations, the first of 
which is frequent temper outbursts. These outbursts typically occur in response to frus- 
tration and can be verbal or behavioral (the latter in the form of aggression against prop- 
erty, self, or others). They must occur frequently (i.e., on average, three or more times per 
week) (Criterion C) over at least 1 year in at least two settings (Criteria E and F), such as in 
the home and at school, and they must be developmentally inappropriate (Criterion B). 
The second manifestation of severe irritability consists of chronic, persistently irritable or 
angry mood that is present between the severe temper outbursts. This irritable or angry 
mood must be characteristic of the child, being present most of the day, nearly every day, 
and noticeable by others in the child’s environment (Criterion D). 


Disruptive Mood Dysregulation Disorder 157 


The clinical presentation of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder must be carefully 
distinguished from presentations of other, related conditions, particularly pediatric bi- 
polar disorder. In fact, disruptive mood dysregulation disorder was added to DSM-5 to 
address the considerable concern about the appropriate classification and treatment of 
children who present with chronic, persistent irritability relative to children who present 
with classic (i.e., episodic) bipolar disorder. 

Some researchers view severe, non-episodic irritability as characteristic of bipolar dis- 
order in children, although both DSM-IV and DSM-5 require that both children and adults 
have distinct episodes of mania or hypomania to qualify for the diagnosis of bipolar I dis- 
order. During the latter decades of the 20th century, this contention by researchers that 
severe, nonepisodic irritability is a manifestation of pediatric mania coincided with an up- 
surge in the rates at which clinicians assigned the diagnosis of bipolar disorder to their 
pediatric patients. This sharp increase in rates appears to be attributable to clinicians com- 
bining at least two clinical presentations into a single category. That is, both classic, epi- 
sodic presentations of mania and non-episodic presentations of severe irritability have 
been labeled as bipolar disorder in children. In DSM-5, the term bipolar disorder is explicitly 
reserved for episodic presentations of bipolar symptoms. DSM-IV did not include a diagno- 
sis designed to capture youths whose hallmark symptoms consisted of very severe, non- 
episodic irritability, whereas DSM-5, with the inclusion of disruptive mood dysregulation 
disorder, provides a distinct category for such presentations. 


Prevalence 


Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder is common among children presenting to pedi- 
atric mental health clinics. Prevalence estimates of the disorder in the community are un- 
clear. Based on rates of chronic and severe persistent irritability, which is the core feature 
of the disorder, the overall 6-month to 1-year period-prevalence of disruptive mood dys- 
regulation disorder among children and adolescents probably falls in the 2%-5% range. 
However, rates are expected to be higher in males and school-age children than in females 
and adolescents. 


Development and Course 


The onset of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder must be before age 10 years, and the 
diagnosis should not be applied to children with a developmental age of less than 6 years. 
It is unknown whether the condition presents only in this age-delimited fashion. Because 
the symptoms of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder are likely to change as children 
mature, use of the diagnosis should be restricted to age groups similar to those in which 
validity has been established (7-18 years). Approximately half of children with severe, 
chronic irritability will have a presentation that continues to meet criteria for the condition 
1 year later. Rates of conversion from severe, nonepisodic irritability to bipolar disorder 
are very low. Instead, children with chronic irritability are at risk to develop unipolar de- 
pressive and/or anxiety disorders in adulthood. 

Age-related variations also differentiate classic bipolar disorder and disruptive mood 
dysregulation disorder. Rates of bipolar disorder generally are very low prior to adoles- 
cence (<1%), with a steady increase into early adulthood (1%-2% prevalence). Disruptive 
mood dysregulation disorder is more common than bipolar disorder prior to adolescence, 
and symptoms of the condition generally become less common as children transition into 
adulthood. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Children with chronic irritability typically exhibit complicated psy- 
chiatric histories. In such children, a relatively extensive history of chronic irritability is 


158 Depressive Disorders 


common, typically manifesting before full criteria for the syndrome are met. Such predi- 
agnostic presentations may have qualified for a diagnosis of oppositional defiant disorder. 
Many children with disruptive mood dysregulation disorder have symptoms that also 
meet criteria for attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) and for an anxiety dis- 
order, with such diagnoses often being present from a relatively early age. For some chil- 
dren, the criteria for major depressive disorder may also be met. 


Genetic and physiological. In terms of familial aggregation and genetics, it has been 
suggested that children presenting with chronic, non-episodic irritability can be differen- 
tiated from children with bipolar disorder in their family-based risk. However, these two 
groups do not differ in familial rates of anxiety disorders, unipolar depressive disorders, 
or substance abuse. Compared with children with pediatric bipolar disorder or other men- 
tal illnesses, those with disruptive mood dysregulation disorder exhibit both commonal- 
ities and differences in information-processing deficits. For example, face-emotion 
labeling deficits, as well as perturbed decision making and cognitive control, are present in 
children with bipolar disorder and chronically irritable children, as well as in children 
with some other psychiatric conditions. There is also evidence for disorder-specific dys- 
function, such as during tasks assessing attention deployment in response to emotional 
stimuli, which has demonstrated unique signs of dysfunction in children with chronic ir- 
ritability. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Children presenting to clinics with features of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder are 
predominantly male. Among community samples, a male preponderance appears to be 
supported. This difference in prevalence between males and females differentiates disrup- 
tive mood dysregulation disorder from bipolar disorder, in which there is an equal gender 
prevalence. 


Suicide Risk 


In general, evidence documenting suicidal behavior and aggression, as well as other se- 
vere functional consequences, in disruptive mood dysregulation disorder should be noted 
when evaluating children with chronic irritability. 


Functional Consequences of 
Disruptive Mood Dysregulation Disorder 


Chronic, severe irritability, such as is seen in disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, is 
associated with marked disruption in a child’s family and peer relationships, as well as in 
school performance. Because of their extremely low frustration tolerance, such children 
generally have difficulty succeeding in school; they are often unable to participate in the 
activities typically enjoyed by healthy children; their family life is severely disrupted by 
their outbursts and irritability; and they have trouble initiating or sustaining friendships. 
Levels of dysfunction in children with bipolar disorder and disruptive mood dysregulation 
disorder are generally comparable. Both conditions cause severe disruption in the lives of 
the affected individual and their families. In both disruptive mood dysregulation disorder 
and pediatric bipolar disorder, dangerous behavior, suicidal ideation or suicide attempts, 
severe aggression, and psychiatric hospitalization are common. 


Differential Diagnosis 

Because chronically irritable children and adolescents typically present with complex histo- 
ries, the diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder must be made while consid- 
ering the presence or absence of multiple other conditions. Despite the need to consider 


Disruptive Mood Dysregulation Disorder 159 


many other syndromes, differentiation of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder from bi- 
polar disorder and oppositional defiant disorder requires particularly careful assessment. 


Bipolar disorders. The central feature differentiating disruptive mood dysregulation disor- 
der and bipolar disorders in children involves the longitudinal course of the core symptoms. In 
children, as in adults, bipolar I disorder and bipolar II disorder manifest as an episodic illness 
with discrete episodes of mood perturbation that can be differentiated from the child’s typical 
presentation. The mood perturbation that occurs during a manic episode is distinctly different 
from the child’s usual mood. In addition, during a manic episode, the change in mood must be 
accompanied by the onset, or worsening, of associated cognitive, behavioral, and physical 
symptoms (e.g., distractibility, increased goal-directed activity), which are also present to a de- 
gree that is distinctly different from the child’s usual baseline. Thus, in the case of a manic ep- 
isode, parents (and, depending on developmental level, children) should be able to identify a 
distinct time period during which the child’s mood and behavior were markedly different 
from usual. In contrast, the irritability of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder is persistent 
and is present over many months; while it may wax and wane to a certain degree, severe irri- 
tability is characteristic of the child with disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. Thus, while 
bipolar disorders are episodic conditions, disruptive mood dysregulation disorder is not. In 
fact, the diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder cannot be assigned to a child 
who has ever experienced a full-duration hypomanic or manic episode (irritable or euphoric) 
or who has ever had a manic or hypomanic episode lasting more than 1 day. Another central 
differentiating feature between bipolar disorders and disruptive mood dysregulation disorder 
is the presence of elevated or expansive mood and grandiosity. These symptoms are common 
features of mania but are not characteristic of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. 


Oppositional defiant disorder. While symptoms of oppositional defiant disorder typi- 
cally do occur in children with disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, mood symptoms 
of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder are relatively rare in children with opposi- 
tional defiant disorder. The key features that warrant the diagnosis of disruptive mood 
dysregulation disorder in children whose symptoms also meet criteria for oppositional de- 
fiant disorder are the presence of severe and frequently recurrent outbursts and a persis- 
tent disruption in mood between outbursts. In addition, the diagnosis of disruptive mood 
dysregulation disorder requires severe impairment in at least one setting (i.e., home, 
school, or among peers) and mild to moderate impairment ina second setting. For this rea- 
son, while most children whose symptoms meet criteria for disruptive mood dysregula- 
tion disorder will also have a presentation that meets criteria for oppositional defiant 
disorder, the reverse is not the case. That is, in only approximately 15% of individuals with 
oppositional defiant disorder would criteria for disruptive mood dysregulation disorder 
be met. Moreover, even for children in whom criteria for both disorders are met, only the 
diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder should be made. Finally, both the 
prominent mood symptoms in disruptive mood dysregulation disorder and the high risk 
for depressive and anxiety disorders in follow-up studies justify placement of disruptive 
mood dysregulation disorder among the depressive disorders in DSM-5. (Oppositional 
defiant disorder is included in the chapter “Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct 
Disorders.”) This reflects the more prominent mood component among individuals with 
disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, as compared with individuals with oppositional 
defiant disorder. Nevertheless, it also should be noted that disruptive mood dysregulation 
disorder appears to carry a high risk for behavioral problems as well as mood problems. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, major depressive disorder, anxiety disorders, 
and autism spectrum disorder. Unlike children diagnosed with bipolar disorder or op- 
positional defiant disorder, a child whose symptoms meet criteria for disruptive mood 
dysregulation disorder also can receive a comorbid diagnosis of ADHD, major depressive 
disorder, and/or anxiety disorder. However, children whose irritability is present only in 
the context of a major depressive episode or persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia) 


160 Depressive Disorders 


should receive one of those diagnoses rather than disruptive mood dysregulation disor- 
der. Children with disruptive mood dysregulation disorder may have symptoms that also 
meet criteria for an anxiety disorder and can receive both diagnoses, but children whose ir- 
ritability is manifest only in the context of exacerbation of an anxiety disorder should re- 
ceive the relevant anxiety disorder diagnosis rather than disruptive mood dysregulation 
disorder. In addition, children with autism spectrum disorders frequently present with 
temper outbursts when, for example, their routines are disturbed. In that instance, the 
temper outbursts would be considered secondary to the autism spectrum disorder, and 
the child should not receive the diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. 


Intermittent explosive disorder. Children with symptoms suggestive of intermittent 
explosive disorder present with instances of severe temper outbursts, much like children 
with disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. However, unlike disruptive mood dysreg- 
ulation disorder, intermittent explosive disorder does not require persistent disruption in 
mood between outbursts. In addition, intermittent explosive disorder requires only 3 months 
of active symptoms, in contrast to the 12-month requirement for disruptive mood dys- 
regulation disorder. Thus, these two diagnoses should not be made in the same child. For 
children with outbursts and intercurrent, persistent irritability, only the diagnosis of dis- 
ruptive mood dysregulation disorder should be made. 


Comorbidity 


Rates of comorbidity in disruptive mood dysregulation disorder are extremely high. It is 
rare to find individuals whose symptoms meet criteria for disruptive mood dysregulation 
disorder alone. Comorbidity between disruptive mood dysregulation disorder and other 
DSM-defined syndromes appears higher than for many other pediatric mental illnesses; 
the strongest overlap is with oppositional defiant disorder. Not only is the overall rate of 
comorbidity high in disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, but also the range of comor- 
bid illnesses appears particularly diverse. These children typically present to the clinic 
with a wide range of disruptive behavior, mood, anxiety, and even autism spectrum 
symptoms and diagnoses. However, children with disruptive mood dysregulation disor- 
der should not have symptoms that meet criteria for bipolar disorder, as in that context, 
only the bipolar disorder diagnosis should be made. If children have symptoms that meet 
criteria for oppositional defiant disorder or intermittent explosive disorder and disruptive 
mood dysregulation disorder, only the diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation disor- 
der should be assigned. Also, as noted earlier, the diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregu- 
lation disorder should not be assigned if the symptoms occur only in an anxiety- 
provoking context, when the routines of a child with autism spectrum disorder or obses- 
sive-compulsive disorder are disturbed, or in the context of a major depressive episode. 


Major Depressive Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Five (or more) of the following symptoms have been present during the same 2-week 
period and represent a change from previous functioning; at least one of the symptoms 
is either (1) depressed mood or (2) loss of interest or pleasure. 

Note: Do not include symptoms that are clearly attributable to another medical condition. 


1. Depressed mood most of the day, nearly every day, as indicated by either subjec- 
tive report (e.g., feels sad, empty, hopeless) or observation made by others (e.g., 
appears tearful). (Note: In children and adolescents, can be irritable mood.) 

2. Markedly diminished interest or pleasure in all, or almost all, activities most of the 
day, nearly every day (as indicated by either subjective account or observation). 


Major Depressive Disorder 161 


3. Significant weight loss when not dieting or weight gain (e.g., a change of more than 
5% of body weight in a month), or decrease or increase in appetite nearly every day. 
(Note: In children, consider failure to make expected weight gain.) 

4. Insomnia or hypersomnia nearly every day. 

5. Psychomotor agitation or retardation nearly every day (observable by others, not 
merely subjective feelings of restlessness or being slowed down). 

6. Fatigue or loss of energy nearly every day. 

7. Feelings of worthlessness or excessive or inappropriate guilt (which may be delu- 
sional) nearly every day (not merely self-reproach or guilt about being sick). 

8. Diminished ability to think or concentrate, or indecisiveness, nearly every day (ei- 
ther by subjective account or as observed by others). 

9. Recurrent thoughts of death (not just fear of dying), recurrent suicidal ideation with- 
out a specific plan, or a suicide attempt or a specific plan for committing suicide. 


B. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

C. The episode is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance or to another 
medical condition. 

Note: Criteria A-C represent a major depressive episode. 


Note: Responses to a significant loss (e.g., bereavement, financial ruin, losses from a nat- 
ural disaster, a serious medical illness or disability) may include the feelings of intense sad- 
ness, rumination about the loss, insomnia, poor appetite, and weight loss noted in Criterion A, 
which may resemble a depressive episode. Although such symptoms may be understand- 
able or considered appropriate to the loss, the presence of a major depressive episode in 
addition to the normal response to a significant loss should also be carefully considered. This 
decision inevitably requires the exercise of clinical judgment based on the individual’s history 
and the cultural norms for the expression of distress in the context of loss. ! 


D. The occurrence of the major depressive episode is not better explained by schizoaf- 
fective disorder, schizophrenia, schizophreniform disorder, delusional disorder, or 
other specified and unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorders. 

E. There has never been a manic episode or a hypomanic episode. 

Note: This exclusion does not apply if all of the manic-like or hypomanic-like episodes 
are substance-induced or are attributable to the physiological effects of another med- 
ical condition. 


lIn distinguishing grief from a major depressive episode (MDE), it is useful to consider that in 
grief the predominant affect is feelings of emptiness and loss, while in MDE it is persistent 
depressed mood and the inability to anticipate happiness or pleasure. The dysphoria in grief is 
likely to decrease in intensity over days to weeks and occurs in waves, the so-called pangs of 
grief. These waves tend to be associated with thoughts or reminders of the deceased. The 
depressed mood of MDE is more persistent and not tied to specific thoughts or preoccupations. 
The pain of grief may be accompanied by positive emotions and humor that are uncharacteristic 
of the pervasive unhappiness and misery characteristic of MDE. The thought content associated 
with grief generally features a preoccupation with thoughts and memories of the deceased, 
rather than the self-critical or pessimistic ruminations seen in MDE. In grief, self-esteem is gener- 
ally preserved, whereas in MDE feelings of worthlessness and self-loathing are common. If self- 
derogatory ideation is present in grief, it typically involves perceived failings vis-a-vis the 
deceased (e.g., not visiting frequently enough, not telling the deceased how much he or she was 
loved). If a bereaved individual thinks about death and dying, such thoughts are generally 
focused on the deceased and possibly about “joining” the deceased, whereas in MDE such 
thoughts are focused on ending one’s own life because of feeling worthless, undeserving of life, 
or unable to cope with the pain of depression. 


162 Depressive Disorders 


Coding and Recording Procedures 

The diagnostic code for major depressive disorder is based on whether this is a single or 
recurrent episode, current severity, presence of psychotic features, and remission status. 
Current severity and psychotic features are only indicated if full criteria are currently met 
for a major depressive episode. Remission specifiers are only indicated if the full criteria 
are not currently met for a major depressive episode. Codes are as follows: 


Severity/course specifier Single episode Recurrent episode* 
Mild (p. 188) 296.21 (F32.0) 296.31 (F33.0) 
Moderate (p. 188) 296.22 (F32.1) 296.32 (F33.1) 
Severe (p. 188) 296.23 (F32.2) 296.33 (F33.2) 
With psychotic features** (p. 186) 296.24 (F32.3) 296.34 (F33.3) 

In partial remission (p. 188) 296.25 (F32.4) 296.35 (F33.41) 
In full remission (p. 188) 296.26 (F32.5) 296.36 (F33.42) 
Unspecified 296.20 (F32.9) 296.30 (F33.9) 


*For an episode to be considered recurrent, there must be an interval of at least 2 consecutive months 
between separate episodes in which criteria are not met for a major depressive episode. The defini- 
tions of specifiers are found on the indicated pages. 

“If psychotic features are present, code the “with psychotic features” specifier irrespective of epi- 
sode severity. 


In recording the name of a diagnosis, terms should be listed in the following order: major 
depressive disorder, single or recurrent episode, severity/psychotic/remission specifiers, 
followed by as many of the following specifiers without codes that apply to the current 
episode. 
Specify: 

With anxious distress (p. 184) 

With mixed features (pp. 184-185) 

With melancholic features (p. 185) 

With atypical features (pp. 185-186) 

With mood-congruent psychotic features (p. 186) 

With mood-incongruent psychotic features (p. 186) 

With catatonia (p. 186). Coding note: Use additional code 293.89 (F06.1). 

With peripartum onset (pp. 186-187) 

With seasonal pattern (recurrent episode only) (pp. 187-188) 


Diagnostic Features 


The criterion symptoms for major depressive disorder must be present nearly every day to 
be considered present, with the exception of weight change and suicidal ideation. De- 
pressed mood must be present for most of the day, in addition to being present nearly ev- 
ery day. Often insomnia or fatigue is the presenting complaint, and failure to probe for 
accompanying depressive symptoms will result in underdiagnosis. Sadness may be de- 
nied at first but may be elicited through interview or inferred from facial expression and 
demeanor. With individuals who focus on a somatic complaint, clinicians should de- 
termine whether the distress from that complaint is associated with specific depressive 
symptoms. Fatigue and sleep disturbance are present in a high proportion of cases; psy- 
chomotor disturbances are much less common but are indicative of greater overall sever- 
ity, as is the presence of delusional or near-delusional guilt. 


Major Depressive Disorder 163 


The essential feature of a major depressive episode is a period of at least 2 weeks during 
which there is either depressed mood or the loss of interest or pleasure in nearly all activi- 
ties (Criterion A). In children and adolescents, the mood may be irritable rather than sad. 
The individual must also experience at least four additional symptoms drawn from a list 
that includes changes in appetite or weight, sleep, and psychomotor activity; decreased en- 
ergy; feelings of worthlessness or guilt; difficulty thinking, concentrating, or making deci- 
sions; or recurrent thoughts of death or suicidal ideation or suicide plans or attempts. To 
count toward a major depressive episode, a symptom must either be newly present or must 
have clearly worsened compared with the person’s pre-episode status. The symptoms 
must persist for most of the day, nearly every day, for at least 2 consecutive weeks. The ep- 
isode must be accompanied by clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occu- 
pational, or other important areas of functioning. For some individuals with milder 
episodes, functioning may appear to be normal but requires markedly increased effort. 

The mood in a major depressive episode is often described by the person as depressed, 
sad, hopeless, discouraged, or “down in the dumps” (Criterion A1). In some cases, sadness 
may be denied at first but may subsequently be elicited by interview (e.g., by pointing out 
that the individual looks as if he or she is about to cry). In some individuals who complain 
of feeling “blah,” having no feelings, or feeling anxious, the presence of a depressed mood 
can be inferred from the person’s facial expression and demeanor. Some individuals em- 
phasize somatic complaints (e.g., bodily aches and pains) rather than reporting feelings of 
sadness. Many individuals report or exhibit increased irritability (e.g., persistent anger, a 
tendency to respond to events with angry outbursts or blaming others, an exaggerated 
sense of frustration over minor matters). In children and adolescents, an irritable or cranky 
mood may develop rather than a sad or dejected mood. This presentation should be dif- 
ferentiated from a pattern of irritability when frustrated. 

Loss of interest or pleasure is nearly always present, at least to some degree. Individ- 
uals may report feeling less interested in hobbies, “not caring anymore,” or not feeling any 
enjoyment in activities that were previously considered pleasurable (Criterion A2). Family 
members often notice social withdrawal or neglect of pleasurable avocations (e.g., a for- 
merly avid golfer no longer plays, a child who used to enjoy soccer finds excuses not to 
practice). In some individuals, there is a significant reduction from previous levels of sex- 
ual interest or desire. 

Appetite change may involve either a reduction or increase. Some depressed individ- 
uals report that they have to force themselves to eat. Others may eat more and may crave 
specific foods (e.g., sweets or other carbohydrates). When appetite changes are severe (in 
either direction), there may be a significant loss or gain in weight, or, in children, a failure 
to make expected weight gains may be noted (Criterion A3). 

Sleep disturbance may take the form of either difficulty sleeping or sleeping exces- 
sively (Criterion A4). When insomnia is present, it typically takes the form of middle in- 
somnia (i.e., waking up during the night and then having difficulty returning to sleep) or 
terminal insomnia (i.e., waking too early and being unable to return to sleep). Initial in- 
somnia (i.e., difficulty falling asleep) may also occur. Individuals who present with over- 
sleeping (hypersomnia) may experience prolonged sleep episodes at night or increased 
daytime sleep. Sometimes the reason that the individual seeks treatment is for the dis- 
turbed sleep. 

Psychomotor changes include agitation (e.g., the inability to sit still, pacing, hand- 
wringing; or pulling or rubbing of the skin, clothing, or other objects) or retardation (e.g., 
slowed speech, thinking, and body movements; increased pauses before answering; 
speech that is decreased in volume, inflection, amount, or variety of content, or muteness) 
(Criterion A5). The psychomotor agitation or retardation must be severe enough to be ob- 
servable by others and not represent merely subjective feelings. 

Decreased energy, tiredness, and fatigue are common (Criterion A6). A person may re- 
port sustained fatigue without physical exertion. Even the smallest tasks seem to require 


164 Depressive Disorders 


substantial effort. The efficiency with which tasks are accomplished may be reduced. For 
example, an individual may complain that washing and dressing in the morning are ex- 
hausting and take twice as long as usual. 

The sense of worthlessness or guilt associated with a major depressive episode may in- 
clude unrealistic negative evaluations of one’s worth or guilty preoccupations or rumina- 
tions over minor past failings (Criterion A7). Such individuals often misinterpret neutral 
or trivial day-to-day events as evidence of personal defects and have an exaggerated sense 
of responsibility for untoward events. The sense of worthlessness or guilt may be of delu- 
sional proportions (e.g., an individual who is convinced that he or she is personally re- 
sponsible for world poverty). Blaming oneself for being sick and for failing to meet 
occupational or interpersonal responsibilities as a result of the depression is very common 
and, unless delusional, is not considered sufficient to meet this criterion. 

Many individuals report impaired ability to think, concentrate, or make even minor 
decisions (Criterion A8). They may appear easily distracted or complain of memory diffi- 
culties. Those engaged in cognitively demanding pursuits are often unable to function. In 
children, a precipitous drop in grades may reflect poor concentration. In elderly individ- 
uals, memory difficulties may be the chief complaint and may be mistaken for early signs 
of a dementia (“pseudodementia”). When the major depressive episode is successfully 
treated, the memory problems often fully abate. However, in some individuals, particu- 
larly elderly persons, a major depressive episode may sometimes be the initial presenta- 
tion of an irreversible dementia. 

Thoughts of death, suicidal ideation, or suicide attempts (Criterion A9) are common. 
They may range from a passive wish not to awaken in the morning or a belief that others 
would be better off if the individual were dead, to transient but recurrent thoughts of com- 
mitting suicide, to a specific suicide plan. More severely suicidal individuals may have put 
their affairs in order (e.g., updated wills, settled debts), acquired needed materials (e.g., a 
rope or a gun), and chosen a location and time to accomplish the suicide. Motivations for 
suicide may include a desire to give up in the face of perceived insurmountable obstacles, 
an intense wish to end what is perceived as an unending and excruciatingly painful emo- 
tional state, an inability to foresee any enjoyment in life, or the wish to not be a burden to 
others. The resolution of such thinking may be a more meaningful measure of diminished 
suicide risk than denial of further plans for suicide. 

The evaluation of the symptoms of a major depressive episode is especially difficult 
when they occur in an individual who also has a general medical condition (e.g., cancer, 
stroke, myocardial infarction, diabetes, pregnancy). Some of the criterion signs and symp- 
toms of a major depressive episode are identical to those of general medical conditions 
(e.g., weight loss with untreated diabetes; fatigue with cancer; hypersomnia early in preg- 
nancy; insomnia later in pregnancy or the postpartum). Such symptoms count toward a 
major depressive diagnosis except when they are clearly and fully attributable to a general 
medical condition. Nonvegetative symptoms of dysphoria, anhedonia, guilt or worthless- 
ness, impaired concentration or indecision, and suicidal thoughts should be assessed with 
particular care in such cases. Definitions of major depressive episodes that have been mod- 
ified to include only these nonvegetative symptoms appear to identify nearly the same in- 
dividuals as do the full criteria. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Major depressive disorder is associated with high mortality, much of which is accounted 
for by suicide; however, it is not the only cause. For example, depressed individuals ad- 
mitted to nursing homes have a markedly increased likelihood of death in the first year. In- 
dividuals frequently present with tearfulness, irritability, brooding, obsessive rumination, 
anxiety, phobias, excessive worry over physical health, and complaints of pain (e.g., head- 
aches; joint, abdominal, or other pains). In children, separation anxiety may occur. 


Major Depressive Disorder 165 


Although an extensive literature exists describing neuroanatomical, neuroendocrino- 
logical, and neurophysiological correlates of major depressive disorder, no laboratory test 
has yielded results of sufficient sensitivity and specificity to be used as a diagnostic tool for 
this disorder. Until recently, hypothalamic-pituitary-adrenal axis hyperactivity had been 
the most extensively investigated abnormality associated with major depressive episodes, 
and it appears to be associated with melancholia, psychotic features, and risks for eventual 
suicide. Molecular studies have also implicated peripheral factors, including genetic vari- 
ants in neurotrophic factors and pro-inflammatory cytokines. Additionally, functional 
magnetic resonance imaging studies provide evidence for functional abnormalities in spe- 
cific neural systems supporting emotion processing, reward seeking, and emotion regula- 
tion in adults with major depression. 


Prevalence 


Twelve-month prevalence of major depressive disorder in the United States is approximately 
7%, with marked differences by age group such that the prevalence in 18- to 29-year-old indi- 
viduals is threefold higher than the prevalence in individuals age 60 years or older. Females ex- 
perience 1.5- to 3-fold higher rates than males beginning in early adolescence. 


Development and Course 


Major depressive disorder may first appear at any age, but the likelihood of onset in- 
creases markedly with puberty. In the United States, incidence appears to peak in the 20s; 
however, first onset in late life is not uncommon. 

The course of major depressive disorder is quite variable, such that some individuals 
rarely, if ever, experience remission (a period of 2 or more months with no symptoms, or 
only one or two symptoms to no more than a mild degree), while others experience many 
years with few or no symptoms between discrete episodes. It is important to distinguish 
individuals who present for treatment during an exacerbation of a chronic depressive ill- 
ness from those whose symptoms developed recently. Chronicity of depressive symptoms 
substantially increases the likelihood of underlying personality, anxiety, and substance 
use disorders and decreases the likelihood that treatment will be followed by full symp- 
tom resolution. It is therefore useful to ask individuals presenting with depressive symp- 
toms to identify the last period of at least 2 months during which they were entirely free of 
depressive symptoms. 

Recovery typically begins within 3 months of onset for two in five individuals with ma- 
jor depression and within 1 year for four in five individuals. Recency of onset is a strong 
determinant of the likelihood of near-term recovery, and many individuals who have been 
depressed only for several months can be expected to recover spontaneously. Features as- 
sociated with lower recovery rates, other than current episode duration, include psychotic 
features, prominent anxiety, personality disorders, and symptom severity. 

The risk of recurrence becomes progessively lower over time as the duration of re- 
mission increases. The risk is higher in individuals whose preceding episode was severe, 
in younger individuals, and in individuals who have already experienced multiple epi- 
sodes. The persistence of even mild depressive symptoms during remission is a powerful 
predictor of recurrence. 

Many bipolar illnesses begin with one or more depressive episodes, and a substantial 
proportion of individuals who initially appear to have major depressive disorder will 
prove, in time, to instead have a bipolar disorder. This is more likely in individuals with 
onset of the illness in adolescence, those with psychotic features, and those with a family 
history of bipolar illness. The presence of a “with mixed features” specifier also increases 
the risk for future manic or hypomanic diagnosis. Major depressive disorder, particularly 
with psychotic features, may also transition into schizophrenia, a change that is much 
more frequent than the reverse. 


166 Depressive Disorders 


Despite consistent differences between genders in prevalence rates for depressive disor- 
ders, there appear to be no clear differences by gender in phenomenology, course, or treat- 
ment response. Similarly, there are no clear effects of current age on the course or treatment 
response of major depressive disorder. Some symptom differences exist, though, such that 
hypersomnia and hyperphagia are more likely in younger individuals, and melancholic 
symptoms, particularly psychomotor disturbances, are more common in older individuals. 
The likelihood of suicide attempts lessens in middle and late life, although the risk of com- 
pleted suicide does not. Depressions with earlier ages at onset are more familial and more 
likely to involve personality disturbances. The course of major depressive disorder within 
individuals does not generally change with aging. Mean times to recovery appear to be sta- 
ble over long periods, and the likelihood of being in an episode does not generally increase 
or decrease with time. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Neuroticism (negative affectivity) is a well-established risk factor for the 
onset of major depressive disorder, and high levels appear to render individuals more likely 
to develop depressive episodes in response to stressful life events. 


Environmental. Adverse childhood experiences, particularly when there are multiple 
experiences of diverse types, constitute a set of potent risk factors for major depressive dis- 
order. Stressful life events are well recognized as precipitants of major depressive epi- 
sodes, but the presence or absence of adverse life events near the onset of episodes does 
not appear to provide a useful guide to prognosis or treatment selection. 


Genetic and physiological. First-degree family members of individuals with major de- 
pressive disorder have a risk for major depressive disorder two- to fourfold higher than 
that of the general population. Relative risks appear to be higher for early-onset and re- 
current forms. Heritability is approximately 40%, and the personality trait neuroticism ac- 
counts for a substantial portion of this genetic liability. 


Course modifiers. Essentially all major nonmood disorders increase the risk of an indi- 
vidual developing depression. Major depressive episodes that develop against the back- 
ground of another disorder often follow a more refractory course. Substance use, anxiety, 
and borderline personality disorders are among the most common of these, and the pre- 
senting depressive symptoms may obscure and delay their recognition. However, sus- 
tained clinical improvement in depressive symptoms may depend on the appropriate 
treatment of underlying illnesses. Chronic or disabling medical conditions also increase 
risks for major depressive episodes. Such prevalent illnesses as diabetes, morbid obesity, 
and cardiovascular disease are often complicated by depressive episodes, and these epi- 
sodes are more likely to become chronic than are depressive episodes in medically healthy 
individuals. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Surveys of major depressive disorder across diverse cultures have shown sevenfold dif- 
ferences in 12-month prevalence rates but much more consistency in female-to-male ratio, 
mean ages at onset, and the degree to which presence of the disorder raises the likelihood 
of comorbid substance abuse. While these findings suggest substantial cultural differences 
in the expression of major depressive disorder, they do not permit simple linkages be- 
tween particular cultures and the likelihood of specific symptoms. Rather, clinicians 
should be aware that in most countries the majority of cases of depression go unrecog- 
nized in primary care settings and that in many cultures, somatic symptoms are very likely 
to constitute the presenting complaint. Among the Criterion A symptoms, insomnia and 
loss of energy are the most uniformly reported. 


Major Depressive Disorder 167 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Although the most reproducible finding in the epidemiology of major depressive disorder 
has been a higher prevalence in females, there are no clear differences between genders in 
symptoms, course, treatment response, or functional consequences. In women, the risk for 
suicide attempts is higher, and the risk for suicide completion is lower. The disparity in 
suicide rate by gender is not as great among those with depressive disorders as it is in the 
population as a whole. 


Suicide Risk 


The possibility of suicidal behavior exists at all times during major depressive episodes. 
The most consistently described risk factor is a past history of suicide attempts or threats, 
but it should be remembered that most completed suicides are not preceded by unsuccess- 
ful attempts. Other features associated with an increased risk for completed suicide 
include male sex, being single or living alone, and having prominent feelings of hopeless- 
ness. The presence of borderline personality disorder markedly increases risk for future 
suicide attempts. 


Functional Consequences of 
Major Depressive Disorder 


Many of the functional consequences of major depressive disorder derive from individual 
symptoms. Impairment can be very mild, such that many of those who interact with the af- 
fected individual are unaware of depressive symptoms. Impairment may, however, range 
to complete incapacity such that the depressed individual is unable to attend to basic self- 
care needs or is mute or catatonic. Among individuals seen in general medical settings, 
those with major depressive disorder have more pain and physical illness and greater de- 
creases in physical, social, and role functioning. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Manic episodes with irritable mood or mixed episodes. Major depressive episodes 
with prominent irritable mood may be difficult to distinguish from manic episodes with 
irritable mood or from mixed episodes. This distinction requires a careful clinical evalua- 
tion of the presence of manic symptoms. 


Mood disorder due to another medical condition. A major depressive episode is the 
appropriate diagnosis if the mood disturbance is not judged, based on individual history, 
physical examination, and laboratory findings, to be the direct pathophysiological conse- 
quence of a specific medical condition (e.g., multiple sclerosis, stroke, hypothyroidism). 


Substance/medication-induced depressive or bipolar disorder. This disorder is distin- 
guished from major depressive disorder by the fact that a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, 
a medication, a toxin) appears to be etiologically related to the mood disturbance. For ex- 
ample, depressed mood that occurs only in the context of withdrawal from cocaine would 
be diagnosed as cocaine-induced depressive disorder. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Distractibility and low frustration tolerance 
can occur in both attention-deficit/ hyperactivity disorder and a major depressive epi- 
sode; if the criteria are met for both, attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder may be diag- 
nosed in addition to the mood disorder. However, the clinician must be cautious not to 
overdiagnose a major depressive episode in children with attention-deficit/hyperactivity 
disorder whose disturbance in mood is characterized by irritability rather than by sadness 
or loss of interest. 


168 Depressive Disorders 


Adjustment disorder with depressed mood. A major depressive episode that occurs in 
response to a psychosocial stressor is distinguished from adjustment disorder with de- 
pressed mood by the fact that the full criteria for a major depressive episode are not met in 
adjustment disorder. 

Sadness. Finally, periods of sadness are inherent aspects of the human experience. 
These periods should not be diagnosed as a major depressive episode unless criteria are 
met for severity (i.e., five out of nine symptoms), duration (i.e., most of the day, nearly ev- 
ery day for at least 2 weeks), and clinically significant distress or impairment. The diagno- 
sis other specified depressive disorder may be appropriate for presentations of depressed 
mood with clinically significant impairment that do not meet criteria for duration or se- 
verity. 


Comorbidity 

Other disorders with which major depressive disorder frequently co-occurs are substance- 
related disorders, panic disorder, obsessive-compulsive disorder, anorexia nervosa, buli- 
mia nervosa, and borderline personality disorder. 


Persistent Depressive Disorder (Dysthymia) 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.4 (F34.1) 


This disorder represents a consolidation of DSM-IV-defined chronic major depressive dis- 

order and dysthymic disorder. 

A. Depressed mood for most of the day, for more days than not, as indicated by either 
subjective account or observation by others, for at least 2 years. 
Note: In children and adolescents, mood can be irritable and duration must be at least 
1 year. 


B. Presence, while depressed, of two (or more) of the following: 


Poor appetite or overeating. 

Insomnia or hypersomnia. 

Low energy or fatigue. 

Low self-esteem. 

Poor concentration or difficulty making decisions. 
Feelings of hopelessness. 


QOahowh = 


C. During the 2-year period (1 year for children or adolescents) of the disturbance, the individ- 
ual has never been without the symptoms in Criteria A and B for more than 2 months at a 
time. 

D. Criteria for a major depressive disorder may be continuously present for 2 years. 

E. There has never been a manic episode or a hypomanic episode, and criteria have 
never been met for cyclothymic disorder. 

F. The disturbance is not better explained by a persistent schizoaffective disorder, 
schizophrenia, delusional disorder, or other specified or unspecified schizophrenia 
spectrum and other psychotic disorder. 

G. The symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition (e.g. hypothyroidism). 

H. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, 
or other important areas of functioning. 


Note: Because the criteria for a major depressive episode include four symptoms that are 
absent from the symptom list for persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia), a very limited 


Persistent Depressive Disorder (Dysthymia) 169 


number of individuals will have depressive symptoms that have persisted longer than 2 years 
but will not meet criteria for persistent depressive disorder. If full criteria for a major de- 
pressive episode have been met at some point during the current episode of illness, they 
should be given a diagnosis of major depressive disorder. Otherwise, a diagnosis of other 
specified depressive disorder or unspecified depressive disorder is warranted. 
Specify if: 

With anxious distress (p. 184) 

With mixed features (pp. 184-185) 

With melancholic features (p. 185) 

With atypical features (pp. 185-186) 

With mood-congruent psychotic features (p. 186) 

With mood-incongruent psychotic features (p. 186) 

With peripartum onset (pp. 186-187) 
Specify if: 

In partial remission (p. 188) 

In full remission (p. 188) 
Specify if: 

Early onset: If onset is before age 21 years. 

Late onset: If onset is at age 21 years or older. 


Specify if (for most recent 2 years of persistent depressive disorder): 
With pure dysthymic syndrome: Full criteria for a major depressive episode have not 
been met in at least the preceding 2 years. 
With persistent major depressive episode: Full criteria for a major depressive epi- 
sode have been met throughout the preceding 2-year period. 
With intermittent major depressive episodes, with current episode: Full criteria for 
a major depressive episode are currently met, but there have been periods of at least 
8 weeks in at least the preceding 2 years with symptoms below the threshold for a full 
major depressive episode. 
With intermittent major depressive episodes, without current episode: Full crite- 
ria for a major depressive episode are not currently met, but there has been one or 
more major depressive episodes in at least the preceding 2 years. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild (p. 188) 
Moderate (p. 188) 
Severe (p. 188) 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia) is a depressed mood 
that occurs for most of the day, for more days than not, for at least 2 years, or at least 1 year 
for children and adolescents (Criterion A). This disorder represents a consolidation of 
DSM-IV-defined chronic major depressive disorder and dysthymic disorder. Major de- 
pression may precede persistent depressive disorder, and major depressive episodes may 
occur during persistent depressive disorder. Individuals whose symptoms meet major de- 
pressive disorder criteria for 2 years should be given a diagnosis of persistent depressive 
disorder as well as major depressive disorder. 

Individuals with persistent depressive disorder describe their mood as sad or “down 
in the dumps.” During periods of depressed mood, at least two of the six symptoms from 
Criterion B are present. Because these symptoms have become a part of the individual’s 
day-to-day experience, particularly in the case of early onset (e.g., “I’ve always been this 


170 Depressive Disorders 


way”), they may not be reported unless the individual is directly prompted. During the 2-year 
period (1 year for children or adolescents), any symptom-free intervals last no longer than 
2 months (Criterion C). 


Prevalence 


Persistent depressive disorder is effectively an amalgam of DSM-IV dysthymic disorder and 
chronic major depressive episode. The 12-month prevalence in the United States is approxi- 
mately 0.5% for persistent depressive disorder and 1.5% for chronic major depressive disorder. 


Development and Course 


Persistent depressive disorder often has an early and insidious onset (i.e., in childhood, 
adolescence, or early adult life) and, by definition, a chronic course. Among individuals 
with both persistent depressive disorder and borderline personality disorder, the covari- 
ance of the corresponding features over time suggests the operation of a common mecha- 
nism. Early onset (i.e., before age 21 years) is associated with a higher likelihood of 
comorbid personality disorders and substance use disorders. 

When symptoms rise to the level of a major depressive episode, they are likely to sub- 
sequently revert to a lower level. However, depressive symptoms are much less likely to 
resolve in a given period of time in the context of persistent depressive disorder than they 
are in a major depressive episode. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Factors predictive of poorer long-term outcome include higher levels 
of neuroticism (negative affectivity), greater symptom severity, poorer global functioning, 
and presence of anxiety disorders or conduct disorder. 


Environmental. Childhood risk factors include parental loss or separation. 


Genetic and physiological. There are no clear differences in illness development, course, 
or family history between DSM-IV dysthymic disorder and chronic major depressive dis- 
order. Earlier findings pertaining to either disorder are therefore likely to apply to per- 
sistent depressive disorder. It is thus likely that individuals with persistent depressive 
disorder will have a higher proportion of first-degree relatives with persistent depressive 
disorder than do individuals with major depressive disorder, and more depressive disor- 
ders in general. 

A number of brain regions (e.g., prefrontal cortex, anterior cingulate, amygdala, hip- 
pocampus) have been implicated in persistent depressive disorder. Possible polysomno- 
graphic abnormalities exist as well. 


Functional Consequences of 
Persistent Depressive Disorder 


The degree to which persistent depressive disorder impacts social and occupational func- 
tioning is likely to vary widely, but effects can be as great as or greater than those of major 
depressive disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Major depressive disorder. If there is a depressed mood plus two or more symptoms 
meeting criteria for a persistent depressive episode for 2 years or more, then the diagnosis of 
persistent depressive disorder is made. The diagnosis depends on the 2-year duration, 
which distinguishes it from episodes of depression that do not last 2 years. If the symptom 


Premenstrual Dysphoric Disorder 171 


criteria are sufficient for a diagnosis of a major depressive episode at any time during this pe- 
riod, then the diagnosis of major depression should be noted, but it is coded not as a separate 
diagnosis but rather as a specifier with the diagnosis of persistent depressive disorder. If the 
individual’s symptoms currently meet full criteria for a major depressive episode, then the 
specifier of “with intermittent major depressive episodes, with current episode” would be 
made. If the major depressive episode has persisted for at least a 2-year duration and re- 
mains present, then the specifier “with persistent major depressive episode” is used. When 
full major depressive episode criteria are not currently met but there has been at least one 
previous episode of major depression in the context of at least 2 years of persistent depres- 
sive symptoms, then the specifier of “with intermittent major depressive episodes, without 
current episode” is used. If the individual has not experienced an episode of major depres- 
sion in the last 2 years, then the specifier “with pure dysthymic syndrome” is used. 


Psychotic disorders. Depressive symptoms are a common associated feature of chronic 
psychotic disorders (e.g., schizoaffective disorder, schizophrenia, delusional disorder). A 
separate diagnosis of persistent depressive disorder is not made if the symptoms occur 
only during the course of the psychotic disorder (including residual phases). 


Depressive or bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition. Persistent 
depressive disorder must be distinguished from a depressive or bipolar and related dis- 
order due to another medical condition. The diagnosis is depressive or bipolar and related 
disorder due to another medical condition if the mood disturbance is judged, based on his- 
tory, physical examination, or laboratory findings, to be attributable to the direct patho- 
physiological effects of a specific, usually chronic, medical condition (e.g., multiple 
sclerosis). If it is judged that the depressive symptoms are not attributable to the physiolog- 
ical effects of another medical condition, then the primary mental disorder (e.g., persistent 
depressive disorder) is recorded, and the medical condition is noted as a concomitant med- 
ical condition (e.g., diabetes mellitus). 


Substance/medication-induced depressive or bipolar disorder. A substance/medi- 
cation-induced depressive or bipolar and related disorder is distinguished from persis- 
tent depressive disorder when a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication, a toxin) is 
judged to be etiologically related to the mood disturbance. 


Personality disorders. Often, there is evidence of a coexisting personality disturbance. 


When an individual’s presentation meets the criteria for both persistent depressive disor- 
der and a personality disorder, both diagnoses are given. 


Comorbidity 

In comparison to individuals with major depressive disorder, those with persistent de- 
pressive disorder are at higher risk for psychiatric comorbidity in general, and for anxiety 
disorders and substance use disorders in particular. Early-onset persistent depressive dis- 
order is strongly associated with DSM-IV Cluster B and C personality disorders. 


Premenstrual Dysphoric Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 625.4 (N94.3) 


A. In the majority of menstrual cycles, at least five symptoms must be present in the final 
week before the onset of menses, start to improve within a few days after the onset of 
menses, and become minimal or absent in the week postmenses. 

B. One (or more) of the following symptoms must be present: 


1. Marked affective lability (e.g., mood swings; feeling suddenly sad or tearful, or in- 
creased sensitivity to rejection). 


172 Depressive Disorders 


2. Marked irritability or anger or increased interpersonal conflicts. 
3. Marked depressed mood, feelings of hopelessness, or self-deprecating thoughts. 
4. Marked anxiety, tension, and/or feelings of being keyed up or on edge. 
C. One (or more) of the following symptoms must additionally be present, to reach a total 
of five symptoms when combined with symptoms from Criterion B above. 
Decreased interest in usual activities (e.g., work, school, friends, hobbies). 
Subjective difficulty in concentration. 
Lethargy, easy fatigability, or marked lack of energy. 
Marked change in appetite; overeating; or specific food cravings. 
Hypersomnia or insomnia. 
A sense of being overwhelmed or out of control. 
Physical symptoms such as breast tenderness or swelling, joint or muscle pain, a 
sensation of “bloating,” or weight gain. 


DO OUR Gas IN 


Note: The symptoms in Criteria A-C must have been met for most menstrual cycles that 
occurred in the preceding year. 


D. The symptoms are associated with clinically significant distress or interference with 
work, school, usual social activities, or relationships with others (e.g., avoidance of so- 
cial activities; decreased productivity and efficiency at work, school, or home). 

E. The disturbance is not merely an exacerbation of the symptoms of another disorder, 
such as major depressive disorder, panic disorder, persistent depressive disorder 
(dysthymia), or a personality disorder (although it may co-occur with any of these dis- 
orders). 

F. Criterion A should be confirmed by prospective daily ratings during at least two symptom- 
atic cycles. (Note: The diagnosis may be made provisionally prior to this confirmation.) 

G. The symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication, other treatment) or another medical condition (e.g., hy- 
perthyroidism). 


Recording Procedures 


If symptoms have not been confirmed by prospective daily ratings of at least two symp- 
tomatic cycles, “provisional” should be noted after the name of the diagnosis (i.e., “pre- 
menstrual dysphoric disorder, provisional”). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of premenstrual dysphoric disorder are the expression of mood la- 
bility, irritability, dysphoria, and anxiety symptoms that occur repeatedly during the pre- 
menstrual phase of the cycle and remit around the onset of menses or shortly thereafter. 
These symptoms may be accompanied by behavioral and physical symptoms. Symptoms 
must have occurred in most of the menstrual cycles during the past year and must have an 
adverse effect on work or social functioning. The intensity and/or expressivity of the ac- 
companying symptoms may be closely related to social and cultural background charac- 
teristics of the affected female, family perspectives, and more specific factors such as 
religious beliefs, social tolerance, and female gender role issues. 

Typically, symptoms peak around the time of the onset of menses. Although it is not 
uncommon for symptoms to linger into the first few days of menses, the individual must 
have a symptom-free period in the follicular phase after the menstrual period begins. 
While the core symptoms include mood and anxiety symptoms, behavioral and somatic 
symptoms commonly also occur. However, the presence of physical and/or behavioral 
symptoms in the absence of mood and/or anxious symptoms is not sufficient for a diag- 


Premenstrual Dysphoric Disorder 173 


nosis. Symptoms are of comparable severity (but not duration) to those of another mental 
disorder, such as a major depressive episode or generalized anxiety disorder. In order to 
confirm a provisional diagnosis, daily prospective symptom ratings are required for at 
least two symptomatic cycles. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Delusions and hallucinations have been described in the late luteal phase of the menstrual 
cycle but are rare. The premenstrual phase has been considered by some to be a risk period 
for suicide. 


Prevalence 


Twelve-month prevalence of premenstrual dysphoric disorder is between 1.8% and 5.8% 
of menstruating women. Estimates are substantially inflated if they are based on retro- 
spective reports rather than prospective daily ratings. However, estimated prevalence 
based on a daily record of symptoms for 1-2 months may be less representative, as indi- 
viduals with the most severe symptoms may be unable to sustain the rating process. The 
most rigorous estimate of premenstrual dysphoric disorder is 1.8% for women whose 
symptoms meet the full criteria without functional impairment and 1.3% for women 
whose symptoms meet the current criteria with functional impairment and without co-oc- 
curring symptoms from another mental disorder. 


Development and Course 


Onset of premenstrual dysphoric disorder can occur at any point after menarche. Inci- 
dence of new cases over a 40-month follow-up period is 2.5% (95% confidence interval = 
1.7-3.7). Anecdotally, many individuals, as they approach menopause, report that symp- 
toms worsen. Symptoms cease after menopause, although cyclical hormone replacement 
can trigger the re-expression of symptoms. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Environmental factors associated with the expression of premenstrual 
dysphoric disorder include stress, history of interpersonal trauma, seasonal changes, and 
sociocultural aspects of female sexual behavior in general, and female gender role in par- 
ticular. 


Genetic and physiological. Heritability of premenstrual dysphoric disorder is unknown. 
However, for premenstrual symptoms, estimates for heritability range between 30% and 
80%, with the most stable component of premenstrual symptoms estimated to be about 
50% heritable. 


Course modifiers. Women who use oral contraceptives may have fewer premenstrual 
complaints than do women who do not use oral contraceptives. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 

Premenstrual dysphoric disorder is not a culture-bound syndrome and has been observed 
in individuals in the United States, Europe, India, and Asia. It is unclear as to whether rates 
differ by race. Nevertheless, frequency, intensity, and expressivity of symptoms and help- 
seeking patterns may be significantly influenced by cultural factors. 


Diagnostic Markers 


As indicated earlier, the diagnosis of premenstrual dysphoric disorder is appropriately 
confirmed by 2 months of prospective symptom ratings. A number of scales, including the 


174 Depressive Disorders 


Daily Rating of Severity of Problems and the Visual Analogue Scales for Premenstrual 
Mood Symptoms, have undergone validation and are commonly used in clinical trials for 
premenstrual dysphoric disorder. The Premenstrual Tension Syndrome Rating Scale has a 
self-report and an observer version, both of which have been validated and used widely to 
measure illness severity in women who have premenstrual dysphoric disorder. 


Functional Consequences of 
Premenstrual Dysphoric Disorder 


Symptoms must be associated with clinically meaningful distress and/or an obvious and 
marked impairment in the ability to function socially or occupationally in the week prior 
to menses. Impairment in social functioning may be manifested by marital discord and 
problems with children, other family members, or friends. Chronic marital or job prob- 
lems should not be confused with dysfunction that occurs only in association with pre- 
menstrual dysphoric disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Premenstrual syndrome. Premenstrual syndrome differs from premenstrual dysphoric 
disorder in that a minimum of five symptoms is not required, and there is no stipulation of 
affective symptoms for individuals who have premenstrual syndrome. This condition 
may be more common than premenstrual dysphoric disorder, although the estimated 
prevalence of premenstrual syndrome varies. While premenstrual syndrome shares the 
feature of symptom expression during the premenstrual phase of the menstrual cycle, it is 
generally considered to be less severe than premenstrual dysphoric disorder. The pres- 
ence of physical or behavioral symptoms in the premenstruum, without the required 
affective symptoms, likely meets criteria for premenstrual syndrome and not for premen- 
strual dysphoric disorder. 


Dysmenorrhea. Dysmenorrhea is a syndrome of painful menses, but this is distinct from a 
syndrome characterized by affective changes. Moreover, symptoms of dysmenorrhea begin 
with the onset of menses, whereas symptoms of premenstrual dysphoric disorder, by defini- 
tion, begin before the onset of menses, even if they linger into the first few days of menses. 


Bipolar disorder, major depressive disorder, and persistent depressive disorder 
(dysthymia). Many women with (either naturally occurring or substance /medication- 
induced) bipolar or major depressive disorder or persistent depressive disorder believe 
that they have premenstrual dysphoric disorder. However, when they chart symptoms, 
they realize that the symptoms do not follow a premenstrual pattern. Women with an- 
other mental disorder may experience chronic symptoms or intermittent symptoms that 
are unrelated to menstrual cycle phase. However, because the onset of menses constitutes 
a memorable event, they may report that symptoms occur only during the premenstruum 
or that symptoms worsen premenstrually. This is one of the rationales for the requirement 
that symptoms be confirmed by daily prospective ratings. The process of differential di- 
agnosis, particularly if the clinician relies on retrospective symptoms only, is made more 
difficult because of the overlap between symptoms of premenstrual dysphoric disorder 
and some other diagnoses. The overlap of symptoms is particularly salient for differenti- 
ating premenstrual dysphoric disorder from major depressive episodes, persistent de- 
pressive disorder, bipolar disorders, and borderline personality disorder. However, the 
rate of personality disorders is no higher in individuals with premenstrual dysphoric dis- 
order than in those without the disorder. 


Use of hormonal treatments. Some women who present with moderate to severe pre- 
menstrual symptoms may be using hormonal treatments, including hormonal contracep- 
tives. If such symptoms occur after initiation of exogenous hormone use, the symptoms 


Substance/Medication-Induced Depressive Disorder 175 


may be due to the use of hormones rather than to the underlying condition of premen- 
strual dysphoric disorder. If the woman stops hormones and the symptoms disappear, 
this is consistent with substance /medication-induced depressive disorder. 


Comorbidity 


A major depressive episode is the most frequently reported previous disorder in individuals 
presenting with premenstrual dysphoric disorder. A wide range of medical (e.g., migraine, 
asthma, allergies, seizure disorders) or other mental disorders (e.g., depressive and bipolar 
disorders, anxiety disorders, bulimia nervosa, substance use disorders) may worsen in the 
premenstrual phase; however, the absence of a symptom-free period during the postmen- 
strual interval obviates a diagnosis of premenstrual dysphoric disorder. These conditions 
are better considered premenstrual exacerbation of a current mental or medical disorder. Al- 
though the diagnosis of premenstrual dysphoric disorder should not be assigned in situa- 
tions in which an individual only experiences a premenstrual exacerbation of another 
mental or physical disorder, it can be considered in addition to the diagnosis of another men- 
tal or physical disorder if the individual experiences symptoms and changes in level of func- 
tioning that are characteristic of premenstrual dysphoric disorder and markedly different 
from the symptoms experienced as part of the ongoing disorder. 


Substance/Medication-Induced 
Depressive Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A prominent and persistent disturbance in mood that predominates in the clinical pic- 
ture and is characterized by depressed mood or markedly diminished interest or plea- 
sure in all, or almost all, activities. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of both 
(1) and (2): 


1. The symptoms in Criterion A developed during or soon after substance intoxication 
or withdrawal or after exposure to a medication. 

2. The involved substance/medication is capable of producing the symptoms in Crite- 
rion A. 


C. The disturbance is not better explained by a depressive disorder that is not substance/ 
medication-induced. Such evidence of an independent depressive disorder could in- 
clude the following: 


The symptoms preceded the onset of the substance/medication use; the symptoms 
persist for a substantial period of time (e.g., about 1 month) after the cessation of acute 
withdrawal or severe intoxication; or there is other evidence suggesting the existence 
of an independent non-substance/medication-induced depressive disorder (e.g., a his- 
tory of recurrent non-substance/medication-related episodes). 


D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

Note: This diagnosis should be made instead of a diagnosis of substance intoxication or 
substance withdrawal only when the symptoms in Criterion A predominate in the clinical 
picture and when they are sufficiently severe to warrant clinical attention. 

Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance/medica- 
tion]-induced depressive disorders are indicated in the table below. Note that the ICD-10- 


176 Depressive Disorders 


CM code depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance use disorder present for 
the same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance- 
induced depressive disorder, the 4th position character is “1,” and the clinician should record 
“mild [substance] use disorder’ before the substance-induced depressive disorder (e.g., 
“mild cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced depressive disorder’). If a moderate or se- 
vere substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance-induced depressive disorder, 
the 4th position character is “2,” and the clinician should record “moderate [substance] use 
disorder’ or “severe [substance] use disorder,” depending on the severity of the comorbid 
substance use disorder. If there is no comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one- 
time heavy use of the substance), then the 4th position character is “9,” and the clinician should 
record only the substance-induced depressive disorder. 


ICD-10-CM 
With use 
With use disorder, Without 
disorder, moderate use 
ICD-9-CM mild or severe disorder 

Alcohol 291.89 F10.14 F10.24 F10.94 
Phencyclidine 292.84 F16.14 F16.24 F16.94 
Other hallucinogen 292.84 F16.14 F16.24 F16.94 
Inhalant 292.84 F18.14 F18.24 F18.94 
Opioid 292.84 F11.14 F11.24 F11.94 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 292.84 F13.14 F13.24 F13.94 
Amphetamine (or other 292.84 F15.14 F15.24 F15.94 
stimulant) 
Cocaine 292.84 F14.14 F14.24 F14.94 
Other (or unknown) substance 292.84 F19.14 F19.24 F19.94 


Specify if (see Table 1 in the chapter “Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders” for di- 
agnoses associated with substance class): 
With onset during intoxication: If criteria are met for intoxication with the substance 
and the symptoms develop during intoxication. 
With onset during withdrawal: If criteria are met for withdrawal from the substance 
and the symptoms develop during, or shortly after, withdrawal. 


Recording Procedures 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced depressive disorder begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, dexamethasone) that is presumed to be causing 
the depressive symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the 
criteria set, which is based on the drug class. For substances that do not fit into any of the 
classes (e.g., dexamethasone), the code for “other substance” should be used; and in cases 
in which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance 
is unknown, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder is followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during in- 
toxication, onset during withdrawal). Unlike the recording procedures for ICD-10-CM, 
which combine the substance-induced disorder and substance use disorder into a single 


Substance/Medication-Induced Depressive Disorder 177 


code, for ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is given for the substance use disorder. For 
example, in the case of depressive symptoms occurring during withdrawal in a man with 
a severe cocaine use disorder, the diagnosis is 292.84 cocaine-induced depressive disorder, 
with onset during withdrawal. An additional diagnosis of 304.20 severe cocaine use dis- 
order is also given. When more than one substance is judged to play a significant role in 
the development of depressive mood symptoms, each should be listed separately (e.g., 
292.84 methylphenidate-induced depressive disorder, with onset during withdrawal; 
292.84 dexamethasone-induced depressive disorder, with onset during intoxication). 


ICD-10-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced depressive disorder begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, dexamethasone) that is presumed to be causing 
the depressive symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the 
criteria set, which is based on the drug class and presence or absence of a comorbid sub- 
stance use disorder. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., dexameth- 
asone), the code for “other substance” should be used; and in cases in which a substance is 
judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance is unknown, the category 
“anknown substance” should be used. 

When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) is 
listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the substance-induced de- 
pressive disorder, followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during intoxication, onset 
during withdrawal). For example, in the case of depressive symptoms occurring during with- 
drawal in a man with a severe cocaine use disorder, the diagnosis is F14.24 severe cocaine use 
disorder with cocaine-induced depressive disorder, with onset during withdrawal. A separate 
diagnosis of the comorbid severe cocaine use disorder is not given. If the substance-induced 
depressive disorder occurs without a comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one-time 
heavy use of the substance), no accompanying substance use disorder is noted (e.g., F16.94 
phencyclidine-induced depressive disorder, with onset during intoxication). When more than 
one substance is judged to play a significant role in the development of depressive mood 
symptoms, each should be listed separately (e.g., F15.24 severe methylphenidate use disorder 
with methylphenidate-induced depressive disorder, with onset during withdrawal; F19.94 
dexamethasone-induced depressive disorder, with onset during intoxication). 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic features of substance /medication-induced depressive disorder include the 
symptoms of a depressive disorder, such as major depressive disorder; however, the de- 
pressive symptoms are associated with the ingestion, injection, or inhalation of a sub- 
stance (e.g., drug of abuse, toxin, psychotropic medication, other medication), and the 
depressive symptoms persist beyond the expected length of physiological effects, intoxi- 
cation, or withdrawal period. As evidenced by clinical history, physical examination, or 
laboratory findings, the relevant depressive disorder should have developed during or 
within 1 month after use of a substance that is capable of producing the depressive disor- 
der (Criterion B1). In addition, the diagnosis is not better explained by an independent 
depressive disorder. Evidence of an independent depressive disorder includes the de- 
pressive disorder preceded the onset of ingestion or withdrawal from the substance; the 
depressive disorder persists beyond a substantial period of time after the cessation of sub- 
stance use; or other evidence suggests the existence of an independent non-substance/ 
medication-induced depressive disorder (Criterion C). This diagnosis should not be made 
when symptoms occur exclusively during the course of a delirium (Criterion D). The de- 
pressive disorder associated with the substance use, intoxication, or withdrawal must 
cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other impor- 
tant areas of functioning to qualify for this diagnosis (Criterion E). 

Some medications (e.g., stimulants, steroids, L-dopa, antibiotics, central nervous 
system drugs, dermatological agents, chemotherapeutic drugs, immunological agents) 


178 Depressive Disorders 


can induce depressive mood disturbances. Clinical judgment is essential to determine 
whether the medication is truly associated with inducing the depressive disorder or 
whether a primary depressive disorder happened to have its onset while the person was 
receiving the treatment. For example, a depressive episode that developed within the first 
several weeks of beginning alpha-methyldopa (an antihypertensive agent) in an individ- 
ual with no history of major depressive disorder would qualify for the diagnosis of med- 
ication-induced depressive disorder. In some cases, a previously established condition 
(e.g., major depressive disorder, recurrent) can recur while the individual is coincidentally 
taking a medication that has the capacity to cause depressive symptoms (e.g., L-dopa, oral 
contraceptives). In such cases, the clinician must make a judgment as to whether the med- 
ication is causative in this particular situation. 

A substance/medication-induced depressive disorder is distinguished from a primary 
depressive disorder by considering the onset, course, and other factors associated with the 
substance use. There must be evidence from the history, physical examination, or labora- 
tory findings of substance use, abuse, intoxication, or withdrawal prior to the onset of the 
depressive disorder. The withdrawal state for some substances can be relatively pro- 
tracted, and thus intense depressive symptoms can last for a long period after the cessation 
of substance use. 


Prevalence 


Ina nationally representative U.S. adult population, the lifetime prevalence of substance / 
medication-induced depressive disorder is 0.26%. 


Development and Course 


A depressive disorder associated with the use of substance (i.e., alcohol, illicit drugs, or a 
prescribed treatment for a mental disorder or another medical condition) must have its on- 
set while the individual is using the substance or during withdrawal, if there is a with- 
drawal syndrome associated with the substance. Most often, the depressive disorder has 
its onset within the first few weeks or 1 month of use of the substance. Once the substance 
is discontinued, the depressive symptoms usually remit within days to several weeks, de- 
pending on the half-life of the substance/medication and the presence of a withdrawal 
syndrome. If symptoms persist 4 weeks beyond the expected time course of withdrawal of 
a particular substance/ medication, other causes for the depressive mood symptoms 
should be considered. 

Although there are a few prospective controlled trials examining the association of de- 
pressive symptoms with use of a medication, most reports are from postmarketing sur- 
veillance studies, retrospective observational studies, or case reports, making evidence of 
causality difficult to determine. Substances implicated in medication-induced depressive 
disorder, with varying degrees of evidence, include antiviral agents (efavirenz), cardio- 
vascular agents (clonidine, guanethidine, methyldopa, reserpine), retinoic acid deriva- 
tives (isotretinoin), antidepressants, anticonvulsants, anti-migraine agents (triptans), 
antipsychotics, hormonal agents (corticosteroids, oral contraceptives, gonadotropin- 
releasing hormone agonists, tamoxifen), smoking cessation agents (varenicline), and im- 
munological agents (interferon). However, other potential substances continue to emerge 
as new compounds are synthesized. A history of such substance use may help increase di- 
agnostic certainty. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Factors that appear to increase the risk of substance /medication- 
induced depressive disorder can be conceptualized as pertaining to the specific type of 
drug or to a group of individuals with underlying alcohol or drug use disorders. Risk fac- 


Substance/Medication-Induced Depressive Disorder 179 


tors common to all drugs include history of major depressive disorder, history of drug- 
induced depression, and psychosocial stressors. 


Environmental. There are also risks factors pertaining to a specific type of medication 
(e.g., increased immune activation prior to treatment for hepatitis C associated with inter- 
feron-alfa-induced depression); high doses (greater than 80 mg/day prednisone-equiva- 
lents) of corticosteroids or high plasma concentrations of efavirenz; and high estrogen/ 
progesterone content in oral contraceptives. 


Course modifiers. Inarepresentative U.S. adult population, compared with individuals 
with major depressive disorder who did not have a substance use disorder, individuals 
with substance-induced depressive disorder were more likely to be male, to be black, to 
have at most a high school diploma, to lack insurance, and to have lower family income. 
They were also more likely to report higher family history of substance use disorders and 
antisocial behavior, higher 12-month history of stressful life events, and a greater number 
of DSM-IV major depressive disorder criteria. They were more likely to report feelings of 
worthlessness, insomnia/hypersomnia, and thoughts of death and suicide attempts, but 
less likely to report depressed mood and parental loss by death before age 18 years. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Determination of the substance of use can sometimes be made through laboratory assays 
of the suspected substance in the blood or urine to corroborate the diagnosis. 


Suicide Risk 


Drug-induced or treatment-emergent suicidality represents a marked change in thoughts 
and behavior from the person’s baseline, is usually temporally associated with initiation of 
a substance, and must be distinguished from the underlying primary mental disorders. 
In regard to the treatment-emergent suicidality associated with antidepressants, a U.S. 
Food and Drug Administration (FDA) advisory committee considered meta-analyses of 
99,839 participants enrolled in 372 randomized clinical trials of antidepressants in trials for 
mental disorders. The analyses showed that when the data were pooled across all adult 
age groups, there was no perceptible increased risk of suicidal behavior or ideation. How- 
ever, in age-stratified analyses, the risk for patients ages 18-24 years was elevated, albeit 
not significantly (odds ratio [OR] = 1.55; 95% confidence interval [CI] = 0.91-2.70). The 
FDA meta-analyses reveal an absolute risk of suicide in patients taking investigational an- 
tidepressants of 0.01%. In conclusion, suicide is clearly an extremely rare treatment-emer- 
gent phenomenon, but the outcome of suicide was serious enough to prompt the FDA to 
issue an expanded black-box warning in 2007 regarding the importance of careful moni- 
toring of treatment-emergent suicidal ideation in patients receiving antidepressants. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Substance intoxication and withdrawal. Depressive symptoms occur commonly in sub- 
stance intoxication and substance withdrawal, and the diagnosis of the substance-specific 
intoxication or withdrawal will usually suffice to categorize the symptom presentation. A 
diagnosis of substance-induced depressive disorder should be made instead of a diag- 
nosis of substance intoxication or substance withdrawal when the mood symptoms are 
sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. For example, dysphoric 
mood is a characteristic feature of cocaine withdrawal. Substance/medication-induced 
depressive disorder should be diagnosed instead of cocaine withdrawal only if the mood 
disturbance is substantially more intense or longer lasting than what is usually encountered 
with cocaine withdrawal and is sufficiently severe to be a separate focus of attention and 
treatment. 


180 Depressive Disorders 


Primary depressive disorder. A substance/medication-induced depressive disorder is 
distinguished from a primary depressive disorder by the fact that a substance is judged to 
be etiologically related to the symptoms, as described earlier (see section “Development 
and Course” for this disorder). 


Depressive disorder due to another medical condition. Because individuals with other 
medical conditions often take medications for those conditions, the clinician must consider the 
possibility that the mood symptoms are caused by the physiological consequences of the med- 
ical condition rather than the medication, in which case depressive disorder due to another 
medical condition is diagnosed. The history often provides the primary basis for such a judg- 
ment. At times, a change in the treatment for the other medical condition (e.g., medication sub- 
stitution or discontinuation) may be needed to determine empirically whether the medication 
is the causative agent. If the clinician has ascertained that the disturbance is a function of both 
another medical condition and substance use or withdrawal, both diagnoses (i.e., depressive 
disorder due to another medical condition and substance /medication-induced depressive 
disorder) may be given. When there is insufficient evidence to determine whether the depres- 
sive symptoms are associated with substance (including a medication) ingestion or with- 
drawal or with another medical condition or are primary (i.e., not a function of either a 
substance or another medical condition), a diagnosis of other specified depressive disorder or 
unspecified depressive disorder would be indicated. 


Comorbidity 


Compared with individuals with major depressive disorder and no comorbid substance 
use disorder, those with substance/medication-induced depressive disorder have higher 
rates of comorbidity with any DSM-IV mental disorder; are more likely to have specific 
DSM-IV disorders of pathological gambling and paranoid, histrionic, and antisocial per- 
sonality disorders; and are less likely to have persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia). 
Compared with individuals with major depressive disorder and a comorbid substance use 
disorder, individuals with substance /medication-induced depressive disorder are more 
likely to have alcohol use disorder, any other substance use disorder, and histrionic per- 
sonality disorder; however, they are less likely to have persistent depressive disorder. 


Depressive Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A prominent and persistent period of depressed mood or markedly diminished interest 
or pleasure in all, or almost all, activities that predominates in the clinical picture. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the 
disturbance is the direct pathophysiological consequence of another medical condi- 
tion. 

C. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder (e.g., adjustment 
disorder, with depressed mood, in which the stressor is a serious medical condition). 

D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 

E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code for depressive disorder due to another medical condi- 
tion is 293.83, which is assigned regardless of the specifier. The ICD-10-CM code de- 
pends on the specifier (see below). 


Depressive Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 181 


Specify if: 
(F06.31) With depressive features: Full criteria are not met for a major depressive 
episode. 
(F06.32) With major depressive—like episode: Full criteria are met (except Criterion 
C) for a major depressive episode. 
(F06.34) With mixed features: Symptoms of mania or hypomania are also present but 
do not predominate in the clinical picture. 


Coding note: Include the name of the other medical condition in the name of the mental dis- 
order (e.g., 293.83 [FO6.31] depressive disorder due to hypothyroidism, with depressive fea- 
tures). The other medical condition should also be coded and listed separately immediately 
before the depressive disorder due to the medical condition (e.g., 244.9 [E03.9] hypothyroid- 
ism; 293.83 [F06.31] depressive disorder due to hypothyroidism, with depressive features). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of depressive disorder due to another medical condition is a promi- 
nent and persistent period of depressed mood or markedly diminished interest or plea- 
sure in all, or almost all, activities that predominates in the clinical picture (Criterion A) 
and that is thought to be related to the direct physiological effects of another medical con- 
dition (Criterion B). In determining whether the mood disturbance is due to a general 
medical condition, the clinician must first establish the presence of a general medical con- 
dition. Further, the clinician must establish that the mood disturbance is etiologically re- 
lated to the general medical condition through a physiological mechanism. A careful and 
comprehensive assessment of multiple factors is necessary to make this judgment. Al- 
though there are no infallible guidelines for determining whether the relationship 
between the mood disturbance and the general medical condition is etiological, several 
considerations provide some guidance in this area. One consideration is the presence of a 
temporal association between the onset, exacerbation, or remission of the general medical 
condition and that of the mood disturbance. A second consideration is the presence of fea- 
tures that are atypical of primary Mood Disorders (e.g., atypical age at onset or course or 
absence of family history). Evidence from the literature that suggests that there can be a di- 
rect association between the general medical condition in question and the development 
of mood symptoms can provide a useful context in the assessment of a particular situation. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Etiology (i.e., a causal relationship to another medical condition based on best clinical ev- 
idence) is the key variable in depressive disorder due to another medical condition. The 
listing of the medical conditions that are said to be able to induce major depression is never 
complete, and the clinician’s best judgment is the essence of this diagnosis. 

There are clear associations, as well as some neuroanatomical correlates, of depression 
with stroke, Huntington’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, and traumatic brain injury. Among 
the neuroendocrine conditions most closely associated with depression are Cushing’s dis- 
ease and hypothyroidism. There are numerous other conditions thought to be associated 
with depression, such as multiple sclerosis. However, the literature’s support for a causal 
association is greater with some conditions, such as Parkinson’s disease and Huntington’s 
disease, than with others, for which the differential diagnosis may be adjustment disorder, 
with depressed mood. 


Development and Course 


Following stroke, the onset of depression appears to be very acute, occurring within 1 day 
or a few days of the cerebrovascular accident (CVA) in the largest case series. However, in 


182 Depressive Disorders 


some cases, onset of the depression is weeks to months following the CVA. In the largest 
series, the duration of the major depressive episode following stroke was 9-11 months on 
average. Similarly, in Huntington’s disease the depressive state comes quite early in the 
course of the illness. With Parkinson’s disease and Huntington's disease, it often precedes 
the major motor impairments and cognitive impairments associated with each condition. 
This is more prominently the case for Huntington’s disease, in which depression is con- 
sidered to be the first neuropsychiatric symptom. There is some observational evidence 
that depression is less common as the dementia of Huntington’s disease progresses. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


The risk of acute onset of a major depressive disorder following a CVA (within 1 day toa 
week of the event) appears to be strongly correlated with lesion location, with greatest risk 
associated with left frontal strokes and least risk apparently associated with right frontal 
lesions in those individuals who present within days of the stroke. The association with 
frontal regions and laterality is not observed in depressive states that occur in the 2-6 months 
following stroke. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Gender differences pertain to those associated with the medical condition (e.g., systemic 
lupus erythematosus is more common in females; stroke is somewhat more common in 
middle-age males compared with females). 


Diagnostic Markers 


Diagnostic markers pertain to those associated with the medical condition (e.g., steroid 
levels in blood or urine to help corroborate the diagnosis of Cushing’s disease, which can 
be associated with manic or depressive syndromes). 


Suicide Risk 


There are no epidemiological studies that provide evidence to differentiate the risk of sui- 
cide from a major depressive episode due to another medical condition compared with the 
risk from a major depressive episode in general. There are case reports of suicides in 
association with major depressive episodes associated with another medical condition. 
There is a clear association between serious medical illnesses and suicide, particularly 
shortly after onset or diagnosis of the illness. Thus, it would be prudent to assume that the 
risk of suicide for major depressive episodes associated with medical conditions is not less 
than that for other forms of major depressive episode, and might even be greater. 


Functional Consequences of Depressive Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


Functional consequences pertain to those associated with the medical condition. In gen- 
eral, it is believed, but not established, that a major depressive episode induced by Cush- 
ing’s disease will not recur if the Cushing’s disease is cured or arrested. However, it is also 
suggested, but not established, that mood syndromes, including depressive and manic/ 
hypomanic ones, may be episodic (i.e., recurring) in some individuals with static brain in- 
juries and other central nervous system diseases. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Depressive disorders not due to another medical condition. Determination of whether 
a medical condition accompanying a depressive disorder is causing the disorder depends 
on a) the absence of an episode(s) of depressive episodes prior to the onset of the medical 


Other Specified Depressive Disorder 183 


condition, b) the probability that the associated medical condition has a potential to pro- 
mote or cause a depressive disorder, and c) a course of the depressive symptoms shortly 
after the onset or worsening of the medical condition, especially if the depressive symp- 
toms remit near the time that the medical disorder is effectively treated or remits. 


Medication-induced depressive disorder. Animportant caveat is that some medical con- 
ditions are treated with medications (e.g., steroids or alpha-interferon) that can induce depres- 
sive or manic symptoms. In these cases, clinical judgment, based on all the evidence in hand, is 
the best way to try to separate the most likely and/or the most important of two etiological fac- 
tors (i.e., association with the medical condition vs. a substance-induced syndrome). 


Adjustment disorders. It is important to differentiate a depressive episode from an ad- 
justment disorder, as the onset of the medical condition is in itself a life stressor that could 
bring on either an adjustment disorder or an episode of major depression. The major dif- 
ferentiating elements are the pervasiveness the depressive picture and the number and 
quality of the depressive symptoms that the patient reports or demonstrates on the mental 
status examination. The differential diagnosis of the associated medical conditions is rel- 
evant but largely beyond the scope of the present manual. 


Comorbidity 


Conditions comorbid with depressive disorder due to another medical condition are those 
associated with the medical conditions of etiological relevance. It has been noted that de- 
lirium can occur before or along with depressive symptoms in individuals with a variety 
of medical conditions, such as Cushing’s disease. The association of anxiety symptoms, 
usually generalized symptoms, is common in depressive disorders, regardless of cause. 


Other Specified Depressive Disorder 
311 (F32.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a depressive 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the depressive disorders diagnostic class. The other specified depressive 
disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the 
specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific depressive 
disorder. This is done by recording “other specified depressive disorder” followed by the 
specific reason (e.g., “short-duration depressive episode’). 

Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 

1. Recurrent brief depression: Concurrent presence of depressed mood and at least 
four other symptoms of depression for 2-13 days at least once per month (not associ- 
ated with the menstrual cycle) for at least 12 consecutive months in an individual 
whose presentation has never met criteria for any other depressive or bipolar disorder 
and does not currently meet active or residual criteria for any psychotic disorder. 

2. Short-duration depressive episode (4—13 days): Depressed affect and at least four 
of the other eight symptoms of a major depressive episode associated with clinically 
significant distress or impairment that persists for more than 4 days, but less than 14 days, 
in an individual whose presentation has never met criteria for any other depressive or 
bipolar disorder, does not currently meet active or residual criteria for any psychotic dis- 
order, and does not meet criteria for recurrent brief depression. 

3. Depressive episode with insufficient symptoms: Depressed affect and at least one 
of the other eight symptoms of a major depressive episode associated with clinically 


184 Depressive Disorders 


significant distress or impairment that persist for at least 2 weeks in an individual 
whose presentation has never met criteria for any other depressive or bipolar disorder, 
does not currently meet active or residual criteria for any psychotic disorder, and does 
not meet criteria for mixed anxiety and depressive disorder symptoms. 


Unspecified Depressive Disorder 
311 (F32.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a depressive dis- 
order that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other im- 
portant areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of the disorders 
in the depressive disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified depressive disorder category is 
used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria are 
not met for a specific depressive disorder, and includes presentations for which there is insuf- 
ficient information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Specifiers for Depressive Disorders 


Specity if: 
With anxious distress: Anxious distress is defined as the presence of at least two of 
the following symptoms during the majority of days of a major depressive episode or 
persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia): 

Feeling keyed up or tense. 

Feeling unusually restless. 

Difficulty concentrating because of worry. 

Fear that something awful may happen. 

Feeling that the individual might lose control of himself or herself. 


OV BiG) Nc 


Specify current severity: 

Mild: Two symptoms. 

Moderate: Three symptoms. 

Moderate-severe: Four or five symptoms. 

Severe: Four or five symptoms and with motor agitation. 
Note: Anxious distress has been noted as a prominent feature of both bipolar and ma- 
jor depressive disorder in both primary care and specialty mental health settings. High 
levels of anxiety have been associated with higher suicide risk, longer duration of ill- 
ness, and greater likelihood of treatment nonresponse. As a result, it is clinically useful 
to specify accurately the presence and severity levels of anxious distress for treatment 
planning and monitoring of response to treatment. 
With mixed features: 


A. Atleast three of the following manic/hypomanic symptoms are present nearly every 
day during the majority of days of a major depressive episode: 
1. Elevated, expansive mood. 

Inflated self-esteem or grandiosity. 

More talkative than usual or pressure to keep talking. 

Flight of ideas or subjective experience that thoughts are racing. 

Increase in energy or goal-directed activity (either socially, at work or school, or 

sexually). 


akon 


Specifiers for Depressive Disorders 185 


6. Increased or excessive involvement in activities that have a high potential for 
painful consequences (e.g., engaging in unrestrained buying sprees, sexual in- 
discretions, foolish business investments). 

7. Decreased need for sleep (feeling rested despite sleeping less than usual; to be 
contrasted with insomnia). 


B. Mixed symptoms are observable by others and represent a change from the per- 
son’s usual behavior. 

C. For individuals whose symptoms meet full criteria for either mania or hypomania, 
the diagnosis should be bipolar | or bipolar II disorder. 

D. The mixed symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance 
(e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication or other treatment). 


Note: Mixed features associated with a major depressive episode have been found 
to be a significant risk factor for the development of bipolar | or bipolar II disorder. 
As a result, it is clinically useful to note the presence of this specifier for treatment 
planning and monitoring of response to treatment. 

With melancholic features: 


A. One of the following is present during the most severe period of the current epi- 
sode: 


1. Loss of pleasure in all, or almost all, activities. 
2. Lack of reactivity to usually pleasurable stimuli (does not feel much better, even 
temporarily, when something good happens). 
B. Three (or more) of the following: 


1. Adistinct quality of depressed mood characterized by profound despondency, 
despair, and/or moroseness or by so-called empty mood. 

Depression that is regularly worse in the morning. 

Early-morning awakening (i.e., at least 2 hours before usual awakening). 
Marked psychomotor agitation or retardation. 

Significant anorexia or weight loss. 

Excessive or inappropriate guilt. 


OO} Ee On 


Note: The specifier “with melancholic features” is applied if these features are present 
at the most severe stage of the episode. There is a near-complete absence of the ca- 
pacity for pleasure, not merely a diminution. A guideline for evaluating the lack of reac- 
tivity of mood is that even highly desired events are not associated with marked 
brightening of mood. Either mood does not brighten at all, or it brightens only partially 
(e.g., up to 20%—40% of normal for only minutes at a time). The “distinct quality” of mood 
that is characteristic of the “with melancholic features” specifier is experienced as qual- 
itatively different from that during a nonmelancholic depressive episode. A depressed 
mood that is described as merely more severe, longer lasting, or present without a rea- 
son is not considered distinct in quality. Psychomotor changes are nearly always pres- 
ent and are observable by others. 

Melancholic features exhibit only a modest tendency to repeat across episodes in the 
same individual. They are more frequent in inpatients, as opposed to outpatients; are 
less likely to occur in milder than in more severe major depressive episodes; and are 
more likely to occur in those with psychotic features. 


With atypical features: This specifier can be applied when these features predomi- 
nate during the majority of days of the current or most recent major depressive episode 
or persistent depressive disorder. 


A. Mood reactivity (i.e., mood brightens in response to actual or potential positive 
events). 


186 Depressive Disorders 


B. Two (or more) of the following: 


1. Significant weight gain or increase in appetite. 

2. Hypersomnia. 

3. Leaden paralysis (i.e., heavy, leaden feelings in arms or legs). 

4. A long-standing pattern of interpersonal rejection sensitivity (not limited to epi- 
sodes of mood disturbance) that results in significant social or occupational im- 
pairment. 


C. Criteria are not met for “with melancholic features” or “with catatonia” during the 
same episode. 


Note: “Atypical depression” has historical significance (i.e., atypical in contradistinction 
to the more classical agitated, “endogenous” presentations of depression that were the 
norm when depression was rarely diagnosed in outpatients and almost never in ado- 
lescents or younger adults) and today does not connote an uncommon or unusual clin- 
ical presentation as the term might imply. 

Mood reactivity is the capacity to be cheered up when presented with positive events 
(e.g., a visit from children, compliments from others). Mood may become euthymic (not 
sad) even for extended periods of time if the external circumstances remain favorable. 
Increased appetite may be manifested by an obvious increase in food intake or by 
weight gain. Hypersomnia may include either an extended period of nighttime sleep or 
daytime napping that totals at least 10 hours of sleep per day (or at least 2 hours more 
than when not depressed). Leaden paralysis is defined as feeling heavy, leaden, or 
weighted down, usually in the arms or legs. This sensation is generally present for at 
least an hour a day but often lasts for many hours at a time. Unlike the other atypical 
features, pathological sensitivity to perceived interpersonal rejection is a trait that has 
an early onset and persists throughout most of adult life. Rejection sensitivity occurs 
both when the person is and is not depressed, though it may be exacerbated during 
depressive periods. 


With psychotic features: Delusions and/or hallucinations are present. 


With mood-congruent psychotic features: The content of all delusions and hal- 
lucinations is consistent with the typical depressive themes of personal inade- 
quacy, guilt, disease, death, nihilism, or deserved punishment. 

With mood-incongruent psychotic features: The content of the delusions or hal- 
lucinations does not involve typical depressive themes of personal inadequacy, 
guilt, disease, death, nihilism, or deserved punishment, or the content is a mixture 
of mood-incongruent and mood-congruent themes. 


With catatonia: The catatonia specifier can apply to an episode of depression if cata- 
tonic features are present during most of the episode. See criteria for catatonia asso- 
ciated with a mental disorder (for a description of catatonia, see the chapter 
“Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders”). 


With peripartum onset: This specifier can be applied to the current or, if full criteria 
are not currently met for a major depressive episode, most recent episode of major de- 
pression if onset of mood symptoms occurs during pregnancy or in the 4 weeks follow- 
ing delivery. 
Note: Mood episodes can have their onset either during pregnancy or postpartum. 
Although the estimates differ according to the period of follow-up after delivery, be- 
tween 3% and 6% of women will experience the onset of a major depressive epi- 
sode during pregnancy or in the weeks or months following delivery. Fifty percent 
of “postpartum” major depressive episodes actually begin prior to delivery. Thus, 
these episodes are referred to collectively as peripartum episodes. Women with 
peripartum major depressive episodes often have severe anxiety and even panic 


Specifiers for Depressive Disorders 187 


attacks. Prospective studies have demonstrated that mood and anxiety symptoms 
during pregnancy, as well as the “baby blues,” increase the risk for a postpartum 
major depressive episode. 

Peripartum-onset mood episodes can present either with or without psychotic 
features. Infanticide is most often associated with postpartum psychotic episodes 
that are characterized by command hallucinations to kill the infant or delusions that 
the infant is possessed, but psychotic symptoms can also occur in severe postpar- 
tum mood episodes without such specific delusions or hallucinations. 

Postpartum mood (major depressive or manic) episodes with psychotic features 
appear to occur in from 1 in 500 to 1 in 1,000 deliveries and may be more common 
in primiparous women. The risk of postpartum episodes with psychotic features is 
particularly increased for women with prior postpartum mood episodes but is also 
elevated for those with a prior history of a depressive or bipolar disorder (especially 
bipolar | disorder) and those with a family history of bipolar disorders. 

Once a woman has had a postpartum episode with psychotic features, the risk 
of recurrence with each subsequent delivery is between 30% and 50%. Postpartum 
episodes must be differentiated from delirium occurring in the postpartum period, 
which is distinguished by a fluctuating level of awareness or attention. The postpar- 
tum period is unique with respect to the degree of neuroendocrine alterations and 
psychosocial adjustments, the potential impact of breast-feeding on treatment 
planning, and the long-term implications of a history of postpartum mood disorder 
on subsequent family planning. 

With seasonal pattern: This specifier applies to recurrent major depressive disorder. 

A. There has been a regular temporal relationship between the onset of major depres- 
sive episodes in major depressive disorder and a particular time of the year (e.g., 
in the fall or winter). 

Note: Do not include cases in which there is an obvious effect of seasonally related 
psychosocial stressors (e.g., regularly being unemployed every winter). 

B. Full remissions (or a change from major depression to mania or hypomania) also 
occur at a characteristic time of the year (e.g., depression disappears in the spring). 

C. Inthe last 2 years, two major depressive episodes have occurred that demonstrate 
the temporal seasonal relationships defined above and no nonseasonal major de- 
pressive episodes have occurred during that same period. 

D. Seasonal major depressive episodes (as described above) substantially outnum- 
ber the nonseasonal major depressive episodes that may have occurred over the 
individual’s lifetime. 

Note: The specifier “with seasonal pattern” can be applied to the pattern of major de- 
pressive episodes in major depressive disorder, recurrent. The essential feature is the 
onset and remission of major depressive episodes at characteristic times of the year. 
In most cases, the episodes begin in fall or winter and remit in spring. Less commonly, 
there may be recurrent summer depressive episodes. This pattern of onset and remis- 
sion of episodes must have occurred during at least a 2-year period, without any non- 
seasonal episodes occurring during this period. In addition, the seasonal depressive 
episodes must substantially outnumber any nonseasonal depressive episodes over 
the individual’s lifetime. 

This specifier does not apply to those situations in which the pattern is better ex- 
plained by seasonally linked psychosocial stressors (e.g., seasonal unemployment or 
school schedule). Major depressive episodes that occur in a seasonal pattern are often 
characterized by prominent energy, hypersomnia, overeating, weight gain, and a crav- 
ing for carbohydrates. It is unclear whether a seasonal pattern is more likely in recur- 
rent major depressive disorder or in bipolar disorders. However, within the bipolar 
disorders group, a seasonal pattern appears to be more likely in bipolar II disorder than 


188 Depressive Disorders 


in bipolar | disorder. In some individuals, the onset of manic or hypomanic episodes 
may also be linked to a particular season. 

The prevalence of winter-type seasonal pattern appears to vary with latitude, age, 
and sex. Prevalence increases with higher latitudes. Age is also a strong predictor of 
seasonality, with younger persons at higher risk for winter depressive episodes. 

Specity if: 
In partial remission: Symptoms of the immediately previous major depressive episode 
are present, but full criteria are not met, or there is a period lasting less than 2 months 
without any significant symptoms of a major depressive episode following the end of 
such an episode. 
In full remission: During the past 2 months, no significant signs or symptoms of the 
disturbance were present. 


Specify current severity: 
Severity is based on the number of criterion symptoms, the severity of those symptoms, 
and the degree of functional disability. 
Mild: Few, if any, symptoms in excess of those required to make the diagnosis are 
present, the intensity of the symptoms is distressing but manageable, and the symp- 
toms result in minor impairment in social or occupational functioning. 
Moderate: The number of symptoms, intensity of symptoms, and/or functional impair- 
ment are between those specified for “mild” and “severe.” 
Severe: The number of symptoms is substantially in excess of that required to make 
the diagnosis, the intensity of the symptoms is seriously distressing and unmanage- 
able, and the symptoms markedly interfere with social and occupational functioning. 


Anxiety 
Disorders 


Anxiety disorders include disorders that share features of excessive fear and anxi- 
ety and related behavioral disturbances. Fear is the emotional response to real or per- 
ceived imminent threat, whereas anxiety is anticipation of future threat. Obviously, these 
two states overlap, but they also differ, with fear more often associated with surges of au- 
tonomic arousal necessary for fight or flight, thoughts of immediate danger, and escape 
behaviors, and anxiety more often associated with muscle tension and vigilance in prep- 
aration for future danger and cautious or avoidant behaviors. Sometimes the level of fear 
or anxiety is reduced by pervasive avoidance behaviors. Panic attacks feature prominently 
within the anxiety disorders as a particular type of fear response. Panic attacks are not lim- 
ited to anxiety disorders but rather can be seen in other mental disorders as well. 

The anxiety disorders differ from one another in the types of objects or situations that 
induce fear, anxiety, or avoidance behavior, and the associated cognitive ideation. Thus, 
while the anxiety disorders tend to be highly comorbid with each other, they can be dif- 
ferentiated by close examination of the types of situations that are feared or avoided and 
the content of the associated thoughts or beliefs. 

Anxiety disorders differ from developmentally normative fear or anxiety by being ex- 
cessive or persisting beyond developmentally appropriate periods. They differ from tran- 
sient fear or anxiety, often stress-induced, by being persistent (e.g., typically lasting 6 months 
or more), although the criterion for duration is intended as a general guide with allowance 
for some degree of flexibility and is sometimes of shorter duration in children (as in sepa- 
ration anxiety disorder and selective mutism). Since individuals with anxiety disorders 
typically overestimate the danger in situations they fear or avoid, the primary determina- 
tion of whether the fear or anxiety is excessive or out of proportion is made by the clinician, 
taking cultural contextual factors into account. Many of the anxiety disorders develop in 
childhood and tend to persist if not treated. Most occur more frequently in females than in 
males (approximately 2:1 ratio). Each anxiety disorder is diagnosed only when the symp- 
toms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance /medication or to another 
medical condition or are not better explained by another mental disorder. 

The chapter is arranged developmentally, with disorders sequenced according to the 
typical age at onset. The individual with separation anxiety disorder is fearful or anxious 
about separation from attachment figures to a degree that is developmentally inappro- 
priate. There is persistent fear or anxiety about harm coming to attachment figures and 
events that could lead to loss of or separation from attachment figures and reluctance to go 
away from attachment figures, as well as nightmares and physical symptoms of distress. Al- 
though the symptoms often develop in childhood, they can be expressed throughout adult- 
hood as well. 

Selective mutism is characterized by a consistent failure to speak in social situations in 
which there is an expectation to speak (e.g., school) even though the individual speaks in 
other situations. The failure to speak has significant consequences on achievement in aca- 
demic or occupational settings or otherwise interferes with normal social communication. 

Individuals with specific phobia are fearful or anxious about or avoidant of circum- 
scribed objects or situations. A specific cognitive ideation is not featured in this disorder, 
as it is in other anxiety disorders. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is almost always imme- 


189 


190 Anxiety Disorders 


diately induced by the phobic situation, to a degree that is persistent and out of proportion 
to the actual risk posed. There are various types of specific phobias: animal; natural envi- 
ronment; blood-injection-injury; situational; and other situations. 

In social anxiety disorder (social phobia), the individual is fearful or anxious about or 
avoidant of social interactions and situations that involve the possibility of being scruti- 
nized. These include social interactions such as meeting unfamiliar people, situations in 
which the individual may be observed eating or drinking, and situations in which the in- 
dividual performs in front of others. The cognitive ideation is of being negatively evalu- 
ated by others, by being embarrassed, humiliated, or rejected, or offending others. 

In panic disorder, the individual experiences recurrent unexpected panic attacks and is 
persistently concerned or worried about having more panic attacks or changes his or her 
behavior in maladaptive ways because of the panic attacks (e.g., avoidance of exercise or of 
unfamiliar locations). Panic attacks are abrupt surges of intense fear or intense discomfort 
that reach a peak within minutes, accompanied by physical and/or cognitive symptoms. 
Limited-symptom panic attacks include fewer than four symptoms. Panic attacks may be 
expected, such as in response to a typically feared object or situation, or unexpected, meaning 
that the panic attack occurs for no apparent reason. Panic attacks function as a marker and 
prognostic factor for severity of diagnosis, course, and comorbidity across an array of dis- 
orders, including, but not limited to, the anxiety disorders (e.g., substance use, depressive 
and psychotic disorders). Panic attack may therefore be used as a descriptive specifier for 
any anxiety disorder as well as other mental disorders. 

Individuals with agoraphobia are fearful and anxious about two or more of the follow- 
ing situations: using public transportation; being in open spaces; being in enclosed places; 
standing in line or being in a crowd; or being outside of the home alone in other situations. 
The individual fears these situations because of thoughts that escape might be difficult or 
help might not be available in the event of developing panic-like symptoms or other inca- 
pacitating or embarrassing symptoms. These situations almost always induce fear or anx- 
iety and are often avoided and require the presence of a companion. 

The key features of generalized anxiety disorder are persistent and excessive anxiety 
and worry about various domains, including work and school performance, that the indi- 
vidual finds difficult to control. In addition, the individual experiences physical symptoms, 
including restlessness or feeling keyed up or on edge; being easily fatigued; difficulty con- 
centrating or mind going blank; irritability; muscle tension; and sleep disturbance. 

Substance /medication-induced anxiety disorder involves anxiety due to substance in- 
toxication or withdrawal or to a medication treatment. In anxiety disorder due to another 
medical condition, anxiety symptoms are the physiological consequence of another med- 
ical condition. 

Disorder-specific scales are available to better characterize the severity of each anxiety 
disorder and to capture change in severity over time. For ease of use, particularly for in- 
dividuals with more than one anxiety disorder, these scales have been developed to have 
the same format (but different focus) across the anxiety disorders, with ratings of behav- 
ioral symptoms, cognitive ideation symptoms, and physical symptoms relevant to each 
disorder. 


Separation Anxiety Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 309.21 (F93.0) 


A. Developmentally inappropriate and excessive fear or anxiety concerning separation from 
those to whom the individual is attached, as evidenced by at least three of the following: 


1. Recurrent excessive distress when anticipating or experiencing separation from 
home or from major attachment figures. 


Separation Anxiety Disorder 191 


2. Persistent and excessive worry about losing major attachment figures or about pos- 
sible harm to them, such as illness, injury, disasters, or death. 

3. Persistent and excessive worry about experiencing an untoward event (e.g., getting 
lost, being kidnapped, having an accident, becoming ill) that causes separation 
from a major attachment figure. 

4. Persistent reluctance or refusal to go out, away from home, to school, to work, or 
elsewhere because of fear of separation. 

5. Persistent and excessive fear of or reluctance about being alone or without major 
attachment figures at home or in other settings. 

6. Persistent reluctance or refusal to sleep away from home or to go to sleep without 
being near a major attachment figure. 

7. Repeated nightmares involving the theme of separation. 

8. Repeated complaints of physical symptoms (e.g., headaches, stomachaches, nau- 
sea, vomiting) when separation from major attachment figures occurs or is antici- 
pated. 


B. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is persistent, lasting at least 4 weeks in children and 
adolescents and typically 6 months or more in adults. 

C. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, aca- 
demic, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder, such as refusing 
to leave home because of excessive resistance to change in autism spectrum disorder; 
delusions or hallucinations concerning separation in psychotic disorders; refusal to go 
outside without a trusted companion in agoraphobia; worries about ill health or other 
harm befalling significant others in generalized anxiety disorder; or concerns about 
having an illness in illness anxiety disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of separation anxiety disorder is excessive fear or anxiety concerning 
separation from home or attachment figures. The anxiety exceeds what may be expected 
given the person’s developmental level (Criterion A). Individuals with separation anxiety 
disorder have symptoms that meet at least three of the following criteria: They experience 
recurrent excessive distress when separation from home or major attachment figures is an- 
ticipated or occurs (Criterion A1). They worry about the well-being or death of attachment 
figures, particularly when separated from them, and they need to know the whereabouts 
of their attachment figures and want to stay in touch with them (Criterion A2). They also 
worry about untoward events to themselves, such as getting lost, being kidnapped, or 
having an accident, that would keep them from ever being reunited with their major at- 
tachment figure (Criterion A3). Individuals with separation anxiety disorder are reluctant 
or refuse to go out by themselves because of separation fears (Criterion A4). They have 
persistent and excessive fear or reluctance about being alone or without major attachment 
figures at home or in other settings. Children with separation anxiety disorder may be un- 
able to stay or go ina room by themselves and may display “clinging” behavior, staying 
close to or “shadowing” the parent around the house, or requiring someone to be with 
them when going to another room in the house (Criterion A5). They have persistent reluc- 
tance or refusal to go to sleep without being near a major attachment figure or to sleep 
away from home (Criterion A6). Children with this disorder often have difficulty at bed- 
time and may insist that someone stay with them until they fall asleep. During the night, 
they may make their way to their parents’ bed (or that of a significant other, such as a sib- 
ling). Children may be reluctant or refuse to attend camp, to sleep at friends’ homes, or to 
go on errands. Adults may be uncomfortable when traveling independently (e.g., sleeping 
in a hotel room). There may be repeated nightmares in which the content expresses the in- 


192 Anxiety Disorders 


dividual’s separation anxiety (e.g., destruction of the family through fire, murder, or other 
catastrophe) (Criterion A7). Physical symptoms (e.g., headaches, abdominal complaints, 
nausea, vomiting) are common in children when separation from major attachment fig- 
ures occurs or is anticipated (Criterion A8). Cardiovascular symptoms such as palpitations, 
dizziness, and feeling faint are rare in younger children but may occur in adolescents and 
adults. 

The disturbance must last for a period of at least 4 weeks in children and adolescents 
younger than 18 years and is typically 6 months or longer in adults (Criterion B). However, 
the duration criterion for adults should be used as a general guide, with allowance for 
some degree of flexibility. The disturbance must cause clinically significant distress or im- 
pairment in social, academic, occupational, or other important areas of functioning (Cri- 
terion C). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


When separated from major attachment figures, children with separation anxiety disorder 
may exhibit social withdrawal, apathy, sadness, or difficulty concentrating on work or 
play. Depending on their age, individuals may have fears of animals, monsters, the dark, 
muggers, burglars, kidnappers, car accidents, plane travel, and other situations that are 
perceived as presenting danger to the family or themselves. Some individuals become 
homesick and uncomfortable to the point of misery when away from home. Separation 
anxiety disorder in children may lead to school refusal, which in turn may lead to academic 
difficulties and social isolation. When extremely upset at the prospect of separation, chil- 
dren may show anger or occasionally aggression toward someone who is forcing separa- 
tion. When alone, especially in the evening or the dark, young children may report unusual 
perceptual experiences (e.g., seeing people peering into their room, frightening creatures 
reaching for them, feeling eyes staring at them). Children with this disorder may be de- 
scribed as demanding, intrusive, and in need of constant attention, and, as adults, may ap- 
pear dependent and overprotective. The individual’s excessive demands often become a 
source of frustration for family members, leading to resentment and conflict in the family. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence of separation anxiety disorder among adults in the United States 
is 0.9%-1.9%. In children, 6- to 12-month prevalence is estimated to be approximately 4%. 
In adolescents in the United States, the 12-month prevalence is 1.6%. Separation anxiety 
disorder decreases in prevalence from childhood through adolescence and adulthood and 
is the most prevalent anxiety disorder in children younger than 12 years. In clinical sam- 
ples of children, the disorder is equally common in males and females. In the community, 
the disorder is more frequent in females. 


Development and Course 


Periods of heightened separation anxiety from attachment figures are part of normal early 
development and may indicate the development of secure attachment relationships (e.g., 
around 1 year of age, when infants may suffer from stranger anxiety). Onset of separation 
anxiety disorder may be as early as preschool age and may occur at any time during child- 
hood and more rarely in adolescence. Typically there are periods of exacerbation and re- 
mission. In some cases, both the anxiety about possible separation and the avoidance of 
situations involving separation from the home or nuclear family (e.g., going away to col- 
lege, moving away from attachment figures) may persist through adulthood. However, 
the majority of children with separation anxiety disorder are free of impairing anxiety dis- 
orders over their lifetimes. Many adults with separation anxiety disorder do not recall a 
childhood onset of separation anxiety disorder, although they may recall symptoms. 


Separation Anxiety Disorder 193 


The manifestations of separation anxiety disorder vary with age. Younger children are 
more reluctant to go to school or may avoid school altogether. Younger children may not 
express worries or specific fears of definite threats to parents, home, or themselves, and the 
anxiety is manifested only when separation is experienced. As children age, worries 
emerge; these are often worries about specific dangers (e.g., accidents, kidnapping, mug- 
ging, death) or vague concerns about not being reunited with attachment figures. In adults, 
separation anxiety disorder may limit their ability to cope with changes in circumstances 
(e.g., moving, getting married). Adults with the disorder are typically overconcerned about 
their offspring and spouses and experience marked discomfort when separated from them. 
They may also experience significant disruption in work or social experiences because of 
needing to continuously check on the whereabouts of a significant other. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Separation anxiety disorder often develops after life stress, especially a 
loss (e.g., the death of a relative or pet; an illness of the individual or a relative; a change of 
schools; parental divorce; a move to a new neighborhood; immigration; a disaster that in- 
volved periods of separation from attachment figures). In young adults, other examples of 
life stress include leaving the parental home, entering into a romantic relationship, and be- 
coming a parent. Parental overprotection and intrusiveness may be associated with sepa- 
ration anxiety disorder. 


Genetic and physiological. Separation anxiety disorder in children may be heritable. 
Heritability was estimated at 73% in a community sample of 6-year-old twins, with higher 
rates in girls. Children with separation anxiety disorder display particularly enhanced 
sensitivity to respiratory stimulation using CO)-enriched air. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There are cultural variations in the degree to which it is considered desirable to tolerate 
separation, so that demands and opportunities for separation between parents and chil- 
dren are avoided in some cultures. For example, there is wide variation across countries 
and cultures with respect to the age at which it is expected that offspring should leave the 
parental home. It is important to differentiate separation anxiety disorder from the high 
value some cultures place on strong interdependence among family members. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Girls manifest greater reluctance to attend or avoidance of school than boys. Indirect ex- 
pression of fear of separation may be more common in males than in females, for example, 
by limited independent activity, reluctance to be away from home alone, or distress when 
spouse or offspring do things independently or when contact with spouse or offspring is 
not possible. 


Suicide Risk 


Separation anxiety disorder in children may be associated with an increased risk for sui- 
cide. Ina community sample, the presence of mood disorders, anxiety disorders, or sub- 
stance use has been associated with suicidal ideation and attempts. However, this 
association is not specific to separation anxiety disorder and is found in several anxiety 
disorders. 


Functional Consequences of Separation Anxiety Disorder 


Individuals with separation anxiety disorder often limit independent activities away from 
home or attachment figures (e.g., in children, avoiding school, not going to camp, having 


194 Anxiety Disorders 


difficulty sleeping alone; in adolescents, not going away to college; in adults, not leaving the 
parental home, not traveling, not working outside the home). 


Differential Diagnosis 


Generalized anxiety disorder. Separation anxiety disorder is distinguished from gener- 
alized anxiety disorder in that the anxiety predominantly concerns separation from attach- 
ment figures, and if other worries occur, they do not predominate the clinical picture. 


Panic disorder. Threats of separation may lead to extreme anxiety and even a panic at- 
tack. In separation anxiety disorder, in contrast to panic disorder, the anxiety concerns the 
possibility of being away from attachment figures and worry about untoward events be- 
falling them, rather than being incapacitated by an unexpected panic attack. 


Agoraphobia. Unlike individuals with agoraphobia, those with separation anxiety dis- 
order are not anxious about being trapped or incapacitated in situations from which es- 
cape is perceived as difficult in the event of panic-like symptoms or other incapacitating 
symptoms. 


Conduct disorder. School avoidance (truancy) is common in conduct disorder, but anx- 
iety about separation is not responsible for school absences, and the child or adolescent 
usually stays away from, rather than returns to, the home. 


Social anxiety disorder. School refusal may be due to social anxiety disorder (social pho- 
bia). In such instances, the school avoidance is due to fear of being judged negatively by oth- 
ers rather than to worries about being separated from the attachment figures. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder. Fear of separation from loved ones is common after trau- 
matic events such as a disasters, particularly when periods of separation from loved ones 
were experienced during the traumatic event. In posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD), the 
central symptoms concern intrusions about, and avoidance of, memories associated with 
the traumatic event itself, whereas in separation anxiety disorder, the worries and avoid- 
ance concern the well-being of attachment figures and separation from them. 


Illness anxiety disorder. Individuals with illness anxiety disorder worry about specific 
illnesses they may have, but the main concern is about the medical diagnosis itself, not 
about being separated from attachment figures. 


Bereavement. Intense yearning or longing for the deceased, intense sorrow and emo- 
tional pain, and preoccupation with the deceased or the circumstances of the death are ex- 
pected responses occurring in bereavement, whereas fear of separation from other 
attachment figures is central in separation anxiety disorder. 


Depressive and bipolar disorders. These disorders may be associated with reluctance 
to leave home, but the main concern is not worry or fear of untoward events befalling at- 
tachment figures, but rather low motivation for engaging with the outside world. How- 
ever, individuals with separation anxiety disorder may become depressed while being 
separated or in anticipation of separation. 


Oppositional defiant disorder. Children and adolescents with separation anxiety disor- 
der may be oppositional in the context of being forced to separate from attachment figures. 
Oppositional defiant disorder should be considered only when there is persistent opposi- 
tional behavior unrelated to the anticipation or occurrence of separation from attachment 
figures. 


Psychotic disorders. Unlike the hallucinations in psychotic disorders, the unusual per- 
ceptual experiences that may occur in separation anxiety disorder are usually based on a 
misperception of an actual stimulus, occur only in certain situations (e.g., nighttime), and 
are reversed by the presence of an attachment figure. 


Selective Mutism 195 


Personality disorders. Dependent personality disorder is characterized by an indis- 
criminate tendency to rely on others, whereas separation anxiety disorder involves con- 
cern about the proximity and safety of main attachment figures. Borderline personality 
disorder is characterized by fear of abandonment by loved ones, but problems in identity, 
self-direction, interpersonal functioning, and impulsivity are additionally central to that 
disorder, whereas they are not central to separation anxiety disorder. 


Comorbidity 


In children, separation anxiety disorder is highly comorbid with generalized anxiety dis- 
order and specific phobia. In adults, common comorbidities include specific phobia, 
PTSD, panic disorder, generalized anxiety disorder, social anxiety disorder, agoraphobia, 
obsessive-compulsive disorder, and personality disorders. Depressive and bipolar disor- 
ders are also comorbid with separation anxiety disorder in adults. 


Selective Mutism 
Diagnostic Criteria 313.23 (F94.0) 


A. Consistent failure to speak in specific social situations in which there is an expectation 
for speaking (e.g., at school) despite speaking in other situations. 

B. The disturbance interferes with educational or occupational achievement or with social 
communication. 

C. The duration of the disturbance is at least 1 month (not limited to the first month of 
school). 

D. The failure to speak is not attributable to a lack of knowledge of, or comfort with, the 
spoken language required in the social situation. 

E. The disturbance is not better explained by a communication disorder (e.g., childhood- 
onset fluency disorder) and does not occur exclusively during the course of autism 
spectrum disorder, schizophrenia, or another psychotic disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


When encountering other individuals in social interactions, children with selective mut- 
ism do not initiate speech or reciprocally respond when spoken to by others. Lack of 
speech occurs in social interactions with children or adults. Children with selective mut- 
ism will speak in their home in the presence of immediate family members but often not 
even in front of close friends or second-degree relatives, such as grandparents or cousins. 
The disturbance is often marked by high social anxiety. Children with selective mutism of- 
ten refuse to speak at school, leading to academic or educational impairment, as teachers 
often find it difficult to assess skills such as reading. The lack of speech may interfere with 
social communication, although children with this disorder sometimes use nonspoken or 
nonverbal means (e.g., grunting, pointing, writing) to communicate and may be willing or 
eager to perform or engage in social encounters when speech is not required (e.g., nonver- 
bal parts in school plays). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Associated features of selective mutism may include excessive shyness, fear of social em- 
barrassment, social isolation and withdrawal, clinging, compulsive traits, negativism, 
temper tantrums, or mild oppositional behavior. Although children with this disorder 
generally have normal language skills, there may occasionally be an associated commu- 


196 Anxiety Disorders 


nication disorder, although no particular association with a specific communication dis- 
order has been identified. Even when these disorders are present, anxiety is present as 
well. In clinical settings, children with selective mutism are almost always given an addi- 
tional diagnosis of another anxiety disorder—most commonly, social anxiety disorder (so- 
cial phobia). 


Prevalence 


Selective mutism is a relatively rare disorder and has not been included as a diagnostic cat- 
egory in epidemiological studies of prevalence of childhood disorders. Point prevalence 
using various clinic or school samples ranges between 0.03% and 1% depending on the set- 
ting (e.g., clinic vs. school vs. general population) and ages of the individuals in the sample. 
The prevalence of the disorder does not seem to vary by sex or race/ethnicity. The disor- 
der is more likely to manifest in young children than in adolescents and adults. 


Development and Course 


The onset of selective mutism is usually before age 5 years, but the disturbance may not 
come to clinical attention until entry into school, where there is an increase in social inter- 
action and performance tasks, such as reading aloud. The persistence of the disorder is 
variable. Although clinical reports suggest that many individuals “outgrow” selective 
mutism, the longitudinal course of the disorder is unknown. In some cases, particularly in 
individuals with social anxiety disorder, selective mutism may disappear, but symptoms 
of social anxiety disorder remain. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Temperamental risk factors for selective mutism are not well identi- 
fied. Negative affectivity (neuroticism) or behavioral inhibition may play a role, as may 
parental history of shyness, social isolation, and social anxiety. Children with selective 
mutism may have subtle receptive language difficulties compared with their peers, al- 
though receptive language is still within the normal range. 


Environmental. Social inhibition on the part of parents may serve as a model for social 
reticence and selective mutism in children. Furthermore, parents of children with selective 
mutism have been described as overprotective or more controlling than parents of chil- 
dren with other anxiety disorders or no disorder. 


Genetic and physiological factors. Because of the significant overlap between selective 
mutism and social anxiety disorder, there may be shared genetic factors between these 
conditions. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Children in families who have immigrated to a country where a different language is spo- 
ken may refuse to speak the new language because of lack of knowledge of the language. 
If comprehension of the new language is adequate but refusal to speak persists, a diagno- 
sis of selective mutism may be warranted. 


Functional Consequences of Selective Mutism 


Selective mutism may result in social impairment, as children may be too anxious to en- 
gage in reciprocal social interaction with other children. As children with selective mutism 
mature, they may face increasing social isolation. In school settings, these children may 
suffer academic impairment, because often they do not communicate with teachers re- 
garding their academic or personal needs (e.g., not understanding a class assignment, not 


Specific Phobia 197 


asking to use the restroom). Severe impairment in school and social functioning, including 
that resulting from teasing by peers, is common. In certain instances, selective mutism 
may serve as a compensatory strategy to decrease anxious arousal in social encounters. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Communication disorders. Selective mutism should be distinguished from speech dis- 
turbances that are better explained by a communication disorder, such as language 
disorder, speech sound disorder (previously phonological disorder), childhood-onset 
fluency disorder (stuttering), or pragmatic (social) communication disorder. Unlike selec- 
tive mutism, the speech disturbance in these conditions is not restricted to a specific social 
situation. 


Neurodevelopmental disorders and schizophrenia and other psychotic disorders. 
Individuals with an autism spectrum disorder, schizophrenia or another psychotic disor- 
der, or severe intellectual disability may have problems in social communication and be 
unable to speak appropriately in social situations. In contrast, selective mutism should be 
diagnosed only when a child has an established capacity to speak in some social situations 
(e.g., typically at home). 

Social anxiety disorder (social phobia). The social anxiety and social avoidance in so- 


cial anxiety disorder may be associated with selective mutism. In such cases, both diagno- 
ses may be given. 


Comorbidity 


The most common comorbid conditions are other anxiety disorders, most commonly so- 
cial anxiety disorder, followed by separation anxiety disorder and specific phobia. Oppo- 
sitional behaviors have been noted to occur in children with selective mutism, although 
oppositional behavior may be limited to situations requiring speech. Communication de- 
lays or disorders also may appear in some children with selective mutism. 


Specific Phobia 
Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Marked fear or anxiety about a specific object or situation (e.g., flying, heights, animals, 
receiving an injection, seeing blood). 

Note: In children, the fear or anxiety may be expressed by crying, tantrums, freezing, 
or clinging. 

B. The phobic object or situation almost always provokes immediate fear or anxiety. 

C. The phobic object or situation is actively avoided or endured with intense fear or anxiety. 

D. The fear or anxiety is out of proportion to the actual danger posed by the specific object 
or situation and to the sociocultural context. 

E. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is persistent, typically lasting for 6 months or more. 

F. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in 
social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

G. The disturbance is not better explained by the symptoms of another mental disorder, 
including fear, anxiety, and avoidance of situations associated with panic-like symptoms 
or other incapacitating symptoms (as in agoraphobia); objects or situations related to 
obsessions (as in obsessive-compulsive disorder); reminders of traumatic events (as in 
posttraumatic stress disorder); separation from home or attachment figures (as in sep- 
aration anxiety disorder); or social situations (as in social anxiety disorder). 


198 Anxiety Disorders 


Specify if: 
Code based on the phobic stimulus: 
300.29 (F40.218) Animal (e.g., spiders, insects, dogs). 
300.29 (F40.228) Natural environment (e.g., heights, storms, water). 
300.29 (F40.23x) Blood-injection-injury (e.g., needles, invasive medical procedures). 


Coding note: Select specific ICD-10-CM code as follows: F40.230 fear of blood; 
F40.231 fear of injections and transfusions; F40.232 fear of other medical care; or 
F40.233 fear of injury. 


300.29 (F40.248) Situational (e.g., airplanes, elevators, enclosed places). 
300.29 (F40.298) Other (e.g., situations that may lead to choking or vomiting; in chil- 
dren, e.g., loud sounds or costumed characters). 


Coding note: When more than one phobic stimulus is present, code all ICD-10-CM codes 
that apply (e.g., for fear of snakes and flying, F40.218 specific phobia, animal, and 
F40.248 specific phobia, situational). 


Specifiers 

It is common for individuals to have multiple specific phobias. The average individual with 
specific phobia fears three objects or situations, and approximately 75% of individuals with 
specific phobia fear more than one situation or object. In such cases, multiple specific phobia 
diagnoses, each with its own diagnostic code reflecting the phobic stimulus, would need to be 
given. For example, if an individual fears thunderstorms and flying, then two diagnoses 
would be given: specific phobia, natural environment, and specific phobia, situational. 


Diagnostic Features 


A key feature of this disorder is that the fear or anxiety is circumscribed to the presence of a 
particular situation or object (Criterion A), which may be termed the phobic stimulus. The cat- 
egories of feared situations or objects are provided as specifiers. Many individuals fear objects 
or situations from more than one category, or phobic stimulus. For the diagnosis of specific 
phobia, the response must differ from normal, transient fears that commonly occur in the pop- 
ulation. To meet the criteria for a diagnosis, the fear or anxiety must be intense or severe (i.e., 
“marked”) (Criterion A). The amount of fear experienced may vary with proximity to the 
feared object or situation and may occur in anticipation of or in the actual presence of the object 
or situation. Also, the fear or anxiety may take the form of a full or limited symptom panic at- 
tack (i.e., expected panic attack). Another characteristic of specific phobias is that fear or anxi- 
ety is evoked nearly every time the individual comes into contact with the phobic stimulus 
(Criterion B). Thus, an individual who becomes anxious only occasionally upon being con- 
fronted with the situation or object (e.g., becomes anxious when flying only on one out of every 
five airplane flights) would not be diagnosed with specific phobia. However, the degree of fear 
or anxiety expressed may vary (from anticipatory anxiety to a full panic attack) across different 
occasions of encountering the phobic object or situation because of various contextual factors 
such as the presence of others, duration of exposure, and other threatening elements such as 
turbulence on a flight for individuals who fear flying. Fear and anxiety are often expressed dif- 
ferently between children and adults. Also, the fear or anxiety occurs as soon as the phobic ob- 
ject or situation is encountered (i.e., immediately rather than being delayed). 

The individual actively avoids the situation, or if he or she either is unable or decides 
not to avoid it, the situation or object evokes intense fear or anxiety (Criterion C). Active 
avoidance means the individual intentionally behaves in ways that are designed to prevent 
or minimize contact with phobic objects or situations (e.g., takes tunnels instead of bridges 
on daily commute to work for fear of heights; avoids entering a dark room for fear of spi- 
ders; avoids accepting a job in a locale where a phobic stimulus is more common). Avoid- 


Specific Phobia 199 


ance behaviors are often obvious (e.g., an individual who fears blood refusing to go to the 
doctor) but are sometimes less obvious (e.g., an individual who fears snakes refusing to 
look at pictures that resemble the form or shape of snakes). Many individuals with specific 
phobias have suffered over many years and have changed their living circumstances in 
ways designed to avoid the phobic object or situation as much as possible (e.g., an indi- 
vidual diagnosed with specific phobia, animal, who moves to reside in an area devoid of 
the particular feared animal). Therefore, they no longer experience fear or anxiety in their 
daily life. In such instances, avoidance behaviors or ongoing refusal to engage in activities 
that would involve exposure to the phobic object or situation (e.g., repeated refusal to ac- 
cept offers for work-related travel because of fear of flying) may be helpful in confirming 
the diagnosis in the absence of overt anxiety or panic. 

The fear or anxiety is out of proportion to the actual danger that the object or situation 
poses, or more intense than is deemed necessary (Criterion D). Although individuals with 
specific phobia often recognize their reactions as disproportionate, they tend to overesti- 
mate the danger in their feared situations, and thus the judgment of being out of propor- 
tion is made by the clinician. The individual’s sociocultural context should also be taken 
into account. For example, fears of the dark may be reasonable in a context of ongoing 
violence, and fear of insects may be more disproportionate in settings where insects are 
consumed in the diet. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is persistent, typically lasting for 
6 months or more (Criterion E), which helps distinguish the disorder from transient fears 
that are common in the population, particularly among children. However, the duration 
criterion should be used as a general guide, with allowance for some degree of flexibility. 
The specific phobia must cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, or other important areas of functioning in order for the disorder to be diag- 
nosed (Criterion F). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with specific phobia typically experience an increase in physiological arousal 
in anticipation of or during exposure to a phobic object or situation. However, the physi- 
ological response to the feared situation or object varies. Whereas individuals with situa- 
tional, natural environment, and animal specific phobias are likely to show sympathetic 
nervous system arousal, individuals with blood-injection-injury specific phobia often 
demonstrate a vasovagal fainting or near-fainting response that is marked by initial brief 
acceleration of heart rate and elevation of blood pressure followed by a deceleration of 
heart rate and a drop in blood pressure. Current neural systems models for specific phobia 
emphasize the amygdala and related structures, much as in other anxiety disorders. 


Prevalence 


In the United States, the 12-month community prevalence estimate for specific phobia is 
approximately 7%—9%. Prevalence rates in European countries are largely similar to those 
in the United States (e.g., about 6%), but rates are generally lower in Asian, African, and 
Latin American countries (2%-—4%). Prevalence rates are approximately 5% in children and 
are approximately 16% in 13- to 17-year-olds. Prevalence rates are lower in older individ- 
uals (about 3%-5%), possibly reflecting diminishing severity to subclinical levels. Females 
are more frequently affected than males, at a rate of approximately 2:1, although rates vary 
across different phobic stimuli. That is, animal, natural environment, and situational spe- 
cific phobias are predominantly experienced by females, whereas blood-injection-injury 
phobia is experienced nearly equally by both genders. 


Development and Course 


Specific phobia sometimes develops following a traumatic event (e.g., being attacked by 
an animal or stuck in an elevator), observation of others going through a traumatic event (e.g., 


200 Anxiety Disorders 


watching someone drown), an unexpected panic attack in the to be feared situation (e.g., 
an unexpected panic attack while on the subway), or informational transmission (e.g., ex- 
tensive media coverage of a plane crash). However, many individuals with specific phobia 
are unable to recall the specific reason for the onset of their phobias. Specific phobia usu- 
ally develops in early childhood, with the majority of cases developing prior to age 10 
years. The median age at onset is between 7 and 11 years, with the mean at about 10 years. 
Situational specific phobias tend to have a later age at onset than natural environment, an- 
imal, or blood-injection-injury specific phobias. Specific phobias that develop in child- 
hood and adolescence are likely to wax and wane during that period. However, phobias 
that do persist into adulthood are unlikely to remit for the majority of individuals. 

When specific phobia is being diagnosed in children, two issues should be considered. 
First, young children may express their fear and anxiety by crying, tantrums, freezing, 
or clinging. Second, young children typically are not able to understand the concept of 
avoidance. Therefore, the clinician should assemble additional information from parents, 
teachers, or others who know the child well. Excessive fears are quite common in young 
children but are usually transitory and only mildly impairing and thus considered devel- 
opmentally appropriate. In such cases a diagnosis of specific phobia would not be made. 
When the diagnosis of specific phobia is being considered in a child, it is important to 
assess the degree of impairment and the duration of the fear, anxiety, or avoidance, and 
whether it is typical for the child’s particular developmental stage. 

Although the prevalence of specific phobia is lower in older populations, it remains 
one of the more commonly experienced disorders in late life. Several issues should be con- 
sidered when diagnosing specific phobia in older populations. First, older individuals 
may be more likely to endorse natural environment specific phobias, as well as phobias of 
falling. Second, specific phobia (like all anxiety disorders) tends to co-occur with medical 
concerns in older individuals, including coronary heart disease and chronic obstructive 
pulmonary disease. Third, older individuals may be more likely to attribute the symptoms 
of anxiety to medical conditions. Fourth, older individuals may be more likely to manifest 
anxiety in an atypical manner (e.g., involving symptoms of both anxiety and depression) 
and thus be more likely to warrant a diagnosis of unspecified anxiety disorder. Addition- 
ally, the presence of specific phobia in older adults is associated with decreased quality of 
life and may serve as a risk factor for major neurocognitive disorder. 

Although most specific phobias develop in childhood and adolescence, it is possible for a 
specific phobia to develop at any age, often as the result of experiences that are traumatic. For 
example, phobias of choking almost always follow a near-choking event at any age. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Temperamental risk factors for specific phobia, such as negative affec- 
tivity (neuroticism) or behavioral inhibition, are risk factors for other anxiety disorders as 
well. 


Environmental. Environmental risk factors for specific phobias, such as parental over- 
protectiveness, parental loss and separation, and physical and sexual abuse, tend to pre- 
dict other anxiety disorders as well. As noted earlier, negative or traumatic encounters 
with the feared object or situation sometimes (but not always) precede the development of 
specific phobia. 

Genetic and physiological. There may bea genetic susceptibility to a certain category of 
specific phobia (e.g., an individual with a first-degree relative with a specific phobia of an- 
imals is significantly more likely to have the same specific phobia than any other category 
of phobia). Individuals with blood-injection-injury phobia show a unique propensity to 
vasovagal syncope (fainting) in the presence of the phobic stimulus. 


Specific Phobia 201 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In the United States, Asians and Latinos report significantly lower rates of specific phobia 
than non-Latino whites, African Americans, and Native Americans. In addition to having 
lower prevalence rates of specific phobia, some countries outside of the United States, par- 
ticularly Asian and African countries, show differing phobia content, age at onset, and 
gender ratios. 


Suicide Risk 


Individuals with specific phobia are up to 60% more likely to make a suicide attempt than 
are individuals without the diagnosis. However, it is likely that these elevated rates are 
primarily due to comorbidity with personality disorders and other anxiety disorders. 


Functional Consequences of Specific Phobia 


Individuals with specific phobia show similar patterns of impairment in psychosocial 
functioning and decreased quality of life as individuals with other anxiety disorders and 
alcohol and substance use disorders, including impairments in occupational and inter- 
personal functioning. In older adults, impairment may be seen in caregiving duties and 
volunteer activities. Also, fear of falling in older adults can lead to reduced mobility and 
reduced physical and social functioning, and may lead to receiving formal or informal 
home support. The distress and impairment caused by specific phobias tend to increase 
with the number of feared objects and situations. Thus, an individual who fears four ob- 
jects or situations is likely to have more impairment in his or her occupational and social 
roles and a lower quality of life than an individual who fears only one object or situation. 
Individuals with blood-injection-injury specific phobia are often reluctant to obtain med- 
ical care even when a medical concern is present. Additionally, fear of vomiting and chok- 
ing may substantially reduce dietary intake. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Agoraphobia. Situational specific phobia may resemble agoraphobia in its clinical pre- 
sentation, given the overlap in feared situations (e.g., flying, enclosed places, elevators). If 
an individual fears only one of the agoraphobia situations, then specific phobia, situa- 
tional, may be diagnosed. If two or more agoraphobic situations are feared, a diagnosis of 
agoraphobia is likely warranted. For example, an individual who fears airplanes and ele- 
vators (which overlap with the “public transportation” agoraphobic situation) but does 
not fear other agoraphobic situations would be diagnosed with specific phobia, situa- 
tional, whereas an individual who fears airplanes, elevators, and crowds (which overlap 
with two agoraphobic situations, “using public transportation” and “standing in line and 
or being in a crowd”) would be diagnosed with agoraphobia. Criterion B of agoraphobia 
(the situations are feared or avoided “because of thoughts that escape might be difficult or 
help might not be available in the event of developing panic-like symptoms or other inca- 
pacitating or embarrassing symptoms”) can also be useful in differentiating agoraphobia 
from specific phobia. If the situations are feared for other reasons, such as fear of being 
harmed directly by the object or situations (e.g., fear of the plane crashing, fear of the an- 
imal biting), a specific phobia diagnosis may be more appropriate. 


Social anxiety disorder. If the situations are feared because of negative evaluation, so- 
cial anxiety disorder should be diagnosed instead of specific phobia. 


Separation anxiety disorder. If the situations are feared because of separation from a 
primary caregiver or attachment figure, separation anxiety disorder should be diagnosed 
instead of specific phobia. 


202 Anxiety Disorders 


Panic disorder. Individuals with specific phobia may experience panic attacks when con- 
fronted with their feared situation or object. A diagnosis of specific phobia would be given if 
the panic attacks only occurred in response to the specific object or situation, whereas a di- 
agnosis of panic disorder would be given if the individual also experienced panic attacks 
that were unexpected (i.e., not in response to the specific phobia object or situation). 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. If an individual’s primary fear or anxiety is of an ob- 
ject or situation as a result of obsessions (e.g., fear of blood due to obsessive thoughts about 
contamination from blood-borne pathogens [i.e., HIV]; fear of driving due to obsessive im- 
ages of harming others), and if other diagnostic criteria for obsessive-compulsive disorder 
are met, then obsessive-compulsive disorder should be diagnosed. 


Trauma- and stressor-related disorders. If the phobia develops following a traumatic 
event, posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD) should be considered as a diagnosis. How- 
ever, traumatic events can precede the onset of PTSD and specific phobia. In this case, a di- 
agnosis of specific phobia would be assigned only if all of the criteria for PTSD are not met. 


Eating disorders. A diagnosis of specific phobia is not given if the avoidance behavior is 
exclusively limited to avoidance of food and food-related cues, in which case a diagnosis 
of anorexia nervosa or bulimia nervosa should be considered. 


Schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorders. When the fear and avoidance 
are due to delusional thinking (as in schizophrenia or other schizophrenia spectrum and 
other psychotic disorders), a diagnosis of specific phobia is not warranted. 


Comorbidity 


Specific phobia is rarely seen in medical-clinical settings in the absence of other psycho- 
pathology and is more frequently seen in nonmedical mental health settings. Specific pho- 
bia is frequently associated with a range of other disorders, especially depression in older 
adults. Because of early onset, specific phobia is typically the temporally primary disorder. 
Individuals with specific phobia are at increased risk for the development of other dis- 
orders, including other anxiety disorders, depressive and bipolar disorders, substance- 
related disorders, somatic symptom and related disorders, and personality disorders (par- 
ticularly dependent personality disorder). 


Social Anxiety Disorder (Social Phobia) 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.23 (F40.10) 


A. Marked fear or anxiety about one or more social situations in which the individual is 
exposed to possible scrutiny by others. Examples include social interactions (e.g., hav- 
ing a conversation, meeting unfamiliar people), being observed (e.g., eating or drink- 
ing), and performing in front of others (e.g., giving a speech). 

Note: In children, the anxiety must occur in peer settings and not just during interac- 
tions with adults. 

B. The individual fears that he or she will act in a way or show anxiety symptoms that will 
be negatively evaluated (i.e., will be humiliating or embarrassing; will lead to rejection 
or offend others). 

C. The social situations almost always provoke fear or anxiety. 

Note: In children, the fear or anxiety may be expressed by crying, tantrums, freezing, 
clinging, shrinking, or failing to speak in social situations. 


D. The social situations are avoided or endured with intense fear or anxiety. 


Social Anxiety Disorder (Social Phobia) 203 


E. The fear or anxiety is out of proportion to the actual threat posed by the social situation 
and to the sociocultural context. 

F. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is persistent, typically lasting for 6 months or more. 

G. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in 
social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

H. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a sub- 
stance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition. 

l. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is not better explained by the symptoms of another 
mental disorder, such as panic disorder, body dysmorphic disorder, or autism spectrum 
disorder. 

J. If another medical condition (e.g., Parkinson’s disease, obesity, disfigurement from burns 
or injury) is present, the fear, anxiety, or avoidance is clearly unrelated or is excessive. 


Specify if: 
Performance only: If the fear is restricted to speaking or performing in public. 


Specifiers 

Individuals with the performance only type of social anxiety disorder have performance 
fears that are typically most impairing in their professional lives (e.g., musicians, dancers, 
performers, athletes) or in roles that require regular public speaking. Performance fears 
may also manifest in work, school, or academic settings in which regular public presenta- 
tions are required. Individuals with performance only social anxiety disorder do not fear 
or avoid nonperformance social situations. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of social anxiety disorder is a marked, or intense, fear or anxiety of so- 
cial situations in which the individual may be scrutinized by others. In children the fear or 
anxiety must occur in peer settings and not just during interactions with adults (Criterion 
A). When exposed to such social situations, the individual fears that he or she will be neg- 
atively evaluated. The individual is concerned that he or she will be judged as anxious, 
weak, crazy, stupid, boring, intimidating, dirty, or unlikable. The individual fears that 
he or she will act or appear in a certain way or show anxiety symptoms, such as blushing, 
trembling, sweating, stumbling over one’s words, or staring, that will be negatively eval- 
uated by others (Criterion B). Some individuals fear offending others or being rejected as 
a result. Fear of offending others—for example, by a gaze or by showing anxiety symp- 
toms—may be the predominant fear in individuals from cultures with strong collectivistic 
orientations. An individual with fear of trembling of the hands may avoid drinking, eat- 
ing, writing, or pointing in public; an individual with fear of sweating may avoid shaking 
hands or eating spicy foods; and an individual with fear of blushing may avoid public per- 
formance, bright lights, or discussion about intimate topics. Some individuals fear and 
avoid urinating in public restrooms when other individuals are present (i.e., paruresis, or 
“shy bladder syndrome”). 

The social situations almost always provoke fear or anxiety (Criterion C). Thus, an in- 
dividual who becomes anxious only occasionally in the social situation(s) would not be di- 
agnosed with social anxiety disorder. However, the degree and type of fear and anxiety 
may vary (e.g., anticipatory anxiety, a panic attack) across different occasions. The antici- 
patory anxiety may occur sometimes far in advance of upcoming situations (e.g., worrying 
every day for weeks before attending a social event, repeating a speech for days in advance). 
In children, the fear or anxiety may be expressed by crying, tantrums, freezing, clinging, or 
shrinking in social situations. The individual will often avoid the feared social situations. 
Alternatively, the situations are endured with intense fear or anxiety (Criterion D). Avoid- 


204 Anxiety Disorders 


ance can be extensive (e.g., not going to parties, refusing school) or subtle (e.g., overpre- 
paring the text of a speech, diverting attention to others, limiting eye contact). 

The fear or anxiety is judged to be out of proportion to the actual risk of being nega- 
tively evaluated or to the consequences of such negative evaluation (Criterion E). Some- 
times, the anxiety may not be judged to be excessive, because it is related to an actual 
danger (e.g., being bullied or tormented by others). However, individuals with social anx- 
iety disorder often overestimate the negative consequences of social situations, and thus 
the judgment of being out of proportion is made by the clinician. The individual's socio- 
cultural context needs to be taken into account when this judgment is being made. For ex- 
ample, in certain cultures, behavior that might otherwise appear socially anxious may be 
considered appropriate in social situations (e.g., might be seen as a sign of respect). 

The duration of the disturbance is typically at least 6 months (Criterion F). This dura- 
tion threshold helps distinguish the disorder from transient social fears that are com- 
mon, particularly among children and in the community. However, the duration criterion 
should be used as a general guide, with allowance for some degree of flexibility. The fear, 
anxiety, and avoidance must interfere significantly with the individual’s normal routine, 
occupational or academic functioning, or social activities or relationships, or must cause 
clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important ar- 
eas of functioning (Criterion G). For example, an individual who is afraid to speak in pub- 
lic would not receive a diagnosis of social anxiety disorder if this activity is not routinely 
encountered on the job or in classroom work, and if the individual is not significantly dis- 
tressed about it. However, if the individual avoids, or is passed over for, the job or educa- 
tion he or she really wants because of social anxiety symptoms, Criterion G is met. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with social anxiety disorder may be inadequately assertive or excessively sub- 
missive or, less commonly, highly controlling of the conversation. They may show overly 
rigid body posture or inadequate eye contact, or speak with an overly soft voice. These in- 
dividuals may be shy or withdrawn, and they may be less open in conversations and dis- 
close little about themselves. They may seek employment in jobs that do not require social 
contact, although this is not the case for individuals with social anxiety disorder, perfor- 
mance only. They may live at home longer. Men may be delayed in marrying and having 
a family, whereas women who would want to work outside the home may live a life as 
homemaker and mother. Self-medication with substances is common (e.g., drinking be- 
fore going to a party). Social anxiety among older adults may also include exacerbation of 
symptoms of medical illnesses, such as increased tremor or tachycardia. Blushing is a hall- 
mark physical response of social anxiety disorder. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence estimate of social anxiety disorder for the United States is ap- 
proximately 7%. Lower 12-month prevalence estimates are seen in much of the world us- 
ing the same diagnostic instrument, clustering around 0.5%-2.0%; median prevalence in 
Europe is 2.3%. The 12-month prevalence rates in children and adolescents are comparable 
to those in adults. Prevalence rates decrease with age. The 12-month prevalence for older 
adults ranges from 2% to 5%. In general, higher rates of social anxiety disorder are found 
in females than in males in the general population (with odds ratios ranging from 1.5 to 
2.2), and the gender difference in prevalence is more pronounced in adolescents and 
young adults. Gender rates are equivalent or slightly higher for males in clinical samples, 
and it is assumed that gender roles and social expectations play a significant role in ex- 
plaining the heightened help-seeking behavior in male patients. Prevalence in the United 
States is higher in American Indians and lower in persons of Asian, Latino, African Amer- 
ican, and Afro-Caribbean descent compared with non-Hispanic whites. 


Social Anxiety Disorder (Social Phobia) 205 


Development and Course 


Median age at onset of social anxiety disorder in the United States is 13 years, and 75% of 
individuals have an age at onset between 8 and 15 years. The disorder sometimes emerges 
out of a childhood history of social inhibition or shyness in U.S. and European studies. On- 
set can also occur in early childhood. Onset of social anxiety disorder may follow a stress- 
ful or humiliating experience (e.g., being bullied, vomiting during a public speech), or it 
may be insidious, developing slowly. First onset in adulthood is relatively rare and is more 
likely to occur after a stressful or humiliating event or after life changes that require new 
social roles (e.g., marrying someone from a different social class, receiving a job promo- 
tion). Social anxiety disorder may diminish after an individual with fear of dating marries 
and may reemerge after divorce. Among individuals presenting to clinical care, the disor- 
der tends to be particularly persistent. 

Adolescents endorse a broader pattern of fear and avoidance, including of dating, 
compared with younger children. Older adults express social anxiety at lower levels but 
across a broader range of situations, whereas younger adults express higher levels of so- 
cial anxiety for specific situations. In older adults, social anxiety may concern disability 
due to declining sensory functioning (hearing, vision) or embarrassment about one’s ap- 
pearance (e.g., tremor as a symptom of Parkinson’s disease) or functioning due to medical 
conditions, incontinence, or cognitive impairment (e.g., forgetting people’s names). In the 
community approximately 30% of individuals with social anxiety disorder experience re- 
mission of symptoms within 1 year, and about 50% experience remission within a few 
years. For approximately 60% of individuals without a specific treatment for social anxiety 
disorder, the course takes several years or longer. 

Detection of social anxiety disorder in older adults may be challenging because of sev- 
eral factors, including a focus on somatic symptoms, comorbid medical illness, limited 
insight, changes to social environment or roles that may obscure impairment in social 
functioning, or reticence about describing psychological distress. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Underlying traits that predispose individuals to social anxiety disor- 
der include behavioral inhibition and fear of negative evaluation. 


Environmental. There is no causative role of increased rates of childhood maltreatment or 
other early-onset psychosocial adversity in the development of social anxiety disorder. How- 
ever, childhood maltreatment and adversity are risk factors for social anxiety disorder. 


Genetic and physiological. Traits predisposing individuals to social anxiety disorder, 
such as behavioral inhibition, are strongly genetically influenced. The genetic influence is 
subject to gene-environment interaction; that is, children with high behavioral inhibition 
are more susceptible to environmental influences, such as socially anxious modeling by 
parents. Also, social anxiety disorder is heritable (but performance-only anxiety less so). 
First-degree relatives have a two to six times greater chance of having social anxiety dis- 
order, and liability to the disorder involves the interplay of disorder-specific (e.g., fear of 
negative evaluation) and nonspecific (e.g., neuroticism) genetic factors. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The syndrome of taijin kyofusho (e.g., in Japan and Korea) is often characterized by social- 
evaluative concerns, fulfilling criteria for social anxiety disorder, that are associated with 
the fear that the individual makes other people uncomfortable (e.g., “My gaze upsets peo- 
ple so they look away and avoid me”), a fear that is at times experienced with delusional 
intensity. This symptom may also be found in non-Asian settings. Other presentations 
of taijin kyofusho may fulfill criteria for body dysmorphic disorder or delusional disorder. 


206 Anxiety Disorders 


Immigrant status is associated with significantly lower rates of social anxiety disorder in 
both Latino and non-Latino white groups. Prevalence rates of social anxiety disorder may 
not be in line with self-reported social anxiety levels in the same culture—that is, societies 
with strong collectivistic orientations may report high levels of social anxiety but low prev- 
alence of social anxiety disorder. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Females with social anxiety disorder report a greater number of social fears and comorbid 
depressive, bipolar, and anxiety disorders, whereas males are more likely to fear dating, 
have oppositional defiant disorder or conduct disorder, and use alcohol and illicit drugs to 
relieve symptoms of the disorder. Paruresis is more common in males. 


Functional Consequences of Social Anxiety Disorder 


Social anxiety disorder is associated with elevated rates of school dropout and with de- 
creased well-being, employment, workplace productivity, socioeconomic status, and quality 
of life. Social anxiety disorder is also associated with being single, unmarried, or divorced 
and with not having children, particularly among men. In older adults, there may be impair- 
ment in caregiving duties and volunteer activities. Social anxiety disorder also impedes lei- 
sure activities. Despite the extent of distress and social impairment associated with social 
anxiety disorder, only about half of individuals with the disorder in Western societies ever 
seek treatment, and they tend to do so only after 15-20 years of experiencing symptoms. Not 
being employed is a strong predictor for the persistence of social anxiety disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normative shyness. Shyness (i.e., social reticence) is a common personality trait and is 
not by itself pathological. In some societies, shyness is even evaluated positively. How- 
ever, when there is a significant adverse impact on social, occupational, and other impor- 
tant areas of functioning, a diagnosis of social anxiety disorder should be considered, and 
when full diagnostic criteria for social anxiety disorder are met, the disorder should be di- 
agnosed. Only a minority (12%) of self-identified shy individuals in the United States have 
symptoms that meet diagnostic criteria for social anxiety disorder. 


Agoraphobia. Individuals with agoraphobia may fear and avoid social situations (e.g., go- 
ing to a movie) because escape might be difficult or help might not be available in the event of 
incapacitation or panic-like symptoms, whereas individuals with social anxiety disorder are 
most fearful of scrutiny by others. Moreover, individuals with social anxiety disorder are likely 
to be calm when left entirely alone, which is often not the case in agoraphobia. 


Panic disorder. Individuals with social anxiety disorder may have panic attacks, but the 
concern is about fear of negative evaluation, whereas in panic disorder the concern is 
about the panic attacks themselves. 


Generalized anxiety disorder. Social worries are common in generalized anxiety disorder, 
but the focus is more on the nature of ongoing relationships rather than on fear of negative 
evaluation. Individuals with generalized anxiety disorder, particularly children, may have ex- 
cessive worries about the quality of their social performance, but these worries also pertain to 
nonsocial performance and when the individual is not being evaluated by others. In social anx- 
iety disorder, the worries focus on social performance and others’ evaluation. 


Separation anxiety disorder. Individuals with separation anxiety disorder may avoid 
social settings (including school refusal) because of concerns about being separated from 
attachment figures or, in children, about requiring the presence of a parent when it is not 
developmentally appropriate. Individuals with separation anxiety disorder are usually 
comfortable in social settings when their attachment figure is present or when they are at 


Social Anxiety Disorder (Social Phobia) 207 


home, whereas those with social anxiety disorder may be uncomfortable when social sit- 
uations occur at home or in the presence of attachment figures. 


Specific phobias. Individuals with specific phobias may fear embarrassment or humil- 
iation (e.g., embarrassment about fainting when they have their blood drawn), but they do 
not generally fear negative evaluation in other social situations. 


Selective mutism. Individuals with selective mutism may fail to speak because of fear of 
negative evaluation, but they do not fear negative evaluation in social situations where no 
speaking is required (e.g., nonverbal play). 


Major depressive disorder. Individuals with major depressive disorder may be con- 
cerned about being negatively evaluated by others because they feel they are bad or not 
worthy of being liked. In contrast, individuals with social anxiety disorder are worried 
about being negatively evaluated because of certain social behaviors or physical symptoms. 


Body dysmorphic disorder. Individuals with body dysmorphic disorder are preoccu- 
pied with one or more perceived defects or flaws in their physical appearance that are not 
observable or appear slight to others; this preoccupation often causes social anxiety and 
avoidance. If their social fears and avoidance are caused only by their beliefs about their 
appearance, a separate diagnosis of social anxiety disorder is not warranted. 


Delusional disorder. Individuals with delusional disorder may have nonbizarre delu- 
sions and/or hallucinations related to the delusional theme that focus on being rejected by 
or offending others. Although extent of insight into beliefs about social situations may 
vary, many individuals with social anxiety disorder have good insight that their beliefs are 
out of proportion to the actual threat posed by the social situation. 


Autism spectrum disorder. Social anxiety and social communication deficits are hall- 
marks of autism spectrum disorder. Individuals with social anxiety disorder typically 
have adequate age-appropriate social relationships and social communication capacity, 
although they may appear to have impairment in these areas when first interacting with 
unfamiliar peers or adults. 


Personality disorders. Given its frequent onset in childhood and its persistence into and 
through adulthood, social anxiety disorder may resemble a personality disorder. The most 
apparent overlap is with avoidant personality disorder. Individuals with avoidant person- 
ality disorder have a broader avoidance pattern than those with social anxiety disorder. 
Nonetheless, social anxiety disorder is typically more comorbid with avoidant personality 
disorder than with other personality disorders, and avoidant personality disorder is more 
comorbid with social anxiety disorder than with other anxiety disorders. 


Other mental disorders. Social fears and discomfort can occur as part of schizophrenia, 
but other evidence for psychotic symptoms is usually present. In individuals with an eat- 
ing disorder, it is important to determine that fear of negative evaluation about eating 
disorder symptoms or behaviors (e.g., purging and vomiting) is not the sole source of so- 
cial anxiety before applying a diagnosis of social anxiety disorder. Similarly, obsessive- 
compulsive disorder may be associated with social anxiety, but the additional diagnosis of 
social anxiety disorder is used only when social fears and avoidance are independent of 
the foci of the obsessions and compulsions. 


Other medical conditions. Medical conditions may produce symptoms that may be em- 
barrassing (e.g. trembling in Parkinson’s disease). When the fear of negative evaluation 
due to other medical conditions is excessive, a diagnosis of social anxiety disorder should 
be considered. 


Oppositional defiant disorder. Refusal to speak due to opposition to authority figures 
should be differentiated from failure to speak due to fear of negative evaluation. 


208 Anxiety Disorders 


Comorbidity 

Social anxiety disorder is often comorbid with other anxiety disorders, major depressive 
disorder, and substance use disorders, and the onset of social anxiety disorder generally 
precedes that of the other disorders, except for specific phobia and separation anxiety dis- 
order. Chronic social isolation in the course of a social anxiety disorder may result in major 
depressive disorder. Comorbidity with depression is high also in older adults. Substances 
may be used as self-medication for social fears, but the symptoms of substance intoxica- 
tion or withdrawal, such as trembling, may also be a source of (further) social fear. Social 
anxiety disorder is frequently comorbid with bipolar disorder or body dysmorphic disor- 
der; for example, an individual has body dysmorphic disorder concerning a preoccupa- 
tion with a slight irregularity of her nose, as well as social anxiety disorder because of a 
severe fear of sounding unintelligent. The more generalized form of social anxiety disor- 
der, but not social anxiety disorder, performance only, is often comorbid with avoidant 
personality disorder. In children, comorbidities with high-functioning autism and selec- 
tive mutism are common. 


Panic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.01 (F41.0) 


A. Recurrent unexpected panic attacks. A panic attack is an abrupt surge of intense fear 
or intense discomfort that reaches a peak within minutes, and during which time four 
(or more) of the following symptoms occur: 


Note: The abrupt surge can occur from a calm state or an anxious state. 


1. Palpitations, pounding heart, or accelerated heart rate. 
2. Sweating. 
3. Trembling or shaking. 
4. Sensations of shortness of breath or smothering. 
5. Feelings of choking. 
6. Chest pain or discomfort. 
7. Nausea or abdominal distress. 
8. Feeling dizzy, unsteady, light-headed, or faint. 
9. Chills or heat sensations. 
10. Paresthesias (numbness or tingling sensations). 
11. Derealization (feelings of unreality) or depersonalization (being detached from one- 
self). 
12. Fear of losing control or “going crazy.” 


13. Fear of dying. 


Note: Culture-specific symptoms (e.g., tinnitus, neck soreness, headache, uncontrol- 
lable screaming or crying) may be seen. Such symptoms should not count as one of 
the four required symptoms. 


B. At least one of the attacks has been followed by 1 month (or more) of one or both of 
the following: 


1. Persistent concern or worry about additional panic attacks or their consequences 
(e.g., losing control, having a heart attack, “going crazy”). 

2. Asignificant maladaptive change in behavior related to the attacks (e.g., behaviors 
designed to avoid having panic attacks, such as avoidance of exercise or unfamiliar 
situations). 


Panic Disorder 209 


C. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition (e.g., hyperthyroidism, car- 
diopulmonary disorders). 

D. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder (e.g., the panic at- 
tacks do not occur only in response to feared social situations, as in social anxiety dis- 
order; in response to circumscribed phobic objects or situations, as in specific phobia; 
in response to obsessions, as in obsessive-compulsive disorder; in response to re- 
minders of traumatic events, as in posttraumatic stress disorder; or in response to sep- 
aration from attachment figures, as in separation anxiety disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 


Panic disorder refers to recurrent unexpected panic attacks (Criterion A). A panic attack is 
an abrupt surge of intense fear or intense discomfort that reaches a peak within minutes, 
and during which time four or more of a list of 13 physical and cognitive symptoms occur. 
The term recurrent literally means more than one unexpected panic attack. The term unex- 
pected refers to a panic attack for which there is no obvious cue or trigger at the time of oc- 
currence—that is, the attack appears to occur from out of the blue, such as when the 
individual is relaxing or emerging from sleep (nocturnal panic attack). In contrast, expected 
panic attacks are attacks for which there is an obvious cue or trigger, such as a situation in 
which panic attacks typically occur. The determination of whether panic attacks are ex- 
pected or unexpected is made by the clinician, who makes this judgment based on a com- 
bination of careful questioning as to the sequence of events preceding or leading up to the 
attack and the individual’s own judgment of whether or not the attack seemed to occur for 
no apparent reason. Cultural interpretations may influence the assignment of panic at- 
tacks as expected or unexpected (see section “Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues” for this 
disorder). In the United States and Europe, approximately one-half of individuals with 
panic disorder have expected panic attacks as well as unexpected panic attacks. Thus, the 
presence of expected panic attacks does not rule out the diagnosis of panic disorder. For 
more details regarding expected versus unexpected panic attacks, see the text accompa- 
nying panic attacks (pp. 214-217). 

The frequency and severity of panic attacks vary widely. In terms of frequency, there 
may be moderately frequent attacks (e.g., one per week) for months at a time, or short 
bursts of more frequent attacks (e.g., daily) separated by weeks or months without any at- 
tacks or with less frequent attacks (e.g., two per month) over many years. Persons who 
have infrequent panic attacks resemble persons with more frequent panic attacks in terms 
of panic attack symptoms, demographic characteristics, comorbidity with other disorders, 
family history, and biological data. In terms of severity, individuals with panic disorder 
may have both full-symptom (four or more symptoms) and limited-symptom (fewer than 
four symptoms) attacks, and the number and type of panic attack symptoms frequently 
differ from one panic attack to the next. However, more than one unexpected full-symp- 
tom panic attack is required for the diagnosis of panic disorder. 

The worries about panic attacks or their consequences usually pertain to physical con- 
cerns, such as worry that panic attacks reflect the presence of life-threatening illnesses 
(e.g., cardiac disease, seizure disorder); social concerns, such as embarrassment or fear of 
being judged negatively by others because of visible panic symptoms; and concerns about 
mental functioning, such as “going crazy” or losing control (Criterion B). The maladaptive 
changes in behavior represent attempts to minimize or avoid panic attacks or their conse- 
quences. Examples include avoiding physical exertion, reorganizing daily life to ensure 
that help is available in the event of a panic attack, restricting usual daily activities, and 
avoiding agoraphobia-type situations, such as leaving home, using public transportation, 
or shopping. If agoraphobia is present, a separate diagnosis of agoraphobia is given. 


210 Anxiety Disorders 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


One type of unexpected panic attack is a nocturnal panic attack (i.e., waking from sleep in 
a state of panic, which differs from panicking after fully waking from sleep). In the United 
States, this type of panic attack has been estimated to occur at least one time in roughly 
one-quarter to one-third of individuals with panic disorder, of whom the majority also 
have daytime panic attacks. In addition to worry about panic attacks and their conse- 
quences, many individuals with panic disorder report constant or intermittent feelings of 
anxiety that are more broadly related to health and mental health concerns. For example, 
individuals with panic disorder often anticipate a catastrophic outcome from a mild phys- 
ical symptom or medication side effect (e.g., thinking that they may have heart disease or 
that a headache means presence of a brain tumor). Such individuals often are relatively in- 
tolerant of medication side effects. In addition, there may be pervasive concerns about 
abilities to complete daily tasks or withstand daily stressors, excessive use of drugs (e.g., 
alcohol, prescribed medications or illicit drugs) to control panic attacks, or extreme behav- 
iors aimed at controlling panic attacks (e.g., severe restrictions on food intake or avoidance 
of specific foods or medications because of concerns about physical symptoms that pro- 
voke panic attacks). 


Prevalence 


In the general population, the 12-month prevalence estimate for panic disorder across the 
United States and several European countries is about 2%-3% in adults and adolescents. In 
the United States, significantly lower rates of panic disorder are reported among Latinos, 
African Americans, Caribbean blacks, and Asian Americans, compared with non-Latino 
whites; American Indians, by contrast, have significantly higher rates. Lower estimates 
have been reported for Asian, African, and Latin American countries, ranging from 0.1% 
to 0.8%. Females are more frequently affected than males, at a rate of approximately 2:1. The 
gender differentiation occurs in adolescence and is already observable before age 14 years. 
Although panic attacks occur in children, the overall prevalence of panic disorder is low 
before age 14 years (<0.4%). The rates of panic disorder show a gradual increase during ad- 
olescence, particularly in females, and possibly following the onset of puberty, and peak dur- 
ing adulthood. The prevalence rates decline in older individuals (i.e., 0.7% in adults over 
the age of 64), possibly reflecting diminishing severity to subclinical levels. 


Development and Course 


The median age at onset for panic disorder in the United States is 20-24 years. A small 
number of cases begin in childhood, and onset after age 45 years is unusual but can occur. 
The usual course, if the disorder is untreated, is chronic but waxing and waning. Some in- 
dividuals may have episodic outbreaks with years of remission in between, and others 
may have continuous severe symptomatology. Only a minority of individuals have full 
remission without subsequent relapse within a few years. The course of panic disorder 
typically is complicated by a range of other disorders, in particular other anxiety disor- 
ders, depressive disorders, and substance use disorders (see section “Comorbidity” for 
this disorder). 

Although panic disorder is very rare in childhood, first occurrence of “fearful spells” is 
often dated retrospectively back to childhood. As in adults, panic disorder in adolescents 
tends to have a chronic course and is frequently comorbid with other anxiety, depressive, 
and bipolar disorders. To date, no differences in the clinical presentation between adoles- 
cents and adults have been found. However, adolescents may be less worried about addi- 
tional panic attacks than are young adults. Lower prevalence of panic disorder in older 
adults appears to be attributable to age-related “dampening” of the autonomic nervous 
system response. Many older individuals with “panicky feelings” are observed to have a 
“hybrid” of limited-symptom panic attacks and generalized anxiety. Also, older adults 


Panic Disorder 211 


tend to attribute their panic attacks to certain stressful situations, such as a medical pro- 
cedure or social setting. Older individuals may retrospectively endorse explanations for 
the panic attack (which would preclude the diagnosis of panic disorder), even if an attack 
might actually have been unexpected in the moment (and thus qualify as the basis for a 
panic disorder diagnosis). This may result in under-endorsement of unexpected panic at- 
tacks in older individuals. Thus, careful questioning of older adults is required to assess 
whether panic attacks were expected before entering the situation, so that unexpected 
panic attacks and the diagnosis of panic disorder are not overlooked. 

While the low rate of panic disorder in children could relate to difficulties in symptom 
reporting, this seems unlikely given that children are capable of reporting intense fear or 
panic in relation to separation and to phobic objects or phobic situations. Adolescents 
might be less willing than adults to openly discuss panic attacks. Therefore, clinicians 
should be aware that unexpected panic attacks do occur in adolescents, much as they do in 
adults, and be attuned to this possibility when encountering adolescents presenting with 
episodes of intense fear or distress. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Negative affectivity (neuroticism) (i.e., proneness to experiencing neg- 
ative emotions) and anxiety sensitivity (i.e., the disposition to believe that symptoms of 
anxiety are harmful) are risk factors for the onset of panic attacks and, separately, for 
worry about panic, although their risk status for the diagnosis of panic disorder is un- 
known. History of “fearful spells” (i.e., limited-symptom attacks that do not meet full cri- 
teria for a panic attack) may be a risk factor for later panic attacks and panic disorder. 
Although separation anxiety in childhood, especially when severe, may precede the later 
development of panic disorder, it is not a consistent risk factor. 


Environmental. Reports of childhood experiences of sexual and physical abuse are more 
common in panic disorder than in certain other anxiety disorders. Smoking is a risk factor 
for panic attacks and panic disorder. Most individuals report identifiable stressors in the 
months before their first panic attack (e.g., interpersonal stressors and stressors related to 
physical well-being, such as negative experiences with illicit or prescription drugs, dis- 
ease, or death in the family). 


Genetic and physiological. It is believed that multiple genes confer vulnerability to panic 
disorder. However, the exact genes, gene products, or functions related to the genetic re- 
gions implicated remain unknown. Current neural systems models for panic disorder em- 
phasize the amygdala and related structures, much as in other anxiety disorders. There is 
an increased risk for panic disorder among offspring of parents with anxiety, depressive, 
and bipolar disorders. Respiratory disturbance, such as asthma, is associated with panic 
disorder, in terms of past history, comorbidity, and family history. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The rate of fears about mental and somatic symptoms of anxiety appears to vary across 
cultures and may influence the rate of panic attacks and panic disorder. Also, cultural ex- 
pectations may influence the classification of panic attacks as expected or unexpected. For 
example, a Vietnamese individual who has a panic attack after walking out into a windy 
environment (trting gid; “hit by the wind”) may attribute the panic attack to exposure to 
wind as a result of the cultural syndrome that links these two experiences, resulting in clas- 
sification of the panic attack as expected. Various other cultural syndromes are associated 
with panic disorder, including ataque de nervios (“attack of nerves”) among Latin Ameri- 
cans and khyél attacks and “soul loss” among Cambodians. Ataque de nervios may involve 
trembling, uncontrollable screaming or crying, aggressive or suicidal behavior, and deper- 
sonalization or derealization, which may be experienced longer than the few minutes typical 


212 Anxiety Disorders 


of panic attacks. Some clinical presentations of ataque de nervios fulfill criteria for condi- 
tions other than panic attack (e.g., other specified dissociative disorder). These syndromes 
impact the symptoms and frequency of panic disorder, including the individual’s attribu- 
tion of unexpectedness, as cultural syndromes may create fear of certain situations, rang- 
ing from interpersonal arguments (associated with ataque de nervios), to types of exertion 
(associated with khyél attacks), to atmospheric wind (associated with triing gid attacks). 
Clarification of the details of cultural attributions may aid in distinguishing expected and 
unexpected panic attacks. For more information regarding cultural syndromes, refer to the 
“Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress” in the Appendix. 

The specific worries about panic attacks or their consequences are likely to vary from 
one culture to another (and across different age groups and gender). For panic disorder, 
U.S. community samples of non-Latino whites have significantly less functional impair- 
ment than African Americans. There are also higher rates of objectively defined severity in 
non-Latino Caribbean blacks with panic disorder, and lower rates of panic disorder over- 
all in both African American and Afro-Caribbean groups, suggesting that among individ- 
uals of African descent, the criteria for panic disorder may be met only when there is 
substantial severity and impairment. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The clinical features of panic disorder do not appear to differ between males and females. 
There is some evidence for sexual dimorphism, with an association between panic disor- 
der and the catechol-O-methyltransferase (COMT) gene in females only. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Agents with disparate mechanisms of action, such as sodium lactate, caffeine, isoprotere- 
nol, yohimbine, carbon dioxide, and cholecystokinin, provoke panic attacks in individuals 
with panic disorder to a much greater extent than in healthy control subjects (and in some 
cases, than in individuals with other anxiety, depressive, or bipolar disorders without 
panic attacks). Also, for a proportion of individuals with panic disorder, panic attacks are 
related to hypersensitive medullary carbon dioxide detectors, resulting in hypocapnia and 
other respiratory irregularities. However, none of these laboratory findings are consid- 
ered diagnostic of panic disorder. 


Suicide Risk 


Panic attacks and a diagnosis of panic disorder in the past 12 months are related to a higher 
rate of suicide attempts and suicidal ideation in the past 12 months even when comorbid- 
ity and a history of childhood abuse and other suicide risk factors are taken into account. 


Functional Consequences of Panic Disorder 


Panic disorder is associated with high levels of social, occupational, and physical disabil- 
ity; considerable economic costs; and the highest number of medical visits among the anx- 
iety disorders, although the effects are strongest with the presence of agoraphobia. 
Individuals with panic disorder may be frequently absent from work or school for doctor 
and emergency room visits, which can lead to unemployment or dropping out of school. 
In older adults, impairment may be seen in caregiving duties or volunteer activities. Full- 
symptom panic attacks typically are associated with greater morbidity (e.g., greater health 
care utilization, more disability, poorer quality of life) than limited-symptom attacks. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other specified anxiety disorder or unspecified anxiety disorder. Panic disorder should 
not be diagnosed if full-symptom (unexpected) panic attacks have never been experienced. In 


Panic Disorder 213 


the case of only limited-symptom unexpected panic attacks, an other specified anxiety dis- 
order or unspecified anxiety disorder diagnosis should be considered. 


Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition. Panic disorder is not diagnosed if 
the panic attacks are judged to be a direct physiological consequence of another medical 
condition. Examples of medical conditions that can cause panic attacks include hyperthy- 
roidism, hyperparathyroidism, pheochromocytoma, vestibular dysfunctions, seizure dis- 
orders, and cardiopulmonary conditions (e.g., arrhythmias, supraventricular tachycardia, 
asthma, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease [COPD]). Appropriate laboratory tests 
(e.g., serum calcium levels for hyperparathyroidism; Holter monitor for arrhythmias) or 
physical examinations (e.g., for cardiac conditions) may be helpful in determining the eti- 
ological role of another medical condition. 


Substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder. Panic disorder is not diagnosed if 
the panic attacks are judged to be a direct physiological consequence of a substance. In- 
toxication with central nervous system stimulants (e.g., cocaine, amphetamines, caffeine) 
or cannabis and withdrawal from central nervous system depressants (e.g., alcohol, bar- 
biturates) can precipitate a panic attack. However, if panic attacks continue to occur out- 
side of the context of substance use (e.g., long after the effects of intoxication or withdrawal 
have ended), a diagnosis of panic disorder should be considered. In addition, because 
panic disorder may precede substance use in some individuals and may be associated 
with increased substance use, especially for purposes of self-medication, a detailed history 
should be taken to determine if the individual had panic attacks prior to excessive sub- 
stance use. If this is the case, a diagnosis of panic disorder should be considered in addition 
to a diagnosis of substance use disorder. Features such as onset after age 45 years or the 
presence of atypical symptoms during a panic attack (e.g., vertigo, loss of consciousness, 
loss of bladder or bowel control, slurred speech, amnesia) suggest the possibility that an- 
other medical condition or a substance may be causing the panic attack symptoms. 


Other mental disorders with panic attacks as an associated feature (e.g., other anxiety 
disorders and psychotic disorders). Panic attacks that occur as a symptom of other anx- 
iety disorders are expected (e.g., triggered by social situations in social anxiety disorder, by 
phobic objects or situations in specific phobia or agoraphobia, by worry in generalized anx- 
iety disorder, by separation from home or attachment figures in separation anxiety disorder) 
and thus would not meet criteria for panic disorder. (Note: Sometimes an unexpected panic 
attack is associated with the onset of another anxiety disorder, but then the attacks become 
expected, whereas panic disorder is characterized by recurrent unexpected panic attacks.) If 
the panic attacks occur only in response to specific triggers, then only the relevant anxiety 
disorder is assigned. However, if the individual experiences unexpected panic attacks as 
well and shows persistent concern and worry or behavioral change because of the attacks, 
then an additional diagnosis of panic disorder should be considered. 


Comorbidity 


Panic disorder infrequently occurs in clinical settings in the absence of other psychopa- 
thology. The prevalence of panic disorder is elevated in individuals with other disorders, 
particularly other anxiety disorders (and especially agoraphobia), major depression, bipo- 
lar disorder, and possibly mild alcohol use disorder. While panic disorder often has an ear- 
lier age at onset than the comorbid disorder(s), onset sometimes occurs after the comorbid 
disorder and may be seen as a severity marker of the comorbid illness. 

Reported lifetime rates of comorbidity between major depressive disorder and panic 
disorder vary widely, ranging from 10% to 65% in individuals with panic disorder. In ap- 
proximately one-third of individuals with both disorders, the depression precedes the on- 
set of panic disorder. In the remaining two-thirds, depression occurs coincident with or 
following the onset of panic disorder. A subset of individuals with panic disorder develop 
a substance-related disorder, which for some represents an attempt to treat their anxiety 


214 Anxiety Disorders 


with alcohol or medications. Comorbidity with other anxiety disorders and illness anxiety 
disorder is also common. 

Panic disorder is significantly comorbid with numerous general medical symptoms 
and conditions, including, but not limited to, dizziness, cardiac arrhythmias, hyperthy- 
roidism, asthma, COPD, and irritable bowel syndrome. However, the nature of the asso- 
ciation (e.g., cause and effect) between panic disorder and these conditions remains 
unclear. Although mitral valve prolapse and thyroid disease are more common among in- 
dividuals with panic disorder than in the general population, the differences in prevalence 
are not consistent. 


Panic Attack Specifier 


Note: Symptoms are presented for the purpose of identifying a panic attack; however, 
panic attack is not a mental disorder and cannot be coded. Panic attacks can occur in the 
context of any anxiety disorder as well as other mental disorders (e.g., depressive disor- 
ders, posttraumatic stress disorder, substance use disorders) and some medical condi- 
tions (e.g., cardiac, respiratory, vestibular, gastrointestinal). When the presence of a panic 
attack is identified, it should be noted as a specifier (e.g., “posttraumatic stress disorder 
with panic attacks”). For panic disorder, the presence of panic attack is contained within 
the criteria for the disorder and panic attack is not used as a specifier. 

An abrupt surge of intense fear or intense discomfort that reaches a peak within minutes, 
and during which time four (or more) of the following symptoms occur: 

Note: The abrupt surge can occur from a calm state or an anxious state. 


1. Palpitations, pounding heart, or accelerated heart rate. 
2. Sweating. 
3. Trembling or shaking. 
4. Sensations of shortness of breath or smothering. 
5. Feelings of choking. 
6. Chest pain or discomfort. 
7. Nausea or abdominal distress. 
8. Feeling dizzy, unsteady, light-headed, or faint. 
9. Chills or heat sensations. 
10. Paresthesias (numbness or tingling sensations). 
11. Derealization (feelings of unreality) or depersonalization (being detached from oneself). 
12. Fear of losing control or “going crazy.” 
13. Fear of dying. 


Note: Culture-specific symptoms (e.g., tinnitus, neck soreness, headache, uncontrollable 
screaming or crying) may be seen. Such symptoms should not count as one of the four 
required symptoms. 


Features 


The essential feature of a panic attack is an abrupt surge of intense fear or intense discomfort 
that reaches a peak within minutes and during which time four or more of 13 physical and cog- 
nitive symptoms occur. Eleven of these 13 symptoms are physical (e.g., palpitations, sweat- 
ing), while two are cognitive (i.e., fear of losing control or going crazy, fear of dying). “Fear of 
going crazy” is a colloquialism often used by individuals with panic attacks and is not in- 
tended as a pejorative or diagnostic term. The term within minutes means that the time to peak 


Panic Attack Specifier 215 


intensity is literally only a few minutes. A panic attack can arise from either a calm state or an 
anxious state, and time to peak intensity should be assessed independently of any preceding 
anxiety. That is, the start of the panic attack is the point at which there is an abrupt increase in 
discomfort rather than the point at which anxiety first developed. Likewise, a panic attack can 
return to either an anxious state or a calm state and possibly peak again. A panic attack is dis- 
tinguished from ongoing anxiety by its time to peak intensity, which occurs within minutes; its 
discrete nature; and its typically greater severity. Attacks that meet all other criteria but have 
fewer than four physical and/or cognitive symptoms are referred to as limited-symptom attacks. 

There are two characteristic types of panic attacks: expected and unexpected. Expected 
panic attacks are attacks for which there is an obvious cue or trigger, such as situations in 
which panic attacks have typically occurred. Unexpected panic attacks are those for which 
there is no obvious cue or trigger at the time of occurrence (e.g., when relaxing or out of 
sleep [nocturnal panic attack]). The determination of whether panic attacks are expected 
or unexpected is made by the clinician, who makes this judgment based on a combination 
of careful questioning as to the sequence of events preceding or leading up to the attack 
and the individual’s own judgment of whether or not the attack seemed to occur for no ap- 
parent reason. Cultural interpretations may influence their determination as expected or 
unexpected. Culture-specific symptoms (e.g., tinnitus, neck soreness, headache, uncon- 
trollable screaming or crying) may be seen; however, such symptoms should not count as 
one of the four required symptoms. Panic attacks can occur in the context of any mental 
disorder (e.g., anxiety disorders, depressive disorders, bipolar disorders, eating disorders, 
obsessive-compulsive and related disorders, personality disorders, psychotic disorders, 
substance use disorders) and some medical conditions (e.g., cardiac, respiratory, vestibu- 
lar, gastrointestinal), with the majority never meeting criteria for panic disorder. Recur- 
rent unexpected panic attacks are required for a diagnosis of panic disorder. 


Associated Features 


One type of unexpected panic attack is a nocturnal panic attack (i.e., waking from sleep in a 
state of panic), which differs from panicking after fully waking from sleep. Panic attacks 
are related to a higher rate of suicide attempts and suicidal ideation even when comorbid- 
ity and other suicide risk factors are taken into account. 


Prevalence 


In the general population, 12-month prevalence estimates for panic attacks in the United 
States is 11.2% in adults. Twelve-month prevalence estimates do not appear to differ sig- 
nificantly among African Americans, Asian Americans, and Latinos. Lower 12-month 
prevalence estimates for European countries appear to range from 2.7% to 3.3%. Females 
are more frequently affected than males, although this gender difference is more pro- 
nounced for panic disorder. Panic attacks can occur in children but are relatively rare until 
the age of puberty, when the prevalence rates increase. The prevalence rates decline in 
older individuals, possibly reflecting diminishing severity to subclinical levels. 


Development and Course 


The mean age at onset for panic attacks in the United States is approximately 22-23 years 
among adults. However, the course of panic attacks is likely influenced by the course of 
any co-occurring mental disorder(s) and stressful life events. Panic attacks are uncommon, 
and unexpected panic attacks are rare, in preadolescent children. Adolescents might be 
less willing than adults to openly discuss panic attacks, even though they present with ep- 
isodes of intense fear or discomfort. Lower prevalence of panic attacks in older individuals 
may be related to a weaker autonomic response to emotional states relative to younger in- 
dividuals. Older individuals may be less inclined to use the word “fear” and more inclined 


216 Anxiety Disorders 


to use the word “discomfort” to describe panic attacks. Older individuals with “panicky 
feelings” may have a hybrid of limited-symptom attacks and generalized anxiety. In 
addition, older individuals tend to attribute panic attacks to certain situations that are 
stressful (e.g., medical procedures, social settings) and may retrospectively endorse expla- 
nations for the panic attack even if it was unexpected in the moment. This may result in un- 
der-endorsement of unexpected panic attacks in older individuals. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Negative affectivity (neuroticism) (i.e., proneness to experiencing neg- 
ative emotions) and anxiety sensitivity (i.e., the disposition to believe that symptoms of 
anxiety are harmful) are risk factors for the onset of panic attacks. History of “fearful 
spells” (i.e., limited-symptom attacks that do not meet full criteria for a panic attack) may 
be a risk factor for later panic attacks. 


Environmental. Smoking is a risk factor for panic attacks. Most individuals report iden- 
tifiable stressors in the months before their first panic attack (e.g., interpersonal stressors 
and stressors related to physical well-being, such as negative experiences with illicit or 
prescription drugs, disease, or death in the family). 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Cultural interpretations may influence the determination of panic attacks as expected or 
unexpected. Culture-specific symptoms (e.g., tinnitus, neck soreness, headache, and un- 
controllable screaming or crying) may be seen; however, such symptoms should not count 
as one of the four required symptoms. Frequency of each of the 13 symptoms varies cross- 
culturally (e.g., higher rates of paresthesias in African Americans and of dizziness in sev- 
eral Asian groups). Cultural syndromes also influence the cross-cultural presentation of 
panic attacks, resulting in different symptom profiles across different cultural groups. Ex- 
amples include khyél (wind) attacks, a Cambodian cultural syndrome involving dizziness, 
tinnitus, and neck soreness; and triing gid (wind-related) attacks, a Vietnamese cultural 
syndrome associated with headaches. Ataque de nervios (attack of nerves) is a cultural syn- 
drome among Latin Americans that may involve trembling, uncontrollable screaming or 
crying, aggressive or suicidal behavior, and depersonalization or derealization, and which 
may be experienced for longer than only a few minutes. Some clinical presentations of 
ataque de nervios fulfill criteria for conditions other than panic attack (e.g., other specified 
dissociative disorder). Also, cultural expectations may influence the classification of panic 
attacks as expected or unexpected, as cultural syndromes may create fear of certain situa- 
tions, ranging from interpersonal arguments (associated with ataque de nervios), to types of 
exertion (associated with khyfl attacks), to atmospheric wind (associated with tring gi6 at- 
tacks). Clarification of the details of cultural attributions may aid in distinguishing ex- 
pected and unexpected panic attacks. For more information about cultural syndromes, see 
“Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress” in the Appendix to this manual. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Panic attacks are more common in females than in males, but clinical features or symp- 
toms of panic attacks do not differ between males and females. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Physiological recordings of naturally occurring panic attacks in individuals with panic 
disorder indicate abrupt surges of arousal, usually of heart rate, that reach a peak within 
minutes and subside within minutes, and for a proportion of these individuals the panic 
attack may be preceded by cardiorespiratory instabilities. 


Agoraphobia 217 


Functional Consequences of Panic Attacks 


In the context of co-occurring mental disorders, including anxiety disorders, depressive 
disorders, bipolar disorder, substance use disorders, psychotic disorders, and personality 
disorders, panic attacks are associated with increased symptom severity, higher rates of 
comorbidity and suicidality, and poorer treatment response. Also, full-symptom panic at- 
tacks typically are associated with greater morbidity (e.g., greater health care utilization, 
more disability, poorer quality of life) than limited-symptom attacks. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other paroxysmal episodes (e.g., “anger attacks”). Panic attacks should not be diag- 
nosed if the episodes do not involve the essential feature of an abrupt surge of intense fear 
or intense discomfort, but rather other emotional states (e.g., anger, grief). 


Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition. Medical conditions that can cause 
or be misdiagnosed as panic attacks include hyperthyroidism, hyperparathyroidism, pheo- 
chromocytoma, vestibular dysfunctions, seizure disorders, and cardiopulmonary con- 
ditions (e.g., arrhythmias, supraventricular tachycardia, asthma, chronic obstructive 
pulmonary disease). Appropriate laboratory tests (e.g., serum calcium levels for hyperpara- 
thyroidism,; Holter monitor for arrhythmias) or physical examinations (e.g., for cardiac con- 
ditions) may be helpful in determining the etiological role of another medical condition. 


Substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder. Intoxication with central nervous 
system stimulants (e.g., cocaine, amphetamines, caffeine) or cannabis and withdrawal 
from central nervous system depressants (e.g., alcohol, barbiturates) can precipitate a 
panic attack. A detailed history should be taken to determine if the individual had panic 
attacks prior to excessive substance use. Features such as onset after age 45 years or the 
presence of atypical symptoms during a panic attack (e.g., vertigo, loss of consciousness, 
loss of bladder or bowel control, slurred speech, or amnesia) suggest the possibility that a 
medical condition or a substance may be causing the panic attack symptoms. 


Panic disorder. Repeated unexpected panic attacks are required but are not sufficient for 
the diagnosis of panic disorder (ie., full diagnostic criteria for panic disorder must be met). 


Comorbidity 

Panic attacks are associated with increased likelihood of various comorbid mental dis- 
orders, including anxiety disorders, depressive disorders, bipolar disorders, impulse- 
control disorders, and substance use disorders. Panic attacks are associated with increased 
likelihood of later developing anxiety disorders, depressive disorders, bipolar disorders, 
and possibly other disorders. 


Agoraphobia 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.22 (F 40.00) 


A. Marked fear or anxiety about two (or more) of the following five situations: 


1. Using public transportation (e.g., automobiles, buses, trains, ships, planes). 
Being in open spaces (e.g., parking lots, marketplaces, bridges). 

Being in enclosed places (e.g., shops, theaters, cinemas). 

Standing in line or being in a crowd. 

5. Being outside of the home alone. 


on 


B. The individual fears or avoids these situations because of thoughts that escape might 
be difficult or help might not be available in the event of developing panic-like symp- 


218 Anxiety Disorders 


toms or other incapacitating or embarrassing symptoms (e.g., fear of falling in the el- 
derly; fear of incontinence). 

C. The agoraphobic situations almost always provoke fear or anxiety. 

D. The agoraphobic situations are actively avoided, require the presence of a companion, 
or are endured with intense fear or anxiety. 

E. The fear or anxiety is out of proportion to the actual danger posed by the agoraphobic 
situations and to the sociocultural context. 

F. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is persistent, typically lasting for 6 months or more. 

G. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in 
social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

H. If another medical condition (e.g., inflammatory bowel disease, Parkinson’s disease) 
is present, the fear, anxiety, or avoidance is clearly excessive. 

|. The fear, anxiety, or avoidance is not better explained by the symptoms of another men- 
tal disorder—for example, the symptoms are not confined to specific phobia, situational 
type; do not involve only social situations (as in social anxiety disorder); and are not re- 
lated exclusively to obsessions (as in obsessive-compulsive disorder), perceived defects 
or flaws in physical appearance (as in body dysmorphic disorder), reminders of traumatic 
events (as in posttraumatic stress disorder), or fear of separation (as in separation anx- 
iety disorder). 


Note: Agoraphobia is diagnosed irrespective of the presence of panic disorder. If an indi- 
vidual’s presentation meets criteria for panic disorder and agoraphobia, both diagnoses 
should be assigned. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of agoraphobia is marked, or intense, fear or anxiety triggered by the 
real or anticipated exposure to a wide range of situations (Criterion A). The diagnosis re- 
quires endorsement of symptoms occurring in at least two of the following five situations: 
1) using public transporation, such as automobiles, buses, trains, ships, or planes; 2) being 
in open spaces, such as parking lots, marketplaces, or bridges; 3) being in enclosed spaces, 
such as shops, theaters, or cinemas; 4) standing in line or being in a crowd; or 5) being out- 
side of the home alone. The examples for each situation are not exhaustive; other situations 
may be feared. When experiencing fear and anxiety cued by such situations, individuals 
typically experience thoughts that something terrible might happen (Criterion B). Individ- 
uals frequently believe that escape from such situations might be difficult (e.g., “can’t get 
out of here”) or that help might be unavailable (e.g., “there is nobody to help me”) when 
panic-like symptoms or other incapacitating or embarrassing symptoms occur. “Panic-like 
symptoms” refer to any of the 13 symptoms included in the criteria for panic attack, such as 
dizziness, faintness, and fear of dying. “Other incapacitating or embarrassing symptoms” 
include symptoms such as vomiting and inflammatory bowel symptoms, as well as, in 
older adults, a fear of falling or, in children, a sense of disorientation and getting lost. 

The amount of fear experienced may vary with proximity to the feared situation and 
may occur in anticipation of or in the actual presence of the agoraphobic situation. Also, 
the fear or anxiety may take the form of a full- or limited-symptom panic attack (i.e., an ex- 
pected panic attack). Fear or anxiety is evoked nearly every time the individual comes into 
contact with the feared situation (Criterion C). Thus, an individual who becomes anxious 
only occasionally in an agoraphobic situation (e.g., becomes anxious when standing in line 
on only one out of every five occasions) would not be diagnosed with agoraphobia. The in- 
dividual actively avoids the situation or, if he or she either is unable or decides not to avoid 
it, the situation evokes intense fear or anxiety (Criterion D). Active avoidance means the in- 
dividual is currently behaving in ways that are intentionally designed to prevent or min- 
imize contact with agoraphobic situations. Avoidance can be behavioral (e.g., changing 


Agoraphobia 219 


daily routines, choosing a job nearby to avoid using public transportation, arranging for 
food delivery to avoid entering shops and supermarkets) as well as cognitive (e.g., using 
distraction to get through agoraphobic situations) in nature. The avoidance can become so 
severe that the person is completely homebound. Often, an individual is better able to con- 
front a feared situation when accompanied by a companion, such as a partner, friend, or 
health professional. 

The fear, anxiety, or avoidance must be out of proportion to the actual danger posed by 
the agoraphobic situations and to the sociocultural context (Criterion E). Differentiating 
clinically significant agoraphobic fears from reasonable fears (e.g., leaving the house dur- 
ing a bad storm) or from situations that are deemed dangerous (e.g., walking in a parking 
lot or using public transportation in a high-crime area) is important for a number of reasons. 
First, what constitutes avoidance may be difficult to judge across cultures and sociocultural 
contexts (e.g., itis socioculturally appropriate for orthodox Muslim women in certain parts 
of the world to avoid leaving the house alone, and thus such avoidance would not be con- 
sidered indicative of agoraphobia). Second, older adults are likely to overattribute their 
fears to age-related constraints and are less likely to judge their fears as being out of pro- 
portion to the actual risk. Third, individuals with agoraphobia are likely to overestimate 
danger in relation to panic-like or other bodily symptoms. Agoraphobia should be diag- 
nosed only if the fear, anxiety, or avoidance persists (Criterion F) and if it causes clinically 
significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of func- 
tioning (Criterion G). The duration of “typically lasting for 6 months or more” is meant to 
exclude individuals with short-lived, transient problems. However, the duration criterion 
should be used as a general guide, with allowance for some degree of flexibility. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


In its most severe forms, agoraphobia can cause individuals to become completely home- 
bound, unable to leave their home and dependent on others for services or assistance to pro- 
vide even for basic needs. Demoralization and depressive symptoms, as well as abuse of 
alcohol and sedative medication as inappropriate self-medication strategies, are common. 


Prevalence 


Every year approximately 1.7% of adolescents and adults have a diagnosis of agoraphobia. 
Females are twice as likely as males to experience agoraphobia. Agoraphobia may occur in 
childhood, but incidence peaks in late adolescence and early adulthood. Twelve-month 
prevalence in individuals older than 65 years is 0.4%. Prevalence rates do not appear to 
vary systematically across cultural/racial groups. 


Development and Course 


The percentage of individuals with agoraphobia reporting panic attacks or panic disorder 
preceding the onset of agoraphobia ranges from 30% in community samples to more than 
50% in clinic samples. The majority of individuals with panic disorder show signs of anx- 
iety and agoraphobia before the onset of panic disorder. 

In two-thirds of all cases of agoraphobia, initial onset is before age 35 years. There is a 
substantial incidence risk in late adolescence and early adulthood, with indications for 
a second high incidence risk phase after age 40 years. First onset in childhood is rare. The 
overall mean age at onset for agoraphobia is 17 years, although the age at onset without 
preceding panic attacks or panic disorder is 25-29 years. 

The course of agoraphobia is typically persistent and chronic. Complete remission is 
rare (10%), unless the agoraphobia is treated. With more severe agoraphobia, rates of full 
remission decrease, whereas rates of relapse and chronicity increase. A range of other dis- 
orders, in particular other anxiety disorders, depressive disorders, substance use disor- 
ders, and personality disorders, may complicate the course of agoraphobia. The long-term 


220 Anxiety Disorders 


course and outcome of agoraphobia are associated with substantially elevated risk of sec- 
ondary major depressive disorder, persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia), and sub- 
stance use disorders. 

The clinical features of agoraphobia are relatively consistent across the lifespan, although 
the type of agoraphobic situations triggering fear, anxiety, or avoidance, as well as the type of 
cognitions, may vary. For example, in children, being outside of the home alone is the most fre- 
quent situation feared, whereas in older adults, being in shops, standing in line, and being in 
open spaces are most often feared. Also, cognitions often pertain to becoming lost (in children), 
to experiencing panic-like symptoms (in adults), to falling (in older adults). 

The low prevalence of agoraphobia in children could reflect difficulties in symptom re- 
porting, and thus assessments in young children may require solicitation of information 
from multiple sources, including parents or teachers. Adolescents, particularly males, 
may be less willing than adults to openly discuss agoraphobic fears and avoidance; how- 
ever, agoraphobia can occur prior to adulthood and should be assessed in children and 
adolescents. In older adults, comorbid somatic symptom disorders, as well as motor dis- 
turbances (e.g., sense of falling or having medical complications), are frequently men- 
tioned by individuals as the reason for their fear and avoidance. In these instances, care is 
to be taken in evaluating whether the fear and avoidance are out of proportion to the real 
danger involved. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Behavioral inhibition and neurotic disposition (i.e., negative affectivity 
[neuroticism] and anxiety sensitivity) are closely associated with agoraphobia but are rel- 
evant to most anxiety disorders (phobic disorders, panic disorder, generalized anxiety dis- 
order). Anxiety sensitivity (the disposition to believe that symptoms of anxiety are 
harmful) is also characteristic of individuals with agoraphobia. 


Environmental. Negative events in childhood (e.g., separation, death of parent) and other 
stressful events, such as being attacked or mugged, are associated with the onset of agorapho- 
bia. Furthermore, individuals with agoraphobia describe the family climate and child-rearing 
behavior as being characterized by reduced warmth and increased overprotection. 


Genetic and physiological. Heritability for agoraphobia is 61%. Of the various phobias, 
agoraphobia has the strongest and most specific association with the genetic factor that 
represents proneness to phobias. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Females have different patterns of comorbid disorders than males. Consistent with gender 
differences in the prevalence of mental disorders, males have higher rates of comorbid 
substance use disorders. 


Functional Consequences of Agoraphobia 


Agoraphobia is associated with considerable impairment and disability in terms of role 
functioning, work productivity, and disability days. Agoraphobia severity is a strong de- 
terminant of the degree of disability, irrespective of the presence of comorbid panic disor- 
der, panic attacks, and other comorbid conditions. More than one-third of individuals 
with agoraphobia are completely homebound and unable to work. 


Differential Diagnosis 

When diagnostic criteria for agoraphobia and another disorder are fully met, both diagnoses 
should be assigned, unless the fear, anxiety, or avoidance of agoraphobia is attributable to the 
other disorder. Weighting of criteria and clinical judgment may be helpful in some cases. 


Agoraphobia 221 


Specific phobia, situational type. Differentiating agoraphobia from situational specific 
phobia can be challenging in some cases, because these conditions share several symptom 
characteristics and criteria. Specific phobia, situational type, should be diagnosed versus ago- 
raphobia if the fear, anxiety, or avoidance is limited to one of the agoraphobic situations. 
Requiring fears from two or more of the agoraphobic situations is a robust means for differen- 
tiating agoraphobia from specific phobias, particularly the situational subtype. Additional dif- 
ferentiating features include the cognitive ideation. Thus, if the situation is feared for reasons 
other than panic-like symptoms or other incapacitating or embarrassing symptoms (e.g., fears 
of being directly harmed by the situation itself, such as fear of the plane crashing for individ- 
uals who fear flying), then a diagnosis of specific phobia may be more appropriate. 


Separation anxiety disorder. Separation anxiety disorder can be best differentiated 
from agoraphobia by examining cognitive ideation. In separation anxiety disorder, the 
thoughts are about detachment from significant others and the home environment (i.e., 
parents or other attachment figures), whereas in agoraphobia the focus is on panic-like 
symptoms or other incapacitating or embarrassing symptoms in the feared situations. 


Social anxiety disorder (social phobia). Agoraphobia should be differentiated from so- 
cial anxiety disorder based primarily on the situational clusters that trigger fear, anxiety, 
or avoidance and the cognitive ideation. In social anxiety disorder, the focus is on fear of 
being negatively evaluated. 


Panic disorder. When criteria for panic disorder are met, agoraphobia should not be di- 
agnosed if the avoidance behaviors associated with the panic attacks do not extend to avoid- 
ance of two or more agoraphobic situations. 


Acute stress disorder and posttraumatic stress disorder. Acute stress disorder and 
posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD) can be differentiated from agoraphobia by examin- 
ing whether the fear, anxiety, or avoidance is related only to situations that remind the 
individual of a traumatic event. If the fear, anxiety, or avoidance is restricted to trauma re- 
minders, and if the avoidance behavior does not extend to two or more agoraphobic situ- 
ations, then a diagnosis of agoraphobia is not warranted. 


Major depressive disorder. In major depressive disorder, the individual may avoid leav- 
ing home because of apathy, loss of energy, low self-esteem, and anhedonia. If the avoid- 
ance is unrelated to fears of panic-like or other incapacitating or embarrassing symptoms, 
then agoraphobia should not be diagnosed. 


Other medical conditions. Agoraphobia is not diagnosed if the avoidance of situations 
is judged to be a physiological consequence of a medical condition. This determination is 
based on history, laboratory findings, and a physical examination. Other relevant medical 
conditions may include neurodegenerative disorders with associated motor disturbances 
(e.g., Parkinson's disease, multiple sclerosis), as well as cardiovascular disorders. Individ- 
uals with certain medical conditions may avoid situations because of realistic concerns 
about being incapacitated (e.g., fainting in an individual with transient ischemic attacks) 
or being embarrassed (e.g., diarrhea in an individual with Crohn’s disease). The diagnosis 
of agoraphobia should be given only when the fear or avoidance is clearly in excess of that 
usually associated with these medical conditions. 


Comorbidity 


The majority of individuals with agoraphobia also have other mental disorders. The most 
frequent additional diagnoses are other anxiety disorders (e.g., specific phobias, panic dis- 
order, social anxiety disorder), depressive disorders (major depressive disorder), PTSD, 
and alcohol use disorder. Whereas other anxiety disorders (e.g., separation anxiety disor- 
der, specific phobias, panic disorder) frequently precede onset of agoraphobia, depressive 
disorders and substance use disorders typically occur secondary to agoraphobia. 


222 Anxiety Disorders 


Generalized Anxiety Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.02 (F41.1) 


A. Excessive anxiety and worry (apprehensive expectation), occurring more days than 
not for at least 6 months, about a number of events or activities (such as work or school 
performance). 

B. The individual finds it difficult to control the worry. 

C. The anxiety and worry are associated with three (or more) of the following six symp- 
toms (with at least some symptoms having been present for more days than not for the 
past 6 months): 


Note: Only one item is required in children. 


Restlessness or feeling keyed up or on edge. 

Being easily fatigued. 

Difficulty concentrating or mind going blank. 

Irritability. 

Muscle tension. 

Sleep disturbance (difficulty falling or staying asleep, or restless, unsatisfying 
sleep). 


Oahon > 


D. The anxiety, worry, or physical symptoms cause Clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

E. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition (e.g., hyperthyroidism). 

F. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder (e.g., anxiety or 
worry about having panic attacks in panic disorder, negative evaluation in social anxi- 
ety disorder [social phobia], contamination or other obsessions in obsessive-compul- 
sive disorder, separation from attachment figures in separation anxiety disorder, 
reminders of traumatic events in posttraumatic stress disorder, gaining weight in an- 
orexia nervosa, physical complaints in somatic symptom disorder, perceived appear- 
ance flaws in body dysmorphic disorder, having a serious illness in illness anxiety 
disorder, or the content of delusional beliefs in schizophrenia or delusional disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of generalized anxiety disorder is excessive anxiety and worry (ap- 
prehensive expectation) about a number of events or activities. The intensity, duration, or 
frequency of the anxiety and worry is out of proportion to the actual likelihood or impact 
of the anticipated event. The individual finds it difficult to control the worry and to keep 
worrisome thoughts from interfering with attention to tasks at hand. Adults with gener- 
alized anxiety disorder often worry about everyday, routine life circumstances, such as 
possible job responsibilities, health and finances, the health of family members, misfor- 
tune to their children, or minor matters (e.g., doing household chores or being late for ap- 
pointments). Children with generalized anxiety disorder tend to worry excessively about 
their competence or the quality of their performance. During the course of the disorder, 
the focus of worry may shift from one concern to another. 

Several features distinguish generalized anxiety disorder from nonpathological anxiety. 
First, the worries associated with generalized anxiety disorder are excessive and typically in- 
terfere significantly with psychosocial functioning, whereas the worries of everyday life 
are not excessive and are perceived as more manageable and may be put off when more 
pressing matters arise. Second, the worries associated with generalized anxiety disorder are 


Generalized Anxiety Disorder 223 


more pervasive, pronounced, and distressing; have longer duration; and frequently occur 
without precipitants. The greater the range of life circumstances about which a person 
worries (e.g., finances, children’s safety, job performance), the more likely his or her symp- 
toms are to meet criteria for generalized anxiety disorder. Third, everyday worries are much 
less likely to be accompanied by physical symptoms (e.g., restlessness or feeling keyed up 
or on edge). Individuals with generalized anxiety disorder report subjective distress due 
to constant worry and related impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas 
of functioning. 

The anxiety and worry are accompanied by at least three of the following additional 
symptoms: restlessness or feeling keyed up or on edge, being easily fatigued, difficulty 
concentrating or mind going blank, irritability, muscle tension, and disturbed sleep, al- 
though only one additional symptom is required in children. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Associated with muscle tension, there may be trembling, twitching, feeling shaky, and 
muscle aches or soreness. Many individuals with generalized anxiety disorder also expe- 
rience somatic symptoms (e.g., sweating, nausea, diarrhea) and an exaggerated startle re- 
sponse. Symptoms of autonomic hyperarousal (e.g., accelerated heart rate, shortness of 
breath, dizziness) are less prominent in generalized anxiety disorder than in other anxiety 
disorders, such as panic disorder. Other conditions that may be associated with stress (e.¢., 
irritable bowel syndrome, headaches) frequently accompany generalized anxiety disorder. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence of generalized anxiety disorder is 0.9% among adolescents and 
2.9% among adults in the general community of the United States. The 12-month preva- 
lence for the disorder in other countries ranges from 0.4% to 3.6%. The lifetime morbid risk 
is 9.0%. Females are twice as likely as males to experience generalized anxiety disorder. The 
prevalence of the diagnosis peaks in middle age and declines across the later years of life. 
Individuals of European descent tend to experience generalized anxiety disorder more 
frequently than do individuals of non-European descent (i.e., Asian, African, Native 
American and Pacific Islander). Furthermore, individuals from developed countries are 
more likely than individuals from nondeveloped countries to report that they have expe- 
rienced symptoms that meet criteria for generalized anxiety disorder in their lifetime. 


Development and Course 


Many individuals with generalized anxiety disorder report that they have felt anxious and 
nervous all of their lives. The median age at onset for generalized anxiety disorder is 30 
years; however, age at onset is spread over a very broad range. The median age at onset is 
later than that for the other anxiety disorders. The symptoms of excessive worry and anx- 
iety may occur early in life but are then manifested as an anxious temperament. Onset of 
the disorder rarely occurs prior to adolescence. The symptoms of generalized anxiety dis- 
order tend to be chronic and wax and wane across the lifespan, fluctuating between syn- 
dromal and subsyndromal forms of the disorder. Rates of full remission are very low. 

The clinical expression of generalized anxiety disorder is relatively consistent across 
the lifespan. The primary difference across age groups is in the content of the individual’s 
worry. Children and adolescents tend to worry more about school and sporting perfor- 
mance, whereas older adults report greater concern about the well-being of family or their 
own physical heath. Thus, the content of an individual’s worry tends to be age appropri- 
ate. Younger adults experience greater severity of symptoms than do older adults. 

The earlier in life individuals have symptoms that meet criteria for generalized anxiety 
disorder, the more comorbidity they tend to have and the more impaired they are likely to 


224 Anxiety Disorders 


be. The advent of chronic physical disease can be a potent issue for excessive worry in the 
elderly. In the frail elderly, worries about safety—and especially about falling—may limit 
activities. In those with early cognitive impairment, what appears to be excessive worry 
about, for example, the whereabouts of things is probably better regarded as realistic 
given the cognitive impairment. 

In children and adolescents with generalized anxiety disorder, the anxieties and wor- 
ries often concern the quality of their performance or competence at school or in sporting 
events, even when their performance is not being evaluated by others. There may be ex- 
cessive concerns about punctuality. They may also worry about catastrophic events, such 
as earthquakes or nuclear war. Children with the disorder may be overly conforming, per- 
fectionist, and unsure of themselves and tend to redo tasks because of excessive dissatis- 
faction with less-than-perfect performance. They are typically overzealous in seeking 
reassurance and approval and require excessive reassurance about their performance and 
other things they are worried about. 

Generalized anxiety disorder may be overdiagnosed in children. When this diagnosis 
is being considered in children, a thorough evaluation for the presence of other childhood 
anxiety disorders and other mental disorders should be done to determine whether the 
wotries may be better explained by one of these disorders. Separation anxiety disorder, so- 
cial anxiety disorder (social phobia), and obsessive-compulsive disorder are often accom- 
panied by worries that may mimic those described in generalized anxiety disorder. For 
example, a child with social anxiety disorder may be concerned about school performance 
because of fear of humiliation. Worries about illness may also be better explained by sep- 
aration anxiety disorder or obsessive-compulsive disorder. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Behavioral inhibition, negative affectivity (neuroticism), and harm 
avoidance have been associated with generalized anxiety disorder. 


Environmental. Although childhood adversities and parental overprotection have been 
associated with generalized anxiety disorder, no environmental factors have been identi- 
fied as specific to generalized anxiety disorder or necessary or sufficient for making the di- 
agnosis. 

Genetic and physiological. One-third of the risk of experiencing generalized anxiety 
disorder is genetic, and these genetic factors overlap with the risk of neuroticism and are 
shared with other anxiety and mood disorders, particularly major depressive disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There is considerable cultural variation in the expression of generalized anxiety disorder. 
For example, in some cultures, somatic symptoms predominate in the expression of the 
disorder, whereas in other cultures cognitive symptoms tend to predominate. This differ- 
ence may be more evident on initial presentation than subsequently, as more symptoms 
are reported over time. There is no information as to whether the propensity for excessive 
worrying is related to culture, although the topic being worried about can be culture spe- 
cific. It is important to consider the social and cultural context when evaluating whether 
wotries about certain situations are excessive. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In clinical settings, generalized anxiety disorder is diagnosed somewhat more frequently 
in females than in males (about 55%-—60% of those presenting with the disorder are 
female). In epidemiological studies, approximately two-thirds are female. Females and 
males who experience generalized anxiety disorder appear to have similar symptoms but 


Generalized Anxiety Disorder 225 


demonstrate different patterns of comorbidity consistent with gender differences in the 
prevalence of disorders. In females, comorbidity is largely confined to the anxiety disor- 
ders and unipolar depression, whereas in males, comorbidity is more likely to extend to 
the substance use disorders as well. 


Functional Consequences of 
Generalized Anxiety Disorder 


Excessive worrying impairs the individual’s capacity to do things quickly and efficiently, 
whether at home or at work. The worrying takes time and energy; the associated symp- 
toms of muscle tension and feeling keyed up or on edge, tiredness, difficulty concentrat- 
ing, and disturbed sleep contribute to the impairment. Importantly the excessive worrying 
may impair the ability of individuals with generalized anxiety disorder to encourage con- 
fidence in their children. 

Generalized anxiety disorder is associated with significant disability and distress that is 
independent of comorbid disorders, and most non-institutionalized adults with the disorder 
are moderately to seriously disabled. Generalized anxiety disorder accounts for 110 mil- 
lion disability days per annum in the U.S. population. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition. The diagnosis of anxiety disorder 
associated with another medical condition should be assigned if the individual’s anxiety 
and worry are judged, based on history, laboratory findings, or physical examination, to 
be a physiological effect of another specific medical condition (e.g., pheochromocytoma, 
hyperthyroidism). 


Substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder. A substance/medication-induced 
anxiety disorder is distinguished from generalized anxiety disorder by the fact that a sub- 
stance or medication (e.g., a drug of abuse, exposure to a toxin) is judged to be etiologically 
related to the anxiety. For example, severe anxiety that occurs only in the context of heavy 
coffee consumption would be diagnosed as caffeine-induced anxiety disorder. 


Social anxiety disorder. Individuals with social anxiety disorder often have anticipa- 
tory anxiety that is focused on upcoming social situations in which they must perform or 
be evaluated by others, whereas individuals with generalized anxiety disorder worry, 
whether or not they are being evaluated. 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. Several features distinguish the excessive worry of 
generalized anxiety disorder from the obsessional thoughts of obsessive-compulsive dis- 
order. In generalized anxiety disorder the focus of the worry is about forthcoming prob- 
lems, and it is the excessiveness of the worry about future events that is abnormal. In 
obsessive-compulsive disorder, the obsessions are inappropriate ideas that take the form of 
intrusive and unwanted thoughts, urges, or images. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder and adjustment disorders. Anxiety is invariably pres- 
ent in posttraumatic stress disorder. Generalized anxiety disorder is not diagnosed if the 
anxiety and worry are better explained by symptoms of posttraumatic stress disorder. 
Anxiety may also be present in adjustment disorder, but this residual category should be 
used only when the criteria are not met for any other disorder (including generalized anx- 
iety disorder). Moreover, in adjustment disorders, the anxiety occurs in response to an 
identifiable stressor within 3 months of the onset of the stressor and does not persist for 
more than 6 months after the termination of the stressor or its consequences. 


Depressive, bipolar, and psychotic disorders. Generalized anxiety /worry is a common 
associated feature of depressive, bipolar, and psychotic disorders and should not be di- 


226 Anxiety Disorders 


agnosed separately if the excessive worry has occurred only during the course of these 
conditions. 


Comorbidity 


Individuals whose presentation meets criteria for generalized anxiety disorder are likely 
to have met, or currently meet, criteria for other anxiety and unipolar depressive disor- 
ders. The neuroticism or emotional liability that underpins this pattern of comorbidity is 
associated with temperamental antecedents and genetic and environmental risk factors 
shared between these disorders, although independent pathways are also possible. Co- 
morbidity with substance use, conduct, psychotic, neurodevelopmental, and neurocogni- 
tive disorders is less common. 


Substance/Medication-Induced 
Anxiety Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Panic attacks or anxiety is predominant in the clinical picture. 
B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of both 
(1) and (2): 


1. The symptoms in Criterion A developed during or soon after substance intoxication 
or withdrawal or after exposure to a medication. 

2. The involved substance/medication is capable of producing the symptoms in Crite- 
rion A. 


C. The disturbance is not better explained by an anxiety disorder that is not substance/ 
medication-induced. Such evidence of an independent anxiety disorder could include 
the following: 


The symptoms precede the onset of the substance/medication use; the symptoms 
persist for a substantial period of time (e.g., about 1 month) after the cessation of 
acute withdrawal or severe intoxication; or there is other evidence suggesting the 
existence of an independent non-substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder 
(e.g., a history of recurrent non-substance/medication-related episodes). 


D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


Note: This diagnosis should be made instead of a diagnosis of substance intoxication or 
substance withdrawal only when the symptoms in Criterion A predominate in the clinical 
picture and they are sufficiently severe to warrant clinical attention. 

Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance/medica- 
tion]-induced anxiety disorders are indicated in the table below. Note that the ICD-10-CM 
code depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance use disorder present for 
the same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is comorbid with the sub- 
stance-induced anxiety disorder, the 4th position character is “1,” and the clinician should 
record “mild [substance] use disorder” before the substance-induced anxiety disorder 
(e.g., “mild cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced anxiety disorder’). If a moderate or 
severe substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance-induced anxiety disorder, 
the 4th position character is “2,” and the clinician should record “moderate [substance] use 
disorder” or “severe [substance] use disorder,” depending on the severity of the comorbid 
substance use disorder. If there is no comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one- 


Substance/Medication-Induced Anxiety Disorder 227 


time heavy use of the substance), then the 4th position character is “9,” and the clinician 
should record only the substance-induced anxiety disorder. 


ICD-10-CM 
With use 
With use disorder, Without 
disorder, moderate use 
ICD-9-CM mild or severe disorder 
Alcohol 291.89 F10.180 F10.280 F10.980 
Caffeine 292.89 F15.180 F15.280 F15.980 
Cannabis 292.89 F12.180 F12.280 F12.980 
Phencyclidine 292.89 F16.180 F16.280 F16.980 
Other hallucinogen 292.89 F16.180 F16.280 F16.980 
Inhalant 292.89 F18.180 F18.280 F18.980 
Opioid 292.89 F11.188 F11.288 F11.988 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 292.89 F13.180 F13.280 F13.980 
Amphetamine (or other 292.89 F15.180 F15.280 F15.980 
stimulant) 
Cocaine 292.89 F14.180 F14.280 F14.980 


Other (or unknown) substance 292.89 F19.180 F19.280 F19.980 


Specify if (see Table 1 in the chapter “Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders” for di- 
agnoses associated with substance class): 
With onset during intoxication: This specifier applies if criteria are met for intoxica- 
tion with the substance and the symptoms develop during intoxication. 
With onset during withdrawal: This specifier applies if criteria are met for withdrawal 
from the substance and the symptoms develop during, or shortly after, withdrawal. 
With onset after medication use: Symptoms may appear either at initiation of medi- 
cation or after a modification or change in use. 


Recording Procedures 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, salbutamol) that is presumed to be causing the 
anxiety symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria 
set, which is based on the drug class. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes 
(e.g., salbutamol), the code for “other substance” should be used; and in cases in which 
a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance is un- 
known, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder is followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during in- 
toxication, onset during withdrawal, with onset during medication use). Unlike the record- 
ing procedures for ICD-10-CM, which combine the substance-induced disorder and 
substance use disorder into a single code, for ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is given 
for the substance use disorder. For example, in the case of anxiety symptoms occurring dur- 
ing withdrawal in a man with a severe lorazepam use disorder, the diagnosis is 292.89 loraz- 
epam-induced anxiety disorder, with onset during withdrawal. An additional diagnosis of 
304.10 severe lorazepam use disorder is also given. When more than one substance is judged 
to play a significant role in the development of anxiety symptoms, each should be listed sep- 


228 Anxiety Disorders 


arately (e.g., 292.89 methylphenidate-induced anxiety disorder, with onset during intoxica- 
tion; 292.89 salbutamol-induced anxiety disorder, with onset after medication use). 


ICD-10-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, salbutamol) that is presumed to be causing the 
anxiety symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria 
set, which is based on the drug class and presence or absence of a comorbid substance use 
disorder. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., salbutamol), the code 
for “other substance” should be used; and in cases in which a substance is judged to be an 
etiological factor but the specific class of substance is unknown, the category “unknown 
substance” should be used. 

When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) 
is listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the substance-induced 
anxiety disorder, followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during intoxication, 
onset during withdrawal, with onset during medication use). For example, in the case of 
anxiety symptoms occurring during withdrawal in a man witha severe lorazepam use dis- 
order, the diagnosis is F13.280 severe lorazepam use disorder with lorazepam-induced 
anxiety disorder, with onset during withdrawal. A separate diagnosis of the comorbid se- 
vere lorazepam use disorder is not given. If the substance-induced anxiety disorder occurs 
without a comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one-time heavy use of the substance), 
no accompanying substance use disorder is noted (e.g., F16.980 psilocybin-induced anxi- 
ety disorder, with onset during intoxication). When more than one substance is judged to 
play a significant role in the development of anxiety symptoms, each should be listed sep- 
arately (e.g., F15.280 severe methylphenidate use disorder with methylphenidate-induced 
anxiety disorder, with onset during intoxication; F19.980 salbutamol-induced anxiety dis- 
order, with onset after medication use). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of substance /medication-induced anxiety disorder are prominent 
symptoms of panic or anxiety (Criterion A) that are judged to be due to the effects of a sub- 
stance (e.g.,a drug of abuse, a medication, or a toxin exposure). The panic or anxiety symp- 
toms must have developed during or soon after substance intoxication or withdrawal or 
after exposure to a medication, and the substances or medications must be capable of pro- 
ducing the symptoms (Criterion B2). Substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder 
due to a prescribed treatment for a mental disorder or another medical condition must 
have its onset while the individual is receiving the medication (or during withdrawal, if a 
withdrawal is associated with the medication). Once the treatment is discontinued, the 
panic or anxiety symptoms will usually improve or remit within days to several weeks to 
a month (depending on the half-life of the substance /medication and the presence of with- 
drawal). The diagnosis of substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder should not be 
given if the onset of the panic or anxiety symptoms precedes the substance /medication in- 
toxication or withdrawal, or if the symptoms persist for a substantial period of time (i.e., 
usually longer than 1 month) from the time of severe intoxication or withdrawal. If the 
panic or anxiety symptoms persist for substantial periods of time, other causes for the 
symptoms should be considered. 

The substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder diagnosis should be made in- 
stead of a diagnosis of substance intoxication or substance withdrawal only when the 
symptoms in Criterion A are predominant in the clinical picture and are sufficiently severe 
to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Panic or anxiety can occur in association with intoxication with the following classes of sub- 
stances: alcohol, caffeine, cannabis, phencyclidine, other hallucinogens, inhalants, stimu- 


Substance/Medication-Induced Anxiety Disorder 229 


lants (including cocaine), and other (or unknown) substances. Panic or anxiety can occur in 
association with withdrawal from the following classes of substances: alcohol; opioids; sed- 
atives, hypnotics, and anxiolytics; stimulants (including cocaine); and other (or unknown) 
substances. Some medications that evoke anxiety symptoms include anesthetics and anal- 
gesics, sympathomimetics or other bronchodilators, anticholinergics, insulin, thyroid prep- 
arations, oral contraceptives, antihistamines, antiparkinsonian medications, corticosteroids, 
antihypertensive and cardiovascular medications, anticonvulsants, lithium carbonate, an- 
tipsychotic medications, and antidepressant medications. Heavy metals and toxins (e.g., 
organophosphate insecticide, nerve gases, carbon monoxide, carbon dioxide, volatile sub- 
stances such as gasoline and paint) may also cause panic or anxiety symptoms. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of substance /medication-induced anxiety disorder is not clear. General 
population data suggest that it may be rare, with a 12-month prevalence of approximately 
0.002%. However, in clinical populations, the prevalence is likely to be higher. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Laboratory assessments (e.g., urine toxicology) may be useful to measure substance intox- 
ication as part of an assessment for substance /medication-induced anxiety disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Substance intoxication and substance withdrawal. Anxiety symptoms commonly oc- 
cur in substance intoxication and substance withdrawal. The diagnosis of the substance- 
specific intoxication or substance-specific withdrawal will usually suffice to categorize the 
symptom presentation. A diagnosis of substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder 
should be made in addition to substance intoxication or substance withdrawal when the 
panic or anxiety symptoms are predominant in the clinical picture and are sufficiently se- 
vere to warrant independent clinical attention. For example, panic or anxiety symptoms 
are characteristic of alcohol withdrawal. 


Anxiety disorder (i.e., not induced by a substance/medication). Substance/medication- 
induced anxiety disorder is judged to be etiologically related to the substance /medication. 
Substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder is distinguished from a primary anxiety 
disorder based on the onset, course, and other factors with respect to substances /medica- 
tions. For drugs of abuse, there must be evidence from the history, physical examination, or 
laboratory findings for use, intoxication, or withdrawal. Substance /medication-induced 
anxiety disorders arise only in association with intoxication or withdrawal states, whereas 
primary anxiety disorders may precede the onset of substance/ medication use. The pres- 
ence of features that are atypical of a primary anxiety disorder, such as atypical age at onset 
(e.g., onset of panic disorder after age 45 years) or symptoms (e.g., atypical panic attack 
symptoms such as true vertigo, loss of balance, loss of consciousness, loss of bladder con- 
trol, headaches, slurred speech) may suggest a substance /medication-induced etiology. A 
primary anxiety disorder diagnosis is warranted if the panic or anxiety symptoms persist 
for a substantial period of time (about 1 month or longer) after the end of the substance in- 
toxication or acute withdrawal or there is a history of an anxiety disorder. 


Delirium. If panic or anxiety symptoms occur exclusively during the course of delirium, 
they are considered to be an associated feature of the delirium and are not diagnosed sep- 
arately. 


Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition. If the panic or anxiety symptoms 
are attributed to the physiological consequences of another medical condition (i.e., rather 
than to the medication taken for the medical condition), anxiety disorder due to another 


230 Anxiety Disorders 


medical condition should be diagnosed. The history often provides the basis for such a 
judgment. At times, a change in the treatment for the other medical condition (e.g., med- 
ication substitution or discontinuation) may be needed to determine whether the medica- 
tion is the causative agent (in which case the symptoms may be better explained by 
substance /medication-induced anxiety disorder). If the disturbance is attributable to both 
another medical condition and substance use, both diagnoses (i.e., anxiety disorder due to 
another medical condition and substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder) may be 
given. When there is insufficient evidence to determine whether the panic or anxiety symp- 
toms are attributable to a substance / medication or to another medical condition or are pri- 
mary (i.e., not attributable to either a substance or another medical condition), a diagnosis 
of other specified or unspecified anxiety disorder would be indicated. 


Anxiety Disorder Due to 
Another Medical Condition 


Diagnostic Criteria 293.84 (FO6.4) 


A. Panic attacks or anxiety is predominant in the clinical picture. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the dis- 
turbance is the direct pathophysiological consequence of another medical condition. 

C. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder. 

D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 

E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


Coding note: Include the name of the other medical condition within the name of the men- 
tal disorder (e.g., 293.84 [F06.4] anxiety disorder due to pheochromocytoma). The other 
medical condition should be coded and listed separately immediately before the anxiety 
disorder due to the medical condition (e.g., 227.0 [D35.00] pheochromocytoma; 293.84 
[FO6.4] anxiety disorder due to pheochromocytoma. 


Diagnostic Features 

The essential feature of anxiety disorder due to another medical condition is clinically signifi- 
cant anxiety that is judged to be best explained as a physiological effect of another medical con- 
dition. Symptoms can include prominent anxiety symptoms or panic attacks (Criterion A). 
The judgment that the symptoms are best explained by the associated physical condition must 
be based on evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings (Criterion 
B). Additionally, it must be judged that the symptoms are not better accounted for by another 
mental disorder, in particular, adjustment disorder, with anxiety, in which the stressor is the 
medical condition (Criterion C). In this case, an individual with adjustment disorder is espe- 
cially distressed about the meaning or the consequences of the associated medical condition. 
By contrast, there is often a prominent physical component to the anxiety (e.g., shortness of 
breath) when the anxiety is due to another medical condition. The diagnosis is not made if the 
anxiety symptoms occur only during the course of a delirium (Criterion D). The anxiety symp- 
toms must cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other 
important areas of functioning (Criterion E). 

In determining whether the anxiety symptoms are attributable to another medical con- 
dition, the clinician must first establish the presence of the medical condition. Further- 
more, it must be established that anxiety symptoms can be etiologically related to the 
medical condition through a physiological mechanism before making a judgment that this 
is the best explanation for the symptoms in a specific individual. A careful and compre- 


Anxiety Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 231 


hensive assessment of multiple factors is necessary to make this judgment. Several aspects 
of the clinical presentation should be considered: 1) the presence of a clear temporal asso- 
ciation between the onset, exacerbation, or remission of the medical condition and the anx- 
iety symptoms; 2) the presence of features that are atypical of a primary anxiety disorder 
(e.g., atypical age at onset or course); and 3) evidence in the literature that a known phys- 
iological mechanism (e.g., hyperthyroidism) causes anxiety. In addition, the disturbance 
must not be better explained by a primary anxiety disorder, a substance /medication- 
induced anxiety disorder, or another primary mental disorder (e.g., adjustment disorder). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A number of medical conditions are known to include anxiety as a symptomatic manifes- 
tation. Examples include endocrine disease (e.g., hyperthyroidism, pheochromocytoma, 
hypoglycemia, hyperadrenocortisolism), cardiovascular disorders (e.g., congestive heart 
failure, pulmonary embolism, arrhythmia such as atrial fibrillation), respiratory illness 
(e.g., chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, asthma, pneumonia), metabolic distur- 
bances (e.g., vitamin Bj deficiency, porphyria), and neurological illness (e.g., neoplasms, 
vestibular dysfunction, encephalitis, seizure disorders). Anxiety due to another medical 
condition is diagnosed when the medical condition is known to induce anxiety and when 
the medical condition preceded the onset of the anxiety. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of anxiety disorder due to another medical condition is unclear. There ap- 
pears to be an elevated prevalence of anxiety disorders among individuals with a variety 
of medical conditions, including asthma, hypertension, ulcers, and arthritis. However, this 
increased prevalence may be due to reasons other than the anxiety disorder directly caus- 
ing the medical condition. 


Development and Course 


The development and course of anxiety disorder due to another medical condition gen- 
erally follows the course of the underlying illness. This diagnosis is not meant to include 
primary anxiety disorders that arise in the context of chronic medical illness. This is im- 
portant to consider with older adults, who may experience chronic medical illness and 
then develop independent anxiety disorders secondary to the chronic medical illness. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Laboratory assessments and/or medical examinations are necessary to confirm the diag- 
nosis of the associated medical condition. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Delirium. A separate diagnosis of anxiety disorder due to another medical condition is 
not given if the anxiety disturbance occurs exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
However, a diagnosis of anxiety disorder due to another medical condition may be given 
in addition to a diagnosis of major neurocognitive disorder (dementia) if the etiology of 
anxiety is judged to be a physiological consequence of the pathological process causing the 
neurocognitive disorder and if anxiety is a prominent part of the clinical presentation. 


Mixed presentation of symptoms (e.g., mood and anxiety). If the presentation includes 
a mix of different types of symptoms, the specific mental disorder due to another medical 
condition depends on which symptoms predominate in the clinical picture. 


Substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder. If there is evidence of recent or pro- 
longed substance use (including medications with psychoactive effects), withdrawal from 


232 Anxiety Disorders 


a substance, or exposure to a toxin, a substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder 
should be considered. Certain medications are known to increase anxiety (e.g., corticoste- 
roids, estrogens, metoclopramide), and when this is the case, the medication may be the 
most likely etiology, although it may be difficult to distinguish whether the anxiety is at- 
tributable to the medications or to the medical illness itself. When a diagnosis of substance- 
induced anxiety is being made in relation to recreational or nonprescribed drugs, it may be 
useful to obtain a urine or blood drug screen or other appropriate laboratory evaluation. 
Symptoms that occur during or shortly after (i.e., within 4 weeks of) substance intoxication 
or withdrawal or after medication use may be especially indicative of a substance/medi- 
cation-induced anxiety disorder, depending on the type, duration, or amount of the sub- 
stance used. If the disturbance is associated with both another medical condition and 
substance use, both diagnoses (i.e., anxiety disorder due to another medical condition and 
substance /medication-induced anxiety disorder) can be given. Features such as onset af- 
ter age 45 years or the presence of atypical symptoms during a panic attack (e.g., vertigo, 
loss of consciousness, loss of bladder or bowel control, slurred speech, amnesia) suggest 
the possibility that another medical condition or a substance may be causing the panic at- 
tack symptoms. 


Anxiety disorder (not due to a known medical condition). Anxiety disorder due to an- 
other medical condition should be distinguished from other anxiety disorders (especially 
panic disorder and generalized anxiety disorder). In other anxiety disorders, no specific 
and direct causative physiological mechanisms associated with another medical condition 
can be demonstrated. Late age at onset, atypical symptoms, and the absence of a personal 
or family history of anxiety disorders suggest the need for a thorough assessment to rule 
out the diagnosis of anxiety disorder due to another medical condition. Anxiety disorders 
can exacerbate or pose increased risk for medical conditions such as cardiovascular events 
and myocardial infarction and should not be diagnosed as anxiety disorder due to another 
medical condition in these cases. 


Illness anxiety disorder. Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition should be 
distinguished from illness anxiety disorder. Illness anxiety disorder is characterized by 
worry about illness, concern about pain, and bodily preoccupations. In the case of illness 
anxiety disorder, individuals may or may not have diagnosed medical conditions. Al- 
though an individual with illness anxiety disorder and a diagnosed medical condition is 
likely to experience anxiety about the medical condition, the medical condition is not 
physiologically related to the anxiety symptoms. 


Adjustment disorders. Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition should be 
distinguished from adjustment disorders, with anxiety, or with anxiety and depressed 
mood. Adjustment disorder is warranted when individuals experience a maladaptive re- 
sponse to the stress of having another medical condition. The reaction to stress usually 
concerns the meaning or consequences of the stress, as compared with the experience of 
anxiety or mood symptoms that occur as a physiological consequence of the other medical 
condition. In adjustment disorder, the anxiety symptoms are typically related to coping 
with the stress of having a general medical condition, whereas in anxiety disorder due to 
another medical condition, individuals are more likely to have prominent physical symp- 
toms and to be focused on issues other than the stress of the illness itself. 


Associated feature of another mental disorder. Anxiety symptoms may be an associ- 
ated feature of another mental disorder (e.g., schizophrenia, anorexia nervosa). 


Other specified or unspecified anxiety disorder. This diagnosis is given if it cannot be 
determined whether the anxiety symptoms are primary, substance-induced, or associated 
with another medical condition. 


Other Specified Anxiety Disorder 233 


Other Specified Anxiety Disorder 
300.09 (F41.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an anxiety dis- 
order that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or oth- 
er important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of the 
disorders in the anxiety disorders diagnostic class. The other specified anxiety disorder 
category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific 
reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific anxiety disorder. 
This is done by recording “other specified anxiety disorder’ followed by the specific reason 
(e.g., “generalized anxiety not occurring more days than not’). 
Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 
1. Limited-symptom attacks. 
2. Generalized anxiety not occurring more days than not. 
3. Khyal cap (wind attacks): See “Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress” in the Ap- 
pendix. 
4. Ataque de nervios (attack of nerves): See “Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress” 
in the Appendix. 


Unspecified Anxiety Disorder 
300.00 (F41.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an anxiety dis- 
order that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or oth- 
er important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of the 
disorders in the anxiety disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified anxiety disorder cate- 
gory is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the 
criteria are not met for a specific anxiety disorder, and includes presentations in which 
there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room 
settings). 


This page intentionally left blank 


Obsessive-Compulsive and 
Related Disorders 


Obsess ive-comp UISIVE and related disorders include obsessive-compulsive 
disorder (OCD), body dysmorphic disorder, hoarding disorder, trichotillomania (hair- 
pulling disorder), excoriation (skin-picking) disorder, substance /medication-induced ob- 
sessive-compulsive and related disorder, obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due 
to another medical condition, and other specified obsessive-compulsive and related dis- 
order and unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder (e.g., body-focused re- 
petitive behavior disorder, obsessional jealousy). 

OCD is characterized by the presence of obsessions and/or compulsions. Obsessions 
are recurrent and persistent thoughts, urges, or images that are experienced as intrusive 
and unwanted, whereas compulsions are repetitive behaviors or mental acts that an indi- 
vidual feels driven to perform in response to an obsession or according to rules that must 
be applied rigidly. Some other obsessive-compulsive and related disorders are also char- 
acterized by preoccupations and by repetitive behaviors or mental acts in response to the 
preoccupations. Other obsessive-compulsive and related disorders are characterized pri- 
marily by recurrent body-focused repetitive behaviors (e.g., hair pulling, skin picking) and 
repeated attempts to decrease or stop the behaviors. 

The inclusion of a chapter on obsessive-compulsive and related disorders in DSM-5 re- 
flects the increasing evidence of these disorders’ relatedness to one another in terms of a 
range of diagnostic validators as well as the clinical utility of grouping these disorders in 
the same chapter. Clinicians are encouraged to screen for these conditions in individuals 
who present with one of them and be aware of overlaps between these conditions. At the 
same time, there are important differences in diagnostic validators and treatment ap- 
proaches across these disorders. Moreover, there are close relationships between the anx- 
iety disorders and some of the obsessive-compulsive and related disorders (e.g., OCD), 
which is reflected in the sequence of DSM-5 chapters, with obsessive-compulsive and re- 
lated disorders following anxiety disorders. 

The obsessive-compulsive and related disorders differ from developmentally norma- 
tive preoccupations and rituals by being excessive or persisting beyond developmentally 
appropriate periods. The distinction between the presence of subclinical symptoms and a 
clinical disorder requires assessment of a number of factors, including the individual’s 
level of distress and impairment in functioning. 

The chapter begins with OCD. It then covers body dysmorphic disorder and hoarding 
disorder, which are characterized by cognitive symptoms such as perceived defects or 
flaws in physical appearance or the perceived need to save possessions, respectively. The 
chapter then covers trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder) and excoriation (skin-picking) 
disorder, which are characterized by recurrent body-focused repetitive behaviors. Finally, 
it covers substance/medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, 
obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to another medical condition, and other 
specified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder and unspecified obsessive-compul- 
sive and related disorder. 

While the specific content of obsessions and compulsions varies among individuals, 
certain symptom dimensions are common in OCD, including those of cleaning (contami- 
nation obsessions and cleaning compulsions); symmetry (symmetry obsessions and repeat- 


235 


236 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


ing, ordering, and counting compulsions); forbidden or taboo thoughts (e.g., aggressive, 
sexual, and religious obsessions and related compulsions); and harm (e.g., fears of harm to 
oneself or others and related checking compulsions). The tic-related specifier of OCD is 
used when an individual has a current or past history of a tic disorder. 

Body dysmorphic disorder is characterized by preoccupation with one or more per- 
ceived defects or flaws in physical appearance that are not observable or appear only slight 
to others, and by repetitive behaviors (e.g., mirror checking, excessive grooming, skin 
picking, or reassurance seeking) or mental acts (e.g., comparing one’s appearance with that 
of other people) in response to the appearance concerns. The appearance preoccupations 
are not better explained by concerns with body fat or weight in an individual with an eat- 
ing disorder. Muscle dysmorphia is a form of body dysmorphic disorder that is character- 
ized by the belief that one’s body build is too small or is insufficiently muscular. 

Hoarding disorder is characterized by persistent difficulty discarding or parting with 
possessions, regardless of their actual value, as a result of a strong perceived need to save 
the items and to distress associated with discarding them. Hoarding disorder differs from 
normal collecting. For example, symptoms of hoarding disorder result in the accumula- 
tion of a large number of possessions that congest and clutter active living areas to the ex- 
tent that their intended use is substantially compromised. The excessive acquisition form 
of hoarding disorder, which characterizes most but not all individuals with hoarding dis- 
order, consists of excessive collecting, buying, or stealing of items that are not needed or 
for which there is no available space. 

Trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder) is characterized by recurrent pulling out of 
one's hair resulting in hair loss, and repeated attempts to decrease or stop hair pulling. 
Excoriation (skin-picking) disorder is characterized by recurrent picking of one’s skin re- 
sulting in skin lesions and repeated attempts to decrease or stop skin picking. The body- 
focused repetitive behaviors that characterize these two disorders are not triggered by ob- 
sessions or preoccupations; however, they may be preceded or accompanied by various 
emotional states, such as feelings of anxiety or boredom. They may also be preceded by an 
increasing sense of tension or may lead to gratification, pleasure, or a sense of relief when 
the hair is pulled out or the skin is picked. Individuals with these disorders may have vary- 
ing degrees of conscious awareness of the behavior while engaging in it, with some indi- 
viduals displaying more focused attention on the behavior (with preceding tension and 
subsequent relief) and other individuals displaying more automatic behavior (with the be- 
haviors seeming to occur without full awareness). 

Substance /medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder consists of 
symptoms that are due to substance intoxication or withdrawal or to a medication. Obses- 
sive-compulsive and related disorder due to another medical condition involves symptoms 
characteristic of obsessive-compulsive and related disorders that are the direct pathophysio- 
logical consequence of a medical disorder. Other specified obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder and unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder consist of symptoms 
that do not meet criteria for a specific obsessive-compulsive and related disorder because of 
atypical presentation or uncertain etiology; these categories are also used for other specific 
syndromes that are not listed in Section Il and when insufficient information is available to di- 
agnose the presentation as another obsessive-compulsive and related disorder. Examples of 
specific syndromes not listed in Section II, and therefore diagnosed as other specified obses- 
sive-compulsive and related disorder or as unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder include body-focused repetitive behavior disorder and obsessional jealousy. 

Obsessive-compulsive and related disorders that have a cognitive component have in- 
sight as the basis for specifiers; in each of these disorders, insight ranges from “good or fair 
insight” to “poor insight” to “absent insight/delusional beliefs” with respect to disorder- 
related beliefs. For individuals whose obsessive-compulsive and related disorder symp- 
toms warrant the “with absent insight /delusional beliefs” specifier, these symptoms 
should not be diagnosed as a psychotic disorder. 


Obsessive-Compulsive Disorder 237 


Obsessive-Compulsive Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.3 (F42) 


A. Presence of obsessions, compulsions, or both: 
Obsessions are defined by (1) and (2): 


1. Recurrent and persistent thoughts, urges, or images that are experienced, at some 
time during the disturbance, as intrusive and unwanted, and that in most individuals 
cause marked anxiety or distress. 

2. The individual attempts to ignore or suppress such thoughts, urges, or images, or to 
neutralize them with some other thought or action (i.e., by performing a compulsion). 


Compulsions are defined by (1) and (2): 


1. Repetitive behaviors (e.g., hand washing, ordering, checking) or mental acts (e.g., 
praying, counting, repeating words silently) that the individual feels driven to per- 
form in response to an obsession or according to rules that must be applied rigidly. 

2. The behaviors or mental acts are aimed at preventing or reducing anxiety or dis- 
tress, or preventing some dreaded event or situation; however, these behaviors or 
mental acts are not connected in a realistic way with what they are designed to neu- 
tralize or prevent, or are clearly excessive. 

Note: Young children may not be able to articulate the aims of these behaviors or 
mental acts. 

B. The obsessions or compulsions are time-consuming (e.g., take more than 1 hour per 
day) or cause Clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning. 

C. The obsessive-compulsive symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects 
of a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition. 

D. The disturbance is not better explained by the symptoms of another mental disorder 
(e.g., excessive worries, as in generalized anxiety disorder; preoccupation with ap- 
pearance, as in body dysmorphic disorder; difficulty discarding or parting with posses- 
sions, as in hoarding disorder; hair pulling, as in trichotillomania [hair-pulling disorder]; 
skin picking, as in excoriation [skin-picking] disorder; stereotypies, as in stereotypic 
movement disorder; ritualized eating behavior, as in eating disorders; preoccupation 
with substances or gambling, as in substance-related and addictive disorders; preoc- 
cupation with having an illness, as in illness anxiety disorder; sexual urges or fantasies, 
as in paraphilic disorders; impulses, as in disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct dis- 
orders; guilty ruminations, as in major depressive disorder; thought insertion or delu- 
sional preoccupations, as in schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorders; or 
repetitive patterns of behavior, as in autism spectrum disorder). 


Specify if: 
With good or fair insight: The individual recognizes that obsessive-compulsive dis- 
order beliefs are definitely or probably not true or that they may or may not be true. 
With poor insight: The individual thinks obsessive-compulsive disorder beliefs are 
probably true. 
With absent insight/delusional beliefs: The individual is completely convinced that 
obsessive-compulsive disorder beliefs are true. 

Specify if: 
Tic-related: The individual has a current or past history of a tic disorder. 


238 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


Specifiers 

Many individuals with obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD) have dysfunctional beliefs. 
These beliefs can include an inflated sense of responsibility and the tendency to overesti- 
mate threat; perfectionism and intolerance of uncertainty; and over-importance of thoughts 
(e.g., believing that having a forbidden thought is as bad as acting on it) and the need to 
control thoughts. 

Individuals with OCD vary in the degree of insight they have about the accuracy of the 
beliefs that underlie their obsessive-compulsive symptoms. Many individuals have good or 
fair insight (e.g., the individual believes that the house definitely will not, probably will not, 
or may or may not burn down if the stove is not checked 30 times). Some have poor insight 
(e.g., the individual believes that the house will probably burn down if the stove is not 
checked 30 times), and a few (4% or less) have absent insight/delusional beliefs (e.g., the in- 
dividual is convinced that the house will burn down if the stove is not checked 30 times). 
Insight can vary within an individual over the course of the illness. Poorer insight has been 
linked to worse long-term outcome. 

Up to 30% of individuals with OCD have a lifetime tic disorder. This is most common 
in males with onset of OCD in childhood. These individuals tend to differ from those with- 
out a history of tic disorders in the themes of their OCD symptoms, comorbidity, course, 
and pattern of familial transmission. 


Diagnostic Features 


The characteristic symptoms of OCD are the presence of obsessions and compulsions (Cri- 
terion A). Obsessions are repetitive and persistent thoughts (e.g., of contamination), images 
(e.g., of violent or horrific scenes), or urges (e.g., to stab someone). Importantly, obsessions 
are not pleasurable or experienced as voluntary: they are intrusive and unwanted and 
cause marked distress or anxiety in most individuals. The individual attempts to ignore or 
suppress these obsessions (e.g., avoiding triggers or using thought suppression) or to neu- 
tralize them with another thought or action (e.g., performing a compulsion). Compulsions 
(or rituals) are repetitive behaviors (e.g., washing, checking) or mental acts (e.g., counting, 
repeating words silently) that the individual feels driven to perform in response to an 
obsession or according to rules that must be applied rigidly. Most individuals with OCD 
have both obsessions and compulsions. Compulsions are typically performed in response 
to an obsession (e.g., thoughts of contamination leading to washing rituals or that some- 
thing is incorrect leading to repeating rituals until it feels “just right”). The aim is to reduce 
the distress triggered by obsessions or to prevent a feared event (e.g., becoming ill). How- 
ever, these compulsions either are not connected in a realistic way to the feared event (e.g., 
arranging items symmetrically to prevent harm to a loved one) or are clearly excessive 
(e.g., showering for hours each day). Compulsions are not done for pleasure, although some 
individuals experience relief from anxiety or distress. 

Criterion B emphasizes that obsessions and compulsions must be time-consuming (e.g., 
more than 1 hour per day) or cause clinically significant distress or impairment to warrant 
a diagnosis of OCD. This criterion helps to distinguish the disorder from the occasional in- 
trusive thoughts or repetitive behaviors that are common in the general population (e.g., 
double-checking that a door is locked). The frequency and severity of obsessions and com- 
pulsions vary across individuals with OCD (e.g., some have mild to moderate symptoms, 
spending 1-3 hours per day obsessing or doing compulsions, whereas others have nearly 
constant intrusive thoughts or compulsions that can be incapacitating). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 

The specific content of obsessions and compulsions varies between individuals. However, 
certain themes, or dimensions, are common, including those of cleaning (contamination 
obsessions and cleaning compulsions); symmetry (symmetry obsessions and repeating, 


Obsessive-Compulsive Disorder 239 


ordering, and counting compulsions); forbidden or taboo thoughts (e.g., aggressive, sexual, 
or religious obsessions and related compulsions); and harm (e.g., fears of harm to oneself 
or others and checking compulsions). Some individuals also have difficulties discarding 
and accumulate (hoard) objects as a consequence of typical obsessions and compulsions, 
such as fears of harming others. These themes occur across different cultures, are rela- 
tively consistent over time in adults with the disorder, and may be associated with differ- 
ent neural substrates. Importantly, individuals often have symptoms in more than one 
dimension. 

Individuals with OCD experience a range of affective responses when confronted with 
situations that trigger obsessions and compulsions. For example, many individuals expe- 
rience marked anxiety that can include recurrent panic attacks. Others report strong feel- 
ings of disgust. While performing compulsions, some individuals report a distressing 
sense of “incompleteness” or uneasiness until things look, feel, or sound “just right.” 

It is common for individuals with the disorder to avoid people, places, and things that 
trigger obsessions and compulsions. For example, individuals with contamination con- 
cerns might avoid public situations (e.g., restaurants, public restrooms) to reduce ex- 
posure to feared contaminants; individuals with intrusive thoughts about causing harm 
might avoid social interactions. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence of OCD in the United States is 1.2%, with a similar prevalence in- 
ternationally (1.1%-—1.8%). Females are affected at a slightly higher rate than males in 
adulthood, although males are more commonly affected in childhood. 


Development and Course 


In the United States, the mean age at onset of OCD is 19.5 years, and 25% of cases start by 
age 14 years. Onset after age 35 years is unusual but does occur. Males have an earlier age 
at onset than females: nearly 25% of males have onset before age 10 years. The onset of 
symptoms is typically gradual; however, acute onset has also been reported. 

If OCD is untreated, the course is usually chronic, often with waxing and waning symp- 
toms. Some individuals have an episodic course, and a minority have a deteriorating 
course. Without treatment, remission rates in adults are low (e.g., 20% for those reevalu- 
ated 40 years later). Onset in childhood or adolescence can lead to a lifetime of OCD. How- 
ever, 40% of individuals with onset of OCD in childhood or adolescence may experience 
remission by early adulthood. The course of OCD is often complicated by the co-occurrence 
of other disorders (see section “Comorbidity” for this disorder). 

Compulsions are more easily diagnosed in children than obsessions are because com- 
pulsions are observable. However, most children have both obsessions and compulsions 
(as do most adults). The pattern of symptoms in adults can be stable over time, but it is 
more variable in children. Some differences in the content of obsessions and compulsions 
have been reported when children and adolescent samples have been compared with 
adult samples. These differences likely reflect content appropriate to different develop- 
mental stages (e.g., higher rates of sexual and religious obsessions in adolescents than in 
children; higher rates of harm obsessions [e.g., fears of catastrophic events, such as death 
or illness to self or loved ones] in children and adolescents than in adults). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 
Temperamental. Greater internalizing symptoms, higher negative emotionality, and 
behavioral inhibition in childhood are possible temperamental risk factors. 


Environmental. Physical and sexual abuse in childhood and other stressful or traumatic 
events have been associated with an increased risk for developing OCD. Some children 


240 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


may develop the sudden onset of obsessive-compulsive symptoms, which has been asso- 
ciated with different environmental factors, including various infectious agents and a 
post-infectious autoimmune syndrome. 


Genetic and physiological. The rate of OCD among first-degree relatives of adults with 
OCD is approximately two times that among first-degree relatives of those without the 
disorder; however, among first-degree relatives of individuals with onset of OCD in child- 
hood or adolescence, the rate is increased 10-fold. Familial transmission is due in part to 
genetic factors (e.g., a concordance rate of 0.57 for monozygotic vs. 0.22 for dizygotic twins). 
Dysfunction in the orbitofrontal cortex, anterior cingulate cortex, and striatum have been 
most strongly implicated. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


OCD occurs across the world. There is substantial similarity across cultures in the gender 
distribution, age at onset, and comorbidity of OCD. Moreover, around the globe, there is a 
similar symptom structure involving cleaning, symmetry, hoarding, taboo thoughts, or 
fear of harm. However, regional variation in symptom expression exists, and cultural 
factors may shape the content of obsessions and compulsions. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Males have an earlier age at onset of OCD than females and are more likely to have co- 
morbid tic disorders. Gender differences in the pattern of symptom dimensions have been 
reported, with, for example, females more likely to have symptoms in the cleaning dimen- 
sion and males more likely to have symptoms in the forbidden thoughts and symmetry di- 
mensions. Onset or exacerbation of OCD, as well as symptoms that can interfere with the 
mother-infant relationship (e.g., aggressive obsessions leading to avoidance of the infant), 
have been reported in the peripartum period. 


Suicide Risk 


Suicidal thoughts occur at some point in as many as about half of individuals with OCD. 
Suicide attempts are also reported in up to one-quarter of individuals with OCD; the pres- 
ence of comorbid major depressive disorder increases the risk. 


Functional Consequences of 
Obsessive-Compulsive Disorder 


OCD is associated with reduced quality of life as well as high levels of social and occupa- 
tional impairment. Impairment occurs across many different domains of life and is asso- 
ciated with symptom severity. Impairment can be caused by the time spent obsessing and 
doing compulsions. Avoidance of situations that can trigger obsessions or compulsions 
can also severely restrict functioning. In addition, specific symptoms can create specific 
obstacles. For example, obsessions about harm can make relationships with family and 
friends feel hazardous; the result can be avoidance of these relationships. Obsessions 
about symmetry can derail the timely completion of school or work projects because the 
project never feels “just right,” potentially resulting in school failure or job loss. Health 
consequences can also occur. For example, individuals with contamination concerns may 
avoid doctors’ offices and hospitals (e.g., because of fears of exposure to germs) or develop 
dermatological problems (e.g., skin lesions due to excessive washing). Sometimes the 
symptoms of the disorder interfere with its own treatment (e.g., when medications are con- 
sidered contaminated). When the disorder starts in childhood or adolescence, individuals 
may experience developmental difficulties. For example, adolescents may avoid socializ- 
ing with peers; young adults may struggle when they leave home to live independently. 


Obsessive-Compulsive Disorder 241 


The result can be few significant relationships outside the family and a lack of autonomy 
and financial independence from their family of origin. In addition, some individuals with 
OCD try to impose rules and prohibitions on family members because of their disorder 
(e.g.,no one in the family can have visitors to the house for fear of contamination), and this 
can lead to family dysfunction. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Anxiety disorders. Recurrent thoughts, avoidant behaviors, and repetitive requests for 
reassurance can also occur in anxiety disorders. However, the recurrent thoughts that are 
present in generalized anxiety disorder (i.e., worries) are usually about real-life concerns, 
whereas the obsessions of OCD usually do not involve real-life concerns and can include 
content that is odd, irrational, or of a seemingly magical nature; moreover, compulsions 
are often present and usually linked to the obsessions. Like individuals with OCD, indi- 
viduals with specific phobia can have a fear reaction to specific objects or situations; how- 
ever, in specific phobia the feared object is usually much more circumscribed, and rituals 
are not present. In social anxiety disorder (social phobia), the feared objects or situations 
are limited to social interactions, and avoidance or reassurance seeking is focused on re- 
ducing this social fear. 


Major depressive disorder. OCD can be distinguished from the rumination of major 
depressive disorder, in which thoughts are usually mood-congruent and not necessarily 
experienced as intrusive or distressing; moreover, ruminations are not linked to compul- 
sions, as is typical in OCD. 


Other obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. In body dysmorphic disorder, the 
obsessions and compulsions are limited to concerns about physical appearance; and in 
trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder), the compulsive behavior is limited to hair pulling 
in the absence of obsessions. Hoarding disorder symptoms focus exclusively on the per- 
sistent difficulty discarding or parting with possessions, marked distress associated with 
discarding items, and excessive accumulation of objects. However, if an individual has ob- 
sessions that are typical of OCD (e.g., concerns about incompleteness or harm), and these 
obsessions lead to compulsive hoarding behaviors (e.g., acquiring all objects in a set to at- 
tain a sense of completeness or not discarding old newspapers because they may contain 
information that could prevent harm), a diagnosis of OCD should be given instead. 


Eating disorders. OCD can be distinguished from anorexia nervosa in that in OCD the 
obsessions and compulsions are not limited to concerns about weight and food. 


Tics (in tic disorder) and stereotyped movements. A fic is a sudden, rapid, recurrent, 
nonrhythmic motor movement or vocalization (e.g., eye blinking, throat clearing). A ste- 
reotyped movement is a repetitive, seemingly driven, nonfunctional motor behavior (e.g., 
head banging, body rocking, self-biting). Tics and stereotyped movements are typically 
less complex than compulsions and are not aimed at neutralizing obsessions. However, 
distinguishing between complex tics and compulsions can be difficult. Whereas compul- 
sions are usually preceded by obsessions, tics are often preceded by premonitory sensory 
urges. Some individuals have symptoms of both OCD and a tic disorder, in which case 
both diagnoses may be warranted. 


Psychotic disorders. Some individuals with OCD have poor insight or even delusional 
OCD beliefs. However, they have obsessions and compulsions (distinguishing their 
condition from delusional disorder) and do not have other features of schizophrenia or 
schizoaffective disorder (e.g., hallucinations or formal thought disorder). 


Other compulsive-like behaviors. Certain behaviors are sometimes described as “com- 
pulsive,” including sexual behavior (in the case of paraphilias), gambling (i-e., gambling 


242 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


disorder), and substance use (e.g., alcohol use disorder). However, these behaviors differ 
from the compulsions of OCD in that the person usually derives pleasure from the activity 
and may wish to resist it only because of its deleterious consequences. 


Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder. Although obsessive-compulsive person- 
ality disorder and OCD have similar names, the clinical manifestations of these disorders 
are quite different. Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder is not characterized by in- 
trusive thoughts, images, or urges or by repetitive behaviors that are performed in re- 
sponse to these intrusions; instead, it involves an enduring and pervasive maladaptive 
pattern of excessive perfectionism and rigid control. If an individual manifests symptoms 
of both OCD and obsessive-compulsive personality disorder, both diagnoses can be given. 


Comorbidity 


Individuals with OCD often have other psychopathology. Many adults with the disorder 
have a lifetime diagnosis of an anxiety disorder (76%; e.g., panic disorder, social anxiety 
disorder, generalized anxiety disorder, specific phobia) or a depressive or bipolar disorder 
(63% for any depressive or bipolar disorder, with the most common being major depres- 
sive disorder [41%]). Onset of OCD is usually later than for most comorbid anxiety disor- 
ders (with the exception of separation anxiety disorder) and PTSD but often precedes that 
of depressive disorders. Comorbid obsessive-compulsive personality disorder is also 
common in individuals with OCD (e.g., ranging from 23% to 32%). 

Up to 30% of individuals with OCD also have a lifetime tic disorder. A comorbid tic 
disorder is most common in males with onset of OCD in childhood. These individuals 
tend to differ from those without a history of tic disorders in the themes of their OCD 
symptoms, comorbidity, course, and pattern of familial transmission. A triad of OCD, tic 
disorder, and attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder can also be seen in children. 

Disorders that occur more frequently in individuals with OCD than in those without 
the disorder include several obsessive-compulsive and related disorders such as body 
dysmorphic disorder, trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder), and excoriation (skin-pick- 
ing) disorder. Finally, an association between OCD and some disorders characterized by 
impulsivity, such as oppositional defiant disorder, has been reported. 

OCD is also much more common in individuals with certain other disorders than 
would be expected based on its prevalence in the general population; when one of those 
other disorders is diagnosed, the individual should be assessed for OCD as well. For ex- 
ample, in individuals with schizophrenia or schizoaffective disorder, the prevalence of 
OCD is approximately 12%. Rates of OCD are also elevated in bipolar disorder; eating dis- 
orders, such as anorexia nervosa and bulimia nervosa; and Tourette’s disorder. 


Body Dysmorphic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.7 (F45.22) 


A. Preoccupation with one or more perceived defects or flaws in physical appearance that 
are not observable or appear slight to others. 

B. At some point during the course of the disorder, the individual has performed repetitive 
behaviors (e.g., mirror checking, excessive grooming, skin picking, reassurance seek- 
ing) or mental acts (e.g., comparing his or her appearance with that of others) in re- 
sponse to the appearance concerns. 

C. The preoccupation causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occu- 
pational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The appearance preoccupation is not better explained by concerns with body fat or 
weight in an individual whose symptoms meet diagnostic criteria for an eating disorder. 


Body Dysmorphic Disorder 243 


Specify if: 
With muscle dysmorphia: The individual is preoccupied with the idea that his or her 
body build is too small or insufficiently muscular. This specifier is used even if the indi- 
vidual is preoccupied with other body areas, which is often the case. 


Specify if: 
Indicate degree of insight regarding body dysmorphic disorder beliefs (e.g., “I look ugly” or 
“| look deformed”). 


With good or fair insight: The individual recognizes that the body dysmorphic disor- 
der beliefs are definitely or probably not true or that they may or may not be true. 
With poor insight: The individual thinks that the body dysmorphic disorder beliefs are 
probably true. 

With absent insight/delusional beliefs: The individual is completely convinced that 
the body dysmorphic disorder beliefs are true. 


Diagnostic Features 


Individuals with body dysmorphic disorder (formerly known as dysmorphophobia) are pre- 
occupied with one or more perceived defects or flaws in their physical appearance, which 
they believe look ugly, unattractive, abnormal, or deformed (Criterion A). The perceived 
flaws are not observable or appear only slight to other individuals. Concerns range from 
looking “unattractive” or “not right” to looking “hideous” or “like a monster.” Preoccu- 
pations can focus on one or many body areas, most commonly the skin (e.g., perceived 
acne, scars, lines, wrinkles, paleness), hair (e.g., “thinning” hair or “excessive” body or fa- 
cial hair), or nose (e.g., size or shape). However, any body area can be the focus of concern 
(e.g., eyes, teeth, weight, stomach, breasts, legs, face size or shape, lips, chin, eyebrows, 
genitals). Some individuals are concerned about perceived asymmetry of body areas. The 
preoccupations are intrusive, unwanted, time-consuming (occurring, on average, 3-8 
hours per day), and usually difficult to resist or control. 

Excessive repetitive behaviors or mental acts (e.g., comparing) are performed in re- 
sponse to the preoccupation (Criterion B). The individual feels driven to perform these be- 
haviors, which are not pleasurable and may increase anxiety and dysphoria. They are 
typically time-consuming and difficult to resist or control. Common behaviors are com- 
paring one’s appearance with that of other individuals; repeatedly checking perceived 
defects in mirrors or other reflecting surfaces or examining them directly; excessively 
grooming (e.g., combing, styling, shaving, plucking, or pulling hair); camouflaging (e.¢g., 
repeatedly applying makeup or covering disliked areas with such things as a hat, clothing, 
makeup, or hair); seeking reassurance about how the perceived flaws look; touching dis- 
liked areas to check them; excessively exercising or weight lifting; and seeking cosmetic 
procedures. Some individuals excessively tan (e.g., to darken “pale” skin or diminish per- 
ceived acne), repeatedly change their clothes (e.g., to camouflage perceived defects), or 
compulsively shop (e.g., for beauty products). Compulsive skin picking intended to 
improve perceived skin defects is common and can cause skin damage, infections, or 
ruptured blood vessels. The preoccupation must cause clinically significant distress or im- 
pairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning (Criterion C); 
usually both are present. Body dysmorphic disorder must be differentiated from an eating 
disorder. 

Muscle dysmorphia, a form of body dysmorphic disorder occurring almost exclusively 
in males, consists of preoccupation with the idea that one’s body is too small or insuffi- 
ciently lean or muscular. Individuals with this form of the disorder actually have a nor- 
mal-looking body or are even very muscular. They may also be preoccupied with other 
body areas, such as skin or hair. A majority (but not all) diet, exercise, and/or lift weights 
excessively, sometimes causing bodily damage. Some use potentially dangerous anabolic- 


244 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


androgenic steroids and other substances to try to make their body bigger and more mus- 
cular. Body dysmorphic disorder by proxy is a form of body dysmorphic disorder in 
which individuals are preoccupied with defects they perceive in another person’s appear- 
ance. 

Insight regarding body dysmorphic disorder beliefs can range from good to absent/ 
delusional (i.e., delusional beliefs consisting of complete conviction that the individual’s 
view of their appearance is accurate and undistorted). On average, insight is poor; one- 
third or more of individuals currently have delusional body dysmorphic disorder beliefs. 
Individuals with delusional body dysmorphic disorder tend to have greater morbidity in 
some areas (e.g., suicidality), but this appears accounted for by their tendency to have 
more severe body dysmorphic disorder symptoms. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Many individuals with body dysmorphic disorder have ideas or delusions of reference, 
believing that other people take special notice of them or mock them because of how they 
look. Body dysmorphic disorder is associated with high levels of anxiety, social anxiety, 
social avoidance, depressed mood, neuroticism, and perfectionism as well as low extro- 
version and low self-esteem. Many individuals are ashamed of their appearance and their 
excessive focus on how they look, and are reluctant to reveal their concerns to others. A 
majority of individuals receive cosmetic treatment to try to improve their perceived de- 
fects. Dermatological treatment and surgery are most common, but any type (e.g., dental, 
electrolysis) may be received. Occasionally, individuals may perform surgery on them- 
selves. Body dysmorphic disorder appears to respond poorly to such treatments and 
sometimes becomes worse. Some individuals take legal action or are violent toward the 
clinician because they are dissatisfied with the cosmetic outcome. 

Body dysmorphic disorder has been associated with executive dysfunction and visual 
processing abnormalities, with a bias for analyzing and encoding details rather than ho- 
listic or configural aspects of visual stimuli. Individuals with this disorder tend to have a 
bias for negative and threatening interpretations of facial expressions and ambiguous sce- 
narios. 


Prevalence 


The point prevalence among U.S. adults is 2.4% (2.5% in females and 2.2% in males). Out- 
side the United States (i.e., Germany), current prevalence is approximately 1.7%-1.8%, 
with a gender distribution similar to that in the United States. The current prevalence is 
9%-15% among dermatology patients, 7%-8% among U.S. cosmetic surgery patients, 3%— 
16% among international cosmetic surgery patients (most studies), 8% among adult orth- 
odontia patients, and 10% among patients presenting for oral or maxillofacial surgery. 


Development and Course 


The mean age at disorder onset is 16-17 years, the median age at onset is 15 years, and the 
most common age at onset is 12-13 years. Two-thirds of individuals have disorder onset 
before age 18. Subclinical body dysmorphic disorder symptoms begin, on average, at age 
12 or 13 years. Subclinical concerns usually evolve gradually to the full disorder, although 
some individuals experience abrupt onset of body dysmorphic disorder. The disorder 
appears to usually be chronic, although improvement is likely when evidence-based 
treatment is received. The disorder’s clinical features appear largely similar in children/ 
adolescents and adults. Body dysmorphic disorder occurs in the elderly, but little is known 
about the disorder in this age group. Individuals with disorder onset before age 18 years 
are more likely to attempt suicide, have more comorbidity, and have gradual (rather than 
acute) disorder onset than those with adult-onset body dysmorphic disorder. 


Body Dysmorphic Disorder 245 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Body dysmorphic disorder has been associated with high rates of child- 
hood neglect and abuse. 


Genetic and physiological. The prevalence of body dysmorphic disorder is elevated in 
first-degree relatives of individuals with obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD). 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Body dysmorphic disorder has been reported internationally. It appears that the disorder 
may have more similarities than differences across races and cultures but that cultural 
values and preferences may influence symptom content to some degree. Taijin kyofusho, 
included in the traditional Japanese diagnostic system, has a subtype similar to body dys- 
morphic disorder: shubo-kyofu (“the phobia of a deformed body”). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Females and males appear to have more similarities than differences in terms of most clin- 
ical features— for example, disliked body areas, types of repetitive behaviors, symptom 
severity, suicidality, comorbidity, illness course, and receipt of cosmetic procedures for 
body dysmorphic disorder. However, males are more likely to have genital preoccupa- 
tions, and females are more likely to have a comorbid eating disorder. Muscle dysmorphia 
occurs almost exclusively in males. 


Suicide Risk 


Rates of suicidal ideation and suicide attempts are high in both adults and children/ado- 
lescents with body dysmorphic disorder. Furthermore, risk for suicide appears high in ad- 
olescents. A substantial proportion of individuals attribute suicidal ideation or suicide 
attempts primarily to their appearance concerns. Individuals with body dysmorphic dis- 
order have many risk factors for completed suicide, such as high rates of suicidal ideation 
and suicide attempts, demographic characteristics associated with suicide, and high rates 
of comorbid major depressive disorder. 


Functional Consequences of 
Body Dysmorphic Disorder 


Nearly all individuals with body dysmorphic disorder experience impaired psychosocial 
functioning because of their appearance concerns. Impairment can range from moderate 
(e.g., avoidance of some social situations) to extreme and incapacitating (e.g., being com- 
pletely housebound). On average, psychosocial functioning and quality of life are mark- 
edly poor. More severe body dysmorphic disorder symptoms are associated with poorer 
functioning and quality of life. Most individuals experience impairment in their job, aca- 
demic, or role functioning (e.g., as a parent or caregiver), which is often severe (e.g., per- 
forming poorly, missing school or work, not working). About 20% of youths with body 
dysmorphic disorder report dropping out of school primarily because of their body dys- 
morphic disorder symptoms. Impairment in social functioning (e.g., social activities, rela- 
tionships, intimacy), including avoidance, is common. Individuals may be housebound 
because of their body dysmorphic disorder symptoms, sometimes for years. A high pro- 
portion of adults and adolescents have been psychiatrically hospitalized. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normal appearance concerns and clearly noticeable physical defects. Body dysmor- 
phic disorder differs from normal appearance concerns in being characterized by exces- 


246 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


sive appearance-related preoccupations and repetitive behaviors that are time-consuming, 
are usually difficult to resist or control, and cause clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in functioning. Physical defects that are clearly noticeable (i.e., not slight) are not 
diagnosed as body dysmorphic disorder. However, skin picking as a symptom of body 
dysmorphic disorder can cause noticeable skin lesions and scarring; in such cases, body dys- 
morphic disorder should be diagnosed. 


Eating disorders. In an individual with an eating disorder, concerns about being fat are 
considered a symptom of the eating disorder rather than body dysmorphic disorder. 
However, weight concerns may occur in body dysmorphic disorder. Eating disorders and 
body dysmorphic disorder can be comorbid, in which case both should be diagnosed. 


Other obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. The preoccupations and repetitive 
behaviors of body dysmorphic disorder differ from obsessions and compulsions in OCD 
in that the former focus only on appearance. These disorders have other differences, such 
as poorer insight in body dysmorphic disorder. When skin picking is intended to improve 
the appearance of perceived skin defects, body dysmorphic disorder, rather than excoria- 
tion (skin-picking) disorder, is diagnosed. When hair removal (plucking, pulling, or other 
types of removal) is intended to improve perceived defects in the appearance of facial 
or body hair, body dysmorphic disorder is diagnosed rather than trichotillomania (hair- 
pulling disorder). 


Illness anxiety disorder. Individuals with body dysmorphic disorder are not preoccu- 
pied with having or acquiring a serious illness and do not have particularly elevated levels 
of somatization. 


Major depressive disorder. The prominent preoccupation with appearance and exces- 
sive repetitive behaviors in body dysmorphic disorder differentiate it from major de- 
pressive disorder. However, major depressive disorder and depressive symptoms are 
common in individuals with body dysmorphic disorder, often appearing to be secondary 
to the distress and impairment that body dysmorphic disorder causes. Body dysmorphic 
disorder should be diagnosed in depressed individuals if diagnostic criteria for body dys- 
morphic disorder are met. 


Anxiety disorders. Social anxiety and avoidance are common in body dysmorphic dis- 
order. However, unlike social anxiety disorder (social phobia), agoraphobia, and avoidant 
personality disorder, body dysmorphic disorder includes prominent appearance-related 
preoccupation, which may be delusional, and repetitive behaviors, and the social anxiety 
and avoidance are due to concerns about perceived appearance defects and the belief or 
fear that other people will consider these individuals ugly, ridicule them, or reject them be- 
cause of their physical features. Unlike generalized anxiety disorder, anxiety and worry in 
body dysmorphic disorder focus on perceived appearance flaws. 


Psychotic disorders. Many individuals with body dysmorphic disorder have delu- 
sional appearance beliefs (i-e., complete conviction that their view of their perceived de- 
fects is accurate), which is diagnosed as body dysmorphic disorder, with absent insight/ 
delusional beliefs, not as delusional disorder. Appearance-related ideas or delusions of 
reference are common in body dysmorphic disorder; however, unlike schizophrenia or 
schizoaffective disorder, body dysmorphic disorder involves prominent appearance pre- 
occupations and related repetitive behaviors, and disorganized behavior and other psy- 
chotic symptoms are absent (except for appearance beliefs, which may be delusional). 


Other disorders and symptoms. Body dysmorphic disorder should not be diagnosed if 
the preoccupation is limited to discomfort with or a desire to be rid of one’s primary and/ 
or secondary sex characteristics in an individual with gender dysphoria or if the preoccu- 
pation focuses on the belief that one emits a foul or offensive body odor as in olfactory 
reference syndrome (which is not a DSM-5 disorder). Body identity integrity disorder 


Hoarding Disorder 247 


(apotemnophilia) (which is not a DSM-5 disorder) involves a desire to have a limb ampu- 
tated to correct an experience of mismatch between a person’s sense of body identity and 
his or her actual anatomy. However, the concern does not focus on the limb’s appearance, 
as it would in body dysmorphic disorder. Koro, a culturally related disorder that usually 
occurs in epidemics in Southeastern Asia, consists of a fear that the penis (labia, nipples, or 
breasts in females) is shrinking or retracting and will disappear into the abdomen, often 
accompanied by a belief that death will result. Koro differs from body dysmorphic disor- 
der in several ways, including a focus on death rather than preoccupation with perceived 
ugliness. Dysmorphic concern (which is not a DSM-5 disorder) is a much broader construct 
than, and is not equivalent to, body dysmorphic disorder. It involves symptoms reflecting 
an overconcern with slight or imagined flaws in appearance. 


Comorbidity 


Major depressive disorder is the most common comorbid disorder, with onset usually af- 
ter that of body dysmorphic disorder. Comorbid social anxiety disorder (social phobia), 
OCD, and substance-related disorders are also common. 


Hoarding Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.3 (F42) 


A. Persistent difficulty discarding or parting with possessions, regardless of their actual value. 

B. This difficulty is due to a perceived need to save the items and to distress associated 
with discarding them. 

C. The difficulty discarding possessions results in the accumulation of possessions that 
congest and clutter active living areas and substantially compromises their intended 
use. If living areas are uncluttered, it is only because of the interventions of third parties 
(e.g., family members, cleaners, authorities). 

D. The hoarding causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning (including maintaining a safe environ- 
ment for self and others). 

E. The hoarding is not attributable to another medical condition (e.g., brain injury, cere- 
brovascular disease, Prader-Willi syndrome). 

F. The hoarding is not better explained by the symptoms of another mental disorder (e.g., 
obsessions in obsessive-compulsive disorder, decreased energy in major depressive 
disorder, delusions in schizophrenia or another psychotic disorder, cognitive deficits in 
major neurocognitive disorder, restricted interests in autism spectrum disorder). 

Specify if: 

With excessive acquisition: If difficulty discarding possessions is accompanied by ex- 
cessive acquisition of items that are not needed or for which there is no available space. 

Specify if: 

With good or fair insight: The individual recognizes that hoarding-related beliefs and 
behaviors (pertaining to difficulty discarding items, clutter, or excessive acquisition) are 
problematic. 

With poor insight: The individual is mostly convinced that hoarding-related beliefs 
and behaviors (pertaining to difficulty discarding items, clutter, or excessive acquisi- 
tion) are not problematic despite evidence to the contrary. 

With absent insight/delusional beliefs: The individual is completely convinced that 
hoarding-related beliefs and behaviors (pertaining to difficulty discarding items, clutter, 
or excessive acquisition) are not problematic despite evidence to the contrary. 


248 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


Specifiers 


With excessive acquisition. Approximately 80%-90% of individuals with hoarding 
disorder display excessive acquisition. The most frequent form of acquisition is excessive 
buying, followed by acquisition of free items (e.g., leaflets, items discarded by others). 
Stealing is less common. Some individuals may deny excessive acquisition when first as- 
sessed, yet it may appear later during the course of treatment. Individuals with hoarding 
disorder typically experience distress if they are unable to or are prevented from acquiring 
items. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of hoarding disorder is persistent difficulties discarding or parting 
with possessions, regardless of their actual value (Criterion A). The term persistent indi- 
cates a long-standing difficulty rather than more transient life circumstances that may lead 
to excessive clutter, such as inheriting property. The difficulty in discarding possessions 
noted in Criterion A refers to any form of discarding, including throwing away, selling, 
giving away, or recycling. The main reasons given for these difficulties are the perceived 
utility or aesthetic value of the items or strong sentimental attachment to the possessions. 
Some individuals feel responsible for the fate of their possessions and often go to great 
lengths to avoid being wasteful. Fears of losing important information are also common. 
The most commonly saved items are newspapers, magazines, old clothing, bags, books, 
mail, and paperwork, but virtually any item can be saved. The nature of items is not lim- 
ited to possessions that most other people would define as useless or of limited value. 
Many individuals collect and save large numbers of valuable things as well, which are of- 
ten found in piles mixed with other less valuable items. 

Individuals with hoarding disorder purposefully save possessions and experience dis- 
tress when facing the prospect of discarding them (Criterion B). This criterion emphasizes 
that the saving of possessions is intentional, which discriminates hoarding disorder from 
other forms of psychopathology that are characterized by the passive accumulation of 
items or the absence of distress when possessions are removed. 

Individuals accumulate large numbers of items that fill up and clutter active living ar- 
eas to the extent that their intended use is no longer possible (Criterion C). For example, 
the individual may not be able to cook in the kitchen, sleep in his or her bed, or sit ina 
chair. If the space can be used, it is only with great difficulty. Clutter is defined as a large 
group of usually unrelated or marginally related objects piled together in a disorganized 
fashion in spaces designed for other purposes (e.g., tabletops, floor, hallway). Criterion C 
emphasizes the “active” living areas of the home, rather than more peripheral areas, such 
as garages, attics, or basements, that are sometimes cluttered in homes of individuals with- 
out hoarding disorder. However, individuals with hoarding disorder often have posses- 
sions that spill beyond the active living areas and can occupy and impair the use of other 
spaces, such as vehicles, yards, the workplace, and friends’ and relatives’ houses. In some 
cases, living areas may be uncluttered because of the intervention of third parties (e.g., 
family members, cleaners, local authorities). Individuals who have been forced to clear 
their homes still have a symptom picture that meets criteria for hoarding disorder because 
the lack of clutter is due to a third-party intervention. Hoarding disorder contrasts with 
normative collecting behavior, which is organized and systematic, even if in some cases 
the actual amount of possessions may be similar to the amount accumulated by an indi- 
vidual with hoarding disorder. Normative collecting does not produce the clutter, dis- 
tress, or impairment typical of hoarding disorder. 

Symptoms (i.e., difficulties discarding and/or clutter) must cause clinically significant 
distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning, in- 
cluding maintaining a safe environment for self and others (Criterion D). In some cases, 


Hoarding Disorder 249 


particularly when there is poor insight, the individual may not report distress, and the im- 
pairment may be apparent only to those around the individual. However, any attempts to 
discard or clear the possessions by third parties result in high levels of distress. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Other common features of hoarding disorder include indecisiveness, perfectionism, 
avoidance, procrastination, difficulty planning and organizing tasks, and distractibility. 
Some individuals with hoarding disorder live in unsanitary conditions that may be a log- 
ical consequence of severely cluttered spaces and/or that are related to planning and or- 
ganizing difficulties. Animal hoarding can be defined as the accumulation of a large number 
of animals and a failure to provide minimal standards of nutrition, sanitation, and veter- 
inary care and to act on the deteriorating condition of the animals (including disease, star- 
vation, or death) and the environment (e.g., severe overcrowding, extremely unsanitary 
conditions). Animal hoarding may be a special manifestation of hoarding disorder. Most 
individuals who hoard animals also hoard inanimate objects. The most prominent differ- 
ences between animal and object hoarding are the extent of unsanitary conditions and the 
poorer insight in animal hoarding. 


Prevalence 


Nationally representative prevalence studies of hoarding disorder are not available. Com- 
munity surveys estimate the point prevalence of clinically significant hoarding in the 
United States and Europe to be approximately 2%-6%. Hoarding disorder affects both 
males and females, but some epidemiological studies have reported a significantly greater 
prevalence among males. This contrasts with clinical samples, which are predominantly 
female. Hoarding symptoms appear to be almost three times more prevalent in older 
adults (ages 55-94 years) compared with younger adults (ages 34—44 years). 


Development and Course 


Hoarding appears to begin early in life and spans well into the late stages. Hoarding symp- 
toms may first emerge around ages 11-15 years, start interfering with the individual’s ev- 
eryday functioning by the mid-20s, and cause clinically significant impairment by the 
mid-30s. Participants in clinical research studies are usually in their 50s. Thus, the severity 
of hoarding increases with each decade of life. Once symptoms begin, the course of hoard- 
ing is often chronic, with few individuals reporting a waxing and waning course. 

Pathological hoarding in children appears to be easily distinguished from develop- 
mentally adaptive saving and collecting behaviors. Because children and adolescents 
typically do not control their living environment and discarding behaviors, the possible 
intervention of third parties (e.g., parents keeping the spaces usable and thus reducing in- 
terference) should be considered when making the diagnosis. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Indecisiveness is a prominent feature of individuals with hoarding dis- 
order and their first-degree relatives. 


Environmental. Individuals with hoarding disorder often retrospectively report stressful 
and traumatic life events preceding the onset of the disorder or causing an exacerbation. 


Genetic and physiological. Hoarding behavior is familial, with about 50% of individu- 
als who hoard reporting having a relative who also hoards. Twin studies indicate that ap- 
proximately 50% of the variability in hoarding behavior is attributable to additive genetic 
factors. 


250 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


While most of the research has been done in Western, industrialized countries and urban 
communities, the available data from non-Western and developing countries suggest that 
hoarding is a universal phenomenon with consistent clinical features. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The key features of hoarding disorder (i.e., difficulties discarding, excessive amount of 
clutter) are generally comparable in males and females, but females tend to display more 
excessive acquisition, particularly excessive buying, than do males. 


Functional Consequences of Hoarding Disorder 


Clutter impairs basic activities, such as moving through the house, cooking, cleaning, per- 
sonal hygiene, and even sleeping. Appliances may be broken, and utilities such as water 
and electricity may be disconnected, as access for repair work may be difficult. Quality of 
life is often considerably impaired. In severe cases, hoarding can put individuals at risk for 
fire, falling (especially elderly individuals), poor sanitation, and other health risks. Hoard- 
ing disorder is associated with occupational impairment, poor physical health, and high 
social service utilization. Family relationships are frequently under great strain. Conflict 
with neighbors and local authorities is common, and a substantial proportion of individ- 
uals with severe hoarding disorder have been involved in legal eviction proceedings, and 
some have a history of eviction. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other medical conditions. Hoarding disorder is not diagnosed if the symptoms are 
judged to be a direct consequence of another medical condition (Criterion E), such as trau- 
matic brain injury, surgical resection for treatment of a tumor or seizure control, cerebro- 
vascular disease, infections of the central nervous system (e.g., herpes simplex encephalitis), 
or neurogenetic conditions such as Prader-Willi syndrome. Damage to the anterior ven- 
tromedial prefrontal and cingulate cortices has been particularly associated with the ex- 
cessive accumulation of objects. In these individuals, the hoarding behavior is not present 
prior to the onset of the brain damage and appears shortly after the brain damage occurs. 
Some of these individuals appear to have little interest in the accumulated items and are 
able to discard them easily or do not care if others discard them, whereas others appear to 
be very reluctant to discard anything. 


Neurodevelopmental disorders. Hoarding disorder is not diagnosed if the accumula- 
tion of objects is judged to be a direct consequence of a neurodevelopmental disorder, such 
as autism spectrum disorder or intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder). 


Schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorders. Hoarding disorder is not di- 
agnosed if the accumulation of objects is judged to be a direct consequence of delusions or 
negative symptoms in schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorders. 


Major depressive episode. Hoarding disorder is not diagnosed if the accumulation of 
objects is judged to be a direct consequence of psychomotor retardation, fatigue, or loss of 
energy during a major depressive episode. 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. Hoarding disorder is not diagnosed if the symptoms 
are judged to be a direct consequence of typical obsessions or compulsions, such as fears 
of contamination, harm, or feelings of incompleteness in obsessive-compulsive disorder 
(OCD). Feelings of incompleteness (e.g., losing one’s identity, or having to document and 
preserve all life experiences) are the most frequent OCD symptoms associated with this 
form of hoarding. The accumulation of objects can also be the result of persistently avoid- 


Trichotillomania (Hair-Pulling Disorder) 251 


ing onerous rituals (e.g., not discarding objects in order to avoid endless washing or check- 
ing rituals). 

In OCD, the behavior is generally unwanted and highly distressing, and the individual ex- 
periences no pleasure or reward from it. Excessive acquisition is usually not present; if exces- 
sive acquisition is present, items are acquired because of a specific obsession (e.g., the need to 
buy items that have been accidentally touched in order to avoid contaminating other people), 
not because of a genuine desire to possess the items. Individuals who hoard in the context of 
OCD are also more likely to accumulate bizarre items, such as trash, feces, urine, nails, hair, 
used diapers, or rotten food. Accumulation of such items is very unusual in hoarding disorder. 

When severe hoarding appears concurrently with other typical symptoms of OCD but 
is judged to be independent from these symptoms, both hoarding disorder and OCD may 
be diagnosed. 


Neurocognitive disorders. Hoarding disorder is not diagnosed if the accumulation of 
objects is judged to be a direct consequence of a degenerative disorder, such as neurocog- 
nitive disorder associated with frontotemporal lobar degeneration or Alzheimer’s disease. 
Typically, onset of the accumulating behavior is gradual and follows onset of the neuro- 
cognitive disorder. The accumulating behavior may be accompanied by self-neglect and 
severe domestic squalor, alongside other neuropsychiatric symptoms, such as disinhibi- 
tion, gambling, rituals /stereotypies, tics, and self-injurious behaviors. 


Comorbidity 


Approximately 75% of individuals with hoarding disorder have a comorbid mood or anx- 
iety disorder. The most common comorbid conditions are major depressive disorder (up 
to 50% of cases), social anxiety disorder (social phobia), and generalized anxiety disorder. 
Approximately 20% of individuals with hoarding disorder also have symptoms that meet 
diagnostic criteria for OCD. These comorbidities may often be the main reason for consul- 
tation, because individuals are unlikely to spontaneously report hoarding symptoms, and 
these symptoms are often not asked about in routine clinical interviews. 


Trichotillomania (Hair-Pulling Disorder) 
Diagnostic Criteria 312.39 (F63.3) 


A. Recurrent pulling out of one’s hair, resulting in hair loss. 

B. Repeated attempts to decrease or stop hair pulling. 

C. The hair pulling causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The hair pulling or hair loss is not attributable to another medical condition (e.g., a der- 
matological condition). 

E. The hair pulling is not better explained by the symptoms of another mental disorder 
(e.g., attempts to improve a perceived defect or flaw in appearance in body dysmorphic 
disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder) is the recurrent pulling out 
of one’s own hair (Criterion A). Hair pulling may occur from any region of the body in 
which hair grows; the most common sites are the scalp, eyebrows, and eyelids, while less 
common sites are axillary, facial, pubic, and peri-rectal regions. Hair-pulling sites may 
vary over time. Hair pulling may occur in brief episodes scattered throughout the day or 
during less frequent but more sustained periods that can continue for hours, and such hair 


252 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


pulling may endure for months or years. Criterion A requires that hair pulling lead to hair 
loss, although individuals with this disorder may pull hair in a widely distributed pattern 
(i.e., pulling single hairs from all over a site) such that hair loss may not be clearly visible. 
Alternatively, individuals may attempt to conceal or camouflage hair loss (e.g., by using 
makeup, scarves, or wigs). Individuals with trichotillomania have made repeated at- 
tempts to decrease or stop hair pulling (Criterion B). Criterion C indicates that hair pulling 
causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other impor- 
tant areas of functioning. The term distress includes negative affects that may be experi- 
enced by individuals with hair pulling, such as feeling a loss of control, embarrassment, 
and shame. Significant impairment may occur in several different areas of functioning 
(e.g., social, occupational, academic, and leisure), in part because of avoidance of work, 
school, or other public situations. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Hair pulling may be accompanied by a range of behaviors or rituals involving hair. Thus, 
individuals may search for a particular kind of hair to pull (e.g., hairs with a specific tex- 
ture or color), may try to pull out hair in a specific way (e.g., so that the root comes out in- 
tact), or may visually examine or tactilely or orally manipulate the hair after it has been 
pulled (e.g., rolling the hair between the fingers, pulling the strand between the teeth, bit- 
ing the hair into pieces, or swallowing the hair). 

Hair pulling may also be preceded or accompanied by various emotional states; it may 
be triggered by feelings of anxiety or boredom, may be preceded by an increasing sense of 
tension (either immediately before pulling out the hair or when attempting to resist the 
urge to pull), or may lead to gratification, pleasure, or a sense of relief when the hair is 
pulled out. Hair-pulling behavior may involve varying degrees of conscious awareness, 
with some individuals displaying more focused attention on the hair pulling (with pre- 
ceding tension and subsequent relief), and other individuals displaying more automatic 
behavior (in which the hair pulling seems to occur without full awareness). Many individ- 
uals report a mix of both behavioral styles. Some individuals experience an “itch-like” or 
tingling sensation in the scalp that is alleviated by the act of pulling hair. Pain does not 
usually accompany hair pulling. 

Patterns of hair loss are highly variable. Areas of complete alopecia, as well as areas of 
thinned hair density, are common. When the scalp is involved, there may be a predilection 
for pulling out hair in the crown or parietal regions. There may be a pattern of nearly com- 
plete baldness except for a narrow perimeter around the outer margins of the scalp, par- 
ticularly at the nape of the neck (“tonsure trichotillomania”). Eyebrows and eyelashes may 
be completely absent. 

Hair pulling does not usually occur in the presence of other individuals, except imme- 
diate family members. Some individuals have urges to pull hair from other individuals 
and may sometimes try to find opportunities to do so surreptitiously. Some individuals 
may pull hairs from pets, dolls, and other fibrous materials (e.g., sweaters or carpets). 
Some individuals may deny their hair pulling to others. The majority of individuals with 
trichotillomania also have one or more other body-focused repetitive behaviors, including 
skin picking, nail biting, and lip chewing. 


Prevalence 


In the general population, the 12-month prevalence estimate for trichotillomania in adults 
and adolescents is 1%-2%. Females are more frequently affected than males, at a ratio of 
approximately 10:1. This estimate likely reflects the true gender ratio of the condition, al- 
though it may also reflect differential treatment seeking based on gender or cultural at- 
titudes regarding appearance (e.g., acceptance of normative hair loss among males). 
Among children with trichotillomania, males and females are more equally represented. 


Trichotillomania (Hair-Pulling Disorder) 253 


Development and Course 


Hair pulling may be seen in infants, and this behavior typically resolves during early devel- 
opment. Onset of hair pulling in trichotillomania most commonly coincides with, or follows 
the onset of, puberty. Sites of hair pulling may vary over time. The usual course of trichotillo- 
mania is chronic, with some waxing and waning if the disorder is untreated. Symptoms may 
possibly worsen in females accompanying hormonal changes (e.g., menstruation, perimeno- 
pause). For some individuals, the disorder may come and go for weeks, months, or years at a 
time. A minority of individuals remit without subsequent relapse within a few years of onset. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. There is evidence for a genetic vulnerability to trichotillo- 
mania. The disorder is more common in individuals with obsessive-compulsive disorder 
(OCD) and their first-degree relatives than in the general population. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Trichotillomania appears to manifest similarly across cultures, although there is a paucity 
of data from non-Western regions. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Most individuals with trichotillomania admit to hair pulling; thus, dermatopathological 
diagnosis is rarely required. Skin biopsy and dermoscopy (or trichoscopy) of trichotillo- 
mania are able to differentiate the disorder from other causes of alopecia. In trichotil- 
lomania, dermoscopy shows a range of characteristic features, including decreased hair 
density, short vellus hair, and broken hairs with different shaft lengths. 


Functional Consequences of 
Trichotillomania (Hair-Pulling Disorder) 


Trichotillomania is associated with distress as well as with social and occupational impair- 
ment. There may be irreversible damage to hair growth and hair quality. Infrequent med- 
ical consequences of trichotillomania include digit purpura, musculoskeletal injury (e.g., 
carpal tunnel syndrome; back, shoulder and neck pain), blepharitis, and dental damage 
(e.g., worn or broken teeth due to hair biting). Swallowing of hair (trichophagia) may lead 
to trichobezoars, with subsequent anemia, abdominal pain, hematemesis, nausea and 
vomiting, bowel obstruction, and even perforation. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normative hair removal/manipulation. Trichotillomania should not be diagnosed when 
hair removal is performed solely for cosmetic reasons (i.e., to improve one’s physical ap- 
pearance). Many individuals twist and play with their hair, but this behavior does not usu- 
ally qualify for a diagnosis of trichotillomania. Some individuals may bite rather than pull 
hair; again, this does not qualify for a diagnosis of trichotillomania. 


Other obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. Individuals with OCD and sym- 
metry concerns may pull out hairs as part of their symmetry rituals, and individuals with 
body dysmorphic disorder may remove body hair that they perceive as ugly, asymmetri- 
cal, or abnormal; in such cases a diagnosis of trichotillomania is not given. The description 
of body-focused repetitive behavior disorder in other specified obsessive-compulsive and 
related disorder excludes individuals who meet diagnostic criteria for trichotillomania. 


254 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


Neurodevelopmental disorders. In neurodevelopmental disorders, hair pulling may 
meet the definition of stereotypies (e.g., in stereotypic movement disorder). Tics (in tic dis- 
orders) rarely lead to hair pulling. 


Psychotic disorder. Individuals with a psychotic disorder may remove hair in response 
to a delusion or hallucination. Trichotillomania is not diagnosed in such cases. 


Another medical condition. Trichotillomania is not diagnosed if the hair pulling or hair 
loss is attributable to another medical condition (e.g., inflammation of the skin or other der- 
matological conditions). Other causes of scarring alopecia (e.g., alopecia areata, androgenic 
alopecia, telogen effluvium) or nonscarring alopecia (e.g., chronic discoid lupus erythema- 
tosus, lichen planopilaris, central centrifugal cicatricial alopecia, pseudopelade, folliculitis 
decalvans, dissecting folliculitis, acne keloidalis nuchae) should be considered in individu- 
als with hair loss who deny hair pulling. Skin biopsy or dermoscopy can be used to differ- 
entiate individuals with trichotillomania from those with dermatological disorders. 


Substance-related disorders. Hair-pulling symptoms may be exacerbated by certain 
substances—for example, stimulants—but it is less likely that substances are the primary 
cause of persistent hair pulling. 


Comorbidity 


Trichotillomania is often accompanied by other mental disorders, most commonly major 
depressive disorder and excoriation (skin-picking) disorder. Repetitive body-focused 
symptoms other than hair pulling or skin picking (e.g. nail biting) occur in the majority of 
individuals with trichotillomania and may deserve an additional diagnosis of other spec- 
ified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder (i.e., body-focused repetitive behavior 
disorder). 


Excoriation (Skin-Picking) Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 698.4 (L98.1) 


A. Recurrent skin picking resulting in skin lesions. 

B. Repeated attempts to decrease or stop skin picking. 

C. The skin picking causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The skin picking is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., co- 
caine) or another medical condition (e.g., scabies). 

E. The skin picking is not better explained by symptoms of another mental disorder (e.g., 
delusions or tactile hallucinations in a psychotic disorder, attempts to improve a per- 
ceived defect or flaw in appearance in body dysmorphic disorder, stereotypies in ste- 
reotypic movement disorder, or intention to harm oneself in nonsuicidal self-injury). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of excoriation (skin-picking) disorder is recurrent picking at one’s 
own skin (Criterion A). The most commonly picked sites are the face, arms, and hands, but 
many individuals pick from multiple body sites. Individuals may pick at healthy skin, at 
minor skin irregularities, at lesions such as pimples or calluses, or at scabs from previous 
picking. Most individuals pick with their fingernails, although many use tweezers, pins, 
or other objects. In addition to skin picking, there may be skin rubbing, squeezing, lancing, 
and biting. Individuals with excoriation disorder often spend significant amounts of time 
on their picking behavior, sometimes several hours per day, and such skin picking may 


Excoriation (Skin-Picking) Disorder 255 


endure for months or years. Criterion A requires that skin picking lead to skin lesions, al- 
though individuals with this disorder often attempt to conceal or camouflage such lesions 
(e.g., with makeup or clothing). Individuals with excoriation disorder have made repeated 
attempts to decrease or stop skin picking (Criterion B). 

Criterion C indicates that skin picking causes clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. The term distress in- 
cludes negative affects that may be experienced by individuals with skin picking, such as 
feeling a loss of control, embarrassment, and shame. Significant impairment may occur in 
several different areas of functioning (e.g., social, occupational, academic, and leisure), in 
part because of avoidance of social situations. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Skin picking may be accompanied by a range of behaviors or rituals involving skin or scabs. 
Thus, individuals may search for a particular kind of scab to pull, and they may examine, 
play with, or mouth or swallow the skin after it has been pulled. Skin picking may also be pre- 
ceded or accompanied by various emotional states. Skin picking may be triggered by feelings 
of anxiety or boredom, may be preceded by an increasing sense of tension (either immedi- 
ately before picking the skin or when attempting to resist the urge to pick), and may lead to 
gratification, pleasure, or a sense of relief when the skin or scab has been picked. Some indi- 
viduals report picking in response to a minor skin irregularity or to relieve an uncomfortable 
bodily sensation. Pain is not routinely reported to accompany skin picking. Some individuals 
engage in skin picking that is more focused (i.e., with preceding tension and subsequent re- 
lief), whereas others engage in more automatic picking (i.e., when skin picking occurs with- 
out preceding tension and without full awareness), and many have a mix of both behavioral 
styles. Skin picking does not usually occur in the presence of other individuals, except im- 
mediate family members. Some individuals report picking the skin of others. 


Prevalence 


In the general population, the lifetime prevalence for excoriation disorder in adults is 1.4% 
or somewhat higher. Three-quarters or more of individuals with the disorder are female. 
This likely reflects the true gender ratio of the condition, although it may also reflect dif- 
ferential treatment seeking based on gender or cultural attitudes regarding appearance. 


Development and Course 


Although individuals with excoriation disorder may present at various ages, the skin pick- 
ing most often has onset during adolescence, commonly coinciding with or following the 
onset of puberty. The disorder frequently begins with a dermatological condition, such 
as acne. Sites of skin picking may vary over time. The usual course is chronic, with some 
waxing and waning if untreated. For some individuals, the disorder may come and go for 
weeks, months, or years ata time. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Excoriation disorder is more common in individuals with 
obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD) and their first-degree family members than in the 
general population. 


Diagnostic Markers 

Most individuals with excoriation disorder admit to skin picking; therefore, dermato- 
pathological diagnosis is rarely required. However, the disorder may have characteristic 
features on histopathology. 


256 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


Functional Consequences of 
Excoriation (Skin-Picking) Disorder 


Excoriation disorder is associated with distress as well as with social and occupational im- 
pairment. The majority of individuals with this condition spend at least 1 hour per day 
picking, thinking about picking, and resisting urges to pick. Many individuals report 
avoiding social or entertainment events as well as going out in public. A majority of indi- 
viduals with the disorder also report experiencing work interference from skin picking on 
at least a daily or weekly basis. A significant proportion of students with excoriation disor- 
der report having missed school, having experienced difficulties managing responsibilities 
at school, or having had difficulties studying because of skin picking. Medical complica- 
tions of skin picking include tissue damage, scarring, and infection and can be life-threaten- 
ing. Rarely, synovitis of the wrists due to chronic picking has been reported. Skin picking 
often results in significant tissue damage and scarring. It frequently requires antibiotic treat- 
ment for infection, and on occasion it may require surgery. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Psychotic disorder. Skin picking may occur in response to a delusion (i.e., parasitosis) 
or tactile hallucination (i.e., formication) in a psychotic disorder. In such cases, excoriation 
disorder should not be diagnosed. 


Other obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. Excessive washing compulsions 
in response to contamination obsessions in individuals with OCD may lead to skin lesions, 
and skin picking may occur in individuals with body dysmorphic disorder who pick their 
skin solely because of appearance concerns; in such cases, excoriation disorder should not 
be diagnosed. The description of body-focused repetitive behavior disorder in other spec- 
ified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder excludes individuals whose symptoms 
meet diagnostic criteria for excoriation disorder. 


Neurodevelopmental disorders. While stereotypic movement disorder may be charac- 
terized by repetitive self-injurious behavior, onset is in the early developmental period. 
For example, individuals with the neurogenetic condition Prader-Willi syndrome may 
have early onset of skin picking, and their symptoms may meet criteria for stereotypic 
movement disorder. While tics in individuals with Tourette’s disorder may lead to self- 
injury, the behavior is not tic-like in excoriation disorder. 


Somatic symptom and related disorders. Excoriation disorder is not diagnosed if the 
skin lesion is primarily attributable to deceptive behaviors in factitious disorder. 


Other disorders. Excoriation disorder is not diagnosed if the skin picking is primarily 
attributable to the intention to harm oneself that is characteristic of nonsuicidal self-injury. 


Other medical conditions. Excoriation disorder is not diagnosed if the skin picking is 
primarily attributable to another medical condition. For example, scabies is a dermatolog- 
ical condition invariably associated with severe itching and scratching. However, excori- 
ation disorder may be precipitated or exacerbated by an underlying dermatological 
condition. For example, acne may lead to some scratching and picking, which may also be 
associated with comorbid excoriation disorder. The differentiation between these two 
clinical situations (acne with some scratching and picking vs. acne with comorbid excori- 
ation disorder) requires an assessment of the extent to which the individual's skin picking 
has become independent of the underlying dermatological condition. 


Substance/medication-induced disorders. Skin-picking symptoms may also be induced 
by certain substances (e.g., cocaine), in which case excoriation disorder should not be di- 
agnosed. If such skin picking is clinically significant, then a diagnosis of substance /med- 
ication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder should be considered. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder 257 


Comorbidity 

Excoriation disorder is often accompanied by other mental disorders. Such disorders in- 
clude OCD and trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder), as well as major depressive dis- 
order. Repetitive body-focused symptoms other than skin picking and hair pulling (e.g., 
nail biting) occur in many individuals with excoriation disorder and may deserve an ad- 
ditional diagnosis of other specified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder (i.e., 
body-focused repetitive behavior disorder). 


Substance/Medication-Induced 
Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Obsessions, compulsions, skin picking, hair pulling, other body-focused repetitive be- 
haviors, or other symptoms characteristic of the obsessive-compulsive and related dis- 
orders predominate in the clinical picture. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of both 
(1) and (2): 


1. The symptoms in Criterion A developed during or soon after substance intoxication 
or withdrawal or after exposure to a medication. 

2. The involved substance/medication is capable of producing the symptoms in Crite- 
rion A. 


C. The disturbance is not better explained by an obsessive-compulsive and related disor- 
der that is not substance/medication-induced. Such evidence of an independent ob- 
sessive-compulsive and related disorder could include the following: 


The symptoms precede the onset of the substance/medication use; the symptoms 
persist for a substantial period of time (e.g., about 1 month) after the cessation of acute 
withdrawal or severe intoxication; or there is other evidence suggesting the exis- 
tence of an independent non-substance/medication-induced obsessive-compul- 
sive and related disorder (e.g., a history of recurrent non-substance/medication- 
related episodes). 


D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


Note: This diagnosis should be made in addition to a diagnosis of substance intoxication 
or substance withdrawal only when the symptoms in Criterion A predominate in the clinical 
picture and are sufficiently severe to warrant clinical attention. 

Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance/medica- 
tion]-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorders are indicated in the table below. 
Note that the ICD-10-CM code depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance 
use disorder present for the same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is 
comorbid with the substance-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, the 4th 
position character is “1,” and the clinician should record “mild [substance] use disorder” 
before the substance-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder (e.g., “mild co- 
caine use disorder with cocaine-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder’). If 
a moderate or severe substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance-induced ob- 
sessive-compulsive and related disorder, the 4th position character is “2,” and the clinician 
should record “moderate [substance] use disorder” or “severe [substance] use disorder,” 
depending on the severity of the comorbid substance use disorder. If there is no comorbid 


258 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


substance use disorder (e.g., after a one-time heavy use of the substance), then the 4th 
position character is “9,” and the clinician should record only the substance-induced ob- 
sessive-compulsive and related disorder. 


ICD-10-CM 
With use 
With use disorder, Without 
disorder, moderate use 
ICD-9-CM mild or severe disorder 
Amphetamine (or other 292.89 F15.188 F15.288 F15.988 
stimulant) 
Cocaine 292.89 F14.188 F14.288 F14.988 


Other (or unknown) substance 292.89 F19.188 F19.288 F19.988 


Specify if (see Table 1 in the chapter “Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders” for di- 
agnoses associated with substance class): 
With onset during intoxication: If the criteria are met for intoxication with the sub- 
stance and the symptoms develop during intoxication. 
With onset during withdrawal: If criteria are met for withdrawal from the substance 
and the symptoms develop during, or shortly after, withdrawal. 
With onset after medication use: Symptoms may appear either at initiation of medi- 
cation or after a modification or change in use. 


Recording Procedures 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance /medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and 
related disorder begins with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine) that is presumed to be 
causing the obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected 
from the table included in the criteria set, which is based on the drug class. For substances 
that do not fit into any of the classes, the code for “other substance” should be used; and in 
cases in which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of sub- 
stance is unknown, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder is followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during in- 
toxication, onset during withdrawal, with onset after medication use). Unlike the record- 
ing procedures for ICD-10-CM, which combine the substance-induced disorder and 
substance use disorder into a single code, for ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is 
given for the substance use disorder. For example, in the case of repetitive behaviors oc- 
curring during intoxication in a man with a severe cocaine use disorder, the diagnosis is 
292.89 cocaine-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, with onset during in- 
toxication. An additional diagnosis of 304.20 severe cocaine use disorder is also given. 
When more than one substance is judged to play a significant role in the development of 
the obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, each should be listed separately. 


ICD-10-CM. Thename of the substance/medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and re- 
lated disorder begins with the specific substance (e.g., cocaine) that is presumed to be causing 
the obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the ta- 
ble included in the criteria set, which is based on the drug class and presence or absence of a 
comorbid substance use disorder. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes, 
the code for “other substance” with no comorbid substance use should be used; and in cases in 
which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance is un- 
known, the category “unknown substance” with no comorbid substance use should be used. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder 259 


When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) is 
listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the substance-induced ob- 
sessive-compulsive and related disorder, followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset dur- 
ing intoxication, onset during withdrawal, with onset after medication use). For example, in 
the case of repetitive behaviors occurring during intoxication in a man with a severe cocaine 
use disorder, the diagnosis is F14.288 severe cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced obses- 
sive-compulsive and related disorder, with onset during intoxication. A separate diagnosis of 
the comorbid severe cocaine use disorder is not given. If the substance-induced obsessive- 
compulsive and related disorder occurs without a comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after 
a one-time heavy use of the substance), no accompanying substance use disorder is noted (e.¢., 
F15.988 amphetamine-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, with onset during 
intoxication). When more than one substance is judged to play a significant role in the devel- 
opment of the obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, each should be listed separately. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of substance/medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder are prominent symptoms of an obsessive-compulsive and related disorder (Criterion 
A) that are judged to be attributable to the effects of a substance (e.g., drug of abuse, medica- 
tion). The obsessive-compulsive and related disorder symptoms must have developed during 
or soon after substance intoxication or withdrawal or after exposure to a medication or toxin, 
and the substance/medication must be capable of producing the symptoms (Criterion B). Sub- 
stance /medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to a prescribed 
treatment for a mental disorder or general medical condition must have its onset while the in- 
dividual is receiving the medication. Once the treatment is discontinued, the obsessive-com- 
pulsive and related disorder symptoms will usually improve or remit within days to several 
weeks to 1 month (depending on the half-life of the substance/medication). The diagnosis of 
substance /medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder should not be 
given if onset of the obsessive-compulsive and related disorder symptoms precedes the sub- 
stance intoxication or medication use, or if the symptoms persist for a substantial period of 
time, usually longer than 1 month, from the time of severe intoxication or withdrawal. If the 
obsessive-compulsive and related disorder symptoms persist for a substantial period of time, 
other causes for the symptoms should be considered. The substance /medication-induced ob- 
sessive-compulsive and related disorder diagnosis should be made in addition to a diagnosis 
of substance intoxication only when the symptoms in Criterion A predominate in the clinical 
picture and are sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Obsessions, compulsions, hair pulling, skin picking, or other body-focused repetitive be- 
haviors can occur in association with intoxication with the following classes of substances: 
stimulants (including cocaine) and other (or unknown) substances. Heavy metals and tox- 
ins may also cause obsessive-compulsive and related disorder symptoms. Laboratory as- 
sessments (e.g., urine toxicology) may be useful to measure substance intoxication as part 
of an assessment for obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. 


Prevalence 


In the general population, the very limited data that are available indicate that substance- 
induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder is very rare. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Substance intoxication. Obsessive-compulsive and related disorder symptoms may oc- 
cur in substance intoxication. The diagnosis of the substance-specific intoxication will usu- 


260 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


ally suffice to categorize the symptom presentation. A diagnosis of an obsessive-compulsive 
and related disorder should be made in addition to substance intoxication when the symp- 
toms are judged to be in excess of those usually associated with intoxication and are suf- 
ficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorder (i.e., not induced by a substance). Sub- 
stance/medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder is judged to be 
etiologically related to the substance/medication. Substance /medication-induced obses- 
sive-compulsive and related disorder is distinguished from a primary obsessive-compul- 
sive and related disorder by considering the onset, course, and other factors with respect 
to substances/medications. For drugs of abuse, there must be evidence from the history, 
physical examination, or laboratory findings for use or intoxication. Substance /medica- 
tion-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder arises only in association with in- 
toxication, whereas a primary obsessive-compulsive and related disorder may precede the 
onset of substance/ medication use. The presence of features that are atypical of a primary 
obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, such as atypical age at onset of symptoms, 
may suggest a substance-induced etiology. A primary obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder diagnosis is warranted if the symptoms persist for a substantial period of time 
(about 1 month or longer) after the end of the substance intoxication or the individual has 
a history of an obsessive-compulsive and related disorder. 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to another medical condition. If the 
obsessive-compulsive and related disorder symptoms are attributable to another medical 
condition (i.e., rather than to the medication taken for the other medical condition), obses- 
sive-compulsive and related disorder due to another medical condition should be diag- 
nosed. The history often provides the basis for judgment. At times, a change in the 
treatment for the other medical condition (e.g., medication substitution or discontinua- 
tion) may be needed to determine whether or not the medication is the causative agent (in 
which case the symptoms may be better explained by substance /medication-induced ob- 
sessive-compulsive and related disorder). If the disturbance is attributable to both another 
medical condition and substance use, both diagnoses (i.e., obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder due to another medical condition and substance/medication-induced obsessive- 
compulsive and related disorder) may be given. When there is insufficient evidence to de- 
termine whether the symptoms are attributable to either a substance/ medication or an- 
other medical condition or are primary (i.e., attributable to neither a substance/medication 
nor another medical condition), a diagnosis of other specified or unspecified obsessive- 
compulsive and related disorder would be indicated. 


Delirium. If obsessive-compulsive and related disorder symptoms occur exclusively 


during the course of delirium, they are considered to be an associated feature of the delir- 
ium and are not diagnosed separately. 


Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


Diagnostic Criteria 294.8 (FO6.8) 


A. Obsessions, compulsions, preoccupations with appearance, hoarding, skin picking, 
hair pulling, other body-focused repetitive behaviors, or other symptoms characteristic 
of obsessive-compulsive and related disorder predominate in the clinical picture. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the 
disturbance is the direct pathophysiological consequence of another medical condition. 

C. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder. 


Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 261 


D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 

E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

Specify if: 
With obsessive-compulsive disorder-like symptoms: If obsessive-compulsive dis- 
order—like symptoms predominate in the clinical presentation. 
With appearance preoccupations: If preoccupation with perceived appearance de- 
fects or flaws predominates in the clinical presentation. 
With hoarding symptoms: If hoarding predominates in the clinical presentation. 
With hair-pulling symptoms: If hair pulling predominates in the clinical presentation. 
With skin-picking symptoms: If skin picking predominates in the clinical presenta- 
tion. 


Coding note: Include the name of the other medical condition in the name of the mental 
disorder (e.g., 294.8 [FO06.8] obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to cerebral 
infarction). The other medical condition should be coded and listed separately immediately 
before the obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to the medical condition (e.g., 
438.89 [169.398] cerebral infarction; 294.8 [FO6.8] obsessive-compulsive and related dis- 
order due to cerebral infarction). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to another medical 
condition is clinically significant obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms that are 
judged to be best explained as the direct pathophysiological consequence of another med- 
ical condition. Symptoms can include prominent obsessions, compulsions, preoccu- 
pations with appearance, hoarding, hair pulling, skin picking, or other body-focused 
repetitive behaviors (Criterion A). The judgment that the symptoms are best explained by 
the associated medical condition must be based on evidence from the history, physical ex- 
amination, or laboratory findings (Criterion B). Additionally, it must be judged that the 
symptoms are not better explained by another mental disorder (Criterion C). The diagno- 
sis is not made if the obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms occur only during the 
course of a delirium (Criterion D). The obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms must 
cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other impor- 
tant areas of functioning (Criterion E). 

In determining whether the obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms are attribut- 
able to another medical condition, a relevant medical condition must be present. Further- 
more, it must be established that obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms can be 
etiologically related to the medical condition through a pathophysiological mechanism 
and that this best explains the symptoms in the individual. Although there are no infallible 
guidelines for determining whether the relationship between the obsessive-compulsive 
and related symptoms and the medical condition is etiological, considerations that may 
provide some guidance in making this diagnosis include the presence of a clear temporal 
association between the onset, exacerbation, or remission of the medical condition and the 
obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms; the presence of features that are atypical of 
a primary obsessive-compulsive and related disorder (e.g., atypical age at onset or course); 
and evidence in the literature that a known physiological mechanism (e.g., striatal dam- 
age) causes obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms. In addition, the disturbance 
cannot be better explained by a primary obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, a sub- 
stance/medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, or another men- 
tal disorder. 

There is some controversy about whether obsessive-compulsive and related disorders 
can be attributed to Group A streptococcal infection. Sydenham’s chorea is the neurolog- 


262 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


ical manifestation of rheumatic fever, which is in turn due to Group A streptococcal in- 
fection. Sydenham’s chorea is characterized by a combination of motor and nonmotor 
features. Nonmotor features include obsessions, compulsions, attention deficit, and emo- 
tional lability. Although individuals with Sydenham’s chorea may present with non- 
neuropsychiatric features of acute rheumatic fever, such as carditis and arthritis, they may 
present with obsessive-compulsive disorder—like symptoms; such individuals should 
be diagnosed with obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to another medical 
condition. 

Pediatric autoimmune neuropsychiatric disorders associated with streptococcal infec- 
tions (PANDAS) has been identified as another post-infectious autoimmune disorder 
characterized by the sudden onset of obsessions, compulsions, and/or tics accompanied 
by a variety of acute neuropsychiatric symptoms in the absence of chorea, carditis, or ar- 
thritis, after Group A streptococcal infection. Although there is a body of evidence that 
supports the existence of PANDAS, it remains a controversial diagnosis. Given this ongo- 
ing controversy, the description of PANDAS has been modified to eliminate etiological 
factors and to designate an expanded clinical entity: pediatric acute-onset neuropsychiat- 
ric syndrome (PANS) or idiopathic childhood acute neuropsychiatric symptoms (CANS), 
which deserves further study. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A number of other medical disorders are known to include obsessive-compulsive and re- 
lated symptoms as a manifestation. Examples include disorders leading to striatal dam- 
age, such as cerebral infarction. 


Development and Course 


The development and course of obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to another 
medical condition generally follows the course of the underlying illness. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Laboratory assessments and/or medical examinations are necessary to confirm the diag- 
nosis of another medical condition. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Delirium. A separate diagnosis of obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to an- 
other medical condition is not given if the disturbance occurs exclusively during the 
course of a delirium. However, a diagnosis of obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
due to another medical condition may be given in addition to a diagnosis of major neuro- 
cognitive disorder (dementia) if the etiology of the obsessive-compulsive symptoms is 
judged to bea physiological consequence of the pathological process causing the dementia 
and if obsessive-compulsive symptoms are a prominent part of the clinical presentation. 


Mixed presentation of symptoms (e.g., mood and obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder symptoms). If the presentation includes a mix of different types of symptoms, 
the specific mental disorder due to another medical condition depends on which symp- 
toms predominate in the clinical picture. 


Substance/medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. If there 
is evidence of recent or prolonged substance use (including medications with psychoac- 
tive effects), withdrawal from a substance, or exposure to a toxin, a substance /medication- 
induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder should be considered. When a sub- 
stance/medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder is being diag- 
nosed in relation to drugs of abuse, it may be useful to obtain a urine or blood drug screen 


Other Specified Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorder 263 


or other appropriate laboratory evaluation. Symptoms that occur during or shortly after 
(i.e., within 4 weeks of) substance intoxication or withdrawal or after medication use may 
be especially indicative of a substance /medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and re- 
lated disorder, depending on the type, duration, or amount of the substance used. 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorders (primary). Obsessive-compulsive and re- 
lated disorder due to another medical condition should be distinguished from a primary 
obsessive-compulsive and related disorder. In primary mental disorders, no specific and 
direct causative physiological mechanisms associated with a medical condition can be 
demonstrated. Late age at onset or atypical symptoms suggest the need for a thorough as- 
sessment to rule out the diagnosis of obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to an- 
other medical condition. 


lilness anxiety disorder. Illness anxiety disorder is characterized by a preoccupation with 
having or acquiring a serious illness. In the case of illness anxiety disorder, individuals 
may or may not have diagnosed medical conditions. 


Associated feature of another mental disorder. Obsessive-compulsive and related symp- 
toms may be an associated feature of another mental disorder (e.g., schizophrenia, an- 
orexia nervosa). 


Other specified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder or unspecified obsessive- 
compulsive and related disorder. These diagnoses are given if it is unclear whether the 
obsessive-compulsive and related symptoms are primary, substance-induced, or due to 
another medical condition. 


Other Specified Obsessive-Compulsive 
and Related Disorder 


300.3 (F42) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an obsessive- 

compulsive and related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in 

social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet 
the full criteria for any of the disorders in the obsessive-compulsive and related disorders 
diagnostic class. The other specified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder category 
is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific reason that 
the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific obSessive-compulsive and re- 
lated disorder. This is done by recording “other specified obsessive-compulsive and relat- 
ed disorder’ followed by the specific reason (e.g., “body-focused repetitive behavior 
disorder’). 

Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 

1. Body dysmorphic-like disorder with actual flaws: This is similar to body dysmor- 
phic disorder except that the defects or flaws in physical appearance are clearly ob- 
servable by others (i.e., they are more noticeable than “slight’). In such cases, the 
preoccupation with these flaws is clearly excessive and causes significant impairment 
or distress. 

2. Body dysmorphic-like disorder without repetitive behaviors: Presentations that 
meet body dysmorphic disorder except that the individual has not performed repetitive 
behaviors or mental acts in response to the appearance concerns. 

3. Body-focused repetitive behavior disorder: This is characterized by recurrent body- 
focused repetitive behaviors (e.g., nail biting, lip biting, cheek chewing) and repeated 
attempts to decrease or stop the behaviors. These symptoms cause clinically significant 


264 Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning 
and are not better explained by trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder), excoriation (skin- 
picking) disorder, stereotypic movement disorder, or nonsuicidal self-injury. 

4. Obsessional jealousy: This is characterized by nondelusional preoccupation with a 
partner’s perceived infidelity. The preoccupations may lead to repetitive behaviors or 
mental acts in response to the infidelity concerns; they cause clinically significant dis- 
tress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning; and 
they are not better explained by another mental disorder such as delusional disorder, 
jealous type, or paranoid personality disorder. 

5. Shubo-kyofu: A variant of taijin kyofusho (see “Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Dis- 
tress” in the Appendix) that is similar to body dysmorphic disorder and is characterized 
by excessive fear of having a bodily deformity. 

6. Koro: Related to dhat syndrome (see “Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress” in 
the Appendix), an episode of sudden and intense anxiety that the penis (or the vulva 
and nipples in females) will recede into the body, possibly leading to death. 

7. Jikoshu-kyofu: A variant of taijin kyofusho (see “Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Dis- 
tress” in the Appendix) characterized by fear of having an offensive body odor (also 
termed olfactory reference syndrome). 


Unspecified Obsessive-Compulsive 
and Related Disorder 


300.3 (F42) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an obsessive- 
compulsive and related disorder that cause Clinically significant distress or impairment in 
social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet 
the full criteria for any of the disorders in the obsessive-compulsive and related disorders 
diagnostic class. The unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder category is 
used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria 
are not met for a specific obSessive-compulsive and related disorder, and includes presen- 
tations in which there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in 
emergency room settings). 


Trauma- and 
Stressor-Related Disorders 


Trauma- and stressor-related disorders include disorders in which exposure to 
a traumatic or stressful event is listed explicitly as a diagnostic criterion. These include reactive 
attachment disorder, disinhibited social engagement disorder, posttraumatic stress disor- 
der (PTSD), acute stress disorder, and adjustment disorders. Placement of this chapter reflects 
the close relationship between these diagnoses and disorders in the surrounding chapters on 
anxiety disorders, obsessive-compulsive and related disorders, and dissociative disorders. 
Psychological distress following exposure to a traumatic or stressful event is quite vari- 
able. In some cases, symptoms can be well understood within an anxiety- or fear-based 
context. It is clear, however, that many individuals who have been exposed to a traumatic 
or stressful event exhibit a phenotype in which, rather than anxiety- or fear-based symp- 
toms, the most prominent clinical characteristics are anhedonic and dysphoric symptoms, 
externalizing angry and aggressive symptoms, or dissociative symptoms. Because of these 
variable expressions of clinical distress following exposure to catastrophic or aversive 
events, the aforementioned disorders have been grouped under a separate category: 
trauma- and stressor-related disorders. Furthermore, it is not uncommon for the clinical pic- 
ture to include some combination of the above symptoms (with or without anxiety- or 
fear-based symptoms). Such a heterogeneous picture has long been recognized in adjust- 
ment disorders, as well. Social neglect—that is, the absence of adequate caregiving during 
childhood—is a diagnostic requirement of both reactive attachment disorder and disin- 
hibited social engagement disorder. Although the two disorders share a common etiology, 
the former is expressed as an internalizing disorder with depressive symptoms and with- 
drawn behavior, while the latter is marked by disinhibition and externalizing behavior. 


Reactive Attachment Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 313.89 (F94.1) 


A. Aconsistent pattern of inhibited, emotionally withdrawn behavior toward adult caregiv- 
ers, manifested by both of the following: 
1. The child rarely or minimally seeks comfort when distressed. 
2. The child rarely or minimally responds to comfort when distressed. 

B. Apersistent social and emotional disturbance characterized by at least two of the following: 
1. Minimal social and emotional responsiveness to others. 
2. Limited positive affect. 
3. Episodes of unexplained irritability, sadness, or fearfulness that are evident even 

during nonthreatening interactions with adult caregivers. 

C. The child has experienced a pattern of extremes of insufficient care as evidenced by 

at least one of the following: 


1. Social neglect or deprivation in the form of persistent lack of having basic emotional 
needs for comfort, stimulation, and affection met by caregiving adults. 


265 


266 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


2. Repeated changes of primary caregivers that limit opportunities to form stable at- 
tachments (e.g., frequent changes in foster care). 

3. Rearing in unusual settings that severely limit opportunities to form selective at- 
tachments (e.g., institutions with high child-to-caregiver ratios). 


D. The care in Criterion C is presumed to be responsible for the disturbed behavior in Cri- 
terion A (e.g., the disturbances in Criterion A began following the lack of adequate care 
in Criterion C). 

E. The criteria are not met for autism spectrum disorder. 

F. The disturbance is evident before age 5 years. 

G. The child has a developmental age of at least 9 months. 


Specity if: 
Persistent: The disorder has been present for more than 12 months. 

Specify current severity: 
Reactive attachment disorder is specified as severe when a child exhibits all symp- 
toms of the disorder, with each symptom manifesting at relatively high levels. 


Diagnostic Features 


Reactive attachment disorder of infancy or early childhood is characterized by a pattern of 
markedly disturbed and developmentally inappropriate attachment behaviors, in whicha 
child rarely or minimally turns preferentially to an attachment figure for comfort, support, 
protection, and nurturance. The essential feature is absent or grossly underdeveloped at- 
tachment between the child and putative caregiving adults. Children with reactive attach- 
ment disorder are believed to have the capacity to form selective attachments. However, 
because of limited opportunities during early development, they fail to show the behavioral 
manifestations of selective attachments. That is, when distressed, they show no consistent 
effort to obtain comfort, support, nurturance, or protection from caregivers. Furthermore, 
when distressed, children with this disorder do not respond more than minimally to com- 
forting efforts of caregivers. Thus, the disorder is associated with the absence of expected 
comfort seeking and response to comforting behaviors. As such, children with reactive 
attachment disorder show diminished or absent expression of positive emotions during 
routine interactions with caregivers. In addition, their emotion regulation capacity is com- 
promised, and they display episodes of negative emotions of fear, sadness, or irritability 
that are not readily explained. A diagnosis of reactive attachment disorder should not be 
made in children who are developmentally unable to form selective attachments. For this 
reason, the child must have a developmental age of at least 9 months. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Because of the shared etiological association with social neglect, reactive attachment dis- 
order often co-occurs with developmental delays, especially in delays in cognition and 
language. Other associated features include stereotypies and other signs of severe neglect 
(e.g., malnutrition or signs of poor care). 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of reactive attachment disorder is unknown, but the disorder is seen rela- 
tively rarely in clinical settings. The disorder has been found in young children exposed to 
severe neglect before being placed in foster care or raised in institutions. However, even in 
populations of severely neglected children, the disorder is uncommon, occurring in less 
than 10% of such children. 


Reactive Attachment Disorder 267 


Development and Course 


Conditions of social neglect are often present in the first months of life in children diag- 
nosed with reactive attachment disorder, even before the disorder is diagnosed. The clin- 
ical features of the disorder manifest in a similar fashion between the ages of 9 months and 
5 years. That is, signs of absent-to-minimal attachment behaviors and associated emotion- 
ally aberrant behaviors are evident in children throughout this age range, although differ- 
ing cognitive and motor abilities may affect how these behaviors are expressed. Without 
remediation and recovery through normative caregiving environments, it appears that signs 
of the disorder may persist, at least for several years. 

It is unclear whether reactive attachment disorder occurs in older children and, if so, how 
it differs from its presentation in young children. Because of this, the diagnosis should be 
made with caution in children older than 5 years. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Serious social neglect is a diagnostic requirement for reactive attach- 
ment disorder and is also the only known risk factor for the disorder. However, the ma- 
jority of severely neglected children do not develop the disorder. Prognosis appears to 
depend on the quality of the caregiving environment following serious neglect. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Similar attachment behaviors have been described in young children in many different 
cultures around the world. However, caution should be exercised in making the diagnosis 
of reactive attachment disorder in cultures in which attachment has not been studied. 


Functional Consequences of 
Reactive Attachment Disorder 


Reactive attachment disorder significantly impairs young children’s abilities to relate in- 
terpersonally to adults or peers and is associated with functional impairment across many 
domains of early childhood. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Autism spectrum disorder. Aberrant social behaviors manifest in young children with 
reactive attachment disorder, but they also are key features of autism spectrum disorder. 
Specifically, young children with either condition can manifest dampened expression of 
positive emotions, cognitive and language delays, and impairments in social reciprocity. 
Asa result, reactive attachment disorder must be differentiated from autism spectrum dis- 
order. These two disorders can be distinguished based on differential histories of neglect 
and on the presence of restricted interests or ritualized behaviors, specific deficit in social 
communication, and selective attachment behaviors. Children with reactive attachment 
disorder have experienced a history of severe social neglect, although it is not always pos- 
sible to obtain detailed histories about the precise nature of their experiences, especially in 
initial evaluations. Children with autistic spectrum disorder will only rarely have a history 
of social neglect. The restricted interests and repetitive behaviors characteristic of autism 
spectrum disorder are not a feature of reactive attachment disorder. These clinical features 
manifest as excessive adherence to rituals and routines; restricted, fixated interests; and 
unusual sensory reactions. However, it is important to note that children with either con- 
dition can exhibit stereotypic behaviors such as rocking or flapping. Children with either 
disorder also may exhibit a range of intellectual functioning, but only children with autis- 


268 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


tic spectrum disorder exhibit selective impairments in social communicative behaviors, 
such as intentional communication (i.e., impairment in communication that is deliberate, 
goal-directed, and aimed at influencing the behavior of the recipient). Children with reac- 
tive attachment disorder show social communicative functioning comparable to their 
overall level of intellectual functioning. Finally, children with autistic spectrum disorder 
regularly show attachment behavior typical for their developmental level. In contrast, 
children with reactive attachment disorder do so only rarely or inconsistently, if at all. 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder). Developmental delays of- 
ten accompany reactive attachment disorder, but they should not be confused with the 
disorder. Children with intellectual disability should exhibit social and emotional skills 
comparable to their cognitive skills and do not demonstrate the profound reduction in 
positive affect and emotion regulation difficulties evident in children with reactive attach- 
ment disorder. In addition, developmentally delayed children who have reached a cogni- 
tive age of 7-9 months should demonstrate selective attachments regardless of their 
chronological age. In contrast, children with reactive attachment disorder show lack of 
preferred attachment despite having attained a developmental age of at least 9 months. 


Depressive disorders. Depression in young children is also associated with reductions 
in positive affect. There is limited evidence, however, to suggest that children with depres- 
sive disorders have impairments in attachment. That is, young children who have been di- 
agnosed with depressive disorders still should seek and respond to comforting efforts by 
caregivers. 


Comorbidity 

Conditions associated with neglect, including cognitive delays, language delays, and ste- 
reotypies, often co-occur with reactive attachment disorder. Medical conditions, such as 
severe malnutrition, may accompany signs of the disorder. Depressive symptoms also 
may co-occur with reactive attachment disorder. 


Disinhibited Social Engagement Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 313.89 (F94.2) 


A. A pattern of behavior in which a child actively approaches and interacts with unfamiliar 
adults and exhibits at least two of the following: 


1. Reduced or absent reticence in approaching and interacting with unfamiliar adults. 

2. Overly familiar verbal or physical behavior (that is not consistent with culturally 
sanctioned and with age-appropriate social boundaries). 

3. Diminished or absent checking back with adult caregiver after venturing away, even 
in unfamiliar settings. 

4. Willingness to go off with an unfamiliar adult with minimal or no hesitation. 


B. The behaviors in Criterion A are not limited to impulsivity (as in attention-deficit/hyper- 
activity disorder) but include socially disinhibited behavior. 
C. The child has experienced a pattern of extremes of insufficient care as evidenced by 
at least one of the following: 
1. Social neglect or deprivation in the form of persistent lack of having basic emotional 
needs for comfort, stimulation, and affection met by caregiving adults. 
2. Repeated changes of primary caregivers that limit opportunities to form stable at- 
tachments (e.g., frequent changes in foster care). 
3. Rearing in unusual settings that severely limit opportunities to form selective at- 
tachments (e.g., institutions with high child-to-caregiver ratios). 


Disinhibited Social Engagement Disorder 269 


D. The care in Criterion C is presumed to be responsible for the disturbed behavior in Cri- 
terion A (e.g., the disturbances in Criterion A began following the pathogenic care in 
Criterion C). 

E. The child has a developmental age of at least 9 months. 


Specify if: 
Persistent: The disorder has been present for more than 12 months. 

Specify current severity: 
Disinhibited social engagement disorder is specified as severe when the child exhibits 
all symptoms of the disorder, with each symptom manifesting at relatively high levels. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of disinhibited social engagement disorder is a pattern of behavior 
that involves culturally inappropriate, overly familiar behavior with relative strangers 
(Criterion A). This overly familiar behavior violates the social boundaries of the culture. A 
diagnosis of disinhibited social engagement disorder should not be made before children 
are developmentally able to form selective attachments. For this reason, the child must 
have a developmental age of at least 9 months. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Because of the shared etiological association with social neglect, disinhibited social en- 
gagement disorder may co-occur with developmental delays, especially cognitive and lan- 
guage delays, stereotypies, and other signs of severe neglect, such as malnutrition or poor 
care. However, signs of the disorder often persist even after these other signs of neglect are 
no longer present. Therefore, it is not uncommon for children with the disorder to present 
with no current signs of neglect. Moreover, the condition can present in children who 
show no signs of disordered attachment. Thus, disinhibited social engagement disorder 
may be seen in children with a history of neglect who lack attachments or whose attach- 
ments to their caregivers range from disturbed to secure. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of disinhibited social attachment disorder is unknown. Nevertheless, the 
disorder appears to be rare, occurring in a minority of children, even those who have been 
severely neglected and subsequently placed in foster care or raised in institutions. In such 
high-risk populations, the condition occurs in only about 20% of children. The condition is 
seen rarely in other clinical settings. 


Development and Course 


Conditions of social neglect are often present in the first months of life in children diag- 
nosed with disinhibited social engagement disorder, even before the disorder is diag- 
nosed. However, there is no evidence that neglect beginning after age 2 years is associated 
with manifestations of the disorder. If neglect occurs early and signs of the disorder 
appear, clinical features of the disorder are moderately stable over time, particularly if 
conditions of neglect persist. Indiscriminate social behavior and lack of reticence with un- 
familiar adults in toddlerhood are accompanied by attention-seeking behaviors in pre- 
schoolers. When the disorder persists into middle childhood, clinical features manifest as 
verbal and physical overfamiliarity as well as inauthentic expression of emotions. These 
signs appear particularly apparent when the child interacts with adults. Peer relationships 
are most affected in adolescence, with both indiscriminate behavior and conflicts appar- 
ent. The disorder has not been described in adults. 


270 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


Disinhibited social engagement disorder has been described from the second year of 
life through adolescence. There are some differences in manifestations of the disorder 
from early childhood through adolescence. At the youngest ages, across many cultures, 
children show reticence when interacting with strangers. Young children with the disorder 
fail to show reticence to approach, engage with, and even accompany adults. In preschool 
children, verbal and social intrusiveness appear most prominent, often accompanied by 
attention-seeking behavior. Verbal and physical overfamiliarity continue through middle 
childhood, accompanied by inauthentic expressions of emotion. In adolescence, indis- 
criminate behavior extends to peers. Relative to healthy adolescents, adolescents with the 
disorder have more “superficial” peer relationships and more peer conflicts. Adult man- 
ifestations of the disorder are unknown. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Serious social neglect is a diagnostic requirement for disinhibited social 
engagement disorder and is also the only known risk factor for the disorder. However, the 
majority of severely neglected children do not develop the disorder. Neurobiological vul- 
nerability may differentiate neglected children who do and do not develop the disorder. 
However, no clear link with any specific neurobiological factors has been established. The 
disorder has not been identified in children who experience social neglect only after age 
2 years. Prognosis is only modestly associated with quality of the caregiving environment 
following serious neglect. In many cases, the disorder persists, even in children whose 
caregiving environment becomes markedly improved. 


Course modifiers. Caregiving quality seems to moderate the course of disinhibited so- 
cial engagement disorder. Nevertheless, even after placement in normative caregiving 
environments, some children show persistent signs of the disorder, at least through ado- 
lescence. 


Functional Consequences of 
Disinhibited Social Engagement Disorder 


Disinhibited social engagement disorder significantly impairs young children’s abilities to 
relate interpersonally to adults and peers. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Because of social impulsivity that sometimes 
accompanies attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD), it is necessary to differ- 
entiate the two disorders. Children with disinhibited social engagement disorder may be 
distinguished from those with ADHD because the former do not show difficulties with at- 
tention or hyperactivity. 


Comorbidity 


Limited research has examined the issue of disorders comorbid with disinhibited social 
engagement disorder. Conditions associated with neglect, including cognitive delays, 
language delays, and stereotypies, may co-occur with disinhibited social engagement dis- 
order. In addition, children may be diagnosed with ADHD and disinhibited social engage- 
ment disorder concurrently. 


Posttraumatic Stress Disorder 271 


Posttraumatic Stress Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 309.81 (F43.10) 


Posttraumatic Stress Disorder 

Note: The following criteria apply to adults, adolescents, and children older than 6 years. 

For children 6 years and younger, see corresponding criteria below. 

A. Exposure to actual or threatened death, serious injury, or sexual violence in one (or 
more) of the following ways: 


1. 
2. 
3. 


Directly experiencing the traumatic event(s). 

Witnessing, in person, the event(s) as it occurred to others. 

Learning that the traumatic event(s) occurred to a close family member or close 
friend. In cases of actual or threatened death of a family member or friend, the 
event(s) must have been violent or accidental. 

Experiencing repeated or extreme exposure to aversive details of the traumatic 
event(s) (e.g., first responders collecting human remains; police officers repeatedly 
exposed to details of child abuse). 


Note: Criterion A4 does not apply to exposure through electronic media, television, 
movies, or pictures, unless this exposure is work related. 


B. Presence of one (or more) of the following intrusion symptoms associated with the 
traumatic event(s), beginning after the traumatic event(s) occurred: 


1. 


Recurrent, involuntary, and intrusive distressing memories of the traumatic event(s). 
Note: In children older than 6 years, repetitive play may occur in which themes or 
aspects of the traumatic event(s) are expressed. 

Recurrent distressing dreams in which the content and/or affect of the dream are 
related to the traumatic event(s). 

Note: In children, there may be frightening dreams without recognizable content. 
Dissociative reactions (e.g., flashbacks) in which the individual feels or acts as if 
the traumatic event(s) were recurring. (Such reactions may occur on a continuum, 
with the most extreme expression being a complete loss of awareness of present 
surroundings.) 

Note: In children, trauma-specific reenactment may occur in play. 

Intense or prolonged psychological distress at exposure to internal or external cues 
that symbolize or resemble an aspect of the traumatic event(s). 

Marked physiological reactions to internal or external cues that symbolize or re- 
semble an aspect of the traumatic event(s). 


C. Persistent avoidance of stimuli associated with the traumatic event(s), beginning after 
the traumatic event(s) occurred, as evidenced by one or both of the following: 


1. 


2. 


Avoidance of or efforts to avoid distressing memories, thoughts, or feelings about 
or closely associated with the traumatic event(s). 

Avoidance of or efforts to avoid external reminders (people, places, conversations, 
activities, objects, situations) that arouse distressing memories, thoughts, or feel- 
ings about or closely associated with the traumatic event(s). 


D. Negative alterations in cognitions and mood associated with the traumatic event(s), 
beginning or worsening after the traumatic event(s) occurred, as evidenced by two (or 
more) of the following: 


1. 


Inability to remember an important aspect of the traumatic event(s) (typically due to dis- 
sociative amnesia and not to other factors such as head injury, alcohol, or drugs). 


272 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


2. Persistent and exaggerated negative beliefs or expectations about oneself, others, 
or the world (e.g., “l am bad,” “No one can be trusted,” “The world is completely 
dangerous,” “My whole nervous system is permanently ruined”). 

3. Persistent, distorted cognitions about the cause or consequences of the traumatic 

event(s) that lead the individual to blame himself/herself or others. 

Persistent negative emotional state (e.g., fear, horror, anger, guilt, or shame). 

Markedly diminished interest or participation in significant activities. 

Feelings of detachment or estrangement from others. 

Persistent inability to experience positive emotions (e.g., inability to experience 

happiness, satisfaction, or loving feelings). 


NO os 


E. Marked alterations in arousal and reactivity associated with the traumatic event(s), be- 
ginning or worsening after the traumatic event(s) occurred, as evidenced by two (or 
more) of the following: 

1. Irritable behavior and angry outbursts (with little or no provocation) typically ex- 
pressed as verbal or physical aggression toward people or objects. 

Reckless or self-destructive behavior. 

Hypervigilance. 

Exaggerated startle response. 

Problems with concentration. 

Sleep disturbance (e.g., difficulty falling or staying asleep or restless sleep). 


OPaARwWN 


F. Duration of the disturbance (Criteria B, C, D, and E) is more than 1 month. 

G. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

H. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., 
medication, alcohol) or another medical condition. 


Specify whether: 
With dissociative symptoms: The individual’s symptoms meet the criteria for post- 
traumatic stress disorder, and in addition, in response to the stressor, the individual ex- 
periences persistent or recurrent symptoms of either of the following: 


1. Depersonalization: Persistent or recurrent experiences of feeling detached from, 
and as if one were an outside observer of, one’s mental processes or body (e.g., 
feeling as though one were in a dream; feeling a sense of unreality of self or body 
or of time moving slowly). 

2. Derealization: Persistent or recurrent experiences of unreality of surroundings 
(e.g., the world around the individual is experienced as unreal, dreamlike, distant, 
or distorted). 


Note: To use this subtype, the dissociative symptoms must not be attributable to the 
physiological effects of a substance (e.g., blackouts, behavior during alcohol intoxica- 
tion) or another medical condition (e.g., complex partial seizures). 

Specity if: 
With delayed expression: If the full diagnostic criteria are not met until at least 6 months 
after the event (although the onset and expression of some symptoms may be immediate). 


Posttraumatic Stress Disorder for Children 6 Years and Younger 
A. Inchildren 6 years and younger, exposure to actual or threatened death, serious injury, 
or sexual violence in one (or more) of the following ways: 
1. Directly experiencing the traumatic event(s). 
2. Witnessing, in person, the event(s) as it occurred to others, especially primary care- 
givers. 


Posttraumatic Stress Disorder 273 


Note: Witnessing does not include events that are witnessed only in electronic me- 
dia, television, movies, or pictures. 


3. Learning that the traumatic event(s) occurred to a parent or caregiving figure. 


B. Presence of one (or more) of the following intrusion symptoms associated with the 
traumatic event(s), beginning after the traumatic event(s) occurred: 
1. Recurrent, involuntary, and intrusive distressing memories of the traumatic 
event(s). 
Note: Spontaneous and intrusive memories may not necessarily appear distress- 
ing and may be expressed as play reenactment. 


2. Recurrent distressing dreams in which the content and/or affect of the dream are 
related to the traumatic event(s). 


Note: It may not be possible to ascertain that the frightening content is related to 
the traumatic event. 


3. Dissociative reactions (e.g., flashbacks) in which the child feels or acts as if the 
traumatic event(s) were recurring. (Such reactions may occur on a continuum, with 
the most extreme expression being a complete loss of awareness of present sur- 
roundings.) Such trauma-specific reenactment may occur in play. 

4. Intense or prolonged psychological distress at exposure to internal or external cues 
that symbolize or resemble an aspect of the traumatic event(s). 

5. Marked physiological reactions to reminders of the traumatic event(s). 

C. One (or more) of the following symptoms, representing either persistent avoidance of 
stimuli associated with the traumatic event(s) or negative alterations in cognitions and 
mood associated with the traumatic event(s), must be present, beginning after the 
event(s) or worsening after the event(s): 

Persistent Avoidance of Stimuli 

1. Avoidance of or efforts to avoid activities, places, or physical reminders that arouse 
recollections of the traumatic event(s). 

2. Avoidance of or efforts to avoid people, conversations, or interpersonal situations 
that arouse recollections of the traumatic event(s). 

Negative Alterations in Cognitions 

3. Substantially increased frequency of negative emotional states (e.g., fear, guilt, 
sadness, shame, confusion). 

4. Markedly diminished interest or participation in significant activities, including con- 
striction of play. 

5. Socially withdrawn behavior. 

6. Persistent reduction in expression of positive emotions. 

D. Alterations in arousal and reactivity associated with the traumatic event(s), beginning 
or worsening after the traumatic event(s) occurred, as evidenced by two (or more) of 
the following: 

1. Irritable behavior and angry outbursts (with little or no provocation) typically ex- 
pressed as verbal or physical aggression toward people or objects (including ex- 
treme temper tantrums). 

Hypervigilance. 

Exaggerated startle response. 

Problems with concentration. 

5. Sleep disturbance (e.g., difficulty falling or staying asleep or restless sleep). 

E. The duration of the disturbance is more than 1 month. 


-oOnN 


274 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


F. The disturbance causes Clinically significant distress or impairment in relationships 
with parents, siblings, peers, or other caregivers or with school behavior. 

G. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., 
medication or alcohol) or another medical condition. 


Specify whether: 
With dissociative symptoms: The individual’s symptoms meet the criteria for post- 
traumatic stress disorder, and the individual experiences persistent or recurrent symp- 
toms of either of the following: 


1. Depersonalization: Persistent or recurrent experiences of feeling detached from, 
and as if one were an outside observer of, one’s mental processes or body (e.g., 
feeling as though one were in a dream; feeling a sense of unreality of self or body 
or of time moving slowly). 

2. Derealization: Persistent or recurrent experiences of unreality of surroundings 
(e.g., the world around the individual is experienced as unreal, dreamlike, distant, 
or distorted). 


Note: To use this subtype, the dissociative symptoms must not be attributable to the 
physiological effects of a substance (e.g., blackouts) or another medical condition 
(e.g., complex partial seizures). 

Specify if: 
With delayed expression: If the full diagnostic criteria are not met until at least 


6 months after the event (although the onset and expression of some symptoms may 
be immediate). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD) is the development of char- 
acteristic symptoms following exposure to one or more traumatic events. Emotional re- 
actions to the traumatic event (e.g., fear, helplessness, horror) are no longer a part of 
Criterion A. The clinical presentation of PTSD varies. In some individuals, fear-based re- 
experiencing, emotional, and behavioral symptoms may predominate. In others, anhe- 
donic or dysphoric mood states and negative cognitions may be most distressing. In some 
other individuals, arousal and reactive-externalizing symptoms are prominent, while in 
others, dissociative symptoms predominate. Finally, some individuals exhibit combina- 
tions of these symptom patterns. 

The directly experienced traumatic events in Criterion A include, but are not limited 
to, exposure to war as a combatant or civilian, threatened or actual physical assault (e.g., 
physical attack, robbery, mugging, childhood physical abuse), threatened or actual sexual 
violence (e.g., forced sexual penetration, alcohol/drug-facilitated sexual penetration, abu- 
sive sexual contact, noncontact sexual abuse, sexual trafficking), being kidnapped, being 
taken hostage, terrorist attack, torture, incarceration as a prisoner of war, natural or hu- 
man-made disasters, and severe motor vehicle accidents. For children, sexually violent 
events may include developmentally inappropriate sexual experiences without physical 
violence or injury. A life-threatening illness or debilitating medical condition is not neces- 
sarily considered a traumatic event. Medical incidents that qualify as traumatic events in- 
volve sudden, catastrophic events (e.g., waking during surgery, anaphylactic shock). 
Witnessed events include, but are not limited to, observing threatened or serious injury, 
unnatural death, physical or sexual abuse of another person due to violent assault, domes- 
tic violence, accident, war or disaster, or a medical catastrophe in one’s child (e.g., a life- 
threatening hemorrhage). Indirect exposure through learning about an event is limited to 
experiences affecting close relatives or friends and experiences that are violent or acciden- 
tal (e.g., death due to natural causes does not qualify). Such events include violent per- 


Posttraumatic Stress Disorder 275 


sonal assault, suicide, serious accident, and serious injury. The disorder may be especially 
severe or long-lasting when the stressor is interpersonal and intentional (e.g., torture, sex- 
ual violence). 

The traumatic event can be reexperienced in various ways. Commonly, the individual 
has recurrent, involuntary, and intrusive recollections of the event (Criterion B1). Intrusive 
recollections in PTSD are distinguished from depressive rumination in that they apply 
only to involuntary and intrusive distressing memories. The emphasis is on recurrent 
memories of the event that usually include sensory, emotional, or physiological behavioral 
components. A common reexperiencing symptom is distressing dreams that replay the 
event itself or that are representative or thematically related to the major threats involved 
in the traumatic event (Criterion B2). The individual may experience dissociative states 
that last from a few seconds to several hours or even days, during which components of 
the event are relived and the individual behaves as if the event were occurring at that mo- 
ment (Criterion B3). Such events occur on a continuum from brief visual or other sensory 
intrusions about part of the traumatic event without loss of reality orientation, to complete 
loss of awareness of present surroundings. These episodes, often referred to as “flash- 
backs,” are typically brief but can be associated with prolonged distress and heightened 
arousal. For young children, reenactment of events related to trauma may appear in play 
or in dissociative states. Intense psychological distress (Criterion B4) or physiological re- 
activity (Criterion B5) often occurs when the individual is exposed to triggering events that 
resemble or symbolize an aspect of the traumatic event (e.g., windy days after a hurricane; 
seeing someone who resembles one’s perpetrator). The triggering cue could be a physical 
sensation (e.g., dizziness for survivors of head trauma; rapid heartbeat for a previously 
traumatized child), particularly for individuals with highly somatic presentations. 

Stimuli associated with the trauma are persistently (e.g., always or almost always) 
avoided. The individual commonly makes deliberate efforts to avoid thoughts, memories, 
feelings, or talking about the traumatic event (e.g., utilizing distraction techniques to avoid 
internal reminders) (Criterion C1) and to avoid activities, objects, situations, or people 
who arouse recollections of it (Criterion C2). 

Negative alterations in cognitions or mood associated with the event begin or worsen 
after exposure to the event. These negative alterations can take various forms, including an 
inability to remember an important aspect of the traumatic event; such amnesia is typically 
due to dissociative amnesia and is not due to head injury, alcohol, or drugs (Criterion D1). 
Another form is persistent (i.e., always or almost always) and exaggerated negative ex- 
pectations regarding important aspects of life applied to oneself, others, or the future (e.g., 
“Thave always had bad judgment”; “People in authority can’t be trusted”) that may man- 
ifest as a negative change in perceived identity since the trauma (e.g., “I can’t trust anyone 
ever again”; Criterion D2). Individuals with PTSD may have persistent erroneous cogni- 
tions about the causes of the traumatic event that lead them to blame themselves or others 
(e.g., “It’s all my fault that my uncle abused me”) (Criterion D3). A persistent negative 
mood state (e.g., fear, horror, anger, guilt, shame) either began or worsened after exposure 
to the event (Criterion D4). The individual may experience markedly diminished interest 
or participation in previously enjoyed activities (Criterion D5), feeling detached or es- 
tranged from other people (Criterion D6), or a persistent inability to feel positive emotions 
(especially happiness, joy, satisfaction, or emotions associated with intimacy, tenderness, 
and sexuality) (Criterion D7). 

Individuals with PTSD may be quick tempered and may even engage in aggressive 
verbal and/or physical behavior with little or no provocation (e.g., yelling at people, get- 
ting into fights, destroying objects) (Criterion E1). They may also engage in reckless or self- 
destructive behavior such as dangerous driving, excessive alcohol or drug use, or self- 
injurious or suicidal behavior (Criterion E2). PTSD is often characterized by a heightened 
sensitivity to potential threats, including those that are related to the traumatic experience 
(e.g., following a motor vehicle accident, being especially sensitive to the threat potentially 


276 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


caused by cars or trucks) and those not related to the traumatic event (e.g., being fearful of 
suffering a heart attack) (Criterion E3). Individuals with PTSD may be very reactive to un- 
expected stimuli, displaying a heightened startle response, or jumpiness, to loud noises or 
unexpected movements (e.g., jumping markedly in response to a telephone ringing) (Cri- 
terion E4). Concentration difficulties, including difficulty remembering daily events (e.g., 
forgetting one’s telephone number) or attending to focused tasks (e.g., following a conver- 
sation for a sustained period of time), are commonly reported (Criterion E5). Problems 
with sleep onset and maintenance are common and may be associated with nightmares 
and safety concerns or with generalized elevated arousal that interferes with adequate sleep 
(Criterion E6). Some individuals also experience persistent dissociative symptoms of de- 
tachment from their bodies (depersonalization) or the world around them (derealization); 
this is reflected in the “with dissociative symptoms” specifier. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Developmental regression, such as loss of language in young children, may occur. Audi- 
tory pseudo-hallucinations, such as having the sensory experience of hearing one’s 
thoughts spoken in one or more different voices, as well as paranoid ideation, can be pres- 
ent. Following prolonged, repeated, and severe traumatic events (e.g., childhood abuse, 
torture), the individual may additionally experience difficulties in regulating emotions or 
maintaining stable interpersonal relationships, or dissociative symptoms. When the trau- 
matic event produces violent death, symptoms of both problematic bereavement and PTSD 
may be present. 


Prevalence 


In the United States, projected lifetime risk for PTSD using DSM-IV criteria at age 75 years 
is 8.7%. Twelve-month prevalence among U.S. adults is about 3.5%. Lower estimates are 
seen in Europe and most Asian, African, and Latin American countries, clustering around 
0.5%-1.0%. Although different groups have different levels of exposure to traumatic 
events, the conditional probability of developing PTSD following a similar level of expo- 
sure may also vary across cultural groups. Rates of PTSD are higher among veterans and 
others whose vocation increases the risk of traumatic exposure (e.g., police, firefighters, 
emergency medical personnel). Highest rates (ranging from one-third to more than one- 
half of those exposed) are found among survivors of rape, military combat and captivity, 
and ethnically or politically motivated internment and genocide. The prevalence of PTSD 
may vary across development; children and adolescents, including preschool children, 
generally have displayed lower prevalence following exposure to serious traumatic 
events; however, this may be because previous criteria were insufficiently developmen- 
tally informed. The prevalence of full-threshold PTSD also appears to be lower among 
older adults compared with the general population; there is evidence that subthreshold 
presentations are more common than full PTSD in later life and that these symptoms are 
associated with substantial clinical impairment. Compared with U.S. non-Latino whites, 
higher rates of PTSD have been reported among U.S. Latinos, African Americans, and 
American Indians, and lower rates have been reported among Asian Americans, after ad- 
justment for traumatic exposure and demographic variables. 


Development and Course 


PTSD can occur at any age, beginning after the first year of life. Symptoms usually begin 
within the first 3 months after the trauma, although there may be a delay of months, or 
even years, before criteria for the diagnosis are met. There is abundant evidence for what 
DSM-IV called “delayed onset” but is now called “delayed expression,” with the recogni- 
tion that some symptoms typically appear immediately and that the delay is in meeting 
full criteria. 


Posttraumatic Stress Disorder 277 


Frequently, an individual’s reaction to a trauma initially meets criteria for acute stress 
disorder in the immediate aftermath of the trauma. The symptoms of PTSD and the rela- 
tive predominance of different symptoms may vary over time. Duration of the symptoms 
also varies, with complete recovery within 3 months occurring in approximately one-half 
of adults, while some individuals remain symptomatic for longer than 12 months and 
sometimes for more than 50 years. Symptom recurrence and intensification may occur in 
response to reminders of the original trauma, ongoing life stressors, or newly experienced 
traumatic events. For older individuals, declining health, worsening cognitive function- 
ing, and social isolation may exacerbate PTSD symptoms. 

The clinical expression of reexperiencing can vary across development. Young children 
may report new onset of frightening dreams without content specific to the traumatic event. 
Before age 6 years (see criteria for preschool subtype), young children are more likely to ex- 
press reexperiencing symptoms through play that refers directly or symbolically to the 
trauma. They may not manifest fearful reactions at the time of the exposure or during reex- 
periencing. Parents may report a wide range of emotional or behavioral changes in young 
children. Children may focus on imagined interventions in their play or storytelling. In ad- 
dition to avoidance, children may become preoccupied with reminders. Because of young 
children’s limitations in expressing thoughts or labeling emotions, negative alterations in 
mood or cognition tend to involve primarily mood changes. Children may experience co- 
occurring traumas (e.g., physical abuse, witnessing domestic violence) and in chronic cir- 
cumstances may not be able to identify onset of symptomatology. Avoidant behavior may 
be associated with restricted play or exploratory behavior in young children; reduced par- 
ticipation in new activities in school-age children; or reluctance to pursue developmental op- 
portunities in adolescents (e.g., dating, driving). Older children and adolescents may judge 
themselves as cowardly. Adolescents may harbor beliefs of being changed in ways that 
make them socially undesirable and estrange them from peers (e.g., “Now Ill never fit in”) 
and lose aspirations for the future. Irritable or aggressive behavior in children and adoles- 
cents can interfere with peer relationships and school behavior. Reckless behavior may lead 
to accidental injury to self or others, thrill-seeking, or high-risk behaviors. Individuals who 
continue to experience PTSD into older adulthood may express fewer symptoms of hy- 
perarousal, avoidance, and negative cognitions and mood compared with younger adults 
with PTSD, although adults exposed to traumatic events during later life may display more 
avoidance, hyperarousal, sleep problems, and crying spells than do younger adults exposed 
to the same traumatic events. In older individuals, the disorder is associated with negative 
health perceptions, primary care utilization, and suicidal ideation. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Risk (and protective) factors are generally divided into pretraumatic, peritraumatic, and 
posttraumatic factors. 


Pretraumatic factors 


Temperamental. These include childhood emotional problems by age 6 years (e.g., prior 
traumatic exposure, externalizing or anxiety problems) and prior mental disorders (e.g., 
panic disorder, depressive disorder, PTSD, or obsessive-compulsive disorder [OCD)). 


Environmental. These include lower socioeconomic status; lower education; exposure to 
prior trauma (especially during childhood); childhood adversity (e.g., economic depriva- 
tion, family dysfunction, parental separation or death); cultural characteristics (e.g., fatal- 
istic or self-blaming coping strategies); lower intelligence; minority racial/ethnic status; 
and a family psychiatric history. Social support prior to event exposure is protective. 


Genetic and physiological. These include female gender and younger age at the time of 
trauma exposure (for adults). Certain genotypes may either be protective or increase risk 
of PTSD after exposure to traumatic events. 


278 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


Peritraumatic factors 


Environmental. These include severity (dose) of the trauma (the greater the magnitude 
of trauma, the greater the likelihood of PTSD), perceived life threat, personal injury, in- 
terpersonal violence (particularly trauma perpetrated by a caregiver or involving a wit- 
nessed threat to a caregiver in children), and, for military personnel, being a perpetrator, 
witnessing atrocities, or killing the enemy. Finally, dissociation that occurs during the trauma 
and persists afterward is a risk factor. 


Posttraumatic factors 


Temperamental. These include negative appraisals, inappropriate coping strategies, 
and development of acute stress disorder. 


Environmental. These include subsequent exposure to repeated upsetting reminders, subse- 
quent adverse life events, and financial or other trauma-related losses. Social support (includ- 
ing family stability, for children) is a protective factor that moderates outcome after trauma. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The risk of onset and severity of PTSD may differ across cultural groups as a result of vari- 
ation in the type of traumatic exposure (e.g., genocide), the impact on disorder severity of 
the meaning attributed to the traumatic event (e.g., inability to perform funerary rites after 
a mass killing), the ongoing sociocultural context (e.g., residing among unpunished per- 
petrators in postconflict settings), and other cultural factors (e.g., acculturative stress in 
immigrants). The relative risk for PTSD of particular exposures (e.g., religious persecu- 
tion) may vary across cultural groups. The clinical expression of the symptoms or symp- 
tom clusters of PTSD may vary culturally, particularly with respect to avoidance and 
numbing symptoms, distressing dreams, and somatic symptoms (e.g., dizziness, short- 
ness of breath, heat sensations). 

Cultural syndromes and idioms of distress influence the expression of PTSD and the 
range of comorbid disorders in different cultures by providing behavioral and cognitive 
templates that link traumatic exposures to specific symptoms. For example, panic attack 
symptoms may be salient in PTSD among Cambodians and Latin Americans because of 
the association of traumatic exposure with panic-like khyal attacks and ataque de nervios. 
Comprehensive evaluation of local expressions of PTSD should include assessment of cul- 
tural concepts of distress (see the chapter “Cultural Formulation” in Section III). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


PTSD is more prevalent among females than among males across the lifespan. Females in 
the general population experience PTSD for a longer duration than do males. At least some 
of the increased risk for PTSD in females appears to be attributable to a greater likelihood 
of exposure to traumatic events, such as rape, and other forms of interpersonal violence. 
Within populations exposed specifically to such stressors, gender differences in risk for 
PTSD are attenuated or nonsignificant. 


Suicide Risk 


Traumatic events such as childhood abuse increase a person’s suicide risk. PTSD is associated 
with suicidal ideation and suicide attempts, and presence of the disorder may indicate which 
individuals with ideation eventually make a suicide plan or actually attempt suicide. 


Functional Consequences of 
Posttraumatic Stress Disorder 


PTSD is associated with high levels of social, occupational, and physical disability, as well 
as considerable economic costs and high levels of medical utilization. Impaired function- 


Posttraumatic Stress Disorder 279 


ing is exhibited across social, interpersonal, developmental, educational, physical health, 
and occupational domains. In community and veteran samples, PTSD is associated with 
poor social and family relationships, absenteeism from work, lower income, and lower ed- 
ucational and occupational success. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Adjustment disorders. In adjustment disorders, the stressor can be of any severity or 
type rather than that required by PTSD Criterion A. The diagnosis of an adjustment dis- 
order is used when the response to a stressor that meets PTSD Criterion A does not meet 
all other PTSD criteria (or criteria for another mental disorder). An adjustment disorder is 
also diagnosed when the symptom pattern of PTSD occurs in response to a stressor that 
does not meet PTSD Criterion A (e.g., spouse leaving, being fired). 


Other posttraumatic disorders and conditions. Not all psychopathology that occurs in 
individuals exposed to an extreme stressor should necessarily be attributed to PTSD. The 
diagnosis requires that trauma exposure precede the onset or exacerbation of pertinent 
symptoms. Moreover, if the symptom response pattern to the extreme stressor meets cri- 
teria for another mental disorder, these diagnoses should be given instead of, or in addi- 
tion to, PTSD. Other diagnoses and conditions are excluded if they are better explained by 
PTSD (e.g., symptoms of panic disorder that occur only after exposure to traumatic re- 
minders). If severe, symptom response patterns to the extreme stressor may warrant a sep- 
arate diagnosis (e.g., dissociative amnesia). 


Acute stress disorder. Acute stress disorder is distinguished from PTSD because the 
symptom pattern in acute stress disorder is restricted to a duration of 3 days to 1 month 
following exposure to the traumatic event. 


Anxiety disorders and obsessive-compulsive disorder. In OCD, there are recurrent 
intrusive thoughts, but these meet the definition of an obsession. In addition, the intrusive 
thoughts are not related to an experienced traumatic event, compulsions are usually pres- 
ent, and other symptoms of PTSD or acute stress disorder are typically absent. Neither the 
arousal and dissociative symptoms of panic disorder nor the avoidance, irritability, and 
anxiety of generalized anxiety disorder are associated with a specific traumatic event. The 
symptoms of separation anxiety disorder are clearly related to separation from home or 
family, rather than to a traumatic event. 


Major depressive disorder. Major depression may or may not be preceded by a trau- 
matic event and should be diagnosed if other PTSD symptoms are absent. Specifically, ma- 
jor depressive disorder does not include any PTSD Criterion B or C symptoms. Nor does it 
include a number of symptoms from PTSD Criterion D or E. 


Personality disorders. Interpersonal difficulties that had their onset, or were greatly ex- 
acerbated, after exposure to a traumatic event may be an indication of PTSD, rather than a 
personality disorder, in which such difficulties would be expected independently of any 
traumatic exposure. 


Dissociative disorders. Dissociative amnesia, dissociative identity disorder, and de- 
personalization-derealization disorder may or may not be preceded by exposure to a trau- 
matic event or may or may not have co-occurring PTSD symptoms. When full PTSD criteria 
are also met, however, the PTSD “with dissociative symptoms” subtype should be considered. 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder). New onset of somatic 
symptoms within the context of posttraumatic distress might be an indication of PTSD 
rather than conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder). 


Psychotic disorders. Flashbacks in PTSD must be distinguished from illusions, halluci- 
nations, and other perceptual disturbances that may occur in schizophrenia, brief psy- 
chotic disorder, and other psychotic disorders; depressive and bipolar disorders with 


280 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


psychotic features; delirium; substance /medication-induced disorders; and psychotic dis- 
orders due to another medical condition. 


Traumatic brain injury. When a brain injury occurs in the context of a traumatic event (e.g., 
traumatic accident, bomb blast, acceleration/deceleration trauma), symptoms of PTSD may 
appear. An event causing head trauma may also constitute a psychological traumatic event, 
and tramautic brain injury (TBI)-related neurocognitive symptoms are not mutually exclusive 
and may occur concurrently. Symptoms previously termed postconcussive (e.g., headaches, 
dizziness, sensitivity to light or sound, irritability, concentration deficits) can occur in brain- 
injured and non-brain-injured populations, including individuals with PTSD. Because symp- 
toms of PTSD and TBI-related neurocognitive symptoms can overlap, a differential diagnosis 
between PTSD and neurocognitive disorder symptoms attributable to TBI may be possible 
based on the presence of symptoms that are distinctive to each presentation. Whereas reexpe- 
riencing and avoidance are characteristic of PTSD and not the effects of TBI, persistent disori- 
entation and confusion are more specific to TBI (neurocognitive effects) than to PTSD. 


Comorbidity 


Individuals with PTSD are 80% more likely than those without PTSD to have symptoms 
that meet diagnostic criteria for at least one other mental disorder (e.g., depressive, bipo- 
lar, anxiety, or substance use disorders). Comorbid substance use disorder and conduct 
disorder are more common among males than among females. Among U.S. military per- 
sonnel and combat veterans who have been deployed to recent wars in Afghanistan and 
Iraq, co-occurrence of PTSD and mild TBI is 48%. Although most young children with 
PTSD also have at least one other diagnosis, the patterns of comorbidity are different than 
in adults, with oppositional defiant disorder and separation anxiety disorder predominat- 
ing. Finally, there is considerable comorbidity between PTSD and major neurocognitive 
disorder and some overlapping symptoms between these disorders. 


Acute Stress Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 308.3 (F43.0) 


A. Exposure to actual or threatened death, serious injury, or sexual violation in one (or 
more) of the following ways: 


1. Directly experiencing the traumatic event(s). 

2. Witnessing, in person, the event(s) as it occurred to others. 

3. Learning that the event(s) occurred to a close family member or close friend. Note: 
In cases of actual or threatened death of a family member or friend, the event(s) 
must have been violent or accidental. 

4. Experiencing repeated or extreme exposure to aversive details of the traumatic 
event(s) (e.g., first responders collecting human remains, police officers repeatedly 
exposed to details of child abuse). 


Note: This does not apply to exposure through electronic media, television, mov- 
ies, or pictures, unless this exposure is work related. 


B. Presence of nine (or more) of the following symptoms from any of the five categories 
of intrusion, negative mood, dissociation, avoidance, and arousal, beginning or wors- 
ening after the traumatic event(s) occurred: 


Intrusion Symptoms 


1. Recurrent, involuntary, and intrusive distressing memories of the traumatic 
event(s). Note: In children, repetitive play may occur in which themes or aspects of 
the traumatic event(s) are expressed. 


Acute Stress Disorder 281 


2. Recurrent distressing dreams in which the content and/or affect of the dream are 
related to the event(s). Note: In children, there may be frightening dreams without 
recognizable content. 

3. Dissociative reactions (e.g., flashbacks) in which the individual feels or acts as if 
the traumatic event(s) were recurring. (Such reactions may occur on a continuum, 
with the most extreme expression being a complete loss of awareness of present 
surroundings.) Note: In children, trauma-specific reenactment may occur in play. 

4. Intense or prolonged psychological distress or marked physiological reactions in re- 
sponse to internal or external cues that symbolize or resemble an aspect of the 
traumatic event(s). 


Negative Mood 


5. Persistent inability to experience positive emotions (e.g., inability to experience 
happiness, satisfaction, or loving feelings). 


Dissociative Symptoms 


6. Analtered sense of the reality of one’s surroundings or oneself (e.g., seeing oneself 
from another’s perspective, being in a daze, time slowing). 

7. Inability to remember an important aspect of the traumatic event(s) (typically due to 
dissociative amnesia and not to other factors such as head injury, alcohol, or 
drugs). 

Avoidance Symptoms 


8. Efforts to avoid distressing memories, thoughts, or feelings about or closely asso- 
ciated with the traumatic event(s). 

9. Efforts to avoid external reminders (people, places, conversations, activities, ob- 
jects, situations) that arouse distressing memories, thoughts, or feelings about or 
closely associated with the traumatic event(s). 


Arousal Symptoms 


10. Sleep disturbance (e.g., difficulty falling or staying asleep, restless sleep). 

11. Irritable behavior and angry outbursts (with little or no provocation), typically ex- 
pressed as verbal or physical aggression toward people or objects. 

12. Hypervigilance. 

13. Problems with concentration. 

14. Exaggerated startle response. 


C. Duration of the disturbance (symptoms in Criterion B) is 3 days to 1 month after trauma 
exposure. 


Note: Symptoms typically begin immediately after the trauma, but persistence for at 
least 3 days and up to a month is needed to meet disorder criteria. 


D. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

E. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., 
medication or alcohol) or another medical condition (e.g., mild traumatic brain injury) 
and is not better explained by brief psychotic disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of acute stress disorder is the development of characteristic symp- 
toms lasting from 3 days to 1 month following exposure to one or more traumatic events. 
Traumatic events that are experienced directly include, but are not limited to, exposure 
to war as a combatant or civilian, threatened or actual violent personal assault (e.g., sexual 


282 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


violence, physical attack, active combat, mugging, childhood physical and/or sexual vio- 
lence, being kidnapped, being taken hostage, terrorist attack, torture), natural or human- 
made disasters (e.g., earthquake, hurricane, airplane crash), and severe accident (e.g., 
severe motor vehicle, industrial accident). For children, sexually traumatic events may 
include inappropriate sexual experiences without violence or injury. A life-threatening 
illness or debilitating medical condition is not necessarily considered a traumatic event. 
Medical incidents that qualify as traumatic events involve sudden, catastrophic events (e.g., 
waking during surgery, anaphylactic shock). Stressful events that do not possess the severe 
and traumatic components of events encompassed by Criterion A may lead to an adjust- 
ment disorder but not to acute stress disorder. 

The clinical presentation of acute stress disorder may vary by individual but typically 
involves an anxiety response that includes some form of reexperiencing of or reactivity to 
the traumatic event. In some individuals, a dissociative or detached presentation can pre- 
dominate, although these individuals typically will also display strong emotional or phys- 
iological reactivity in response to trauma reminders. In other individuals, there can be a 
strong anger response in which reactivity is characterized by irritable or possibly aggres- 
sive responses. The full symptom picture must be present for at least 3 days after the trau- 
matic event and can be diagnosed only up to 1 month after the event. Symptoms that occur 
immediately after the event but resolve in less than 3 days would not meet criteria for 
acute stress disorder. 

Witnessed events include, but are not limited to, observing threatened or serious in- 
jury, unnatural death, physical or sexual violence inflicted on another individual as a re- 
sult of violent assault, severe domestic violence, severe accident, war, and disaster; it may 
also include witnessing a medical catastrophe (e.g., a life-threatening hemorrhage) involv- 
ing one’s child. Events experienced indirectly through learning about the event are limited 
to close relatives or close friends. Such events must have been violent or accidental—death 
due to natural causes does not qualify—and include violent personal assault, suicide, se- 
rious accident, or serious injury. The disorder may be especially severe when the stressor 
is interpersonal and intentional (e.g., torture, rape). The likelihood of developing this dis- 
order may increase as the intensity of and physical proximity to the stressor increase. 

The traumatic event can be reexperienced in various ways. Commonly, the individual 
has recurrent and intrusive recollections of the event (Criterion B1). The recollections are 
spontaneous or triggered recurrent memories of the event that usually occur in response 
to astimulus that is reminiscent of the traumatic experience (e.g., the sound of a backfiring 
car triggering memories of gunshots). These intrusive memories often include sensory 
(e.g., sensing the intense heat that was perceived in a house fire), emotional (e.g., experi- 
encing the fear of believing that one was about to be stabbed), or physiological (e.g., expe- 
riencing the shortness of breath that one suffered during a near-drowning) components. 

Distressing dreams may contain themes that are representative of or thematically re- 
lated to the major threats involved in the traumatic event. (For example, in the case of a 
motor vehicle accident survivor, the distressing dreams may involve crashing cars gener- 
ally; in the case of a combat soldier, the distressing dreams may involve being harmed in 
ways other than combat.) 

Dissociative states may last from a few seconds to several hours, or even days, during 
which components of the event are relived and the individual behaves as though experi- 
encing the event at that moment. While dissociative responses are common during a trau- 
matic event, only dissociative responses that persist beyond 3 days after trauma exposure 
are considered for the diagnosis of acute stress disorder. For young children, reenactment 
of events related to trauma may appear in play and may include dissociative moments 
(e.g., a child who survives a motor vehicle accident may repeatedly crash toy cars during 
play in a focused and distressing manner). These episodes, often referred to as flashbacks, 
are typically brief but involve a sense that the traumatic event is occurring in the present 
rather than being remembered in the past and are associated with significant distress. 


Acute Stress Disorder 283 


Some individuals with the disorder do not have intrusive memories of the event itself, 
but instead experience intense psychological distress or physiological reactivity when 
they are exposed to triggering events that resemble or symbolize an aspect of the traumatic 
event (e.g., windy days for children after a hurricane, entering an elevator for a male or fe- 
male who was raped in an elevator, seeing someone who resembles one’s perpetrator). 
The triggering cue could be a physical sensation (e.g., a sense of heat for a burn victim, diz- 
ziness for survivors of head trauma), particularly for individuals with highly somatic pre- 
sentations. The individual may have a persistent inability to feel positive emotions (e.g., 
happiness, joy, satisfaction, or emotions associated with intimacy, tenderness, or sexual- 
ity) but can experience negative emotions such as fear, sadness, anger, guilt, or shame. 

Alterations in awareness can include depersonalization, a detached sense of oneself (e.g., 
seeing oneself from the other side of the room), or derealization, having a distorted view of 
one’s surroundings (e.g., perceiving that things are moving in slow motion, seeing things 
in a daze, not being aware of events that one would normally encode). Some individuals 
also report an inability to remember an important aspect of the traumatic event that was 
presumably encoded. This symptom is attributable to dissociative amnesia and is not at- 
tributable to head injury, alcohol, or drugs. 

Stimuli associated with the trauma are persistently avoided. The individual may refuse 
to discuss the traumatic experience or may engage in avoidance strategies to minimize 
awareness of emotional reactions (e.g., excessive alcohol use when reminded of the ex- 
perience). This behavioral avoidance may include avoiding watching news coverage of 
the traumatic experience, refusing to return to a workplace where the trauma occurred, or 
avoiding interacting with others who shared the same traumatic experience. 

It is very common for individuals with acute stress disorder to experience problems 
with sleep onset and maintenance, which may be associated with nightmares or with gen- 
eralized elevated arousal that prevents adequate sleep. Individuals with acute stress dis- 
order may be quick tempered and may even engage in aggressive verbal and/or physical 
behavior with little provocation. Acute stress disorder is often characterized by a height- 
ened sensitivity to potential threats, including those that are related to the traumatic ex- 
perience (e.g., a motor vehicle accident victim may be especially sensitive to the threat 
potentially caused by any cars or trucks) or those not related to the traumatic event (e.g., 
fear of having a heart attack). Concentration difficulties, including difficulty remembering 
daily events (e.g., forgetting one’s telephone number) or attending to focused tasks (e.g., 
following a conversation for a sustained period of time), are commonly reported. Individ- 
uals with acute stress disorder may be very reactive to unexpected stimuli, displaying a 
heightened startle response or jumpiness to loud noises or unexpected movements (e.g., 
the individual may jump markedly in the response to a telephone ringing). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with acute stress disorder commonly engage in catastrophic or extremely neg- 
ative thoughts about their role in the traumatic event, their response to the traumatic ex- 
perience, or the likelihood of future harm. For example, an individual with acute stress 
disorder may feel excessively guilty about not having prevented the traumatic event or 
about not adapting to the experience more successfully. Individuals with acute stress dis- 
order may also interpret their symptoms in a catastrophic manner, such that flashback 
memories or emotional numbing may be interpreted as a sign of diminished mental ca- 
pacity. It is common for individuals with acute stress disorder to experience panic attacks 
in the initial month after trauma exposure that may be triggered by trauma reminders or 
may apparently occur spontaneously. Additionally, individuals with acute stress disorder 
may display chaotic or impulsive behavior. For example, individuals may drive reck- 
lessly, make irrational decisions, or gamble excessively. In children, there may be sig- 
nificant separation anxiety, possibly manifested by excessive needs for attention from 


284 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


caregivers. In the case of bereavement following a death that occurred in traumatic cir- 
cumstances, the symptoms of acute stress disorder can involve acute grief reactions. In 
such cases, reexperiencing, dissociative, and arousal symptoms may involve reactions to 
the loss, such as intrusive memories of the circumstances of the individual’s death, disbe- 
lief that the individual has died, and anger about the death. Postconcussive symptoms 
(e.g., headaches, dizziness, sensitivity to light or sound, irritability, concentration deficits), 
which occur frequently following mild traumatic brain injury, are also frequently seen in 
individuals with acute stress disorder. Postconcussive symptoms are equally common in 
brain-injured and non-brain-injured populations, and the frequent occurrence of postcon- 
cussive symptoms could be attributable to acute stress disorder symptoms. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of acute stress disorder in recently trauma-exposed populations (i.e., 
within 1 month of trauma exposure) varies according to the nature of the event and the 
context in which it is assessed. In both U.S. and non-U.S. populations, acute stress disorder 
tends to be identified in less than 20% of cases following traumatic events that do not in- 
volve interpersonal assault; 13%-21% of motor vehicle accidents, 14% of mild traumatic 
brain injury, 19% of assault, 10% of severe burns, and 6%-12% of industrial accidents. 
Higher rates (i.e., 20%-50%) are reported following interpersonal traumatic events, in- 
cluding assault, rape, and witnessing a mass shooting. 


Development and Course 


Acute stress disorder cannot be diagnosed until 3 days after a traumatic event. Although 
acute stress disorder may progress to posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD) after 1 month, 
it may also be a transient stress response that remits within 1 month of trauma exposure 
and does not result in PTSD. Approximately half of individuals who eventually develop 
PTSD initially present with acute stress disorder. Symptom worsening during the initial 
month can occur, often as a result of ongoing life stressors or further traumatic events. 

The forms of reexperiencing can vary across development. Unlike adults or adoles- 
cents, young children may report frightening dreams without content that clearly reflects 
aspects of the trauma (e.g., waking in fright in the aftermath of the trauma but being unable 
to relate the content of the dream to the traumatic event). Children age 6 years and younger 
are more likely than older children to express reexperiencing symptoms through play that 
refers directly or symbolically to the trauma. For example, a very young child who sur- 
vived a fire may draw pictures of flames. Young children also do not necessarily manifest 
fearful reactions at the time of the exposure or even during reexperiencing. Parents typi- 
cally report a range of emotional expressions, such as anger, shame, or withdrawal, and 
even excessively bright positive affect, in young children who are traumatized. Although 
children may avoid reminders of the trauma, they sometimes become preoccupied with 
reminders (e.g.,a young child bitten by a dog may talk about dogs constantly yet avoid go- 
ing outside because of fear of coming into contact with a dog). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Risk factors include prior mental disorder, high levels of negative af- 
fectivity (neuroticism), greater perceived severity of the traumatic event, and an avoidant 
coping style. Catastrophic appraisals of the traumatic experience, often characterized by 
exaggerated appraisals of future harm, guilt, or hopelessness, are strongly predictive of 
acute stress disorder. 


Environmental. First and foremost, an individual must be exposed to a traumatic event to 
be at risk for acute stress disorder. Risk factors for the disorder include a history of prior 
trauma. 


Acute Stress Disorder 285 


Genetic and physiological. Females are at greater risk for developing acute stress dis- 
order. 

Elevated reactivity, as reflected by acoustic startle response, prior to trauma exposure 
increases the risk for developing acute stress disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The profile of symptoms of acute stress disorder may vary cross-culturally, particularly 
with respect to dissociative symptoms, nightmares, avoidance, and somatic symptoms 
(e.g., dizziness, shortness of breath, heat sensations). Cultural syndromes and idioms of 
distress shape the local symptom profiles of acute stress disorder. Some cultural groups 
may display variants of dissociative responses, such as possession or trancelike behaviors 
in the initial month after trauma exposure. Panic symptoms may be salient in acute stress 
disorder among Cambodians because of the association of traumatic exposure with panic- 
like khyél attacks, and ataque de nervios among Latin Americans may also follow a traumatic 
exposure. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Acute stress disorder is more prevalent among females than among males. Sex-linked neu- 
robiological differences in stress response may contribute to females’ increased risk for 
acute stress disorder. The increased risk for the disorder in females may be attributable in 
part to a greater likelihood of exposure to the types of traumatic events with a high con- 
ditional risk for acute stress disorder, such as rape and other interpersonal violence. 


Functional Consequences of Acute Stress Disorder 


Impaired functioning in social, interpersonal, or occupational domains has been shown 
across survivors of accidents, assault, and rape who develop acute stress disorder. The ex- 
treme levels of anxiety that may be associated with acute stress disorder may interfere 
with sleep, energy levels, and capacity to attend to tasks. Avoidance in acute stress dis- 
order can result in generalized withdrawal from many situations that are perceived as 
potentially threatening, which can lead to nonattendance of medical appointments, avoid- 
ance of driving to important appointments, and absenteeism from work. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Adjustment disorders. In acute stress disorder, the stressor can be of any severity rather 
than of the severity and type required by Criterion A of acute stress disorder. The diagnosis of 
an adjustment disorder is used when the response to a Criterion A event does not meet the cri- 
teria for acute stress disorder (or another specific mental disorder) and when the symptom pat- 
tern of acute stress disorder occurs in response to a stressor that does not meet Criterion A for 
exposure to actual or threatened death, serious injury, or sexual violence (e.g., spouse leaving, 
being fired). For example, severe stress reactions to life-threatening illnesses that may include 
some acute stress disorder symptoms may be more appropriately described as an adjustment 
disorder. Some forms of acute stress response do not include acute stress disorder symptoms 
and may be characterized by anger, depression, or guilt. These responses are more appro- 
priately described as primarily an adjustment disorder. Depressive or anger responses in an 
adjustment disorder may involve rumination about the traumatic event, as opposed to invol- 
untary and intrusive distressing memories in acute stress disorder. 


Panic disorder. Spontaneous panic attacks are very common in acute stress disorder. 
However, panic disorder is diagnosed only if panic attacks are unexpected and there is 
anxiety about future attacks or maladaptive changes in behavior associated with fear of 
dire consequences of the attacks. 


286 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


Dissociative disorders. Severe dissociative responses (in the absence of characteristic 
acute stress disorder symptoms) may be diagnosed as derealization/depersonalization 
disorder. If severe amnesia of the trauma persists in the absence of characteristic acute 
stress disorder symptoms, the diagnosis of dissociative amnesia may be indicated. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder. Acute stress disorder is distinguished from PTSD because 
the symptom pattern in acute stress disorder must occur within 1 month of the traumatic event 
and resolve within that 1-month period. If the symptoms persist for more than 1 month and 
meet criteria for PTSD, the diagnosis is changed from acute stress disorder to PTSD. 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. In obsessive-compulsive disorder, there are recurrent 
intrusive thoughts, but these meet the definition of an obsession. In addition, the intrusive 
thoughts are not related to an experienced traumatic event, compulsions are usually pres- 
ent, and other symptoms of acute stress disorder are typically absent. 


Psychotic disorders. Flashbacks in acute stress disorder must be distinguished from il- 
lusions, hallucinations, and other perceptual disturbances that may occur in schizophre- 
nia, other psychotic disorders, depressive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features, a 
delirium, substance/medication-induced disorders, and psychotic disorders due to an- 
other medical condition. Acute stress disorder flashbacks are distinguished from these 
other perceptual disturbances by being directly related to the traumatic experience and by 
occurring in the absence of other psychotic or substance-induced features. 


Traumatic brain injury. When a brain injury occurs in the context of a traumatic event 
(e.g., traumatic accident, bomb blast, acceleration/deceleration trauma), symptoms of 
acute stress disorder may appear. An event causing head trauma may also constitute a 
psychological traumatic event, and tramautic brain injury (TBI)-related neurocognitive 
symptoms are not mutually exclusive and may occur concurrently. Symptoms previously 
termed postconcussive (e.g., headaches, dizziness, sensitivity to light or sound, irritability, 
concentration deficits) can occur in brain-injured and non-brain injured populations, in- 
cluding individuals with acute stress disorder. Because symptoms of acute stress disorder 
and TBI-related neurocognitive symptoms can overlap, a differential diagnosis between 
acute stress disorder and neurocognitive disorder symptoms attributable to TBI may be 
possible based on the presence of symptoms that are distinctive to each presenta- 
tion. Whereas reexperiencing and avoidance are characteristic of acute stress disorder and 
not the effects of TBI, persistent disorientation and confusion are more specific to TBI (neu- 
rocognitive effects) than to acute stress disorder. Furthermore, differential is aided by the 
fact that symptoms of acute stress disorder persist for up to only 1 month following trauma 
exposure. 


Adjustment Disorders 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The development of emotional or behavioral symptoms in response to an identifiable 
stressor(s) occurring within 3 months of the onset of the stressor(s). 

B. These symptoms or behaviors are clinically significant, as evidenced by one or both of 
the following: 

1. Marked distress that is out of proportion to the severity or intensity of the stressor, 
taking into account the external context and the cultural factors that might influence 
symptom severity and presentation. 

2. Significant impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 


C. The stress-related disturbance does not meet the criteria for another mental disorder 
and is not merely an exacerbation of a preexisting mental disorder. 


Adjustment Disorders 287 


D. The symptoms do not represent normal bereavement. 
E. Once the stressor or its consequences have terminated, the symptoms do not persist 
for more than an additional 6 months. 


Specify whether: 
309.0 (F43.21) With depressed mood: Low mood, tearfulness, or feelings of hope- 
lessness are predominant. 
309.24 (F43.22) With anxiety: Nervousness, worry, jitteriness, or separation anxiety 
is predominant. 
309.28 (F43.23) With mixed anxiety and depressed mood: A combination of de- 
pression and anxiety is predominant. 
309.3 (F43.24) With disturbance of conduct: Disturbance of conduct is predominant. 
309.4 (F43.25) With mixed disturbance of emotions and conduct: Both emotional 
symptoms (e.g., depression, anxiety) and a disturbance of conduct are predominant. 
309.9 (F43.20) Unspecified: For maladaptive reactions that are not classifiable as one 
of the specific subtypes of adjustment disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The presence of emotional or behavioral symptoms in response to an identifiable stressor 
is the essential feature of adjustment disorders (Criterion A). The stressor may be a single 
event (e.g., a termination of a romantic relationship), or there may be multiple stressors 
(e.g., marked business difficulties and marital problems). Stressors may be recurrent (e.g., 
associated with seasonal business crises, unfulfilling sexual relationships) or continuous 
(e.g., a persistent painful illness with increasing disability, living in a crime-ridden neigh- 
borhood). Stressors may affect a single individual, an entire family, or a larger group or 
community (e.g.,a natural disaster). Some stressors may accompany specific developmen- 
tal events (e.g., going to school, leaving a parental home, reentering a parental home, get- 
ting married, becoming a parent, failing to attain occupational goals, retirement). 

Adjustment disorders may be diagnosed following the death of a loved one when the 
intensity, quality, or persistence of grief reactions exceeds what normally might be ex- 
pected, when cultural, religious, or age-appropriate norms are taken into account. A more 
specific set of bereavement-related symptoms has been designated persistent complex be- 
reavement disorder. 

Adjustment disorders are associated with an increased risk of suicide attempts and 
completed suicide. 


Prevalence 


Adjustment disorders are common, although prevalence may vary widely as a function of 
the population studied and the assessment methods used. The percentage of individuals 
in outpatient mental health treatment with a principal diagnosis of an adjustment disorder 
ranges from approximately 5% to 20%. In a hospital psychiatric consultation setting, it is 
often the most common diagnosis, frequently reaching 50%. 


Development and Course 


By definition, the disturbance in adjustment disorders begins within 3 months of onset of 
a stressor and lasts no longer than 6 months after the stressor or its consequences have 
ceased. If the stressor is an acute event (e.g., being fired from a job), the onset of the dis- 
turbance is usually immediate (i-e., within a few days) and the duration is relatively brief 
(i.e.,no more than a few months). If the stressor or its consequences persist, the adjustment 
disorder may also continue to be present and become the persistent form. 


288 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Individuals from disadvantaged life circumstances experience a high 
rate of stressors and may be at increased risk for adjustment disorders. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The context of the individual’s cultural setting should be taken into account in making the 
clinical judgment of whether the individual’s response to the stressor is maladaptive or 
whether the associated distress is in excess of what would be expected. The nature, mean- 
ing, and experience of the stressors and the evaluation of the response to the stressors may 
vary across cultures. 


Functional Consequences of Adjustment Disorders 


The subjective distress or impairment in functioning associated with adjustment disorders 
is frequently manifested as decreased performance at work or school and temporary 
changes in social relationships. An adjustment disorder may complicate the course of ill- 
ness in individuals who have a general medical condition (e.g., decreased compliance with 
the recommended medical regimen; increased length of hospital stay). 


Differential Diagnosis 


Major depressive disorder. If an individual has symptoms that meet criteria for a major 
depressive disorder in response to a stressor, the diagnosis of an adjustment disorder is 
not applicable. The symptom profile of major depressive disorder differentiates it from ad- 
justment disorders. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder and acute stress disorder. In adjustment disorders, the 
stressor can be of any severity rather than of the severity and type required by Criterion A 
of acute stress disorder and posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD). In distinguishing ad- 
justment disorders from these two posttraumatic diagnoses, there are both timing and 
symptom profile considerations. Adjustment disorders can be diagnosed immediately 
and persist up to 6 months after exposure to the traumatic event, whereas acute stress dis- 
order can only occur between 3 days and 1 month of exposure to the stressor, and PTSD 
cannot be diagnosed until at least 1 month has passed since the occurrence of the traumatic 
stressor. The required symptom profile for PTSD and acute stress disorder differentiates 
them from the adjustment disorders. With regard to symptom profiles, an adjustment dis- 
order may be diagnosed following a traumatic event when an individual exhibits symptoms 
of either acute stress disorder or PTSD that do not meet or exceed the diagnostic threshold 
for either disorder. An adjustment disorder should also be diagnosed for individuals who 
have not been exposed to a traumatic event but who otherwise exhibit the full symptom pro- 
file of either acute stress disorder or PTSD. 


Personality disorders. With regard to personality disorders, some personality features 
may be associated with a vulnerability to situational distress that may resemble an adjust- 
ment disorder. The lifetime history of personality functioning will help inform the in- 
terpretation of distressed behaviors to aid in distinguishing a long-standing personality 
disorder from an adjustment disorder. In addition to some personality disorders incurring 
vulnerability to distress, stressors may also exacerbate personality disorder symptoms. In 
the presence of a personality disorder, if the symptom criteria for an adjustment disorder 
are met, and the stress-related disturbance exceeds what may be attributable to maladap- 
tive personality disorder symptoms (i.e., Criterion C is met), then the diagnosis of an ad- 
justment disorder should be made. 


Other Specified Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorder 289 


Psychological factors affecting other medical conditions. In psychological factors af- 
fecting other medical conditions, specific psychological entities (e.g., psychological symp- 
toms, behaviors, other factors) exacerbate a medical condition. These psychological 
factors can precipitate, exacerbate, or put an individual at risk for medical illness, or they 
can worsen an existing condition. In contrast, an adjustment disorder is a reaction to the 
stressor (e.g., having a medical illness). 


Normative stress reactions. When bad things happen, most people get upset. This is 
not an adjustment disorder. The diagnosis should only be made when the magnitude of 
the distress (e.g., alterations in mood, anxiety, or conduct) exceeds what would normally 
be expected (which may vary in different cultures) or when the adverse event precipitates 
functional impairment. 


Comorbidity 


Adjustment disorders can accompany most mental disorders and any medical disorder. 
Adjustment disorders can be diagnosed in addition to another mental disorder only if the 
latter does not explain the particular symptoms that occur in reaction to the stressor. For 
example, an individual may develop an adjustment disorder, with depressed mood, after 
losing a job and at the same time have a diagnosis of obsessive-compulsive disorder. Or, 
an individual may have a depressive or bipolar disorder and an adjustment disorder as 
long as the criteria for both are met. Adjustment disorders are common accompaniments 
of medical illness and may be the major psychological response to a medical disorder. 


Other Specified Trauma- and 
Stressor-Related Disorder 


309.89 (F43.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a trauma- and 

stressor-related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 

occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full 

criteria for any of the disorders in the trauma- and stressor-related disorders diagnostic 

class. The other specified trauma- and stressor-related disorder category is used in situa- 

tions in which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific reason that the presenta- 

tion does not meet the criteria for any specific trauma- and stressor-related disorder. This 

is done by recording “other specified trauma- and stressor-related disorder” followed by 

the specific reason (e.g., “persistent complex bereavement disorder’). 
Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 

include the following: 

1. Adjustment-like disorders with delayed onset of symptoms that occur more than 
3 months after the stressor. 

2. Adjustment-like disorders with prolonged duration of more than 6 months with- 
out prolonged duration of stressor. 

3. Ataque de nervios: See “Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress” in the Appendix. 

4. Other cultural syndromes: See “Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress” in the Ap- 
pendix. 

5. Persistent complex bereavement disorder: This disorder is characterized by severe 
and persistent grief and mourning reactions (see the chapter “Conditions for Further 
Study’). 


290 Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


Unspecified Trauma- and 
Stressor-Related Disorder 


309.9 (F43.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a trauma- and 
stressor-related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full cri- 
teria for any of the disorders in the trauma- and stressor-related disorders diagnostic class. 
The unspecified trauma- or stressor-related disorder category is used in situations in which 
the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for a specific 
trauma- and stressor-related disorder, and includes presentations in which there is insuffi- 
cient information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Dissociative 
Disorders 


Dissociative disordersS are characterized by a disruption of and/or discontinuity 
in the normal integration of consciousness, memory, identity, emotion, perception, body 
representation, motor control, and behavior. Dissociative symptoms can potentially dis- 
rupt every area of psychological functioning. This chapter includes dissociative identity 
disorder, dissociative amnesia, depersonalization/derealization disorder, other specified 
dissociative disorder, and unspecified dissociative disorder. 

Dissociative symptoms are experienced as a) unbidden intrusions into awareness and 
behavior, with accompanying losses of continuity in subjective experience (i.e., “positive” 
dissociative symptoms such as fragmentation of identity, depersonalization, and dereal- 
ization) and/or b) inability to access information or to control mental functions that nor- 
mally are readily amenable to access or control (i.e., “negative” dissociative symptoms such 
as amnesia). 

The dissociative disorders are frequently found in the aftermath of trauma, and many 
of the symptoms, including embarrassment and confusion about the symptoms or a desire 
to hide them, are influenced by the proximity to trauma. In DSM-5, the dissociative disor- 
ders are placed next to, but are not part of, the trauma- and stressor-related disorders, re- 
flecting the close relationship between these diagnostic classes. Both acute stress disorder 
and posttraumatic stress disorder contain dissociative symptoms, such as amnesia, flash- 
backs, numbing, and depersonalization/derealization. 

Depersonalization/derealization disorder is characterized by clinically significant persis- 
tent or recurrent depersonalization (i.e., experiences of unreality or detachment from one’s 
mind, self, or body) and/or derealization (i.e., experiences of unreality or detachment from 
one’s surroundings). These alterations of experience are accompanied by intact reality 
testing. There is no evidence of any distinction between individuals with predominantly 
depersonalization versus derealization symptoms. Therefore, individuals with this disor- 
der can have depersonalization, derealization, or both. 

Dissociative amnesia is characterized by an inability to recall autobiographical informa- 
tion. This amnesia may be localized (i.e., an event or period of time), selective (i.e., a specific 
aspect of an event), or generalized (i.e., identity and life history). Dissociative amnesia is fun- 
damentally an inability to recall autobiographical information that is inconsistent with nor- 
mal forgetting. It may or may not involve purposeful travel or bewildered wandering (i.e., 
fugue). Although some individuals with amnesia promptly notice that they have “lost time” 
or that they have a gap in their memory, most individuals with dissociative disorders are ini- 
tially unaware of their amnesias. For them, awareness of amnesia occurs only when personal 
identity is lost or when circumstances make these individuals aware that autobiographical 
information is missing (e.g., when they discover evidence of events they cannot recall or 
when others tell them or ask them about events they cannot recall). Until and unless this hap- 
pens, these individuals have “amnesia for their amnesia.” Amnesia is experienced as an es- 
sential feature of dissociative amnesia; individuals may experience localized or selective 
amnesia most commonly, or generalized amnesia rarely. Dissociative fugue is rare in per- 
sons with dissociative amnesia but common in dissociative identity disorder. 

Dissociative identity disorder is characterized by a) the presence of two or more distinct 
personality states or an experience of possession and b) recurrent episodes of amnesia. The 


291 


292 Dissociative Disorders 


fragmentation of identity may vary with culture (e.g., possession-form presentations) and cir- 
cumstance. Thus, individuals may experience discontinuities in identity and memory that 
may not be immediately evident to others or are obscured by attempts to hide dysfunction. In- 
dividuals with dissociative identity disorder experience a) recurrent, inexplicable intrusions 
into their conscious functioning and sense of self (e.g., voices; dissociated actions and speech; 
intrusive thoughts, emotions, and impulses), b) alterations of sense of self (e.g., attitudes, pref- 
erences, and feeling like one’s body or actions are not one’s own), c) odd changes of perception 
(e.g., depersonalization or derealization, such as feeling detached from one’s body while cut- 
ting), and d) intermittent functional neurological symptoms. Stress often produces transient 
exacerbation of dissociative symptoms that makes them more evident. 

The residual category of other specified dissociative disorder has seven examples: chronic 
or recurrent mixed dissociative symptoms that approach, but fall short of, the diagnostic cri- 
teria for dissociative identity disorder; dissociative states secondary to brainwashing or 
thought reform; two acute presentations, of less than 1 month’s duration, of mixed dissociative 
symptoms, one of which is also marked by the presence of psychotic symptoms; and three sin- 
gle-symptom dissociative presentations—dissociative trance, dissociative stupor or coma, and 
Ganser’s syndrome (the giving of approximate and vague answers). 


Dissociative Identity Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.14 (F44.81) 


A. Disruption of identity characterized by two or more distinct personality states, which 
may be described in some cultures as an experience of possession. The disruption in 
identity involves marked discontinuity in sense of self and sense of agency, accompa- 
nied by related alterations in affect, behavior, consciousness, memory, perception, 
cognition, and/or sensory-motor functioning. These signs and symptoms may be ob- 
served by others or reported by the individual. 

B. Recurrent gaps in the recall of everyday events, important personal information, and/ 
or traumatic events that are inconsistent with ordinary forgetting. 

C. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The disturbance is not a normal part of a broadly accepted cultural or religious practice. 
Note: In children, the symptoms are not better explained by imaginary playmates or 
other fantasy play. 

E. The symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., 
blackouts or chaotic behavior during alcohol intoxication) or another medical condition 
(e.g., complex partial seizures). 


Diagnostic Features 


The defining feature of dissociative identity disorder is the presence of two or more dis- 
tinct personality states or an experience of possession (Criterion A). The overtness or 
covertness of these personality states, however, varies as a function of psychological 
motivation, current level of stress, culture, internal conflicts and dynamics, and emotional 
resilience. Sustained periods of identity disruption may occur when psychosocial pres- 
sures are severe and/or prolonged. In many possession-form cases of dissociative identity 
disorder, and in a small proportion of non-possession-form cases, manifestations of alter- 
nate identities are highly overt. Most individuals with non-possession-form dissociative 
identity disorder do not overtly display their discontinuity of identity for long periods of 
time; only a small minority present to clinical attention with observable alternation of 


Dissociative Identity Disorder 293 


identities. When alternate personality states are not directly observed, the disorder can be 
identified by two clusters of symptoms: 1) sudden alterations or discontinuities in sense of 
self and sense of agency (Criterion A), and 2) recurrent dissociative amnesias (Criterion B). 

Criterion A symptoms are related to discontinuities of experience that can affect any 
aspect of an individual’s functioning. Individuals with dissociative identity disorder may 
report the feeling that they have suddenly become depersonalized observers of their 
“own” speech and actions, which they may feel powerless to stop (sense of self). Such in- 
dividuals may also report perceptions of voices (e.g., a child’s voice; crying; the voice of a 
spiritual being). In some cases, voices are experienced as multiple, perplexing, indepen- 
dent thought streams over which the individual experiences no control. Strong emotions, 
impulses, and even speech or other actions may suddenly emerge, without a sense of per- 
sonal ownership or control (sense of agency). These emotions and impulses are frequently 
reported as ego-dystonic and puzzling. Attitudes, outlooks, and personal preferences 
(e.g., about food, activities, dress) may suddenly shift and then shift back. Individuals may 
report that their bodies feel different (e.g., like a small child, like the opposite gender, huge 
and muscular). Alterations in sense of self and loss of personal agency may be accompa- 
nied by a feeling that these attitudes, emotions, and behaviors—even one’s body—are 
“not mine” and/or are “not under my control.” Although most Criterion A symptoms are 
subjective, many of these sudden discontinuities in speech, affect, and behavior can be wit- 
nessed by family, friends, or the clinician. Non-epileptic seizures and other conversion 
symptoms are prominent in some presentations of dissociative identity disorder, espe- 
cially in some non-Western settings. 

The dissociative amnesia of individuals with dissociative identity disorder manifests in 
three primary ways: as 1) gaps in remote memory of personal life events (e.g., periods of 
childhood or adolescence; some important life events, such as the death of a grandparent, 
getting married, giving birth); 2) lapses in dependable memory (e.g., of what happened 
today, of well-learned skills such as how to do their job, use a computer, read, drive); and 
3) discovery of evidence of their everyday actions and tasks that they do not recollect do- 
ing (e.g., finding unexplained objects in their shopping bags or among their possessions; 
finding perplexing writings or drawings that they must have created; discovering injuries; 
“coming to” in the midst of doing something). Dissociative fugues, wherein the person 
discovers dissociated travel, are common. Thus, individuals with dissociative identity dis- 
order may report that they have suddenly found themselves at the beach, at work, in a night- 
club, or somewhere at home (e.g., in the closet, on a bed or sofa, in the corner) with no 
memory of how they came to be there. Amnesia in individuals with dissociative identity dis- 
order is not limited to stressful or traumatic events; these individuals often cannot recall 
everyday events as well. 

Individuals with dissociative identity disorder vary in their awareness and attitude to- 
ward their amnesias. It is common for these individuals to minimize their amnestic symp- 
toms. Some of their amnestic behaviors may be apparent to others—as when these persons 
do not recall something they were witnessed to have done or said, when they cannot 
remember their own name, or when they do not recognize their spouse, children, or close 
friends. 

Possession-form identities in dissociative identity disorder typically manifest as be- 
haviors that appear as if a “spirit,” supernatural being, or outside person has taken control, 
such that the individual begins speaking or acting in a distinctly different manner. For ex- 
ample, an individual’s behavior may give the appearance that her identity has been 
replaced by the “ghost” of a girl who committed suicide in the same community years 
before, speaking and acting as though she were still alive. Or an individual may be “taken 
over” by a demon or deity, resulting in profound impairment, and demanding that the in- 
dividual or a relative be punished for a past act, followed by more subtle periods of iden- 
tity alteration. However, the majority of possession states around the world are normal, 
usually part of spiritual practice, and do not meet criteria for dissociative identity disor- 


294 Dissociative Disorders 


der. The identities that arise during possession-form dissociative identity disorder present 
recurrently, are unwanted and involuntary, cause clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment (Criterion C), and are not a normal part of a broadly accepted cultural or religious 
practice (Criterion D). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with dissociative identity disorder typically present with comorbid depression, 
anxiety, substance abuse, self-injury, non-epileptic seizures, or another common symp- 
tom. They often conceal, or are not fully aware of, disruptions in consciousness, amnesia, 
or other dissociative symptoms. Many individuals with dissociative identity disorder re- 
port dissociative flashbacks during which they undergo a sensory reliving of a previous 
event as though it were occurring in the present, often with a change of identity, a partial 
or complete loss of contact with or disorientation to current reality during the flashback, 
and a subsequent amnesia for the content of the flashback. Individuals with the disorder 
typically report multiple types of interpersonal maltreatment during childhood and adult- 
hood. Nonmaltreatment forms of overwhelming early life events, such as multiple long, 
painful, early-life medical procedures, also may be reported. Self-mutilation and suicidal 
behavior are frequent. On standardized measures, these individuals report higher levels 
of hypnotizability and dissociativity compared with other clinical groups and healthy con- 
trol subjects. Some individuals experience transient psychotic phenomena or episodes. 
Several brain regions have been implicated in the pathophysiology of dissociative identity 
disorder, including the orbitofrontal cortex, hippocampus, parahippocampal gyrus, and 
amygdala. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence of dissociative identity disorder among adults in a small U.S. 
community study was 1.5%. The prevalence across genders in that study was 1.6% for 
males and 1.4% for females. 


Development and Course 


Dissociative identity disorder is associated with overwhelming experiences, traumatic 
events, and/or abuse occurring in childhood. The full disorder may first manifest at al- 
most any age (from earliest childhood to late life). Dissociation in children may generate 
problems with memory, concentration, attachment, and traumatic play. Nevertheless, chil- 
dren usually do not present with identity changes; instead they present primarily with over- 
lap and interference among mental states (Criterion A phenomena), with symptoms related 
to discontinuities of experience. Sudden changes in identity during adolescence may ap- 
pear to be just adolescent turmoil or the early stages of another mental disorder. Older 
individuals may present to treatment with what appear to be late-life mood disorders, ob- 
sessive-compulsive disorder, paranoia, psychotic mood disorders, or even cognitive dis- 
orders due to dissociative amnesia. In some cases, disruptive affects and memories may 
increasingly intrude into awareness with advancing age. 

Psychological decompensation and overt changes in identity may be triggered by 1) re- 
moval from the traumatizing situation (e.g., through leaving home); 2) the individual’s 
children reaching the same age at which the individual was originally abused or trauma- 
tized; 3) later traumatic experiences, even seemingly inconsequential ones, like a minor 
motor vehicle accident; or 4) the death of, or the onset of a fatal illness in, their abuser(s). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Interpersonal physical and sexual abuse is associated with an increased 
risk of dissociative identity disorder. Prevalence of childhood abuse and neglect in the 


Dissociative Identity Disorder 295 


United States, Canada, and Europe among those with the disorder is about 90%. Other 
forms of traumatizing experiences, including childhood medical and surgical procedures, 
war, childhood prostitution, and terrorism, have been reported. 


Course modifiers. Ongoing abuse, later-life retraumatization, comorbidity with mental 
disorders, severe medical illness, and delay in appropriate treatment are associated with 
poorer prognosis. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Many features of dissociative identity disorder can be influenced by the individual’s cul- 
tural background. Individuals with this disorder may present with prominent medically 
unexplained neurological symptoms, such as non-epileptic seizures, paralyses, or sensory 
loss, in cultural settings where such symptoms are common. Similarly, in settings where 
normative possession is common (e.g., rural areas in the developing world, among certain 
religious groups in the United States and Europe), the fragmented identities may take the 
form of possessing spirits, deities, demons, animals, or mythical figures. Acculturation or 
prolonged intercultural contact may shape the characteristics of the other identities (e.g., 
identities in India may speak English exclusively and wear Western clothes). Possession- 
form dissociative identity disorder can be distinguished from culturally accepted posses- 
sion states in that the former is involuntary, distressing, uncontrollable, and often recur- 
rent or persistent; involves conflict between the individual and his or her surrounding 
family, social, or work milieu; and is manifested at times and in places that violate the 
norms of the culture or religion. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Females with dissociative identity disorder predominate in adult clinical settings but not 
in child clinical settings. Adult males with dissociative identity disorder may deny their 
symptoms and trauma histories, and this can lead to elevated rates of false negative di- 
agnosis. Females with dissociative identity disorder present more frequently with acute 
dissociative states (e.g., flashbacks, amnesia, fugue, functional neurological [conversion] 
symptoms, hallucinations, self-mutilation). Males commonly exhibit more criminal or vi- 
olent behavior than females; among males, common triggers of acute dissociative states in- 
clude combat, prison conditions, and physical or sexual assaults. 


Suicide Risk 


Over 70% of outpatients with dissociative identity disorder have attempted suicide; mul- 
tiple attempts are common, and other self-injurious behavior is frequent. Assessment of 
suicide risk may be complicated when there is amnesia for past suicidal behavior or when 
the presenting identity does not feel suicidal and is unaware that other dissociated iden- 
tities do. 


Functional Consequences of 
Dissociative Identity Disorder 


Impairment varies widely, from apparently minimal (e.g., in high-functioning profession- 
als) to profound. Regardless of level of disability, individuals with dissociative identity 
disorder commonly minimize the impact of their dissociative and posttraumatic symp- 
toms. The symptoms of higher-functioning individuals may impair their relational, mar- 
ital, family, and parenting functions more than their occupational and professional life 
(although the latter also may be affected). With appropriate treatment, many impaired in- 
dividuals show marked improvement in occupational and personal functioning. How- 
ever, some remain highly impaired in most activities of living. These individuals may only 
respond to treatment very slowly, with gradual reduction in or improved tolerance of 


296 Dissociative Disorders 


their dissociative and posttraumatic symptoms. Long-term supportive treatment may 
slowly increase these individuals’ ability to manage their symptoms and decrease use of 
more restrictive levels of care. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other specified dissociative disorder. The core of dissociative identity disorder is the 
division of identity, with recurrent disruption of conscious functioning and sense of self. 
This central feature is shared with one form of other specified dissociative disorder, which 
may be distinguished from dissociative identity disorder by the presence of chronic or re- 
current mixed dissociative symptoms that do not meet Criterion A for dissociative identity 
disorder or are not accompanied by recurrent amnesia. 


Major depressive disorder. Individuals with dissociative identity disorder are often de- 
pressed, and their symptoms may appear to meet the criteria for a major depressive episode. 
Rigorous assessment indicates that this depression in some cases does not meet full criteria for 
major depressive disorder. Other specified depressive disorder in individuals with dissocia- 
tive identity disorder often has an important feature: the depressed mood and cognitions fluc- 
tuate because they are experienced in some identity states but not others. 


Bipolar disorders. Individuals with dissociative identity disorder are often misdiag- 
nosed with a bipolar disorder, most often bipolar II disorder. The relatively rapid shifts in 
mood in individuals with this disorder—typically within minutes or hours, in contrast to 
the slower mood changes typically seen in individuals with bipolar disorders—are due to 
the rapid, subjective shifts in mood commonly reported across dissociative states, some- 
times accompanied by fluctuation in levels of activation. Furthermore, in dissociative 
identity disorder, elevated or depressed mood may be displayed in conjunction with overt 
identities, so one or the other mood may predominate for a relatively long period of time 
(often for days) or may shift within minutes. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder. Some traumatized individuals have both posttraumatic 
stress disorder (PTSD) and dissociative identity disorder. Accordingly, it is crucial to dis- 
tinguish between individuals with PTSD only and individuals who have both PTSD and 
dissociative identity disorder. This differential diagnosis requires that the clinician estab- 
lish the presence or absence of dissociative symptoms that are not characteristic of acute 
stress disorder or PTSD. Some individuals with PTSD manifest dissociative symptoms that 
also occur in dissociative identity disorder: 1) amnesia for some aspects of trauma, 2) dis- 
sociative flashbacks (i.e., reliving of the trauma, with reduced awareness of one’s current 
orientation), and 3) symptoms of intrusion and avoidance, negative alterations in cogni- 
tion and mood, and hyperarousal that are focused around the traumatic event. On the other 
hand, individuals with dissociative identity disorder manifest dissociative symptoms that 
are not a manifestation of PTSD: 1) amnesias for many everyday (i.e., nontraumatic) events, 
2) dissociative flashbacks that may be followed by amnesia for the content of the flashback, 
3) disruptive intrusions (unrelated to traumatic material) by dissociated identity states 
into the individual's sense of self and agency, and 4) infrequent, full-blown changes 
among different identity states. 


Psychotic disorders. Dissociative identity disorder may be confused with schizophre- 
nia or other psychotic disorders. The personified, internally communicative inner voices 
of dissociative identity disorder, especially of a child (e.g., “I hear a little girl crying ina 
closet and an angry man yelling at her”), may be mistaken for psychotic hallucinations. 
Dissociative experiences of identity fragmentation or possession, and of perceived loss of 
control over thoughts, feelings, impulses, and acts, may be confused with signs of formal 
thought disorder, such as thought insertion or withdrawal. Individuals with dissociative 
identity disorder may also report visual, tactile, olfactory, gustatory, and somatic halluci- 
nations, which are usually related to posttraumatic and dissociative factors, such as partial 


Dissociative Identity Disorder 297 


flashbacks. Individuals with dissociative identity disorder experience these symptoms as 
caused by alternate identities, do not have delusional explanations for the phenomena, 
and often describe the symptoms in a personified way (e.g., “I feel like someone else wants 
to cry with my eyes”). Persecutory and derogatory internal voices in dissociative identity 
disorder associated with depressive symptoms may be misdiagnosed as major depression 
with psychotic features. Chaotic identity change and acute intrusions that disrupt thought 
processes may be distinguished from brief psychotic disorder by the predominance of dis- 
sociative symptoms and amnesia for the episode, and diagnostic evaluation after cessation 
of the crisis can help confirm the diagnosis. 


Substance/medication-induced disorders. Symptoms associated with the physiological 
effects of a substance can be distinguished from dissociative identity disorder if the sub- 
stance in question is judged to be etiologically related to the disturbance. 


Personality disorders. Individuals with dissociative identity disorder often present identi- 
ties that appear to encapsulate a variety of severe personality disorder features, suggesting a 
differential diagnosis of personality disorder, especially of the borderline type. Importantly, 
however, the individual’s longitudinal variability in personality style (due to inconsistency 
among identities) differs from the pervasive and persistent dysfunction in affect management 
and interpersonal relationships typical of those with personality disorders. 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder). This disorder may be 
distinguished from dissociative identity disorder by the absence of an identity disruption 
characterized by two or more distinct personality states or an experience of possession. 
Dissociative amnesia in conversion disorder is more limited and circumscribed (e.g., am- 
nesia for a non-epileptic seizure). 


Seizure disorders. Individuals with dissociative identity disorder may present with sei- 
zurelike symptoms and behaviors that resemble complex partial seizures with temporal 
lobe foci. These include déja vu, jamais vu, depersonalization, derealization, out-of-body 
experiences, amnesia, disruptions of consciousness, hallucinations, and other intrusion 
phenomena of sensation, affect, and thought. Normal electroencephalographic findings, 
including telemetry, differentiate non-epileptic seizures from the seizurelike symptoms of 
dissociative identity disorder. Also, individuals with dissociative identity disorder obtain 
very high dissociation scores, whereas individuals with complex partial seizures do not. 


Factitious disorder and malingering. Individuals who feign dissociative identity disor- 
der do not report the subtle symptoms of intrusion characteristic of the disorder; instead 
they tend to overreport well-publicized symptoms of the disorder, such as dissociative 
amnesia, while underreporting less-publicized comorbid symptoms, such as depression. 
Individuals who feign dissociative identity disorder tend to be relatively undisturbed by 
or may even seem to enjoy “having” the disorder. In contrast, individuals with genuine 
dissociative identity disorder tend to be ashamed of and overwhelmed by their symptoms 
and to underreport their symptoms or deny their condition. Sequential observation, cor- 
roborating history, and intensive psychometric and psychological assessment may be 
helpful in assessment. 

Individuals who malinger dissociative identity disorder usually create limited, stereo- 
typed alternate identities, with feigned amnesia, related to the events for which gain is 
sought. For example, they may present an “all-good” identity and an “all-bad” identity in 
hopes of gaining exculpation for a crime. 


Comorbidity 


Many individuals with dissociative identity disorder present with a comorbid disorder. If 
not assessed and treated specifically for the dissociative disorder, these individuals often 
receive prolonged treatment for the comorbid diagnosis only, with limited overall treat- 
ment response and resultant demoralization, and disability. 


298 Dissociative Disorders 


Individuals with dissociative identity disorder usually exhibit a large number of co- 
morbid disorders. In particular, most develop PTSD. Other disorders that are highly co- 
morbid with dissociative identity disorder include depressive disorders, trauma- and 
stressor-related disorders, personality disorders (especially avoidant and borderline per- 
sonality disorders), conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), 
somatic symptom disorder, eating disorders, substance-related disorders, obsessive- 
compulsive disorder, and sleep disorders. Dissociative alterations in identity, memory, 
and consciousness may affect the symptom presentation of comorbid disorders. 


Dissociative Amnesia 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.12 (F44.0) 


A. An inability to recall important autobiographical information, usually of a traumatic or 
stressful nature, that is inconsistent with ordinary forgetting. 

Note: Dissociative amnesia most often consists of localized or selective amnesia for a 
specific event or events; or generalized amnesia for identity and life history. 

B. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

C. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., al- 
cohol or other drug of abuse, a medication) or a neurological or other medical condition 
(e.g., partial complex seizures, transient global amnesia, sequelae of a closed head in- 
jury/traumatic brain injury, other neurological condition). 

D. The disturbance is not better explained by dissociative identity disorder, posttraumatic 
stress disorder, acute stress disorder, somatic symptom disorder, or major or mild neu- 
rocognitive disorder. 


Coding note: The code for dissociative amnesia without dissociative fugue is 300.12 
(F44.0). The code for dissociative amnesia with dissociative fugue is 300.13 (F44.1). 


Specity if: 
300.13 (F44.1) With dissociative fugue: Apparently purposeful travel or bewildered 
wandering that is associated with amnesia for identity or for other important autobio- 
graphical information. 


Diagnostic Features 


The defining characteristic of dissociative amnesia is an inability to recall important auto- 
biographical information that 1) should be successfully stored in memory and 2) ordinar- 
ily would be readily remembered (Criterion A). Dissociative amnesia differs from the 
permanent amnesias due to neurobiological damage or toxicity that prevent memory stor- 
age or retrieval in that it is always potentially reversible because the memory has been suc- 
cessfully stored. 

Localized amnesia, a failure to recall events during a circumscribed period of time, is the 
most common form of dissociative amnesia. Localized amnesia may be broader than am- 
nesia for a single traumatic event (e.g., months or years associated with child abuse or in- 
tense combat). In selective amnesia, the individual can recall some, but not all, of the events 
during a circumscribed period of time. Thus, the individual may remember part of a trau- 
matic event but not other parts. Some individuals report both localized and selective am- 
nesias. 

Generalized amnesia, a complete loss of memory for one’s life history, is rare. Individuals 
with generalized amnesia may forget personal identity. Some lose previous knowledge 
about the world (i.e., semantic knowledge) and can no longer access well-learned skills 


Dissociative Amnesia 299 


(i.e., procedural knowledge). Generalized amnesia has an acute onset; the perplexity, dis- 
orientation, and purposeless wandering of individuals with generalized amnesia usually 
bring them to the attention of the police or psychiatric emergency services. Generalized 
amnesia may be more common among combat veterans, sexual assault victims, and indi- 
viduals experiencing extreme emotional stress or conflict. 

Individuals with dissociative amnesia are frequently unaware (or only partially aware) 
of their memory problems. Many, especially those with localized amnesia, minimize the 
importance of their memory loss and may become uncomfortable when prompted to ad- 
dress it. In systematized amnesia, the individual loses memory for a specific category of in- 
formation (e.g., all memories relating to one’s family, a particular person, or childhood 
sexual abuse). In continuous amnesia, an individual forgets each new event as it occurs. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Many individuals with dissociative amnesia are chronically impaired in their ability to 
form and sustain satisfactory relationships. Histories of trauma, child abuse, and victim- 
ization are common. Some individuals with dissociative amnesia report dissociative flash- 
backs (i.e., behavioral reexperiencing of traumatic events). Many have a history of self- 
mutilation, suicide attempts, and other high-risk behaviors. Depressive and functional 
neurological symptoms are common, as are depersonalization, auto-hypnotic symptoms, 
and high hypnotizability. Sexual dysfunctions are common. Mild traumatic brain injury 
may precede dissociative amnesia. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence for dissociative amnesia among adults in a small U.S. commu- 
nity study was 1.8% (1.0% for males; 2.6% for females). 


Development and Course 


Onset of generalized amnesia is usually sudden. Less is known about the onset of localized 
and selective amnesias because these amnesias are seldom evident, even to the individual. 
Although overwhelming or intolerable events typically precede localized amnesia, its on- 
set may be delayed for hours, days, or longer. 

Individuals may report multiple episodes of dissociative amnesia. A single episode 
may predispose to future episodes. In between episodes of amnesia, the individual may or 
may not appear to be acutely symptomatic. The duration of the forgotten events can range 
from minutes to decades. Some episodes of dissociative amnesia resolve rapidly (e.g., 
when the person is removed from combat or some other stressful situation), whereas other 
episodes persist for long periods of time. Some individuals may gradually recall the dis- 
sociated memories years later. Dissociative capacities may decline with age, but not al- 
ways. As the amnesia remits, there may be considerable distress, suicidal behavior, and 
symptoms of posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD). 

Dissociative amnesia has been observed in young children, adolescents, and adults. 
Children may be the most difficult to evaluate because they often have difficulty under- 
standing questions about amnesia, and interviewers may find it difficult to formulate child- 
friendly questions about memory and amnesia. Observations of apparent dissociative am- 
nesia are often difficult to differentiate from inattention, absorption, anxiety, oppositional 
behavior, and learning disorders. Reports from several different sources (e.g., teacher, 
therapist, case worker) may be needed to diagnose amnesia in children. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Single or repeated traumatic experiences (e.g., war, childhood maltreat- 
ment, natural disaster, internment in concentration camps, genocide) are common ante- 


300 Dissociative Disorders 


cedents. Dissociative amnesia is more likely to occur with 1) a greater number of adverse 
childhood experiences, particularly physical and/or sexual abuse, 2) interpersonal vio- 
lence; and 3) increased severity, frequency, and violence of the trauma. 


Genetic and physiological. There are no genetic studies of dissociative amnesia. Stud- 
ies of dissociation report significant genetic and environmental factors in both clinical and 
nonclinical samples. 


Course modifiers. Removal from the traumatic circumstances underlying the dissociative 
amnesia (e.g., combat) may bring about a rapid return of memory. The memory loss of indi- 
viduals with dissociative fugue may be particularly refractory. Onset of PTSD symptoms may 
decrease localized, selective, or systematized amnesia. The returning memory, however, may 
be experienced as flashbacks that alternate with amnesia for the content of the flashbacks. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In Asia, the Middle East, and Latin America, non-epileptic seizures and other functional 
neurological symptoms may accompany dissociative amnesia. In cultures with highly re- 
strictive social traditions, the precipitants of dissociative amnesia often do not involve 
frank trauma. Instead, the amnesia is preceded by severe psychological stresses or con- 
flicts (e.g., marital conflict, other family disturbances, attachment problems, conflicts due 
to restriction or oppression). 


Suicide Risk 


Suicidal and other self-destructive behaviors are common in individuals with dissociative 
amnesia. Suicidal behavior may be a particular risk when the amnesia remits suddenly 
and overwhelms the individual with intolerable memories. 


Functional Consequences of Dissociative Amnesia 


The impairment of individuals with localized, selective, or systematized dissociative am- 
nesia ranges from limited to severe. Individuals with chronic generalized dissociative am- 
nesia usually have impairment in all aspects of functioning. Even when these individuals 
“re-learn” aspects of their life history, autobiographical memory remains very impaired. 
Most become vocationally and interpersonally disabled. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Dissociative identity disorder. Individuals with dissociative amnesia may report de- 
personalization and auto-hypnotic symptoms. Individuals with dissociative identity dis- 
order report pervasive discontinuities in sense of self and agency, accompanied by many 
other dissociative symptoms. The amnesias of individuals with localized, selective, and/ 
or systematized dissociative amnesias are relatively stable. Amnesias in dissociative iden- 
tity disorder include amnesia for everyday events, finding of unexplained possessions, 
sudden fluctuations in skills and knowledge, major gaps in recall of life history, and brief 
amnesic gaps in interpersonal interactions. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder. Some individuals with PTSD cannot recall part or all of 
a specific traumatic event (e.g., a rape victim with depersonalization and/or derealization 
symptoms who cannot recall most events for the entire day of the rape). When that amne- 
sia extends beyond the immediate time of the trauma, a comorbid diagnosis of dissociative 
amnesia is warranted. 


Neurocognitive disorders. In neurocognitive disorders, memory loss for personal infor- 
mation is usually embedded in cognitive, linguistic, affective, attentional, and behavioral 


Dissociative Amnesia 301 


disturbances. In dissociative amnesia, memory deficits are primarily for autobiographical 
information; intellectual and cognitive abilities are preserved. 


Substance-related disorders. In the context of repeated intoxication with alcohol or 
other substances / medications, there may be episodes of “black outs” or periods for which the 
individual has no memory. To aid in distinguishing these episodes from dissociative am- 
nesia, a longitudinal history noting that the amnestic episodes occur only in the context of 
intoxication and do not occur in other situations would help identify the source as sub- 
stance-induced; however the distinction may be difficult when the individual with dis- 
sociative amnesia may also misuse alcohol or other substances in the context of stressful 
situations that may also exacerbate dissociative symptoms. Some individuals with comor- 
bid dissociative amnesia and substance use disorders will attribute their memory prob- 
lems solely to the substance use. Prolonged use of alcohol or other substances may result in 
a substance-induced neurocognitive disorder that may be associated with impaired cog- 
nitive function, but in this context the protracted history of substance use and the persis- 
tent deficits associated with the neurocognitive disorder would serve to distinguish it 
from dissociative amnesia, where there is typically no evidence of persistent impairment in 
intellectual functioning. 


Posttraumatic amnesia due to brain injury. Amnesia may occur in the context of a trau- 
matic brain injury (TBI) when there has been an impact to the head or other mechanisms of 
rapid movement or displacement of the brain within the skull TBI. Other characteristics of 
TBI include loss of consciousness, disorientation and confusion, or, in more severe cases, 
neurological signs (e.g., abnormalities on neuroimaging, a new onset of seizures or a marked 
worsening of a preexisting seizure disorder, visual field cuts, anosmia). A neurocognitive 
disorder attributable to TBI must present either immediately after brain injury occurs or im- 
mediately after the individual recovers consciousness after the injury, and persist past the 
acute post-injury period. The cognitive presentation of a neurocognitive disorder following 
TBI is variable and includes difficulties in the domains of complex attention, executive func- 
tion, learning and memory as well as slowed speed of information processing and distur- 
bances in social cognition. These additional features help distinguish it from dissociative 
amnesia. 


Seizure disorders. Individuals with seizure disorders may exhibit complex behavior dur- 
ing seizures or post-ictally with subsequent amnesia. Some individuals with a seizure disorder 
engage in nonpurposive wandering that is limited to the period of seizure activity. Con- 
versely, behavior during a dissociative fugue is usually purposeful, complex, and goal- 
directed and may last for days, weeks, or longer. Occasionally, individuals with a seizure dis- 
order will report that earlier autobiographical memories have been “wiped out” as the seizure 
disorder progresses. Such memory loss is not associated with traumatic circumstances and ap- 
pears to occur randomly. Serial electroencephalograms usually show abnormalities. Telemet- 
ric electroencephalographic monitoring usually shows an association between the episodes of 
amnesia and seizure activity. Dissociative and epileptic amnesias may coexist. 


Catatonic stupor. Mutism in catatonic stupor may suggest dissociative amnesia, but fail- 
ure of recall is absent. Other catatonic symptoms (e.g., rigidity, posturing, negativism) are 
usually present. 


Factitious disorder and malingering. There is no test, battery of tests, or set of procedures 
that invariably distinguishes dissociative amnesia from feigned amnesia. Individuals with 
factitious disorder or malingering have been noted to continue their deception even during 
hypnotic or barbiturate-facilitated interviews. Feigned amnesia is more common in individ- 
uals with 1) acute, florid dissociative amnesia; 2) financial, sexual, or legal problems; or 3) a 
wish to escape stressful circumstances. True amnesia can be associated with those same cir- 
cumstances. Many individuals who malinger confess spontaneously or when confronted. 


302 Dissociative Disorders 


Normal and age-related changes in memory. Memory decrements in major and mild 
neurocognitive disorders differ from those of dissociative amnesia, which are usually as- 
sociated with stressful events and are more specific, extensive, and/or complex. 


Comorbidity 


As dissociative amnesia begins to remit, a wide variety of affective phenomena may sur- 
face: dysphoria, grief, rage, shame, guilt, psychological conflict and turmoil, and suicidal 
and homicidal ideation, impulses, and acts. These individuals may have symptoms that 
then meet diagnostic criteria for persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia); major de- 
pressive disorder; other specified or unspecified depressive disorder; adjustment disor- 
der, with depressed mood; or adjustment disorder, with mixed disturbance of emotions 
and conduct. Many individuals with dissociative amnesia develop PTSD at some point 
during their life, especially when the traumatic antecedents of their amnesia are brought 
into conscious awareness. 

Many individuals with dissociative amnesia have symptoms that meet diagnostic cri- 
teria for a comorbid somatic symptom or related disorder (and vice versa), including so- 
matic symptom disorder and conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom 
disorder). Many individuals with dissociative amnesia have symptoms that meet diagnos- 
tic criteria for a personality disorder, especially dependent, avoidant, and borderline. 


Depersonalization/Derealization Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.6 (F48.1) 


A. The presence of persistent or recurrent experiences of depersonalization, derealiza- 
tion, or both: 


1. Depersonalization: Experiences of unreality, detachment, or being an outside ob- 
server with respect to one’s thoughts, feelings, sensations, body, or actions (e.g., 
perceptual alterations, distorted sense of time, unreal or absent self, emotional and/ 
or physical numbing). 

2. Derealization: Experiences of unreality or detachment with respect to surround- 
ings (e.g., individuals or objects are experienced as unreal, dreamlike, foggy, life- 
less, or visually distorted). 


B. During the depersonalization or derealization experiences, reality testing remains intact. 

C. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, medication) or another medical condition (e.g., seizures). 

E. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder, such as schizo- 
phrenia, panic disorder, major depressive disorder, acute stress disorder, posttrau- 
matic stress disorder, or another dissociative disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of depersonalization/derealization disorder are persistent or recur- 
rent episodes of depersonalization, derealization, or both. Episodes of depersonalization 
are characterized by a feeling of unreality or detachment from, or unfamiliarity with, one’s 
whole self or from aspects of the self (Criterion A1). The individual may feel detached 
from his or her entire being (e.g., “Iam no one,” “I have no self”). He or she may also feel 
subjectively detached from aspects of the self, including feelings (e.g., hypoemotionality: 


Depersonalization/Derealization Disorder 303 


“T know [ have feelings but I don’t feel them”), thoughts (e.g., “My thoughts don’t feel like 
my own,” “head filled with cotton”), whole body or body parts, or sensations (e.g., touch, 
proprioception, hunger, thirst, libido). There may also be a diminished sense of agency 
(e.g., feeling robotic, like an automaton; lacking control of one’s speech or movements). 
The depersonalization experience can sometimes be one of a split self, with one part ob- 
serving and one participating, known as an “out-of-body experience” in its most extreme 
form. The unitary symptom of “depersonalization” consists of several symptom factors: 
anomalous body experiences (i.e., unreality of the self and perceptual alterations); emo- 
tional or physical numbing; and temporal distortions with anomalous subjective recall. 

Episodes of derealization are characterized by a feeling of unreality or detachment 
from, or unfamiliarity with, the world, be it individuals, inanimate objects, or all surround- 
ings (Criterion A2). The individual may feel as if he or she were in a fog, dream, or bubble, or 
as if there were a veil or a glass wall between the individual and world around. Surround- 
ings may be experienced as artificial, colorless, or lifeless. Derealization is commonly ac- 
companied by subjective visual distortions, such as blurriness, heightened acuity, widened 
or narrowed visual field, two-dimensionality or flatness, exaggerated three-dimensional- 
ity, or altered distance or size of objects (i.e., macropsia or micropsia). Auditory distortions 
can also occur, whereby voices or sounds are muted or heightened. In addition, Criterion 
C requires the presence of clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning, and Criteria D and E describe exclusionary 
diagnoses. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with depersonalization/derealization disorder may have difficulty describ- 
ing their symptoms and may think they are “crazy” or “going crazy”. Another common 
experience is the fear of irreversible brain damage. A commonly associated symptom is a 
subjectively altered sense of time (i.e., too fast or too slow), as well as a subjective difficulty 
in vividly recalling past memories and owning them as personal and emotional. Vague so- 
matic symptoms, such as head fullness, tingling, or lightheadedness, are not uncommon. 
Individuals may suffer extreme rumination or obsessional preoccupation (e.g., constantly 
obsessing about whether they really exist, or checking their perceptions to determine 
whether they appear real). Varying degrees of anxiety and depression are also common as- 
sociated features. Individuals with the disorder have been found to have physiological 
hyporeactivity to emotional stimuli. Neural substrates of interest include the hypotha- 
lamic-pituitary-adrenocortical axis, inferior parietal lobule, and prefrontal cortical-limbic 
circuits. 


Prevalence 


Transient depersonalization/derealization symptoms lasting hours to days are common 
in the general population. The 12-month prevalence of depersonalization/derealization 
disorder is thought to be markedly less than for transient symptoms, although precise es- 
timates for the disorder are unavailable. In general, approximately one-half of all adults 
have experienced at least one lifetime episode of depersonalization/derealization. How- 
ever, symptomatology that meets full criteria for depersonalization/derealization disor- 
der is markedly less common than transient symptoms. Lifetime prevalence in U.S. and 
non-U.S. countries is approximately 2% (range of 0.8% to 2.8%). The gender ratio for the 
disorder is 1:1. 


Development and Course 


The mean age at onset of depersonalization/derealization disorder is 16 years, although the 
disorder can start in early or middle childhood; a minority cannot recall ever not having had 


304 Dissociative Disorders 


the symptoms. Less than 20% of individuals experience onset after age 20 years and only 
5% after age 25 years. Onset in the fourth decade of life or later is highly unusual. Onset can 
range from extremely sudden to gradual. Duration of depersonalization/derealization 
disorder episodes can vary greatly, from brief (hours or days) to prolonged (weeks, 
months, or years). Given the rarity of disorder onset after age 40 years, in such cases the in- 
dividual should be examined more closely for underlying medical conditions (e.g., brain 
lesions, seizure disorders, sleep apnea). The course of the disorder is often persistent. 
About one-third of cases involve discrete episodes; another third, continuous symptoms 
from the start; and still another third, an initially episodic course that eventually becomes 
continuous. 

While in some individuals the intensity of symptoms can wax and wane considerably, 
others report an unwavering level of intensity that in extreme cases can be constantly pres- 
ent for years or decades. Internal and external factors that affect symptom intensity vary 
between individuals, yet some typical patterns are reported. Exacerbations can be trig- 
gered by stress, worsening mood or anxiety symptoms, novel or overstimulating settings, 
and physical factors such as lighting or lack of sleep. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Individuals with depersonalization/derealization disorder are charac- 
terized by harm-avoidant temperament, immature defenses, and both disconnection and 
overconnection schemata. Immature defenses such as idealization/ devaluation, projec- 
tion and acting out result in denial of reality and poor adaptation. Cognitive disconnection 
schemata reflect defectiveness and emotional inhibition and subsume themes of abuse, ne- 
glect, and deprivation. Overconnection schemata involve impaired autonomy with themes 
of dependency, vulnerability, and incompetence. 


Environmental. There is a clear association between the disorder and childhood interper- 
sonal traumas in a substantial portion of individuals, although this association is not as prev- 
alent or as extreme in the nature of the traumas as in other dissociative disorders, such as 
dissociative identity disorder. In particular, emotional abuse and emotional neglect have been 
most strongly and consistently associated with the disorder. Other stressors can include phys- 
ical abuse; witnessing domestic violence; growing up with a seriously impaired, mentally ill 
parent; or unexpected death or suicide of a family member or close friend. Sexual abuse is a 
much less common antecedent but can be encountered. The most common proximal precipi- 
tants of the disorder are severe stress (interpersonal, financial, occupational), depression, anx- 
iety (particularly panic attacks), and illicit drug use. Symptoms may be specifically induced by 
substances such as tetrahydrocannabinol, hallucinogens, ketamine, MDMA (3,4-methylene- 
dioxymethamphetamine; “ecstasy”) and salvia. Marijuana use may precipitate new-onset 
panic attacks and depersonalization/derealization symptoms simultaneously. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 

Volitionally induced experiences of depersonalization/derealization can be a part of med- 
itative practices that are prevalent in many religions and cultures and should not be diag- 
nosed as a disorder. However, there are individuals who initially induce these states 
intentionally but over time lose control over them and may develop a fear and aversion for 
related practices. 


Functional Consequences of 
Depersonalization/Derealization Disorder 


Symptoms of depersonalization/derealization disorder are highly distressing and are as- 
sociated with major morbidity. The affectively flattened and robotic demeanor that these 


Depersonalization/Derealization Disorder 305 


individuals often demonstrate may appear incongruent with the extreme emotional pain 
reported by those with the disorder. Impairment is often experienced in both interpersonal 
and occupational spheres, largely due to the hypoemotionality with others, subjective diffi- 
culty in focusing and retaining information, and a general sense of disconnectedness from 
life. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Illness anxiety disorder. Although individuals with depersonalization/derealization dis- 
order can present with vague somatic complaints as well as fears of permanent brain dam- 
age, the diagnosis of depersonalization/derealization disorder is characterized by the 
presence of a constellation of typical depersonalization /derealization symptoms and the ab- 
sence of other manifestations of illness anxiety disorder. 


Major depressive disorder. Feelings of numbness, deadness, apathy, and being ina 
dream are not uncommon in major depressive episodes. However, in depersonalization/ 
derealization disorder, such symptoms are associated with further symptoms of the dis- 
order. If the depersonalization/derealization clearly precedes the onset of a major depres- 
sive episode or clearly continues after its resolution, the diagnosis of depersonalization/ 
derealization disorder applies. 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. Some individuals with depersonalization/dereal- 
ization disorder can become obsessively preoccupied with their subjective experience or 
develop rituals checking on the status of their symptoms. However, other symptoms of 
obsessive-compulsive disorder unrelated to depersonalization/derealization are not 
present. 


Other dissociative disorders. In order to diagnose depersonalization/derealization 
disorder, the symptoms should not occur in the context of another dissociative disorder, 
such as dissociative identity disorder. Differentiation from dissociative amnesia and con- 
version disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder) is simpler, as the symptoms 
of these disorders do not overlap with those of depersonalization/derealization disorder. 


Anxiety disorders. Depersonalization/derealization is one of the symptoms of panic at- 
tacks, increasingly common as panic attack severity increases. Therefore, depersonal- 
ization/derealization disorder should not be diagnosed when the symptoms occur only 
during panic attacks that are part of panic disorder, social anxiety disorder, or specific 
phobia. In addition, it is not uncommon for depersonalization/derealization symptoms 
to first begin in the context of new-onset panic attacks or as panic disorder progresses and 
worsens. In such presentations, the diagnosis of depersonalization/derealization disorder 
can be made if 1) the depersonalization/derealization component of the presentation is 
very prominent from the start, clearly exceeding in duration and intensity the occurrence 
of actual panic attacks; or 2) the depersonalization/derealization continues after panic dis- 
order has remitted or has been successfully treated. 


Psychotic disorders. The presence of intact reality testing specifically regarding the 
depersonalization/derealization symptoms is essential to differentiating depersonal- 
ization/derealization disorder from psychotic disorders. Rarely, positive-symptom 
schizophrenia can pose a diagnostic challenge when nihilistic delusions are present. For 
example, an individual may complain that he or she is dead or the world is not real; this 
could be either a subjective experience that the individual knows is not true or a delusional 
conviction. 


Substance/medication-induced disorders. Depersonalization/derealization associated 
with the physiological effects of substances during acute intoxication or withdrawal is not 
diagnosed as depersonalization/derealization disorder. The most common precipitating 
substances are the illicit drugs marijuana, hallucinogens, ketamine, ecstasy, and salvia. In 


306 Dissociative Disorders 


about 15% of all cases of depersonalization/derealization disorder, the symptoms are pre- 
cipitated by ingestion of such substances. If the symptoms persist for some time in the ab- 
sence of any further substance or medication use, the diagnosis of depersonalization/ 
derealization disorder applies. This diagnosis is usually easy to establish since the vast ma- 
jority of individuals with this presentation become highly phobic and aversive to the trig- 
gering substance and do not use it again. 


Mental disorders due to another medical condition. Features such as onset after age 
40 years or the presence of atypical symptoms and course in any individual suggest the 
possibility of an underlying medical condition. In such cases, it is essential to conduct a 
thorough medical and neurological evaluation, which may include standard laboratory 
studies, viral titers, an electroencephalogram, vestibular testing, visual testing, sleep stud- 
ies, and/or brain imaging. When the suspicion of an underlying seizure disorder proves 
difficult to confirm, an ambulatory electroencephalogram may be indicated; although 
temporal lobe epilepsy is most commonly implicated, parietal and frontal lobe epilepsy 
may also be associated. 


Comorbidity 


In a convenience sample of adults recruited for a number of depersonalization research 
studies, lifetime comorbidities were high for unipolar depressive disorder and for any 
anxiety disorder, with a significant proportion of the sample having both disorders. Comor- 
bidity with posttraumatic stress disorder was low. The three most commonly co-occurring 
personality disorders were avoidant, borderline, and obsessive-compulsive. 


Other Specified Dissociative Disorder 
300.15 (F44.89) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a dissociative 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the dissociative disorders diagnostic class. The other specified dissocia- 
tive disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate 
the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific disso- 
ciative disorder. This is done by recording “other specified dissociative disorder” followed 
by the specific reason (e.g., “dissociative trance”). 

Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 

1. Chronic and recurrent syndromes of mixed dissociative symptoms: This cate- 
gory includes identity disturbance associated with less-than-marked discontinuities in 
sense of self and agency, or alterations of identity or episodes of possession in an in- 
dividual who reports no dissociative amnesia. 

2. Identity disturbance due to prolonged and intense coercive persuasion: Individ- 
uals who have been subjected to intense coercive persuasion (e.g., brainwashing, 
thought reform, indoctrination while captive, torture, long-term political imprisonment, 
recruitment by sects/cults or by terror organizations) may present with prolonged 
changes in, or conscious questioning of, their identity. 

3. Acute dissociative reactions to stressful events: This category is for acute, tran- 
sient conditions that typically last less than 1 month, and sometimes only a few hours 
or days. These conditions are characterized by constriction of consciousness; deper- 
sonalization; derealization; perceptual disturbances (e.g., time slowing, macropsia); 


Unspecified Dissociative Disorder 307 


micro-amnesias; transient stupor; and/or alterations in sensory-motor functioning (e.g., 
analgesia, paralysis). 

4. Dissociative trance: This condition is characterized by an acute narrowing or com- 
plete loss of awareness of immediate surroundings that manifests as profound unre- 
sponsiveness or insensitivity to environmental stimuli. The unresponsiveness may be 
accompanied by minor stereotyped behaviors (e.g., finger movements) of which the in- 
dividual is unaware and/or that he or she cannot control, as well as transient paralysis 
or loss of consciousness. The dissociative trance is not a normal part of a broadly ac- 
cepted collective cultural or religious practice. 


Unspecified Dissociative Disorder 
300.15 (F44.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a dissociative 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the dissociative disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified dissociative 
disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the rea- 
son that the criteria are not met for a specific dissociative disorder, and includes presen- 
tations for which there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., 
in emergency room settings). 


This page intentionally left blank 


Somatic Symptom and 
Related Disorders 


Somatic symptom disorder and other disorders with prominent somatic symp- 
toms constitute a new category in DSM-5 called somatic symptom and related disorders. This 
chapter includes the diagnoses of somatic symptom disorder, illness anxiety disorder, con- 
version disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), psychological factors affect- 
ing other medical conditions, factitious disorder, other specified somatic symptom and 
related disorder, and unspecified somatic symptom and related disorder. All of the disor- 
ders in this chapter share a common feature: the prominence of somatic symptoms associ- 
ated with significant distress and impairment. Individuals with disorders with prominent 
somatic symptoms are commonly encountered in primary care and other medical settings 
but are less commonly encountered in psychiatric and other mental health settings. These 
reconceptualized diagnoses, based on a reorganization of DSM-IV somatoform disorder di- 
agnoses, are more useful for primary care and other medical (nonpsychiatric) clinicians. 

The major diagnosis in this diagnostic class, somatic symptom disorder, emphasizes 
diagnosis made on the basis of positive symptoms and signs (distressing somatic symp- 
toms plus abnormal thoughts, feelings, and behaviors in response to these symptoms) 
rather than the absence of a medical explanation for somatic symptoms. A distinctive char- 
acteristic of many individuals with somatic symptom disorder is not the somatic symp- 
toms per se, but instead the way they present and interpret them. Incorporating affective, 
cognitive, and behavioral components into the criteria for somatic symptom disorder pro- 
vides a more comprehensive and accurate reflection of the true clinical picture than can be 
achieved by assessing the somatic complaints alone. 

The principles behind the changes in the somatic symptom and related diagnoses from 
DSM-IV are crucial in understanding the DSM-5 diagnoses. The DSM-IV term somatoform 
disorders was confusing and is replaced by somatic symptom and related disorders. In DSM-IV 
there was a great deal of overlap across the somatoform disorders and a lack of clarity 
about the boundaries of diagnoses. Although individuals with these disorders primarily 
present in medical rather than mental health settings, nonpsychiatric physicians found the 
DSM-IV somatoform diagnoses difficult to understand and use. The current DSM-5 clas- 
sification recognizes this overlap by reducing the total number of disorders as well as their 
subcategories. 

The previous criteria overemphasized the centrality of medically unexplained symptoms. 
Such symptoms are present to various degrees, particularly in conversion disorder, but so- 
matic symptom disorders can also accompany diagnosed medical disorders. The reli- 
ability of determining that a somatic symptom is medically unexplained is limited, and 
grounding a diagnosis on the absence of an explanation is problematic and reinforces 
mind-body dualism. It is not appropriate to give an individual a mental disorder diagnosis 
solely because a medical cause cannot be demonstrated. Furthermore, the presence of a 
medical diagnosis does not exclude the possibility of a comorbid mental disorder, includ- 
ing a somatic symptom and related disorder. Perhaps because of the predominant focus 
on lack of medical explanation, individuals regarded these diagnoses as pejorative and de- 
meaning, implying that their physical symptoms were not “real.” The new classification 
defines the major diagnosis, somatic symptom disorder, on the basis of positive symptoms 
(distressing somatic symptoms plus abnormal thoughts, feelings, and behaviors in response 


309 


310 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


to these symptoms). However, medically unexplained symptoms remain a key feature in 
conversion disorder and pseudocyesis (other specified somatic symptom and related dis- 
order) because it is possible to demonstrate definitively in such disorders that the symp- 
toms are not consistent with medical pathophysiology. 

Itis important to note that some other mental disorders may initially manifest with pri- 
marily somatic symptoms (e.g., major depressive disorder, panic disorder). Such diagno- 
ses may account for the somatic symptoms, or they may occur alongside one of the somatic 
symptom and related disorders in this chapter. There is also considerable medical comor- 
bidity among somatizing individuals. Although somatic symptoms are frequently associ- 
ated with psychological distress and psychopathology, some somatic symptom and 
related disorders can arise spontaneously, and their causes can remain obscure. Anxiety 
disorders and depressive disorders may accompany somatic symptom and related disor- 
ders. The somatic component adds severity and complexity to depressive and anxiety dis- 
orders and results in higher severity, functional impairment, and even refractoriness to 
traditional treatments. In rare instances, the degree of preoccupation may be so severe as 
to warrant consideration of a delusional disorder diagnosis. 

A number of factors may contribute to somatic symptom and related disorders. These 
include genetic and biological vulnerability (e.g., increased sensitivity to pain), early trau- 
matic experiences (e.g., violence, abuse, deprivation), and learning (e.g., attention ob- 
tained from illness, lack of reinforcement of nonsomatic expressions of distress), as well as 
cultural/social norms that devalue and stigmatize psychological suffering as compared 
with physical suffering. Differences in medical care across cultures affect the presentation, 
recognition, and management of these somatic presentations. Variations in symptom pre- 
sentation are likely the result of the interaction of multiple factors within cultural con- 
texts that affect how individuals identify and classify bodily sensations, perceive illness, 
and seek medical attention for them. Thus, somatic presentations can be viewed as expres- 
sions of personal suffering inserted in a cultural and social context. 

All of these disorders are characterized by the prominent focus on somatic concerns 
and their initial presentation mainly in medical rather than mental health care settings. So- 
matic symptom disorder offers a more clinically useful method of characterizing individ- 
uals who may have been considered in the past for a diagnosis of somatization disorder. 
Furthermore, approximately 75% of individuals previously diagnosed with hypochon- 
driasis are subsumed under the diagnosis of somatic symptom disorder. However, about 
25% of individuals with hypochondriasis have high health anxiety in the absence of so- 
matic symptoms, and many such individuals’ symptoms would not qualify for an anxiety 
disorder diagnosis. The DSM-5 diagnosis of illness anxiety disorder is for this latter group 
of individuals. IIIness anxiety disorder can be considered either in this diagnostic section 
or as an anxiety disorder. Because of the strong focus on somatic concerns, and because ill- 
ness anxiety disorder is most often encountered in medical settings, for utility it is listed 
with the somatic symptom and related disorders. In conversion disorder, the essential fea- 
ture is neurological symptoms that are found, after appropriate neurological assessment, 
to be incompatible with neurological pathophysiology. Psychological factors affecting 
other medical conditions is also included in this chapter. Its essential feature is the pres- 
ence of one or more clinically significant psychological or behavioral factors that adversely 
affect a medical condition by increasing the risk for suffering, death, or disability. Like the 
other somatic symptom and related disorders, factitious disorder embodies persistent 
problems related to illness perception and identity. In the great majority of reported cases 
of factitious disorder, both imposed on self and imposed on another, individuals present 
with somatic symptoms and medical disease conviction. Consequently, DSM-5 factitious 
disorder is included among the somatic symptom and related disorders. Other specified 
somatic symptom and related disorder and unspecified somatic symptom and related dis- 
order include conditions for which some, but not all, of the criteria for somatic symptom 
disorder or illness anxiety disorder are met, as well as pseudocyesis. 


Somatic Symptom Disorder 311 


Somatic Symptom Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.82 (F45.1) 


A. One or more somatic symptoms that are distressing or result in significant disruption 
of daily life. 

B. Excessive thoughts, feelings, or behaviors related to the somatic symptoms or associ- 
ated health concerns as manifested by at least one of the following: 


1. Disproportionate and persistent thoughts about the seriousness of one’s symptoms. 
2. Persistently high level of anxiety about health or symptoms. 
3. Excessive time and energy devoted to these symptoms or health concerns. 


C. Although any one somatic symptom may not be continuously present, the state of be- 
ing symptomatic is persistent (typically more than 6 months). 


Specify if: 
With predominant pain (previously pain disorder): This specifier is for individuals 
whose somatic symptoms predominantly involve pain. 

Specify if: 
Persistent: A persistent course is characterized by severe symptoms, marked impair- 
ment, and long duration (more than 6 months). 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Only one of the symptoms specified in Criterion B is fulfilled. 
Moderate: Two or more of the symptoms specified in Criterion B are fulfilled. 
Severe: Two or more of the symptoms specified in Criterion B are fulfilled, plus there 
are multiple somatic complaints (or one very severe somatic symptom). 


Diagnostic Features 


Individuals with somatic symptom disorder typically have multiple, current, somatic symp- 
toms that are distressing or result in significant disruption of daily life (Criterion A), al- 
though sometimes only one severe symptom, most commonly pain, is present. Symptoms 
may be specific (e.g., localized pain) or relatively nonspecific (e.g., fatigue). The symptoms 
sometimes represent normal bodily sensations or discomfort that does not generally sig- 
nify serious disease. Somatic symptoms without an evident medical explanation are not 
sufficient to make this diagnosis. The individual's suffering is authentic, whether or not it 
is medically explained. 

The symptoms may or may not be associated with another medical condition. The di- 
agnoses of somatic symptom disorder and a concurrent medical illness are not mutually 
exclusive, and these frequently occur together. For example, an individual may become se- 
riously disabled by symptoms of somatic symptom disorder after an uncomplicated myo- 
cardial infarction even if the myocardial infarction itself did not result in any disability. If 
another medical condition or high risk for developing one is present (e.g., strong family 
history), the thoughts, feelings, and behaviors associated with this condition are excessive 
(Criterion B). 

Individuals with somatic symptom disorder tend to have very high levels of worry 
about illness (Criterion B). They appraise their bodily symptoms as unduly threatening, 
harmful, or troublesome and often think the worst about their health. Even when there is 
evidence to the contrary, some patients still fear the medical seriousness of their symp- 
toms. In severe somatic symptom disorder, health concerns may assume a central role in 
the individual’s life, becoming a feature of his or her identity and dominating interper- 
sonal relationships. 


312 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


Individuals typically experience distress that is principally focused on somatic symp- 
toms and their significance. When asked directly about their distress, some individuals de- 
scribe it in relation to other aspects of their lives, while others deny any source of distress 
other than the somatic symptoms. Health-related quality of life is often impaired, both 
physically and mentally. In severe somatic symptom disorder, the impairment is marked, 
and when persistent, the disorder can lead to invalidism. 

There is often a high level of medical care utilization, which rarely alleviates the individ- 
ual’s concerns. Consequently, the patient may seek care from multiple doctors for the same 
symptoms. These individuals often seem unresponsive to medical interventions, and new 
interventions may only exacerbate the presenting symptoms. Some individuals with the dis- 
order seem unusually sensitive to medication side effects. Some feel that their medical as- 
sessment and treatment have been inadequate. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Cognitive features include attention focused on somatic symptoms, attribution of normal 
bodily sensations to physical illness (possibly with catastrophic interpretations), worry 
about illness, and fear that any physical activity may damage the body. The relevant as- 
sociated behavioral features may include repeated bodily checking for abnormalities, re- 
peated seeking of medical help and reassurance, and avoidance of physical activity. These 
behavioral features are most pronounced in severe, persistent somatic symptom disorder. 
These features are usually associated with frequent requests for medical help for different 
somatic symptoms. This may lead to medical consultations in which individuals are so fo- 
cused on their concerns about somatic symptom(s) that they cannot be redirected to other 
matters. Any reassurance by the doctor that the symptoms are not indicative of serious 
physical illness tends to be short-lived and/or is experienced by the individuals as the 
doctor not taking their symptoms with due seriousness. As the focus on somatic symp- 
toms is a primary feature of the disorder, individuals with somatic symptom disorder typ- 
ically present to general medical health services rather than mental health services. The 
suggestion of referral to a mental health specialist may be met with surprise or even frank 
refusal by individuals with somatic symptom disorder. 

Since somatic symptom disorder is associated with depressive disorders, there is an in- 
creased suicide risk. It is not known whether somatic symptom disorder is associated with 
suicide risk independent of its association with depressive disorders. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of somatic symptom disorder is not known. However, the prevalence of 
somatic symptom disorder is expected to be higher than that of the more restrictive DSM- 
IV somatization disorder (<1%) but lower than that of undifferentiated somatoform dis- 
order (approximately 19%). The prevalence of somatic symptom disorder in the general 
adult population may be around 5%-7%. Females tend to report more somatic symptoms 
than do males, and the prevalence of somatic symptom disorder is consequently likely to 
be higher in females. 


Development and Course 


In older individuals, somatic symptoms and concurrent medical illnesses are common, 
and a focus on Criterion B is crucial for making the diagnosis. Somatic symptom disorder 
may be underdiagnosed in older adults either because certain somatic symptoms (e.g., 
pain, fatigue) are considered part of normal aging or because illness worry is considered 
“understandable” in older adults who have more general medical illnesses and medica- 
tions than do younger people. Concurrent depressive disorder is common in older people 
who present with numerous somatic symptoms. 


Somatic Symptom Disorder 313 


In children, the most common symptoms are recurrent abdominal pain, headache, fa- 
tigue, and nausea. A single prominent symptom is more common in children than in 
adults. While young children may have somatic complaints, they rarely worry about “ill- 
ness” per se prior to adolescence. The parents’ response to the symptom is important, as 
this may determine the level of associated distress. It is the parent who may determine the 
interpretation of symptoms and the associated time off school and medical help seeking. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. The personality trait of negative affectivity (neuroticism) has been identi- 
fied as an independent correlate /risk factor of a high number of somatic symptoms. Comorbid 
anxiety or depression is common and may exacerbate symptoms and impairment. 


Environmental. Somatic symptom disorder is more frequent in individuals with few years 
of education and low socioeconomic status, and in those who have recently experienced 
stressful life events. 


Course modifiers. Persistent somatic symptoms are associated with demographic fea- 
tures (female sex, older age, fewer years of education, lower socioeconomic status, un- 
employment), a reported history of sexual abuse or other childhood adversity, concurrent 
chronic physical illness or psychiatric disorder (depression, anxiety, persistent depressive 
disorder [dysthymia], panic), social stress, and reinforcing social factors such as illness 
benefits. Cognitive factors that affect clinical course include sensitization to pain, height- 
ened attention to bodily sensations, and attribution of bodily symptoms to a possible med- 
ical illness rather than recognizing them as anormal phenomenon or psychological stress. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Somatic symptoms are prominent in various “culture-bound syndromes.” High numbers 
of somatic symptoms are found in population-based and primary care studies around the 
world, with a similar pattern of the most commonly reported somatic symptoms, impair- 
ment, and treatment seeking. The relationship between number of somatic symptoms and 
illness worry is similar in different cultures, and marked illness worry is associated with 
impairment and greater treatment seeking across cultures. The relationship between nu- 
merous somatic symptoms and depression appears to be very similar around the world 
and between different cultures within one country. 

Despite these similarities, there are differences in somatic symptoms among cultures 
and ethnic groups. The description of somatic symptoms varies with linguistic and other 
local cultural factors. These somatic presentations have been described as “idioms of dis- 
tress” because somatic symptoms may have special meanings and shape patient-clinician 
interactions in the particular cultural contexts. “Burnout,” the sensation of heaviness or 
the complaints of “gas”; too much heat in the body; or burning in the head are examples of 
symptoms that are common in some cultures or ethnic groups but rare in others. Explan- 
atory models also vary, and somatic symptoms may be attributed variously to particular 
family, work, or environmental stresses; general medical illness; the suppression of feel- 
ings of anger and resentment; or certain culture-specific phenomena, such as semen loss. 
There may also be differences in medical treatment seeking among cultural groups, in ad- 
dition to differences due to variable access to medical care services. Seeking treatment for 
multiple somatic symptoms in general medical clinics is a worldwide phenomenon and 
occurs at similar rates among ethnic groups in the same country. 


Functional Consequences of Somatic Symptom Disorder 
The disorder is associated with marked impairment of health status. Many individuals 
with severe somatic symptom disorder are likely to have impaired health status scores 
more than 2 standard deviations below population norms. 


314 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


Differential Diagnosis 


If the somatic symptoms are consistent with another mental disorder (e.g., panic disorder), 
and the diagnostic criteria for that disorder are fulfilled, then that mental disorder should 
be considered as an alternative or additional diagnosis. A separate diagnosis of somatic 
symptom disorder is not made if the somatic symptoms and related thoughts, feelings, or 
behaviors occur only during major depressive episodes. If, as commonly occurs, the crite- 
ria for both somatic symptom disorder and another mental disorder diagnosis are ful- 
filled, then both should be coded, as both may require treatment. 


Other medical conditions. The presence of somatic symptoms of unclear etiology is not 
in itself sufficient to make the diagnosis of somatic symptom disorder. The symptoms of 
many individuals with disorders like irritable bowel syndrome or fibromyalgia would not 
satisfy the criterion necessary to diagnose somatic symptom disorder (Criterion B). Con- 
versely, the presence of somatic symptoms of an established medical disorder (e.g., diabe- 
tes or heart disease) does not exclude the diagnosis of somatic symptom disorder if the 
criteria are otherwise met. 


Panic disorder. In panic disorder, somatic symptoms and anxiety about health tend to 
occur in acute episodes, whereas in somatic symptom disorder, anxiety and somatic symp- 
toms are more persistent. 


Generalized anxiety disorder. Individuals with generalized anxiety disorder worry about 
multiple events, situations, or activities, only one of which may involve their health. The 
main focus is not usually somatic symptoms or fear of illness as it is in somatic symptom 
disorder. 


Depressive disorders. Depressive disorders are commonly accompanied by somatic 
symptoms. However, depressive disorders are differentiated from somatic symptom dis- 
order by the core depressive symptoms of low (dysphoric) mood and anhedonia. 


Illness anxiety disorder. If the individual has extensive worries about health but no or 
minimal somatic symptoms, it may be more appropriate to consider illness anxiety disorder. 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder). In conversion disor- 
der, the presenting symptom is loss of function (e.g., of a limb), whereas in somatic symp- 
tom disorder, the focus is on the distress that particular symptoms cause. The features 
listed under Criterion B of somatic symptom disorder may be helpful in differentiating the 
two disorders. 


Delusional disorder. In somatic symptom disorder, the individual’s beliefs that somatic 
symptoms might reflect serious underlying physical illness are not held with delusional 
intensity. Nonetheless, the individual's beliefs concerning the somatic symptoms can be 
firmly held. In contrast, in delusional disorder, somatic subtype, the somatic symptom be- 
liefs and behavior are stronger than those found in somatic symptom disorder. 


Body dysmorphic disorder. In body dysmorphic disorder, the individual is excessively 
concerned about, and preoccupied by, a perceived defect in his or her physical features. In 
contrast, in somatic symptom disorder, the concern about somatic symptoms reflects fear 
of underlying illness, not of a defect in appearance. 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. In somaticsymptom disorder, the recurrent ideas about 
somatic symptoms or illness are less intrusive, and individuals with this disorder do not 
exhibit the associated repetitive behaviors aimed at reducing anxiety that occur in obses- 
sive-compulsive disorder. 


Comorbidity 


Somatic symptom disorder is associated with high rates of comorbidity with medical dis- 
orders as well as anxiety and depressive disorders. When a concurrent medical illness is 


Illness Anxiety Disorder 315 


present, the degree of impairment is more marked than would be expected from the phys- 
ical illness alone. When an individual’s symptoms meet diagnostic criteria for somatic 
symptom disorder, the disorder should be diagnosed; however, in view of the frequent co- 
morbidity, especially with anxiety and depressive disorders, evidence for these concur- 
rent diagnoses should be sought. 


Illness Anxiety Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.7 (F45.21) 


A. Preoccupation with having or acquiring a serious illness. 

B. Somatic symptoms are not present or, if present, are only mild in intensity. If another 
medical condition is present or there is a high risk for developing a medical condition 
(e.g., strong family history is present), the preoccupation is clearly excessive or dispro- 
portionate. 

C. There is a high level of anxiety about health, and the individual is easily alarmed about 
personal health status. 

D. The individual performs excessive health-related behaviors (e.g., repeatedly checks 
his or her body for signs of illness) or exhibits maladaptive avoidance (e.g., avoids doc- 
tor appointments and hospitals). 

E. Illness preoccupation has been present for at least 6 months, but the specific illness 
that is feared may change over that period of time. 

F. The illness-related preoccupation is not better explained by another mental disorder, such 
as somatic symptom disorder, panic disorder, generalized anxiety disorder, body dysmor- 
phic disorder, obsessive-compulsive disorder, or delusional disorder, somatic type. 


Specify whether: 
Care-seeking type: Medical care, including physician visits or undergoing tests and 
procedures, is frequently used. 
Care-avoidant type: Medical care is rarely used. 


Diagnostic Features 


Most individuals with hypochondriasis are now classified as having somatic symptom 
disorder; however, in a minority of cases, the diagnosis of illness anxiety disorder applies 
instead. Illness anxiety disorder entails a preoccupation with having or acquiring a seri- 
ous, undiagnosed medical illness (Criterion A). Somatic symptoms are not present or, if 
present, are only mild in intensity (Criterion B). A thorough evaluation fails to identify a 
serious medical condition that accounts for the individual’s concerns. While the concern 
may be derived from a nonpathological physical sign or sensation, the individual’s dis- 
tress emanates not primarily from the physical complaint itself but rather from his or her 
anxiety about the meaning, significance, or cause of the complaint (i.e., the suspected med- 
ical diagnosis). If a physical sign or symptom is present, it is often a normal physiological 
sensation (e.g., orthostatic dizziness), a benign and self-limited dysfunction (e.g., transient 
tinnitus), or a bodily discomfort not generally considered indicative of disease (e.g., belch- 
ing). If a diagnosable medical condition is present, the individual’s anxiety and preoccu- 
pation are clearly excessive and disproportionate to the severity of the condition (Criterion 
B). Empirical evidence and existing literature pertain to previously defined DSM hypo- 
chondriasis, and it is unclear to what extent and how precisely they apply to the descrip- 
tion of this new diagnosis. 

The preoccupation with the idea that one is sick is accompanied by substantial anxiety 
about health and disease (Criterion C). Individuals with illness anxiety disorder are easily 


316 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


alarmed about illness, such as by hearing about someone else falling ill or reading a health- 
related news story. Their concerns about undiagnosed disease do not respond to appro- 
priate medical reassurance, negative diagnostic tests, or benign course. The physician’s at- 
tempts at reassurance and symptom palliation generally do not alleviate the individual’s 
concerns and may heighten them. Illness concerns assume a prominent place in the indi- 
vidual’s life, affecting daily activities, and may even result in invalidism. Illness becomes 
a central feature of the individual's identity and self-image, a frequent topic of social dis- 
course, and a characteristic response to stressful life events. Individuals with the disorder 
often examine themselves repeatedly (e.g., examining one’s throat in the mirror) (Crite- 
rion D). They research their suspected disease excessively (e.g., on the Internet) and re- 
peatedly seek reassurance from family, friends, or physicians. This incessant worrying often 
becomes frustrating for others and may result in considerable strain within the family. In 
some cases, the anxiety leads to maladaptive avoidance of situations (e.g., visiting sick 
family members) or activities (e.g., exercise) that these individuals fear might jeopardize 
their health. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Because they believe they are medically ill, individuals with illness anxiety disorder are 
encountered far more frequently in medical than in mental health settings. The majority of 
individuals with illness anxiety disorder have extensive yet unsatisfactory medical care, 
though some may be too anxious to seek medical attention. They generally have elevated 
rates of medical utilization but do not utilize mental health services more than the general 
population. They often consult multiple physicians for the same problem and obtain re- 
peatedly negative diagnostic test results. At times, medical attention leads to a paradoxical 
exacerbation of anxiety or to iatrogenic complications from diagnostic tests and proce- 
dures. Individuals with the disorder are generally dissatisfied with their medical care and 
find it unhelpful, often feeling they are not being taken seriously by physicians. At times, 
these concerns may be justified, since physicians sometimes are dismissive or respond 
with frustration or hostility. This response can occasionally result in a failure to diagnose 
a medical condition that is present. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence estimates of illness anxiety disorder are based on estimates of the DSM-III and 
DSM-IV diagnosis hypochondriasis. The 1- to 2-year prevalence of health anxiety and/or 
disease conviction in community surveys and population-based samples ranges from 1.3% 
to 10%. In ambulatory medical populations, the 6-month/ 1-year prevalence rates are be- 
tween 3% and 8%. The prevalence of the disorder is similar in males and females. 


Development and Course 


The development and course of illness anxiety disorder are unclear. Illness anxiety disor- 
der is generally thought to be a chronic and relapsing condition with an age at onset in 
early and middle adulthood. In population-based samples, health-related anxiety in- 
creases with age, but the ages of individuals with high health anxiety in medical settings 
do not appear to differ from those of other patients in those settings. In older individuals, 
health-related anxiety often focuses on memory loss; the disorder is thought to be rare in 
children. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Illness anxiety disorder may sometimes be precipitated by a major life 
stress or a serious but ultimately benign threat to the individual’s health. A history of child- 


Illness Anxiety Disorder 317 


hood abuse or of a serious childhood illness may predispose to development of the disor- 
der in adulthood. 


Course modifiers. Approximately one-third to one-half of individuals with illness anx- 
iety disorder have a transient form, which is associated with less psychiatric comorbidity, 
more medical comorbidity, and less severe illness anxiety disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The diagnosis should be made with caution in individuals whose ideas about disease are 
congruent with widely held, culturally sanctioned beliefs. Little is known about the phe- 
nomenology of the disorder across cultures, although the prevalence appears to be similar 
across different countries with diverse cultures. 


Functional Consequences of Illness Anxiety Disorder 


Illness anxiety disorder causes substantial role impairment and decrements in physical 
function and health-related quality of life. Health concerns often interfere with interper- 
sonal relationships, disrupt family life, and damage occupational performance. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other medical conditions. The first differential diagnostic consideration is an underly- 
ing medical condition, including neurological or endocrine conditions, occult malignan- 
cies, and other diseases that affect multiple body systems. The presence of a medical 
condition does not rule out the possibility of coexisting illness anxiety disorder. If a med- 
ical condition is present, the health-related anxiety and disease concerns are clearly dis- 
proportionate to its seriousness. Transient preoccupations related to a medical condition 
do not constitute illness anxiety disorder. 


Adjustment disorders. Health-related anxiety is a normal response to serious illness 
and is not a mental disorder. Such nonpathological health anxiety is clearly related to the 
medical condition and is typically time-limited. If the health anxiety is severe enough, an 
adjustment disorder may be diagnosed. However, only when the health anxiety is of suf- 
ficient duration, severity, and distress can illness anxiety disorder be diagnosed. Thus, the 
diagnosis requires the continuous persistence of disproportionate health-related anxiety 
for at least 6 months. 


Somatic symptom disorder. Somatic symptom disorder is diagnosed when significant 
somatic symptoms are present. In contrast, individuals with illness anxiety disorder have 
minimal somatic symptoms and are primarily concerned with the idea they are ill. 


Anxiety disorders. In generalized anxiety disorder, individuals worry about multiple 
events, situations, or activities, only one of which may involve health. In panic disorder, 
the individual may be concerned that the panic attacks reflect the presence of a medical ill- 
ness; however, although these individuals may have health anxiety, their anxiety is typi- 
cally very acute and episodic. In illness anxiety disorder, the health anxiety and fears are 
more persistent and enduring. Individuals with illness anxiety disorder may experience 
panic attacks that are triggered by their illness concerns. 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorders. Individuals with illness anxiety disor- 
der may have intrusive thoughts about having a disease and also may have associated 
compulsive behaviors (e.g., seeking reassurance). However, in illness anxiety disorder, the 
preoccupations are usually focused on having a disease, whereas in obsessive-compulsive 
disorder (OCD), the thoughts are intrusive and are usually focused on fears of getting a 
disease in the future. Most individuals with OCD have obsessions or compulsions involv- 
ing other concerns in addition to fears about contracting disease. In body dysmorphic dis- 


318 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


order, concerns are limited to the individual’s physical appearance, which is viewed as 
defective or flawed. 


Major depressive disorder. Some individuals with a major depressive episode rumi- 
nate about their health and worry excessively about illness. A separate diagnosis of illness 
anxiety disorder is not made if these concerns occur only during major depressive epi- 
sodes. However, if excessive illness worry persists after remission of an episode of major 
depressive disorder, the diagnosis of illness anxiety disorder should be considered. 


Psychotic disorders. Individuals with illness anxiety disorder are not delusional and 
can acknowledge the possibility that the feared disease is not present. Their ideas do not 
attain the rigidity and intensity seen in the somatic delusions occurring in psychotic dis- 
orders (e.g., schizophrenia; delusional disorder, somatic type; major depressive disorder, 
with psychotic features). True somatic delusions are generally more bizarre (e.g., that an 
organ is rotting or dead) than the concerns seen in illness anxiety disorder. The concerns 
seen in illness anxiety disorder, though not founded in reality, are plausible. 


Comorbidity 

Because illness anxiety disorder is a new disorder, exact comorbidities are unknown. Hy- 
pochondriasis co-occurs with anxiety disorders (in particular, generalized anxiety disor- 
der, panic disorder, and OCD) and depressive disorders. Approximately two-thirds of 
individuals with illness anxiety disorder are likely to have at least one other comorbid ma- 
jor mental disorder. Individuals with illness anxiety disorder may have an elevated risk 
for somatic symptom disorder and personality disorders. 


Conversion Disorder 
(Functional Neurological Symptom Disorder) 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. One or more symptoms of altered voluntary motor or sensory function. 

B. Clinical findings provide evidence of incompatibility between the symptom and recog- 
nized neurological or medical conditions. 

C. The symptom or deficit is not better explained by another medical or mental disorder. 

D. The symptom or deficit causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, or other important areas of functioning or warrants medical evaluation. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code for conversion disorder is 300.11, which is assigned 
regardless of the symptom type. The ICD-10-CM code depends on the symptom type (see 
below). 
Specify symptom type: 
(F44.4) With weakness or paralysis 
(F44.4) With abnormal movement (e.g., tremor, dystonic movement, myoclonus, gait 
disorder) 
(F44.4) With swallowing symptoms 
(F44.4) With speech symptom (e.g., dysphonia, slurred speech) 
(F44.5) With attacks or seizures 
(F44.6) With anesthesia or sensory loss 
(F44.6) With special sensory symptom (e.g., visual, olfactory, or hearing distur- 
bance) 
(F44.7) With mixed symptoms 


Conversion Disorder (Functional Neurological Symptom Disorder) 319 


Specify if: 
Acute episode: Symptoms present for less than 6 months. 
Persistent: Symptoms occurring for 6 months or more. 
Specify if: 
With psychological stressor (specify stressor) 
Without psychological stressor 


Diagnostic Features 


Many clinicians use the alternative names of “functional” (referring to abnormal central 
nervous system functioning) or “psychogenic” (referring to an assumed etiology) to de- 
scribe the symptoms of conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disor- 
der). In conversion disorder, there may be one or more symptoms of various types. Motor 
symptoms include weakness or paralysis; abnormal movements, such as tremor or dys- 
tonic movements; gait abnormalities; and abnormal limb posturing. Sensory symptoms 
include altered, reduced, or absent skin sensation, vision, or hearing. Episodes of abnor- 
mal generalized limb shaking with apparent impaired or loss of consciousness may resem- 
ble epileptic seizures (also called psychogenic or non-epileptic seizures). There may be 
episodes of unresponsiveness resembling syncope or coma. Other symptoms include re- 
duced or absent speech volume (dysphonia/aphonia), altered articulation (dysarthria), a 
sensation of a lump in the throat (globus), and diplopia. 

Although the diagnosis requires that the symptom is not explained by neurological 
disease, it should not be made simply because results from investigations are normal or 
because the symptom is “bizarre.” There must be clinical findings that show clear evidence 
of incompatibility with neurological disease. Internal inconsistency at examination is one 
way to demonstrate incompatibility (i.e., demonstrating that physical signs elicited 
through one examination method are no longer positive when tested a different way). Ex- 
amples of such examination findings include 


¢ Hoover's sign, in which weakness of hip extension returns to normal strength with con- 
tralateral hip flexion against resistance. 

¢ Marked weakness of ankle plantar-flexion when tested on the bed in an individual who 
is able to walk on tiptoes; 

¢ Positive findings on the tremor entrainment test. On this test, a unilateral tremor may 
be identified as functional if the tremor changes when the individual is distracted away 
from it. This may be observed if the individual is asked to copy the examiner in making 
a rhythmical movement with their unaffected hand and this causes the functional 
tremor to change such that it copies or “entrains” to the rhythm of the unaffected hand 
or the functional tremor is suppressed, or no longer makes a simple rhythmical move- 
ment. 

e In attacks resembling epilepsy or syncope (“psychogenic” non-epileptic attacks), the 
occurrence of closed eyes with resistance to opening or a normal simultaneous electro- 
encephalogram (although this alone does not exclude all forms of epilepsy or syncope). 

¢ For visual symptoms, a tubular visual field (i.e., tunnel vision). 


It is important to note that the diagnosis of conversion disorder should be based on the 
overall clinical picture and not on a single clinical finding. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 

A number of associated features can support the diagnosis of conversion disorder. There 
may be a history of multiple similar somatic symptoms. Onset may be associated with 
stress or trauma, either psychological or physical in nature. The potential etiological rele- 


320 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


vance of this stress or trauma may be suggested by a close temporal relationship. However, 
while assessment for stress and trauma is important, the diagnosis should not be withheld 
if none is found. 

Conversion disorder is often associated with dissociative symptoms, such as deperson- 
alization, derealization, and dissociative amnesia, particularly at symptom onset or during 
attacks. 

The diagnosis of conversion disorder does not require the judgment that the symptoms 
are not intentionally produced (ie., not feigned), as the definite absence of feigning may 
not be reliably discerned. The phenomenon of la belle indifférence (i.e., lack of concern about 
the nature or implications of the symptom) has been associated with conversion disorder 
but it is not specific for conversion disorder and should not be used to make the diagnosis. 
Similarly the concept of secondary gain (i.e., when individuals derive external benefits such 
as money or release from responsibilities) is also not specific to conversion disorder and 
particularly in the context of definite evidence for feigning, the diagnoses that should be 
considered instead would include factitious disorder or malingering (see the section “Dif- 
ferential Diagnosis” for this disorder). 


Prevalence 


Transient conversion symptoms are common, but the precise prevalence of the disorder is 
unknown. This is partly because the diagnosis usually requires assessment in secondary 
care, where it is found in approximately 5% of referrals to neurology clinics. The incidence 
of individual persistent conversion symptoms is estimated to be 2-5/100,000 per year. 


Development and Course 


Onset has been reported throughout the life course. The onset of non-epileptic attacks 
peaks in the third decade, and motor symptoms have their peak onset in the fourth decade. 
The symptoms can be transient or persistent. The prognosis may be better in younger chil- 
dren than in adolescents and adults. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Maladaptive personality traits are commonly associated with conver- 
sion disorder. 


Environmental. There may be a history of childhood abuse and neglect. Stressful life 
events are often, but not always, present. 

Genetic and physiological. The presence of neurological disease that causes similar symp- 
toms is a risk factor (e.g., non-epileptic seizures are more common in patients who also 
have epilepsy). 

Course modifiers. Short duration of symptoms and acceptance of the diagnosis are pos- 
itive prognostic factors. Maladaptive personality traits, the presence of comorbid physical 
disease, and the receipt of disability benefits may be negative prognostic factors. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Changes resembling conversion (and dissociative) symptoms are common in certain 
culturally sanctioned rituals. If the symptoms are fully explained within the particular 
cultural context and do not result in clinically significant distress or disability, then the di- 
agnosis of conversion disorder is not made. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Conversion disorder is two to three times more common in females. 


Conversion Disorder (Functional Neurological Symptom Disorder) 321 


Functional Consequences of Conversion Disorder 


Individuals with conversion symptoms may have substantial disability. The severity of dis- 
ability can be similar to that experienced by individuals with comparable medical diseases. 


Differential Diagnosis 


If another mental disorder better explains the symptoms, that diagnosis should be made. 
However the diagnosis of conversion disorder may be made in the presence of another 
mental disorder. 


Neurological disease. The main differential diagnosis is neurological disease that might 
better explain the symptoms. After a thorough neurological assessment, an unexpected 
neurological disease cause for the symptoms is rarely found at follow up. However, reas- 
sessment may be required if the symptoms appear to be progressive. Conversion disorder 
may coexist with neurological disease. 


Somatic symptom disorder. Conversion disorder may be diagnosed in addition to so- 
matic symptom disorder. Most of the somatic symptoms encountered in somatic symptom 
disorder cannot be demonstrated to be clearly incompatible with pathophysiology (e.g., 
pain, fatigue), whereas in conversion disorder, such incompatibility is required for the di- 
agnosis. The excessive thoughts, feelings, and behaviors characterizing somatic symptom 
disorder are often absent in conversion disorder. 


Factitious disorder and malingering. The diagnosis of conversion disorder does not re- 
quire the judgment that the symptoms are not intentionally produced (i.e., not feigned), 
because assessment of conscious intention is unreliable. However definite evidence of 
feigning (e.g., clear evidence that loss of function is present during the examination but not 
at home) would suggest a diagnosis of factitious disorder if the individual’s apparent aim 
is to assume the sick role or malingering if the aim is to obtain an incentive such as money. 


Dissociative disorders. Dissociative symptoms are common in individuals with con- 
version disorder. If both conversion disorder and a dissociative disorder are present, both 
diagnoses should be made. 


Body dysmorphic disorder. Individuals with body dysmorphic disorder are exces- 
sively concerned about a perceived defect in their physical features but do not complain of 
symptoms of sensory or motor functioning in the affected body part. 


Depressive disorders. In depressive disorders, individuals may report general heavi- 
ness of their limbs, whereas the weakness of conversion disorder is more focal and prom- 
inent. Depressive disorders are also differentiated by the presence of core depressive 
symptoms. 


Panic disorder. Episodic neurological symptoms (e.g., tremors and paresthesias) can 
occur in both conversion disorder and panic attacks. In panic attacks, the neurological 
symptoms are typically transient and acutely episodic with characteristic cardiorespira- 
tory symptoms. Loss of awareness with amnesia for the attack and violent limb move- 
ments occur in non-epileptic attacks, but not in panic attacks. 


Comorbidity 


Anxiety disorders, especially panic disorder, and depressive disorders commonly co-occur 
with conversion disorder. Somatic symptom disorder may co-occur as well. Psychosis, sub- 
stance use disorder, and alcohol misuse are uncommon. Personality disorders are more 
common in individuals with conversion disorder than in the general population. Neuro- 
logical or other medical conditions commonly coexist with conversion disorder as well. 


322 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


Psychological Factors Affecting 
Other Medical Conditions 


Diagnostic Criteria 316 (F54) 


A. A medical symptom or condition (other than a mental disorder) is present. 
B. Psychological or behavioral factors adversely affect the medical condition in one of the 
following ways: 


1. The factors have influenced the course of the medical condition as shown by a 
close temporal association between the psychological factors and the development 
or exacerbation of, or delayed recovery from, the medical condition. 

2. The factors interfere with the treatment of the medical condition (e.g., poor adher- 
ence). 

3. The factors constitute additional well-established health risks for the individual. 

4. The factors influence the underlying pathophysiology, precipitating or exacerbating 
symptoms or necessitating medical attention. 


C. The psychological and behavioral factors in Criterion B are not better explained by an- 
other mental disorder (e.g., panic disorder, major depressive disorder, posttraumatic 
stress disorder). 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Increases medical risk (e.g., inconsistent adherence with antihypertension treat- 
ment). 
Moderate: Aggravates underlying medical condition (e.g., anxiety aggravating 
asthma). 
Severe: Results in medical hospitalization or emergency room visit. 
Extreme: Results in severe, life-threatening risk (e.g., ignoring heart attack symp- 
toms). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of psychological factors affecting other medical conditions is the 
presence of one or more clinically significant psychological or behavioral factors that ad- 
versely affect a medical condition by increasing the risk for suffering, death, or disability 
(Criterion B). These factors can adversely affect the medical condition by influencing its 
course or treatment, by constituting an additional well-established health risk factor, or by 
influencing the underlying pathophysiology to precipitate or exacerbate symptoms or to 
necessitate medical attention. 

Psychological or behavioral factors include psychological distress, patterns of interper- 
sonal interaction, coping styles, and maladaptive health behaviors, such as denial of symp- 
toms or poor adherence to medical recommendations. Common clinical examples are 
anxiety-exacerbating asthma, denial of need for treatment for acute chest pain, and manip- 
ulation of insulin by an individual with diabetes wishing to lose weight. Many different 
psychological factors have been demonstrated to adversely influence medical conditions— 
for example, symptoms of depression or anxiety, stressful life events, relationship style, 
personality traits, and coping styles. The adverse effects can range from acute, with imme- 
diate medical consequences (e.g., Takotsubo cardiomyopathy) to chronic, occurring over a 
long period of time (e.g., chronic occupational stress increasing risk for hypertension). Af- 
fected medical conditions can be those with clear pathophysiology (e.g., diabetes, cancer, 
coronary disease), functional syndromes (e.g., migraine, irritable bowel syndrome, fibro- 
myalgia), or idiopathic medical symptoms (e.g., pain, fatigue, dizziness). 


Psychological Factors Affecting Other Medical Conditions 323 


This diagnosis should be reserved for situations in which the effect of the psychological 
factor on the medical condition is evident and the psychological factor has clinically sig- 
nificant effects on the course or outcome of the medical condition. Abnormal psychologi- 
cal or behavioral symptoms that develop in response to a medical condition are more 
properly coded as an adjustment disorder (a clinically significant psychological response 
to an identifiable stressor). There must be reasonable evidence to suggest an association 
between the psychological factors and the medical condition, although it may often not be 
possible to demonstrate direct causality or the mechanisms underlying the relationship. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of psychological factors affecting other medical conditions is unclear. In 
U.S. private insurance billing data, it is amore common diagnosis than somatic symptom 
disorders. 


Development and Course 


Psychological factors affecting other medical conditions can occur across the lifespan. Par- 
ticularly with young children, corroborative history from parents or school can assist the di- 
agnostic evaluation. Some conditions are characteristic of particular life stages (e.g., in older 
individuals, the stress associated with acting as a caregiver for an ill spouse or partner). 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Many differences between cultures may influence psychological factors and their effects 
on medical conditions, such as those in language and communication style, explanatory 
models of illness, patterns of seeking health care, service availability and organization, 
doctor-patient relationships and other healing practices, family and gender roles, and at- 
titudes toward pain and death. Psychological factors affecting other medical conditions 
must be differentiated from culturally specific behaviors such as using faith or spiritual 
healers or other variations in illness management that are acceptable within a culture and 
represent an attempt to help the medical condition rather than interfere with it. These local 
practices may complement rather than obstruct evidence-based interventions. If they do 
not adversely affect outcomes, they should not be pathologized as psychological factors 
affecting other medical conditions. 


Functional Consequences of Psychological Factors 
Affecting Other Medical Conditions 


Psychological and behavioral factors have been demonstrated to affect the course of many 
medical diseases. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Mental disorder due to another medical condition. A temporal association between 
symptoms of a mental disorder and those of a medical condition is also characteristic of a 
mental disorder due to another medical condition, but the presumed causality is in the op- 
posite direction. In a mental disorder due to another medical condition, the medical 
condition is judged to be causing the mental disorder through a direct physiological mech- 
anism. In psychological factors affecting other medical conditions, the psychological or be- 
havioral factors are judged to affect the course of the medical condition. 


Adjustment disorders. Abnormal psychological or behavioral symptoms that develop in 
response to a medical condition are more properly coded as an adjustment disorder (a clin- 
ically significant psychological response to an identifiable stressor). For example, an indi- 


324 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


vidual with angina that is precipitated whenever he becomes enraged would be diagnosed 
as having psychological factors affecting other medical conditions, whereas an individual 
with angina who developed maladaptive anticipatory anxiety would be diagnosed as hav- 
ing an adjustment disorder with anxiety. In clinical practice, however, psychological fac- 
tors and a medical condition are often mutually exacerbating (e.g., anxiety as both a 
precipitant and a consequence of angina), in which case the distinction is arbitrary. Other 
mental disorders frequently result in medical complications, most notably substance use 
disorders (e.g., alcohol use disorder, tobacco use disorder). If an individual has a coexisting 
major mental disorder that adversely affects or causes another medical condition, diagno- 
ses of the mental disorder and the medical condition are usually sufficient. Psychological 
factors affecting other medical conditions is diagnosed when the psychological traits or 
behaviors do not meet criteria for a mental diagnosis. 


Somatic symptom disorder. Somatic symptom disorder is characterized by a combina- 
tion of distressing somatic symptoms and excessive or maladaptive thoughts, feelings, 
and behavior in response to these symptoms or associated health concerns. The individual 
may or may not have a diagnosable medical condition. In contrast, in psychological factors 
affecting other medical conditions, the psychological factors adversely affect a medical 
condition; the individual’s thoughts, feelings, and behavior are not necessarily excessive. 
The difference is one of emphasis, rather than a clear-cut distinction. In psychological fac- 
tors affecting other medical conditions, the emphasis is on the exacerbation of the medical 
condition (e.g., an individual with angina that is precipitated whenever he becomes anx- 
ious). In somatic symptom disorder, the emphasis is on maladaptive thoughts, feelings, 
and behavior (e.g., an individual with angina who worries constantly that she will have a 
heart attack, takes her blood pressure multiple times per day, and restricts her activities). 
Illness anxiety disorder. Illness anxiety disorder is characterized by high illness anxiety 
that is distressing and/or disruptive to daily life with minimal somatic symptoms. The fo- 
cus of clinical concern is the individual’s worry about having a disease; in most cases, no 
serious disease is present. In psychological factors affecting other medical conditions, anx- 
iety may be a relevant psychological factor affecting a medical condition, but the clinical 
concern is the adverse effects on the medical condition. 


Comorbidity 


By definition, the diagnosis of psychological factors affecting other medical conditions entails 
a relevant psychological or behavioral syndrome or trait and a comorbid medical condition. 


Factitious Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 300.19 (F68.10) 


Factitious Disorder Imposed on Self 

A. Falsification of physical or psychological signs or symptoms, or induction of injury or 
disease, associated with identified deception. 

B. The individual presents himself or herself to others as ill, impaired, or injured. 

C. The deceptive behavior is evident even in the absence of obvious external rewards. 

D. The behavior is not better explained by another mental disorder, such as delusional 
disorder or another psychotic disorder. 

Specify: 
Single episode 
Recurrent episodes (two or more events of falsification of illness and/or induction of 
injury) 


Factitious Disorder 325 


Factitious Disorder Imposed on Another 

(Previously Factitious Disorder by Proxy) 

A. Falsification of physical or psychological signs or symptoms, or induction of injury or 
disease, in another, associated with identified deception. 

B. The individual presents another individual (victim) to others as ill, impaired, or injured. 

C. The deceptive behavior is evident even in the absence of obvious external rewards. 

D. The behavior is not better explained by another mental disorder, such as delusional 
disorder or another psychotic disorder. 


Note: The perpetrator, not the victim, receives this diagnosis. 

Specify: 
Single episode 
Recurrent episodes (two or more events of falsification of illness and/or induction of 
injury) 


Recording Procedures 


When an individual falsifies illness in another (e.g., children, adults, pets), the diagnosis is 
factitious disorder imposed on another. The perpetrator, not the victim, is given the diag- 
nosis. The victim may be given an abuse diagnosis (e.g., 995.54 [T74.12X]; see the chapter 
“Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention”). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of factitious disorder is the falsification of medical or psychological signs 
and symptoms in oneself or others that are associated with the identified deception. Indi- 
viduals with factitious disorder can also seek treatment for themselves or another following 
induction of injury or disease. The diagnosis requires demonstrating that the individual is 
taking surreptitious actions to misrepresent, simulate, or cause signs or symptoms of ill- 
ness or injury in the absence of obvious external rewards. Methods of illness falsification 
can include exaggeration, fabrication, simulation, and induction. While a preexisting med- 
ical condition may be present, the deceptive behavior or induction of injury associated 
with deception causes others to view such individuals (or another) as more ill or impaired, 
and this can lead to excessive clinical intervention. Individuals with factitious disorder 
might, for example, report feelings of depression and suicidality following the death of a 
spouse despite the death not being true or the individual’s not having a spouse; decep- 
tively report episodes of neurological symptoms (e.g., seizures, dizziness, or blacking out); 
manipulate a laboratory test (e.g., by adding blood to urine) to falsely indicate an abnor- 
mality; falsify medical records to indicate an illness; ingest a substance (e.g., insulin or 
warfarin) to induce an abnormal laboratory result or illness; or physically injure them- 
selves or induce illness in themselves or another (e.g., by injecting fecal material to produce 
an abscess or to induce sepsis). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with factitious disorder imposed on self or factitious disorder imposed on an- 
other are at risk for experiencing great psychological distress or functional impairment by 
causing harm to themselves and others. Family, friends, and health care professionals are 
also often adversely affected by their behavior. Factitious disorders have similarities to 
substance use disorders, eating disorders, impulse-control disorders, pedophilic disorder, 
and some other established disorders related to both the persistence of the behavior and 
the intentional efforts to conceal the disordered behavior through deception. Whereas 
some aspects of factitious disorders might represent criminal behavior (e.g., factitious dis- 


326 Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


order imposed on another, in which the parent’s actions represent abuse and maltreat- 
ment of a child), such criminal behavior and mental illness are not mutually exclusive. The 
diagnosis of factitious disorder emphasizes the objective identification of falsification of 
signs and symptoms of illness, rather than an inference about intent or possible underly- 
ing motivation. Moreover, such behaviors, including the induction of injury or disease, are 
associated with deception. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of factitious disorder is unknown, likely because of the role of deception in 
this population. Among patients in hospital settings, it is estimated that about 1% of indi- 
viduals have presentations that meet the criteria for factitious disorder. 


Development and Course 


The course of factitious disorder is usually one of intermittent episodes. Single episodes 
and episodes that are characterized as persistent and unremitting are both less common. 
Onset is usually in early adulthood, often after hospitalization for a medical condition ora 
mental disorder. When imposed on another, the disorder may begin after hospitalization 
of the individual's child or other dependent. In individuals with recurrent episodes of fal- 
sification of signs and symptoms of illness and/or induction of injury, this pattern of suc- 
cessive deceptive contact with medical personnel, including hospitalizations, may become 
lifelong. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Caregivers who lie about abuse injuries in dependents solely to protect themselves from lia- 
bility are not diagnosed with factitious disorder imposed on another because protection from 
liability is an external reward (Criterion C, the deceptive behavior is evident even in the ab- 
sence of obvious external rewards). Such caregivers who, upon observation, analysis of med- 
ical records, and/or interviews with others, are found to lie more extensively than needed for 
immediate self-protection are diagnosed with factitious disorder imposed on another. 


Somatic symptom disorder. In somatic symptom disorder, there may be excessive at- 
tention and treatment seeking for perceived medical concerns, but there is no evidence that 
the individual is providing false information or behaving deceptively. 


Malingering. Malingering is differentiated from factitious disorder by the intentional re- 
porting of symptoms for personal gain (e.g., money, time off work). In contrast, the diag- 
nosis of factitious disorder requires the absence of obvious rewards. 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder). Conversion disorder 
is characterized by neurological symptoms that are inconsistent with neurological patho- 
physiology. Factitious disorder with neurological symptoms is distinguished from con- 
version disorder by evidence of deceptive falsification of symptoms. 


Borderline personality disorder. Deliberate physical self-harm in the absence of suicidal 
intent can also occur in association with other mental disorders such as borderline person- 
ality disorder. Factitious disorder requires that the induction of injury occur in association 
with deception. 


Medical condition or mental disorder not associated with intentional symptom falsifi- 
cation. Presentation of signs and symptoms of illness that do not conform to an identi- 
fiable medical condition or mental disorder increases the likelihood of the presence of a 
factitious disorder. However, the diagnosis of factitious disorder does not exclude the 
presence of true medical condition or mental disorder, as comorbid illness often occurs in 
the individual along with factitious disorder. For example, individuals who might manip- 
ulate blood sugar levels to produce symptoms may also have diabetes. 


Other Specified Somatic Symptom and Related Disorder 327 


Other Specified Somatic Symptom and 
Related Disorder 


300.89 (F 45.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a somatic 
symptom and related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in so- 
cial, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the 
full criteria for any of the disorders in the somatic symptom and related disorders diagnos- 
tic class. 
Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 
1. Brief somatic symptom disorder: Duration of symptoms is less than 6 months. 
2. Brief illness anxiety disorder: Duration of symptoms is less than 6 months. 
3. Illness anxiety disorder without excessive health-related behaviors: Criterion D 
for illness anxiety disorder is not met. 
4. Pseudocyesis: A false belief of being pregnant that is associated with objective signs 
and reported symptoms of pregnancy. 


Unspecified Somatic Symptom and 
Related Disorder 


300.82 (F45.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a somatic 
symptom and related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in so- 
cial, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the 
full criteria for any of the disorders in the somatic symptom and related disorders diagnos- 
tic class. The unspecified somatic symptom and related disorder category should not be 
used unless there are decidedly unusual situations where there is insufficient information 
to make a more specific diagnosis. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Feeding and 
Eating Disorders 


Feedin gan d eatin Q disorders are characterized by a persistent disturbance of eat- 
ing or eating-related behavior that results in the altered consumption or absorption of 
food and that significantly impairs physical health or psychosocial functioning. Diagnos- 
tic criteria are provided for pica, rumination disorder, avoidant/restrictive food intake 
disorder, anorexia nervosa, bulimia nervosa, and binge-eating disorder. 

The diagnostic criteria for rumination disorder, avoidant/restrictive food intake dis- 
order, anorexia nervosa, bulimia nervosa, and binge-eating disorder result in a classifica- 
tion scheme that is mutually exclusive, so that during a single episode, only one of these 
diagnoses can be assigned. The rationale for this approach is that, despite a number of 
common psychological and behavioral features, the disorders differ substantially in clin- 
ical course, outcome, and treatment needs. A diagnosis of pica, however, may be assigned 
in the presence of any other feeding and eating disorder. 

Some individuals with disorders described in this chapter report eating-related symp- 
toms resembling those typically endorsed by individuals with substance use disorders, 
such as craving and patterns of compulsive use. This resemblance may reflect the involve- 
ment of the same neural systems, including those implicated in regulatory self-control and 
reward, in both groups of disorders. However, the relative contributions of shared and 
distinct factors in the development and perpetuation of eating and substance use disor- 
ders remain insufficiently understood. 

Finally, obesity is not included in DSM-5 as a mental disorder. Obesity (excess body fat) 
results from the long-term excess of energy intake relative to energy expenditure. A range 
of genetic, physiological, behavioral, and environmental factors that vary across individ- 
uals contributes to the development of obesity; thus, obesity is not considered a mental 
disorder. However, there are robust associations between obesity and a number of mental 
disorders (e.g., binge-eating disorder, depressive and bipolar disorders, schizophrenia). 
The side effects of some psychotropic medications contribute importantly to the develop- 
ment of obesity, and obesity may be a risk factor for the development of some mental dis- 
orders (e.g., depressive disorders). 


Pica 
Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Persistent eating of nonnutritive, nonfood substances over a period of at least 1 month. 

B. The eating of nonnutritive, nonfood substances is inappropriate to the developmental 
level of the individual. 

C. The eating behavior is not part of a culturally supported or socially normative practice. 

D. Ifthe eating behavior occurs in the context of another mental disorder (e.g., intellectual 
disability [intellectual developmental disorder], autism spectrum disorder, schizophre- 
nia) or medical condition (including pregnancy), it is sufficiently severe to warrant ad- 
ditional clinical attention. 


329 


330 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code for pica is 307.52 and is used for children or adults. 
The ICD-10-CM codes for pica are (F98.3) in children and (F50.8) in adults. 
Specify if: 
In remission: After full criteria for pica were previously met, the criteria have not been 
met for a sustained period of time. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of pica is the eating of one or more nonnutritive, nonfood substances on a 
persistent basis over a period of at least 1 month (Criterion A) that is severe enough to warrant 
clinical attention. Typical substances ingested tend to vary with age and availability and might 
include paper, soap, cloth, hair, string, wool, soil, chalk, talcum powder, paint, gum, metal, 
pebbles, charcoal or coal, ash, clay, starch, or ice. The term nonfood is included because the di- 
agnosis of pica does not apply to ingestion of diet products that have minimal nutritional con- 
tent. There is typically no aversion to food in general. The eating of nonnutritive, nonfood 
substances must be developmentally inappropriate (Criterion B) and not part of a culturally 
supported or socially normative practice (Criterion C). A minimum age of 2 years is suggested 
for a pica diagnosis to exclude developmentally normal mouthing of objects by infants that re- 
sults in ingestion. The eating of nonnutritive, nonfood substances can be an associated feature 
of other mental disorders (e.g., intellectual disability [intellectual developmental disorder], 
autism spectrum disorder, schizophrenia). If the eating behavior occurs exclusively in the con- 
text of another mental disorder, a separate diagnosis of pica should be made only if the eating 
behavior is sufficiently severe to warrant additional clinical attention (Criterion D). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Although deficiencies in vitamins or minerals (e.g., zinc, iron) have been reported in some 
instances, often no specific biological abnormalities are found. In some cases, pica comes 
to clinical attention only following general medical complications (e.g., mechanical bowel 
problems; intestinal obstruction, such as that resulting from a bezoar; intestinal perfora- 
tion; infections such as toxoplasmosis and toxocariasis as a result of ingesting feces or dirt; 
poisoning, such as by ingestion of lead-based paint). 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of pica is unclear. Among individuals with intellectual disability, the prev- 
alence of pica appears to increase with the severity of the condition. 


Development and Course 


Onset of pica can occur in childhood, adolescence, or adulthood, although childhood onset 
is most commonly reported. Pica can occur in otherwise normally developing children, 
whereas in adults, it appears more likely to occur in the context of intellectual disability or 
other mental disorders. The eating of nonnutritive, nonfood substances may also manifest 
in pregnancy, when specific cravings (e.g., chalk or ice) might occur. The diagnosis of pica 
during pregnancy is only appropriate if such cravings lead to the ingestion of nonnutri- 
tive, nonfood substances to the extent that the eating of these substances poses potential 
medical risks. The course of the disorder can be protracted and can result in medical emer- 
gencies (e.g., intestinal obstruction, acute weight loss, poisoning). The disorder can poten- 
tially be fatal depending on substances ingested. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Neglect, lack of supervision, and developmental delay can increase the 
risk for this condition. 


Pica 331 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In some populations, the eating of earth or other seemingly nonnutritive substances is believed 
to be of spiritual, medicinal, or other social value, or may be a culturally supported or socially 
normative practice. Such behavior does not warrant a diagnosis of pica (Criterion C). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Pica occurs in both males and females. It can occur in females during pregnancy; however, 
little is known about the course of pica in the postpartum period. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Abdominal flat plate radiography, ultrasound, and other scanning methods may reveal 
obstructions related to pica. Blood tests and other laboratory tests can be used to ascertain 
levels of poisoning or the nature of infection. 


Functional Consequences of Pica 


Pica can significantly impair physical functioning, but it is rarely the sole cause of impair- 
ment in social functioning. Pica often occurs with other disorders associated with im- 
paired social functioning. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Eating of nonnutritive, nonfood substances may occur during the course of other mental 
disorders (e.g., autism spectrum disorder, schizophrenia) and in Kleine-Levin syndrome. 
In any such instance, an additional diagnosis of pica should be given only if the eating be- 
havior is sufficiently persistent and severe to warrant additional clinical attention. 


Anorexia nervosa. Pica can usually be distinguished from the other feeding and eating 
disorders by the consumption of nonnutritive, nonfood substances. It is important to note, 
however, that some presentations of anorexia nervosa include ingestion of nonnutritive, 
nonfood substances, such as paper tissues, as a means of attempting to control appetite. In 
such cases, when the eating of nonnutritive, nonfood substances is primarily used as a 
means of weight control, anorexia nervosa should be the primary diagnosis. 


Factitious disorder. Some individuals with factitious disorder may intentionally ingest 
foreign objects as part of the pattern of falsification of physical symptoms. In such in- 
stances, there is an element of deception that is consistent with deliberate induction of in- 
jury or disease. 


Nonsuicidal self-injury and nonsuicidal self-injury behaviors in personality disorders. 
Some individuals may swallow potentially harmful items (e.g., pins, needles, knives) in 
the context of maladaptive behavior patterns associated with personality disorders or 
nonsuicidal self-injury. 


Comorbidity 


Disorders most commonly comorbid with pica are autism spectrum disorder and intellec- 
tual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), and, to a lesser degree, schizophrenia 
and obsessive-compulsive disorder. Pica can be associated with trichotillomania (hair- 
pulling disorder) and excoriation (skin-picking) disorder. In comorbid presentations, the 
hair or skin is typically ingested. Pica can also be associated with avoidant/restrictive food 
intake disorder, particularly in individuals with a strong sensory component to their pre- 
sentation. When an individual is known to have pica, assessment should include con- 
sideration of the possibility of gastrointestinal complications, poisoning, infection, and 
nutritional deficiency. 


332 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


Rumination Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.53 (F98.21) 


A. Repeated regurgitation of food over a period of at least 1 month. Regurgitated food 
may be re-chewed, re-swallowed, or spit out. 

B. The repeated regurgitation is not attributable to an associated gastrointestinal or other 
medical condition (e.g., gastroesophageal reflux, pyloric stenosis). 

C. The eating disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of anorexia nervosa, 
bulimia nervosa, binge-eating disorder, or avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder. 

D. If the symptoms occur in the context of another mental disorder (e.g., intellectual dis- 
ability [intellectual developmental disorder] or another neurodevelopmental disorder), 
they are sufficiently severe to warrant additional clinical attention. 


Specify if: 
In remission: After full criteria for rumination disorder were previously met, the criteria 
have not been met for a sustained period of time. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of rumination disorder is the repeated regurgitation of food occur- 
ring after feeding or eating over a period of at least 1 month (Criterion A). Previously swal- 
lowed food that may be partially digested is brought up into the mouth without apparent 
nausea, involuntary retching, or disgust. The food may be re-chewed and then ejected 
from the mouth or re-swallowed. Regurgitation in rumination disorder should be fre- 
quent, occurring at least several times per week, typically daily. The behavior is not better 
explained by an associated gastrointestinal or other medical condition (e.g., gastroesoph- 
ageal reflux, pyloric stenosis) (Criterion B) and does not occur exclusively during the 
course of anorexia nervosa, bulimia nervosa, binge-eating disorder, or avoidant/restric- 
tive food intake disorder (Criterion C). If the symptoms occur in the context of another 
mental disorder (e.g., intellectual disability [intellectual developmental disorder], neuro- 
developmental disorder), they must be sufficiently severe to warrant additional clinical 
attention (Criterion D) and should represent a primary aspect of the individual’s presen- 
tation requiring intervention. The disorder may be diagnosed across the life span, par- 
ticularly in individuals who also have intellectual disability. Many individuals with 
rumination disorder can be directly observed engaging in the behavior by the clinician. In 
other instances diagnosis can be made on the basis of self-report or corroborative informa- 
tion from parents or caregivers. Individuals may describe the behavior as habitual or out- 
side of their control. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Infants with rumination disorder display a characteristic position of straining and arching 
the back with the head held back, making sucking movements with their tongue. They 
may give the impression of gaining satisfaction from the activity. They may be irritable 
and hungry between episodes of regurgitation. Weight loss and failure to make expected 
weight gains are common features in infants with rumination disorder. Malnutrition may 
occur despite the infant’s apparent hunger and the ingestion of relatively large amounts of 
food, particularly in severe cases, when regurgitation immediately follows each feeding 
episode and regurgitated food is expelled. Malnutrition might also occur in older children 
and adults, particularly when the regurgitation is accompanied by restriction of intake. 
Adolescents and adults may attempt to disguise the regurgitation behavior by placing a 


Rumination Disorder 333 


hand over the mouth or coughing. Some will avoid eating with others because of the ac- 
knowledged social undesirability of the behavior. This may extend to an avoidance of eat- 
ing prior to social situations, such as work or school (e.g., avoiding breakfast because it 
may be followed by regurgitation). 


Prevalence 


Prevalence data for rumination disorder are inconclusive, but the disorder is commonly 
reported to be higher in certain groups, such as individuals with intellectual disability. 


Development and Course 


Onset of rumination disorder can occur in infancy, childhood, adolescence, or adulthood. 
The age at onset in infants is usually between ages 3 and 12 months. In infants, the disorder 
frequently remits spontaneously, but its course can be protracted and can result in medical 
emergencies (e.g., severe malnutrition). It can potentially be fatal, particularly in infancy. 
Rumination disorder can have an episodic course or occur continuously until treated. In 
infants, as well as in older individuals with intellectual disability (intellectual developmen- 
tal disorder) or other neurodevelopmental disorders, the regurgitation and rumination be- 
havior appears to have a self-soothing or self-stimulating function, similar to that of other 
repetitive motor behaviors such as head banging. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Psychosocial problems such as lack of stimulation, neglect, stressful life 
situations, and problems in the parent-child relationship may be predisposing factors in 
infants and young children. 


Functional Consequences of Rumination Disorder 


Malnutrition secondary to repeated regurgitation may be associated with growth delay 
and have a negative effect on development and learning potential. Some older individuals 
with rumination disorder deliberately restrict their food intake because of the social un- 
desirability of regurgitation. They may therefore present with weight loss or low weight. 
In older children, adolescents, and adults, social functioning is more likely to be adversely 
affected. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Gastrointestinal conditions. It is important to differentiate regurgitation in rumination 
disorder from other conditions characterized by gastroesophageal reflux or vomiting. Con- 
ditions such as gastroparesis, pyloric stenosis, hiatal hernia, and Sandifer syndrome in in- 
fants should be ruled out by appropriate physical examinations and laboratory tests. 


Anorexia nervosa and bulimia nervosa. Individuals with anorexia nervosa and bulimia 
nervosa may also engage in regurgitation with subsequent spitting out of food as a means 
of disposing of ingested calories because of concerns about weight gain. 


Comorbidity 


Regurgitation with associated rumination can occur in the context of a concurrent medical 
condition or another mental disorder (e.g., generalized anxiety disorder). When the regur- 
gitation occurs in this context, a diagnosis of rumination disorder is appropriate only when 
the severity of the disturbance exceeds that routinely associated with such conditions or 
disorders and warrants additional clinical attention. 


334 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


Avoidant/Restrictive Food Intake Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.59 (F50.8) 


A. An eating or feeding disturbance (e.g., apparent lack of interest in eating or food; avoid- 
ance based on the sensory characteristics of food; concern about aversive conse- 
quences of eating) as manifested by persistent failure to meet appropriate nutritional 
and/or energy needs associated with one (or more) of the following: 


1. Significant weight loss (or failure to achieve expected weight gain or faltering 
growth in children). 

2. Significant nutritional deficiency. 

3. Dependence on enteral feeding or oral nutritional supplements. 

4. Marked interference with psychosocial functioning. 


B. The disturbance is not better explained by lack of available food or by an associated 
culturally sanctioned practice. 

C. The eating disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of anorexia ner- 
vosa or bulimia nervosa, and there is no evidence of a disturbance in the way in which 
one’s body weight or shape is experienced. 

D. The eating disturbance is not attributable to a concurrent medical condition or not bet- 
ter explained by another mental disorder. When the eating disturbance occurs in the 
context of another condition or disorder, the severity of the eating disturbance exceeds 
that routinely associated with the condition or disorder and warrants additional clinical 
attention. 


Specify if: 
In remission: After full criteria for avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder were previ- 
ously met, the criteria have not been met for a sustained period of time. 


Diagnostic Features 


Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder replaces and extends the DSM-IV diagnosis of 
feeding disorder of infancy or early childhood. The main diagnostic feature of avoidant/ 
restrictive food intake disorder is avoidance or restriction of food intake (Criterion A) 
manifested by clinically significant failure to meet requirements for nutrition or insuffi- 
cient energy intake through oral intake of food. One or more of the following key features 
must be present: significant weight loss, significant nutritional deficiency (or related 
health impact), dependence on enteral feeding or oral nutritional supplements, or marked 
interference with psychosocial functioning. The determination of whether weight loss is 
significant (Criterion A1) is a clinical judgment; instead of losing weight, children and ad- 
olescents who have not completed growth may not maintain weight or height increases 
along their developmental trajectory. 

Determination of significant nutritional deficiency (Criterion A2) is also based on clin- 
ical assessment (e.g., assessment of dietary intake, physical examination, and laboratory 
testing), and related impact on physical health can be of a similar severity to that seen in 
anorexia nervosa (e.g., hypothermia, bradycardia, anemia). In severe cases, particularly in 
infants, malnutrition can be life threatening. “Dependence” on enteral feeding or oral nu- 
tritional supplements (Criterion A3) means that supplementary feeding is required to sus- 
tain adequate intake. Examples of individuals requiring supplementary feeding include 
infants with failure to thrive who require nasogastric tube feeding, children with neuro- 
developmental disorders who are dependent on nutritionally complete supplements, and 
individuals who rely on gastrostomy tube feeding or complete oral nutrition supplements 
in the absence of an underlying medical condition. Inability to participate in normal social 


Avoidant/Restrictive Food Intake Disorder 335 


activities, such as eating with others, or to sustain relationships as a result of the distur- 
bance would indicate marked interference with psychosocial functioning (Criterion A4). 

Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder does not include avoidance or restriction of 
food intake related to lack of availability of food or to cultural practices (e.g., religious fast- 
ing or normal dieting) (Criterion B), nor does it include developmentally normal behaviors 
(e.g., picky eating in toddlers, reduced intake in older adults). The disturbance is not better 
explained by excessive concern about body weight or shape (Criterion C) or by concurrent 
medical factors or mental disorders (Criterion D). 

In some individuals, food avoidance or restriction may be based on the sensory char- 
acteristics of qualities of food, such as extreme sensitivity to appearance, color, smell, 
texture, temperature, or taste. Such behavior has been described as “restrictive eating,” 
“selective eating,” “choosy eating,” “perseverant eating,” “chronic food refusal,” and 
“food neophobia” and may manifest as refusal to eat particular brands of foods or to tol- 
erate the smell of food being eaten by others. Individuals with heightened sensory sensi- 
tivities associated with autism may show similar behaviors. 

Food avoidance or restriction may also represent a conditioned negative response as- 
sociated with food intake following, or in anticipation of, an aversive experience, such as 
choking; a traumatic investigation, usually involving the gastrointestinal tract (e.g., esoph- 
agoscopy); or repeated vomiting. The terms functional dysphagia and globus hystericus have 
also been used for such conditions. 


Wu vu 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Several features may be associated with food avoidance or reduced food intake, including 
a lack of interest in eating or food, leading to weight loss or faltering growth. Very young 
infants may present as being too sleepy, distressed, or agitated to feed. Infants and young 
children may not engage with the primary caregiver during feeding or communicate hun- 
ger in favor of other activities. In older children and adolescents, food avoidance or restric- 
tion may be associated with more generalized emotional difficulties that do not meet 
diagnostic criteria for an anxiety, depressive, or bipolar disorder, sometimes called “food 
avoidance emotional disorder.” 


Development and Course 


Food avoidance or restriction associated with insufficient intake or lack of interest in eat- 
ing most commonly develops in infancy or early childhood and may persist in adulthood. 
Likewise, avoidance based on sensory characteristics of food tends to arise in the first de- 
cade of life but may persist into adulthood. Avoidance related to aversive consequences 
can arise at any age. The scant literature regarding long-term outcomes suggests that food 
avoidance or restriction based on sensory aspects is relatively stable and long-standing, 
but when persisting into adulthood, such avoidance/ restriction can be associated with rel- 
atively normal functioning. There is currently insufficient evidence directly linking avoid- 
ant/restrictive food intake disorder and subsequent onset of an eating disorder. 

Infants with avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder may be irritable and difficult to 
console during feeding, or may appear apathetic and withdrawn. In some instances, par- 
ent-child interaction may contribute to the infant’s feeding problem (e.g., presenting food 
inappropriately, or interpreting the infant’s behavior as an act of aggression or rejection). 
Inadequate nutritional intake may exacerbate the associated features (e.g., irritability, de- 
velopmental lags) and further contribute to feeding difficulties. Associated factors include 
infant temperament or developmental impairments that reduce an infant’s responsiveness 
to feeding. Coexisting parental psychopathology, or child abuse or neglect, is suggested if 
feeding and weight improve in response to changing caregivers. In infants, children, and 
prepubertal adolescents, avoidant/ restrictive food intake disorder may be associated with 
growth delay, and the resulting malnutrition negatively affects development and learning 


336 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


potential. In older children, adolescents, and adults, social functioning tends to be ad- 
versely affected. Regardless of the age, family function may be affected, with heightened 
stress at mealtimes and in other feeding or eating contexts involving friends and relatives. 

Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder manifests more commonly in children than 
in adults, and there may be a long delay between onset and clinical presentation. Triggers 
for presentation vary considerably and include physical, social, and emotional difficulties. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Anxiety disorders, autism spectrum disorder, obsessive-compulsive 
disorder, and attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder may increase risk for avoidant or 
restrictive feeding or eating behavior characteristic of the disorder. 


Environmental. Environmental risk factors for avoidant/restrictive food intake disor- 
der include familial anxiety. Higher rates of feeding disturbances may occur in children of 
mothers with eating disorders. 


Genetic and physiological. History of gastrointestinal conditions, gastroesophageal re- 
flux disease, vomiting, and a range of other medical problems has been associated with 
feeding and eating behaviors characteristic of avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Presentations similar to avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder occur in various popu- 
lations, including in the United States, Canada, Australia, and Europe. Avoidant/restrictive 
food intake disorder should not be diagnosed when avoidance of food intake is solely re- 
lated to specific religious or cultural practices. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder is equally common in males and females in in- 
fancy and early childhood, but avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder comorbid with 
autism spectrum disorder has a male predominance. Food avoidance or restriction related 
to altered sensory sensitivities can occur in some physiological conditions, most notably 
pregnancy, but is not usually extreme and does not meet full criteria for the disorder. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Diagnostic markers include malnutrition, low weight, growth delay, and the need for ar- 
tificial nutrition in the absence of any clear medical condition other than poor intake. 


Functional Consequences of Avoidant/Restrictive 
Food Intake Disorder 


Associated developmental and functional limitations include impairment of physical de- 
velopment and social difficulties that can have a significant negative impact on family 
function. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Appetite loss preceding restricted intake is a nonspecific symptom that can accompany a 
number of mental diagnoses. Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder can be diagnosed 
concurrently with the disorders below if all criteria are met, and the eating disturbance re- 
quires specific clinical attention. 


Other medical conditions (e.g., gastrointestinal disease, food allergies and intoler- 
ances, occult malignancies). Restriction of food intake may occur in other medical condi- 


Avoidant/Restrictive Food Intake Disorder 337 


tions, especially those with ongoing symptoms such as vomiting, loss of appetite, nausea, ab- 
dominal pain, or diarrhea. A diagnosis of avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder requires 
that the disturbance of intake is beyond that directly accounted for by physical symptoms con- 
sistent with a medical condition; the eating disturbance may also persist after being triggered 
by a medical condition and following resolution of the medical condition. 

Underlying medical or comorbid mental conditions may complicate feeding and eating. 
Because older individuals, postsurgical patients, and individuals receiving chemotherapy 
often lose their appetite, an additional diagnosis of avoidant/restrictive food intake dis- 
order requires that the eating disturbance is a primary focus for intervention. 


Specific neurological/neuromuscular, structural, or congenital disorders and condi- 
tions associated with feeding difficulties. Feeding difficulties are common in a number 
of congenital and neurological conditions often related to problems with oral/esophageal/ 
pharyngeal structure and function, such as hypotonia of musculature, tongue protrusion, 
and unsafe swallowing. Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder can be diagnosed in in- 
dividuals with such presentations as long as all diagnostic criteria are met. 


Reactive attachment disorder. Some degree of withdrawal is characteristic of reactive 
attachment disorder and can lead to a disturbance in the caregiver-child relationship that 
can affect feeding and the child’s intake. Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder should 
be diagnosed concurrently only if all criteria are met for both disorders and the feeding 
disturbance is a primary focus for intervention. 


Autism spectrum disorder. Individuals with autism spectrum disorder often present with 
rigid eating behaviors and heightened sensory sensitivities. However, these features do 
not always result in the level of impairment that would be required for a diagnosis of 
avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder. Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder should 
be diagnosed concurrently only if all criteria are met for both disorders and when the eat- 
ing disturbance requires specific treatment. 


Specific phobia, social anxiety disorder (social phobia), and other anxiety disorders. 
Specific phobia, other type, specifies “situations that may lead to choking or vomiting” and 
can represent the primary trigger for the fear, anxiety, or avoidance required for diagnosis. 
Distinguishing specific phobia from avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder can be dif- 
ficult when a fear of choking or vomiting has resulted in food avoidance. Although avoid- 
ance or restriction of food intake secondary to a pronounced fear of choking or vomiting 
can be conceptualized as specific phobia, in situations when the eating problem becomes 
the primary focus of clinical attention, avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder becomes 
the appropriate diagnosis. In social anxiety disorder, the individual may present with a 
fear of being observed by others while eating, which can also occur in avoidant/restrictive 
food intake disorder. 


Anorexia nervosa. Restriction of energy intake relative to requirements leading to sig- 
nificantly low body weight is a core feature of anorexia nervosa. However, individuals 
with anorexia nervosa also display a fear of gaining weight or of becoming fat, or persis- 
tent behavior that interferes with weight gain, as well as specific disturbances in relation to 
perception and experience of their own body weight and shape. These features are not 
present in avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder, and the two disorders should not be 
diagnosed concurrently. Differential diagnosis between avoidant/restrictive food intake 
disorder and anorexia nervosa may be difficult, especially in late childhood and early ad- 
olescence, because these disorders may share a number of common symptoms (e.g., food 
avoidance, low weight). Differential diagnosis is also potentially difficult in individuals 
with anorexia nervosa who deny any fear of fatness but nonetheless engage in persistent 
behaviors that prevent weight gain and who do not recognize the medical seriousness of 
their low weight—a presentation sometimes termed “non-fat phobic anorexia nervosa.” 
Full consideration of symptoms, course, and family history is advised, and diagnosis may 


338 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


be best made in the context of a clinical relationship over time. In some individuals, avoid- 
ant/restrictive food intake disorder might precede the onset of anorexia nervosa. 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. Individuals with obsessive-compulsive disorder may 
present with avoidance or restriction of intake in relation to preoccupations with food or 
ritualized eating behavior. Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder should be diagnosed 
concurrently only if all criteria are met for both disorders and when the aberrant eating is 
a major aspect of the clinical presentation requiring specific intervention. 


Major depressive disorder. In major depressive disorder, appetite might be affected to 
such an extent that individuals present with significantly restricted food intake, usually in 
relation to overall energy intake and often associated with weight loss. Usually appetite 
loss and related reduction of intake abate with resolution of mood problems. Avoidant/ 
restrictive food intake disorder should only be used concurrently if full criteria are met for 
both disorders and when the eating disturbance requires specific treatment. 


Schizophrenia spectrum disorders. Individuals with schizophrenia, delusional disor- 
der, or other psychotic disorders may exhibit odd eating behaviors, avoidance of specific 
foods because of delusional beliefs, or other manifestations of avoidant or restrictive in- 
take. In some cases, delusional beliefs may contribute to a concern about negative conse- 
quences of ingesting certain foods. Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder should be 
used concurrently only if all criteria are met for both disorders and when the eating dis- 
turbance requires specific treatment. 


Factitious disorder or factitious disorder imposed on another. Avoidant/restrictive 
food intake disorder should be differentiated from factitious disorder or factitious disor- 
der imposed on another. In order to assume the sick role, some individuals with factitious 
disorder may intentionally describe diets that are much more restrictive than those they 
are actually able to consume, as well as complications of such behavior, such as a need for 
enteral feedings or nutritional supplements, an inability to tolerate a normal range of 
foods, and/or an inability to participate normally in age-appropriate situations involving 
food. The presentation may be impressively dramatic and engaging, and the symptoms re- 
ported inconsistently. In factitious disorder imposed on another, the caregiver describes 
symptoms consistent with avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder and may induce 
physical symptoms such as failure to gain weight. As with any diagnosis of factitious dis- 
order imposed on another, the caregiver receives the diagnosis rather than the affected in- 
dividual, and diagnosis should be made only on the basis of a careful, comprehensive 
assessment of the affected individual, the caregiver, and their interaction. 


Comorbidity 


The most commonly observed disorders comorbid with avoidant/restrictive food intake 
disorder are anxiety disorders, obsessive-compulsive disorder, and neurodevelopmental 
disorders (specifically autism spectrum disorder, attention-deficit/hyperactivity disor- 
der, and intellectual disability [intellectual developmental disorder]). 


Anorexia Nervosa 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Restriction of energy intake relative to requirements, leading to a significantly low body 
weight in the context of age, sex, developmental trajectory, and physical health. Sig- 
nificantly low weight is defined as a weight that is less than minimally normal or, for 
children and adolescents, less than that minimally expected. 

B. Intense fear of gaining weight or of becoming fat, or persistent behavior that interferes 
with weight gain, even though at a significantly low weight. 


Anorexia Nervosa 339 


C. Disturbance in the way in which one’s body weight or shape is experienced, undue in- 
fluence of body weight or shape on self-evaluation, or persistent lack of recognition of 
the seriousness of the current low body weight. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code for anorexia nervosa is 307.1, which is assigned re- 

gardless of the subtype. The ICD-10-CM code depends on the subtype (see below). 

Specify whether: 
(F50.01) Restricting type: During the last 3 months, the individual has not engaged in re- 
current episodes of binge eating or purging behavior (i.e., self-induced vomiting or the mis- 
use of laxatives, diuretics, or enemas). This subtype describes presentations in which 
weight loss is accomplished primarily through dieting, fasting, and/or excessive exercise. 
(F50.02) Binge-eating/purging type: During the last 3 months, the individual has en- 
gaged in recurrent episodes of binge eating or purging behavior (i.e., self-induced 
vomiting or the misuse of laxatives, diuretics, or enemas). 

Specify if: 
In partial remission: After full criteria for anorexia nervosa were previously met, Cri- 
terion A (low body weight) has not been met for a sustained period, but either Criterion 
B (intense fear of gaining weight or becoming fat or behavior that interferes with weight 
gain) or Criterion C (disturbances in self-perception of weight and shape) is still met. 
In full remission: After full criteria for anorexia nervosa were previously met, none of 
the criteria have been met for a sustained period of time. 


Specify current severity: 
The minimum level of severity is based, for adults, on current body mass index (BMI) (see 
below) or, for children and adolescents, on BMI percentile. The ranges below are derived 
from World Health Organization categories for thinness in adults; for children and adoles- 
cents, corresponding BMI percentiles should be used. The level of severity may be in- 
creased to reflect clinical symptoms, the degree of functional disability, and the need for 
supervision. 

Mild: BMI > 17 kg/m? 

Moderate: BMI 16-16.99 kg/m? 

Severe: BMI 15-15.99 kg/m? 

Extreme: BMI < 15 kg/m? 


Subtypes 


Most individuals with the binge-eating / purging type of anorexia nervosa who binge eat 
also purge through self-induced vomiting or the misuse of laxatives, diuretics, or enemas. 
Some individuals with this subtype of anorexia nervosa do not binge eat but do regularly 
purge after the consumption of small amounts of food. 

Crossover between the subtypes over the course of the disorder is not uncommon; 
therefore, subtype description should be used to describe current symptoms rather than 
longitudinal course. 


Diagnostic Features 


There are three essential features of anorexia nervosa: persistent energy intake restriction; 
intense fear of gaining weight or of becoming fat, or persistent behavior that interferes 
with weight gain; and a disturbance in self-perceived weight or shape. The individual main- 
tains a body weight that is below a minimally normal level for age, sex, developmental tra- 
jectory, and physical health (Criterion A). Individuals’ body weights frequently meet this 
criterion following a significant weight loss, but among children and adolescents, there 
may alternatively be failure to make expected weight gain or to maintain a normal devel- 
opmental trajectory (i.e., while growing in height) instead of weight loss. 


340 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


Criterion A requires that the individual’s weight be significantly low (i.e., less than 
minimally normal or, for children and adolescents, less than that minimally expected). 
Weight assessment can be challenging because normal weight range differs among indi- 
viduals, and different thresholds have been published defining thinness or underweight 
status. Body mass index (BMI; calculated as weight in kilograms/height in mes Pisa 
useful measure to assess body weight for height. For adults, a BMI of 18.5 kg/m? has been 
employed by the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (CDC) and the World Health 
Organization (WHO) as the lower limit of normal body weight. Therefore, most adults with 
a BMI greater than or equal to 18.5 kg/ m? would not be considered by have a significantly 
low body weight. On the other hand, a BMI of lower than 17.0 kg/m? has been considered 
by the WHO to sage moderate or severe thinness; therefore, an individual with a BMI 
less than 17.0 kg/m? would likely be considered to have a significant] y low weight. An 
adult with a BMI between 17.0 and 18.5 kg/m2, or even above 18.5 kg/m“, might be consid- 
ered to have a significantly low weight if clinical history or other physiological informa- 
tion supports this judgment. 

For children and adolescents, determining a BMI-for-age percentile is useful (see, e.g., 
the CDC BMI percentile calculator for children and teenagers. As for adults, it is not pos- 
sible to provide definitive standards for judging whether a child’s or an adolescent’s weight 
is significantly low, and variations in developmental trajectories among youth limit the 
utility of simple numerical guidelines. The CDC has used a BMI-for-age below the 5th per- 
centile as suggesting underweight; however, children and adolescents with a BMI above 
this benchmark may be judged to be significantly underweight in light of failure to main- 
tain their expected growth trajectory. In summary, in determining whether Criterion A is 
met, the clinician should consider available numerical guidelines, as well as the individual’s 
body build, weight history, and any physiological disturbances. 

Individuals with this disorder typically display an intense fear of gaining weight or of 
becoming fat (Criterion B). This intense fear of becoming fat is usually not alleviated by 
weight loss. In fact, concern about weight gain may increase even as weight falls. Younger 
individuals with anorexia nervosa, as well as some adults, may not recognize or acknowl- 
edge a fear of weight gain. In the absence of another explanation for the significantly low 
weight, clinician inference drawn from collateral history, observational data, physical and 
laboratory findings, or longitudinal course either indicating a fear of weight gain or sup- 
porting persistent behaviors that prevent it may be used to establish Criterion B. 

The experience and significance of body weight and shape are distorted in these indi- 
viduals (Criterion C). Some individuals feel globally overweight. Others realize that they 
are thin but are still concerned that certain body parts, particularly the abdomen, buttocks, 
and thighs, are “too fat.” They may employ a variety of techniques to evaluate their body 
size or weight, including frequent weighing, obsessive measuring of body parts, and per- 
sistent use of a mirror to check for perceived areas of “fat.” The self-esteem of individuals 
with anorexia nervosa is highly dependent on their perceptions of body shape and weight. 
Weight loss is often viewed as an impressive achievement and a sign of extraordinary self- 
discipline, whereas weight gain is perceived as an unacceptable failure of self-control. Al- 
though some individuals with this disorder may acknowledge being thin, they often do 
not recognize the serious medical implications of their malnourished state. 

Often, the individual is brought to professional attention by family members after marked 
weight loss (or failure to make expected weight gains) has occurred. If individuals seek help 
on their own, it is usually because of distress over the somatic and psychological sequelae 
of starvation. It is rare for an individual with anorexia nervosa to complain of weight loss 
per se. In fact, individuals with anorexia nervosa frequently either lack insight into or deny 
the problem. It is therefore often important to obtain information from family members or 
other sources to evaluate the history of weight loss and other features of the illness. 


Anorexia Nervosa 341 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The semi-starvation of anorexia nervosa, and the purging behaviors sometimes associated 
with it, can result in significant and potentially life-threatening medical conditions. The 
nutritional compromise associated with this disorder affects most major organ systems 
and can produce a variety of disturbances. Physiological disturbances, including amenor- 
rhea and vital sign abnormalities, are common. While most of the physiological distur- 
bances associated with malnutrition are reversible with nutritional rehabilitation, some, 
including loss of bone mineral density, are often not completely reversible. Behaviors such 
as self-induced vomiting and misuse of laxatives, diuretics, and enemas may cause a num- 
ber of disturbances that lead to abnormal laboratory findings; however, some individuals 
with anorexia nervosa exhibit no laboratory abnormalities. 

When seriously underweight, many individuals with anorexia nervosa have depressive 
signs and symptoms such as depressed mood, social withdrawal, irritability, insomnia, and 
diminished interest in sex. Because these features are also observed in individuals without 
anorexia nervosa who are significantly undernourished, many of the depressive features 
may be secondary to the physiological sequelae of semi-starvation, although they may also 
be sufficiently severe to warrant an additional diagnosis of major depressive disorder. 

Obsessive-compulsive features, both related and unrelated to food, are often prominent. 
Most individuals with anorexia nervosa are preoccupied with thoughts of food. Some col- 
lect recipes or hoard food. Observations of behaviors associated with other forms of star- 
vation suggest that obsessions and compulsions related to food may be exacerbated by 
undernutrition. When individuals with anorexia nervosa exhibit obsessions and compul- 
sions that are not related to food, body shape, or weight, an additional diagnosis of obses- 
sive-compulsive disorder (OCD) may be warranted. 

Other features sometimes associated with anorexia nervosa include concerns about 
eating in public, feelings of ineffectiveness, a strong desire to control one’s environment, 
inflexible thinking, limited social spontaneity, and overly restrained emotional ex- 
pression. Compared with individuals with anorexia nervosa, restricting type, those with 
binge-eating /purging type have higher rates of impulsivity and are more likely to abuse 
alcohol and other drugs. 

A subgroup of individuals with anorexia nervosa show excessive levels of physical ac- 
tivity. Increases in physical activity often precede onset of the disorder, and over the 
course of the disorder increased activity accelerates weight loss. During treatment, exces- 
sive activity may be difficult to control, thereby jeopardizing weight recovery. 

Individuals with anorexia nervosa may misuse medications, such as by manipulating 
dosage, in order to achieve weight loss or avoid weight gain. Individuals with diabetes 
mellitus may omit or reduce insulin doses in order to minimize carbohydrate metabolism. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence of anorexia nervosa among young females is approximately 
0.4%. Less is known about prevalence among males, but anorexia nervosa is far less com- 
mon in males than in females, with clinical populations generally reflecting approximately 
a 10:1 female-to-male ratio. 


Development and Course 


Anorexia nervosa commonly begins during adolescence or young adulthood. It rarely be- 
gins before puberty or after age 40, but cases of both early and late onset have been de- 
scribed. The onset of this disorder is often associated with a stressful life event, such as 
leaving home for college. The course and outcome of anorexia nervosa are highly variable. 
Younger individuals may manifest atypical features, including denying “fear of fat.” Older 


342 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


individuals more likely have a longer duration of illness, and their clinical presentation may 
include more signs and symptoms of long-standing disorder. Clinicians should not exclude 
anorexia nervosa from the differential diagnosis solely on the basis of older age. 

Many individuals have a period of changed eating behavior prior to full criteria for the 
disorder being met. Some individuals with anorexia nervosa recover fully after a single 
episode, with some exhibiting a fluctuating pattern of weight gain followed by relapse, 
and others experiencing a chronic course over many years. Hospitalization may be re- 
quired to restore weight and to address medical complications. Most individuals with an- 
orexia nervosa experience remission within 5 years of presentation. Among individuals 
admitted to hospitals, overall remission rates may be lower. The crude mortality rate (CMR) 
for anorexia nervosa is approximately 5% per decade. Death most commonly results from 
medical complications associated with the disorder itself or from suicide. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Individuals who develop anxiety disorders or display obsessional 
traits in childhood are at increased risk of developing anorexia nervosa. 


Environmental. Historical and cross-cultural variability in the prevalence of anorexia 
nervosa supports its association with cultures and settings in which thinness is valued. Oc- 
cupations and avocations that encourage thinness, such as modeling and elite athletics, are 
also associated with increased risk. 


Genetic and physiological. There is an increased risk of anorexia nervosa and bulimia 
nervosa among first-degree biological relatives of individuals with the disorder. An in- 
creased risk of bipolar and depressive disorders has also been found among first-degree 
relatives of individuals with anorexia nervosa, particularly relatives of individuals with 
the binge-eating/purging type. Concordance rates for anorexia nervosa in monozygotic 
twins are significantly higher than those for dizygotic twins. A range of brain abnormali- 
ties has been described in anorexia nervosa using functional imaging technologies (func- 
tional magnetic resonance imaging, positron emission tomography). The degree to which 
these findings reflect changes associated with malnutrition versus primary abnormalities 
associated with the disorder is unclear. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Anorexia nervosa occurs across culturally and socially diverse populations, although available 
evidence suggests cross-cultural variation in its occurrence and presentation. Anorexia ner- 
vosa is probably most prevalent in post-industrialized, high-income countries such as in the 
United States, many European countries, Australia, New Zealand, and Japan, but its incidence 
in most low- and middle-income countries is uncertain. Whereas the prevalence of anorexia 
nervosa appears comparatively low among Latinos, African Americans, and Asians in the 
United States, clinicians should be aware that mental health service utilization among individ- 
uals with an eating disorder is significantly lower in these ethnic groups and that the low rates 
may reflect an ascertainment bias. The presentation of weight concerns among individuals 
with eating and feeding disorders varies substantially across cultural contexts. The absence of 
an expressed intense fear of weight gain, sometimes referred to as “fat phobia,” appears to be 
relatively more common in populations in Asia, where the rationale for dietary restriction is 
commonly related to a more culturally sanctioned complaint such as gastrointestinal discom- 
fort. Within the United States, presentations without a stated intense fear of weight gain may 
be comparatively more common among Latino groups. 


Diagnostic Markers 


The following laboratory abnormalities may be observed in anorexia nervosa; their pres- 
ence may serve to increase diagnostic confidence. 


Anorexia Nervosa 343 


Hematology. Leukopenia is common, with the loss of all cell types but usually with ap- 
parent lymphocytosis. Mild anemia can occur, as well as thrombocytopenia and, rarely, 
bleeding problems. 


Serum chemistry. Dehydration may be reflected by an elevated blood urea nitrogen 
level. Hypercholesterolemia is common. Hepatic enzyme levels may be elevated. Hypo- 
magnesemia, hypozincemia, hypophosphatemia, and hyperamylasemia are occasionally 
observed. Self-induced vomiting may lead to metabolic alkalosis (elevated serum bicarbon- 
ate), hypochloremia, and hypokalemia; laxative abuse may cause a mild metabolic acidosis. 


Endocrine. Serum thyroxine (T4) levels are usually in the low-normal range; triiodothy- 
ronine (T3) levels are decreased, while reverse T3 levels are elevated. Females have low se- 
rum estrogen levels, whereas males have low levels of serum testosterone. 


Electrocardiography. Sinus bradycardia is common, and, rarely, arrhythmias are noted. 
Significant prolongation of the QTc interval is observed in some individuals. 


Bone mass. Low bone mineral density, with specific areas of osteopenia or osteoporo- 
sis, is often seen. The risk of fracture is significantly elevated. 


Electroencephalography. Diffuse abnormalities, reflecting a metabolic encephalopa- 
thy, may result from significant fluid and electrolyte disturbances. 


Resting energy expenditure. There is often a significant reduction in resting energy ex- 
penditure. 


Physical signs and symptoms. Many of the physical signs and symptoms of anorexia 
nervosa are attributable to starvation. Amenorrhea is commonly present and appears to 
be an indicator of physiological dysfunction. If present, amenorrhea is usually a conse- 
quence of the weight loss, but in a minority of individuals it may actually precede the 
weight loss. In prepubertal females, menarche may be delayed. In addition to amenorrhea, 
there may be complaints of constipation, abdominal pain, cold intolerance, lethargy, and 
excess energy. 

The most remarkable finding on physical examination is emaciation. Commonly, there 
is also significant hypotension, hypothermia, and bradycardia. Some individuals develop 
lanugo, a fine downy body hair. Some develop peripheral edema, especially during 
weight restoration or upon cessation of laxative and diuretic abuse. Rarely, petechiae or 
ecchymoses, usually on the extremities, may indicate a bleeding diathesis. Some individ- 
uals evidence a yellowing of the skin associated with hypercarotenemia. As may be seen in 
individuals with bulimia nervosa, individuals with anorexia nervosa who self-induce 
vomiting may have hypertrophy of the salivary glands, particularly the parotid glands, as 
well as dental enamel erosion. Some individuals may have scars or calluses on the dorsal 
surface of the hand from repeated contact with the teeth while inducing vomiting. 


Suicide Risk 


Suicide risk is elevated in anorexia nervosa, with rates reported as 12 per 100,000 per year. 
Comprehensive evaluation of individuals with anorexia nervosa should include assess- 
ment of suicide-related ideation and behaviors as well as other risk factors for suicide, in- 
cluding a history of suicide attempt(s). 


Functional Consequences of Anorexia Nervosa 


Individuals with anorexia nervosa may exhibit a range of functional limitations associated 
with the disorder. While some individuals remain active in social and professional func- 
tioning, others demonstrate significant social isolation and/or failure to fulfill academic or 
career potential. 


344 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other possible causes of either significantly low body weight or significant weight loss 
should be considered in the differential diagnosis of anorexia nervosa, especially when the 
presenting features are atypical (e.g., onset after age 40 years). 


Medical conditions (e.g., gastrointestinal disease, hyperthyroidism, occult malignan- 
cies, and acquired immunodeficiency syndrome [AIDS]). Serious weight loss may oc- 
cur in medical conditions, but individuals with these disorders usually do not also mani- 
fest a disturbance in the way their body weight or shape is experienced or an intense fear 
of weight gain or persist in behaviors that interfere with appropriate weight gain. Acute 
weight loss associated with a medical condition can occasionally be followed by the onset 
or recurrence of anorexia nervosa, which can initially be masked by the comorbid medical 
condition. Rarely, anorexia nervosa develops after bariatric surgery for obesity. 


Major depressive disorder. In major depressive disorder, severe weight loss may occur, 
but most individuals with major depressive disorder do not have either a desire for exces- 
sive weight loss or an intense fear of gaining weight. 


Schizophrenia. Individuals with schizophrenia may exhibit odd eating behavior and oc- 
casionally experience significant weight loss, but they rarely show the fear of gaining 
weight and the body image disturbance required for a diagnosis of anorexia nervosa. 


Substance use disorders. Individuals with substance use disorders may experience low 
weight due to poor nutritional intake but generally do not fear gaining weight and do not 
manifest body image disturbance. Individuals who abuse substances that reduce appetite 
(e.g., cocaine, stimulants) and who also endorse fear of weight gain should be carefully 
evaluated for the possibility of comorbid anorexia nervosa, given that the substance use 
may represent a persistent behavior that interferes with weight gain (Criterion B). 


Social anxiety disorder (social phobia), obsessive-compulsive disorder, and body dys- 
morphic disorder. Some of the features of anorexia nervosa overlap with the criteria for 
social phobia, OCD, and body dysmorphic disorder. Specifically, individuals may feel hu- 
miliated or embarrassed to be seen eating in public, as in social phobia; may exhibit obses- 
sions and compulsions related to food, as in OCD; or may be preoccupied with an imagined 
defect in bodily appearance, as in body dysmorphic disorder. If the individual with anorexia 
nervosa has social fears that are limited to eating behavior alone, the diagnosis of social pho- 
bia should not be made, but social fears unrelated to eating behavior (e.g., excessive fear of 
speaking in public) may warrant an additional diagnosis of social phobia. Similarly, an ad- 
ditional diagnosis of OCD should be considered only if the individual exhibits obsessions 
and compulsions unrelated to food (e.g., an excessive fear of contamination), and an addi- 
tional diagnosis of body dysmorphic disorder should be considered only if the distortion is 
unrelated to body shape and size (e.g., preoccupation that one’s nose is too big). 


Bulimia nervosa. Individuals with bulimia nervosa exhibit recurrent episodes of binge 
eating, engage in inappropriate behavior to avoid weight gain (e.g., self-induced vomit- 
ing), and are overly concerned with body shape and weight. However, unlike individuals 
with anorexia nervosa, binge-eating / purging type, individuals with bulimia nervosa main- 
tain body weight at or above a minimally normal level. 

Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder. Individuals with this disorder may exhibit 
significant weight loss or significant nutritional deficiency, but they do not have a fear of 
gaining weight or of becoming fat, nor do they have a disturbance in the way they expe- 
rience their body shape and weight. 


Comorbidity 


Bipolar, depressive, and anxiety disorders commonly co-occur with anorexia nervosa. 
Many individuals with anorexia nervosa report the presence of either an anxiety disorder 


Bulimia Nervosa 345 


or symptoms prior to onset of their eating disorder. OCD is described in some individuals 
with anorexia nervosa, especially those with the restricting type. Alcohol use disorder and 
other substance use disorders may also be comorbid with anorexia nervosa, especially 
among those with the binge-eating/purging type. 


Bulimia Nervosa 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.51 (F50.2) 


A. Recurrent episodes of binge eating. An episode of binge eating is characterized by 
both of the following: 


1. Eating, in a discrete period of time (e.g., within any 2-hour period), an amount of 
food that is definitely larger than what most individuals would eat in a similar period 
of time under similar circumstances. 

2. A sense of lack of control over eating during the episode (e.g., a feeling that one 
cannot stop eating or control what or how much one is eating). 


B. Recurrent inappropriate compensatory behaviors in order to prevent weight gain, such 
as self-induced vomiting; misuse of laxatives, diuretics, or other medications; fasting; 
or excessive exercise. 

C. The binge eating and inappropriate compensatory behaviors both occur, on average, 
at least once a week for 3 months. 

D. Self-evaluation is unduly influenced by body shape and weight. 

E. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during episodes of anorexia nervosa. 


Specify if: 
In partial remission: After full criteria for bulimia nervosa were previously met, some, 
but not all, of the criteria have been met for a sustained period of time. 
In full remission: After full criteria for bulimia nervosa were previously met, none of 
the criteria have been met for a sustained period of time. 


Specify current severity: 
The minimum level of severity is based on the frequency of inappropriate compensatory 
behaviors (see below). The level of severity may be increased to reflect other symptoms 
and the degree of functional disability. 
Mild: An average of 1-3 episodes of inappropriate compensatory behaviors per week. 
Moderate: An average of 4—7 episodes of inappropriate compensatory behaviors per 
week. 
Severe: An average of 8-13 episodes of inappropriate compensatory behaviors per 
week. 
Extreme: An average of 14 or more episodes of inappropriate compensatory behav- 
iors per week. 


Diagnostic Features 
There are three essential features of bulimia nervosa: recurrent episodes of binge eating 
(Criterion A), recurrent inappropriate compensatory behaviors to prevent weight gain 
(Criterion B), and self-evaluation that is unduly influenced by body shape and weight 
(Criterion D). To qualify for the diagnosis, the binge eating and inappropriate compensa- 
tory behaviors must occur, on average, at least once per week for 3 months (Criterion C). 
An “episode of binge eating” is defined as eating, in a discrete period of time, an 
amount of food that is definitely larger than most individuals would eat in a similar period 
of time under similar circumstances (Criterion A1). The context in which the eating occurs 


346 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


may affect the clinician’s estimation of whether the intake is excessive. For example, a 
quantity of food that might be regarded as excessive for a typical meal might be consid- 
ered normal during a celebration or holiday meal. A “discrete period of time” refers to a 
limited period, usually less than 2 hours. A single episode of binge eating need not be re- 
stricted to one setting. For example, an individual may begin a binge in a restaurant and 
then continue to eat on returning home. Continual snacking on small amounts of food 
throughout the day would not be considered an eating binge. 

An occurrence of excessive food consumption must be accompanied by a sense of lack 
of control (Criterion A2) to be considered an episode of binge eating. An indicator of loss 
of control is the inability to refrain from eating or to stop eating once started. Some indi- 
viduals describe a dissociative quality during, or following, the binge-eating episodes. The 
impairment in control associated with binge eating may not be absolute; for example, an 
individual may continue binge eating while the telephone is ringing but will cease if a 
roommate or spouse unexpectedly enters the room. Some individuals report that their 
binge-eating episodes are no longer characterized by an acute feeling of loss of control but 
rather by a more generalized pattern of uncontrolled eating. If individuals report that they 
have abandoned efforts to control their eating, loss of control should be considered as 
present. Binge eating can also be planned in some instances. 

The type of food consumed during binges varies both across individuals and for a 
given individual. Binge eating appears to be characterized more by an abnormality in the 
amount of food consumed than by a craving for a specific nutrient. However, during binges, 
individuals tend to eat foods they would otherwise avoid. 

Individuals with bulimia nervosa are typically ashamed of their eating problems and 
attempt to conceal their symptoms. Binge eating usually occurs in secrecy or as inconspic- 
uously as possible. The binge eating often continues until the individual is uncomfortably, 
or even painfully, full. The most common antecedent of binge eating is negative affect. 
Other triggers include interpersonal stressors; dietary restraint; negative feelings related 
to body weight, body shape, and food; and boredom. Binge eating may minimize or mit- 
igate factors that precipitated the episode in the short-term, but negative self-evaluation 
and dysphoria often are the delayed consequences. 

Another essential feature of bulimia nervosa is the recurrent use of inappropriate com- 
pensatory behaviors to prevent weight gain, collectively referred to as purge behaviors or 
purging (Criterion B). Many individuals with bulimia nervosa employ several methods to 
compensate for binge eating. Vomiting is the most common inappropriate compensatory 
behavior. The immediate effects of vomiting include relief from physical discomfort and re- 
duction of fear of gaining weight. In some cases, vomiting becomes a goal in itself, and the 
individual will binge eat in order to vomit or will vomit after eating a small amount of food. 
Individuals with bulimia nervosa may use a variety of methods to induce vomiting, includ- 
ing the use of fingers or instruments to stimulate the gag reflex. Individuals generally 
become adept at inducing vomiting and are eventually able to vomit at will. Rarely, indi- 
viduals consume syrup of ipecac to induce vomiting. Other purging behaviors include the 
misuse of laxatives and diuretics. A number of other compensatory methods may also be 
used in rare cases. Individuals with bulimia nervosa may misuse enemas following epi- 
sodes of binge eating, but this is seldom the sole compensatory method employed. Individ- 
uals with this disorder may take thyroid hormone in an attempt to avoid weight gain. 
Individuals with diabetes mellitus and bulimia nervosa may omit or reduce insulin doses in 
order to reduce the metabolism of food consumed during eating binges. Individuals with 
bulimia nervosa may fast for a day or more or exercise excessively in an attempt to prevent 
weight gain. Exercise may be considered excessive when it significantly interferes with im- 
portant activities, when it occurs at inappropriate times or in inappropriate settings, or 
when the individual continues to exercise despite injury or other medical complications. 

Individuals with bulimia nervosa place an excessive emphasis on body shape or weight 
in their self-evaluation, and these factors are typically extremely important in determining 


Bulimia Nervosa 347 


self-esteem (Criterion D). Individuals with this disorder may closely resemble those with 
anorexia nervosa in their fear of gaining weight, in their desire to lose weight, and in the 
level of dissatisfaction with their bodies. However, a diagnosis of bulimia nervosa should 
not be given when the disturbance occurs only during episodes of anorexia nervosa (Cri- 
terion E). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with bulimia nervosa typically are within the normal weight or overweight 
range (body mass index [BMI] > 18.5 and < 30 in adults). The disorder occurs but is un- 
common among obese individuals. Between eating binges, individuals with bulimia ner- 
vosa typically restrict their total caloric consumption and preferentially select low-calorie 
(“diet”) foods while avoiding foods that they perceive to be fattening or likely to trigger a 
binge. 

Menstrual irregularity or amenorrhea often occurs among females with bulimia ner- 
vosa; it is uncertain whether such disturbances are related to weight fluctuations, to nu- 
tritional deficiencies, or to emotional distress. The fluid and electrolyte disturbances 
resulting from the purging behavior are sometimes sufficiently severe to constitute med- 
ically serious problems. Rare but potentially fatal complications include esophageal tears, 
gastric rupture, and cardiac arrhythmias. Serious cardiac and skeletal myopathies have 
been reported among individuals following repeated use of syrup of ipecac to induce vom- 
iting. Individuals who chronically abuse laxatives may become dependent on their use to 
stimulate bowel movements. Gastrointestinal symptoms are commonly associated with 
bulimia nervosa, and rectal prolapse has also been reported among individuals with this 
disorder. 


Prevalence 


Twelve-month prevalence of bulimia nervosa among young females is 1%-1.5%. Point 
prevalence is highest among young adults since the disorder peaks in older adolescence 
and young adulthood. Less is known about the point prevalence of bulimia nervosa in 
males, but bulimia nervosa is far less common in males than it is in females, with an ap- 
proximately 10:1 female-to-male ratio. 


Development and Course 


Bulimia nervosa commonly begins in adolescence or young adulthood. Onset before pu- 
berty or after age 40 is uncommon. The binge eating frequently begins during or after an 
episode of dieting to lose weight. Experiencing multiple stressful life events also can pre- 
cipitate onset of bulimia nervosa. 

Disturbed eating behavior persists for at least several years in a high percentage of 
clinic samples. The course may be chronic or intermittent, with periods of remission 
alternating with recurrences of binge eating. However, over longer-term follow-up, the 
symptoms of many individuals appear to diminish with or without treatment, although 
treatment clearly impacts outcome. Periods of remission longer than 1 year are associated 
with better long-term outcome. 

Significantly elevated risk for mortality (all-cause and suicide) has been reported for 
individuals with bulimia nervosa. The CMR (crude mortality rate) for bulimia nervosa is 
nearly 2% per decade. 

Diagnostic cross-over from initial bulimia nervosa to anorexia nervosa occurs in a mi- 
nority of cases (10%-15%). Individuals who do experience cross-over to anorexia nervosa 
commonly will revert back to bulimia nervosa or have multiple occurrences of cross-overs 
between these disorders. A subset of individuals with bulimia nervosa continue to binge 
eat but no longer engage in inappropriate compensatory behaviors, and therefore their 


348 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


symptoms meet criteria for binge-eating disorder or other specified eating disorder. Diag- 
nosis should be based on the current (i.e., past 3 months) clinical presentation. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Weight concerns, low self-esteem, depressive symptoms, social anxi- 
ety disorder, and overanxious disorder of childhood are associated with increased risk for 
the development of bulimia nervosa. 


Environmental. Internalization of a thin body ideal has been found to increase risk for 
developing weight concerns, which in turn increase risk for the development of bulimia 
nervosa. Individuals who experienced childhood sexual or physical abuse are at increased 
risk for developing bulimia nervosa. 


Genetic and physiological. Childhood obesity and early pubertal maturation increase 
risk for bulimia nervosa. Familial transmission of bulimia nervosa may be present, as well 
as genetic vulnerabilities for the disorder. 


Course modifiers. Severity of psychiatric comorbidity predicts worse long-term outcome 
of bulimia nervosa. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Bulimia nervosa has been reported to occur with roughly similar frequencies in most in- 
dustrialized countries, including the United States, Canada, many European countries, 
Australia, Japan, New Zealand, and South Africa. In clinical studies of bulimia nervosa in 
the United States, individuals presenting with this disorder are primarily white. However, 
the disorder also occurs in other ethnic groups and with prevalence comparable to esti- 
mated prevalences observed in white samples. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Bulimia nervosa is far more common in females than in males. Males are especially under- 
represented in treatment-seeking samples, for reasons that have not yet been systemati- 
cally examined. 


Diagnostic Markers 


No specific diagnostic test for bulimia nervosa currently exists. However, several labora- 
tory abnormalities may occur as a consequence of purging and may increase diagnostic 
certainty. These include fluid and electrolyte abnormalities, such as hypokalemia (which 
can provoke cardiac arrhythmias), hypochloremia, and hyponatremia. The loss of gastric 
acid through vomiting may produce a metabolic alkalosis (elevated serum bicarbonate), 
and the frequent induction of diarrhea or dehydration through laxative and diuretic abuse 
can cause metabolic acidosis. Some individuals with bulimia nervosa exhibit mildly ele- 
vated levels of serum amylase, probably reflecting an increase in the salivary isoenzyme. 

Physical examination usually yields no physical findings. However, inspection of the 
mouth may reveal significant and permanent loss of dental enamel, especially from lin- 
gual surfaces of the front teeth due to recurrent vomiting. These teeth may become 
chipped and appear ragged and “moth-eaten.” There may also be an increased frequency 
of dental caries. In some individuals, the salivary glands, particularly the parotid glands, 
may become notably enlarged. Individuals who induce vomiting by manually stimulating 
the gag reflex may develop calluses or scars on the dorsal surface of the hand from re- 
peated contact with the teeth. Serious cardiac and skeletal myopathies have been reported 
among individuals following repeated use of syrup of ipecac to induce vomiting. 


Bulimia Nervosa 349 


Suicide Risk 


Suicide risk is elevated in bulimia nervosa. Comprehensive evaluation of individuals with 
this disorder should include assessment of suicide-related ideation and behaviors as well 
as other risk factors for suicide, including a history of suicide attempts. 


Functional Consequences of Bulimia Nervosa 


Individuals with bulimia nervosa may exhibit a range of functional limitations associated 
with the disorder. A minority of individuals report severe role impairment, with the so- 
cial-life domain most likely to be adversely affected by bulimia nervosa. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Anorexia nervosa, binge-eating/purging type. Individuals whose binge-eating behav- 
ior occurs only during episodes of anorexia nervosa are given the diagnosis anorexia ner- 
vosa, binge-eating/ purging type, and should not be given the additional diagnosis of 
bulimia nervosa. For individuals with an initial diagnosis of anorexia nervosa who binge 
and purge but whose presentation no longer meets the full criteria for anorexia nervosa, 
binge-eating/purging type (e.g., when weight is normal), a diagnosis of bulimia ner- 
vosa should be given only when all criteria for bulimia nervosa have been met for at least 
3 months. 


Binge-eating disorder. Some individuals binge eat but do not engage in regular inap- 
propriate compensatory behaviors. In these cases, the diagnosis of binge-eating disorder 
should be considered. 


Kleine-Levin syndrome. In certain neurological or other medical conditions, such as 
Kleine-Levin syndrome, there is disturbed eating behavior, but the characteristic psycho- 
logical features of bulimia nervosa, such as overconcern with body shape and weight, are 
not present. 


Major depressive disorder, with atypical features. Overeating is common in major de- 
pressive disorder, with atypical features, but individuals with this disorder do not engage 
in inappropriate compensatory behaviors and do not exhibit the excessive concern with 
body shape and weight characteristic of bulimia nervosa. If criteria for both disorders are 
met, both diagnoses should be given. 


Borderline personality disorder. Binge-eating behavior is included in the impulsive be- 
havior criterion that is part of the definition of borderline personality disorder. If the cri- 
teria for both borderline personality disorder and bulimia nervosa are met, both diagnoses 
should be given. 


Comorbidity 


Comorbidity with mental disorders is common in individuals with bulimia nervosa, with 
most experiencing at least one other mental disorder and many experiencing multiple co- 
morbidities. Comorbidity is not limited to any particular subset but rather occurs across a 
wide range of mental disorders. There is an increased frequency of depressive symptoms 
(e.g., low self-esteem) and bipolar and depressive disorders (particularly depressive dis- 
orders) in individuals with bulimia nervosa. In many individuals, the mood disturbance 
begins at the same time as or following the development of bulimia nervosa, and individ- 
uals often ascribe their mood disturbances to the bulimia nervosa. However, in some in- 
dividuals, the mood disturbance clearly precedes the development of bulimia nervosa. 
There may also be an increased frequency of anxiety symptoms (e.g., fear of social situa- 
tions) or anxiety disorders. These mood and anxiety disturbances frequently remit follow- 


350 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


ing effective treatment of the bulimia nervosa. The lifetime prevalence of substance use, 
particularly alcohol or stimulant use, is at least 30% among individuals with bulimia ner- 
vosa. Stimulant use often begins in an attempt to control appetite and weight. A substan- 
tial percentage of individuals with bulimia nervosa also have personality features that 
meet criteria for one or more personality disorders, most frequently borderline personality 
disorder. 


Binge-Eating Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.51 (F50.8) 


A. Recurrent episodes of binge eating. An episode of binge eating is characterized 
by both of the following: 

1. Eating, in a discrete period of time (e.g., within any 2-hour period), an amount of 
food that is definitely larger than what most people would eat in a similar period of 
time under similar circumstances. 

2. A sense of lack of control over eating during the episode (e.g., a feeling that one 
cannot stop eating or control what or how much one is eating). 

B. The binge-eating episodes are associated with three (or more) of the following: 


1. Eating much more rapidly than normal. 

2. Eating until feeling uncomfortably full. 

3. Eating large amounts of food when not feeling physically hungry. 

4. Eating alone because of feeling embarrassed by how much one is eating. 
5. Feeling disgusted with oneself, depressed, or very guilty afterward. 


. Marked distress regarding binge eating is present. 

. The binge eating occurs, on average, at least once a week for 3 months. 

. The binge eating is not associated with the recurrent use of inappropriate compensa- 
tory behavior as in bulimia nervosa and does not occur exclusively during the course 
of bulimia nervosa or anorexia nervosa. 


moog 


Specify if: 
In partial remission: After full criteria for binge-eating disorder were previously met, 
binge eating occurs at an average frequency of less than one episode per week for a 
sustained period of time. 
In full remission: After full criteria for binge-eating disorder were previously met, none 
of the criteria have been met for a sustained period of time. 
Specify current severity: 
The minimum level of severity is based on the frequency of episodes of binge eating (see 
below). The level of severity may be increased to reflect other symptoms and the degree 
of functional disability. 
Mild: 1—3 binge-eating episodes per week. 
Moderate: 4—7 binge-eating episodes per week. 
Severe: 8—13 binge-eating episodes per week. 
Extreme: 14 or more binge-eating episodes per week. 


Diagnostic Features 

The essential feature of binge-eating disorder is recurrent episodes of binge eating that 
must occur, on average, at least once per week for 3 months (Criterion D). An “episode of 
binge eating” is defined as eating, in a discrete period of time, an amount of food that is defi- 


Binge-Eating Disorder 351 


nitely larger than most people would eat in a similar period of time under similar circum- 
stances (Criterion A1). The context in which the eating occurs may affect the clinician’s 
estimation of whether the intake is excessive. For example, a quantity of food that might be 
regarded as excessive for a typical meal might be considered normal during a celebration 
or holiday meal. A “discrete period of time” refers to a limited period, usually less than 
2 hours. A single episode of binge eating need not be restricted to one setting. For example, 
an individual may begin a binge in a restaurant and then continue to eat on returning 
home. Continual snacking on small amounts of food throughout the day would not be con- 
sidered an eating binge. 

An occurrence of excessive food consumption must be accompanied by a sense of lack 
of control (Criterion A2) to be considered an episode of binge eating. An indicator of loss 
of control is the inability to refrain from eating or to stop eating once started. Some indi- 
viduals describe a dissociative quality during, or following, the binge-eating episodes. The 
impairment in control associated with binge eating may not be absolute; for example, an 
individual may continue binge eating while the telephone is ringing but will cease if a 
roommate or spouse unexpectedly enters the room. Some individuals report that their 
binge-eating episodes are no longer characterized by an acute feeling of loss of control but 
rather by a more generalized pattern of uncontrolled eating. If individuals report that they 
have abandoned efforts to control their eating, loss of control may still be considered as 
present. Binge eating can also be planned in some instances. 

The type of food consumed during binges varies both across individuals and for a given 
individual. Binge eating appears to be characterized more by an abnormality in the amount 
of food consumed than by a craving for a specific nutrient. 

Binge eating must be characterized by marked distress (Criterion C) and at least three 
of the following features: eating much more rapidly than normal; eating until feeling un- 
comfortably full; eating large amounts of food when not feeling physically hungry; eating 
alone because of feeling embarrassed by how much one is eating; and feeling disgusted 
with oneself, depressed, or very guilty afterward (Criterion B). 

Individuals with binge-eating disorder are typically ashamed of their eating problems 
and attempt to conceal their symptoms. Binge eating usually occurs in secrecy or as incon- 
spicuously as possible. The most common antecedent of binge eating is negative affect. 
Other triggers include interpersonal stressors; dietary restraint; negative feelings related 
to body weight, body shape, and food; and boredom. Binge eating may minimize or mit- 
igate factors that precipitated the episode in the short-term, but negative self-evaluation 
and dysphoria often are the delayed consequences. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Binge-eating disorder occurs in normal-weight/overweight and obese individuals. It is re- 
liably associated with overweight and obesity in treatment-seeking individuals. Never- 
theless, binge-eating disorder is distinct from obesity. Most obese individuals do not 
engage in recurrent binge eating. In addition, compared with weight-matched obese indi- 
viduals without binge-eating disorder, those with the disorder consume more calories in 
laboratory studies of eating behavior and have greater functional impairment, lower qual- 
ity of life, more subjective distress, and greater psychiatric comorbidity. 


Prevalence 


Twelve-month prevalence of binge-eating disorder among U.S. adult (age 18 or older) fe- 
males and males is 1.6% and 0.8%, respectively. The gender ratio is far less skewed in binge- 
eating disorder than in bulimia nervosa. Binge-eating disorder is as prevalent among fe- 
males from racial or ethnic minority groups as has been reported for white females. The 
disorder is more prevalent among individuals seeking weight-loss treatment than in the 
general population. 


352 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


Development and Course 


Little is known about the development of binge-eating disorder. Both binge eating and 
loss-of-control eating without objectively excessive consumption occur in children and are 
associated with increased body fat, weight gain, and increases in psychological symptoms. 
Binge eating is common in adolescent and college-age samples. Loss-of-control eating or 
episodic binge eating may represent a prodromal phase of eating disorders for some indi- 
viduals. 

Dieting follows the development of binge eating in many individuals with binge- 
eating disorder. (This is in contrast to bulimia nervosa, in which dysfunctional dieting 
usually precedes the onset of binge eating.) Binge-eating disorder typically begins in ad- 
olescence or young adulthood but can begin in later adulthood. Individuals with binge- 
eating disorder who seek treatment usually are older than individuals with either bulimia 
nervosa or anorexia nervosa who seek treatment. 

Remission rates in both natural course and treatment outcome studies are higher for 
binge-eating disorder than for bulimia nervosa or anorexia nervosa. Binge-eating disorder 
appears to be relatively persistent, and the course is comparable to that of bulimia nervosa 
in terms of severity and duration. Crossover from binge-eating disorder to other eating 
disorders is uncommon. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Binge-eating disorder appears to run in families, which may 
reflect additive genetic influences. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Binge-eating disorder occurs with roughly similar frequencies in most industrialized 
countries, including the United States, Canada, many European countries, Australia, and 
New Zealand. In the United States, the prevalence of binge-eating disorder appears com- 
parable among non-Latino whites, Latinos, Asians, and African Americans. 


Functional Consequences of Binge-Eating Disorder 


Binge-eating disorder is associated with a range of functional consequences, including so- 
cial role adjustment problems, impaired health-related quality of life and life satisfaction, 
increased medical morbidity and mortality, and associated increased health care utiliza- 
tion compared with body mass index (BMI)-matched control subjects. It may also be as- 
sociated with an increased risk for weight gain and the development of obesity. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Bulimia nervosa. Binge-eating disorder has recurrent binge eating in common with bu- 
limia nervosa but differs from the latter disorder in some fundamental respects. In terms of 
clinical presentation, the recurrent inappropriate compensatory behavior (e.g., purging, 
driven exercise) seen in bulimia nervosa is absent in binge-eating disorder. Unlike in- 
dividuals with bulimia nervosa, individuals with binge-eating disorder typically do not 
show marked or sustained dietary restriction designed to influence body weight and 
shape between binge-eating episodes. They may, however, report frequent attempts at 
dieting. Binge-eating disorder also differs from bulimia nervosa in terms of response to treat- 
ment. Rates of improvement are consistently higher among individuals with binge-eating 
disorder than among those with bulimia nervosa. 


Obesity. Binge-eating disorder is associated with overweight and obesity but has 
several key features that are distinct from obesity. First, levels of overvaluation of body 


Other Specified Feeding or Eating Disorder 353 


weight and shape are higher in obese individuals with the disorder than in those without 
the disorder. Second, rates of psychiatric comorbidity are significantly higher among 
obese individuals with the disorder compared with those without the disorder. Third, the 
long-term successful outcome of evidence-based psychological treatments for binge- 
eating disorder can be contrasted with the absence of effective long-term treatments for 
obesity. 


Bipolar and depressive disorders. Increases in appetite and weight gain are included 
in the criteria for major depressive episode and in the atypical features specifiers for de- 
pressive and bipolar disorders. Increased eating in the context of a major depressive epi- 
sode may or may not be associated with loss of control. If the full criteria for both disorders 
are met, both diagnoses can be given. Binge eating and other symptoms of disordered eat- 
ing are seen in association with bipolar disorder. If the full criteria for both disorders are 
met, both diagnoses should be given. 


Borderline personality disorder. Binge eating is included in the impulsive behavior cri- 
terion that is part of the definition of borderline personality disorder. If the full criteria for 
both disorders are met, both diagnoses should be given. 


Comorbidity 


Binge-eating disorder is associated with significant psychiatric comorbidity that is com- 
parable to that of bulimia nervosa and anorexia nervosa. The most common comorbid dis- 
orders are bipolar disorders, depressive disorders, anxiety disorders, and, to a lesser 
degree, substance use disorders. The psychiatric comorbidity is linked to the severity of 
binge eating and not to the degree of obesity. 


Other Specified Feeding or Eating Disorder 
307.59 (F50.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a feeding and 
eating disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupation- 
al, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for 
any of the disorders in the feeding and eating disorders diagnostic class. The other spec- 
ified feeding or eating disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses 
to communicate the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any 
specific feeding and eating disorder. This is done by recording “other specified feeding or 
eating disorder” followed by the specific reason (e.g., “bulimia nervosa of low frequency”). 

Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 

1. Atypical anorexia nervosa: All of the criteria for anorexia nervosa are met, except 
that despite significant weight loss, the individual’s weight is within or above the normal 
range. 

2. Bulimia nervosa (of low frequency and/or limited duration): All of the criteria for 
bulimia nervosa are met, except that the binge eating and inappropriate compensatory 
behaviors occur, on average, less than once a week and/or for less than 3 months. 

3. Binge-eating disorder (of low frequency and/or limited duration): All of the criteria 
for binge-eating disorder are met, except that the binge eating occurs, on average, less 
than once a week and/or for less than 3 months. 

4. Purging disorder: Recurrent purging behavior to influence weight or shape (e.g., self- 
induced vomiting; misuse of laxatives, diuretics, or other medications) in the absence 
of binge eating. 


354 Feeding and Eating Disorders 


5. Night eating syndrome: Recurrent episodes of night eating, as manifested by eating 
after awakening from sleep or by excessive food consumption after the evening meal. 
There is awareness and recall of the eating. The night eating is not better explained by 
external influences such as changes in the individual’s sleep-wake cycle or by local so- 
cial norms. The night eating causes significant distress and/or impairment in function- 
ing. The disordered pattern of eating is not better explained by binge-eating disorder 
or another mental disorder, including substance use, and is not attributable to another 
medical disorder or to an effect of medication. 


Unspecified Feeding or Eating Disorder 
307.50 (F50.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a feeding and 
eating disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupation- 
al, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for 
any of the disorders in the feeding and eating disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified 
feeding or eating disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not 
to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for a specific feeding and eating disorder, 
and includes presentations in which there is insufficient information to make a more spe- 
cific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Elimination 
Disorders 


Elimination disorders all involve the inappropriate elimination of urine or feces 
and are usually first diagnosed in childhood or adolescence. This group of disorders in- 
cludes enuresis, the repeated voiding of urine into inappropriate places, and encopresis, the 
repeated passage of feces into inappropriate places. Subtypes are provided to differentiate 
nocturnal from diurnal (i.e., during waking hours) voiding for enuresis and the presence or 
absence of constipation and overflow incontinence for encopresis. Although there are min- 
imum age requirements for diagnosis of both disorders, these are based on developmental 
age and not solely on chronological age. Both disorders may be voluntary or involuntary. 
Although these disorders typically occur separately, co-occurrence may also be observed. 


Enuresis 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.6 (F98.0) 


A. Repeated voiding of urine into bed or clothes, whether involuntary or intentional. 

B. The behavior is clinically significant as manifested by either a frequency of at least twice a 
week for at least 3 consecutive months or the presence of clinically significant distress or 
impairment in social, academic (occupational), or other important areas of functioning. 

C. Chronological age is at least 5 years (or equivalent developmental level). 

D. The behavior is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a di- 
uretic, an antipsychotic medication) or another medical condition (e.g., diabetes, spina 
bifida, a seizure disorder). 


Specify whether: 
Nocturnal only: Passage of urine only during nighttime sleep. 
Diurnal only: Passage of urine during waking hours. 
Nocturnal and diurnal: A combination of the two subtypes above. 


Subtypes 


The nocturnal-only subtype of enuresis, sometimes referred to as monosymptomatic enure- 
sis, is the most common subtype and involves incontinence only during nighttime sleep, 
typically during the first one-third of the night. The diurnal-only subtype occurs in the 
absence of nocturnal enuresis and may be referred to simply as urinary incontinence. Indi- 
viduals with this subtype can be divided into two groups. Individuals with “urge incon- 
tinence” have sudden urge symptoms and detrusor instability, whereas individuals with 
“voiding postponement” consciously defer micturition urges until incontinence results. 
The nocturnal-and-diurnal subtype is also known as nonmonosymptomatic enuresis. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of enuresis is repeated voiding of urine during the day or at night into 
bed or clothes (Criterion A). Most often the voiding is involuntary, but occasionally it may 


355 


356 Elimination Disorders 


be intentional. To qualify for a diagnosis of enuresis, the voiding of urine must occur at 
least twice a week for at least 3 consecutive months or must cause clinically significant dis- 
tress or impairment in social, academic (occupational), or other important areas of func- 
tioning (Criterion B). The individual must have reached an age at which continence is 
expected (i-e., a chronological age of at least 5 years or, for children with developmental 
delays, a mental age of at least 5 years) (Criterion C). The urinary incontinence is not at- 
tributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a diuretic, an antipsychotic med- 
ication) or another medical condition (e.g., diabetes, spina bifida, a seizure disorder) 
(Criterion D). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


During nocturnal enuresis, occasionally the voiding takes place during rapid eye movement 
(REM) sleep, and the child may recall a dream that involved the act of urinating. During day- 
time (diurnal) enuresis, the child defers voiding until incontinence occurs, sometimes because 
of a reluctance to use the toilet as a result of social anxiety or a preoccupation with school or 
play activity. The enuretic event most commonly occurs in the early afternoon on school days 
and may be associated with symptoms of disruptive behavior. The enuresis commonly per- 
sists after appropriate treatment of an associated infection. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of enuresis is 5%-10% among 5-year-olds, 3%-5% among 10-year-olds, 
and around 1% among individuals 15 years or older. 


Development and Course 


Two types of course of enuresis have been described: a “primary” type, in which the indi- 
vidual has never established urinary continence, and a “secondary” type, in which the dis- 
turbance develops after a period of established urinary continence. There are no differences 
in prevalence of comorbid mental disorders between the two types. By definition, primary 
enuresis begins at age 5 years. The most common time for the onset of secondary enuresis 
is between ages 5 and 8 years, but it may occur at any time. After age 5 years, the rate of spon- 
taneous remission is 5%-10% per year. Most children with the disorder become continent 
by adolescence, but in approximately 1% of cases the disorder continues into adulthood. 
Diurnal enuresis is uncommon after age 9 years. While occasional diurnal incontinence is 
not uncommon in middle childhood, it is substantially more common in those who also 
have persistent nocturnal enuresis. When enuresis persists into late childhood or adoles- 
cence, the frequency of incontinence may increase, whereas continence in early childhood 
is usually associated with a declining frequency of wet nights. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. A number of predisposing factors for enuresis have been suggested, in- 
cluding delayed or lax toilet training and psychosocial stress. 


Genetic and physiological. Enuresis has been associated with delays in the develop- 
ment of normal circadian rhythms of urine production, with resulting nocturnal polyuria 
or abnormalities of central vasopressin receptor sensitivity, and reduced functional blad- 
der capacities with bladder hyperreactivity (unstable bladder syndrome). Nocturnal en- 
uresis is a genetically heterogeneous disorder. Heritability has been shown in family, twin, 
and segregation analyses. Risk for childhood nocturnal enuresis is approximately 3.6 times 
higher in offspring of enuretic mothers and 10.1 times higher in the presence of paternal 
urinary incontinence. The risk magnitudes for nocturnal enuresis and diurnal incontinence 
are similar. 


Encopresis 357 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Enuresis has been reported in a variety of European, African, and Asian countries as well 
as in the United States. At a national level, prevalence rates are remarkably similar, and 
there is great similarity in the developmental trajectories found in different countries. 
There are very high rates of enuresis in orphanages and other residential institutions, 
likely related to the mode and environment in which toilet training occurs. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Nocturnal enuresis is more common in males. Diurnal incontinence is more common in fe- 
males. The relative risk of having a child who develops enuresis is greater for previously 
enuretic fathers than for previously enuretic mothers. 


Functional Consequences of Enuresis 


The amount of impairment associated with enuresis is a function of the limitation on the 
child’s social activities (e.g., ineligibility for sleep-away camp) or its effect on the child’s 
self-esteem, the degree of social ostracism by peers, and the anger, punishment, and rejec- 
tion on the part of caregivers. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Neurogenic bladder or another medical condition. The diagnosis of enuresis is not made 
in the presence of a neurogenic bladder or another medical condition that causes polyuria or 
urgency (e.g., untreated diabetes mellitus or diabetes insipidus) or during an acute urinary 
tract infection. However, a diagnosis is compatible with such conditions if urinary inconti- 
nence was regularly present prior to the development of another medical condition or if it per- 
sists after the institution of appropriate treatment of the medical condition. 


Medication side effects. Enuresis may occur during treatment with antipsychotic med- 
ications, diuretics, or other medications that may induce incontinence. In this case, the di- 
agnosis should not be made in isolation but may be noted as a medication side effect. 
However, a diagnosis of enuresis may be made if urinary incontinence was regularly pres- 
ent prior to treatment with the medication. 


Comorbidity 

Although most children with enuresis do not have a comorbid mental disorder, the prevalence 
of comorbid behavioral symptoms is higher in children with enuresis than in children without 
enuresis. Developmental delays, including speech, language, learning, and motor skills 
delays, are also present in a portion of children with enuresis. Encopresis, sleepwalking, and 
sleep terror disorder may be present. Urinary tract infections are more common in children 
with enuresis, especially the diurnal subtype, than in those who are continent. 


Encopresis 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.7 (F98.1) 


A. Repeated passage of feces into inappropriate places (e.g., clothing, floor), whether in- 
voluntary or intentional. 

B. At least one such event occurs each month for at least 3 months. 

C. Chronological age is at least 4 years (or equivalent developmental level). 

D. The behavior is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., laxa- 
tives) or another medical condition except through a mechanism involving constipation. 


358 Elimination Disorders 


Specify whether: 
With constipation and overflow incontinence: There is evidence of constipation on 
physical examination or by history. 
Without constipation and overflow incontinence: There is no evidence of constipa- 
tion on physical examination or by history. 


Subtypes 


Feces in the with constipation and overflow incontinence subtype are characteristically 
(but not invariably) poorly formed, and leakage can be infrequent to continuous, occur- 
ring mostly during the day and rarely during sleep. Only part of the feces is passed during 
toileting, and the incontinence resolves after treatment of the constipation. 

In the without constipation and overflow incontinence subtype, feces are likely to be of 
normal form and consistency, and soiling is intermittent. Feces may be deposited in a 
prominent location. This is usually associated with the presence of oppositional defiant 
disorder or conduct disorder or may be the consequence of anal masturbation. Soiling 
without constipation appears to be less common than soiling with constipation. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of encopresis is repeated passage of feces into inappropriate places (e.g., 
clothing or floor) (Criterion A). Most often the passage is involuntary but occasionally may be 
intentional. The event must occur at least once a month for at least 3 months (Criterion B), and 
the chronological age of the child must be at least 4 years (or for children with developmental 
delays, the mental age must be at least 4 years) (Criterion C). The fecal incontinence must not 
be exclusively attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., laxatives) or another 
medical condition except through a mechanism involving constipation (Criterion D). 

When the passage of feces is involuntary rather than intentional, it is often related to 
constipation, impaction, and retention with subsequent overflow. The constipation may 
develop for psychological reasons (e.g., anxiety about defecating in a particular place, a 
more general pattern of anxious or oppositional behavior), leading to avoidance of defeca- 
tion. Physiological predispositions to constipation include ineffectual straining or paradox- 
ical defecation dynamics, with contraction rather than relaxation of the external sphincter 
or pelvic floor during straining for defecation. Dehydration associated with a febrile ill- 
ness, hypothyroidism, or a medication side effect can also induce constipation. Once con- 
stipation has developed, it may be complicated by an anal fissure, painful defecation, and 
further fecal retention. The consistency of the stool may vary. In some individuals the stool 
may be of normal or near-normal consistency. In other individuals—such as those with 
overflow incontinence secondary to fecal retention—it may be liquid. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The child with encopresis often feels ashamed and may wish to avoid situations (e.g., 
camp, school) that might lead to embarrassment. The amount of impairment is a function 
of the effect on the child's self-esteem, the degree of social ostracism by peers, and the an- 
ger, punishment, and rejection on the part of caregivers. Smearing feces may be deliberate 
or accidental, resulting from the child’s attempt to clean or hide feces that were passed in- 
voluntarily. When the incontinence is clearly deliberate, features of oppositional defiant 
disorder or conduct disorder may also be present. Many children with encopresis and 
chronic constipation also have enuresis symptoms and may have associated urinary reflux 
in the bladder or ureters that may lead to chronic urinary infections, the symptoms of 
which may remit with treatment of the constipation. 


Other Specified Elimination Disorder 359 


Prevalence 


It is estimated that approximately 1% of 5-year-olds have encopresis, and the disorder is 
more common in males than in females. 


Development and Course 


Encopresis is not diagnosed until a child has reached a chronological age of at least 4 years 
(or for children with developmental delays, a mental age of at least 4 years). Inadequate, 
inconsistent toilet training and psychosocial stress (e.g., entering school, the birth of a sib- 
ling) may be predisposing factors. Two types of course have been described: a “primary” 
type, in which the individual has never established fecal continence, and a “secondary” 
type, in which the disturbance develops after a period of established fecal continence. En- 
copresis can persist, with intermittent exacerbations, for years. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Painful defecation can lead to constipation and a cycle of with- 
holding behaviors that make encopresis more likely. Use of some medications (e.g., anti- 
convulsants, cough suppressants) may increase constipation and make encopresis more 
likely. 


Diagnostic Markers 


In addition to physical examination, gastrointestinal imaging (e.g., abdominal radiograph) 
may be informative to assess retained stool and gas in the colon. Additional tests, such as 
barium enema and anorectal manography, may be used to help exclude other medical 
conditions, such as Hirschsprung’s disease. 


Differential Diagnosis 


A diagnosis of encopresis in the presence of another medical condition is appropriate only 
if the mechanism involves constipation that cannot be explained by other medical condi- 
tions. Fecal incontinence related to other medical conditions (e.g., chronic diarrhea, spina 
bifida, anal stenosis) would not warrant a DSM-5 diagnosis of encopresis. 


Comorbidity 


Urinary tract infections can be comorbid with encopresis and are more common in females. 


Other Specified Elimination Disorder 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an elimination 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the elimination disorders diagnostic class. The other specified elimination 
disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the 
specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific elimination 
disorder. This is done by recording “other specified elimination disorder” followed by the 
specific reason (e.g., “low-frequency enuresis”). 


Coding note: Code 788.39 (N39.498) for other specified elimination disorder with urinary 
symptoms; 787.60 (R15.9) for other specified elimination disorder with fecal symptoms. 


360 Elimination Disorders 


Unspecified Elimination Disorder 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an elimination 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the elimination disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified elimination dis- 
order category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason 
that the criteria are not met for a specific elimination disorder, and includes presentations 
in which there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emer- 
gency room settings). 


Coding note: Code 788.30 (R32) for unspecified elimination disorder with urinary symp- 
toms; 787.60 (R15.9) for unspecified elimination disorder with fecal symptoms. 


Sleep-Wake 
Disorders 


The DSM-5 classification of sleep-wake disorders is intended for use by general 
mental health and medical clinicians (those caring for adult, geriatric, and pediatric pa- 
tients). Sleep-wake disorders encompass 10 disorders or disorder groups: insomnia disor- 
der, hypersomnolence disorder, narcolepsy, breathing-related sleep disorders, circadian 
rhythm sleep-wake disorders, non-rapid eye movement (NREM) sleep arousal disorders, 
nightmare disorder, rapid eye movement (REM) sleep behavior disorder, restless legs syn- 
drome, and substance /medication-induced sleep disorder. Individuals with these disor- 
ders typically present with sleep-wake complaints of dissatisfaction regarding the quality, 
timing, and amount of sleep. Resulting daytime distress and impairment are core features 
shared by all of these sleep-wake disorders. 

The organization of this chapter is designed to facilitate differential diagnosis of sleep- 
wake complaints and to clarify when referral to a sleep specialist is appropriate for further 
assessment and treatment planning. The DSM-5 sleep disorders nosology uses a simple, 
clinically useful approach, while also reflecting scientific advances in epidemiology, ge- 
netics, pathophysiology, assessment, and interventions research since DSM-IV. In some 
cases (e.g., insomnia disorder), a “lumping” approach has been adopted, whereas in oth- 
ers (e.g., narcolepsy), a “splitting” approach has been taken, reflecting the availability of 
validators derived from epidemiological, neurobiological, and interventions research. 

Sleep disorders are often accompanied by depression, anxiety, and cognitive changes 
that must be addressed in treatment planning and management. Furthermore, persistent 
sleep disturbances (both insomnia and excessive sleepiness) are established risk factors for 
the subsequent development of mental illnesses and substance use disorders. They may 
also represent a prodromal expression of an episode of mental illness, allowing the possi- 
bility of early intervention to preempt or to attenuate a full-blown episode. 

The differential diagnosis of sleep-wake complaints necessitates a multidimensional 
approach, with consideration of possibly coexisting medical and neurological conditions. 
Coexisting clinical conditions are the rule, not the exception. Sleep disturbances furnish a 
clinically useful indicator of medical and neurological conditions that often coexist with 
depression and other common mental disorders. Prominent among these comorbidities 
are breathing-related sleep disorders, disorders of the heart and lungs (e.g., congestive 
heart failure, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease), neurodegenerative disorders (e.g., 
Alzheimer’s disease), and disorders of the musculoskeletal system (e.g., osteoarthritis). 
These disorders not only may disturb sleep but also may themselves be worsened during 
sleep (e.g., prolonged apneas or electrocardiographic arrhythmias during REM sleep; con- 
fusional arousals in patients with dementing illness; seizures in persons with complex 
partial seizures). REM sleep behavior disorder is often an early indicator of neurodegen- 
erative disorders (alpha synucleinopathies) like Parkinson’s disease. For all of these rea- 
sons—trelated to differential diagnosis, clinical comorbidity, and facilitation of treatment 
planning—sleep disorders are included in DSM-5. 

The approach taken to the classification of sleep-wake disorders in DSM-5 can be under- 
stood within the context of “lumping versus splitting.” DSM-IV represented an effort to 
simplify sleep-wake disorders classification and thus aggregated diagnoses under broader, 
less differentiated labels. At the other pole, the International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 


361 


362 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


2nd Edition (ICSD-2) elaborated numerous diagnostic subtypes. DSM-IV was prepared for 
use by mental health and general medical clinicians who are not experts in sleep medicine. 
ICSD-2 reflected the science and opinions of the sleep specialist community and was pre- 
pared for use by specialists. 

The weight of available evidence supports the superior performance characteristics 
(interrater reliability, as well as convergent, discriminant, and face validity) of simpler, less- 
differentiated approaches to diagnosis of sleep-wake disorders. The text accompanying 
each set of diagnostic criteria provides linkages to the corresponding disorders included in 
ICSD-2. The DSM-5 sleep-wake disorders classification also specifies corresponding non- 
psychiatric listings (e.g., neurology codes) from the International Classification of Diseases 
(ICD). 

The field of sleep disorders medicine has progressed in this direction since the publi- 
cation of DSM-IV. The use of biological validators is now embodied in the DSM-5 classi- 
fication of sleep-wake disorders, particularly for disorders of excessive sleepiness, such as 
narcolepsy; for breathing-related sleep disorders, for which formal sleep studies (i.e., 
polysomnography) are indicated; and for restless legs syndrome, which can often coexist 
with periodic limb movements during sleep, detectable via polysomnography. 


Insomnia Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.42 (F51.01) 


A. A predominant complaint of dissatisfaction with sleep quantity or quality, associated 
with one (or more) of the following symptoms: 


1. Difficulty initiating sleep. (In children, this may manifest as difficulty initiating sleep 
without caregiver intervention.) 

2. Difficulty maintaining sleep, characterized by frequent awakenings or problems re- 
turning to sleep after awakenings. (In children, this may manifest as difficulty return- 
ing to sleep without caregiver intervention.) 

3. Early-morning awakening with inability to return to sleep. 


ius) 


. The sleep disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, educational, academic, behavioral, or other important areas of functioning. 

. The sleep difficulty occurs at least 3 nights per week. 

. The sleep difficulty is present for at least 3 months. 

. The sleep difficulty occurs despite adequate opportunity for sleep. 

. The insomnia is not better explained by and does not occur exclusively during the 
course of another sleep-wake disorder (e.g., narcolepsy, a breathing-related sleep dis- 
order, a circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorder, a parasomnia). 

G. The insomnia is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug 

of abuse, a medication). 

H. Coexisting mental disorders and medical conditions do not adequately explain the pre- 

dominant complaint of insomnia. 


7™mO00Q0 


Specify if: 
With non-sleep disorder mental comorbidity, including substance use disorders 
With other medical comorbidity 
With other sleep disorder 
Coding note: The code 307.42 (F51.01) applies to all three specifiers. Code also the 
relevant associated mental disorder, medical condition, or other sleep disorder imme- 
diately after the code for insomnia disorder in order to indicate the association. 


Insomnia Disorder 363 


Specify if: 
Episodic: Symptoms last at least 1 month but less than 3 months. 
Persistent: Symptoms last 3 months or longer. 
Recurrent: Two (or more) episodes within the space of 1 year. 


Note: Acute and short-term insomnia (i.e., symptoms lasting less than 3 months but oth- 
erwise meeting all criteria with regard to frequency, intensity, distress, and/or impairment) 
should be coded as an other specified insomnia disorder. 


Note. The diagnosis of insomnia disorder is given whether it occurs as an independent 
condition or is comorbid with another mental disorder (e.g., major depressive disorder), 
medical condition (e.g., pain), or another sleep disorder (e.g., a breathing-related sleep dis- 
order). For instance, insomnia may develop its own course with some anxiety and depres- 
sive features but in the absence of criteria being met for any one mental disorder. Insomnia 
may also manifest as a clinical feature of a more predominant mental disorder. Persistent 
insomnia may even be a risk factor for depression and is a common residual symptom af- 
ter treatment for this condition. With comorbid insomnia and a mental disorder, treatment 
may also need to target both conditions. Given these different courses, it is often impossi- 
ble to establish the precise nature of the relationship between these clinical entities, and 
this relationship may change over time. Therefore, in the presence of insomnia and a co- 
morbid disorder, it is not necessary to make a causal attribution between the two condi- 
tions. Rather, the diagnosis of insomnia disorder is made with concurrent specification of 
the clinically comorbid conditions. A concurrent insomnia diagnosis should only be con- 
sidered when the insomnia is sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention; 
otherwise, no separate diagnosis is necessary. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of insomnia disorder is dissatisfaction with sleep quantity or quality 
with complaints of difficulty initiating or maintaining sleep. The sleep complaints are ac- 
companied by clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other 
important areas of functioning. The sleep disturbance may occur during the course of an- 
other mental disorder or medical condition, or it may occur independently. 

Different manifestations of insomnia can occur at different times of the sleep period. Sleep- 
onset insomnia (or initial insomnia) involves difficulty initiating sleep at bedtime. Sleep mainte- 
nance insomnia (or middle insomnia) involves frequent or prolonged awakenings throughout 
the night. Late insomnia involves early-morning awakening with an inability to return to sleep. 
Difficulty maintaining sleep is the most common single symptom of insomnia, followed by 
difficulty falling asleep, while a combination of these symptoms is the most common presen- 
tation overall. The specific type of sleep complaint often varies over time. Individuals who 
complain of difficulty falling asleep at one time may later complain of difficulty maintaining 
sleep, and vice versa. Symptoms of difficulty falling asleep and difficulty maintaining sleep 
can be quantified by the individual's retrospective self-report, sleep diaries, or other methods, 
such as actigraphy or polysomnography, but the diagnosis of insomnia disorder is based on 
the individual's subjective perception of sleep or a caretaker’s report. 

Nonrestorative sleep, a complaint of poor sleep quality that does not leave the individual 
rested upon awakening despite adequate duration, is a common sleep complaint usually 
occurring in association with difficulty initiating or maintaining sleep, or less frequently in 
isolation. This complaint can also be reported in association with other sleep disorders 
(e.g., breathing-related sleep disorder). When a complaint of nonrestorative sleep occurs 
in isolation (i.e., in the absence of difficulty initiating and/or maintaining sleep) but all di- 
agnostic criteria with regard to frequency, duration, and daytime distress and impairments 
are otherwise met, a diagnosis of other specified insomnia disorder or unspecified insom- 
nia disorder is made. 


364 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Aside from the frequency and duration criteria required to make the diagnosis, addi- 
tional criteria are useful to quantify insomnia severity. These quantitative criteria, while 
arbitrary, are provided for illustrative purpose only. For instance, difficulty initiating sleep 
is defined by a subjective sleep latency greater than 20-30 minutes, and difficulty maintain- 
ing sleep is defined by a subjective time awake after sleep onset greater than 20-30 min- 
utes. Although there is no standard definition of early-morning awakening, this symptom 
involves awakening at least 30 minutes before the scheduled time and before total sleep 
time reaches 6% hours. It is essential to take into account not only the final awakening time 
but also the bedtime on the previous evening. Awakening at 4:00 A.M. does not have the 
same clinical significance in those who go to bed at 9:00 P.M. as in those who go to bed at 
11:00 P.M. Such a symptom may also reflect an age-dependent decrease in the ability to sus- 
tain sleep or an age-dependent shift in the timing of the main sleep period. 

Insomnia disorder involves daytime impairments as well as nighttime sleep difficulties. 
These include fatigue or, less commonly, daytime sleepiness; the latter is more common 
among older individuals and when insomnia is comorbid with another medical condition 
(e.g., chronic pain) or sleep disorder (e.g., sleep apnea). Impairment in cognitive performance 
may include difficulties with attention, concentration and memory, and even with performing 
simple manual skills. Associated mood disturbances are typically described as irritability or 
mood lability and less commonly as depressive or anxiety symptoms. Not all individuals with 
nighttime sleep disturbances are distressed or have functional impairment. For example, sleep 
continuity is often interrupted in healthy older adults who nevertheless identify themselves 
as good sleepers. A diagnosis of insomnia disorder should be reserved for those individuals 
with significant daytime distress or impairment related to their nighttime sleep difficulties. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Insomnia is often associated with physiological and cognitive arousal and conditioning 
factors that interfere with sleep. A preoccupation with sleep and distress due to the inabil- 
ity to sleep may lead to a vicious cycle: the more the individual strives to sleep, the more 
frustration builds and further impairs sleep. Thus, excessive attention and efforts to sleep, 
which override normal sleep-onset mechanisms, may contribute to the development of in- 
somnia. Individuals with persistent insomnia may also acquire maladaptive sleep habits 
(e.g., spending excessive time in bed; following an erratic sleep schedule; napping) and 
cognitions (e.g., fear of sleeplessness; apprehensions of daytime impairments; clock mon- 
itoring) during the course of the disorder. Engaging in such activities in an environment in 
which the individual has frequently spent sleepless nights may further compound the con- 
ditioned arousal and perpetuate sleep difficulties. Conversely, the individual may fall asleep 
more easily when not trying to do so. Some individuals also report better sleep when away 
from their own bedrooms and their usual routines. 

Insomnia may be accompanied by a variety of daytime complaints and symptoms, in- 
cluding fatigue, decreased energy, and mood disturbances. Symptoms of anxiety or de- 
pression that do not meet criteria for a specific mental disorder may be present, as well as 
an excessive focus on the perceived effects of sleep loss on daytime functioning. 

Individuals with insomnia may have elevated scores on self-report psychological or 
personality inventories with profiles indicating mild depression and anxiety, a worrisome 
cognitive style, an emotion-focused and internalizing style of conflict resolution, and a so- 
matic focus. Patterns of neurocognitive impairment among individuals with insomnia dis- 
order are inconsistent, although there may be impairments in performing tasks of higher 
complexity and those requiring frequent changes in performance strategy. Individuals 
with insomnia often require more effort to maintain cognitive performance. 


Prevalence 


Population-based estimates indicate that about one-third of adults report insomnia symp- 
toms, 10%-15% experience associated daytime impairments, and 6%-10% have symptoms 


Insomnia Disorder 365 


that meet criteria for insomnia disorder. Insomnia disorder is the most prevalent of all 
sleep disorders. In primary care settings, approximately 10%-20% of individuals complain 
of significant insomnia symptoms. Insomnia is a more prevalent complaint among fe- 
males than among males, with a gender ratio of about 1.44:1. Although insomnia can be a 
symptom or an independent disorder, it is most frequently observed as a comorbid con- 
dition with another medical condition or mental disorder. For instance, 40%—50% of indi- 
viduals with insomnia also present with a comorbid mental disorder. 


Development and Course 


The onset of insomnia symptoms can occur at any time during life, but the first episode is 
more common in young adulthood. Less frequently, insomnia begins in childhood or ad- 
olescence. In women, new-onset insomnia may occur during menopause and persist even 
after other symptoms (e.g., hot flashes) have resolved. Insomnia may have a late-life onset, 
which is often associated with the onset of other health-related conditions. 

Insomnia can be situational, persistent, or recurrent. Situational or acute insomnia usu- 
ally lasts a few days or a few weeks and is often associated with life events or rapid changes 
in sleep schedules or environment. It usually resolves once the initial precipitating event 
subsides. For some individuals, perhaps those more vulnerable to sleep disturbances, in- 
somnia may persist long after the initial triggering event, possibly because of conditioning 
factors and heightened arousal. The factors that precipitate insomnia may differ from 
those that perpetuate it. For example, an individual who is bedridden with a painful injury 
and has difficulty sleeping may then develop negative associations for sleep. Conditioned 
arousal may then persist and lead to persistent insomnia. A similar course may develop in 
the context of an acute psychological stress or a mental disorder. For instance, insomnia that 
occurs during an episode of major depressive disorder can become a focus of attention, 
with consequent negative conditioning, and persist even after resolution of the depressive 
episode. In some cases, insomnia may also have an insidious onset without any identifi- 
able precipitating factor. 

The course of insomnia may also be episodic, with recurrent episodes of sleep difficul- 
ties associated with the occurrence of stressful events. Chronicity rates range from 45% 
to 75% for follow-ups of 1-7 years. Even when the course of the insomnia has become 
chronic, there is night-to-night variability in sleep patterns, with an occasional restful night’s 
sleep interspersed with several nights of poor sleep. The characteristics of insomnia may 
also change over time. Many individuals with insomnia have a history of “light” or easily 
disturbed sleep prior to onset of more persistent sleep problems. 

Insomnia complaints are more prevalent among middle-age and older adults. The type 
of insomnia symptom changes as a function of age, with difficulties initiating sleep being 
more common among young adults and problems maintaining sleep occurring more fre- 
quently among middle-age and older individuals. 

Difficulties initiating and maintaining sleep can also occur in children and adolescents, 
but there are more limited data on prevalence, risk factors, and comorbidity during these 
developmental phases of the lifespan. Sleep difficulties in childhood can result from con- 
ditioning factors (e.g., a child who does not learn to fall asleep or return to sleep without 
the presence of a parent) or from the absence of consistent sleep schedules and bedtime 
routines. Insomnia in adolescence is often triggered or exacerbated by irregular sleep sched- 
ules (e.g., phase delay). In both children and adolescents, psychological and medical fac- 
tors can contribute to insomnia. 

The increased prevalence of insomnia in older adults is partly explained by the higher 
incidence of physical health problems with aging. Changes in sleep patterns associated with 
the normal developmental process must be differentiated from those exceeding age-related 
changes. Although polysomnography is of limited value in the routine evaluation of in- 
somnia, it may be more useful in the differential diagnosis among older adults because the 
etiologies of insomnia (e.g., sleep apnea) are more often identifiable in older individuals. 


366 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


While the risk and prognostic factors discussed in this section increase vulnerability to in- 
somnia, sleep disturbances are more likely to occur when predisposed individuals are ex- 
posed to precipitating events, such as major life events (e.g., illness, separation) or less 
severe but more chronic daily stress. Most individuals resume normal sleep patterns after 
the initial triggering event has disappeared, but others—perhaps those more vulnerable to 
insomnia—continue experiencing persistent sleep difficulties. Perpetuating factors such as 
poor sleep habits, irregular sleep scheduling, and the fear of not sleeping feed into the in- 
somnia problem and may contribute to a vicious cycle that may induce persistent insomnia. 


Temperamental. Anxiety or worry-prone personality or cognitive styles, increased arousal 
predisposition, and tendency to repress emotions can increase vulnerability to insomnia. 


Environmental. Noise, light, uncomfortably high or low temperature, and high altitude 
may also increase vulnerability to insomnia. 


Genetic and physiological. Female gender and advancing age are associated with in- 
creased vulnerability to insomnia. Disrupted sleep and insomnia display a familial dispo- 
sition. The prevalence of insomnia is higher among monozygotic twins relative to 
dizygotic twins; it is also higher in first-degree family members compared with the general 
population. The extent to which this link is inherited through a genetic predisposition, 
learned by observations of parental models, or established as a by-product of another psy- 
chopathology remains undetermined. 


Course modifiers. Deleterious course modifiers include poor sleep hygiene practices 
(e.g., excessive caffeine use, irregular sleep schedules). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Insomnia is a more prevalent complaint among females than among males, with first onset 
often associated with the birth of a new child or with menopause. Despite higher preva- 
lence among older females, polysomnographic studies suggest better preservation of 
sleep continuity and slow-wave sleep in older females than in older males. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Polysomnography usually shows impairments of sleep continuity (e.g., increased sleep la- 
tency and time awake after sleep onset and decreased sleep efficiency [percentage of time 
in bed asleep] and may show increased stage 1 sleep and decreased stages 3 and 4 sleep. 
The severity of these sleep impairments does not always match the individual’s clinical 
presentation or subjective complaint of poor sleep, as individuals with insomnia often un- 
derestimate sleep duration and overestimate wakefulness relative to polysomnography. 
Quantitative electroencephalographic analyses may indicate that individuals with insom- 
nia have greater high-frequency electroencephalography power relative to good sleepers 
both around the sleep onset period and during non-rapid eye movement sleep, a feature 
suggestive of increased cortical arousal. Individuals with insomnia disorder may have a 
lower sleep propensity and typically do not show increased daytime sleepiness on objec- 
tive sleep laboratory measures compared with individuals without sleep disorders. 

Other laboratory measures show evidence, although not consistently, of increased 
arousal and a generalized activation of the hypothalamic-pituitary-adrenal axis (e.g., in- 
creased cortisol levels, heart rate variability, reactivity to stress, metabolic rate). In general, 
findings are consistent with the hypothesis that increased physiological and cognitive 
arousal plays a significant role in insomnia disorder. 

Individuals with insomnia disorder may appear either fatigued or haggard or, con- 
versely, overaroused and “wired.” However, there are no consistent or characteristic 
abnormalities on physical examination. There may be an increased incidence of stress- 


Insomnia Disorder 367 


related psychophysiological symptoms (e.g., tension headache, muscle tension or pain, 
gastrointestinal symptoms). 


Functional Consequences of Insomnia Disorder 


Interpersonal, social, and occupational problems may develop as a result of insomnia or 
excessive concern with sleep, increased daytime irritability, and poor concentration. De- 
creased attention and concentration are common and may be related to higher rates of ac- 
cidents observed in insomnia. Persistent insomnia is also associated with long-term 
consequences, including increased risks of major depressive disorder, hypertension, and 
myocardial infarction; increased absenteeism and reduced productivity at work; reduced 
quality of life; and increased economic burden. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normal sleep variations. Normal sleep duration varies considerably across individuals. 
Some individuals who require little sleep (“short sleepers”) may be concerned about their 
sleep duration. Short sleepers differ from individuals with insomnia disorder by the lack of 
difficulty falling or staying asleep and by the absence of characteristic daytime symptoms 
(e.g., fatigue, concentration problems, irritability). However, some short sleepers may desire 
or attempt to sleep for a longer period of time and, by prolonging time in bed, may create an 
insomnia-like sleep pattern. Clinical insomnia also should be distinguished from normal, 
age-related sleep changes. Insomnia must also be distinguished from sleep deprivation due 
to inadequate opportunity or circumstance for sleep resulting, for example, from an emer- 
gency or from professional or family obligations forcing the individual to stay awake. 


Situational/acute insomnia. Situational/acute insomnia is a condition lasting a few days 
to a few weeks, often associated with life events or with changes in sleep schedules. These 
acute or short-term insomnia symptoms may also produce significant distress and inter- 
fere with social, personal, and occupational functioning. When such symptoms are fre- 
quent enough and meet all other criteria except for the 3-month duration, a diagnosis of 
other specified insomnia disorder or unspecified insomnia disorder is made. 


Delayed sleep phase and shift work types of circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorder. 
Individuals with the delayed sleep phase type of circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorder re- 
port sleep-onset insomnia only when they try to sleep at socially normal times, but they do 
not report difficulty falling asleep or staying asleep when their bed and rising times are 
delayed and coincide with their endogenous circadian rhythm. Shift work type differs from 
insomnia disorder by the history of recent shift work. 


Restless legs syndrome. Restless legs syndrome often produces difficulties initiating 
and maintaining sleep. However, an urge to move the legs and any accompanying unpleas- 
ant leg sensations are features that differentiate this disorder from insomnia disorder. 


Breathing-related sleep disorders. Most individuals with a breathing-related sleep dis- 
order have a history of loud snoring, breathing pauses during sleep, and excessive daytime 
sleepiness. Nonetheless, as many as 50% of individuals with sleep apnea may also report 
insomnia symptoms, a feature that is more common among females and older adults. 


Narcolepsy. Narcolepsy may cause insomnia complaints but is distinguished from in- 
somnia disorder by the predominance of symptoms of excessive daytime sleepiness, cat- 
aplexy, sleep paralysis, and sleep-related hallucinations. 


Parasomnias. Parasomnias are characterized by a complaint of unusual behavior or events 
during sleep that may lead to intermittent awakenings and difficulty resuming sleep. 
However, it is these behavioral events, rather than the insomnia per se, that dominate the 
clinical picture. 


368 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Substance/medication-induced sleep disorder, insomnia type. Substance/medication- 
induced sleep disorder, insomnia type, is distinguished from insomnia disorder by the fact 
that a substance (i.e., a drug of abuse, a medication, or exposure to a toxin) is judged to be 
etiologically related to the insomnia (see “Substance/Medication-Induced Sleep Disor- 
der” later in this chapter). For example, insomnia occurring only in the context of heavy 
coffee consumption would be diagnosed as caffeine-induced sleep disorder, insomnia 
type, with onset during intoxication. 


Comorbidity 


Insomnia is a common comorbidity of many medical conditions, including diabetes, cor- 
onary heart disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, arthritis, fibromyalgia, and 
other chronic pain conditions. The risk relationship appears to be bidirectional: insomnia 
increases the risk of medical conditions, and medical problems increase the risk of insom- 
nia. The direction of the relationship is not always clear and may change over time; for this 
reason, comorbid insomnia is the preferred terminology in the presence of coexisting in- 
somnia with another medical condition (or mental disorder). 

Individuals with insomnia disorder frequently have a comorbid mental disorder, par- 
ticularly bipolar, depressive, and anxiety disorders. Persistent insomnia represents a risk 
factor or an early symptom of subsequent bipolar, depressive, anxiety, and substance use 
disorders. Individuals with insomnia may misuse medications or alcohol to help with 
nighttime sleep, anxiolytics to combat tension or anxiety, and caffeine or other stimulants 
to combat excessive fatigue. In addition to worsening the insomnia, this type of substance 
use may in some cases progress to a substance use disorder. 


Relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders 


There are several distinct insomnia phenotypes relating to the perceived source of the in- 
somnia that are recognized by the International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition 
(ICSD-2). These include psychophysiological insomnia, idiopathic insomnia, sleep-state mispercep- 
tion, and inadequate sleep hygiene. Despite their clinical appeal and heuristic value, there is 
limited evidence to support these distinct phenotypes. 


Hypersomnolence Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.44 (F51.11) 


A. Self-reported excessive sleepiness (hypersomnolence) despite a main sleep period 
lasting at least 7 hours, with at least one of the following symptoms: 


1. Recurrent periods of sleep or lapses into sleep within the same day. 

2. Aprolonged main sleep episode of more than 9 hours per day that is nonrestorative 
(i.e., unrefreshing). 

3. Difficulty being fully awake after abrupt awakening. 


B. The hypersomnolence occurs at least three times per week, for at least 3 months. 

C. The hypersomnolence is accompanied by significant distress or impairment in cogni- 
tive, social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The hypersomnolence is not better explained by and does not occur exclusively during 
the course of another sleep disorder (e.g., narcolepsy, breathing-related sleep disor- 
der, circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorder, or a parasomnia). 

E. The hypersomnolence is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance 
(e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication). 


Hypersomnolence Disorder 369 


F. Coexisting mental and medical disorders do not adequately explain the predominant 
complaint of hypersomnolence. 


Specify if: 
With mental disorder, including substance use disorders 
With medical condition 
With another sleep disorder 


Coding note: The code 307.44 (F51.11) applies to all three specifiers. Code also the 
relevant associated mental disorder, medical condition, or other sleep disorder im- 
mediately after the code for hypersomnolence disorder in order to indicate the associ- 
ation. 


Specify if: 
Acute: Duration of less than 1 month. 
Subacute: Duration of 1-3 months. 
Persistent: Duration of more than 3 months. 


Specify current severity: 
Specify severity based on degree of difficulty maintaining daytime alertness as manifested 
by the occurrence of multiple attacks of irresistible sleepiness within any given day occur- 
ring, for example, while sedentary, driving, visiting with friends, or working. 

Mild: Difficulty maintaining daytime alertness 1-2 days/week. 

Moderate: Difficulty maintaining daytime alertness 3—4 days/week. 

Severe: Difficulty maintaining daytime alertness 5—7 days/week. 


Diagnostic Features 


Hypersomnolence is a broad diagnostic term and includes symptoms of excessive quantity 
of sleep (e.g., extended nocturnal sleep or involuntary daytime sleep), deteriorated quality 
of wakefulness (i.e., sleep propensity during wakefulness as shown by difficulty awaken- 
ing or inability to remain awake when required), and sleep inertia (i.e., a period of im- 
paired performance and reduced vigilance following awakening from the regular sleep 
episode or from a nap) (Criterion A). Individuals with this disorder fall asleep quickly and 
have a good sleep efficiency (>90%). They may have difficulty waking up in the morning, 
sometimes appearing confused, combative, or ataxic. This prolonged impairment of alert- 
ness at the sleep-wake transition is often referred to as sleep inertia (i.e., sleep drunkenness). 
It can also occur upon awakening from a daytime nap. During that period, the individual 
appears awake, but there is a decline in motor dexterity, behavior may be very inappro- 
priate, and memory deficits, disorientation in time and space, and feelings of grogginess 
may occur. This period may last some minutes to hours. 

The persistent need for sleep can lead to automatic behavior (usually of a very routine, 
low-complexity type) that the individual carries out with little or no subsequent recall. For 
example, individuals may find themselves having driven several miles from where they 
thought they were, unaware of the “automatic” driving they did in the preceding minutes. 
For some individuals with hypersomnolence disorder, the major sleep episode (for most 
individuals, nocturnal sleep) has a duration of 9 hours or more. However, the sleep is often 
nonrestorative and is followed by difficulty awakening in the morning. For other individ- 
uals with hypersomnolence disorder, the major sleep episode is of normal nocturnal sleep 
duration (6-9 hours). In these cases, the excessive sleepiness is characterized by several un- 
intentional daytime naps. These daytime naps tend to be relatively long (often lasting 1 hour 
or more), are experienced as nonrestorative (i.e., unrefreshing), and do not lead to improved 
alertness. Individuals with hypersomnolence have daytime naps nearly everyday regard- 
less of the nocturnal sleep duration. Subjective sleep quality may or may not be reported as 
good. Individuals typically feel sleepiness developing over a period of time, rather than 


370 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


experiencing a sudden sleep “attack.” Unintentional sleep episodes typically occur in low- 
stimulation and low-activity situations (e.g., while attending lectures, reading, watching 
television, or driving long distances), but in more severe cases they can manifest in high- 
attention situations such as at work, in meetings, or at social gatherings. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Nonrestorative sleep, automatic behavior, difficulties awakening in the morning, and 
sleep inertia, although common in hypersomnolence disorder, may also be seen in a variety 
of conditions, including narcolepsy. Approximately 80% of individuals with hyper- 
somnolence report that their sleep is nonrestorative, and as many have difficulties awak- 
ening in the morning. Sleep inertia, though less common (i.e., observed in 36%-50% of 
individuals with hypersomnolence disorder), is highly specific to hypersomnolence. Short 
naps (i.e., duration of less than 30 minutes) are often unrefreshing. Individuals with hy- 
persomnolence often appear sleepy and may even fall asleep in the clinician’s waiting 
area. 

A subset of individuals with hypersomnolence disorder have a family history of hy- 
persomnolence and also have symptoms of autonomic nervous system dysfunction, in- 
cluding recurrent vascular-type headaches, reactivity of the peripheral vascular system 
(Raynaud’s phenomenon), and fainting. 


Prevalence 


Approximately 5%-10% of individuals who consult in sleep disorders clinics with com- 
plaints of daytime sleepiness are diagnosed as having hypersomnolence disorder. It is es- 
timated that about 1% of the European and U.S. general population has episodes of sleep 
inertia. Hypersomnolence occurs with relatively equal frequency in males and females. 


Development and Course 


Hypersomnolence disorder has a persistent course, with a progressive evolution in the se- 
verity of symptoms. In most extreme cases, sleep episodes can last up to 20 hours. How- 
ever, the average nighttime sleep duration is around 9% hours. While many individuals 
with hypersomnolence are able to reduce their sleep time during working days, weekend 
and holiday sleep is greatly increased (by up to 3 hours). Awakenings are very difficult 
and accompanied by sleep inertia episodes in nearly 40% of cases. Hypersomnolence fully 
manifests in most cases in late adolescence or early adulthood, with a mean age at onset of 
17-24 years. Individuals with hypersomnolence disorder are diagnosed, on average, 10-15 
years after the appearance of the first symptoms. Pediatric cases are rare. 

Hypersomnolence has a progressive onset, with symptoms beginning between ages 15 
and 25 years, with a gradual progression over weeks to months. For most individuals, the 
course is then persistent and stable, unless treatment is initiated. The development of other 
sleep disorders (e.g., breathing-related sleep disorder) may worsen the degree of sleepi- 
ness. Although hyperactivity may be one of the presenting signs of daytime sleepiness in 
children, voluntary napping increases with age. This normal phenomenon is distinct from 
hypersomnolence. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Hypersomnolence can be increased temporarily by psychological stress 
and alcohol use, but they have not been documented as environmental precipitating 
factors. Viral infections have been reported to have preceded or accompanied hyper- 
somnolence in about 10% of cases. Viral infections, such as HIV pneumonia, infectious 
mononucleosis, and Guillain-Barré syndrome, can also evolve into hypersomnolence within 


Hypersomnolence Disorder 371 


months after the infection. Hypersomnolence can also appear within 6-18 months follow- 
ing a head trauma. 


Genetic and physiological. Hypersomnolence may be familial, with an autosomal- 
dominant mode of inheritance. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Nocturnal polysomnography demonstrates a normal to prolonged sleep duration, short 
sleep latency, and normal to increased sleep continuity. The distribution of rapid eye 
movement (REM) sleep is also normal. Sleep efficiency is mostly greater than 90%. Some 
individuals with hypersomnolence disorder have increased amounts of slow-wave sleep. 
The multiple sleep latency test documents sleep tendency, typically indicated by mean 
sleep latency values of less than 8 minutes. In hypersomnolence disorder, the mean sleep 
latency is typically less than 10 minutes and frequently 8 minutes or less. Sleep-onset REM 
periods (SOREMPs; i.e., the occurrence of REM sleep within 20 minutes of sleep onset) 
may be present but occur less than two times in four to five nap opportunities. 


Functional Consequences of Hypersomnolence Disorder 


The low level of alertness that occurs while an individual fights the need for sleep can lead 
to reduced efficiency, diminished concentration, and poor memory during daytime activ- 
ities. Hypersomnolence can lead to significant distress and dysfunction in work and social 
relationships. Prolonged nocturnal sleep and difficulty awakening can result in difficulty 
in meeting morning obligations, such as arriving at work on time. Unintentional daytime 
sleep episodes can be embarrassing and even dangerous, if, for instance, the individual is 
driving or operating machinery when the episode occurs. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normative variation in sleep. “Normal” sleep duration varies considerably in the general 
population. “Long sleepers” (i.e., individuals who require a greater than average amount 
of sleep) do not have excessive sleepiness, sleep inertia, or automatic behavior when they 
obtain their required amount of nocturnal sleep. Sleep is reported to be refreshing. If social 
or occupational demands lead to shorter nocturnal sleep, daytime symptoms may appear. 
In hypersomnolence disorder, by contrast, symptoms of excessive sleepiness occur regard- 
less of nocturnal sleep duration. An inadequate amount of nocturnal sleep, or behaviorally 
induced insufficient sleep syndrome, can produce symptoms of daytime sleepiness very similar 
to those of hypersomnolence. An average sleep duration of fewer than 7 hours per night 
strongly suggests inadequate nocturnal sleep, and an average of more than 9-10 hours of 
sleep per 24-hour period suggests hypersomnolence. Individuals with inadequate noctur- 
nal sleep typically “catch up” with longer sleep durations on days when they are free from 
social or occupational demands or on vacations. Unlike hypersomnolence, insufficient 
nocturnal sleep is unlikely to persist unabated for decades. A diagnosis of hypersomno- 
lence disorder should not be made if there is a question regarding the adequacy of noctur- 
nal sleep duration. A diagnostic and therapeutic trial of sleep extension for 10-14 days can 
often clarify the diagnosis. 


Poor sleep quality and fatigue. Hypersomnolence disorder should be distinguished 
from excessive sleepiness related to insufficient sleep quantity or quality and fatigue (i.e., 
tiredness not necessarily relieved by increased sleep and unrelated to sleep quantity or 
quality). Excessive sleepiness and fatigue are difficult to differentiate and may overlap 
considerably. 


Breathing-related sleep disorders. Individuals with hypersomnolence and breathing- 
related sleep disorders may have similar patterns of excessive sleepiness. Breathing- 


372 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


related sleep disorders are suggested by a history of loud snoring, pauses in breathing 
during sleep, brain injury, or cardiovascular disease and by the presence of obesity, oro- 
pharyngeal anatomical abnormalities, hypertension, or heart failure on physical examina- 
tion. Polysomnographic studies can confirm the presence of apneic events in breathing- 
related sleep disorder (and their absence in hypersomnolence disorder). 


Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders. Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders are 
often characterized by daytime sleepiness. A history of an abnormal sleep-wake schedule 
(with shifted or irregular hours) is present in individuals with a circadian rhythm sleep- 
wake disorder. 


Parasomnias. Parasomnias rarely produce the prolonged, undisturbed nocturnal sleep 
or daytime sleepiness characteristic of hypersomnolence disorder. 


Other mental disorders. Hypersomnolence disorder must be distinguished from mental 
disorders that include hypersomnolence as an essential or associated feature. In particular, 
complaints of daytime sleepiness may occur in a major depressive episode, with atypical fea- 
tures, and in the depressed phase of bipolar disorder. Assessment for other mental disorders is 
essential before a diagnosis of hypersomnolence disorder is considered. A diagnosis of hyper- 
somnolence disorder can be made in the presence of another current or past mental disorder. 


Comorbidity 


Hypersomnolence can be associated with depressive disorders, bipolar disorders (during a 
depressive episode), and major depressive disorder, with seasonal pattern. Many individu- 
als with hypersomnolence disorder have symptoms of depression that may meet criteria for 
a depressive disorder. This presentation may be related to the psychosocial consequences of 
persistent increased sleep need. Individuals with hypersomnolence disorder are also at 
risk for substance-related disorders, particularly related to self-medication with stimulants. 
This general lack of specificity may contribute to very heterogeneous profiles among indi- 
viduals whose symptoms meet the same diagnostic criteria for hypersomnolence disorder. 
Neurodegenerative conditions, such as Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, and mul- 
tiple system atrophy, may also be associated with hypersomnolence. 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 

The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2), differentiates nine 
subtypes of “hypersomnias of central origin,” including recurrent hypersomnia (Kleine- 
Levin syndrome). 


Narcolepsy 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recurrent periods of an irrepressible need to sleep, lapsing into sleep, or napping oc- 
curring within the same day. These must have been occurring at least three times per 
week over the past 3 months. 

B. The presence of at least one of the following: 


1. Episodes of cataplexy, defined as either (a) or (b), occurring at least a few times 
per month: 


a. In individuals with long-standing disease, brief (seconds to minutes) episodes 
of sudden bilateral loss of muscle tone with maintained consciousness that are 
precipitated by laughter or joking. 


Narcolepsy 373 


b. In children or in individuals within 6 months of onset, spontaneous grimaces or 
jaw-opening episodes with tongue thrusting or a global hypotonia, without any 
obvious emotional triggers. 


2. Hypocretin deficiency, as measured using cerebrospinal fluid (CSF) hypocretin-1 
immunoreactivity values (less than or equal to one-third of values obtained in 
healthy subjects tested using the same assay, or less than or equal to 110 pg/mL). 
Low CSF levels of hypocretin-1 must not be observed in the context of acute brain 
injury, inflammation, or infection. 

3. Nocturnal sleep polysomnography showing rapid eye movement (REM) sleep la- 
tency less than or equal to 15 minutes, or a multiple sleep latency test showing a 
mean sleep latency less than or equal to 8 minutes and two or more sleep-onset 
REM periods. 


Specify whether: 
347.00 (G47.419) Narcolepsy without cataplexy but with hypocretin deficiency: Cri- 
terion B requirements of low CSF hypocretin-1 levels and positive polysomnography/ 
multiple sleep latency test are met, but no cataplexy is present (Criterion B1 not met). 
347.01 (G47.411) Narcolepsy with cataplexy but without hypocretin deficiency: 
In this rare subtype (less than 5% of narcolepsy cases), Criterion B requirements of 
cataplexy and positive polysomnography/multiple sleep latency test are met, but CSF 
hypocretin-1 levels are normal (Criterion B2 not met). 
347.00 (G47.419) Autosomal dominant cerebellar ataxia, deafness, and narco- 
lepsy: This subtype is caused by exon 21 DNA (cytosine-5)-methyltransferase-1 mu- 
tations and is characterized by late-onset (age 30-40 years) narcolepsy (with low or 
intermediate CSF hypocretin-1 levels), deafness, cerebellar ataxia, and eventually de- 
mentia. 
347.00 (G47.419) Autosomal dominant narcolepsy, obesity, and type 2 diabetes: 
Narcolepsy, obesity, and type 2 diabetes and low CSF hypocretin-1 levels have been 
described in rare cases and are associated with a mutation in the myelin oligodendro- 
cyte glycoprotein gene. 
347.10 (G47.429) Narcolepsy secondary to another medical condition: This sub- 
type is for narcolepsy that develops secondary to medical conditions that cause infec- 
tious (e.g., Whipple’s disease, sarcoidosis), traumatic, or tumoral destruction of 
hypocretin neurons. 


Coding note (for ICD-9-CM code 347.10 only): Code first the underlying medical con- 
dition (e.g., 040.2 Whipple’s disease; 347.10 narcolepsy secondary to Whipple’s dis- 
ease). 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Infrequent cataplexy (less than once per week), need for naps only once or twice 
per day, and less disturbed nocturnal sleep. 
Moderate: Cataplexy once daily or every few days, disturbed nocturnal sleep, and 
need for multiple naps daily. 
Severe: Drug-resistant cataplexy with multiple attacks daily, nearly constant sleepi- 
ness, and disturbed nocturnal sleep (i.e., movements, insomnia, and vivid dreaming). 


Subtypes 


In narcolepsy without cataplexy but with hypocretin deficiency, unclear “cataplexy-like” 
symptoms may be reported (e.g., the symptoms are not triggered by emotions and are un- 
usually long lasting). In extremely rare cases, cerebrospinal fluid (CSF) levels of hypocre- 
tin-1 are low, and polysomnographic/multiple sleep latency test (MSLT) results are 
negative: repeating the test is advised before establishing the subtype diagnosis. In narco- 


374 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


lepsy with cataplexy but without hypocretin deficiency, test results for human leukocyte 
antigen (HLA) DQB1*06:02 may be negative. Seizures, falls of other origin, and conversion 
disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder) should be excluded. In narcolepsy 
secondary to infectious (e.g., Whipple’s disease, sarcoidosis), traumatic, or tumoral de- 
struction of hypocretin neurons, test results for HLA DQB1*06:02 may be positive and may 
result from the insult triggering the autoimmune process. In other cases, the destruction of 
hypocretin neurons may be secondary to trauma or hypothalamic surgery. Head trauma 
or infections of the central nervous system can, however, produce transitory decreases in 
CSF hypocretin-1 levels without hypocretin cell loss, complicating the diagnosis. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of sleepiness in narcolepsy are recurrent daytime naps or lapses into 
sleep. Sleepiness typically occurs daily but must occur at a minimum three times a week 
for at least 3 months (Criterion A). Narcolepsy generally produces cataplexy, which most 
commonly presents as brief episodes (seconds to minutes) of sudden, bilateral loss of mus- 
cle tone precipitated by emotions, typically laughing and joking. Muscles affected may 
include those of the neck, jaw, arms, legs, or whole body, resulting in head bobbing, jaw 
dropping, or complete falls. Individuals are awake and aware during cataplexy. To meet 
Criterion B1(a), cataplexy must be triggered by laughter or joking and must occur at least 
a few times per month when the condition is untreated or in the past. 

Cataplexy should not be confused with “weakness” occurring in the context of athletic 
activities (physiological) or exclusively after unusual emotional triggers such as stress or 
anxiety (suggesting possible psychopathology). Episodes lasting hours or days, or those not 
triggered by emotions, are unlikely to be cataplexy, nor is rolling on the floor while laugh- 
ing hysterically. 

In children close to onset, genuine cataplexy can be atypical, affecting primarily the 
face, causing grimaces or jaw opening with tongue thrusting (“cataplectic faces”). Alter- 
natively, cataplexy may present as low-grade continuous hypotonia, yielding a wobbling 
walk. In these cases, Criterion B1(b) can be met in children or in individuals within 6 months 
of a rapid onset. 

Narcolepsy-cataplexy nearly always results from the loss of hypothalamic hypocretin 
(orexin)—producing cells, causing hypocretin deficiency (less than or equal to one-third of 
control values, or 110 pg/mL in most laboratories). Cell loss is likely autoimmune, and ap- 
proximately 99% of affected individuals carry HLA-DQB1*06:02 (vs. 12%-38% of control 
subjects). Thus, checking for the presence of DQB1*06:02 prior to a lumbar puncture for eval- 
uation of CSF hypocretin-1 immunoreactivity may be useful. Rarely, low CSF levels of hypo- 
cretin-1 occur without cataplexy, notably in youths who may develop cataplexy later. CSF 
hypocretin-1 measurement represents the gold standard, excepting associated severe con- 
ditions (neurological, inflammatory, infectious, trauma) that can interfere with the assay. 

A nocturnal polysomnographic sleep study followed by an MSLT can also be used to 
confirm the diagnosis (Criterion B3). These tests must be performed after the individual 
has stopped all psychotropic medications, following 2 weeks of adequate sleep time (as 
documented with sleep diaries, actigraphy). Short rapid eye movement (REM) latency 
(sleep-onset REM period, REM latency less than or equal to 15 minutes) during polysom- 
nography is sufficient to confirm the diagnosis and meets Criterion B3. Alternatively, the 
MSLT result must be positive, showing a mean sleep latency of less than or equal to 8 min- 
utes and two or more sleep-onset REM periods in four to five naps. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 

When sleepiness is severe, automatic behaviors may occur, with the individual continuing 
his or her activities in a semi-automatic, hazelike fashion without memory or conscious- 
ness. Approximately 20%-60% of individuals experience vivid hypnagogic hallucinations 


Narcolepsy 375 


before or upon falling asleep or hypnopompic hallucinations just after awakening. These 
hallucinations are distinct from the less vivid, nonhallucinatory dreamlike mentation at 
sleep onset that occurs in normal sleepers. Nightmares and vivid dreaming are also fre- 
quent in narcolepsy, as is REM sleep behavior disorder. Approximately 20%-60% of indi- 
viduals experience sleep paralysis upon falling asleep or awakening, leaving them awake 
but unable to move or speak. However, many normal sleepers also report sleep paralysis, 
especially with stress or sleep deprivation. Nocturnal eating may occur. Obesity is com- 
mon. Nocturnal sleep disruption with frequent long or short awakenings is common and 
can be disabling. 

Individuals may appear sleepy or fall asleep in the waiting area or during clinical ex- 
amination. During cataplexy, individuals may slump ina chair and have slurred speech or 
drooping eyelids. If the clinician has time to check reflexes during cataplexy (most attacks 
are less than 10 seconds), reflexes are abolished—an important finding distinguishing gen- 
uine cataplexy from conversion disorder. 


Prevalence 


Narcolepsy-cataplexy affects 0.02%-—0.04% of the general population in most countries. 
Narcolepsy affects both genders, with possibly a slight male preponderance. 


Development and Course 


Onset is typically in children and adolescents/young adults but rarely in older adults. 
Two peaks of onset are suggested, at ages 15-25 years and ages 30-35 years. Onset can be 
abrupt or progressive (over years). Severity is highest when onset is abrupt in children, 
and then decreases with age or with treatment, so that symptoms such as cataplexy can oc- 
casionally disappear. Abrupt onset in young, prepubescent children can be associated 
with obesity and premature puberty, a phenotype more frequently observed since 2009. In 
adolescents, onset is more difficult to pinpoint. Onset in adults is often unclear, with some 
individuals reporting having had excessive sleepiness since birth. Once the disorder has 
manifested, the course is persistent and lifelong. 

In 90% of cases, the first symptom to manifest is sleepiness or increased sleep, followed 
by cataplexy (within 1 year in 50% of cases, within 3 years in 85%). Sleepiness, hypnagogic 
hallucinations, vivid dreaming, and REM sleep behavior disorder (excessive movements 
during REM sleep) are early symptoms. Excessive sleep rapidly progresses to an inability 
to stay awake during the day, and to maintain good sleep at night, without a clear increase 
in total 24-hour sleep needs. In the first months, cataplexy may be atypical, especially in 
children. Sleep paralysis usually develops around puberty in children with prepubertal 
onset. Exacerbations of symptoms suggest lack of compliance with medications or devel- 
opment of a concurrent sleep disorder, notably sleep apnea. 

Young children and adolescents with narcolepsy often develop aggression or behav- 
ioral problems secondary to sleepiness and/or nighttime sleep disruption. Workload and 
social pressure increase through high school and college, reducing available sleep time at 
night. Pregnancy does not seem to modify symptoms consistently. After retirement, indi- 
viduals typically have more opportunity for napping, reducing the need for stimulants. 
Maintaining a regular schedule benefits individuals at all ages. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Parasomnias, such as sleepwalking, bruxism, REM sleep behavior dis- 
order, and enuresis, may be more common in individuals who develop narcolepsy. Indi- 
viduals commonly report that they need more sleep than other family members. 


Environmental. Group A streptococcal throat infection, influenza (notably pandemic 
H1N1 2009), or other winter infections are likely triggers of the autoimmune process, pro- 


376 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


ducing narcolepsy a few months later. Head trauma and abrupt changes in sleep-wake 
patterns (e.g., job changes, stress) may be additional triggers. 


Genetic and physiological. Monozygotic twins are 25%-32% concordant for narcolepsy. 
The prevalence of narcolepsy is 1%—2% in first-degree relatives (a 10- to 40-fold increase 
overall). Narcolepsy is strongly associated with DQB1*06:02 (99% vs. 12%-38% in control 
subjects of various ethnic groups; 25% in the general U.S. population). DQB1*03:01 in- 
creases, while DQB1*05:01, DQB1*06:01, and DQB1*06:03 reduce risk in the presence of 
DQB1*06:02, but the effect is small. Polymorphisms within the T-cell receptor alpha gene 
and other immune modulating genes also modulate risk slightly. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Narcolepsy has been described in all ethnic groups and in many cultures. Among African 
Americans, more cases present without cataplexy or with atypical cataplexy, complicating 
diagnosis, especially in the presence of obesity and obstructive sleep apnea. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Functional imaging suggests impaired hypothalamic responses to humorous stimuli. 
Nocturnal polysomnography followed by an MSLT is used to confirm the diagnosis of 
narcolepsy, especially when the disorder is first being diagnosed and before treatment has 
begun, and if hypocretin deficiency has not been documented biochemically. The poly- 
somnography/MSLT should be performed after the individual is no longer taking any 
psychotropic drugs and after regular sleep-wake patterns, without shift work or sleep de- 
privation, have been documented. 

A sleep-onset REM period during the polysomnography (REM sleep latency less than 
or equal to 15 minutes) is highly specific (approximately 1% positive in control subjects) 
but moderately sensitive (approximately 50%). A positive MSLT result displays an aver- 
age sleep latency of less than or equal to 8 minutes, and sleep-onset REM periods in two or 
more naps on a four- or five-nap test. The MSLT result is positive in 90%-95% of individ- 
uals with narcolepsy versus 2%—4% of control subjects or individuals with other sleep dis- 
orders. Additional polysomnographic findings often include frequent arousals, decreased 
sleep efficiency, and increased stage 1 sleep. Periodic limb movements (found in about 
40% of individuals with narcolepsy) and sleep apnea are often noted. 

Hypocretin deficiency is demonstrated by measuring CSF hypocretin-1 immunoreac- 
tivity. The test is particularly useful in individuals with suspected conversion disorder 
and those without typical cataplexy, or in treatment-refractory cases. The diagnostic value 
of the test is not affected by medications, sleep deprivation, or circadian time, but the find- 
ings are uninterpretable when the individual is severely ill with a concurrent infection or 
head trauma or is comatose. CSF cytology, protein, and glucose are within normal range 
even when sampled within weeks of rapid onset. CSF hypocretin-1 in these incipient cases 
is typically already very diminished or undetectable. 


Functional Consequences of Narcolepsy 


Driving and working are impaired, and individuals with narcolepsy should avoid jobs 
that place themselves (e.g., working with machinery) or others (e.g., bus driver, pilot) in 
danger. Once the narcolepsy is controlled with therapy, patients can usually drive, al- 
though rarely long distances alone. Untreated individuals are also at risk for social isola- 
tion and accidental injury to themselves or others. Social relations may suffer as these 
individuals strive to avert cataplexy by exerting control over emotions. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other hypersomnias. Hypersomnolence and narcolepsy are similar with respect to the 
degree of daytime sleepiness, age at onset, and stable course over time but can be distin- 


Narcolepsy 377 


guished based on distinctive clinical and laboratory features. Individuals with hypersom- 
nolence typically have longer and less disrupted nocturnal sleep, greater difficulty 
awakening, more persistent daytime sleepiness (as opposed to more discrete “sleep at- 
tacks” in narcolepsy), longer and less refreshing daytime sleep episodes, and little or no 
dreaming during daytime naps. By contrast, individuals with narcolepsy have cataplexy 
and recurrent intrusions of elements of REM sleep into the transition between sleep and 
wakefulness (e.g., sleep-related hallucinations and sleep paralysis). The MSLT typically 
demonstrates shorter sleep latencies (i.e., greater physiological sleepiness) as well as the 
presence of multiple sleep-onset REM periods in individuals with narcolepsy. 


Sleep deprivation and insufficient nocturnal sleep. Sleep deprivation and insufficient 
nocturnal sleep are common in adolescents and shift workers. In adolescents, difficulties 
falling asleep at night are common, causing sleep deprivation. The MSLT result may be 
positive if conducted while the individual is sleep deprived or while his or her sleep is 
phase delayed. 


Sleep apnea syndromes. Sleep apneas are especially likely in the presence of obesity. 
Because obstructive sleep apnea is more frequent than narcolepsy, cataplexy may be over- 
looked (or absent), and the individual is assumed to have obstructive sleep apnea unre- 
sponsive to usual therapies. 


Major depressive disorder. Narcolepsy or hypersomnia may be associated or confused 
with depression. Cataplexy is not present in depression. The MSLT results are most often 
normal, and there is dissociation between subjective and objective sleepiness, as measured 
by the mean sleep latency during the MSLT. 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder). Atypical features, 
such as long-lasting cataplexy or unusual triggers, may be present in conversion disorder 
(functional neurological symptom disorder). Individuals may report sleeping and dream- 
ing, yet the MSLT does not show the characteristic sleep-onset REM period. Full-blown, 
long-lasting pseudocataplexy may occur during consultation, allowing the examining 
physician enough time to verify reflexes, which remain intact. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder or other behavioral problems. In children and 
adolescents, sleepiness can cause behavioral problems, including aggressiveness and in- 
attention, leading to a misdiagnosis of attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. 


Seizures. In young children, cataplexy can be misdiagnosed as seizures. Seizures are not 
commonly triggered by emotions, and when they are, the trigger is not usually laughing or 
joking. During a seizure, individuals are more likely to hurt themselves when falling. Sei- 
zures characterized by isolated atonia are rarely seen in isolation of other seizures, and 
they also have signatures on the electroencephalogram. 


Chorea and movement disorders. In young children, cataplexy can be misdiagnosed as 
chorea or pediatric autoimmune neuropsychiatric disorders associated with streptococcal 
infections, especially in the context of a strep throat infection and high antistreptolysin O 
antibody levels. Some children may have an overlapping movement disorder close to on- 
set of the cataplexy. 


Schizophrenia. In the presence of florid and vivid hypnagogic hallucinations, individuals 
may think these experiences are real—a feature that suggests schizophrenia. Similarly, 
with stimulant treatment, persecutory delusions may develop. If cataplexy is present, the 
clinician should first assume that these symptoms are secondary to narcolepsy before con- 
sidering a co-occurring diagnosis of schizophrenia. 


Comorbidity 


Narcolepsy can co-occur with bipolar, depressive, and anxiety disorders, and in rare cases 
with schizophrenia. Narcolepsy is also associated with increased body mass index or obe- 


378 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


sity, especially when the narcolepsy is untreated. Rapid weight gain is common in young 
children with a sudden disease onset. Comorbid sleep apnea should be considered if there 
is a sudden aggravation of preexisting narcolepsy. 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 


The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2), differentiates five 
subtypes of narcolepsy. 


Breathing-Related Sleep Disorders 


The breathing-related sleep disorders category encompasses three relatively distinct dis- 
orders: obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, central sleep apnea, and sleep-related hypo- 
ventilation. 


Obstructive Sleep Apnea Hypopnea 
Diagnostic Criteria 327.23 (G47.33) 


A. Either (1) or (2): 


1. Evidence by polysomnography of at least five obstructive apneas or hypopneas per 
hour of sleep and either of the following sleep symptoms: 


a. Nocturnal breathing disturbances: snoring, snorting/gasping, or breathing 
pauses during sleep. 

b. Daytime sleepiness, fatigue, or unrefreshing sleep despite sufficient opportuni- 
ties to sleep that is not better explained by another mental disorder (including a 
sleep disorder) and is not attributable to another medical condition. 


2. Evidence by polysomnography of 15 or more obstructive apneas and/or hypopneas 
per hour of sleep regardless of accompanying symptoms. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Apnea hypopnea index is less than 15. 
Moderate: Apnea hypopnea index is 15-30. 
Severe: Apnea hypopnea index is greater than 30. 


Specifiers 

Disease severity is measured by a count of the number of apneas plus hypopneas per hour 
of sleep (apnea hypopnea index) using polysomnography or other overnight monitoring. 
Overall severity is also informed by levels of nocturnal desaturation and sleep fragmen- 
tation (measured by brain cortical arousal frequency and sleep stages) and degree of as- 
sociated symptoms and daytime impairment. However, the exact number and thresholds 
may vary according to the specific measurement techniques used, and these numbers may 
change over time. Regardless of the apnea hypopnea index (count) per se, the disorder is 
considered to be more severe when apneas and hypopneas are accompanied by significant 
oxygen hemoglobin desaturation (e.g., when more than 10% of the sleep time is spent at 
desaturation levels of less than 90%) or when sleep is severely fragmented as shown by an 


Obstructive Sleep Apnea Hypopnea 379 


elevated arousal index (arousal index greater than 30) or reduced stages in deep sleep (e.g., 
percentage stage N3 [slow-wave sleep] less than 5%). 


Diagnostic Features 


Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea is the most common breathing-related sleep disorder. 
It is characterized by repeated episodes of upper (pharyngeal) airway obstruction (apneas 
and hypopneas) during sleep. Apnea refers to the total absence of airflow, and hypopnea re- 
fers to a reduction in airflow. Each apnea or hypopnea represents a reduction in breathing 
of at least 10 seconds in duration in adults or two missed breaths in children and is typi- 
cally associated with drops in oxygen saturation of 3% or greater and/or an electroenceph- 
alographic arousal. Both sleep-related (nocturnal) and wake-time symptoms are common. 
The cardinal symptoms of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea are snoring and daytime 
sleepiness. 

Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea in adults is diagnosed on the basis of polysom- 
nographic findings and symptoms. The diagnosis is based on symptoms of 1) nocturnal 
breathing disturbances (i.e., snoring, snorting / gasping, breathing pauses during sleep), or 
2) daytime sleepiness, fatigue, or unrefreshing sleep despite sufficient opportunities to 
sleep that are not better explained by another mental disorder and not attributable to an- 
other medical condition, along with 3) evidence by polysomnography of five or more ob- 
structive apneas or hypopneas per hour of sleep (Criterion A1). Diagnosis can be made in 
the absence of these symptoms if there is evidence by polysomnography of 15 or more ob- 
structive apneas and/or hypopneas per hour of sleep (Criterion A2). 

Specific attention to disturbed sleep occurring in association with snoring or breathing 
pauses and physical findings that increase risk of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea (e.g., 
central obesity, crowded pharyngeal airway, elevated blood pressure) is needed to reduce 
the chance of misdiagnosing this treatable condition. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Because of the frequency of nocturnal awakenings that occur with obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea, individuals may report symptoms of insomnia. Other common, though non- 
specific, symptoms of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea are heartburn, nocturia, morning 
headaches, dry mouth, erectile dysfunction, and reduced libido. Rarely, individuals may 
complain of difficulty breathing while lying supine or sleeping. Hypertension may occur 
in more than 60% of individuals with obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea. 


Prevalence 

Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea is a very common disorder, affecting at least 1%-2% of 
children, 2%-15% of middle-age adults, and more than 20% of older individuals. In the 
general community, prevalence rates of undiagnosed obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea 
may be very high in elderly individuals. Since the disorder is strongly associated with obe- 
sity, increases in obesity rates are likely to be accompanied by an increased prevalence of 
this disorder. Prevalence may be particularly high among males, older adults, and certain 
racial/ethnic groups. In adults, the male-to-female ratio of obstructive sleep apnea hypop- 
nea ranges from 2:1 to 4:1. Gender differences decline in older age, possibly because of an 
increased prevalence in females after menopause. There is no gender difference among 
prepubertal children. 


Development and Course 

The age distribution of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea likely follows a J-shaped distri- 
bution. There is a peak in children ages 3-8 years when the nasopharynx may be compro- 
mised by a relatively large mass of tonsillar tissue compared with the size of the upper 


380 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


airway. With growth of the airway and regression of lymphoid tissue during later child- 
hood, there is reduction in prevalence. Then, as obesity prevalence increases in midlife and 
females enter menopause, obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea again increases. The course 
in older age is unclear; the disorder may level off after age 65 years, but in other individ- 
uals, prevalence may increase with aging. Because there is some age dependency of the oc- 
currence of apneas and hypopneas, polysomnographic results must be interpreted in light 
of other clinical data. In particular, significant clinical symptoms of insomnia or hyper- 
somnia should be investigated regardless of the individual’s age. 

Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea usually has an insidious onset, gradual progression, 
and persistent course. Typically the loud snoring has been present for many years, often since 
childhood, but an increase in its severity may lead the individual to seek evaluation. Weight 
gain may precipitate an increase in symptoms. Although obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea 
can occur at any age, it most commonly manifests among individuals ages 40-60 years. Over 
4-5 years, the average apnea hypopnea index increases in adults and older individuals by ap- 
proximately two apneas/hypopneas per hour. The apnea hypopnea index is increased and in- 
cident obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea is greater among individuals who are older, who are 
male, or who have a higher baseline body mass index (BMI) or increase their BMI over time. 
Spontaneous resolution of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea has been reported with weight 
loss, particularly after bariatric surgery. In children, seasonal variation in obstructive sleep ap- 
nea hypopnea has been observed, as has improvement with overall growth. 

In young children, the signs and symptoms of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea may be 
more subtle than in adults, making diagnosis more difficult to establish. Polysomnography is 
useful in confirming diagnosis. Evidence of fragmentation of sleep on the polysomnogram 
may not be as apparent as in studies of older individuals, possibly because of the high homeo- 
static drive in young individuals. Symptoms such as snoring are usually parent-reported and 
thus have reduced sensitivity. Agitated arousals and unusual sleep postures, such as sleeping 
on the hands and knees, may occur. Nocturnal enuresis also may occur and should raise the 
suspicion of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea if it recurs in a child who was previously dry at 
night. Children may also manifest excessive daytime sleepiness, although this is not as com- 
mon or pronounced as in adults. Daytime mouth breathing, difficulty in swallowing, and poor 
speech articulation are also common features in children. Children younger than 5 years more 
often present with nighttime symptoms, such as observed apneas or labored breathing, than 
with behavioral symptoms (i.e., the nighttime symptoms are more noticeable and more often 
bring the child to clinical attention). In children older than 5 years, daytime symptoms such as 
sleepiness and behavioral problems (e.g., impulsivity and hyperactivity), attention-deficit/ 
hyperactivity disorder, learning difficulties, and morning headaches are more often the focus 
of concern. Children with obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea also may present with failure to 
thrive and developmental delays. In young children, obesity is a less common risk factor, 
while delayed growth and “failure to thrive” may be present. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. The major risk factors for obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea 
are obesity and male gender. Others include maxillary-mandibular retrognathia or micro- 
gnathia, positive family history of sleep apnea, genetic syndromes that reduce upper 
airway patency (e.g., Down’s syndrome, Treacher Collin’s syndrome), adenotonsillar hy- 
pertrophy (especially in young children), menopause (in females), and various endocrine 
syndromes (e.g., acromegaly). Compared with premenopausal females, males are at in- 
creased risk for obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, possibly reflecting the influences of sex 
hormones on ventilatory control and body fat distribution, as well as because of gender 
differences in airway structure. Medications for mental disorders and medical conditions 
that tend to induce somnolence may worsen the course of apnea symptoms if these med- 
ications are not managed carefully. 


Obstructive Sleep Apnea Hypopnea 381 


Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea has a strong genetic basis, as evidenced by the sig- 
nificant familial aggregation of the apnea hypopnea index. The prevalence of obstructive 
sleep apnea hypopnea is approximately twice as high among the first-degree relatives of 
probands with obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea as compared with members of control 
families. One-third of the variance in the apnea hypopnea index is explained by shared fa- 
milial factors. Although genetic markers with diagnostic or prognostic value are not yet 
available for use, eliciting a family history of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea should in- 
crease the clinical suspicion for the disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There is a potential for sleepiness and fatigue to be reported differently across cultures. In 
some groups, snoring may be considered a sign of health and thus may not trigger con- 
cerns. Individuals of Asian ancestry may be at increased risk for obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea despite relatively low BML, possibly reflecting the influence of craniofacial risk 
factors that narrow the nasopharynx. 


Gender-Related Issues 


Females may more commonly report fatigue rather than sleepiness and may underreport 
snoring. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Polysomnography provides quantitative data on frequency of sleep-related respiratory 
disturbances and associated changes in oxygen saturation and sleep continuity. Polysom- 
nographic findings in children differ from those in adults in that children demonstrate 
labored breathing, partial obstructive hypoventilation with cyclical desaturations, hyper- 
capnia and paradoxical movements. Apnea hypopnea index levels as low as 2 are used to 
define thresholds of abnormality in children. 

Arterial blood gas measurements while the individual is awake are usually normal, but 
some individuals can have waking hypoxemia or hypercapnia. This pattern should alert the 
clinician to the possibility of coexisting lung disease or hypoventilation. Imaging procedures 
may reveal narrowing of the upper airway. Cardiac testing may show evidence of impaired 
ventricular function. Individuals with severe nocturnal oxygen desaturation may also have el- 
evated hemoglobin or hematocrit values. Validated sleep measures (e.g., multiple sleep la- 
tency test [MSLT], maintenance of wakefulness test) may identify sleepiness. 


Functional Consequences of 
Obstructive Sleep Apnea Hypopnea 


More than 50% of individuals with moderate to severe obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea 
report symptoms of daytime sleepiness. A twofold increased risk of occupational accidents 
has been reported in association with symptoms of snoring and sleepiness. Motor vehicle 
crashes also have been reported to be as much as sevenfold higher among individuals with 
elevated apnea hypopnea index values. Clinicians should be cognizant of state govern- 
ment requirements for reporting this disorder, especially in relationship to commercial 
drivers. Reduced scores on measures of health-related quality of life are common in individ- 
uals with obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, with the largest decrements observed in the 
physical and vitality subscales. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Primary snoring and other sleep disorders. Individuals with obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea must be differentiated from individuals with primary snoring (i.e., otherwise 


382 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


asymptomatic individuals who snore and do not have abnormalities on overnight polysom- 
nography). Individuals with obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea may additionally report 
nocturnal gasping and choking. The presence of sleepiness or other daytime symptoms 
not explained by other etiologies suggests the diagnosis of obstructive sleep apnea hypop- 
nea, but this differentiation requires polysomnography. Definitive differential diagnosis 
between hypersomnia, central sleep apnea, sleep-related hypoventilation, and obstructive 
sleep apnea hypopnea also requires polysomnographic studies. 

Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea must be differentiated from other causes of sleepi- 
ness, such as narcolepsy, hypersomnia, and circadian rhythm sleep disorders. Obstructive 
sleep apnea hypopnea can be differentiated from narcolepsy by the absence of cataplexy, 
sleep-related hallucinations, and sleep paralysis and by the presence of loud snoring, 
gasping during sleep, or observed apneas in sleep. Daytime sleep episodes in narcolepsy 
are characteristically shorter, more refreshing, and more often associated with dreaming. 
Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea shows characteristic apneas and hypopneas and oxy- 
gen desaturation during nocturnal polysomnographic studies. Narcolepsy results in mul- 
tiple sleep-onset rapid eye movement (REM) periods during the MSLT. Narcolepsy, like 
obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, may be associated with obesity, and some individuals 
have concurrent narcolepsy and obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea. A diagnosis of narco- 
lepsy does not exclude the diagnosis of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, as the two con- 
ditions may co-occur. 


Insomnia disorder. For individuals complaining of difficulty initiating or maintaining 
sleep or early-morning awakenings, insomnia disorder can be differentiated from obstruc- 
tive sleep apnea hypopnea by the absence of snoring and the absence of the history, signs, 
and symptoms characteristic of the latter disorder. However, insomnia and obstructive 
sleep apnea hypopnea may coexist, and if so, both disorders may need to be addressed 
concurrently to improve sleep. 


Panic attacks. Nocturnal panic attacks may include symptoms of gasping or choking 
during sleep that may be difficult to distinguish clinically from obstructive sleep apnea hy- 
popnea. However, the lower frequency of episodes, intense autonomic arousal, and lack of 
excessive sleepiness differentiate nocturnal panic attacks from obstructive sleep apnea hy- 
popnea. Polysomnography in individuals with nocturnal panic attacks does not reveal the 
typical pattern of apneas or oxygen desaturation characteristic of obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea. Individuals with obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea do not provide a history of 
daytime panic attacks. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder in chil- 
dren may include symptoms of inattention, academic impairment, hyperactivity, and in- 
ternalizing behaviors, all of which may also be symptoms of childhood obstructive sleep 
apnea hypopnea. The presence of other symptoms and signs of childhood obstructive 
sleep apnea hypopnea (e.g., labored breathing or snoring during sleep and adenotonsillar 
hypertrophy) would suggest the presence of obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea. Obstruc- 
tive sleep apnea hypopnea and attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder may commonly 
co-occur, and there may be causal links between them; therefore, risk factors such as en- 
larged tonsils, obesity, or a family history of sleep apnea may help alert the clinician to 
their co-occurrence. 


Substance/medication-induced insomnia or hypersomnia. Substance use and substance 
withdrawal (including medications) can produce insomnia or hypersomnia. A careful his- 
tory is usually sufficient to identify the relevant substance/ medication, and follow-up 
shows improvement of the sleep disturbance after discontinuation of the substance/med- 
ication. In other cases, the use of a substance/ medication (e.g., alcohol, barbiturates, ben- 
zodiazepines, tobacco) has been shown to exacerbate obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea. 
An individual with symptoms and signs consistent with obstructive sleep apnea hypop- 


Central Sleep Apnea 383 


nea should receive that diagnosis, even in the presence of concurrent substance use that is 
exacerbating the condition. 


Comorbidity 


Systemic hypertension, coronary artery disease, heart failure, stroke, diabetes, and increased 
mortality are consistently associated with obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea. Risk esti- 
mates vary from 30% to as much as 300% for moderate to severe obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea. Evidence of pulmonary hypertension and right heart failure (e.g., cor pulmo- 
nale, ankle edema, hepatic congestion) are rare in obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea and 
when present indicate either very severe disease or associated hypoventilation or cardio- 
pulmonary comorbidities. Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea also may occur with in- 
creased frequency in association with a number of medical or neurological conditions (e.g., 
cerebrovascular disease, Parkinson’s disease). Physical findings reflect the co-occurrence of 
these conditions. 

As many as one-third of individuals referred for evaluation of obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea report symptoms of depression, with as many of 10% having depression scores 
consistent with moderate to severe depression. Severity of obstructive sleep apnea hypop- 
nea, as measured by the apnea hypopnea index, has been found to be correlated with se- 
verity of symptoms of depression. This association may be stronger in males than in 
females. 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 

The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2), differentiates 11 sub- 
types of “sleep-related breathing disorders,” including primary central sleep apnea, ob- 
structive sleep apnea, and sleep-related hypoventilation. 


Central Sleep Apnea 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Evidence by polysomnography of five or more central apneas per hour of sleep. 
B. The disorder is not better explained by another current sleep disorder. 


Specify whether: 
327.21 (G47.31) Idiopathic central sleep apnea: Characterized by repeated epi- 
sodes of apneas and hypopneas during sleep caused by variability in respiratory effort 
but without evidence of airway obstruction. 
786.04 (RO6.3) Cheyne-Stokes breathing: A pattern of periodic crescendo- 
decrescendo variation in tidal volume that results in central agneas and hypopneas at 
a frequency of at least five events per hour, accompanied by frequent arousal. 
780.57 (G47.37) Central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid use: The pathogenesis 
of this subtype is attributed to the effects of opioids on the respiratory rhythm genera- 
tors in the medulla as well as the differential effects on hypoxic versus hypercapnic re- 
spiratory drive. 


Coding note (for 780.57 [G47.37] code only): When an opioid use disorder is present, first 
code the opioid use disorder: 305.50 (F11.10) mild opioid use disorder or 304.00 (F11.20) 
moderate or severe opioid use disorder; then code 780.57 (G47.37) central sleep apnea 
comorbid with opioid use. When an opioid use disorder is not present (e.g., after a one- 
time heavy use of the substance), code only 780.57 (G47.37) central sleep apnea comor- 
bid with opioid use. 


384 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Note: See the section “Diagnostic Features” in text. 


Specify current severity: 
Severity of central sleep apnea is graded according to the frequency of the breathing 
disturbances as well as the extent of associated oxygen desaturation and sleep frag- 
mentation that occur as a consequence of repetitive respiratory disturbances. 


Subtypes 


Idiopathic central sleep apnea and Cheyne-Stokes breathing are characterized by increased 
gain of the ventilatory control system, also referred to as high loop gain, which leads to in- 
stability in ventilation and PaCO, levels. This instability is termed periodic breathing and 
can be recognized by hyperventilation alternating with hypoventilation. Individuals with 
these disorders typically have pCO, levels while awake that are slightly hypocapneic or 
normocapneic. Central sleep apnea may also manifest during initiation of treatment of ob- 
structive sleep apnea hypopnea or may occur in association with obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea syndrome (termed complex sleep apnea). The occurrence of central sleep apnea in 
association with obstructive sleep apnea is also considered to be due to high loop gain. In 
contrast, the pathogenesis of central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid use has been at- 
tributed to the effects of opioids on the respiratory rhythm generators in the medulla as 
well as to its differential effects on hypoxic versus hypercapneic respiratory drive. These 
individuals may have elevated pCO, levels while awake. Individuals receiving chronic 
methadone maintenance therapy have been noted to have increased somnolence and de- 
pression, although the role of breathing disorders associated with opioid medication in caus- 
ing these problems has not been studied. 


Specifiers 

An increase in the central apnea index (i.e., number of central apneas per hour of sleep) re- 
flects an increase in severity of central sleep apnea. Sleep continuity and quality may be 
markedly impaired with reductions in restorative stages of non—rapid eye movement (REM) 
sleep (i.e., decreased slow-wave sleep [stage N3]). In individuals with severe Cheyne- 
Stokes breathing, the pattern can also be observed during resting wakefulness, a finding 
that is thought to be a poor prognostic marker for mortality. 


Diagnostic Features 


Central sleep apnea disorders are characterized by repeated episodes of apneas and hy- 
popneas during sleep caused by variability in respiratory effort. These are disorders of 
ventilatory control in which respiratory events occur in a periodic or intermittent pattern. 
Idiopathic central sleep apnea is characterized by sleepiness, insomnia, and awakenings due 
to dyspnea in association with five or more central apneas per hour of sleep. Central sleep 
apnea occurring in individuals with heart failure, stroke, or renal failure typically have a 
breathing pattern called Cheyne-Stokes breathing, which is characterized by a pattern of 
periodic crescendo-decrescendo variation in tidal volume that results in central apneas 
and hypopneas occurring at a frequency of at least five events per hour that are accompa- 
nied by frequent arousals. Central and obstructive sleep apneas may coexist; the ratio of 
central to obstructive apneas/hypopneas may be used to identify which condition is pre- 
dominant. 

Alterations in neuromuscular control of breathing can occur in association with med- 
ications or substances used in individuals with mental health conditions, which can cause 
or exacerbate impairments of respiratory rhythm and ventilation. Individuals taking these 
medications have a sleep-related breathing disorder that could contribute to sleep distur- 
bances and symptoms such as sleepiness, confusion, and depression. Specifically, chronic 


Central Sleep Apnea 385 


use of long-acting opioid medications is often associated with impairment of respiratory con- 
trol leading to central sleep apnea. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with central sleep apnea hypopneas can manifest with sleepiness or insomnia. 
There can be complaints of sleep fragmentation, including awakening with dyspnea. 
Some individuals are asymptomatic. Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea can coexist with 
Cheyne-Stokes breathing, and thus snoring and abruptly terminating apneas may be ob- 
served during sleep. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of idiopathic central sleep apnea is unknown but thought to be rare. The 
prevalence of Cheyne-Stokes breathing is high in individuals with depressed cardiac ven- 
tricular ejection fraction. In individuals with an ejection fraction of less than 45%, the prev- 
alence has been reported to be 20% or higher. The male-to-female ratio for prevalence is 
even more highly skewed toward males than for obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea. Prev- 
alence increases with age, and most patients are older than 60 years. Cheyne-Stokes breath- 
ing occurs in approximately 20% of individuals with acute stroke. Central sleep apnea 
comorbid with opioid use occurs in approximately 30% of individuals taking chronic opi- 
oids for nonmalignant pain and similarly in individuals receiving methadone mainte- 
nance therapy. 


Development and Course 


The onset of Cheyne-Stokes breathing appears tied to the development of heart failure. The 
Cheyne-Stokes breathing pattern is associated with oscillations in heart rate, blood pres- 
sure and oxygen desaturation, and elevated sympathetic nervous system activity that can 
promote progression of heart failure. The clinical significance of Cheyne-Stokes breathing 
in the setting of stroke is not known, but Cheyne-Stokes breathing may be a transient find- 
ing that resolves with time after acute stroke. Central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid 
use has been documented with chronic use (i.e., several months). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Cheyne-Stokes breathing is frequently present in individu- 
als with heart failure. The coexistence of atrial fibrillation further increases risk, as do older 
age and male gender. Cheyne-Stokes breathing is also seen in association with acute stroke 
and possibly renal failure. The underlying ventilatory instability in the setting of heart fail- 
ure has been attributed to increased ventilatory chemosensitivity and hyperventilation 
due to pulmonary vascular congestion and circulatory delay. Central sleep apnea is seen 
in individuals taking long-acting opioids. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Physical findings seen in individuals with a Cheyne-Stokes breathing pattern relate to its 
risk factors. Findings consistent with heart failure, such as jugular venous distension, $3 
heart sound, lung crackles, and lower extremity edema, may be present. Polysomnogra- 
phy is used to characterize the breathing characteristics of each breathing-related sleep 
disorder subtype. Central sleep apneas are recorded when periods of breathing cessation 
for longer than 10 seconds occur. Cheyne-Stokes breathing is characterized by a pattern of 
periodic crescendo-decrescendo variation in tidal volume that results in central apneas 
and hypopneas occurring at a frequency of at least five events per hour that are accompa- 
nied by frequent arousals. The cycle length of Cheyne-Stokes breathing (or time from end 
of one central apnea to the end of the next apnea) is about 60 seconds. 


386 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Functional Consequences of Central Sleep Apnea 


Idiopathic central sleep apnea has been reported to cause symptoms of disrupted sleep, in- 
cluding insomnia and sleepiness. Cheyne-Stokes breathing with comorbid heart failure 
has been associated with excessive sleepiness, fatigue, and insomnia, although many in- 
dividuals may be asymptomatic. Coexistence of heart failure and Cheyne-Stokes breath- 
ing may be associated with increased cardiac arrhythmias and increased mortality or 
cardiac transplantation. Individuals with central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid use 
may present with symptoms of sleepiness or insomnia. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Idiopathic central sleep apnea must be distinguished from other breathing-related sleep 
disorders, other sleep disorders, and medical conditions and mental disorders that cause 
sleep fragmentation, sleepiness, and fatigue. This is achieved using polysomnography. 


Other breathing-related sleep disorders and sleep disorders. Central sleep apnea can 
be distinguished from obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea by the presence of at least five 
central apneas per hour of sleep. These conditions may co-occur, but central sleep apnea is 
considered to predominate when the ratio of central to obstructive respiratory events ex- 
ceeds 50%. 

Cheyne-Stokes breathing can be distinguished from other mental disorders, including 
other sleep disorders, and other medical conditions that cause sleep fragmentation, sleep- 
iness, and fatigue based on the presence of a predisposing condition (e.g., heart failure or 
stroke) and signs and polysomnographic evidence of the characteristic breathing pattern. 
Polysomnographic respiratory findings can help distinguish Cheyne-Stokes breathing 
from insomnia due to other medical conditions. High-altitude periodic breathing has a 
pattern that resembles Cheyne-Stokes breathing but has a shorter cycle time, occurs only 
at high altitude, and is not associated with heart failure. 

Central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid use can be differentiated from other types of 
breathing-related sleep disorders based on the use of long-acting opioid medications in 
conjunction with polysomnographic evidence of central apneas and periodic or ataxic 
breathing. It can be distinguished from insomnia due to drug or substance use based on 
polysomnographic evidence of central sleep apnea. 


Comorbidity 


Central sleep apnea disorders are frequently present in users of long-acting opioids, such 
as methadone. Individuals taking these medications have a sleep-related breathing disor- 
der that could contribute to sleep disturbances and symptoms such as sleepiness, confu- 
sion, and depression. While the individual is asleep, breathing patterns such as central 
apneas, periodic apneas, and ataxic breathing may be observed. Obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea may coexist with central sleep apnea, and features consistent with this condi- 
tion can also be present (see “Obstructive Sleep Apnea Hypopnea” earlier in this chapter). 
Cheyne-Stokes breathing is more commonly observed in association with conditions that 
include heart failure, stroke, and renal failure and is seen more frequently in individuals 
with atrial fibrillation. Individuals with Cheyne-Stokes breathing are more likely to be 
older, to be male, and to have lower weight than individuals with obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea. 


Sleep-Related Hypoventilation 387 


Sleep-Related Hypoventilation 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Polysomnograpy demonstrates episodes of decreased respiration associated with el- 
evated COs, levels. (Note: In the absence of objective measurement of COs, persistent 
low levels of hemoglobin oxygen saturation unassociated with apneic/hypopneic 
events may indicate hypoventilation.) 

B. The disturbance is not better explained by another current sleep disorder. 


Specify whether: 
327.24 (G47.34) Idiopathic hypoventilation: This subtype is not attributable to any 
readily identified condition. 
327.25 (G47.35) Congenital central alveolar hypoventilation: This subtype is a rare 
congenital disorder in which the individual typically presents in the perinatal period with 
shallow breathing, or cyanosis and apnea during sleep. 
327.26 (G47.36) Comorbid sleep-related hypoventilation: This subtype occurs as a 
consequence of a medical condition, such as a pulmonary disorder (e.g., interstitial 
lung disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease) or a neuromuscular or chest wall 
disorder (e.g., muscular dystrophies, postpolio syndrome, cervical spinal cord injury, 
kyphoscoliosis), or medications (e.g., benzodiazepines, opiates). It also occurs with 
obesity (obesity hypoventilation disorder), where it reflects a combination of increased 
work of breathing due to reduced chest wall compliance and ventilation-perfusion mis- 
match and variably reduced ventilatory drive. Such individuals usually are character- 
ized by body mass index of greater than 30 and hypercapnia during wakefulness (with 
a pCOz of greater than 45), without other evidence of hypoventilation. 


Specify current severity: 
Severity is graded according to the degree of hypoxemia and hypercarbia present dur- 
ing sleep and evidence of end organ impairment due to these abnormalities (e.g., right- 
sided heart failure). The presence of blood gas abnormalities during wakefulness is an 
indicator of greater severity. 


Subtypes 


Regarding obesity hypoventilation disorder, the prevalence of obesity hypoventilation in 
the general population is not known but is thought to be increasing in association with the 
increased prevalence of obesity and extreme obesity. 


Diagnostic Features 


Sleep-related hypoventilation can occur independently or, more frequently, comorbid 
with medical or neurological disorders, medication use, or substance use disorder. Al- 
though symptoms are not mandatory to make this diagnosis, individuals often report 
excessive daytime sleepiness, frequent arousals and awakenings during sleep, morning 
headaches, and insomnia complaints. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with sleep-related hypoventilation can present with sleep-related complaints 
of insomnia or sleepiness. Episodes of orthopnea can occur in individuals with diaphragm 
weakness. Headaches upon awakening may be present. During sleep, episodes of shallow 
breathing may be observed, and obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea or central sleep apnea 
may coexist. Consequences of ventilatory insufficiency, including pulmonary hyperten- 
sion, cor pulmonale (right heart failure), polycythemia, and neurocognitive dysfunction, 


388 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


can be present. With progression of ventilatory insufficiency, blood gas abnormalities ex- 
tend into wakefulness. Features of the medical condition causing sleep-related hypoven- 
tilation can also be present. Episodes of hypoventilation may be associated with frequent 
arousals or bradytachycardia. Individuals may complain of excessive sleepiness and in- 
somnia or morning headaches or may present with findings of neurocognitive dysfunction 
or depression. Hypoventilation may not be present during wakefulness. 


Prevalence 


Idiopathic sleep-related hypoventilation in adults is very uncommon. The prevalence of 
congenital central alveolar hypoventilation is unknown, but the disorder is rare. Comor- 
bid sleep-related hypoventilation (i.e., hypoventilation comorbid with other conditions, 
such as chronic obstructive pulmonary disease [COPD], neuromuscular disorders, or obe- 
sity) is more common. 


Development and Course 


Idiopathic sleep-related hypoventilation is thought to be a slowly progressive disorder of 
respiratory impairment. When this disorder occurs comorbidly with other disorders (e.g., 
COPD, neuromuscular disorders, obesity), disease severity reflects the severity of the un- 
derlying condition, and the disorder progresses as the condition worsens. Complications 
such as pulmonary hypertension, cor pulmonale, cardiac dysrhythmias, polycythemia, 
neurocognitive dysfunction, and worsening respiratory failure can develop with increas- 
ing severity of blood gas abnormalities. 

Congenital central alveolar hypoventilation usually manifests at birth with shallow, 
erratic, or absent breathing. This disorder can also manifest during infancy, childhood, 
and adulthood because of variable penetrance of the PHOX2B mutation. Children with 
congenital central alveolar hypoventilation are more likely to have disorders of the auto- 
nomic nervous system, Hirschsprung’s disease, neural crest tumors, and characteristic box- 
shaped face (i.e., the face is short relative to its width). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Ventilatory drive can be reduced in individuals using central nervous 
system depressants, including benzodiazepines, opiates, and alcohol. 


Genetic and physiological. Idiopathic sleep-related hypoventilation is associated with 
reduced ventilatory drive due to a blunted chemoresponsiveness to CO, (reduced respi- 
ratory drive; ie., “won't breathe”), reflecting underlying neurological deficits in centers 
governing the control of ventilation. More commonly, sleep-related hypoventilation is co- 
morbid with another medical condition, such as a pulmonary disorder, a neuromuscular 
or chest wall disorder, or hypothyroidism, or with use of medications (e.g., benzodiaze- 
pines, opiates). In these conditions, the hypoventilation may be a consequence of in- 
creased work of breathing and/or impairment of respiratory muscle function (i.e., “can’t 
breathe”) or reduced respiratory drive (i.e., “won't breathe”). 

Neuromuscular disorders influence breathing through impairment of respiratory mo- 
tor innervation or respiratory muscle function. They include conditions such as amyo- 
trophic lateral sclerosis, spinal cord injury, diaphragmatic paralysis, myasthenia gravis, 
Lambert-Eaton syndrome, toxic or metabolic myopathies, postpolio syndrome, and Char- 
cot-Marie-Tooth syndrome. 

Congenital central alveolar hypoventilation is a genetic disorder attributable to muta- 
tions of PHOX2B, a gene that is crucial for the development of the embryonic autonomic 
nervous system and neural crest derivatives. Children with congenital central alveolar hy- 
poventilation show blunted ventilatory responses to hypercapnia, especially in non-rapid 
eye movement sleep. 


Sleep-Related Hypoventilation 389 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Gender distributions for sleep-related hypoventilation occurring in association with co- 
morbid conditions reflect the gender distributions of the comorbid conditions. For exam- 
ple, COPD is more frequently present in males and with increasing age. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Sleep-related hypoventilation is diagnosed using polysomnography showing sleep-related 
hypoxemia and hypercapnia that is not better explained by another breathing-related sleep 
disorder. The documentation of increased arterial pCO, levels to greater than 55 mmHg 
during sleep or a 10 mmHg or greater increase in pCO, levels (to a level that also exceeds 
50 mmHg) during sleep in comparison to awake supine values, for 10 minutes or longer, is 
the gold standard for diagnosis. However, obtaining arterial blood gas determinations dur- 
ing sleep is impractical, and non-invasive measures of pCO, have not been adequately val- 
idated during sleep and are not widely used during polysomnography in adults. Prolonged 
and sustained decreases in oxygen saturation (oxygen saturation of less than 90% for more 
than 5 minutes with a nadir of at least 85%, or oxygen saturation of less than 90% for at least 
30% of sleep time) in the absence of evidence of upper airway obstruction are often used as 
an indication of sleep-related hypoventilation; however, this finding is not specific, as there 
are other potential causes of hypoxemia, such as that due to lung disease. 


Functional Consequences of 
Sleep-Related Hypoventilation 


The consequences of sleep-related hypoventilation are related to the effects of chronic ex- 
posure to hypercapnia and hypoxemia. These blood gas derangements cause vasocon- 
striction of the pulmonary vasculature leading to pulmonary hypertension, which, if 
severe, can result in right-sided heart failure (cor pulmonale). Hypoxemia can lead to dys- 
function of organs such as the brain, blood, and heart, leading to outcomes such as cog- 
nitive dysfunction, polycythemia, and cardiac arrhythmias. Hypercapnia can depress 
ventilatory drive, leading to progressive respiratory failure. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other medical conditions affecting ventilation. In adults, the idiopathic variety of sleep- 
related hypoventilation is very uncommon and is determined by excluding the presence of 
lung diseases, skeletal malformations, neuromuscular disorders, and other medical and 
neurological disorders or medications that affect ventilation. Sleep-related hypoventila- 
tion must be distinguished from other causes of sleep-related hypoxemia, such as that due 
to lung disease. 


Other breathing-related sleep disorders. Sleep-related hypoventilation can be distin- 
guished from obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea and central sleep apnea based on clinical 
features and findings on polysomnography. Sleep-related hypoventilation typically shows 
more sustained periods of oxygen desaturation rather that the periodic episodes seen in 
obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea and central sleep apnea. Obstructive sleep apnea hy- 
popnea and central sleep apnea also show a pattern of discrete episodes of repeated air- 
flow decreases that can be absent in sleep-related hypoventilation. 


Comorbidity 

Sleep-related hypoventilation often occurs in association with a pulmonary disorder (e.g., in- 
terstitial lung disease, COPD), with a neuromuscular or chest wall disorder (e.g., muscular 
dystrophies, post-polio syndrome, cervical spinal cord injury, obesity, kyphoscoliosis), or, 


390 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


most relevant to the mental health provider, with medication use (e.g., benzodiazepines, opi- 
ates). Congenital central alveolar hypoventilation often occurs in association with autonomic 
dysfunction and may occur in association with Hirschsprung’s disease. COPD, a disorder of 
lower airway obstruction usually associated with cigarette smoking, can result in sleep- 
related hypoventilation and hypoxemia. The presence of coexisting obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea is thought to exacerbate hypoxemia and hypercapnia during sleep and wakeful- 
ness. The relationship between congenital central alveolar hypoventilation and idiopathic 
sleep-related hypoventilation is unclear; in some individuals, idiopathic sleep-related hy- 
poventilation may represent cases of late-onset congenital central alveolar hypoventilation. 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 


The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2), combines sleep- 
related hypoventilation and sleep-related hypoxemia under the category of sleep-related 
hypoventilation/hypoxemic syndromes. This approach to classification reflects the fre- 
quent co-occurrence of disorders that lead to hypoventilation and hypoxemia. In contrast, 
the classification used in DSM-5 reflects evidence that there are distinct sleep-related 
pathogenetic processes leading to hypoventilation. 


Circadian Rhythm Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Apersistent or recurrent pattern of sleep disruption that is primarily due to an alteration 
of the circadian system or to a misalignment between the endogenous circadian 
rhythm and the sleep—wake schedule required by an individual’s physical environment 
or social or professional schedule. 

B. The sleep disruption leads to excessive sleepiness or insomnia, or both. 

C. The sleep disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, and other important areas of functioning. 


Coding note: For ICD-9-CM, code 307.45 for all subtypes. For ICD-10-CM, code is based 
on subtype. 
Specify whether: 
307.45 (G47.21) Delayed sleep phase type: A pattern of delayed sleep onset and 
awakening times, with an inability to fall asleep and awaken at a desired or convention- 
ally acceptable earlier time. 
Specify if: 
Familial: A family history of delayed sleep phase is present. 
Specity if: 
Overlapping with non-24-hour sleep-wake type: Delayed sleep phase type 
may overlap with another circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorder, non-24-hour 
sleep-wake type. 
307.45 (G47.22) Advanced sleep phase type: A pattern of advanced sleep onset and 
awakening times, with an inability to remain awake or asleep until the desired or con- 
ventionally acceptable later sleep or wake times. 
Specity if: 
Familial: A family history of advanced sleep phase is present. 
307.45 (G47.23) Irregular sleep-wake type: A temporally disorganized sleep-wake 
pattern, such that the timing of sleep and wake periods is variable throughout the 24- 
hour period. 


Circadian Rhythm Sleep-Wake Disorders 391 


307.45 (G47.24) Non-24-hour sleep-wake type: A pattern of sleep-wake cycles that 
is not synchronized to the 24-hour environment, with a consistent daily drift (usually to 
later and later times) of sleep onset and wake times. 
307.45 (G47.26) Shift work type: Insomnia during the major sleep period and/or ex- 
cessive sleepiness (including inadvertent sleep) during the major awake period asso- 
ciated with a shift work schedule (i.e., requiring unconventional work hours). 
307.45 (G47.20) Unspecified type 

Specify if: 
Episodic: Symptoms last at least 1 month but less than 3 months. 
Persistent: Symptoms last 3 months or longer. 
Recurrent: Two or more episodes occur within the space of 1 year. 


Delayed Sleep Phase Type 


Diagnostic Features 


The delayed sleep phase type is based primarily on a history of a delay in the timing of the 
major sleep period (usually more than 2 hours) in relation to the desired sleep and wake- 
up time, resulting in symptoms of insomnia and excessive sleepiness. When allowed to set 
their own schedule, individuals with delayed sleep phase type exhibit normal sleep qual- 
ity and duration for age. Symptoms of sleep-onset insomnia, difficulty waking in the 
morning, and excessive early day sleepiness are prominent. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Common associated features of delayed sleep phase type include a history of mental dis- 
orders or a concurrent mental disorder. Extreme and prolonged difficulty awakening with 
morning confusion is also common. Psychophysiological insomnia may develop as a re- 
sult of maladaptive behaviors that impair sleep and increase arousal because of repeated 
attempts to fall asleep at an earlier time. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence of delayed sleep phase type in the general population is approximately 0.17% 
but appears to be greater than 7% in adolescents. Although the prevalence of familial de- 
layed sleep phase type has not been established, a family history of delayed sleep phase is 
present in individuals with delayed sleep phase type. 


Development and Course 


Course is persistent, lasting longer than 3 months, with intermittent exacerbations through- 
out adulthood. Although age at onset is variable, symptoms begin typically in adolescence 
and early adulthood and persist for several months to years before diagnosis is estab- 
lished. Severity may decrease with age. Relapse of symptoms is common. 

Clinical expression may vary across the lifespan depending on social, school, and work 
obligations. Exacerbation is usually triggered by a change in work or school schedule that 
requires an early rise time. Individuals who can alter their work schedules to accommo- 
date the delayed circadian sleep and wake timing can experience remission of symptoms. 

Increased prevalence in adolescence may be a consequence of both physiological and be- 
havioral factors. Hormonal changes may be involved specifically, as delayed sleep phase is as- 
sociated with the onset of puberty. Thus, delayed sleep phase type in adolescents should be 
differentiated from the common delay in the timing of circadian rhythms in this age group. In 
the familial form, the course is persistent and may not improve significantly with age. 


392 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Predisposing factors may include a longer than average cir- 
cadian period, changes in light sensitivity, and impaired homeostatic sleep drive. Some in- 
dividuals with delayed sleep phase type may be hypersensitive to evening light, which 
can serve as a delay signal to the circadian clock, or they may be hyposensitive to morning 
light such that its phase-advancing effects are reduced. Genetic factors may play a role in 
the pathogenesis of familial and sporadic forms of delayed sleep phase type, including 
mutations in circadian genes (e.g., PER3, CKIe). 


Diagnostic Markers 


Confirmation of the diagnosis includes a complete history and use of a sleep diary or actigra- 
phy (i.e.,a wrist-worn motion detector that monitors motor activity for prolonged periods and 
can be used as a proxy for sleep-wake patterns for at least 7 days). The period covered should 
include weekends, when social and occupational obligations are less strict, to ensure that the 
individual exhibits a consistently delayed sleep-wake pattern. Biomarkers such as salivary 
dim light melatonin onset should be obtained only when the diagnosis is unclear. 


Functional Consequences of Delayed Sleep Phase Type 


Excessive early day sleepiness is prominent. Extreme and prolonged difficulty awakening 
with morning confusion (i.e., sleep inertia) is also common. The severity of insomnia and 
excessive sleepiness symptoms varies substantially among individuals and largely de- 
pends on the occupational and social demands on the individual. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normative variations in sleep. Delayed sleep phase type must be distinguished from 
“normal” sleep patterns in which an individual has a late schedule that does not cause 
personal, social, or occupational distress (most commonly seen in adolescents and young 
adults). 


Other sleep disorders. Insomnia disorder and other circadian rhythm sleep-wake dis- 
orders should be included in the differential. Excessive sleepiness may also be caused by 
other sleep disturbances, such as breathing-related sleep disorders, insomnias, sleep- 
related movement disorders, and medical, neurological, and mental disorders. Overnight 
polysomnography may help in evaluating for other comorbid sleep disorders, such as 
sleep apnea. The circadian nature of delayed sleep phase type, however, should differen- 
tiate it from other disorders with similar complaints. 


Comorbidity 


Delayed sleep phase type is strongly associated with depression, personality disorder, and 
somatic symptom disorder or illness anxiety disorder. In addition, comorbid sleep disor- 
ders, such as insomnia disorder, restless legs syndrome, and sleep apnea, as well as depres- 
sive and bipolar disorders and anxiety disorders, can exacerbate symptoms of insomnia 
and excessive sleepiness. Delayed sleep phase type may overlap with another circadian 
rhythm sleep-wake disorder, non-24-hour sleep-wake type. Sighted individuals with non- 
24-hour sleep-wake type disorder commonly also have a history of delayed circadian sleep 
phase. 


Circadian Rhythm Sleep-Wake Disorders 393 


Advanced Sleep Phase Type 


Specifiers 

Advanced sleep phase type may be documented with the specified “familial.” Although 
the prevalence of familial advanced sleep phase type has not been established, a family 
history of advanced sleep phase is present in individuals with advanced sleep phase type. 
In this type, specific mutations demonstrate an autosomal dominant mode of inheritance. 
In the familial form, onset of symptoms may occur earlier (during childhood and early 
adulthood), the course is persistent, and the severity of symptoms may increase with age. 


Diagnostic Features 


Advanced sleep phase type is characterized by sleep-wake times that are several hours 
earlier than desired or conventional times. Diagnosis is based primarily on a history of an 
advance in the timing of the major sleep period (usually more than 2 hours) in relation to 
the desired sleep and wake-up time, with symptoms of early morning insomnia and ex- 
cessive daytime sleepiness. When allowed to set their schedule, individuals with ad- 
vanced sleep phase type will exhibit normal sleep quality and duration for age. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with advanced sleep phase type are “morning types,” having earlier sleep- 
wake times, with the timing of circadian biomarkers such as melatonin and core body tem- 
perature rhythms occurring 2—4 hours earlier than normal. When required to keep a con- 
ventional schedule requiring a delay of bedtime, these individuals will continue to have an 
early rise time, leading to persistent sleep deprivation and daytime sleepiness. Use of hyp- 
notics or alcohol to combat sleep-maintenance insomnia and stimulants to reduce daytime 
sleepiness may lead to substance abuse in these individuals. 


Prevalence 


The estimated prevalence of advanced sleep phase type is approximately 1% in middle- 
age adults. Sleep-wake times and circadian phase advance in older individuals, probably 
accounting for increased prevalence in this population. 


Development and Course 


Onset is usually in late adulthood. In the familial form, onset can be earlier. The course is typ- 
ically persistent, lasting more than 3 months, but the severity may increase depending on work 
and social schedules. The advanced sleep phase type is more common in older adults. 

Clinical expression may vary across the lifespan depending on social, school, and work 
obligations. Individuals who can alter their work schedules to accommodate the advanced 
circadian sleep and wake timing can experience remission of symptoms. Increasing age 
tends to advance the sleep phase, however, it is unclear whether the common age-associ- 
ated advanced sleep phase type is due solely to a change in circadian timing (as seen in the 
familial form) or also to age-related changes in the homeostatic regulation of sleep, result- 
ing in earlier awakening. Severity, remission, and relapse of symptoms suggest lack of ad- 
herence to behavioral and environmental treatments designed to control sleep and wake 
structure and light exposure. 


394 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Decreased late afternoon/early evening exposure to light and/or expo- 
sure to early morning light due to early morning awakening can increase the risk of ad- 
vanced sleep phase type by advancing circadian rhythms. By going to bed early, these 
individuals are not exposed to light in the phase delay region of the curve, resulting in per- 
petuation of advanced phase. In familial advanced sleep phase type, a shortening of the 
endogenous circadian period can result in an advanced sleep phase, although circadian pe- 
riod does not appear to systematically decrease with age. 


Genetic and physiological. Advanced sleep phase type has demonstrated an autoso- 
mal dominant mode of inheritance, including a PER2 gene mutation causing hypophos- 
phorylation of the PER2 protein and a missense mutation in CKI. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


African Americans may have a shorter circadian period and larger magnitude phase ad- 
vances to light than do Caucasians, possibly increasing the risk for development of ad- 
vanced sleep phase type in this population. 


Diagnostic Markers 


A sleep diary and actigraphy may be used as diagnostic markers, as described earlier for 
delayed sleep phase type. 


Functional Consequences of Advanced Sleep Phase Type 


Excessive sleepiness associated with advanced sleep phase can have a negative effect on 
cognitive performance, social interaction, and safety. Use of wake-promoting agents to 
combat sleepiness or sedatives for early morning awakening may increase potential for 
substance abuse. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other sleep disorders. Behavioral factors such as irregular sleep schedules, voluntary 
early awakening, and exposure to light in the early morning should be considered, partic- 
ularly in older adults. Careful attention should be paid to rule out other sleep-wake dis- 
orders, such as insomnia disorder, and other mental disorders and medical conditions that 
can cause early morning awakening. 


Depressive and bipolar disorders. Because early morning awakening, fatigue, and sleep- 
iness are prominent features of major depressive disorder, depressive and bipolar disor- 
ders must also be considered. 


Comorbidity 


Medical conditions and mental disorders with the symptom of early morning awakening, 
such as insomnia, can co-occur with the advance sleep phase type. 


Irregular Sleep-Wake Type 


Diagnostic Features 

The diagnosis of irregular sleep-wake type is based primarily on a history of symptoms of 
insomnia at night (during the usual sleep period) and excessive sleepiness (napping) dur- 
ing the day. Irregular sleep-wake type is characterized by a lack of discernable sleep-wake 


Circadian Rhythm Sleep-Wake Disorders 395 


circadian rhythm. There is no major sleep period, and sleep is fragmented into at least 
three periods during the 24-hour day. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with irregular sleep-wake type typically present with insomnia or excessive 
sleepiness, depending on the time of day. Sleep and wake periods across 24 hours are frag- 
mented, although the longest sleep period tends to occur between 2:00 A.M. and 6:00 A.M. 
and is usually less than 4 hours. A history of isolation or reclusion may occur in association 
with the disorder and contribute to the symptoms via a lack of external stimuli to help en- 
train a normal pattern. Individuals or their caregivers report frequent naps throughout the 
day. Irregular sleep-wake type is most commonly associated with neurodegenerative dis- 
orders, such as major neurocognitive disorder, and many neurodevelopmental disorders 
in children. 


Prevalence 
Prevalence of irregular sleep-wake type in the general population is unknown. 


Development and Course 


The course of irregular sleep-wake type is persistent. Age at onset is variable, but the dis- 
order is more common in older adults. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Neurodegenerative disorders, such as Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s 
disease, and Huntington’s disease, and neurodevelopmental disorders in children in- 
crease the risk for irregular sleep-wake type. 


Environmental. Decreased exposure to environmental light and structured daytime ac- 
tivity can be associated with a low-amplitude circadian rhythm. Hospitalized individuals 
are especially prone to such weak external entraining stimuli, and even outside the hospi- 
tal setting, individuals with major neurocognitive disorder (i.e., dementia) are exposed to 
significantly less bright light. 


Diagnostic Markers 


A detailed sleep history and a sleep diary (by a caregiver) or actigraphy help confirm the 
irregular sleep-wake pattern. 


Functional Consequences of 
Irregular Sleep-Wake Type 


Lack of a clearly discernible major sleep and wake period in irregular sleep-wake type re- 
sults in insomnia or excessive sleepiness, depending on the time of day. Disruption of the 
caregiver's sleep also often occurs and is an important consideration. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normative variations in sleep. Irregular sleep-wake type should be distinguished from 
a voluntary irregular sleep-wake schedule and poor sleep hygiene, which can result in in- 
somnia and excessive sleepiness. 


Other medical conditions and mental disorders. Other causes of insomnia and daytime 
sleepiness, including comorbid medical conditions and mental disorders or medication, 
should be considered. 


396 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Comorbidity 


Irregular sleep-wake type is often comorbid with neurodegenerative and neurodevelop- 
mental disorders, such as major neurocognitive disorder, intellectual disability (intellec- 
tual developmental disorder), and traumatic brain injury. It is also comorbid with other 
medical conditions and mental disorders in which there is social isolation and/or lack of 
light and structured activities. 


Non-24-Hour Sleep-Wake Type 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnosis of non-24-hour sleep-wake type is based primarily on a history of symp- 
toms of insomnia or excessive sleepiness related to abnormal synchronization between the 
24-hour light-dark cycle and the endogenous circadian rhythm. Individuals typically pre- 
sent with periods of insomnia, excessive sleepiness, or both, which alternate with short 
asymptomatic periods. Starting with the asymptomatic period, when the individual’s 
sleep phase is aligned to the external environment, sleep latency will gradually increase 
and the individual will complain of sleep-onset insomnia. As the sleep phase continues to 
drift so that sleep time is now in the daytime, the individual will have trouble staying 
awake during the day and will complain of sleepiness. Because the circadian period is not 
aligned to the external 24-hour environment, symptoms will depend on when an individ- 
ual tries to sleep in relation to the circadian rhythm of sleep propensity. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Non-24-hour sleep-wake type is most common among blind or visually impaired individ- 
uals who have decreased light perception. In sighted individuals, there is often a history of 
delayed sleep phase and of decreased exposure to light and structured social and physical 
activity. Sighted individuals with non-24-hour sleep-wake type also demonstrate in- 
creased sleep duration. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence of non-24-hour sleep-wake type in the general population is unclear, but the 
disorder appears rare in sighted individuals. The prevalence in blind individuals is esti- 
mated to be 50%. 


Development and Course 


Course of non-24-hour sleep-wake type is persistent, with intermittent remission and ex- 
acerbations due to changes in work and social schedules throughout the lifespan. Age at 
onset is variable, depending on the onset of visual impairment. In sighted individuals, be- 
cause of the overlap with delayed sleep phase type, non-24-hour sleep-wake type may de- 
velop in adolescence or early adulthood. Remission and relapse of symptoms in blind and 
sighted individuals largely depend on adherence to treatments designed to control sleep 
and wake structure and light exposure. 

Clinical expression may vary across the lifespan depending on social, school, and work 
obligations. In adolescents and adults, irregular sleep-wake schedules and exposure to 
light or lack of light at critical times of the day can exacerbate the effects of sleep loss and 
disrupt circadian entrainment. Consequently, symptoms of insomnia, daytime sleepiness, 
and school, professional, and interpersonal functioning may worsen. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. In sighted individuals, decreased exposure or sensitivity to light and so- 
cial and physical activity cues may contribute to a free-running circadian rhythm. With the 


Circadian Rhythm Sleep-Wake Disorders 397 


high frequency of mental disorders involving social isolation and cases of non-24-hour 
sleep-wake type developing after a change in sleep habits (e.g., night shift work, job loss), 
behavioral factors in combination with physiological tendency may precipitate and per- 
petuate this disorder in sighted individuals. Hospitalized individuals with neurological and 
psychiatric disorders can become insensitive to social cues, predisposing them to the de- 
velopment of non-24-hour sleep-wake type. 


Genetic and physiological. Blindness is a risk factor for non-24-hour sleep-wake type. 
Non-24-hour sleep-wake type has been associated with traumatic brain injury. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Diagnosis is confirmed by history and sleep diary or actigraphy for an extended period. 
Sequential measurement of phase markers (e.g., melatonin) can help determine circadian 
phase in both sighted and blind individuals. 


Functional Consequences of 
Non-24-Hour Sleep-Wake Type 


Complaints of insomnia (sleep onset and sleep maintenance), excessive sleepiness, or both 
are prominent. The unpredictability of sleep and wake times (typically a daily delay drift) 
results in an inability to attend school or maintain a steady job and may increase potential 
for social isolation. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders. In sighted individuals, non-24-hour sleep-wake 
type should be differentiated from delayed sleep phase type, as individuals with delayed 
sleep phase type may display a similar progressive delay in sleep period for several days. 


Depressive disorders. Depressive symptoms and depressive disorders may result in 
similar circadian dysregulation and symptoms. 


Comorbidity 


Blindness is often comorbid with non-24-hour sleep-wake type, as are depressive and bi- 
polar disorders with social isolation. 


Shift Work Type 


Diagnostic Features 


Diagnosis is primarily based on a history of the individual working outside of the normal 
8:00 A.M. to 6:00 P.M. daytime window (particularly at night) on a regularly scheduled (i.e., 
non-overtime) basis. Symptoms of excessive sleepiness at work, and impaired sleep at 
home, on a persistent basis are prominent. Presence of both sets of symptoms are usually 
required for a diagnosis of shift work type. Typically, when the individual reverts to a day- 
work routine, symptoms resolve. Although the etiology is slightly different, individuals 
who travel across many time zones on a very frequent basis may experience effects similar 
to those experienced by individuals with shift work type who work rotating shifts. 


Prevalence 

The prevalence of shift work type is unclear, but the disorder is estimated to affect 5%—-10% 
of the night worker population (16%-20% of the workforce). Prevalence rises with advance- 
ment into middle-age and beyond (Drake et al. 2004). 


398 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Development and Course 


Shift work type can appear in individuals of any age but is more prevalent in individuals 
older than 50 years and typically worsens with the passage of time if the disruptive work 
hours persist. Although older adults may show similar rates of circadian phase adjust- 
ment to a change in routine as do younger adults, they appear to experience significantly 
more sleep disruption as a consequence of the circadian phase shift. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Predisposing factors include a morning-type disposition, a need for 
long (i.e., more than 8 hours) sleep durations in order to feel well rested, and strong com- 
peting social and domestic needs (e.g., parents of young children). Individuals who are able 
to commit to a nocturnal lifestyle, with few competing day-oriented demands, appear at 
lower risk for shift work type. 


Genetic and physiological. Because shift workers are more likely than day workers to 
be obese, obstructive sleep apnea may be present and may exacerbate the symptoms. 


Diagnostic Markers 


A history and sleep diary or actigraphy may be useful in diagnosis, as discussed earlier for 
delayed sleep phase type. 


Functional Consequences of Shift Work Type 


Individuals with shift work type not only may perform poorly at work but also appear to 
be at risk for accidents both at work and on the drive home. They may also be at risk for 
poor mental health (e.g., alcohol use disorder, substance use disorder, depression) and 
physical health (e.g., gastrointestinal disorders, cardiovascular disease, diabetes, cancer). 
Individuals with a history of bipolar disorder are particularly vulnerable to shift work 
type-related episodes of mania resulting from missed nights of sleep. Shift work type of- 
ten results in interpersonal problems. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normative variations in sleep with shift work. The diagnosis of shift work type, as op- 
posed to the “normal” difficulties of shift work, must depend to some extent on the sever- 
ity of symptoms and/or level of distress experienced by the individual. Presence of shift 
work type symptoms even when the individual is able to live on a day-oriented routine for 
several weeks at a time may suggest the presence of other sleep disorders, such as sleep ap- 
nea, insomnia, and narcolepsy, which should be ruled out. 


Comorbidity 


Shift work type has been associated with increased alcohol use disorder, other substance 
use disorders, and depression. A variety of physical health disorders (e.g., gastrointestinal 
disorders, cardiovascular disease, diabetes, cancer) have been found to be associated with 
prolonged exposure to shift work. 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 


The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2), differentiates nine 
circadian rhythm sleep disorders, including jet lag type. 


Non-Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Arousal Disorders 399 


Parasomnias 


Parasomnias are disorders characterized by abnormal behavioral, experiential, or physio- 
logical events occurring in association with sleep, specific sleep stages, or sleep-wake tran- 
sitions. The most common parasomnias—non-rapid eye movement (NREM) sleep 
arousal disorders and rapid eye movement (REM) sleep behavior disorder—represent ad- 
mixtures of wakefulness and NREM sleep and wakefulness and REM sleep, respectively. 
These conditions serve as a reminder that sleep and wakefulness are not mutually exclu- 
sive and that sleep is not necessarily a global, whole-brain phenomenon. 


Non-Rapid Eye Movement 
Sleep Arousal Disorders 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recurrent episodes of incomplete awakening from sleep, usually occurring during the 
first third of the major sleep episode, accompanied by either one of the following: 


1. Sleepwalking: Repeated episodes of rising from bed during sleep and walking 
about. While sleepwalking, the individual has a blank, staring face; is relatively un- 
responsive to the efforts of others to communicate with him or her; and can be 
awakened only with great difficulty. 

2. Sleep terrors: Recurrent episodes of abrupt terror arousals from sleep, usually be- 
ginning with a panicky scream. There is intense fear and signs of autonomic 
arousal, such as mydriasis, tachycardia, rapid breathing, and sweating, during 
each episode. There is relative unresponsiveness to efforts of others to comfort the 
individual during the episodes. 

. No or little (e.g., only a single visual scene) dream imagery is recalled. 
. Amnesia for the episodes is present. 
. The episodes cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, 
or other important areas of functioning. 
E. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication). 
F. Coexisting mental and medical disorders do not explain the episodes of sleepwalking 
or sleep terrors. 
Coding note: For ICD-9-CM, code 307.46 for all subtypes. For ICD-10-CM, code is based 
on subtype. 
Specify whether: 
307.46 (F51.3) Sleepwalking type 
Specify if: 
With sleep-related eating 
With sleep-related sexual behavior (sexsomnia) 
307.46 (F51.4) Sleep terror type 


008 


400 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of non—-rapid eye movement (NREM) sleep arousal disorders is the 
repeated occurrence of incomplete arousals, usually beginning during the first third of the 
major sleep episode (Criterion A), that typically are brief, lasting 1-10 minutes, but may be 
protracted, lasting up to 1 hour. The maximum duration of an event is unknown. The eyes 
are typically open during these events. Many individuals exhibit both subtypes of arousals 
on different occasions, which underscores the unitary underlying pathophysiology. The 
subtypes reflect varying degrees of simultaneous occurrence of wakefulness and NREM 
sleep, resulting in complex behaviors arising from sleep with varying degrees of conscious 
awareness, motor activity, and autonomic activation. 

The essential feature of sleepwalking is repeated episodes of complex motor behavior 
initiated during sleep, including rising from bed and walking about (Criterion A1). Sleep- 
walking episodes begin during any stage of NREM sleep, most commonly during slow- 
wave sleep and therefore most often occurring during the first third of the night. During 
episodes, the individual has reduced alertness and responsiveness, a blank stare, and rel- 
ative unresponsiveness to communication with others or efforts by others to awaken the 
individual. If awakened during the episode (or on awakening the following morning), the 
individual has limited recall for the episode. After the episode, there may initially be a brief 
period of confusion or difficulty orienting, followed by full recovery of cognitive function 
and appropriate behavior. 

The essential feature of sleep terrors is the repeated occurrence of precipitous awaken- 
ings from sleep, usually beginning with a panicky scream or cry (Criterion A2). Sleep ter- 
rors usually begin during the first third of the major sleep episode and last 1-10 minutes, 
but they may last considerably longer, particularly in children. The episodes are accom- 
panied by impressive autonomic arousal and behavioral manifestations of intense fear. 
During an episode, the individual is difficult to awaken or comfort. If the individual awak- 
ens after the sleep terror, little or none of the dream, or only fragmentary, single images, 
are recalled. During a typical episode of sleep terrors, the individual abruptly sits up in 
bed screaming or crying, with a frightened expression and autonomic signs of intense anx- 
iety (e.g., tachycardia, rapid breathing, sweating, dilation of the pupils). The individual 
may be inconsolable and is usually unresponsive to the efforts of others to awaken or com- 
fort him or her. Sleep terrors are also called “night terrors” or “pavor nocturnus.” 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Sleepwalking episodes can include a wide variety of behaviors. Episodes may begin with 
confusion: the individual may simply sit up in bed, look about, or pick at the blanket or 
sheet. This behavior then becomes progressively complex. The individual may actually 
leave the bed and walk into closets, out of the room, and even out of buildings. Individuals 
may use the bathroom, eat, talk, or engage in more complex behaviors. Running and fran- 
tic attempts to escape some apparent threat can also occur. Most behaviors during sleep- 
walking episodes are routine and of low complexity. However, cases of unlocking doors 
and even operating machinery (driving an automobile) have been reported. Sleepwalking 
can also include inappropriate behavior (e.g., commonly, urinating in a closet or waste- 
basket). Most episodes last for several minutes to a half hour but may be more protracted. 
Inasmuch as sleep is a state of relative analgesia, painful injuries sustained during sleep- 
walking may not be appreciated until awakening after the fact. 

There are two “specialized” forms of sleepwalking: sleep-related eating behavior and 
sleep-related sexual behavior (sexsomnia or sleep sex). Individuals with sleep-related eating 
experience unwanted recurrent episodes of eating with varying degrees of amnesia, rang- 
ing from no awareness to full awareness without the ability to not eat. During these epi- 
sodes, inappropriate foods may be ingested. Individuals with sleep-related eating disorder 
may find evidence of their eating only the next morning. In sexsomnia, varying degrees of 


Non-—Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Arousal Disorders 401 


sexual activity (e.g., masturbation, fondling, groping, sexual intercourse) occur as complex 
behaviors arising from sleep without conscious awareness. This condition is more common 
in males and may result in serious interpersonal relationship problems or medicolegal 
consequences. 

During a typical episode of sleep terrors, there is often a sense of overwhelming dread, 
with a compulsion to escape. Although fragmentary vivid dream images may occur, a story- 
like dream sequence (as in nightmares) is not reported. Most commonly, the individual does 
not awaken fully, but returns to sleep and has amnesia for the episode on awakening the next 
morning. Usually only one episode will occur on any one night. Occasionally several episodes 
may occur at intervals throughout the night. These events rarely arise during daytime naps. 


Prevalence 


Isolated or infrequent NREM sleep arousal disorders are very common in the general pop- 
ulation. From 10% to 30% of children have had at least one episode of sleepwalking, and 
2%-3% sleepwalk often. The prevalence of sleepwalking disorder, marked by repeated ep- 
isodes and impairment or distress, is much lower, probably in the range of 1%-5%. The 
prevalence of sleepwalking episodes (not sleepwalking disorder) is 1.0%-7.0% among 
adults, with weekly to monthly episodes occurring in 0.5%-0.7%. The lifetime prevalence 
of sleepwalking in adults is 29.2%, with a past-year prevalence of sleepwalking of 3.6%. 

The prevalence of sleep terrors in the general population is unknown. The prevalence 
of sleep terror episodes (as opposed to sleep terror disorder, in which there is recurrence 
and distress or impairment) is approximately 36.9% at 18 months of age, 19.7% at 30 months 
of age, and 2.2% in adults. 


Development and Course 


NREM sleep arousal disorders occur most commonly in childhood and diminish in fre- 
quency with increasing age. The onset of sleepwalking in adults with no prior history of 
sleepwalking as children should prompt a search for specific etiologies, such as obstruc- 
tive sleep apnea, nocturnal seizures, or effect of medication. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Sedative use, sleep deprivation, sleep-wake schedule disruptions, fa- 
tigue, and physical or emotional stress increase the likelihood of episodes. Fever and sleep 
deprivation can produce an increased frequency of NREM sleep arousal disorders. 


Genetic and physiological. A family history for sleepwalking or sleep terrors may oc- 
cur in up to 80% of individuals who sleepwalk. The risk for sleepwalking is further in- 
creased (to as much as 60% of offspring) when both parents have a history of the disorder. 

Individuals with sleep terrors frequently have a positive family history of either sleep 
terrors or sleepwalking, with as high as a 10-fold increase in the prevalence of the disorder 
among first-degree biological relatives. Sleep terrors are much more common in monozy- 
gotic twins as compared with dizygotic twins. The exact mode of inheritance is unknown. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Violent or sexual activity during sleepwalking episodes is more likely to occur in adults. 
Eating during sleepwalking episodes is more commonly seen in females. Sleepwalking oc- 
curs more often in females during childhood but more often in males during adulthood. 

Older children and adults provide a more detailed recollection of fearful images asso- 
ciated with sleep terrors than do younger children, who are more likely to have complete 
amnesia or report only a vague sense of fear. Among children, sleep terrors are more com- 
mon in males than in females. Among adults, the sex ratio is even. 


402 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Diagnostic Markers 


NREM sleep arousal disorders arise from any stage of NREM sleep but most commonly 
from deep NREM sleep (slow-wave sleep). They are most likely to appear in the first third 
of the night and do not commonly occur during daytime naps. During the episode, the 
polysomnogram may be obscured with movement artifact. In the absence of such artifact, 
the electroencephalogram typically shows theta or alpha frequency activity during the ep- 
isode, indicating partial or incomplete arousal. 

Polysomnography in conjunction with audiovisual monitoring can be used to document 
episodes of sleepwalking. In the absence of actually capturing an event during a polysomno- 
graphic recording, there are no polysomnographic features that can serve as a marker for 
sleepwalking. Sleep deprivation may increase the likelihood of capturing an event. Asa group, 
individuals who sleepwalk show instability of deep NREM sleep, but the overlap in findings 
with individuals who do not sleepwalk is great enough to preclude use of this indicator in es- 
tablishing a diagnosis. Unlike arousals from REM sleep associated with nightmares, in which 
there is an increase in heart rate and respiration prior to the arousal, the NREM sleep arousals 
of sleep terrors begin precipitously from sleep, without anticipatory autonomic changes. The 
arousals are associated with impressive autonomic activity, with doubling or tripling of 
the heart rate. The pathophysiology is poorly understood, but there appears to be instability in 
the deeper stages of NREM sleep. Absent capturing an event during a formal sleep study, 
there are no reliable polysomnographic indicators of the tendency to experience sleep terrors. 


Functional Consequences of 
Non-REM Sleep Arousal Disorders 


For the diagnosis of a NREM sleep arousal disorder to be made, the individual or house- 
hold members must experience clinically significant distress or impairment, although pa- 
rasomnia symptoms may occur occasionally in nonclinical populations and would be 
subthreshold for the diagnosis. Embarrassment concerning the episodes can impair social 
relationships. Social isolation or occupational difficulties can result. The determination of a 
“disorder” depends on a number of factors, which may vary on an individual basis and 
will depend on the frequency of events, potential for violence or injurious behaviors, em- 
barrassment, or disruption/distress of other household members. Severity determination 
is best made based on the nature or consequence of the behaviors rather than simply on fre- 
quency. Uncommonly, NREM sleep arousal disorders may result in serious injury to the 
individual or to someone trying to console the individual. Injuries to others are confined to 
those in close proximity; individuals are not “sought out.” Typically, sleepwalking in both 
children and adults is not associated with significant mental disorders. For individuals 
with sleep-related eating behaviors, unknowingly preparing or eating food during the 
sleep period may create problems such as poor diabetes control, weight gain, injury (cuts 
and burns), or consequences of eating dangerous or toxic inedibles. NREM sleep arousal 
disorders may rarely result in violent or injurious behaviors with forensic implications. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nightmare disorder. In contrast to individuals with NREM sleep arousal disorders, in- 
dividuals with nightmare disorder typically awaken easily and completely, report vivid 
storylike dreams accompanying the episodes, and tend to have episodes later in the night. 
NREM sleep arousal disorders occur during NREM sleep, whereas nightmares usually oc- 
cur during REM sleep. Parents of children with NREM sleep arousal disorders may mis- 
interpret reports of fragmentary imagery as nightmares. 


Breathing-related sleep disorders. Breathing disorders during sleep can also produce 
confusional arousals with subsequent amnesia. However, breathing-related sleep disor- 
ders are also characterized by characteristic symptoms of snoring, breathing pauses, and 


Non-Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Arousal Disorders 403 


daytime sleepiness. In some individuals, a breathing-related sleep disorder may precipi- 
tate episodes of sleepwalking. 


REM sleep behavior disorder. REM sleep behavior disorder may be difficult to distin- 
guish from NREM sleep arousal disorders. REM sleep behavior disorder is characterized 
by episodes of prominent, complex movements, often involving personal injury arising 
from sleep. In contrast to NREM sleep arousal disorders, REM sleep behavior disorder oc- 
curs during REM sleep. Individuals with REM sleep behavior disorder awaken easily and 
report more detailed and vivid dream content than do individuals with NREM sleep arousal 
disorders. They often report that they “act out dreams.” 


Parasomnia overlap syndrome. Parasomnia overlap syndrome consists of clinical and 
polysomnographic features of both sleepwalking and REM sleep behavior disorder. 


Sleep-related seizures. Some types of seizures can produce episodes of very unusual 
behaviors that occur predominantly or exclusively during sleep. Nocturnal seizures may 
closely mimic NREM sleep arousal disorders but tend to be more stereotypic in nature, oc- 
cur multiple times nightly, and be more likely to occur from daytime naps. The presence of 
sleep-related seizures does not preclude the presence of NREM sleep arousal disorders. 
Sleep-related seizures should be classified as a form of epilepsy. 


Alcohol-induced blackouts. Alcohol-induced blackouts may be associated with extremely 
complex behaviors in the absence of other suggestions of intoxication. They do not involve 
the loss of consciousness but rather reflect an isolated disruption of memory for events 
during a drinking episode. By history, these behaviors may be indistinguishable from those 
seen in NREM sleep arousal disorders. 


Dissociative amnesia, with dissociative fugue. Dissociative fugue may be extremely 
difficult to distinguish from sleepwalking. Unlike all other parasomnias, nocturnal disso- 
ciative fugue arises from a period of wakefulness during sleep, rather than precipitously 
from sleep without intervening wakefulness. A history of recurrent childhood physical or 
sexual abuse is usually present (but may be difficult to obtain). 


Malingering or other voluntary behavior occurring during wakefulness. As with disso- 
ciative fugue, malingering or other voluntary behavior occurring during wakefulness 
arises from wakefulness. 


Panic disorder. Panic attacks may also cause abrupt awakenings from deep NREM sleep 
accompanied by fearfulness, but these episodes produce rapid and complete awakening with- 
out the confusion, amnesia, or motor activity typical of NREM sleep arousal disorders. 


Medication-induced complex behaviors. Behaviors similar to those in NREM sleep 
arousal disorders can be induced by use of, or withdrawal from, substances or medica- 
tions (e.g., benzodiazepines, nonbenzodiazepine sedative-hypnotics, opiates, cocaine, nic- 
otine, antipsychotics, tricyclic antidepressants, chloral hydrate). Such behaviors may arise 
from the sleep period and may be extremely complex. The underlying pathophysiology 
appears to be a relatively isolated amnesia. In such cases, substance /medication-induced 
sleep disorder, parasomnia type, should be diagnosed (see “Substance /Medication- 
Induced Sleep Disorder” later in this chapter). 


Night eating syndrome. The sleep-related eating disorder form of sleepwalking is to be 
differentiated from night eating syndrome, in which there is a delay in the circadian rhythm 
of food ingestion and an association with insomnia and/or depression. 


Comorbidity 

In adults, there is an association between sleepwalking and major depressive episodes and 
obsessive-compulsive disorder. Children or adults with sleep terrors may have elevated 
scores for depression and anxiety on personality inventories. 


404 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders 


The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition, includes “confusional 
arousal” as a NREM sleep arousal disorder. 


Nightmare Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 307.47 (F51.5) 


A. Repeated occurrences of extended, extremely dysphoric, and well-remembered 
dreams that usually involve efforts to avoid threats to survival, security, or physical in- 
tegrity and that generally occur during the second half of the major sleep episode. 

B. On awakening from the dysphoric dreams, the individual rapidly becomes oriented and 
alert. 

C. The sleep disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The nightmare symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a sub- 
stance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication). 

E. Coexisting mental and medical disorders do not adequately explain the predominant 
complaint of dysphoric dreams. 

Specify if: 

During sleep onset 
Specity if: 
With associated non-sleep disorder, including substance use disorders 
With associated other medical condition 
With associated other sleep disorder 
Coding note: The code 307.47 (F51.5) applies to all three specifiers. Code also the 
relevant associated mental disorder, medical condition, or other sleep disorder imme- 
diately after the code for nightmare disorder in order to indicate the association. 

Specify if: 

Acute: Duration of period of nightmares is 1 month or less. 

Subacute: Duration of period of nightmares is greater than 1 month but less than 
6 months. 

Persistent: Duration of period of nightmares is 6 months or greater. 


Specify current severity: 
Severity can be rated by the frequency with which the nightmares occur: 
Mild: Less than one episode per week on average. 
Moderate: One or more episodes per week but less than nightly. 
Severe: Episodes nightly. 


Diagnostic Features 


Nightmares are typically lengthy, elaborate, storylike sequences of dream imagery that 
seem real and that incite anxiety, fear, or other dysphoric emotions. Nightmare content 
typically focuses on attempts to avoid or cope with imminent danger but may involve 
themes that evoke other negative emotions. Nightmares occurring after traumatic experi- 
ences may replicate the threatening situation (“replicative nightmares”), but most do not. 
On awakening, nightmares are well remembered and can be described in detail. They arise 


Nightmare Disorder 405 


almost exclusively during rapid eye movement (REM) sleep and can thus occur through- 
out sleep but are more likely in the second half of the major sleep episode when dreaming 
is longer and more intense. Factors that increase early-night REM intensity, such as sleep 
fragmentation or deprivation, jet lag, and REM-sensitive medications, might facilitate 
nightmares earlier in the night, including at sleep onset. 

Nightmares usually terminate with awakening and rapid return of full alertness. How- 
ever, the dysphoric emotions may persist into wakefulness and contribute to difficulty re- 
turning to sleep and lasting daytime distress. Some nightmares, known as “bad dreams,” 
may not induce awakening and are recalled only later. If nightmares occur during sleep- 
onset REM periods (hypnagogic), the dysphoric emotion is frequently accompanied by a 
sense of being both awake and unable to move voluntarily (isolated sleep paralysis). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Mild autonomic arousal, including sweating, tachycardia, and tachypnea, may character- 
ize nightmares. Body movements and vocalizations are not characteristic because of REM 
sleep-—related loss of skeletal muscle tone, but such behaviors may occur under situations 
of emotional stress or sleep fragmentation and in posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD). 
When talking or emoting occurs, it is typically a brief event terminating the nightmare. 
Individuals with frequent nightmares are at substantially greater risk for suicidal ide- 
ation and suicide attempts, even when gender and mental illness are taken into account. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence of nightmares increases through childhood into adolescence. From 1.3% to 
3.9% of parents report that their preschool children have nightmares “often” or “always”. 
Prevalence increases from ages 10 to 13 for both males and females but continues to in- 
crease to ages 20-29 for females (while decreasing for males), when it can be twice as high 
for females as for males. Prevalence decreases steadily with age for both sexes, but the gen- 
der difference remains. Among adults, prevalence of nightmares at least monthly is 6%, 
whereas prevalence for frequent nightmares is 1%—2%. Estimates often combine idio- 
pathic and posttraumatic nightmares indiscriminately. 


Development and Course 


Nightmares often begin between ages 3 and 6 years but reach a peak prevalence and se- 
verity in late adolescence or early adulthood. Nightmares most likely appear in children 
exposed to acute or chronic psychosocial stressors and thus may not resolve spontane- 
ously. Ina minority, frequent nightmares persist into adulthood, becoming virtually a life- 
long disturbance. Although specific nightmare content may reflect the individual’s age, 
the essential features of the disorder are the same across age groups. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Individuals who experience nightmares report more frequent past ad- 
verse events, but not necessarily trauma, and often display personality disturbances or 
psychiatric diagnosis. 

Environmental. Sleep deprivation or fragmentation, and irregular sleep-wake schedules 
that alter the timing, intensity, or quantity of REM sleep, can put individuals at risk for 
nightmares. 


Genetic and physiological. Twin studies have identified genetic effects on the disposi- 
tion to nightmares and their co-occurrence with other parasomnias (e.g., sleeptalking). 


Course modifiers. Adaptive parental bedside behaviors, such as soothing the child fol- 
lowing nightmares, may protect against developing chronic nightmares. 


406 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The significance attributed to nightmares may vary by culture, and sensitivity to such be- 
liefs may facilitate disclosure. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Adult females report having nightmares more frequently than do adult males. Nightmare 
content differs by sex, with adult females tending to report themes of sexual harassment or 
of loved ones disappearing /dying, and adult males tending to report themes of physical 
aggression or war/ terror. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Polysomnographic studies demonstrate abrupt awakenings from REM sleep, usually during 
the second half of the night, prior to report of a nightmare. Heart, respiratory, and eye move- 
ment rates may quicken or increase in variability before awakening. Nightmares following 
traumatic events may also arise during non-REM (NREM), particularly stage 2, sleep. The typ- 
ical sleep of individuals with nightmares is mildly impaired (e.g., reduced efficiency, less slow- 
wave sleep, more awakenings), with more frequent periodic leg movements in sleep and rel- 
ative sympathetic nervous system activation after REM sleep deprivation. 


Functional Consequences of Nightmare Disorder 


Nightmares cause more significant subjective distress than demonstrable social or occu- 
pational impairment. However, if awakenings are frequent or result in sleep avoidance, 
individuals may experience excessive daytime sleepiness, poor concentration, depression, 
anxiety, or irritability. Frequent childhood nightmares (e.g., several per week), may cause 
significant distress to parents and child. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Sleep terror disorder. Both nightmare disorder and sleep terror disorder include awak- 
enings or partial awakenings with fearfulness and autonomic activation, but the two dis- 
orders are differentiable. Nightmares typically occur later in the night, during REM sleep, 
and produce vivid, storylike, and clearly recalled dreams; mild autonomic arousal; and 
complete awakenings. Sleep terrors typically arise in the first third of the night during 
stage 3 or 4 NREM sleep and produce either no dream recall or images without an elabo- 
rate storylike quality. The terrors lead to partial awakenings that leave the individual con- 
fused, disoriented, and only partially responsive and with substantial autonomic arousal. 
There is usually amnesia for the event in the morning. 


REM sleep behavior disorder. The presence of complex motor activity during fright- 
ening dreams should prompt further evaluation for REM sleep behavior disorder, which 
occurs more typically among late middle-age males and, unlike nightmare disorder, is as- 
sociated with often violent dream enactments and a history of nocturnal injuries. The 
dream disturbance of REM sleep behavior disorder is described by patients as nightmares 
but is controlled by appropriate medication. 


Bereavement. Dysphoric dreams may occur during bereavement but typically involve 
loss and sadness and are followed by self-reflection and insight, rather than distress, on 
awakening. 


Narcolepsy. Nightmares are a frequent complaint in narcolepsy, but the presence of ex- 
cessive sleepiness and cataplexy differentiates this condition from nightmare disorder. 


Nocturnal seizures. Seizures may rarely manifest as nightmares and should be evalu- 
ated with polysomnography and continuous video electroencephalography. Nocturnal 
seizures usually involve stereotypical motor activity. Associated nightmares, if recalled, 


Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Behavior Disorder 407 


are often repetitive in nature or reflect epileptogenic features such as the content of diurnal 
auras (e.g., unmotivated dread), phosphenes, or ictal imagery. Disorders of arousal, espe- 
cially confusional arousals, may also be present. 


Breathing-related sleep disorders. Breathing-related sleep disorders can lead to awaken- 
ings with autonomic arousal, but these are not usually accompanied by recall of nightmares. 


Panic disorder. Attacks arising during sleep can produce abrupt awakenings with au- 
tonomic arousal and fearfulness, but nightmares are typically not reported and symptoms 
are similar to panic attacks arising during wakefulness. 


Sleep-related dissociative disorders. Individuals may recall actual physical or emo- 
tional trauma as a “dream” during electroencephalography-documented awakenings. 


Medication or substance use. Numerous substances/medications can precipitate night- 
mares, including dopaminergics; beta-adrenergic antagonists and other antihypertensives; 
amphetamine, cocaine, and other stimulants; antidepressants; smoking cessation aids; 
and melatonin. Withdrawal of REM sleep-suppressant medications (e.g., antidepressants) 
and alcohol can produce REM sleep rebound accompanied by nightmares. If nightmares 
are sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention, a diagnosis of substance/ 
medication-induced sleep disorder should be considered. 


Comorbidity 


Nightmares may be comorbid with several medical conditions, including coronary heart 
disease, cancer, parkinsonism, and pain, and can accompany medical treatments, such as he- 
modialysis, or withdrawal from medications or substances of abuse. Nightmares frequently 
are comorbid with other mental disorders, including PTSD; insomnia disorder; schizophrenia; 
psychosis; mood, anxiety, adjustment, and personality disorders; and grief during be- 
reavement. A concurrent nightmare disorder diagnosis should only be considered when in- 
dependent clinical attention is warranted (i.e., Criteria A-C are met). Otherwise, no separate 
diagnosis is necessary. These conditions should be listed under the appropriate comorbid 
category specifier. However, nightmare disorder may be diagnosed as a separate disorder in 
individuals with PTSD if the nightmares are temporally unrelated to PTSD (i.e., preceding 
other PTSD symptoms or persisting after other PTSD symptoms have resolved). 

Nightmares are normally characteristic of REM sleep behavior disorder, PTSD, and acute 
stress disorder, but nightmare disorder may be independently coded if nightmares preceded 
the condition and their frequency or severity necessitates independent clinical attention. The 
latter may be determined by asking whether nightmares were a problem before onset of the 
other disorder and whether they continued after other symptoms had remitted. 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 


The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2), presents similar di- 
agnostic criteria for nightmare disorder. 


Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Behavior Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 327.42 (G47.52) 


A. Repeated episodes of arousal during sleep associated with vocalization and/or com- 
plex motor behaviors. 

B. These behaviors arise during rapid eye movement (REM) sleep and therefore usually 
occur more than 90 minutes after sleep onset, are more frequent during the later por- 
tions of the sleep period, and uncommonly occur during daytime naps. 


408 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


C. Upon awakening from these episodes, the individual is completely awake, alert, and 
not confused or disoriented. 
D. Either of the following: 


1. REM sleep without atonia on polysomnographic recording. 
2. Ahistory suggestive of REM sleep behavior disorder and an established synuclein- 
opathy diagnosis (e.g., Parkinson’s disease, multiple system atrophy). 


E. The behaviors cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning (which may include injury to self or the 
bed partner). 

F. The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a 
drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition. 

G. Coexisting mental and medical disorders do not explain the episodes. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of rapid eye movement (REM) sleep behavior disorder is repeated 
episodes of arousal, often associated with vocalizations and/or complex motor behaviors 
arising from REM sleep (Criterion A). These behaviors often reflect motor responses to the 
content of action-filled or violent dreams of being attacked or trying to escape from a 
threatening situation, which may be termed dream enacting behaviors. The vocalizations are 
often loud, emotion-filled, and profane. These behaviors may be very bothersome to the 
individual and the bed partner and may result in significant injury (e.g., falling, jumping, 
or flying out of bed; running, punching, thrusting, hitting, or kicking). Upon awakening, 
the individual is immediately awake, alert, and oriented (Criterion C) and is often able to 
recall dream mentation, which closely correlates with the observed behavior. The eyes 
typically remain closed during these events. The diagnosis of REM sleep behavior disor- 
der requires clinically significant distress or impairment (Criterion E); this determination 
will depend on a number of factors, including the frequency of events, the potential for vi- 
olence or injurious behaviors, embarrassment, and distress in other household members. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Severity determination is best made based on the nature or consequence of the behavior 
rather than simply on frequency. Although the behaviors are typically prominent and vi- 
olent, lesser behaviors may also occur. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of REM sleep behavior disorder is approximately 0.38%-0.5% in the gen- 
eral population. Prevalence in patients with psychiatric disorders may be greater, possibly 
related to medications prescribed for the psychiatric disorder. 


Development and Course 


The onset of REM sleep behavior disorder may be gradual or rapid, and the course is usu- 
ally progressive. REM sleep behavior disorder associated with neurodegenerative disor- 
ders may improve as the underlying neurodegenerative disorder progresses. Because of 
the very high association with the later appearance of an underlying neurodegenerative 
disorder, most notably one of the synucleinopathies (Parkinson’s disease, multiple system 
atrophy, or major or mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies), the neurological 
status of individuals with REM sleep behavior disorder should be closely monitored. 
REM sleep behavior disorder overwhelmingly affects males older than 50 years, but in- 
creasingly this disorder is being identified in females and in younger individuals. Symp- 


Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Behavior Disorder 409 


toms in young individuals, particularly young females, should raise the possibility of 
narcolepsy or medication-induced REM sleep behavior disorder. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Many widely prescribed medications, including tricyclic 
antidepressants, selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors, serotonin-norepinephrine reup- 
take inhibitors, and beta-blockers, may result in polysomnographic evidence of REM sleep 
without atonia and in frank REM sleep behavior disorder. It is not known whether the 
medications per se result in REM sleep behavior disorder or they unmask an underlying 
predisposition. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Associated laboratory findings from polysomnography indicate increased tonic and/or 
phasic electromyographic activity during REM sleep that is normally associated with mus- 
cle atonia. The increased muscle activity variably affects different muscle groups, mandating 
more extensive electromyographic monitoring than is employed in conventional sleep stud- 
ies. For this reason, it is suggested that electromyographic monitoring include the submen- 
talis, bilateral extensor digitorum, and bilateral anterior tibialis muscle groups. Continuous 
video monitoring is mandatory. Other polysomnographic findings may include very fre- 
quent periodic and aperiodic extremity electromyography activity during non-REM 
(NREM) sleep. This polysomnography observation, termed REM sleep without atonia, is pres- 
ent in virtually all cases of REM sleep behavior disorder but may also be an asymptomatic 
polysomnographic finding. Clinical dream-enacting behaviors coupled with the polysom- 
nographic finding of REM without atonia is necessary for the diagnosis of REM sleep behav- 
ior disorder. REM sleep without atonia without a clinical history of dream-enacting 
behaviors is simply an asymptomatic polysomnographic observation. It is not known 
whether isolated REM sleep without atonia is a precursor to REM sleep behavior disorder. 


Functional Consequences of 
Rapid Eye Movement Sleep Behavior Disorder 


REM sleep behavior disorder may occur in isolated occasions in otherwise unaffected in- 
dividuals. Embarrassment concerning the episodes can impair social relationships. Indi- 
viduals may avoid situations in which others might become aware of the disturbance, 
visiting friends overnight, or sleeping with bed partners. Social isolation or occupational 
difficulties can result. Uncommonly, REM sleep behavior disorder may result in serious 
injury to the victim or to the bed partner. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other parasomnias. Confusional arousals, sleepwalking, and sleep terrors can easily be 
confused with REM sleep behavior disorder. In general, these disorders occur in younger 
individuals. Unlike REM sleep behavior disorder, they arise from deep NREM sleep and 
therefore tend to occur in the early portion of the sleep period. Awakening from a confu- 
sional arousal is associated with confusion, disorientation, and incomplete recall of dream 
mentation accompanying the behavior. Polysomnographic monitoring in the disorders of 
arousal reveals normal REM atonia. 


Nocturnal seizures. Nocturnal seizures may perfectly mimic REM sleep behavior disor- 
der, but the behaviors are generally more stereotyped. Polysomnographic monitoring em- 
ploying a full electroencephalographic seizure montage may differentiate the two. REM 
sleep without atonia is not present on polysomnographic monitoring. 


410 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Obstructive sleep apnea. Obstructive sleep apnea may result in behaviors indistin- 
guishable from REM sleep behavior disorder. Polysomnographic monitoring is necessary 
to differentiate between the two. In this case, the symptoms resolve following effective 
treatment of the obstructive sleep apnea, and REM sleep without atonia is not present on 
polysomnography monitoring. 

Other specified dissociative disorder (sleep-related psychogenic dissociative disorder). 
Unlike virtually all other parasomnias, which arise precipitously from NREM or REM 
sleep, psychogenic dissociative behaviors arise from a period of well-defined wakefulness 
during the sleep period. Unlike REM sleep behavior disorder, this condition is more prev- 
alent in young females. 


Malingering. Many cases of malingering in which the individual reports problematic 
sleep movements perfectly mimic the clinical features of REM sleep behavior disorder, 
and polysomnographic documentation is mandatory. 


Comorbidity 


REM sleep behavior disorder is present concurrently in approximately 30% of patients 
with narcolepsy. When it occurs in narcolepsy, the demographics reflect the younger age 
range of narcolepsy, with equal frequency in males and females. Based on findings from 
individuals presenting to sleep clinics, most individuals (>50%) with initially “idiopathic” 
REM sleep behavior disorder will eventually develop a neurodegenerative disease—most 
notably, one of the synucleinopathies (Parkinson’s disease, multiple system atrophy, or 
major or mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies). REM sleep behavior disorder 
often predates any other sign of these disorders by many years (often more than a decade). 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 


REM sleep behavior disorder is virtually identical to REM sleep behavior disorder in the 
International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2). 


Restless Legs Syndrome 
Diagnostic Criteria 333.94 (G25.81) 


A. Anurge to move the legs, usually accompanied by or in response to uncomfortable and 
unpleasant sensations in the legs, characterized by all of the following: 


1. The urge to move the legs begins or worsens during periods of rest or inactivity. 

2. The urge to move the legs is partially or totally relieved by movement. 

3. The urge to move the legs is worse in the evening or at night than during the day, 
or occurs only in the evening or at night. 


B. The symptoms in Criterion A occur at least three times per week and have persisted 
for at least 3 months. 

C. The symptoms in Criterion A are accompanied by significant distress or impairment in 
social, occupational, educational, academic, behavioral, or other important areas of 
functioning. 

D. The symptoms in Criterion A are not attributable to another mental disorder or medical 
condition (e.g., arthritis, leg edema, peripheral ischemia, leg cramps) and are not better 
explained by a behavioral condition (e.g., positional discomfort, habitual foot tapping). 

E. The symptoms are not attributable to the physiological effects of a drug of abuse or 
medication (e.g., akathisia). 


Restless Legs Syndrome 411 


Diagnostic Features 


Restless legs syndrome (RLS) is a sensorimotor, neurological sleep disorder characterized 
by a desire to move the legs or arms, usually associated with uncomfortable sensations 
typically described as creeping, crawling, tingling, burning, or itching (Criterion A). The 
diagnosis of RLS is based primarily on patient self-report and history. Symptoms are 
worse when the individual is at rest, and frequent movements of the legs occur in an effort 
to relieve the uncomfortable sensations. Symptoms are worse in the evening or night, and 
in some individuals they occur only in the evening or night. Evening worsening occurs in- 
dependently of any differences in activity. It is important to differentiate RLS from other 
conditions such as positional discomfort and leg cramps (Criterion D). 

The symptoms of RLS can delay sleep onset and awaken the individual from sleep and 
are associated with significant sleep fragmentation. The relief obtained from moving the 
legs may no longer be apparent in severe cases. RLS is associated with daytime sleepiness 
and is frequently accompanied by significant clinical distress or functional impairment. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Periodic leg movements in sleep (PLMS) can serve as corroborating evidence for RLS, with 
up to 90% of individuals diagnosed with RLS demonstrating PLMS when recordings are 
taken over multiple nights. Periodic leg movements during wakefulness are supportive of 
an RLS diagnosis. Reports of difficulty initiating and maintaining sleep and of excessive 
daytime sleepiness may also support the diagnosis of RLS. Additional supportive features 
include a family history of RLS among first-degree relatives and a reduction in symptoms, 
at least initially, with dopaminergic treatment. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence rates of RLS vary widely when broad criteria are utilized but range from 2% to 
7.2% when more defined criteria are employed. When frequency of symptoms is at least 
three times per week with moderate or severe distress, the prevalence rate is 1.6%; when 
frequency of symptoms is a minimum of one time per week, the prevalence rate is 4.5%. 
Females are 1.5-2 times more likely than males to have RLS. RLS also increases with age. 
The prevalence of RLS may be lower in Asian populations. 


Development and Course 


The onset of RLS typically occurs in the second or third decade. Approximately 40% of in- 
dividuals diagnosed with RLS during adulthood report having experienced symptoms 
before age 20 years, and 20% report having experienced symptoms before age 10 years. 
Prevalence rates of RLS increase steadily with age until about age 60 years, with symptoms 
remaining stable or decreasing slightly in older age groups. Compared with nonfamilial 
cases, familial RLS usually has a younger age at onset and a slower progressive course. The 
clinical course of RLS differs by age at onset. When onset occurs before age 45, there is of- 
ten a slow progression of symptoms. In late-onset RLS, rapid progression is typical, and 
aggravating factors are common. Symptoms of RLS appear similar across the lifespan, re- 
maining stable or decreasing slightly in older age groups. 

Diagnosis of RLS in children can be difficult because of the self-report component. 
While Criterion A for adults assumes that the description of “urge to move” is by the pa- 
tient, pediatric diagnosis requires a description in the child’s own words rather than by a 
parent or caretaker. Typically children age 6 years or older are able to provide detailed, ad- 
equate descriptors of RLS. However, children rarely use or understand the word “urge,” 
reporting instead that their legs “have to” or “got to” move. Also, potentially related to 
prolonged periods of sitting during class, two-thirds of children and adolescents report 
daytime leg sensations. Thus, for diagnostic Criterion A3, it is important to compare equal 


412 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


duration of sitting or lying down in the day to sitting or lying down in the evening or night. 
Nocturnal worsening tends to persist even in the context of pediatric RLS. As with RLS in 
adults, there is a significant negative impact on sleep, mood, cognition, and function. Im- 
pairment in children and adolescents is manifested more often in behavioral and educa- 
tional domains. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Predisposing factors include female gender, advancing 
age, genetic risk variants, and family history of RLS. Precipitating factors are often time- 
limited, such as iron deficiency, with most individuals resuming normal sleep patterns 
after the initial triggering event has disappeared. Genetic risk variants also play a role in 
RLS secondary to such disorders as uremia, suggesting that individuals with a genetic sus- 
ceptibility develop RLS in the presence of further risk factors. RLS has a strong familial 
component. 

There are defined pathophysiological pathways subserving RLS. Genome-wide asso- 
ciation studies have found that RLS is significantly associated with common genetic vari- 
ants in intronic or intergenic regions in MEIS1, BTBD9, and MAP2K5 on chromosomes 2p, 
6p, and 15q, respectively. The association of these three variants with RLS has been inde- 
pendently replicated. BTBD9 confers a very large (80%) excessive risk when even a single 
allele is present. Because of the high frequency of this variant in individuals of European 
descent, the population attributable risk (PAR) approximates 50%. At-risk alleles associ- 
ated with MEIS1 and BTBD9 are less common in individuals of African or Asian descent, 
perhaps suggesting lower risk for RLS in these populations. 

Pathophysiological mechanisms in RLS also include disturbances in the central dopa- 
minergic system and disturbances in iron metabolism. The endogenous opiate system 
may also be involved. Treatment effects of dopaminergic drugs (primarily D and D3 non- 
ergot agonists) provide further support that RLS is grounded in dysfunctional central 
dopaminergic pathways. While the effective treatment of RLS has also been shown to sig- 
nificantly reduce depressive symptoms, serotonergic antidepressants can induce or aggra- 
vate RLS in some individuals. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Although RLS is more prevalent in females than in males, there are no diagnostic differ- 
ences according to gender. However, the prevalence of RLS during pregnancy is two to 
three times greater than in the general population. RLS associated with pregnancy peaks 
during the third trimester and improves or resolves in most cases soon after delivery. The 
gender difference in prevalence of RLS is explained at least in part by parity, with nullipa- 
rous females being at the same risk of RLS as age-matched males. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Polysomnography demonstrates significant abnormalities in RLS, commonly increased 
latency to sleep, and higher arousal index. Polysomnography with a preceding immobili- 
zation test may provide an indicator of the motor sign of RLS, periodic limb movements, 
under standard conditions of sleep and during quiet resting, both of which can provoke RLS 
symptoms. 


Functional Consequences of Restless Legs Syndrome 


Forms of RLS severe enough to significantly impair functioning or associated with mental dis- 

orders, including depression and anxiety, occur in approximately 2%-3% of the population. 
Although the impact of milder symptoms is less well characterized, individuals with 

RLS complain of disruption in at least one activity of daily living, with up to 50% reporting 


Substance/Medication-Induced Sleep Disorder 413 


a negative impact on mood, and 47.6% reporting a lack of energy. The most common conse- 
quences of RLS are sleep disturbance, including reduced sleep time, sleep fragmentation, 
and overall disturbance; depression, generalized anxiety disorder, panic disorder, and post- 
traumatic stress disorder; and quality-of-life impairments. RLS can result in daytime sleep- 
iness or fatigue and is frequently accompanied by significant distress or impairment in 
affective, social, occupational, educational, academic, behavioral, or cognitive functioning. 


Differential Diagnosis 


The most important conditions in the differential diagnosis of RLS are leg cramps, posi- 
tional discomfort, arthralgias/arthritis, myalgias, positional ischemia (numbness), leg 
edema, peripheral neuropathy, radiculopathy, and habitual foot tapping. “Knotting” of 
the muscle (cramps), relief with a single postural shift, limitation to joints, soreness to pal- 
pation (myalgias), and other abnormalities on physical examination are not characteristic 
of RLS. Unlike RLS, nocturnal leg cramps do not typically present with the desire to move 
the limbs nor are there frequent limb movements. Less common conditions to be differen- 
tiated from RLS include neuroleptic-induced akathisia, myelopathy, symptomatic venous 
insufficiency, peripheral artery disease, eczema, other orthopedic problems, and anxiety- 
induced restlessness. Worsening at night and periodic limb movements are more common 
in RLS than in medication-induced akathisia or peripheral neuropathy. 

While is it important that RLS symptoms not be solely accounted for by another medical 
or behavioral condition, it should also be appreciated that any of these similar conditions can 
occur in an individual with RLS. This necessitates a separate focus on each possible condi- 
tion in the diagnostic process and when assessing impact. For cases in which the diagnosis of 
RLS is not certain, evaluation for the supportive features of RLS, particularly PLMS or a fam- 
ily history of RLS, may be helpful. Clinical features, such as response to a dopaminergic 
agent and positive family history for RLS, can help with the differential diagnosis. 


Comorbidity 

Depressive disorders, anxiety disorders, and attentional disorders are commonly comor- 
bid with RLS and are discussed in the section “Functional Consequences of Restless Legs 
Syndrome.” The main medical disorder comorbid with RLS is cardiovascular disease. 
There may be an association with numerous other medical disorders, including hyperten- 
sion, narcolepsy, migraine, Parkinson’s disease, multiple sclerosis, peripheral neuropathy, 
obstructive sleep apnea, diabetes mellitus, fibromyalgia, osteoporosis, obesity, thyroid 
disease, and cancer. Iron deficiency, pregnancy, and chronic renal failure are also comor- 
bid with RLS. 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 


The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2), presents similar diag- 
nostic criteria for RLS but does not contain a criterion specifying frequency or duration of 
symptoms. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Sleep Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A prominent and severe disturbance in sleep. 
B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of both 
(1) and (2): 


414 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


1. The symptoms in Criterion A developed during or soon after substance intoxication 
or after withdrawal from or exposure to a medication. 

2. The involved substance/medication is capable of producing the symptoms in Crite- 
rion A. 


C. The disturbance is not better explained by a sleep disorder that is not substance/ 
medication-induced. Such evidence of an independent sleep disorder could include 
the following: 


The symptoms precede the onset of the substance/medication use; the symptoms 
persist for a substantial period of time (e.g., about 1 month) after the cessation of 
acute withdrawal or severe intoxication; or there is other evidence suggesting the 
existence of an independent non-substance/medication-induced sleep disorder 
(e.g., a history of recurrent non-substance/medication-related episodes). 


D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


Note: This diagnosis should be made instead of a diagnosis of substance intoxication or 
substance withdrawal only when the symptoms in Criterion A predominate in the clinical 
picture and when they are sufficiently severe to warrant clinical attention. 
Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance/medica- 
tion]-induced sleep disorders are indicated in the table below. Note that the ICD-10-CM 
code depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance use disorder present for 
the same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is comorbid with the sub- 
stance-induced sleep disorder, the 4th position character is “1,” and the clinician should 
record “mild [substance] use disorder” before the substance-induced sleep disorder (e.g., 
“mild cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced sleep disorder’). If a moderate or severe 
substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance-induced sleep disorder, the 4th po- 
sition character is “2,” and the clinician should record “moderate [substance] use disorder” 
or “severe [substance] use disorder,” depending on the severity of the comorbid substance 
use disorder. If there is no comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one-time heavy 
use of the substance), then the 4th position character is “9,” and the clinician should record 
only the substance-induced sleep disorder. A moderate or severe tobacco use disorder is 
required in order to code a tobacco-induced sleep disorder; it is not permissible to code a 
comorbid mild tobacco use disorder or no tobacco use disorder with a tobacco-induced 
sleep disorder. 
Specify whether: 
Insomnia type: Characterized by difficulty falling asleep or maintaining sleep, frequent 
nocturnal awakenings, or nonrestorative sleep. 
Daytime sleepiness type: Characterized by predominant complaint of excessive 
sleepiness/fatigue during waking hours or, less commonly, a long sleep period. 
Parasomnia type: Characterized by abnormal behavioral events during sleep. 
Mixed type: Characterized by a substance/medication-induced sleep problem charac- 
terized by multiple types of sleep symptoms, but no symptom clearly predominates. 
Specify if (see Table 1 in the chapter “Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders” for di- 
agnoses associated with substance class): 
With onset during intoxication: This specifier should be used if criteria are met for 
intoxication with the substance/medication and symptoms developed during the intox- 
ication period. 
With onset during discontinuation/withdrawal: This specifier should be used if cri- 
teria are met for discontinuation/withdrawal from the substance/medication and symp- 
toms developed during, or shortly after, discontinuation of the substance/medication. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Sleep Disorder 415 


ICD-10-CM 
With use 
With use disorder, Without 
disorder, moderate use 
ICD-9-CM mild or severe disorder 
Alcohol 291.82 F10.182 F10.282 F10.982 
Caffeine 292.85 F15.182 F15.282 F15.982 
Cannabis 292.85 F12.188 F12.288 F12.988 
Opioid 292.85 F11.182 F11.282 F11.982 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 292.85 F13.182 F13.282 F13.982 
Amphetamine (or other 292.85 F15.182 F15.282 F15.982 
stimulant) 
Cocaine 292.85 F14.182 F14.282 F14.982 
Tobacco 292.85 NA F17.208 NA 


Other (or unknown) substance 292.85 F19.182 F19.282 F19.982 


Recording Procedures 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced sleep disorder begins with 
the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, bupropion) that is presumed to be causing the sleep 
disturbance. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria set, 
which is based on the drug class. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., 
bupropion), the code for “other substance” should be used; and in cases in which a sub- 
stance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance is unknown, 
the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder is followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during in- 
toxication, onset during discontinuation/withdrawal), followed by the subtype designa- 
tion (i.e., insomnia type, daytime sleepiness type, parasomnia type, mixed type). Unlike 
the recording procedures for ICD-10-CM, which combine the substance-induced disorder 
and substance use disorder into a single code, for ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code 
is given for the substance use disorder. For example, in the case of insomnia occurring 
during withdrawal in a man with a severe lorazepam use disorder, the diagnosis is 292.85 
lorazepam-induced sleep disorder, with onset during withdrawal, insomnia type. An ad- 
ditional diagnosis of 304.10 severe lorazepam use disorder is also given. When more than 
one substance is judged to play a significant role in the development of the sleep distur- 
bance, each should be listed separately (e.g., 292.85 alcohol-induced sleep disorder, with 
onset during intoxication, insomnia type; 292.85 cocaine-induced sleep disorder, with on- 
set during intoxication, insomnia type). 


ICD-10-CM. Thename of the substance/medication-induced sleep disorder begins with the 
specific substance (e.g., cocaine, bupropion) that is presumed to be causing the sleep distur- 
bance. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria set, which is based 
on the drug class and presence or absence of a comorbid substance use disorder. For sub- 
stances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., bupropion), the code for “other substance” 
should be used; and in cases in which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the 
specific class of substance is unknown, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 
When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) 
is listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the substance-induced 
sleep disorder, followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during intoxication, onset 


416 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


during discontinuation / withdrawal), followed by the subtype designation (i.e., insomnia 
type, daytime sleepiness type, parasomnia type, mixed type). For example, in the case of 
insomnia occurring during withdrawal in a man witha severe lorazepam use disorder, the 
diagnosis is F13.282 severe lorazepam use disorder with lorazepam-induced sleep disor- 
der, with onset during withdrawal, insomnia type. A separate diagnosis of the comorbid 
severe lorazepam use disorder is not given. If the substance-induced sleep disorder occurs 
without a comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., with medication use), no accompanying 
substance use disorder is noted (e.g., F19.982 bupropion-induced sleep disorder, with on- 
set during medication use, insomnia type). When more than one substance is judged to 
play a significant role in the development of the sleep disturbance, each should be listed 
separately (e.g., F10.282 severe alcohol use disorder with alcohol-induced sleep disorder, 
with onset during intoxication, insomnia type; F14.282 severe cocaine use disorder with 
cocaine-induced sleep disorder, with onset during intoxication, insomnia type). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of substance/medication-induced sleep disorder is a prominent sleep 
disturbance that is sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention (Criterion A) 
and that is judged to be primarily associated with the pharmacological effects of a substance 
(i.e., a drug of abuse, a medication, toxin exposure) (Criterion B). Depending on the sub- 
stance involved, one of four types of sleep disturbances is reported. Insomnia type and day- 
time sleepiness type are most common, while parasomnia type is seen less often. The mixed 
type is noted when more than one type of sleep disturbance-related symptom is present and 
none predominates. The disturbance must not be better explained by another sleep disorder 
(Criterion C). A substance /medication-induced sleep disorder is distinguished from insom- 
nia disorder or a disorder associated with excessive daytime sleepiness by considering onset 
and course. For drugs of abuse, there must be evidence of intoxication or withdrawal from 
the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings. Substance /medication-induced 
sleep disorder arises only in association with intoxication or discontinuation /withdrawal 
states, whereas other sleep disorders may precede the onset of substance use or occur during 
times of sustained abstinence. As discontinuation/withdrawal states for some substances 
can be protracted, onset of the sleep disturbance can occur 4 weeks after cessation of sub- 
stance use, and the disturbance may have features atypical of other sleep disorders (e.g., 
atypical age at onset or course). The diagnosis is not made if the sleep disturbance occurs 
only during a delirium (Criterion D). The symptoms must cause clinically significant dis- 
tress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning (Crite- 
rion E). This diagnosis should be made instead of a diagnosis of substance intoxication or 
substance withdrawal only when the symptoms in Criterion A predominate in the clinical 
picture and when the symptoms warrant independent clinical attention. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


During periods of substance /medication use, intoxication, or withdrawal, individuals fre- 
quently complain of dysphoric mood, including depression and anxiety, irritability, cog- 
nitive impairment, inability to concentrate, and fatigue. 

Prominent and severe sleep disturbances can occur in association with intoxication 
with the following classes of substances: alcohol; caffeine; cannabis; opioids; sedatives, 
hypnotics, or anxiolytics; stimulants (including cocaine); and other (or unknown) sub- 
stances. Prominent and severe sleep disturbances can occur in association with withdrawal 
from the following classes of substances: alcohol; caffeine; cannabis; opioids; sedatives, 
hypnotics, or anxiolytics; stimulant (including cocaine); tobacco; and other (or unknown) 
substances. Some medications that invoke sleep disturbances include adrenergic agonists 
and antagonists, dopamine agonists and antagonists, cholinergic agonists and antagonists, 
serotonergic agonists and antagonists, antihistamines, and corticosteroids. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Sleep Disorder 417 


Alcohol. Alcohol-induced sleep disorder typically occurs as insomnia type. During 
acute intoxication, alcohol produces an immediate sedative effect depending on dose, ac- 
companied by increased stages 3 and 4 non—-rapid eye movement (NREM) sleep and re- 
duced rapid eye movement (REM) sleep. Following these initial effects, there may be 
increased wakefulness, restless sleep, and vivid and anxiety-laden dreams for the remain- 
ing sleep period. In parallel, stages 3 and 4 sleep are reduced, and wakefulness and REM 
sleep are increased. Alcohol can aggravate breathing-related sleep disorder. With habitual 
use, alcohol continues to show a short-lived sedative effect in the first half of the night, fol- 
lowed by sleep continuity disruption in the second half. During alcohol withdrawal, there 
is extremely disrupted sleep continuity, and an increased amount and intensity of REM 
sleep, associated frequently with vivid dreaming, which in extreme form, constitutes part 
of alcohol withdrawal delirium. After acute withdrawal, chronic alcohol users may con- 
tinue to complain of light, fragmented sleep for weeks to years associated with a persistent 
deficit in slow-wave sleep. 


Caffeine. Caffeine-induced sleep disorder produces insomnia in a dose-dependent man- 
ner, with some individuals presenting with daytime sleepiness related to withdrawal. 


Cannabis. Acute administration of cannabis may shorten sleep latency, though arous- 
ing effects with increments in sleep latency also occur. Cannabis enhances slow-wave 
sleep and suppresses REM sleep after acute administration. In chronic users, tolerance to 
the sleep-inducing and slow-wave sleep-enhancing effects develops. Upon withdrawal, 
sleep difficulties and unpleasant dreams have been reported lasting for several weeks. 
Polysomnography studies demonstrate reduced slow-wave sleep and increased REM sleep 
during this phase. 


Opioids. Opioids may produce an increase in sleepiness and in subjective depth of sleep, 
and reduced REM sleep, during acute short-term use. With continued administration, tol- 
erance to the sedative effects of opioids develops and there are complaints of insomnia. 
Consistent with their respiratory depressant effects, opioids exacerbate sleep apnea. 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic substances. Sedatives, hypnotics, and anxiolytics (e.g., 
barbiturates, benzodiazepines receptor agonists, meprobamate, glutethimide, methypry- 
lon) have similar effects as opioids on sleep. During acute intoxication, sedative-hypnotic 
drugs produce the expected increase in sleepiness and decrease in wakefulness. Chronic 
use (particularly of barbiturates and the older nonbarbiturate, nonbenzodiazepine drugs) 
may cause tolerance with subsequent return of insomnia. Daytime sleepiness may occur. 
Sedative-hypnotic drugs can increase the frequency and severity of obstructive sleep ap- 
nea events. Parasomnias are associated with use of benzodiazepine receptor agonists, es- 
pecially when these medications are taken at higher doses and when they are combined 
with other sedative drugs. Abrupt discontinuation of chronic sedative, hypnotic, or anx- 
iolytic use can lead to withdrawal but more commonly rebound insomnia, a condition of 
an exacerbation of insomnia upon drug discontinuation for 1-2 days reported to occur 
even with short-term use. Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic drugs with short durations of 
action are most likely to produce complaints of rebound insomnia, whereas those with 
longer durations of action are more often associated with daytime sleepiness. Any sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic drug can potentially cause daytime sedation, withdrawal, or re- 
bound insomnia. 


Amphetamines and related substances and other stimulants. Sleep disorders induced 
by amphetamine and related substances and other stimulants are characterized by insomnia 
during intoxication and excessive sleepiness during withdrawal. During acute intoxication, 
stimulants reduce the total amount of sleep, increase sleep latency and sleep continuity distur- 
bances, and decrease REM sleep. Slow-wave sleep tends to be reduced. During withdrawal 
from chronic stimulant use, there is both prolonged nocturnal sleep duration and excessive 
daytime sleepiness. Multiple sleep latency tests may show increased daytime sleepiness dur- 


418 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


ing the withdrawal phase. Drugs like 3,4-methylenedioxymethamphetamine (MDMA; “ec- 
stasy”) and related substances lead to restless and disturbed sleep within 48 hours of intake; 
frequent use of these compounds is associated with persisting symptoms of anxiety, depres- 
sion, and sleep disturbances, even during longer-term abstinence. 


Tobacco. Chronic tobacco consumption is associated primarily with symptoms of insom- 
nia, decreased slow-wave sleep with a reduction of sleep efficiency, and increased daytime 
sleepiness. Withdrawal from tobacco can lead to impaired sleep. Individuals who smoke 
heavily may experience regular nocturnal awakenings caused by tobacco craving. 


Other or unknown substances/medications. Other substances /medications may pro- 
duce sleep disturbances, particularly medications that affect the central or autonomic 
nervous systems (e.g., adrenergic agonists and antagonists, dopamine agonists and antag- 
onists, cholinergic agonists and antagonists, serotonergic agonists and antagonists, anti- 
histamines, corticosteroids). 


Development and Course 


Insomnia in children can be identified by either a parent or the child. Often the child has a 
clear sleep disturbance associated with initiation of a medication but may not report 
symptoms, although parents observe the sleep disturbances. The use of some illicit sub- 
stances (e.g., cannabis, ecstasy) is prevalent in adolescence and early adulthood. Insomnia 
or any other sleep disturbance encountered in this age group should prompt careful con- 
sideration of whether the sleep disturbance is due to consumption of these substances. 
Help-seeking behavior for the sleep disturbance in these age groups is limited, and thus 
corroborative report may be elicited from a parent, caregiver, or teacher. Older individuals 
take more medications and are at increased risk for developing a substance/medication- 
induced sleep disorder. They may interpret sleep disturbance as part of normal aging and 
fail to report symptoms. Individuals with major neurocognitive disorder (e.g., dementia) 
are at risk for substance /medication-induced sleep disorders but may not report symp- 
toms, making corroborative report from caregiver(s) particularly important. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Risk and prognostic factors involved in substance abuse/dependence or medication use 
are normative for certain age groups. They are relevant for, and likely applicable to, the 
type of sleep disturbance encountered (see the chapter “Substance-Related and Addictive 
Disorders” for descriptions of respective substance use disorders). 


Temperamental. Substance use generally precipitates or accompanies insomnia in vul- 
nerable individuals. Thus, presence of insomnia in response to stress or change in sleep en- 
vironment or timing can represent a risk for developing substance/medication-induced 
sleep disorder. A similar risk may be present for individuals with other sleep disorders 
(e.g., individuals with hypersomnia who use stimulants). 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The consumption of substances, including prescribed medications, may depend in part on 
cultural background and specific local drug regulations. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Gender-specific prevalences (i.e., females affected more than males at a ratio of about 2:1) exist 
for patterns of consumption of some substances (e.g., alcohol). The same amount and duration 
of consumption of a given substance may lead to highly different sleep-related outcomes in 
males and females based on, for example, gender-specific differences in hepatic functioning. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Sleep Disorder 419 


Diagnostic Markers 


Each of the substance/medication-induced sleep disorders produces electroencephalo- 
graphic sleep patterns that are associated with, but cannot be considered diagnostic of, other 
disorders. The electroencephalographic sleep profile for each substance is related to the 
stage of use, whether intake /intoxication, chronic use, or withdrawal following discontinu- 
ation of the substance. All-night polysomnography can help define the severity of insomnia 
complaints, while the multiple sleep latency test provides information about the severity of 
daytime sleepiness. Monitoring of nocturnal respiration and periodic limb movements with 
polysomnography may verify a substance’s impact on nocturnal breathing and motor be- 
havior. Sleep diaries for 2 weeks and actigraphy are considered helpful in confirming the 
presence of substance /medication-induced sleep disorder. Drug screening can be of use 
when the individual is not aware or unwilling to relate information about substance intake. 


Functional Consequences of 
Substance/Medication-Induced Sleep Disorder 


While there are many functional consequences associated with sleep disorders, the only 
unique consequence for substance /medication-induced sleep disorder is increased risk 
for relapse. The degree of sleep disturbance during alcohol withdrawal (e.g., REM sleep 
rebound predicts risk of relapse of drinking). Monitoring of sleep quality and daytime 
sleepiness during and after withdrawal may provide clinically meaningful information on 
whether an individual is at increased risk for relapse. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Substance intoxication or substance withdrawal. Sleep disturbances are commonly en- 
countered in the context of substance intoxication or substance discontinuation /with- 
drawal. A diagnosis of substance/medication-induced sleep disorder should be made 
instead of a diagnosis of substance intoxication or substance withdrawal only when the 
sleep disturbance is predominant in the clinical picture and is sufficiently severe to war- 
rant independent clinical attention. 


Delirium. If the substance/medication-induced sleep disturbance occurs exclusively dur- 
ing the course of a delirium, it is not diagnosed separately. 


Other sleep disorders. A substance/medication-induced sleep disorder is distinguished 
from another sleep disorder if a substance /medication is judged to be etiologically related to 
the symptoms. A substance/medication-induced sleep disorder attributed to a prescribed 
medication for a mental disorder or medical condition must have its onset while the individual 
is receiving the medication or during discontinuation, if there is a discontinuation/with- 
drawal syndrome associated with the medication. Once treatment is discontinued, the sleep 
disturbance will usually remit within days to several weeks. If symptoms persist beyond 
4 weeks, other causes for the sleep disturbance-related symptoms should be considered. Not 
infrequently, individuals with another sleep disorder use medications or drugs of abuse to 
self-medicate their symptoms (e.g., alcohol for management of insomnia). If the substance / 
medication is judged to play a significant role in the exacerbation of the sleep disturbance, an 
additional diagnosis of a substance /medication-induced sleep disorder may be warranted. 


Sleep disorder due to another medical condition. Substance/medication-induced sleep 
disorder and sleep disorder associated with another medical condition may produce sim- 
ilar symptoms of insomnia, daytime sleepiness, or a parasomnia. Many individuals with 
other medical conditions that cause sleep disturbance are treated with medications that 
may also cause sleep disturbances. The chronology of symptoms is the most important fac- 
tor in distinguishing between these two sources of sleep symptoms. Difficulties with sleep 
that clearly preceded the use of any medication for treatment of a medical condition would 


420 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


suggest a diagnosis of sleep disorder associated with another medical condition. Con- 
versely, sleep symptoms that appear only after the initiation of a particular medication/ 
substance suggest a substance/medication-induced sleep disorder. If the disturbance is 
comorbid with another medical condition and is also exacerbated by substance use, both 
diagnoses (i.e., sleep disorder associated with another medical condition and substance/ 
medication-induced sleep disorder) are given. When there is insufficient evidence to de- 
termine whether the sleep disturbance is attributable to a substance /medication or to an- 
other medical condition or is primary (i.e., not due to either a substance/medication or 
another medical condition), a diagnosis of other specified sleep-wake disorder or unspec- 
ified sleep-wake disorder is indicated. 


Comorbidity 


See the “Comorbidity” sections for other sleep disorders in this chapter, including insom- 
nia, hypersomnolence, central sleep apnea, sleep-related hypoventilation, and circadian 
rhythm sleep-wake disorders, shift work type. 


Relationship to International Classification of 


Sleep Disorders 


The International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd Edition (ICSD-2), lists sleep disorders 
“due to drug or substance” under their respective phenotypes (e.g., insomnia, hypersomnia). 


Other Specified Insomnia Disorder 
780.52 (G47.09) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of insomnia disorder 
that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important 
areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for insomnia disorder or any 
of the disorders in the sleep-wake disorders diagnostic class. The other specified insomnia dis- 
order category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific 
reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for insomnia disorder or any specific 
sleep-wake disorder. This is done by recording “other specified insomnia disorder’ followed by 
the specific reason (e.g., “brief insomnia disorder’). 
Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include the following: 
1. Brief insomnia disorder: Duration is less than 3 months. 
2. Restricted to nonrestorative sleep: Predominant complaint is nonrestorative sleep 
unaccompanied by other sleep symptoms such as difficulty falling asleep or remaining 
asleep. 


Unspecified Insomnia Disorder 
780.52 (G47.00) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of insomnia disor- 
der that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other 
important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for insomnia dis- 
order or any of the disorders in the sleep-wake disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified 


Other Specified Hypersomnolence Disorder 421 


insomnia disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify 
the reason that the criteria are not met for insomnia disorder or a specific sleep-wake dis- 
order, and includes presentations in which there is insufficient information to make a more 
specific diagnosis. 


Other Specified Hypersomnolence Disorder 
780.54 (G47.19) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of hypersomno- 
lence disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupation- 
al, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for 
hypersomnolence disorder or any of the disorders in the sleep-wake disorders diagnostic 
class. The other specified hypersomnolence disorder category is used in situations in 
which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific reason that the presentation does 
not meet the criteria for hypersomnolence disorder or any specific sleep-wake disorder. 
This is done by recording “other specified hypersomnolence disorder” followed by the spe- 
cific reason (e.g., “brief-duration hypersomnolence,” as in Kleine-Levin syndrome). 


Unspecified Hypersomnolence Disorder 
780.54 (G47.10) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of hypersomno- 
lence disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupation- 
al, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for 
hypersomnolence disorder or any of the disorders in the sleep-wake disorders diagnostic 
class. The unspecified hypersomnolence disorder category is used in situations in which 
the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for hypersom- 
nolence disorder or a specific sleep-wake disorder, and includes presentations in which 
there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis. 


Other Specified Sleep-Wake Disorder 
780.59 (G47.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a sleep-wake 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the sleep-wake disorders diagnostic class and do not qualify for a diagno- 
sis of other specified insomnia disorder or other specified hypersomnolence disorder. The 
other specified sleep-wake disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician 
chooses to communicate the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the 
criteria for any specific sleep-wake disorder. This is done by recording “other specified 
sleep-wake disorder” followed by the specific reason (e.g., “repeated arousals during rapid 
eye movement sleep without polysomnography or history of Parkinson’s disease or other 
synucleinopathy’). 


422 Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Unspecified Sleep-Wake Disorder 
780.59 (G47.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a sleep-wake 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the sleep-wake disorders diagnostic class and do not qualify for a diagno- 
sis of unspecified insomnia disorder or unspecified hypersomnolence disorder. The un- 
specified sleep-wake disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses 
not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for a specific sleep-wake disorder, 
and includes presentations in which there is insufficient information to make a more spe- 
cific diagnosis. 


Sexual 
Dysfunctions 


Sexual dysfunctions include delayed ejaculation, erectile disorder, female orgasmic 
disorder, female sexual interest/arousal disorder, genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder, 
male hypoactive sexual desire disorder, premature (early) ejaculation, substance /medication- 
induced sexual dysfunction, other specified sexual dysfunction, and unspecified sexual dys- 
function. Sexual dysfunctions are a heterogeneous group of disorders that are typically char- 
acterized by a clinically significant disturbance in a person’s ability to respond sexually or to 
experience sexual pleasure. An individual may have several sexual dysfunctions at the same 
time. In such cases, all of the dysfunctions should be diagnosed. 

Clinical judgment should be used to determine if the sexual difficulties are the result of 
inadequate sexual stimulation; in these cases, there may still be a need for care, but a di- 
agnosis of a sexual dysfunction would not be made. These cases may include, but are not 
limited to, conditions in which lack of knowledge about effective stimulation prevents the 
experience of arousal or orgasm. 

Subtypes are used to designate the onset of the difficulty. In many individuals with 
sexual dysfunctions, the time of onset may indicate different etiologies and interventions. 
Lifelong refers to a sexual problem that has been present from first sexual experiences, and 
acquired applies to sexual disorders that develop after a period of relatively normal sexual 
function. Generalized refers to sexual difficulties that are not limited to certain types of 
stimulation, situations, or partners, and situational refers to sexual difficulties that only oc- 
cur with certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 

In addition to the lifelong/acquired and generalized /situational subtypes, a number 
of factors must be considered during the assessment of sexual dysfunction, given that they 
may be relevant to etiology and/or treatment, and that may contribute, to varying degrees, 
across individuals: 1) partner factors (e.g., partner’s sexual problems; partner’s health sta- 
tus); 2) relationship factors (e.g., poor communication; discrepancies in desire for sexual 
activity); 3) individual vulnerability factors (e.g., poor body image; history of sexual or emo- 
tional abuse), psychiatric comorbidity (e.g., depression, anxiety), or stressors (e.g., job loss, 
bereavement); 4) cultural or religious factors (e.g., inhibitions related to prohibitions against 
sexual activity or pleasure; attitudes toward sexuality); and 5) medical factors relevant to 
prognosis, course, or treatment. 

Clinical judgment about the diagnosis of sexual dysfunction should take into consideration 
cultural factors that may influence expectations or engender prohibitions about the experience 
of sexual pleasure. Aging may be associated with a normative decrease in sexual response. 

Sexual response has a requisite biological underpinning, yet is usually experienced in 
an intrapersonal, interpersonal, and cultural context. Thus, sexual function involves a com- 
plex interaction among biological, sociocultural, and psychological factors. In many clinical 
contexts, a precise understanding of the etiology of a sexual problem is unknown. Nonethe- 
less, a sexual dysfunction diagnosis requires ruling out problems that are better explained 
by anonsexual mental disorder, by the effects of a substance (e.g., drug or medication), by 
a medical condition (e.g., due to pelvic nerve damage), or by severe relationship distress, 
partner violence, or other stressors. 

If the sexual dysfunction is mostly explainable by another nonsexual mental disorder (e.g., 
depressive or bipolar disorder, anxiety disorder, posttraumatic stress disorder, psychotic dis- 


423 


424 Sexual Dysfunctions 


order), then only the other mental disorder diagnosis should be made. If the problem is 
thought to be better explained by the use/ misuse or discontinuation of a drug or substance, it 
should be diagnosed accordingly as a substance /medication-induced sexual dysfunction. If 
the sexual dysfunction is attributable to another medical condition (e.g., peripheral neuropa- 
thy), the individual would not receive a psychiatric diagnosis. If severe relationship distress, 
partner violence, or significant stressors better explain the sexual difficulties, then a sexual dys- 
function diagnosis is not made, but an appropriate V or Z code for the relationship problem or 
stressor may be listed. In many cases, a precise etiological relationship between another con- 
dition (e.g., a medical condition) and a sexual dysfunction cannot be established. 


Delayed Ejaculation 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.74 (F52.32) 


A. Either of the following symptoms must be experienced on almost all or all occasions 
(approximately 75%—100%) of partnered sexual activity (in identified situational con- 
texts or, if generalized, in all contexts), and without the individual desiring delay: 

1. Marked delay in ejaculation. 
2. Marked infrequency or absence of ejaculation. 

B. The symptoms in Criterion A have persisted for a minimum duration of approximately 
6 months. 

C. The symptoms in Criterion A cause clinically significant distress in the individual. 

D. The sexual dysfunction is not better explained by a nonsexual mental disorder or as a 
consequence of severe relationship distress or other significant stressors and is not at- 
tributable to the effects of a substance/medication or another medical condition. 


Specify whether: 

Lifelong: The disturbance has been present since the individual became sexually active. 

Acquired: The disturbance began after a period of relatively normal sexual function. 
Specify whether: 

Generalized: Not limited to certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 

Situational: Only occurs with certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 
Specify current severity: 

Mild: Evidence of mild distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 

Moderate: Evidence of moderate distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 

Severe: Evidence of severe or extreme distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 


Diagnostic Features 


The distinguishing feature of delayed ejaculation is a marked delay in or inability to 
achieve ejaculation (Criterion A). The man reports difficulty or inability to ejaculate de- 
spite the presence of adequate sexual stimulation and the desire to ejaculate. The present- 
ing complaint usually involves partnered sexual activity. In most cases, the diagnosis will 
be made by self-report of the individual. The definition of “delay” does not have precise 
boundaries, as there is noconsensus as to what constitutes a reasonable time to reach or- 
gasm or what is unacceptably long for most men and their sexual partners. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The man and his partner may report prolonged thrusting to achieve orgasm to the point of 
exhaustion or genital discomfort and then ceasing efforts. Some men may report avoiding 


Delayed Ejaculation 425 


sexual activity because of a repetitive pattern of difficulty ejaculating. Some sexual partners 
may report feeling less sexually attractive because their partner cannot ejaculate easily. 

In addition to the subtypes “lifelong /acquired” and “generalized/situational,” the fol- 
lowing five factors must be considered during assessment and diagnosis of delayed ejacu- 
lation, given that they may be relevant to etiology and/or treatment: 1) partner factors (e.g., 
partner’s sexual problems, partner’s health status); 2) relationship factors (e.g., poor com- 
munication, discrepancies in desire for sexual activity); 3) individual vulnerability factors 
(e.g., poor body image; history of sexual or emotional abuse), psychiatric comorbidity (e.g., 
depression, anxiety), or stressors (e.g., job loss, bereavement); 4) cultural/religious factors 
(e.g., inhibitions related to prohibitions against sexual activity; attitudes toward sexuality); 
and 5) medical factors relevant to prognosis, course, or treatment. Each of these factors may 
contribute differently to the presenting symptoms of different men with this disorder. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence is unclear because of the lack of a precise definition of this syndrome. It is the 
least common male sexual complaint. Only 75% of men report always ejaculating during 
sexual activity, and less than 1% of men will complain of problems with reaching ejacula- 
tion that last more than 6 months. 


Development and Course 


Lifelong delayed ejaculation begins with early sexual experiences and continues through- 
out life. By definition, acquired delayed ejaculation begins after a period of normal sexual 
function. There is minimal evidence concerning the course of acquired delayed ejacula- 
tion. The prevalence of delayed ejaculation appears to remain relatively constant until 
around age 50 years, when the incidence begins to increase significantly. Men in their 80s 
report twice as much difficulty ejaculating as men younger than 59 years. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Age-related loss of the fast-conducting peripheral sensory 
nerves and age-related decreased sex steroid secretion may be associated with the increase 
in delayed ejaculation in men older than 50 years. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Complaints of ejaculatory delay vary across countries and cultures. Such complaints are 
more common among men in Asian populations than in men living in Europe, Australia, 
or the United States. This variation may be attributable to cultural or genetic differences 
between cultures. 


Functional Consequences of Delayed Ejaculation 


Difficulty with ejaculation may contribute to difficulties in conception. Delayed ejacula- 
tion is often associated with considerable psychological distress in one or both partners. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Another medical condition. The major differential diagnosis is between delayed ejacu- 
lation fully explained by another medical illness or injury and delayed ejaculation with a 
psychogenic, idiopathic, or combined psychological and medical etiology. A situational 
aspect to the complaint is suggestive of a psychological basis for the problem (e.g., men 
who can ejaculate during sexual activity with one sex but not the other; men who can ejac- 
ulate with one partner but not another of the same sex; men with paraphilic arousal pat- 


426 Sexual Dysfunctions 


terns; men who require highly ritualized activity to ejaculate during partnered sexual 
activity). Another medical illness or injury may produce delays in ejaculation independent 
of psychological issues. For example, inability to ejaculate can be caused by interruption of 
the nerve supply to the genitals, such as can occur after traumatic surgical injury to the 
lumbar sympathetic ganglia, abdominoperitoneal surgery, or lumbar sympathectomy. 
Ejaculation is thought to be under autonomic nervous system control involving the hypo- 
gastric (sympathetic) and pudendal (parasympathetic) nerves. A number of neurodegen- 
erative diseases, such as multiple sclerosis and diabetic and alcoholic neuropathy, can 
cause inability to ejaculate. Delayed ejaculation should also be differentiated from retro- 
grade ejaculation (i.e., ejaculation into the bladder), which may follow transurethral pros- 
tatic resection. 


Substance/medication use. A number of pharmacological agents, such as antidepres- 
sants, antipsychotics, alpha sympathetic drugs, and opioid drugs, can cause ejaculatory 
problems. 


Dysfunction with orgasm. It is important in the history to ascertain whether the com- 
plaint concerns delayed ejaculation or the sensation of orgasm, or both. Ejaculation occurs 
in the genitals, whereas the experience of orgasm is believed to be primarily subjective. 
Ejaculation and orgasm usually occur together but not always. For example, a man witha 
normal ejaculatory pattern may complain of decreased pleasure (i.e., anhedonic ejacula- 
tion). Such a complaint would not be coded as delayed ejaculation but could be coded as 
other specified sexual dysfunction or unspecified sexual dysfunction. 


Comorbidity 


There is some evidence to suggest that delayed ejaculation may be more common in severe 
forms of major depressive disorder. 


Erectile Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.72 (F52.21) 


A. At least one of the three following symptoms must be experienced on almost all or all 
(approximately 75%—100%) occasions of sexual activity (in identified situational con- 
texts or, if generalized, in all contexts): 

1. Marked difficulty in obtaining an erection during sexual activity. 
2. Marked difficulty in maintaining an erection until the completion of sexual activity. 
3. Marked decrease in erectile rigidity. 

B. The symptoms in Criterion A have persisted for a minimum duration of approximately 
6 months. 

C. The symptoms in Criterion A cause clinically significant distress in the individual. 

D. The sexual dysfunction is not better explained by a nonsexual mental disorder or as a 
consequence of severe relationship distress or other significant stressors and is not at- 
tributable to the effects of a substance/medication or another medical condition. 


Specify whether: 
Lifelong: The disturbance has been present since the individual became sexually ac- 
tive. 
Acquired: The disturbance began after a period of relatively normal sexual function. 
Specify whether: 
Generalized: Not limited to certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 
Situational: Only occurs with certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 


Erectile Disorder 427 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Evidence of mild distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Moderate: Evidence of moderate distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Severe: Evidence of severe or extreme distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of erectile disorder is the repeated failure to obtain or maintain erec- 
tions during partnered sexual activities (Criterion A). A careful sexual history is necessary 
to ascertain that the problem has been present for a significant duration of time (i.e., at least 
approximately 6 months) and occurs on the majority of sexual occasions (i.e., at least 75% 
of the time). Symptoms may occur only in specific situations involving certain types of 
stimulation or partners, or they may occur in a generalized manner in all types of situa- 
tions, stimulation, or partners. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Many men with erectile disorder may have low self-esteem, low self-confidence, and a de- 
creased sense of masculinity, and may experience depressed affect. Fear and/or avoid- 
ance of future sexual encounters may occur. Decreased sexual satisfaction and reduced 
sexual desire in the individual’s partner are common. 

In addition to the subtypes “lifelong /acquired” and “generalized/situational,” the fol- 
lowing five factors must be considered during assessment and diagnosis of erectile disorder 
given that they may be relevant to etiology and/or treatment: 1) partner factors (e.g., part- 
ner’s sexual problems, partner’s health status); 2) relationship factors (e.g., poor communi- 
cation, discrepancies in desire for sexual activity); 3) individual vulnerability factors (e.g., 
poor body image, history of sexual or emotional abuse), psychiatric comorbidity (e.g., de- 
pression, anxiety), or stressors (e.g., job loss, bereavement); 4) cultural/religious factors (e.g., 
inhibitions related to prohibitions against sexual activity; attitudes toward sexuality); and 
5) medical factors relevant to prognosis, course, or treatment. Each of these factors may con- 
tribute differently to the presenting symptoms of different men with this disorder. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of lifelong versus acquired erectile disorder is unknown. There is a strong 
age-related increase in both prevalence and incidence of problems with erection, particu- 
larly after age 50 years. Approximately 13%-21% of men ages 40-80 years complain of oc- 
casional problems with erections. Approximately 2% of men younger than age 40-50 years 
complain of frequent problems with erections, whereas 40%-50% of men older than 60-70 
years may have significant problems with erections. About 20% of men fear erectile prob- 
lems on their first sexual experience, whereas approximately 8% experienced erectile prob- 
lems that hindered penetration during their first sexual experience. 


Development and Course 


Erectile failure on first sexual attempt has been found to be related to having sex with a pre- 
viously unknown partner, concomitant use of drugs or alcohol, not wanting to have sex, and 
peer pressure. There is minimal evidence regarding the persistence of such problems after 
the first attempt. It is assumed that most of these problems spontaneously remit without pro- 
fessional intervention, but some men may continue to have episodic problems. In contrast, 
acquired erectile disorder is often associated with biological factors such as diabetes and car- 
diovascular disease. Acquired erectile disorder is likely to be persistent in most men. 

The natural history of lifelong erectile disorder is unknown. Clinical observation sup- 
ports the association of lifelong erectile disorder with psychological factors that are self- 


428 Sexual Dysfunctions 


limiting or responsive to psychological interventions, whereas, as noted above, acquired 
erectile disorder is more likely to be related to biological factors and to be persistent. The 
incidence of erectile disorder increases with age. A minority of men diagnosed as having 
moderate erectile failure may experience spontaneous remission of symptoms without 
medical intervention. Distress associated with erectile disorder is lower in older men as 
compared with younger men. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Neurotic personality traits may be associated with erectile problems in col- 
lege students, and submissive personality traits may be associated with erectile problems in 
men age 40 years and older. Alexithymia (i.e., deficits in cognitive processing of emotions) is 
common in men diagnosed with “psychogenic” erectile dysfunction. Erectile problems are 
common in men diagnosed with depression and posttraumatic stress disorder. 


Course modifiers. Risk factors for acquired erectile disorder include age, smoking to- 
bacco, lack of physical exercise, diabetes, and decreased desire. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Complaints of erectile disorder have been found to vary across countries. It is unclear to 
what extent these differences represent differences in cultural expectations as opposed to 
genuine differences in the frequency of erectile failure. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Nocturnal penile tumescence testing and measured erectile turgidity during sleep can be 
employed to help differentiate organic from psychogenic erectile problems on the as- 
sumption that adequate erections during rapid eye movement sleep indicate a psycholog- 
ical etiology to the problem. A number of other diagnostic procedures may be employed 
depending on the clinician’s assessment of their relevance given the individual’s age, co- 
morbid medical problems, and clinical presentation. Doppler ultrasonography and intra- 
vascular injection of vasoactive drugs, as well as invasive diagnostic procedures such as 
dynamic infusion cavernosography, can be used to assess vascular integrity. Pudendal 
nerve conduction studies, including somatosensory evoked potentials, can be employed 
when a peripheral neuropathy is suspected. In men also complaining of decreased sexual 
desire, serum bioavailable or free testosterone is frequently assessed to determine if the 
difficulty is secondary to endocrinological factors. Thyroid function may also be assessed. 
Determination of fasting serum glucose is useful to screen for the presence of diabetes mel- 
litus. The assessment of serum lipids is important, as erectile disorder in men 40 years and 
older is predictive of the future risk of coronary artery disease. 


Functional Consequences of Erectile Disorder 


Erectile disorder can interfere with fertility and produce both individual and interpersonal 
distress. Fear and/or avoidance of sexual encounters may interfere with the ability to de- 
velop intimate relationships. 


Differential Diagnosis 
Nonsexual mental disorders. Major depressive disorder and erectile disorder are closely 
associated, and erectile disorder accompanying severe depressive disorder may occur. 


Normal erectile function. The differential should include consideration of normal erec- 
tile function in men with excessive expectations. 


Female Orgasmic Disorder 429 


Substance/medication use. Another major differential diagnosis is whether the erectile 
problem is secondary to substance/medication use. An onset that coincides with the be- 
ginning of substance /medication use and that dissipates with discontinuation of the sub- 
stance/medication or dose reduction is suggestive of a substance/medication-induced 
sexual dysfunction. 


Another medical condition. The most difficult aspect of the differential diagnosis of erec- 
tile disorder is ruling out erectile problems that are fully explained by medical factors. Such 
cases would not receive a diagnosis of a mental disorder. The distinction between erectile 
disorder as a mental disorder and erectile dysfunction as the result of another medical con- 
dition is usually unclear, and many cases will have complex, interactive biological and psy- 
chiatric etiologies. If the individual is older than 40-50 years and/or has concomitant 
medical problems, the differential diagnosis should include medical etiologies, especially 
vascular disease. The presence of an organic disease known to cause erectile problems does 
not confirm a causal relationship. For example, a man with diabetes mellitus can develop 
erectile disorder in response to psychological stress. In general, erectile dysfunction due to 
organic factors is generalized and gradual in onset. An exception would be erectile problems 
after traumatic injury to the nervous innervation of the genital organs (e.g., spinal cord injury). 
Erectile problems that are situational and inconsistent and that have an acute onset after a 
stressful life event are most often due to psychological events. An age of less than 40 years is 
also suggestive of a psychological etiology to the difficulty. 


Other sexual dysfunctions. Erectile disorder may coexist with premature (early) ejacu- 
lation and male hypoactive sexual desire disorder. 


Comorbidity 

Erectile disorder can be comorbid with other sexual diagnoses, such as premature (early) 
ejaculation and male hypoactive sexual desire disorder, as well as with anxiety and de- 
pressive disorders. Erectile disorder is common in men with lower urinary tract symptoms 
related to prostatic hypertrophy. Erectile disorder may be comorbid with dyslipidemia, car- 
diovascular disease, hypogonadism, multiple sclerosis, diabetes mellitus, and other diseases 
that interfere with the vascular, neurological, or endocrine function necessary for normal 
erectile function. 


Relationship to International Classification of Diseases 


Erectile response is coded as failure of genital response in ICD-10 (F2.2). 


Female Orgasmic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.73 (F52.31) 


A. Presence of either of the following symptoms and experienced on almost all or all (ap- 
proximately 75%—100%) occasions of sexual activity (in identified situational contexts 
or, if generalized, in all contexts): 


1. Marked delay in, marked infrequency of, or absence of orgasm. 
2. Markedly reduced intensity of orgasmic sensations. 

B. The symptoms in Criterion A have persisted for a minimum duration of approximately 
6 months. 

C. The symptoms in Criterion A cause clinically significant distress in the individual. 


D. The sexual dysfunction is not better explained by a nonsexual mental disorder or as a 
consequence of severe relationship distress (e.g., partner violence) or other significant 


430 Sexual Dysfunctions 


stressors and is not attributable to the effects of a substance/medication or another 
medical condition. 


Specify whether: 
Lifelong: The disturbance has been present since the individual became sexually active. 
Acquired: The disturbance began after a period of relatively normal sexual function. 


Specify whether: 
Generalized: Not limited to certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 
Situational: Only occurs with certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 
Specify if: 
Never experienced an orgasm under any situation. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Evidence of mild distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Moderate: Evidence of moderate distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Severe: Evidence of severe or extreme distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 


Diagnostic Features 


Female orgasmic disorder is characterized by difficulty experiencing orgasm and/or 
markedly reduced intensity of orgasmic sensations (Criterion A). Women show wide vari- 
ability in the type or intensity of stimulation that elicits orgasm. Similarly, subjective descrip- 
tions of orgasm are extremely varied, suggesting that it is experienced in very different 
ways, both across women and on different occasions by the same woman. For a diagnosis 
of female orgasmic disorder, symptoms must be experienced on almost all or all (approx- 
imately 75%-100%) occasions of sexual activity (in identified situational contexts or, if 
generalized, in all contexts) and have a minimum duration of approximately 6 months. 
The use of the minimum severity and duration criteria is intended to distinguish transient 
orgasm difficulties from more persistent orgasmic dysfunction. The inclusion of “approx- 
imately” in Criterion B allows for clinician judgment in cases in which symptom duration 
does not meet the recommended 6-month threshold. 

For a woman to have a diagnosis of female orgasmic disorder, clinically significant dis- 
tress must accompany the symptoms (Criterion C). In many cases of orgasm problems, the 
causes are multifactorial or cannot be determined. If female orgasmic disorder is deemed 
to be better explained by another mental disorder, the effects of a substance/medication, 
or a medical condition, then a diagnosis of female orgasmic disorder would not be made. 
Finally, if interpersonal or significant contextual factors, such as severe relationship dis- 
tress, intimate partner violence, or other significant stressors, are present, then a diagnosis 
of female orgasmic disorder would not be made. 

Many women require clitoral stimulation to reach orgasm, and a relatively small pro- 
portion of women report that they always experience orgasm during penile-vaginal inter- 
course. Thus, a woman’s experiencing orgasm through clitoral stimulation but not during 
intercourse does not meet criteria for a clinical diagnosis of female orgasmic disorder. It is 
also important to consider whether orgasmic difficulties are the result of inadequate sex- 
ual stimulation; in these cases, there may still be a need for care, but a diagnosis of female 
orgasmic disorder would not be made. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Associations between specific patterns of personality traits or psychopathology and orgas- 
mic dysfunction have generally not been supported. Compared with women without the 
disorder, some women with female orgasmic disorder may have greater difficulty com- 
municating about sexual issues. Overall sexual satisfaction, however, is not strongly cor- 
related with orgasmic experience. Many women report high levels of sexual satisfaction 


Female Orgasmic Disorder 431 


despite rarely or never experiencing orgasm. Orgasmic difficulties in women often co- 
occur with problems related to sexual interest and arousal. 

In addition to the subtypes “lifelong /acquired” and “generalized /situational,” the fol- 
lowing five factors must be considered during assessment and diagnosis of female orgas- 
mic disorder given that they may be relevant to etiology and/or treatment: 1) partner 
factors (e.g., partner’s sexual problems, partner’s health status); 2) relationship factors 
(e.g., poor communication, discrepancies in desire for sexual activity); 3) individual vul- 
nerability factors (e.g., poor body image, history of sexual or emotional abuse), psychiatric 
comorbidity (e.g., depression, anxiety), or stressors (e.g., job loss, bereavement); (4) cul- 
tural/religious factors (e.g., inhibitions related to prohibitions against sexual activity; 
attitudes toward sexuality); and 5) medical factors relevant to prognosis, course, or treat- 
ment. Each of these factors may contribute differently to the presenting symptoms of dif- 
ferent women with this disorder. 


Prevalence 


Reported prevalence rates for female orgasmic problems in women vary widely, from 10% 
to 42%, depending on multiple factors (e.g., age, culture, duration, and severity of symp- 
toms); however, these estimates do not take into account the presence of distress. Only a 
proportion of women experiencing orgasm difficulties also report associated distress. 
Variation in how symptoms are assessed (e.g., the duration of symptoms and the recall pe- 
riod) also influence prevalence rates. Approximately 10% of women do not experience or- 
gasm throughout their lifetime. 


Development and Course 


By definition, lifelong female orgasmic disorder indicates that the orgasmic difficulties have 
always been present, whereas the acquired subtype would be assigned if the woman’s or- 
gasmic difficulties developed after a period of normal orgasmic functioning. 

A woman’s first experience of orgasm can occur any time from the prepubertal period 
to well into adulthood. Women show a more variable pattern in age at first orgasm than do 
men, and women’s reports of having experienced orgasm increase with age. Many women 
learn to experience orgasm as they experience a wide variety of stimulation and acquire 
more knowledge about their bodies. Women’s rates of orgasm consistency (defined as 
“usually or always” experiencing orgasm) are higher during masturbation than during 
sexual activity with a partner. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. A wide range of psychological factors, such as anxiety and concerns 
about pregnancy, can potentially interfere with a woman’s ability to experience orgasm. 


Environmental. There is a strong association between relationship problems, physical 
health, and mental health and orgasm difficulties in women. Sociocultural factors (e.g., 
gender role expectations and religious norms) are also important influences on the expe- 
rience of orgasmic difficulties. 


Genetic and physiological. Many physiological factors may influence a woman’s expe- 
rience of orgasm, including medical conditions and medications. Conditions such as mul- 
tiple sclerosis, pelvic nerve damage from radical hysterectomy, and spinal cord injury can 
all influence orgasmic functioning in women. Selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors are 
known to delay or inhibit orgasm in women. Women with vulvovaginal atrophy (charac- 
terized by symptoms such as vaginal dryness, itching, and pain) are significantly more 
likely to report orgasm difficulties than are women without this condition. Menopausal 
status is not consistently associated with the likelihood of orgasm difficulties. There may 
be a significant genetic contribution to variation in female orgasmic function. However, 


432 Sexual Dysfunctions 


psychological, sociocultural, and physiological factors likely interact in complex ways to 
influence women’s experience of orgasm and of orgasm difficulties. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The degree to which lack of orgasm in women is regarded as a problem that requires treat- 
ment may vary depending on cultural context. In addition, women differ in how important 
orgasm is to their sexual satisfaction. There may be marked sociocultural and generational 
differences in women’s orgasmic ability. For example, the prevalence of inability to reach or- 
gasm has ranged from 17.7% (in Northern Europe) to 42.2% (in Southeast Asia). 


Diagnostic Markers 


Although measurable physiological changes occur during female orgasm, including 
changes in hormones, pelvic floor musculature, and brain activation, there is significant 
variability in these indicators of orgasm across women. In clinical situations, the diagnosis 
of female orgasmic disorder is based on a woman’s self-report. 


Functional Consequences of Female Orgasmic Disorder 


The functional consequences of female orgasmic disorder are unclear. Although there is a 
strong association between relationship problems and orgasmic difficulties in women, it is 
unclear whether relationship factors are risk factors for orgasmic difficulties or are conse- 
quences of those difficulties. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nonsexual mental disorders. Nonsexual mental disorders, such as major depressive 
disorder, which is characterized by markedly diminished interest or pleasure in all, or al- 
most all, activities, may explain female orgasmic disorder. If the orgasmic difficulties are 
better explained by another mental disorder, then a diagnosis of female orgasmic disorder 
would not be made. 


Substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunction. Substance/medication use may 
explain the orgasmic difficulties. 


Another medical condition. If the disorder is due to another medical condition (e.g., 
multiple sclerosis, spinal cord injury), then a diagnosis of female orgasmic disorder would 
not be made. 


Interpersonal factors. If interpersonal or significant contextual factors, such as severe 
relationship distress, intimate partner violence, or other significant stressors, are associ- 
ated with the orgasmic difficulties, then a diagnosis of female orgasmic disorder would 
not be made. 


Other sexual dysfunctions. Female orgasmic disorder may occur in association with other 
sexual dysfunctions (e.g., female sexual interest/arousal disorder). The presence of another 
sexual dysfunction does not rule out a diagnosis of female orgasmic disorder. Occasional or- 
gasmic difficulties that are short-term or infrequent and are not accompanied by clinically sig- 
nificant distress or impairment are not diagnosed as female orgasmic disorder. A diagnosis is 
also not appropriate if the problems are the result of inadequate sexual stimulation. 


Comorbidity 


Women with female orgasmic disorder may have co-occurring sexual interest/arousal 
difficulties. Women with diagnoses of other nonsexual mental disorders, such as major de- 
pressive disorder, may experience lower sexual interest/arousal, and this may indirectly 
increase the likelihood of orgasmic difficulties. 


Female Sexual Interest/Arousal Disorder 433 


Female Sexual Interest/Arousal Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.72 (F52.22) 


A. Lack of, or significantly reduced, sexual interest/arousal, as manifested by at least 
three of the following: 


1. Absent/reduced interest in sexual activity. 

2. Absent/reduced sexual/erotic thoughts or fantasies. 

3. No/reduced initiation of sexual activity, and typically unreceptive to a partner's at- 
tempts to initiate. 

4. Absent/reduced sexual excitement/pleasure during sexual activity in almost all or 
all (approximately 75%—100%) sexual encounters (in identified situational contexts 
or, if generalized, in all contexts). 

5. Absent/reduced sexual interest/arousal in response to any internal or external sex- 
ual/erotic cues (e.g., written, verbal, visual). 

6. Absent/reduced genital or nongenital sensations during sexual activity in almost all 
or all (approximately 75%—100%) sexual encounters (in identified situational con- 
texts or, if generalized, in all contexts). 


B. The symptoms in Criterion A have persisted for a minimum duration of approximately 
6 months. 

C. The symptoms in Criterion A cause clinically significant distress in the individual. 

D. The sexual dysfunction is not better explained by a nonsexual mental disorder or as a 
consequence of severe relationship distress (e.g., partner violence) or other significant 
stressors and is not attributable to the effects of a substance/medication or another 
medical condition. 


Specify whether: 
Lifelong: The disturbance has been present since the individual became sexually 
active. 
Acquired: The disturbance began after a period of relatively normal sexual function. 
Specify whether: 
Generalized: Not limited to certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 
Situational: Only occurs with certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Evidence of mild distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Moderate: Evidence of moderate distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Severe: Evidence of severe or extreme distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 


Diagnostic Features 


In assessing female sexual interest/arousal disorder, interpersonal context must be taken 
into account. A “desire discrepancy,” in which a woman has lower desire for sexual activ- 
ity than her partner, is not sufficient to diagnose female sexual interest/arousal disorder. 
In order for the criteria for the disorder to be met, there must be absence or reduced fre- 
quency or intensity of at least three of six indicators (Criterion A) for a minimum duration 
of approximately 6 months (Criterion B). There may be different symptom profiles across 
women, as well as variability in how sexual interest and arousal are expressed. For exam- 
ple, in one woman, sexual interest /arousal disorder may be expressed as a lack of interest 
in sexual activity, an absence of erotic or sexual thoughts, and reluctance to initiate sexual 
activity and respond to a partner’s sexual invitations. In another woman, an inability to be- 
come sexually excited, to respond to sexual stimuli with sexual desire, and a correspond- 


434 Sexual Dysfunctions 


ing lack of signs of physical sexual arousal may be the primary features. Because sexual 
desire and arousal frequently coexist and are elicited in response to adequate sexual cues, 
the criteria for female sexual interest /arousal disorder take into account that difficulties in 
desire and arousal often simultaneously characterize the complaints of women with this 
disorder. Short-term changes in sexual interest or arousal are common and may be adaptive 
responses to events in a woman’s life and do not represent a sexual dysfunction. Diagnosis 
of female sexual interest/arousal disorder requires a minimum duration of symptoms of 
approximately 6 months as a reflection that the symptoms must be a persistent problem. 
The estimation of persistence may be determined by clinical judgment when a duration of 
6 months cannot be ascertained precisely. 

There may be absent or reduced frequency or intensity of interest in sexual activity (Crite- 
rion A1), which was previously termed hypoactive sexual desire disorder. The frequency or inten- 
sity of sexual and erotic thoughts or fantasies may be absent or reduced (Criterion A2). The 
expression of fantasies varies widely across women and may include memories of past sexual 
experiences. The normative decline in sexual thoughts with age should be taken into account 
when this criterion is being assessed. Absence or reduced frequency of initiating sexual activ- 
ity and of receptivity to a partner’s sexual invitations (Criterion A3) is a behaviorally focused 
criterion. A couple’s beliefs and preferences for sexual initiation patterns are highly relevant to 
the assessment of this criterion. There may be absent or reduced sexual excitement or pleasure 
during sexual activity in almost all or all (approximately 75%-100%) sexual encounters (Cri- 
terion A4). Lack of pleasure is acommon presenting clinical complaint in women with low de- 
sire. Among women who report low sexual desire, there are fewer sexual or erotic cues that 
elicit sexual interest or arousal (i.e., there is a lack of “responsive desire”). Assessment of the 
adequacy of sexual stimuli will assist in determining if there is a difficulty with responsive sex- 
ual desire (Criterion A5). Frequency or intensity of genital or nongenital sensations during sex- 
ual activity may be reduced or absent (Criterion A6). This may include reduced vaginal 
lubrication /vasocongestion, but because physiological measures of genital sexual response do 
not differentiate women who report sexual arousal concerns from those who do not, the self- 
report of reduced or absent genital or nongenital sensations is sufficient. 

For a diagnosis of female sexual interest /arousal disorder to be made, clinically signif- 
icant distress must accompany the symptoms in Criterion A. Distress may be experienced 
as a result of the lack of sexual interest /arousal or as a result of significant interference in 
a womans life and well-being. If a lifelong lack of sexual desire is better explained by one’s 
self-identification as “asexual,” then a diagnosis of female sexual interest/arousal disor- 
der would not be made. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Female sexual interest /arousal disorder is frequently associated with problems in experi- 
encing orgasm, pain experienced during sexual activity, infrequent sexual activity, and 
couple-level discrepancies in desire. Relationship difficulties and mood disorders are also 
frequently associated features of female sexual interest/arousal disorder. Unrealistic ex- 
pectations and norms regarding the “appropriate” level of sexual interest or arousal, along 
with poor sexual techniques and lack of information about sexuality, may also be evident 
in women diagnosed with female sexual interest/arousal disorder. The latter, as well as 
normative beliefs about gender roles, are important factors to consider. 

In addition to the subtypes “lifelong /acquired” and “generalized /situational,” the follow- 
ing five factors must be considered during assessment and diagnosis of female sexual interest / 
arousal disorder given that they may be relevant to etiology and/or treatment: 1) partner fac- 
tors (e.g., partner’s sexual problems, partner’s health status); 2) relationship factors (e.g., poor 
communication, discrepancies in desire for sexual activity); 3) individual vulnerability factors 
(e.g., poor body image, history of sexual or emotional abuse), psychiatric comorbidity (e.g., de- 
pression, anxiety), or stressors (e.g., job loss, bereavement); 4) cultural/religious factors (e.g., 
inhibitions related to prohibitions against sexual activity; attitudes toward sexuality); and 


Female Sexual Interest/Arousal Disorder 435 


5) medical factors relevant to prognosis, course, or treatment. Note that each of these factors 
may contribute differently to the presenting symptoms of different women with this disorder. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of female sexual interest /arousal disorder, as defined in this manual, is 
unknown. The prevalence of low sexual desire and of problems with sexual arousal (with 
and without associated distress), as defined by DSM-IV or ICD-10, may vary markedly in 
relation to age, cultural setting, duration of symptoms, and presence of distress. Regard- 
ing duration of symptoms, there are striking differences in prevalence estimates between 
short-term and persistent problems related to lack of sexual interest. When distress about 
sexual functioning is required, prevalence estimates are markedly lower. Some older 
women report less distress about low sexual desire than younger women, although sexual 
desire may decrease with age. 


Development and Course 


By definition, lifelong female sexual interest/arousal disorder suggests that the lack of 
sexual interest or arousal has been present for the woman’s entire sexual life. For Criteria 
A3, A4, and A6, which assess functioning during sexual activity, a subtype of lifelong 
would mean presence of symptoms since the individual's first sexual experiences. The ac- 
quired subtype would be assigned if the difficulties with sexual interest or arousal de- 
veloped after a period of nonproblematic sexual functioning. Adaptive and normative 
changes in sexual functioning may result from partner-related, interpersonal, or personal 
events and may be transient in nature. However, persistence of symptoms for approxi- 
mately 6 months or more would constitute a sexual dysfunction. 

There are normative changes in sexual interest and arousal across the life span. Fur- 
thermore, women in relationships of longer duration are more likely to report engaging in 
sex despite no obvious feelings of sexual desire at the outset of a sexual encounter com- 
pared with women in shorter-duration relationships. Vaginal dryness in older women is 
related to age and menopausal status. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Temperamental factors include negative cognitions and attitudes about 
sexuality and past history of mental disorders. Differences in propensity for sexual excitation 
and sexual inhibition may also predict the likelihood of developing sexual problems. 


Environmental. Environmental factors include relationship difficulties, partner sexual 
functioning, and developmental history, such as early relationships with caregivers and 
childhood stressors. 


Genetic and physiological. Some medical conditions (e.g., diabetes mellitus, thyroid 
dysfunction) can be risk factors for female sexual interest/arousal disorder. There appears 
to be a strong influence of genetic factors on vulnerability to sexual problems in women. 
Psychophysiological research using vaginal photoplethysmography has not found differ- 
ences between women with and without perceived lack of genital arousal. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There is marked variability in prevalence rates of low desire across cultures. Lower rates of 
sexual desire may be more common among East Asian women compared with Euro- 
Canadian women. Although the lower levels of sexual desire and arousal found in men 
and women from East Asian countries compared with Euro-American groups may reflect 
less interest in sex in those cultures, the possibility remains that such group differences are 
an artifact of the measures used to quantify desire. A judgment about whether low sexual 


436 Sexual Dysfunctions 


desire reported by a woman from a certain ethnocultural group meets criteria for female 
sexual interest /arousal disorder must take into account the fact that different cultures may 
pathologize some behaviors and not others. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


By definition, the diagnosis of female sexual interest/arousal disorder is only given to 
women. Distressing difficulties with sexual desire in men would be considered under 
male hypoactive sexual desire disorder. 


Functional Consequences of 
Female Sexual Interest/Arousal Disorder 


Difficulties in sexual interest/arousal are often associated with decreased relationship sat- 
isfaction. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nonsexual mental disorders. Nonsexual mental disorders, such as major depressive 
disorder, in which there is “markedly diminished interest or pleasure in all, or almost all, 
activities most of the day, nearly every day,” may explain the lack of sexual interest / 
arousal. If the lack of interest or arousal is completely attributable to another mental dis- 
order, then a diagnosis of female sexual interest/arousal disorder would not be made. 


Substance/medication use. Substance or medication use may explain the lack of inter- 
est/arousal. 


Another medical condition. If the sexual symptoms are considered to be almost exclu- 
sively associated with the effects of another medical condition (e.g., diabetes mellitus, en- 
dothelial disease, thyroid dysfunction, central nervous system disease), then a diagnosis 
of female sexual interest /arousal disorder would not be made. 


Interpersonal factors. If interpersonal or significant contextual factors, such as severe 
relationship distress, intimate partner violence, or other significant stressors, explain the 
sexual interest /arousal symptoms, then a diagnosis of female sexual interest/arousal dis- 
order would not be made. 


Other sexual dysfunctions. The presence of another sexual dysfunction does not rule 
out a diagnosis of female sexual interest /arousal disorder. It is common for women to ex- 
perience more than one sexual dysfunction. For example, the presence of chronic genital 
pain may lead to a lack of desire for the (painful) sexual activity. Lack of interest and 
arousal during sexual activity may impair orgasmic ability. For some women, all aspects 
of the sexual response may be unsatisfying and distressing. 


Inadequate or absent sexual stimuli. When differential diagnoses are being considered, 
it is important to assess the adequacy of sexual stimuli within the woman’s sexual experi- 
ence. In cases where inadequate or absent sexual stimuli are contributing to the clinical pic- 
ture, there may be evidence for clinical care, but a sexual dysfunction diagnosis would not 
be made. Similarly, transient and adaptive alterations in sexual functioning that are second- 
ary to a significant life or personal event must be considered in the differential diagnosis. 


Comorbidity 


Comorbidity between sexual interest/arousal problems and other sexual difficulties is 
extremely common. Sexual distress and dissatisfaction with sex life are also highly cor- 
related in women with low sexual desire. Distressing low desire is associated with depres- 
sion, thyroid problems, anxiety, urinary incontinence, and other medical factors. Arthritis 
and inflammatory or irritable bowel disease are also associated with sexual arousal prob- 


Genito-Pelvic Pain/Penetration Disorder 437 


lems. Low desire appears to be comorbid with depression, sexual and physical abuse in 
adulthood, global mental functioning, and use of alcohol. 


Genito-Pelvic Pain/Penetration Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.76 (F52.6) 


A. Persistent or recurrent difficulties with one (or more) of the following: 


1. Vaginal penetration during intercourse. 

2. Marked vulvovaginal or pelvic pain during vaginal intercourse or penetration attempts. 

3. Marked fear or anxiety about vulvovaginal or pelvic pain in anticipation of, during, 
or as a result of vaginal penetration. 

4. Marked tensing or tightening of the pelvic floor muscles during attempted vaginal 
penetration. 


B. The symptoms in Criterion A have persisted for a minimum duration of approximately 
6 months. 

C. The symptoms in Criterion A cause clinically significant distress in the individual. 

D. The sexual dysfunction is not better explained by a nonsexual mental disorder or as a 
consequence of a severe relationship distress (e.g., partner violence) or other signifi- 
cant stressors and is not attributable to the effects of a substance/medication or an- 
other medical condition. 


Specify whether: 
Lifelong: The disturbance has been present since the individual became sexually active. 
Acquired: The disturbance began after a period of relatively normal sexual function. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Evidence of mild distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Moderate: Evidence of moderate distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Severe: Evidence of severe or extreme distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 


Diagnostic Features 


Genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder refers to four commonly comorbid symptom di- 
mensions: 1) difficulty having intercourse, 2) genito-pelvic pain, 3) fear of pain or vaginal 
penetration, and 4) tension of the pelvic floor muscles (Criterion A). Because major diffi- 
culty in any one of these symptom dimensions is often sufficient to cause clinically sig- 
nificant distress, a diagnosis can be made on the basis of marked difficulty in only one 
symptom dimension. However, all four symptom dimensions should be assessed even if a 
diagnosis can be made on the basis of only one symptom dimension. 

Marked difficulty having vaginal intercourse/penetration (Criterion A1) can vary froma total in- 
ability to experience vaginal penetration in any situation (e.g., intercourse, gynecological ex- 
aminations, tampon insertion) to the ability to easily experience penetration in one situation 
and but not in another. Although the most common clinical situation is when a woman is un- 
able to experience intercourse or penetration with a partner, difficulties in undergoing re- 
quired gynecological examinations may also be present. Marked vulvovaginal or pelvic pain 
during vaginal intercourse or penetration attempts (Criterion A2) refers to pain occurring in differ- 
ent locations in the genito-pelvic area. Location of pain as well as intensity should be assessed. 
Typically, pain can be characterized as superficial (vulvovaginal or occurring during penetra- 
tion) or deep (pelvic; i-e., not felt until deeper penetration). The intensity of the pain is often not 
linearly related to distress or interference with sexual intercourse or other sexual activities. 
Some genito-pelvic pain only occurs when provoked (i.e., by intercourse or mechanical stim- 


438 Sexual Dysfunctions 


ulation); other genito-pelvic pain may be spontaneous as well as provoked. Genito-pelvic pain 
can also be usefully characterized qualitatively (e.g., “burning,” “cutting,” “shooting,” “throb- 
bing”). The pain may persist for a period after intercourse is completed and may also occur 
during urination. Typically, the pain experienced during sexual intercourse can be reproduced 
during a gynecological examination. 

Marked fear or anxiety about vulvovaginal or pelvic pain either in anticipation of, or during, or 
as a result of vaginal penetration (Criterion A3) is commonly reported by women who have 
regularly experienced pain during sexual intercourse. This “normal” reaction may lead to 
avoidance of sexual/intimate situations. In other cases, this marked fear does not appear 
to be closely related to the experience of pain but nonetheless leads to avoidance of inter- 
course and vaginal penetration situations. Some have described this as similar to a phobic 
reaction except that the phobic object may be vaginal penetration or the fear of pain. 

Marked tensing or tightening of the pelvic floor muscles during attempted vaginal penetration 
(Criterion A4) can vary from reflexive-like spasm of the pelvic floor in response to at- 
tempted vaginal entry to “normal/voluntary” muscle guarding in response to the antici- 
pated or the repeated experience of pain or to fear or anxiety. In the case of “normal/ 
guarding” reactions, penetration may be possible under circumstances of relaxation. The 
characterization and assessment of pelvic floor dysfunction is often best undertaken by a 
specialist gynecologist or by a pelvic floor physical therapist. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder is frequently associated with other sexual dysfunc- 
tions, particularly reduced sexual desire and interest (female sexual interest /arousal disor- 
der). Sometimes desire and interest are preserved in sexual situations that are not painful or 
do not require penetration. Even when individuals with genito-pelvic pain/penetration dis- 
order report sexual interest /motivation, there is often behavioral avoidance of sexual situ- 
ations and opportunities. Avoidance of gynecological examinations despite medical 
recommendations is also frequent. The pattern of avoidance is similar to that seen in phobic 
disorders. It is common for women who have not succeeded in having sexual intercourse to 
come for treatment only when they wish to conceive. Many women with genito-pelvic pain/ 
penetration disorder will experience associated relationship /marital problems; they also of- 
ten report that the symptoms significantly diminish their feelings of femininity. 

In addition to the subtype “lifelong/acquired,” five factors should be considered dur- 
ing assessment and diagnosis of genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder because they 
may be relevant to etiology and/or treatment: 1) partner factors (e.g., partner’s sexual 
problems, partner’s health status); 2) relationship factors (e.g., poor communication, dis- 
crepancies in desire for sexual activity); 3) individual vulnerability factors (e.g., poor body 
image, history of sexual or emotional abuse), psychiatric comorbidity (e.g., depression, 
anxiety), or stressors (e.g., job loss, bereavement); 4) cultural/religious factors (e.g., inhi- 
bitions related to prohibitions against sexual activity; attitudes toward sexuality); and 
5) medical factors relevant to prognosis, course, or treatment. Each of these factors may 
contribute differently to the presenting symptoms of different women with this disorder. 

There are no valid physiological measures of any of the component symptom dimen- 
sions of genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder. Validated psychometric inventories may 
be used to formally assess the pain and anxiety components related to genito-pelvic pain/ 
penetration disorder. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder is unknown. However, approx- 
imately 15% of women in North America report recurrent pain during intercourse. Diffi- 
culties having intercourse appear to be a frequent referral to sexual dysfunction clinics and 
to specialist clinicians. 


Genito-Pelvic Pain/Penetration Disorder 439 


Development and Course 


The development and course of genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder is unclear. Because 
women generally do not seek treatment until they experience problems in sexual functioning, 
it can, in general, be difficult to characterize genito-pelvic pain /penetration disorder as life- 
long (primary) or acquired (secondary). Although women typically come to clinical atten- 
tion after the initiation of sexual activity, there are often earlier clinical signs. For example, 
difficulty with or the avoidance of use of tampons is an important predictor of later problems. 
Difficulties with vaginal penetration (inability or fear or pain) may not be obvious until sex- 
ual intercourse is attempted. Even once intercourse is attempted, the frequency of attempts 
may not be significant or regular. In cases where it is difficult to establish whether symptom- 
atology is lifelong or acquired, it is useful to determine the presence of any consistent period 
of successful pain-, fear-, and tension-free intercourse. If the experience of such a period can 
be established, then genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder can be characterized as ac- 
quired. Once symptomatology is well established for a period of approximately 6 months, 
the probability of spontaneous and significant symptomatic remission appears to diminish. 

Complaints related to genito-pelvic pain peak during early adulthood and in the peri- 
and postmenopausal period. Women with complaints about difficulty having intercourse 
appear to be primarily premenopausal. There may also be an increase in genito-pelvic 
pain-related symptoms in the postpartum period. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Sexual and/or physical abuse have often been cited as predictors of the 
DSM-IV-defined sexual pain disorders dyspareunia and vaginismus. This is a matter of con- 
troversy in the current literature. 


Genetic and physiological. Women experiencing superficial pain during sexual inter- 
course often report the onset of the pain after a history of vaginal infections. Even after the in- 
fections have resolved and there are no known residual physical findings, the pain persists. 
Pain during tampon insertion or the inability to insert tampons before any sexual contact has 
been attempted is an important risk factor for genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In the past, inadequate sexual education and religious orthodoxy have often been consid- 
ered to be culturally related predisposing factors to the DSM-IV diagnosis of vaginismus. 
This perception appears to be confirmed by recent reports from Turkey, a primarily Mus- 
lim country, indicating a strikingly high prevalence for the disorder. However, most avail- 
able research, although limited in scope, does not support this notion (Lahaie et al. 2010). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


By definition, the diagnosis of genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder is only given to 
women. There is relatively new research concerning urological chronic pelvic pain syn- 
drome in men, suggesting that men may experience some similar problems. The research 
and clinical experience are not sufficiently developed yet to justify the application of this 
diagnosis to men. Other specified sexual dysfunction or unspecified sexual dysfunction 
may be diagnosed in men appearing to fit this pattern. 


Functional Consequences of 
Genito-Pelvic Pain/Penetration Disorder 


Functional difficulties in genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder are often associated 
with interference in relationship satisfaction and sometimes with the ability to conceive 
via penile/vaginal intercourse. 


440 Sexual Dysfunctions 


Differential Diagnosis 


Another medical condition. In many instances, women with genito-pelvic pain/pene- 
tration disorder will also be diagnosed with another medical condition (e.g., lichen scle- 
rosus, endometriosis, pelvic inflammatory disease, vulvovaginal atrophy). In some cases, 
treating the medical condition may alleviate the genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder. 
Much of the time, this is not the case. There are no reliable tools or diagnostic methods to 
allow clinicians to know whether the medical condition or genito-pelvic pain/ penetration 
disorder is primary. Often, the associated medical conditions are difficult to diagnose and 
treat. For example, the increased incidence of postmenopausal pain during intercourse 
may sometimes be attributable to vaginal dryness or vulvovaginal atrophy associated with 
declining estrogen levels. The relationship, however, between vulvovaginal atrophy /dry- 
ness, estrogen, and pain is not well understood. 


Somatic symptom and related disorders. Some women with genito-pelvic pain/pene- 
tration disorder may also be diagnosable with somatic symptom disorder. Since both 
genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder and the somatic symptom and related disorders 
are new diagnoses, it is not yet clear whether they can be reliably differentiated. Some 
women diagnosed with genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder will also be diagnosed 
with a specific phobia. 

Inadequate sexual stimuli. It is important that the clinician, in considering differential diag- 
noses, assess the adequacy of sexual stimuli within the woman’s sexual experience. Sexual sit- 
uations in which there is inadequate foreplay or arousal may lead to difficulties in penetration, 
pain, or avoidance. Erectile dysfunction or premature ejaculation in the male partner may 
result in difficulties with penetration. These conditions should be carefully assessed. In some 
situations, a diagnosis of genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder may not be appropriate. 


Comorbidity 


Comorbidity between genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder and other sexual difficul- 
ties appears to be common. Comorbidity with relationship distress is also common. This is 
not surprising, since in Western cultures the inability to have (pain-free) intercourse with 
a desired partner and the avoidance of sexual opportunities may be either a contributing 
factor to or the result of other sexual or relationship problems. Because pelvic floor symp- 
toms are implicated in the diagnosis of genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder, there is 
likely to be a higher prevalence of other disorders related to the pelvic floor or reproduc- 
tive organs (e.g., interstitial cystitis, constipation, vaginal infection, endometriosis, irrita- 
ble bowel syndrome). 


Male Hypoactive Sexual Desire Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.71 (F52.0) 


A. Persistently or recurrently deficient (or absent) sexual/erotic thoughts or fantasies and 
desire for sexual activity. The judgment of deficiency is made by the clinician, taking 
into account factors that affect sexual functioning, such as age and general and socio- 
cultural contexts of the individual's life. 

B. The symptoms in Criterion A have persisted for a minimum duration of approximately 
6 months. 

C. The symptoms in Criterion A cause clinically significant distress in the individual. 

D. The sexual dysfunction is not better explained by a nonsexual mental disorder or as a 
consequence of severe relationship distress or other significant stressors and is not at- 
tributable to thes effects of a substance/medication or another medical condition. 


Male Hypoactive Sexual Desire Disorder 441 


Specify whether: 
Lifelong: The disturbance has been present since the individual became sexually 
active. 
Acquired: The disturbance began after a period of relatively normal sexual function. 


Specify whether: 
Generalized: Not limited to certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 
Situational: Only occurs with certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Evidence of mild distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Moderate: Evidence of moderate distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 
Severe: Evidence of severe or extreme distress over the symptoms in Criterion A. 


Diagnostic Features 


When an assessment for male hypoactive sexual desire disorder is being made, inter- 
personal context must be taken into account. A “desire discrepancy,” in which a man has 
lower desire for sexual activity than his partner, is not sufficient to diagnose male hypo- 
active sexual desire disorder. Both low/absent desire for sex and deficient/absent sexual 
thoughts or fantasies are required for a diagnosis of the disorder. There may be variation 
across men in how sexual desire is expressed. 

The lack of desire for sex and deficient/absent erotic thoughts or fantasies must be per- 
sistent or recurrent and must occur for a minimum duration of approximately 6 months. 
The inclusion of this duration criterion is meant to safeguard against making a diagnosis in 
cases in which a man’s low sexual desire may represent an adaptive response to adverse 
life conditions (e.g., concern about a partner’s pregnancy when the man is considering ter- 
minating the relationship). The introduction of “approximately” in Criterion B allows for 
clinician judgment in cases in which symptom duration does not meet the recommended 
6-month threshold. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Male hypoactive sexual desire disorder is sometimes associated with erectile and/or ejac- 
ulatory concerns. For example, persistent difficulties obtaining an erection may lead aman 
to lose interest in sexual activity. Men with hypoactive sexual desire disorder often report 
that they no longer initiate sexual activity and that they are minimally receptive to a part- 
ner’s attempt to initiate. Sexual activities (e.g., masturbation or partnered sexual activity) 
may sometimes occur even in the presence of low sexual desire. Relationship-specific pref- 
erences regarding patterns of sexual initiation must be taken into account when making a 
diagnosis of male hypoactive sexual desire disorder. Although men are more likely to ini- 
tiate sexual activity, and thus low desire may be characterized by a pattern of non-initiation, 
many men may prefer to have their partner initiate sexual activity. In such situations, the 
man’s lack of receptivity to a partner’s initiation should be considered when evaluating low 
desire. 

In addition to the subtypes “lifelong /acquired” and “generalized /situational,” the fol- 
lowing five factors must be considered during assessment and diagnosis of male hypo- 
active sexual desire disorder given that they may be relevant to etiology and/or treatment: 
1) partner factors (e.g., partner’s sexual problems, partner’s health status); 2) relationship 
factors (e.g., poor communication, discrepancies in desire for sexual activity); 3) individ- 
ual vulnerability factors (e.g., poor body image, history of sexual or emotional abuse), psy- 
chiatric comorbidity (e.g., depression, anxiety), or stressors (e.g., job loss, bereavement); 
4) cultural/religious factors (e.g., inhibitions related to prohibitions against sexual activity; 
attitudes toward sexuality); and 5) medical factors relevant to prognosis, course, or treat- 


442 Sexual Dysfunctions 


ment. Each of these factors may contribute differently to the presenting symptoms of dif- 
ferent men with this disorder. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of male hypoactive sexual desire disorder varies depending on country of 
origin and method of assessment. Approximately 6% of younger men (ages 18-24 years) 
and 41% of older men (ages 66-74 years) have problems with sexual desire. However, a 
persistent lack of interest in sex, lasting 6 months or more, affects only a small proportion 
of men ages 16-44 (1.8%). 


Development and Course 


By definition, lifelong male hypoactive sexual desire disorder indicates that low or no sex- 
ual desire has always been present, whereas the acquired subtype would be assigned if the 
man’s low desire developed after a period of normal sexual desire. There is a requirement 
that low desire persist for approximately 6 months or more; thus, short-term changes in 
sexual desire should not be diagnosed as male hypoactive sexual desire disorder. 

There is a normative age-related decline in sexual desire. Like women, men identify a 
variety of triggers for their sexual desire, and they describe a wide range of reasons that 
they choose to engage in sexual activity. Although erotic visual cues may be more potent 
elicitors of desire in younger men, the potency of sexual cues may decrease with age and 
must be considered when evaluating men for hypoactive sexual desire disorder. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Mood and anxiety symptoms appear to be strong predictors of low de- 
sire in men. Up to half of men with a past history of psychiatric symptoms may have mod- 
erate or severe loss of desire, compared with only 15% of those without such a history. A 
man’s feelings about himself, his perception of his partner’s sexual desire toward him, 
feelings of being emotionally connected, and contextual variables may all negatively (as 
well as positively) affect sexual desire. 


Environmental. Alcohol use may increase the occurrence of low desire. Among gay men, 
self-directed homophobia, interpersonal problems, attitudes, lack of adequate sex educa- 
tion, and trauma resulting from early life experiences must be taken into account in ex- 
plaining the low desire. Social and cultural contextual factors should also be considered. 


Genetic and physiological. Endocrine disorders such as hyperprolactinemia signifi- 
cantly affect sexual desire in men. Age is a significant risk factor for low desire in men. It is 
unclear whether or not men with low desire also have abnormally low levels of testoster- 
one; however, among hypogonadal men, low desire is common. There also may be a crit- 
ical threshold below which testosterone will affect sexual desire in men and above which 
there is little effect of testosterone on men’s desire. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There is marked variability in prevalence rates of low desire across cultures, ranging from 
12.5% in Northern European men to 28% in Southeast Asian men ages 40-80 years. Just as 
there are higher rates of low desire among East Asian subgroups of women, men of East 
Asian ancestry also have higher rates of low desire. Guilt about sex may mediate this as- 
sociation between East Asian ethnicity and sexual desire in men. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In contrast to the classification of sexual disorders in women, desire and arousal disorders 
have been retained as separate constructs in men. Despite some similarities in the experi- 


Premature (Early) Ejaculation 443 


ence of desire across men and women, and the fact that desire fluctuates over time and is 
dependent on contextual factors, men do report a significantly higher intensity and fre- 
quency of sexual desire compared with women. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nonsexual mental disorders. Nonsexual mental disorders, such as major depressive 
disorder, which is characterized by “markedly diminished interest or pleasure in all, or al- 
most all, activities,” may explain the lack of sexual desire. If the lack of desire is better 
explained by another mental disorder, then a diagnosis of male hypoactive sexual desire 
disorder would not be made. 


Substance/medication use. Substance/medication use may explain the lack of sexual 
desire. 


Another medical condition. If the low/absent desire and deficient /absent erotic thoughts 
or fantasies are better explained by the effects of another medical condition (e.g., hypogo- 
nadism, diabetes mellitus, thyroid dysfunction, central nervous system disease), then a di- 
agnosis of male hypoactive sexual desire disorder would not be made. 


Interpersonal factors. If interpersonal or significant contextual factors, such as severe 
relationship distress or other significant stressors, are associated with the loss of desire in 
the man, then a diagnosis of male hypoactive sexual desire disorder would not be made. 


Other sexual dysfunctions. The presence of another sexual dysfunction does not rule out a 
diagnosis of male hypoactive sexual desire disorder; there is some evidence that up to one-half 
of men with low sexual desire also have erectile difficulties, and slightly fewer may also have 
early ejaculation difficulties. If the man’s low desire is explained by self-identification as an 
asexual, then a diagnosis of male hypoactive sexual desire disorder is not made. 


Comorbidity 


Depression and other mental disorders, as well as endocrinological factors, are often co- 
morbid with male hypoactive sexual desire disorder. 


Premature (Early) Ejaculation 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.75 (F52.4) 


A. A persistent or recurrent pattern of ejaculation occurring during partnered sexual activ- 
ity within approximately 1 minute following vaginal penetration and before the individ- 
ual wishes it. 

Note: Although the diagnosis of premature (early) ejaculation may be applied to indi- 
viduals engaged in nonvaginal sexual activities, specific duration criteria have not been 
established for these activities. 


B. The symptom in Criterion A must have been present for at least 6 months and must be 
experienced on almost all or all (approximately 75%—100%) occasions of sexual activ- 
ity (in identified situational contexts or, if generalized, in all contexts). 

C. The symptom in Criterion A causes clinically significant distress in the individual. 

D. The sexual dysfunction is not better explained by a nonsexual mental disorder or as a 
consequence of severe relationship distress or other significant stressors and is not at- 
tributable to the effects of a substance/medication or another medical condition. 


Specify whether: 
Lifelong: The disturbance has been present since the individual became sexually active. 
Acquired: The disturbance began after a period of relatively normal sexual function. 


444 Sexual Dysfunctions 


Specify whether: 
Generalized: Not limited to certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 
Situational: Only occurs with certain types of stimulation, situations, or partners. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Ejaculation occurring within approximately 30 seconds to 1 minute of vaginal 
penetration. 
Moderate: Ejaculation occurring within approximately 15-30 seconds of vaginal pen- 
etration. 
Severe: Ejaculation occurring prior to sexual activity, at the start of sexual activity, or 
within approximately 15 seconds of vaginal penetration. 


Diagnostic Features 


Premature (early) ejaculation is manifested by ejaculation that occurs prior to or shortly af- 
ter vaginal penetration, operationalized by an individual's estimate of ejaculatory latency 
(i.e., elapsed time before ejaculation) after vaginal penetration. Estimated and measured 
intravaginal ejaculatory latencies are highly correlated as long as the ejaculatory latency is 
of short duration; therefore, self-reported estimates of ejaculatory latency are sufficient for 
diagnostic purposes. A 60-second intravaginal ejaculatory latency time is an appropriate 
cutoff for the diagnosis of lifelong premature (early) ejaculation in heterosexual men. 
There are insufficient data to determine if this duration criterion can be applied to ac- 
quired premature (early) ejaculation. The durational definition may apply to males of 
varying sexual orientations, since ejaculatory latencies appear to be similar across men of 
different sexual orientations and across different sexual activities. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Many males with premature (early) ejaculation complain of a sense of lack of control over 
ejaculation and report apprehension about their anticipated inability to delay ejaculation 
on future sexual encounters. 

The following factors may be relevant in the evaluation of any sexual dysfunction: 
1) partner factors (e.g., partner’s sexual problems, partner’s health status); 2) relationship fac- 
tors (e.g., poor communication, discrepancies in desire for sexual activity); 3) individual 
vulnerability factors (e.g., poor body image, history of sexual or emotional abuse), psychiatric 
comorbidity (e.g., depression, anxiety), and stressors (e.g., job loss, bereavement); 4) cultural/ 
religious factors (e.g., inhibitions related to prohibitions against sexual activity; attitudes 
toward sexuality); and 5) medical factors relevant to prognosis, course, or treatment. 


Prevalence 


Estimates of the prevalence of premature (early) ejaculation vary widely depending on the 
definition utilized. Internationally, more than 20%-30% of men ages 18-70 years report 
concern about how rapidly they ejaculate. With the new definition of premature (early) 
ejaculation (i.e., ejaculation occurring within approximately 1 minute of vaginal penetra- 
tion), only 1%-3% of men would be diagnosed with the disorder. Prevalence of premature 
(early) ejaculation may increase with age. 


Development and Course 


By definition, lifelong premature (early) ejaculation starts during a male’s initial sexual ex- 
periences and persists thereafter. Some men may experience premature (early) ejaculation 
during their initial sexual encounters but gain ejaculatory control over time. It is the persis- 
tence of ejaculatory problems for longer than 6 months that determines the diagnosis of pre- 
mature (early) ejaculation. In contrast, some men develop the disorder after a period of 


Premature (Early) Ejaculation 445 


having a normal ejaculatory latency, known as acquired premature (early) ejaculation. There is 
far less known about acquired premature (early) ejaculation than about lifelong premature 
(early) ejaculation. The acquired form likely has a later onset, usually appearing during or af- 
ter the fourth decade of life. Lifelong is relatively stable throughout life. Little is known about 
the course of acquired premature (early) ejaculation. Reversal of medical conditions such as 
hyperthyroidism and prostatitis appears to restore ejaculatory latencies to baseline values. 
Lifelong premature (early) ejaculation begins with early sexual experiences and persists 
throughout an individual's life. In approximately 20% of men with premature (early) ejacu- 
lation, ejaculatory latencies decrease further with age. Age and relationship length have been 
found to be negatively associated with prevalence of premature (early) ejaculation. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Premature (early) ejaculation may be more common in men with anx- 
iety disorders, especially social anxiety disorder (social phobia). 


Genetic and physiological. There is a moderate genetic contribution to lifelong prema- 
ture (early) ejaculation. Premature (early) ejaculation may be associated with dopamine 
transporter gene polymorphism or serotonin transporter gene polymorphism. Thyroid 
disease, prostatitis, and drug withdrawal are associated with acquired premature (early) 
ejaculation. Positron emission tomography measures of regional cerebral blood flow dur- 
ing ejaculation have shown primary activation in the mesocephalic transition zone, includ- 
ing the ventral tegmental area. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Perception of what constitutes a normal ejaculatory latency is different in many cultures. 
Measured ejaculatory latencies may differ in some countries. Such differences may be ex- 
plained by cultural or religious factors as well as genetic differences between populations. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Premature (early) ejaculation is a sexual disorder in males. Males and their sexual partners 
may differ in their perception of what constitutes an acceptable ejaculatory latency. There 
may be increasing concerns in females about early ejaculation in their sexual partners, 
which may be a reflection of changing societal attitudes concerning female sexual activity. 


Diagnostic Markers 

Ejaculatory latency is usually monitored in research settings by the sexual partner utilizing 
a timing device (e.g., stopwatch), though this is not ideal in real-life sexual situations. For 
vaginal intercourse, the time between intravaginal penetration and ejaculation is measured. 


Functional Consequences of 
Premature (Early) Ejaculation 


A pattern of premature (early) ejaculation may be associated with decreased self-esteem, a 
sense of lack of control, and adverse consequences for partner relationships. It may also 
cause personal distress in the sexual partner and decreased sexual satisfaction in the sexual 
partner. Ejaculation prior to penetration may be associated with difficulties in conception. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunction. When problems with premature 
ejaculation are due exclusively to substance use, intoxication, or withdrawal, substance/ 
medication-induced sexual dysfunction should be diagnosed. 


446 Sexual Dysfunctions 


Ejaculatory concerns that do not meet diagnostic criteria. It is necessary to identify 
males with normal ejaculatory latencies who desire longer ejaculatory latencies and males 
who have episodic premature (early) ejaculation (e.g., during the first sexual encounter 
with a new partner when a short ejaculatory latency may be common or normative). Neither 
of these situations would lead to a diagnosis of premature (early) ejaculation, even though 
these situations may be distressing to some males. 


Comorbidity 


Premature (early) ejaculation may be associated with erectile problems. In many cases, it 
may be difficult to determine which difficulty preceded the other. Lifelong premature 
(early) ejaculation may be associated with certain anxiety disorders. Acquired premature 
(early) ejaculation may be associated with prostatitis, thyroid disease, or drug withdrawal 
(e.g., during opioid withdrawal). 


Substance/Medication-Induced 
Sexual Dysfunction 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A clinically significant disturbance in sexual function is predominant in the clinical picture. 
B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of both 
(1) and (2): 


1. The symptoms in Criterion A developed during or soon after substance intoxication 
or withdrawal or after exposure to a medication. 

2. The involved substance/medication is capable of producing the symptoms in Crite- 
rion A. 


C. The disturbance is not better explained by a sexual dysfunction that is not substance/ 
medication-induced. Such evidence of an independent sexual dysfunction could in- 
clude the following: 


The symptoms precede the onset of the substance/medication use; the symptoms 
persist for a substantial period of time (e.g., about 1 month) after the cessation of 
acute withdrawal or severe intoxication; or there is other evidence suggesting the 
existence of an independent non-substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunc- 
tion (e.g., a history of recurrent non-substance/medication-related episodes). 


D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress in the individual. 


Note: This diagnosis should be made instead of a diagnosis of substance intoxication or 
substance withdrawal only when the symptoms in Criterion A predominate in the clinical 
picture and are sufficiently severe to warrant clinical attention. 

Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance/medica- 
tion]-induced sexual dysfunctions are indicated in the table below. Note that the ICD-10-CM 
code depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance use disorder present for the 
same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance- 
induced sexual dysfunction, the 4th position character is “1,” and the clinician should record 
“mild [substance] use disorder’ before the substance-induced sexual dysfunction (e.g., “mild 
cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced sexual dysfunction”). If a moderate or severe 
substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance-induced sexual dysfunction, the 4th 
position character is “2,” and the clinician should record “moderate [substance] use disorder” 
or “severe [substance] use disorder,” depending on the severity of the comorbid substance 


Substance/Medication-Induced Sexual Dysfunction 447 


use disorder. If there is no comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one-time heavy 
use of the substance), then the 4th position character is “9,” and the clinician should record 
only the substance-induced sexual dysfunction. 


ICD-10-CM 
With use 
With use disorder, Without 
disorder, moderate use 
ICD-9-CM mild or severe disorder 
Alcohol 291.89 F10.181 F10.281 F10.981 
Opioid 292.89 F11.181 F11.281 F11.981 
Sedative, hypnotic, or 292.89 F13.181 F13.281 F13.981 
anxiolytic 
Amphetamine (or other 292.89 F15.181 F15.281 F15.981 
stimulant) 
Cocaine 292.89 F14.181 F14.281 F14.981 


Other (or unknown) substance 292.89 F19.181 F19.281 F19.981 


Specify if (see Table 1 in the chapter “Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders” for di- 
agnoses associated with substance class): 
With onset during intoxication: If the criteria are met for intoxication with the sub- 
stance and the symptoms develop during intoxication. 
With onset during withdrawal: If criteria are met for withdrawal from the substance 
and the symptoms develop during, or shortly after, withdrawal. 
With onset after medication use: Symptoms may appear either at initiation of medi- 
cation or after a modification or change in use. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Occurs on 25%—50% of occasions of sexual activity. 
Moderate: Occurs on 50%-—75% of occasions of sexual activity. 
Severe: Occurs on 75% or more of occasions of sexual activity. 


Recording Procedures 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunction begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., alcohol, fluoxetine) that is presumed to be causing the 
sexual dysfunction. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria 
set, which is based on the drug class. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes 
(e.g., fluoxetine), the code for “other substance” should be used; and in cases in which a 
substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance is un- 
known, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder is followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during in- 
toxication, onset during withdrawal, with onset after medication use), followed by the se- 
verity specifier (e.g., mild, moderate, severe). Unlike the recording procedures for ICD-10- 
CM, which combine the substance-induced disorder and substance use disorder into a sin- 
gle code, for ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is given for the substance use disorder. 
For example, in the case of erectile dysfunction occurring during intoxication in a man 
with a severe alcohol use disorder, the diagnosis is 291.89 alcohol-induced sexual dysfunc- 
tion, with onset during intoxication, moderate. An additional diagnosis of 303.90 severe 
alcohol use disorder is also given. When more than one substance is judged to play a sig- 


448 Sexual Dysfunctions 


nificant role in the development of the sexual dysfunction, each should be listed separately 
(e.g., 292.89 cocaine-induced sexual dysfunction with onset during intoxication, moderate; 
292.89 fluoxetine-induced sexual dysfunction, with onset after medication use). 


ICD-10-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunction begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., alcohol, fluoxetine) that is presumed to be causing the 
sexual dysfunction. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria 
set, which is based on the drug class and presence or absence of a comorbid substance use 
disorder. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., fluoxetine), the code for 
“other substance” should be used; and in cases in which a substance is judged to be an eti- 
ological factor but the specific class of substance is unknown, the category “unknown sub- 
stance” should be used. 

When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) 
is listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the substance-induced 
sexual dysfunction, followed by the specification of onset (i.e., onset during intoxication, 
onset during withdrawal, with onset after medication use), followed by the severity spec- 
ifier (e.g., mild, moderate, severe). For example, in the case of erectile dysfunction occur- 
ring during intoxication in a man with a severe alcohol use disorder, the diagnosis is 
F10.281 moderate alcohol use disorder with alcohol-induced sexual dysfunction, with on- 
set during intoxication, moderate. A separate diagnosis of the comorbid severe alcohol use 
disorder is not given. If the substance-induced sexual dysfunction occurs without a co- 
morbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one-time heavy use of the substance), no ac- 
companying substance use disorder is noted (e.g., F15.981 amphetamine-induced sexual 
dysfunction, with onset during intoxication). When more than one substance is judged to 
play a significant role in the development of the sexual dysfunction, each should be listed 
separately (e.g., F14.181 mild cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced sexual dysfunc- 
tion, with onset during intoxication, moderate; F19.981 fluoxetine-induced sexual dys- 
function, with onset after medication use, moderate). 


Diagnostic Features 


The major feature is a disturbance in sexual function that has a temporal relationship with 
substance / medication initiation, dose increase, or substance / medication discontinuation. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Sexual dysfunctions can occur in association with intoxication with the following classes of 
substances: alcohol; opioids; sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics; stimulants (including co- 
caine); and other (or unknown) substances. Sexual dysfunctions can occur in association 
with withdrawal from the following classes of substances: alcohol; opioids; sedatives, hyp- 
notics, or anxiolytics; and other (or unknown) substances. Medications that can induce sex- 
ual dysfunctions include antidepressants, antipsychotics, and hormonal contraceptives. 

The most commonly reported side effect of antidepressant drugs is difficulty with or- 
gasm or ejaculation. Problems with desire and erection are less frequent. Approximately 
30% of sexual complaints are clinically significant. Certain agents, such as bupropion and 
mirtazapine, appear not to be associated with sexual side effects. 

The sexual problems associated with antipsychotic drugs, including problems with 
sexual desire, erection, lubrication, ejaculation, or orgasm, have occurred with typical as 
well as atypical agents. However, problems are less common with prolactin-sparing anti- 
psychotics than with agents that cause significant prolactin elevation. 

Although the effects of mood stabilizers on sexual function are unclear, it is possible 
that lithium and anticonvulsants, with the possible exception of lamotrigine, have adverse 
effects on sexual desire. Problems with orgasm may occur with gabapentin. Similarly, there 
may be a higher prevalence of erectile and orgasmic problems associated with benzodiaz- 
epines. There have not been such reports with buspirone. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Sexual Dysfunction 449 


Many nonpsychiatric medications, such as cardiovascular, cytotoxic, gastrointestinal, 
and hormonal agents, are associated with disturbances in sexual function. Illicit substance 
use is associated with decreased sexual desire, erectile dysfunction, and difficulty reach- 
ing orgasm. Sexual dysfunctions are also seen in individuals receiving methadone but are 
seldom reported by patients receiving buprenorphine. Chronic alcohol abuse and chronic 
nicotine abuse are associated with erectile problems. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence and the incidence of substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunction 
are unclear, likely because of underreporting of treatment-emergent sexual side effects. 
Data on substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunction typically concern the effects of 
antidepressant drugs. The prevalence of antidepressant-induced sexual dysfunction var- 
ies in part depending on the specific agent. Approximately 25%-80% of individuals taking 
monoamine oxidase inhibitors, tricyclic antidepressants, serotonergic antidepressants, 
and combined serotonergic-adrenergic antidepressants report sexual side effects. There 
are differences in the incidence of sexual side effects between some serotonergic and com- 
bined adrenergic-serotonergic antidepressants, although it is unclear if these differences 
are clinically significant. 

Approximately 50% of individuals taking antipsychotic medications will experience 
adverse sexual side effects, including problems with sexual desire, erection, lubrication, 
ejaculation, or orgasm. The incidence of these side effects among different antipsychotic 
agents is unclear. 

Exact prevalence and incidence of sexual dysfunctions among users of nonpsychiatric 
medications such as cardiovascular, cytotoxic, gastrointestinal, and hormonal agents are 
unknown. Elevated rates of sexual dysfunction have been reported with methadone or 
high-dose opioid drugs for pain. There are increased rates of decreased sexual desire, erec- 
tile dysfunction, and difficulty reaching orgasm associated with illicit substance use. The 
prevalence of sexual problems appears related to chronic drug abuse and appears higher 
in individuals who abuse heroin (approximately 60%-70%) than in individuals who abuse 
amphetamines or 3,4-methylenedioxymethamphetamine (i.e., MDMA, ecstasy). Elevated 
rates of sexual dysfunction are also seen in individuals receiving methadone but are sel- 
dom reported by patients receiving buprenorphine. Chronic alcohol abuse and chronic 
nicotine abuse are related to higher rates of erectile problems. 


Development and Course 


The onset of antidepressant-induced sexual dysfunction may be as early as 8 days after the 
agent is first taken. Approximately 30% of individuals with mild to moderate orgasm de- 
lay will experience spontaneous remission of the dysfunction within 6 months. In some 
cases, serotonin reuptake inhibitor-induced sexual dysfunction may persist after the 
agent is discontinued. The time to onset of sexual dysfunction after initiation of antipsy- 
chotic drugs or drugs of abuse is unknown. It is probable that the adverse effects of nico- 
tine and alcohol may not appear until after years of use. Premature (early) ejaculation can 
sometimes occur after cessation of opioid use. There is some evidence that disturbances in 
sexual function related to substance/medication use increase with age. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There may be an interaction among cultural factors, the influence of medications on sexual 
functioning, and the response of the individual to those changes. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Some gender differences in sexual side effects may exist. 


450 Sexual Dysfunctions 


Functional Consequences of 
Substance/Medication-Induced Sexual Dysfunction 


Medication-induced sexual dysfunction may result in medication noncompliance. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Non-substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunctions. Many mental conditions, such 
as depressive, bipolar, anxiety, and psychotic disorders, are associated with disturbances 
of sexual function. Thus, differentiating a substance /medication-induced sexual dys- 
function from a manifestation of the underlying mental disorder can be quite difficult. The 
diagnosis is usually established if a close relationship between substance /medication ini- 
tiation or discontinuation is observed. A clear diagnosis can be established if the problem 
occurs after substance/ medication initiation, dissipates with substance /medication dis- 
continuation, and recurs with introduction of the same agent. Most substance /medication-in- 
duced side effects occur shortly after initiation or discontinuation. Sexual side effects that 
only occur after chronic use of a substance /medication may be extremely difficult to di- 
agnose with certainty. 


Other Specified Sexual Dysfunction 
302.79 (F52.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a sexual dys- 
function that cause clinically significant distress in the individual predominate but do not 
meet the full criteria for any of the disorders in the sexual dysfunctions diagnostic class. 
The other specified sexual dysfunction category is used in situations in which the clinician 
chooses to communicate the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the cri- 
teria for any specific sexual dysfunction. This is done by recording “other specified sexual 
dysfunction” followed by the specific reason (e.g., “sexual aversion’). 


Unspecified Sexual Dysfunction 
302.70 (F52.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a sexual dys- 
function that cause clinically significant distress in the individual predominate but do not 
meet the full criteria for any of the disorders in the sexual dysfunctions diagnostic class. 
The unspecified sexual dysfunction category is used in situations in which the clinician 
chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for a specific sexual dys- 
function, and includes presentations for which there is insufficient information to make a 
more specific diagnosis. 


Gender 
Dysphoria 


In this chapter, there is one overarching diagnosis of gender dysphoria, with sepa- 
rate developmentally appropriate criteria sets for children and for adolescents and adults. 
The area of sex and gender is highly controversial and has led to a proliferation of terms 
whose meanings vary over time and within and between disciplines. An additional source 
of confusion is that in English “sex” connotes both male/female and sexuality. This chapter 
employs constructs and terms as they are widely used by clinicians from various disci- 
plines with specialization in this area. In this chapter, sex and sexual refer to the biological 
indicators of male and female (understood in the context of reproductive capacity), such 
as in sex chromosomes, gonads, sex hormones, and nonambiguous internal and external 
genitalia. Disorders of sex development denote conditions of inborn somatic deviations of 
the reproductive tract from the norm and/or discrepancies among the biological indica- 
tors of male and female. Cross-sex hormone treatment denotes the use of feminizing hor- 
mones in an individual assigned male at birth based on traditional biological indicators or 
the use of masculinizing hormones in an individual assigned female at birth. 

The need to introduce the term gender arose with the realization that for individuals 
with conflicting or ambiguous biological indicators of sex (i.e., “intersex”, the lived role in 
society and/or the identification as male or female could not be uniformly associated with 
or predicted from the biological indicators and, later, that some individuals develop an 
identity as female or male at variance with their uniform set of classical biological indica- 
tors. Thus, gender is used to denote the public (and usually legally recognized) lived role as 
boy or girl, man or woman, but, in contrast to certain social constructionist theories, biolog- 
ical factors are seen as contributing, in interaction with social and psychological factors, to 
gender development. Gender assignment refers to the initial assignment as male or female. 
This occurs usually at birth and, thereby, yields the “natal gender.” Gender-atypical refers to 
somatic features or behaviors that are not typical (in a statistical sense) of individuals with 
the same assigned gender in a given society and historical era; for behavior, gender-noncon- 
forming is an alternative descriptive term. Gender reassignment denotes an official (and usu- 
ally legal) change of gender. Gender identity is a category of social identity and refers to an 
individual’s identification as male, female, or, occasionally, some category other than male 
or female. Gender dysphoria as a general descriptive term refers to an individual's affective/ 
cognitive discontent with the assigned gender but is more specifically defined when used 
as a diagnostic category. Transgender refers to the broad spectrum of individuals who tran- 
siently or persistently identify with a gender different from their natal gender. Transsexual 
denotes an individual who seeks, or has undergone, a social transition from male to female 
or female to male, which in many, but not all, cases also involves a somatic transition by 
cross-sex hormone treatment and genital surgery (sex reassignment surgery). 

Gender dysphoria refers to the distress that may accompany the incongruence between 
one’s experienced or expressed gender and one’s assigned gender. Although not all indi- 
viduals will experience distress as a result of such incongruence, many are distressed if the 
desired physical interventions by means of hormones and/or surgery are not available. 
The current term is more descriptive than the previous DSM-IV term gender identity disor- 
der and focuses on dysphoria as the clinical problem, not identity per se. 


451 


452 Gender Dysphoria 


Gender Dysphoria 
Diagnostic Criteria 


Gender Dysphoria in Children 302.6 (F64.2) 


A. A marked incongruence between one’s experienced/expressed gender and assigned 
gender, of at least 6 months’ duration, as manifested by at least six of the following 
(one of which must be Criterion A1): 


1. Astrong desire to be of the other gender or an insistence that one is the other gen- 
der (or some alternative gender different from one’s assigned gender). 

2. In boys (assigned gender), a strong preference for cross-dressing or simulating fe- 
male attire; or in girls (assigned gender), a strong preference for wearing only typ- 
ical masculine clothing and a strong resistance to the wearing of typical feminine 
clothing. 

3. A strong preference for cross-gender roles in make-believe play or fantasy play. 

4. A strong preference for the toys, games, or activities stereotypically used or en- 
gaged in by the other gender. 

5. A strong preference for playmates of the other gender. 

6. In boys (assigned gender), a strong rejection of typically masculine toys, games, 
and activities and a strong avoidance of rough-and-tumble play; or in girls (as- 
signed gender), a strong rejection of typically feminine toys, games, and activities. 

7. Astrong dislike of one’s sexual anatomy. 

8. A strong desire for the primary and/or secondary sex characteristics that match 
one’s experienced gender. 


B. The condition is associated with clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 
school, or other important areas of functioning. 

Specify if: 
With a disorder of sex development (e.g., a congenital adrenogenital disorder such 
as 255.2 [E25.0] congenital adrenal hyperplasia or 259.50 [E34.50] androgen insensi- 
tivity syndrome). 
Coding note: Code the disorder of sex development as well as gender dysphoria. 


Gender Dysphoria in Adolescents and Adults 302.85 (F64.1) 


A. A marked incongruence between one’s experienced/expressed gender and assigned 
gender, of at least 6 months’ duration, as manifested by at least two of the following: 


1. A marked incongruence between one’s experienced/expressed gender and pri- 
mary and/or secondary sex characteristics (or in young adolescents, the antici- 
pated secondary sex characteristics). 

2. Astrong desire to be rid of one’s primary and/or secondary sex characteristics be- 
cause of a marked incongruence with one’s experienced/expressed gender (or in 
young adolescents, a desire to prevent the development of the anticipated second- 
ary sex characteristics). 

3. A strong desire for the primary and/or secondary sex characteristics of the other 
gender. 

4. Astrong desire to be of the other gender (or some alternative gender different from 
one’s assigned gender). 

5. A strong desire to be treated as the other gender (or some alternative gender dif- 
ferent from one’s assigned gender). 

6. Astrong conviction that one has the typical feelings and reactions of the other gen- 
der (or some alternative gender different from one’s assigned gender). 


Gender Dysphoria 453 


B. The condition is associated with clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 
occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

Specify if: 
With a disorder of sex development (e.g., a congenital adrenogenital disorder such 
as 255.2 [E25.0] congenital adrenal hyperplasia or 259.50 [E34.50] androgen insensi- 
tivity syndrome). 
Coding note: Code the disorder of sex development as well as gender dysphoria. 


Specify if: 
Posttransition: The individual has transitioned to full-time living in the desired gender 
(with or without legalization of gender change) and has undergone (or is preparing to 
have) at least one cross-sex medical procedure or treatment regimen—namely, regu- 
lar cross-sex hormone treatment or gender reassignment surgery confirming the desired 
gender (e.g., penectomy, vaginoplasty in a natal male; mastectomy or phalloplasty in 
a natal female). 


Specifiers 
The posttransition specifier may be used in the context of continuing treatment procedures 
that serve to support the new gender assignment. 


Diagnostic Features 


Individuals with gender dysphoria have a marked incongruence between the gender they 
have been assigned to (usually at birth, referred to as natal gender) and their experienced / 
expressed gender. This discrepancy is the core component of the diagnosis. There must 
also be evidence of distress about this incongruence. Experienced gender may include al- 
ternative gender identities beyond binary stereotypes. Consequently, the distress is not 
limited to a desire to simply be of the other gender, but may include a desire to be of an al- 
ternative gender, provided that it differs from the individual’s assigned gender. 

Gender dysphoria manifests itself differently in different age groups. Prepubertal natal 
girls with gender dysphoria may express the wish to be a boy, assert they are a boy, or as- 
sert they will grow up to be a man. They prefer boys’ clothing and hairstyles, are often 
perceived by strangers as boys, and may ask to be called by a boy’s name. Usually, they dis- 
play intense negative reactions to parental attempts to have them wear dresses or other 
feminine attire. Some may refuse to attend school or social events where such clothes are 
required. These girls may demonstrate marked cross-gender identification in role-playing, 
dreams, and fantasies. Contact sports, rough-and-tumble play, traditional boyhood games, 
and boys as playmates are most often preferred. They show little interest in stereotypically 
feminine toys (e.g., dolls) or activities (e.g., feminine dress-up or role-play). Occasionally, 
they refuse to urinate in a sitting position. Some natal girls may express a desire to have a 
penis or claim to have a penis or that they will grow one when older. They may also state that 
they do not want to develop breasts or menstruate. 

Prepubertal natal boys with gender dysphoria may express the wish to be a girl or as- 
sert they are a girl or that they will grow up to be a woman. They have a preference for 
dressing in girls’ or women’s clothes or may improvise clothing from available materials 
(e.g., using towels, aprons, and scarves for long hair or skirts). These children may role- 
play female figures (e.g., playing “mother”) and often are intensely interested in female 
fantasy figures. Traditional feminine activities, stereotypical games, and pastimes (e.g., 
“playing house”; drawing feminine pictures; watching television or videos of favorite fe- 
male characters) are most often preferred. Stereotypical female-type dolls (e.g., Barbie) are 
often favorite toys, and girls are their preferred playmates. They avoid rough-and-tumble 
play and competitive sports and have little interest in stereotypically masculine toys (e.g., 
cars, trucks). Some may pretend not to have a penis and insist on sitting to urinate. More 


454 Gender Dysphoria 


rarely, they may state that they find their penis or testes disgusting, that they wish them re- 
moved, or that they have, or wish to have, a vagina. 

In young adolescents with gender dysphoria, clinical features may resemble those of 
children or adults with the condition, depending on developmental level. As secondary 
sex characteristics of young adolescents are not yet fully developed, these individuals may 
not state dislike of them, but they are concerned about imminent physical changes. 

In adults with gender dysphoria, the discrepancy between experienced gender and 
physical sex characteristics is often, but not always, accompanied by a desire to be rid of 
primary and/or secondary sex characteristics and/or a strong desire to acquire some pri- 
mary and/or secondary sex characteristics of the other gender. To varying degrees, adults 
with gender dysphoria may adopt the behavior, clothing, and mannerisms of the experi- 
enced gender. They feel uncomfortable being regarded by others, or functioning in soci- 
ety, as members of their assigned gender. Some adults may have a strong desire to be of a 
different gender and treated as such, and they may have an inner certainty to feel and re- 
spond as the experienced gender without seeking medical treatment to alter body char- 
acteristics. They may find other ways to resolve the incongruence between experienced / 
expressed and assigned gender by partially living in the desired role or by adopting a gen- 
der role neither conventionally male nor conventionally female. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


When visible signs of puberty develop, natal boys may shave their legs at the first signs of 
hair growth. They sometimes bind their genitals to make erections less visible. Girls may 
bind their breasts, walk with a stoop, or use loose sweaters to make breasts less visible. In- 
creasingly, adolescents request, or may obtain without medical prescription and supervi- 
sion, hormonal suppressors (“blockers”) of gonadal steroids (e.g., gonadotropin-releasing 
hormone [GnRH] analog, spironolactone). Clinically referred adolescents often want hor- 
mone treatment and many also wish for gender reassignment surgery. Adolescents living in 
an accepting environment may openly express the desire to be and be treated as the experi- 
enced gender and dress partly or completely as the experienced gender, have a hairstyle typ- 
ical of the experienced gender, preferentially seek friendships with peers of the other gender, 
and/or adopt a new first name consistent with the experienced gender. Older adolescents, 
when sexually active, usually do not show or allow partners to touch their sexual organs. For 
adults with an aversion toward their genitals, sexual activity is constrained by the preference 
that their genitals not be seen or touched by their partners. Some adults may seek hormone 
treatment (sometimes without medical prescription and supervision) and gender reassign- 
ment surgery. Others are satisfied with either hormone treatment or surgery alone. 

Adolescents and adults with gender dysphoria before gender reassignment are at in- 
creased risk for suicidal ideation, suicide attempts, and suicides. After gender reassign- 
ment, adjustment may vary, and suicide risk may persist. 


Prevalence 


For natal adult males, prevalence ranges from 0.005% to 0.014%, and for natal females, 
from 0.002% to 0.003%. Since not all adults seeking hormone treatment and surgical reas- 
signment attend specialty clinics, these rates are likely modest underestimates. Sex differ- 
ences in rate of referrals to specialty clinics vary by age group. In children, sex ratios of 
natal boys to girls range from 2:1 to 4.5:1. In adolescents, the sex ratio is close to parity; in 
adults, the sex ratio favors natal males, with ratios ranging from 1:1 to 6.1:1. In two coun- 
tries, the sex ratio appears to favor natal females (Japan: 2.2:1; Poland: 3.4:1). 


Development and Course 


Because expression of gender dysphoria varies with age, there are separate criteria sets for 
children versus adolescents and adults. Criteria for children are defined in a more con- 


Gender Dysphoria 455 


crete, behavioral manner than those for adolescents and adults. Many of the core criteria 
draw on well-documented behavioral gender differences between typically developing 
boys and girls. Young children are less likely than older children, adolescents, and adults 
to express extreme and persistent anatomic dysphoria. In adolescents and adults, incon- 
gruence between experienced gender and somatic sex is a central feature of the diagnosis. 
Factors related to distress and impairment also vary with age. A very young child may 
show signs of distress (e.g., intense crying) only when parents tell the child that he or she 
is “really” not a member of the other gender but only “desires” to be. Distress may not be 
manifest in social environments supportive of the child’s desire to live in the role of the 
other gender and may emerge only if the desire is interfered with. In adolescents and 
adults, distress may manifest because of strong incongruence between experienced gender 
and somatic sex. Such distress may, however, be mitigated by supportive environments and 
knowledge that biomedical treatments exist to reduce incongruence. Impairment (e.g., 
school refusal, development of depression, anxiety, and substance abuse) may be a conse- 
quence of gender dysphoria. 


Gender dysphoria without a disorder of sex development. For clinic-referred children, 
onset of cross-gender behaviors is usually between ages 2 and 4 years. This corresponds to 
the developmental time period in which most typically developing children begin ex- 
pressing gendered behaviors and interests. For some preschool-age children, both perva- 
sive cross-gender behaviors and the expressed desire to be the other gender may be 
present, or, more rarely, labeling oneself as a member of the other gender may occur. In 
some cases, the expressed desire to be the other gender appears later, usually at entry into 
elementary school. A small minority of children express discomfort with their sexual anat- 
omy or will state the desire to have a sexual anatomy corresponding to the experienced 
gender (“anatomic dysphoria”). Expressions of anatomic dysphoria become more com- 
mon as children with gender dysphoria approach and anticipate puberty. 

Rates of persistence of gender dysphoria from childhood into adolescence or adulthood 
vary. In natal males, persistence has ranged from 2.2% to 30%. In natal females, persistence 
has ranged from 12% to 50%. Persistence of gender dysphoria is modestly correlated with 
dimensional measures of severity ascertained at the time of a childhood baseline assess- 
ment. In one sample of natal males, lower socioeconomic background was also modestly 
correlated with persistence. It is unclear if particular therapeutic approaches to gender 
dysphoria in children are related to rates of long-term persistence. Extant follow-up sam- 
ples consisted of children receiving no formal therapeutic intervention or receiving ther- 
apeutic interventions of various types, ranging from active efforts to reduce gender 
dysphoria to a more neutral, “watchful waiting” approach. It is unclear if children “en- 
couraged” or supported to live socially in the desired gender will show higher rates of per- 
sistence, since such children have not yet been followed longitudinally in a systematic 
manner. For both natal male and female children showing persistence, almost all are 
sexually attracted to individuals of their natal sex. For natal male children whose gender 
dysphoria does not persist, the majority are androphilic (sexually attracted to males) and of- 
ten self-identify as gay or homosexual (ranging from 63% to 100%). In natal female chil- 
dren whose gender dysphoria does not persist, the percentage who are gynephilic (sexually 
attracted to females) and self-identify as lesbian is lower (ranging from 32% to 50%). 

In both adolescent and adult natal males, there are two broad trajectories for develop- 
ment of gender dysphoria: early onset and late onset. Early-onset gender dysphoria starts in 
childhood and continues into adolescence and adulthood; or, there is an intermittent pe- 
riod in which the gender dysphoria desists and these individuals self-identify as gay or ho- 
mosexual, followed by recurrence of gender dysphoria. Late-onset gender dysphoria occurs 
around puberty or much later in life. Some of these individuals report having had a desire 
to be of the other gender in childhood that was not expressed verbally to others. Others do 
not recall any signs of childhood gender dysphoria. For adolescent males with late-onset 
gender dysphoria, parents often report surprise because they did not see signs of gender 


456 Gender Dysphoria 


dysphoria during childhood. Expressions of anatomic dysphoria are more common and 
salient in adolescents and adults once secondary sex characteristics have developed. 

Adolescent and adult natal males with early-onset gender dysphoria are almost al- 
ways sexually attracted to men (androphilic). Adolescents and adults with late-onset gen- 
der dysphoria frequently engage in transvestic behavior with sexual excitement. The 
majority of these individuals are gynephilic or sexually attracted to other posttransition 
natal males with late-onset gender dysphoria. A substantial percentage of adult males 
with late-onset gender dysphoria cohabit with or are married to natal females. After gen- 
der transition, many self-identify as lesbian. Among adult natal males with gender dyspho- 
ria, the early-onset group seeks out clinical care for hormone treatment and reassignment 
surgery at an earlier age than does the late-onset group. The late-onset group may have more 
fluctuations in the degree of gender dysphoria and be more ambivalent about and less 
likely satisfied after gender reassignment surgery. 

In both adolescent and adult natal females, the most common course is the early-onset 
form of gender dysphoria. The late-onset form is much less common in natal females com- 
pared with natal males. As in natal males with gender dysphoria, there may have been a 
period in which the gender dysphoria desisted and these individuals self-identified as les- 
bian; however, with recurrence of gender dysphoria, clinical consultation is sought, often 
with the desire for hormone treatment and reassignment surgery. Parents of natal adoles- 
cent females with the late-onset form also report surprise, as no signs of childhood gender 
dysphoria were evident. Expressions of anatomic dysphoria are much more common and 
salient in adolescents and adults than in children. 

Adolescent and adult natal females with early-onset gender dysphoria are almost 
always gynephilic. Adolescents and adults with the late-onset form of gender dysphoria 
are usually androphilic and after gender transition self-identify as gay men. Natal females 
with the late-onset form do not have co-occurring transvestic behavior with sexual ex- 
citement. 


Gender dysphoria in association with a disorder of sex development. Most individuals 
with a disorder of sex development who develop gender dysphoria have already come to 
medical attention at an early age. For many, starting at birth, issues of gender assignment 
were raised by physicians and parents. Moreover, as infertility is quite common for this 
group, physicians are more willing to perform cross-sex hormone treatments and genital 
surgery before adulthood. 

Disorders of sex development in general are frequently associated with gender-atypi- 
cal behavior starting in early childhood. However, in the majority of cases, this does not 
lead to gender dysphoria. As individuals with a disorder of sex development become 
aware of their medical history and condition, many experience uncertainty about their 
gender, as opposed to developing a firm conviction that they are another gender. How- 
ever, most do not progress to gender transition. Gender dysphoria and gender transition 
may vary considerably as a function of a disorder of sex development, its severity, and as- 
signed gender. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. For individuals with gender dysphoria without a disorder of sex de- 
velopment, atypical gender behavior among individuals with early-onset gender dyspho- 
ria develops in early preschool age, and it is possible that a high degree of atypicality 
makes the development of gender dysphoria and its persistence into adolescence and 
adulthood more likely. 


Environmental. Among individuals with gender dysphoria without a disorder of sex de- 
velopment, males with gender dysphoria (in both childhood and adolescence) more com- 
monly have older brothers than do males without the condition. Additional predisposing 


Gender Dysphoria 457 


factors under consideration, especially in individuals with late-onset gender dysphoria (ad- 
olescence, adulthood), include habitual fetishistic transvestism developing into autogyne- 
philia (i.e., sexual arousal associated with the thought or image of oneself as a woman) and 
other forms of more general social, psychological, or developmental problems. 


Genetic and physiological. For individuals with gender dysphoria without a disorder of 
sex development, some genetic contribution is suggested by evidence for (weak) familial- 
ity of transsexualism among nontwin siblings, increased concordance for transsexualism 
in monozygotic compared with dizygotic same-sex twins, and some degree of heritability 
of gender dysphoria. As to endocrine findings, no endogenous systemic abnormalities in 
sex-hormone levels have been found in 46,XY individuals, whereas there appear to be in- 
creased androgen levels (in the range found in hirsute women but far below normal male 
levels) in 46,XX individuals. Overall, current evidence is insufficient to label gender dys- 
phoria without a disorder of sex development as a form of intersexuality limited to the cen- 
tral nervous system. 

In gender dysphoria associated with a disorder of sex development, the likelihood of 
later gender dysphoria is increased if prenatal production and utilization (via receptor 
sensitivity) of androgens are grossly atypical relative to what is usually seen in individuals 
with the same assigned gender. Examples include 46,XY individuals with a history of nor- 
mal male prenatal hormone milieu but inborn nonhormonal genital defects (as in cloacal 
bladder exstrophy or penile agenesis) and who have been assigned to the female gender. 
The likelihood of gender dysphoria is further enhanced by additional, prolonged, highly 
gender-atypical postnatal androgen exposure with somatic virilization as may occur in fe- 
male-raised and noncastrated 46,XY individuals with 5-alpha reductase-2 deficiency or 
17-beta-hydroxysteroid dehydrogenase-3 deficiency or in female-raised 46,XX individuals 
with classical congenital adrenal hyperplasia with prolonged periods of non-adherence to 
glucocorticoid replacement therapy. However, the prenatal androgen milieu is more 
closely related to gendered behavior than to gender identity. Many individuals with dis- 
orders of sex development and markedly gender-atypical behavior do not develop gender 
dysphoria. Thus, gender-atypical behavior by itself should not be interpreted as an indi- 
cator of current or future gender dysphoria. There appears to be a higher rate of gender 
dysphoria and patient-initiated gender change from assigned female to male than from as- 
signed male to female in 46,XY individuals with a disorder of sex development. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Individuals with gender dysphoria have been reported across many countries and cul- 
tures. The equivalent of gender dysphoria has also been reported in individuals living in 
cultures with institutionalized gender categories other than male or female. It is unclear 
whether with these individuals the diagnostic criteria for gender dysphoria would be met. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Individuals with a somatic disorder of sex development show some correlation of final 
gender identity outcome with the degree of prenatal androgen production and utilization. 
However, the correlation is not robust enough for the biological factor, where ascertain- 
able, to replace a detailed and comprehensive diagnostic interview evaluation for gender 
dysphoria. 


Functional Consequences of Gender Dysphoria 


Preoccupation with cross-gender wishes may develop at all ages after the first 2-3 years of 
childhood and often interfere with daily activities. In older children, failure to develop 
age-typical same-sex peer relationships and skills may lead to isolation from peer groups 
and to distress. Some children may refuse to attend school because of teasing and harass- 


458 Gender Dysphoria 


ment or pressure to dress in attire associated with their assigned sex. Also in adolescents 
and adults, preoccupation with cross-gender wishes often interferes with daily activities. 
Relationship difficulties, including sexual relationship problems, are common, and func- 
tioning at school or at work may be impaired. Gender dysphoria, along with atypical 
gender expression, is associated with high levels of stigmatization, discrimination, and 
victimization, leading to negative self-concept, increased rates of mental disorder comor- 
bidity, school dropout, and economic marginalization, including unemployment, with at- 
tendant social and mental health risks, especially in individuals from resource-poor family 
backgrounds. In addition, these individuals’ access to health services and mental health 
services may be impeded by structural barriers, such as institutional discomfort or inex- 
perience in working with this patient population. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nonconformity to gender roles. Gender dysphoria should be distinguished from sim- 
ple nonconformity to stereotypical gender role behavior by the strong desire to be of an- 
other gender than the assigned one and by the extent and pervasiveness of gender-variant 
activities and interests. The diagnosis is not meant to merely describe nonconformity to 
stereotypical gender role behavior (e.g., “tomboyism” in girls, “girly-boy” behavior in 
boys, occasional cross-dressing in adult men). Given the increased openness of atypical 
gender expressions by individuals across the entire range of the transgender spectrum, it 
is important that the clinical diagnosis be limited to those individuals whose distress and 
impairment meet the specified criteria. 


Transvestic disorder. Transvestic disorder occurs in heterosexual (or bisexual) adoles- 
cent and adult males (rarely in females) for whom cross-dressing behavior generates sex- 
ual excitement and causes distress and/or impairment without drawing their primary 
gender into question. It is occasionally accompanied by gender dysphoria. An individual 
with transvestic disorder who also has clinically significant gender dysphoria can be given 
both diagnoses. In many cases of late-onset gender dysphoria in gynephilic natal males, 
transvestic behavior with sexual excitement is a precursor. 


Body dysmorphic disorder. An individual with body dysmorphic disorder focuses on 
the alteration or removal of a specific body part because it is perceived as abnormally formed, 
not because it represents a repudiated assigned gender. When an individual’s presenta- 
tion meets criteria for both gender dysphoria and body dysmorphic disorder, both diag- 
noses can be given. Individuals wishing to have a healthy limb amputated (termed by 
some body integrity identity disorder) because it makes them feel more “complete” usually 
do not wish to change gender, but rather desire to live as an amputee or a disabled person. 


Schizophrenia and other psychotic disorders. In schizophrenia, there may rarely be 
delusions of belonging to some other gender. In the absence of psychotic symptoms, in- 
sistence by an individual with gender dysphoria that he or she is of some other gender is 
not considered a delusion. Schizophrenia (or other psychotic disorders) and gender dys- 
phoria may co-occur. 


Other clinical presentations. Some individuals with an emasculinization desire who 
develop an alternative, nonmale/nonfemale gender identity do have a presentation that 
meets criteria for gender dysphoria. However, some males seek castration and/or penec- 
tomy for aesthetic reasons or to remove psychological effects of androgens without chang- 
ing male identity; in these cases, the criteria for gender dysphoria are not met. 


Comorbidity 


Clinically referred children with gender dysphoria show elevated levels of emotional and 
behavioral problems—most commonly, anxiety, disruptive and impulse-control, and de- 


Other Specified Gender Dysphoria 459 


pressive disorders. In prepubertal children, increasing age is associated with having more 
behavioral or emotional problems; this is related to the increasing non-acceptance of gen- 
der-variant behavior by others. In older children, gender-variant behavior often leads to 
peer ostracism, which may lead to more behavioral problems. The prevalence of mental 
health problems differs among cultures; these differences may also be related to differences 
in attitudes toward gender variance in children. However, also in some non-Western cul- 
tures, anxiety has been found to be relatively common in individuals with gender dysphoria, 
even in cultures with accepting attitudes toward gender-variant behavior. Autism spec- 
trum disorder is more prevalent in clinically referred children with gender dysphoria than 
in the general population. Clinically referred adolescents with gender dysphoria appear to 
have comorbid mental disorders, with anxiety and depressive disorders being the most 
common. As in children, autism spectrum disorder is more prevalent in clinically referred 
adolescents with gender dysphoria than in the general population. Clinically referred 
adults with gender dysphoria may have coexisting mental health problems, most commonly 
anxiety and depressive disorders. 


Other Specified Gender Dysphoria 
302.6 (F64.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of gender dys- 
phoria that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other 
important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for gender dys- 
phoria. The other specified gender dysphoria category is used in situations in which the 
clinician chooses to communicate the specific reason that the presentation does not meet 
the criteria for gender dysphoria. This is done by recording “other specified gender dys- 
phoria” followed by the specific reason (e.g., “brief gender dysphoria”). 

An example of a presentation that can be specified using the “other specified” desig- 
nation is the following: 

The current disturbance meets symptom criteria for gender dysphoria, but the 

duration is less than 6 months. 


Unspecified Gender Dysphoria 
302.6 (F64.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of gender dys- 
phoria that cause Clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or oth- 
er important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for gender 
dysphoria. The unspecified gender dysphoria category is used in situations in which the 
clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for gender dyspho- 
ria, and includes presentations in which there is insufficient information to make a more 
specific diagnosis. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Disruptive, Impulse-Control, 
and Conduct Disorders 


Disru ptive ; im pu Ise-control , and conduct disorders include conditions involv- 
ing problems in the self-control of emotions and behaviors. While other disorders in DSM- 
5 may also involve problems in emotional and/or behavioral regulation, the disorders in 
this chapter are unique in that these problems are manifested in behaviors that violate the 
rights of others (e.g., aggression, destruction of property) and/or that bring the individual 
into significant conflict with societal norms or authority figures. The underlying causes of 
the problems in the self-control of emotions and behaviors can vary greatly across the dis- 
orders in this chapter and among individuals within a given diagnostic category. 

The chapter includes oppositional defiant disorder, intermittent explosive disorder, con- 
duct disorder, antisocial personality disorder (which is described in the chapter “Personality 
Disorders”), pyromania, kleptomania, and other specified and unspecified disruptive, im- 
pulse-control, and conduct disorders. Although all the disorders in the chapter involve 
problems in both emotional and behavioral regulation, the source of variation among the 
disorders is the relative emphasis on problems in the two types of self-control. For example, 
the criteria for conduct disorder focus largely on poorly controlled behaviors that violate the 
rights of others or that violate major societal norms. Many of the behavioral symptoms (e.g., 
aggression) can be a result of poorly controlled emotions such as anger. At the other extreme, 
the criteria for intermittent explosive disorder focus largely on such poorly controlled emo- 
tion, outbursts of anger that are disproportionate to the interpersonal or other provocation 
or to other psychosocial stressors. Intermediate in impact to these two disorders is opposi- 
tional defiant disorder, in which the criteria are more evenly distributed between emotions 
(anger and irritation) and behaviors (argumentativeness and defiance). Pyromania and 
kleptomania are less commonly used diagnoses characterized by poor impulse control re- 
lated to specific behaviors (fire setting or stealing) that relieve internal tension. Other speci- 
fied disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder is a category for conditions in which 
there are symptoms of conduct disorder, oppositional defiant disorder, or other disruptive, 
impulse-control, and conduct disorders, but the number of symptoms does not meet the di- 
agnostic threshold for any of the disorders in this chapter, even though there is evidence of 
clinically significant impairment associated with the symptoms. 

The disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorders all tend to be more common in 
males than in females, although the relative degree of male predominance may differ both 
across disorders and within a disorder at different ages. The disorders in this chapter tend to 
have first onset in childhood or adolescence. In fact, itis very rare for either conduct disorder or 
oppositional defiant disorder to first emerge in adulthood. There is a developmental relation- 
ship between oppositional defiant disorder and conduct disorder, in that most cases of con- 
duct disorder previously would have met criteria for oppositional defiant disorder, at least in 
those cases in which conduct disorder emerges prior to adolescence. However, most children 
with oppositional defiant disorder do not eventually develop conduct disorder. Furthermore, 
children with oppositional defiant disorder are at risk for eventually developing other prob- 
lems besides conduct disorder, including anxiety and depressive disorders. 

Many of the symptoms that define the disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disor- 
ders are behaviors that can occur to some degree in typically developing individuals. 
Thus, it is critical that the frequency, persistence, pervasiveness across situations, and im- 


461 


462 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


pairment associated with the behaviors indicative of the diagnosis be considered relative 
to what is normative for a person’s age, gender, and culture when determining if they are 
symptomatic of a disorder. 

The disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorders have been linked to a common 
externalizing spectrum associated with the personality dimensions labeled as disinhibition 
and (inversely) constraint and, to a lesser extent, negative emotionality. These shared per- 
sonality dimensions could account for the high level of comorbidity among these disorders 
and their frequent comorbidity with substance use disorders and antisocial personality 
disorder. However, the specific nature of the shared diathesis that constitutes the exter- 
nalizing spectrum remains unknown. 


Oppositional Defiant Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 313.81 (F91.3) 


A. Apattern of angry/irritable mood, argumentative/defiant behavior, or vindictiveness lasting 
at least 6 months as evidenced by at least four symptoms from any of the following cate- 
gories, and exhibited during interaction with at least one individual who is not a sibling. 


Angry/irritable Mood 


1. Often loses temper. 
2. Is often touchy or easily annoyed. 
3. Is often angry and resentful. 


Argumentative/Defiant Behavior 


4. Often argues with authority figures or, for children and adolescents, with adults. 

5. Often actively defies or refuses to comply with requests from authority figures or 
with rules. 

6. Often deliberately annoys others. 

7. Often blames others for his or her mistakes or misbehavior. 


Vindictiveness 
8. Has been spiteful or vindictive at least twice within the past 6 months. 


Note: The persistence and frequency of these behaviors should be used to distinguish 
a behavior that is within normal limits from a behavior that is symptomatic. For children 
younger than 5 years, the behavior should occur on most days for a period of at least 
6 months unless otherwise noted (Criterion A8). For individuals 5 years or older, the 
behavior should occur at least once per week for at least 6 months, unless otherwise 
noted (Criterion A8). While these frequency criteria provide guidance on a minimal lev- 
el of frequency to define symptoms, other factors should also be considered, such as 
whether the frequency and intensity of the behaviors are outside a range that is nor- 
mative for the individual’s developmental level, gender, and culture. 


B. The disturbance in behavior is associated with distress in the individual or others in his or 
her immediate social context (e.g., family, peer group, work colleagues), or it impacts neg- 
atively on social, educational, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

C. The behaviors do not occur exclusively during the course of a psychotic, substance 
use, depressive, or bipolar disorder. Also, the criteria are not met for disruptive mood 
dysregulation disorder. 


Specify current severity: 


Mild: Symptoms are confined to only one setting (e.g., at home, at school, at work, with 
peers). 


Oppositional Defiant Disorder 463 


Moderate: Some symptoms are present in at least two settings. 
Severe: Some symptoms are present in three or more settings. 


Specifiers 

It is not uncommon for individuals with oppositional defiant disorder to show symptoms 
only at home and only with family members. However, the pervasiveness of the symp- 
toms is an indicator of the severity of the disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of oppositional defiant disorder is a frequent and persistent pattern 
of angry /irritable mood, argumentative/defiant behavior, or vindictiveness (Criterion 
A). It is not unusual for individuals with oppositional defiant disorder to show the behav- 
ioral features of the disorder without problems of negative mood. However, individuals 
with the disorder who show the angry /irritable mood symptoms typically show the be- 
havioral features as well. 

The symptoms of oppositional defiant disorder may be confined to only one setting, 
and this is most frequently the home. Individuals who show enough symptoms to meet 
the diagnostic threshold, even if it is only at home, may be significantly impaired in their 
social functioning. However, in more severe cases, the symptoms of the disorder are pres- 
ent in multiple settings. Given that the pervasiveness of symptoms is an indicator of the 
severity of the disorder, it is critical that the individual’s behavior be assessed across mul- 
tiple settings and relationships. Because these behaviors are common among siblings, they 
must be observed during interactions with persons other than siblings. Also, because 
symptoms of the disorder are typically more evident in interactions with adults or peers 
whom the individual knows well, they may not be apparent during a clinical examination. 

The symptoms of oppositional defiant disorder can occur to some degree in individu- 
als without this disorder. There are several key considerations for determining if the be- 
haviors are symptomatic of oppositional defiant disorder. First, the diagnostic threshold 
of four or more symptoms within the preceding 6 months must be met. Second, the per- 
sistence and frequency of the symptoms should exceed what is normative for an individ- 
ual’s age, gender, and culture. For example, it is not unusual for preschool children to 
show temper tantrums on a weekly basis. Temper outbursts for a preschool child would be 
considered a symptom of oppositional defiant disorder only if they occurred on most days 
for the preceding 6 months, if they occurred with at least three other symptoms of the dis- 
order, and if the temper outbursts contributed to the significant impairment associated 
with the disorder (e.g., led to destruction of property during outbursts, resulted in the 
child being asked to leave a preschool). 

The symptoms of the disorder often are part of a pattern of problematic interactions 
with others. Furthermore, individuals with this disorder typically do not regard themselves 
as angry, oppositional, or defiant. Instead, they often justify their behavior as a response to 
unreasonable demands or circumstances. Thus, it can be difficult to disentangle the rela- 
tive contribution of the individual with the disorder to the problematic interactions he or 
she experiences. For example, children with oppositional defiant disorder may have ex- 
perienced a history of hostile parenting, and it is often impossible to determine if the 
child’s behavior caused the parents to act ina more hostile manner toward the child, if the 
parents’ hostility led to the child’s problematic behavior, or if there was some combination 
of both. Whether or not the clinician can separate the relative contributions of potential 
causal factors should not influence whether or not the diagnosis is made. In the event that 
the child may be living in particularly poor conditions where neglect or mistreatment may 
occur (e.g., in institutional settings), clinical attention to reducing the contribution of the 
environment may be helpful. 


464 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


In children and adolescents, oppositional defiant disorder is more prevalent in families in 
which child care is disrupted by a succession of different caregivers or in families in which 
harsh, inconsistent, or neglectful child-rearing practices are common. Two of the most 
common co-occurring conditions with oppositional defiant disorder are attention-deficit/ 
hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) and conduct disorder (see the section “Comorbidity” for 
this disorder). Oppositional defiant disorder has been associated with increased risk for 
suicide attempts, even after comorbid disorders are controlled for. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of oppositional defiant disorder ranges from 1% to 11%, with an average 
prevalence estimate of around 3.3%. The rate of oppositional defiant disorder may vary 
depending on the age and gender of the child. The disorder appears to be somewhat more 
prevalent in males than in females (1.4:1) prior to adolescence. This male predominance is 
not consistently found in samples of adolescents or adults. 


Development and Course 


The first symptoms of oppositional defiant disorder usually appear during the preschool 
years and rarely later than early adolescence. Oppositional defiant disorder often precedes 
the development of conduct disorder, especially for those with the childhood-onset type 
of conduct disorder. However, many children and adolescents with oppositional defiant 
disorder do not subsequently develop conduct disorder. Oppositional defiant disorder 
also conveys risk for the development of anxiety disorders and major depressive disorder, 
even in the absence of conduct disorder. The defiant, argumentative, and vindictive symp- 
toms carry most of the risk for conduct disorder, whereas the angry-irritable mood symp- 
toms carry most of the risk for emotional disorders. 

Manifestations of the disorder across development appear consistent. Children and 
adolescents with oppositional defiant disorder are at increased risk for a number of prob- 
lems in adjustment as adults, including antisocial behavior, impulse-control problems, 
substance abuse, anxiety, and depression. 

Many of the behaviors associated with oppositional defiant disorder increase in fre- 
quency during the preschool period and in adolescence. Thus, it is especially critical dur- 
ing these development periods that the frequency and intensity of these behaviors be 
evaluated against normative levels before it is decided that they are symptoms of opposi- 
tional defiant disorder. 


Risk and Prognostic Features 


Temperamental. Temperamental factors related to problems in emotional regulation 
(e.g., high levels of emotional reactivity, poor frustration tolerance) have been predictive 
of the disorder. 


Environmental. Harsh, inconsistent, or neglectful child-rearing practices are common in 
families of children and adolescents with oppositional defiant disorder, and these parent- 
ing practices play an important role in many causal theories of the disorder. 


Genetic and physiological. A number of neurobiological markers (e.g., lower heart rate 
and skin conductance reactivity; reduced basal cortisol reactivity; abnormalities in the pre- 
frontal cortex and amygdala) have been associated with oppositional defiant disorder. 
However, the vast majority of studies have not separated children with oppositional de- 
fiant disorder from those with conduct disorder. Thus, it is unclear whether there are 
markers specific to oppositional defiant disorder. 


Oppositional Defiant Disorder 465 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The prevalence of the disorder in children and adolescents is relatively consistent across 
countries that differ in race and ethnicity. 


Functional Consequences of 
Oppositional Defiant Disorder 


When oppositional defiant disorder is persistent throughout development, individuals 
with the disorder experience frequent conflicts with parents, teachers, supervisors, peers, 
and romantic partners. Such problems often result in significant impairments in the indi- 
vidual’s emotional, social, academic, and occupational adjustment. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Conduct disorder. Conduct disorder and oppositional defiant disorder are both related 
to conduct problems that bring the individual in conflict with adults and other authority 
figures (e.g., teachers, work supervisors). The behaviors of oppositional defiant disorder 
are typically of a less severe nature than those of conduct disorder and do not include ag- 
gression toward people or animals, destruction of property, or a pattern of theft or deceit. 
Furthermore, oppositional defiant disorder includes problems of emotional dysregulation 
(i.e., angry and irritable mood) that are not included in the definition of conduct disorder. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. ADHD is often comorbid with oppositional de- 
fiant disorder. To make the additional diagnosis of oppositional defiant disorder, it is impor- 
tant to determine that the individual's failure to conform to requests of others is not solely in 
situations that demand sustained effort and attention or demand that the individual sit still. 


Depressive and bipolar disorders. Depressive and bipolar disorders often involve neg- 
ative affect and irritability. As a result, a diagnosis of oppositional defiant disorder should 
not be made if the symptoms occur exclusively during the course of a mood disorder. 


Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. Oppositional defiant disorder shares with dis- 
ruptive mood dysregulation disorder the symptoms of chronic negative mood and temper 
outbursts. However, the severity, frequency, and chronicity of temper outbursts are more 
severe in individuals with disruptive mood dysregulation disorder than in those with 
oppositional defiant disorder. Thus, only a minority of children and adolescents whose 
symptoms meet criteria for oppositional defiant disorder would also be diagnosed with dis- 
ruptive mood dysregulation disorder. When the mood disturbance is severe enough to meet 
criteria for disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, a diagnosis of oppositional defiant dis- 
order is not given, even if all criteria for oppositional defiant disorder are met. 


Intermittent explosive disorder. Intermittent explosive disorder also involves high 
rates of anger. However, individuals with this disorder show serious aggression toward 
others that is not part of the definition of oppositional defiant disorder. 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder). In individuals with intel- 
lectual disability, a diagnosis of oppositional defiant disorder is given only if the opposi- 
tional behavior is markedly greater than is commonly observed among individuals of 
comparable mental age and with comparable severity of intellectual disability. 


Language disorder. Oppositional defiant disorder must also be distinguished from a 
failure to follow directions that is the result of impaired language comprehension (e.g., 
hearing loss). 


Social anxiety disorder (social phobia). Oppositional defiant disorder must also be dis- 
tinguished from defiance due to fear of negative evaluation associated with social anxiety 
disorder. 


466 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


Comorbidity 


Rates of oppositional defiant disorder are much higher in samples of children, adoles- 
cents, and adults with ADHD, and this may be the result of shared temperamental risk fac- 
tors. Also, oppositional defiant disorder often precedes conduct disorder, although this 
appears to be most common in children with the childhood-onset subtype. Individuals 
with oppositional defiant disorder are also at increased risk for anxiety disorders and ma- 
jor depressive disorder, and this seems largely attributable to the presence of the angry- 
irritable mood symptoms. Adolescents and adults with oppositional defiant disorder also 
show a higher rate of substance use disorders, although it is unclear if this association is in- 
dependent of the comorbidity with conduct disorder. 


Intermittent Explosive Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 312.34 (F63.81) 


A. Recurrent behavioral outbursts representing a failure to control aggressive impulses 
as manifested by either of the following: 


1. Verbal aggression (e.g., temper tantrums, tirades, verbal arguments or fights) or 
physical aggression toward property, animals, or other individuals, occurring twice 
weekly, on average, for a period of 3 months. The physical aggression does not re- 
sult in damage or destruction of property and does not result in physical injury to 
animals or other individuals. 

2. Three behavioral outbursts involving damage or destruction of property and/or 
physical assault involving physical injury against animals or other individuals occur- 
ring within a 12-month period. 


B. The magnitude of aggressiveness expressed during the recurrent outbursts is grossly 
out of proportion to the provocation or to any precipitating psychosocial stressors. 

C. The recurrent aggressive outbursts are not premeditated (i.e., they are impulsive and/ 
or anger-based) and are not committed to achieve some tangible objective (e.g., 
money, power, intimidation). 

D. The recurrent aggressive outbursts cause either marked distress in the individual or 
impairment in occupational or interpersonal functioning, or are associated with finan- 
cial or legal consequences. 

. Chronological age is at least 6 years (or equivalent developmental level). 

F. The recurrent aggressive outbursts are not better explained by another mental disor- 
der (e.g., major depressive disorder, bipolar disorder, disruptive mood dysregulation 
disorder, a psychotic disorder, antisocial personality disorder, borderline personality 
disorder) and are not attributable to another medical condition (e.g., head trauma, Alz- 
heimer’s disease) or to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, 
a medication). For children ages 6-18 years, aggressive behavior that occurs as part 
of an adjustment disorder should not be considered for this diagnosis. 


m 


Note: This diagnosis can be made in addition to the diagnosis of attention-deficit/hyper- 
activity disorder, conduct disorder, oppositional defiant disorder, or autism spectrum dis- 
order when recurrent impulsive aggressive outbursts are in excess of those usually seen 
in these disorders and warrant independent clinical attention. 


Diagnostic Features 


The impulsive (or anger-based) aggressive outbursts in intermittent explosive disorder have 
a rapid onset and, typically, little or no prodromal period. Outbursts typically last for less 


Intermittent Explosive Disorder 467 


than 30 minutes and commonly occur in response to a minor provocation by a close intimate 
or associate. Individuals with intermittent explosive disorder often have less severe epi- 
sodes of verbal and/or nondamaging, nondestructive, or noninjurious physical assault (Cri- 
terion A1) in between more severe destructive /assaultive episodes (Criterion A2). Criterion 
Al defines frequent (i.e., twice weekly, on average, for a period of 3 months) aggressive out- 
bursts characterized by temper tantrums, tirades, verbal arguments or fights, or assault 
without damage to objects or without injury to animals or other individuals. Criterion A2 
defines infrequent (i.e., three in a 1-year period) impulsive aggressive outbursts character- 
ized by damaging or destroying an object, regardless of its tangible value, or by assaulting / 
striking or otherwise causing physical injury to an animal or to another individual. Regard- 
less of the nature of the impulsive aggressive outburst, the core feature of intermittent 
explosive disorder is failure to control impulsive aggressive behavior in response to subjec- 
tively experienced provocation (i.e., psychosocial stressor) that would not typically result in 
an aggressive outburst (Criterion B). The aggressive outbursts are generally impulsive and/ 
or anger-based, rather than premeditated or instrumental (Criterion C) and are associated 
with significant distress or impairment in psychosocial function (Criterion D). A diagnosis 
of intermittent explosive disorder should not be given to individuals younger than 6 years, 
or the equivalent developmental level (Criterion E), or to individuals whose aggressive out- 
bursts are better explained by another mental disorder (Criterion F). A diagnosis of intermit- 
tent explosive disorder should not be given to individuals with disruptive mood 
dysregulation disorder or to individuals whose impulsive aggressive outbursts are attribut- 
able to another medical condition or to the physiological effects of a substance (Criterion F). 
In addition, children ages 6-18 years should not receive this diagnosis when impulsive ag- 
gressive outbursts occur in the context of an adjustment disorder (Criterion F). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Mood disorders (unipolar), anxiety disorders, and substance use disorders are associated 
with intermittent explosive disorder, although onset of these disorders is typically later 
than that of intermittent explosive disorder. 


Prevalence 


One-year prevalence data for intermittent explosive disorder in the United States is about 
2.7% (narrow definition). Intermittent explosive disorder is more prevalent among 
younger individuals (e.g., younger than 35-40 years), compared with older individuals 
(older than 50 years), and in individuals with a high school education or less. 


Development and Course 


The onset of recurrent, problematic, impulsive aggressive behavior is most common in late 
childhood or adolescence and rarely begins for the first time after age 40 years. The core 
features of intermittent explosive disorder, typically, are persistent and continue for many 
years. 

The course of the disorder may be episodic, with recurrent periods of impulsive ag- 
gressive outbursts. Intermittent explosive disorder appears to follow a chronic and persis- 
tent course over many years. It also appears to be quite common regardless of the presence 
or absence of attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) or disruptive, impulse- 
control, and conduct disorders (e.g., conduct disorder, oppositional defiant disorder). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Individuals with a history of physical and emotional trauma during the 
first two decades of life are at increased risk for intermittent explosive disorder. 


468 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


Genetic and physiological. First-degree relatives of individuals with intermittent ex- 
plosive disorder are at increased risk for intermittent explosive disorder, and twin studies 
have demonstrated a substantial genetic influence for impulsive aggression. 

Research provides neurobiological support for the presence of serotonergic abnormal- 
ities, globally and in the brain, specifically in areas of the limbic system (anterior cingulate) 
and orbitofrontal cortex in individuals with intermittent explosive disorder. Amygdala 
responses to anger stimuli, during functional magnetic resonance imaging scanning, are 
greater in individuals with intermittent explosive disorder compared with healthy indi- 
viduals. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The lower prevalence of intermittent explosive disorder in some regions (Asia, Middle 
East) or countries (Romania, Nigeria), compared with the United States, suggests that in- 
formation about recurrent, problematic, impulsive aggressive behaviors either is not elic- 
ited on questioning or is less likely to be present, because of cultural factors. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In some studies the prevalence of intermittent explosive disorder is greater in males than 
in females (odds ratio = 1.4~2.3); other studies have found no gender difference. 


Functional Consequences of 
Intermittent Explosive Disorder 


Social (e.g., loss of friends, relatives, marital instability), occupational (e.g., demotion, loss 
of employment), financial (e.g., due to value of objects destroyed), and legal (e.g., civil 
suits as a result of aggressive behavior against person or property; criminal charges for as- 
sault) problems often develop as a result of intermittent explosive disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


A diagnosis of intermittent explosive disorder should not be made when Criteria Al and/ 
or A2 are only met during an episode of another mental disorder (e.g., major depressive 
disorder, bipolar disorder, psychotic disorder), or when impulsive aggressive outbursts 
are attributable to another medical condition or to the physiological effects of a substance 
or medication. This diagnosis also should not be made, particularly in children and ado- 
lescents ages 6-18 years, when the impulsive aggressive outbursts occur in the context of 
an adjustment disorder. Other examples in which recurrent, problematic, impulsive ag- 
gressive outbursts may, or may not, be diagnosed as intermittent explosive disorder in- 
clude the following. 


Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. In contrast to intermittent explosive disorder, 
disruptive mood dysregulation disorder is characterized by a persistently negative mood state 
(i.e., irritability, anger) most of the day, nearly every day, between impulsive aggressive out- 
bursts. A diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder can only be given when the on- 
set of recurrent, problematic, impulsive aggressive outbursts is before age 10 years. Finally, a 
diagnosis of disruptive mood dysregulation disorder should not be made for the first time 
after age 18 years. Otherwise, these diagnoses are mutually exclusive. 


Antisocial personality disorder or borderline personality disorder. Individuals with an- 
tisocial personality disorder or borderline personality disorder often display recurrent, 
problematic impulsive aggressive outbursts. However, the level of impulsive aggression 
in individuals with antisocial personality disorder or borderline personality disorder is 
lower than that in individuals with intermittent explosive disorder. 


Conduct Disorder 469 


Delirium, major neurocognitive disorder, and personality change due to another med- 
ical condition, aggressive type. A diagnosis of intermittent explosive disorder should not 
be made when aggressive outbursts are judged to result from the physiological effects of an- 
other diagnosable medical condition (e.g., brain injury associated with a change in personality 
characterized by aggressive outbursts; complex partial epilepsy). Nonspecific abnormalities 
on neurological examination (e.g., “soft signs”) and nonspecific electroencephalographic 
changes are compatible with a diagnosis of intermittent explosive disorder unless there is a di- 
agnosable medical condition that better explains the impulsive aggressive outbursts. 


Substance intoxication or substance withdrawal. A diagnosis of intermittent explosive 
disorder should not be made when impulsive aggressive outbursts are nearly always as- 
sociated with intoxication with or withdrawal from substances (e.g., alcohol, phencyclidine, 
cocaine and other stimulants, barbiturates, inhalants). However, when a sufficient number 
of impulsive aggressive outbursts also occur in the absence of substance intoxication or 
withdrawal, and these warrant independent clinical attention, a diagnosis of intermittent 
explosive disorder may be given. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, conduct disorder, oppositional defiant disor- 
der, or autism spectrum disorder. Individuals with any of these childhood-onset dis- 
orders may exhibit impulsive aggressive outbursts. Individuals with ADHD are typically 
impulsive and, as a result, may also exhibit impulsive aggressive outbursts. While indi- 
viduals with conduct disorder can exhibit impulsive aggressive outbursts, the form of ag- 
gression characterized by the diagnostic criteria is proactive and predatory. Aggression in 
oppositional defiant disorder is typically characterized by temper tantrums and verbal ar- 
guments with authority figures, whereas impulsive aggressive outbursts in intermittent 
explosive disorder are in response to a broader array of provocation and include physical 
assault. The level of impulsive aggression in individuals with a history of one or more of 
these disorders has been reported as lower than that in comparable individuals whose 
symptoms also meet intermittent explosive disorder Criteria A through E. Accordingly, if 
Criteria A through E are also met, and the impulsive aggressive outbursts warrant inde- 
pendent clinical attention, a diagnosis of intermittent explosive disorder may be given. 


Comorbidity 

Depressive disorders, anxiety disorders, and substance use disorders are most commonly 
comorbid with intermittent explosive disorder. In addition, individuals with antisocial 
personality disorder or borderline personality disorder, and individuals with a history of 
disorders with disruptive behaviors (e.g., ADHD, conduct disorder, oppositional defiant 
disorder), are at greater risk for comorbid intermittent explosive disorder. 


Conduct Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A repetitive and persistent pattern of behavior in which the basic rights of others or ma- 
jor age-appropriate societal norms or rules are violated, as manifested by the presence 
of at least three of the following 15 criteria in the past 12 months from any of the cate- 
gories below, with at least one criterion present in the past 6 months: 


Aggression to People and Animals 
1. Often bullies, threatens, or intimidates others. 
2. Often initiates physical fights. 


3. Has used a weapon that can cause serious physical harm to others (e.g., a bat, 
brick, broken bottle, knife, gun). 


470 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


4. Has been physically cruel to people. 

5. Has been physically cruel to animals. 

6. Has stolen while confronting a victim (e.g., mugging, purse snatching, extortion, 
armed robbery). 

7. Has forced someone into sexual activity. 


Destruction of Property 


8. Has deliberately engaged in fire setting with the intention of causing serious damage. 
9. Has deliberately destroyed others’ property (other than by fire setting). 


Deceitfulness or Theft 


10. Has broken into someone else’s house, building, or car. 

11. Often lies to obtain goods or favors or to avoid obligations (i.e., “cons” others). 

12. Has stolen items of nontrivial value without confronting a victim (e.g., shoplifting, 
but without breaking and entering; forgery). 


Serious Violations of Rules 
13. Often stays out at night despite parental prohibitions, beginning before age 13 years. 
14. Has run away from home overnight at least twice while living in the parental or pa- 
rental surrogate home, or once without returning for a lengthy period. 
15. Is often truant from school, beginning before age 13 years. 


B. The disturbance in behavior causes clinically significant impairment in social, aca- 
demic, or occupational functioning. 

C. lf the individual is age 18 years or older, criteria are not met for antisocial personality 
disorder. 


Specify whether: 
312.81 (F91.1) Childhood-onset type: Individuals show at least one symptom char- 
acteristic of conduct disorder prior to age 10 years. 
312.82 (F91.2) Adolescent-onset type: Individuals show no symptom characteristic 
of conduct disorder prior to age 10 years. 
312.89 (F91.9) Unspecified onset: Criteria for a diagnosis of conduct disorder are 
met, but there is not enough information available to determine whether the onset of 
the first symptom was before or after age 10 years. 

Specify if: 
With limited prosocial emotions: To qualify for this specifier, an individual must have dis- 
played at least two of the following characteristics persistently over at least 12 months and 
in multiple relationships and settings. These characteristics reflect the individual’s typical 
pattern of interpersonal and emotional functioning over this period and not just occasional 
occurrences in some situations. Thus, to assess the criteria for the specifier, multiple infor- 
mation sources are necessary. In addition to the individual’s self-report, it is necessary to 
consider reports by others who have known the individual for extended periods of time 
(e.g., parents, teachers, co-workers, extended family members, peers). 


Lack of remorse or guilt: Does not feel bad or guilty when he or she does some- 
thing wrong (exclude remorse when expressed only when caught and/or facing 
punishment). The individual shows a general lack of concern about the negative 
consequences of his or her actions. For example, the individual is not remorseful 
after hurting someone or does not care about the consequences of breaking rules. 
Callous—lack of empathy: Disregards and is unconcerned about the feelings of 
others. The individual is described as cold and uncaring. The person appears more 
concerned about the effects of his or her actions on himself or herself, rather than 
their effects on others, even when they result in substantial harm to others. 


Conduct Disorder 471 


Unconcerned about performance: Does not show concern about poor/problem- 
atic performance at school, at work, or in other important activities. The individual 
does not put forth the effort necessary to perform well, even when expectations are 
clear, and typically blames others for his or her poor performance. 

Shallow or deficient affect: Does not express feelings or show emotions to others, 
except in ways that seem shallow, insincere, or superficial (e.g., actions contradict the 
emotion displayed; can turn emotions “on” or “off’ quickly) or when emotional expres- 
sions are used for gain (e.g., emotions displayed to manipulate or intimidate others). 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Few if any conduct problems in excess of those required to make the diagnosis 
are present, and conduct problems cause relatively minor harm to others (e.g., lying, 
truancy, staying out after dark without permission, other rule breaking). 
Moderate: The number of conduct problems and the effect on others are intermediate 
between those specified in “mild” and those in “severe” (e.g., stealing without confront- 
ing a victim, vandalism). 
Severe: Many conduct problems in excess of those required to make the diagnosis are 
present, or conduct problems cause considerable harm to others (e.g., forced sex, physical 
cruelty, use of a weapon, stealing while confronting a victim, breaking and entering). 


Subtypes 


Three subtypes of conduct disorder are provided based on the age at onset of the disorder. 
Onset is most accurately estimated with information from both the youth and the care- 
giver; estimates are often 2 years later than actual onset. Both subtypes can occur ina mild, 
moderate, or severe form. An unspecified-onset subtype is designated when there is in- 
sufficient information to determine age at onset. 

In childhood-onset conduct disorder, individuals are usually male, frequently display 
physical aggression toward others, have disturbed peer relationships, may have had op- 
positional defiant disorder during early childhood, and usually have symptoms that meet 
full criteria for conduct disorder prior to puberty. Many children with this subtype also 
have concurrent attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) or other neurodevel- 
opmental difficulties. Individuals with childhood-onset type are more likely to have per- 
sistent conduct disorder into adulthood than are those with adolescent-onset type. As 
compared with individuals with childhood-onset type, individuals with adolescent-onset 
conduct disorder are less likely to display aggressive behaviors and tend to have more 
normative peer relationships (although they often display conduct problems in the com- 
pany of others). These individuals are less likely to have conduct disorder that persists into 
adulthood. The ratio of males to females with conduct disorder is more balanced for the 
adolescent-onset type than for the childhood-onset type. 


Specifiers 

A minority of individuals with conduct disorder exhibit characteristics that qualify for the 
“with limited prosocial emotions” specifier. The indicators of this specifier are those that 
have often been labeled as callous and unemotional traits in research. Other personality 
features, such as thrill seeking, fearlessness, and insensitivity to punishment, may also dis- 
tinguish those with characteristics described in the specifier. Individuals with character- 
istics described in this specifier may be more likely than other individuals with conduct 
disorder to engage in aggression that is planned for instrumental gain. Individuals with 
conduct disorder of any subtype or any level of severity can have characteristics that qual- 
ify for the specifier “with limited prosocial emotions,” although individuals with the spec- 
ifier are more likely to have childhood-onset type and a severity specifier rating of severe. 


472 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


Although the validity of self-report to assess the presence of the specifier has been sup- 
ported in some research contexts, individuals with conduct disorder with this specifier 
may not readily admit to the traits in a clinical interview. Thus, to assess the criteria for the 
specifier, multiple information sources are necessary. Also, because the indicators of the 
specifier are characteristics that reflect the individual's typical pattern of interpersonal and 
emotional functioning, it is important to consider reports by others who have known the 
individual for extended periods of time and across relationships and settings (e.g., par- 
ents, teachers, co-workers, extended family members, peers). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of conduct disorder is a repetitive and persistent pattern of behavior 
in which the basic rights of others or major age-appropriate societal norms or rules are vi- 
olated (Criterion A). These behaviors fall into four main groupings: aggressive conduct 
that causes or threatens physical harm to other people or animals (Criteria Al—A7); non- 
aggressive conduct that causes property loss or damage (Criteria A8-A9); deceitfulness or 
theft (Criteria A10—A12); and serious violations of rules (Criteria A13—A15). Three or more 
characteristic behaviors must have been present during the past 12 months, with at least 
one behavior present in the past 6 months. The disturbance in behavior causes clinically 
significant impairment in social, academic, or occupational functioning (Criterion B). The 
behavior pattern is usually present in a variety of settings, such as home, at school, or in 
the community. Because individuals with conduct disorder are likely to minimize their 
conduct problems, the clinician often must rely on additional informants. However, infor- 
mants’ knowledge of the individual’s conduct problems may be limited if they have inad- 
equately supervised the individual or the individual has concealed symptom behaviors. 

Individuals with conduct disorder often initiate aggressive behavior and react aggres- 
sively to others. They may display bullying, threatening, or intimidating behavior (includ- 
ing bullying via messaging on Web-based social media) (Criterion A1); initiate frequent 
physical fights (Criterion A2); use a weapon that can cause serious physical harm (e.g., a bat, 
brick, broken bottle, knife, gun) (Criterion A3); be physically cruel to people (Criterion A4) 
or animals (Criterion A5); steal while confronting a victim (e.g., mugging, purse snatching, 
extortion, armed robbery) (Criterion A6); or force someone into sexual activity (Criterion A7). 
Physical violence may take the form of rape, assault, or, in rare cases, homicide. Deliberate 
destruction of others’ property may include deliberate fire setting with the intention of caus- 
ing serious damage (Criterion A8) or deliberate destroying of other people’s property in 
other ways (e.g., smashing car windows, vandalizing school property) (Criterion A9). Acts of 
deceitfulness or theft may include breaking into someone else’s house, building, or car (Crite- 
rion A10); frequently lying or breaking promises to obtain goods or favors or to avoid debts 
or obligations (e.g., “conning” other individuals) (Criterion A11); or stealing items of non- 
trivial value without confronting the victim (e.g., shoplifting, forgery, fraud) (Criterion A12). 

Individuals with conduct disorder may also frequently commit serious violations of 
rules (e.g., school, parental, workplace). Children with conduct disorder often have a pat- 
tern, beginning before age 13 years, of staying out late at night despite parental prohi- 
bitions (Criterion A13). Children may also show a pattern of running away from home 
overnight (Criterion A14). To be considered a symptom of conduct disorder, the running 
away must have occurred at least twice (or only once if the individual did not return for a 
lengthy period). Runaway episodes that occur as a direct consequence of physical or sex- 
ual abuse do not typically qualify for this criterion. Children with conduct disorder may 
often be truant from school, beginning prior to age 13 years (Criterion A15). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Especially in ambiguous situations, aggressive individuals with conduct disorder fre- 
quently misperceive the intentions of others as more hostile and threatening than is the 


Conduct Disorder 473 


case and respond with aggression that they then feel is reasonable and justified. Person- 
ality features of trait negative emotionality and poor self-control, including poor frustra- 
tion tolerance, irritability, temper outbursts, suspiciousness, insensitivity to punishment, 
thrill seeking, and recklessness, frequently co-occur with conduct disorder. Substance 
misuse is often an associated feature, particularly in adolescent females. Suicidal ideation, 
suicide attempts, and completed suicide occur at a higher-than-expected rate in individu- 
als with conduct disorder. 


Prevalence 


One-year population prevalence estimates range from 2% to more than 10%, with a median 
of 4%. The prevalence of conduct disorder appears to be fairly consistent across various 
countries that differ in race and ethnicity. Prevalence rates rise from childhood to adoles- 
cence and are higher among males than among females. Few children with impairing con- 
duct disorder receive treatment. 


Development and Course 


The onset of conduct disorder may occur as early as the preschool years, but the first sig- 
nificant symptoms usually emerge during the period from middle childhood through 
middle adolescence. Oppositional defiant disorder is a common precursor to the child- 
hood-onset type of conduct disorder. Conduct disorder may be diagnosed in adults, how- 
ever, symptoms of conduct disorder usually emerge in childhood or adolescence, and 
onset is rare after age 16 years. The course of conduct disorder after onset is variable. Ina 
majority of individuals, the disorder remits by adulthood. Many individuals with conduct 
disorder—particularly those with adolescent-onset type and those with few and milder 
symptoms—achieve adequate social and occupational adjustment as adults. However, the 
early-onset type predicts a worse prognosis and an increased risk of criminal behavior, 
conduct disorder, and substance-related disorders in adulthood. Individuals with conduct 
disorder are at risk for later mood disorders, anxiety disorders, posttraumatic stress dis- 
order, impulse-control disorders, psychotic disorders, somatic symptom disorders, and 
substance-related disorders as adults. 

Symptoms of the disorder vary with age as the individual develops increased physical 
strength, cognitive abilities, and sexual maturity. Symptom behaviors that emerge first 
tend to be less serious (e.g., lying, shoplifting), whereas conduct problems that emerge last 
tend to be more severe (e.g., rape, theft while confronting a victim). However, there are 
wide differences among individuals, with some engaging in the more damaging behaviors 
at an early age (which is predictive of a worse prognosis). When individuals with conduct 
disorder reach adulthood, symptoms of aggression, property destruction, deceitfulness, 
and rule violation, including violence against co-workers, partners, and children, may be ex- 
hibited in the workplace and the home, such that antisocial personality disorder may be 
considered. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Temperamental risk factors include a difficult undercontrolled infant 
temperament and lower-than-average intelligence, particularly with regard to verbal IQ. 


Environmental. Family-level risk factors include parental rejection and neglect, inconsis- 
tent child-rearing practices, harsh discipline, physical or sexual abuse, lack of supervision, 
early institutional living, frequent changes of caregivers, large family size, parental criminal- 
ity, and certain kinds of familial psychopathology (e.g., substance-related disorders). Com- 
munity-level risk factors include peer rejection, association with a delinquent peer group, 
and neighborhood exposure to violence. Both types of risk factors tend to be more common 
and severe among individuals with the childhood-onset subtype of conduct disorder. 


474 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


Genetic and physiological. Conduct disorder is influenced by both genetic and envi- 
ronmental factors. The risk is increased in children with a biological or adoptive parent or 
a sibling with conduct disorder. The disorder also appears to be more common in children 
of biological parents with severe alcohol use disorder, depressive and bipolar disorders, or 
schizophrenia or biological parents who have a history of ADHD or conduct disorder. 
Family history particularly characterizes individuals with the childhood-onset subtype of 
conduct disorder. Slower resting heart rate has been reliably noted in individuals with 
conduct disorder compared with those without the disorder, and this marker is not char- 
acteristic of any other mental disorder. Reduced autonomic fear conditioning, particularly 
low skin conductance, is also well documented. However, these psychophysiological find- 
ings are not diagnostic of the disorder. Structural and functional differences in brain areas 
associated with affect regulation and affect processing, particularly frontotemporal-limbic 
connections involving the brain’s ventral prefrontal cortex and amygdala, have been con- 
sistently noted in individuals with conduct disorder compared with those without the dis- 
order. However, neuroimaging findings are not diagnostic of the disorder. 


Course modifiers. Persistence is more likely for individuals with behaviors that meet 
criteria for the childhood-onset subtype and qualify for the specifier “with limited pro- 
social emotions”. The risk that conduct disorder will persist is also increased by co-occurring 
ADHD and by substance abuse. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Conduct disorder diagnosis may at times be potentially misapplied to individuals in set- 
tings where patterns of disruptive behavior are viewed as near-normative (e.g., in very 
threatening, high-crime areas or war zones). Therefore, the context in which the undesir- 
able behaviors have occurred should be considered. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Males with a diagnosis of conduct disorder frequently exhibit fighting, stealing, vandalism, 
and school discipline problems. Females with a diagnosis of conduct disorder are more likely 
to exhibit lying, truancy, running away, substance use, and prostitution. Whereas males tend 
to exhibit both physical aggression and relational aggression (behavior that harms social re- 
lationships of others), females tend to exhibit relatively more relational aggression. 


Functional Consequences of Conduct Disorder 


Conduct disorder behaviors may lead to school suspension or expulsion, problems in 
work adjustment, legal difficulties, sexually transmitted diseases, unplanned pregnancy, 
and physical injury from accidents or fights. These problems may preclude attendance in 
ordinary schools or living in a parental or foster home. Conduct disorder is often associ- 
ated with an early onset of sexual behavior, alcohol use, tobacco smoking, use of illegal 
substances, and reckless and risk-taking acts. Accident rates appear to be higher among in- 
dividuals with conduct disorder compared with those without the disorder. These func- 
tional consequences of conduct disorder may predict health difficulties when individuals 
reach midlife. It is not uncommon for individuals with conduct disorder to come into con- 
tact with the criminal justice system for engaging in illegal behavior. Conduct disorder is 
a common reason for treatment referral and is frequently diagnosed in mental health fa- 
cilities for children, especially in forensic practice. It is associated with impairment that is 
more severe and chronic than that experienced by other clinic-referred children. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Oppositional defiant disorder. Conduct disorder and oppositional defiant disorder are 
both related to symptoms that bring the individual in conflict with adults and other au- 


Conduct Disorder 475 


thority figures (e.g., parents, teachers, work supervisors). The behaviors of oppositional 
defiant disorder are typically of a less severe nature than those of individuals with conduct 
disorder and do not include aggression toward individuals or animals, destruction of 
property, or a pattern of theft or deceit. Furthermore, oppositional defiant disorder in- 
cludes problems of emotional dysregulation (i.e., angry and irritable mood) that are not in- 
cluded in the definition of conduct disorder. When criteria are met for both oppositional 
defiant disorder and conduct disorder, both diagnoses can be given. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Although children with ADHD often exhibit 
hyperactive and impulsive behavior that may be disruptive, this behavior does not by it- 
self violate societal norms or the rights of others and therefore does not usually meet cri- 
teria for conduct disorder. When criteria are met for both ADHD and conduct disorder, both 
diagnoses should be given. 


Depressive and bipolar disorders. Irritability, aggression, and conduct problems can 
occur in children or adolescents with a major depressive disorder, a bipolar disorder, or 
disruptive mood dysregulation disorder. The behaviorial problems associated with these 
mood disorders can usually be distinguished from the pattern of conduct problems seen in 
conduct disorder based on their course. Specifically, persons with conduct disorder will 
display substantial levels of aggressive or non-aggressive conduct problems during peri- 
ods in which there is no mood disturbance, either historically (i.e., a history of conduct 
problems predating the onset of the mood disturbance) or concurrently (i.e., display of 
some conduct problems that are premeditated and do not occur during periods of intense 
emotional arousal). In those cases in which criteria for conduct disorder and a mood dis- 
order are met, both diagnoses can be given. 


Intermittent explosive disorder. Both conduct disorder and intermittent explosive dis- 
order involve high rates of aggression. However, the aggression in individuals with inter- 
mittent explosive disorder is limited to impulsive aggression and is not premeditated, and 
it is not committed in order to achieve some tangible objective (e.g., money, power, intim- 
idation). Also, the definition of intermittent explosive disorder does not include the non- 
aggressive symptoms of conduct disorder. If criteria for both disorders are met, the diag- 
nosis of intermittent explosive disorder should be given only when the recurrent impul- 
sive aggressive outbursts warrant independent clinical attention. 


Adjustment disorders. The diagnosis of an adjustment disorder (with disturbance of con- 
duct or with mixed disturbance of emotions and conduct) should be considered if clinically 
significant conduct problems that do not meet the criteria for another specific disorder de- 
velop in clear association with the onset of a psychosocial stressor and do not resolve within 
6 months of the termination of the stressor (or its consequences). Conduct disorder is diag- 
nosed only when the conduct problems represent a repetitive and persistent pattern that is 
associated with impairment in social, academic, or occupational functioning. 


Comorbidity 


ADHD and oppositional defiant disorder are both common in individuals with conduct 
disorder, and this comorbid presentation predicts worse outcomes. Individuals who show 
the personality features associated with antisocial personality disorder often violate the 
basic rights of others or violate major age-appropriate societal norms, and as a result their 
pattern of behavior often meets criteria for conduct disorder. Conduct disorder may also 
co-occur with one or more of the following mental disorders: specific learning disorder, 
anxiety disorders, depressive or bipolar disorders, and substance-related disorders. Aca- 
demic achievement, particularly in reading and other verbal skills, is often below the level 
expected on the basis of age and intelligence and may justify the additional diagnosis of 
specific learning disorder or a communication disorder. 


476 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


Antisocial Personality Disorder 


Criteria and text for antisocial personality disorder can be found in the chapter “Person- 
ality Disorders.” Because this disorder is closely connected to the spectrum of “external- 
izing” conduct disorders in this chapter, as well as to the disorders in the adjoining chapter 
“Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders,” it is dual coded here as well as in the chap- 
ter “Personality Disorders.” 


Pyromania 
Diagnostic Criteria 312.33 (F63.1) 


A. Deliberate and purposeful fire setting on more than one occasion. 

B. Tension or affective arousal before the act. 

C. Fascination with, interest in, curiosity about, or attraction to fire and its situational con- 
texts (e.g., paraphernalia, uses, consequences). 

D. Pleasure, gratification, or relief when setting fires or when witnessing or participating 
in their aftermath. 

E. The fire setting is not done for monetary gain, as an expression of sociopolitical ideol- 
ogy, to conceal criminal activity, to express anger or vengeance, to improve one’s living 
circumstances, in response to a delusion or hallucination, or as a result of impaired 
judgment (e.g., in major neurocognitive disorder, intellectual disability [intellectual de- 
velopmental disorder], substance intoxication). 

F. The fire setting is not better explained by conduct disorder, a manic episode, or anti- 
social personality disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of pyromania is the presence of multiple episodes of deliberate and 
purposeful fire setting (Criterion A). Individuals with this disorder experience tension or af- 
fective arousal before setting a fire (Criterion B). There is a fascination with, interest in, cu- 
riosity about, or attraction to fire and its situational contexts (e.g., paraphernalia, uses, 
consequences) (Criterion C). Individuals with this disorder are often regular “watchers” at 
fires in their neighborhoods, may set off false alarms, and derive pleasure from institutions, 
equipment, and personnel associated with fire. They may spend time at the local fire depart- 
ment, set fires to be affiliated with the fire department, or even become firefighters. Individ- 
uals with this disorder experience pleasure, gratification, or relief when setting the fire, 
witnessing its effects, or participating in its aftermath (Criterion D). The fire setting is not 
done for monetary gain, as an expression of sociopolitical ideology, to conceal criminal ac- 
tivity, to express anger or vengeance, to improve one’s living circumstances, or in response 
to a delusion or a hallucination (Criterion E). The fire setting does not result from impaired 
judgment (e.g., in major neurocognitive disorder or intellectual disability [intellectual devel- 
opmental disorder]). The diagnosis is not made if the fire setting is better explained by con- 
duct disorder, a manic episode, or antisocial personality disorder (Criterion F). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with pyromania may make considerable advance preparation for starting a 
fire. They may be indifferent to the consequences to life or property caused by the fire, or 


Pyromania 477 


they may derive satisfaction from the resulting property destruction. The behaviors may 
lead to property damage, legal consequences, or injury or loss of life to the fire setter or to 
others. Individuals who impulsively set fires (who may or may not have pyromania) often 
have a current or past history of alcohol use disorder. 


Prevalence 


The population prevalence of pyromania is not known. The lifetime prevalence of fire set- 
ting, which is just one component of pyromania and not sufficient for a diagnosis by itself, 
was reported as 1.13% in a population sample, but the most common comorbidities were 
antisocial personality disorder, substance use disorder, bipolar disorder, and pathological 
gambling (gambling disorder). In contrast, pyromania as a primary diagnosis appears to 
be very rare. Among a sample of persons reaching the criminal system with repeated fire 
setting, only 3.3% had symptoms that met full criteria for pyromania. 


Development and Course 


There are insufficient data to establish a typical age at onset of pyromania. The relation- 
ship between fire setting in childhood and pyromania in adulthood has not been docu- 
mented. In individuals with pyromania, fire-setting incidents are episodic and may wax 
and wane in frequency. Longitudinal course is unknown. Although fire setting is a major 
problem in children and adolescents (over 40% of those arrested for arson offenses in the 
United States are younger than 18 years), pyromania in childhood appears to be rare. Ju- 
venile fire setting is usually associated with conduct disorder, attention-deficit/hyperac- 
tivity disorder, or an adjustment disorder. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Pyromania occurs much more often in males, especially those with poorer social skills and 
learning difficulties. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other causes of intentional fire setting. It is important to rule out other causes of fire 
setting before giving the diagnosis of pyromania. Intentional fire setting may occur for 
profit, sabotage, or revenge; to conceal a crime; to make a political statement (e.g., an act of 
terrorism or protest); or to attract attention or recognition (e.g., setting a fire in order to dis- 
cover it and save the day). Fire setting may also occur as part of developmental experi- 
mentation in childhood (e.g., playing with matches, lighters, or fire). 


Other mental disorders. A separate diagnosis of pyromania is not given when fire set- 
ting occurs as part of conduct disorder, a manic episode, or antisocial personality disorder, 
or if it occurs in response to a delusion or a hallucination (e.g., in schizophrenia) or is at- 
tributable to the physiological effects of another medical condition (e.g., epilepsy). The di- 
agnosis of pyromania should also not be given when fire setting results from impaired 
judgment associated with major neurocognitive disorder, intellectual disability, or sub- 
stance intoxication. 


Comorbidity 

There appears to be a high co-occurrence of substance use disorders, gambling disorder, 
depressive and bipolar disorders, and other disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct dis- 
orders with pyromania. 


478 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


Kleptomania 
Diagnostic Criteria 312.32 (F63.2) 


A. Recurrent failure to resist impulses to steal objects that are not needed for personal 
use or for their monetary value. 

B. Increasing sense of tension immediately before committing the theft. 

C. Pleasure, gratification, or relief at the time of committing the theft. 

D. The stealing is not committed to express anger or vengeance and is not in response 
to a delusion or a hallucination. 

E. The stealing is not better explained by conduct disorder, a manic episode, or antisocial 
personality disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of kleptomania is the recurrent failure to resist impulses to steal items 
even though the items are not needed for personal use or for their monetary value (Criterion 
A). The individual experiences a rising subjective sense of tension before the theft (Criterion B) 
and feels pleasure, gratification, or relief when committing the theft (Criterion C). The stealing 
is not committed to express anger or vengeance, is not done in response to a delusion or hal- 
lucination (Criterion D), and is not better explained by conduct disorder, a manic episode, or 
antisocial personality disorder (Criterion E). The objects are stolen despite the fact that they are 
typically of little value to the individual, who could have afforded to pay for them and often 
gives them away or discards them. Occasionally the individual may hoard the stolen objects or 
surreptitiously return them. Although individuals with this disorder will generally avoid 
stealing when immediate arrest is probable (e.g., in full view of a police officer), they usually 
do not preplan the thefts or fully take into account the chances of apprehension. The stealing is 
done without assistance from, or collaboration with, others. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with kleptomania typically attempt to resist the impulse to steal, and they are 
aware that the act is wrong and senseless. The individual frequently fears being appre- 
hended and often feels depressed or guilty about the thefts. Neurotransmitter pathways 
associated with behavioral addictions, including those associated with the serotonin, do- 
pamine, and opioid systems, appear to play a role in kleptomania as well. 


Prevalence 


Kleptomania occurs in about 4%-24% of individuals arrested for shoplifting. Its preva- 
lence in the general population is very rare, at approximately 0.3%—0.6%. Females outnum- 
ber males at a ratio of 3:1. 


Development and Course 


Age at onset of kleptomania is variable, but the disorder often begins in adolescence. How- 
ever, the disorder may begin in childhood, adolescence, or adulthood, and in rare cases 
in late adulthood. There is little systematic information on the course of kleptomania, but 
three typical courses have been described: sporadic with brief episodes and long periods 
of remission; episodic with protracted periods of stealing and periods of remission; and 
chronic with some degree of fluctuation. The disorder may continue for years, despite 
multiple convictions for shoplifting. 


Other Specified Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorder 479 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. There are no controlled family history studies of kleptoma- 
nia. However, first-degree relatives of individuals with kleptomania may have higher 
rates of obsessive-compulsive disorder than the general population. There also appears to 
be a higher rate of substance use disorders, including alcohol use disorder, in relatives of 
individuals with kleptomania than in the general population. 


Functional Consequences of Kleptomania 


The disorder may cause legal, family, career, and personal difficulties. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Ordinary theft. Kleptomania should be distinguished from ordinary acts of theft or 
shoplifting. Ordinary theft (whether planned or impulsive) is deliberate and is motivated 
by the usefulness of the object or its monetary worth. Some individuals, especially adoles- 
cents, may also steal on a dare, as an act of rebellion, or as a rite of passage. The diagnosis 
is not made unless other characteristic features of kleptomania are also present. Klepto- 
mania is exceedingly rare, whereas shoplifting is relatively common. 


Malingering. In malingering, individuals may simulate the symptoms of kleptomania to 
avoid criminal prosecution. 


Antisocial personality disorder and conduct disorder. Antisocial personality disorder 
and conduct disorder are distinguished from kleptomania by a general pattern of antiso- 
cial behavior. 


Manic episodes, psychotic episodes, and major neurocognitive disorder. Kleptomania 
should be distinguished from intentional or inadvertent stealing that may occur during a 
manic episode, in response to delusions or hallucinations (as in, e.g., schizophrenia), or as 
a result of a major neurocognitive disorder. 


Comorbidity 


Kleptomania may be associated with compulsive buying as well as with depressive and 
bipolar disorders (especially major depressive disorder), anxiety disorders, eating disor- 
ders (particularly bulimia nervosa), personality disorders, substance use disorders (espe- 
cially alcohol use disorder), and other disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorders. 


Other Specified Disruptive, Impulse-Control, 
and Conduct Disorder 


312.89 (F91.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a disruptive, 
impulse-control, and conduct disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do 
not meet the full criteria for any of the disorders in the disruptive, impulse-control, and con- 
duct disorders diagnostic class. The other specified disruptive, impulse-control, and con- 
duct disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate 
the specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific disrup- 
tive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder. This is done by recording “other specified dis- 
ruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder” followed by the specific reason (e.g., 
“recurrent behavioral outbursts of insufficient frequency”). 


480 Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


Unspecified Disruptive, Impulse-Control, 
and Conduct Disorder 


312.9 (F91.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a disruptive, 
impulse-control, and conduct disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do 
not meet the full criteria for any of the disorders in the disruptive, impulse-control, and con- 
duct disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct 
disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the rea- 
son that the criteria are not met for a specific disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct dis- 
order, and includes presentations in which there is insufficient information to make a more 
specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Substance-Related and 
Addictive Disorders 


The substance-related disorders encompass 10 separate classes of drugs: alco- 
hol; caffeine; cannabis; hallucinogens (with separate categories for phencyclidine [or sim- 
ilarly acting arylcyclohexylamines] and other hallucinogens); inhalants; opioids; 
sedatives, hypnotics, and anxiolytics; stimulants (amphetamine-type substances, cocaine, 
and other stimulants); tobacco; and other (or unknown) substances. These 10 classes are 
not fully distinct. All drugs that are taken in excess have in common direct activation of 
the brain reward system, which is involved in the reinforcement of behaviors and the pro- 
duction of memories. They produce such an intense activation of the reward system that 
normal activities may be neglected. Instead of achieving reward system activation 
through adaptive behaviors, drugs of abuse directly activate the reward pathways. The 
pharmacological mechanisms by which each class of drugs produces reward are different, 
but the drugs typically activate the system and produce feelings of pleasure, often re- 
ferred to as a “high.” Furthermore, individuals with lower levels of self-control, which 
may reflect impairments of brain inhibitory mechanisms, may be particularly predisposed 
to develop substance use disorders, suggesting that the roots of substance use disorders 
for some persons can be seen in behaviors long before the onset of actual substance use 
itself. 

In addition to the substance-related disorders, this chapter also includes gambling dis- 
order, reflecting evidence that gambling behaviors activate reward systems similar to 
those activated by drugs of abuse and produce some behavioral symptoms that appear 
comparable to those produced by the substance use disorders. Other excessive behavioral 
patterns, such as Internet gaming, have also been described, but the research on these and 
other behavioral syndromes is less clear. Thus, groups of repetitive behaviors, which some 
term behavioral addictions, with such subcategories as “sex addiction,” “exercise addiction,” 
or “shopping addiction,” are not included because at this time there is insufficient peer-re- 
viewed evidence to establish the diagnostic criteria and course descriptions needed to 
identify these behaviors as mental disorders. 

The substance-related disorders are divided into two groups: substance use disorders 
and substance-induced disorders. The following conditions may be classified as sub- 
stance-induced: intoxication, withdrawal, and other substance /medication-induced men- 
tal disorders (psychotic disorders, bipolar and related disorders, depressive disorders, 
anxiety disorders, obsessive-compulsive and related disorders, sleep disorders, sexual dys- 
functions, delirium, and neurocognitive disorders). 

The current section begins with a general discussion of criteria sets for a substance 
use disorder, substance intoxication and withdrawal, and other substance /medication- 
induced mental disorders, at least some of which are applicable across classes of sub- 
stances. Reflecting some unique aspects of the 10 substance classes relevant to this chapter, 
the remainder of the chapter is organized by the class of substance and describes their 
unique aspects. To facilitate differential diagnosis, the text and criteria for the remaining 
substance /medication-induced mental disorders are included with disorders with which 
they share phenomenology (e.g., substance /medication-induced depressive disorder is in 
the chapter “Depressive Disorders”). The broad diagnostic categories associated with each 
specific group of substances are shown in Table 1. 


481 


TABLE 1 Diagnoses associated with substance class 


Obsessive- Sub- = Sub- 
Depres- compulsive Sexual Neuro- Substance stance stance 
Psychotic Bipolar sive Anxiety and related Sleep dysfunc- cognitive use intoxi- — with- 


disorders disorders disorders disorders disorders disorders tions Delirium disorders disorders cation drawal 


Alcohol 1/W I/W 1/W I/W I/W I/W 1/W I/W/P x xX xX 
Caffeine I 1/W xX Xx 
Cannabis I I 1/W I xX xX xX 
Hallucinogens 

Phencyclidine I I I I I Xx xX 

Other hallucino- I I I I I Xx Xx 

gens 

Inhalants I I I I I/P xX Xx 
Opioids 1/W WwW 1/W 1/W 1/W xX x x 
Sedatives, 1/W 1/W 1/W WwW 1/W I/W 1/W I/W/P xX Xx x 

hypnotics, or 

anxiolytics 
Stimulants** I I/W 1/W I/W I/W 1/W I I xX Xx xX 
Tobacco WwW x xX 
Other (or 1/W 1/W 1/W 1/W 1/W 1/W I/W 1/W I/W/P x Xx x 

unknown) 


Note. X = The category is recognized in DSM-5. 

I= The specifier “with onset during intoxication” may be noted for the category. 

W = The specifier “with onset during withdrawal” may be noted for the category. 

I/W = Either “with onset during intoxication” or “with onset during withdrawal” may be noted for the category. 
P = The disorder is persisting. 

*Also hallucinogen persisting perception disorder (flashbacks). 

*Includes amphetamine-type substances, cocaine, and other or unspecified stimulants. 


csr 


SIOPJOSIG SANOIPPY PUe pelejey-eouRsqns 


Substance Use Disorders 483 


Substance-Related Disorders 


Substance Use Disorders 


Features 


The essential feature of a substance use disorder is a cluster of cognitive, behavioral, and 
physiological symptoms indicating that the individual continues using the substance de- 
spite significant substance-related problems. As seen in Table 1, the diagnosis of a sub- 
stance use disorder can be applied to all 10 classes included in this chapter except caffeine. 
For certain classes some symptoms are less salient, and in a few instances not all symptoms 
apply (e.g., withdrawal symptoms are not specified for phencyclidine use disorder, other 
hallucinogen use disorder, or inhalant use disorder). 

Animportant characteristic of substance use disorders is an underlying change in brain cir- 
cuits that may persist beyond detoxification, particularly in individuals with severe disorders. 
The behavioral effects of these brain changes may be exhibited in the repeated relapses and in- 
tense drug craving when the individuals are exposed to drug-related stimuli. These persistent 
drug effects may benefit from long-term approaches to treatment. 

Overall, the diagnosis of a substance use disorder is based on a pathological pattern of 
behaviors related to use of the substance. To assist with organization, Criterion A criteria can 
be considered to fit within overall groupings of impaired control, social impairment, risky use, 
and pharmacological criteria. Impaired control over substance use is the first criteria grouping 
(Criteria 1-4). The individual may take the substance in larger amounts or over a longer pe- 
riod than was originally intended (Criterion 1). The individual may express a persistent de- 
sire to cut down or regulate substance use and may report multiple unsuccessful efforts to 
decrease or discontinue use (Criterion 2). The individual may spend a great deal of time ob- 
taining the substance, using the substance, or recovering from its effects (Criterion 3). In 
some instances of more severe substance use disorders, virtually all of the individual’s daily 
activities revolve around the substance. Craving (Criterion 4) is manifested by an intense de- 
sire or urge for the drug that may occur at any time but is more likely when in an environ- 
ment where the drug previously was obtained or used. Craving has also been shown to 
involve classical conditioning and is associated with activation of specific reward structures 
in the brain. Craving is queried by asking if there has ever been a time when they had such 
strong urges to take the drug that they could not think of anything else. Current craving is of- 
ten used as a treatment outcome measure because it may be a signal of impending relapse. 

Social impairment is the second grouping of criteria (Criteria 5-7). Recurrent substance 
use may result in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at work, school, or home (Crite- 
rion 5). The individual may continue substance use despite having persistent or recurrent 
social or interpersonal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of the substance (Cri- 
terion 6). Important social, occupational, or recreational activities may be given up or re- 
duced because of substance use (Criterion 7). The individual may withdraw from family 
activities and hobbies in order to use the substance. 

Risky use of the substance is the third grouping of criteria (Criteria 8-9). This may take 
the form of recurrent substance use in situations in which it is physically hazardous (Cri- 
terion 8). The individual may continue substance use despite knowledge of having a per- 
sistent or recurrent physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or 
exacerbated by the substance (Criterion 9). The key issue in evaluating this criterion is not 
the existence of the problem, but rather the individual’s failure to abstain from using the 
substance despite the difficulty it is causing. 


484 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Pharmacological criteria are the final grouping (Criteria 10 and 11). Tolerance (Crite- 
rion 10) is signaled by requiring a markedly increased dose of the substance to achieve the 
desired effect or a markedly reduced effect when the usual dose is consumed. The degree 
to which tolerance develops varies greatly across different individuals as well as across 
substances and may involve a variety of central nervous system effects. For example, tol- 
erance to respiratory depression and tolerance to sedating and motor coordination may 
develop at different rates, depending on the substance. Tolerance may be difficult to de- 
termine by history alone, and laboratory tests may be helpful (e.g., high blood levels of the 
substance coupled with little evidence of intoxication suggest that tolerance is likely). Tol- 
erance must also be distinguished from individual variability in the initial sensitivity to 
the effects of particular substances. For example, some first-time alcohol drinkers show 
very little evidence of intoxication with three or four drinks, whereas others of similar 
weight and drinking histories have slurred speech and incoordination. 

Withdrawal (Criterion 11) is a syndrome that occurs when blood or tissue concentra- 
tions of a substance decline in an individual who had maintained prolonged heavy use of 
the substance. After developing withdrawal symptoms, the individual is likely to con- 
sume the substance to relieve the symptoms. Withdrawal symptoms vary greatly across 
the classes of substances, and separate criteria sets for withdrawal are provided for the 
drug classes. Marked and generally easily measured physiological signs of withdrawal are 
common with alcohol, opioids, and sedatives, hypnotics, and anxiolytics. Withdrawal 
signs and symptoms with stimulants (amphetamines and cocaine), as well as tobacco and 
cannabis, are often present but may be less apparent. Significant withdrawal has not been 
documented in humans after repeated use of phencyclidine, other hallucinogens, and in- 
halants; therefore, this criterion is not included for these substances. Neither tolerance nor 
withdrawal is necessary for a diagnosis of a substance use disorder. However, for most 
classes of substances, a past history of withdrawal is associated with a more severe clinical 
course (i.e., an earlier onset of a substance use disorder, higher levels of substance intake, 
and a greater number of substance-related problems). 

Symptoms of tolerance and withdrawal occurring during appropriate medical treat- 
ment with prescribed medications (e.g., opioid analgesics, sedatives, stimulants) are spe- 
cifically not counted when diagnosing a substance use disorder. The appearance of normal, 
expected pharmacological tolerance and withdrawal during the course of medical treat- 
ment has been known to lead to an erroneous diagnosis of “addiction” even when these 
were the only symptoms present. Individuals whose only symptoms are those that occur 
as a result of medical treatment (i.e., tolerance and withdrawal as part of medical care 
when the medications are taken as prescribed) should not receive a diagnosis solely on the 
basis of these symptoms. However, prescription medications can be used inappropriately, 
and a substance use disorder can be correctly diagnosed when there are other symptoms 
of compulsive, drug-seeking behavior. 


Severity and Specifiers 


Substance use disorders occur in a broad range of severity, from mild to severe, with se- 
verity based on the number of symptom criteria endorsed. As a general estimate of sever- 
ity, a mild substance use disorder is suggested by the presence of two to three symptoms, 
moderate by four to five symptoms, and severe by six or more symptoms. Changing severity 
across time is also reflected by reductions or increases in the frequency and/or dose of 
substance use, as assessed by the individual’s own report, report of knowledgeable others, 
clinician’s observations, and biological testing. The following course specifiers and descrip- 
tive features specifiers are also available for substance use disorders: “in early remission,” 
“in sustained remission,” “on maintenance therapy,” and “in a controlled environment.” 
Definitions of each are provided within respective criteria sets. 


Substance Use Disorders 485 


Recording Procedures for Substance Use Disorders 


The clinician should use the code that applies to the class of substances but record the 
name of the specific substance. For example, the clinician should record 304.10 (F13.20) 
moderate alprazolam use disorder (rather than moderate sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
use disorder) or 305.70 (F15.10) mild methamphetamine use disorder (rather than mild 
stimulant use disorder). For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., anabolic 
steroids), the appropriate code for “other substance use disorder” should be used and the 
specific substance indicated (e.g., 305.90 [F19.10] mild anabolic steroid use disorder). If the 
substance taken by the individual is unknown, the code for the class “other (or unknown)” 
should be used (e.g., 304.90 [F19.20] severe unknown substance use disorder). If criteria 
are met for more than one substance use disorder, all should be diagnosed (e.g., 304.00 
[F11.20] severe heroin use disorder; 304.20 [F14.20] moderate cocaine use disorder). 

The appropriate ICD-10-CM code for a substance use disorder depends on whether 
there is a comorbid substance-induced disorder (including intoxication and withdrawal). In 
the above example, the diagnostic code for moderate alprazolam use disorder, F13.20, re- 
flects the absence of a comorbid alprazolam-induced mental disorder. Because ICD-10-CM 
codes for substance-induced disorders indicate both the presence (or absence) and severity 
of the substance use disorder, ICD-10-CM codes for substance use disorders can be used 
only in the absence of a substance-induced disorder. See the individual substance-specific 
sections for additional coding information. 

Note that the word addiction is not applied as a diagnostic term in this classification, 
although it is in common usage in many countries to describe severe problems related to 
compulsive and habitual use of substances. The more neutral term substance use disorder is 
used to describe the wide range of the disorder, from a mild form to a severe state of chron- 
ically relapsing, compulsive drug taking. Some clinicians will choose to use the word ad- 
diction to describe more extreme presentations, but the word is omitted from the official 
DSM-5 substance use disorder diagnostic terminology because of its uncertain definition 
and its potentially negative connotation. 


Substance-Induced Disorders 


The overall category of substance-induced disorders includes intoxication, withdrawal, 
and other substance/medication-induced mental disorders (e.g., substance-induced psy- 
chotic disorder, substance-induced depressive disorder). 


Substance Intoxication and Withdrawal 


Criteria for substance intoxication are included within the substance-specific sections of 
this chapter. The essential feature is the development of a reversible substance-specific 
syndrome due to the recent ingestion of a substance (Criterion A). The clinically significant 
problematic behavioral or psychological changes associated with intoxication (e.g., bellig- 
erence, mood lability, impaired judgment) are attributable to the physiological effects of 
the substance on the central nervous system and develop during or shortly after use of the 
substance (Criterion B). The symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition 
and are not better explained by another mental disorder (Criterion D). Substance intoxi- 
cation is common among those with a substance use disorder but also occurs frequently in 
individuals without a substance use disorder. This category does not apply to tobacco. 
The most common changes in intoxication involve disturbances of perception, wake- 
fulness, attention, thinking, judgment, psychomotor behavior, and interpersonal behav- 
ior. Short-term, or “acute,” intoxications may have different signs and symptoms than 


486 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


sustained, or “chronic,” intoxications. For example, moderate cocaine doses may initially 
produce gregariousness, but social withdrawal may develop if such doses are frequently 
repeated over days or weeks. 

When used in the physiological sense, the term intoxication is broader than substance 
intoxication as defined here. Many substances may produce physiological or psychologi- 
cal changes that are not necessarily problematic. For example, an individual with tachy- 
cardia from substance use has a physiological effect, but if this is the only symptom in the 
absence of problematic behavior, the diagnosis of intoxication would not apply. Intoxica- 
tion may sometimes persist beyond the time when the substance is detectable in the body. 
This may be due to enduring central nervous system effects, the recovery of which takes 
longer than the time for elimination of the substance. These longer-term effects of intoxi- 
cation must be distinguished from withdrawal (i.e., symptoms initiated by a decline in 
blood or tissue concentrations of a substance). 

Criteria for substance withdrawal are included within the substance-specific sections of 
this chapter. The essential feature is the development of a substance-specific problematic be- 
havioral change, with physiological and cognitive concomitants, that is due to the cessation of, 
or reduction in, heavy and prolonged substance use (Criterion A). The substance-specific syn- 
drome causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other im- 
portant areas of functioning (Criterion C). The symptoms are not due to another medical 
condition and are not better explained by another mental disorder (Criterion D). Withdrawal 
is usually, but not always, associated with a substance use disorder. Most individuals with 
withdrawal have an urge to re-administer the substance to reduce the symptoms. 


Route of Administration and Speed of Substance Effects 


Routes of administration that produce more rapid and efficient absorption into the blood- 
stream (e.g., intravenous, smoking, intranasal “snorting”) tend to result in a more intense 
intoxication and an increased likelihood of an escalating pattern of substance use leading 
to withdrawal. Similarly, rapidly acting substances are more likely than slower-acting 
substances to produce immediate intoxication. 


Duration of Effects 


Within the same drug category, relatively short-acting substances tend to have a higher 
potential for the development of withdrawal than do those with a longer duration of ac- 
tion. However, longer-acting substances tend to have longer withdrawal duration. The 
half-life of the substance parallels aspects of withdrawal: the longer the duration of action, 
the longer the time between cessation and the onset of withdrawal symptoms and the lon- 
ger the withdrawal duration. In general, the longer the acute withdrawal period, the less 
intense the syndrome tends to be. 


Use of Multiple Substances 


Substance intoxication and withdrawal often involve several substances used simultane- 
ously or sequentially. In these cases, each diagnosis should be recorded separately. 


Associated Laboratory Findings 


Laboratory analyses of blood and urine samples can help determine recent use and the specific 
substances involved. However, a positive laboratory test result does not by itself indicate that 
the individual has a pattern of substance use that meets criteria for a substance-induced or sub- 
stance use disorder, and a negative test result does not by itself rule out a diagnosis. 
Laboratory tests can be useful in identifying withdrawal. If the individual presents 
with withdrawal from an unknown substance, laboratory tests may help identify the sub- 
stance and may also be helpful in differentiating withdrawal from other mental disorders. 


Substance-Induced Disorders 487 


In addition, normal functioning in the presence of high blood levels of a substance sug- 
gests considerable tolerance. 


Development and Course 


Individuals ages 18-24 years have relatively high prevalence rates for the use of virtually 
every substance. Intoxication is usually the initial substance-related disorder and often be- 
gins in the teens. Withdrawal can occur at any age as long as the relevant drug has been 
taken in sufficient doses over an extended period of time. 


Recording Procedures for Intoxication and Withdrawal 


The clinician should use the code that applies to the class of substances but record the 
name of the specific substance. For example, the clinician should record 292.0 (F13.239) seco- 
barbital withdrawal (rather than sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal) or 292.89 
(F15.129) methamphetamine intoxication (rather than stimulant intoxication). Note that 
the appropriate ICD-10-CM diagnostic code for intoxication depends on whether there is 
a comorbid substance use disorder. In this case, the F15.129 code for methamphetamine in- 
dicates the presence of a comorbid mild methamphetamine use disorder. If there had been 
no comorbid methamphetamine use disorder, the diagnostic code would have been 
F15.929. ICD-10-CM coding rules require that all withdrawal codes imply a comorbid 
moderate to severe substance use disorder for that substance. In the above case, the code 
for secobarbital withdrawal (F13.239) indicates the comorbid presence of a moderate to se- 
vere secobarbital use disorder. See the coding note for the substance-specific intoxication 
and withdrawal syndromes for the actual coding options. 

For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., anabolic steroids), the appropriate 
code for “other substance intoxication” should be used and the specific substance indicated 
(e.g., 292.89 [F19.929] anabolic steroid intoxication). If the substance taken by the individual is 
unknown, the code for the class “other (or unknown)” should be used (e.g., 292.89 [F19.929] 
unknown substance intoxication). If there are symptoms or problems associated with a partic- 
ular substance but criteria are not met for any of the substance-specific disorders, the unspec- 
ified category can be used (e.g., 292.9 [F12.99] unspecified cannabis-related disorder). 

As noted above, the substance-related codes in ICD-10-CM combine the substance use dis- 
order aspect of the clinical picture and the substance-induced aspect into a single combined 
code. Thus, if both heroin withdrawal and moderate heroin use disorder are present, the single 
code F11.23 is given to cover both presentations. In ICD-9-CM, separate diagnostic codes 
(292.0 and 304.00) are given to indicate withdrawal and a moderate heroin use disorder, re- 
spectively. See the individual substance-specific sections for additional coding information. 


Substance/Medication-lnduced Mental Disorders 


The substance/medication-induced mental disorders are potentially severe, usually tem- 
porary, but sometimes persisting central nervous system (CNS) syndromes that develop 
in the context of the effects of substances of abuse, medications, or several toxins. They are 
distinguished from the substance use disorders, in which a cluster of cognitive, behav- 
ioral, and physiological symptoms contribute to the continued use of a substance despite 
significant substance-related problems. The substance/medication-induced mental disor- 
ders may be induced by the 10 classes of substances that produce substance use disorders, 
or by a great variety of other medications used in medical treatment. Each substance- 
induced mental disorder is described in the relevant chapter (e.g., “Depressive Disorders,” 
“Neurocognitive Disorders”), and therefore, only a brief description is offered here. All 
substance /medication-induced disorders share common characteristics. It is important to 
recognize these common features to aid in the detection of these disorders. These features 
are described as follows: 


488 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


A. The disorder represents a clinically significant symptomatic presentation of a relevant 
mental disorder. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings of 
both of the following: 


1. The disorder developed during or within 1 month of a substance intoxication or 
withdrawal or taking a medication; and 
2. The involved substance/medication is capable of producing the mental disorder. 


C. The disorder is not better explained by an independent mental disorder (i.e., one that is 
not substance- or medication-induced). Such evidence of an independent mental dis- 
order could include the following: 


1. The disorder preceded the onset of severe intoxication or withdrawal or exposure 
to the medication; or 

2. The full mental disorder persisted for a substantial period of time (e.g., at least 1 month) 
after the cessation of acute withdrawal or severe intoxication or taking the medica- 
tion. This criterion does not apply to substance-induced neurocognitive disorders 
or hallucinogen persisting perception disorder, which persist beyond the cessation 
of acute intoxication or withdrawal. 


. The disorder does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
The disorder causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 


mo 


Features 


Some generalizations can be made regarding the categories of substances capable of produc- 
ing clinically relevant substance-induced mental disorders. In general, the more sedating 
drugs (sedative, hypnotics, or anxiolytics, and alcohol) can produce prominent and clini- 
cally significant depressive disorders during intoxication, while anxiety conditions are likely 
to be observed during withdrawal syndromes from these substances. Also, during intoxica- 
tion, the more stimulating substances (e.g., amphetamines and cocaine) are likely to be as- 
sociated with substance-induced psychotic disorders and substance-induced anxiety 
disorders, with substance-induced major depressive episodes observed during withdrawal. 
Both the more sedating and more stimulating drugs are likely to produce significant but 
temporary sleep and sexual disturbances. An overview of the relationship between specific 
categories of substances and specific psychiatric syndromes is presented in Table 1. 

The medication-induced conditions include what are often idiosyncratic CNS reac- 
tions or relatively extreme examples of side effects for a wide range of medications taken 
for a variety of medical concerns. These include neurocognitive complications of anesthet- 
ics, antihistamines, antihypertensives, and a variety of other medications and toxins (e.g., 
organophosphates, insecticides, carbon monoxide), as described in the chapter on neuro- 
cognitive disorders. Psychotic syndromes may be temporarily experienced in the context 
of anticholinergic, cardiovascular, and steroid drugs, as well as during use of stimulant- 
like and depressant-like prescription or over-the-counter drugs. Temporary but severe 
mood disturbances can be observed with a wide range of medications, including steroids, 
antihypertensives, disulfiram, and any prescription or over-the-counter depressant or 
stimulant-like substances. A similar range of medications can be associated with tempo- 
rary anxiety syndromes, sexual dysfunctions, and conditions of disturbed sleep. 

In general, to be considered a substance/medication-induced mental disorder, there 
must be evidence that the disorder being observed is not likely to be better explained by an 
independent mental condition. The latter are most likely to be seen if the mental disorder 
was present before the severe intoxication or withdrawal or medication administration, or, 
with the exception of several substance-induced persisting disorders listed in Table 1, con- 
tinued more than 1 month after cessation of acute withdrawal, severe intoxication, or use 


Substance-Induced Disorders 489 


of the medications. When symptoms are only observed during a delirium (e.g., alcohol 
withdrawal delirium), the mental disorder should be diagnosed as a delirium, and the 
psychiatric syndrome occurring during the delirium should not also be diagnosed sepa- 
rately, as many symptoms (including disturbances in mood, anxiety, and reality testing) 
are commonly seen during agitated, confused states. The features associated with each rel- 
evant major mental disorder are similar whether observed with independent or sub- 
stance/medication-induced mental disorders. However, individuals with substance/ 
medication-induced mental disorders are likely to also demonstrate the associated fea- 
tures seen with the specific category of substance or medication, as listed in other subsec- 
tions of this chapter. 


Development and Course 


Substance-induced mental disorders develop in the context of intoxication or withdrawal 
from substances of abuse, and medication-induced mental disorders are seen with pre- 
scribed or over-the-counter medications that are taken at the suggested doses. Both condi- 
tions are usually temporary and likely to disappear within 1 month or so of cessation of acute 
withdrawal, severe intoxication, or use of the medication. Exceptions to these generaliza- 
tions occur for certain long-duration substance-induced disorders: substance-associated 
neurocognitive disorders that relate to conditions such as alcohol-induced neurocognitive 
disorder, inhalant-induced neurocognitive disorder, and sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic- 
induced neurocognitive disorder; and hallucinogen persisting perception disorder (“flash- 
backs”; see the section “Hallucinogen-Related Disorders” later in this chapter). However, 
most other substance/medication-induced mental disorders, regardless of the severity of 
the symptoms, are likely to improve relatively quickly with abstinence and unlikely to re- 
main clinically relevant for more than 1 month after complete cessation of use. 

As is true of many consequences of heavy substance use, some individuals are more 
and others less prone toward specific substance-induced disorders. Similar types of pre- 
dispositions may make some individuals more likely to develop psychiatric side effects of 
some types of medications, but not others. However, it is unclear whether individuals 
with family histories or personal prior histories with independent psychiatric syndromes 
are more likely to develop the induced syndrome once the consideration is made as to 
whether the quantity and frequency of the substance was sufficient to lead to the devel- 
opment of a substance-induced syndrome. 

There are indications that the intake of substances of abuse or some medications with 
psychiatric side effects in the context of a preexisting mental disorder is likely to result in 
an intensification of the preexisting independent syndrome. The risk for substance/med- 
ication-induced mental disorders is likely to increase with both the quantity and the fre- 
quency of consumption of the relevant substance. 

The symptom profiles for the substance /medication-induced mental disorders resem- 
ble independent mental disorders. While the symptoms of substance /medication-in- 
duced mental disorders can be identical to those of independent mental disorders (e.g., 
delusions, hallucinations, psychoses, major depressive episodes, anxiety syndromes), and 
although they can have the same severe consequences (e.g., suicide), most induced mental 
disorders are likely to improve in a matter of days to weeks of abstinence. 

The substance/medication-induced mental disorders are an important part of the dif- 
ferential diagnoses for the independent psychiatric conditions. The importance of recog- 
nizing an induced mental disorder is similar to the relevance of identifying the possible 
role of some medical conditions and medication reactions before diagnosing an indepen- 
dent mental disorder. Symptoms of substance- and medication-induced mental disorders 
may be identical cross-sectionally to those of independent mental disorders but have dif- 
ferent treatments and prognoses from the independent condition. 


490 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Functional Consequences of Substance/Medication- 
Induced Mental Disorders 


The same consequences related to the relevant independent mental disorder (e.g., suicide 
attempts) are likely to apply to the substance /medication-induced mental disorders, but 
these are likely to disappear within 1 month after abstinence. Similarly, the same func- 
tional consequences associated with the relevant substance use disorder are likely to be seen 
for the substance-induced mental disorders. 


Recording Procedures for Substance/Medication- 


Induced Mental Disorders 


Coding notes and separate recording procedures for ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for 
other specific substance/medication-induced mental disorders are provided in other 
chapters of the manual with disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the sub- 
stance /medication-induced mental disorders in these chapters: “Schizophrenia Spectrum 
and Other Psychotic Disorders,” “Bipolar and Related Disorders,” “Depressive Disor- 
ders,” “Anxiety Disorders,” “Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders,” “Sleep- 
Wake Disorders,” “Sexual Dysfunctions,” and “Neurocognitive Disorders”). Generally, 
for ICD-9-CM, if a mental disorder is induced by a substance use disorder, a separate di- 
agnostic code is given for the specific substance use disorder, in addition to the code for the 
substance /medication-induced mental disorder. For ICD-10-CM, a single code combines 
the substance-induced mental disorder with the substance use disorder. A separate diag- 
nosis of the comorbid substance use disorder is not given, although the name and severity 
of the specific substance use disorder (when present) are used when recording the sub- 
stance /medication-induced mental disorder. ICD-10-CM codes are also provided for sit- 
uations in which the substance/medication-induced mental disorder is not induced by a 
substance use disorder (e.g., when a disorder is induced by one-time use of a substance or 
medication). Additional information needed to record the diagnostic name of the sub- 
stance/medication-induced mental disorder is provided in the section “Recording Proce- 
dures” for each substance/medication-induced mental disorder in its respective chapter. 


Alcohol-Related Disorders 


Alcohol Use Disorder 
Alcohol Intoxication 
Alcohol Withdrawal 
Other Alcohol-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Alcohol-Related Disorder 


Alcohol Use Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A problematic pattern of alcohol use leading to clinically significant impairment or dis- 
tress, as manifested by at least two of the following, occurring within a 12-month period: 
1. Alcohol is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was intended. 
2. There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control alcohol use. 


Alcohol Use Disorder 491 


3. A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain alcohol, use alcohol, 
or recover from its effects. 

4. Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use alcohol. 

5. Recurrent alcohol use resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at work, 
school, or home. 

6. Continued alcohol use despite having persistent or recurrent social or interpersonal 
problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of alcohol. 

7. Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of alcohol use. 

8. Recurrent alcohol use in situations in which it is physically hazardous. 

9. Alcohol use is continued despite knowledge of having a persistent or recurrent 
physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or exacerbated 
by alcohol. 

10. Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 


a. Aneed for markedly increased amounts of alcohol to achieve intoxication or de- 
sired effect. 
b. Amarkedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of alcohol. 


11. Withdrawal, as manifested by either of the following: 


a. The characteristic withdrawal syndrome for alcohol (refer to Criteria A and B of 
the criteria set for alcohol withdrawal, pp. 499-500). 
b. Alcohol (or a closely related substance, such as a benzodiazepine) is taken to 
relieve or avoid withdrawal symptoms. 
Specify if: 
In early remission: After full criteria for alcohol use disorder were previously met, 
none of the criteria for alcohol use disorder have been met for at least 3 months but for 
less than 12 months (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong desire 
or urge to use alcohol,” may be met). 
In sustained remission: After full criteria for alcohol use disorder were previously 
met, none of the criteria for alcohol use disorder have been met at any time during a 
period of 12 months or longer (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a 
strong desire or urge to use alcohol,” may be met). 
Specify if: 
In acontrolled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to alcohol is restricted. 


Code based on current severity: Note for ICD-10-CM codes: If an alcohol intoxication, 
alcohol withdrawal, or another alcohol-induced mental disorder is also present, do not use 
the codes below for alcohol use disorder. Instead, the comorbid alcohol use disorder is 
indicated in the 4th character of the alcohol-induced disorder code (see the coding note 
for alcohol intoxication, alcohol withdrawal, or a specific alcohol-induced mental disorder). 
For example, if there is comorbid alcohol intoxication and alcohol use disorder, only the 
alcohol intoxication code is given, with the 4th character indicating whether the comorbid 
alcohol use disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: F10.129 for mild alcohol use disorder 
with alcohol intoxication or F10.229 for a moderate or severe alcohol use disorder with al- 
cohol intoxication. 


Specify current severity: 
305.00 (F10.10) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
303.90 (F10.20) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
303.90 (F10.20) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


492 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Specifiers 

“In a controlled environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is 
both in remission and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled 
environment or in sustained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these 
environments are closely supervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, 
and locked hospital units. 

Severity of the disorder is based on the number of diagnostic criteria endorsed. For a 
given individual, changes in severity of alcohol use disorder across time are also reflected 
by reductions in the frequency (e.g., days of use per month) and/or dose (e.g., number of 
standard drinks consumed per day) of alcohol used, as assessed by the individual’s self- 
report, report of knowledgeable others, clinician observations, and, when practical, bio- 
logical testing (e.g., elevations in blood tests as described in the section “Diagnostic Mark- 
ers” for this disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 


Alcohol use disorder is defined by a cluster of behavioral and physical symptoms, which 
can include withdrawal, tolerance, and craving. Alcohol withdrawal is characterized by 
withdrawal symptoms that develop approximately 4-12 hours after the reduction of in- 
take following prolonged, heavy alcohol ingestion. Because withdrawal from alcohol can 
be unpleasant and intense, individuals may continue to consume alcohol despite adverse 
consequences, often to avoid or to relieve withdrawal symptoms. Some withdrawal symp- 
toms (e.g., sleep problems) can persist at lower intensities for months and can contribute to 
relapse. Once a pattern of repetitive and intense use develops, individuals with alcohol 
use disorder may devote substantial periods of time to obtaining and consuming alcoholic 
beverages. 

Craving for alcohol is indicated by a strong desire to drink that makes it difficult to 
think of anything else and that often results in the onset of drinking. School and job per- 
formance may also suffer either from the aftereffects of drinking or from actual intoxica- 
tion at school or on the job; child care or household responsibilities may be neglected; and 
alcohol-related absences may occur from school or work. The individual may use alcohol 
in physically hazardous circumstances (e.g., driving an automobile, swimming, operating 
machinery while intoxicated). Finally, individuals with an alcohol use disorder may con- 
tinue to consume alcohol despite the knowledge that continued consumption poses sig- 
nificant physical (e.g., blackouts, liver disease), psychological (e.g., depression), social, or 
interpersonal problems (e.g., violent arguments with spouse while intoxicated, child 
abuse). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Alcohol use disorder is often associated with problems similar to those associated with 
other substances (e.g., cannabis; cocaine; heroin; amphetamines; sedatives, hypnotics, or 
anxiolytics). Alcohol may be used to alleviate the unwanted effects of these other 
substances or to substitute for them when they are not available. Symptoms of conduct 
problems, depression, anxiety, and insomnia frequently accompany heavy drinking and 
sometimes precede it. 

Repeated intake of high doses of alcohol can affect nearly every organ system, espe- 
cially the gastrointestinal tract, cardiovascular system, and the central and peripheral ner- 
vous systems. Gastrointestinal effects include gastritis, stomach or duodenal ulcers, and, 
in about 15% of individuals who use alcohol heavily, liver cirrhosis and/or pancreatitis. 
There is also an increased rate of cancer of the esophagus, stomach, and other parts of the 
gastrointestinal tract. One of the most commonly associated conditions is low-grade hy- 
pertension. Cardiomyopathy and other myopathies are less common but occur at an in- 


Alcohol Use Disorder 493 


creased rate among those who drink very heavily. These factors, along with marked 
increases in levels of triglycerides and low-density lipoprotein cholesterol, contribute to 
an elevated risk of heart disease. Peripheral neuropathy may be evidenced by muscular 
weakness, paresthesias, and decreased peripheral sensation. More persistent central ner- 
vous system effects include cognitive deficits, severe memory impairment, and degener- 
ative changes in the cerebellum. These effects are related to the direct effects of alcohol or 
of trauma and to vitamin deficiencies (particularly of the B vitamins, including thiamine). 
One devastating central nervous system effect is the relatively rare alcohol-induced per- 
sisting amnestic disorder, or Wernicke-Korsakoff syndrome, in which the ability to encode 
new memory is severely impaired. This condition would now be described within the chap- 
ter “Neurocognitive Disorders” and would be termed a substance/medication-induced neuro- 
cognitive disorder. 

Alcohol use disorder is an important contributor to suicide risk during severe intoxi- 
cation and in the context of a temporary alcohol-induced depressive and bipolar disorder. 
There is an increased rate of suicidal behavior as well as of completed suicide among in- 
dividuals with the disorder. 


Prevalence 


Alcohol use disorder is a common disorder. In the United States, the 12-month prevalence 
of alcohol use disorder is estimated to be 4.6% among 12- to 17-year-olds and 8.5% among 
adults age 18 years and older in the United States. Rates of the disorder are greater among 
adult men (12.4%) than among adult women (4.9%). Twelve-month prevalence of alcohol 
use disorder among adults decreases in middle age, being greatest among individuals 18- 
to 29-years-old (16.2%) and lowest among individuals age 65 years and older (1.5%). 

Twelve-month prevalence varies markedly across race/ethnic subgroups of the U.S. 
population. For 12- to 17-year-olds, rates are greatest among Hispanics (6.0%) and Native 
Americans and Alaska Natives (5.7%) relative to whites (5.0%), African Americans (1.8%), 
and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders (1.6%). In contrast, among adults, the 12-month 
prevalence of alcohol use disorder is clearly greater among Native Americans and Alaska 
Natives (12.1%) than among whites (8.9%), Hispanics (7.9%), African Americans (6.9%), 
and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders (4.5%). 


Development and Course 


The first episode of alcohol intoxication is likely to occur during the mid-teens. Alcohol- 
related problems that do not meet full criteria for a use disorder or isolated problems may 
occur prior to age 20 years, but the age at onset of an alcohol use disorder with two or more 
of the criteria clustered together peaks in the late teens or early to mid 20s. The large ma- 
jority of individuals who develop alcohol-related disorders do so by their late 30s. The first 
evidence of withdrawal is not likely to appear until after many other aspects of an alcohol 
use disorder have developed. An earlier onset of alcohol use disorder is observed in ado- 
lescents with preexisting conduct problems and those with an earlier onset of intoxication. 

Alcohol use disorder has a variable course that is characterized by periods of remission 
and relapse. A decision to stop drinking, often in response to a crisis, is likely to be followed 
by a period of weeks or more of abstinence, which is often followed by limited periods of 
controlled or nonproblematic drinking. However, once alcohol intake resumes, it is highly 
likely that consumption will rapidly escalate and that severe problems will once again 
develop. 

Alcohol use disorder is often erroneously perceived as an intractable condition, per- 
haps based on the fact that individuals who present for treatment typically have a history 
of many years of severe alcohol-related problems. However, these most severe cases rep- 
resent only a small proportion of individuals with this disorder, and the typical individual 
with the disorder has a much more promising prognosis. 


494 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Among adolescents, conduct disorder and repeated antisocial behavior often co-occur 
with alcohol- and with other substance-related disorders. While most individuals with al- 
cohol use disorder develop the condition before age 40 years, perhaps 10% have later 
onset. Age-related physical changes in older individuals result in increased brain suscep- 
tibility to the depressant effects of alcohol; decreased rates of liver metabolism of a variety 
of substances, including alcohol; and decreased percentages of body water. These changes 
can cause older people to develop more severe intoxication and subsequent problems at 
lower levels of consumption. Alcohol-related problems in older people are also especially 
likely to be associated with other medical complications. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Environmental risk and prognostic factors may include cultural atti- 
tudes toward drinking and intoxication, the availability of alcohol (including price), 
acquired personal experiences with alcohol, and stress levels. Additional potential medi- 
ators of how alcohol problems develop in predisposed individuals include heavier peer 
substance use, exaggerated positive expectations of the effects of alcohol, and suboptimal 
ways of coping with stress. 


Genetic and physiological. Alcohol use disorder runs in families, with 40%—60% of the 
variance of risk explained by genetic influences. The rate of this condition is three to four 
times higher in close relatives of individuals with alcohol use disorder, with values highest 
for individuals with a greater number of affected relatives, closer genetic relationships to 
the affected person, and higher severity of the alcohol-related problems in those relatives. 
A significantly higher rate of alcohol use disorders exists in the monozygotic twin than in 
the dizygotic twin of an individual with the condition. A three- to fourfold increase in risk 
has been observed in children of individuals with alcohol use disorder, even when these 
children were given up for adoption at birth and raised by adoptive parents who did not 
have the disorder. 

Recent advances in our understanding of genes that operate through intermediate 
characteristics (or phenotypes) to affect the risk of alcohol use disorder can help to identify 
individuals who might be at particularly low or high risk for alcohol use disorder. Among 
the low-risk phenotypes are the acute alcohol-related skin flush (seen most prominently in 
Asians). High vulnerability is associated with preexisting schizophrenia or bipolar disor- 
der, as well as impulsivity (producing enhanced rates of all substance use disorders and 
gambling disorder), and a high risk specifically for alcohol use disorder is associated with 
a low level of response (low sensitivity) to alcohol. A number of gene variations may ac- 
count for low response to alcohol or modulate the dopamine reward systems; it is impor- 
tant to note, however, that any one gene variation is likely to explain only 1%—2% of the risk 
for these disorders. 


Course modifiers. In general, high levels of impulsivity are associated with an earlier 
onset and more severe alcohol use disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In most cultures, alcohol is the most frequently used intoxicating substance and contrib- 
utes to considerable morbidity and mortality. An estimated 3.8% of all global deaths and 
4.6% of global disability-adjusted life-years are attributable to alcohol. In the United States, 
80% of adults (age 18 years and older) have consumed alcohol at some time in their lives, 
and 65% are current drinkers (last 12 months). An estimated 3.6% of the world population 
(15-64 years old) has a current (12-month) alcohol use disorder, with a lower prevalence 
(1.1%) found in the African region, a higher rate (5.2%) found in the American region (North, 
South, and Central America and the Caribbean), and the highest rate (10.9%) found in the 
Eastern Europe region. 


Alcohol Use Disorder 495 


Polymorphisms of genes for the alcohol-metabolizing enzymes alcohol dehydroge- 
nase and aldehyde dehydrogenase are most often seen in Asians and affect the response to 
alcohol. When consuming alcohol, individuals with these gene variations can experience a 
flushed face and palpitations, reactions that can be so severe as to limit or preclude future 
alcohol consumption and diminish the risk for alcohol use disorder. These gene variations 
are seen in as many as 40% of Japanese, Chinese, Korean, and related groups worldwide 
and are related to lower risks for the disorder. 

Despite small variations regarding individual criterion items, the diagnostic criteria 
perform equally well across most race/ethnicity groups. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Males have higher rates of drinking and related disorders than females. However, because 
females generally weigh less than males, have more fat and less water in their bodies, and 
metabolize less alcohol in their esophagus and stomach, they are likely to develop higher 
blood alcohol levels per drink than males. Females who drink heavily may also be more 
vulnerable than males to some of the physical consequences associated with alcohol, in- 
cluding liver disease. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Individuals whose heavier drinking places them at elevated risk for alcohol use disorder 
can be identified both through standardized questionnaires and by elevations in blood test 
results likely to be seen with regular heavier drinking. These measures do not establish a 
diagnosis of an alcohol-related disorder but can be useful in highlighting individuals for 
whom more information should be gathered. The most direct test available to measure al- 
cohol consumption cross-sectionally is blood alcohol concentration, which can also be used to 
judge tolerance to alcohol. For example, an individual with a concentration of 150 mg of 
ethanol per deciliter (dL) of blood who does not show signs of intoxication can be pre- 
sumed to have acquired at least some degree of tolerance to alcohol. At 200 mg/dL, most 
nontolerant individuals demonstrate severe intoxication. 

Regarding laboratory tests, one sensitive laboratory indicator of heavy drinking is a 
modest elevation or high-normal levels (>35 units) of gamma-glutamyltransferase (GGT). 
This may be the only laboratory finding. At least 70% of individuals with a high GGT level 
are persistent heavy drinkers (i.e., consuming eight or more drinks daily on a regular basis). 
A second test with comparable or even higher levels of sensitivity and specificity is carbo- 
hydrate-deficient transferrin (CDT), with levels of 20 units or higher useful in identifying in- 
dividuals who regularly consume eight or more drinks daily. Since both GGT and CDT 
levels return toward normal within days to weeks of stopping drinking, both state markers 
may be useful in monitoring abstinence, especially when the clinician observes increases, 
rather than decreases, in these values over time—a finding indicating that the person is 
likely to have returned to heavy drinking. The combination of tests for CDT and GGT may 
have even higher levels of sensitivity and specificity than either test used alone. Additional 
useful tests include the mean corpuscular volume (MCV), which may be elevated to high- 
normal values in individuals who drink heavily—a change that is due to the direct toxic ef- 
fects of alcohol on erythropoiesis. Although the MCV can be used to help identify those who 
drink heavily, it is a poor method of monitoring abstinence because of the long half-life of 
red blood cells. Liver function tests (e.g., alanine aminotransferase [ALT] and alkaline phos- 
phatase) can reveal liver injury that is a consequence of heavy drinking. Other potential 
markers of heavy drinking that are more nonspecific for alcohol but can help the clinician 
think of the possible effects of alcohol include elevations in blood levels or lipids (e.g., tri- 
glycerides and high-density lipoprotein cholesterol) and high-normal levels of uric acid. 

Additional diagnostic markers relate to signs and symptoms that reflect the consequences 
often associated with persistent heavy drinking. For example, dyspepsia, nausea, and bloat- 


496 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


ing can accompany gastritis, and hepatomegaly, esophageal varices, and hemorrhoids may 
reflect alcohol-induced changes in the liver. Other physical signs of heavy drinking include 
tremor, unsteady gait, insomnia, and erectile dysfunction. Males with chronic alcohol use dis- 
order may exhibit decreased testicular size and feminizing effects associated with reduced 
testosterone levels. Repeated heavy drinking in females is associated with menstrual irregu- 
larities and, during pregnancy, spontaneous abortion and fetal alcohol syndrome. Individu- 
als with preexisting histories of epilepsy or severe head trauma are more likely to develop 
alcohol-related seizures. Alcohol withdrawal may be associated with nausea, vomiting, gas- 
tritis, hematemesis, dry mouth, puffy blotchy complexion, and mild peripheral edema. 


Functional Consequences of Alcohol Use Disorder 


The diagnostic features of alcohol use disorder highlight major areas of life functioning 
likely to be impaired. These include driving and operating machinery, school and work, 
interpersonal relationships and communication, and health. Alcohol-related disorders 
contribute to absenteeism from work, job-related accidents, and low employee productiv- 
ity. Rates are elevated in homeless individuals, perhaps reflecting a downward spiral in 
social and occupational functioning, although most individuals with alcohol use disorder 
continue to live with their families and function within their jobs. 

Alcohol use disorder is associated with a significant increase in the risk of accidents, vi- 
olence, and suicide. It is estimated that one in five intensive care unit admissions in some 
urban hospitals is related to alcohol and that 40% of individuals in the United States ex- 
perience an alcohol-related adverse event at some time in their lives, with alcohol account- 
ing for up to 55% of fatal driving events. Severe alcohol use disorder, especially in 
individuals with antisocial personality disorder, is associated with the commission of 
criminal acts, including homicide. Severe problematic alcohol use also contributes to dis- 
inhibition and feelings of sadness and irritability, which contribute to suicide attempts and 
completed suicides. 

Unanticipated alcohol withdrawal in hospitalized individuals for whom a diagnosis of 
alcohol use disorder has been overlooked can add to the risks and costs of hospitalization 
and to time spent in the hospital. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nonpathological use of alcohol. The key element of alcohol use disorder is the use of 
heavy doses of alcohol with resulting repeated and significant distress or impaired func- 
tioning. While most drinkers sometimes consume enough alcohol to feel intoxicated, only 
a minority (less than 20%) ever develop alcohol use disorder. Therefore, drinking, even 
daily, in low doses and occasional intoxication do not by themselves make this diagnosis. 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. The signs and symptoms of alcohol use 
disorder are similar to those seen in sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. The two 
must be distinguished, however, because the course may be different, especially in rela- 
tion to medical problems. 


Conduct disorder in childhood and adult antisocial personality disorder. Alcohol use 
disorder, along with other substance use disorders, is seen in the majority of individuals 
with antisocial personality and preexisting conduct disorder. Because these diagnoses are 
associated with an early onset of alcohol use disorder as well as a worse prognosis, it is im- 
portant to establish both conditions. 


Comorbidity 


Bipolar disorders, schizophrenia, and antisocial personality disorder are associated with a 
markedly increased rate of alcohol use disorder, and several anxiety and depressive disorders 


Alcohol Intoxication 497 


may relate to alcohol use disorder as well. At least a part of the reported association between 
depression and moderate to severe alcohol use disorder may be attributable to temporary, al- 
cohol-induced comorbid depressive symptoms resulting from the acute effects of intoxication 
or withdrawal. Severe, repeated alcohol intoxication may also suppress immune mechanisms 
and predispose individuals to infections and increase the risk for cancers. 


Alcohol Intoxication 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recent ingestion of alcohol. 

B. Clinically significant problematic behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., inappropri- 
ate sexual or aggressive behavior, mood lability, impaired judgment) that developed 
during, or shortly after, alcohol ingestion. 

C. One (or more) of the following signs or symptoms developing during, or shortly after, 
alcohol use: 

Slurred speech. 

Incoordination. 

Unsteady gait. 

Nystagmus. 

Impairment in attention or memory. 

Stupor or coma. 


Oy C1 RON 


D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not better 
explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another substance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 303.00. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
there is a comorbid alcohol use disorder. If a mild alcohol use disorder is comorbid, the 
ICD-10-CM code is F10.129, and if a moderate or severe alcohol use disorder is comorbid, 
the ICD-10-CM code is F10.229. If there is no comorbid alcohol use disorder, then the 
ICD-10-CM code is F10.929. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of alcohol intoxication is the presence of clinically significant problematic 
behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., inappropriate sexual or aggressive behavior, mood 
lability, impaired judgment, impaired social or occupational functioning) that develop during, 
or shortly after, alcohol ingestion (Criterion B). These changes are accompanied by evidence of 
impaired functioning and judgment and, if intoxication is intense, can result in a life-threaten- 
ing coma. The symptoms must not be attributable to another medical condition (e.g., diabetic 
ketoacidosis), are not a reflection of conditions such as delirium, and are not related to intoxi- 
cation with other depressant drugs (e.g., benzodiazepines) (Criterion D). The levels of incoor- 
dination can interfere with driving abilities and performance of usual activities to the point of 
causing accidents. Evidence of alcohol use can be obtained by smelling alcohol on the individ- 
ual’s breath, eliciting a history from the individual or another observer, and, when needed, 
having the individual provide breath, blood, or urine samples for toxicology analyses. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Alcohol intoxication is sometimes associated with amnesia for the events that occurred 
during the course of the intoxication (“blackouts”). This phenomenon may be related to 
the presence of a high blood alcohol level and, perhaps, to the rapidity with which this 
level is reached. During even mild alcohol intoxication, different symptoms are likely to be 


498 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


observed at different time points. Evidence of mild intoxication with alcohol can be seen in 
most individuals after approximately two drinks (each standard drink is approximately 
10-12 grams of ethanol and raises the blood alcohol concentration approximately 20 mg/ 
dL). Early in the drinking period, when blood alcohol levels are rising, symptoms often 
include talkativeness, a sensation of well-being, and a bright, expansive mood. Later, es- 
pecially when blood alcohol levels are falling, the individual is likely to become progres- 
sively more depressed, withdrawn, and cognitively impaired. At very high blood alcohol 
levels (e.g., 200-300 mg/dL), an individual who has not developed tolerance for alcohol is 
likely to fall asleep and enter a first stage of anesthesia. Higher blood alcohol levels (e.g., in 
excess of 300-400 mg/dL) can cause inhibition of respiration and pulse and even death in 
nontolerant individuals. The duration of intoxication depends on how much alcohol was 
consumed over what period of time. In general, the body is able to metabolize approxi- 
mately one drink per hour, so that the blood alcohol level generally decreases at a rate of 
15-20 mg/dL per hour. Signs and symptoms of intoxication are likely to be more intense 
when the blood alcohol level is rising than when it is falling. 

Alcohol intoxication is an important contributor to suicidal behavior. There appears to 
be an increased rate of suicidal behavior, as well as of completed suicide, among persons 
intoxicated by alcohol. 


Prevalence 


The large majority of alcohol consumers are likely to have been intoxicated to some degree at 
some point in their lives. For example, in 2010, 44% of 12th-grade students admitted to having 
been “drunk in the past year,” with more than 70% of college students reporting the same. 


Development and Course 


Intoxication usually occurs as an episode usually developing over minutes to hours and typi- 
cally lasting several hours. In the United States, the average age at first intoxication is approx- 
imately 15 years, with the highest prevalence at approximately 18-25 years. Frequency and 
intensity usually decrease with further advancing age. The earlier the onset of regular intoxi- 
cation, the greater the likelihood the individual will go on to develop alcohol use disorder. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Episodes of alcohol intoxication increase with personality characteris- 
tics of sensation seeking and impulsivity. 


Environmental. Episodes of alcohol intoxication increase with a heavy drinking envi- 
ronment. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The major issues parallel the cultural differences regarding the use of alcohol overall. 
Thus, college fraternities and sororities may encourage alcohol intoxication. This condi- 
tion is also frequent on certain dates of cultural significance (e.g., New Year’s Eve) and, for 
some subgroups, during specific events (e.g., wakes following funerals). Other subgroups 
encourage drinking at religious celebrations (e.g., Jewish and Catholic holidays), while 
still others strongly discourage all drinking or intoxication (e.g., some religious groups, 
such as Mormons, fundamentalist Christians, and Muslims). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 

Historically, in many Western societies, acceptance of drinking and drunkenness is more 
tolerated for males, but such gender differences may be much less prominent in recent 
years, especially during adolescence and young adulthood. 


Alcohol Withdrawal 499 


Diagnostic Markers 

Intoxication is usually established by observing an individual’s behavior and smelling alcohol 
on the breath. The degree of intoxication increases with an individual’s blood or breath alcohol 
level and with the ingestion of other substances, especially those with sedating effects. 


Functional Consequences of Alcohol Intoxication 

Alcohol intoxication contributes to the more than 30,000 alcohol-related drinking deaths in 
the United States each year. In addition, intoxication with this drug contributes to huge 
costs associated with drunk driving, lost time from school or work, as well as interpersonal 
arguments and physical fights. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other medical conditions. Several medical (e.g., diabetic acidosis) and neurological condi- 
tions (e.g., cerebellar ataxia, multiple sclerosis) can temporarily resemble alcohol intoxication. 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication. Intoxication with sedative, hypnotic, or 
anxiolytic drugs or with other sedating substances (e.g., antihistamines, anticholinergic 
drugs) can be mistaken for alcohol intoxication. The differential requires observing alco- 
hol on the breath, measuring blood or breath alcohol levels, ordering a medical workup, 
and gathering a good history. The signs and symptoms of sedative-hypnotic intoxication 
are very similar to those observed with alcohol and include similar problematic behavioral 
or psychological changes. These changes are accompanied by evidence of impaired func- 
tioning and judgment—which, if intense, can result in a life-threatening coma—and levels 
of incoordination that can interfere with driving abilities and with performing usual 
activities. However, there is no smell as there is with alcohol, but there is likely to be evi- 
dence of misuse of the depressant drug in the blood or urine toxicology analyses. 


Comorbidity 


Alcohol intoxication may occur comorbidly with other substance intoxication, especially 
in individuals with conduct disorder or antisocial personality disorder. 


Alcohol Withdrawal 
Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Cessation of (or reduction in) alcohol use that has been heavy and prolonged. 

B. Two (or more) of the following, developing within several hours to a few days after the 
cessation of (or reduction in) alcohol use described in Criterion A: 

Autonomic hyperactivity (e.g., sweating or pulse rate greater than 100 bpm). 

Increased hand tremor. 

Insomnia. 

Nausea or vomiting. 

Transient visual, tactile, or auditory hallucinations or illusions. 

Psychomotor agitation. 

Anxiety. 

Generalized tonic-clonic seizures. 


OO OOM Fi Ne 


C. The signs or symptoms in Criterion B cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 


500 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication or withdrawal from 
another substance. 


Specify if: 
With perceptual disturbances: This specifier applies in the rare instance when hal- 
lucinations (usually visual or tactile) occur with intact reality testing, or auditory, visual, 
or tactile illusions occur in the absence of a delirium. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 291.81. The ICD-10-CM code for alcohol withdrawal 
without perceptual disturbances is F10.239, and the ICD-10-CM code for alcohol withdrawal 
with perceptual disturbances is F10.232. Note that the ICD-10-CM code indicates the comor- 
bid presence of a moderate or severe alcohol use disorder, reflecting the fact that alcohol with- 
drawal can only occur in the presence of a moderate or severe alcohol use disorder. It is not 
permissible to code a comorbid mild alcohol use disorder with alcohol withdrawal. 


Specifiers 
When hallucinations occur in the absence of delirium (i.e., ina clear sensorium), a diagno- 
sis of substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder should be considered. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of alcohol withdrawal is the presence of a characteristic withdrawal 
syndrome that develops within several hours to a few days after the cessation of (or re- 
duction in) heavy and prolonged alcohol use (Criteria A and B). The withdrawal syn- 
drome includes two or more of the symptoms reflecting autonomic hyperactivity and 
anxiety listed in Criterion B, along with gastrointestinal symptoms. 

Withdrawal symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, or other important areas of functioning (Criterion C). The symptoms must not 
be attributable to another medical condition and are not better explained by another men- 
tal disorder (e.g., generalized anxiety disorder), including intoxication or withdrawal 
from another substance (e.g., sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal) (Criterion D). 

Symptoms can be relieved by administering alcohol or benzodiazepines (e.g., diazepam). 
The withdrawal symptoms typically begin when blood concentrations of alcohol decline 
sharply (i.e., within 4-12 hours) after alcohol use has been stopped or reduced. Reflecting the 
relatively fast metabolism of alcohol, symptoms of alcohol withdrawal usually peak in inten- 
sity during the second day of abstinence and are likely to improve markedly by the fourth or 
fifth day. Following acute withdrawal, however, symptoms of anxiety, insomnia, and auto- 
nomic dysfunction may persist for up to 3-6 months at lower levels of intensity. 

Fewer than 10% of individuals who develop alcohol withdrawal will ever develop dra- 
matic symptoms (e.g., severe autonomic hyperactivity, tremors, alcohol withdrawal delir- 
ium). Tonic-clonic seizures occur in fewer than 3% of individuals. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Although confusion and changes in consciousness are not core criteria for alcohol with- 
drawal, alcohol withdrawal delirium (see “Delirium” in the chapter “Neurocognitive Dis- 
orders”) may occur in the context of withdrawal. As is true for any agitated, confused state, 
regardless of the cause, in addition to a disturbance of consciousness and cognition, with- 
drawal delirium can include visual, tactile, or (rarely) auditory hallucinations (delirium tre- 
mens). When alcohol withdrawal delirium develops, it is likely that a clinically relevant 
medical condition may be present (e.g., liver failure, pneumonia, gastrointestinal bleeding, 
sequelae of head trauma, hypoglycemia, an electrolyte imbalance, postoperative status). 


Alcohol Withdrawal 501 


Prevalence 


It is estimated that approximately 50% of middle-class, highly functional individuals with 
alcohol use disorder have ever experienced a full alcohol withdrawal syndrome. Among 
individuals with alcohol use disorder who are hospitalized or homeless, the rate of al- 
cohol withdrawal may be greater than 80%. Less than 10% of individuals in withdrawal 
ever demonstrate alcohol withdrawal delirium or withdrawal seizures. 


Development and Course 


Acute alcohol withdrawal occurs as an episode usually lasting 4-5 days and only after 
extended periods of heavy drinking. Withdrawal is relatively rare in individuals younger 
than 30 years, and the risk and severity increase with increasing age. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. The probability of developing alcohol withdrawal increases with the 
quantity and frequency of alcohol consumption. Most individuals with this condition are 
drinking daily, consuming large amounts (approximately more than eight drinks per day) 
for multiple days. However, there are large inter-individual differences, with enhanced 
risks for individuals with concurrent medical conditions, those with family histories of al- 
cohol withdrawal (i.e., a genetic component), those with prior withdrawals, and individ- 
uals who consume sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic drugs. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Autonomic hyperactivity in the context of moderately high but falling blood alcohol levels 
and a history of prolonged heavy drinking indicate a likelihood of alcohol withdrawal. 


Functional Consequences of Alcohol Withdrawal 


Symptoms of withdrawal may serve to perpetuate drinking behaviors and contribute to 
relapse, resulting in persistently impaired social and occupational functioning. Symptoms 
requiring medically supervised detoxification result in hospital utilization and loss of 
work productivity. Overall, the presence of withdrawal is associated with greater func- 
tional impairment and poor prognosis. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other medical conditions. The symptoms of alcohol withdrawal can also be mimicked 
by some medical conditions (e.g., hypoglycemia and diabetic ketoacidosis). Essential 
tremor, a disorder that frequently runs in families, may erroneously suggest the tremu- 
lousness associated with alcohol withdrawal. 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal. Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic with- 
drawal produces a syndrome very similar to that of alcohol withdrawal. 


Comorbidity 


Withdrawal is more likely to occur with heavier alcohol intake, and that might be most of- 
ten observed in individuals with conduct disorder and antisocial personality disorder. 
Withdrawal states are also more severe in older individuals, individuals who are also de- 
pendent on other depressant drugs (sedative-hypnotics), and individuals who have had 
more alcohol withdrawal experiences in the past. 


502 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Other Alcohol-Induced Disorders 


The following alcohol-induced disorders are described in other chapters of the manual with 
disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance /medication-induced 
mental disorders in these chapters): alcohol-induced psychotic disorder (“Schizophrenia Spec- 
trum and Other Psychotic Disorders”); alcohol-induced bipolar disorder (“Bipolar and 
Related Disorders”); alcohol-induced depressive disorder (“Depressive Disorders”); alcohol- 
induced anxiety disorder (“Anxiety Disorders”); alcohol-induced sleep disorder (“Sleep- 
Wake Disorders”); alcohol-induced sexual dysfunction (“Sexual Dysfunctions”); and alcohol- 
induced major or mild neurocognitive disorder (“Neurocognitive Disorders”). For alcohol 
intoxication delirium and alcohol withdrawal delirium, see the criteria and discussion of de- 
lirium in the chapter “Neurocognitive Disorders.” These alcohol-induced disorders are diag- 
nosed instead of alcohol intoxication or alcohol withdrawal only when the symptoms are 
sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Features 


The symptom profiles for an alcohol-induced condition resemble independent mental disor- 
ders as described elsewhere in DSM-5. However, the alcohol-induced disorder is temporary 
and observed after severe intoxication with and/or withdrawal from alcohol. While the symp- 
toms can be identical to those of independent mental disorders (e.g., psychoses, major depres- 
sive disorder), and while they can have the same severe consequences (e.g., suicide attempts), 
alcohol-induced conditions are likely to improve without formal treatment in a matter of days 
to weeks after cessation of severe intoxication and/or withdrawal. 

Each alcohol-induced mental disorder is listed in the relevant diagnostic section and there- 
fore only a brief description is offered here. Alcohol-induced disorders must have developed 
in the context of severe intoxication and/or withdrawal from the substance capable of produc- 
ing the mental disorder. In addition, there must be evidence that the disorder being observed 
is not likely to be better explained by another non-alcohol-induced mental disorder. The latter 
is likely to occur if the mental disorder was present before the severe intoxication or with- 
drawal, or continued more than 1 month after the cessation of severe intoxication and/or with- 
drawal. When symptoms are observed only during a delirium, they should be considered part 
of the delirium and not diagnosed separately, as many symptoms (including disturbances in 
mood, anxiety, and reality testing) are commonly seen during agitated, confused states. The al- 
cohol-induced disorder must be clinically relevant, causing significant levels of distress or sig- 
nificant functional impairment. Finally, there are indications that the intake of substances of 
abuse in the context of a preexisting mental disorder are likely to result in an intensification of 
the preexisting independent syndrome. 

The features associated with each relevant major mental disorder (e.g., psychotic epi- 
sodes, major depressive disorder) are similar whether observed with an independent or an 
alcohol-induced condition. However, individuals with alcohol-induced disorders are 
likely to also demonstrate the associated features seen with an alcohol use disorder, as 
listed in the subsections of this chapter. 

Rates of alcohol-induced disorders vary somewhat by diagnostic category. For exam- 
ple, the lifetime risk for major depressive episodes in individuals with alcohol use disorder 
is approximately 40%, but only about one-third to one-half of these represent independent 
major depressive syndromes observed outside the context of intoxication. Similar rates of 
alcohol-induced sleep and anxiety conditions are likely, but alcohol-induced psychotic ep- 
isodes are fairly rare. 


Development and Course 


Once present, the symptoms of an alcohol-induced condition are likely to remain clinically 
relevant as long as the individual continues to experience severe intoxication and/or with- 


Unspecified Alcohol-Related Disorder 503 


drawal. While the symptoms are identical to those of independent mental disorders (e.g., 
psychoses, major depressive disorder), and while they can have the same severe conse- 
quences (e.g., suicide attempts), all alcohol-induced syndromes other than alcohol- 
induced neurocognitive disorder, amnestic confabulatory type (alcohol-induced persist- 
ing amnestic disorder), regardless of the severity of the symptoms, are likely to improve 
relatively quickly and unlikely to remain clinically relevant for more than 1 month after 
cessation of severe intoxication and/or withdrawal. 

The alcohol-induced disorders are an important part of the differential diagnoses for 
the independent mental conditions. Independent schizophrenia, major depressive disor- 
der, bipolar disorder, and anxiety disorders, such as panic disorder, are likely to be asso- 
ciated with much longer-lasting periods of symptoms and often require longer-term 
medications to optimize the probability of improvement or recovery. The alcohol-induced 
conditions, on the other hand, are likely to be much shorter in duration and disappear 
within several days to 1 month after cessation of severe intoxication and/or withdrawal, 
even without psychotropic medications. 

The importance of recognizing an alcohol-induced disorder is similar to the relevance 
of identifying the possible role of some endocrine conditions and medication reactions be- 
fore diagnosing an independent mental disorder. In light of the high prevalence of alcohol 
use disorders worldwide, it is important that these alcohol-induced diagnoses be consid- 
ered before independent mental disorders are diagnosed. 


Unspecified Alcohol-Related Disorder 
291.9 (F 10.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an alcohol- 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any specific alcohol-related disorder or any of the disorders in the substance-related 
and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


Caffeine-Related Disorders 


Caffeine Intoxication 
Caffeine Withdrawal 
Other Caffeine-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Caffeine-Related Disorder 


Caffeine Intoxication 
Diagnostic Criteria 305.90 (F 15.929) 


A. Recent consumption of caffeine (typically a high dose well in excess of 250 mg). 
B. Five (or more) of the following signs or symptoms developing during, or shortly after, 
caffeine use: 


1. Restlessness. 
2. Nervousness. 


504 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


3. Excitement. 
4. Insomnia. 

5. Flushed face. 
6. Diuresis. 

7. Gastrointestinal disturbance. 

8. Muscle twitching. 

9. Rambling flow of thought and speech. 
10. Tachycardia or cardiac arrhythmia. 
11. Periods of inexhaustibility. 

12. Psychomotor agitation. 


C. The signs or symptoms in Criterion B cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not bet- 
ter explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another substance. 


Diagnostic Features 


Caffeine can be consumed from a number of different sources, including coffee, tea, caf- 
feinated soda, “energy” drinks, over-the-counter analgesics and cold remedies, energy 
aids (e.g., drinks), weight-loss aids, and chocolate. Caffeine is also increasingly being used 
as an additive to vitamins and to food products. More than 85% of children and adults con- 
sume caffeine regularly. Some caffeine users display symptoms consistent with problem- 
atic use, including tolerance and withdrawal (see “Caffeine Withdrawal” later in this 
chapter); the data are not available at this time to determine the clinical significance of a 
caffeine use disorder and its prevalence. In contrast, there is evidence that caffeine with- 
drawal and caffeine intoxication are clinically significant and sufficiently prevalent. 

The essential feature of caffeine intoxication is recent consumption of caffeine and five 
or more signs or symptoms that develop during or shortly after caffeine use (Criteria A 
and B). Symptoms include restlessness, nervousness, excitement, insomnia, flushed face, 
diuresis, and gastrointestinal complaints, which can occur with low doses (e.g., 200 mg) in 
vulnerable individuals such as children, the elderly, or individuals who have not been ex- 
posed to caffeine previously. Symptoms that generally appear at levels of more than 1 g/ 
day include muscle twitching, rambling flow of thought and speech, tachycardia or car- 
diac arrhythmia, periods of inexhaustibility, and psychomotor agitation. Caffeine intoxi- 
cation may not occur despite high caffeine intake because of the development of tolerance. 
The signs or symptoms must cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 
occupational, or other important areas of functioning (Criterion C). The signs or symp- 
toms must not be attributable to another medical condition and are not better explained by 
another mental disorder (e.g., an anxiety disorder) or intoxication with another substance 
(Criterion D). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Mild sensory disturbances (e.g., ringing in the ears and flashes of light) may occur with high 
doses of caffeine. Although large doses of caffeine can increase heart rate, smaller doses can 
slow heart rate. Whether excess caffeine intake can cause headaches is unclear. On physical 
examination, agitation, restlessness, sweating, tachycardia, flushed face, and increased 
bowel motility may be seen. Caffeine blood levels may provide important information for 
diagnosis, particularly when the individual is a poor historian, although these levels are not 
diagnostic by themselves in view of the individual variation in response to caffeine. 


Caffeine Intoxication 505 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of caffeine intoxication in the general population is unclear. In the United 
States, approximately 7% of individuals in the population may experience five or more symp- 
toms along with functional impairment consistent with a diagnosis of caffeine intoxication. 


Development and Course 


Consistent with a half-life of caffeine of approximately 4-6 hours, caffeine intoxication 
symptoms usually remit within the first day or so and do not have any known long-lasting 
consequences. However, individuals who consume very high doses of caffeine (i.e., 5-10 
g) may require immediate medical attention, as such doses can be lethal. 

With advancing age, individuals are likely to demonstrate increasingly intense reac- 
tions to caffeine, with greater complaints of interference with sleep or feelings of hyper- 
arousal. Caffeine intoxication among young individuals after consumption of highly 
caffeinated products, including energy drinks, has been observed. Children and adoles- 
cents may be at increased risk for caffeine intoxication because of low body weight, lack of 
tolerance, and lack of knowledge about the pharmacological effects of caffeine. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Caffeine intoxication is often seen among individuals who use caffeine 
less frequently or in those who have recently increased their caffeine intake by a substan- 
tial amount. Furthermore, oral contraceptives significantly decrease the elimination of caf- 
feine and consequently may increase the risk of intoxication. 


Genetic and physiological. Genetic factors may affect risk of caffeine intoxication. 


Functional Consequences of Caffeine Intoxication 


Impairment from caffeine intoxication may have serious consequences, including dys- 
function at work or school, social indiscretions, or failure to fulfill role obligations. More- 
over, extremely high doses of caffeine can be fatal. In some cases, caffeine intoxication may 
precipitate a caffeine-induced disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders. Caffeine intoxication may be characterized by symptoms (e.g., 
panic attacks) that resemble primary mental disorders. To meet criteria for caffeine intoxica- 
tion, the symptoms must not be associated with another medical condition or another mental 
disorder, such as an anxiety disorder, that could better explain them. Manic episodes; panic 
disorder; generalized anxiety disorder; amphetamine intoxication; sedative, hypnotic, or anx- 
iolytic withdrawal or tobacco withdrawal; sleep disorders; and medication-induced side ef- 
fects (e.g., akathisia) can cause a clinical picture that is similar to that of caffeine intoxication. 


Other caffeine-induced disorders. The temporal relationship of the symptoms to increased 
caffeine use or to abstinence from caffeine helps to establish the diagnosis. Caffeine intoxica- 
tion is differentiated from caffeine-induced anxiety disorder, with onset during intoxication 
(see “Substance /Medication-Induced Anxiety Disorder” in the chapter “Anxiety Disorders”), 
and caffeine-induced sleep disorder, with onset during intoxication (see “Substance/Medica- 
tion-Induced Sleep Disorder” in the chapter “Sleep-Wake Disorders”), by the fact that the 
symptoms in these latter disorders are in excess of those usually associated with caffeine in- 
toxication and are severe enough to warrant independent clinical attention. 


506 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Comorbidity 


Typical dietary doses of caffeine have not been consistently associated with medical prob- 
lems. However, heavy use (e.g., >400 mg) can cause or exacerbate anxiety and somatic 
symptoms and gastrointestinal distress. With acute, extremely high doses of caffeine, 
grand mal seizures and respiratory failure may result in death. Excessive caffeine use is as- 
sociated with depressive disorders, bipolar disorders, eating disorders, psychotic disor- 
ders, sleep disorders, and substance-related disorders, whereas individuals with anxiety 
disorders are more likely to avoid caffeine. 


Caffeine Withdrawal 
Diagnostic Criteria 292.0 (F15.93) 


A. Prolonged daily use of caffeine. 
B. Abrupt cessation of or reduction in caffeine use, followed within 24 hours by three (or 
more) of the following signs or symptoms: 


1. Headache. 

2. Marked fatigue or drowsiness. 

3. Dysphoric mood, depressed mood, or irritability. 

4. Difficulty concentrating. 

5. Flu-like symptoms (nausea, vomiting, or muscle pain/stiffness). 


C. The signs or symptoms in Criterion B cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The signs or symptoms are not associated with the physiological effects of another 
medical condition (e.g., migraine, viral illness) and are not better explained by another 
mental disorder, including intoxication or withdrawal from another substance. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of caffeine withdrawal is the presence of a characteristic withdrawal 
syndrome that develops after the abrupt cessation of (or substantial reduction in) pro- 
longed daily caffeine ingestion (Criterion B). The caffeine withdrawal syndrome is indi- 
cated by three or more of the following (Criterion B): headache; marked fatigue or 
drowsiness; dysphoric mood, depressed mood, or irritability; difficulty concentrating; 
and flu-like symptoms (nausea, vomiting, or muscle pain/stiffness). The withdrawal syn- 
drome causes clinical significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other 
important areas of functioning (Criterion C). The symptoms must not be associated with 
the physiological effects of another medical condition and are not better explained by an- 
other mental disorder (Criterion D). 

Headache is the hallmark feature of caffeine withdrawal and may be diffuse, gradual 
in development, throbbing, severe, and sensitive to movement. However, other symptoms 
of caffeine withdrawal can occur in the absence of headache. Caffeine is the most widely 
used behaviorally active drug in the world and is present in many different types of bev- 
erages (e.g., coffee, tea, maté, soft drinks, energy drinks), foods, energy aids, medications, 
and dietary supplements. Because caffeine ingestion is often integrated into social customs 
and daily rituals (e.g., coffee break, tea time), some caffeine consumers may be unaware of 
their physical dependence on caffeine. Thus, caffeine withdrawal symptoms could be un- 
expected and misattributed to other causes (e.g., the flu, migraine). Furthermore, caffeine 
withdrawal symptoms may occur when individuals are required to abstain from foods 
and beverages prior to medical procedures or when a usual caffeine dose is missed be- 
cause of a change in routine (e.g., during travel, weekends). 


Caffeine Withdrawal 507 


The probability and severity of caffeine withdrawal generally increase as a function of 
usual daily caffeine dose. However, there is large variability among individuals and 
within individuals across different episodes in the incidence, severity, and time course of 
withdrawal symptoms. Caffeine withdrawal symptoms may occur after abrupt cessation 
of relatively low chronic daily doses of caffeine (i.e., 100 mg). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Caffeine abstinence has been shown to be associated with impaired behavioral and cogni- 
tive performance (e.g., sustained attention). Electroencephalographic studies have shown 
that caffeine withdrawal symptoms are significantly associated with increases in theta 
power and decreases in beta-2 power. Decreased motivation to work and decreased socia- 
bility have also been reported during caffeine withdrawal. Increased analgesic use during 
caffeine withdrawal has been documented. 


Prevalence 


More than 85% of adults and children in the United States regularly consume caffeine, 
with adult caffeine consumers ingesting about 280 mg/day on average. The incidence and 
prevalence of the caffeine withdrawal syndrome in the general population are unclear. In 
the United States, headache may occur in approximately 50% of cases of caffeine absti- 
nence. In attempts to permanently stop caffeine use, more than 70% of individuals may ex- 
perience at least one caffeine withdrawal symptom (47% may experience headache), and 
24% may experience headache plus one or more other symptoms as well as functional 
impairment due to withdrawal. Among individuals who abstain from caffeine for at least 
24 hours but are not trying to permanently stop caffeine use, 11% may experience head- 
ache plus one or more other symptoms as well as functional impairment. Caffeine con- 
sumers can decrease the incidence of caffeine withdrawal by using caffeine daily or only 
infrequently (e.g., no more than 2 consecutive days). Gradual reduction in caffeine over a 
period of days or weeks may decrease the incidence and severity of caffeine withdrawal. 


Development and Course 


Symptoms usually begin 12-24 hours after the last caffeine dose and peak after 1-2 days 
of abstinence. Caffeine withdrawal symptoms last for 2-9 days, with the possibility of 
withdrawal headaches occurring for up to 21 days. Symptoms usually remit rapidly 
(within 30-60 minutes) after re-ingestion of caffeine. 

Caffeine is unique in that it is a behaviorally active drug that is consumed by individ- 
uals of nearly all ages. Rates of caffeine consumption and overall level of caffeine con- 
sumption increase with age until the early to mid-30s and then level off. Although caffeine 
withdrawal among children and adolescents has been documented, relatively little is 
known about risk factors for caffeine withdrawal among this age group. The use of highly 
caffeinated energy drinks is increasing with in young individuals, which could increase 
the risk for caffeine withdrawal. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Heavy caffeine use has been observed among individuals with mental 
disorders, including eating disorders; smokers; prisoners; and drug and alcohol abusers. 
Thus, these individuals could be at higher risk for caffeine withdrawal upon acute caffeine 
abstinence. 


Environmental. The unavailability of caffeine is an environmental risk factor for incipi- 
ent withdrawal symptoms. While caffeine is legal and usually widely available, there are 
conditions in which caffeine use may be restricted, such as during medical procedures, 
pregnancy, hospitalizations, religious observances, wartime, travel, and research partici- 


508 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


pation. These external environmental circumstances may precipitate a withdrawal syn- 
drome in vulnerable individuals. 


Genetic and physiological factors. Genetic factors appear to increase vulnerability to 
caffeine withdrawal, but no specific genes have been identified. 


Course modifiers. Caffeine withdrawal symptoms usually remit within 30-60 minutes 
of reexposure to caffeine. Doses of caffeine significantly less than one’s usual daily dose 
may be sufficient to prevent or attenuate caffeine withdrawal symptoms (e.g., consump- 
tion of 25 mg by an individual who typically consumes 300 mg). 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Habitual caffeine consumers who fast for religious reasons may be at increased risk for caf- 
feine withdrawal. 


Functional Consequences of 
Caffeine Withdrawal Disorder 


Caffeine withdrawal symptoms can vary from mild to extreme, at times causing functional 
impairment in normal daily activities. Rates of functional impairment range from 10% to 
55% (median 13%), with rates as high as 73% found among individuals who also show 
other problematic features of caffeine use. Examples of functional impairment include be- 
ing unable to work, exercise, or care for children; staying in bed all day; missing religious 
services; ending a vacation early; and cancelling a social gathering. Caffeine withdrawal 
headaches may be described by individuals as “the worst headaches” ever experienced. 
Decrements in cognitive and motor performance have also been observed. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other medical disorders and medical side effects. Several disorders should be consid- 
ered in the differential diagnosis of caffeine withdrawal. Caffeine withdrawal can mimic 
migraine and other headache disorders, viral illnesses, sinus conditions, tension, other 
drug withdrawal states (e.g., from amphetamines, cocaine), and medication side effects. 
The final determination of caffeine withdrawal should rest on a determination of the pat- 
tern and amount consumed, the time interval between caffeine abstinence and onset of 
symptoms, and the particular clinical features presented by the individual. A challenge 
dose of caffeine followed by symptom remission may be used to confirm the diagnosis. 


Comorbidity 


Caffeine withdrawal may be associated with major depressive disorder, generalized anx- 
iety disorder, panic disorder, antisocial personality disorder in adults, moderate to severe 
alcohol use disorder, and cannabis and cocaine use. 


Other Caffeine-Induced Disorders 


The following caffeine-induced disorders are described in other chapters of the manual 
with disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance/medication- 
induced mental disorders in these chapters): caffeine-induced anxiety disorder (“Anxiety 
Disorders”) and caffeine-induced sleep disorder (“Sleep-Wake Disorders”). These caf- 
feine-induced disorders are diagnosed instead of caffeine intoxication or caffeine with- 
drawal only when the symptoms are sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical 
attention. 


Unspecified Caffeine-Related Disorder 509 


Unspecified Caffeine-Related Disorder 
292.9 (F 15.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a caffeine- 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any specific caffeine-related disorder or any of the disorders in the substance-related 
and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


Cannabis-Related Disorders 


Cannabis Use Disorder 
Cannabis Intoxication 
Cannabis Withdrawal 

Other Cannabis-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Cannabis-Related Disorder 


Cannabis Use Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A problematic pattern of cannabis use leading to clinically significant impairment or dis- 
tress, as manifested by at least two of the following, occurring within a 12-month period: 


1. 
2. 
3. 


10. 


11. 


Cannabis is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was intended. 
There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control cannabis use. 
A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain cannabis, use canna- 
bis, or recover from its effects. 

Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use cannabis. 

Recurrent cannabis use resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at work, 
school, or home. 

Continued cannabis use despite having persistent or recurrent social or interper- 
sonal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of cannabis. 

Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of cannabis use. 

Recurrent cannabis use in situations in which it is physically hazardous. 

Cannabis use is continued despite knowledge of having a persistent or recurrent 
physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or exacerbated 
by cannabis. 

Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 


a. A need for markedly increased amounts of cannabis to achieve intoxication or 
desired effect. 

b. Markedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of cannabis. 

Withdrawal, as manifested by either of the following: 


a. The characteristic withdrawal syndrome for cannabis (refer to Criteria A and B 
of the criteria set for cannabis withdrawal, pp. 517-518). 


510 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


b. Cannabis (or a closely related substance) is taken to relieve or avoid withdrawal 
symptoms. 


Specify if: 
In early remission: After full criteria for cannabis use disorder were previously met, 
none of the criteria for cannabis use disorder have been met for at least 3 months but 
for less than 12 months (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong de- 
sire or urge to use cannabis,” may be met). 
In sustained remission: After full criteria for cannabis use disorder were previously 
met, none of the criteria for cannabis use disorder have been met at any time during a 
period of 12 months or longer (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a 
strong desire or urge to use cannabis,” may be present). 

Specity if: 
In a controlled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to cannabis is restricted. 


Code based on current severity: Note for ICD-10-CM codes: If a cannabis intoxication, 
cannabis withdrawal, or another cannabis-induced mental disorder is also present, do not 
use the codes below for cannabis use disorder. Instead, the comorbid cannabis use disorder 
is indicated in the 4th character of the cannabis-induced disorder code (see the coding note 
for cannabis intoxication, cannabis withdrawal, or a specific cannabis-induced mental disor- 
der). For example, if there is comorbid cannabis-induced anxiety disorder and cannabis use 
disorder, only the cannabis-induced anxiety disorder code is given, with the 4th character 
indicating whether the comorbid cannabis use disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: 
F12.180 for mild cannabis use disorder with cannabis-induced anxiety disorder or F12.280 
for a moderate or severe cannabis use disorder with cannabis-induced anxiety disorder. 


Specify current severity: 
305.20 (F12.10) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
304.30 (F12.20) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
304.30 (F12.20) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


Specifiers 

“In a controlled environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is 
both in remission and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled 
environment or in sustained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these 
environments are closely supervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, 
and locked hospital units. 

Changing severity across time in an individual may also be reflected by changes in the 
frequency (e.g., days of use per month or times used per day) and/or dose (e.g., amount 
used per episode) of cannabis, as assessed by individual self-report, report of knowledge- 
able others, clinician’s observations, and biological testing. 


Diagnostic Features 


Cannabis use disorder and the other cannabis-related disorders include problems that are 
associated with substances derived from the cannabis plant and chemically similar syn- 
thetic compounds. Over time, this plant material has accumulated many names (e.g., 
weed, pot, herb, grass, reefer, mary jane, dagga, dope, bhang, skunk, boom, gangster, kif, 
and ganja). A concentrated extraction of the cannabis plant that is also commonly used is 
hashish. Cannabis is the generic and perhaps the most appropriate scientific term for the 
psychoactive substance(s) derived from the plant, and as such it is used in this manual 
to refer to all forms of cannabis-like substances, including synthetic cannabinoid com- 
pounds. 


Cannabis Use Disorder 511 


Synthetic oral formulations (pill/capsules) of delta-9-tetrahydrocannabinol (delta-9- 
THC) are available by prescription for a number of approved medical indications (e.g., for 
nausea and vomiting caused by chemotherapy; for anorexia and weight loss in individuals 
with AIDS). Other synthetic cannabinoid compounds have been manufactured and dis- 
tributed for nonmedical use in the form of plant material that has been sprayed with a can- 
nabinoid formulation (e.g., K2, Spice, JWH-018, JWH-073). 

The cannabinoids have diverse effects in the brain, prominent among which are actions 
on CB1 and CB2 cannabinoid receptors that are found throughout the central nervous sys- 
tem. Endogenous ligands for these receptors behave essentially like neurotransmitters. 
The potency of cannabis (delta-9-THC concentration) that is generally available varies 
greatly, ranging from 1% to approximately 15% in typical cannabis plant material and 
10%-20% in hashish. During the past two decades, a steady increase in the potency of 
seized cannabis has been observed. 

Cannabis is most commonly smoked via a variety of methods: pipes, water pipes 
(bongs or hookahs), cigarettes (joints or reefers), or, most recently, in the paper from hol- 
lowed out cigars (blunts). Cannabis is also sometimes ingested orally, typically by mixing 
it into food. More recently, devices have been developed in which cannabis is “vapor- 
ized.” Vaporization involves heating the plant material to release psychoactive cannabi- 
noids for inhalation. As with other psychoactive substances, smoking (and vaporization) 
typically produces more rapid onset and more intense experiences of the desired effects. 

Individuals who regularly use cannabis can develop all the general diagnostic features 
of a substance use disorder. Cannabis use disorder is commonly observed as the only sub- 
stance use disorder experienced by the individual; however, it also frequently occurs con- 
currently with other types of substance use disorders (i.e., alcohol, cocaine, opioid). In 
cases for which multiple types of substances are used, many times the individual may 
minimize the symptoms related to cannabis, as the symptoms may be less severe or cause 
less harm than those directly related to the use of the other substances. Pharmacological 
and behavioral tolerance to most of the effects of cannabis has been reported in individuals 
who use cannabis persistently. Generally, tolerance is lost when cannabis use is discontin- 
ued for a significant period of time (i.e., for at least several months). 

New to DSM-5 is the recognition that abrupt cessation of daily or near-daily cannabis 
use often results in the onset of a cannabis withdrawal syndrome. Common symptoms of 
withdrawal include irritability, anger or aggression, anxiety, depressed mood, restless- 
ness, sleep difficulty, and decreased appetite or weight loss. Although typically not as 
severe as alcohol or opiate withdrawal, the cannabis withdrawal syndrome can cause sig- 
nificant distress and contribute to difficulty quitting or relapse among those trying to 
abstain. 

Individuals with cannabis use disorder may use cannabis throughout the day over a 
period of months or years, and thus may spend many hours a day under the influence. 
Others may use less frequently, but their use causes recurrent problems related to family, 
school, work, or other important activities (e.g., repeated absences at work; neglect of fam- 
ily obligations). Periodic cannabis use and intoxication can negatively affect behavioral 
and cognitive functioning and thus interfere with optimal performance at work or school, 
or place the individual at increased physical risk when performing activities that could be 
physically hazardous (e.g., driving a car; playing certain sports; performing manual work 
activities, including operating machinery). Arguments with spouses or parents over the 
use of cannabis in the home, or its use in the presence of children, can adversely impact 
family functioning and are common features of those with cannabis use disorder. Last, in- 
dividuals with cannabis use disorder may continue using despite knowledge of physical 
problems (e.g., chronic cough related to smoking) or psychological problems (e.g., exces- 
sive sedation or exacerbation of other mental health problems) associated with its use. 

Whether or not cannabis is being used for legitimate medical reasons may also affect 
diagnosis. When a substance is taken as indicated for a medical condition, symptoms of 


512 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


tolerance and withdrawal will naturally occur and should not be used as the primary cri- 
teria for determining a diagnosis of a substance use disorder. Although medical uses of 
cannabis remain controversial and equivocal, use for medical circumstances should be 
considered when a diagnosis is being made. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals who regularly use cannabis often report that it is being used to cope with 
mood, sleep, pain, or other physiological or psychological problems, and those diagnosed 
with cannabis use disorder frequently do have concurrent other mental disorders. Careful 
assessment typically reveals reports of cannabis use contributing to exacerbation of these 
same symptoms, as well as other reasons for frequent use (e.g., to experience euphoria, to 
forget about problems, in response to anger, as an enjoyable social activity). Related to this 
issue, some individuals who use cannabis multiple times per day for the aforementioned 
reasons do not perceive themselves as (and thus do not report) spending an excessive 
amount of time under the influence or recovering from the effects of cannabis, despite be- 
ing intoxicated on cannabis or coming down from it effects for the majority of most days. 
An important marker of a substance use disorder diagnosis, particularly in milder cases, is 
continued use despite a clear risk of negative consequences to other valued activities or re- 
lationships (e.g., school, work, sport activity, partner or parent relationship). 

Because some cannabis users are motivated to minimize their amount or frequency of 
use, it is important to be aware of common signs and symptoms of cannabis use and intox- 
ication so as to better assess the extent of use. As with other substances, experienced users 
of cannabis develop behavioral and pharmacological tolerance such that it can be difficult 
to detect when they are under the influence. Signs of acute and chronic use include red eyes 
(conjunctival injection), cannabis odor on clothing, yellowing of finger tips (from smoking 
joints), chronic cough, burning of incense (to hide the odor), and exaggerated craving and 
impulse for specific foods, sometimes at unusual times of the day or night. 


Prevalence 


Cannabinoids, especially cannabis, are the most widely used illicit psychoactive sub- 
stances in the United States. The 12-month prevalence of cannabis use disorder (DSM-IV 
abuse and dependence rates combined) is approximately 3.4% among 12- to 17-year-olds 
and 1.5% among adults age 18 years and older. Rates of cannabis use disorder are greater 
among adult males (2.2%) than among adult females (0.8%) and among 12- to 17-year-old 
males (3.8%) than among 12- to 17-year-old females (3.0%). Twelve-month prevalence 
rates of cannabis use disorder among adults decrease with age, with rates highest among 
18- to 29-year-olds (4.4%) and lowest among individuals age 65 years and older (0.01%). 
The high prevalence of cannabis use disorder likely reflects the much more widespread 
use of cannabis relative to other illicit drugs rather than greater addictive potential. 

Ethnic and racial differences in prevalence are moderate. Twelve-month prevalences 
of cannabis use disorder vary markedly across racial-ethnic subgroups in the United 
States. For 12- to 17-year-olds, rates are highest among Native American and Alaska Na- 
tives (7.1%) compared with Hispanics (4.1%), whites (3.4%), African Americans (2.7%), 
and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders (0.9%). Among adults, the prevalence of can- 
nabis use disorder is also highest among Native Americans and Alaska Natives (3.4%) rel- 
ative to rates among African Americans (1.8%), whites (1.4%), Hispanics (1.2%), and Asian 
and Pacific Islanders (1.2%). During the past decade the prevalence of cannabis use disor- 
der has increased among adults and adolescents. Gender differences in cannabis use dis- 
order generally are concordant with those in other substance use disorders. Cannabis use 
disorder is more commonly observed in males, although the magnitude of this difference 
is less among adolescents. 


Cannabis Use Disorder 513 


Development and Course 


The onset of cannabis use disorder can occur at any time during or following adolescence, 
but onset is most commonly during adolescence or young adulthood. Although much less 
frequent, onset of cannabis use disorder in the preteen years or in the late 20s or older can 
occur. Recent acceptance by some of the use and availability of “medical marijuana” may 
increase the rate of onset of cannabis use disorder among older adults. 

Generally, cannabis use disorder develops over an extended period of time, although 
the progression appears to be more rapid in adolescents, particularly those with pervasive 
conduct problems. Most people who develop a cannabis use disorder typically establish a 
pattern of cannabis use that gradually increases in both frequency and amount. Cannabis, 
along with tobacco and alcohol, is traditionally the first substance that adolescents try. 
Many perceive cannabis use as less harmful than alcohol or tobacco use, and this percep- 
tion likely contributes to increased use. Moreover, cannabis intoxication does not typically 
result in as severe behavioral and cognitive dysfunction as does significant alcohol intox- 
ication, which may increase the probability of more frequent use in more diverse situa- 
tions than with alcohol. These factors likely contribute to the potential rapid transition 
from cannabis use to a cannabis use disorder among some adolescents and the common 
pattern of using throughout the day that is commonly observed among those with more 
severe cannabis use disorder. 

Cannabis use disorder among preteens, adolescents, and young adults is typically ex- 
pressed as excessive use with peers that is a component of a pattern of other delinquent 
behaviors usually associated with conduct problems. Milder cases primarily reflect con- 
tinued use despite clear problems related to disapproval of use by other peers, school ad- 
ministration, or family, which also places the youth at risk for physical or behavioral 
consequences. In more severe cases, there is a progression to using alone or using through- 
out the day such that use interferes with daily functioning and takes the place of previ- 
ously established, prosocial activities. 

With adolescent users, changes in mood stability, energy level, and eating patterns are 
commonly observed. These signs and symptoms are likely due to the direct effects of can- 
nabis use (intoxication) and the subsequent effects following acute intoxication (coming 
down), as well as attempts to conceal use from others. School-related problems are com- 
monly associated with cannabis use disorder in adolescents, particularly a dramatic drop 
in grades, truancy, and reduced interest in general school activities and outcomes. 

Cannabis use disorder among adults typically involves well-established patterns of daily 
cannabis use that continue despite clear psychosocial or medical problems. Many adults have 
experienced repeated desire to stop or have failed at repeated cessation attempts. Milder adult 
cases may resemble the more common adolescent cases in that cannabis use is not as frequent 
or heavy but continues despite potential significant consequences of sustained use. The rate of 
use among middle-age and older adults appears to be increasing, likely because of a cohort ef- 
fect resulting from high prevalence of use in the late 1960s and the 1970s. 

Early onset of cannabis use (e.g., prior to age 15 years) is a robust predictor of the de- 
velopment of cannabis use disorder and other types of substance use disorders and mental 
disorders during young adulthood. Such early onset is likely related to concurrent other 
externalizing problems, most notably conduct disorder symptoms. However, early onset 
is also a predictor of internalizing problems and as such probably reflects a general risk 
factor for the development of mental health disorders. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. A history of conduct disorder in childhood or adolescence and antiso- 
cial personality disorder are risk factors for the development of many substance-related 
disorders, including cannabis-related disorders. Other risk factors include externalizing 


514 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


or internalizing disorders during childhood or adolescence. Youths with high behavioral 
disinhibition scores show early-onset substance use disorders, including cannabis use dis- 
order, multiple substance involvement, and early conduct problems. 


Environmental. Risk factors include academic failure, tobacco smoking, unstable or abu- 
sive family situation, use of cannabis among immediate family members, a family history 
of a substance use disorder, and low socioeconomic status. As with all substances of abuse, 
the ease of availability of the substance is a risk factor; cannabis is relatively easy to obtain 
in most cultures, which increases the risk of developing a cannabis use disorder. 


Genetic and physiological. Genetic influences contribute to the development of canna- 
bis use disorders. Heritable factors contribute between 30% and 80% of the total variance 
in risk of cannabis use disorders. It should be noted that common genetic and shared en- 
vironmental influences between cannabis and other types of substance use disorders sug- 
gest a common genetic basis for adolescent substance use and conduct problems. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Cannabis is probably the world’s most commonly used illicit substance. Occurrence of 
cannabis use disorder across countries is unknown, but the prevalence rates are likely sim- 
ilar among developed countries. It is frequently among the first drugs of experimentation 
(often in the teens) of all cultural groups in the United States. 

Acceptance of cannabis for medical purposes varies widely across and within cultures. 
Cultural factors (acceptability and legal status) that might impact diagnosis relate to dif- 
ferential consequences across cultures for detection of use (i.e., arrest, school suspensions, 
or employment suspension). The general change in substance use disorder diagnostic cri- 
teria from DSM-IV to DSM-5 (i.e., removal of the recurrent substance-related legal prob- 
lems criterion) mitigates this concern to some degree. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Biological tests for cannabinoid metabolites are useful for determining if an individual has 
recently used cannabis. Such testing is helpful in making a diagnosis, particularly in 
milder cases if an individual denies using while others (family, work, school) purport con- 
cern about a substance use problem. Because cannabinoids are fat soluble, they persist in 
bodily fluids for extended periods of time and are excreted slowly. Expertise in urine test- 
ing methods is needed to reliably interpret results. 


Functional Consequences of Cannabis Use Disorder 


Functional consequences of cannabis use disorder are part of the diagnostic criteria. Many 
areas of psychosocial, cognitive, and health functioning may be compromised in relation 
to cannabis use disorder. Cognitive function, particularly higher executive function, ap- 
pears to be compromised in cannabis users, and this relationship appears to be dose de- 
pendent (both acutely and chronically). This may contribute to increased difficulty at 
school or work. Cannabis use has been related to a reduction in prosocial goal-directed ac- 
tivity, which some have labeled an amotivational syndrome, that manifests itself in poor 
school performance and employment problems. These problems may be related to perva- 
sive intoxication or recovery from the effects of intoxication. Similarly, cannabis-associated 
problems with social relationships are commonly reported in those with cannabis use dis- 
order. Accidents due to engagement in potentially dangerous behaviors while under the 
influence (e.g., driving, sport, recreational or employment activities) are also of concern. 
Cannabis smoke contains high levels of carcinogenic compounds that place chronic users 
at risk for respiratory illnesses similar to those experienced by tobacco smokers. Chronic 
cannabis use may contribute to the onset or exacerbation of many other mental disorders. 
In particular, concern has been raised about cannabis use as a causal factor in schizophrenia 
and other psychotic disorders. Cannabis use can contribute to the onset of an acute psy- 


Cannabis Use Disorder 515 


chotic episode, can exacerbate some symptoms, and can adversely affect treatment of a 
major psychotic illness. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nonproblematic use of cannabis. The distinction between nonproblematic use of can- 
nabis and cannabis use disorder can be difficult to make because social, behavioral, or psy- 
chological problems may be difficult to attribute to the substance, especially in the context 
of use of other substances. Also, denial of heavy cannabis use and the attribution that can- 
nabis is related to or causing substantial problems are common among individuals who 
are referred to treatment by others (i.e., school, family, employer, criminal justice system). 


Other mental disorders. Cannabis-induced disorder may be characterized by symp- 
toms (e.g., anxiety) that resemble primary mental disorders (e.g., generalized anxiety dis- 
order vs. cannabis-induced anxiety disorder, with generalized anxiety, with onset during 
intoxication). Chronic intake of cannabis can produce a lack of motivation that resembles 
persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia). Acute adverse reactions to cannabis should be 
differentiated from the symptoms of panic disorder, major depressive disorder, delusional 
disorder, bipolar disorder, or schizophrenia, paranoid type. Physical examination will 
usually show an increased pulse and conjunctival injection. Urine toxicological testing can 
be helpful in making a diagnosis. 


Comorbidity 


Cannabis has been commonly thought of as a “gateway” drug because individuals who 
frequently use cannabis have a much greater lifetime probability than nonusers of using 
what are commonly considered more dangerous substances, like opioids or cocaine. Can- 
nabis use and cannabis use disorder are highly comorbid with other substance use disor- 
ders. Co-occurring mental conditions are common in cannabis use disorder. Cannabis use 
has been associated with poorer life satisfaction; increased mental health treatment and 
hospitalization; and higher rates of depression, anxiety disorders, suicide attempts, and 
conduct disorder. Individuals with past-year or lifetime cannabis use disorder have high 
rates of alcohol use disorder (greater than 50%) and tobacco use disorder (53%). Rates of 
other substance use disorders are also likely to be high among individuals with cannabis 
use disorder. Among those seeking treatment for a cannabis use disorder, 74% report 
problematic use of a secondary or tertiary substance: alcohol (40%), cocaine (12%), meth- 
amphetamine (6%), and heroin or other opiates (2%). Among those younger than 18 years, 
61% reported problematic use of a secondary substance: alcohol (48%), cocaine (4%), meth- 
amphetamine (2%), and heroin or other opiates (2%). Cannabis use disorder is also often 
observed as a secondary problem among those with a primary diagnosis of other substance 
use disorders, with approximately 25%-80% of those in treatment for another substance 
use disorder reporting use of cannabis. 

Individuals with past-year or lifetime diagnoses of cannabis use disorder also have 
high rates of concurrent mental disorders other than substance use disorders. Major de- 
pressive disorder (11%), any anxiety disorder (24%), and bipolar I disorder (13%) are quite 
common among individuals with a past-year diagnosis of a cannabis use disorder, as are 
antisocial (30%), obsessive-compulsive, (19%), and paranoid (18%) personality disorders. 
Approximately 33% of adolescents with cannabis use disorder have internalizing disor- 
ders (e.g., anxiety, depression, posttraumatic stress disorder), and 60% have externalizing 
disorders (e.g., conduct disorder, attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder). 

Although cannabis use can impact multiple aspects of normal human functioning, in- 
cluding the cardiovascular, immune, neuromuscular, ocular, reproductive, and respira- 
tory systems, as well as appetite and cognition/perception, there are few clear medical 
conditions that commonly co-occur with cannabis use disorder. The most significant health 


516 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


effects of cannabis involve the respiratory system, and chronic cannabis smokers exhibit 
high rates of respiratory symptoms of bronchitis, sputum production, shortness of breath, 
and wheezing. 


Cannabis Intoxication 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recent use of cannabis. 

B. Clinically significant problematic behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., impaired 
motor coordination, euphoria, anxiety, sensation of slowed time, impaired judgment, 
social withdrawal) that developed during, or shortly after, cannabis use. 

C. Two (or more) of the following signs or symptoms developing within 2 hours of canna- 
bis use: 


1. Conjunctival injection. 
2. Increased appetite. 
3. Dry mouth. 

4. Tachycardia. 


D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not better 
explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another substance. 


Specify if: 
With perceptual disturbances: Hallucinations with intact reality testing or auditory, vi- 
sual, or tactile illusions occur in the absence of a delirium. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.89. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
or not there is a comorbid cannabis use disorder and whether or not there are perceptual 
disturbances. 


For cannabis intoxication, without perceptual disturbances: If a mild cannabis use 
disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F12.129, and if a moderate or severe 
cannabis use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F12.229. If there is no co- 
morbid cannabis use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F12.929. 


For cannabis intoxication, with perceptual disturbances: If a mild cannabis use 
disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F12.122, and if a moderate or severe 
cannabis use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F12.222. If there is no co- 
morbid cannabis use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F12.922. 


Specifiers 
When hallucinations occur in the absence of intact reality testing, a diagnosis of substance/ 
medication-induced psychotic disorder should be considered. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of cannabis intoxication is the presence of clinically significant prob- 
lematic behavioral or psychological changes that develop during, or shortly after, canna- 
bis use (Criterion B). Intoxication typically begins with a “high” feeling followed by 
symptoms that include euphoria with inappropriate laughter and grandiosity, sedation, 
lethargy, impairment in short-term memory, difficulty carrying out complex mental pro- 
cesses, impaired judgment, distorted sensory perceptions, impaired motor performance, 
and the sensation that time is passing slowly. Occasionally, anxiety (which can be severe), 


Cannabis Withdrawal 517 


dysphoria, or social withdrawal occurs. These psychoactive effects are accompanied by 
two or more of the following signs, developing within 2 hours of cannabis use: conjuncti- 
val injection, increased appetite, dry mouth, and tachycardia (Criterion C). 

Intoxication develops within minutes if the cannabis is smoked but may take a few 
hours to develop if the cannabis is ingested orally. The effects usually last 3-4 hours, with 
the duration being somewhat longer when the substance is ingested orally. The magnitude 
of the behavioral and physiological changes depends on the dose, the method of adminis- 
tration, and the characteristics of the individual using the substance, such as rate of absorp- 
tion, tolerance, and sensitivity to the effects of the substance. Because most cannabinoids, 
including delta-9-tetrahydrocannabinol (delta-9-THC), are fat soluble, the effects of canna- 
bis or hashish may occasionally persist or reoccur for 12-24 hours because of the slow re- 
lease of psychoactive substances from fatty tissue or to enterohepatic circulation. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of actual episodes of cannabis intoxication in the general population is un- 
known. However, it is probable that most cannabis users would at some time meet criteria 
for cannabis intoxication. Given this, the prevalence of cannabis users and the prevalence 
of individuals experiencing cannabis intoxication are likely similar. 


Functional Consequences of Cannabis Intoxication 


Impairment from cannabis intoxication may have serious consequences, including dys- 
function at work or school, social indiscretions, failure to fulfill role obligations, traffic ac- 
cidents, and having unprotected sex. In rare cases, cannabis intoxication may precipitate a 
psychosis that may vary in duration. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Note that if the clinical presentation includes hallucinations in the absence of intact reality 
testing, a diagnosis of substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder should be con- 
sidered. 


Other substance intoxication. Cannabis intoxication may resemble intoxication with 
other types of substances. However, in contrast to cannabis intoxication, alcohol intoxica- 
tion and sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication frequently decrease appetite, in- 
crease aggressive behavior, and produce nystagmus or ataxia. Hallucinogens in low doses 
may cause a clinical picture that resembles cannabis intoxication. Phencyclidine, like can- 
nabis, can be smoked and also causes perceptual changes, but phencyclidine intoxication 
is much more likely to cause ataxia and aggressive behavior. 

Other cannabis-induced disorders. Cannabis intoxication is distinguished from the other 
cannabis-induced disorders (e.g., cannabis-induced anxiety disorder, with onset during 
intoxication) because the symptoms in these latter disorders predominate the clinical pre- 
sentation and are severe enough to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Cannabis Withdrawal 
Diagnostic Criteria 292.0 (F12.288) 


A. Cessation of cannabis use that has been heavy and prolonged (i.e., usually daily or 
almost daily use over a period of at least a few months). 

B. Three (or more) of the following signs and symptoms develop within approximately 1 week 
after Criterion A: 


518 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Irritability, anger, or aggression. 

Nervousness or anxiety. 

Sleep difficulty (e.g., insomnia, disturbing dreams). 

Decreased appetite or weight loss. 

Restlessness. 

Depressed mood. 

At least one of the following physical symptoms causing significant discomfort: ab- 
dominal pain, shakiness/tremors, sweating, fever, chills, or headache. 


NOOR ON + 


C. The signs or symptoms in Criterion B cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication or withdrawal from 
another substance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.0. The ICD-10-CM code for cannabis withdrawal 
is F12.288. Note that the ICD-10-CM code indicates the comorbid presence of a moderate 
or severe cannabis use disorder, reflecting the fact that cannabis withdrawal can only oc- 
cur in the presence of a moderate or severe cannabis use disorder. It is not permissible to 
code a comorbid mild cannabis use disorder with cannabis withdrawal. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of cannabis withdrawal is the presence of a characteristic withdrawal 
syndrome that develops after the cessation of or substantial reduction in heavy and pro- 
longed cannabis use. In addition to the symptoms in Criterion B, the following may also be 
observed postabstinence: fatigue, yawning, difficulty concentrating, and rebound periods 
of increased appetite and hypersomnia that follow initial periods of loss of appetite and in- 
somnia. For the diagnosis, withdrawal symptoms must cause clinically significant distress 
or impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning (Criterion 
C). Many cannabis users report smoking cannabis or taking other substances to help re- 
lieve withdrawal symptoms, and many report that withdrawal symptoms make quitting 
difficult or have contributed to relapse. The symptoms typically are not of sufficient se- 
verity to require medical attention, but medication or behavioral strategies may help alle- 
viate symptoms and improve prognosis in those trying to quit using cannabis. 

Cannabis withdrawal is commonly observed in individuals seeking treatment for can- 
nabis use as well as in heavy cannabis users who are not seeking treatment. Among indi- 
viduals who have used cannabis regularly during some period of their lifetime, up to one- 
third report having experienced cannabis withdrawal. Among adults and adolescents en- 
rolled in treatment or heavy cannabis users, 50%—95% report cannabis withdrawal. These 
findings indicate that cannabis withdrawal occurs among a substantial subset of regular 
cannabis users who try to quit. 


Development and Course 


The amount, duration, and frequency of cannabis smoking that is required to produce an 
associated withdrawal disorder during a quit attempt are unknown. Most symptoms have 
their onset within the first 24-72 hours of cessation, peak within the first week, and last 
approximately 1-2 weeks. Sleep difficulties may last more than 30 days. Cannabis with- 
drawal has been documented among adolescents and adults. Withdrawal tends to be more 
common and severe among adults, most likely related to the more persistent and greater 
frequency and quantity of use among adults. 


Unspecified Cannabis-Related Disorder 519 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Most likely, the prevalence and severity of cannabis withdrawal are 
greater among heavier cannabis users, and particularly among those seeking treatment for 
cannabis use disorders. Withdrawal severity also appears to be positively related to the se- 
verity of comorbid symptoms of mental disorders. 


Functional Consequences of Cannabis Withdrawal 


Cannabis users report using cannabis to relieve withdrawal symptoms, suggesting that 
withdrawal might contribute to ongoing expression of cannabis use disorder. Worse out- 
comes may be associated with greater withdrawal. A substantial proportion of adults and 
adolescents in treatment for moderate to severe cannabis use disorder acknowledge mod- 
erate to severe withdrawal symptoms, and many complain that these symptoms make ces- 
sation more difficult. Cannabis users report having relapsed to cannabis use or initiating 
use of other drugs (e.g., tranquilizers) to provide relief from cannabis withdrawal symp- 
toms. Last, individuals living with cannabis users observe significant withdrawal effects, 
suggesting that such symptoms are disruptive to daily living. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Because many of the symptoms of cannabis withdrawal are also symptoms of other sub- 
stance withdrawal syndromes or of depressive or bipolar disorders, careful evaluation 
should focus on ensuring that the symptoms are not better explained by cessation from an- 
other substance (e.g., tobacco or alcohol withdrawal), another mental disorder (general- 
ized anxiety disorder, major depressive disorder), or another medical condition. 


Other Cannabis-Induced Disorders 


The following cannabis-induced disorders are described in other chapters of the manual with 
disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance /medication-induced 
mental disorders in these chapters): cannabis-induced psychotic disorder (“Schizophrenia 
Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders”); cannabis-induced anxiety disorder (“Anxiety 
Disorders”); and cannabis-induced sleep disorder (“Sleep-Wake Disorders”). For cannabis 
intoxication delirium, see the criteria and discussion of delirium in the chapter “Neurocog- 
nitive Disorders.” These cannabis-induced disorders are diagnosed instead of cannabis in- 
toxication or cannabis withdrawal when the symptoms are sufficiently severe to warrant 
independent clinical attention. 


Unspecified Cannabis-Related Disorder 
292.9 (F 12.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a cannabis- 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any specific cannabis-related disorder or any of the disorders in the substance-related 
and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


520 


Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Hallucinogen-Related Disorders 


Phencyclidine Use Disorder 
Other Hallucinogen Use Disorder 
Phencyclidine Intoxication 
Other Hallucinogen Intoxication 
Hallucinogen Persisting Perception Disorder 
Other Phencyclidine-Induced Disorders 
Other Hallucinogen-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Phencyclidine-Related Disorder 
Unspecified Hallucinogen-Related Disorder 


Phencyclidine Use Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A pattern of phencyclidine (or a pharmacologically similar substance) use leading to 
Clinically significant impairment or distress, as manifested by at least two of the follow- 
ing, occurring within a 12-month period: 


1. 


2. 


3. 


10. 


Phencyclidine is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was in- 
tended. 

There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control phency- 
clidine use. 

A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain phencyclidine, use the 
phencyclidine, or recover from its effects. 

Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use phencyclidine. 

Recurrent phencyclidine use resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at 
work, school, or home (e.g., repeated absences from work or poor work performance 
related to phencyclidine use; phencyclidine-related absences, suspensions, or ex- 
pulsions from school; neglect of children or household). 

Continued phencyclidine use despite having persistent or recurrent social or inter- 
personal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of the phencyclidine (e.g., 
arguments with a spouse about consequences of intoxication; physical fights). 
Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of phencyclidine use. 

Recurrent phencyclidine use in situations in which it is physically hazardous (e.g., 
driving an automobile or operating a machine when impaired by a phencyclidine). 
Phencyclidine use is continued despite knowledge of having a persistent or recur- 
rent physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or exac- 
erbated by the phencyclidine. 

Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 


a. A need for markedly increased amounts of the phencyclidine to achieve intoxi- 
cation or desired effect. 

b. A markedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of the 
phencyclidine. 


Phencyclidine Use Disorder 521 


Note: Withdrawal symptoms and signs are not established for phencyclidines, and so this 
criterion does not apply. (Withdrawal from phencyclidines has been reported in animals 
but not documented in human users.) 
Specify if: 
In early remission: After full criteria for phencyclidine use disorder were previously 
met, none of the criteria for phencyclidine use disorder have been met for at least 
3 months but for less than 12 months (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, 
or a strong desire or urge to use the phencyclidine,” may be met). 
In sustained remission: After full criteria for phencyclidine use disorder were previ- 
ously met, none of the criteria for phencyclidine use disorder have been met at any time 
during a period of 12 months or longer (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, 
or a strong desire or urge to use the phencyclidine,” may be met). 
Specify if: 
In acontrolled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to phencyclidines is restricted. 


Coding based on current severity: Note for ICD-10-CM codes: If a phencyclidine intoxica- 
tion or another phencyclidine-induced mental disorder is also present, do not use the codes 
below for phencyclidine use disorder. Instead, the comorbid phencyclidine use disorder is in- 
dicated in the 4th character of the phencyclidine-induced disorder code (see the coding note 
for phencyclidine intoxication or a specific phencyclidine-induced mental disorder). For ex- 
ample, if there is comorbid phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder, only the phencyclidine- 
induced psychotic disorder code is given, with the 4th character indicating whether the co- 
morbid phencyclidine use disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: F16.159 for mild phencycli- 
dine use disorder with phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder or F16.259 for a moderate 
or severe phencyclidine use disorder with phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder. 


Specify current severity: 
305.90 (F16.10) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
304.60 (F16.20) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
304.60 (F16.20) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


Specifiers 

“Ina controlled environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is 
both in remission and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled 
environment or in sustained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these 
environments are closely supervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, 
and locked hospital units. 


Diagnostic Features 


The phencyclidines (or phencyclidine-like substances) include phencyclidine (e.g., PCP, 
“angel dust”) and less potent but similarly acting compounds such as ketamine, cyclohex- 
amine, and dizocilpine. These substances were first developed as dissociative anesthetics 
in the 1950s and became street drugs in the 1960s. They produce feelings of separation 
from mind and body (hence “dissociative”) in low doses, and at high doses, stupor and 
coma can result. These substances are most commonly smoked or taken orally, but they 
may also be snorted or injected. Although the primary psychoactive effects of PCP last for 
a few hours, the total elimination rate of this drug from the body typically extends 8 days 
or longer. The hallucinogenic effects in vulnerable individuals may last for weeks and may 
precipitate a persistent psychotic episode resembling schizophrenia. Ketamine has been 
observed to have utility in the treatment of major depressive disorder. Withdrawal symp- 


522 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


toms have not been clearly established in humans, and therefore the withdrawal criterion 
is not included in the diagnosis of phencyclidine use disorder. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Phencyclidine may be detected in urine for up to 8 days or even longer at very high doses. In 
addition to laboratory tests to detect its presence, characteristic symptoms resulting from 
intoxication with phencyclidine or related substances may aid in its diagnosis. Phencycli- 
dine is likely to produce dissociative symptoms, analgesia, nystagmus, and hypertension, 
with risk of hypotension and shock. Violent behavior can also occur with phencyclidine 
use, as intoxicated persons may believe that they are being attacked. Residual symptoms 
following use may resemble schizophrenia. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of phencyclidine use disorder is unknown. Approximately 2.5% of the pop- 
ulation reports having ever used phencyclidine. The proportion of users increases with 
age, from 0.3% of 12- to 17-year-olds, to 1.3% of 18- to 25-year-olds, to 2.9% of those age 26 
years and older reporting ever using phencyclidine. There appears to have been an in- 
crease among 12th graders in both ever used (to 2.3% from 1.8%) and past-year use (to 1.3% 
from 1.0%) of phencyclidine. Past-year use of ketamine appears relatively stable among 
12th graders (1.6%-1.7% over the past 3 years). 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


There is little information about risk factors for phencyclidine use disorder. Among indi- 
viduals admitted to substance abuse treatment, those for whom phencyclidine was the 
primary substance were younger than those admitted for other substance use, had lower 
educational levels, and were more likely to be located in the West and Northeast regions of 
the United States, compared with other admissions. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Ketamine use in youths ages 16-23 years has been reported to be more common among 
whites (0.5%) than among other ethnic groups (range 0%-0.3%). Among individuals ad- 
mitted to substance abuse treatment, those for whom phencyclidine was the primary sub- 
stance were predominantly black (49%) or Hispanic (29%). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Males make up about three-quarters of those with phencyclidine-related emergency room 
visits. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Laboratory testing may be useful, as phencyclidine is present in the urine in intoxicated in- 
dividuals up to 8 days after ingestion. The individual’s history, along with certain physical 
signs, such as nystagmus, analgesia and prominent hypertension, may aid in distinguish- 
ing the phencyclidine clinical picture from that of other hallucinogens. 


Functional Consequences of Phencyclidine Use Disorder 


In individuals with phencyclidine use disorder, there may be physical evidence of injuries 
from accidents, fights, and falls. Chronic use of phencyclidine may lead to deficits in mem- 
ory, speech, and cognition that may last for months. Cardiovascular and neurological tox- 
icities (e.g., seizures, dystonias, dyskinesias, catalepsy, hypothermia or hyperthermia) 
may result from intoxication with phencyclidine. Other consequences include intracranial 
hemorrhage, rhabdomyolysis, respiratory problems, and (occasionally) cardiac arrest. 


Other Hallucinogen Use Disorder 523 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other substance use disorders. Distinguishing the effects of phencyclidine from those 
of other substances is important, since it may be a common additive to other substances 
(e.g., cannabis, cocaine). 


Schizophrenia and other mental disorders. Some of the effects of phencyclidine and 
related substance use may resemble symptoms of other psychiatric disorders, such as psy- 
chosis (schizophrenia), low mood (major depressive disorder), violent aggressive be- 
haviors (conduct disorder, antisocial personality disorder). Discerning whether these 
behaviors occurred before the intake of the drug is important in the differentiation of acute 
drug effects from preexisting mental disorder. Phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder 
should be considered when there is impaired reality testing in individuals experiencing 
disturbances in perception resulting from ingestion of phencyclidine. 


Other Hallucinogen Use Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A problematic pattern of hallucinogen (other than phencyclidine) use leading to clini- 
cally significant impairment or distress, as manifested by at least two of the following, 
occurring within a 12-month period: 


1. The hallucinogen is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was 
intended. 

2. There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control halluci- 
nogen use. 

3. A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain the hallucinogen, use 
the hallucinogen, or recover from its effects. 

4. Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the hallucinogen. 

5. Recurrent hallucinogen use resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at 
work, school, or home (e.g., repeated absences from work or poor work perfor- 
mance related to hallucinogen use; hallucinogen-related absences, suspensions, 
or expulsions from school; neglect of children or household). 

6. Continued hallucinogen use despite having persistent or recurrent social or inter- 
personal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of the hallucinogen (e.g., 
arguments with a spouse about consequences of intoxication; physical fights). 

7. Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of hallucinogen use. 

8. Recurrent hallucinogen use in situations in which it is physically hazardous (e.g., 
driving an automobile or operating a machine when impaired by the hallucinogen). 

9. Hallucinogen use is continued despite knowledge of having a persistent or recur- 
rent physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or exac- 
erbated by the hallucinogen. 

10. Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 
a. A need for markedly increased amounts of the hallucinogen to achieve intoxi- 
cation or desired effect. 
b. Amarkedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of the hal- 
lucinogen. 
Note: Withdrawal symptoms and signs are not established for hallucinogens, and so this 
criterion does not apply. 


524 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Specify the particular hallucinogen. 

Specity if: 
In early remission: After full criteria for other hallucinogen use disorder were previ- 
ously met, none of the criteria for other hallucinogen use disorder have been met for 
at least 3 months but for less than 12 months (with the exception that Criterion A4, 
“Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the hallucinogen,” may be met). 
In sustained remission: After full criteria for other hallucinogen use disorder were 
previously met, none of the criteria for other hallucinogen use disorder have been met 
at any time during a period of 12 months or longer (with the exception that Criterion A4, 
“Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the hallucinogen,” may be met). 

Specity if: 
In a controlled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to hallucinogens is restricted. 


Coding based on current severity: Note for |CD-10-CM codes: If a hallucinogen intoxication 
or another hallucinogen-induced mental disorder is also present, do not use the codes below 
for hallucinogen use disorder. Instead, the comorbid hallucinogen use disorder is indicated in 
the 4th character of the hallucinogen-induced disorder code (see the coding note for halluci- 
nogen intoxication or specific hallucinogen-induced mental disorder). For example, if there is 
comorbid hallucinogen-induced psychotic disorder and hallucinogen use disorder, only the 
hallucinogen-induced psychotic disorder code is given, with the 4th character indicating wheth- 
er the comorbid hallucinogen use disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: F16.159 for mild hal- 
lucinogen use disorder with hallucinogen-induced psychotic disorder or F16.259 for a 
moderate or severe hallucinogen use disorder with hallucinogen-induced psychotic disorder. 


Specify current severity: 
305.30 (F16.10) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
304.50 (F16.20) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
304.50 (F16.20) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


Specifiers 

“In a controlled environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is 
both in remission and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled 
environment or in sustained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these 
environments are closely supervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, 
and locked hospital units. 


Diagnostic Features 


Hallucinogens comprise a diverse group of substances that, despite having different chem- 
ical structures and possibly involving different molecular mechanisms, produce similar 
alterations of perception, mood, and cognition in users. Hallucinogens included are phenyl- 
alkylamines (e.g., mescaline, DOM [2,5-dimethoxy-4-methylamphetamine], and MDMA 
[3,4-methylenedioxymethamphetamine; also called “ecstasy”]); the indoleamines, includ- 
ing psilocybin (i.e., psilocin) and dimethyltryptamine (DMT); and the ergolines, such as LSD 
(lysergic acid diethylamide) and morning glory seeds. In addition, miscellaneous other 
ethnobotanical compounds are classified as “hallucinogens,” of which Salvia divinorum and 
jimsonweed are two examples. Excluded from the hallucinogen group are cannabis and its 
active compound, delta-9-tetrahydrocannabinol (THC) (see the section “Cannabis-Related 
Disorders”). These substances can have hallucinogenic effects but are diagnosed separately 
because of significant differences in their psychological and behavioral effects. 
Hallucinogens are usually taken orally, although some forms are smoked (e.g., DMT, 
salvia) or (rarely) taken intranasally or by injection (e.g., ecstasy). Duration of effects varies 


Other Hallucinogen Use Disorder 525 


across types of hallucinogens. Some of these substances (i.e., LSD, MDMA) have a long 
half-life and extended duration such that users may spend hours to days using and/or re- 
covering from the effects of these drugs. However, other hallucinogenic drugs (e.g., DMT, 
salvia) are short acting. Tolerance to hallucinogens develops with repeated use and has 
been reported to have both autonomic and psychological effects. Cross-tolerance exists be- 
tween LSD and other hallucinogens (e.g., psilocybin, mescaline) but does not extend to 
other drug categories such as amphetamines and cannabis. 

MDMA /ecstasy as a hallucinogen may have distinctive effects attributable to both its hal- 
lucinogenic and its stimulant properties. Among heavy ecstasy users, continued use despite 
physical or psychological problems, tolerance, hazardous use, and spending a great deal of 
time obtaining the substance are the most commonly reported criteria—over 50% in adults 
and over 30% in a younger sample, while legal problems related to substance use and persis- 
tent desire /inability to quit are rarely reported. As found for other substances, diagnostic cri- 
teria for other hallucinogen use disorder are arrayed along a single continuum of severity. 

One of the generic criteria for substance use disorders, a clinically significant with- 
drawal syndrome, has not been consistently documented in humans, and therefore the di- 
agnosis of hallucinogen withdrawal syndrome is not included in DSM-5. However, there 
is evidence of withdrawal from MDMA, with endorsement of two or more withdrawal 
symptoms observed in 59%-98% in selected samples of ecstasy users. Both psychological 
and physical problems have been commonly reported as withdrawal problems. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The characteristic symptom features of some of the hallucinogens can aid in diagnosis if 
urine or blood toxicology results are not available. For example, individuals who use LSD 
tend to experience visual hallucinations that can be frightening. Individuals intoxicated 
with hallucinogens may exhibit a temporary increase in suicidality. 


Prevalence 


Of all substance use disorders, other hallucinogen use disorder is one of the rarest. The 
12-month prevalence is estimated to be 0.5% among 12- to 17-year-olds and 0.1% among 
adults age 18 and older in the United States. Rates are higher in adult males (0.2%) compared 
with females (0.1%), but the opposite is observed in adolescent samples ages 12-17, in which 
the 12-month rate is slightly higher in females (0.6%) than in males (0.4%). Rates are highest in 
individuals younger than 30 years, with the peak occurring in individuals ages 18-29 years 
(0.6%) and decreasing to virtually 0.0% among individuals age 45 and older. 

There are marked ethnic differences in 12-month prevalence of other hallucinogen use 
disorder. Among youths ages 12-17 years, 12-month prevalence is higher among Native 
Americans and Alaska Natives (1.2%) than among Hispanics (0.6%), whites (0.6%), Afri- 
can Americans (0.2%), and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders (0.2%). Among adults, 
12-month prevalence of other hallucinogen use disorder is similar for Native Americans 
and Alaska Natives, whites, and Hispanics (all 0.2%) but somewhat lower for Asian Amer- 
icans and Pacific Islanders (0.07%) and African Americans (0.03%). Past-year prevalence is 
higher in clinical samples (e.g., 19% in adolescents in treatment). Among individuals cur- 
rently using hallucinogens in the general population, 7.8% (adult) to 17% (adolescent) had 
a problematic pattern of use that met criteria for past-year other hallucinogen use disorder. 
Among select groups of individuals who use hallucinogens (e.g., recent heavy ecstasy 
use), 73.5% of adults and 77% of adolescents have a problematic pattern of use that may 
meet other hallucinogen use disorder criteria. 


Development and Course 


Unlike most substances where an early age at onset is associated with elevations in risk for 
the corresponding use disorder, it is unclear whether there is an association of an early age 


526 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


at onset with elevations in risk for other hallucinogen use disorder. However, patterns of 
drug consumption have been found to differ by age at onset, with early-onset ecstasy users 
more likely to be polydrug users than their later-onset counterparts. There may be a dis- 
proportionate influence of use of specific hallucinogens on risk of developing other hallu- 
cinogen use disorder, with use of ecstasy/ MDMA increasing the risk of the disorder 
relative to use of other hallucinogens. 

Little is known regarding the course of other hallucinogen use disorder, but it is generally 
thought to have low incidence, low persistence, and high rates of recovery. Adolescents are es- 
pecially at risk for using these drugs, and it is estimated that 2.7% of youths ages 12-17 years 
have used one or more of these drugs in the past 12 months, with 44% having used ecstasy / 
MDMA. Other hallucinogen use disorder is a disorder observed primarily in individuals 
younger than 30 years, with rates vanishingly rare among older adults. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. In adolescents but not consistently in adults, MDMA use is associated with 
an elevated rate of other hallucinogen use disorder. Other substance use disorders, particu- 
larly alcohol, tobacco, and cannabis, and major depressive disorder are associated with ele- 
vated rates of other hallucinogen use disorder. Antisocial personality disorder may be 
elevated among individuals who use more than two other drugs in addition to hallucinogens, 
compared with their counterparts with less extensive use history. The influence of adult anti- 
social behaviors—but not conduct disorder or antisocial personality disorder—on other hal- 
lucinogen use disorder may be stronger in females than in males. Use of specific hallucinogens 
(e.g., salvia) is prominent among individuals ages 18-25 years with other risk-taking behaviors 
and illegal activities. Cannabis use has also been implicated as a precursor to initiation of use of 
hallucinogens (e.g., ecstasy), along with early use of alcohol and tobacco. Higher drug use by 
peers and high sensation seeking have also been associated with elevated rates of ecstasy use. 
MDMA /ecstasy use appears to signify a more severe group of hallucinogen users. 


Genetic and physiological. Among male twins, total variance due to additive genetics 
has been estimated to range from 26% to 79%, with inconsistent evidence for shared envi- 
ronmental influences. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Historically, hallucinogens have been used as part of established religious practices, such 
as the use of peyote in the Native American Church and in Mexico. Ritual use by indige- 
nous populations of psilocybin obtained from certain types of mushrooms has occurred in 
South America, Mexico, and some areas in the United States, or of ayahuasca in the Santo 
Daime and Uniao de Vegetal sects. Regular use of peyote as part of religious rituals is not 
linked to neuropsychological or psychological deficits. For adults, no race or ethnicity dif- 
ferences for the full criteria or for any individual criterion are apparent at this time. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In adolescents, females may be less likely than males to endorse “hazardous use,” and fe- 
male gender may be associated with increased odds of other hallucinogen use disorder. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Laboratory testing can be useful in distinguishing among the different hallucinogens. 
However, because some agents (e.g., LSD) are so potent that as little as 75 micrograms can 
produce severe reactions, typical toxicological examination will not always reveal which 
substance has been used. 


Phencyclidine Intoxication 527 


Functional Consequences of 
Other Hallucinogen Use Disorder 


There is evidence for long-term neurotoxic effects of MDMA/ecstasy use, including im- 
pairments in memory, psychological function, and neuroendocrine function; serotonin 
system dysfunction; and sleep disturbance; as well as adverse effects on brain microvas- 
culature, white matter maturation, and damage to axons. Use of MDMA/ecstasy may di- 
minish functional connectivity among brain regions. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other substance use disorders. The effects of hallucinogens must be distinguished from 
those of other substances (e.g., amphetamines), especially because contamination of the 
hallucinogens with other drugs is relatively common. 


Schizophrenia. Schizophrenia also must be ruled out, as some affected individuals (e.g., 
individuals with schizophrenia who exhibit paranoia) may falsely attribute their symp- 
toms to use of hallucinogens. 


Other mental disorders or medical conditions. Other potential disorders or conditions 
to consider include panic disorder, depressive and bipolar disorders, alcohol or sedative 
withdrawal, hypoglycemia and other metabolic conditions, seizure disorder, stroke, oph- 
thalmological disorder, and central nervous system tumors. Careful history of drug tak- 
ing, collateral reports from family and friends (if possible), age, clinical history, physical 
examination, and toxicology reports should be useful in arriving at the final diagnostic de- 
cision. 


Comorbidity 


Adolescents who use MDMA /ecstasy and other hallucinogens, as well as adults who have 
recently used ecstasy, have a higher prevalence of other substance use disorders compared 
with nonhallucinogen substance users. Individuals who use hallucinogens exhibit eleva- 
tions of nonsubstance mental disorders (especially anxiety, depressive, and bipolar disor- 
ders), particularly with use of ecstasy and salvia. Rates of antisocial personality disorder (but 
not conduct disorder) are significantly elevated among individuals with other hallucinogen 
use disorder, as are rates of adult antisocial behavior. However, it is unclear whether the 
mental illnesses may be precursors to rather than consequences of other hallucinogen use 
disorder (see the section “Risk and Prognostic Factors” for this disorder). Both adults and 
adolescents who use ecstasy are more likely than other drug users to be polydrug users and 
to have other drug use disorders. 


Phencyclidine Intoxication 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recent use of phencyclidine (or a pharmacologically similar substance). 

B. Clinically significant problematic behavioral changes (e.g., belligerence, assaultive- 
ness, impulsiveness, unpredictability, psychomotor agitation, impaired judgment) that 
developed during, or shortly after, phencyclidine use. 

C. Within 1 hour, two (or more) of the following signs or symptoms: 

Note: When the drug is smoked, “snorted,” or used intravenously, the onset may be 
particularly rapid. 

1. Vertical or horizontal nystagmus. 

2. Hypertension or tachycardia. 


528 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


. Numbness or diminished responsiveness to pain. 
. Ataxia. 

. Dysarthria. 

. Muscle rigidity. 

. Seizures or coma. 

. Hyperacusis. 


ONDOO FW 


D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not better 
explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another substance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.89. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
there is a comorbid phencyclidine use disorder. If a mild phencyclidine use disorder is co- 
morbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F16.129, and if a moderate or severe phencyclidine use 
disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F16.229. If there is no comorbid phencycli- 
dine use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F16.929. 


Note: In addition to the section “Functional Consequences of Phencyclidine Intoxication,” 
see the corresponding section in phencyclidine use disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


Phencyclidine intoxication reflects the clinically significant behavioral changes that occur 
shortly after ingestion of this substance (or a pharmacologically similar substance). The 
most common clinical presentations of phencyclidine intoxication include disorientation, 
confusion without hallucinations, hallucinations or delusions, a catatonic-like syndrome, 
and coma of varying severity. The intoxication typically lasts for several hours but, de- 
pending on the type of clinical presentation and whether other drugs besides phencycli- 
dine were consumed, may last for several days or longer. 


Prevalence 


Use of phencyclidine or related substances may be taken as an estimate of the prevalence 
of intoxication. Approximately 2.5% of the population reports having ever used phency- 
clidine. Among high school students, 2.3% of 12th graders report ever using phencycli- 
dine, with 57% having used in the past 12 months. This represents an increase from prior 
to 2011. Past-year use of ketamine, which is assessed separately from other substances, has 
remained stable over time, with about 1.7% of 12th graders reporting use. 


Diagnostic Markers 

Laboratory testing may be useful, as phencyclidine is detectable in urine for up to 8 days 
following use, although the levels are only weakly associated with an individual's clinical 
presentation and may therefore not be useful for case management. Creatine phosphoki- 
nase and aspartate aminotransferase levels may be elevated. 


Functional Consequences of Phencyclidine Intoxication 


Phencyclidine intoxication produces extensive cardiovascular and neurological (e.g., sei- 
zures, dystonias, dyskinesias, catalepsy, hypothermia or hyperthermia) toxicity. 


Differential Diagnosis 

In particular, in the absence of intact reality testing (i-e., without insight into any percep- 
tual abnormalities), an additional diagnosis of phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder 
should be considered. 

Other substance intoxication. Phencyclidine intoxication should be differentiated from 
intoxication due to other substances, including other hallucinogens; amphetamine, co- 


Other Hallucinogen Intoxication 529 


caine, or other stimulants; and anticholinergics, as well as withdrawal from benzodiaze- 
pines. Nystagmus and bizarre and violent behavior may distinguish intoxication due to 
phencyclidine from that due to other substances. Toxicological tests may be useful in mak- 
ing this distinction, since phencyclidine is detectable in urine for up to 8 days after use. 
However, there is a weak correlation between quantitative toxicology levels of phencycli- 
dine and clinical presentation that diminishes the utility of the laboratory findings for pa- 
tient management. 

Other conditions. Other conditions to be considered include schizophrenia, depression, 
withdrawal from other drugs (e.g., sedatives, alcohol), certain metabolic disorders like hy- 
poglycemia and hyponatremia, central nervous system tumors, seizure disorders, sepsis, 
neuroleptic malignant syndrome, and vascular insults. 


Other Hallucinogen Intoxication 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recent use of a hallucinogen (other than phencyclidine). 

B. Clinically significant problematic behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., marked 
anxiety or depression, ideas of reference, fear of “losing one’s mind,” paranoid ide- 
ation, impaired judgment) that developed during, or shortly after, hallucinogen use. 

C. Perceptual changes occurring in a state of full wakefulness and alertness (e.g., sub- 
jective intensification of perceptions, depersonalization, derealization, illusions, hallu- 
cinations, synesthesias) that developed during, or shortly after, hallucinogen use. 

D. Two (or more) of the following signs developing during, or shortly after, hallucinogen 
use: 


. Pupillary dilation. 
. Tachycardia. 

. Sweating. 

. Palpitations. 

. Blurring of vision. 
. Tremors. 

7. Incoordination. 


oar WND 


E. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another sub- 
stance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.89. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
there is a comorbid hallucinogen use disorder. If a mild hallucinogen use disorder is co- 
morbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F16.129, and if a moderate or severe hallucinogen use 
disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F16.229. If there is no comorbid hallucinogen 
use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F16.929. 


Note: For information on Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis and Culture-Related 
Diagnostic Issues, see the corresponding sections in other hallucinogen use disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


Other hallucinogen intoxication reflects the clinically significant behavioral or psycholog- 
ical changes that occur shortly after ingestion of a hallucinogen. Depending on the specific 
hallucinogen, the intoxication may last only minutes (e.g., for salvia) or several hours or 
longer (e.g., for LSD [lysergic acid diethylamide] or MDMA [3,4-methylenedioxymetham- 
phetamine]). 


530 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of other hallucinogen intoxication may be estimated by use of those sub- 
stances. In the United States, 1.8% of individuals age 12 years or older report using hallu- 
cinogens in the past year. Use is more prevalent among younger individuals, with 3.1% of 
12- to 17-year-olds and 7.1% of 18- to 25-year-olds using hallucinogens in the past year, 
compared with only 0.7% of individuals age 26 years or older. Twelve-month prevalence 
for hallucinogen use is more common in males (2.4%) than in females (1.2%), and even 
more so among 18- to 25-year-olds (9.2% for males vs. 5.0% for females). In contrast, 
among individuals ages 12-17 years, there are no gender differences (3.1% for both gen- 
ders). These figures may be used as proxy estimates for gender-related differences in the 
prevalence of other hallucinogen intoxication. 


Suicide Risk 


Other hallucinogen intoxication may lead to increased suicidality, although suicide is rare 
among users of hallucinogens. 


Functional Consequences of 
Other Hallucinogen Intoxication 


Other hallucinogen intoxication can have serious consequences. The perceptual distur- 
bances and impaired judgment associated with other hallucinogen intoxication can result 
in injuries or fatalities from automobile crashes, physical fights, or unintentional self- 
injury (e.g., attempts to “fly” from high places). Environmental factors and the personality 
and expectations of the individual using the hallucinogen may contribute to the nature of 
and severity of hallucinogen intoxication. Continued use of hallucinogens, particularly 
MDMA, has also been linked with neurotoxic effects. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other substance intoxication. Other hallucinogen intoxication should be differentiated 
from intoxication with amphetamines, cocaine, or other stimulants; anticholinergics; in- 
halants; and phencyclidine. Toxicological tests are useful in making this distinction, and 
determining the route of administration may also be useful. 


Other conditions. Other disorders and conditions to be considered include schizophre- 
nia, depression, withdrawal from other drugs (e.g., sedatives, alcohol), certain metabolic 
disorders (e.g., hypoglycemia), seizure disorders, tumors of the central nervous system, 
and vascular insults. 


Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder. Other hallucinogen intoxication is dis- 
tinguished from hallucinogen persisting perception disorder because the symptoms in the 
latter continue episodically or continuously for weeks (or longer) after the most recent in- 
toxication. 


Other hallucinogen-induced disorders. Other hallucinogen intoxication is distinguished 
from the other hallucinogen-induced disorders (e.g., hallucinogen-induced anxiety disor- 
der, with onset during intoxication) because the symptoms in these latter disorders pre- 
dominate the clinical presentation and are severe enough to warrant independent clinical 
attention. 


Hallucinogen Persisting Perception Disorder 531 


Hallucinogen Persisting Perception Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 292.89 (F 16.983) 


A. Following cessation of use of a hallucinogen, the reexperiencing of one or more of the 
perceptual symptoms that were experienced while intoxicated with the hallucinogen 
(e.g., geometric hallucinations, false perceptions of movement in the peripheral visual 
fields, flashes of color, intensified colors, trails of images of moving objects, positive 
afterimages, halos around objects, macropsia and micropsia). 

B. The symptoms in Criterion A cause clinically significant distress or impairment in so- 
cial, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

C. The symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition (e.g., anatomical le- 
sions and infections of the brain, visual epilepsies) and are not better explained by an- 
other mental disorder (e.g., delirium, major neurocognitive disorder, schizophrenia) or 
hypnopompic hallucinations. 


Diagnostic Features 


The hallmark of hallucinogen persisting perception disorder is the reexperiencing, when the 
individual is sober, of the perceptual disturbances that were experienced while the individ- 
ual was intoxicated with the hallucinogen (Criterion A). The symptoms may include any 
perceptual perturbations, but visual disturbances tend to be predominant. Typical of the ab- 
normal visual perceptions are geometric hallucinations, false perceptions of movement in 
the peripheral visual fields, flashes of color, intensified colors, trails of images of moving ob- 
jects (i.e., images left suspended in the path of a moving object as seen in stroboscopic pho- 
tography), perceptions of entire objects, positive afterimages (i.e., a same-colored or 
complementary-colored “shadow” of an object remaining after removal of the object), halos 
around objects, or misperception of images as too large (macropsia) or too small (micropsia). 
Duration of the visual disturbances may be episodic or nearly continuous and must cause 
clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas 
of functioning (Criterion B). The disturbances may last for weeks, months, or years. Other 
explanations for the disturbances (e.g., brain lesions, preexisting psychosis, seizure disor- 
ders, migraine aura without headaches) must be ruled out (Criterion C). 

Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder occurs primarily after LSD (lysergic acid 
diethylamide) use, but not exclusively. There does not appear to be a strong correlation be- 
tween hallucinogen persisting perception disorder and number of occasions of hallucino- 
gen use, with some instances of hallucinogen persisting perception disorder occurring in 
individuals with minimal exposure to hallucinogens. Some instances of hallucinogen per- 
sisting perception disorder may be triggered by use of other substances (e.g., cannabis or 
alcohol) or in adaptation to dark environments. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 

Reality testing remains intact in individuals with hallucinogen persisting perception dis- 
order (i.e., the individual is aware that the disturbance is linked to the effect of the drug). 
If this is not the case, another disorder might better explain the abnormal perceptions. 


Prevalence 

Prevalence estimates of hallucinogen persisting perception disorder are unknown. Initial 
prevalence estimates of the disorder among individuals who use hallucinogens is approx- 
imately 4.2%. 


532 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Development and Course 


Little is known about the development of hallucinogen persisting perception disorder. Its 
course, as suggested by its name, is persistent, lasting for weeks, months, or even years in 
certain individuals. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


There is little evidence regarding risk factors for hallucinogen persisting perception dis- 
order, although genetic factors have been suggested as a possible explanation underlying 
the susceptibility to LSD effects in this condition. 


Functional Consequences of 
Hallucinogen Persisting Perception Disorder 


Although hallucinogen persisting perception disorder remains a chronic condition in 
some cases, many individuals with the disorder are able to suppress the disturbances and 
continue to function normally. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Conditions to be ruled out include schizophrenia, other drug effects, neurodegenerative 
disorders, stroke, brain tumors, infections, and head trauma. Neuroimaging results in hal- 
lucinogen persisting perception disorder cases are typically negative. As noted earlier, re- 
ality testing remains intact (i.e., the individual is aware that the disturbance is linked to the 
effect of the drug); if this is not the case, another disorder (e.g., psychotic disorder, another 
medical condition) might better explain the abnormal perceptions. 


Comorbidity 


Common comorbid mental disorders accompanying hallucinogen persisting perception 
disorder are panic disorder, alcohol use disorder, and major depressive disorder. 


Other Phencyclidine-Induced Disorders 


Other phencyclidine-induced disorders are described in other chapters of the manual with 
disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance /medication-induced 
mental disorders in these chapters): phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder (“Schizo- 
phrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders”); phencyclidine-induced bipolar dis- 
order (“Bipolar and Related Disorders”); phencyclidine-induced depressive disorder 
(“Depressive Disorders”); and phencyclidine-induced anxiety disorder (“Anxiety Disor- 
ders”). For phencyclidine-induced intoxication delirium, see the criteria and discussion of 
delirium in the chapter “Neurocognitive Disorders.” These phencyclidine-induced disor- 
ders are diagnosed instead of phencyclidine intoxication only when the symptoms are suf- 
ficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Other Hallucinogen-Induced Disorders 


The following other hallucinogen-induced disorders are described in other chapters of the 
manual with disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance /medi- 
cation-induced mental disorders in these chapters): other hallucinogen-induced psychotic 
disorder (“Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders”); other hallucinogen- 
induced bipolar disorder (“Bipolar and Related Disorders”); other hallucinogen—induced 


Unspecified Phencyclidine-Related Disorder 533 


depressive disorder (“Depressive Disorders”); and other hallucinogen-induced anxiety 
disorder (“Anxiety Disorders”). For other hallucinogen intoxication delirium, see the cri- 
teria and discussion of delirium in the chapter “Neurocognitive Disorders.” These hallu- 
cinogen-induced disorders are diagnosed instead of other hallucinogen intoxication only 
when the symptoms are sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Unspecified Phencyclidine-Related Disorder 
292.9 (F 16.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a phencycli- 
dine-related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full 
criteria for any specific phencyclidine-related disorder or any of the disorders in the sub- 
stance-related and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


Unspecified Hallucinogen-Related Disorder 
292.9 (F 16.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a hallucinogen- 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any specific hallucinogen-related disorder or any of the disorders in the substance- 
related and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


Inhalant-Related Disorders 


Inhalant Use Disorder 
Inhalant Intoxication 
Other Inhalant-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Inhalant-Related Disorder 


Inhalant Use Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A problematic pattern of use of a hydrocarbon-based inhalant substance leading to 
Clinically significant impairment or distress, as manifested by at least two of the follow- 
ing, occurring within a 12-month period: 


1. The inhalant substance is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than 
was intended. 

2. There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control use of the 
inhalant substance. 


534 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


3. Agreat deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain the inhalant substance, 
use it, or recover from its effects. 

4. Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the inhalant substance. 

5. Recurrent use of the inhalant substance resulting in a failure to fulfill major role ob- 
ligations at work, school, or home. 

6. Continued use of the inhalant substance despite having persistent or recurrent so- 
cial or interpersonal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of its use. 

7. Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of use of the inhalant substance. 

8. Recurrent use of the inhalant substance in situations in which it is physically haz- 
ardous. 

9. Use of the inhalant substance is continued despite knowledge of having a persis- 
tent or recurrent physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been 
caused or exacerbated by the substance. 

10. Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 


a. A need for markedly increased amounts of the inhalant substance to achieve 
intoxication or desired effect. 

b. A markedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of the in- 
halant substance. 


Specify the particular inhalant: When possible, the particular substance involved should 

be named (e.g., “solvent use disorder’). 

Specify if: 
In early remission: After full criteria for inhalant use disorder were previously met, 
none of the criteria for inhalant use disorder have been met for at least 3 months but 
for less than 12 months (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong de- 
sire or urge to use the inhalant substance,” may be met). 
In sustained remission: After full criteria for inhalant use disorder were previously 
met, none of the criteria for inhalant use disorder have been met at any time during a 
period of 12 months or longer (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a 
strong desire or urge to use the inhalant substance,” may be met). 

Specity if: 
In a controlled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to inhalant substances is restricted. 


Coding based on current severity: Note for ICD-10-CM codes: If an inhalant intoxication 
or another inhalant-induced mental disorder is also present, do not use the codes below 
for inhalant use disorder. Instead, the comorbid inhalant use disorder is indicated in the 
Ath character of the inhalant-induced disorder code (see the coding note for inhalant intox- 
ication or a specific inhalant-induced mental disorder). For example, if there is comorbid 
inhalant-induced depressive disorder and inhalant use disorder, only the inhalant-induced 
depressive disorder code is given, with the 4th character indicating whether the comorbid 
inhalant use disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: F18.14 for mild inhalant use disorder 
with inhalant-induced depressive disorder or F18.24 for a moderate or severe inhalant use 
disorder with inhalant-induced depressive disorder. 


Specify current severity: 
305.90 (F18.10) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
304.60 (F18.20) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
304.60 (F18.20) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


Inhalant Use Disorder 535 


Specifiers 

This manual recognizes volatile hydrocarbon use meeting the above diagnostic criteria as 
inhalant use disorder. Volatile hydrocarbons are toxic gases from glues, fuels, paints, and 
other volatile compounds. When possible, the particular substance involved should be 
named (e.g., “toluene use disorder”). However, most compounds that are inhaled are a 
mixture of several substances that can produce psychoactive effects, and it is often difficult 
to ascertain the exact substance responsible for the disorder. Unless there is clear evidence 
that a single, unmixed substance has been used, the general term inhalant should be used 
in recording the diagnosis. Disorders arising from inhalation of nitrous oxide or of amyl-, 
butyl-, or isobutylnitrite are considered as other (or unknown) substance use disorder. 

“In a controlled environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individ- 
ual is both in remission and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a con- 
trolled environment or in sustained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of 
these environments are closely supervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communi- 
ties, and locked hospital units. 

The severity of individuals’ inhalant use disorder is assessed by the number of diag- 
nostic criteria endorsed. Changing severity of individuals’ inhalant use disorder across 
time is reflected by reductions in the frequency (e.g., days used per month) and/or dose 
(e.g., tubes of glue per day) used, as assessed by the individual's self-report, report of oth- 
ers, clinician’s observations, and biological testing (when practical). 


Diagnostic Features 


Features of inhalant use disorder include repeated use of an inhalant substance despite the 
individual’s knowing that the substance is causing serious problems for the individual 
(Criterion A9). Those problems are reflected in the diagnostic criteria. 

Missing work or school or inability to perform typical responsibilities at work or school 
(Criterion A5), and continued use of the inhalant substance even though it causes arguments 
with family or friends, fights, and other social or interpersonal problems (Criterion A6), may 
be seen in inhalant use disorder. Limiting family contact, work or school obligations, or rec- 
reational activities (e.g., sports, games, hobbies) may also occur (Criterion A7). Use of inhal- 
ants when driving or operating dangerous equipment (Criterion A8) is also seen. 

Tolerance (Criterion A10) and mild withdrawal are each reported by about 10% of in- 
dividuals who use inhalants, and a few individuals use inhalants to avoid withdrawal. 
However, because the withdrawal symptoms are mild, this manual neither recognizes a 
diagnosis of inhalant withdrawal nor counts withdrawal complaints as a diagnostic crite- 
rion for inhalant use disorder. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A diagnosis of inhalant use disorder is supported by recurring episodes of intoxication 
with negative results in standard drug screens (which do not detect inhalants); possession, 
or lingering odors, of inhalant substances; peri-oral or peri-nasal “glue-sniffer’s rash”; as- 
sociation with other individuals known to use inhalants; membership in groups with prev- 
alent inhalant use (e.g., some native or aboriginal communities, homeless children in street 
gangs); easy access to certain inhalant substances; paraphernalia possession; presence of 
the disorder’s characteristic medical complications (e.g., brain white matter pathology, 
rhabdomyolysis); and the presence of multiple substance use disorders. Inhalant use and 
inhalant use disorder are associated with past suicide attempts, especially among adults 
reporting previous episodes of low mood or anhedonia. 


Prevalence 


About 0.4% of Americans ages 12-17 years have a pattern of use that meets criteria for in- 
halant use disorder in the past 12 months. Among those youths, the prevalence is highest 


536 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


in Native Americans and lowest in African Americans. Prevalence falls to about 0.1% among 
Americans ages 18-29 years, and only 0.02% when all Americans 18 years or older are con- 
sidered, with almost no females and a preponderance of European Americans. Of course, 
in isolated subgroups, prevalence may differ considerably from these overall rates. 


Development and Course 


About 10% of 13-year-old American children report having used inhalants at least once; 
that percentage remains stable through age 17 years. Among those 12- to 17-year-olds who 
use inhalants, the more-used substances include glue, shoe polish, or toluene; gasoline or 
lighter fluid; or spray paints. 

Only 0.4% of 12- to 17-year-olds progress to inhalant use disorder; those youths tend to 
exhibit multiple other problems. The declining prevalence of inhalant use disorder after 
adolescence indicates that this disorder usually remits in early adulthood. 

Volatile hydrocarbon use disorder is rare in prepubertal children, most common in ad- 
olescents and young adults, and uncommon in older persons. Calls to poison-control cen- 
ters for “intentional abuse” of inhalants peak with calls involving individuals at age 14 years. 
Of adolescents who use inhalants, perhaps one-fifth develop inhalant use disorder; a few 
die from inhalant-related accidents, or “sudden sniffing death”. But the disorder apparently 
remits in many individuals after adolescence. Prevalence declines dramatically among in- 
dividuals in their 20s. Those with inhalant use disorder extending into adulthood often 
have severe problems: substance use disorders, antisocial personality disorder, and sui- 
cidal ideation with attempts. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Predictors of progression from nonuse of inhalants, to use, to inhalant 
use disorder include comorbid non-inhalant substance use disorders and either conduct 
disorder or antisocial personality disorder. Other predictors are earlier onset of inhalant 
use and prior use of mental health services. 


Environmental. Inhalant gases are widely and legally available, increasing the risk of mis- 
use. Childhood maltreatment or trauma also is associated with youthful progression from 
inhalant non-use to inhalant use disorder. 


Genetic and physiological. Behavioral disinhibition is a highly heritable general propensity 
to not constrain behavior in socially acceptable ways, to break social norms and rules, and to 
take dangerous risks, pursuing rewards excessively despite dangers of adverse consequences. 
Youths with strong behavioral disinhibition show risk factors for inhalant use disorder: early- 
onset substance use disorder, multiple substance involvement, and early conduct problems. 
Because behavioral disinhibition is under strong genetic influence, youths in families with 
substance and antisocial problems are at elevated risk for inhalant use disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Certain native or aboriginal communities have experienced a high prevalence of inhalant 
problems. Also, in some countries, groups of homeless children in street gangs have ex- 
tensive inhalant use problems. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Although the prevalence of inhalant use disorder is almost identical in adolescent males 
and females, the disorder is very rare among adult females. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Urine, breath, or saliva tests may be valuable for assessing concurrent use of non-inhalant 
substances by individuals with inhalant use disorder. However, technical problems and 


Inhalant Use Disorder 537 


the considerable expense of analyses make frequent biological testing for inhalants them- 
selves impractical. 


Functional Consequences of Inhalant Use Disorder 


Because of inherent toxicity, use of butane or propane is not infrequently fatal. Moreover, 
any inhaled volatile hydrocarbons may produce “sudden sniffing death” from cardiac ar- 
rhythmia. Fatalities may occur even on the first inhalant exposure and are not thought to 
be dose-related. Volatile hydrocarbon use impairs neurobehavioral function and causes 
various neurological, gastrointestinal, cardiovascular, and pulmonary problems. 

Long-term inhalant users are at increased risk for tuberculosis, HIV/AIDS, sexually 
transmitted diseases, depression, anxiety, bronchitis, asthma, and sinusitis. Deaths may 
occur from respiratory depression, arrhythmias, asphyxiation, aspiration of vomitus, or 
accident and injury. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Inhalant exposure (unintentional) from industrial or other accidents. This designation 
is used when findings suggest repeated or continuous inhalant exposure but the involved 
individual and other informants deny any history of purposeful inhalant use. 


Inhalant use (intentional), without meeting criteria for inhalant use disorder. Inhalant use 
is common among adolescents, but for most of those individuals, the inhalant use does not 
meet the diagnostic standard of two or more Criterion A items for inhalant use disorder in 
the past year. 


Inhalant intoxication, without meeting criteria for inhalant use disorder. Inhalant intox- 
ication occurs frequently during inhalant use disorder but also may occur among individ- 
uals whose use does not meet criteria for inhalant use disorder, which requires at least two 
of the 10 diagnostic criteria in the past year. 


Inhalant-induced disorders (i.e., inhalant-induced psychotic disorder, depressive dis- 
order, anxiety disorder, neurocognitive disorder, other inhalant-induced disorders) 
without meeting criteria for inhalant use disorder. Criteria are met for a psychotic, de- 
pressive, anxiety, or major neurocognitive disorder, and there is evidence from history, 
physical examination, or laboratory findings that the deficits are etiologically related to 
the effects of inhalant substances. Yet, criteria for inhalant use disorder may not be met 
(i.e., fewer than 2 of the 10 criteria were present). 


Other substance use disorders, especially those involving sedating substances (e.g., 
alcohol, benzodiazepines, barbiturates). Inhalant use disorder commonly co-occurs 
with other substance use disorders, and the symptoms of the disorders may be similar and 
overlapping. To disentangle symptom patterns, it is helpful to inquire about which symp- 
toms persisted during periods when some of the substances were not being used. 


Other toxic, metabolic, traumatic, neoplastic, or infectious disorders impairing central or 
peripheral nervous system function. Individuals with inhalant use disorder may pre- 
sent with symptoms of pernicious anemia, subacute combined degeneration of the spinal 
cord, psychosis, major or minor cognitive disorder, brain atrophy, leukoencephalopathy, 
and many other nervous system disorders. Of course, these disorders also may occur in 
the absence of inhalant use disorder. A history of little or no inhalant use helps to exclude 
inhalant use disorder as the source of these problems. 


Disorders of other organ systems. Individuals with inhalant use disorder may present 
with symptoms of hepatic or renal damage, rhabdomyolysis, methemoglobinemia, or symp- 
toms of other gastrointestinal, cardiovascular, or pulmonary diseases. A history of little or no 
inhalant use helps to exclude inhalant use disorder as the source of such medical problems. 


538 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Comorbidity 

Individuals with inhalant use disorder receiving clinical care often have numerous other 
substance use disorders. Inhalant use disorder commonly co-occurs with adolescent con- 
duct disorder and adult antisocial personality disorder. Adult inhalant use and inhalant 
use disorder also are strongly associated with suicidal ideation and suicide attempts. 


Inhalant Intoxication 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recent intended or unintended short-term, high-dose exposure to inhalant sub- 
stances, including volatile hydrocarbons such as toluene or gasoline. 

B. Clinically significant problematic behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., belliger- 
ence, assaultiveness, apathy, impaired judgment) that developed during, or shortly af- 
ter, exposure to inhalants. 

C. Two (or more) of the following signs or symptoms developing during, or shortly after, 
inhalant use or exposure: 


Dizziness. 

Nystagmus. 

Incoordination. 

Slurred speech. 

Unsteady gait. 

Lethargy. 

Depressed reflexes. 

Psychomotor retardation. 
9. Tremor. 

10. Generalized muscle weakness. 

11. Blurred vision or diplopia. 

12. Stupor or coma. 

13. Euphoria. 


CON AO): OF: eGo Ne 


D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not bet- 
ter explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another substance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.89. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
there is a comorbid inhalant use disorder. If a mild inhalant use disorder is comorbid, the 
ICD-10-CM code is F18.129, and if a moderate or severe inhalant use disorder is comor- 
bid, the ICD-10-CM code is F18.229. If there is no comorbid inhalant use disorder, then 
the ICD-10-CM code is F18.929. 


Note: For information on Development and Course, Risk and Prognostic Factors, Culture- 
Related Diagnostic Issues, and Diagnostic Markers, see the corresponding sections in in- 
halant use disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


Inhalant intoxication is an inhalant-related, clinically significant mental disorder that de- 
velops during, or immediately after, intended or unintended inhalation of a volatile hy- 
drocarbon substance. Volatile hydrocarbons are toxic gases from glues, fuels, paints, and 
other volatile compounds. When it is possible to do so, the particular substance involved 
should be named (e.g., toluene intoxication). Among those who do, the intoxication clears 
within a few minutes to a few hours after the exposure ends. Thus, inhalant intoxication 
usually occurs in brief episodes that may recur. 


Inhalant Intoxication 539 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Inhalant intoxication may be indicated by evidence of possession, or lingering odors, of in- 
halant substances (e.g., glue, paint thinner, gasoline, butane lighters); apparent intoxica- 
tion occurring in the age range with the highest prevalence of inhalant use (12-17 years); 
and apparent intoxication with negative results from the standard drug screens that usu- 
ally fail to identify inhalants. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of actual episodes of inhalant intoxication in the general population is un- 
known, but it is probable that most inhalant users would at some time exhibit use that 
would meet criteria for inhalant intoxication disorder. Therefore, the prevalence of inhal- 
ant use and the prevalence of inhalant intoxication disorder are likely similar. In 2009 and 
2010, inhalant use in the past year was reported by 0.8% of all Americans older than 12 years; 
the prevalence was highest in younger age groups (3.6% for individuals 12 to 17 years old, 
and 1.7% for individuals 18 to 25 years old). 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Gender differences in the prevalence of inhalant intoxication in the general population are 
unknown. However, if it is assumed that most inhalant users eventually experience inhal- 
ant intoxication, gender differences in the prevalence of inhalant users likely approximate 
those in the proportions of males and females experiencing inhalant intoxication. Regard- 
ing gender differences in the prevalence of inhalant users in the United States, 1% of males 
older than 12 years and 0.7% of females older than 12 years have used inhalants in the pre- 
vious year, but in the younger age groups more females than males have used inhalants 
(e.g., among 12- to 17-year-olds, 3.6% of males and 4.2% of females). 


Functional Consequences of Inhalant Intoxication 


Use of inhaled substances in a closed container, such as a plastic bag over the head, may 
lead to unconsciousness, anoxia, and death. Separately, “sudden sniffing death,” likely 
from cardiac arrhythmia or arrest, may occur with various volatile inhalants. The en- 
hanced toxicity of certain volatile inhalants, such as butane or propane, also causes fatal- 
ities. Although inhalant intoxication itself is of short duration, it may produce persisting 
medical and neurological problems, especially if the intoxications are frequent. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Inhalant exposure, without meeting the criteria for inhalant intoxication disorder. 
The individual intentionally or unintentionally inhaled substances, but the dose was in- 
sufficient for the diagnostic criteria for inhalant use disorder to be met. 


Intoxication and other substance/medication-induced disorders from other sub- 
stances, especially from sedating substances (e.g., alcohol, benzodiazepines, barbi- 
turates). These disorders may have similar signs and symptoms, but the intoxication is 
attributable to other intoxicants that may be identified via a toxicology screen. Differenti- 
ating the source of the intoxication may involve discerning evidence of inhalant exposure 
as described for inhalant use disorder. A diagnosis of inhalant intoxication may be sug- 
gested by possession, or lingering odors, of inhalant substances (e.g., glue, paint thinner, 
gasoline, butane lighters,); paraphernalia possession (e.g., rags or bags for concentrating 
glue fumes); perioral or perinasal “glue-sniffer’s rash”; reports from family or friends that 
the intoxicated individual possesses or uses inhalants; apparent intoxication despite neg- 
ative results on standard drug screens (which usually fail to identify inhalants); apparent 
intoxication occurring in that age range with the highest prevalence of inhalant use (12-17 


540 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


years); association with others known to use inhalants; membership in certain small com- 
munities with prevalent inhalant use (e.g., some native or aboriginal communities, home- 
less street children and adolescents); or unusual access to certain inhalant substances. 


Other inhalant-related disorders. Episodes of inhalant intoxication do occur during, 
but are not identical with, other inhalant-related disorders. Those inhalant-related disorders 
are recognized by their respective diagnostic criteria: inhalant use disorder, inhalant- 
induced neurocognitive disorder, inhalant-induced psychotic disorder, inhalant-induced 
depressive disorder, inhalant-induced anxiety disorder, and other inhalant-induced dis- 
orders. 


Other toxic, metabolic, traumatic, neoplastic, or infectious disorders that impair brain 
function and cognition. Numerous neurological and other medical conditions may pro- 
duce the clinically significant behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., belligerence, as- 
saultiveness, apathy, impaired judgment) that also characterize inhalant intoxication. 


Other Inhalant-Induced Disorders 


The following inhalant-induced disorders are described in other chapters of the manual 
with disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance /medication- 
induced mental disorders in these chapters): inhalant-induced psychotic disorder (“Schizo- 
phrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders”); inhalant-induced depressive disorder 
(“Depressive Disorders”); inhalant-induced anxiety disorder (“Anxiety Disorders”); and in- 
halant-induced major or mild neurocognitive disorder (“Neurocognitive Disorders”). For 
inhalant intoxication delirium, see the criteria and discussion of delirium in the chapter 
“Neurocognitive Disorders.” These inhalant-induced disorders are diagnosed instead of in- 
halant intoxication only when symptoms are sufficiently severe to warrant independent 
clinical attention. 


Unspecified Inhalant-Related Disorder 
292.9 (F18.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an inhalant- 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any specific inhalant-related disorder or any of the disorders in the substance-related 
and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


Opioid-Related Disorders 


Opioid Use Disorder 
Opioid Intoxication 
Opioid Withdrawal 
Other Opioid-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Opioid-Related Disorder 


Opioid Use Disorder 541 


Opioid Use Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Aproblematic pattern of opioid use leading to clinically significant impairment or distress, 
as manifested by at least two of the following, occurring within a 12-month period: 


1. 


Opioids are often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was in- 
tended. 


2. There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control opioid use. 

3. A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain the opioid, use the opi- 
oid, or recover from its effects. 

4. Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use opioids. 

5. Recurrent opioid use resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at work, 
school, or home. 

6. Continued opioid use despite having persistent or recurrent social or interpersonal 
problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of opioids. 

7. Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of opioid use. 

8. Recurrent opioid use in situations in which it is physically hazardous. 

9. Continued opioid use despite knowledge of having a persistent or recurrent physi- 
cal or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or exacerbated by 
the substance. 

10. Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 
a. Aneed for markedly increased amounts of opioids to achieve intoxication or de- 
sired effect. 
b. Amarkedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of an opioid. 
Note: This criterion is not considered to be met for those taking opioids solely under 
appropriate medical supervision. 
11. Withdrawal, as manifested by either of the following: 
a. The characteristic opioid withdrawal syndrome (refer to Criteria A and B of the 
criteria set for opioid withdrawal, pp. 547-548). 
b. Opioids (or a closely related substance) are taken to relieve or avoid withdrawal 
symptoms. 
Note: This criterion is not considered to be met for those individuals taking opioids 
solely under appropriate medical supervision. 
Specify if: 


In early remission: After full criteria for opioid use disorder were previously met, none 
of the criteria for opioid use disorder have been met for at least 3 months but for less 
than 12 months (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong desire or 
urge to use opioids,” may be met). 

In sustained remission: After full criteria for opioid use disorder were previously met, 
none of the criteria for opioid use disorder have been met at any time during a period 
of 12 months or longer (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong de- 
sire or urge to use opioids,” may be met). 

Specify if: 

On maintenance therapy: This additional specifier is used if the individual is taking a 
prescribed agonist medication such as methadone or buprenorphine and none of the 
criteria for opioid use disorder have been met for that class of medication (except tol- 
erance to, or withdrawal from, the agonist). This category also applies to those individ- 


542 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


uals being maintained on a partial agonist, an agonist/antagonist, or a full antagonist 
such as oral naltrexone or depot naltrexone. 

In a controlled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to opioids is restricted. 


Coding based on current severity: Note for |ICD-10-CM codes: If an opioid intoxication, 
opioid withdrawal, or another opioid-induced mental disorder is also present, do not use 
the codes below for opioid use disorder. Instead, the comorbid opioid use disorder is indi- 
cated in the 4th character of the opioid-induced disorder code (see the coding note for opi- 
oid intoxication, opioid withdrawal, or a specific opioid-induced mental disorder). For 
example, if there is comorbid opioid-induced depressive disorder and opioid use disorder, 
only the opioid-induced depressive disorder code is given, with the 4th character indicating 
whether the comorbid opioid use disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: F11.14 for mild opi- 
oid use disorder with opioid-induced depressive disorder or F11.24 for a moderate or se- 
vere opioid use disorder with opioid-induced depressive disorder. 
Specify current severity: 

305.50 (F11.10) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 

304.00 (F11.20) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 

304.00 (F11.20) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


Specifiers 
The “on maintenance therapy” specifier applies as a further specifier of remission if the in- 
dividual is both in remission and receiving maintenance therapy. “In a controlled environ- 
ment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is both in remission and in 
a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled environment or in sustained 
remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these environments are closely super- 
vised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, and locked hospital units. 
Changing severity across time in an individual is also reflected by reductions in the fre- 
quency (e.g., days of use per month) and/or dose (e.g., injections or number of pills) of an 
opioid, as assessed by the individual's self-report, report of knowledgeable others, clini- 
cian’s observations, and biological testing. 


Diagnostic Features 


Opioid use disorder includes signs and symptoms that reflect compulsive, prolonged self- 
administration of opioid substances that are used for no legitimate medical purpose or, if 
another medical condition is present that requires opioid treatment, that are used in doses 
greatly in excess of the amount needed for that medical condition. (For example, an indi- 
vidual prescribed analgesic opioids for pain relief at adequate dosing will use significantly 
more than prescribed and not only because of persistent pain.) Individuals with opioid use 
disorder tend to develop such regular patterns of compulsive drug use that daily activities 
are planned around obtaining and administering opioids. Opioids are usually purchased 
on the illegal market but may also be obtained from physicians by falsifying or exagger- 
ating general medical problems or by receiving simultaneous prescriptions from several 
physicians. Health care professionals with opioid use disorder will often obtain opioids by 
writing prescriptions for themselves or by diverting opioids that have been prescribed for 
patients or from pharmacy supplies. Most individuals with opioid use disorder have 
significant levels of tolerance and will experience withdrawal on abrupt discontinuation 
of opioid substances. Individuals with opioid use disorder often develop conditioned 
responses to drug-related stimuli (e.g., craving on seeing any heroin powder-like sub- 
stance)—a phenomenon that occurs with most drugs that cause intense psychological 
changes. These responses probably contribute to relapse, are difficult to extinguish, and typ- 
ically persist long after detoxification is completed. 


Opioid Use Disorder 543 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Opioid use disorder can be associated with a history of drug-related crimes (e.g., posses- 
sion or distribution of drugs, forgery, burglary, robbery, larceny, receiving stolen goods). 
Among health care professionals and individuals who have ready access to controlled 
substances, there is often a different pattern of illegal activities involving problems with 
state licensing boards, professional staffs of hospitals, or other administrative agencies. 
Marital difficulties (including divorce), unemployment, and irregular employment are of- 
ten associated with opioid use disorder at all socioeconomic levels. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalence of opioid use disorder is approximately 0.37% among adults age 
18 years and older in the community population. This may be an underestimate because of 
the large number of incarcerated individuals with opioid use disorders. Rates are higher in 
males than in females (0.49% vs. 0.26%), with the male-to-female ratio typically being 1.5:1 
for opioids other than heroin (i.e., available by prescription) and 3:1 for heroin. Female ad- 
olescents may have a higher likelihood of developing opioid use disorders. The preva- 
lence decreases with age, with the prevalence highest (0.82%) among adults age 29 years or 
younger, and decreasing to 0.09% among adults age 65 years and older. Among adults, the 
prevalence of opioid use disorder is lower among African Americans at 0.18% and over- 
represented among Native Americans at 1.25%. It is close to average among whites (0.38%), 
Asian or Pacific Islanders (0.35%), and Hispanics (0.39%). 

Among individuals in the United States ages 12-17 years, the overall 12-month prev- 
alence of opioid use disorder in the community population is approximately 1.0%, but the 
prevalence of heroin use disorder is less than 0.1%. By contrast, analgesic use disorder is 
prevalent in about 1.0% of those ages 12-17 years, speaking to the importance of opioid an- 
algesics as a group of substances with significant health consequences. 

The 12-month prevalence of problem opioid use in European countries in the commu- 
nity population ages 15-64 years is between 0.1% and 0.8%. The average prevalence of 
problem opioid use in the European Union and Norway is between 0.36% and 0.44%. 


Development and Course 


Opioid use disorder can begin at any age, but problems associated with opioid use are 
most commonly first observed in the late teens or early 20s. Once opioid use disorder 
develops, it usually continues over a period of many years, even though brief periods of 
abstinence are frequent. In treated populations, relapse following abstinence is common. 
Even though relapses do occur, and while some long-term mortality rates may be as high 
as 2% per year, about 20%-30% of individuals with opioid use disorder achieve long-term 
abstinence. An exception concerns that of military service personnel who became depen- 
dent on opioids in Vietnam; over 90% of this population who had been dependent on opi- 
oids during deployment in Vietnam achieved abstinence after they returned, but they 
experienced increased rates of alcohol or amphetamine use disorder as well as increased 
suicidality. 

Increasing age is associated with a decrease in prevalence as a result of early mortality 
and the remission of symptoms after age 40 years (i.e., “maturing out”). However, many 
individuals continue have presentations that meet opioid use disorder criteria for decades. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. The risk for opiate use disorder can be related to individual, 
family, peer, and social environmental factors, but within these domains, genetic factors 
play a particularly important role both directly and indirectly. For instance, impulsivity 
and novelty seeking are individual temperaments that relate to the propensity to develop 


544 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


a substance use disorder but may themselves be genetically determined. Peer factors may 
relate to genetic predisposition in terms of how an individual selects his or her environ- 
ment. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Despite small variations regarding individual criterion items, opioid use disorder diag- 
nostic criteria perform equally well across most race/ethnicity groups. Individuals from 
ethnic minority populations living in economically deprived areas have been overrep- 
resented among individuals with opioid use disorder. However, over time, opioid use 
disorder is seen more often among white middle-class individuals, especially females, 
suggesting that differences in use reflect the availability of opioid drugs and that other so- 
cial factors may impact prevalence. Medical personnel who have ready access to opioids 
may be at increased risk for opioid use disorder. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Routine urine toxicology test results are often positive for opioid drugs in individuals with 
opioid use disorder. Urine test results remain positive for most opioids (e.g., heroin, mor- 
phine, codeine, oxycodone, propoxyphene) for 12-36 hours after administration. Fentanyl 
is not detected by standard urine tests but can be identified by more specialized proce- 
dures for several days. Methadone, buprenorphine (or buprenorphine/naloxone combi- 
nation), and LAAM (L-alpha-acetylmethadol) have to be specifically tested for and will not 
cause a positive result on routine tests for opiates. They can be detected for several days up 
to more than 1 week. Laboratory evidence of the presence of other substances (e.g., co- 
caine, marijuana, alcohol, amphetamines, benzodiazepines) is common. Screening test re- 
sults for hepatitis A, B, and C virus are positive in as many as 80%-—90% of injection opioid 
users, either for hepatitis antigen (signifying active infection) or for hepatitis antibody (sig- 
nifying past infection). HIV is prevalent in injection opioid users as well. Mildly elevated 
liver function test results are common, either as a result of resolving hepatitis or from toxic 
injury to the liver due to contaminants that have been mixed with the injected opioid. Sub- 
tle changes in cortisol secretion patterns and body temperature regulation have been ob- 
served for up to 6 months following opioid detoxification. 


Suicide Risk 


Similar to the risk generally observed for all substance use disorders, opioid use disorder 
is associated with a heightened risk for suicide attempts and completed suicides. Particu- 
larly notable are both accidental and deliberate opioid overdoses. Some suicide risk factors 
overlap with risk factors for an opioid use disorder. In addition, repeated opioid intoxica- 
tion or withdrawal may be associated with severe depressions that, although temporary, 
can be intense enough to lead to suicide attempts and completed suicides. Available data 
suggest that nonfatal accidental opioid overdose (which is common) and attempted sui- 
cide are distinct clinically significant problems that should not be mistaken for each other. 


Functional Consequences of Opioid Use Disorder 


Opioid use is associated with a lack of mucous membrane secretions, causing dry mouth 
and nose. Slowing of gastrointestinal activity and a decrease in gut motility can produce 
severe constipation. Visual acuity may be impaired as a result of pupillary constriction 
with acute administration. In individuals who inject opioids, sclerosed veins (“tracks”) 
and puncture marks on the lower portions of the upper extremities are common. Veins 
sometimes become so severely sclerosed that peripheral edema develops, and individuals 
switch to injecting in veins in the legs, neck, or groin. When these veins become unusable, 
individuals often inject directly into their subcutaneous tissue (“skin-popping”), resulting 


Opioid Use Disorder 545 


in cellulitis, abscesses, and circular-appearing scars from healed skin lesions. Tetanus and 
Clostridium botulinum infections are relatively rare but extremely serious consequences of 
injecting opioids, especially with contaminated needles. Infections may also occur in other 
organs and include bacterial endocarditis, hepatitis, and HIV infection. Hepatitis C infec- 
tions, for example, may occur in up to 90% of persons who inject opioids. In addition, the 
prevalence of HIV infection can be high among individuals who inject drugs, a large pro- 
portion of whom are individuals with opioid use disorder. HIV infection rates have been 
reported to be as high as 60% among heroin users with opioid use disorder in some areas 
of the United States or the Russian Federation. However, the incidence may also be 10% or 
less in other areas, especially those where access to clean injection material and parapher- 
nalia is facilitated. 

Tuberculosis is a particularly serious problem among individuals who use drugs in- 
travenously, especially those who are dependent on heroin; infection is usually asymptom- 
atic and evident only by the presence of a positive tuberculin skin test. However, many cases 
of active tuberculosis have been found, especially among those who are infected with HIV. 
These individuals often have a newly acquired infection but also are likely to experience 
reactivation of a prior infection because of impaired immune function. 

Individuals who sniff heroin or other opioids into the nose (“snorting”) often develop 
irritation of the nasal mucosa, sometimes accompanied by perforation of the nasal septum. 
Difficulties in sexual functioning are common. Males often experience erectile dysfunction 
during intoxication or chronic use. Females commonly have disturbances of reproductive 
function and irregular menses. 

In relation to infections such as cellulitis, hepatitis, HIV infection, tuberculosis, and en- 
docarditis, opioid use disorder is associated with a mortality rate as high as 1.5%-2% per 
year. Death most often results from overdose, accidents, injuries, AIDS, or other general 
medical complications. Accidents and injuries due to violence that is associated with buy- 
ing or selling drugs are common. In some areas, violence accounts for more opioid-related 
deaths than overdose or HIV infection. Physiological dependence on opioids may occur in 
about half of the infants born to females with opioid use disorder; this can produce a se- 
vere withdrawal syndrome requiring medical treatment. Although low birth weight is 
also seen in children of mothers with opioid use disorder, it is usually not marked and is 
generally not associated with serious adverse consequences. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Opioid-induced mental disorders. Opioid-induced disorders occur frequently in individ- 
uals with opioid use disorder. Opioid-induced disorders may be characterized by symptoms 
(e.g., depressed mood) that resemble primary mental disorders (e.g., persistent depressive dis- 
order [dysthymia] vs. opioid-induced depressive disorder, with depressive features, with on- 
set during intoxication). Opioids are less likely to produce symptoms of mental disturbance 
than are most other drugs of abuse. Opioid intoxication and opioid withdrawal are distin- 
guished from the other opioid-induced disorders (e.g., opioid-induced depressive disorder, 
with onset during intoxication) because the symptoms in these latter disorders predominate 
the clinical presentation and are severe enough to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Other substance intoxication. Alcohol intoxication and sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
intoxication can cause a clinical picture that resembles that for opioid intoxication. A diag- 
nosis of alcohol or sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication can usually be made based 
on the absence of pupillary constriction or the lack of a response to naloxone challenge. In 
some cases, intoxication may be due both to opioids and to alcohol or other sedatives. In 
these cases, the naloxone challenge will not reverse all of the sedative effects. 


Other withdrawal disorders. The anxiety and restlessness associated with opioid with- 
drawal resemble symptoms seen in sedative-hypnotic withdrawal. However, opioid 
withdrawal is also accompanied by rhinorrhea, lacrimation, and pupillary dilation, which 


546 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


are not seen in sedative-type withdrawal. Dilated pupils are also seen in hallucinogen 
intoxication and stimulant intoxication. However, other signs or symptoms of opioid 
withdrawal, such as nausea, vomiting, diarrhea, abdominal cramps, rhinorrhea, or lacri- 
mation, are not present. 


Comorbidity 


The most common medical conditions associated with opioid use disorder are viral (e.g., 
HIV, hepatitis C virus) and bacterial infections, particularly among users of opioids by in- 
jection. These infections are less common in opioid use disorder with prescription opioids. 
Opioid use disorder is often associated with other substance use disorders, especially those 
involving tobacco, alcohol, cannabis, stimulants, and benzodiazepines, which are often 
taken to reduce symptoms of opioid withdrawal or craving for opioids, or to enhance the ef- 
fects of administered opioids. Individuals with opioid use disorder are at risk for the devel- 
opment of mild to moderate depression that meets symptomatic and duration criteria for 
persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia) or, in some cases, for major depressive disorder. 
These symptoms may represent an opioid-induced depressive disorder or an exacerbation 
of a preexisting primary depressive disorder. Periods of depression are especially common 
during chronic intoxication or in association with physical or psychosocial stressors that are 
related to the opioid use disorder. Insomnia is common, especially during withdrawal. An- 
tisocial personality disorder is much more common in individuals with opioid use disorder 
than in the general population. Posttraumatic stress disorder is also seen with increased fre- 
quency. A history of conduct disorder in childhood or adolescence has been identified as a 
significant risk factor for substance-related disorders, especially opioid use disorder. 


Opioid Intoxication 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recent use of an opioid. 

B. Clinically significant problematic behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., initial eu- 
phoria followed by apathy, dysphoria, psychomotor agitation or retardation, impaired 
judgment) that developed during, or shortly after, opioid use. 

C. Pupillary constriction (or pupillary dilation due to anoxia from severe overdose) and 
one (or more) of the following signs or symptoms developing during, or shortly after, 
opioid use: 

1. Drowsiness or coma. 
2. Slurred speech. 
3. Impairment in attention or memory. 


D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another sub- 
stance. 

Specity if: 

With perceptual disturbances: This specifier may be noted in the rare instance in 
which hallucinations with intact reality testing or auditory, visual, or tactile illusions oc- 
cur in the absence of a delirium. 

Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.89. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 

or not there is a comorbid opioid use disorder and whether or not there are perceptual dis- 

turbances. 
For opioid intoxication without perceptual disturbances: If a mild opioid use dis- 
order is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F11.129, and if a moderate or severe opioid 


Opioid Withdrawal 547 


use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F11.229. If there is no comorbid opi- 
oid use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F11.929. 


For opioid intoxication with perceptual disturbances: If a mild opioid use disorder 
is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F11.122, and if a moderate or severe opioid use 
disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F11.222. If there is no comorbid opioid 
use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F11.922. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of opioid intoxication is the presence of clinically significant prob- 
lematic behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., initial euphoria followed by apathy, 
dysphoria, psychomotor agitation or retardation, impaired judgment) that develop dur- 
ing, or shortly after, opioid use (Criteria A and B). Intoxication is accompanied by pupil- 
lary constriction (unless there has been a severe overdose with consequent anoxia and 
pupillary dilation) and one or more of the following signs: drowsiness (described as be- 
ing “on the nod”), slurred speech, and impairment in attention or memory (Criterion C); 
drowsiness may progress to coma. Individuals with opioid intoxication may demonstrate 
inattention to the environment, even to the point of ignoring potentially harmful events. 
The signs or symptoms must not be attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder (Criterion D). 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other substance intoxication. Alcohol intoxication and sedative-hypnotic intoxication 
can cause a clinical picture that resembles opioid intoxication. A diagnosis of alcohol or 
sedative-hypnotic intoxication can usually be made based on the absence of pupillary con- 
striction or the lack of a response to a naloxone challenge. In some cases, intoxication may 
be due both to opioids and to alcohol or other sedatives. In these cases, the naloxone chal- 
lenge will not reverse all of the sedative effects. 

Other opioid-related disorders. Opioid intoxication is distinguished from the other 
opioid-induced disorders (e.g., opioid-induced depressive disorder, with onset during in- 
toxication) because the symptoms in the latter disorders predominate in the clinical pre- 
sentation and meet full criteria for the relevant disorder. 


Opioid Withdrawal 
Diagnostic Criteria 292.0 (F11.23) 


A. Presence of either of the following: 
1. Cessation of (or reduction in) opioid use that has been heavy and prolonged (i.e., 
several weeks or longer). 
2. Administration of an opioid antagonist after a period of opioid use. 


B. Three (or more) of the following developing within minutes to several days after Criterion A: 


1. Dysphoric mood. 

Nausea or vomiting. 

Muscle aches. 

Lacrimation or rhinorrhea. 

Pupillary dilation, piloerection, or sweating. 


aProN 


548 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


6. Diarrhea. 
7. Yawning. 
8. Fever. 

9. Insomnia. 


C. The signs or symptoms in Criterion B cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication or withdrawal from 
another substance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.0. The ICD-10-CM code for opioid withdrawal is 
F11.23. Note that the ICD-10-CM code indicates the comorbid presence of a moderate or 
severe opioid use disorder, reflecting the fact that opioid withdrawal can only occur in the 
presence of a moderate or severe opioid use disorder. It is not permissible to code a co- 
morbid mild opioid use disorder with opioid withdrawal. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of opioid withdrawal is the presence of a characteristic withdrawal 
syndrome that develops after the cessation of (or reduction in) opioid use that has been 
heavy and prolonged (Criterion A1). The withdrawal syndrome can also be precipitated 
by administration of an opioid antagonist (e.g., naloxone or naltrexone) after a period of 
opioid use (Criterion A2). This may also occur after administration of an opioid partial ag- 
onist such as buprenorphine to a person currently using a full opioid agonist. 

Opioid withdrawal is characterized by a pattern of signs and symptoms that are oppo- 
site to the acute agonist effects. The first of these are subjective and consist of complaints of 
anxiety, restlessness, and an “achy feeling” that is often located in the back and legs, along 
with irritability and increased sensitivity to pain. Three or more of the following must be 
present to make a diagnosis of opioid withdrawal: dysphoric mood; nausea or vomiting; 
muscle aches; lacrimation or rhinorrhea; pupillary dilation, piloerection, or increased 
sweating; diarrhea; yawning; fever; and insomnia (Criterion B). Piloerection and fever are 
associated with more severe withdrawal and are not often seen in routine clinical practice 
because individuals with opioid use disorder usually obtain substances before with- 
drawal becomes that far advanced. These symptoms of opioid withdrawal must cause 
clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important ar- 
eas of functioning (Criterion C). The symptoms must not be attributable to another med- 
ical condition and are not better explained by another mental disorder (Criterion D). 
Meeting diagnostic criteria for opioid withdrawal alone is not sufficient for a diagnosis of 
opioid use disorder, but concurrent symptoms of craving and drug-seeking behavior are 
suggestive of comorbid opioid use disorder. ICD-10-CM codes only allow a diagnosis of 
opioid withdrawal in the presence of comorbid moderate to severe opioid use disorder. 

The speed and severity of withdrawal associated with opioids depend on the half-life of 
the opioid used. Most individuals who are physiologically dependent on short-acting drugs 
such as heroin begin to have withdrawal symptoms within 6-12 hours after the last dose. 
Symptoms may take 2-4 days to emerge in the case of longer-acting drugs such as metha- 
done, LAAM (L-alpha-acetylmethadol), or buprenorphine. Acute withdrawal symptoms for 
a short-acting opioid such as heroin usually peak within 1-3 days and gradually subside 
over a period of 5-7 days. Less acute withdrawal symptoms can last for weeks to months. 
These more chronic symptoms include anxiety, dysphoria, anhedonia, and insomnia. 


Opioid Withdrawal 549 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Males with opioid withdrawal may experience piloerection, sweating, and spontaneous 
ejaculations while awake. Opioid withdrawal is distinct from opioid use disorder and 
does not necessarily occur in the presence of the drug-seeking behavior associated with 
opioid use disorder. Opioid withdrawal may occur in any individual after cessation of re- 
peated use of an opioid, whether in the setting of medical management of pain, during 
opioid agonist therapy for opioid use disorder, in the context of private recreational use, or 
following attempts to self-treat symptoms of mental disorders with opioids. 


Prevalence 


Among individuals from various clinical settings, opioid withdrawal occurred in 60% of 
individuals who had used heroin at least once in the prior 12 months. 


Development and Course 


Opioid withdrawal is typical in the course of an opioid use disorder. It can be part of an es- 
calating pattern in which an opioid is used to reduce withdrawal symptoms, in turn lead- 
ing to more withdrawal at a later time. For persons with an established opioid use 
disorder, withdrawal and attempts to relieve withdrawal are typical. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other withdrawal disorders. The anxiety and restlessness associated with opioid with- 
drawal resemble symptoms seen in sedative-hypnotic withdrawal. However, opioid with- 
drawal is also accompanied by rhinorrhea, lacrimation, and pupillary dilation, which are 
not seen in sedative-type withdrawal. 


Other substance intoxication. Dilated pupils are also seen in hallucinogen intoxication 
and stimulant intoxication. However, other signs or symptoms of opioid withdrawal, such 
as nausea, vomiting, diarrhea, abdominal cramps, rhinorrhea, and lacrimation, are not 
present. 


Other opioid-induced disorders. Opioid withdrawal is distinguished from the other 
opioid-induced disorders (e.g., opioid-induced depressive disorder, with onset during 
withdrawal) because the symptoms in these latter disorders are in excess of those usually 
associated with opioid withdrawal and meet full criteria for the relevant disorder. 


Other Opioid-Induced Disorders 


The following opioid-induced disorders are described in other chapters of the manual with 
disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance /medication-induced 
mental disorders in these chapters): opioid-induced depressive disorder (“Depressive Dis- 
orders”); opioid-induced anxiety disorder (“Anxiety Disorders”); opioid-induced sleep 
disorder (“Sleep-Wake Disorders”); and opioid-induced sexual dysfunction (“Sexual Dys- 
functions”). For opioid intoxication delirium and opioid withdrawal delirium, see the crite- 
ria and discussion of delirium in the chapter “Neurocognitive Disorders.” These opioid- 
induced disorders are diagnosed instead of opioid intoxication or opioid withdrawal only 
when the symptoms are sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. 


550 


Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Unspecified Opioid-Related Disorder 
292.9 (F 11.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an opioid- 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any specific opioid-related disorder or any of the disorders in the substance-related and 
addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


Sedative-, Hypnotic-, 
or Anxiolytic-Related Disorders 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Use Disorder 
Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Intoxication 
Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Withdrawal 

Other Sedative-, Hypnotic-, or Anxiolytic-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Sedative-, Hypnotic-, or Anxiolytic-Related Disorder 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Use Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A problematic pattern of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use leading to clinically signif- 
icant impairment or distress, as manifested by at least two of the following, occurring 
within a 12-month period: 


1. 


2. 


3. 


Sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics are often taken in larger amounts or over a lon- 
ger period than was intended. 

There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic use. 

A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain the sedative, hypnotic, 
or anxiolytic; use the sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic; or recover from its effects. 
Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic. 
Recurrent sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use resulting in a failure to fulfill major 
role obligations at work, school, or home (e.g., repeated absences from work or 
poor work performance related to sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use; sedative-, 
hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-related absences, suspensions, or expulsions from school; 
neglect of children or household). 

Continued sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use despite having persistent or re- 
current social or interpersonal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of 
sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics (e.g., arguments with a spouse about conse- 
quences of intoxication; physical fights). 

Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use. 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Use Disorder 551 


8. Recurrent sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use in situations in which it is physically 
hazardous (e.g., driving an automobile or operating a machine when impaired by 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use). 

9. Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use is continued despite knowledge of having a 
persistent or recurrent physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been 
caused or exacerbated by the sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic. 

10. Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 


a. Aneed for markedly increased amounts of the sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
to achieve intoxication or desired effect. 

b. Amarkedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of the sed- 
ative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic. 


Note: This criterion is not considered to be met for individuals taking sedatives, 
hypnotics, or anxiolytics under medical supervision. 
11. Withdrawal, as manifested by either of the following: 


a. The characteristic withdrawal syndrome for sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics 
(refer to Criteria A and B of the criteria set for sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
withdrawal, pp. 557-558). 

b. Sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics (or a closely related substance, such as al- 
cohol) are taken to relieve or avoid withdrawal symptoms. 


Note: This criterion is not considered to be met for individuals taking sedatives, 
hypnotics, or anxiolytics under medical supervision. 
Specify if: 
In early remission: After full criteria for sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder 
were previously met, none of the criteria for sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disor- 
der have been met for at least 3 months but for less than 12 months (with the exception 
that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the sedative, hypnotic, or 
anxiolytic,” may be met). 
In sustained remission: After full criteria for sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use dis- 
order were previously met, none of the criteria for sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use 
disorder have been met at any time during a period of 12 months or longer (with the 
exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic,” may be met). 
Specify if: 
In acontrolled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics is restricted. 


Coding based on current severity: Note for ICD-10-CM codes: If a sedative, hypnotic, or 
anxiolytic intoxication; sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal; or another sedative-, 
hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced mental disorder is also present, do not use the codes be- 
low for sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. Instead the comorbid sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic use disorder is indicated in the 4th character of the sedative-, hypnotic-, 
or anxiolytic-induced disorder (see the coding note for sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic in- 
toxication; sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal; or specific sedative-, hypnotic-, or 
anxiolytic-induced mental disorder). For example, if there is comorbid sedative-, hypnotic-, 
or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder and sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disor- 
der, only the sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder code is given 
with the 4th character indicating whether the comorbid sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use 
disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: F13.14 for mild sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use 
disorder with sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder or F13.24 for 
a moderate or severe sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder with sedative-, hypnotic-, 
or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder. 


552 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Specify current severity: 
305.40 (F13.10) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
304.10 (F13.20) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
304.10 (F13.20) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


Specifiers 

“In a controlled environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is 
both in remission and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled 
environment or in sustained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these 
environments are closely supervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, 
and locked hospital units. 


Diagnostic Features 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic substances include benzodiazepines, benzodiazepine- 
like drugs (e.g., zolpidem, zaleplon), carbamates (e.g., glutethimide, meprobamate), 
barbiturates (e.g., secobarbital), and barbiturate-like hypnotics (e.g., glutethimide, meth- 
aqualone). This class of substances includes all prescription sleeping medications and 
almost all prescription antianxiety medications. Nonbenzodiazepine antianxiety agents 
(e.g., buspirone, gepirone) are not included in this class because they do not appear to be 
associated with significant misuse. 

Like alcohol, these agents are brain depressants and can produce similar substance/ 
medication-induced and substance use disorders. Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic sub- 
stances are available both by prescription and illegally. Some individuals who obtain these 
substances by prescription will develop a sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, 
while others who misuse these substances or use them for intoxication will not develop a 
use disorder. In particular, sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics with rapid onset and/or 
short to intermediate lengths of action may be taken for intoxication purposes, although 
longer acting substances in this class may be taken for intoxication as well. 

Craving (Criterion A4), either while using or during a period of abstinence, is a typical 
feature of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. Misuse of substances from this 
class may occur on its own or in conjunction with use of other substances. For example, in- 
dividuals may use intoxicating doses of sedatives or benzodiazepines to “come down” 
from cocaine or amphetamines or use high doses of benzodiazepines in combination with 
methadone to “boost” its effects. 

Repeated absences or poor work performance, school absences, suspensions or expul- 
sions, and neglect of children or household (Criterion A5) may be related to sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic use disorder, as may the continued use of the substances despite 
arguments with a spouse about consequences of intoxication or despite physical fights 
(Criterion A6). Limiting contact with family or friends, avoiding work or school, or stop- 
ping participation in hobbies, sports, or games (Criterion A7) and recurrent sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic use when driving an automobile or operating a machine when im- 
paired by sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use (Criterion A8) are also seen in sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. 

Very significant levels of tolerance and withdrawal can develop to the sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic. There may be evidence of tolerance and withdrawal in the absence of 
a diagnosis of a sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder in an individual who has 
abruptly discontinued use of benzodiazepines that were taken for long periods of time at 
prescribed and therapeutic doses. In these cases, an additional diagnosis of sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic use disorder is made only if other criteria are met. That is, sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic medications may be prescribed for appropriate medical purposes, 
and depending on the dose regimen, these drugs may then produce tolerance and with- 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Use Disorder 553 


drawal. If these drugs are prescribed or recommended for appropriate medical purposes, 
and if they are used as prescribed, the resulting tolerance or withdrawal does not meet the 
criteria for diagnosing a substance use disorder. However, it is necessary to determine 
whether the drugs were appropriately prescribed and used (e.g., falsifying medical symp- 
toms to obtain the medication; using more medication than prescribed; obtaining the med- 
ication from several doctors without informing them of the others’ involvement). 

Given the unidimensional nature of the symptoms of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
use disorder, severity is based on the number of criteria endorsed. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder is often associated with other substance use dis- 
orders (e.g., alcohol, cannabis, opioid, stimulant use disorders). Sedatives are often used to al- 
leviate the unwanted effects of these other substances. With repeated use of the substance, 
tolerance develops to the sedative effects, and a progressively higher dose is used. However, 
tolerance to brain stem depressant effects develops much more slowly, and as the individual 
takes more substance to achieve euphoria or other desired effects, there may be a sudden onset 
of respiratory depression and hypotension, which may result in death. Intense or repeated 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication may be associated with severe depression that, 
although temporary, can lead to suicide attempt and completed suicide. 


Prevalence 


The 12-month prevalences of DSM-IV sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder are es- 
timated to be 0.3% among 12- to 17-year-olds and 0.2% among adults age 18 years and 
older. Rates of DSM-IV sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder are slightly greater 
among adult males (0.3%) than among adult females, but for 12- to 17-year-olds, the rate 
for females (0.4%) exceeds that for males (0.2%). The 12-month prevalence of DSM-IV 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder decreases as a function of age and is great- 
est among 18- to 29-year-olds (0.5%) and lowest among individuals 65 years and older 
(0.04%). 

Twelve-month prevalence of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder varies across 
racial/ethnic subgroups of the U.S. population. For 12- to 17-year-olds, rates are greatest 
among whites (0.3%) relative to African Americans (0.2%), Hispanics (0.2%), Native Amer- 
icans (0.1%), and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders (0.1%). Among adults, 12-month 
prevalence is greatest among Native Americans and Alaska Natives (0.8%), with rates of 
approximately 0.2% among African Americans, whites, and Hispanics and 0.1% among 
Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders. 


Development and Course 


The usual course of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder involves individuals in 
their teens or 20s who escalate their occasional use of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
agents to the point at which they develop problems that meet criteria for a diagnosis. This 
pattern may be especially likely among individuals who have other substance use disor- 
ders (e.g., alcohol, opioids, stimulants). An initial pattern of intermittent use socially (e.g., 
at parties) can lead to daily use and high levels of tolerance. Once this occurs, an increasing 
level of interpersonal difficulties, as well as increasingly severe episodes of cognitive dys- 
function and physiological withdrawal, can be expected. 

The second and less frequently observed clinical course begins with an individual who 
originally obtained the medication by prescription from a physician, usually for the treat- 
ment of anxiety, insomnia, or somatic complaints. As either tolerance or a need for higher 
doses of the medication develops, there is a gradual increase in the dose and frequency of 
self-administration. The individual is likely to continue to justify use on the basis of his or 
her original symptoms of anxiety or insomnia, but substance-seeking behavior becomes 


554 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


more prominent, and the individual may seek out multiple physicians to obtain sufficient 
supplies of the medication. Tolerance can reach high levels, and withdrawal (including 
seizures and withdrawal delirium) may occur. 

As with many substance use disorders, sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder gen- 
erally has an onset during adolescence or early adult life. There is an increased risk for misuse 
and problems from many psychoactive substances as individuals age. In particular, cognitive 
impairment increases as a side effect with age, and the metabolism of sedatives, hypnotics, or 
anxiolytics decreases with age among older individuals. Both acute and chronic toxic effects 
of these substances, especially effects on cognition, memory, and motor coordination, are 
likely to increase with age as a consequence of pharmacodynamic and pharmacokinetic age- 
related changes. Individuals with major neurocognitive disorder (dementia) are more likely 
to develop intoxication and impaired physiological functioning at lower doses. 

Deliberate intoxication to achieve a “high” is most likely to be observed in teenagers 
and individuals in their 20s. Problems associated with sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics 
are also seen in individuals in their 40s and older who escalate the dose of prescribed med- 
ications. In older individuals, intoxication can resemble a progressive dementia. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Impulsivity and novelty seeking are individual temperaments that re- 
late to the propensity to develop a substance use disorder but may themselves be geneti- 
cally determined. 


Environmental. Since sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics are all pharmaceuticals, a key 
risk factor relates to availability of the substances. In the United States, the historical pat- 
terns of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic misuse relate to the broad prescribing patterns. 
For instance, a marked decrease in prescription of barbiturates was associated with an in- 
crease in benzodiazepine prescribing. Peer factors may relate to genetic predisposition in 
terms of how individuals select their environment. Other individuals at heightened risk 
might include those with alcohol use disorder who may receive repeated prescriptions in 
response to their complaints of alcohol-related anxiety or insomnia. 


Genetic and physiological. As for other substance use disorders, the risk for sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder can be related to individual, family, peer, social, and 
environmental factors. Within these domains, genetic factors play a particularly important 
role both directly and indirectly. Overall, across development, genetic factors seem to play 
a larger role in the onset of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder as individuals age 
through puberty into adult life. 


Course modifiers. Early onset of use is associated with greater likelihood for develop- 
ing a sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There are marked variations in prescription patterns (and availability) of this class of sub- 
stances in different countries, which may lead to variations in prevalence of sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic use disorders. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Females may be at higher risk than males for prescription drug misuse of sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic substances. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Almost all sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic substances can be identified through labora- 
tory evaluations of urine or blood (the latter of which can quantify the amounts of these 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Use Disorder 555 


agents in the body). Urine tests are likely to remain positive for up to approximately 1 week 
after the use of long-acting substances, such as diazepam or flurazepam. 


Functional Consequences of 
Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Use Disorder 


The social and interpersonal consequences of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder 
mimic those of alcohol in terms of the potential for disinhibited behavior. Accidents, interper- 
sonal difficulties (such as arguments or fights), and interference with work or school perfor- 
mance are all common outcomes. Physical examination is likely to reveal evidence of a mild 
decrease in most aspects of autonomic nervous system functioning, including a slower pulse, 
a slightly decreased respiratory rate, and a slight drop in blood pressure (most likely to occur 
with postural changes). At high doses, sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic substances can be le- 
thal, particularly when mixed with alcohol, although the lethal dosage varies considerably 
among the specific substances. Overdoses may be associated with a deterioration in vital signs 
that signals an impending medical emergency (e.g., respiratory arrest from barbiturates). 
There may be consequences of trauma (e.g., internal bleeding or a subdural hematoma) from 
accidents that occur while intoxicated. Intravenous use of these substances can result in med- 
ical complications related to the use of contaminated needles (e.g., hepatitis and HIV). 

Acute intoxication can result in accidental injuries and automobile accidents. For elderly 
individuals, even short-term use of these sedating medications at prescribed doses can be as- 
sociated with an increased risk for cognitive problems and falls. The disinhibiting effects of 
these agents, like alcohol, may potentially contribute to overly aggressive behavior, with sub- 
sequent interpersonal and legal problems. Accidental or deliberate overdoses, similar to those 
observed for alcohol use disorder or repeated alcohol intoxication, can occur. In contrast to 
their wide margin of safety when used alone, benzodiazepines taken in combination with al- 
cohol can be particularly dangerous, and accidental overdoses are reported commonly. Acci- 
dental overdoses have also been reported in individuals who deliberately misuse barbiturates 
and other nonbenzodiazepine sedatives (e.g., methaqualone), but since these agents are much 
less available than the benzodiazepines, the frequency of overdosing is low in most settings. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders or medical conditions. Individuals with sedative-, hypnotic-, 
or anxiolytic-induced disorders may present with symptoms (e.g., anxiety) that resemble 
primary mental disorders (e.g., generalized anxiety disorder vs. sedative-, hypnotic-, or 
anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder, with onset during withdrawal). The slurred speech, 
incoordination, and other associated features characteristic of sedative, hypnotic, or anx- 
iolytic intoxication could be the result of another medical condition (e.g., multiple sclero- 
sis) or of a prior head trauma (e.g., a subdural hematoma). 


Alcohol use disorder. Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder must be differenti- 
ated from alcohol use disorder. 


Clinically appropriate use of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic medications. Individuals 
may continue to take benzodiazepine medication according to a physician’s direction for a 
legitimate medical indication over extended periods of time. Even if physiological signs of 
tolerance or withdrawal are manifested, many of these individuals do not develop symp- 
toms that meet the criteria for sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder because they 
are not preoccupied with obtaining the substance and its use does not interfere with their 
performance of usual social or occupational roles. 


Comorbidity 


Nonmedical use of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic agents is associated with alcohol use 
disorder, tobacco use disorder, and, generally, illicit drug use. There may also be an over- 


556 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


lap between sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder and antisocial personality dis- 
order; depressive, bipolar, and anxiety disorders; and other substance use disorders, such 
as alcohol use disorder and illicit drug use disorders. Antisocial behavior and antisocial 
personality disorder are especially associated with sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use 
disorder when the substances are obtained illegally. 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Intoxication 
Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recent use of a sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic. 

B. Clinically significant maladaptive behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., inappro- 
priate sexual or aggressive behavior, mood lability, impaired judgment) that developed 
during, or shortly after, sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use. 

C. One (or more) of the following signs or symptoms developing during, or shortly after, 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use: 


Slurred speech. 

Incoordination. 

Unsteady gait. 

Nystagmus. 

Impairment in cognition (e.g., attention, memory). 
6. Stupor or coma. 


Oe ONS 


D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another sub- 
stance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.89. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
there is a comorbid sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. If a mild sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F13.129, and if a mod- 
erate or severe sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM 
code is F13.229. If there is no comorbid sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, then 
the ICD-10-CM code is F13.929. 


Note: For information on Development and Course; Risk and Prognostic Factors; Culture- 
Related Diagnostic Issues; Diagnostic Markers; Functional Consequences of Sedative, 
Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Intoxication; and Comorbidity, see the corresponding sections in 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication is the presence of clini- 
cally significant maladaptive behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., inappropriate sexual 
or aggressive behavior, mood lability, impaired judgment, impaired social or occupational 
functioning) that develop during, or shortly after, use of a sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
(Criteria A and B). As with other brain depressants, such as alcohol, these behaviors may be ac- 
companied by slurred speech, incoordination (at levels that can interfere with driving abilities 
and with performing usual activities to the point of causing falls or automobile accidents), an 
unsteady gait, nystagmus, impairment in cognition (e.g., attentional or memory problems), 
and stupor or coma (Criterion C). Memory impairment is a prominent feature of sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic intoxication and is most often characterized by an anterograde amnesia that 
resembles “alcoholic blackouts,” which can be disturbing to the individual. The symptoms 
must not be attributable to another medical condition and are not better explained by another 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Withdrawal 557 


mental disorder (Criterion D). Intoxication may occur in individuals who are receiving these 
substances by prescription, are borrowing the medication from friends or relatives, or are de- 
liberately taking the substance to achieve intoxication. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Associated features include taking more medication than prescribed, taking multiple dif- 
ferent medications, or mixing sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic agents with alcohol, which 
can markedly increase the effects of these agents. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication in the general population 
is unclear. However, it is probable that most nonmedical users of sedatives, hypnotics, or 
anxiolytics would at some time have signs or symptoms that meet criteria for sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication; if so, then the prevalence of nonmedical sedative, 
hypnotic, or anxiolytic use in the general population may be similar to the prevalence of 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication. For example, tranquilizers are used non- 
medically by 2.2% of Americans older than 12 years. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Alcohol use disorders. Since the clinical presentations may be identical, distinguishing sed- 
ative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication from alcohol use disorders requires evidence for re- 
cent ingestion of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic medications by self-report, informant report, 
or toxicological testing. Many individuals who misuse sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics may 
also misuse alcohol and other substances, and so multiple intoxication diagnoses are possible. 


Alcohol intoxication. Alcohol intoxication may be distinguished from sedative, hypnotic, 
or anxiolytic intoxication by the smell of alcohol on the breath. Otherwise, the features of 
the two disorders may be similar. 


Other sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced disorders. Sedative, hypnotic, or anx- 
iolytic intoxication is distinguished from the other sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic- 
induced disorders (e.g., sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder, with 
onset during withdrawal) because the symptoms in the latter disorders predominate in 
the clinical presentation and are severe enough to warrant clinical attention. 


Neurocognitive disorders. In situations of cognitive impairment, traumatic brain in- 
jury, and delirium from other causes, sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics may be intoxi- 
cating at quite low dosages. The differential diagnosis in these complex settings is based 
on the predominant syndrome. An additional diagnosis of sedative, hypnotic, or anxio- 
lytic intoxication may be appropriate even if the substance has been ingested at a low dos- 
age in the setting of these other (or similar) co-occurring conditions. 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Withdrawal 
Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Cessation of (or reduction in) sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use that has been pro- 
longed. 

B. Two (or more) of the following, developing within several hours to a few days after the ces- 
sation of (or reduction in) sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use described in Criterion A: 


1. Autonomic hyperactivity (e.g., sweating or pulse rate greater than 100 bpm). 
2. Hand tremor. 


558 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Insomnia. 

Nausea or vomiting. 

Transient visual, tactile, or auditory hallucinations or illusions. 
Psychomotor agitation. 

Anxiety. 

Grand mal seizures. 


ONOaAR 


C. The signs or symptoms in Criterion B cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication or withdrawal from 
another substance. 


Specify if: 
With perceptual disturbances: This specifier may be noted when hallucinations with in- 
tact reality testing or auditory, visual, or tactile illusions occur in the absence of a delirium. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.0. The ICD-10-CM code for sedative, hypnotic, 
or anxiolytic withdrawal depends on whether or not there is a comorbid moderate or se- 
vere sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder and whether or not there are perceptual 
disturbances. For sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal without perceptual distur- 
bances, the ICD-10-CM code is F13.239. For sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal 
with perceptual disturbances, the ICD-10-CM code is F13.232. Note that the ICD-10-CM 
codes indicate the comorbid presence of a moderate or severe sedative, hypnotic, or anx- 
iolytic use disorder, reflecting the fact that sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal can 
only occur in the presence of a moderate or severe sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use 
disorder. It is not permissible to code a comorbid mild sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use 
disorder with sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal. 


Note: For information on Development and Course; Risk and Prognostic Factors; Culture- 
Related Diagnostic Issues; Functional Consequences of Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic 
Withdrawal; and Comorbidity, see the corresponding sections in sedative, hypnotic, or 
anxiolytic use disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal is the presence of a char- 
acteristic syndrome that develops after a marked decrease in or cessation of intake after several 
weeks or more of regular use (Criteria A and B). This withdrawal syndrome is characterized by 
two or more symptoms (similar to alcohol withdrawal) that include autonomic hyperactivity 
(e.g., increases in heart rate, respiratory rate, blood pressure, or body temperature, along with 
sweating); a tremor of the hands; insomnia; nausea, sometimes accompanied by vomiting; 
anxiety; and psychomotor agitation. A grand mal seizure may occur in perhaps as many as 
20%-30% of individuals undergoing untreated withdrawal from these substances. In severe 
withdrawal, visual, tactile, or auditory hallucinations or illusions can occur but are usually in 
the context of a delirium. If the individual’s reality testing is intact (i.e., he or she knows the 
substance is causing the hallucinations) and the illusions occur in a clear sensorium, the spec- 
ifier “with perceptual disturbances” can be noted. When hallucinations occur in the absence of 
intact reality testing, a diagnosis of substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder should 
be considered. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, or other important areas of functioning (Criterion C). The symptoms must not be 
attributable to another medical condition and are not better explained by another mental dis- 
order (e.g., alcohol withdrawal or generalized anxiety disorder) (Criterion D). Relief of with- 
drawal symptoms with administration of any sedative-hypnotic agent would support a 
diagnosis of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal. 


Sedative, Hypnotic, or Anxiolytic Withdrawal 559 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The timing and severity of the withdrawal syndrome will differ depending on the specific 
substance and its pharmacokinetics and pharmacodynamics. For example, withdrawal 
from shorter-acting substances that are rapidly absorbed and that have no active metabo- 
lites (e.g., triazolam) can begin within hours after the substance is stopped; withdrawal 
from substances with long-acting metabolites (e.g., diazepam) may not begin for 1-2 days 
or longer. The withdrawal syndrome produced by substances in this class may be charac- 
terized by the development of a delirium that can be life-threatening. There may be evi- 
dence of tolerance and withdrawal in the absence of a diagnosis of a substance use 
disorder in an individual who has abruptly discontinued benzodiazepines that were taken 
for long periods of time at prescribed and therapeutic doses. However, ICD-10-CM codes 
only allow a diagnosis of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal in the presence of 
comorbid moderate to severe sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder. 

The time course of the withdrawal syndrome is generally predicted by the half-life of 
the substance. Medications whose actions typically last about 10 hours or less (e.g., loraz- 
epam, oxazepam, temazepam) produce withdrawal symptoms within 6-8 hours of de- 
creasing blood levels that peak in intensity on the second day and improve markedly by 
the fourth or fifth day. For substances with longer half-lives (e.g., diazepam), symptoms 
may not develop for more than 1 week, peak in intensity during the second week, and de- 
crease markedly during the third or fourth week. There may be additional longer-term 
symptoms at a much lower level of intensity that persist for several months. 

The longer the substance has been taken and the higher the dosages used, the more likely 
it is that there will be severe withdrawal. However, withdrawal has been reported with as little 
as 15 mg of diazepam (or its equivalent in other benzodiazepines) when taken daily for several 
months. Doses of approximately 40 mg of diazepam (or its equivalent) daily are more likely to 
produce clinically relevant withdrawal symptoms, and even higher doses (e.g., 100 mg of di- 
azepam) are more likely to be followed by withdrawal seizures or delirium. Sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic withdrawal delirium is characterized by disturbances in consciousness and 
cognition, with visual, tactile, or auditory hallucinations. When present, sedative, hypnotic, or 
anxiolytic withdrawal delirium should be diagnosed instead of withdrawal. 


Prevalence 
The prevalence of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal is unclear. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Seizures and autonomic instability in the setting of a history of prolonged exposure to sed- 
ative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic medications suggest a high likelihood of sedative, hypnotic, 
or anxiolytic withdrawal. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other medical disorders. The symptoms of sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic with- 
drawal may be mimicked by other medical conditions (e.g., hypoglycemia, diabetic keto- 
acidosis). If seizures are a feature of the sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal, the 
differential diagnosis includes the various causes of seizures (e.g., infections, head injury, 
poisonings). 


Essential tremor. Essential tremor, a disorder that frequently runs in families, may 
erroneously suggest the tremulousness associated with sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
withdrawal. 


Alcohol withdrawal. Alcohol withdrawal produces a syndrome very similar to that of 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal. 


560 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Other sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced disorders. Sedative, hypnotic, or anx- 
iolytic withdrawal is distinguished from the other sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic- 
induced disorders (e.g., sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder, with 
onset during withdrawal) because the symptoms in the latter disorders predominate in 
the clinical presentation and are severe enough to warrant clinical attention. 


Anxiety disorders. Recurrence or worsening of an underlying anxiety disorder pro- 
duces a syndrome similar to sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal. Withdrawal 
would be suspected with an abrupt reduction in the dosage of a sedative, hypnotic, or anx- 
iolytic medication. When a taper is under way, distinguishing the withdrawal syndrome 
from the underlying anxiety disorder can be difficult. As with alcohol, lingering with- 
drawal symptoms (e.g., anxiety, moodiness, and trouble sleeping) can be mistaken for 
non-substance/medication-induced anxiety or depressive disorders (e.g., generalized 
anxiety disorder). 


Other Sedative-, Hypnotic-, 
or Anxiolytic-Induced Disorders 


The following sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced disorders are described in other 
chapters of the manual with disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the sub- 
stance /medication-induced mental disorders in these chapters): sedative-, hypnotic-, or 
anxiolytic-induced psychotic disorder (“Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic 
Disorders”); sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced bipolar disorder (“Bipolar and Re- 
lated Disorders”); sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder (“De- 
pressive Disorders”); sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder 
(“Anxiety Disorders”); sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sleep disorder (“Sleep- 
Wake Disorders”); sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sexual dysfunction (“Sex- 
ual Dysfunctions”); and sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced major or mild neuro- 
cognitive disorder (“Neurocognitive Disorders”). For sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 
intoxication delirium and sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal delirium, see the 
criteria and discussion of delirium in the chapter “Neurocognitive Disorders.” These sed- 
ative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced disorders are diagnosed instead of sedative, hyp- 
notic, or anxiolytic intoxication or sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal only when 
the symptoms are sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Unspecified Sedative-, Hypnotic-, 
or Anxiolytic-Related Disorder 


292.9 (F13.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a sedative-, 
hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do 
not meet the full criteria for any specific sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-related disorder 
or any of the disorders in the substance-related and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


Stimulant Use Disorder 561 


Stimulant-Related Disorders 


Stimulant Use Disorder 
Stimulant Intoxication 
Stimulant Withdrawal 

Other Stimulant-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Stimulant-Related Disorder 


Stimulant Use Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A pattern of amphetamine-type substance, cocaine, or other stimulant use leading to 
clinically significant impairment or distress, as manifested by at least two of the follow- 
ing, occurring within a 12-month period: 


1. 


2. 
3. 


0 


10. 


11. 


The stimulant is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was in- 
tended. 

There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control stimulant use. 
A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain the stimulant, use the 
stimulant, or recover from its effects. 

Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the stimulant. 

Recurrent stimulant use resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at work, 
school, or home. 

Continued stimulant use despite having persistent or recurrent social or interper- 
sonal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of the stimulant. 

Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of stimulant use. 

Recurrent stimulant use in situations in which it is physically hazardous. 

Stimulant use is continued despite knowledge of having a persistent or recurrent 
physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or exacerbated 
by the stimulant. 

Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 


a. Aneed for markedly increased amounts of the stimulant to achieve intoxication 
or desired effect. 

b. A markedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of the 
stimulant. 


Note: This criterion is not considered to be met for those taking stimulant medica- 

tions solely under appropriate medical supervision, such as medications for atten- 

tion-deficit/hyperactivity disorder or narcolepsy. 

Withdrawal, as manifested by either of the following: 

a. The characteristic withdrawal syndrome for the stimulant (refer to Criteria A and 
B of the criteria set for stimulant withdrawal, p. 569). 


b. The stimulant (or a closely related substance) is taken to relieve or avoid with- 
drawal symptoms. 


562 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Note: This criterion is not considered to be met for those taking stimulant medica- 
tions solely under appropriate medical supervision, such as medications for atten- 
tion-deficit/hyperactivity disorder or narcolepsy. 
Specify if: 
In early remission: After full criteria for stimulant use disorder were previously met, 
none of the criteria for stimulant use disorder have been met for at least 3 months but 
for less than 12 months (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong de- 
sire or urge to use the stimulant,” may be met). 
In sustained remission: After full criteria for stimulant use disorder were previously 
met, none of the criteria for stimulant use disorder have been met at any time during a 
period of 12 months or longer (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a 
strong desire or urge to use the stimulant,” may be met). 


Specity if: 
In a controlled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to stimulants is restricted. 


Coding based on current severity: Note for ICD-10-CM codes: If an amphetamine in- 
toxication, amphetamine withdrawal, or another amphetamine-induced mental disorder is 
also present, do not use the codes below for amphetamine use disorder. Instead, the co- 
morbid amphetamine use disorder is indicated in the 4th character of the amphetamine- 
induced disorder code (see the coding note for amphetamine intoxication, amphetamine 
withdrawal, or a specific amphetamine-induced mental disorder). For example, if there is 
comorbid amphetamine-type or other stimulant-induced depressive disorder and amphet- 
amine-type or other stimulant use disorder, only the amphetamine-type or other stimulant- 
induced depressive disorder code is given, with the 4th character indicating whether the 
comorbid amphetamine-type or other stimulant use disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: 
F15.14 for mild amphetamine-type or other stimulant use disorder with amphetamine-type 
or other stimulant-induced depressive disorder or F15.24 for a moderate or severe am- 
phetamine-type or other stimulant use disorder with amphetamine-type or other stimulant- 
induced depressive disorder. Similarly, if there is comorbid cocaine-induced depressive 
disorder and cocaine use disorder, only the cocaine-induced depressive disorder code is 
given, with the 4th character indicating whether the comorbid cocaine use disorder is mild, 
moderate, or severe: F14.14 for mild cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced depressive 
disorder or F14.24 for a moderate or severe cocaine use disorder with cocaine-induced 
depressive disorder. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
305.70 (F15.10) Amphetamine-type substance 
305.60 (F14.10) Cocaine 
305.70 (F15.10) Other or unspecified stimulant 
Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
304.40 (F15.20) Amphetamine-type substance 
304.20 (F14.20) Cocaine 
304.40 (F15.20) Other or unspecified stimulant 
Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 
304.40 (F15.20) Amphetamine-type substance 
304.20 (F14.20) Cocaine 
304.40 (F15.20) Other or unspecified stimulant 


Stimulant Use Disorder 563 


Specifiers 

“Ina controlled environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is 
both in remission and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled 
environment or in sustained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these 
environments are closely supervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, 
and locked hospital units. 


Diagnostic Features 


The amphetamine and amphetamine-type stimulants include substances with a substi- 
tuted-phenylethylamine structure, such as amphetamine, dextroamphetamine, and meth- 
amphetamine. Also included are those substances that are structurally different but have 
similar effects, such as methylphenidate. These substances are usually taken orally or in- 
travenously, although methamphetamine is also taken by the nasal route. In addition to 
the synthetic amphetamine-type compounds, there are naturally occurring, plant-derived 
stimulants such as khat. Amphetamines and other stimulants may be obtained by prescrip- 
tion for the treatment of obesity, attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, and narcolepsy. 
Consequently, prescribed stimulants may be diverted into the illegal market. The effects of 
amphetamines and amphetamine-like drugs are similar to those of cocaine, such that the 
criteria for stimulant use disorder are presented here as a single disorder with the ability to 
specify the particular stimulant used by the individual. Cocaine may be consumed in sev- 
eral preparations (e.g., coca leaves, coca paste, cocaine hydrochloride, and cocaine alka- 
loids such as freebase and crack) that differ in potency because of varying levels of purity 
and speed of onset. However, in all forms of the substance, cocaine is the active ingredient. 
Cocaine hydrochloride powder is usually “snorted” through the nostrils or dissolved in 
water and injected intravenously. 

Individuals exposed to amphetamine-type stimulants or cocaine can develop stimu- 
lant use disorder as rapidly as 1 week, although the onset is not always this rapid. Re- 
gardless of the route of administration, tolerance occurs with repeated use. Withdrawal 
symptoms, particularly hypersomnia, increased appetite, and dysphoria, can occur and 
can enhance craving. Most individuals with stimulant use disorder have experienced tol- 
erance or withdrawal. 

Use patterns and course are similar for disorders involving amphetamine-type stimu- 
lants and cocaine, as both substances are potent central nervous system stimulants with 
similar psychoactive and sympathomimetic effects. Amphetamine-type stimulants are 
longer acting than cocaine and thus are used fewer times per day. Usage may be chronic or 
episodic, with binges punctuated by brief non-use periods. Aggressive or violent behavior 
is common when high doses are smoked, ingested, or administered intravenously. Intense 
temporary anxiety resembling panic disorder or generalized anxiety disorder, as well as 
paranoid ideation and psychotic episodes that resemble schizophrenia, is seen with high- 
dose use. 

Withdrawal states are associated with temporary but intense depressive symptoms that 
can resemble a major depressive episode; the depressive symptoms usually resolve within 
1 week. Tolerance to amphetamine-type stimulants develops and leads to escalation of the 
dose. Conversely, some users of amphetamine-type stimulants develop sensitization, 
characterized by enhanced effects. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


When injected or smoked, stimulants typically produce an instant feeling of well-being, 
confidence, and euphoria. Dramatic behavioral changes can rapidly develop with stimu- 
lant use disorder. Chaotic behavior, social isolation, aggressive behavior, and sexual dys- 
function can result from long-term stimulant use disorder. 


564 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Individuals with acute intoxication may present with rambling speech, headache, tran- 
sient ideas of reference, and tinnitus. There may be paranoid ideation, auditory halluci- 
nations in a clear sensorium, and tactile hallucinations, which the individual usually 
recognizes as drug effects. Threats or acting out of aggressive behavior may occur. Depres- 
sion, suicidal ideation, irritability, anhedonia, emotional lability, or disturbances in atten- 
tion and concentration commonly occur during withdrawal. Mental disturbances associated 
with cocaine use usually resolve hours to days after cessation of use but can persist for 
1 month. Physiological changes during stimulant withdrawal are opposite to those of the 
intoxication phase, sometimes including bradycardia. Temporary depressive symptoms 
may meet symptomatic and duration criteria for major depressive episode. Histories con- 
sistent with repeated panic attacks, social anxiety disorder (social phobia)—like behavior, 
and generalized anxiety—like syndromes are common, as are eating disorders. One ex- 
treme instance of stimulant toxicity is stimulant-induced psychotic disorder, a disorder 
that resembles schizophrenia, with delusions and hallucinations. 

Individuals with stimulant use disorder often develop conditioned responses to drug- 
related stimuli (e.g., craving on seeing any white powderlike substance). These responses 
contribute to relapse, are difficult to extinguish, and persist after detoxification. 

Depressive symptoms with suicidal ideation or behavior can occur and are generally 
the most serious problems seen during stimulant withdrawal. 


Prevalence 


Stimulant use disorder: amphetamine-type stimulants. Estimated 12-month prevalence 
of amphetamine-type stimulant use disorder in the United States is 0.2% among 12- to 17- 
year-olds and 0.2% among individuals 18 years and older. Rates are similar among adult 
males and females (0.2%), but among 12- to 17-year-olds, the rate for females (0.3%) is 
greater than that for males (0.1%). Intravenous stimulant use has a male-to-female ratio of 
3:1 or 4:1, but rates are more balanced among non-injecting users, with males representing 
54% of primary treatment admissions. Twelve-month prevalence is greater among 18- to 
29-year-olds (0.4%) compared with 45- to 64-year-olds (0.1%). For 12- to 17-year-olds, rates 
are highest among whites and African Americans (0.3%) compared with Hispanics (0.1%) 
and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders (0.01%), with amphetamine-type stimulant use 
disorder virtually absent among Native Americans. Among adults, rates are highest among 
Native Americans and Alaska Natives (0.6%) compared with whites (0.2%) and Hispanics 
(0.2%), with amphetamine-type stimulant use disorder virtually absent among African 
Americans and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders. Past-year nonprescribed use of 
prescription stimulants occurred among 5%-9% of children through high school, with 
5%-35% of college-age persons reporting past-year use. 


Stimulant use disorder: cocaine. Estimated 12-month prevalence of cocaine use disorder 
in the United States is 0.2% among 12- to 17-year-olds and 0.3% among individuals 18 years 
and older. Rates are higher among males (0.4%) than among females (0.1%). Rates are 
highest among 18- to 29-year-olds (0.6%) and lowest among 45- to 64-year-olds (0.1%). Among 
adults, rates are greater among Native Americans (0.8%) compared with African Ameri- 
cans (0.4%), Hispanics (0.3%), whites (0.2%), and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders 
(0.1%). In contrast, for 12- to 17-year-olds, rates are similar among Hispanics (0.2%), whites 
(0.2%), and Asian Americans and Pacific Islanders (0.2%); and lower among African Amer- 
icans (0.02%); with cocaine use disorder virtually absent among Native Americans and 
Alaska Natives. 


Development and Course 


Stimulant use disorders occur throughout all levels of society and are more common among 
individuals ages 12-25 years compared with individuals 26 years and older. First regular use 


Stimulant Use Disorder 565 


among individuals in treatment occurs, on average, at approximately age 23 years. For pri- 
mary methamphetamine-primary treatment admissions, the average age is 31 years. 

Some individuals begin stimulant use to control weight or to improve performance in 
school, work, or athletics. This includes obtaining medications such as methylphenidate or 
amphetamine salts prescribed to others for the treatment of attention-deficit/hyperac- 
tivity disorder. Stimulant use disorder can develop rapidly with intravenous or smoked 
administration; among primary admissions for amphetamine-type stimulant use, 66% re- 
ported smoking, 18% reported injecting, and 10% reported snorting. 

Patterns of stimulant administration include episodic or daily (or almost daily) use. 
Episodic use tends to be separated by 2 or more days of non-use (e.g., intense use over a 
weekend or on one or more weekdays). “Binges” involve continuous high-dose use over 
hours or days and are often associated with physical dependence. Binges usually termi- 
nate only when stimulant supplies are depleted or exhaustion ensues. Chronic daily use 
may involve high or low doses, often with an increase in dose over time. 

Stimulant smoking and intravenous use are associated with rapid progression to se- 
vere-level stimulant use disorder, often occurring over weeks to months. Intranasal use of 
cocaine and oral use of amphetamine-type stimulants result in more gradual progression 
occurring over months to years. With continuing use, there is a diminution of pleasurable 
effects due to tolerance and an increase in dysphoric effects. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Comorbid bipolar disorder, schizophrenia, antisocial personality disor- 
der, and other substance use disorders are risk factors for developing stimulant use disorder 
and for relapse to cocaine use in treatment samples. Also, impulsivity and similar personality 
traits may affect treatment outcomes. Childhood conduct disorder and adult antisocial per- 
sonality disorder are associated with the later development of stimulant-related disorders. 


Environmental. Predictors of cocaine use among teenagers include prenatal cocaine ex- 
posure, postnatal cocaine use by parents, and exposure to community violence during 
childhood. For youths, especially females, risk factors include living in an unstable home 
environment, having a psychiatric condition, and associating with dealers and users. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Stimulant use—attendant disorders affect all racial/ethnic, socioeconomic, age, and gender 
groups. Diagnostic issues may be related to societal consequences (e.g., arrest, school sus- 
pensions, employment suspension). Despite small variations, cocaine and other stimulant 
use disorder diagnostic criteria perform equally across gender and race/ethnicity groups. 

Chronic use of cocaine impairs cardiac left ventricular function in African Americans. 
Approximately 66% of individuals admitted for primary methamphetamine /amphet- 
amine-related disorders are non-Hispanic white, followed by 21% of Hispanic origin, 3% 
Asian and Pacific Islander, and 3% non-Hispanic black. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Benzoylecgonine, a metabolite of cocaine, typically remains in the urine for 1-3 days after 
a single dose and may be present for 7-12 days in individuals using repeated high doses. 
Mildly elevated liver function tests can be present in cocaine injectors or users with con- 
comitant alcohol use. There are no neurobiological markers of diagnostic utility. Discon- 
tinuation of chronic cocaine use may be associated with electroencephalographic changes, 
suggesting persistent abnormalities; alterations in secretion patterns of prolactin; and 
downregulation of dopamine receptors. 

Short-half-life amphetamine-type stimulants (MDMA [3,4-methylenedioxy-N-methyl- 
amphetamine], methamphetamine) can be detected for 1-3 days, and possibly up to 4 days 


566 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


depending on dosage and metabolism. Hair samples can be used to detect presence of am- 
phetamine-type stimulants for up to 90 days. Other laboratory findings, as well as physical 
findings and other medical conditions (e.g., weight loss, malnutrition; poor hygiene), are 
similar for both cocaine and amphetamine-type stimulant use disorder. 


Functional Consequences of Stimulant Use Disorder 


Various medical conditions may occur depending on the route of administration. Intrana- 
sal users often develop sinusitis, irritation, bleeding of the nasal mucosa, and a perforated 
nasal septum. Individuals who smoke the drugs are at increased risk for respiratory prob- 
lems (e.g., coughing, bronchitis, and pneumonitis). Injectors have puncture marks and 
“tracks,” most commonly on their forearms. Risk of HIV infection increases with frequent 
intravenous injections and unsafe sexual activity. Other sexually transmitted diseases, 
hepatitis, and tuberculosis and other lung infections are also seen. Weight loss and mal- 
nutrition are common. 

Chest pain may be a common symptom during stimulant intoxication. Myocardial in- 
farction, palpitations and arrhythmias, sudden death from respiratory or cardiac arrest, 
and stroke have been associated with stimulant use among young and otherwise healthy 
individuals. Seizures can occur with stimulant use. Phneumothorax can result from per- 
forming Valsalva-like maneuvers done to better absorb inhaled smoke. Traumatic injuries 
due to violent behavior are common among individuals trafficking drugs. Cocaine use is 
associated with irregularities in placental blood flow, abruptio placentae, premature labor 
and delivery, and an increased prevalence of infants with very low birth weights. 

Individuals with stimulant use disorder may become involved in theft, prostitution, or 
drug dealing in order to acquire drugs or money for drugs. 

Neurocognitive impairment is common among methamphetamine users. Oral health 
problems include “meth mouth” with gum disease, tooth decay, and mouth sores related 
to the toxic effects of smoking the drug and to bruxism while intoxicated. Adverse pulmo- 
nary effects appear to be less common for amphetamine-type stimulants because they are 
smoked fewer times per day. Emergency department visits are common for stimulant-re- 
lated mental disorder symptoms, injury, skin infections, and dental pathology. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Primary mental disorders. Stimulant-induced disorders may resemble primary mental 
disorders (e.g., major depressive disorder) (for discussion of this differential diagnosis, see 
“Stimulant Withdrawal”). The mental disturbances resulting from the effects of stimulants 
should be distinguished from the symptoms of schizophrenia; depressive and bipolar dis- 
orders; generalized anxiety disorder; and panic disorder. 


Phencyclidine intoxication. Intoxication with phencyclidine (“PCP” or “angel dust”) or 
synthetic “designer drugs” such as mephedrone (known by different names, including 
“bath salts”) may cause a similar clinical picture and can only be distinguished from stim- 
ulant intoxication by the presence of cocaine or amphetamine-type substance metabolites 
in a urine or plasma sample. 

Stimulant intoxication and withdrawal. Stimulant intoxication and withdrawal are dis- 
tinguished from the other stimulant-induced disorders (e.g., anxiety disorder, with onset 
during intoxication) because the symptoms in the latter disorders predominate the clinical 
presentation and are severe enough to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Comorbidity 


Stimulant-related disorders often co-occur with other substance use disorders, especially 
those involving substances with sedative properties, which are often taken to reduce in- 


Stimulant Intoxication 567 


somnia, nervousness, and other unpleasant side effects. Cocaine users often use alcohol, 
while amphetamine-type stimulant users often use cannabis. Stimulant use disorder may 
be associated with posttraumatic stress disorder, antisocial personality disorder, atten- 
tion-deficit hyperactivity disorder, and gambling disorder. Cardiopulmonary problems 
are often present in individuals seeking treatment for cocaine-related problems, with chest 
pain being the most common. Medical problems occur in response to adulterants used as 
“cutting” agents. Cocaine users who ingest cocaine cut with levamisole, an antimicrobial 
and veterinary medication, may experience agranulocytosis and febrile neutropenia. 


Stimulant Intoxication 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Recent use of an amphetamine-type substance, cocaine, or other stimulant. 

B. Clinically significant problematic behavioral or psychological changes (e.g., euphoria 
or affective blunting; changes in sociability; hypervigilance; interpersonal sensitivity; 
anxiety, tension, or anger; stereotyped behaviors; impaired judgment) that developed 
during, or shortly after, use of a stimulant. 

C. Two (or more) of the following signs or symptoms, developing during, or shortly after, 
stimulant use: 

Tachycardia or bradycardia. 

Pupillary dilation. 

Elevated or lowered blood pressure. 

Perspiration or chills. 

Nausea or vomiting. 

Evidence of weight loss. 

Psychomotor agitation or retardation. 

Muscular weakness, respiratory depression, chest pain, or cardiac arrhythmias. 

Confusion, seizures, dyskinesias, dystonias, or coma. 


ONO Ol RON 


© 


D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another sub- 
stance. 


Specify the specific intoxicant (i.e., amphetamine-type substance, cocaine, or other 
stimulant). 
Specify if: 
With perceptual disturbances: This specifier may be noted when hallucinations with 
intact reality testing or auditory, visual, or tactile illusions occur in the absence of a de- 
lirium. 
Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.89. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
the stimulant is an amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant; whether there is a comorbid 
amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant use disorder; and whether or not there are per- 
ceptual disturbances. 


For amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant intoxication, without perceptual dis- 
turbances: If a mild amphetamine or other stimulant use disorder is comorbid, the ICD- 
10-CM code is F15.129, and if a moderate or severe amphetamine or other stimulant use 
disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F15.229. If there is no comorbid amphet- 
amine or other stimulant use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F15.929. Similarly, if 
a mild cocaine use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F14.129, and if a mod- 
erate or severe cocaine use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F14.229. lf 
there is no comorbid cocaine use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F14.929. 


568 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


For amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant intoxication, with perceptual distur- 
bances: If a mild amphetamine or other stimulant use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10- 
CM code is F15.122, and if a moderate or severe amphetamine or other stimulant use 
disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F15.222. If there is no comorbid amphet- 
amine or other stimulant use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F15.922. Similarly, if 
a mild cocaine use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F14.122, and if a mod- 
erate or severe cocaine use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F14.222. lf 
there is no comorbid cocaine use disorder, then the ICD-10-CM code is F14.922. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of stimulant intoxication, related to amphetamine-type stimulants 
and cocaine, is the presence of clinically significant behavioral or psychological changes 
that develop during, or shortly after, use of stimulants (Criteria A and B). Auditory hallu- 
cinations may be prominent, as may paranoid ideation, and these symptoms must be dis- 
tinguished from an independent psychotic disorder such as schizophrenia. Stimulant 
intoxication usually begins with a “high” feeling and includes one or more of the follow- 
ing: euphoria with enhanced vigor, gregariousness, hyperactivity, restlessness, hypervig- 
ilance, interpersonal sensitivity, talkativeness, anxiety, tension, alertness, grandiosity, 
stereotyped and repetitive behavior, anger, impaired judgment, and, in the case of chronic 
intoxication, affective blunting with fatigue or sadness and social withdrawal. These be- 
havioral and psychological changes are accompanied by two or more of the following 
signs and symptoms that develop during or shortly after stimulant use: tachycardia or bra- 
dycardia; pupillary dilation; elevated or lowered blood pressure; perspiration or chills; 
nausea or vomiting; evidence of weight loss; psychomotor agitation or retardation; mus- 
cular weakness, respiratory depression, chest pain, or cardiac arrhythmias; and confu- 
sion, seizures, dyskinesias, dystonias, or coma (Criterion C). Intoxication, either acute or 
chronic, is often associated with impaired social or occupational functioning. Severe in- 
toxication can lead to convulsions, cardiac arrhythmias, hyperpyrexia, and death. For the 
diagnosis of stimulant intoxication to be made, the symptoms must not be attributable 
to another medical condition and not better explained by another mental disorder (Crite- 
rion D). While stimulant intoxication occurs in individuals with stimulant use disorders, in- 
toxication is not a criterion for stimulant use disorder, which is confirmed by the presence 
of two of the 11 diagnostic criteria for use disorder. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The magnitude and direction of the behavioral and physiological changes depend on many 
variables, including the dose used and the characteristics of the individual using the sub- 
stance or the context (e.g., tolerance, rate of absorption, chronicity of use, context in which 
it is taken). Stimulant effects such as euphoria, increased pulse and blood pressure, and 
psychomotor activity are most commonly seen. Depressant effects such as sadness, brady- 
cardia, decreased blood pressure, and decreased psychomotor activity are less common 
and generally emerge only with chronic high-dose use. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Stimulant-induced disorders. Stimulant intoxication is distinguished from the other 
stimulant-induced disorders (e.g., stimulant-induced depressive disorder, bipolar disor- 
der, psychotic disorder, anxiety disorder) because the severity of the intoxication symp- 
toms exceeds that associated with the stimulant-induced disorders, and the symptoms 
warrant independent clinical attention. Stimulant intoxication delirium would be distin- 
guished by a disturbance in level of awareness and change in cognition. 


Stimulant Withdrawal 569 


Other mental disorders. Salient mental disturbances associated with stimulant intoxi- 
cation should be distinguished from the symptoms of schizophrenia, paranoid type; bi- 
polar and depressive disorders; generalized anxiety disorder; and panic disorder as 
described in DSM-5. 


Stimulant Withdrawal 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Cessation of (or reduction in) prolonged amphetamine-type substance, cocaine, or 
other stimulant use. 

B. Dysphoric mood and two (or more) of the following physiological changes, developing 
within a few hours to several days after Criterion A: 


1. Fatigue. 

2. Vivid, unpleasant dreams. 

3. Insomnia or hypersomnia. 

4. Increased appetite. 

5. Psychomotor retardation or agitation. 


C. The signs or symptoms in Criterion B cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not 
better explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication or withdrawal from 
another substance. 


Specify the specific substance that causes the withdrawal syndrome (i.e., amphet- 
amine-type substance, cocaine, or other stimulant). 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.0. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
the stimulant is an amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant. The ICD-10-CM code for 
amphetamine or an other stimulant withdrawal is F15.23, and the ICD-10-CM for cocaine 
withdrawal is F14.23. Note that the ICD-10-CM code indicates the comorbid presence of 
a moderate or severe amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant use disorder, reflecting 
the fact that amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant withdrawal can only occur in the 
presence of a moderate or severe amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant use disorder. 
It is not permissible to code a comorbid mild amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant use 
disorder with amphetamine, cocaine, or other stimulant withdrawal. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of stimulant withdrawal is the presence of a characteristic with- 
drawal syndrome that develops within a few hours to several days after the cessation of 
(or marked reduction in) stimulant use (generally high dose) that has been prolonged (Cri- 
terion A). The withdrawal syndrome is characterized by the development of dysphoric 
mood accompanied by two or more of the following physiological changes: fatigue, vivid 
and unpleasant dreams, insomnia or hypersomnia, increased appetite, and psychomotor 
retardation or agitation (Criterion B). Bradycardia is often present and is a reliable mea- 
sure of stimulant withdrawal. 

Anhedonia and drug craving can often be present but are not part of the diagnostic cri- 
teria. These symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occu- 
pational, or other important areas of functioning (Criterion C). The symptoms must not be 
attributable to another medical condition and are not better explained by another mental 
disorder (Criterion D). 


570 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Acute withdrawal symptoms (“a crash”) are often seen after periods of repetitive high-dose 
use (“runs” or “binges”). These periods are characterized by intense and unpleasant feelings of 
lassitude and depression and increased appetite, generally requiring several days of rest and 
recuperation. Depressive symptoms with suicidal ideation or behavior can occur and are gen- 
erally the most serious problems seen during “crashing” or other forms of stimulant with- 
drawal. The majority of individuals with stimulant use disorder experience a withdrawal 
syndrome at some point, and virtually all individuals with the disorder report tolerance. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Stimulant use disorder and other stimulant-induced disorders. Stimulant withdrawal 
is distinguished from stimulant use disorder and from the other stimulant-induced disor- 
ders (e.g., stimulant-induced intoxication delirium, depressive disorder, bipolar disorder, 
psychotic disorder, anxiety disorder, sexual dysfunction, sleep disorder) because the 
symptoms of withdrawal predominate the clinical presentation and are severe enough to 
warrant independent clinical attention. 


Other Stimulant-Induced Disorders 


The following stimulant-induced disorders (which include amphetamine-, cocaine-, and 
other stimulant—induced disorders) are described in other chapters of the manual with dis- 
orders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance /medication-induced 
mental disorders in these chapters): stimulant-induced psychotic disorder (“Schizophrenia 
Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders”); stimulant-induced bipolar disorder (“Bipolar 
and Related Disorders”); stimulant-induced depressive disorder (“Depressive Disorders”); 
stimulant-induced anxiety disorder (“Anxiety Disorders”); stimulant-induced obsessive- 
compulsive disorder (“Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders”); stimulant-induced 
sleep disorder (“Sleep-Wake Disorders”); and stimulant-induced sexual dysfunction (“Sex- 
ual Dysfunctions”). For stimulant intoxication delirium, see the criteria and discussion of 
delirium in the chapter “Neurocognitive Disorders.” These stimulant-induced disorders 
are diagnosed instead of stimulant intoxication or stimulant withdrawal only when the 
symptoms are sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Unspecified Stimulant-Related Disorder 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a stimulant- 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any specific stimulant-related disorder or any of the disorders in the substance-related 
and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 

Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.9. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
the stimulant is an amphetamine, cocaine, or another stimulant. The ICD-10-CM code for 
an unspecified amphetamine- or other stimulant-related disorder is F15.99. The ICD-10- 
CM code for an unspecified cocaine-related disorder is F14.99. 


Tobacco Use Disorder 571 


Tobacco-Related Disorders 


Tobacco Use Disorder 
Tobacco Withdrawal 
Other Tobacco-Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Tobacco-Related Disorder 


Tobacco Use Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A problematic pattern of tobacco use leading to clinically significant impairment or dis- 
tress, as manifested by at least two of the following, occurring within a 12-month period: 


1. 


6. 


10. 


11. 


Tobacco is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was intended. 


2. There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control tobacco use. 
3. A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain or use tobacco. 

4. 
5 


Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use tobacco. 

Recurrent tobacco use resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at work, 

school, or home (e.g., interference with work). 

Continued tobacco use despite having persistent or recurrent social or interper- 

sonal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of tobacco (e.g., arguments 

with others about tobacco use). 

Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 

cause of tobacco use. 

Recurrent tobacco use in situations in which it is physically hazardous (e.g., smok- 

ing in bed). 

Tobacco use is continued despite knowledge of having a persistent or recurrent 

physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or exacerbated 

by tobacco. 

Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 

a. Aneed for markedly increased amounts of tobacco to achieve the desired effect. 

b. A markedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of tobacco. 

Withdrawal, as manifested by either of the following: 

a. The characteristic withdrawal syndrome for tobacco (refer to Criteria A and B of 
the criteria set for tobacco withdrawal). 


b. Tobacco (or a closely related substance, such as nicotine) is taken to relieve or 
avoid withdrawal symptoms. 


Specify if: 

In early remission: After full criteria for tobacco use disorder were previously met, 
none of the criteria for tobacco use disorder have been met for at least 3 months but 
for less than 12 months (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong de- 
sire or urge to use tobacco,” may be met). 

In sustained remission: After full criteria for tobacco use disorder were previously 
met, none of the criteria for tobacco use disorder have been met at any time during a 
period of 12 months or longer (with the exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a 
strong desire or urge to use tobacco,” may be met). 


572 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Specify if: 
On maintenance therapy: The individual is taking a long-term maintenance medica- 
tion, such as nicotine replacement medication, and no criteria for tobacco use disorder 
have been met for that class of medication (except tolerance to, or withdrawal from, 
the nicotine replacement medication). 
In a controlled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to tobacco is restricted. 


Coding based on current severity: Note for ICD-10-CM codes: If a tobacco withdrawal or 
tobacco-induced sleep disorder is also present, do not use the codes below for tobacco use 
disorder. Instead, the comorbid tobacco use disorder is indicated in the 4th character of the 
tobacco-induced disorder code (see the coding note for tobacco withdrawal or tobacco- 
induced sleep disorder). For example, if there is comorbid tobacco-induced sleep disorder and 
tobacco use disorder, only the tobacco-induced sleep disorder code is given, with the 4th char- 
acter indicating whether the comorbid tobacco use disorder is moderate or severe: F17.208 
for moderate or severe tobacco use disorder with tobacco-induced sleep disorder. It is not per- 
missible to code a comorbid mild tobacco use disorder with a tobacco-induced sleep disorder. 


Specify current severity: 
305.1 (Z72.0) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
305.1 (F17.200) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
305.1 (F17.200) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


Specifiers 

“On maintenance therapy” applies as a further specifier to individuals being maintained on 
other tobacco cessation medication (e.g., bupropion, varenicline) and as a further specifier of 
remission if the individual is both in remission and on maintenance therapy. “In a controlled 
environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is both in remission 
and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled environment or in sus- 
tained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these environments are closely su- 
pervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, and locked hospital units. 


Diagnostic Features 


Tobacco use disorder is common among individuals who use cigarettes and smokeless to- 
bacco daily and is uncommon among individuals who do not use tobacco daily or who use 
nicotine medications. Tolerance to tobacco is exemplified by the disappearance of nausea 
and dizziness after repeated intake and with a more intense effect of tobacco the first time 
it is used during the day. Cessation of tobacco use can produce a well-defined withdrawal 
syndrome. Many individuals with tobacco use disorder use tobacco to relieve or to avoid 
withdrawal symptoms (e.g., after being in a situation where use is restricted). Many indi- 
viduals who use tobacco have tobacco-related physical symptoms or diseases and con- 
tinue to smoke. The large majority report craving when they do not smoke for several hours. 
Spending excessive time using tobacco can be exemplified by chain-smoking (i.e., smok- 
ing one cigarette after another with no time between cigarettes). Because tobacco sources 
are readily and legally available, and because nicotine intoxication is very rare, spending a 
great deal of time attempting to procure tobacco or recovering from its effects is uncom- 
mon. Giving up important social, occupational, or recreational activities can occur when 
an individual forgoes an activity because it occurs in tobacco use-restricted areas. Use of 
tobacco rarely results in failure to fulfill major role obligations (e.g., interference with 
work, interference with home obligations), but persistent social or interpersonal problems 
(e.g., having arguments with others about tobacco use, avoiding social situations because 
of others’ disapproval of tobacco use) or use that is physically hazardous (e.g., smoking in 


Tobacco Use Disorder 573 


bed, smoking around flammable chemicals) occur at an intermediate prevalence. Although 
these criteria are less often endorsed by tobacco users, if endorsed, they can indicate a 
more severe disorder. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Smoking within 30 minutes of waking, smoking daily, smoking more cigarettes per day, 
and waking at night to smoke are associated with tobacco use disorder. Environmental 
cues can evoke craving and withdrawal. Serious medical conditions, such as lung and 
other cancers, cardiac and pulmonary disease, perinatal problems, cough, shortness of 
breath, and accelerated skin aging, often occur. 


Prevalence 


Cigarettes are the most commonly used tobacco product, representing over 90% of to- 
bacco/nicotine use. In the United States, 57% of adults have never been smokers, 22% are 
former smokers, and 21% are current smokers. Approximately 20% of current U.S. smok- 
ers are nondaily smokers. The prevalence of smokeless tobacco use is less than 5%, and the 
prevalence of tobacco use in pipes and cigars is less than 1%. 

DSM-IV nicotine dependence criteria can be used to estimate the prevalence of tobacco 
use disorder, but since they are a subset of tobacco use disorder criteria, the prevalence of 
tobacco use disorder will be somewhat greater. The 12-month prevalence of DSM-IV nic- 
otine dependence in the United States is 13% among adults age 18 years and older. Rates 
are similar among adult males (14%) and females (12%) and decline in age from 17% 
among 18- to 29-year-olds to 4% among individuals age 65 years and older. The prevalence 
of current nicotine dependence is greater among Native American and Alaska Natives 
(23%) than among whites (14%) but is less among African Americans (10%), Asian Amer- 
icans and Pacific Islanders (6%), and Hispanics (6%). The prevalence among current daily 
smokers is approximately 50%. 

In many developing nations, the prevalence of smoking is much greater in males than 
in females, but this is not the case in developed nations. However, there often is a lag in the 
demographic transition such that smoking increases in females at a later time. 


Development and Course 


The majority of U.S. adolescents experiment with tobacco use, and by age 18 years, about 
20% smoke at least monthly. Most of these individuals become daily tobacco users. Initi- 
ation of smoking after age 21 years is rare. In general, some of the tobacco use disorder cri- 
teria symptoms occur soon after beginning tobacco use, and many individuals’ pattern of 
use meets current tobacco use disorder criteria by late adolescence. More than 80% of in- 
dividuals who use tobacco attempt to quit at some time, but 60% relapse within 1 week 
and less than 5% remain abstinent for life. However, most individuals who use tobacco 
make multiple attempts such that one-half of tobacco users eventually abstain. Individuals 
who use tobacco who do quit usually do not do so until after age 30 years. Although non- 
daily smoking in the United States was previously rare, it has become more prevalent in 
the last decade, especially among younger individuals who use tobacco. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Individuals with externalizing personality traits are more likely to 
initiate tobacco use. Children with attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder or conduct 
disorder, and adults with depressive, bipolar, anxiety, personality, psychotic, or other 
substance use disorders, are at higher risk of starting and continuing tobacco use and of to- 
bacco use disorder. 


574 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Environmental. Individuals with low incomes and low educational levels are more likely 
to initiate tobacco use and are less likely to stop. 


Genetic and physiological. Genetic factors contribute to the onset of tobacco use, the 
continuation of tobacco use, and the development of tobacco use disorder, with a degree of 
heritability equivalent to that observed with other substance use disorders (i.e., about 
50%). Some of this risk is specific to tobacco, and some is common with the vulnerability to 
developing any substance use disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Cultures and subcultures vary widely in their acceptance of the use of tobacco. The prev- 
alence of tobacco use declined in the United States from the 1960s through the 1990s, but 
this decrease has been less evident in African American and Hispanic populations. Also, 
smoking in developing countries is more prevalent than in developed nations. The degree 
to which these cultural differences are due to income, education, and tobacco control ac- 
tivities in a country is unclear. Non-Hispanic white smokers appear to be more likely to 
develop tobacco use disorder than are smokers. Some ethnic differences may be biologi- 
cally based. African American males tend to have higher nicotine blood levels for a given 
number of cigarettes, and this might contribute to greater difficulty in quitting. Also, the 
speed of nicotine metabolism is significantly different for whites compared with African 
Americans and can vary by genotypes associated with ethnicities. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Carbon monoxide in the breath, and nicotine and its metabolite cotinine in blood, saliva, or 
urine, can be used to measure the extent of current tobacco or nicotine use; however, these 
are only weakly related to tobacco use disorder. 


Functional Consequences of Tobacco Use Disorder 


Medical consequences of tobacco use often begin when tobacco users are in their 40s and 
usually become progressively more debilitating over time. One-half of smokers who do 
not stop using tobacco will die early from a tobacco-related illness, and smoking-related 
morbidity occurs in more than one-half of tobacco users. Most medical conditions result 
from exposure to carbon monoxide, tars, and other non-nicotine components of tobacco. 
The major predictor of reversibility is duration of smoking. Secondhand smoke increases 
the risk of heart disease and cancer by 30%. Long-term use of nicotine medications does 
not appear to cause medical harm. 


Comorbidity 


The most common medical diseases from smoking are cardiovascular illnesses, chronic 
obstructive pulmonary disease, and cancers. Smoking also increases perinatal problems, 
such as low birth weight and miscarriage. The most common psychiatric comorbidities are 
alcohol/substance, depressive, bipolar, anxiety, personality, and attention-deficit/hyper- 
activity disorders. In individuals with current tobacco use disorder, the prevalence of cur- 
rent alcohol, drug, anxiety, depressive, bipolar, and personality disorders ranges from 
22% to 32%. Nicotine-dependent smokers are 2.7-8.1 times more likely to have these dis- 
orders than nondependent smokers, never-smokers, or ex-smokers. 


Tobacco Withdrawal 575 


Tobacco Withdrawal 
Diagnostic Criteria 292.0 (F17.203) 


A. Daily use of tobacco for at least several weeks. 

B. Abrupt cessation of tobacco use, or reduction in the amount of tobacco used, followed 
within 24 hours by four (or more) of the following signs or symptoms: 

Irritability, frustration, or anger. 

Anxiety. 

Difficulty concentrating. 

Increased appetite. 

Restlessness. 

Depressed mood. 

Insomnia. 


PO), Oe GON 


C. The signs or symptoms in Criterion B cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The signs or symptoms are not attributed to another medical condition and are not bet- 
ter explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication or withdrawal from an- 
other substance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.0. The ICD-10-CM code for tobacco withdrawal 
is F17.203. Note that the ICD-10-CM code indicates the comorbid presence of a moderate 
or severe tobacco use disorder, reflecting the fact that tobacco withdrawal can only occur 
in the presence of a moderate or severe tobacco use disorder. It is not permissible to code 
a comorbid mild tobacco use disorder with tobacco withdrawal. 


Diagnostic Features 


Withdrawal symptoms impair the ability to stop tobacco use. The symptoms after absti- 
nence from tobacco are in large part due to nicotine deprivation. Symptoms are much 
more intense among individuals who smoke cigarettes or use smokeless tobacco than 
among those who use nicotine medications. This difference in symptom intensity is likely 
due to the more rapid onset and higher levels of nicotine with cigarette smoking. Tobacco 
withdrawal is common among daily tobacco users who stop or reduce but can also occur 
among nondaily users. Typically, heart rate decreases by 5-12 beats per minute in the first 
few days after stopping smoking, and weight increases an average of 4~7 lb (2-3 kg) over 
the first year after stopping smoking. Tobacco withdrawal can produce clinically signifi- 
cant mood changes and functional impairment. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Craving for sweet or sugary foods and impaired performance on tasks requiring vigilance 
are associated with tobacco withdrawal. Abstinence can increase constipation, coughing, 
dizziness, dreaming /nightmares, nausea, and sore throat. Smoking increases the metab- 
olism of many medications used to treat mental disorders; thus, cessation of smoking can 
increase the blood levels of these medications, and this can produce clinically significant 
outcomes. This effect appears to be due not to nicotine but rather to other compounds in 
tobacco. 


576 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Prevalence 


Approximately 50% of tobacco users who quit for 2 or more days will have symptoms that 
meet criteria for tobacco withdrawal. The most commonly endorsed signs and symptoms 
are anxiety, irritability, and difficulty concentrating. The least commonly endorsed symp- 
toms are depression and insomnia. 


Development and Course 


Tobacco withdrawal usually begins within 24 hours of stopping or cutting down on to- 
bacco use, peaks at 2-3 days after abstinence, and lasts 2-3 weeks. Tobacco withdrawal 
symptoms can occur among adolescent tobacco users, even prior to daily tobacco use. Pro- 
longed symptoms beyond 1 month are uncommon. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Smokers with depressive disorders, bipolar disorders, anxiety disor- 
ders, attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, and other substance use disorders have 
more severe withdrawal. 


Genetic and physiological. Genotype can influence the probability of withdrawal upon 
abstinence. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Carbon monoxide in the breath, and nicotine and its metabolite cotinine in blood, saliva, or 
urine, can be used to measure the extent of tobacco or nicotine use but are only weakly re- 
lated to tobacco withdrawal. 


Functional Consequences of Tobacco Withdrawal 


Abstinence from cigarettes can cause clinically significant distress. Withdrawal impairs 
the ability to stop or control tobacco use. Whether tobacco withdrawal can prompt a new 
mental disorder or recurrence of a mental disorder is debatable, but if this occurs, it would 
be in a small minority of tobacco users. 


Differential Diagnosis 


The symptoms of tobacco withdrawal overlap with those of other substance withdrawal 
syndromes (e.g., alcohol withdrawal; sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal; stim- 
ulant withdrawal; caffeine withdrawal; opioid withdrawal); caffeine intoxication; anxiety, 
depressive, bipolar, and sleep disorders; and medication-induced akathisia. Admission to 
smoke-free inpatient units or voluntary smoking cessation can induce withdrawal symp- 
toms that mimic, intensify, or disguise other disorders or adverse effects of medications 
used to treat mental disorders (e.g., irritability thought to be due to alcohol withdrawal 
could be due to tobacco withdrawal). Reduction in symptoms with the use of nicotine 
medications confirms the diagnosis. 


Other Tobacco-Induced Disorders 


Tobacco-induced sleep disorder is discussed in the chapter “Sleep-Wake Disorders” (see 
“Substance /Medication-Induced Sleep Disorder”). 


Unspecified Tobacco-Related Disorder 577 


Unspecified Tobacco-Related Disorder 
292.9 (F17.209) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a tobacco- 
related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria 
for any specific tobacco-related disorder or any of the disorders in the substance-related 
and addictive disorders diagnostic class. 


Other (or Unknown) 
Substance-Related Disorders 


Other (or Unknown) Substance Use Disorder 
Other (or Unknown) Substance Intoxication 
Other (or Unknown) Substance Withdrawal 
Other (or Unknown) Substance—Induced Disorders 
Unspecified Other (or Unknown) Substance-Related Disorder 


Other (or Unknown) Substance Use Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. A problematic pattern of use of an intoxicating substance not able to be classified 
within the alcohol; caffeine; cannabis; hallucinogen (phencyclidine and others); inhal- 
ant; opioid; sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic; stimulant; or tobacco categories and lead- 
ing to clinically significant impairment or distress, as manifested by at least two of the 
following, occurring within a 12-month period: 


1. 


2. 


3. 


4. 


The substance is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was 
intended. 

There is a persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control use of the 
substance. 

A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain the substance, use the 
substance, or recover from its effects. 

Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the substance. 

Recurrent use of the substance resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations 
at work, school, or home. 

Continued use of the substance despite having persistent or recurrent social or in- 
terpersonal problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of its use. 

Important social, occupational, or recreational activities are given up or reduced be- 
cause of use of the substance. 

Recurrent use of the substance in situations in which it is physically hazardous. 
Use of the substance is continued despite knowledge of having a persistent or re- 
current physical or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or ex- 
acerbated by the substance. 


578 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


10. Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 


a. Aneed for markedly increased amounts of the substance to achieve intoxication 
or desired effect. 

b. Amarkedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of the sub- 
stance. 


11. Withdrawal, as manifested by either of the following: 


a. The characteristic withdrawal syndrome for other (or unknown) substance (refer to 
Criteria A and B of the criteria sets for other [or unknown] substance withdrawal, 
p. 583). 

b. The substance (or a closely related substance) is taken to relieve or avoid with- 
drawal symptoms. 


Specity if: 

In early remission: After full criteria for other (or unknown) substance use disorder were 
previously met, none of the criteria for other (or unknown) substance use disorder have 
been met for at least 3 months but for less than 12 months (with the exception that Cri- 
terion A4, “Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the substance,” may be met). 

In sustained remission: After full criteria for other (or unknown) substance use disor- 
der were previously met, none of the criteria for other (or unknown) substance use dis- 
order have been met at any time during a period of 12 months or longer (with the 
exception that Criterion A4, “Craving, or a strong desire or urge to use the substance,” 
may be met). 


Specity if: 
In a controlled environment: This additional specifier is used if the individual is in an 
environment where access to the substance is restricted. 


Coding based on current severity: Note for |CD-10-CM codes: If an other (or unknown) sub- 
stance intoxication, other (or unknown) substance withdrawal, or another other (or unknown) 
substance-induced mental disorder is present, do not use the codes below for other (or un- 
known) substance use disorder. Instead, the comorbid other (or unknown) substance use dis- 
order is indicated in the 4th character of the other (or unknown) substance—induced disorder 
code (see the coding note for other (or unknown) substance intoxication, other (or unknown) 
substance withdrawal, or specific other (or unknown) substance—induced mental disorder). 
For example, if there is comorbid other (or unknown) substance—induced depressive disorder 
and other (or unknown) substance use disorder, only the other (or unknown) substance— 
induced depressive disorder code is given, with the 4th character indicating whether the co- 
morbid other (or unknown) substance use disorder is mild, moderate, or severe: F19.14 for 
other (or unknown) substance use disorder with other (or unknown) substance—induced de- 
pressive disorder or F19.24 for a moderate or severe other (or unknown) substance use dis- 
order with other (or unknown) substance—induced depressive disorder. 


Specify current severity: 
305.90 (F19.10) Mild: Presence of 2-3 symptoms. 
304.90 (F19.20) Moderate: Presence of 4—5 symptoms. 
304.90 (F19.20) Severe: Presence of 6 or more symptoms. 


Specifiers 

“In a controlled environment” applies as a further specifier of remission if the individual is 
both in remission and in a controlled environment (i.e., in early remission in a controlled 
environment or in sustained remission in a controlled environment). Examples of these 
environments are closely supervised and substance-free jails, therapeutic communities, 
and locked hospital units. 


Other (or Unknown) Substance Use Disorder 579 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic class other (or unknown) substance use and related disorders comprises 
substance-related disorders unrelated to alcohol; caffeine; cannabis; hallucinogens (phen- 
cyclidine and others); inhalants; opioids; sedative, hypnotics, or anxiolytics; stimulants 
(including amphetamine and cocaine); or tobacco. Such substances include anabolic ste- 
roids; nonsteroidal anti-inflammatory drugs; cortisol; antiparkinsonian medications; an- 
tihistamines; nitrous oxide; amyl-, butyl-, or isobuty]-nitrites; betel nut, which is chewed 
in many cultures to produce mild euphoria and a floating sensation; kava (from a South 
Pacific pepper plant), which produces sedation, incoordination, weight loss, mild hepati- 
tis, and lung abnormalities; or cathinones (including khét plant agents and synthetic chem- 
ical derivatives) that produce stimulant effects. Unknown substance-related disorders are 
associated with unidentified substances, such as intoxications in which the individual can- 
not identify the ingested drug, or substance use disorders involving either new, black mar- 
ket drugs not yet identified or familiar drugs illegally sold under false names. 

Other (or unknown) substance use disorder is a mental disorder in which repeated use 
of an other or unknown substance typically continues, despite the individual’s knowing 
that the substance is causing serious problems for the individual. Those problems are re- 
flected in the diagnostic criteria. When the substance is known, it should be reflected in the 
name of the disorder upon coding (e.g., nitrous oxide use disorder). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A diagnosis of other (or unknown) substance use disorder is supported by the individual’s 
statement that the substance involved is not among the nine classes listed in this chapter; by re- 
curring episodes of intoxication with negative results in standard drug screens (which may not 
detect new or rarely used substances); or by the presence of symptoms characteristic of an un- 
identified substance that has newly appeared in the individual’s community. 

Because of increased access to nitrous oxide (“laughing gas”), membership in certain 
populations is associated with diagnosis of nitrous oxide use disorder. The role of this gas 
as an anesthetic agent leads to misuse by some medical and dental professionals. Its use as 
a propellant for commercial products (e.g., whipped cream dispensers) contributes to 
misuse by food service workers. With recent widespread availability of the substance in 
“whippet” cartridges for use in home whipped cream dispensers, nitrous oxide misuse by 
adolescents and young adults is significant, especially among those who also inhale vola- 
tile hydrocarbons. Some continuously using individuals, inhaling from as many as 240 
whippets per day, may present with serious medical complications and mental conditions, 
including myeloneuropathy, spinal cord subacute combined degeneration, peripheral 
neuropathy, and psychosis. These conditions are also associated with a diagnosis of ni- 
trous oxide use disorder. 

Use of amyl-, butyl-, and isobuty] nitrite gases has been observed among homosexual 
men and some adolescents, especially those with conduct disorder. Membership in these 
populations may be associated with a diagnosis of amyl-, butyl-, or isobutyl-nitrite use dis- 
order. However, it has not been determined that these substances produce a substance use 
disorder. Despite tolerance, these gases may not alter behavior through central effects, and 
they may be used only for their peripheral effects. 

Substance use disorders generally are associated with elevated risks of suicide, but there 
is no evidence of unique risk factors for suicide with other (or unknown) substance use 
disorder. 


Prevalence 


Based on extremely limited data, the prevalence of other (or unknown) substance use disorder 
is likely lower than that of use disorders involving the nine substance classes in this chapter. 


580 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Development and Course 


No single pattern of development or course characterizes the pharmacologically varied 
other (or unknown) substance use disorders. Often unknown substance use disorders will 
be reclassified when the unknown substance eventually is identified. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Risk and prognostic factors for other (or unknown) substance use disorders are thought to 
be similar to those for most substance use disorders and include the presence of any other 
substance use disorders, conduct disorder, or antisocial personality disorder in the indi- 
vidual or the individual’s family; early onset of substance problems; easy availability of 
the substance in the individual’s environment; childhood maltreatment or trauma; and ev- 
idence of limited early self-control and behavioral disinhibition. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Certain cultures may be associated with other (or unknown) substance use disorders in- 
volving specific indigenous substances within the cultural region, such as betel nut. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Urine, breath, or saliva tests may correctly identify a commonly used substance falsely 
sold as a novel product. However, routine clinical tests usually cannot identify truly un- 
usual or new substances, which may require testing in specialized laboratories. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Use of other or unknown substances without meeting criteria for other (or unknown) 
substance use disorder. Use of unknown substances is not rare among adolescents, but 
most use does not meet the diagnostic standard of two or more criteria for other (or un- 
known) substance use disorder in the past year. 


Substance use disorders. Other (or unknown) substance use disorder may co-occur 
with various substance use disorders, and the symptoms of the disorders may be similar 
and overlapping. To disentangle symptom patterns, it is helpful to inquire about which 
symptoms persisted during periods when some of the substances were not being used. 


Other (or unknown) substance/medication-induced disorder. This diagnosis should 
be differentiated from instances when the individual’s symptoms meet full criteria for one 
of the following disorders, and that disorder is caused by an other or unknown substance: 
delirium, major or mild neurocognitive disorder, psychotic disorder, depressive disorder, 
anxiety disorder, sexual dysfunction, or sleep disorder. 


Other medical conditions. Individuals with substance use disorders, including other 
(or unknown) substance use disorder, may present with symptoms of many medical dis- 
orders. These disorders also may occur in the absence of other (or unknown) substance use 
disorder. A history of little or no use of other or unknown substances helps to exclude 
other (or unknown) substance use disorder as the source of these problems. 


Comorbidity 

Substance use disorders, including other (or unknown) substance use disorder, are com- 
monly comorbid with one another, with adolescent conduct disorder and adult antisocial 
personality disorder, and with suicidal ideation and suicide attempts. 


Other (or Unknown) Substance Intoxication 581 


Other (or Unknown) Substance Intoxication 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The development of a reversible substance-specific syndrome attributable to recent in- 
gestion of (or exposure to) a substance that is not listed elsewhere or is unknown. 

B. Clinically significant problematic behavioral or psychological changes that are attribut- 
able to the effect of the substance on the central nervous system (e.g., impaired motor 
coordination, psychomotor agitation or retardation, euphoria, anxiety, belligerence, 
mood lability, cognitive impairment, impaired judgment, social withdrawal) and develop 
during, or shortly after, use of the substance. 

C. The signs or symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not bet- 
ter explained by another mental disorder, including intoxication with another substance. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.89. The ICD-10-CM code depends on whether 
there is a comorbid other (or unknown) substance use disorder involving the same sub- 
stance. If a mild other (or unknown) substance use disorder is comorbid, the ICD-10-CM 
code is F19.129, and if a moderate or severe other (or unknown) substance use disorder is 
comorbid, the ICD-10-CM code is F19.229. If there is no comorbid other (or unknown) sub- 
stance use disorder involving the same substance, then the ICD-10-CM code is F19.929. 


Note: For information on Risk and Prognostic Factors, Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues, 
and Diagnostic Markers, see the corresponding sections in other (or unknown) substance 
use disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


Other (or unknown) substance intoxication is a clinically significant mental disorder that 
develops during, or immediately after, use of either a) a substance not elsewhere ad- 
dressed in this chapter (i.e., alcohol; caffeine; cannabis; phencyclidine and other halluci- 
nogens; inhalants; opioids; sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics; stimulants; or tobacco) or 
b) an unknown substance. If the substance is known, it should be reflected in the name of 
the disorder upon coding. 

Application of the diagnostic criteria for other (or unknown) substance intoxication is 
very challenging. Criterion A requires development of a reversible “substance-specific 
syndrome,” but if the substance is unknown, that syndrome usually will be unknown. To 
resolve this conflict, clinicians may ask the individual or obtain collateral history as to 
whether the individual has experienced a similar episode after using substances with the 
same “street” name or from the same source. Similarly, hospital emergency departments 
sometimes recognize over a few days numerous presentations of a severe, unfamiliar in- 
toxication syndrome from a newly available, previously unknown substance. Because of 
the great variety of intoxicating substances, Criterion B can provide only broad examples 
of signs and symptoms from some intoxications, with no threshold for the number of 
symptoms required for a diagnosis; clinical judgment guides those decisions. Criterion C 
requires ruling out other medical conditions, mental disorders, or intoxications. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of other (or unknown) substance intoxication is unknown. 


Development and Course 


Intoxications usually appear and then peak minutes to hours after use of the substance, but 
the onset and course vary with the substance and the route of administration. Generally, 


582 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


substances used by pulmonary inhalation and intravenous injection have the most rapid 
onset of action, while those ingested by mouth and requiring metabolism to an active 
product are much slower. (For example, after ingestion of certain mushrooms, the first 
signs of an eventually fatal intoxication may not appear for a few days.) Intoxication ef- 
fects usually resolve within hours to a very few days. However, the body may completely 
eliminate an anesthetic gas such as nitrous oxide just minutes after use ends. At the other 
extreme, some “hit-and-run” intoxicating substances poison systems, leaving permanent 
impairments. For example, MPTP (1-methyl-4-phenyl-1,2,3,6-tetrahydropyridine), a con- 
taminating by-product in the synthesis of a certain opioid, kills dopaminergic cells and in- 
duces permanent parkinsonism in users who sought opioid intoxication. 


Functional Consequences of 
Other (or Unknown) Substance Intoxication 


Impairment from intoxication with any substance may have serious consequences, includ- 
ing dysfunction at work, social indiscretions, problems in interpersonal relationships, fail- 
ure to fulfill role obligations, traffic accidents, fighting, high-risk behaviors (i.e., having 
unprotected sex), and substance or medication overdose. The pattern of consequences will 
vary with the particular substance. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Use of other or unknown substance, without meeting criteria for other (or unknown) 
substance intoxication. The individual used an other or unknown substance(s), but the 
dose was insufficient to produce symptoms that meet the diagnostic criteria required for 
the diagnosis. 


Substance intoxication or other substance/medication-induced disorders. Familiar sub- 
stances may be sold in the black market as novel products, and individuals may experience 
intoxication from those substances. History, toxicology screens, or chemical testing of the 
substance itself may help to identify it. 


Different types of other (or unknown) substance-related disorders. Episodes of other 
(or unknown) substance intoxication may occur during, but are distinct from, other (or un- 
known) substance use disorder, unspecified other (or unknown) substance-related disor- 
der, and other (or unknown) substance—induced disorders. 


Other toxic, metabolic, traumatic, neoplastic, vascular, or infectious disorders that impair 
brain function and cognition. Numerous neurological and other medical conditions may 
produce rapid onset of signs and symptoms mimicking those of intoxications, including the 
examples in Criterion B. Paradoxically, drug withdrawals also must be ruled out, because, for 
example, lethargy may indicate withdrawal from one drug or intoxication with another drug. 


Comorbidity 

As with all substance-related disorders, adolescent conduct disorder, adult antisocial per- 
sonality disorder, and other substance use disorders tend to co-occur with other (or un- 
known) substance intoxication. 


Other (or Unknown) Substance Withdrawal 583 


Other (or Unknown) Substance Withdrawal 
Diagnostic Criteria 292.0 (F19.239) 


A. Cessation of (or reduction in) use of a substance that has been heavy and prolonged. 

B. The development of a substance-specific syndrome shortly after the cessation of (or 
reduction in) substance use. 

C. The substance-specific syndrome causes clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

D. The symptoms are not attributable to another medical condition and are not better ex- 
plained by another mental disorder, including withdrawal from another substance. 

E. The substance involved cannot be classified under any of the other substance catego- 
ries (alcohol; caffeine; cannabis; opioids; sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics; stimu- 
lants; or tobacco) or is unknown. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code is 292.0. The ICD-10-CM code for other (or unknown) sub- 
stance withdrawal is F19.239. Note that the ICD-10-CM code indicates the comorbid presence 
of a moderate or severe other (or unknown) substance use disorder. It is not permissible to 
code a comorbid mild other (or unknown) substance use disorder with other (or unknown) sub- 
stance withdrawal. 


Note: For information on Risk and Prognostic Factors and Diagnostic Markers, see the cor- 
responding sections in other (or unknown) substance use disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


Other (or unknown) substance withdrawal is a clinically significant mental disorder that 
develops during, or within a few hours to days after, reducing or terminating dosing with 
a substance (Criteria A and B). Although recent dose reduction or termination usually is 
clear in the history, other diagnostic procedures are very challenging if the drug is un- 
known. Criterion B requires development of a “substance-specific syndrome” (i.e., the in- 
dividual’s signs and symptoms must correspond with the known withdrawal syndrome 
for the recently stopped drug)—a requirement that rarely can be met with an unknown 
substance. Consequently, clinical judgment must guide such decisions when information 
is this limited. Criterion D requires ruling out other medical conditions, mental disorders, 
or withdrawals from familiar substances. When the substance is known, it should be re- 
flected in the name of the disorder upon coding (e.g., betel nut withdrawal). 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of other (or unknown) substance withdrawal is unknown. 


Development and Course 


Withdrawal signs commonly appear some hours after use of the substance is terminated, 
but the onset and course vary greatly, depending on the dose typically used by the person 
and the rate of elimination of the specific substance from the body. At peak severity, with- 
drawal symptoms from some substances involve only moderate levels of discomfort, 
whereas withdrawal from other substances may be fatal. Withdrawal-associated dyspho- 
ria often motivates relapse to substance use. Withdrawal symptoms slowly abate over 
days, weeks, or months, depending on the particular drug and doses to which the indi- 
vidual became tolerant. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Culture-related issues in diagnosis will vary with the particular substance. 


584 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Functional Consequences of 
Other (or Unknown) Substance Withdrawal 


Withdrawal from any substance may have serious consequences, including physical signs 
and symptoms (e.g., malaise, vital sign changes, abdominal distress, headache), intense 
drug craving, anxiety, depression, agitation, psychotic symptoms, or cognitive impairments. 
These consequences may lead to problems such as dysfunction at work, problems in in- 
terpersonal relationships, failure to fulfill role obligations, traffic accidents, fighting, high- 
risk behavior (e.g., having unprotected sex), suicide attempts, and substance or medica- 
tion overdose. The pattern of consequences will vary with the particular substance. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Dose reduction after extended dosing, but not meeting the criteria for other (or un- 
known) substance withdrawal. The individual used other (or unknown) substances, 
but the dose that was used was insufficient to produce symptoms that meet the criteria re- 
quired for the diagnosis. 


Substance withdrawal or other substance/medication-induced disorders. Familiar 
substances may be sold in the black market as novel products, and individuals may expe- 
rience withdrawal when discontinuing those substances. History, toxicology screens, or 
chemical testing of the substance itself may help to identify it. 


Different types of other (or unknown) substance-related disorders. Episodes of other 
(or unknown) substance withdrawal may occur during, but are distinct from, other (or un- 
known) substance use disorder, unspecified other (or unknown) substance-related disor- 
der, and unspecified other (or unknown) substance—induced disorders. 


Other toxic, metabolic, traumatic, neoplastic, vascular, or infectious disorders that im- 
pair brain function and cognition. Numerous neurological and other medical condi- 
tions may produce rapid onset of signs and symptoms mimicking those of withdrawals. 
Paradoxically, drug intoxications also must be ruled out, because, for example, lethargy 
may indicate withdrawal from one drug or intoxication with another drug. 


Comorbidity 


As with all substance-related disorders, adolescent conduct disorder, adult antisocial per- 
sonality disorder, and other substance use disorders likely co-occur with other (or un- 
known) substance withdrawal. 


Other (or Unknown) 
Substance-Induced Disorders 


Because the category of other or unknown substances is inherently ill-defined, the extent 
and range of induced disorders are uncertain. Nevertheless, other (or unknown) sub- 
stance—induced disorders are possible and are described in other chapters of the manual 
with disorders with which they share phenomenology (see the substance/medication- 
induced mental disorders in these chapters): other (or unknown) substance—induced psy- 
chotic disorder (“Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders”); other (or un- 
known substance-induced bipolar disorder (“Bipolar and Related Disorders”); other (or 
unknown) substance-induced depressive disorder (“Depressive Disorders”); other (or 
unknown) substance-induced anxiety disorders (“Anxiety Disorders”); other (or un- 
known) substance-induced obsessive-compulsive disorder (“Obsessive-Compulsive and 
Related Disorders”); other (or unknown) substance-induced sleep disorder (“Sleep-Wake 


Unspecified Other (or Unknown) Substance—Related Disorder 585 


Disorders”); other (or unknown) substance—induced sexual dysfunction (“Sexual Dys- 
functions”); and other (or unknown) substance/medication—induced major or mild neu- 
rocognitive disorder (“Neurocognitive Disorders”). For other (or unknown) substance- 
induced intoxication delirium and other (or unknown) substance-induced withdrawal 
delirium, see the criteria and discussion of delirium in the chapter “Neurocognitive Dis- 
orders.” These other (or unknown) substance—induced disorders are diagnosed instead of 
other (or unknown) substance intoxication or other (or unknown) substance withdrawal 
only when the symptoms are sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention. 


Unspecified Other (or Unknown) 
Substance—Related Disorder 


292.9 (F19.99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of an other (or un- 
known) substance-related disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment 
in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not 
meet the full criteria for any specific other (or unknown) substance-related disorder or any 
of the disorders in the substance-related disorders diagnostic class. 


Non-Substance-Related Disorders 


Gambling Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 312.31 (F63.0) 


A. Persistent and recurrent problematic gambling behavior leading to clinically significant 
impairment or distress, as indicated by the individual exhibiting four (or more) of the fol- 
lowing in a 12-month period: 


1. Needs to gamble with increasing amounts of money in order to achieve the desired 
excitement. 

2. Is restless or irritable when attempting to cut down or stop gambling. 

3. Has made repeated unsuccessful efforts to control, cut back, or stop gambling. 

4. \s often preoccupied with gambling (e.g., having persistent thoughts of reliving past 
gambling experiences, handicapping or planning the next venture, thinking of ways 
to get money with which to gamble). 

5. Often gambles when feeling distressed (e.g., helpless, guilty, anxious, depressed). 

6. After losing money gambling, often returns another day to get even (“chasing” one’s 
losses). 

7. Lies to conceal the extent of involvement with gambling. 

8. Has jeopardized or lost a significant relationship, job, or educational or career op- 
portunity because of gambling. 

9. Relies on others to provide money to relieve desperate financial situations caused 
by gambling. 


B. The gambling behavior is not better explained by a manic episode. 


586 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


Specify if: 
Episodic: Meeting diagnostic criteria at more than one time point, with symptoms sub- 
siding between periods of gambling disorder for at least several months. 
Persistent: Experiencing continuous symptoms, to meet diagnostic criteria for multiple 
years. 

Specity if: 
In early remission: After full criteria for gambling disorder were previously met, none 
of the criteria for gambling disorder have been met for at least 3 months but for less 
than 12 months. 
In sustained remission: After full criteria for gambling disorder were previously met, 
none of the criteria for gambling disorder have been met during a period of 12 months 
or longer. 


Specify current severity: 
Mild: 4—5 criteria met. 
Moderate: 6-7 criteria met. 
Severe: 8-9 criteria met. 


Note: Although some behavioral conditions that do not involve ingestion of substances 
have similarities to substance-related disorders, only one disorder—gambling disorder— 
has sufficient data to be included in this section. 


Specifiers 

Severity is based on the number of criteria endorsed. Individuals with mild gambling dis- 
order may exhibit only 4—5 of the criteria, with the most frequently endorsed criteria usu- 
ally related to preoccupation with gambling and “chasing” losses. Individuals with 
moderately severe gambling disorder exhibit more of the criteria (i.e., 6-7). Individuals 
with the most severe form will exhibit all or most of the nine criteria (i.e., 8-9). Jeopardiz- 
ing relationships or career opportunities due to gambling and relying on others to provide 
money for gambling losses are typically the least often endorsed criteria and most often oc- 
cur among those with more severe gambling disorder. Furthermore, individuals present- 
ing for treatment of gambling disorder typically have moderate to severe forms of the 
disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


Gambling involves risking something of value in the hopes of obtaining something of 
greater value. In many cultures, individuals gamble on games and events, and most do so 
without experiencing problems. However, some individuals develop substantial impair- 
ment related to their gambling behaviors. The essential feature of gambling disorder is 
persistent and recurrent maladaptive gambling behavior that disrupts personal, family, 
and/or vocational pursuits (Criterion A). Gambling disorder is defined as a cluster of four 
or more of the symptoms listed in Criterion A occurring at any time in the same 12-month 
period. 

A pattern of “chasing one’s losses” may develop, with an urgent need to keep gam- 
bling (often with the placing of larger bets or the taking of greater risks) to undo a loss or 
series of losses. The individual may abandon his or her gambling strategy and try to win 
back losses all at once. Although many gamblers may “chase” for short periods of time, it 
is the frequent, and often long-term, “chase” that is characteristic of gambling disorder 
(Criterion A6). Individuals may lie to family members, therapists, or others to conceal the 
extent of involvement with gambling; these instances of deceit may also include, but 
are not limited to, covering up illegal behaviors such as forgery, fraud, theft, or embez- 
zlement to obtain money with which to gamble (Criterion A7). Individuals may also en- 


Gambling Disorder 587 


gage in “bailout” behavior, turning to family or others for help with a desperate financial 
situation that was caused by gambling (Criterion A9). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Distortions in thinking (e.g., denial, superstitions, a sense of power and control over the 
outcome of chance events, overconfidence) may be present in individuals with gambling 
disorder. Many individuals with gambling disorder believe that money is both the cause 
of and the solution to their problems. Some individuals with gambling disorder are im- 
pulsive, competitive, energetic, restless, and easily bored; they may be overly concerned 
with the approval of others and may be generous to the point of extravagance when win- 
ning. Other individuals with gambling disorder are depressed and lonely, and they may 
gamble when feeling helpless, guilty, or depressed. Up to half of individuals in treatment 
for gambling disorder have suicidal ideation, and about 17% have attempted suicide. 


Prevalence 


The past-year prevalence rate of gambling disorder is about 0.2%-0.3% in the general pop- 
ulation. In the general population, the lifetime prevalence rate is about 0.4%—1.0%. For fe- 
males, the lifetime prevalence rate of gambling disorder is about 0.2%, and for males it is 
about 0.6%. The lifetime prevalence of pathological gambling among African Americans is 
about 0.9%, among whites about 0.4%, and among Hispanics about 0.3%. 


Development and Course 


The onset of gambling disorder can occur during adolescence or young adulthood, but in 
other individuals it manifests during middle or even older adulthood. Generally, gam- 
bling disorder develops over the course of years, although the progression appears to be 
more rapid in females than in males. Most individuals who develop a gambling disorder 
evidence a pattern of gambling that gradually increases in both frequency and amount of 
wagering. Certainly, milder forms can develop into more severe cases. Most individuals 
with gambling disorder report that one or two types of gambling are most problematic for 
them, although some individuals participate in many forms of gambling. Individuals are 
likely to engage in certain types of gambling (e.g., buying scratch tickets daily) more fre- 
quently than others (e.g., playing slot machines or blackjack at the casino weekly). Fre- 
quency of gambling can be related more to the type of gambling than to the severity of the 
overall gambling disorder. For example, purchasing a single scratch ticket each day may 
not be problematic, while less frequent casino, sports, or card gambling may be part of a 
gambling disorder. Similarly, amounts of money spent wagering are not in themselves in- 
dicative of gambling disorder. Some individuals can wager thousands of dollars per 
month and not have a problem with gambling, while others may wager much smaller 
amounts but experience substantial gambling-related difficulties. 

Gambling patterns may be regular or episodic, and gambling disorder can be persis- 
tent or in remission. Gambling can increase during periods of stress or depression and 
during periods of substance use or abstinence. There may be periods of heavy gambling 
and severe problems, times of total abstinence, and periods of nonproblematic gambling. 
Gambling disorder is sometimes associated with spontaneous, long-term remissions. 
Nevertheless, some individuals underestimate their vulnerability to develop gambling 
disorder or to return to gambling disorder following remission. When in a period of re- 
mission, they may incorrectly assume that they will have no problem regulating gambling 
and that they may gamble on some forms nonproblematically, only to experience a return 
to gambling disorder. 

Early expression of gambling disorder is more common among males than among fe- 
males. Individuals who begin gambling in youth often do so with family members or 


588 Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


friends. Development of early-life gambling disorder appears to be associated with impul- 
sivity and substance abuse. Many high school and college students who develop gambling 
disorder grow out of the disorder over time, although it remains a lifelong problem for 
some. Mid- and later-life onset of gambling disorder is more common among females than 
among males. 

There are age and gender variations in the type of gambling activities and the preva- 
lence rates of gambling disorder. Gambling disorder is more common among younger and 
middle-age persons than among older adults. Among adolescents and young adults, the 
disorder is more prevalent in males than in females. Younger individuals prefer different 
forms of gambling (e.g., sports betting), while older adults are more likely to develop 
problems with slot machine and bingo gambling. Although the proportions of individuals 
who seek treatment for gambling disorder are low across all age groups, younger individ- 
uals are especially unlikely to present for treatment. 

Males are more likely to begin gambling earlier in life and to have a younger age at on- 
set of gambling disorder than females, who are more likely to begin gambling later in life 
and to develop gambling disorder in a shorter time frame. Females with gambling disor- 
der are more likely than males with gambling disorder to have depressive, bipolar, and 
anxiety disorders. Females also have a later age at onset of the disorder and seek treatment 
sooner, although rates of treatment seeking are low (<10%) among individuals with gam- 
bling disorder regardless of gender. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Gambling that begins in childhood or early adolescence is associated 
with increased rates of gambling disorder. Gambling disorder also appears to aggregate 
with antisocial personality disorder, depressive and bipolar disorders, and other sub- 
stance use disorders, particularly with alcohol disorders. 


Genetic and physiological. Gambling disorder can aggregate in families, and this effect 
appears to relate to both environmental and genetic factors. Gambling problems are more 
frequent in monozygotic than in dizygotic twins. Gambling disorder is also more preva- 
lent among first-degree relatives of individuals with moderate to severe alcohol use dis- 
order than among the general population. 


Course modifiers. Many individuals, including adolescents and young adults, are likely to 
resolve their problems with gambling disorder over time, although a strong predictor of 
future gambling problems is prior gambling problems. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Individuals from specific cultures and races/ethnicities are more likely to participate in 
some types of gambling activities than others (e.g., pai gow, cockfights, blackjack, horse rac- 
ing). Prevalence rates of gambling disorder are higher among African Americans than 
among European Americans, with rates for Hispanic Americans similar to those of Euro- 
pean Americans. Indigenous populations have high prevalence rates of gambling disorder. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Males develop gambling disorder at higher rates than females, although this gender gap 
may be narrowing. Males tend to wager on different forms of gambling than females, with 
cards, sports, and horse race gambling more prevalent among males, and slot machine and 
bingo gambling more common among females. 


Gambling Disorder 589 


Functional Consequences of Gambling Disorder 


Areas of psychosocial, health, and mental health functioning may be adversely affected by 
gambling disorder. Specifically, individuals with gambling disorder may, because of their 
involvement with gambling, jeopardize or lose important relationships with family mem- 
bers or friends. Such problems may occur from repeatedly lying to others to cover up the 
extent of gambling or from requesting money that is used for gambling or to pay off gam- 
bling debts. Employment or educational activities may likewise be adversely impacted by 
gambling disorder; absenteeism or poor work or school performance can occur with gam- 
bling disorder, as individuals may gamble during work or school hours or be preoccupied 
with gambling or its adverse consequence when they should be working or studying. In- 
dividuals with gambling disorder have poor general health and utilize medical services at 
high rates. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nondisordered gambling. Gambling disorder must be distinguished from professional 
and social gambling. In professional gambling, risks are limited and discipline is central. 
Social gambling typically occurs with friends or colleagues and lasts for a limited period of 
time, with acceptable losses. Some individuals can experience problems associated with 
gambling (e.g., short-term chasing behavior and loss of control) that do not meet the full 
criteria for gambling disorder. 


Manic episode. Loss of judgment and excessive gambling may occur during a manic ep- 
isode. An additional diagnosis of gambling disorder should be given only if the gambling 
behavior is not better explained by manic episodes (e.g., a history of maladaptive gam- 
bling behavior at times other than during a manic episode). Alternatively, an individual 
with gambling disorder may, during a period of gambling, exhibit behavior that resembles 
a manic episode, but once the individual is away from the gambling, these manic-like fea- 
tures dissipate. 


Personality disorders. Problems with gambling may occur in individuals with antisocial 
personality disorder and other personality disorders. If the criteria are met for both disor- 
ders, both can be diagnosed. 


Other medical conditions. Some patients taking dopaminergic medications (e.g., for 
Parkinson‘s disease) may experience urges to gamble. If such symptoms dissipate when 
dopaminergic medications are reduced in dosage or ceased, then a diagnosis of gambling 
disorder would not be indicated. 


Comorbidity 


Gambling disorder is associated with poor general health. In addition, some specific med- 
ical diagnoses, such as tachycardia and angina, are more common among individuals with 
gambling disorder than in the general population, even when other substance use disor- 
ders, including tobacco use disorder, are controlled for. Individuals with gambling disor- 
der have high rates of comorbidity with other mental disorders, such as substance use 
disorders, depressive disorders, anxiety disorders, and personality disorders. In some in- 
dividuals, other mental disorders may precede gambling disorder and be either absent or 
present during the manifestation of gambling disorder. Gambling disorder may also occur 
prior to the onset of other mental disorders, especially anxiety disorders and substance use 
disorders. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Neurocognitive 
Disorders 


The neu rocogn itive disorders (NCDs) (referred to in DSM-IV as “Dementia, 
Delirium, Amnestic, and Other Cognitive Disorders”) begin with delirium, followed by 
the syndromes of major NCD, mild NCD, and their etiological subtypes. The major or 
mild NCD subtypes are NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease; vascular NCD; NCD with Lewy 
bodies; NCD due to Parkinson’s disease; frontotemporal NCD; NCD due to traumatic 
brain injury; NCD due to HIV infection; substance/medication-induced NCD; NCD due 
to Huntington’s disease; NCD due to prion disease; NCD due to another medical condi- 
tion; NCD due to multiple etiologies; and unspecified NCD. The NCD category encom- 
passes the group of disorders in which the primary clinical deficit is in cognitive function, 
and that are acquired rather than developmental. Although cognitive deficits are present 
in many if not all mental disorders (e.g., schizophrenia, bipolar disorders), only disorders 
whose core features are cognitive are included in the NCD category. The NCDs are those 
in which impaired cognition has not been present since birth or very early life, and thus 
represents a decline from a previously attained level of functioning. 

The NCDs are unique among DSM-5 categories in that these are syndromes for which 
the underlying pathology, and frequently the etiology as well, can potentially be deter- 
mined. The various underlying disease entities have all been the subject of extensive re- 
search, clinical experience, and expert consensus on diagnostic criteria. The DSM-5 criteria 
for these disorders have been developed in close consultation with the expert groups for 
each of the disease entities and align as closely as possible with the current consensus cri- 
teria for each of them. The potential utility of biomarkers is also discussed in relation to 
diagnosis. Dementia is subsumed under the newly named entity major neurocognitive dis- 
order, although the term dementia is not precluded from use in the etiological subtypes in 
which that term is standard. Furthermore, DSM-5 recognizes a less severe level of cogni- 
tive impairment, mild neurocognitive disorder, which can also be a focus of care, and which 
in DSM-IV was subsumed under “Cognitive Disorder Not Otherwise Specified.” Diagnos- 
tic criteria are provided for both these syndromic entities, followed by diagnostic criteria 
for the different etiological subtypes. Several of the NCDs frequently coexist with one an- 
other, and their relationships may be multiply characterized under different chapter sub- 
headings, including “Differential Diagnosis” (e.g., NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease vs. 
vascular NCD), “Risk and Prognostic Factors” (e.g., vascular pathology increasing the 
clinical expression of Alzheimer’s disease), and/or “Comorbidity” (e.g., mixed Alzhei- 
mer’s disease—vascular pathology). 

The term dementia is retained in DSM-5 for continuity and may be used in settings 
where physicians and patients are accustomed to this term. Although dementia is the cus- 
tomary term for disorders like the degenerative dementias that usually affect older adults, 
the term neurocognitive disorder is widely used and often preferred for conditions affect- 
ing younger individuals, such as impairment secondary to traumatic brain injury or HIV 
infection. Furthermore, the major NCD definition is somewhat broader than the term 
dementia, in that individuals with substantial decline in a single domain can receive this di- 
agnosis, most notably the DSM-IV category of “Amnestic Disorder,” which would now be 
diagnosed as major NCD due to another medical condition and for which the term demen- 
tia would not be used. 


591 


592 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Neurocognitive Domains 


The criteria for the various NCDs are all based on defined cognitive domains. Table 1 pro- 
vides for each of the key domains a working definition, examples of symptoms or obser- 
vations regarding impairments in everyday activities, and examples of assessments. The 
domains thus defined, along with guidelines for clinical thresholds, form the basis on 
which the NCDs, their levels, and their subtypes may be diagnosed. 


TABLE 1 Neurocognitive domains 


Cognitive domain 


Complex attention 
(sustained attention, 
divided attention, 
selective attention, 
processing speed) 


Executive function 
(planning, decision 
making, working 
memory, respond- 
ing to feedback/ 
error correction, 
overriding habits / 
inhibition, mental 
flexibility) 


Major: Has increased difficulty in environments with multiple 
stimuli (TV, radio, conversation); is easily distracted by compet- 
ing events in the environment. Is unable to attend unless input is 
restricted and simplified. Has difficulty holding new information 
in mind, suchas recalling phone numbers or addresses just given, 
or reporting what was just said. Is unable to perform mental cal- 
culations. All thinking takes longer than usual, and components 
to be processed must be simplified to one or a few. 

Mild: Normal tasks take longer than previously. Begins to find 
errors in routine tasks; finds work needs more double-checking 
than previously. Thinking is easier when not competing with 
other things (radio, TV, other conversations, cell phone, driving). 


Major: Abandons complex projects. Needs to focus on one task 
at a time. Needs to rely on others to plan instrumental activi- 
ties of daily living or make decisions. 

Mild: Increased effort required to complete multistage projects. 
Has increased difficulty multitasking or difficulty resuming a 
task interrupted by a visitor or phone call. May complain of 
increased fatigue from the extra effort required to organize, 
plan, and make decisions. May report that large social gather- 
ings are more taxing or less enjoyable because of increased 
effort required to follow shifting conversations. 


Examples of symptoms or observations Examples of assessments 


Sustained attention: Maintenance of attention over time (e.g., pressing 
a button every time a tone is heard, and over a period of time). 

Selective attention: Maintenance of attention despite competing stim- 
uli and/or distractors: hearing numbers and letters read and asked 
to count only letters. 

Divided attention: Attending to two tasks within the same time 
period: rapidly tapping while learning a story being read. Process- 
ing speed can be quantified on any task by timing it (e.g., time to 
put together a design of blocks; time to match symbols with num- 
bers; speed in responding, such as counting speed or serial 3 
speed). 


Planning: Ability to find the exit to a maze; interpret a sequential pic- 
ture or object arrangement. 

Decision making: Performance of tasks that assess process of deciding 
in the face of competing alternatives (e.g., simulated gambling). 

Working memory: Ability to hold information for a brief period and to 
manipulate it (e.g., adding up a list of numbers or repeating a series 
of numbers or words backward). 

Feedback/error utilization: Ability to benefit from feedback to infer the 
rules for solving a problem. 

Overriding habits/inhibition: Ability to choose a more complex and 
effortful solution to be correct (e.g., looking away from the direc- 
tion indicated by an arrow; naming the color of a word’s font rather 
than naming the word). 

Mental/cognitive flexibility: Ability to shift between two concepts, 
tasks, or response rules (e.g., from number to letter, from verbal to 
key-press response, from adding numbers to ordering numbers, 
from ordering objects by size to ordering by color). 


sJepsosiq eAUBooouNEeN 


€6S 


TABLE 1 Neurocognitive domains (continued) 


Examples of symptoms or observations Examples of assessments 


Cognitive domain 


Learning and mem- 
ory (immediate 
memory, recent 
memory [including 
free recall, cued 
recall, and recogni- 
tion memory], 
very-long-term 
memory [semantic; 
autobiographical], 
implicit learning) 


Language (expres- 
sive language 
[including nam- 
ing, word finding, 
fluency, and gram- 
mar, and syntax] 
and receptive 
language) 


Major: Repeats self in conversation, often within the same con- 
versation. Cannot keep track of short list of items when shop- 
ping or of plans for the day. Requires frequent reminders to 
orient to task at hand. 

Mild: Has difficulty recalling recent events, and relies increas- 
ingly on list making or calendar. Needs occasional reminders 
or re-reading to keep track of characters in a movie or novel. 
Occasionally may repeat self over a few weeks to the same per- 
son. Loses track of whether bills have already been paid. 

Note: Except in severe forms of major neurocognitive disorder, 
semantic, autobiographical, and implicit memory are rela- 
tively preserved, compared with recent memory. 


Major: Has significant difficulties with expressive or receptive 
language. Often uses general-use phrases such as “that thing” 
and “you know what I mean,” and prefers general pronouns 
rather than names. With severe impairment, may not even 
recall names of closer friends and family. Idiosyncratic word 
usage, grammatical errors, and spontaneity of output and 
economy of utterances occur. Stereotypy of speech occurs; 
echolalia and automatic speech typically precede mutism. 


Mild: Has noticeable word-finding difficulty. May substitute 
general for specific terms. May avoid use of specific names of 
acquaintances. Grammatical errors involve subtle omission or 
incorrect use of articles, prepositions, auxiliary verbs, etc. 


Immediate memory span: Ability to repeat a list of words or digits. 
Note: Immediate memory sometimes subsumed under “working 
memory” (see “Executive Function”). 

Recent memory: Assesses the process of encoding new information 
(e.g., word lists, a short story, or diagrams). The aspects of recent 
memory that can be tested include 1) free recall (the person is asked 
to recall as many words, diagrams, or elements of a story as possi- 
ble); 2) cued recall (examiner aids recall by providing semantic cues 
such as “List all the food items on the list” or “Name all of the chil- 
dren from the story”); and 3) recognition memory (examiner asks 
about specific items—e.g., “Was ‘apple’ on the list?” or “Did you 
see this diagram or figure?”). Other aspects of memory that can be 
assessed include semantic memory (memory for facts), autobio- 
graphical memory (memory for personal events or people), and 
implicit (procedural) learning (unconscious learning of skills). 


Expressive language: Confrontational naming (identification of objects 
or pictures); fluency (e.g., name as many items as possible ina 
semantic [e.g., animals] or phonemic [e.g., words starting with “f”] 
category in 1 minute). 

Grammar and syntax (e.g., omission or incorrect use of articles, prep- 
ositions, auxiliary verbs): Errors observed during naming and flu- 
ency tests are compared with norms to assess frequency of errors 
and compare with normal slips of the tongue. 

Receptive language: Comprehension (word definition and object- 
pointing tasks involving animate and inanimate stimuli): perfor- 
mance of actions/activities according to verbal command. 


v6S 


sJepsosiq eAUBooOJNEN 


TABLE 1 Neurocognitive domains (continued) 


Examples of symptoms or observations Examples of assessments 


Cognitive domain 


Perceptual-motor 
(includes abilities 
subsumed under 
the terms visual 
perception, visuo- 
constructional, 
perceptual-motor, 
praxis, and gnosis) 


Major: Has significant difficulties with previously familiar activ- 
ities (using tools, driving motor vehicle), navigating in familiar 
environments; is often more confused at dusk, when shadows 
and lowering levels of light change perceptions. 

Mild: May need to rely more on maps or others for directions. 
Uses notes and follows others to get to a new place. May find 
self lost or turned around when not concentrating on task. Is 
less precise in parking. Needs to expend greater effort for spa- 
tial tasks such as carpentry, assembly, sewing, or knitting. 


Social cognition 
(recognition of 
emotions, theory 
of mind) 


Major: Behavior clearly out of acceptable social range; shows 
insensitivity to social standards of modesty in dress or of polit- 
ical, religious, or sexual topics of conversation. Focuses exces- 
sively on a topic despite group’s disinterest or direct feedback. 
Behavioral intention without regard to family or friends. 
Makes decisions without regard to safety (e.g., inappropriate 
clothing for weather or social setting). Typically, has little 
insight into these changes. 

Mild: Has subtle changes in behavior or attitude, often described 
as a change in personality, such as less ability to recognize 
social cues or read facial expressions, decreased empathy, 
increased extraversion or introversion, decreased inhibition, 
or subtle or episodic apathy or restlessness. 


Visual perception: Line bisection tasks can be used to detect basic 
visual defect or attentional neglect. Motor-free perceptual tasks 
(including facial recognition) require the identification and/or 
matching of figures—best when tasks cannot be verbally mediated 
(e.g., figures are not objects); some require the decision of whether 
a figure can be “real” or not based on dimensionality. 

Visuoconstructional: Assembly of items requiring hand-eye coordina- 
tion, such as drawing, copying, and block assembly. 

Perceptual-motor: Integrating perception with purposeful movement 
(e.g., inserting blocks into a form board without visual cues; rap- 
idly inserting pegs into a slotted board). 

Praxis: Integrity of learned movements, such as ability to imitate 
gestures (wave goodbye) or pantomime use of objects to command 
(“Show me how you would use a hammer”). 

Gnosis: Perceptual integrity of awareness and recognition, such as 
recognition of faces and colors. 


Recognition of emotions: Identification of emotion in images of faces 
representing a variety of both positive and negative emotions. 


Theory of mind: Ability to consider another person’s mental state 
(thoughts, desires, intentions) or experience—story cards with 
questions to elicit information about the mental state of the individ- 
uals portrayed, such as “Where will the girl look for the lost bag?” 
or “Why is the boy sad?” 


SJepsosiq eAUBooO/NEN 


S6S 


596 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Delirium 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. 


B. 


A disturbance in attention (i.e., reduced ability to direct, focus, sustain, and shift atten- 
tion) and awareness (reduced orientation to the environment). 

The disturbance develops over a short period of time (usually hours to a few days), rep- 
resents a change from baseline attention and awareness, and tends to fluctuate in se- 
verity during the course of a day. 


. An additional disturbance in cognition (e.g., memory deficit, disorientation, language, 


visuospatial ability, or perception). 


. The disturbances in Criteria A and C are not better explained by another preexisting, 


established, or evolving neurocognitive disorder and do not occur in the context of a 
severely reduced level of arousal, such as coma. 


. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the 


disturbance is a direct physiological consequence of another medical condition, sub- 
stance intoxication or withdrawal (i.e., due to a drug of abuse or to a medication), or 
exposure to a toxin, or is due to multiple etiologies. 


Specify whether: 


Substance intoxication delirium: This diagnosis should be made instead of sub- 
stance intoxication when the symptoms in Criteria A and C predominate in the clinical 
picture and when they are sufficiently severe to warrant clinical attention. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance] in- 
toxication delirium are indicated in the table below. Note that the ICD-10-CM code 
depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance use disorder present for 
the same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is comorbid with the 
substance intoxication delirium, the 4th position character is “1,” and the clinician 
should record “mild [substance] use disorder” before the substance intoxication de- 
lirium (e.g., “mild cocaine use disorder with cocaine intoxication delirium’). If a mod- 
erate or severe substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance intoxication 
delirium, the 4th position character is “2,” and the clinician should record “moderate 
[substance] use disorder” or “severe [substance] use disorder,” depending on the 
severity of the comorbid substance use disorder. If there is no comorbid substance 
use disorder (e.g., after a one-time heavy use of the substance), then the 4th posi- 
tion character is “9,” and the clinician should record only the substance intoxication 
delirium. 


ICD-10-CM 


With use 
With use disorder, 
disorder, moderateor Without use 
ICD-9-CM mild severe disorder 


Alcohol 291.0 F10.121 F10.221 F10.921 


Cannabis 292.81 F12.121 F12.221 F12.921 
Phencyclidine 292.81 F16.121 F16.221 F16.921 
Other hallucinogen 292.81 F16.121 F16.221 F16.921 
Inhalant 292.81 F18.121 F18.221 F18.921 
Opioid 292.81 F11.121 F11.221 F11.921 


Delirium 597 


ICD-10-CM 


With use 
With use disorder, 
disorder, moderateor Without use 


ICD-9-CM mild severe disorder 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 292.81 F13.121 F13.221 F13.921 
Amphetamine (or other 292.81 F15.121 F15.221 F15.921 
stimulant) 
Cocaine 292.81 F14.121 F14.221 F14.921 
Other (or unknown) substance 292.81 F19.121 F19.221 F19.921 


Substance withdrawal delirium: This diagnosis should be made instead of sub- 
stance withdrawal when the symptoms in Criteria A and C predominate in the clinical 
picture and when they are sufficiently severe to warrant clinical attention. 


Code [specific substance] withdrawal delirium: 291.0 (F10.231) alcohol; 292.0 
(F11.23) opioid; 292.0 (F13.231) sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic; 292.0 (F19.231) 
other (or unknown) substance/medication. 


Medication-induced delirium: This diagnosis applies when the symptoms in Criteria 
A and C arise as a side effect of a medication taken as prescribed. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM code for [specific medication]-induced delirium is 
292.81. The ICD-10-CM code depends on the type of medication. If the medication 
is an opioid taken as prescribed, the code is F11.921. If the medication is a seda- 
tive, hypnotic, or anxiolytic taken as prescribed, the code is F13.921. If the medica- 
tion is an amphetamine-type or other stimulant taken as prescribed, the code is 
F15.921. For medications that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., dexametha- 
sone) and in cases in which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the 
specific class of substance is unknown, the code is F19.921. 


293.0 (F05) Delirium due to another medical condition: There is evidence from the 
history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the disturbance is attributable 
to the physiological consequences of another medical condition. 


Coding note: Include the name of the other medical condition in the name of the 
delirium (e.g., 293.0 [FO5] delirium due to hepatic encephalopathy). The other med- 
ical condition should also be coded and listed separately immediately before the 
delirium due to another medical condition (e.g., 572.2 [K72.90] hepatic encepha- 
lopathy; 293.0 [FO5] delirium due to hepatic encephalopathy). 


293.0 (F05) Delirium due to multiple etiologies: There is evidence from the history, 

physical examination, or laboratory findings that the delirium has more than one etiol- 

ogy (e.g., more than one etiological medical condition; another medical condition plus 

substance intoxication or medication side effect). 
Coding note: Use multiple separate codes reflecting specific delirium etiologies 
(e.g., 572.2 [K72.90] hepatic encephalopathy, 293.0 [FO5] delirium due to hepatic 
failure; 291.0 [F10.231] alcohol withdrawal delirium). Note that the etiological med- 
ical condition both appears as a separate code that precedes the delirium code and 
is substituted into the delirium due to another medical condition rubric. 

Specify if: 
Acute: Lasting a few hours or days. 
Persistent: Lasting weeks or months. 


598 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Specify if: 
Hyperactive: The individual has a hyperactive level of psychomotor activity that may be 
accompanied by mood lability, agitation, and/or refusal to cooperate with medical care. 
Hypoactive: The individual has a hypoactive level of psychomotor activity that may be 
accompanied by sluggishness and lethargy that approaches stupor. 
Mixed level of activity: The individual has a normal level of psychomotor activity even 
though attention and awareness are disturbed. Also includes individuals whose activity 
level rapidly fluctuates. 


Recording Procedures 


Substance intoxication delirium 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance/medication intoxication delirium begins with 
the specific substance (e.g., cocaine, dexamethasone) that is presumed to be causing the 
delirium. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria set, which 
is based on the drug class. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., dexa- 
methasone), the code for “other substance” should be used; and in cases in which a sub- 
stance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance is unknown, 
the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder is followed by the course (i.e., acute, persistent), followed by 
the specifier indicating level of psychomotor activity (i.e., hyperactive, hypoactive, mixed 
level of activity). Unlike the recording procedures for ICD-10-CM, which combine the sub- 
stance / medication intoxication delirium and substance use disorder into a single code, for 
ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is given for the substance use disorder. For example, 
in the case of acute hyperactive intoxication delirium occurring in a man with a severe co- 
caine use disorder, the diagnosis is 292.81 cocaine intoxication delirium, acute, hyperac- 
tive. An additional diagnosis of 304.20 severe cocaine use disorder is also given. If the 
intoxication delirium occurs without a comorbid substance use disorder (e.g., after a one- 
time heavy use of the substance), no accompanying substance use disorder is noted (e.g., 
292.81 phencyclidine intoxication delirium, acute, hypoactive). 


ICD-10-CM. The name of the substance/medication intoxication delirium begins with the 
specific substance (e.g., cocaine, dexamethasone) that is presumed to be causing the delirium. 
The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria set, which is based on the 
drug class and presence or absence of a comorbid substance use disorder. For substances that 
do not fit into any of the classes (e.g., dexamethasone), the code for “other substance” should 
be used; and in cases in which a substance is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific 
class of substance is unknown, the category “unknown substance” should be used. 

When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) is 
listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the substance intoxication 
delirium, followed by the course (i.e., acute, persistent), followed by the specifier indicating 
level of psychomotor activity (i.e., hyperactive, hypoactive, mixed level of activity). For exam- 
ple, in the case of acute hyperactive intoxication delirium occurring in a man with a severe co- 
caine use disorder, the diagnosis is F14.221 severe cocaine use disorder with cocaine 
intoxication delirium, acute, hyperactive. A separate diagnosis of the comorbid severe cocaine 
use disorder is not given. If the intoxication delirium occurs without a comorbid substance use 
disorder (e.g., after a one-time heavy use of the substance), no accompanying substance use 
disorder is noted (e.g., F16.921 phencyclidine intoxication delirium, acute, hypoactive). 


Substance withdrawal delirium 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance/medication withdrawal delirium begins with the 
specific substance (e.g., alcohol) that is presumed to be causing the withdrawal delirium. The 
diagnostic code is selected from substance-specific codes included in the coding note included 


Delirium 599 


in the criteria set. The name of the disorder is followed by the course (i.e., acute, persistent), fol- 
lowed by the specifier indicating level of psychomotor activity (i.e., hyperactive, hypoactive, 
mixed level of activity). Unlike the recording procedures for ICD-10-CM, which combine the 
substance/medication withdrawal delirium and substance use disorder into a single code, for 
ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is given for the substance use disorder. For example, in 
the case of acute hyperactive withdrawal delirium occurring in a man witha severe alcohol use 
disorder, the diagnosis is 291.0 alcohol withdrawal delirium, acute, hyperactive. An additional 
diagnosis of 303.90 severe alcohol use disorder is also given. 


ICD-10-CM. The name of the substance/medication withdrawal delirium begins with 
the specific substance (e.g., alcohol) that is presumed to be causing the withdrawal delir- 
ium. The diagnostic code is selected from substance-specific codes included in the coding 
note included in the criteria set. When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid 
moderate or severe substance use disorder (if any) is listed first, followed by the word 
“with,” followed by the substance withdrawal delirium, followed by the course (i.e., acute, 
persistent), followed by the specifier indicating level of psychomotor activity (i.e., hyper- 
active, hypoactive, mixed level of activity). For example, in the case of acute hyperactive 
withdrawal delirium occurring in a man with a severe alcohol use disorder, the diagnosis 
is F10.231 severe alcohol use disorder with alcohol withdrawal delirium, acute, hyperac- 
tive. A separate diagnosis of the comorbid severe alcohol use disorder is not given. 


Medication-induced delirium. The name of the medication-induced delirium begins 
with the specific substance (e.g., dexamethasone) that is presumed to be causing the de- 
lirium. The name of the disorder is followed by the course (i.e., acute, persistent), followed 
by the specifier indicating level of psychomotor activity (i.e., hyperactive, hypoactive, 
mixed level of activity). For example, in the case of acute hyperactive medication-induced 
delirium occurring in a man using dexamethasone as prescribed, the diagnosis is 292.81 
(F19.921) dexamethasone-induced delirium, acute, hyperactive. 


Specifiers 

Regarding course, in hospital settings, delirium usually lasts about 1 week, but some 

symptoms often persist even after individuals are discharged from the hospital. 
Individuals with delirium may rapidly switch between hyperactive and hypoactive 

states. The hyperactive state may be more common or more frequently recognized and 

often is associated with medication side effects and drug withdrawal. The hypoactive state 

may be more frequent in older adults. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of delirium is a disturbance of attention or awareness that is accom- 
panied by a change in baseline cognition that cannot be better explained by a preexisting 
or evolving neurocognitive disorder (NCD). The disturbance in attention (Criterion A) is 
manifested by reduced ability to direct, focus, sustain, and shift attention. Questions must 
be repeated because the individual’s attention wanders, or the individual may perseverate 
with an answer to a previous question rather than appropriately shift attention. The indi- 
vidual is easily distracted by irrelevant stimuli. The disturbance in awareness is mani- 
fested by a reduced orientation to the environment or at times even to oneself. 

The disturbance develops over a short period of time, usually hours to a few days, and 
tends to fluctuate during the course of the day, often with worsening in the evening and 
night when external orienting stimuli decrease (Criterion B). There is evidence from the 
history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the disturbance is a physiologi- 
cal consequence of an underlying medical condition, substance intoxication or with- 
drawal, use of a medication, or a toxin exposure, or a combination of these factors 
(Criterion E). The etiology should be coded according to the etiologically appropriate sub- 
type (i.e., substance or medication intoxication, substance withdrawal, another medical 


600 Neurocognitive Disorders 


condition, or multiple etiologies). Delirium often occurs in the context of an underlying 
NCD. The impaired brain function of individuals with mild and major NCD renders them 
more vulnerable to delirium. 

There is an accompanying change in at least one other area that may include memory 
and learning (particularly recent memory), disorientation (particularly to time and place), 
alteration in language, or perceptual distortion or a perceptual-motor disturbance (Crite- 
rion C). The perceptual disturbances accompanying delirium include misinterpretations, 
illusions, or hallucinations; these disturbances are typically visual, but may occur in other 
modalities as well, and range from simple and uniform to highly complex. Normal atten- 
tion/arousal, delirium, and coma lie on a continuum, with coma defined as the lack of any 
response to verbal stimuli. The ability to evaluate cognition to diagnose delirium depends 
on there being a level of arousal sufficient for response to verbal stimulation; hence, delir- 
ium should not be diagnosed in the context of coma (Criterion D). Many noncomatose pa- 
tients have a reduced level of arousal. Those patients who show only minimal responses to 
verbal stimulation are incapable of engaging with attempts at standardized testing or even 
interview. This inability to engage should be classified as severe inattention. Low-arousal 
states (of acute onset) should be recognized as indicating severe inattention and cognitive 
change, and hence delirium. They are clinically indistinguishable from delirium diag- 
nosed on the basis of inattention or cognitive change elicited through cognitive testing and 
interview. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Delirium is often associated with a disturbance in the sleep-wake cycle. This disturbance 
can include daytime sleepiness, nighttime agitation, difficulty falling asleep, excessive 
sleepiness throughout the day, or wakefulness throughout the night. In some cases, com- 
plete reversal of the night-day sleep-wake cycle can occur. Sleep-wake cycle disturbances 
are very common in delirium and have been proposed as a core criterion for the diagnosis. 

The individual with delirium may exhibit emotional disturbances, such as anxiety, 
fear, depression, irritability, anger, euphoria, and apathy. There may be rapid and unpre- 
dictable shifts from one emotional state to another. The disturbed emotional state may also 
be evident in calling out, screaming, cursing, muttering, moaning, or making other 
sounds. These behaviors are especially prevalent at night and under conditions in which 
stimulation and environmental cues are lacking. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of delirium is highest among hospitalized older individuals and varies 
depending on the individuals’ characteristics, setting of care, and sensitivity of the detec- 
tion method. The prevalence of delirium in the community overall is low (1%-2%) but in- 
creases with age, rising to 14% among individuals older than 85 years. The prevalence is 
10%-30% in older individuals presenting to emergency departments, where the delirium 
often indicates a medical illness. 

The prevalence of delirium when individuals are admitted to the hospital ranges from 
14% to 24%, and estimates of the incidence of delirium arising during hospitalization 
range from 6% to 56% in general hospital populations. Delirium occurs in 15%-53% of 
older individuals postoperatively and in 70%-87% of those in intensive care. Delirium oc- 
curs in up to 60% of individuals in nursing homes or post-acute care settings and in up to 
83% of all individuals at the end of life. 


Development and Course 


While the majority of individuals with delirium have a full recovery with or without 
treatment, early recognition and intervention usually shortens the duration of the delir- 


Delirium 601 


ium. Delirium may progress to stupor, coma, seizures, or death, particularly if the under- 
lying cause remains untreated. Mortality among hospitalized individuals with delirium is 
high, and as many as 40% of individuals with delirium, particularly those with malignan- 
cies and other significant underlying medical illness, die within a year after diagnosis. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Delirium may be increased in the context of functional impairment, im- 
mobility, a history of falls, low levels of activity, and use of drugs and medications with 
psychoactive properties (particularly alcohol and anticholinergics). 


Genetic and physiological. Both major and mild NCDs can increase the risk for delir- 
ium and complicate the course. Older individuals are especially susceptible to delirium 
compared with younger adults. Susceptibility to delirium in infancy and through child- 
hood may be greater than in early and middle adulthood. In childhood, delirium may be 
related to febrile illnesses and certain medications (e.g., anticholinergics). 


Diagnostic Markers 


In addition to laboratory findings characteristic of underlying medical conditions (or in- 
toxication or withdrawal states), there is often generalized slowing on electroencephalog- 
raphy, and fast activity is occasionally found (e.g., in some cases of alcohol withdrawal 
delirium). However, electroencephalography is insufficiently sensitive and specific for di- 
agnostic use. 


Functional Consequences of Delirium 


Delirium itself is associated with increased functional decline and risk of institutional 
placement. Hospitalized individuals 65 years or older with delirium have three times the 
risk of nursing home placement and about three times the functional decline as hospital- 
ized patients without delirium at both discharge and 3 months postdischarge. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Psychotic disorders and bipolar and depressive disorders with psychotic features. 
Delirium that is characterized by vivid hallucinations, delusions, language disturbances, 
and agitation must be distinguished from brief psychotic disorder, schizophrenia, schizo- 
phreniform disorder, and other psychotic disorders, as well as from bipolar and depres- 
sive disorders with psychotic features. 


Acute stress disorder. Delirium associated with fear, anxiety, and dissociative symptoms, 
such as depersonalization, must be distinguished from acute stress disorder, which is pre- 
cipitated by exposure to a severely traumatic event. 


Malingering and factitious disorder. Delirium can be distinguished from these disor- 
ders on the basis of the often atypical presentation in malingering and factitious disorder 
and the absence of another medical condition or substance that is etiologically related to 
the apparent cognitive disturbance. 


Other neurocognitive disorders. The most common differential diagnostic issue when 
evaluating confusion in older adults is disentangling symptoms of delirium and dementia. 
The clinician must determine whether the individual has delirium; a delirium superim- 
posed on a preexisting NCD, such as that due to Alzheimer’s disease; or an NCD without 
delirium. The traditional distinction between delirium and dementia according to acute- 
ness of onset and temporal course is particularly difficult in those elderly individuals who 
had a prior NCD that may not have been recognized, or who develop persistent cognitive 
impairment following an episode of delirium. 


602 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Other Specified Delirium 
780.09 (R41.0) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of delirium that 
cause Clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other impor- 
tant areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for delirium or any of 
the disorders in the neurocognitive disorders diagnostic class. The other specified delirium 
category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific 
reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for delirium or any specific neuro- 
cognitive disorder. This is done by recording “other specified delirium” followed by the spe- 
cific reason (e.g., “attenuated delirium syndrome’). 

An example of a presentation that can be specified using the “other specified” desig- 
nation is the following: 

Attenuated delirium syndrome: This syndrome applies in cases of delirium in which 

the severity of cognitive impairment falls short of that required for the diagnosis, or in 

which some, but not all, diagnostic criteria for delirium are met. 


Unspecified Delirium 
780.09 (R41.0) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of delirium that 
cause Clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other impor- 
tant areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for delirium or any of 
the disorders in the neurocognitive disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified delirium 
category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that 
the criteria are not met for delirium, and includes presentations for which there is insuffi- 
cient information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Major and Mild Neurocognitive Disorders 


Major Neurocognitive Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Evidence of significant cognitive decline from a previous level of performance in one 
or more cognitive domains (complex attention, executive function, learning and mem- 
ory, language, perceptual-motor, or social cognition) based on: 


1. Concern of the individual, a knowledgeable informant, or the clinician that there has 
been a significant decline in cognitive function; and 

2. A substantial impairment in cognitive performance, preferably documented by stan- 
dardized neuropsychological testing or, in its absence, another quantified clinical 
assessment. 

B. The cognitive deficits interfere with independence in everyday activities (i.e., at a min- 
imum, requiring assistance with complex instrumental activities of daily living such as 
paying bills or managing medications). 

C. The cognitive deficits do not occur exclusively in the context of a delirium. 


Major and Mild Neurocognitive Disorders 


603 


D. The cognitive deficits are not better explained by another mental disorder (e.g., major 
depressive disorder, schizophrenia). 


Specify whether due to: 
Alzheimer’s disease (pp. 611-614) 
Frontotemporal lobar degeneration (pp. 614-618) 
Lewy body disease (pp. 618-621) 
Vascular disease (pp. 621-624) 
Traumatic brain injury (pp. 624-627) 


Substance/medication use (pp. 627-632) 


HIV infection (pp. 632-634) 

Prion disease (pp. 634-636) 
Parkinson’s disease (pp. 636-638) 
Huntington’s disease (pp. 638-641) 


Another medical condition (pp. 641-642) 


Multiple etiologies (pp. 642-643) 
Unspecified (p. 643) 
Coding note: Code based on medical or substance etiology. In some cases, there is need 
for an additional code for the etiological medical condition, which must immediately pre- 
cede the diagnostic code for major neurocognitive disorder, as follows: 


Etiological subtype 


Alzheimer’s 
disease 


Frontotemporal 
lobar degeneration 


Lewy body disease 


Vascular disease 


Traumatic brain 
injury 


Substance/ 
medication- 
induced 


Associated etiological 


medical code for major 


Major neurocogni- 


Mild neurocogni- 


neurocognitive disorder* tive disorder code” tive disorder code® 


Probable: 331.0 (G30.9) 


Possible: no additional 
medical code 


Probable: 331.19 
(G31.09) 

Possible: no additional 
medical code 


Probable: 331.82 
(G31.83) 

Possible: no additional 
medical code 


No additional medical 
code 


907.0 (S06.2X9S) 


No additional medical 
code 


Probable: 294.1x 
(FO2.8x) 
Possible: 331.9 
(G31.9)° 


Probable: 294.1x 
(FO2.8x) 
Possible: 331.9 
(G31.9)° 


Probable: 294.1x 
(FO2.8x) 
Possible: 331.9 
(G31.9)° 


Probable: 290.40 
(FO1.5x) 
Possible: 331.9 
(G31.9)° 


294.1x (F02.8x) 


Code based on the 
type of substance 
causing the major 
neurocognitive 
disorder® ¢ 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use addi- 
tional code for 
Alzheimer’s 
disease.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use addi- 
tional code for 
frontotemporal 
disease.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use addi- 
tional code for 

Lewy body disease.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 

(Do not use addi- 
tional code for the 
vascular disease.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use additional 
code for the trau- 
matic brain injury.) 


Code based on the 
type of substance 
causing the mild 
neurocognitive 
disorder 


604 


Neurocognitive Disorders 


Associated etiological 


Etiological subtype 


medical code for major 


Major neurocogni- 


Mild neurocogni- 
tive disorder code° 


neurocognitive disorder* tive disorder code 


HIV infection 


Prion disease 


Parkinson’s 
disease 


Huntington’s 
disease 


Due to another 
medical condition 


Due to multiple 
etiologies 


Unspecified neuro- 
cognitive disorder 


042 (B20) 


046.79 (A81.9) 


Probable: 332.0 (G20) 
Possible: No additional 
medical code 


333.4 (G10) 


Code the other medical 
condition first 

(e.g., 340 [G35] 
multiple sclerosis) 


Code all of the etiological 
medical conditions first 
(with the exception of 
vascular disease) 


No additional medical 
code 


294.1x (F02.8x) 


294.1x (F02.8x) 


Probable: 294.1x 
(FO2.8x) 
Possible: 331.9 
(G31.9)° 


294.1x (F02.8x) 


294.1x (F02.8x) 


294.1x (FO2.8x) 
(Plus the code for 
the relevant sub- 
stance/medication- 
induced major neu- 
rocognitive disor- 
ders if substances 
or medications 
play a role in the 
etiology.) 


799.59 (R41.9) 


*Code first, before code for major neurocognitive disorder. 
Code fifth character based on symptom specifier: .x0 without behavioral disturbance; .x1 with be- 
havioral disturbance (e.g., psychotic symptoms, mood disturbance, agitation, apathy, or other be- 


havioral symptoms). 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use addi- 
tional code for HIV 
infection.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use addi- 
tional code for 
prion disease.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use addi- 
tional code for 
Parkinson’s 
disease.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use addi- 
tional code for 
Huntington’s 
disease.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Do not use addi- 
tional codes for the 
presumed etiologi- 
cal medical condi- 
tions.) 


331.83 (G31.84) 
(Plus the code for 
the relevant sub- 
stance/medication- 
induced mild neuro- 
cognitive disor- 
ders if substances 
or medications play 
a role in the etiol- 
ogy. Do not use ad- 
ditional codes for 
the presumed 
etiological medical 
conditions.) 


799.59 (R41.9) 


*Note: Behavioral disturbance specifier cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing. 
See “Substance /Medication-Induced Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder.” 


Major and Mild Neurocognitive Disorders 605 


Specify: 
Without behavioral disturbance: If the cognitive disturbance is not accompanied by 
any clinically significant behavioral disturbance. 
With behavioral disturbance (specify disturbance): If the cognitive disturbance is ac- 
companied by a Clinically significant behavioral disturbance (e.g., psychotic symptoms, 
mood disturbance, agitation, apathy, or other behavioral symptoms). 

Specify current severity: 
Mild: Difficulties with instrumental activities of daily living (e.g., housework, managing 
money). 
Moderate: Difficulties with basic activities of daily living (e.g., feeding, dressing). 
Severe: Fully dependent. 


Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Evidence of modest cognitive decline from a previous level of performance in one or 
more cognitive domains (complex attention, executive function, learning and memory, 
language, perceptual-motor, or social cognition) based on: 

1. Concern of the individual, a knowledgeable informant, or the clinician that there has 
been a mild decline in cognitive function; and 

2. A modest impairment in cognitive performance, preferably documented by stan- 
dardized neuropsychological testing or, in its absence, another quantified clinical 
assessment. 

B. The cognitive deficits do not interfere with capacity for independence in everyday 
activities (i.e., complex instrumental activities of daily living such as paying bills or 
managing medications are preserved, but greater effort, compensatory strategies, or 
accommodation may be required). 

C. The cognitive deficits do not occur exclusively in the context of a delirium. 

D. The cognitive deficits are not better explained by another mental disorder (e.g., major 
depressive disorder, schizophrenia). 

Specify whether due to: 

Alzheimer’s disease (pp. 611-614) 
Frontotemporal lobar degeneration (pp. 614-618) 
Lewy body disease (pp. 618-621) 
Vascular disease (pp. 621-624) 
Traumatic brain injury (pp. 624-627) 
Substance/medication use (pp. 627-632) 
HIV infection (pp. 632-634) 

Prion disease (pp. 634-636) 

Parkinson’s disease (pp. 636-638) 
Huntington’s disease (pp. 638-641) 
Another medical condition (pp. 641-642) 
Multiple etiologies (pp. 642-643) 
Unspecified (p. 643) 

Coding note: For mild neurocognitive disorder due to any of the medical etiologies listed 

above, code 331.83 (G31.84). Do not use additional codes for the presumed etiological 

medical conditions. For substance/medication-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, code 
based on type of substance; see “Substance/Medication-Induced Major or Mild Neurocog- 
nitive Disorder.” For unspecified mild neurocognitive disorder, code 799.59 (R41.9). 


606 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Specify: 
Without behavioral disturbance: If the cognitive disturbance is not accompanied by 
any clinically significant behavioral disturbance. 
With behavioral disturbance (specify disturbance): If the cognitive disturbance is ac- 
companied by a clinically significant behavioral disturbance (e.g., psychotic symptoms, 
mood disturbance, agitation, apathy, or other behavioral symptoms). 


Subtypes 


Major and mild neurocognitive disorders (NCDs) are primarily subtyped according to the 
known or presumed etiological/pathological entity or entities underlying the cognitive de- 
cline. These subtypes are distinguished on the basis of a combination of time course, charac- 
teristic domains affected, and associated symptoms. For certain etiological subtypes, the 
diagnosis depends substantially on the presence of a potentially causative entity, such as Par- 
kinson’s or Huntington’s disease, or a traumatic brain injury or stroke in the appropriate time 
period. For other etiological subtypes (generally the neurodegenerative diseases like Alzhei- 
mer’s disease, frontotemporal lobar degeneration, and Lewy body disease), the diagnosis is 
based primarily on the cognitive, behavioral, and functional symptoms. Typically, the differ- 
entiation among these syndromes that lack an independently recognized etiological entity is 
clearer at the level of major NCD than at the level of mild NCD, but sometimes characteristic 
symptoms and associated features are present at the mild level as well. 

NCDs are frequently managed by clinicians in multiple disciplines. For many sub- 
types, multidisciplinary international expert groups have developed specialized consen- 
sus criteria based on clinicopathological correlation with underlying brain pathology. The 
subtype criteria here have been harmonized with those expert criteria. 


Specifiers 
Evidence for distinct behavioral features in NCDs has been recognized, particularly in the 
areas of psychotic symptoms and depression. Psychotic features are common in many 
NCDs, particularly at the mild-to-moderate stage of major NCDs due to Alzheimer’s dis- 
ease, Lewy body disease, and frontotemporal lobar degeneration. Paranoia and other 
delusions are common features, and often a persecutory theme may be a prominent aspect 
of delusional ideation. In contrast to psychotic disorders with onset in earlier life (e.g., 
schizophrenia), disorganized speech and disorganized behavior are not characteristic of 
psychosis in NCDs. Hallucinations may occur in any modality, although visual hallucina- 
tions are more common in NCDs than in depressive, bipolar, or psychotic disorders. 
Mood disturbances, including depression, anxiety, and elation, may occur. Depression 
is common early in the course (including at the mild NCD level) of NCD due to Alzhei- 
mer’s disease and Parkinson’s disease, while elation may occur more commonly in fron- 
totemporal lobar degeneration. When a full affective syndrome meeting diagnostic criteria 
for a depressive or bipolar disorder is present, that diagnosis should be coded as well. 
Mood symptoms are increasingly recognized to be a significant feature in the earliest stages 
of mild NCDs such that clinical recognition and intervention may be important. 
Agitation is common in a wide variety of NCDs, particularly in major NCD of moder- 
ate to severe severity, and often occurs in the setting of confusion or frustration. It may 
arise as combative behaviors, particularly in the context of resisting caregiving duties such 
as bathing and dressing. Agitation is characterized as disruptive motor or vocal activity 
and tends to occur with advanced stages of cognitive impairment across all of the NCDs. 
Individuals with NCD can present with a wide variety of behavioral symptoms that 
are the focus of treatment. Sleep disturbance is a common symptom that can create a need 
for clinical attention and may include symptoms of insomnia, hypersomnia, and circadian 
rhythm disturbances. 


Major and Mild Neurocognitive Disorders 607 


Apathy is common in mild and mild major NCD. It is observed particularly in NCD due 
to Alzheimer’s disease and may be a prominent feature of NCD due to frontotemporal 
lobar degeneration. Apathy is typically characterized by diminished motivation and re- 
duced goal-directed behavior accompanied by decreased emotional responsiveness. 
Symptoms of apathy may manifest early in the course of NCDs when a loss of motivation 
to pursue daily activities or hobbies may be observed. 

Other important behavioral symptoms include wandering, disinhibition, hyperpha- 
gia, and hoarding. Some of these symptoms are characteristic of specific disorders, as dis- 
cussed in the relevant sections. When more than one behavioral disturbance is observed, 
each type should be noted in writing with the specifier “with behavioral symptoms.” 


Diagnostic Features 


Major and mild NCDs exist on a spectrum of cognitive and functional impairment. Major 
NCD corresponds to the condition referred to in DSM-IV as dementia, retained as an alter- 
native in this volume. The core feature of NCDs is acquired cognitive decline in one or 
more cognitive domains (Criterion A) based on both 1) a concern about cognition on the 
part of the individual, a knowledgeable informant, or the clinician, and 2) performance on 
an objective assessment that falls below the expected level or that has been observed to de- 
cline over time. Both a concern and objective evidence are required because they are com- 
plementary. When there is an exclusive focus on objective testing, a disorder may go 
undiagnosed in high-functioning individuals whose currently “normal” performance ac- 
tually represents a substantial decline in abilities, or an illness may be incorrectly diag- 
nosed in individuals whose currently “low” performance does not represent a change 
from their own baseline or is a result of extraneous factors like test conditions or a passing 
illness. Alternatively, excessive focus on subjective symptoms may fail to diagnose illness 
in individuals with poor insight, or whose informants deny or fail to notice their symptoms, 
or it may be overly sensitive in the so-called worried well. 

A cognitive concern differs from a complaint in that it may or may not be voiced spon- 
taneously. Rather, it may need to be elicited by careful questioning about specific symp- 
toms that commonly occur in individuals with cognitive deficits (see Table 1 in the 
introduction to this chapter). For example, memory concerns include difficulty remember- 
ing a short grocery list or keeping track of the plot of a television program; executive con- 
cerns include difficulty resuming a task when interrupted, organizing tax records, or 
planning a holiday meal. At the mild NCD level, the individual is likely to describe these 
tasks as being more difficult or as requiring extra time or effort or compensatory strategies. 
At the major NCD level, such tasks may only be completed with assistance or may be 
abandoned altogether. At the mild NCD level, individuals and their families may not no- 
tice such symptoms or may view them as normal, particularly in the elderly; thus, careful 
history taking is of paramount importance. The difficulties must represent changes rather 
than lifelong patterns: the individual or informant may clarify this issue, or the clinician 
can infer change from prior experience with the patient or from occupational or other 
clues. It is also critical to determine that the difficulties are related to cognitive loss rather 
than to motor or sensory limitations. 

Neuropsychological testing, with performance compared with norms appropriate to 
the patient’s age, educational attainment, and cultural background, is part of the standard 
evaluation of NCDs and is particularly critical in the evaluation of mild NCD. For major 
NCD, performance is typically 2 or more standard deviations below appropriate norms 
(3rd percentile or below). For mild NCD, performance typically lies in the 1-2 standard de- 
viation range (between the 3rd and 16th percentiles). However, neuropsychological test- 
ing is not available in all settings, and neuropsychological thresholds are sensitive to the 
specific test(s) and norms employed, as well as to test conditions, sensory limitations, and 
intercurrent illness. A variety of brief office-based or “bedside” assessments, as described 


608 Neurocognitive Disorders 


in Table 1, can also supply objective data in settings where such testing is unavailable or 
infeasible. In any case, as with cognitive concerns, objective performance must be inter- 
preted in light of the individual's prior performance. Optimally, this information would 
be available from a prior administration of the same test, but often it must be inferred 
based on appropriate norms, along with the individual’s educational history, occupation, 
and other factors. Norms are more challenging to interpret in individuals with very high 
or very low levels of education and in individuals being tested outside their own language 
or cultural background. 

Criterion B relates to the individual’s level of independence in everyday functioning. 
Individuals with major NCD will have impairment of sufficient severity so as to interfere 
with independence, such that others will have to take over tasks that the individuals were 
previously able to complete on their own. Individuals with mild NCD will have preserved 
independence, although there may be subtle interference with function or a report that 
tasks require more effort or take more time than previously. 

The distinction between major and mild NCD is inherently arbitrary, and the disorders 
exist along a continuum. Precise thresholds are therefore difficult to determine. Careful 
history taking, observation, and integration with other findings are required, and the im- 
plications of diagnosis should be considered when an individual’s clinical manifestations 
lie at a boundary. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Typically the associated features that support a diagnosis of major or mild NCD will be 
specific to the etiological subtype (e.g., neuroleptic sensitivity and visual hallucinations in 
NCD due to Lewy body disease). Diagnostic features specific to each of the subtypes are 
found in the relevant sections. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of NCD varies widely by age and by etiological subtype. Overall preva- 
lence estimates are generally only available for older populations. Among individuals 
older than 60 years, prevalence increases steeply with age, so prevalence estimates are 
more accurate for narrow age bands than for broad categories such as “over 65” (where the 
mean age can vary greatly with the life expectancy of the given population). For those eti- 
ological subtypes occurring across the lifespan, prevalence estimates for NCD are likely to 
be available, if at all, only as the fraction of individuals who develop NCD among those 
with the relevant condition (e.g., traumatic brain injury, HIV infection). 

Overall prevalence estimates for dementia (which is largely congruent with major 
NCD) are approximately 1%-2% at age 65 years and as high as 30% by age 85 years. The 
prevalence of mild NCD is very sensitive to the definition of the disorder, particularly in 
community settings, where evaluations are less detailed. In addition, in contrast with clin- 
ical settings, where cognitive concern must be high to seek and locate care, there may be a 
less clear decline from baseline functioning. Estimates of the prevalence of mild cognitive 
impairment (which is substantially congruent with mild NCD) among older individuals 
are fairly variable, ranging from 2% to 10% at age 65 and 5% to 25% by age 85. 


Development and Course 


The course of NCD varies across etiological subtypes, and this variation can be useful in 
differential diagnosis. Some subtypes (e.g., those related to traumatic brain injury or 
stroke) typically begin at a specific time and (at least after initial symptoms related to in- 
flammation or swelling subside) remain static. Others may fluctuate over time (although 
if this occurs, the possibility of delirium superimposed on NCD should be considered). 
NCDs due to neurodegenerative diseases like Alzheimer’s disease or frontotemporal 
lobar degeneration typically are marked by insidious onset and gradual progression, and 


Major and Mild Neurocognitive Disorders 609 


the pattern of onset of cognitive deficits and associated features helps to distinguish among 
them. 

NCDs with onset in childhood and adolescence may have broad repercussions for so- 
cial and intellectual development, and in this setting intellectual disability (intellectual 
developmental disorder) and/or other neurodevelopmental disorders may also be diag- 
nosed to capture the full diagnostic picture and ensure the provision of a broad range of 
services. In older individuals, NCDs often occur in the setting of medical illnesses, frailty, 
and sensory loss, which complicate the clinical picture for diagnosis and treatment. 

When cognitive loss occurs in youth to midlife, individuals and families are likely to 
seek care. NCDs are typically easiest to identify at younger ages, although in some settings 
malingering or other factitious disorders may be a concern. Very late in life, cognitive 
symptoms may not cause concern or may go unnoticed. In late life, mild NCD must also be 
distinguished from the more modest deficits associated with “normal aging,” although a 
substantial fraction of what has been ascribed to normal aging likely represents prodromal 
phases of various NCDs. In addition, it becomes harder to recognize mild NCD with age 
because of the increasing prevalence of medical illness and sensory deficits. It becomes 
harder to differentiate among subtypes with age because there are multiple potential sources 
of neurocognitive decline. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Risk factors vary not only by etiological subtype but also by age at onset within etiological 
subtypes. Some subtypes are distributed throughout the lifespan, whereas others occur 
exclusively or primarily in late life. Even within the NCDs of aging, the relative prevalence 
varies with age: Alzheimer’s disease is uncommon before age 60 years, and the prevalence 
increases steeply thereafter, while the overall less common frontotemporal lobar degener- 
ation has earlier onset and represents a progressively smaller fraction of NCDs with age. 


Genetic and physiological. The strongest risk factor for major and mild NCDs is age, 
primarily because age increases the risk of neurodegenerative and cerebrovascular dis- 
ease. Female gender is associated with higher prevalence of dementia overall, and especially 
Alzheimer’s disease, but this difference is largely, if not wholly, attributable to greater lon- 
gevity in females. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Individuals’ and families’ level of awareness and concern about neurocognitive symp- 
toms may vary across ethnic and occupational groups. Neurocognitive symptoms are 
more likely to be noticed, particularly at the mild level, in individuals who engage in com- 
plex occupational, domestic, or recreational activities. In addition, norms for neuropsy- 
chological testing tend to be available only for broad populations, and thus they may not 
be easily applicable to individuals with less than high school education or those being 
evaluated outside their primary language or culture. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Like age, culture, and occupation, gender issues may affect the level of concern and aware- 
ness of cognitive symptoms. In addition, for late-life NCDs, females are likely to be older, 
to have more medical comorbidity, and to live alone, which can complicate evaluation and 
treatment. In addition, there are gender differences in the frequency of some of the etio- 
logical subtypes. 


Diagnostic Markers 


In addition to a careful history, neuropsychological assessments are the key measures for 
diagnosis of NCDs, particularly at the mild level, where functional changes are minimal 


610 Neurocognitive Disorders 


and symptoms more subtle. Ideally, individuals will be referred for formal neuropsycho- 
logical testing, which will provide a quantitative assessment of all relevant domains and 
thus help with diagnosis; provide guidance to the family on areas where the individual 
may require more support; and serve as a benchmark for further decline or response to 
therapies. When such testing is unavailable or not feasible, the brief assessments in Table 1 
can provide insight into each domain. More global brief mental status tests may be helpful 
but may be insensitive, particularly to modest changes in a single domain or in those with 
high premorbid abilities, and may be overly sensitive in those with low premorbid abilities. 
In distinguishing among etiological subtypes, additional diagnostic markers may 
come into play, particularly neuroimaging studies such as magnetic resonance imaging 
scans and positron emission tomography scans. In addition, specific markers may be in- 
volved in the assessment of specific subtypes and may become more important as addi- 
tional research findings accumulate over time, as discussed in the relevant sections. 


Functional Consequences of 
Major and Mild Neurocognitive Disorders 


By definition, major and mild NCDs affect functioning, given the central role of cognition in 
human life. Thus, the criteria for the disorders, and the threshold for differentiating mild 
from major NCD, are based in part on functional assessment. Within major NCD there is a 
broad range of functional impairment, as implemented in the severity specifiers. In addition, 
the specific functions that are compromised can help identify the cognitive domains affected, 
particularly when neuropsychological testing is not available or is difficult to interpret. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normal cognition. The differential diagnosis between normal cognition and mild NCD, 
as between mild and major NCD, is challenging because the boundaries are inherently ar- 
bitrary. Careful history taking and objective assessment are critical to these distinctions. A 
longitudinal evaluation using quantified assessments may be key in detecting mild NCD. 


Delirium. Both mild and major NCD may be difficult to distinguish from a persistent de- 
lirium, which can co-occur. Careful assessment of attention and arousal will help to make 
the distinction. 


Major depressive disorder. The distinction between mild NCD and major depressive 
disorder, which may co-occur with NCD, can also be challenging. Specific patterns of cog- 
nitive deficits may be helpful. For example, consistent memory and executive function 
deficits are typical of Alzheimer’s disease, whereas nonspecific or more variable perfor- 
mance is seen in major depression. Alternatively, treatment of the depressive disorder 
with repeated observation over time may be required to make the diagnosis. 


Specific learning disorder and other neurodevelopmental disorders. A careful clari- 
fication of the individual’s baseline status will help distinguish an NCD from a specific 
learning disorder or other neurodevelopmental disorders. Additional issues may enter the 
differential for specific etiological subtypes, as described in the relevant sections. 


Comorbidity 


NCDs are common in older individuals and thus often co-occur with a wide variety of age- 
related diseases that may complicate diagnosis or treatment. Most notable of these is 
delirium, for which NCD increases the risk. In older individuals, a delirium during hos- 
pitalization is, in many cases, the first time that an NCD is noticed, although a careful his- 
tory will often reveal evidence of earlier decline. Mixed NCDs are also common in older 
individuals, as many etiological entities increase in prevalence with age. In younger indi- 
viduals, NCD often co-occurs with neurodevelopmental disorders; for example, a head in- 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Alzheimer’s Disease 611 


jury in a preschool child may also lead to significant developmental and learning issues. 
Additional comorbidity of NCD is often related to the etiological subtype, as discussed in 
the relevant sections. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
Due to Alzheimer’s Disease 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. There is insidious onset and gradual progression of impairment in one or more cognitive 
domains (for major neurocognitive disorder, at least two domains must be impaired). 

C. Criteria are met for either probable or possible Alzheimer’s disease as follows: 


For major neurocognitive disorder: 


Probable Alzheimer’s disease is diagnosed if either of the following is present; oth- 
erwise, possible Alzheimer’s disease should be diagnosed. 


1. Evidence of a causative Alzheimer’s disease genetic mutation from family history 
or genetic testing. 
2. All three of the following are present: 


a. Clear evidence of decline in memory and learning and at least one other cogni- 
tive domain (based on detailed history or serial neuropsychological testing). 

b. Steadily progressive, gradual decline in cognition, without extended plateaus. 

c. No evidence of mixed etiology (i.e., absence of other neurodegenerative or 
cerebrovascular disease, or another neurological, mental, or systemic disease 
or condition likely contributing to cognitive decline). 


For mild neurocognitive disorder: 


Probable Alzheimer’s disease is diagnosed if there is evidence of a causative Alz- 
heimer’s disease genetic mutation from either genetic testing or family history. 


Possible Alzheimer’s disease is diagnosed if there is no evidence of a causative Alz- 
heimer’s disease genetic mutation from either genetic testing or family history, and all 
three of the following are present: 


1. Clear evidence of decline in memory and learning. 

2. Steadily progressive, gradual decline in cognition, without extended plateaus. 

3. No evidence of mixed etiology (i.e., absence of other neurodegenerative or cere- 
brovascular disease, or another neurological or systemic disease or condition likely 
contributing to cognitive decline). 


D. The disturbance is not better explained by cerebrovascular disease, another neurode- 
generative disease, the effects of a substance, or another mental, neurological, or sys- 
temic disorder. 


Coding note: For probable major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, 
with behavioral disturbance, code first 331.0 (G30.9) Alzheimer’s disease, followed by 
294.11 (F02.81) major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease. For probable 
neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, without behavioral disturbance, code 
first 331.0 (G30.9) Alzheimer’s disease, followed by 294.10 (F02.80) major neurocognitive 
disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, without behavioral disturbance. 

For possible major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, code 331.9 
(G31.9) possible major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease. (Note: Do not 
use the additional code for Alzheimer’s disease. Behavioral disturbance cannot be coded 
but should still be indicated in writing.) 


612 Neurocognitive Disorders 


For mild neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, code 331.83 (G31.84). 
(Note: Do not use the additional code for Alzheimer’s disease. Behavioral disturbance 
cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


Beyond the neurocognitive disorder (NCD) syndrome (Criterion A), the core features of ma- 
jor or mild NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease include an insidious onset and gradual pro- 
gression of cognitive and behavioral symptoms (Criterion B). The typical presentation is 
amnestic (i.e., with impairment in memory and learning). Unusual nonamnestic presen- 
tations, particularly visuospatial and logopenic aphasic variants, also exist. At the mild 
NCD phase, Alzheimer’s disease manifests typically with impairment in memory and learn- 
ing, sometimes accompanied by deficits in executive function. At the major NCD phase, 
visuoconstructional/perceptual-motor ability and language will also be impaired, partic- 
ularly when the NCD is moderate to severe. Social cognition tends to be preserved until 
late in the course of the disease. 

A level of diagnostic certainty must be specified denoting Alzheimer’s disease as the 
“probable” or “possible” etiology (Criterion C). Probable Alzheimer’s disease is diagnosed in 
both major and mild NCD if there is evidence of a causative Alzheimer’s disease gene, ei- 
ther from genetic testing or from an autosomal dominant family history coupled with au- 
topsy confirmation or a genetic test in an affected family member. For major NCD, a 
typical clinical picture, without extended plateaus or evidence of mixed etiology, can also 
be diagnosed as due to probable Alzheimer’s disease. For mild NCD, given the lesser de- 
gree of certainty that the deficits will progress, these features are only sufficient for a 
possible Alzheimer’s etiology. If the etiology appears mixed, mild NCD due to multiple eti- 
ologies should be diagnosed. In any case, for both mild and major NCD due to Alzhei- 
mer’s disease, the clinical features must not suggest another primary etiology for the NCD 
(Criterion D). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


In specialty clinical settings, approximately 80% of individuals with major NCD due to 
Alzheimer’s disease have behavioral and psychological manifestations; these features are 
also frequent at the mild NCD stage of impairment. These symptoms are as or more dis- 
tressing than cognitive manifestations and are frequently the reason that health care is 
sought. At the mild NCD stage or the mildest level of major NCD, depression and/or ap- 
athy are often seen. With moderately severe major NCD, psychotic features, irritability, 
agitation, combativeness, and wandering are common. Late in the illness, gait distur- 
bance, dysphagia, incontinence, myoclonus, and seizures are observed. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of overall dementia (major NCD) rises steeply with age. In high-income 
countries, it ranges from 5% to 10% in the seventh decade to at least 25% thereafter. U.S. 
census data estimates suggest that approximately 7% of individuals diagnosed with Alz- 
heimer’s disease are between ages 65 and 74 years, 53% are between ages 75 and 84 years, 
and 40% are 85 years and older. The percentage of dementias attributable to Alzheimer’s 
disease ranges from about 60% to over 90%, depending on the setting and diagnostic cri- 
teria. Mild NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease is likely to represent a substantial fraction of 
mild cognitive impairment (MCI) as well. 


Development and Course 


Major or mild NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease progresses gradually, sometimes with 
brief plateaus, through severe dementia to death. The mean duration of survival after di- 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Alzheimer’s Disease 613 


agnosis is approximately 10 years, reflecting the advanced age of the majority of individ- 
uals rather than the course of the disease; some individuals can live with the disease for as 
long as 20 years. Late-stage individuals are eventually mute and bedbound. Death most 
commonly results from aspiration in those who survive through the full course. In mild 
NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease, impairments increase over time, and functional status 
gradually declines until symptoms reach the threshold for the diagnosis of major NCD. 

The onset of symptoms is usually in the eighth and ninth decades; early-onset forms 
seen in the fifth and sixth decades are often related to known causative mutations. Symp- 
toms and pathology do not differ markedly at different onset ages. However, younger in- 
dividuals are more likely to survive the full course of the disease, while older individuals 
are more likely to have numerous medical comorbidities that affect the course and man- 
agement of the illness. Diagnostic complexity is higher in older adults because of the in- 
creased likelihood of comorbid medical illness and mixed pathology. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Traumatic brain injury increases risk for major or mild NCD due to Alz- 
heimer’s disease. 


Genetic and physiological. Age is the strongest risk factor for Alzheimer’s disease. The 
genetic susceptibility polymorphism apolipoprotein E4 increases risk and decreases age 
at onset, particularly in homozygous individuals. There are also extremely rare causative 
Alzheimer’s disease genes. Individuals with Down’s syndrome (trisomy 21) develop Alz- 
heimer’s disease if they survive to midlife. Multiple vascular risk factors influence risk for 
Alzheimer’s disease and may act by increasing cerebrovascular pathology or also through 
direct effects on Alzheimer pathology. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Detection of an NCD may be more difficult in cultural and socioeconomic settings where 
memory loss is considered normal in old age, where older adults face fewer cognitive de- 
mands in everyday life, or where very low educational levels pose greater challenges to 
objective cognitive assessment. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Cortical atrophy, amyloid-predominant neuritic plaques, and tau-predominant neurofibril- 
lary tangles are hallmarks of the pathological diagnosis of Alzheimer’s disease and may be 
confirmed via postmortem histopathological examination. For early-onset cases with auto- 
somal dominant inheritance, a mutation in one of the known causative Alzheimer’s disease 
genes—amyloid precursor protein (APP), presenilin 1 (PSEN1), or presenilin 2 (PSEN2)— 
may be involved, and genetic testing for such mutations is commercially available, at least 
for PSEN1. Apolipoprotein E4 cannot serve as a diagnostic marker because it is only a risk 
factor and neither necessary nor sufficient for disease occurrence. 

Since amyloid beta-42 deposition in the brain occurs early in the pathophysiological 
cascade, amyloid-based diagnostic tests such as amyloid imaging on brain positron emis- 
sion tomography (PET) scans and reduced levels of amyloid beta-42 in the cerebrospinal 
fluid (CSF) may have diagnostic value. Signs of neuronal injury, such as hippocampal and 
temporoparietal cortical atrophy on a magnetic resonance image scan, temporoparietal 
hypometabolism on a fluorodeoxyglucose PET scan, and evidence for elevated total tau 
and phospho-tau levels in CSF, provide evidence of neuronal damage but are less specific 
for Alzheimer’s disease. At present, these biomarkers are not fully validated, and many 
are available only in tertiary care settings. However, some of them, along with novel bio- 
markers, will likely move into wider clinical practice in the coming years. 


614 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Functional Consequences of Major or Mild 
Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Alzheimer’s Disease 


The prominence of memory loss can cause significant difficulties relatively early in the 
course. Social cognition (and thus social functioning) and procedural memory (e.g., danc- 
ing, playing musical instruments) may be relatively preserved for extended periods. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other neurocognitive disorders. Major and mild NCDs due to other neurodegenera- 
tive processes (e.g., Lewy body disease, frontotemporal lobar degeneration) share the in- 
sidious onset and gradual decline caused by Alzheimer’s disease but have distinctive core 
features of their own. In major or mild vascular NCD, there is typically history of stroke 
temporally related to the onset of cognitive impairment, and infarcts or white matter hy- 
perintensities are judged sufficient to account for the clinical picture. However, particu- 
larly when there is no clear history of stepwise decline, major or mild vascular NCD can 
share many clinical features with Alzheimer’s disease. 

Other concurrent, active neurological or systemic illness. Other neurological or sys- 
temic illness should be considered if there is an appropriate temporal relationship and 
severity to account for the clinical picture. At the mild NCD level, it may be difficult to dis- 
tinguish an Alzheimer’s disease etiology from that of another medical condition (e.g., thy- 
roid disorders, vitamin By, deficiency). 

Major depressive disorder. Particularly at the mild NCD level, the differential diagnosis 
also includes major depression. The presence of depression may be associated with re- 
duced daily functioning and poor concentration that may resemble an NCD, but improve- 
ment with treatment of depression may be useful in making the distinction. 


Comorbidity 


Most individuals with Alzheimer’s disease are elderly and have multiple medical conditions 
that can complicate diagnosis and influence the clinical course. Major or mild NCD due to 
Alzheimer’s disease commonly co-occurs with cerebrovascular disease, which contributes 
to the clinical picture. When a comorbid condition contributes to the NCD in an individual 
with Alzheimer’s disease, then NCD due to multiple etiologies should be diagnosed. 


Major or Mild Frontotemporal 
Neurocognitive Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 
B. The disturbance has insidious onset and gradual progression. 
C. Either (1) or (2): 
1. Behavioral variant: 
a. Three or more of the following behavioral symptoms: 
i. Behavioral disinhibition. 
ii. Apathy or inertia. 
iii. Loss of sympathy or empathy. 
iv. Perseverative, stereotyped or compulsive/ritualistic behavior. 
v. Hyperorality and dietary changes. 
b. Prominent decline in social cognition and/or executive abilities. 


Major or Mild Frontotemporal Neurocognitive Disorder 615 


2. Language variant: 


a. Prominent decline in language ability, in the form of speech production, word 
finding, object naming, grammar, or word comprehension. 


D. Relative sparing of learning and memory and perceptual-motor function. 

E. The disturbance is not better explained by cerebrovascular disease, another neurode- 
generative disease, the effects of a substance, or another mental, neurological, or sys- 
temic disorder. 


Probable frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder is diagnosed if either of the following 
is present; otherwise, possible frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder should be di- 
agnosed: 


1. Evidence of a causative frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder genetic mutation, from 
either family history or genetic testing. 

2. Evidence of disproportionate frontal and/or temporal lobe involvement from neuroim- 
aging. 

Possible frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder is diagnosed if there is no evidence 

of a genetic mutation, and neuroimaging has not been performed. 

Coding note: For probable major neurocognitive disorder due to frontotemporal lobar de- 

generation, with behavioral disturbance, code first 331.19 (G31.09) frontotemporal dis- 

ease, followed by 294.11 (F02.81) probable major neurocognitive disorder due to 

frontotemporal lobar degeneration, with behavioral disturbance. For probable major neu- 

rocognitive disorder due to frontotemporal lobar degeneration, without behavioral distur- 

bance, code first 331.19 (G31.09) frontotemporal disease, followed by 294.10 (F02.80) 

probable major neurocognitive disorder due to frontotemporal lobar degeneration, without 

behavioral disturbance. 

For possible major neurocognitive disorder due to frontotemporal lobar degeneration, code 

331.9 (G31.9) possible major neurocognitive disorder due to frontotemporal lobar degen- 

eration. (Note: Do not use the additional code for frontotemporal disease. Behavioral distur- 

bance cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing.) 

For mild neurocognitive disorder due to frontotemporal lobar degeneration, code 331.83 

(G31.84). (Note: Do not use the additional code for frontotemporal disease. Behavioral 

disturbance cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


Major or mild frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder (NCD) comprises a number of syn- 
dromic variants characterized by the progressive development of behavioral and personality 
change and/or language impairment. The behavioral variant and three language variants (se- 
mantic, agrammatic/nonfluent, and logopenic) exhibit distinct patterns of brain atrophy and 
some distinctive neuropathology. The criteria must be met for either the behavioral or the lan- 
guage variant to make the diagnosis, but many individuals present with features of both. 
Individuals with behavioral-variant major or mild frontotemporal NCD present with 
varying degrees of apathy or disinhibition. They may lose interest in socialization, self- 
care, and personal responsibilities, or display socially inappropriate behaviors. Insight is 
usually impaired, and this often delays medical consultation. The first referral is often to a 
psychiatrist. Individuals may develop changes in social style, and in religious and political 
beliefs, with repetitive movements, hoarding, changes in eating behavior, and hyperoral- 
ity. In later stages, loss of sphincter control may occur. Cognitive decline is less prominent, 
and formal testing may show relatively few deficits in the early stages. Common neuro- 
cognitive symptoms are lack of planning and organization, distractibility, and poor judg- 
ment. Deficits in executive function, such as poor performance on tests of mental 


616 Neurocognitive Disorders 


flexibility, abstract reasoning, and response inhibition, are present, but learning and mem- 
ory are relatively spared, and perceptual-motor abilities are almost always preserved in 
the early stages. 

Individuals with language-variant major or mild frontotemporal NCD present with pri- 
mary progressive aphasia with gradual onset, with three subtypes commonly described: 
semantic variant, agrammatic/nonfluent variant, and logopenic variant, and each variant 
has distinctive features and corresponding neuropathology. 

“Probable” is distinguished from “possible” frontotemporal NCD by the presence of 
causative genetic factors (e.g., mutations in the gene coding for microtubule-associated pro- 
tein tau) or by the presence of distinctive atrophy or reduced activity in frontotemporal re- 
gions on structural or functional imaging. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Extrapyramidal features may be prominent in some cases, with an overlap with syn- 
dromes such as progressive supranuclear palsy and corticobasal degeneration. Features of 
motor neuron disease may be present in some cases (e.g., muscle atrophy, weakness). A 
subset of individuals develop visual hallucinations. 


Prevalence 


Major or mild frontotemporal NCD is a common cause of early-onset NCD in individuals 
younger than 65 years. Population prevalence estimates are in the range of 2-10 per 
100,000. Approximately 20%-25% of cases of frontotemporal NCD occur in individuals 
older than 65 years. Frontotemporal NCD accounts for about 5% of all cases of dementia in 
unselected autopsy series. Prevalence estimates of behavioral variant and semantic lan- 
guage variant are higher among males, and prevalence estimates of nonfluent language 
variant are higher among females. 


Development and Course 


Individuals with major or mild frontotemporal NCD commonly present in the sixth de- 
cade of life, although the age at onset varies from the third to the ninth decades. The dis- 
ease is gradually progressive, with median survival being 6-11 years after symptom onset 
and 3-4 years after diagnosis. Survival is shorter and decline is faster in major or mild fron- 
totemporal NCD than in typical Alzheimer’s disease. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Approximately 40% of individuals with major or mild fron- 
totemporal NCD have a family history of early-onset NCD, and approximately 10% show an 
autosomal dominant inheritance pattern. A number of genetic factors have been identified, 
such as mutations in the gene encoding the microtubule associated protein tau (MAPT), the 
granulin gene (GRN), and the C9ORF72 gene. A number of families with causative muta- 
tions have been identified (see the section “Diagnostic Markers” for this disorder), but many 
individuals with known familial transmission do not have a known mutation. The presence 
of motor neuron disease is associated with a more rapid deterioration. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Computed tomography (CT) or structural magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) may show 
distinct patterns of atrophy. In behavioral-variant major or mild frontotemporal NCD, 
both frontal lobes (especially the medial frontal lobes) and the anterior temporal lobes are 
atrophic. In semantic language-variant major or mild frontotemporal NCD, the middle, 
inferior, and anterior temporal lobes are atrophic bilaterally but asymmetrically, with the 


Major or Mild Frontotemporal Neurocognitive Disorder 617 


left side usually being more affected. Nonfluent language-variant major or mild fronto- 
temporal NCD is associated with predominantly left posterior frontal-insular atrophy. 
The logopenic variant of major or mild frontotemporal NCD is associated with predomi- 
nantly left posterior perisylvian or parietal atrophy. Functional imaging demonstrates hy- 
poperfusion and/or cortical hypometabolism in the corresponding brain regions, which 
may be present in the early stages in the absence of structural abnormality. Emerging bio- 
markers for Alzheimer’s disease (e.g., cerebrospinal fluid amyloid-beta and tau levels, and 
amyloid imaging) may help in the differential diagnosis, but the distinction from Alzhei- 
mer’s disease can remain difficult (the logopenic variant is in fact often a manifestation of 
Alzheimer’s disease). 

In familial cases of frontotemporal NCD, the identification of genetic mutations may 
help confirm the diagnosis. Mutations associated with frontotemporal NCD include 
the genes encoding microtubule-associated protein tau (MAPT) and granulin (GRN), 
C9IORF72, transactive response DNA-binding protein of 43 kDa (TDP-43, or TARDBP), 
valosin-containing protein (VCP), chromatin modifying protein 2B (CHMP2B), and fused 
in sarcoma protein (FUS). 


Functional Consequences of Major or Mild 
Frontotemporal Neurocognitive Disorder 


Because of the relative early age at onset of the disorder, the disorder oftens affects work- 
place and family life. Because of the involvement of language and/or behavior, function is 
often more severely impaired relatively early in the course. For individuals with the be- 
havioral variant, prior to diagnostic clarification there may be significant family disrup- 
tion, legal involvement, and problems in the workplace because of socially inappropriate 
behaviors. The functional impairment due to behavioral change and language dysfunc- 
tion, which can include hyperorality, impulsive wandering, and other dishinhibited be- 
haviors, may far exceed that due to the cognitive disturbance and may lead to nursing 
home placement or institutionalization. These behaviors can be severely disruptive, even 
in structured care settings, particularly when the individuals are otherwise healthy, non- 
frail, and free of other medical comorbidities. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other neurocognitive disorders. Other neurodegenerative diseases may be distinguished 
from major or mild frontotemporal NCD by their characteristic features. In major or mild 
NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease, decline in learning and memory is an early feature. 
However, 10%-30% of patients presenting with a syndrome suggestive of major or mild 
frontotemporal NCD are found at autopsy to have Alzheimer’s disease pathology. This oc- 
curs more frequently in individuals who present with progressive dysexecutive syn- 
dromes in the absence of behavioral changes or movement disorder or in those with the 
logopenic variant. 

In major or mild NCD with Lewy bodies, core and suggestive features of Lewy bodies 
must be present. In major or mild NCD due to Parkinson’s disease, spontaneous parkin- 
sonism emerges well before the cognitive decline. In major or mild vascular NCD, depend- 
ing on affected brain regions, there may also be loss of executive ability and behavioral 
changes such as apathy, and this disorder should be considered in the differential diagno- 
sis. However, history of a cerebrovascular event is temporally related to the onset of cog- 
nitive impairment in major or mild vascular NCD, and neuroimaging reveals infarctions 
or white matter lesions sufficient to account for the clinical picture. 


Other neurological conditions. Major or mild frontotemporal NCD overlaps with pro- 
gressive supranuclear palsy, corticobasal degeneration, and motor neuron disease 
clinically as well as pathologically. Progressive supranuclear palsy is characterized by 


618 Neurocognitive Disorders 


supranuclear gaze palsies and axial-predominant parkinsonism. Pseudobulbar signs may 
be present, and retropulsion is often prominent. Neurocognitive assessment shows psy- 
chomotor slowing, poor working memory, and executive dysfunction. Corticobasal degen- 
eration presents with asymmetric rigidity, limb apraxia, postural instability, myoclonus, 
alien limb phenomenon, and cortical sensory loss. Many individuals with behavioral-variant 
major or mild frontotemporal NCD show features of motor neuron disease, which tend to 
be mixed upper and predominantly lower motor neuron disease. 


Other mental disorders and medical conditions. Behavioral-variant major or mild fron- 
totemporal NCD may be mistaken for a primary mental disorder, such as major depression, 
bipolar disorders, or schizophrenia, and individuals with this variant often present initially 
to psychiatry. Over time, the development of progressive neurocognitive difficulties will 
help to make the distinction. A careful medical evaluation will help to exclude treatable 
causes of NCDs, such as metabolic disturbances, nutritional deficiencies, and infections. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
With Lewy Bodies 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. The disorder has an insidious onset and gradual progression. 

C. The disorder meets a combination of core diagnostic features and suggestive diagnos- 
tic features for either probable or possible neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies. 
For probable major or mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, the indi- 
vidual has two core features, or one suggestive feature with one or more core features. 
For possible major or mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, the individ- 
ual has only one core feature, or one or more suggestive features. 


1. Core diagnostic features: 


a. Fluctuating cognition with pronounced variations in attention and alertness. 

b. Recurrent visual hallucinations that are well formed and detailed. 

c. Spontaneous features of parkinsonism, with onset subsequent to the develop- 
ment of cognitive decline. 


2. Suggestive diagnostic features: 


a. Meets criteria for rapid eye movement sleep behavior disorder. 
b. Severe neuroleptic sensitivity. 


D. The disturbance is not better explained by cerebrovascular disease, another neurode- 
generative disease, the effects of a substance, or another mental, neurological, or sys- 
temic disorder. 


Coding note: For probable major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, with behav- 
ioral disturbance, code first 331.82 (G31.83) Lewy body disease, followed by 294.11 
(F02.81) probable major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, with behavioral distur- 
bance. For probable major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, without behavioral 
disturbance, code first 331.82 (G31.83) Lewy body disease, followed by 294.10 (F02.80) 
probable major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, without behavioral disturbance. 
For possible major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, code 331.9 (G31.9) possible 
major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies. (Note: Do not use the additional code for 
Lewy body disease. Behavioral disturbance cannot be coded but should still be indicated 
in writing.) 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder With Lewy Bodies 619 


For mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, code 331.83 (G31.84). (Note: Do not 
use the additional code for Lewy body disease. Behavioral disturbance cannot be coded 
but should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


Major or mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies (NCDLB), in the case of major 
neurocognitive disorder (NCD), corresponds to the condition known as dementia with 
Lewy bodies (DLB). The disorder includes not only progressive cognitive impairment 
(with early changes in complex attention and executive function rather than learning and 
memory) but also recurrent complex visual hallucinations; and concurrent symptoms of 
rapid eye movement (REM) sleep behavior disorder (which can be a very early manifes- 
tation); as well as hallucinations in other sensory modalities, depression, and delusions. 
The symptoms fluctuate in a pattern that can resemble a delirium, but no adequate under- 
lying cause can be found. The variable presentation of NCDLB symptoms reduces the like- 
lihood of all symptoms being observed in a brief clinic visit and necessitates a thorough 
assessment of caregiver observations. The use of assessment scales specifically designed to 
assess fluctuation may aid in diagnosis. Another core feature is spontaneous parkinson- 
ism, which must begin after the onset of cognitive decline; by convention, major cognitive 
deficits are observed at least 1 year before the motor symptoms. The parkinsonism must 
also be distinguished from neuroleptic-induced extrapyramidal signs. Accurate diagnosis 
is essential to safe treatment planning, as up to 50% of individuals with NCDLB have se- 
vere sensitivity to neuroleptic drugs, and these medications should be used with extreme 
caution in managing the psychotic manifestations. 

The diagnosis of mild NCDLB is appropriate for individuals who present with the core 
or suggestive features at a stage when cognitive or functional impairments are not of suf- 
ficient severity to fulfill criteria for major NCD. However, as for all mild NCDs, there will 
often be insufficient evidence to justify any single etiology, and use of the unspecified di- 
agnosis is most appropriate. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with NCDLB frequently experience repeated falls and syncope and transient 
episodes of unexplained loss of consciousness. Autonomic dysfunction, such as ortho- 
static hypotension and urinary incontinence, may be observed. Auditory and other 
nonvisual hallucinations are common, as are systematized delusions, delusional misiden- 
tification, and depression. 


Prevalence 


The few population-based prevalence estimates for NCDLB available range from 0.1% to 
5% of the general elderly population, and from 1.7% to 30.5% of all dementia cases. In 
brain bank (autopsy) series, the pathological lesions known as Lewy bodies are present in 
20%-35% of cases of dementia. The male-to-female ratio is approximately 1.5:1. 


Development and Course 


NCDLB is a gradually progressive disorder with insidious onset. However, there is often 
a prodromal history of confusional episodes (delirium) of acute onset, often precipitated 
by illness or surgery. The distinction between NCDLB, in which Lewy bodies are primar- 
ily cortical in location, and major or mild NCD due to Parkinson’s disease, in which the pa- 
thology is primarily in the basal ganglia, is the order in which the cognitive and motor 
symptoms emerge. In NCDLB, the cognitive decline is manifested early in the course of ill- 
ness, at least a year before the onset of motor symptoms (see the section “Differential Di- 


620 Neurocognitive Disorders 


agnosis” for this disorder). Disease course may be characterized by occasional plateaus 
but eventually progresses through severe dementia to death. Average duration of survival 
is 5-7 years in clinical series. Onset of symptoms is typically observed from the sixth 
through the ninth decades of life, with most cases having their onset when affected indi- 
viduals are in their mid-70s. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Familial aggregation may occur, and several risk genes have 
been identified, but in most cases of NCDLB, there is no family history. 


Diagnostic Markers 


The underlying neurodegenerative disease is primarily a synucleinopathy due to alpha- 
synuclein misfolding and aggregation. Cognitive testing beyond the use of a brief screen- 
ing instrument may be necessary to define deficits clearly. Assessment scales developed to 
measure fluctuation can be useful. The associated condition REM sleep behavior disorder 
may be diagnosed through a formal sleep study or identified by questioning the patient or 
informant about relevant symptoms. Neuroleptic sensitivity (challenge) is not recom- 
mended as a diagnostic marker but raises suspicion of NCDLB if it occurs. A diagnosti- 
cally suggestive feature is low striatal dopamine transporter uptake on single photon 
emission computed tomography (SPECT) or positron emission tomography (PET) scan. 
Other clinically useful markers potentially include relative preservation of medial tempo- 
ral structures on computed tomography (CT)/magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) brain 
scan; reduced striatal dopamine transporter uptake on SPECT/PET scan; generalized low 
uptake on SPECT/PET perfusion scan with reduced occipital activity; abnormal (low up- 
take) MIBG myocardial scintigraphy suggesting sympathetic denervation; and prominent 
slow-wave activity on the electroencephalogram with temporal lobe transient waves. 


Functional Consequences of Major or Mild 
Neurocognitive Disorder With Lewy Bodies 


Individuals with NCDLB are more functionally impaired than would be expected for their 
cognitive deficits when contrasted to individuals with other neurodegenerative diseases, 
such as Alzheimer’s disease. This is largely a result of motor and autonomic impairments, 
which cause problems with toileting, transferring, and eating. Sleep disorders and prom- 
inent psychiatric symptoms may also add to functional difficulties. Consequently, the qual- 
ity of life of individuals with NCDLB is often significantly worse than that of individuals 
with Alzheimer’s disease. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Major or mild neurocognitive disorder due to Parkinson’s disease. A key differenti- 
ating feature in clinical diagnosis is the temporal sequence in which the parkinsonism and 
the NCD appear. For NCD due to Parkinson’s disease, the individual must develop cog- 
nitive decline in the context of established Parkinson’s disease; by convention, the decline 
should not reach the stage of major NCD until at least 1 year after Parkinson’s is diagnosed. 
If less than a year has passed since the onset of motor symptoms, the diagnosis is NCDLB. 
This distinction is clearer at the major NCD level than at the mild NCD level. 

The timing and sequence of parkinsonism and mild NCD may be more difficult to de- 
termine because the onset and clinical presentation can be ambiguous, and unspecified 
mild NCD should be diagnosed if the other core and suggestive features are absent. 


Major or Mild Vascular Neurocognitive Disorder 621 


Comorbidity 


Lewy body pathology frequently coexists with Alzheimer’s disease and cerebrovascular 
disease pathology, particularly among the oldest age groups. In Alzheimer’s disease, there 
is concomitant synuclein pathology in 60% of cases (if amygdala-restricted cases are in- 
cluded). In general, there is a higher rate of Lewy body pathology in individuals with de- 
mentia than in older individuals without dementia. 


Major or Mild Vascular Neurocognitive Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 
B. The clinical features are consistent with a vascular etiology, as suggested by either of 
the following: 


1. Onset of the cognitive deficits is temporally related to one or more cerebrovascular 
events. 

2. Evidence for decline is prominent in complex attention (including processing 
speed) and frontal-executive function. 


C. There is evidence of the presence of cerebrovascular disease from history, physical 
examination, and/or neuroimaging considered sufficient to account for the neurocog- 
nitive deficits. 

D. The symptoms are not better explained by another brain disease or systemic disorder. 


Probable vascular neurocognitive disorder is diagnosed if one of the following is pres- 
ent; otherwise possible vascular neurocognitive disorder should be diagnosed: 


1. Clinical criteria are supported by neuroimaging evidence of significant parenchymal in- 
jury attributed to cerebrovascular disease (neuroimaging-supported). 

2. The neurocognitive syndrome is temporally related to one or more documented cere- 
brovascular events. 

3. Both clinical and genetic (e.g., cerebral autosomal dominant arteriopathy with subcortical 
infarcts and leukoencephalopathy) evidence of cerebrovascular disease is present. 


Possible vascular neurocognitive disorder is diagnosed if the clinical criteria are met 
but neuroimaging is not available and the temporal relationship of the neurocognitive syn- 
drome with one or more cerebrovascular events is not established. 

Coding note: For probable major vascular neurocognitive disorder, with behavioral dis- 
turbance, code 290.40 (F01.51). For probable major vascular neurocognitive disorder, 
without behavioral disturbance, code 290.40 (F01.50). For possible major vascular neuro- 
cognitive disorder, with or without behavioral disturbance, code 331.9 (G31.9). An addi- 
tional medical code for the cerebrovascular disease is not needed. 

For mild vascular neurocognitive disorder, code 331.83 (G31.84). (Note: Do not use an 
additional code for the vascular disease. Behavioral disturbance cannot be coded but 
should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnosis of major or mild vascular neurocognitive disorder (NCD) requires the es- 
tablishment of an NCD (Criterion A) and the determination that cerebrovascular disease is 
the dominant if not exclusive pathology that accounts for the cognitive deficits (Criteria B 
and C). Vascular etiology may range from large vessel stroke to microvascular disease; the 


622 Neurocognitive Disorders 


presentation is therefore very heterogeneous, stemming from the types of vascular lesions 
and their extent and location. The lesions may be focal, multifocal, or diffuse and occur in 
various combinations. 

Many individuals with major or mild vascular NCD present with multiple infarctions, 
with an acute stepwise or fluctuating decline in cognition, and intervening periods of 
stability and even some improvement. Others may have gradual onset with slow pro- 
gression, a rapid development of deficits followed by relative stability, or another complex 
presentation. Major or mild vascular NCD with a gradual onset and slow progression is 
generally due to small vessel disease leading to lesions in the white matter, basal ganglia, 
and/or thalamus. The gradual progression in these cases is often punctuated by acute 
events that leave subtle neurological deficits. The cognitive deficits in these cases can be at- 
tributed to disruption of cortical-subcortical circuits, and complex attention, particularly 
speed of information processing, and executive ability are likely to be affected. 

Assessing for the presence of sufficient cerebrovascular disease relies on history, phys- 
ical examination, and neuroimaging (Criterion C). Etiological certainty requires the dem- 
onstration of abnormalities on neuroimaging. The lack of neuroimaging can result in 
significant diagnostic inaccuracy by overlooking “silent” brain infarction and white mat- 
ter lesions. However, if the neurocognitive impairment is temporally associated with one 
or more well-documented strokes, a probable diagnosis can be made in the absence of neu- 
roimaging. Clinical evidence of cerebrovascular disease includes documented history of 
stroke, with cognitive decline temporally associated with the event, or physical signs con- 
sistent with stroke (e.g., hemiparesis; pseudobulbar syndrome, visual field defect). Neuro- 
imaging (magnetic resonance imaging [MRI] or computed tomography [CT]) evidence of 
cerebrovascular disease comprises one or more of the following: one or more large vessel 
infarcts or hemorrhages, a strategically placed single infarct or hemorrhage (e.g., in angu- 
lar gyrus, thalamus, basal forebrain), two or more lacunar infarcts outside the brain stem, 
or extensive and confluent white matter lesions. The latter is often termed small vessel dis- 
ease or subcortical ischemic changes on clinical neuroimaging evaluations. 

For mild vascular NCD, history of a single stroke or extensive white matter disease is gen- 
erally sufficient. For major vascular NCD, two or more strokes, a strategically placed stroke, 
or a combination of white matter disease and one or more lacunes is generally necessary. 

The disorder must not be better explained by another disorder. For example, promi- 
nent memory deficit early in the course might suggest Alzheimer's disease, early and 
prominent parkinsonian features would suggest Parkinson's disease, and a close associa- 
tion between onset and depression would suggest depression. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A neurological assessment often reveals history of stroke and/or transient ischemic epi- 
sodes, and signs indicative of brain infarctions. Also commonly associated are personality 
and mood changes, abulia, depression, and emotional lability. The development of late- 
onset depressive symptoms accompanied by psychomotor slowing and executive dys- 
function is acommon presentation among older adults with progressive small vessel isch- 
emic disease (“vascular depression”). 


Prevalence 


Major or mild vascular NCD is the second most common cause of NCD after Alzheimer’s 
disease. In the United States, population prevalence estimates for vascular dementia range 
from 0.2% in the 65-70 years age group to 16% in individuals 80 years and older. Within 
3 months following stroke, 20%-30% of individuals are diagnosed with dementia. In neu- 
ropathology series, the prevalence of vascular dementia increases from 13% at age 70 years 
to 44.6% at age 90 years or older, in comparison with Alzheimer’s disease (23.6%-51%) and 
combined vascular dementia and Alzheimer’s disease (2%—46.4%). Higher prevalence has 


Major or Mild Vascular Neurocognitive Disorder 623 


been reported in African Americans compared with Caucasians, and in East Asian countries 
(e.g., Japan, China). Prevalence is higher in males than in females. 


Development and Course 


Major or mild vascular NCD can occur at any age, although the prevalence increases ex- 
ponentially after age 65 years. In older individuals, additional pathologies may partly ac- 
count for the neurocognitive deficits. The course may vary from acute onset with partial 
improvement to stepwise decline to progressive decline, with fluctuations and plateaus of 
varying durations. Pure subcortical major or mild vascular NCD can have a slowly pro- 
gressive course that simulates major or mild NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. The neurocognitive outcomes of vascular brain injury are influenced by 
neuroplasticity factors such as education, physical exercise, and mental activity. 


Genetic and physiological. The major risk factors for major or mild vascular NCD are the 
same as those for cerebrovascular disease, including hypertension, diabetes, smoking, obesity, 
high cholesterol levels, high homocysteine levels, other risk factors for atherosclerosis and ar- 
teriolosclerosis, atrial fibrillation, and other conditions increasing the risk of cerebral emboli. 
Cerebral amyloid angiopathy is an important risk factor in which amyloid deposits occur 
within arterial vessels. Another key risk factor is the hereditary condition cerebral autosomal 
dominant arteriopathy with subcortical infarcts and leukoencephalopathy, or CADASIL. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Structural neuroimaging, using MRI or CT, has an important role in the diagnostic pro- 
cess. There are no other established biomarkers of major or mild vascular NCD. 


Functional Consequences of 
Major or Mild Vascular Neurocognitive Disorder 


Major or mild vascular NCD is commonly associated with physical deficits that cause ad- 
ditional disability. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other neurocognitive disorders. Since incidental brain infarctions and white matter le- 
sions are common in older individuals, it is important to consider other possible etiologies 
when an NCD is present. A history of memory deficit early in the course, and progressive 
worsening of memory, language, executive function, and perceptual-motor abilities in the 
absence of corresponding focal lesions on brain imaging, are suggestive of Alzheimer’s 
disease as the primary diagnosis. Potential biomarkers currently being validated for Alz- 
heimer’s disease, such as cerebrospinal fluid levels of beta-amyloid and phosphorylated 
tau, and amyloid imaging, may prove to be helpful in the differential diagnosis. NCD with 
Lewy bodies is distinguished from major or mild vascular NCD by its core features of fluc- 
tuating cognition, visual hallucinations, and spontaneous parkinsonism. While deficits in 
executive function and language occur in major or mild vascular NCD, the insidious onset 
and gradual progression of behavioral features or language impairment are characteristic 
of frontotemporal NCD and are not typical of vascular etiology. 


Other medical conditions. A diagnosis of major or mild vascular NCD is not made if 
other diseases (e.g., brain tumor, multiple sclerosis, encephalitis, toxic or metabolic disor- 
ders) are present and are of sufficient severity to account for the cognitive impairment. 


624 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Other mental disorders. A diagnosis of major or mild vascular NCD is inappropriate if 
the symptoms can be entirely attributed to delirium, although delirium may sometimes be 
superimposed on a preexisting major or mild vascular NCD, in which case both diagnoses 
can be made. If the criteria for major depressive disorder are met and the cognitive impair- 
ment is temporally related to the likely onset of the depression, major or mild vascular 
NCD should not be diagnosed. However, if the NCD preceded the development of the de- 
pression, or the severity of the cognitive impairment is out of proportion to the severity of 
the depression, both should be diagnosed. 


Comorbidity 


Major or mild NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease commonly co-occurs with major or mild 
vascular NCD, in which case both diagnoses should be made. Major or mild vascular NCD 
and depression frequently co-occur. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
Due to Traumatic Brain Injury 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. There is evidence of a traumatic brain injury—that is, an impact to the head or other 
mechanisms of rapid movement or displacement of the brain within the skull, with one 
or more of the following: 


1. Loss of consciousness. 

2. Posttraumatic amnesia. 

3. Disorientation and confusion. 

4. Neurological signs (e.g., neuroimaging demonstrating injury; a new onset of sei- 
zures; a marked worsening of a preexisting seizure disorder; visual field cuts; an- 
osmia; hemiparesis). 


C. The neurocognitive disorder presents immediately after the occurrence of the trau- 
matic brain injury or immediately after recovery of consciousness and persists past the 
acute post-injury period. 


Coding note: For major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, with behavioral 
disturbance: For ICD-9-CM, first code 907.0 late effect of intracranial injury without skull frac- 
ture, followed by 294.11 major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, with be- 
havioral disturbance. For ICD-10-CM, first code S06.2X9S diffuse traumatic brain injury with 
loss of consciousness of unspecified duration, sequela; followed by F02.81 major neurocog- 
nitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, with behavioral disturbance. 

For major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, without behavioral distur- 
bance: For ICD-9-CM, first code 907.0 late effect of intracranial injury without skull fracture, 
followed by 294.10 major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, without be- 
havioral disturbance. For ICD-10-CM, first code S06.2X9S diffuse traumatic brain injury with 
loss of consciousness of unspecified duration, sequela; followed by F02.80 major neurocog- 
nitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, without behavioral disturbance. 

For mild neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, code 331.83 (G31.84). 
(Note: Do not use the additional code for traumatic brain injury. Behavioral disturbance 
cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing.) 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Traumatic Brain Injury 625 


Specifiers 
Rate the severity of the neurocognitive disorder (NCD), not the underlying traumatic brain 
injury (see the section “Development and Course” for this disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 


Major or mild NCD due to traumatic brain injury (TBI) is caused by an impact to the head, 
or other mechanisms of rapid movement or displacement of the brain within the skull, as 
can happen with blast injuries. Traumatic brain injury is defined as brain trauma with spe- 
cific characteristics that include at least one of the following: loss of consciousness, post- 
traumatic amnesia, disorientation and confusion, or, in more severe cases, neurological 
signs (e.g., positive neuroimaging, a new onset of seizures or a marked worsening of a pre- 
existing seizure disorder, visual field cuts, anosmia, hemiparesis) (Criterion B). To be at- 
tributable to TBI, the NCD must present either immediately after the brain injury occurs or 
immediately after the individual recovers consciousness after the injury and persist past 
the acute post-injury period (Criterion C). 

The cognitive presentation is variable. Difficulties in the domains of complex attention, 
executive ability, learning, and memory are common as well as slowing in speed of infor- 
mation processing and disturbances in social cognition. In more severe TBI in which there 
is brain contusion, intracranial hemorrhage, or penetrating injury, there may be additional 
neurocognitive deficits, such as aphasia, neglect, and constructional dyspraxia. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Major or mild NCD due to TBI may be accompanied by disturbances in emotional function 
(e.g., irritability, easy frustration, tension and anxiety, affective lability); personality 
changes (e.g., disinhibition, apathy, suspiciousness, aggression); physical disturbances 
(e.g., headache, fatigue, sleep disorders, vertigo or dizziness, tinnitus or hyperacusis, pho- 
tosensitivity, anosmia, reduced tolerance to psychotropic medications); and, particularly 
in more severe TBI, neurological symptoms and signs (e.g., seizures, hemiparesis, visual 
disturbances, cranial nerve deficits) and evidence of orthopedic injuries. 


Prevalence 


In the United States, 1.7 million TBIs occur annually, resulting in 1.4 million emergency de- 
partment visits, 275,000 hospitalizations, and 52,000 deaths. About 2% of the population 
lives with TBI-associated disability. Males account for 59% of TBIs in the United States. 
The most common etiologies of TBI in the United States are falls, vehicular accidents, and 
being struck on the head. Collisions and blows to the head that occur in the course of con- 
tact sports are increasingly recognized as sources of mild TBI, with a concern that repeated 
mild TBI may have cumulatively persisting sequelae. 


Development and Course 


The severity of a TBI is rated at the time of injury/initial assessment as mild, moderate, or 
severe according to the thresholds in Table 2. 

The severity rating of the TBI itself does not necessarily correspond to the severity of 
the resulting NCD. The course of recovery from TBI is variable, depending not only on the 
specifics of the injury but also on cofactors, such as age, prior history of brain damage, or 
substance abuse, that may favor or impede recovery. 


626 Neurocognitive Disorders 


TABLE 2 Severity ratings for traumatic brain injury 


Injury characteristic Mild TBI Moderate TBI Severe TBI 
Loss of consciousness <30 min 30 minutes—24 hours >24 hours 
Posttraumatic amnesia <24 hours 24 hours—7 days >7 days 
Disorientation and confusion 13-15 (notbelow13 9-12 3-8 

at initial assessment at 30 minutes) 

(Glasgow Coma Scale 

Score) 


Neurobehavioral symptoms tend to be most severe in the immediate aftermath of the 
TBI. Except in the case of severe TBI, the typical course is that of complete or substantial 
improvement in associated neurocognitive, neurological, and psychiatric symptoms and 
signs. Neurocognitive symptoms associated with mild TBI tend to resolve within days to 
weeks after the injury with complete resolution typical by 3 months. Other symptoms that 
may potentially co-occur with the neurological symptoms (e.g., depression, irritability, 
fatigue, headache, photosensitivity, sleep disturbance) also tend to resolve in the weeks 
following mild TBI. Substantial subsequent deterioration in these areas should trigger con- 
sideration of additional diagnoses. However, repeated mild TBI may be associated with 
persisting neurocognitive disturbance. 

With moderate and severe TBI, in addition to persistence of neurocognitive deficits, 
there may be associated neurophysiological, emotional, and behavioral complications. 
These include seizures (particularly in the first year), photosensitivity, hyperacusis, irritabil- 
ity, aggression, depression, sleep disturbance, fatigue, apathy, inability to resume occu- 
pational and social functioning at pre-injury level, and deterioration in interpersonal 
relationships. Moderate and severe TBI have been associated with increased risk of depres- 
sion, aggression, and possibly neurodegenerative diseases such as Alzheimer’s disease. 

The features of persisting major or mild NCD due to TBI will vary by age, specifics of 
the injury, and cofactors. Persisting TBI-related impairment in an infant or child may be re- 
flected in delays in reaching developmental milestones (e.g., language acquisition), worse 
academic performance, and possibly impaired social development. Among older teenag- 
ers and adults, persisting symptoms may include various neurocognitive deficits, irrita- 
bility, hypersensitivity to light and sound, easy fatigability, and mood changes, including 
depression, anxiety, hostility, or apathy. In older individuals with depleted cognitive re- 
serve, mild TBI is more likely to result in incomplete recoveries. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Risk factors for traumatic brain injury. Traumatic brain injury rates vary by age, with 
the highest prevalence among individuals younger than 4 years, older adolescents, and in- 
dividuals older than 65 years. Falls are the most common cause of TBI, with motor vehicle 
accidents being second. Sports concussions are frequent causes of TBI in older children, 
teenagers, and young adults. 


Risk factors for neurocognitive disorder after traumatic brain injury. Repeated con- 
cussions can lead to persistent NCD and neuropathological evidence of traumatic enceph- 
alopathy. Co-occurring intoxication with a substance may increase the severity of a TBI 
from a motor vehicle accident, but whether intoxication at the time of injury worsens neu- 
rocognitive outcome is unknown. 


Course modifiers. Mild TBI generally resolves within a few weeks to months, although res- 
olution may be delayed or incomplete in the context of repeated TBI. Worse outcome from 


Substance/Medication-Induced Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 627 


moderate to severe TBI is associated with older age (older than 40 years) and initial clinical pa- 
rameters, such as low Glasgow Coma Scale score; worse motor function; pupillary nonreac- 
tivity; and computed tomography (CT) evidence of brain injury (e.g., petechial hemorrhages, 
subarachnoid hemorrhage, midline shift, obliteration of third ventricle). 


Diagnostic Markers 


Beyond neuropsychological testing, CT scanning may reveal petechial hemorrhages, 
subarachnoid hemorrhage, or evidence of contusion. Magnetic resonance image scanning 
may also reveal hyperintensities suggestive of microhemorrhages. 


Functional Consequences of Major or Mild 


Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Traumatic Brain Injury 


With mild NCD due to TBI, individuals may report reduced cognitive efficiency, difficulty 
concentrating, and lessened ability to perform usual activities. With major NCD due to TBI, an 
individual may have difficulty in independent living and self-care. Prominent neuromotor 
features, such as severe incoordination, ataxia, and motor slowing, may be present in major 
NCD due to TBI and may add to functional difficulties. Individuals with TBI histories report 
more depressive symptoms, and these can amplify cognitive complaints and worsen func- 
tional outcome. Additionally, loss of emotional control, including aggressive or inappropriate 
affect and apathy, may be present after more severe TBI with greater neurocognitive impair- 
ment. These features may compound difficulties with independent living and self-care. 


Differential Diagnosis 


In some instances, severity of neurocognitive symptoms may appear to be inconsistent 
with the severity of the TBI. After previously undetected neurological complications (e.g., 
chronic hematoma) are excluded, the possibility of diagnoses such as somatic symptom 
disorder or factitious disorder need to be considered. Posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD) 
can co-occur with the NCD and have overlapping symptoms (e.g., difficulty concentrat- 
ing, depressed mood, aggressive behavioral disinhibition). 


Comorbidity 

Among individuals with substance use disorders, the neurocognitive effects of the sub- 
stance contribute to or compound the TBI-associated neurocognitive change. Some symp- 
toms associated with TBI may overlap with symptoms found in cases of PTSD, and the two 
disorders may co-occur, especially in military populations. 


Substance/Medication-Induced 
Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. The neurocognitive impairments do not occur exclusively during the course of a delir- 
ium and persist beyond the usual duration of intoxication and acute withdrawal. 

C. The involved substance or medication and duration and extent of use are capable of 
producing the neurocognitive impairment. 

D. The temporal course of the neurocognitive deficits is consistent with the timing of sub- 
stance or medication use and abstinence (e.g., the deficits remain stable or improve 
after a period of abstinence). 


628 Neurocognitive Disorders 


E. The neurocognitive disorder is not attributable to another medical condition or is not 
better explained by another mental disorder. 


Coding note: The ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM codes for the [specific substance/medica- 
tion]-induced neurocognitive disorders are indicated in the table below. Note that the ICD- 
10-CM code depends on whether or not there is a comorbid substance use disorder present 
for the same class of substance. If a mild substance use disorder is comorbid with the sub- 
stance-induced neurocognitive disorder, the 4th position character is “1,” and the clinician 
should record “mild [substance] use disorder’ before the substance-induced neurocognitive 
disorder (e.g., “mild inhalant use disorder with inhalant-induced major neurocognitive disor- 
der’). If a moderate or severe substance use disorder is comorbid with the substance- 
induced neurocognitive disorder, the 4th position character is “2,” and the clinician should 
record “moderate [substance] use disorder’ or “severe [substance] use disorder,” depending 
on the severity of the comorbid substance use disorder. If there is no comorbid substance 
use disorder, then the 4th position character is “9,” and the clinician should record only the 
substance-induced neurocognitive disorder. For some classes of substances (i.e., alcohol; 
sedatives, hypnotics, anxiolytics), it is not permissible to code a comorbid mild substance 
use disorder with a substance-induced neurocognitive disorder; only a comorbid moderate 
or severe substance use disorder, or no substance use disorder, can be diagnosed. Behav- 
ioral disturbance cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing. 


ICD-10-CM 


With use 
With use disorder, 
disorder, moderateor Without use 
ICD-9-CM mild severe disorder 


Alcohol (major neurocognitive 291.2 NA F10.27 F10.97 
disorder), nonamnestic- 
confabulatory type 


Alcohol (major neurocognitive 291.1 NA F10.26 F10.96 
disorder), amnestic- 
confabulatory type 


Alcohol (mild neurocognitive 291.89 NA F10.288 F10.988 
disorder) 

Inhalant (major neurocognitive 292.82 F18.17 F18.27 F18.97 
disorder) 

Inhalant (mild neurocognitive 292.89 F18.188 F18.288 F18.988 
disorder) 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 292.82 NA F13.27 F13.97 
(major neurocognitive disorder) 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic 292.89 NA F13.288 F13.988 
(mild neurocognitive disorder) 

Other (or unknown) substance 292.82 F19.17 F19.27 F19.97 
(major neurocognitive disorder) 

Other (or unknown) substance 292.89 F19.188 F19.288 F19.988 


(mild neurocognitive disorder) 


Substance/Medication-Induced Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 629 


Specify if: 
Persistent: Neurocognitive impairment continues to be significant after an extended 
period of abstinence. 


Recording Procedures 


ICD-9-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced neurocognitive disorder be- 
gins with the specific substance /medication (e.g., alcohol) that is presumed to be causing 
the neurocognitive symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in 
the criteria set, which is based on the drug class. For substances that do not fit into any of 
the classes, the code for “other substance” should be used; and in cases in which a substance 
is judged to be an etiological factor but the specific class of substance is unknown, the cat- 
egory “unknown substance” should be used. 

The name of the disorder (i.e., [specific substance]-induced major neurocognitive dis- 
order or [specific substance]-induced mild neurocognitive disorder) is followed by the 
type in the case of alcohol (i.e., nonamnestic-confabulatory type, amnestic-confabulatory 
type), followed by specification of duration (i.e., persistent). Unlike the recording procedures 
for ICD-10-CM, which combine the substance/medication-induced disorder and sub- 
stance use disorder into a single code, for ICD-9-CM a separate diagnostic code is given for 
the substance use disorder. For example, in the case of persistent amnestic-confabulatory 
symptoms in a man with a severe alcohol use disorder, the diagnosis is 291.1 alcohol- 
induced major neurocognitive disorder, amnestic-confabulatory type, persistent. An addi- 
tional diagnosis of 303.90 severe alcohol use disorder is also given. If the substance/medi- 
cation-induced neurocognitive disorder occurs without a comorbid substance use disorder 
(e.g., after a sporadic heavy use of inhalants), no accompanying substance use disorder is 
noted (e.g., 292.82 inhalant-induced mild neurocognitive disorder). 


ICD-10-CM. The name of the substance/medication-induced neurocognitive disorder 
begins with the specific substance (e.g., alcohol) that is presumed to be causing the neuro- 
cognitive symptoms. The diagnostic code is selected from the table included in the criteria 
set, which is based on the drug class and presence or absence of a comorbid substance use 
disorder. For substances that do not fit into any of the classes, the code for “other sub- 
stance” should be used; and in cases in which a substance is judged to be an etiological fac- 
tor but the specific class of substance is unknown, the category “unknown substance” 
should be used. 

When recording the name of the disorder, the comorbid substance use disorder (if any) is 
listed first, followed by the word “with,” followed by the name of the disorder (i.e., [specific 
substance]-induced major neurocognitive disorder or [specific substance]-induced mild 
neurocognitive disorder), followed by the type in the case of alcohol (i.e., nonamnestic-con- 
fabulatory type, amnestic-confabulatory type), followed by specification of duration (i.e., 
persistent). For example, in the case of persistent amnestic-confabulatory symptoms in a 
man with a severe alcohol use disorder, the diagnosis is F10.26 severe alcohol use disorder 
with alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, amnestic-confabulatory type, persis- 
tent. A separate diagnosis of the comorbid severe alcohol use disorder is not given. If the 
substance-induced neurocognitive disorder occurs without a comorbid substance use dis- 
order (e.g., after a sporadic heavy use of inhalants), no accompanying substance use disor- 
der is noted (e.g., F18.988 inhalant-induced mild neurocognitive disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 


Substance /medication-induced major or mild NCD is characterized by neurocognitive 
impairments that persist beyond the usual duration of intoxication and acute withdrawal 
(Criterion B). Initially, these manifestations can reflect slow recovery of brain functions 
from a period of prolonged substance use, and improvements in neurocognitive as well as 


630 Neurocognitive Disorders 


brain imaging indicators may be seen over many months. If the disorder continues for an 
extended period, persistent should be specified. The given substance and its use must be 
known to be capable of causing the observed impairments (Criterion C). While nonspecific 
decrements in a range of cognitive abilities can occur with nearly any substance of abuse 
and a variety of medications, some patterns occur more frequently with selected drug 
classes. For example, NCD due to sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic drugs (e.g., benzodiaz- 
epines, barbiturates) may show greater disturbances in memory than in other cognitive 
functions. NCD induced by alcohol frequently manifests with a combination of impair- 
ments in executive-function and memory and learning domains. The temporal course of 
the substance-induced NCD must be consistent with that of use of the given substance 
(Criterion D). In alcohol-induced amnestic confabulatory (Korsakoff’s) NCD, the features 
include prominent amnesia (severe difficulty learning new information with rapid forget- 
ting) and a tendency to confabulate. These manifestations may co-occur with signs of thi- 
amine encephalopathy (Wernicke’s encephalopathy) with associated features such as 
nystagmus and ataxia. Ophthalmoplegia of Wernicke’s encephalopathy is typically charac- 
terized by a lateral gaze paralysis. 

In addition to or independent of the more common neurocognitive symptoms related 
to methamphetamine use (e.g., difficulties with learning and memory; executive func- 
tion), methamphetamine use can also be associated with evidence of vascular injury (e.g., 
focal weakness, unilateral incoordination, asymmetrical reflexes). The most common neu- 
rocognitive profile approximates that seen in vascular NCD. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Intermediate-duration NCD induced by drugs with central nervous system depressant effects 
may manifest with added symptoms of increased irritability, anxiety, sleep disturbance, and 
dysphoria. Intermediate-duration NCD induced by stimulant drugs may manifest with re- 
bound depression, hypersomnia, and apathy. In severe forms of substance/medication- 
induced major NCD (e.g., associated with long-term alcohol use), there may be prominent 
neuromotor features, such as incoordination, ataxia, and motor slowing. There may also be 
loss of emotional control, including aggressive or inappropriate affect, or apathy. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of these conditions is not known. Prevalence figures for substance abuse are 
available, and substance/medication-induced major or mild NCDs are more likely in those 
who are older, have longer use, and have other risk factors such as nutritional deficits. 

For alcohol abuse, the rate of mild NCD of intermediate duration is approximately 30%- 
40% in the first 2 months of abstinence. Mild NCD may persist, particularly in those who do 
not achieve stable abstinence until after age 50 years. Major NCD is rare and may result from 
concomitant nutritional deficits, as in alcohol-induced amnestic confabulatory NCD. 

For individuals quitting cocaine, methamphetamine, opioids, phencyclidine, and sed- 
ative, hypnotics, or anxiolytics, substance /medication-induced mild NCD of intermediate 
duration may occur in one-third or more, and there is some evidence that these substances 
may also be associated with persistent mild NCD. Major NCD associated with these sub- 
stances is rare, if it occurs at all. In the case of methamphetamine, cerebrovascular disease 
can also occur, resulting in diffuse or focal brain injury that can be of mild or major neu- 
rocognitive levels. Solvent exposure has been linked to both major and mild NCD of both 
intermediate and persistent duration. 

The presence of NCD induced by cannabis and various hallucinogens is controversial. 
With cannabis, intoxication is accompanied by various neurocognitive disturbances, but 
these tend to clear with abstinence. 


Substance/Medication-Induced Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 631 


Development and Course 


Substance use disorders tend to commence during adolescence and peak in the 20s and 
30s. Although longer history of severe substance use disorder is associated with greater 
likelihood of NCD, the relationships are not straightforward, with substantial and even 
complete recovery of neurocognitive functions being common among individuals who 
achieve stable abstinence prior to age 50 years. Substance/medication-induced major or 
mild NCD is most likely to become persistent in individuals who continue abuse of sub- 
stances past age 50 years, presumably because of a combination of lessened neural plas- 
ticity and beginnings of other age-related brain changes. Earlier commencement of abuse, 
particularly of alcohol, may lead to defects in later neural development (e.g., later stages of 
maturation of frontal circuitries), which may have effects on social cognition as well as 
other neurocognitive abilities. For alcohol-induced NCD, there may be an additive effect 
of aging and alcohol-induced brain injury. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Risk factors for substance /medication-induced NCDs include older age, longer use, and 
persistent use past age 50 years. In addition, for alcohol-induced NCD, long-term nutri- 
tional deficiencies, liver disease, vascular risk factors, and cardiovascular and cerebrovas- 
cular disease may contribute to risk. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) of individuals with chronic alcohol abuse frequently 
reveals cortical thinning, white matter loss, and enlargement of sulci and ventricles. While 
neuroimaging abnormalities are more common in those with NCDs, it is possible to ob- 
serve NCDs without neuroimaging abnormalities, and vice versa. Specialized techniques 
(e.g., diffusion tensor imaging) may reveal damage to specific white matter tracts. Mag- 
netic resonance spectroscopy may reveal reduction in N-acetylaspartate, and increase in 
markers of inflammation (e.g., myoinositol) or white matter injury (e.g., choline). Many of 
these brain imaging changes and neurocognitive manifestations reverse following suc- 
cessful abstinence. In individuals with methamphetamine use disorder, MRI may also re- 
veal hyperintensities suggestive of microhemorrhages or larger areas of infarction. 


Functional Consequences of Substance/Medication- 
Induced Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 


The functional consequences of substance/medication-induced mild NCD are sometimes 
augmented by reduced cognitive efficiency and difficulty concentrating beyond that seen 
in many other NCDs. In addition, at both major and mild levels, substance /medication- 
induced NCDs may have associated motor syndromes that increase the level of functional 
impairment. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Individuals with substance use disorders, substance intoxication, and substance withdrawal 
are at increased risk for other conditions that may independently, or through a compounding 
effect, result in neurocognitive disturbance. These include history of traumatic brain injury 
and infections that can accompany substance use disorder (e.g., HIV, hepatitis C virus, syph- 
ilis). Therefore, presence of substance/medication-induced major or mild NCD should be 
differentiated from NCDs arising outside the context of substance use, intoxication, and with- 
drawal, including these accompanying conditions (e.g., traumatic brain injury). 


632 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Comorbidity 


Substance use disorders, substance intoxication, and substance withdrawal are highly co- 
morbid with other mental disorders. Comorbid posttraumatic stress disorder, psychotic 
disorders, depressive and bipolar disorders, and neurodevelopmental disorders can con- 
tribute to neurocognitive impairment in substance users. Traumatic brain injury occurs 
more frequently with substance use, complicating efforts to determine the etiology of NCD 
in such cases. Severe, long-term alcohol use disorder can be associated with major organ 
system disease, including cerebrovascular disease and cirrhosis. Amphetamine-induced 
NCD may be accompanied by major or mild vascular NCD, also secondary to amphet- 
amine use. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
Due to HIV Infection 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. There is documented infection with human immunodeficiency virus (HIV). 

C. The neurocognitive disorder is not better explained by non-HIV conditions, including 
secondary brain diseases such as progressive multifocal leukoencephalopathy or 
cryptococcal meningitis. 

D. The neurocognitive disorder is not attributable to another medical condition and is not 
better explained by a mental disorder. 

Coding note: For major neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection, with behavioral dis- 
turbance, code first 042 (B20) HIV infection, followed by 294.11 (F02.81) major neurocog- 
nitive disorder due to HIV infection, with behavioral disturbance. For major neurocognitive 
disorder due to HIV infection, without behavioral disturbance, code first 042 (B20) HIV in- 
fection, followed by 294.10 (F02.80) major neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection, 
without behavioral disturbance. 

For mild neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection, code 331.83 (G31.84). (Note: Do 

not use the additional code for HIV infection. Behavioral disturbance cannot be coded but 

should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


HIV disease is caused by infection with human immunodeficiency virus type-1 (HIV-1), 
which is acquired through exposure to bodily fluids of an infected person through injection 
drug use, unprotected sexual contact, or accidental or iatrogenic exposure (e.g., contami- 
nated blood supply, needle puncture injury to medical personnel). HIV infects several types 
of cells, most particularly immune cells. Over time, the infection can cause severe depletion 
of “T-helper” (CD4) lymphocytes, resulting in severe immunocompromise, often leading to 
opportunistic infections and neoplasms. This advanced form of HIV infection is termed 
acquired immune deficiency syndrome (AIDS). Diagnosis of HIV is confirmed by established 
laboratory methods such as enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay for HIV antibody with 
Western blot confirmation and/or polymerase chain reaction—based assays for HIV. 

Some individuals with HIV infection develop an NCD, which generally shows a “sub- 
cortical pattern” with prominently impaired executive function, slowing of processing 
speed, problems with more demanding attentional tasks, and difficulty in learning new 
information, but fewer problems with recall of learned information. In major NCD, slow- 
ing may be prominent. Language difficulties, such as aphasia, are uncommon, although 
reductions in fluency may be observed. HIV pathogenic processes can affect any part of 
the brain; therefore, other patterns are possible. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to HIV Infection 633 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Major or mild NCD due to HIV infection is usually more prevalent in individuals with 
prior episodes of severe immunosuppression, high viral loads in the cerebrospinal fluid, 
and indicators of advanced HIV disease such as anemia and hypoalbuminemia. Individ- 
uals with advanced NCD may experience prominent neuromotor features such as severe 
incoordination, ataxia, and motor slowing. There may be loss of emotional control, includ- 
ing aggressive or inappropriate affect or apathy. 


Prevalence 


Depending on stage of HIV disease, approximately one-third to over one-half of HIV- 
infected individuals have at least mild neurocognitive disturbance, but some of these dis- 
turbances may not meet the full criteria for mild NCD. An estimated 25% of individuals 
with HIV will have signs and symptoms that meet criteria for mild NCD, and in fewer than 
5% would criteria for major NCD be met. 


Development and Course 


An NCD due to HIV infection can resolve, improve, slowly worsen, or have a fluctuating 
course. Rapid progression to profound neurocognitive impairment is uncommon in the 
context of currently available combination antiviral treatment; consequently, an abrupt 
change in mental status in an individual with HIV may prompt an evaluation of other 
medical sources for the cognitive change, including secondary infections. Because HIV in- 
fection preferentially affects subcortical regions over the course of illness, including deep 
white matter, the progression of the disorder follows a “subcortical” pattern. Since HIV 
can affect a variety of brain regions, and the illness can take on many different trajectories 
depending on associated comorbidities and consequences of HIV, the overall course of an 
NCD due to HIV infection has considerable heterogeneity. A subcortical neurocognitive 
profile may interact with age over the life course, when psychomotor slowing and motor 
impairments such as slowed gait may occur as a consequence of other age-related condi- 
tions so that the overall progression may appear more pronounced in later life. 

In developed countries, HIV disease is primarily a condition of adults, with acquisition 
via risky behaviors (e.g., unprotected sex, injection drug use) beginning in late adolescence 
and peaking during young and middle adulthood. In developing countries, particularly 
sub-Saharan Africa, where HIV testing and antiretroviral treatments for pregnant women 
are not readily available, perinatal transmission is common. The NCD in such infants and 
children may present primarily as neurodevelopmental delay. As individuals treated for 
HIV survive into older age, additive and interactive neurocognitive effects of HIV and 
aging, including other NCDs (e.g., due to Alzheimer’s disease, due to Parkinson’s dis- 
ease), are possible. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Risk and prognostic factors for HIV infection. Risk factors for HIV infection include injec- 
tion drug use, unprotected sex, and unprotected blood supply and other iatrogenic factors. 


Risk and prognostic factors for major or mild neurocognitive disorder due to HIV in- 
fection. Paradoxically, NCD due to HIV infection has not declined significantly with the 
advent of combined antiretroviral therapy, although the most severe presentations (con- 
sistent with the diagnosis of major NCD) have decreased sharply. Contributory factors 
may include inadequate control of HIV in the central nervous system (CNS), the evolution 
of drug-resistant viral strains, the effects of chronic long-term systemic and brain inflam- 
mation, and the effects of comorbid factors such as aging, drug abuse, past history of CNS 
trauma, and co-infections, such as with the hepatitis C virus. Chronic exposure to antiret- 
roviral drugs also raises the possibility of neurotoxicity, although this has not been defin- 
itively established. 


634 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Diagnostic Markers 


Serum HIV testing is required for the diagnosis. In addition, HIV characterization of the cere- 
brospinal fluid may be helpful if it reveals a disproportionately high viral load in cerebrospinal 
fluid versus in the plasma. Neuroimaging (i.e., magnetic resonance imaging [MRI]) may reveal 
reduction in total brain volume, cortical thinning, reduction in white matter volume, and 
patchy areas of abnormal white matter (hyperintensities). MRI or lumbar puncture may be 
helpful to exclude a specific medical condition such as cryptococcus infection or herpes en- 
cephalitis that may contribute to CNS changes in the context of AIDS. Specialized techniques 
such as diffusion tensor imaging may reveal damage to specific white matter tracts. 


Functional Consequences of Major or Mild 
Neurocognitive Disorder Due to HIV Infection 


Functional consequences of major or mild NCD due to HIV infection are variable across 
individuals. Thus, impaired executive abilities and slowed information processing may 
substantially interfere with the complex disease management decisions required for ad- 
herence to the combined antiretroviral therapy regimen. The likelihood of comorbid dis- 
ease may further create functional challenges. 


Differential Diagnosis 


In the presence of comorbidities, such as other infections (e.g., hepatitis C virus, syphilis), 
drug abuse (e.g., methamphetamine abuse), or prior head injury or neurodevelopmental 
conditions, major or mild NCD due to HIV infection can be diagnosed provided there is ev- 
idence that infection with HIV has worsened any NCDs due to such preexisting or comorbid 
conditions. Among older adults, onset of neurocognitive decline related to cerebrovascular 
disease or neurodegeneration (e.g., major or mild NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease) may 
need to be differentiated. In general, stable, fluctuating (without progression) or improving 
neurocognitive status would favor an HIV etiology, whereas steady or stepwise deter- 
ioration would suggest neurodegenerative or vascular etiology. Because more severe im- 
munodeficiency can result in opportunistic infections of the brain (e.g., toxoplasmosis; 
cryptococcosis) and neoplasia (e.g., CNS lymphoma), sudden onset of an NCD or sudden 
worsening of that disorder demands active investigation of non-HIV etiologies. 


Comorbidity 

HIV disease is accompanied by chronic systemic and neuro-inflammation that can be as- 
sociated with cerebrovascular disease and metabolic syndrome. These complications can 
be part of the pathogenesis of major or mild NCD due to HIV infection. HIV frequently co- 
occurs with conditions such as substance use disorders when the substance has been in- 
jected and other sexually transmitted disorders. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
Due to Prion Disease 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. There is insidious onset, and rapid progression of impairment is common. 

C. There are motor features of prion disease, such as myoclonus or ataxia, or biomarker 
evidence. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Prion Disease 635 


D. The neurocognitive disorder is not attributable to another medical condition and is not 
better explained by another mental disorder. 


Coding note: For major neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease, with behavioral dis- 
turbance, code first 046.79 (A81.9) prion disease, followed by 294.11 (F02.81) major 
neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease, with behavioral disturbance. For major neu- 
rocognitive disorder due to prion disease, without behavioral disturbance, code first 
046.79 (A81.9) prion disease, followed by 294.10 (F02.80) major neurocognitive disorder 
due to prion disease, without behavioral disturbance. 

For mild neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease, code 331.83 (G31.84). (Note: Do 
not use the additional code for prion disease. Behavioral disturbance cannot be coded but 
should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


The classification of major or mild neurocognitive disorder (NCD) due to prion disease in- 
cludes NCDs due to a group of subacute spongiform encephalopathies (including Creutz- 
feldt-Jakob disease, variant Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease, kuru, Gerstmann-Straussler- 
Scheinker syndrome, and fatal insomnia) caused by transmissible agents known as prions. 
The most common type is sporadic Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease, typically referred to as 
Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease (CJD). Variant CJD is much rarer and is associated with trans- 
mission of bovine spongiform encephalopathy, also called “mad cow disease.” Typically, 
individuals with CJD present with neurocognitive deficits, ataxia, and abnormal move- 
ments such as myoclonus, chorea, or dystonia; a startle reflex is also common. Typically, 
the history reveals rapid progression to major NCD over as little as 6 months, and thus the 
disorder is typically seen only at the major level. However, many individuals with the dis- 
order may have atypical presentations, and the disease can be confirmed only by biopsy or 
at autopsy. Individuals with variant CJD may present with a greater preponderance of 
psychiatric symptoms, characterized a by low mood, withdrawal, and anxiety. Prion dis- 
ease is typically not diagnosed without at least one of the characteristic biomarker fea- 
tures: recognized lesions on magnetic resonance imaging with DWI (diffusion-weighted 
imaging) or FLAIR (fluid-attenuated inversion recovery), tau or 14-3-3 protein in cerebro- 
spinal fluid, characteristic triphasic waves on electroencephalogram, or, for rare familial 
forms, family history or genetic testing. 


Prevalence 


The annual incidence of sporadic CJD is approximately one or two cases per million peo- 
ple. Prevalence is unknown but very low given the short survival. 


Development and Course 


Prion disease may develop at any age in adults—the peak age for the sporadic CJD is ap- 
proximately 67 years—although it has been reported to occur in individuals spanning the 
teenage years to late life. Prodromal symptoms of prion disease may include fatigue, anx- 
iety, problems with appetite or sleeping, or difficulties with concentration. After several 
weeks, these symptoms may be followed by incoordination, altered vision, or abnormal 
gait or other movements that may be myoclonic, choreoathetoid, or ballistic, along with a 
rapidly progressive dementia. The disease typically progresses very rapidly to the major 
level of impairment over several months. More rarely, it can progress over 2 years and ap- 
pear similar in its course to other NCDs. 


636 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Risk Factors and Prognosis 


Environmental. Cross-species transmission of prion infections, with agents that are 
closely related to the human form, has been demonstrated (e.g., the outbreak of bovine 
spongiform encephalopathy inducing variant CJD in the United Kingdom during the mid- 
1990s). Transmission by corneal transplantation and by human growth factor injection has 
been documented, and anecdotal cases of transmission to health care workers have been 
reported. 


Genetic and physiological. There is a genetic component in up to 15% of cases, associ- 
ated with an autosomal dominant mutation. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Prion disease can be definitively confirmed only by biopsy or at autopsy. Although there are 
no distinctive findings on cerebrospinal fluid analysis across the prion diseases, reliable bio- 
markers are being developed and include 14-3-3 protein (particularly for sporadic CJD) as 
well as tau protein. Magnetic resonance brain imaging is currently considered the most sen- 
sitive diagnostic test when DWI is performed, with the most common finding being multi- 
focal gray matter hyperintensities in subcortical and cortical regions. In some individuals, 
the electroencephalogram reveals periodic sharp, often triphasic and synchronous dis- 
charges at a rate of 0.5-2 Hz at some point during the course of the disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other major neurocognitive disorders. Major NCD due to prion disease may appear 
similar in its course to other NCDs, but prion diseases are typically distinguished by their 
rapid progression and prominent cerebellar and motor symptoms. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
Due to Parkinson’s Disease 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. The disturbance occurs in the setting of established Parkinson’s disease. 

C. There is insidious onset and gradual progression of impairment. 

D. The neurocognitive disorder is not attributable to another medical condition and is not 
better explained by another mental disorder. 


Major or mild neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s disease should 
be diagnosed if 1 and 2 are both met. Major or mild neurocognitive disorder possibly 
due to Parkinson’s disease should be diagnosed if 1 or 2 is met: 


1. There is no evidence of mixed etiology (i.e., absence of other neurodegenerative or 
cerebrovascular disease or another neurological, mental, or systemic disease or con- 
dition likely contributing to cognitive decline). 

2. The Parkinson’s disease clearly precedes the onset of the neurocognitive disorder. 


Coding note: For major neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s disease, 
with behavioral disturbance, code first 332.0 (G20) Parkinson’s disease, followed by 
294.11 (F02.81) major neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s disease, with 
behavioral disturbance. For major neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s 
disease, without behavioral disturbance, code first 332.0 (G20) Parkinson’s disease, fol- 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Parkinson’s Disease 637 


lowed by 294.10 (F02.80) major neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s dis- 
ease, without behavioral disturbance. 

For major neurocognitive disorder possibly due to Parkinson’s disease, code 331.9 
(G31.9) major neurocognitive disorder possibly due to Parkinson’s disease. (Note: Do not 
use the additional code for Parkinson’s disease. Behavioral disturbance cannot be coded 
but should still be indicated in writing.) 

For mild neurocognitive disorder due to Parkinson’s disease, code 331.83 (G31.84). 
(Note: Do not use the additional code for Parkinson’s disease. Behavioral disturbance 
cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of major or mild neurocognitive disorder (NCD) due to Parkinson’s 
disease is cognitive decline following the onset of Parkinson’s disease. The disturbance 
must occur in the setting of established Parkinson’s disease (Criterion B), and deficits must 
have developed gradually (Criterion C). The NCD is viewed as probably due to Parkinson’s 
disease when there is no evidence of another disorder that might be contributing to the 
cognitive decline and when the Parkinson’s disease clearly precedes onset of the NCD. The 
NCD is considered possibly due to Parkinson’s disease either when there is no evidence of 
another disorder that might be contributing to the cognitive decline or when the Parkin- 
son’s disease precedes onset of the NCD, but not both. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Frequently present features include apathy, depressed mood, anxious mood, hallucina- 
tions, delusions, personality changes, rapid eye movement sleep behavior disorder, and 
excessive daytime sleepiness. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of Parkinson's disease in the United States steadily increases with age from 
approximately 0.5% between ages 65 and 69 to 3% at age 85 years and older. Parkinson’s 
disease is more common in males than in females. Among individuals with Parkinson’s 
disease, as many as 75% will develop a major NCD sometime in the course of their disease. 
The prevalence of mild NCD in Parkinson’s disease has been estimated at 27%. 


Development and Course 

Onset of Parkinson’s disease is typically between the sixth and ninth decades of life, with 
most expression in the early 60s. Mild NCD often develops relatively early in the course of 
Parkinson’s disease, whereas major impairment typically does not occur until late. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Risk factors for Parkinson’s disease include exposure to herbicides and 
pesticides. 


Genetic and physiological. Potential risk factors for NCD among individuals with Par- 
kinson’s disease include older age at disease onset and increasing duration of disease. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Neuropsychological testing, with a focus on tests that do not rely on motor function, is crit- 
ical in detecting the core cognitive deficits, particularly at the mild NCD phase. Structural 
neuroimaging and dopamine transporter scans, such as DaT scans, may differentiate 
Lewy body-related dementias (Parkinson’s and dementia with Lewy bodies) from non- 


638 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Lewy body-related dementias (e.g., Alzheimer’s disease) and can sometimes be helpful in 
the evaluation of major or mild NCD due to Parkinson’s disease. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Major or mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies. This distinction is based sub- 
stantially on the timing and sequence of motor and cognitive symptoms. For NCD to be at- 
tributed to Parkinson’s disease, the motor and other symptoms of Parkinson’s disease must 
be present well before (by convention, at least 1 year prior) cognitive decline has reached 
the level of major NCD, whereas in major or mild NCD with Lewy bodies, cognitive symp- 
toms begin shortly before, or concurrent with, motor symptoms. For mild NCD, the timing 
is harder to establish because the diagnosis itself is less clear and the two disorders exist on 
a continuum. Unless Parkinson’s disease has been established for some time prior to the 
onset of cognitive decline, or typical features of major or mild NCD with Lewy bodies are 
present, it is preferable to diagnose unspecified mild NCD. 


Major or mild neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease. The motor features 
are the key to distinguishing major or mild NCD due to Parkinson’s disease from major or 
mild NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease. However, the two disorders can co-occur. 


Major or mild vascular neurocognitive disorder. Major or mild vascular NCD may pre- 
sent with parkinsonian features such as psychomotor slowing that may occur as a conse- 
quence of subcortical small vessel disease. However, the parkinsonian features typically 
are not sufficient for a diagnosis of Parkinson’s disease, and the course of the NCD usually 
has a clear association with cerebrovascular changes. 


Neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition (e.g., neurodegenerative 
disorders). When a diagnosis of major or mild NCD due to Parkinson’s disease is being 
considered, the distinction must also be made from other brain disorders, such as progres- 
sive supranuclear palsy, corticobasal degeneration, multiple system atrophy, tumors, and 
hydrocephalus. 

Neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism. Neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism can occur in 
individuals with other NCDs, particularly when dopamine-blocking drugs are prescribed 
for the behavioral manifestations of such disorders 

Other medical conditions. Delirium and NCDs due to side effects of dopamine-blocking 
drugs and other medical conditions (e.g., sedation or impaired cognition, severe hypothy- 
roidism, Bj» deficiency) must also be ruled out. 


Comorbidity 

Parkinson’s disease may coexist with Alzheimer’s disease and cerebrovascular disease, espe- 
cially in older individuals. The compounding of multiple pathological features may diminish 
the functional abilities of individuals with Parkinson’s disease. Motor symptoms and frequent 
co-occurrence of depression or apathy can make functional impairment worse. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
Due to Huntington’s Disease 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. There is insidious onset and gradual progression. 

C. There is clinically established Huntington’s disease, or risk for Huntington’s disease 
based on family history or genetic testing. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Huntington’s Disease 639 


D. The neurocognitive disorder is not attributable to another medical condition and is not 
better explained by another mental disorder. 


Coding note: For major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, with behav- 
ioral disturbance, code first 333.4 (G10) Huntington’s disease, followed by 294.11 
(F02.81) major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, with behavioral dis- 
turbance. For major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, without behav- 
ioral disturbance, code first 333.4 (G10) Huntington’s disease, followed by 294.10 (F02.80) 
major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, without behavioral disturbance. 
For mild neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, code 331.83 (G31.84). 
(Note: Do not use the additional code for Huntington’s disease. Behavioral disturbance 
cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


Progressive cognitive impairment is a core feature of Huntington’s disease, with early changes 
in executive function (i.e., processing speed, organization, and planning) rather than learn- 
ing and memory. Cognitive and associated behavioral changes often precede the emergence 
of the typical motor abnormalities of bradykinesia (i.e., slowing of voluntary movement) 
and chorea (i.e., involuntary jerking movements). A diagnosis of definite Huntington’s dis- 
ease is given in the presence of unequivocal, extrapyramidal motor abnormalities in an in- 
dividual with either a family history of Huntington’s disease or genetic testing showing a 
CAG trinucleotide repeat expansion in the HTT gene, located on chromosome 4. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Depression, irritability, anxiety, obsessive-compulsive symptoms, and apathy are fre- 
quently, and psychosis more rarely, associated with Huntington’s disease and often pre- 
cede the onset of motor symptoms. 


Prevalence 


Neurocognitive deficits are an eventual outcome of Huntington’s disease; the worldwide 
prevalence is estimated to be 2.7 per 100,000. The prevalence of Huntington’s disease in 
North America, Europe, and Australia is 5.7 per 100,000, with a much lower prevalence of 
0.40 per 100,000 in Asia. 


Development and Course 


The average age at diagnosis of Huntington’s disease is approximately 40 years, although 
this varies widely. Age at onset is inversely correlated with CAG expansion length. Juve- 
nile Huntington’s disease (onset before age 20) may present more commonly with brady- 
kinesia, dystonia, and rigidity than with the choreic movements characteristic of the adult- 
onset disorder. The disease is gradually progressive, with median survival approximately 
15 years after motor symptom diagnosis. 

Phenotypic expression of Huntington’s disease varies by presence of motor, cognitive, 
and psychiatric symptoms. Psychiatric and cognitive abnormalities can predate the motor 
abnormality by at least 15 years. Initial symptoms requiring care often include irritabity, 
anxiety, or depressed mood. Other behavioral disturbances may include pronounced ap- 
athy, disinhibition, impulsivity, and impaired insight, with apathy often becoming more 
progressive over time. Early movement symptoms may involve the appearance of fidget- 
iness of the extremities as well as mild apraxia (i.e., difficulty with purposeful movements), 
particularly with fine motor tasks. As the disorder progresses, other motor problems in- 
clude impaired gait (ataxia) and postural instability. Motor impairment eventually affects 
speech production (dysarthria) such that the speech becomes very difficult to understand, 


640 Neurocognitive Disorders 


which may result in significant distress resulting from the communication barrier in the 
context of comparatively intact cognition. Advanced motor disease severely affects gait 
with progressive ataxia. Eventually individuals become nonambulatory. End-stage motor 
disease impairs motor control of eating and swallowing, typically a major contributor to 
the death of the individual from aspiration pneumonia. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. The genetic basis of Huntington’s disease is a fully penetrant 
autosomal dominant expansion of the CAG trincleotide, often called a CAG repeat in the 
huntingtin gene. A repeat length of 36 or more is invariably associated with Huntington’s 
disease, with longer repeat lengths associated with early age at onset. A CAG repeat length 
of 36 or more is invariably associated with Huntington’s disease. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Genetic testing is the primary laboratory test for the determination of Huntington's dis- 
ease, which is an autosomal dominant disorder with complete penetrance. The trinucleo- 
tide CAG is observed to have a repeat expansion in the gene that encodes huntingtin 
protein on chromosome 4. A diagnosis of Huntington’s disease is not made in the presence 
of the gene expansion alone, but the diagnosis is made only after symptoms become man- 
ifest. Some individuals with a positive family history request genetic testing in a presymp- 
tomatic stage. Associated features may also include neuroimaging changes; volume loss in 
the basal ganglia, particularly the caudate nucleus and putamen, is well known to occur 
and progresses over the course of illness. Other structural and functional changes have 
been observed in brain imaging but remain research measures. 


Functional Consequences of Major or Mild 
Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Huntington’s Disease 


In the prodromal phase of illness and at early diagnosis, occupational decline is most com- 
mon, with most individuals reporting some loss of ability to engage in their typical work. 
The emotional, behavioral, and cognitive aspects of Huntington’s disease, such as disin- 
hibition and personality changes, are highly associated with functional decline. Cognitive 
deficits that contribute most to functional decline may include speed of processing, initi- 
ation, and attention rather than memory impairment. Given that Huntington’s disease on- 
set occurs in productive years of life, it may have a very disruptive effect on performance 
in the work setting as well as social and family life. As the disease progresses, disability 
from problems such as impaired gait, dysarthria, and impulsive or irritable behaviors may 
substantially add to the level of impairment and daily care needs, over and above the care 
needs attributable to the cognitive decline. Severe choreic movements may substantially 
interfere with provision of care such as bathing, dressing, and toileting. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders. Early symptoms of Huntington’s disease may include instabil- 
ity of mood, irritability, or compulsive behaviors that may suggest another mental disor- 
der. However, genetic testing or the development of motor symptoms will distinguish the 
presence of Huntington’s disease. 


Other neurocognitive disorders. The early symptoms of Huntington’s disease, particu- 
larly symptoms of executive dysfunction and impaired psychomotor speed, may resemble 
other neurocognitive disorders (NCDs), such as major or mild vascular NCD. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder Due to Another Medical Condition 641 


Other movement disorders. Huntington’s disease must also be differentiated from other 
disorders or conditions associated with chorea, such as Wilson’s disease, drug-induced 
tardive dyskinesia, Sydenham’s chorea, systemic lupus erythematosus, or senile chorea. 
Rarely, individuals may present with a course similar to that of Huntington’s disease but 
without positive genetic testing; this is considered to be a Huntington’s disease pheno- 
copy that results from a variety of potential genetic factors. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the 
neurocognitive disorder is the pathophysiological consequence of another medical 
condition. 

C. The cognitive deficits are not better explained by another mental disorder or another 
specific neurocognitive disorder (e.g., Alzheimer’s disease, HIV infection). 


Coding note: For major neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition, with 
behavioral disturbance, code first the other medical condition, followed by the major neu- 
rocognitive disorder due to another medical condition, with behavioral disturbance (e.g., 
340 [G35] multiple sclerosis, 294.11 [F02.81] major neurocognitive disorder due to multi- 
ple sclerosis, with behavioral disturbance). For major neurocognitive disorder due to an- 
other medical condition, without behavioral disturbance, code first the other medical 
condition, followed by the major neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition, 
without behavioral disturbance (e.g., 340 [G35] multiple sclerosis, 294.10 [F02.80] major 
neurocognitive disorder due to multiple sclerosis, without behavioral disturbance). 

For mild neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition, code 331.83 (G31.84). 
(Note: Do not use the additional code for the other medical condition. Behavioral distur- 
bance cannot be coded but should still be indicated in writing.) 


Diagnostic Features 


A number of other medical conditions can cause neurocognitive disorders (NCDs). These 
conditions include structural lesions (e.g., primary or secondary brain tumors, subdural 
hematoma, slowly progressive or normal-pressure hydrocephalus), hypoxia related to hy- 
poperfusion from heart failure, endocrine conditions (e.g., hypothyroidism, hypercalce- 
mia, hypoglycemia), nutritional conditions (e.g., deficiencies of thiamine or niacin), other 
infectious conditions (e.g., neurosyphilis, cryptococcosis), immune disorders (e.g., tempo- 
ral arteritis, systemic lupus erythematosus), hepatic or renal failure, metabolic conditions 
(e.g., Kufs’ disease, adrenoleukodystrophy, metachromatic leukodystrophy, other storage 
diseases of adulthood and childhood), and other neurological conditions (e.g., epilepsy, 
multiple sclerosis). Unusual causes of central nervous system injury, such as electrical 
shock or intracranial radiation, are generally evident from the history. The temporal asso- 
ciation between the onset or exacerbation of the medical condition and the development of 
the cognitive deficit offers the greatest support that the NCD is induced by the medical 
condition. Diagnostic certainty regarding this relationship may be increased if the neuro- 
cognitive deficits ameliorate partially or stabilize in the context of treatment of the medical 
condition. 


642 Neurocognitive Disorders 


Development and Course 


Typically the course of the NCD progresses in a manner that is commensurate with progres- 
sion of the underlying medical disorder. In circumstances where the medical disorder is treat- 
able (e.g., hypothyroidism), the neurocognitive deficit may improve or at least not progress. 
When the medical condition has a deteriorative course (e.g., secondary progressive multiple 
sclerosis), the neurocognitive deficits will progress along with the temporal course of illness. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Associated physical examination and laboratory findings and other clinical features de- 
pend on the nature and severity of the medical condition. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other major or mild neurocognitive disorder. The presence of an attributable medical 
condition does not entirely exclude the possibility of another major or mild NCD. If cog- 
nitive deficits persist following successful treatment of an associated medical condition, 
then another etiology may be responsible for the cognitive decline. 


Major or Mild Neurocognitive Disorder 
Due to Multiple Etiologies 


Diagnostic Criteria 


A. The criteria are met for major or mild neurocognitive disorder. 

B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the 
neurocognitive disorder is the pathophysiological consequence of more than one etio- 
logical process, excluding substances (e.g., neurocognitive disorder due to Alzhei- 
mer’s disease with subsequent development of vascular neurocognitive disorder). 
Note: Please refer to the diagnostic criteria for the various neurocognitive disorders due 
to specific medical conditions for guidance on establishing the particular etiologies. 

C. The cognitive deficits are not better explained by another mental disorder and do not 
occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 


Coding note: For major neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies, with behavioral 
disturbance, code 294.11 (F02.81); for major neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiolo- 
gies, without behavioral disturbance, code 294.10 (F02.80). All of the etiological medical 
conditions (with the exception of vascular disease) should be coded and listed separately 
immediately before major neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies (e.g., 331.0 
[G30.9] Alzheimer’s disease; 331.82 [G31.83] Lewy body disease; 294.11 [F02.81] major 
neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies, with behavioral disturbance). 

When a cerebrovascular etiology is contributing to the neurocognitive disorder, the diagno- 
sis of vascular neurocognitive disorder should be listed in addition to major neurocognitive 
disorder due to multiple etiologies. For example, for a presentation of major neurocognitive 
disorder due to both Alzheimer’s disease and vascular disease, with behavioral disturbance, 
code the following: 331.0 (G30.9) Alzheimer’s disease; 294.11 (F02.81) major neurocogni- 
tive disorder due to multiple etiologies, with behavioral disturbance; 290.40 (F01.51) major 
vascular neurocognitive disorder, with behavioral disturbance. 

For mild neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies, code 331.83 (G31.84). (Note: 
Do not use the additional codes for the etiologies. Behavioral disturbance cannot be coded 
but should still be indicated in writing.) 


Unspecified Neurocognitive Disorder 643 


This category is included to cover the clinical presentation of a neurocognitive disorder (NCD) 
for which there is evidence that multiple medical conditions have played a probable role in the 
development of the NCD. In addition to evidence indicative of the presence of multiple med- 
ical conditions that are known to cause NCD (ie., findings from the history and physical ex- 
amination, and laboratory findings), it may be helpful to refer to the diagnostic criteria and text 
for the various medical etiologies (e.g., NCD due to Parkinson’s disease) for more information 
on establishing the etiological connection for that particular medical condition. 


Unspecified Neurocognitive Disorder 
799.59 (R41.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a neurocogni- 
tive disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, 
or other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any 
of the disorders in the neurocognitive disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified neuro- 
cognitive disorder category is used in situations in which the precise etiology cannot be 
determined with sufficient certainty to make an etiological attribution. 

Coding note: For unspecified major or mild neurocognitive disorder, code 799.59 (R41.9). 
(Note: Do not use additional codes for any presumed etiological medical conditions. Be- 
havioral disturbance cannot be coded but may be indicated in writing.) 


This page intentionally left blank 


Personality 
Disorders 


This ch apter beg INS witha general definition of personality disorder that applies 
to each of the 10 specific personality disorders. A personality disorder is an enduring pattern 
of inner experience and behavior that deviates markedly from the expectations of the in- 
dividual’s culture, is pervasive and inflexible, has an onset in adolescence or early adult- 
hood, is stable over time, and leads to distress or impairment. 

With any ongoing review process, especially one of this complexity, different view- 
points emerge, and an effort was made to accommodate them. Thus, personality disorders 
are included in both Sections II and III. The material in Section II represents an update of 
text associated with the same criteria found in DSM-IV-TR, whereas Section III includes 
the proposed research model for personality disorder diagnosis and conceptualization de- 
veloped by the DSM-5 Personality and Personality Disorders Work Group. As this field 
evolves, it is hoped that both versions will serve clinical practice and research initiatives, 
respectively. 

The following personality disorders are included in this chapter. 


¢ Paranoid personality disorder is a pattern of distrust and suspiciousness such that oth- 
ers’ motives are interpreted as malevolent. 

¢ Schizoid personality disorder is a pattern of detachment from social relationships and 
a restricted range of emotional expression. 

¢ Schizotypal personality disorder is a pattern of acute discomfort in close relationships, 
cognitive or perceptual distortions, and eccentricities of behavior. 

e Antisocial personality disorder is a pattern of disregard for, and violation of, the rights 
of others. 

¢ Borderline personality disorder is a pattern of instability in interpersonal relation- 
ships, self-image, and affects, and marked impulsivity. 

¢ Histrionic personality disorder is a pattern of excessive emotionality and attention 
seeking. 

e Narcissistic personality disorder is a pattern of grandiosity, need for admiration, and 
lack of empathy. 

e Avoidant personality disorder is a pattern of social inhibition, feelings of inadequacy, 
and hypersensitivity to negative evaluation. 

¢ Dependent personality disorder is a pattern of submissive and clinging behavior re- 
lated to an excessive need to be taken care of. 

¢ Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder is a pattern of preoccupation with order- 
liness, perfectionism, and control. 

¢ Personality change due to another medical condition is a persistent personality dis- 
turbance that is judged to be due to the direct physiological effects of a medical condi- 
tion (e.g., frontal lobe lesion). 

¢ Other specified personality disorder and unspecified personality disorder is a cate- 
gory provided for two situations: 1) the individual’s personality pattern meets the gen- 
eral criteria for a personality disorder, and traits of several different personality 
disorders are present, but the criteria for any specific personality disorder are not met; 


645 


646 Personality Disorders 


or 2) the individual’s personality pattern meets the general criteria for a personality dis- 
order, but the individual is considered to have a personality disorder that is not in- 
cluded in the DSM-5 classification (e.g., passive-aggressive personality disorder). 


The personality disorders are grouped into three clusters based on descriptive similarities. 
Cluster A includes paranoid, schizoid, and schizotypal personality disorders. Individuals with 
these disorders often appear odd or eccentric. Cluster B includes antisocial, borderline, histri- 
onic, and narcissistic personality disorders. Individuals with these disorders often appear dra- 
matic, emotional, or erratic. Cluster C includes avoidant, dependent, and obsessive- 
compulsive personality disorders. Individuals with these disorders often appear anxious or 
fearful. It should be noted that this clustering system, although useful in some research and ed- 
ucational situations, has serious limitations and has not been consistently validated. 

Moreover, individuals frequently present with co-occurring personality disorders 
from different clusters. Prevalence estimates for the different clusters suggest 5.7% for dis- 
orders in Cluster A, 1.5% for disorders in Cluster B, 6.0% for disorders in Cluster C, and 
9.1% for any personality disorder, indicating frequent co-occurrence of disorders from dif- 
ferent clusters. Data from the 2001-2002 National Epidemiologic Survey on Alcohol and 
Related Conditions suggest that approximately 15% of U.S. adults have at least one per- 
sonality disorder. 


Dimensional Models for Personality Disorders 


The diagnostic approach used in this manual represents the categorical perspective that 
personality disorders are qualitatively distinct clinical syndromes. An alternative to the 
categorical approach is the dimensional perspective that personality disorders represent 
maladaptive variants of personality traits that merge imperceptibly into normality and 
into one another. See Section III for a full description of a dimensional model for person- 
ality disorders. The DSM-IV personality disorder clusters (i.e., odd-eccentric, dramatic- 
emotional, and anxious-fearful) may also be viewed as dimensions representing spectra of 
personality dysfunction on a continuum with other mental disorders. The alternative di- 
mensional models have much in common and together appear to cover the important ar- 
eas of personality dysfunction. Their integration, clinical utility, and relationship with the 
personality disorder diagnostic categories and various aspects of personality dysfunction 
are under active investigation. 


General Personality Disorder 


Criteria 


A. An enduring pattern of inner experience and behavior that deviates markedly from the 
expectations of the individual’s culture. This pattern is manifested in two (or more) of 
the following areas: 

1. Cognition (i.e., ways of perceiving and interpreting self, other people, and events). 

2. Affectivity (i.e., the range, intensity, lability, and appropriateness of emotional re- 
sponse). 

3. Interpersonal functioning. 

4. Impulse control. 

B. The enduring pattern is inflexible and pervasive across a broad range of personal and 
social situations. 


C. The enduring pattern leads to clinically significant distress or impairment in social, oc- 
cupational, or other important areas of functioning. 


General Personality Disorder 647 


D. The pattern is stable and of long duration, and its onset can be traced back at least to 
adolescence or early adulthood. 

E. The enduring pattern is not better explained as a manifestation or consequence of an- 
other mental disorder. 

F. The enduring pattern is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., 
a drug of abuse, a medication) or another medical condition (e.g., head trauma). 


Diagnostic Features 


Personality traits are enduring patterns of perceiving, relating to, and thinking about the en- 
vironment and oneself that are exhibited in a wide range of social and personal contexts. 
Only when personality traits are inflexible and maladaptive and cause significant func- 
tional impairment or subjective distress do they constitute personality disorders. The essen- 
tial feature of a personality disorder is an enduring pattern of inner experience and behavior 
that deviates markedly from the expectations of the individual’s culture and is manifested 
in at least two of the following areas: cognition, affectivity, interpersonal functioning, or im- 
pulse control (Criterion A). This enduring pattern is inflexible and pervasive across a broad 
range of personal and social situations (Criterion B) and leads to clinically significant dis- 
tress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning (Crite- 
rion C). The pattern is stable and of long duration, and its onset can be traced back at least 
to adolescence or early adulthood (Criterion D). The pattern is not better explained as a 
manifestation or consequence of another mental disorder (Criterion E) and is not attribut- 
able to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug of abuse, a medication, exposure 
to a toxin) or another medical condition (e.g., head trauma) (Criterion F). Specific diagnostic 
criteria are also provided for each of the personality disorders included in this chapter. 

The diagnosis of personality disorders requires an evaluation of the individual’s long- 
term patterns of functioning, and the particular personality features must be evident by 
early adulthood. The personality traits that define these disorders must also be distin- 
guished from characteristics that emerge in response to specific situational stressors or 
more transient mental states (e.g., bipolar, depressive, or anxiety disorders; substance in- 
toxication). The clinician should assess the stability of personality traits over time and 
across different situations. Although a single interview with the individual is sometimes 
sufficient for making the diagnosis, it is often necessary to conduct more than one inter- 
view and to space these over time. Assessment can also be complicated by the fact that the 
characteristics that define a personality disorder may not be considered problematic by 
the individual (i.e., the traits are often ego-syntonic). To help overcome this difficulty, sup- 
plementary information from other informants may be helpful. 


Development and Course 


The features of a personality disorder usually become recognizable during adolescence or 
early adult life. By definition, a personality disorder is an enduring pattern of thinking, 
feeling, and behaving that is relatively stable over time. Some types of personality disorder 
(notably, antisocial and borderline personality disorders) tend to become less evident or to 
remit with age, whereas this appears to be less true for some other types (e.g., obsessive- 
compulsive and schizotypal personality disorders). 

Personality disorder categories may be applied with children or adolescents in those 
relatively unusual instances in which the individual’s particular maladaptive personality 
traits appear to be pervasive, persistent, and unlikely to be limited to a particular devel- 
opmental stage or another mental disorder. It should be recognized that the traits of a per- 
sonality disorder that appear in childhood will often not persist unchanged into adult life. 
For a personality disorder to be diagnosed in an individual younger than 18 years, the fea- 
tures must have been present for at least 1 year. The one exception to this is antisocial per- 


648 Personality Disorders 


sonality disorder, which cannot be diagnosed in individuals younger than 18 years. Al- 
though, by definition, a personality disorder requires an onset no later than early 
adulthood, individuals may not come to clinical attention until relatively late in life. A per- 
sonality disorder may be exacerbated following the loss of significant supporting persons 
(e.g., a Spouse) or previously stabilizing social situations (e.g., a job). However, the devel- 
opment of a change in personality in middle adulthood or later life warrants a thorough 
evaluation to determine the possible presence of a personality change due to another med- 
ical condition or an unrecognized substance use disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Judgments about personality functioning must take into account the individual's ethnic, cul- 
tural, and social background. Personality disorders should not be confused with problems as- 
sociated with acculturation following immigration or with the expression of habits, customs, 
or religious and political values professed by the individual’s culture of origin. It is useful for 
the clinician, especially when evaluating someone from a different background, to obtain ad- 
ditional information from informants who are familiar with the person’s cultural background. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Certain personality disorders (e.g., antisocial personality disorder) are diagnosed more 
frequently in males. Others (e.g., borderline, histrionic, and dependent personality disor- 
ders) are diagnosed more frequently in females. Although these differences in prevalence 
probably reflect real gender differences in the presence of such patterns, clinicians must be 
cautious not to overdiagnose or underdiagnose certain personality disorders in females or 
in males because of social stereotypes about typical gender roles and behaviors. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders and personality traits. Many of the specific criteria for the per- 
sonality disorders describe features (e.g., suspiciousness, dependency, insensitivity) that 
are also characteristic of episodes of other mental disorders. A personality disorder should 
be diagnosed only when the defining characteristics appeared before early adulthood, are 
typical of the individual’s long-term functioning, and do not occur exclusively during an 
episode of another mental disorder. It may be particularly difficult (and not particularly 
useful) to distinguish personality disorders from persistent mental disorders such as per- 
sistent depressive disorder that have an early onset and an enduring, relatively stable 
course. Some personality disorders may have a “spectrum” relationship to other mental 
disorders (e.g., schizotypal personality disorder with schizophrenia; avoidant personality 
disorder with social anxiety disorder [social phobia]) based on phenomenological or bio- 
logical similarities or familial aggregation. 

Personality disorders must be distinguished from personality traits that do not reach 
the threshold for a personality disorder. Personality traits are diagnosed as a personality 
disorder only when they are inflexible, maladaptive, and persisting and cause significant 
functional impairment or subjective distress. 


Psychotic disorders. For the three personality disorders that may be related to the psy- 
chotic disorders (i.e., paranoid, schizoid, and schizotypal), there is an exclusion criterion 
stating that the pattern of behavior must not have occurred exclusively during the course 
of schizophrenia, a bipolar or depressive disorder with psychotic features, or another psy- 
chotic disorder. When an individual has a persistent mental disorder (e.g., schizophrenia) 
that was preceded by a preexisting personality disorder, the personality disorder should 
also be recorded, followed by “premorbid” in parentheses. 


Anxiety and depressive disorders. The clinician must be cautious in diagnosing per- 
sonality disorders during an episode of a depressive disorder or an anxiety disorder, be- 


Paranoid Personality Disorder 649 


cause these conditions may have cross-sectional symptom features that mimic personality 
traits and may make it more difficult to evaluate retrospectively the individual's long-term 
patterns of functioning. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder. When personality changes emerge and persist after an 
individual has been exposed to extreme stress, a diagnosis of posttraumatic stress disorder 
should be considered. 


Substance use disorders. Whenan individual has a substance use disorder, it is impor- 
tant not to make a personality disorder diagnosis based solely on behaviors that are con- 
sequences of substance intoxication or withdrawal or that are associated with activities in 
the service of sustaining substance use (e.g., antisocial behavior). 


Personality change due to another medical condition. When enduring changes in per- 
sonality arise as a result of the physiological effects of another medical condition (e.g., 
brain tumor), a diagnosis of personality change due to another medical condition should 
be considered. 


Cluster A Personality Disorders 


Paranoid Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.0 (F60.0) 


A. A pervasive distrust and suspiciousness of others such that their motives are inter- 
preted as malevolent, beginning by early adulthood and present in a variety of con- 
texts, as indicated by four (or more) of the following: 


1. Suspects, without sufficient basis, that others are exploiting, harming, or deceiving 
him or her. 

2. Is preoccupied with unjustified doubts about the loyalty or trustworthiness of friends 
or associates. 

3. Is reluctant to confide in others because of unwarranted fear that the information 
will be used maliciously against him or her. 

4. Reads hidden demeaning or threatening meanings into benign remarks or events. 

5. Persistently bears grudges (i.e., is unforgiving of insults, injuries, or slights). 

6. Perceives attacks on his or her character or reputation that are not apparent to oth- 
ers and is quick to react angrily or to counterattack. 

7. Has recurrent suspicions, without justification, regarding fidelity of spouse or sexual 
partner. 


B. Does not occur exclusively during the course of schizophrenia, a bipolar disorder or 
depressive disorder with psychotic features, or another psychotic disorder and is not 
attributable to the physiological effects of another medical condition. 


Note: If criteria are met prior to the onset of schizophrenia, add “premorbid,” i.e., “paranoid 
personality disorder (premorbid).” 


Diagnostic Features 

The essential feature of paranoid personality disorder is a pattern of pervasive distrust 
and suspiciousness of others such that their motives are interpreted as malevolent. This 
pattern begins by early adulthood and is present in a variety of contexts. 


650 Personality Disorders 


Individuals with this disorder assume that other people will exploit, harm, or deceive 
them, even if no evidence exists to support this expectation (Criterion A1). They suspect on 
the basis of little or no evidence that others are plotting against them and may attack them 
suddenly, at any time and without reason. They often feel that they have been deeply and 
irreversibly injured by another person or persons even when there is no objective evidence 
for this. They are preoccupied with unjustified doubts about the loyalty or trustworthiness 
of their friends and associates, whose actions are minutely scrutinized for evidence of hos- 
tile intentions (Criterion A2). Any perceived deviation from trustworthiness or loyalty 
serves to support their underlying assumptions. They are so amazed when a friend or as- 
sociate shows loyalty that they cannot trust or believe it. If they get into trouble, they ex- 
pect that friends and associates will either attack or ignore them. 

Individuals with paranoid personality disorder are reluctant to confide in or become 
close to others because they fear that the information they share will be used against them 
(Criterion A3). They may refuse to answer personal questions, saying that the information 
is “nobody’s business.” They read hidden meanings that are demeaning and threatening 
into benign remarks or events (Criterion A4). For example, an individual with this disor- 
der may misinterpret an honest mistake by a store clerk as a deliberate attempt to short- 
change, or view a casual humorous remark by a co-worker as a serious character attack. 
Compliments are often misinterpreted (e.g., a compliment on a new acquisition is mis- 
interpreted as a criticism for selfishness; a compliment on an accomplishment is misinter- 
preted as an attempt to coerce more and better performance). They may view an offer of 
help as a criticism that they are not doing well enough on their own. 

Individuals with this disorder persistently bear grudges and are unwilling to forgive 
the insults, injuries, or slights that they think they have received (Criterion A5). Minor 
slights arouse major hostility, and the hostile feelings persist for a long time. Because they 
are constantly vigilant to the harmful intentions of others, they very often feel that their 
character or reputation has been attacked or that they have been slighted in some other 
way. They are quick to counterattack and react with anger to perceived insults (Criterion 
A6). Individuals with this disorder may be pathologically jealous, often suspecting that 
their spouse or sexual partner is unfaithful without any adequate justification (Criterion 
A7). They may gather trivial and circumstantial “evidence” to support their jealous beliefs. 
They want to maintain complete control of intimate relationships to avoid being betrayed 
and may constantly question and challenge the whereabouts, actions, intentions, and fi- 
delity of their spouse or partner. 

Paranoid personality disorder should not be diagnosed if the pattern of behavior oc- 
curs exclusively during the course of schizophrenia, a bipolar disorder or depressive dis- 
order with psychotic features, or another psychotic disorder, or if it is attributable to the 
physiological effects of a neurological (e.g., temporal lobe epilepsy) or another medical 
condition (Criterion B). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with paranoid personality disorder are generally difficult to get along with 
and often have problems with close relationships. Their excessive suspiciousness and hos- 
tility may be expressed in overt argumentativeness, in recurrent complaining, or by quiet, 
apparently hostile aloofness. Because they are hypervigilant for potential threats, they 
may act ina guarded, secretive, or devious manner and appear to be “cold” and lacking in 
tender feelings. Although they may appear to be objective, rational, and unemotional, they 
more often display a labile range of affect, with hostile, stubborn, and sarcastic expressions 
predominating. Their combative and suspicious nature may elicit a hostile response in 
others, which then serves to confirm their original expectations. 

Because individuals with paranoid personality disorder lack trust in others, they have 
an excessive need to be self-sufficient and a strong sense of autonomy. They also need to 


Paranoid Personality Disorder 651 


have a high degree of control over those around them. They are often rigid, critical of oth- 
ers, and unable to collaborate, although they have great difficulty accepting criticism them- 
selves. They may blame others for their own shortcomings. Because of their quickness to 
counterattack in response to the threats they perceive around them, they may be litigious 
and frequently become involved in legal disputes. Individuals with this disorder seek to 
confirm their preconceived negative notions regarding people or situations they encounter, 
attributing malevolent motivations to others that are projections of their own fears. They 
may exhibit thinly hidden, unrealistic grandiose fantasies, are often attuned to issues of 
power and rank, and tend to develop negative stereotypes of others, particularly those 
from population groups distinct from their own. Attracted by simplistic formulations of the 
world, they are often wary of ambiguous situations. They may be perceived as “fanatics” 
and form tightly knit “cults” or groups with others who share their paranoid belief systems. 

Particularly in response to stress, individuals with this disorder may experience very 
brief psychotic episodes (lasting minutes to hours). In some instances, paranoid personal- 
ity disorder may appear as the premorbid antecedent of delusional disorder or schizo- 
phrenia. Individuals with paranoid personality disorder may develop major depressive 
disorder and may be at increased risk for agoraphobia and obsessive-compulsive dis- 
order. Alcohol and other substance use disorders frequently occur. The most common co- 
occurring personality disorders appear to be schizotypal, schizoid, narcissistic, avoidant, 
and borderline. 


Prevalence 


A prevalence estimate for paranoid personality based on a probability subsample from 
Part II of the National Comorbidity Survey Replication suggests a prevalence of 2.3%, 
while the National Epidemiologic Survey on Alcohol and Related Conditions data suggest 
a prevalence of paranoid personality disorder of 4.4%. 


Development and Course 


Paranoid personality disorder may be first apparent in childhood and adolescence with 
solitariness, poor peer relationships, social anxiety, underachievement in school, hyper- 
sensitivity, peculiar thoughts and language, and idiosyncratic fantasies. These children 
may appear to be “odd” or “eccentric” and attract teasing. In clinical samples, this disorder 
appears to be more commonly diagnosed in males. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. There is some evidence for an increased prevalence of par- 
anoid personality disorder in relatives of probands with schizophrenia and for a more spe- 
cific familial relationship with delusional disorder, persecutory type. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Some behaviors that are influenced by sociocultural contexts or specific life circumstances 
may be erroneously labeled paranoid and may even be reinforced by the process of clinical 
evaluation. Members of minority groups, immigrants, political and economic refugees, or 
individuals of different ethnic backgrounds may display guarded or defensive behaviors 
because of unfamiliarity (e.g., language barriers or lack of knowledge of rules and regula- 
tions) or in response to the perceived neglect or indifference of the majority society. These 
behaviors can, in turn, generate anger and frustration in those who deal with these indi- 
viduals, thus setting up a vicious cycle of mutual mistrust, which should not be confused 
with paranoid personality disorder. Some ethnic groups also display culturally related be- 
haviors that can be misinterpreted as paranoid. 


652 Personality Disorders 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders with psychotic symptoms. Paranoid personality disorder can 
be distinguished from delusional disorder, persecutory type; schizophrenia; and a bipolar or 
depressive disorder with psychotic features because these disorders are all characterized by a 
period of persistent psychotic symptoms (e.g., delusions and hallucinations). For an additional 
diagnosis of paranoid personality disorder to be given, the personality disorder must have 
been present before the onset of psychotic symptoms and must persist when the psychotic 
symptoms are in remission. When an individual has another persistent mental disorder (e.g., 
schizophrenia) that was preceded by paranoid personality disorder, paranoid personality dis- 
order should also be recorded, followed by “premorbid” in parentheses. 


Personality change due to another medical condition. Paranoid personality disorder 
must be distinguished from personality change due to another medical condition, in 
which the traits that emerge are attributable to the direct effects of another medical condi- 
tion on the central nervous system. 


Substance use disorders. Paranoid personality disorder must be distinguished from 
symptoms that may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Paranoid traits associated with physical handicaps. The disorder must also be distin- 
guished from paranoid traits associated with the development of physical handicaps (e.g., 
a hearing impairment). 
Other personality disorders and personality traits. Other personality disorders may be 
confused with paranoid personality disorder because they have certain features in common. 
It is therefore important to distinguish among these disorders based on differences in their 
characteristic features. However, if an individual has personality features that meet criteria 
for one or more personality disorders in addition to paranoid personality disorder, all can be 
diagnosed. Paranoid personality disorder and schizotypal personality disorder share the 
traits of suspiciousness, interpersonal aloofness, and paranoid ideation, but schizotypal per- 
sonality disorder also includes symptoms such as magical thinking, unusual perceptual ex- 
periences, and odd thinking and speech. Individuals with behaviors that meet criteria for 
schizoid personality disorder are often perceived as strange, eccentric, cold, and aloof, but 
they do not usually have prominent paranoid ideation. The tendency of individuals with 
paranoid personality disorder to react to minor stimuli with anger is also seen in borderline 
and histrionic personality disorders. However, these disorders are not necessarily associ- 
ated with pervasive suspiciousness. People with avoidant personality disorder may also be 
reluctant to confide in others, but more from fear of being embarrassed or found inadequate 
than from fear of others’ malicious intent. Although antisocial behavior may be present in 
some individuals with paranoid personality disorder, it is not usually motivated by a desire 
for personal gain or to exploit others as in antisocial personality disorder, but rather is more 
often attributable to a desire for revenge. Individuals with narcissistic personality disorder 
may occasionally display suspiciousness, social withdrawal, or alienation, but this derives 
primarily from fears of having their imperfections or flaws revealed. 

Paranoid traits may be adaptive, particularly in threatening environments. Paranoid 
personality disorder should be diagnosed only when these traits are inflexible, maladap- 
tive, and persisting and cause significant functional impairment or subjective distress. 


Schizoid Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.20 (F60.1) 


A. A pervasive pattern of detachment from social relationships and a restricted range of 
expression of emotions in interpersonal settings, beginning by early adulthood and 
present in a variety of contexts, as indicated by four (or more) of the following: 


Schizoid Personality Disorder 653 


Neither desires nor enjoys close relationships, including being part of a family. 
Almost always chooses solitary activities. 

Has little, if any, interest in having sexual experiences with another person. 
Takes pleasure in few, if any, activities. 

Lacks close friends or confidants other than first-degree relatives. 

Appears indifferent to the praise or criticism of others. 

7. Shows emotional coldness, detachment, or flattened affectivity. 


Oy Ol Gon Ge 


B. Does not occur exclusively during the course of schizophrenia, a bipolar disorder or 
depressive disorder with psychotic features, another psychotic disorder, or autism 
spectrum disorder and is not attributable to the physiological effects of another medical 
condition. 

Note: If criteria are met prior to the onset of schizophrenia, add “premorbid,” i.e., “schiz- 

oid personality disorder (premorbid).” 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of schizoid personality disorder is a pervasive pattern of detachment 
from social relationships and a restricted range of expression of emotions in interpersonal 
settings. This pattern begins by early adulthood and is present in a variety of contexts. 

Individuals with schizoid personality disorder appear to lack a desire for intimacy, 
seem indifferent to opportunities to develop close relationships, and do not seem to derive 
much satisfaction from being part of a family or other social group (Criterion A1). They 
prefer spending time by themselves, rather than being with other people. They often ap- 
pear to be socially isolated or “loners” and almost always choose solitary activities or hob- 
bies that do not include interaction with others (Criterion A2). They prefer mechanical or 
abstract tasks, such as computer or mathematical games. They may have very little interest 
in having sexual experiences with another person (Criterion A3) and take pleasure in few, 
if any, activities (Criterion A4). There is usually a reduced experience of pleasure from sen- 
sory, bodily, or interpersonal experiences, such as walking on a beach at sunset or having 
sex. These individuals have no close friends or confidants, except possibly a first-degree 
relative (Criterion A5). 

Individuals with schizoid personality disorder often seem indifferent to the approval 
or criticism of others and do not appear to be bothered by what others may think of them 
(Criterion A6). They may be oblivious to the normal subtleties of social interaction and of- 
ten do not respond appropriately to social cues so that they seem socially inept or super- 
ficial and self-absorbed. They usually display a “bland” exterior without visible emotional 
reactivity and rarely reciprocate gestures or facial expressions, such as smiles or nods (Cri- 
terion A7). They claim that they rarely experience strong emotions such as anger and joy. 
They often display a constricted affect and appear cold and aloof. However, in those very 
unusual circumstances in which these individuals become at least temporarily comfort- 
able in revealing themselves, they may acknowledge having painful feelings, particularly 
related to social interactions. 

Schizoid personality disorder should not be diagnosed if the pattern of behavior occurs 
exclusively during the course of schizophrenia, a bipolar or depressive disorder with psy- 
chotic features, another psychotic disorder, or autism spectrum disorder, or if it is attrib- 
utable to the physiological effects of a neurological (e.g., temporal lobe epilepsy) or another 
medical condition (Criterion B). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with schizoid personality disorder may have particular difficulty expressing 
anger, even in response to direct provocation, which contributes to the impression that 


654 Personality Disorders 


they lack emotion. Their lives sometimes seem directionless, and they may appear to 
“drift” in their goals. Such individuals often react passively to adverse circumstances and 
have difficulty responding appropriately to important life events. Because of their lack of 
social skills and lack of desire for sexual experiences, individuals with this disorder have 
few friendships, date infrequently, and often do not marry. Occupational functioning may 
be impaired, particularly if interpersonal involvement is required, but individuals with 
this disorder may do well when they work under conditions of social isolation. Particu- 
larly in response to stress, individuals with this disorder may experience very brief psy- 
chotic episodes (lasting minutes to hours). In some instances, schizoid personality 
disorder may appear as the premorbid antecedent of delusional disorder or schizophre- 
nia. Individuals with this disorder may sometimes develop major depressive disorder. 
Schizoid personality disorder most often co-occurs with schizotypal, paranoid, and avoid- 
ant personality disorders. 


Prevalence 


Schizoid personality disorder is uncommon in clinical settings. A prevalence estimate for 
schizoid personality based on a probability subsample from Part II of the National Co- 
morbidity Survey Replication suggests a prevalence of 4.9%. Data from the 2001-2002 
National Epidemiologic Survey on Alcohol and Related Conditions suggest a prevalence of 
3.1%. 


Development and Course 


Schizoid personality disorder may be first apparent in childhood and adolescence with 
solitariness, poor peer relationships, and underachievement in school, which mark these 
children or adolescents as different and make them subject to teasing. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Schizoid personality disorder may have increased preva- 
lence in the relatives of individuals with schizophrenia or schizotypal personality disorder. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Individuals from a variety of cultural backgrounds sometimes exhibit defensive behaviors 
and interpersonal styles that may be erroneously labeled as “schizoid.” For example, those 
who have moved from rural to metropolitan environments may react with “emotional 
freezing” that may last for several months and manifest as solitary activities, constricted 
affect, and other deficits in communication. Immigrants from other countries are some- 
times mistakenly perceived as cold, hostile, or indifferent. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Schizoid personality disorder is diagnosed slightly more often in males and may cause 
more impairment in them. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders with psychotic symptoms. Schizoid personality disorder can 
be distinguished from delusional disorder, schizophrenia, and a bipolar or depressive dis- 
order with psychotic features because these disorders are all characterized by a period of 
persistent psychotic symptoms (e.g., delusions and hallucinations). To give an additional 
diagnosis of schizoid personality disorder, the personality disorder must have been present 
before the onset of psychotic symptoms and must persist when the psychotic symptoms 


Schizotypal Personality Disorder 655 


are in remission. When an individual has a persistent psychotic disorder (e.g., schizophre- 
nia) that was preceded by schizoid personality disorder, schizoid personality disorder 
should also be recorded, followed by “premorbid” in parentheses. 


Autism spectrum disorder. There may be great difficulty differentiating individuals with 
schizoid personality disorder from those with milder forms of autism spectrum disorder, 
which may be differentiated by more severely impaired social interaction and stereotyped 
behaviors and interests. 


Personality change due to another medical condition. Schizoid personality disorder 
must be distinguished from personality change due to another medical condition, in 
which the traits that emerge are attributable to the effects of another medical condition on 
the central nervous system. 


Substance use disorders. Schizoid personality disorder must also be distinguished 
from symptoms that may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Other personality disorders and personality traits. Other personality disorders may be 
confused with schizoid personality disorder because they have certain features in com- 
mon. It is, therefore, important to distinguish among these disorders based on differences 
in their characteristic features. However, if an individual has personality features that 
meet criteria for one or more personality disorders in addition to schizoid personality dis- 
order, all can be diagnosed. Although characteristics of social isolation and restricted af- 
fectivity are common to schizoid, schizotypal, and paranoid personality disorders, 
schizoid personality disorder can be distinguished from schizotypal personality disorder 
by the lack of cognitive and perceptual distortions and from paranoid personality disorder 
by the lack of suspiciousness and paranoid ideation. The social isolation of schizoid per- 
sonality disorder can be distinguished from that of avoidant personality disorder, which is 
attributable to fear of being embarrassed or found inadequate and excessive anticipation 
of rejection. In contrast, people with schizoid personality disorder have a more pervasive 
detachment and limited desire for social intimacy. Individuals with obsessive-compulsive 
personality disorder may also show an apparent social detachment stemming from devo- 
tion to work and discomfort with emotions, but they do have an underlying capacity for 
intimacy. 

Individuals who are “loners” may display personality traits that might be considered 
schizoid. Only when these traits are inflexible and maladaptive and cause significant func- 
tional impairment or subjective distress do they constitute schizoid personality disorder. 


Schizotypal Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.22 (F21) 


A. A pervasive pattern of social and interpersonal deficits marked by acute discomfort 
with, and reduced capacity for, close relationships as well as by cognitive or perceptual 
distortions and eccentricities of behavior, beginning by early adulthood and present in 
a variety of contexts, as indicated by five (or more) of the following: 

1. Ideas of reference (excluding delusions of reference). 

2. Odd beliefs or magical thinking that influences behavior and is inconsistent with 
subcultural norms (e.g., superstitiousness, belief in clairvoyance, telepathy, or 
“sixth sense”; in children and adolescents, bizarre fantasies or preoccupations). 
Unusual perceptual experiences, including bodily illusions. 

4. Odd thinking and speech (e.g., vague, circumstantial, metaphorical, overelaborate, 
or stereotyped). 

5. Suspiciousness or paranoid ideation. 


o 


656 Personality Disorders 


Inappropriate or constricted affect. 

Behavior or appearance that is odd, eccentric, or peculiar. 

Lack of close friends or confidants other than first-degree relatives. 

Excessive social anxiety that does not diminish with familiarity and tends to be as- 
sociated with paranoid fears rather than negative judgments about self. 


Oo ON ® 


B. Does not occur exclusively during the course of schizophrenia, a bipolar disorder or 
depressive disorder with psychotic features, another psychotic disorder, or autism 
spectrum disorder. 


Note: If criteria are met prior to the onset of schizophrenia, add “premorbid,” e.g., “schizo- 
typal personality disorder (premorbid).” 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of schizotypal personality disorder is a pervasive pattern of social 
and interpersonal deficits marked by acute discomfort with, and reduced capacity for, 
close relationships as well as by cognitive or perceptual distortions and eccentricities of be- 
havior. This pattern begins by early adulthood and is present in a variety of contexts. 

Individuals with schizotypal personality disorder often have ideas of reference (i.e., in- 
correct interpretations of casual incidents and external events as having a particular and 
unusual meaning specifically for the person) (Criterion A1). These should be distin- 
guished from delusions of reference, in which the beliefs are held with delusional convic- 
tion. These individuals may be superstitious or preoccupied with paranormal phenomena 
that are outside the norms of their subculture (Criterion A2). They may feel that they have 
special powers to sense events before they happen or to read others’ thoughts. They may 
believe that they have magical control over others, which can be implemented directly 
(e.g., believing that their spouse’s taking the dog out for a walk is the direct result of think- 
ing an hour earlier it should be done) or indirectly through compliance with magical rit- 
uals (e.g., walking past a specific object three times to avoid a certain harmful outcome). 
Perceptual alterations may be present (e.g., sensing that another person is present or hear- 
ing a voice murmuring his or her name) (Criterion A3). Their speech may include unusual 
or idiosyncratic phrasing and construction. It is often loose, digressive, or vague, but with- 
out actual derailment or incoherence (Criterion A4). Responses can be either overly con- 
crete or overly abstract, and words or concepts are sometimes applied in unusual ways 
(e.g., the individual may state that he or she was not “talkable” at work). 

Individuals with this disorder are often suspicious and may have paranoid ideation 
(e.g., believing their colleagues at work are intent on undermining their reputation with 
the boss) (Criterion A5). They are usually not able to negotiate the full range of affects and 
interpersonal cuing required for successful relationships and thus often appear to interact 
with others in an inappropriate, stiff, or constricted fashion (Criterion A6). These individ- 
uals are often considered to be odd or eccentric because of unusual mannerisms, an often 
unkempt manner of dress that does not quite “fit together,” and inattention to the usual 
social conventions (e.g., the individual may avoid eye contact, wear clothes that are ink 
stained and ill-fitting, and be unable to join in the give-and-take banter of co-workers) 
(Criterion A7). 

Individuals with schizotypal personality disorder experience interpersonal related- 
ness as problematic and are uncomfortable relating to other people. Although they may 
express unhappiness about their lack of relationships, their behavior suggests a decreased 
desire for intimate contacts. As a result, they usually have no or few close friends or con- 
fidants other than a first-degree relative (Criterion A8). They are anxious in social situa- 
tions, particularly those involving unfamiliar people (Criterion A9). They will interact 
with other individuals when they have to but prefer to keep to themselves because they 
feel that they are different and just do not “fit in.” Their social anxiety does not easily abate, 


Schizotypal Personality Disorder 657 


even when they spend more time in the setting or become more familiar with the other 
people, because their anxiety tends to be associated with suspiciousness regarding others’ 
motivations. For example, when attending a dinner party, the individual with schizotypal 
personality disorder will not become more relaxed as time goes on, but rather may become 
increasingly tense and suspicious. 

Schizotypal personality disorder should not be diagnosed if the pattern of behavior oc- 
curs exclusively during the course of schizophrenia, a bipolar or depressive disorder with 
psychotic features, another psychotic disorder, or autism spectrum disorder (Criterion B). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with schizotypal personality disorder often seek treatment for the associated 
symptoms of anxiety or depression rather than for the personality disorder features per se. 
Particularly in response to stress, individuals with this disorder may experience transient 
psychotic episodes (lasting minutes to hours), although they usually are insufficient in du- 
ration to warrant an additional diagnosis such as brief psychotic disorder or schizophreni- 
form disorder. In some cases, clinically significant psychotic symptoms may develop that 
meet criteria for brief psychotic disorder, schizophreniform disorder, delusional disorder, 
or schizophrenia. Over half may have a history of at least one major depressive episode. 
From 30% to 50% of individuals diagnosed with this disorder have a concurrent diagnosis 
of major depressive disorder when admitted to a clinical setting. There is considerable co- 
occurrence with schizoid, paranoid, avoidant, and borderline personality disorders. 


Prevalence 


In community studies of schizotypal personality disorder, reported rates range from 0.6% 
in Norwegian samples to 4.6% in a U.S. community sample. The prevalence of schizotypal 
personality disorder in clinical populations seems to be infrequent (0%-1.9%), with a 
higher estimated prevalence in the general population (3.9%) found in the National Epi- 
demiologic Survey on Alcohol and Related Conditions. 


Development and Course 


Schizotypal personality disorder has a relatively stable course, with only a small propor- 
tion of individuals going on to develop schizophrenia or another psychotic disorder. 
Schizotypal personality disorder may be first apparent in childhood and adolescence with 
solitariness, poor peer relationships, social anxiety, underachievement in school, hyper- 
sensitivity, peculiar thoughts and language, and bizarre fantasies. These children may ap- 
pear “odd” or “eccentric” and attract teasing. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Schizotypal personality disorder appears to aggregate fa- 
milially and is more prevalent among the first-degree biological relatives of individuals 
with schizophrenia than among the general population. There may also be a modest in- 
crease in schizophrenia and other psychotic disorders in the relatives of probands with 
schizotypal personality disorder. 


Cultural-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Cognitive and perceptual distortions must be evaluated in the context of the individual’s 
cultural milieu. Pervasive culturally determined characteristics, particularly those regard- 
ing religious beliefs and rituals, can appear to be schizotypal to the uninformed outsider 
(e.g., voodoo, speaking in tongues, life beyond death, shamanism, mind reading, sixth 
sense, evil eye, magical beliefs related to health and illness). 


658 Personality Disorders 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Schizotypal personality disorder may be slightly more common in males. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders with psychotic symptoms. Schizotypal personality disorder 
can be distinguished from delusional disorder, schizophrenia, and a bipolar or depressive 
disorder with psychotic features because these disorders are all characterized by a period 
of persistent psychotic symptoms (e.g., delusions and hallucinations). To give an addi- 
tional diagnosis of schizotypal personality disorder, the personality disorder must have 
been present before the onset of psychotic symptoms and persist when the psychotic 
symptoms are in remission. When an individual has a persistent psychotic disorder (e.g., 
schizophrenia) that was preceded by schizotypal personality disorder, schizotypal per- 
sonality disorder should also be recorded, followed by “premorbid” in parentheses. 


Neurodevelopmental disorders. There may be great difficulty differentiating children 
with schizotypal personality disorder from the heterogeneous group of solitary, odd chil- 
dren whose behavior is characterized by marked social isolation, eccentricity, or peculiar- 
ities of language and whose diagnoses would probably include milder forms of autism 
spectrum disorder or language communication disorders. Communication disorders may 
be differentiated by the primacy and severity of the disorder in language and by the char- 
acteristic features of impaired language found in a specialized language assessment. 
Milder forms of autism spectrum disorder are differentiated by the even greater lack of so- 
cial awareness and emotional reciprocity and stereotyped behaviors and interests. 


Personality change due to another medical condition. Schizotypal personality disor- 
der must be distinguished from personality change due to another medical condition, in 
which the traits that emerge are attributable to the effects of another medical condition on 
the central nervous system. 


Substance use disorders. Schizotypal personality disorder must also be distinguished 
from symptoms that may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Other personality disorders and personality traits. Other personality disorders may 
be confused with schizotypal personality disorder because they have certain features in 
common. It is, therefore, important to distinguish among these disorders based on differ- 
ences in their characteristic features. However, if an individual has personality features 
that meet criteria for one or more personality disorders in addition to schizotypal person- 
ality disorder, all can be diagnosed. Although paranoid and schizoid personality disor- 
ders may also be characterized by social detachment and restricted affect, schizotypal 
personality disorder can be distinguished from these two diagnoses by the presence of 
cognitive or perceptual distortions and marked eccentricity or oddness. Close relation- 
ships are limited in both schizotypal personality disorder and avoidant personality dis- 
order; however, in avoidant personality disorder an active desire for relationships is 
constrained by a fear of rejection, whereas in schizotypal personality disorder there is 
a lack of desire for relationships and persistent detachment. Individuals with narcissistic 
personality disorder may also display suspiciousness, social withdrawal, or alienation, 
but in narcissistic personality disorder these qualities derive primarily from fears of hav- 
ing imperfections or flaws revealed. Individuals with borderline personality disorder may 
also have transient, psychotic-like symptoms, but these are usually more closely related to 
affective shifts in response to stress (e.g., intense anger, anxiety, disappointment) and are 
usually more dissociative (e.g., derealization, depersonalization). In contrast, individuals 
with schizotypal personality disorder are more likely to have enduring psychotic-like symp- 
toms that may worsen under stress but are less likely to be invariably associated with pro- 
nounced affective symptoms. Although social isolation may occur in borderline personality 


Antisocial Personality Disorder 659 


disorder, it is usually secondary to repeated interpersonal failures due to angry outbursts 
and frequent mood shifts, rather than a result of a persistent lack of social contacts and de- 
sire for intimacy. Furthermore, individuals with schizotypal personality disorder do not 
usually demonstrate the impulsive or manipulative behaviors of the individual with bor- 
derline personality disorder. However, there is a high rate of co-occurrence between the 
two disorders, so that making such distinctions is not always feasible. Schizotypal features 
during adolescence may be reflective of transient emotional turmoil, rather than an endur- 
ing personality disorder. 


Cluster B Personality Disorders 


Antisocial Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.7 (F60.2) 


A. Apervasive pattern of disregard for and violation of the rights of others, occurring since 
age 15 years, as indicated by three (or more) of the following: 
1. Failure to conform to social norms with respect to lawful behaviors, as indicated by 
repeatedly performing acts that are grounds for arrest. 
2. Deceitfulness, as indicated by repeated lying, use of aliases, or conning others for 
personal profit or pleasure. 
Impulsivity or failure to plan ahead. 
Irritability and aggressiveness, as indicated by repeated physical fights or assaults. 
Reckless disregard for safety of self or others. 
Consistent irresponsibility, as indicated by repeated failure to sustain consistent 
work behavior or honor financial obligations. 
7. Lack of remorse, as indicated by being indifferent to or rationalizing having hurt, 
mistreated, or stolen from another. 


OY: OV GO 


. The individual is at least age 18 years. 

. There is evidence of conduct disorder with onset before age 15 years. 

. The occurrence of antisocial behavior is not exclusively during the course of schizo- 
phrenia or bipolar disorder. 


008 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of antisocial personality disorder is a pervasive pattern of disregard 
for, and violation of, the rights of others that begins in childhood or early adolescence and 
continues into adulthood. This pattern has also been referred to as psychopathy, sociopathy, 
or dyssocial personality disorder. Because deceit and manipulation are central features of an- 
tisocial personality disorder, it may be especially helpful to integrate information acquired 
from systematic clinical assessment with information collected from collateral sources. 

For this diagnosis to be given, the individual must be at least age 18 years (Criterion B) 
and must have had a history of some symptoms of conduct disorder before age 15 years 
(Criterion C). Conduct disorder involves a repetitive and persistent pattern of behavior in 
which the basic rights of others or major age-appropriate societal norms or rules are vio- 
lated. The specific behaviors characteristic of conduct disorder fall into one of four cate- 
gories: aggression to people and animals, destruction of property, deceitfulness or theft, or 
serious violation of rules. 


660 Personality Disorders 


The pattern of antisocial behavior continues into adulthood. Individuals with antiso- 
cial personality disorder fail to conform to social norms with respect to lawful behavior 
(Criterion A1). They may repeatedly perform acts that are grounds for arrest (whether 
they are arrested or not), such as destroying property, harassing others, stealing, or pur- 
suing illegal occupations. Persons with this disorder disregard the wishes, rights, or feel- 
ings of others. They are frequently deceitful and manipulative in order to gain personal 
profit or pleasure (e.g., to obtain money, sex, or power) (Criterion A2). They may repeat- 
edly lie, use an alias, con others, or malinger. A pattern of impulsivity may be manifested 
by a failure to plan ahead (Criterion A3). Decisions are made on the spur of the moment, 
without forethought and without consideration for the consequences to self or others; this 
may lead to sudden changes of jobs, residences, or relationships. Individuals with antiso- 
cial personality disorder tend to be irritable and aggressive and may repeatedly get into 
physical fights or commit acts of physical assault (including spouse beating or child beat- 
ing) (Criterion A4). (Aggressive acts that are required to defend oneself or someone else 
are not considered to be evidence for this item.) These individuals also display a reckless 
disregard for the safety of themselves or others (Criterion A5). This may be evidenced in 
their driving behavior (i.e., recurrent speeding, driving while intoxicated, multiple acci- 
dents). They may engage in sexual behavior or substance use that has a high risk for harm- 
ful consequences. They may neglect or fail to care for a child in a way that puts the child in 
danger. 

Individuals with antisocial personality disorder also tend to be consistently and ex- 
tremely irresponsible (Criterion A6). Irresponsible work behavior may be indicated by sig- 
nificant periods of unemployment despite available job opportunities, or by abandonment 
of several jobs without a realistic plan for getting another job. There may also be a pattern 
of repeated absences from work that are not explained by illness either in themselves or in 
their family. Financial irresponsibility is indicated by acts such as defaulting on debts, fail- 
ing to provide child support, or failing to support other dependents on a regular basis. In- 
dividuals with antisocial personality disorder show little remorse for the consequences of 
their acts (Criterion A7). They may be indifferent to, or provide a superficial rationaliza- 
tion for, having hurt, mistreated, or stolen from someone (e.g., “life’s unfair,” “losers de- 
serve to lose”). These individuals may blame the victims for being foolish, helpless, or 
deserving their fate (e.g., “he had it coming anyway”); they may minimize the harmful 
consequences of their actions; or they may simply indicate complete indifference. They 
generally fail to compensate or make amends for their behavior. They may believe that 
everyone is out to “help number one” and that one should stop at nothing to avoid being 
pushed around. 

The antisocial behavior must not occur exclusively during the course of schizophrenia 
or bipolar disorder (Criterion D). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with antisocial personality disorder frequently lack empathy and tend to be 
callous, cynical, and contemptuous of the feelings, rights, and sufferings of others. They 
may have an inflated and arrogant self-appraisal (e.g., feel that ordinary work is beneath 
them or lack a realistic concern about their current problems or their future) and may be 
excessively opinionated, self-assured, or cocky. They may display a glib, superficial charm 
and can be quite voluble and verbally facile (e.g., using technical terms or jargon that 
might impress someone who is unfamiliar with the topic). Lack of empathy, inflated self- 
appraisal, and superficial charm are features that have been commonly included in tradi- 
tional conceptions of psychopathy that may be particularly distinguishing of the disorder 
and more predictive of recidivism in prison or forensic settings, where criminal, delin- 
quent, or aggressive acts are likely to be nonspecific. These individuals may also be irre- 
sponsible and exploitative in their sexual relationships. They may have a history of many 


Antisocial Personality Disorder 661 


sexual partners and may never have sustained a monogamous relationship. They may be 
irresponsible as parents, as evidenced by malnutrition of a child, an illness in the child re- 
sulting from a lack of minimal hygiene, a child’s dependence on neighbors or nonresident 
relatives for food or shelter, a failure to arrange for a caretaker for a young child when the 
individual is away from home, or repeated squandering of money required for household 
necessities. These individuals may receive dishonorable discharges from the armed ser- 
vices, may fail to be self-supporting, may become impoverished or even homeless, or may 
spend many years in penal institutions. Individuals with antisocial personality disorder 
are more likely than people in the general population to die prematurely by violent means 
(e.g., suicide, accidents, homicides). 

Individuals with antisocial personality disorder may also experience dysphoria, in- 
cluding complaints of tension, inability to tolerate boredom, and depressed mood. They 
may have associated anxiety disorders, depressive disorders, substance use disorders, so- 
matic symptom disorder, gambling disorder, and other disorders of impulse control. In- 
dividuals with antisocial personality disorder also often have personality features that 
meet criteria for other personality disorders, particularly borderline, histrionic, and nar- 
cissistic personality disorders. The likelihood of developing antisocial personality disor- 
der in adult life is increased if the individual experienced childhood onset of conduct 
disorder (before age 10 years) and accompanying attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. 
Child abuse or neglect, unstable or erratic parenting, or inconsistent parental discipline 
may increase the likelihood that conduct disorder will evolve into antisocial personality 
disorder. 


Prevalence 


Twelve-month prevalence rates of antisocial personality disorder, using criteria from pre- 
vious DSMs, are between 0.2% and 3.3%. The highest prevalence of antisocial personality 
disorder (greater than 70%) is among most severe samples of males with alcohol use dis- 
order and from substance abuse clinics, prisons, or other forensic settings. Prevalence is 
higher in samples affected by adverse socioeconomic (i.e., poverty) or sociocultural (i.e., 
migration) factors. 


Development and Course 


Antisocial personality disorder has a chronic course but may become less evident or remit 
as the individual grows older, particularly by the fourth decade of life. Although this re- 
mission tends to be particularly evident with respect to engaging in criminal behavior, 
there is likely to be a decrease in the full spectrum of antisocial behaviors and substance 
use. By definition, antisocial personality cannot be diagnosed before age 18 years. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Antisocial personality disorder is more common among the 
first-degree biological relatives of those with the disorder than in the general population. 
The risk to biological relatives of females with the disorder tends to be higher than the risk 
to biological relatives of males with the disorder. Biological relatives of individuals with 
this disorder are also at increased risk for somatic symptom disorder and substance use 
disorders. Within a family that has a member with antisocial personality disorder, males 
more often have antisocial personality disorder and substance use disorders, whereas fe- 
males more often have somatic symptom disorder. However, in such families, there is an 
increase in prevalence of all of these disorders in both males and females compared with 
the general population. Adoption studies indicate that both genetic and environmental 
factors contribute to the risk of developing antisocial personality disorder. Both adopted 
and biological children of parents with antisocial personality disorder have an increased 


662 Personality Disorders 


risk of developing antisocial personality disorder, somatic symptom disorder, and sub- 
stance use disorders. Adopted-away children resemble their biological parents more than 
their adoptive parents, but the adoptive family environment influences the risk of devel- 
oping a personality disorder and related psychopathology. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Antisocial personality disorder appears to be associated with low socioeconomic status 
and urban settings. Concerns have been raised that the diagnosis may at times be misap- 
plied to individuals in settings in which seemingly antisocial behavior may be part of a 
protective survival strategy. In assessing antisocial traits, it is helpful for the clinician to 
consider the social and economic context in which the behaviors occur. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Antisocial personality disorder is much more common in males than in females. There has 
been some concern that antisocial personality disorder may be underdiagnosed in fe- 
males, particularly because of the emphasis on aggressive items in the definition of con- 
duct disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


The diagnosis of antisocial personality disorder is not given to individuals younger than 
18 years and is given only if there is a history of some symptoms of conduct disorder be- 
fore age 15 years. For individuals older than 18 years, a diagnosis of conduct disorder is 
given only if the criteria for antisocial personality disorder are not met. 


Substance use disorders. When antisocial behavior in an adult is associated with a 
substance use disorder, the diagnosis of antisocial personality disorder is not made unless 
the signs of antisocial personality disorder were also present in childhood and have con- 
tinued into adulthood. When substance use and antisocial behavior both began in childhood 
and continued into adulthood, both a substance use disorder and antisocial personality 
disorder should be diagnosed if the criteria for both are met, even though some antisocial 
acts may be a consequence of the substance use disorder (e.g., illegal selling of drugs, thefts 
to obtain money for drugs). 


Schizophrenia and bipolar disorders. Antisocial behavior that occurs exclusively dur- 
ing the course of schizophrenia or a bipolar disorder should not be diagnosed as antisocial 
personality disorder. 


Other personality disorders. Other personality disorders may be confused with antiso- 
cial personality disorder because they have certain features in common. It is therefore im- 
portant to distinguish among these disorders based on differences in their characteristic 
features. However, if an individual has personality features that meet criteria for one or 
more personality disorders in addition to antisocial personality disorder, all can be diag- 
nosed. Individuals with antisocial personality disorder and narcissistic personality disor- 
der share a tendency to be tough-minded, glib, superficial, exploitative, and lack empathy. 
However, narcissistic personality disorder does not include characteristics of impulsivity, 
aggression, and deceit. In addition, individuals with antisocial personality disorder may 
not be as needy of the admiration and envy of others, and persons with narcissistic per- 
sonality disorder usually lack the history of conduct disorder in childhood or criminal 
behavior in adulthood. Individuals with antisocial personality disorder and histrionic 
personality disorder share a tendency to be impulsive, superficial, excitement seeking, 
reckless, seductive, and manipulative, but persons with histrionic personality disorder 
tend to be more exaggerated in their emotions and do not characteristically engage in an- 
tisocial behaviors. Individuals with histrionic and borderline personality disorders are 


Borderline Personality Disorder 663 


manipulative to gain nurturance, whereas those with antisocial personality disorder are 
manipulative to gain profit, power, or some other material gratification. Individuals with 
antisocial personality disorder tend to be less emotionally unstable and more aggressive 
than those with borderline personality disorder. Although antisocial behavior may be 
present in some individuals with paranoid personality disorder, it is not usually moti- 
vated by a desire for personal gain or to exploit others as in antisocial personality disorder, 
but rather is more often attributable to a desire for revenge. 


Criminal behavior not associated with a personality disorder. Antisocial personality 
disorder must be distinguished from criminal behavior undertaken for gain that is not ac- 
companied by the personality features characteristic of this disorder. Only when antisocial 
personality traits are inflexible, maladaptive, and persistent and cause significant func- 
tional impairment or subjective distress do they constitute antisocial personality disorder. 


Borderline Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.83 (F60.3) 


A pervasive pattern of instability of interpersonal relationships, self-image, and affects, 

and marked impulsivity, beginning by early adulthood and present in a variety of contexts, 

as indicated by five (or more) of the following: 

1. Frantic efforts to avoid real or imagined abandonment. (Note: Do not include suicidal 
or self-mutilating behavior covered in Criterion 5.) 

2. Apattern of unstable and intense interpersonal relationships characterized by alternat- 

ing between extremes of idealization and devaluation. 

Identity disturbance: markedly and persistently unstable self-image or sense of self. 

4. Impulsivity in at least two areas that are potentially self-damaging (e.g., spending, sex, 

substance abuse, reckless driving, binge eating). (Note: Do not include suicidal or self- 

mutilating behavior covered in Criterion 5.) 

Recurrent suicidal behavior, gestures, or threats, or self-mutilating behavior. 

6. Affective instability due to a marked reactivity of mood (e.g., intense episodic dysphoria, 
irritability, or anxiety usually lasting a few hours and only rarely more than a few days). 

7. Chronic feelings of emptiness. 

8. Inappropriate, intense anger or difficulty controlling anger (e.g., frequent displays of 
temper, constant anger, recurrent physical fights). 

9. Transient, stress-related paranoid ideation or severe dissociative symptoms. 


w 


a 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of borderline personality disorder is a pervasive pattern of instability 
of interpersonal relationships, self-image, and affects, and marked impulsivity that begins 
by early adulthood and is present in a variety of contexts. 

Individuals with borderline personality disorder make frantic efforts to avoid real or 
imagined abandonment (Criterion 1). The perception of impending separation or rejection, 
or the loss of external structure, can lead to profound changes in self-image, affect, cognition, 
and behavior. These individuals are very sensitive to environmental circumstances. They ex- 
perience intense abandonment fears and inappropriate anger even when faced with a real- 
istic time-limited separation or when there are unavoidable changes in plans (e.g., sudden 
despair in reaction to a clinician’s announcing the end of the hour; panic or fury when some- 
one important to them is just a few minutes late or must cancel an appointment). They may 
believe that this “abandonment” implies they are “bad.” These abandonment fears are re- 
lated to an intolerance of being alone and a need to have other people with them. Their frantic 


664 Personality Disorders 


efforts to avoid abandonment may include impulsive actions such as self-mutilating or sui- 
cidal behaviors, which are described separately in Criterion 5. 

Individuals with borderline personality disorder have a pattern of unstable and intense 
relationships (Criterion 2). They may idealize potential caregivers or lovers at the first or 
second meeting, demand to spend a lot of time together, and share the most intimate details 
early in a relationship. However, they may switch quickly from idealizing other people to 
devaluing them, feeling that the other person does not care enough, does not give enough, 
or is not “there” enough. These individuals can empathize with and nurture other people, 
but only with the expectation that the other person will “be there” in return to meet their 
own needs on demand. These individuals are prone to sudden and dramatic shifts in their 
view of others, who may alternatively be seen as beneficent supports or as cruelly punitive. 
Such shifts often reflect disillusionment with a caregiver whose nurturing qualities had 
been idealized or whose rejection or abandonment is expected. 

There may be an identity disturbance characterized by markedly and persistently un- 
stable self-image or sense of self (Criterion 3). There are sudden and dramatic shifts in self- 
image, characterized by shifting goals, values, and vocational aspirations. There may be 
sudden changes in opinions and plans about career, sexual identity, values, and types of 
friends. These individuals may suddenly change from the role of a needy supplicant for 
help to that of a righteous avenger of past mistreatment. Although they usually have a self- 
image that is based on being bad or evil, individuals with this disorder may at times have 
feelings that they do not exist at all. Such experiences usually occur in situations in which 
the individual feels a lack of a meaningful relationship, nurturing, and support. These in- 
dividuals may show worse performance in unstructured work or school situations. 

Individuals with borderline personality disorder display impulsivity in at least two areas 
that are potentially self-damaging (Criterion 4). They may gamble, spend money irrespon- 
sibly, binge eat, abuse substances, engage in unsafe sex, or drive recklessly. Individuals 
with this disorder display recurrent suicidal behavior, gestures, or threats, or self-mutilat- 
ing behavior (Criterion 5). Completed suicide occurs in 8%-10% of such individuals, and 
self-mutilative acts (e.g., cutting or burning) and suicide threats and attempts are very 
common. Recurrent suicidality is often the reason that these individuals present for help. 
These self-destructive acts are usually precipitated by threats of separation or rejection or 
by expectations that the individual assumes increased responsibility. Self-mutilation may 
occur during dissociative experiences and often brings relief by reaffirming the ability to 
feel or by expiating the individual's sense of being evil. 

Individuals with borderline personality disorder may display affective instability that 
is due to a marked reactivity of mood (e.g., intense episodic dysphoria, irritability, or anx- 
iety usually lasting a few hours and only rarely more than a few days) (Criterion 6). The 
basic dysphoric mood of those with borderline personality disorder is often disrupted by 
periods of anger, panic, or despair and is rarely relieved by periods of well-being or satis- 
faction. These episodes may reflect the individual’s extreme reactivity to interpersonal 
stresses. Individuals with borderline personality disorder may be troubled by chronic feel- 
ings of emptiness (Criterion 7). Easily bored, they may constantly seek something to do. 
Individuals with this disorder frequently express inappropriate, intense anger or have dif- 
ficulty controlling their anger (Criterion 8). They may display extreme sarcasm, enduring 
bitterness, or verbal outbursts. The anger is often elicited when a caregiver or lover is seen 
as neglectful, withholding, uncaring, or abandoning. Such expressions of anger are often 
followed by shame and guilt and contribute to the feeling they have of being evil. During 
periods of extreme stress, transient paranoid ideation or dissociative symptoms (e.g., de- 
personalization) may occur (Criterion 9), but these are generally of insufficient severity or 
duration to warrant an additional diagnosis. These episodes occur most frequently in re- 
sponse to a real or imagined abandonment. Symptoms tend to be transient, lasting min- 
utes or hours. The real or perceived return of the caregiver’s nurturance may result in a 
remission of symptoms. 


Borderline Personality Disorder 665 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with borderline personality disorder may have a pattern of undermining 
themselves at the moment a goal is about to be realized (e.g., dropping out of school just 
before graduation; regressing severely after a discussion of how well therapy is going; de- 
stroying a good relationship just when it is clear that the relationship could last). Some in- 
dividuals develop psychotic-like symptoms (e.g., hallucinations, body-image distortions, 
ideas of reference, hypnagogic phenomena) during times of stress. Individuals with this 
disorder may feel more secure with transitional objects (i.e., a pet or inanimate possession) 
than in interpersonal relationships. Premature death from suicide may occur in individu- 
als with this disorder, especially in those with co-occurring depressive disorders or sub- 
stance use disorders. Physical handicaps may result from self-inflicted abuse behaviors or 
failed suicide attempts. Recurrent job losses, interrupted education, and separation or di- 
vorce are common. Physical and sexual abuse, neglect, hostile conflict, and early parental 
loss are more common in the childhood histories of those with borderline personality dis- 
order. Common co-occurring disorders include depressive and bipolar disorders, sub- 
stance use disorders, eating disorders (notably bulimia nervosa), posttraumatic stress 
disorder, and attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Borderline personality disorder 
also frequently co-occurs with the other personality disorders. 


Prevalence 


The median population prevalence of borderline personality disorder is estimated to be 
1.6% but may be as high as 5.9%. The prevalence of borderline personality disorder is 
about 6% in primary care settings, about 10% among individuals seen in outpatient mental 
health clinics, and about 20% among psychiatric inpatients. The prevalence of borderline 
personality disorder may decrease in older age groups. 


Development and Course 


There is considerable variability in the course of borderline personality disorder. The most 
common pattern is one of chronic instability in early adulthood, with episodes of serious 
affective and impulsive dyscontrol and high levels of use of health and mental health re- 
sources. The impairment from the disorder and the risk of suicide are greatest in the 
young-adult years and gradually wane with advancing age. Although the tendency to- 
ward intense emotions, impulsivity, and intensity in relationships is often lifelong, indi- 
viduals who engage in therapeutic intervention often show improvement beginning 
sometime during the first year. During their 30s and 40s, the majority of individuals with 
this disorder attain greater stability in their relationships and vocational functioning. Fol- 
low-up studies of individuals identified through outpatient mental health clinics indicate 
that after about 10 years, as many as half of the individuals no longer have a pattern of be- 
havior that meets full criteria for borderline personality disorder. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Borderline personality disorder is about five times more 
common among first-degree biological relatives of those with the disorder than in the gen- 
eral population. There is also an increased familial risk for substance use disorders, anti- 
social personality disorder, and depressive or bipolar disorders. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 

The pattern of behavior seen in borderline personality disorder has been identified in many 
settings around the world. Adolescents and young adults with identity problems (especially 
when accompanied by substance use) may transiently display behaviors that misleadingly 


666 Personality Disorders 


give the impression of borderline personality disorder. Such situations are characterized by 
emotional instability, “existential” dilemmas, uncertainty, anxiety-provoking choices, con- 
flicts about sexual orientation, and competing social pressures to decide on careers. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Borderline personality disorder is diagnosed predominantly (about 75%) in females. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Depressive and bipolar disorders. Borderline personality disorder often co-occurs with 
depressive or bipolar disorders, and when criteria for both are met, both may be diagnosed. 
Because the cross-sectional presentation of borderline personality disorder can be mimicked 
by an episode of depressive or bipolar disorder, the clinician should avoid giving an addi- 
tional diagnosis of borderline personality disorder based only on cross-sectional presenta- 
tion without having documented that the pattern of behavior had an early onset and a long- 
standing course. 


Other personality disorders. Other personality disorders may be confused with border- 
line personality disorder because they have certain features in common. It is therefore im- 
portant to distinguish among these disorders based on differences in their characteristic 
features. However, if an individual has personality features that meet criteria for one or 
more personality disorders in addition to borderline personality disorder, all can be diag- 
nosed. Although histrionic personality disorder can also be characterized by attention seek- 
ing, manipulative behavior, and rapidly shifting emotions, borderline personality disorder 
is distinguished by self-destructiveness, angry disruptions in close relationships, and 
chronic feelings of deep emptiness and loneliness. Paranoid ideas or illusions may be pres- 
ent in both borderline personality disorder and schizotypal personality disorder, but these 
symptoms are more transient, interpersonally reactive, and responsive to external structur- 
ing in borderline personality disorder. Although paranoid personality disorder and narcis- 
sistic personality disorder may also be characterized by an angry reaction to minor stimuli, 
the relative stability of self-image, as well as the relative lack of self-destructiveness, impul- 
sivity, and abandonment concerns, distinguishes these disorders from borderline person- 
ality disorder. Although antisocial personality disorder and borderline personality disorder 
are both characterized by manipulative behavior, individuals with antisocial personality 
disorder are manipulative to gain profit, power, or some other material gratification, 
whereas the goal in borderline personality disorder is directed more toward gaining the con- 
cern of caretakers. Both dependent personality disorder and borderline personality disorder 
are characterized by fear of abandonment; however, the individual with borderline person- 
ality disorder reacts to abandonment with feelings of emotional emptiness, rage, and de- 
mands, whereas the individual with dependent personality disorder reacts with increasing 
appeasement and submissiveness and urgently seeks a replacement relationship to provide 
caregiving and support. Borderline personality disorder can further be distinguished from 
dependent personality disorder by the typical pattern of unstable and intense relationships. 


Personality change due to another medical condition. Borderline personality disor- 
der must be distinguished from personality change due to another medical condition, in 
which the traits that emerge are attributable to the effects of another medical condition on 
the central nervous system. 


Substance use disorders. Borderline personality disorder must also be distinguished 
from symptoms that may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Identity problems. Borderline personality disorder should be distinguished from an 
identity problem, which is reserved for identity concerns related to a developmental phase 
(e.g., adolescence) and does not qualify as a mental disorder. 


Histrionic Personality Disorder 667 


Histrionic Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.50 (F60.4) 


A pervasive pattern of excessive emotionality and attention seeking, beginning by early adult- 
hood and present in a variety of contexts, as indicated by five (or more) of the following: 

1. Is uncomfortable in situations in which he or she is not the center of attention. 

2. Interaction with others is often characterized by inappropriate sexually seductive or 
provocative behavior. 

Displays rapidly shifting and shallow expression of emotions. 

Consistently uses physical appearance to draw attention to self. 

Has a style of speech that is excessively impressionistic and lacking in detail. 

Shows self-dramatization, theatricality, and exaggerated expression of emotion. 

Is suggestible (i.e., easily influenced by others or circumstances). 

Considers relationships to be more intimate than they actually are. 


ONOAL 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of histrionic personality disorder is pervasive and excessive emotion- 
ality and attention-seeking behavior. This pattern begins by early adulthood and is pres- 
ent in a variety of contexts. 

Individuals with histrionic personality disorder are uncomfortable or feel unappreci- 
ated when they are not the center of attention (Criterion 1). Often lively and dramatic, they 
tend to draw attention to themselves and may initially charm new acquaintances by their 
enthusiasm, apparent openness, or flirtatiousness. These qualities wear thin, however, as 
these individuals continually demand to be the center of attention. They commandeer the 
role of “the life of the party.” If they are not the center of attention, they may do something 
dramatic (e.g., make up stories, create a scene) to draw the focus of attention to themselves. 
This need is often apparent in their behavior with a clinician (e.g., being flattering, bring- 
ing gifts, providing dramatic descriptions of physical and psychological symptoms that 
are replaced by new symptoms each visit). 

The appearance and behavior of individuals with this disorder are often inappropri- 
ately sexually provocative or seductive (Criterion 2). This behavior not only is directed to- 
ward persons in whom the individual has a sexual or romantic interest but also occurs in 
a wide variety of social, occupational, and professional relationships beyond what is ap- 
propriate for the social context. Emotional expression may be shallow and rapidly shifting 
(Criterion 3). Individuals with this disorder consistently use physical appearance to draw 
attention to themselves (Criterion 4). They are overly concerned with impressing others by 
their appearance and expend an excessive amount of time, energy, and money on clothes 
and grooming. They may “fish for compliments” regarding appearance and may be easily 
and excessively upset by a critical comment about how they look or by a photograph that 
they regard as unflattering. 

These individuals have a style of speech that is excessively impressionistic and lacking 
in detail (Criterion 5). Strong opinions are expressed with dramatic flair, but underlying 
reasons are usually vague and diffuse, without supporting facts and details. For example, 
an individual with histrionic personality disorder may comment that a certain individual 
is a wonderful human being, yet be unable to provide any specific examples of good qual- 
ities to support this opinion. Individuals with this disorder are characterized by self- 
dramatization, theatricality, and an exaggerated expression of emotion (Criterion 6). They 
may embarrass friends and acquaintances by an excessive public display of emotions (e.g., 
embracing casual acquaintances with excessive ardor, sobbing uncontrollably on minor 


668 Personality Disorders 


sentimental occasions, having temper tantrums). However, their emotions often seem to 
be turned on and off too quickly to be deeply felt, which may lead others to accuse the in- 
dividual of faking these feelings. 

Individuals with histrionic personality disorder have a high degree of suggestibility (Cri- 
terion 7). Their opinions and feelings are easily influenced by others and by current fads. 
They may be overly trusting, especially of strong authority figures whom they see as mag- 
ically solving their problems. They have a tendency to play hunches and to adopt convic- 
tions quickly. Individuals with this disorder often consider relationships more intimate 
than they actually are, describing almost every acquaintance as “my dear, dear friend” or 
referring to physicians met only once or twice under professional circumstances by their 
first names (Criterion 8). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with histrionic personality disorder may have difficulty achieving emotional in- 
timacy in romantic or sexual relationships. Without being aware of it, they often act out a 
role (e.g., “victim” or “princess”) in their relationships to others. They may seek to control 
their partner through emotional manipulation or seductiveness on one level, while display- 
ing a marked dependency on them at another level. Individuals with this disorder often 
have impaired relationships with same-sex friends because their sexually provocative inter- 
personal style may seem a threat to their friends’ relationships. These individuals may also 
alienate friends with demands for constant attention. They often become depressed and up- 
set when they are not the center of attention. They may crave novelty, stimulation, and ex- 
citement and have a tendency to become bored with their usual routine. These individuals 
are often intolerant of, or frustrated by, situations that involve delayed gratification, and 
their actions are often directed at obtaining immediate satisfaction. Although they often ini- 
tiate a job or project with great enthusiasm, their interest may lag quickly. Longer-term re- 
lationships may be neglected to make way for the excitement of new relationships. 

The actual risk of suicide is not known, but clinical experience suggests that individu- 
als with this disorder are at increased risk for suicidal gestures and threats to get attention 
and coerce better caregiving. Histrionic personality disorder has been associated with 
higher rates of somatic symptom disorder, conversion disorder (functional neurological 
symptom disorder), and major depressive disorder. Borderline, narcissistic, antisocial, and 
dependent personality disorders often co-occur. 


Prevalence 


Data from the 2001-2002 National Epidemiologic Survey on Alcohol and Related Condi- 
tions suggest a prevalence of histrionic personality of 1.84%. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Norms for interpersonal behavior, personal appearance, and emotional expressiveness 
vary widely across cultures, genders, and age groups. Before considering the various traits 
(e.g., emotionality, seductiveness, dramatic interpersonal style, novelty seeking, sociabil- 
ity, charm, impressionability, a tendency to somatization) to be evidence of histrionic per- 
sonality disorder, it is important to evaluate whether they cause clinically significant 
impairment or distress. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In clinical settings, this disorder has been diagnosed more frequently in females; however, 
the sex ratio is not significantly different from the sex ratio of females within the respective 
clinical setting. In contrast, some studies using structured assessments report similar prev- 
alence rates among males and females. 


Narcissistic Personality Disorder 669 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other personality disorders and personality traits. Other personality disorders may 
be confused with histrionic personality disorder because they have certain features in 
common. It is therefore important to distinguish among these disorders based on differ- 
ences in their characteristic features. However, if an individual has personality features 
that meet criteria for one or more personality disorders in addition to histrionic personal- 
ity disorder, all can be diagnosed. Although borderline personality disorder can also be 
characterized by attention seeking, manipulative behavior, and rapidly shifting emotions, 
it is distinguished by self-destructiveness, angry disruptions in close relationships, and 
chronic feelings of deep emptiness and identity disturbance. Individuals with antisocial 
personality disorder and histrionic personality disorder share a tendency to be impulsive, 
superficial, excitement seeking, reckless, seductive, and manipulative, but persons with 
histrionic personality disorder tend to be more exaggerated in their emotions and do not 
characteristically engage in antisocial behaviors. Individuals with histrionic personality 
disorder are manipulative to gain nurturance, whereas those with antisocial personality 
disorder are manipulative to gain profit, power, or some other material gratification. Al- 
though individuals with narcissistic personality disorder also crave attention from others, 
they usually want praise for their “superiority,” whereas individuals with histrionic per- 
sonality disorder are willing to be viewed as fragile or dependent if this is instrumental in 
getting attention. Individuals with narcissistic personality disorder may exaggerate the 
intimacy of their relationships with other people, but they are more apt to emphasize the 
“VIP” status or wealth of their friends. In dependent personality disorder, the individual 
is excessively dependent on others for praise and guidance, but is without the flamboyant, 
exaggerated, emotional features of individuals with histrionic personality disorder. 

Many individuals may display histrionic personality traits. Only when these traits are 
inflexible, maladaptive, and persisting and cause significant functional impairment or 
subjective distress do they constitute histrionic personality disorder. 


Personality change due to another medical condition. Histrionic personality disorder 
must be distinguished from personality change due to another medical condition, in 
which the traits that emerge are attributable to the effects of another medical condition on 
the central nervous system. 


Substance use disorders. The disorder must also be distinguished from symptoms that 
may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Narcissistic Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.81 (F60.81) 


A pervasive pattern of grandiosity (in fantasy or behavior), need for admiration, and lack 

of empathy, beginning by early adulthood and present in a variety of contexts, as indicated 

by five (or more) of the following: 

1. Has a grandiose sense of self-importance (e.g., exaggerates achievements and talents, 
expects to be recognized as superior without commensurate achievements). 

2. Is preoccupied with fantasies of unlimited success, power, brilliance, beauty, or ideal 
love. 

3. Believes that he or she is “special” and unique and can only be understood by, or 
should associate with, other special or high-status people (or institutions). 

4. Requires excessive admiration. 

5. Has a sense of entitlement (i.e., unreasonable expectations of especially favorable 
treatment or automatic compliance with his or her expectations). 


670 Personality Disorders 


6. ls interpersonally exploitative (i.e., takes advantage of others to achieve his or her own 
ends). 

7. Lacks empathy: is unwilling to recognize or identify with the feelings and needs of others. 

Is often envious of others or believes that others are envious of him or her. 

9. Shows arrogant, haughty behaviors or attitudes. 


0 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of narcissistic personality disorder is a pervasive pattern of grandi- 
osity, need for admiration, and lack of empathy that begins by early adulthood and is pres- 
ent in a variety of contexts. 

Individuals with this disorder have a grandiose sense of self-importance (Criterion 1). 
They routinely overestimate their abilities and inflate their accomplishments, often appearing 
boastful and pretentious. They may blithely assume that others attribute the same value to 
their efforts and may be surprised when the praise they expect and feel they deserve is not 
forthcoming. Often implicit in the inflated judgments of their own accomplishments is an un- 
derestimation (devaluation) of the contributions of others. Individuals with narcissistic per- 
sonality disorder are often preoccupied with fantasies of unlimited success, power, brilliance, 
beauty, or ideal love (Criterion 2). They may ruminate about “long overdue” admiration and 
privilege and compare themselves favorably with famous or privileged people. 

Individuals with narcissistic personality disorder believe that they are superior, spe- 
cial, or unique and expect others to recognize them as such (Criterion 3). They may feel 
that they can only be understood by, and should only associate with, other people who are 
special or of high status and may attribute “unique,” “perfect,” or “gifted” qualities to those 
with whom they associate. Individuals with this disorder believe that their needs are spe- 
cial and beyond the ken of ordinary people. Their own self-esteem is enhanced (i.e., “mir- 
rored”) by the idealized value that they assign to those with whom they associate. They are 
likely to insist on having only the “top” person (doctor, lawyer, hairdresser, instructor) or 
being affiliated with the “best” institutions but may devalue the credentials of those who dis- 
appoint them. 

Individuals with this disorder generally require excessive admiration (Criterion 4). Their 
self-esteem is almost invariably very fragile. They may be preoccupied with how well they 
are doing and how favorably they are regarded by others. This often takes the form of aneed 
for constant attention and admiration. They may expect their arrival to be greeted with great 
fanfare and are astonished if others do not covet their possessions. They may constantly fish 
for compliments, often with great charm. A sense of entitlement is evident in these individ- 
uals’ unreasonable expectation of especially favorable treatment (Criterion 5). They expect 
to be catered to and are puzzled or furious when this does not happen. For example, they 
may assume that they do not have to wait in line and that their priorities are so important 
that others should defer to them, and then get irritated when others fail to assist “in their 
very important work.” This sense of entitlement, combined with a lack of sensitivity to the 
wants and needs of others, may result in the conscious or unwitting exploitation of others 
(Criterion 6). They expect to be given whatever they want or feel they need, no matter what 
it might mean to others. For example, these individuals may expect great dedication from 
others and may overwork them without regard for the impact on their lives. They tend to 
form friendships or romantic relationships only if the other person seems likely to advance 
their purposes or otherwise enhance their self-esteem. They often usurp special privileges 
and extra resources that they believe they deserve because they are so special. 

Individuals with narcissistic personality disorder generally have a lack of empathy and 
have difficulty recognizing the desires, subjective experiences, and feelings of others (Crite- 
rion 7). They may assume that others are totally concerned about their welfare. They tend to 
discuss their own concerns in inappropriate and lengthy detail, while failing to recognize 
that others also have feelings and needs. They are often contemptuous and impatient with 


Narcissistic Personality Disorder 671 


others who talk about their own problems and concerns. These individuals may be oblivious 
to the hurt their remarks may inflict (e.g., exuberantly telling a former lover that “I am now 
in the relationship of a lifetime!”; boasting of health in front of someone who is sick). When 
recognized, the needs, desires, or feelings of others are likely to be viewed disparagingly as 
signs of weakness or vulnerability. Those who relate to individuals with narcissistic person- 
ality disorder typically find an emotional coldness and lack of reciprocal interest. 

These individuals are often envious of others or believe that others are envious of them 
(Criterion 8). They may begrudge others their successes or possessions, feeling that they better 
deserve those achievements, admiration, or privileges. They may harshly devalue the contri- 
butions of others, particularly when those individuals have received acknowledgment or 
praise for their accomplishments. Arrogant, haughty behaviors characterize these individuals; 
they often display snobbish, disdainful, or patronizing attitudes (Criterion 9). For example, an 
individual with this disorder may complain about a clumsy waiter’s “rudeness” or “stupidity” 
or conclude a medical evaluation with a condescending evaluation of the physician. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Vulnerability in self-esteem makes individuals with narcissistic personality disorder very 
sensitive to “injury” from criticism or defeat. Although they may not show it outwardly, 
criticism may haunt these individuals and may leave them feeling humiliated, degraded, 
hollow, and empty. They may react with disdain, rage, or defiant counterattack. Such ex- 
periences often lead to social withdrawal or an appearance of humility that may mask and 
protect the grandiosity. Interpersonal relations are typically impaired because of problems 
derived from entitlement, the need for admiration, and the relative disregard for the sen- 
sitivities of others. Though overweening ambition and confidence may lead to high 
achievement, performance may be disrupted because of intolerance of criticism or defeat. 
Sometimes vocational functioning can be very low, reflecting an unwillingness to take a 
risk in competitive or other situations in which defeat is possible. Sustained feelings of 
shame or humiliation and the attendant self-criticism may be associated with social with- 
drawal, depressed mood, and persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia) or major de- 
pressive disorder. In contrast, sustained periods of grandiosity may be associated with a 
hypomanic mood. Narcissistic personality disorder is also associated with anorexia ner- 
vosa and substance use disorders (especially related to cocaine). Histrionic, borderline, 
antisocial, and paranoid personality disorders may be associated with narcissistic person- 
ality disorder. 


Prevalence 


Prevalence estimates for narcissistic personality disorder, based on DSM-IV definitions, 
range from 0% to 6.2% in community samples. 


Development and Course 


Narcissistic traits may be particularly common in adolescents and do not necessarily in- 
dicate that the individual will go on to have narcissistic personality disorder. Individuals 
with narcissistic personality disorder may have special difficulties adjusting to the onset of 
physical and occupational limitations that are inherent in the aging process. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 
Of those diagnosed with narcissistic personality disorder, 50%-75% are male. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other personality disorders and personality traits. Other personality disorders may 
be confused with narcissistic personality disorder because they have certain features in 


672 Personality Disorders 


common. It is, therefore, important to distinguish among these disorders based on differ- 
ences in their characteristic features. However, if an individual has personality features 
that meet criteria for one or more personality disorders in addition to narcissistic person- 
ality disorder, all can be diagnosed. The most useful feature in discriminating narcissistic 
personality disorder from histrionic, antisocial, and borderline personality disorders, in 
which the interactive styles are coquettish, callous, and needy, respectively, is the grandi- 
osity characteristic of narcissistic personality disorder. The relative stability of self-image 
as well as the relative lack of self-destructiveness, impulsivity, and abandonment concerns 
also help distinguish narcissistic personality disorder from borderline personality disor- 
der. Excessive pride in achievements, a relative lack of emotional display, and disdain for 
others’ sensitivities help distinguish narcissistic personality disorder from histrionic 
personality disorder. Although individuals with borderline, histrionic, and narcissistic 
personality disorders may require much attention, those with narcissistic personality dis- 
order specifically need that attention to be admiring. Individuals with antisocial and nar- 
cissistic personality disorders share a tendency to be tough-minded, glib, superficial, 
exploitative, and unempathic. However, narcissistic personality disorder does not neces- 
sarily include characteristics of impulsivity, aggression, and deceit. In addition, individu- 
als with antisocial personality disorder may not be as needy of the admiration and envy of 
others, and persons with narcissistic personality disorder usually lack the history of con- 
duct disorder in childhood or criminal behavior in adulthood. In both narcissistic person- 
ality disorder and obsessive-compulsive personality disorder, the individual may profess 
a commitment to perfectionism and believe that others cannot do things as well. In con- 
trast to the accompanying self-criticism of those with obsessive-compulsive personality 
disorder, individuals with narcissistic personality disorder are more likely to believe that 
they have achieved perfection. Suspiciousness and social withdrawal usually distinguish 
those with schizotypal or paranoid personality disorder from those with narcissistic per- 
sonality disorder. When these qualities are present in individuals with narcissistic person- 
ality disorder, they derive primarily from fears of having imperfections or flaws revealed. 

Many highly successful individuals display personality traits that might be considered 
narcissistic. Only when these traits are inflexible, maladaptive, and persisting and cause 
significant functional impairment or subjective distress do they constitute narcissistic per- 
sonality disorder. 


Mania or hypomania. Grandiosity may emerge as part of manic or hypomanic episodes, 
but the association with mood change or functional impairments helps distinguish these 
episodes from narcissistic personality disorder. 


Substance use disorders. Narcissistic personality disorder must also be distinguished 
from symptoms that may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Cluster C Personality Disorders 


Avoidant Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.82 (F60.6) 


A pervasive pattern of social inhibition, feelings of inadequacy, and hypersensitivity to neg- 

ative evaluation, beginning by early adulthood and present in a variety of contexts, as in- 

dicated by four (or more) of the following: 

1. Avoids occupational activities that involve significant interpersonal contact because of 
fears of criticism, disapproval, or rejection. 


Avoidant Personality Disorder 673 


2. Is unwilling to get involved with people unless certain of being liked. 

3. Shows restraint within intimate relationships because of the fear of being shamed or 
ridiculed. 

Is preoccupied with being criticized or rejected in social situations. 

Is inhibited in new interpersonal situations because of feelings of inadequacy. 

Views self as socially inept, personally unappealing, or inferior to others. 

Is unusually reluctant to take personal risks or to engage in any new activities because 
they may prove embarrassing. 


Oeors 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of avoidant personality disorder is a pervasive pattern of social inhi- 
bition, feelings of inadequacy, and hypersensitivity to negative evaluation that begins by 
early adulthood and is present in a variety of contexts. 

Individuals with avoidant personality disorder avoid work activities that involve sig- 
nificant interpersonal contact because of fears of criticism, disapproval, or rejection (Cri- 
terion 1). Offers of job promotions may be declined because the new responsibilities might 
result in criticism from co-workers. These individuals avoid making new friends unless 
they are certain they will be liked and accepted without criticism (Criterion 2). Until they 
pass stringent tests proving the contrary, other people are assumed to be critical and dis- 
approving. Individuals with this disorder will not join in group activities unless there are 
repeated and generous offers of support and nurturance. Interpersonal intimacy is often 
difficult for these individuals, although they are able to establish intimate relationships 
when there is assurance of uncritical acceptance. They may act with restraint, have diffi- 
culty talking about themselves, and withhold intimate feelings for fear of being exposed, 
ridiculed, or shamed (Criterion 3). 

Because individuals with this disorder are preoccupied with being criticized or re- 
jected in social situations, they may have a markedly low threshold for detecting such re- 
actions (Criterion 4). If someone is even slightly disapproving or critical, they may feel 
extremely hurt. They tend to be shy, quiet, inhibited, and “invisible” because of the fear 
that any attention would be degrading or rejecting. They expect that no matter what they 
say, others will see it as “wrong,” and so they may say nothing at all. They react strongly 
to subtle cues that are suggestive of mockery or derision. Despite their longing to be active 
participants in social life, they fear placing their welfare in the hands of others. Individuals 
with avoidant personality disorder are inhibited in new interpersonal situations because 
they feel inadequate and have low self-esteem (Criterion 5). Doubts concerning social 
competence and personal appeal become especially manifest in settings involving inter- 
actions with strangers. These individuals believe themselves to be socially inept, person- 
ally unappealing, or inferior to others (Criterion 6). They are unusually reluctant to take 
personal risks or to engage in any new activities because these may prove embarrassing 
(Criterion 7). They are prone to exaggerate the potential dangers of ordinary situations, 
and a restricted lifestyle may result from their need for certainty and security. Someone 
with this disorder may cancel a job interview for fear of being embarrassed by not dressing 
appropriately. Marginal somatic symptoms or other problems may become the reason for 
avoiding new activities. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with avoidant personality disorder often vigilantly appraise the movements 
and expressions of those with whom they come into contact. Their fearful and tense de- 
meanor may elicit ridicule and derision from others, which in turn confirms their self- 
doubts. These individuals are very anxious about the possibility that they will react to crit- 
icism with blushing or crying. They are described by others as being “shy,” “timid,” 


674 Personality Disorders 


“lonely,” and “isolated.” The major problems associated with this disorder occur in social 
and occupational functioning. The low self-esteem and hypersensitivity to rejection are 
associated with restricted interpersonal contacts. These individuals may become relatively 
isolated and usually do not have a large social support network that can help them weather 
crises. They desire affection and acceptance and may fantasize about idealized relation- 
ships with others. The avoidant behaviors can also adversely affect occupational function- 
ing because these individuals try to avoid the types of social situations that may be 
important for meeting the basic demands of the job or for advancement. 

Other disorders that are commonly diagnosed with avoidant personality disorder in- 
clude depressive, bipolar, and anxiety disorders, especially social anxiety disorder (social 
phobia). Avoidant personality disorder is often diagnosed with dependent personality 
disorder, because individuals with avoidant personality disorder become very attached to 
and dependent on those few other people with whom they are friends. Avoidant per- 
sonality disorder also tends to be diagnosed with borderline personality disorder and with 
the Cluster A personality disorders (i.e., paranoid, schizoid, or schizotypal personality 
disorders). 


Prevalence 


Data from the 2001-2002 National Epidemiologic Survey on Alcohol and Related Condi- 
tions suggest a prevalence of about 2.4% for avoidant personality disorder. 


Development and Course 


The avoidant behavior often starts in infancy or childhood with shyness, isolation, and 
fear of strangers and new situations. Although shyness in childhood is a common precur- 
sor of avoidant personality disorder, in most individuals it tends to gradually dissipate as 
they get older. In contrast, individuals who go on to develop avoidant personality disor- 
der may become increasingly shy and avoidant during adolescence and early adulthood, 
when social relationships with new people become especially important. There is some 
evidence that in adults, avoidant personality disorder tends to become less evident or to 
remit with age. This diagnosis should be used with great caution in children and adoles- 
cents, for whom shy and avoidant behavior may be developmentally appropriate. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There may be variation in the degree to which different cultural and ethnic groups regard 
diffidence and avoidance as appropriate. Moreover, avoidant behavior may be the result 
of problems in acculturation following immigration. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Avoidant personality disorder appears to be equally frequent in males and females. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Anxiety disorders. There appears to be a great deal of overlap between avoidant person- 
ality disorder and social anxiety disorder (social phobia), so much so that they may be 
alternative conceptualizations of the same or similar conditions. Avoidance also character- 
izes both avoidant personality disorder and agoraphobia, and they often co-occur. 


Other personality disorders and personality traits. Other personality disorders may 
be confused with avoidant personality disorder because they have certain features in com- 
mon. It is, therefore, important to distinguish among these disorders based on differences 
in their characteristic features. However, if an individual has personality features that 
meet criteria for one or more personality disorders in addition to avoidant personality dis- 


Dependent Personality Disorder 675 


order, all can be diagnosed. Both avoidant personality disorder and dependent personal- 
ity disorder are characterized by feelings of inadequacy, hypersensitivity to criticism, and 
a need for reassurance. Although the primary focus of concern in avoidant personality 
disorder is avoidance of humiliation and rejection, in dependent personality disorder the 
focus is on being taken care of. However, avoidant personality disorder and dependent 
personality disorder are particularly likely to co-occur. Like avoidant personality disor- 
der, schizoid personality disorder and schizotypal personality disorder are characterized 
by social isolation. However, individuals with avoidant personality disorder want to have 
relationships with others and feel their loneliness deeply, whereas those with schizoid or 
schizotypal personality disorder may be content with and even prefer their social isola- 
tion. Paranoid personality disorder and avoidant personality disorder are both character- 
ized by a reluctance to confide in others. However, in avoidant personality disorder, this 
reluctance is attributable more to a fear of being embarrassed or being found inadequate 
than to a fear of others’ malicious intent. 

Many individuals display avoidant personality traits. Only when these traits are in- 
flexible, maladaptive, and persisting and cause significant functional impairment or sub- 
jective distress do they constitute avoidant personality disorder. 


Personality change due to another medical condition. Avoidant personality disorder 
must be distinguished from personality change due to another medical condition, in 
which the traits that emerge are attributable to the effects of another medical condition on 
the central nervous system. 


Substance use disorders. Avoidant personality disorder must also be distinguished 
from symptoms that may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Dependent Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.6 (F60.7) 


A pervasive and excessive need to be taken care of that leads to submissive and clinging 

behavior and fears of separation, beginning by early adulthood and present in a variety of 

contexts, as indicated by five (or more) of the following: 

1. Has difficulty making everyday decisions without an excessive amount of advice and 
reassurance from others. 

2. Needs others to assume responsibility for most major areas of his or her life. 

3. Has difficulty expressing disagreement with others because of fear of loss of support 
or approval. (Note: Do not include realistic fears of retribution.) 

4. Has difficulty initiating projects or doing things on his or her own (because of a lack of 
self-confidence in judgment or abilities rather than a lack of motivation or energy). 

5. Goes to excessive lengths to obtain nurturance and support from others, to the point 
of volunteering to do things that are unpleasant. 

6. Feels uncomfortable or helpless when alone because of exaggerated fears of being 
unable to care for himself or herself. 

7. Urgently seeks another relationship as a source of care and support when a close re- 
lationship ends. 

8. Is unrealistically preoccupied with fears of being left to take care of himself or herself. 


Diagnostic Features 

The essential feature of dependent personality disorder is a pervasive and excessive need 
to be taken care of that leads to submissive and clinging behavior and fears of separation. 
This pattern begins by early adulthood and is present in a variety of contexts. The dependent 


676 Personality Disorders 


and submissive behaviors are designed to elicit caregiving and arise from a self-perception 
of being unable to function adequately without the help of others. 

Individuals with dependent personality disorder have great difficulty making every- 
day decisions (e.g., what color shirt to wear to work or whether to carry an umbrella) without 
an excessive amount of advice and reassurance from others (Criterion 1). These individu- 
als tend to be passive and to allow other people (often a single other person) to take the ini- 
tiative and assume responsibility for most major areas of their lives (Criterion 2). Adults 
with this disorder typically depend on a parent or spouse to decide where they should 
live, what kind of job they should have, and which neighbors to befriend. Adolescents 
with this disorder may allow their parent(s) to decide what they should wear, with whom 
they should associate, how they should spend their free time, and what school or college 
they should attend. This need for others to assume responsibility goes beyond age-appro- 
priate and situation-appropriate requests for assistance from others (e.g., the specific 
needs of children, elderly persons, and handicapped persons). Dependent personality dis- 
order may occur in an individual who has a serious medical condition or disability, but in 
such cases the difficulty in taking responsibility must go beyond what would normally be 
associated with that condition or disability. 

Because they fear losing support or approval, individuals with dependent personality 
disorder often have difficulty expressing disagreement with other individuals, especially 
those on whom they are dependent (Criterion 3). These individuals feel so unable to func- 
tion alone that they will agree with things that they feel are wrong rather than risk losing 
the help of those to whom they look for guidance. They do not get appropriately angry at 
others whose support and nurturance they need for fear of alienating them. If the individ- 
ual’s concerns regarding the consequences of expressing disagreement are realistic (e.g., 
realistic fears of retribution from an abusive spouse), the behavior should not be consid- 
ered to be evidence of dependent personality disorder. 

Individuals with this disorder have difficulty initiating projects or doing things inde- 
pendently (Criterion 4). They lack self-confidence and believe that they need help to begin 
and carry through tasks. They will wait for others to start things because they believe that 
as arule others can do them better. These individuals are convinced that they are incapable 
of functioning independently and present themselves as inept and requiring constant as- 
sistance. They are, however, likely to function adequately if given the assurance that some- 
one else is supervising and approving. There may be a fear of becoming or appearing to be 
more competent, because they may believe that this will lead to abandonment. Because 
they rely on others to handle their problems, they often do not learn the skills of indepen- 
dent living, thus perpetuating dependency. 

Individuals with dependent personality disorder may go to excessive lengths to obtain 
nurturance and support from others, even to the point of volunteering for unpleasant 
tasks if such behavior will bring the care they need (Criterion 5). They are willing to submit 
to what others want, even if the demands are unreasonable. Their need to maintain an im- 
portant bond will often result in imbalanced or distorted relationships. They may make ex- 
traordinary self-sacrifices or tolerate verbal, physical, or sexual abuse. (It should be noted 
that this behavior should be considered evidence of dependent personality disorder only 
when it can clearly be established that other options are available to the individual.) Indi- 
viduals with this disorder feel uncomfortable or helpless when alone, because of their ex- 
aggerated fears of being unable to care for themselves (Criterion 6). They will “tag along” 
with important others just to avoid being alone, even if they are not interested or involved 
in what is happening. 

When a close relationship ends (e.g., a breakup with a lover; the death of a caregiver), in- 
dividuals with dependent personality disorder may urgently seek another relationship to 
provide the care and support they need (Criterion 7). Their belief that they are unable to 
function in the absence of a close relationship motivates these individuals to become quickly 
and indiscriminately attached to another individual. Individuals with this disorder are often 


Dependent Personality Disorder 677 


preoccupied with fears of being left to care for themselves (Criterion 8). They see themselves 
as so totally dependent on the advice and help of an important other person that they worry 
about being abandoned by that person when there are no grounds to justify such fears. To be 
considered as evidence of this criterion, the fears must be excessive and unrealistic. For ex- 
ample, an elderly man with cancer who moves into his son’s household for care is exhibiting 
dependent behavior that is appropriate given this person’s life circumstances. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals with dependent personality disorder are often characterized by pessimism 
and self-doubt, tend to belittle their abilities and assets, and may constantly refer to them- 
selves as “stupid.” They take criticism and disapproval as proof of their worthlessness and 
lose faith in themselves. They may seek overprotection and dominance from others. Oc- 
cupational functioning may be impaired if independent initiative is required. They may 
avoid positions of responsibility and become anxious when faced with decisions. Social re- 
lations tend to be limited to those few people on whom the individual is dependent. There 
may be an increased risk of depressive disorders, anxiety disorders, and adjustment dis- 
orders. Dependent personality disorder often co-occurs with other personality disorders, 
especially borderline, avoidant, and histrionic personality disorders. Chronic physical ill- 
ness or separation anxiety disorder in childhood or adolescence may predispose the indi- 
vidual to the development of this disorder. 


Prevalence 


Data from the 2001-2002 National Epidemiologic Survey on Alcohol and Related Condi- 
tions yielded an estimated prevalence of dependent personality disorder of 0.49%, and de- 
pendent personality was estimated, based on a probability subsample from Part II of the 
National Comorbidity Survey Replication, to be 0.6%. 


Development and Course 


This diagnosis should be used with great caution, if at all, in children and adolescents, for 
whom dependent behavior may be developmentally appropriate. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


The degree to which dependent behaviors are considered to be appropriate varies sub- 
stantially across different age and sociocultural groups. Age and cultural factors need to 
be considered in evaluating the diagnostic threshold of each criterion. Dependent behav- 
ior should be considered characteristic of the disorder only when it is clearly in excess of 
the individual's cultural norms or reflects unrealistic concerns. An emphasis on passivity, 
politeness, and deferential treatment is characteristic of some societies and may be mis- 
interpreted as traits of dependent personality disorder. Similarly, societies may differen- 
tially foster and discourage dependent behavior in males and females. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In clinical settings, dependent personality disorder has been diagnosed more frequently in 
females, although some studies report similar prevalence rates among males and females. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Other mental disorders and medical conditions. Dependent personality disorder must 
be distinguished from dependency arising as a consequence of other mental disorders (e.g., 
depressive disorders, panic disorder, agoraphobia) and as a result of other medical conditions. 


678 Personality Disorders 


Other personality disorders and personality traits. Other personality disorders may be 
confused with dependent personality disorder because they have certain features in com- 
mon. It is therefore important to distinguish among these disorders based on differences in 
their characteristic features. However, if an individual has personality features that meet cri- 
teria for one or more personality disorders in addition to dependent personality disorder, all 
can be diagnosed. Although many personality disorders are characterized by dependent 
features, dependent personality disorder can be distinguished by its predominantly submis- 
sive, reactive, and clinging behavior. Both dependent personality disorder and borderline 
personality disorder are characterized by fear of abandonment; however, the individual 
with borderline personality disorder reacts to abandonment with feelings of emotional emp- 
tiness, rage, and demands, whereas the individual with dependent personality disorder re- 
acts with increasing appeasement and submissiveness and urgently seeks a replacement 
relationship to provide caregiving and support. Borderline personality disorder can further 
be distinguished from dependent personality disorder by a typical pattern of unstable and 
intense relationships. Individuals with histrionic personality disorder, like those with de- 
pendent personality disorder, have a strong need for reassurance and approval and may ap- 
pear childlike and clinging. However, unlike dependent personality disorder, which is 
characterized by self-effacing and docile behavior, histrionic personality disorder is charac- 
terized by gregarious flamboyance with active demands for attention. Both dependent 
personality disorder and avoidant personality disorder are characterized by feelings of in- 
adequacy, hypersensitivity to criticism, and a need for reassurance; however, individuals 
with avoidant personality disorder have such a strong fear of humiliation and rejection that 
they withdraw until they are certain they will be accepted. In contrast, individuals with de- 
pendent personality disorder have a pattern of seeking and maintaining connections to im- 
portant others, rather than avoiding and withdrawing from relationships. 

Many individuals display dependent personality traits. Only when these traits are in- 
flexible, maladaptive, and persisting and cause significant functional impairment or sub- 
jective distress do they constitute dependent personality disorder. 


Personality change due to another medical condition. Dependent personality disor- 
der must be distinguished from personality change due to another medical condition, in 
which the traits that emerge are attributable to the effects of another medical condition on 
the central nervous system. 


Substance use disorders. Dependent personality disorder must also be distinguished 
from symptoms that may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Obsessive-Compulsive Personality Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 301.4 (F60.5) 


A pervasive pattern of preoccupation with orderliness, perfectionism, and mental and in- 

terpersonal control, at the expense of flexibility, openness, and efficiency, beginning by 

early adulthood and present in a variety of contexts, as indicated by four (or more) of the 

following: 

1. Is preoccupied with details, rules, lists, order, organization, or schedules to the extent 
that the major point of the activity is lost. 

2. Shows perfectionism that interferes with task completion (e.g., is unable to complete a 
project because his or her own overly strict standards are not met). 

3. Is excessively devoted to work and productivity to the exclusion of leisure activities and 
friendships (not accounted for by obvious economic necessity). 

4. Is overconscientious, scrupulous, and inflexible about matters of morality, ethics, or 
values (not accounted for by cultural or religious identification). 


Obsessive-Compulsive Personality Disorder 679 


5. Is unable to discard worn-out or worthless objects even when they have no sentimental 
value. 

6. Is reluctant to delegate tasks or to work with others unless they submit to exactly his 
or her way of doing things. 

7. Adopts a miserly spending style toward both self and others; money is viewed as 
something to be hoarded for future catastrophes. 

8. Shows rigidity and stubbornness. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of obsessive-compulsive personality disorder is a preoccupation 
with orderliness, perfectionism, and mental and interpersonal control, at the expense of 
flexibility, openness, and efficiency. This pattern begins by early adulthood and is present 
in a variety of contexts. 

Individuals with obsessive-compulsive personality disorder attempt to maintain a 
sense of control through painstaking attention to rules, trivial details, procedures, lists, 
schedules, or form to the extent that the major point of the activity is lost (Criterion 1). They 
are excessively careful and prone to repetition, paying extraordinary attention to detail 
and repeatedly checking for possible mistakes. They are oblivious to the fact that other 
people tend to become very annoyed at the delays and inconveniences that result from this 
behavior. For example, when such individuals misplace a list of things to be done, they 
will spend an inordinate amount of time looking for the list rather than spending a few 
moments re-creating it from memory and proceeding to accomplish the tasks. Time is 
poorly allocated, and the most important tasks are left to the last moment. The perfection- 
ism and self-imposed high standards of performance cause significant dysfunction and 
distress in these individuals. They may become so involved in making every detail of a 
project absolutely perfect that the project is never finished (Criterion 2). For example, the 
completion of a written report is delayed by numerous time-consuming rewrites that all 
come up short of “perfection.” Deadlines are missed, and aspects of the individual’s life 
that are not the current focus of activity may fall into disarray. 

Individuals with obsessive-compulsive personality disorder display excessive devotion 
to work and productivity to the exclusion of leisure activities and friendships (Criterion 3). 
This behavior is not accounted for by economic necessity. They often feel that they do not 
have time to take an evening or a weekend day off to go on an outing or to just relax. They 
may keep postponing a pleasurable activity, such as a vacation, so that it may never occur. 
When they do take time for leisure activities or vacations, they are very uncomfortable un- 
less they have taken along something to work on so they do not “waste time.” There may be 
a great concentration on household chores (e.g., repeated excessive cleaning so that “one 
could eat off the floor”). If they spend time with friends, it is likely to be in some kind of for- 
mally organized activity (e.g., sports). Hobbies or recreational activities are approached as 
serious tasks requiring careful organization and hard work to master. The emphasis is on 
perfect performance. These individuals turn play into a structured task (e.g., correcting an 
infant for not putting rings on the post in the right order; telling a toddler to ride his or her tri- 
cycle in a straight line; turning a baseball game into a harsh “lesson”). 

Individuals with obsessive-compulsive personality disorder may be excessively con- 
scientious, scrupulous, and inflexible about matters of morality, ethics, or values (Crite- 
rion 4). They may force themselves and others to follow rigid moral principles and very 
strict standards of performance. They may also be mercilessly self-critical about their own 
mistakes. Individuals with this disorder are rigidly deferential to authority and rules and 
insist on quite literal compliance, with no rule bending for extenuating circumstances. For 
example, the individual will not lend a quarter to a friend who needs one to make a tele- 
phone call because “neither a borrower nor a lender be” or because it would be “bad” for 


680 Personality Disorders 


the person’s character. These qualities should not be accounted for by the individual's cul- 
tural or religious identification. 

Individuals with this disorder may be unable to discard worn-out or worthless objects, 
even when they have no sentimental value (Criterion 5). Often these individuals will ad- 
mit to being “pack rats.” They regard discarding objects as wasteful because “you never 
know when you might need something” and will become upset if someone tries to get rid of 
the things they have saved. Their spouses or roommates may complain about the amount of 
space taken up by old parts, magazines, broken appliances, and so on. 

Individuals with obsessive-compulsive personality disorder are reluctant to delegate 
tasks or to work with others (Criterion 6). They stubbornly and unreasonably insist that 
everything be done their way and that people conform to their way of doing things. They 
often give very detailed instructions about how things should be done (e.g., there is one 
and only one way to mow the lawn, wash the dishes, build a doghouse) and are surprised 
and irritated if others suggest creative alternatives. At other times they may reject offers of 
help even when behind schedule because they believe no one else can do it right. 

Individuals with this disorder may be miserly and stingy and maintain a standard of 
living far below what they can afford, believing that spending must be tightly controlled to 
provide for future catastrophes (Criterion 7). Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder 
is characterized by rigidity and stubbornness (Criterion 8). Individuals with this disorder 
are so concerned about having things done the one “correct” way that they have trouble 
going along with anyone else’s ideas. These individuals plan ahead in meticulous detail 
and are unwilling to consider changes. Totally wrapped up in their own perspective, they 
have difficulty acknowledging the viewpoints of others. Friends and colleagues may be- 
come frustrated by this constant rigidity. Even when individuals with obsessive-compul- 
sive personality disorder recognize that it may be in their interest to compromise, they 
may stubbornly refuse to do so, arguing that it is “the principle of the thing.” 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


When rules and established procedures do not dictate the correct answer, decision making 
may become a time-consuming, often painful process. Individuals with obsessive- 
compulsive personality disorder may have such difficulty deciding which tasks take pri- 
ority or what is the best way of doing some particular task that they may never get started 
on anything. They are prone to become upset or angry in situations in which they are not 
able to maintain control of their physical or interpersonal environment, although the an- 
ger is typically not expressed directly. For example, an individual may be angry when ser- 
vice in a restaurant is poor, but instead of complaining to the management, the individual 
ruminates about how much to leave as a tip. On other occasions, anger may be expressed 
with righteous indignation over a seemingly minor matter. Individuals with this disorder 
may be especially attentive to their relative status in dominance-submission relationships 
and may display excessive deference to an authority they respect and excessive resistance 
to authority they do not respect. 

Individuals with this disorder usually express affection in a highly controlled or stilted 
fashion and may be very uncomfortable in the presence of others who are emotionally ex- 
pressive. Their everyday relationships have a formal and serious quality, and they may be 
stiff in situations in which others would smile and be happy (e.g., greeting a lover at the 
airport). They carefully hold themselves back until they are sure that whatever they say 
will be perfect. They may be preoccupied with logic and intellect, and intolerant of affec- 
tive behavior in others. They often have difficulty expressing tender feelings, rarely pay- 
ing compliments. Individuals with this disorder may experience occupational difficulties 
and distress, particularly when confronted with new situations that demand flexibility 
and compromise. 

Individuals with anxiety disorders, including generalized anxiety disorder, social anx- 
iety disorder (social phobia), and specific phobias, and obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD) 


Obsessive-Compulsive Personality Disorder 681 


have an increased likelihood of having a personality disturbance that meets criteria for ob- 
sessive-compulsive personality disorder. Even so, it appears that the majority of individ- 
uals with OCD do not have a pattern of behavior that meets criteria for this personality 
disorder. Many of the features of obsessive-compulsive personality disorder overlap with 
“type A” personality characteristics (e.g., preoccupation with work, competitiveness, time 
urgency), and these features may be present in people at risk for myocardial infarction. 
There may be an association between obsessive-compulsive personality disorder and de- 
pressive and bipolar disorders and eating disorders. 


Prevalence 


Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder is one of the most prevalent personality dis- 
orders in the general population, with estimated prevalence ranging from 2.1% to 7.9%. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In assessing an individual for obsessive-compulsive personality disorder, the clinician 
should not include those behaviors that reflect habits, customs, or interpersonal styles that 
are culturally sanctioned by the individual’s reference group. Certain cultures place sub- 
stantial emphasis on work and productivity; the resulting behaviors in members of those 
societies need not be considered indications of obsessive-compulsive personality disorder. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


In systematic studies, obsessive-compulsive personality disorder appears to be diagnosed 
about twice as often among males. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. Despite the similarity in names, OCD is usually easily 
distinguished from obsessive-compulsive personality disorder by the presence of true ob- 
sessions and compulsions in OCD. When criteria for both obsessive-compulsive person- 
ality disorder and OCD are met, both diagnoses should be recorded. 


Hoarding disorder. A diagnosis of hoarding disorder should be considered especially 
when hoarding is extreme (e.g., accumulated stacks of worthless objects present a fire haz- 
ard and make it difficult for others to walk through the house). When criteria for both ob- 
sessive-compulsive personality disorder and hoarding disorder are met, both diagnoses 
should be recorded. 


Other personality disorders and personality traits. Other personality disorders may 
be confused with obsessive-compulsive personality disorder because they have certain 
features in common. It is, therefore, important to distinguish among these disorders based 
on differences in their characteristic features. However, if an individual has personality 
features that meet criteria for one or more personality disorders in addition to obsessive- 
compulsive personality disorder, all can be diagnosed. Individuals with narcissistic per- 
sonality disorder may also profess a commitment to perfectionism and believe that others 
cannot do things as well, but these individuals are more likely to believe that they have 
achieved perfection, whereas those with obsessive-compulsive personality disorder are 
usually self-critical. Individuals with narcissistic or antisocial personality disorder lack 
generosity but will indulge themselves, whereas those with obsessive-compulsive person- 
ality disorder adopt a miserly spending style toward both self and others. Both schizoid 
personality disorder and obsessive-compulsive personality disorder may be characterized 
by an apparent formality and social detachment. In obsessive-compulsive personality dis- 
order, this stems from discomfort with emotions and excessive devotion to work, whereas 
in schizoid personality disorder there is a fundamental lack of capacity for intimacy. 


682 Personality Disorders 


Obsessive-compulsive personality traits in moderation may be especially adaptive, par- 
ticularly in situations that reward high performance. Only when these traits are inflexible, 
maladaptive, and persisting and cause significant functional impairment or subjective dis- 
tress do they constitute obsessive-compulsive personality disorder. 


Personality change due to another medical condition. Obsessive-compulsive person- 
ality disorder must be distinguished from personality change due to another medical con- 
dition, in which the traits emerge attributable to the effects of another medical condition 
on the central nervous system. 


Substance use disorders. Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder must also be dis- 
tinguished from symptoms that may develop in association with persistent substance use. 


Other Personality Disorders 


Personality Change 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


Diagnostic Criteria 310.1 (FO7.0) 


A. Apersistent personality disturbance that represents a change from the individual’s pre- 
vious characteristic personality pattern. 
Note: In children, the disturbance involves a marked deviation from normal devel- 
opment or a significant change in the child’s usual behavior patterns, lasting at least 
1 year. 
B. There is evidence from the history, physical examination, or laboratory findings that the 
disturbance is the direct pathophysiological consequence of another medical condition. 
C. The disturbance is not better explained by another mental disorder (including another 
mental disorder due to another medical condition). 
D. The disturbance does not occur exclusively during the course of a delirium. 
E. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 
Specify whether: 
Labile type: If the predominant feature is affective lability. 
Disinhibited type: If the predominant feature is poor impulse control as evidenced by 
sexual indiscretions, etc. 
Aggressive type: If the predominant feature is aggressive behavior. 
Apathetic type: If the predominant feature is marked apathy and indifference. 
Paranoid type: If the predominant feature is suspiciousness or paranoid ideation. 
Other type: If the presentation is not characterized by any of the above subtypes. 
Combined type: If more than one feature predominates in the clinical picture. 
Unspecified type 
Coding note: Include the name of the other medical condition (e.g., 310.1 [FO7.0] person- 
ality change due to temporal lobe epilepsy). The other medical condition should be coded 
and listed separately immediately before the personality disorder due to another medical 
condition (e.g., 345.40 [G40.209] temporal lobe epilepsy; 310.1 [FO7.0] personality 
change due to temporal lobe epilepsy). 


Personality Change Due to Another Medical Condition 683 


Subtypes 


The particular personality change can be specified by indicating the symptom presenta- 
tion that predominates in the clinical presentation. 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of a personality change due to another medical condition is a persis- 
tent personality disturbance that is judged to be due to the direct pathophysiological ef- 
fects of a medical condition. The personality disturbance represents a change from the 
individual's previous characteristic personality pattern. In children, this condition may be 
manifested as a marked deviation from normal development rather than as a change ina 
stable personality pattern (Criterion A). There must be evidence from the history, physical 
examination, or laboratory findings that the personality change is the direct physiological 
consequence of another medical condition (Criterion B). The diagnosis is not given if the 
disturbance is better explained by another mental disorder (Criterion C). The diagnosis is 
not given if the disturbance occurs exclusively during the course of a delirium (Criterion 
D). The disturbance must also cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 
occupational, or other important areas of functioning (Criterion E). 

Common manifestations of the personality change include affective instability, poor 
impulse control, outbursts of aggression or rage grossly out of proportion to any precipi- 
tating psychosocial stressor, marked apathy, suspiciousness, or paranoid ideation. The 
phenomenology of the change is indicated using the subtypes listed in the criteria set. An 
individual with the disorder is often characterized by others as “not himself [or herself].” 
Although it shares the term “personality” with the other personality disorders, this diag- 
nosis is distinct by virtue of its specific etiology, different phenomenology, and more vari- 
able onset and course. 

The clinical presentation in a given individual may depend on the nature and localiza- 
tion of the pathological process. For example, injury to the frontal lobes may yield symp- 
toms such as lack of judgment or foresight, facetiousness, disinhibition, and euphoria. 
Right hemisphere strokes have often been shown to evoke personality changes in asso- 
ciation with unilateral spatial neglect, anosognosia (i.e., inability of the individual to 
recognize a bodily or functional deficit, such as the existence of hemiparesis), motor im- 
persistence, and other neurological deficits. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


A variety of neurological and other medical conditions may cause personality changes, 
including central nervous system neoplasms, head trauma, cerebrovascular disease, 
Huntington’s disease, epilepsy, infectious conditions with central nervous system in- 
volvement (e.g., HIV), endocrine conditions (e.g., hypothyroidism, hypo- and hyperadre- 
nocorticism), and autoimmune conditions with central nervous system involvement (e.g., 
systemic lupus erythematosus). The associated physical examination findings, laboratory 
findings, and patterns of prevalence and onset reflect those of the neurological or other 
medical condition involved. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Chronic medical conditions associated with pain and disability. Chronic medical con- 
ditions associated with pain and disability can also be associated with changes in person- 
ality. The diagnosis of personality change due to another medical condition is given only 
if a direct pathophysiological mechanism can be established. This diagnosis is not given if 
the change is due to a behavioral or psychological adjustment or response to another med- 
ical condition (e.g., dependent behaviors that result from a need for the assistance of others 
following a severe head trauma, cardiovascular disease, or dementia). 


684 Personality Disorders 


Delirium or major neurocognitive disorder. Personality change is a frequently associated 
feature of a delirium or major neurocognitive disorder. A separate diagnosis of personal- 
ity change due to another medical condition is not given if the change occurs exclusively 
during the course of a delirium. However, the diagnosis of personality change due to an- 
other medical condition may be given in addition to the diagnosis of major neurocognitive 
disorder if the personality change is a prominent part of the clinical presentation. 


Another mental disorder due to another medical condition. The diagnosis of person- 
ality change due to another medical condition is not given if the disturbance is better ex- 
plained by another mental disorder due to another medical condition (e.g., depressive 
disorder due to brain tumor). 


Substance use disorders. Personality changes may also occur in the context of substance 
use disorders, especially if the disorder is long-standing. The clinician should inquire carefully 
about the nature and extent of substance use. If the clinician wishes to indicate an etiological re- 
lationship between the personality change and substance use, the unspecified category for the 
specific substance (e.g., unspecified stimulant-related disorder) can be used. 


Other mental disorders. Marked personality changes may also be an associated feature 
of other mental disorders (e.g., schizophrenia; delusional disorder; depressive and bipolar 
disorders; other specified and unspecified disruptive behavior, impulse-control, and con- 
duct disorders; panic disorder). However, in these disorders, no specific physiological fac- 
tor is judged to be etiologically related to the personality change. 


Other personality disorders. Personality change due to another medical condition can 
be distinguished from a personality disorder by the requirement for a clinically significant 
change from baseline personality functioning and the presence of a specific etiological 
medical condition. 


Other Specified Personality Disorder 
301.89 (F60.89) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a personality 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the personality disorders diagnostic class. The other specified personality 
disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the 
specific reason that the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific personality 
disorder. This is done by recording “other specified personality disorder” followed by the 
specific reason (e.g., “mixed personality features”). 


Unspecified Personality Disorder 
301.9 (F60.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a personality 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the personality disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified personality 
disorder category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the rea- 
son that the criteria are not met for a specific personality disorder, and includes presenta- 
tions in which there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis. 


Paraphilic 
Disorders 


Parap hilic disorders included in this manual are voyeuristic disorder (spying on 
others in private activities), exhibitionistic disorder (exposing the genitals), frotteuristic 
disorder (touching or rubbing against a nonconsenting individual), sexual masochism 
disorder (undergoing humiliation, bondage, or suffering), sexual sadism disorder (inflict- 
ing humiliation, bondage, or suffering), pedophilic disorder (sexual focus on children), fe- 
tishistic disorder (using nonliving objects or having a highly specific focus on nongenital 
body parts), and transvestic disorder (engaging in sexually arousing cross-dressing). 
These disorders have traditionally been selected for specific listing and assignment of ex- 
plicit diagnostic criteria in DSM for two main reasons: they are relatively common, in re- 
lation to other paraphilic disorders, and some of them entail actions for their satisfaction 
that, because of their noxiousness or potential harm to others, are classed as criminal of- 
fenses. The eight listed disorders do not exhaust the list of possible paraphilic disorders. 
Many dozens of distinct paraphilias have been identified and named, and almost any of 
them could, by virtue of its negative consequences for the individual or for others, rise to 
the level of a paraphilic disorder. The diagnoses of the other specified and unspecified 
paraphilic disorders are therefore indispensable and will be required in many cases. 

In this chapter, the order of presentation of the listed paraphilic disorders generally 
corresponds to common classification schemes for these conditions. The first group of 
disorders is based on anomalous activity preferences. These disorders are subdivided into 
courtship disorders, which resemble distorted components of human courtship behavior 
(voyeuristic disorder, exhibitionistic disorder, and frotteuristic disorder), and algolagnic 
disorders, which involve pain and suffering (sexual masochism disorder and sexual sadism 
disorder). The second group of disorders is based on anomalous target preferences. These 
disorders include one directed at other humans (pedophilic disorder) and two directed 
elsewhere (fetishistic disorder and transvestic disorder). 

The term paraphilia denotes any intense and persistent sexual interest other than sexual 
interest in genital stimulation or preparatory fondling with phenotypically normal, phys- 
ically mature, consenting human partners. In some circumstances, the criteria “intense 
and persistent” may be difficult to apply, such as in the assessment of persons who are 
very old or medically ill and who may not have “intense” sexual interests of any kind. In 
such circumstances, the term paraphilia may be defined as any sexual interest greater than 
or equal to normophilic sexual interests. There are also specific paraphilias that are gen- 
erally better described as preferential sexual interests than as intense sexual interests. 

Some paraphilias primarily concern the individual's erotic activities, and others pri- 
marily concern the individual’s erotic targets. Examples of the former would include in- 
tense and persistent interests in spanking, whipping, cutting, binding, or strangulating 
another person, or an interest in these activities that equals or exceeds the individual’s in- 
terest in copulation or equivalent interaction with another person. Examples of the latter 
would include intense or preferential sexual interest in children, corpses, or amputees (as 
a class), as well as intense or preferential interest in nonhuman animals, such as horses or 
dogs, or in inanimate objects, such as shoes or articles made of rubber. 

A paraphilic disorder is a paraphilia that is currently causing distress or impairment to the 
individual or a paraphilia whose satisfaction has entailed personal harm, or risk of harm, to 


685 


686 Paraphilic Disorders 


others. A paraphilia is a necessary but not a sufficient condition for having a paraphilic dis- 
order, and a paraphilia by itself does not necessarily justify or require clinical intervention. 

In the diagnostic criteria set for each of the listed paraphilic disorders, Criterion A specifies 
the qualitative nature of the paraphilia (e.g., an erotic focus on children or on exposing the gen- 
itals to strangers), and Criterion B specifies the negative consequences of the paraphilia (i.e., 
distress, impairment, or harm to others). In keeping with the distinction between paraphilias 
and paraphilic disorders, the term diagnosis should be reserved for individuals who meet both 
Criteria A and B (i.e., individuals who have a paraphilic disorder). If an individual meets Cri- 
terion A but not Criterion B for a particular paraphilia—a circumstance that might arise when 
a benign paraphilia is discovered during the clinical investigation of some other condition— 
then the individual may be said to have that paraphilia but not a paraphilic disorder. 

It is not rare for an individual to manifest two or more paraphilias. In some cases, the para- 
philic foci are closely related and the connection between the paraphilias is intuitively com- 
prehensible (e.g., foot fetishism and shoe fetishism). In other cases, the connection between the 
paraphilias is not obvious, and the presence of multiple paraphilias may be coincidental or else 
related to some generalized vulnerability to anomalies of psychosexual development. In any 
event, comorbid diagnoses of separate paraphilic disorders may be warranted if more than 
one paraphilia is causing suffering to the individual or harm to others. 

Because of the two-pronged nature of diagnosing paraphilic disorders, clinician-rated 
or self-rated measures and severity assessments could address either the strength of the 
paraphilia itself or the seriousness of its consequences. Although the distress and impair- 
ment stipulated in the Criterion B are special in being the immediate or ultimate result of 
the paraphilia and not primarily the result of some other factor, the phenomena of reactive 
depression, anxiety, guilt, poor work history, impaired social relations, and so on are not 
unique in themselves and may be quantified with multipurpose measures of psychosocial 
functioning or quality of life. 

The most widely applicable framework for assessing the strength of a paraphilia itself 
is one in which examinees’ paraphilic sexual fantasies, urges, or behaviors are evaluated in 
relation to their normophilic sexual interests and behaviors. In a clinical interview or on 
self-administered questionnaires, examinees can be asked whether their paraphilic sexual 
fantasies, urges, or behaviors are weaker than, approximately equal to, or stronger than 
their normophilic sexual interests and behaviors. This same type of comparison can be, 
and usually is, employed in psychophysiological measures of sexual interest, such as pe- 
nile plethysmography in males or viewing time in males and females. 


Voyeuristic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.82 (F65.3) 


A. Over a period of at least 6 months, recurrent and intense sexual arousal from observ- 
ing an unsuspecting person who is naked, in the process of disrobing, or engaging in 
sexual activity, as manifested by fantasies, urges, or behaviors. 

B. The individual has acted on these sexual urges with a nonconsenting person, or the 
sexual urges or fantasies cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 
occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

C. The individual experiencing the arousal and/or acting on the urges is at least 18 years 
of age. 

Specity if: 

In acontrolled environment: This specifier is primarily applicable to individuals living 
in institutional or other settings where opportunities to engage in voyeuristic behavior 
are restricted. 


Voyeuristic Disorder 687 


In full remission: The individual has not acted on the urges with a nonconsenting per- 
son, and there has been no distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other ar- 
eas of functioning, for at least 5 years while in an uncontrolled environment. 


Specifiers 
The “in full remission” specifier does not address the continued presence or absence of 
voyeurism per se, which may still be present after behaviors and distress have remitted. 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic criteria for voyeuristic disorder can apply both to individuals who more or less 
freely disclose this paraphilic interest and to those who categorically deny any sexual arousal 
from observing an unsuspecting person who is naked, disrobing, or engaged in sexual activity 
despite substantial objective evidence to the contrary. If disclosing individuals also report dis- 
tress or psychosocial problems because of their voyeuristic sexual preferences, they could be 
diagnosed with voyeuristic disorder. On the other hand, if they declare no distress, demon- 
strated by lack of anxiety, obsessions, guilt, or shame, about these paraphilic impulses and are 
not impaired in other important areas of functioning because of this sexual interest, and their 
psychiatric or legal histories indicate that they do not act on it, they could be ascertained as 
having voyeuristic sexual interest but should not be diagnosed with voyeuristic disorder. 

Nondisclosing individuals include, for example, individuals known to have been spy- 
ing repeatedly on unsuspecting persons who are naked or engaging in sexual activity on 
separate occasions but who deny any urges or fantasies concerning such sexual behavior, 
and who may report that known episodes of watching unsuspecting naked or sexually ac- 
tive persons were all accidental and nonsexual. Others may disclose past episodes of ob- 
serving unsuspecting naked or sexually active persons but contest any significant or 
sustained sexual interest in this behavior. Since these individuals deny having fantasies or 
impulses about watching others nude or involved in sexual activity, it follows that they 
would also reject feeling subjectively distressed or socially impaired by such impulses. De- 
spite their nondisclosing stance, such individuals may be diagnosed with voyeuristic dis- 
order. Recurrent voyeuristic behavior constitutes sufficient support for voyeurism (by 
fulfilling Criterion A) and simultaneously demonstrates that this paraphilically motivated 
behavior is causing harm to others (by fulfilling Criterion B). 

“Recurrent” spying on unsuspecting persons who are naked or engaging in sexual ac- 
tivity (ie., multiple victims, each on a separate occasion) may, as a general rule, be inter- 
preted as three or more victims on separate occasions. Fewer victims can be interpreted as 
satisfying this criterion if there were multiple occasions of watching the same victim or if 
there is corroborating evidence of a distinct or preferential interest in secret watching of 
naked or sexually active unsuspecting persons. Note that multiple victims, as suggested 
earlier, are a sufficient but not a necessary condition for diagnosis; the criteria may also be 
met if the individual acknowledges intense voyeuristic sexual interest. 

The Criterion A time frame, indicating that signs or symptoms of voyeurism must have 
persisted for at least 6 months, should also be understood as a general guideline, not a 
strict threshold, to ensure that the sexual interest in secretly watching unsuspecting naked 
or sexually active others is not merely transient. 

Adolescence and puberty generally increase sexual curiosity and activity. To alleviate 
the risk of pathologizing normative sexual interest and behavior during pubertal adoles- 
cence, the minimum age for the diagnosis of voyeuristic disorder is 18 years (Criterion C). 


Prevalence 


Voyeuristic acts are the most common of potentially law-breaking sexual behaviors. The 
population prevalence of voyeuristic disorder is unknown. However, based on voyeuris- 


688 Paraphilic Disorders 


tic sexual acts in nonclinical samples, the highest possible lifetime prevalence for voyeuris- 
tic disorder is approximately 12% in males and 4% in females. 


Development and Course 


Adult males with voyeuristic disorder often first become aware of their sexual interest in 
secretly watching unsuspecting persons during adolescence. However, the minimum age 
for a diagnosis of voyeuristic disorder is 18 years because there is substantial difficulty in 
differentiating it from age-appropriate puberty-related sexual curiosity and activity. The 
persistence of voyeurism over time is unclear. Voyeuristic disorder, however, per defini- 
tion requires one or more contributing factors that may change over time with or without 
treatment: subjective distress (e.g., guilt, shame, intense sexual frustration, loneliness), 
psychiatric morbidity, hypersexuality, and sexual impulsivity; psychosocial impairment; 
and/or the propensity to act out sexually by spying on unsuspecting naked or sexually ac- 
tive persons. Therefore, the course of voyeuristic disorder is likely to vary with age. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Voyeurism is a necessary precondition for voyeuristic disorder; hence, 
risk factors for voyeurism should also increase the rate of voyeuristic disorder. 


Environmental. Childhood sexual abuse, substance misuse, and sexual preoccupation/ 
hypersexuality have been suggested as risk factors, although the causal relationship to 
voyeurism is uncertain and the specificity unclear. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Voyeuristic disorder is very uncommon among females in clinical settings, while the male- 
to-female ratio for single sexually arousing voyeuristic acts might be 3:1. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Conduct disorder and antisocial personality disorder. Conduct disorder in adolescents 
and antisocial personality disorder would be characterized by additional norm-breaking 
and antisocial behaviors, and the specific sexual interest in secretly watching unsuspect- 
ing others who are naked or engaging in sexual activity should be lacking. 


Substance use disorders. Substance use disorders might involve single voyeuristic ep- 
isodes by intoxicated individuals but should not involve the typical sexual interest in se- 
cretly watching unsuspecting persons being naked or engaging in sexual activity. Hence, 
recurrent voyeuristic sexual fantasies, urges, or behaviors that occur also when the indi- 
vidual is not intoxicated suggest that voyeuristic disorder might be present. 


Comorbidity 


Known comorbidities in voyeuristic disorder are largely based on research with males 
suspected of or convicted for acts involving the secret watching of unsuspecting nude or 
sexually active persons. Hence, these comorbidities might not apply to all individuals with 
voyeuristic disorder. Conditions that occur comorbidly with voyeuristic disorder include 
hypersexuality and other paraphilic disorders, particularly exhibitionistic disorder. De- 
pressive, bipolar, anxiety, and substance use disorders; attention-deficit /hyperactivity 
disorder; and conduct disorder and antisocial personality disorder are also frequent co- 
morbid conditions. 


Exhibitionistic Disorder 689 


Exhibitionistic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.4 (F65.2) 


A. Over a period of at least 6 months, recurrent and intense sexual arousal from the ex- 
posure of one’s genitals to an unsuspecting person, as manifested by fantasies, urges, 
or behaviors. 

B. The individual has acted on these sexual urges with a nonconsenting person, or the 
sexual urges or fantasies cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 
occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 


Specify whether: 
Sexually aroused by exposing genitals to prepubertal children 
Sexually aroused by exposing genitals to physically mature individuals 
Sexually aroused by exposing genitals to prepubertal children and to physically 
mature individuals 

Specify if: 
In a controlled environment: This specifier is primarily applicable to individuals living in 
institutional or other settings where opportunities to expose one’s genitals are restricted. 
In full remission: The individual has not acted on the urges with a nonconsenting per- 
son, and there has been no distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other ar- 
eas of functioning, for at least 5 years while in an uncontrolled environment. 


Subtypes 


The subtypes for exhibitionistic disorder are based on the age or physical maturity of the non- 
consenting individuals to whom the individual prefers to expose his or her genitals. The non- 
consenting individuals could be prepubescent children, adults, or both. This specifier should 
help draw adequate attention to characteristics of victims of individuals with exhibitionistic 
disorder to prevent co-occurring pedophilic disorder from being overlooked. However, indi- 
cations that the individual with exhibitionistic disorder is sexually attracted to exposing his or 
her genitals to children should not preclude a diagnosis of pedophilic disorder. 


Specifiers 
The “in full remission” specifier does not address the continued presence or absence of ex- 
hibitionism per se, which may still be present after behaviors and distress have remitted. 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic criteria for exhibitionistic disorder can apply both to individuals who more or 
less freely disclose this paraphilia and to those who categorically deny any sexual attraction to 
exposing their genitals to unsuspecting persons despite substantial objective evidence to the 
contrary. If disclosing individuals also report psychosocial difficulties because of their sexual 
attractions or preferences for exposing, they may be diagnosed with exhibitionistic disorder. In 
contrast, if they declare no distress (exemplified by absence of anxiety, obsessions, and guilt or 
shame about these paraphilic impulses) and are not impaired by this sexual interest in other 
important areas of functioning, and their self-reported, psychiatric, or legal histories indicate 
that they do not act on them, they could be ascertained as having exhibitionistic sexual interest 
but not be diagnosed with exhibitionistic disorder. 

Examples of nondisclosing individuals include those who have exposed themselves 
repeatedly to unsuspecting persons on separate occasions but who deny any urges or fan- 


690 Paraphilic Disorders 


tasies about such sexual behavior and who report that known episodes of exposure were 
all accidental and nonsexual. Others may disclose past episodes of sexual behavior involv- 
ing genital exposure but refute any significant or sustained sexual interest in such behav- 
ior. Since these individuals deny having urges or fantasies involving genital exposure, it 
follows that they would also deny feeling subjectively distressed or socially impaired by 
such impulses. Such individuals may be diagnosed with exhibitionistic disorder despite 
their negative self-report. Recurrent exhibitionistic behavior constitutes sufficient support 
for exhibitionism (Criterion A) and simultaneously demonstrates that this paraphilically 
motivated behavior is causing harm to others (Criterion B). 

“Recurrent” genital exposure to unsuspecting others (i.e., multiple victims, each on a 
separate occasion) may, as a general rule, be interpreted as three or more victims on sep- 
arate occasions. Fewer victims can be interpreted as satisfying this criterion if there were 
multiple occasions of exposure to the same victim, or if there is corroborating evidence of 
a strong or preferential interest in genital exposure to unsuspecting persons. Note that 
multiple victims, as suggested earlier, are a sufficient but not a necessary condition for di- 
agnosis, as criteria may be met by an individual’s acknowledging intense exhibitionistic 
sexual interest with distress and/or impairment. 

The Criterion A time frame, indicating that signs or symptoms of exhibitionism must 
have persisted for at least 6 months, should also be understood as a general guideline, not 
a strict threshold, to ensure that the sexual interest in exposing one’s genitals to unsuspect- 
ing others is not merely transient. This might be expressed in clear evidence of repeated 
behaviors or distress over a nontransient period shorter than 6 months. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of exhibitionistic disorder is unknown. However, based on exhibitionistic 
sexual acts in nonclinical or general populations, the highest possible prevalence for exhi- 
bitionistic disorder in the male population is 2%—4%. The prevalence of exhibitionistic dis- 
order in females is even more uncertain but is generally believed to be much lower than in 
males. 


Development and Course 


Adult males with exhibitionistic disorder often report that they first became aware of sex- 
ual interest in exposing their genitals to unsuspecting persons during adolescence, at a 
somewhat later time than the typical development of normative sexual interest in women 
or men. Although there is no minimum age requirement for the diagnosis of exhibitionis- 
tic disorder, it may be difficult to differentiate exhibitionistic behaviors from age-appro- 
priate sexual curiosity in adolescents. Whereas exhibitionistic impulses appear to emerge 
in adolescence or early adulthood, very little is known about persistence over time. By def- 
inition, exhibitionistic disorder requires one or more contributing factors, which may 
change over time with or without treatment; subjective distress (e.g., guilt, shame, intense 
sexual frustration, loneliness), mental disorder comorbidity, hypersexuality, and sexual 
impulsivity; psychosocial impairment; and/or the propensity to act out sexually by expos- 
ing the genitals to unsuspecting persons. Therefore, the course of exhibitionistic disorder 
is likely to vary with age. As with other sexual preferences, advancing age may be associ- 
ated with decreasing exhibitionistic sexual preferences and behavior. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Since exhibitionism is a necessary precondition for exhibitionistic dis- 
order, risk factors for exhibitionism should also increase the rate of exhibitionistic disor- 
der. Antisocial history, antisocial personality disorder, alcohol misuse, and pedophilic 
sexual preference might increase risk of sexual recidivism in exhibitionistic offenders. 


Frotteuristic Disorder 691 


Hence, antisocial personality disorder, alcohol use disorder, and pedophilic interest may 
be considered risk factors for exhibitionistic disorder in males with exhibitionistic sexual 
preferences. 


Environmental. Childhood sexual and emotional abuse and sexual preoccupation/hyper- 
sexuality have been suggested as risk factors for exhibitionism, although the causal rela- 
tionship to exhibitionism is uncertain and the specificity unclear. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Exhibitionistic disorder is highly unusual in females, whereas single sexually arousing ex- 
hibitionistic acts might occur up to half as often among women compared with men. 


Functional Consequences of Exhibitionistic Disorder 


The functional consequences of exhibitionistic disorder have not been addressed in re- 
search involving individuals who have not acted out sexually by exposing their genitals to 
unsuspecting strangers but who fulfill Criterion B by experiencing intense emotional dis- 
tress over these preferences. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Potential differential diagnoses for exhibitionistic disorder sometimes occur also as co- 
morbid disorders. Therefore, it is generally necessary to evaluate the evidence for exhibi- 
tionistic disorder and other possible conditions as separate questions. 


Conduct disorder and antisocial personality disorder. Conduct disorder in adolescents 
and antisocial personality disorder would be characterized by additional norm-breaking and 
antisocial behaviors, and the specific sexual interest in exposing the genitals should be lacking. 


Substance use disorders. Alcohol and substance use disorders might involve single 
exhibitionistic episodes by intoxicated individuals but should not involve the typical sex- 
ual interest in exposing the genitals to unsuspecting persons. Hence, recurrent exhibition- 
istic sexual fantasies, urges, or behaviors that occur also when the individual is not 
intoxicated suggest that exhibitionistic disorder might be present. 


Comorbidity 


Known comorbidities in exhibitionistic disorder are largely based on research with indi- 
viduals (almost all males) convicted for criminal acts involving genital exposure to non- 
consenting individuals. Hence, these comorbidities might not apply to all individuals who 
qualify for a diagnosis of exhibitionistic disorder. Conditions that occur comorbidly with 
exhibitionistic disorder at high rates include depressive, bipolar, anxiety, and substance 
use disorders; hypersexuality; attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder; other paraphilic 
disorders; and antisocial personality disorder. 


Frotteuristic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.89 (F65.81) 


A. Over a period of at least 6 months, recurrent and intense sexual arousal from touching 
or rubbing against a nonconsenting person, as manifested by fantasies, urges, or be- 
haviors. 

B. The individual has acted on these sexual urges with a nonconsenting person, or the 
sexual urges or fantasies cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 
occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 


692 Paraphilic Disorders 


Specify if: 
In acontrolled environment: This specifier is primarily applicable to individuals living 
in institutional or other settings where opportunities to touch or rub against a noncon- 
senting person are restricted. 
In full remission: The individual has not acted on the urges with a nonconsenting per- 
son, and there has been no distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other ar- 
eas of functioning, for at least 5 years while in an uncontrolled environment. 


Specifiers 
The “in remission” specifier does not address the continued presence or absence of frot- 
teurism per se, which may still be present after behaviors and distress have remitted. 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic criteria for frotteuristic disorder can apply both to individuals who relatively 
freely disclose this paraphilia and to those who firmly deny any sexual attraction from touch- 
ing or rubbing against a nonconsenting individual regardless of considerable objective evi- 
dence to the contrary. If disclosing individuals also report psychosocial impairment due to 
their sexual preferences for touching or rubbing against a nonconsenting individual, they 
could be diagnosed with frotteuristic disorder. In contrast, if they declare no distress (demon- 
strated by lack of anxiety, obsessions, guilt, or shame) about these paraphilic impulses and are 
not impaired in other important areas of functioning because of this sexual interest, and their 
psychiatric or legal histories indicate that they do not act on it, they could be ascertained as 
having frotteuristic sexual interest but should not be diagnosed with frotteuristic disorder. 

Nondisclosing individuals include, for instance, individuals known to have been 
touching or rubbing against nonconsenting individuals on separate occasions but who 
contest any urges or fantasies concerning such sexual behavior. Such individuals may re- 
port that identified episodes of touching or rubbing against an unwilling individual were 
all unintentional and nonsexual. Others may disclose past episodes of touching or rubbing 
against nonconsenting individuals but contest any major or persistent sexual interest in 
this. Since these individuals deny having fantasies or impulses about touching or rubbing, 
they would consequently reject feeling distressed or psychosocially impaired by such 
impulses. Despite their nondisclosing position, such individuals may be diagnosed with 
frotteuristic disorder. Recurrent frotteuristic behavior constitutes satisfactory support for 
frotteurism (by fulfilling Criterion A) and concurrently demonstrates that this paraphili- 
cally motivated behavior is causing harm to others (by fulfilling Criterion B). 

“Recurrent” touching or rubbing against a nonconsenting individual (i.e., multiple vic- 
tims, each ona separate occasion) may, as a general rule, be interpreted as three or more vic- 
tims on separate occasions. Fewer victims can be interpreted as satisfying this criterion if 
there were multiple occasions of touching or rubbing against the same unwilling individ- 
ual, or corroborating evidence of a strong or preferential interest in touching or rubbing 
against nonconsenting individuals. Note that multiple victims are a sufficient but not a nec- 
essary condition for diagnosis; criteria may also be met if the individual acknowledges in- 
tense frotteuristic sexual interest with clinically significant distress and/or impairment. 

The Criterion A time frame, indicating that signs or symptoms of frotteurism must persist 
for at least 6 months, should also be interpreted as a general guideline, not a strict threshold, to 
ensure that the sexual interest in touching or rubbing against a nonconsenting individual is not 
transient. Hence, the duration part of Criterion A may also be met if there is clear evidence of 
recurrent behaviors or distress over a shorter but nontransient time period. 


Prevalence 


Frotteuristic acts, including the uninvited sexual touching of or rubbing against another 
individual, may occur in up to 30% of adult males in the general population. Approximately 


Frotteuristic Disorder 693 


10%-14% of adult males seen in outpatient settings for paraphilic disorders and hypersex- 
uality have a presentation that meets diagnostic criteria for frotteuristic disorder. Hence, 
whereas the population prevalence of frotteuristic disorder is unknown, it is not likely that 
it exceeds the rate found in selected clinical settings. 


Development and Course 


Adult males with frotteuristic disorder often report first becoming aware of their sexual in- 
terest in surreptitiously touching unsuspecting persons during late adolescence or emerging 
adulthood. However, children and adolescents may also touch or rub against unwilling oth- 
ers in the absence of a diagnosis of frotteuristic disorder. Although there is no minimum age 
for the diagnosis, frotteuristic disorder can be difficult to differentiate from conduct-disor- 
dered behavior without sexual motivation in individuals at younger ages. The persistence of 
frotteurism over time is unclear. Frotteuristic disorder, however, by definition requires one 
or more contributing factors that may change over time with or without treatment: subjec- 
tive distress (e.g., guilt, shame, intense sexual frustration, loneliness); psychiatric morbidity; 
hypersexuality and sexual impulsivity; psychosocial impairment; and/or the propensity to 
act out sexually by touching or rubbing against unconsenting persons. Therefore, the course 
of frotteuristic disorder is likely to vary with age. As with other sexual preferences, advanc- 
ing age may be associated with decreasing frotteuristic sexual preferences and behavior. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Nonsexual antisocial behavior and sexual preoccupation/hypersexuality 
might be nonspecific risk factors, although the causal relationship to frotteurism is uncertain 
and the specificity unclear. However, frotteurism is a necessary precondition for frotteuristic 
disorder, so risk factors for frotteurism should also increase the rate of frotteuristic disorder. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


There appear to be substantially fewer females with frotteuristic sexual preferences than 
males. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Conduct disorder and antisocial personality disorder. Conduct disorder in adolescents 
and antisocial personality disorder would be characterized by additional norm-breaking 
and antisocial behaviors, and the specific sexual interest in touching or rubbing against a 
nonconsenting individual should be lacking. 


Substance use disorders. Substance use disorders, particularly those involving stimu- 
lants such as cocaine and amphetamines, might involve single frotteuristic episodes by in- 
toxicated individuals but should not involve the typical sustained sexual interest in 
touching or rubbing against unsuspecting persons. Hence, recurrent frotteuristic sexual 
fantasies, urges, or behaviors that occur also when the individual is not intoxicated sug- 
gest that frotteuristic disorder might be present. 


Comorbidity 


Known comorbidities in frotteuristic disorder are largely based on research with males 
suspected of or convicted for criminal acts involving sexually motivated touching of or 
rubbing against a nonconsenting individual. Hence, these comorbidities might not apply 
to other individuals with a diagnosis of frotteuristic disorder based on subjective distress 
over their sexual interest. Conditions that occur comorbidly with frotteuristic disorder in- 
clude hypersexuality and other paraphilic disorders, particularly exhibitionistic disorder 
and voyeuristic disorder. Conduct disorder, antisocial personality disorder, depressive 


694 Paraphilic Disorders 


disorders, bipolar disorders, anxiety disorders, and substance use disorders also co-occur. 
Potential differential diagnoses for frotteuristic disorder sometimes occur also as comor- 
bid disorders. Therefore, it is generally necessary to evaluate the evidence for frotteuristic 
disorder and possible comorbid conditions as separate questions. 


Sexual Masochism Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.83 (F65.51) 


A. Over a period of at least 6 months, recurrent and intense sexual arousal from the act 
of being humiliated, beaten, bound, or otherwise made to suffer, as manifested by fan- 
tasies, urges, or behaviors. 

B. The fantasies, sexual urges, or behaviors cause Clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 


Specify if: 
With asphyxiophilia: If the individual engages in the practice of achieving sexual 
arousal related to restriction of breathing. 

Specity if: 
In acontrolled environment: This specifier is primarily applicable to individuals living 
in institutional or other settings where opportunities to engage in masochistic sexual 
behaviors are restricted. 
In full remission: There has been no distress or impairment in social, occupational, 
or other areas of functioning for at last 5 years while in an uncontrolled environment. 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic criteria for sexual masochism disorder are intended to apply to individuals 
who freely admit to having such paraphilic interests. Such individuals openly acknowl- 
edge intense sexual arousal from the act of being humiliated, beaten, bound, or otherwise 
made to suffer, as manifested by fantasies, urges, or behaviors. If these individuals also re- 
port psychosocial difficulties because of their sexual attractions or preferences for being 
humiliated, beaten, bound, or otherwise made to suffer, they may be diagnosed with sex- 
ual masochism disorder. In contrast, if they declare no distress, exemplified by anxiety, ob- 
sessions, guilt, or shame, about these paraphilic impulses, and are not hampered by them 
in pursuing other personal goals, they could be ascertained as having masochistic sexual 
interest but should not be diagnosed with sexual masochism disorder. 

The Criterion A time frame, indicating that the signs or symptoms of sexual masoch- 
ism must have persisted for at least 6 months, should be understood as a general guideline, 
not a strict threshold, to ensure that the sexual interest in being humiliated, beaten, bound, 
or otherwise made to suffer is not merely transient. However, the disorder can be diag- 
nosed in the context of a clearly sustained but shorter time period. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The extensive use of pornography involving the act of being humiliated, beaten, bound, or oth- 
erwise made to suffer is sometimes an associated feature of sexual masochism disorder. 


Prevalence 

The population prevalence of sexual masochism disorder is unknown. In Australia, it has 
been estimated that 2.2% of males and 1.3% of females had been involved in bondage and 
discipline, sadomasochism, or dominance and submission in the past 12 months. 


Sexual Sadism Disorder 695 


Development and Course 


Community individuals with paraphilias have reported a mean age at onset for masoch- 
ism of 19.3 years, although earlier ages, including puberty and childhood, have also been 
reported for the onset of masochistic fantasies. Very little is known about persistence over 
time. Sexual masochism disorder per definition requires one or more contributing factors, 
which may change over time with or without treatment. These include subjective distress 
(e.g., guilt, shame, intense sexual frustration, loneliness), psychiatric morbidity, hypersex- 
uality and sexual impulsivity, and psychosocial impairment. Therefore, the course of sex- 
ual masochism disorder is likely to vary with age. Advancing age is likely to have the same 
reducing effect on sexual preference involving sexual masochism as it has on other para- 
philic or normophilic sexual behavior. 


Functional Consequences of Sexual Masochism Disorder 


The functional consequences of sexual masochism disorder are unknown. However, mas- 
ochists are at risk of accidental death while practicing asphyxiophilia or other autoerotic 
procedures. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Many of the conditions that could be differential diagnoses for sexual masochism disorder 
(e.g., transvestic fetishism, sexual sadism disorder, hypersexuality, alcohol and substance 
use disorders) sometimes occur also as comorbid diagnoses. Therefore, it is necessary to 
carefully evaluate the evidence for sexual masochism disorder, keeping the possibility of 
other paraphilias or other mental disorders as part of the differential diagnosis. Sexual 
masochism in the absence of distress (i.e., no disorder) is also included in the differential, 
as individuals who conduct the behaviors may be satisfied with their masochistic interest. 


Comorbidity 


Known comorbidities with sexual masochism disorder are largely based on individuals in 
treatment. Disorders that occur comorbidly with sexual masochism disorder typically in- 
clude other paraphilic disorders, such as transvestic fetishism. 


Sexual Sadism Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.84 (F65.52) 


A. Over a period of at least 6 months, recurrent and intense sexual arousal from the phys- 
ical or psychological suffering of another person, as manifested by fantasies, urges, or 
behaviors. 

B. The individual has acted on these sexual urges with a nonconsenting person, or the 
sexual urges or fantasies cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, 
occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

Specify if: 

In acontrolled environment: This specifier is primarily applicable to individuals living 
in institutional or other settings where opportunities to engage in sadistic sexual behav- 
iors are restricted. 

In full remission: The individual has not acted on the urges with a nonconsenting per- 
son, and there has been no distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other ar- 
eas of functioning, for at least 5 years while in an uncontrolled environment. 


696 Paraphilic Disorders 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic criteria for sexual sadism disorder are intended to apply both to individuals 
who freely admit to having such paraphilic interests and to those who deny any sexual interest 
in the physical or psychological suffering of another individual despite substantial objective 
evidence to the contrary. Individuals who openly acknowledge intense sexual interest in the 
physical or psychological suffering of others are referred to as “admitting individuals.” If these 
individuals also report psychosocial difficulties because of their sexual attractions or prefer- 
ences for the physical or psychological suffering of another individual, they may be diagnosed 
with sexual sadism disorder. In contrast, if admitting individuals declare no distress, exempli- 
fied by anxiety, obsessions, guilt, or shame, about these paraphilic impulses, and are not ham- 
pered by them in pursuing other goals, and their self-reported, psychiatric, or legal histories 
indicate that they do not act on them, then they could be ascertained as having sadistic sexual 
interest but they would not meet criteria for sexual sadism disorder. 

Examples of individuals who deny any interest in the physical or psychological suffering 
of another individual include individuals known to have inflicted pain or suffering on mul- 
tiple victims on separate occasions but who deny any urges or fantasies about such sexual 
behavior and who may further claim that known episodes of sexual assault were either un- 
intentional or nonsexual. Others may admit past episodes of sexual behavior involving the 
infliction of pain or suffering on a nonconsenting individual but do not report any significant 
or sustained sexual interest in the physical or psychological suffering of another individual. 
Since these individuals deny having urges or fantasies involving sexual arousal to pain and 
suffering, it follows that they would also deny feeling subjectively distressed or socially im- 
paired by such impulses. Such individuals may be diagnosed with sexual sadism disorder 
despite their negative self-report. Their recurrent behavior constitutes clinical support for 
the presence of the paraphilia of sexual sadism (by satisfying Criterion A) and simultane- 
ously demonstrates that their paraphilically motivated behavior is causing clinically signif- 
icant distress, harm, or risk of harm to others (satisfying Criterion B). 

“Recurrent” sexual sadism involving nonconsenting others (i.e., multiple victims, each 
on a separate occasion) may, as general rule, be interpreted as three or more victims on 
separate occasions. Fewer victims can be interpreted as satisfying this criterion, if there are 
multiple instances of infliction of pain and suffering to the same victim, or if there is cor- 
roborating evidence of a strong or preferential interest in pain and suffering involving 
multiple victims. Note that multiple victims, as suggested earlier, are a sufficient but not 
a necessary condition for diagnosis, as the criteria may be met if the individual acknowl- 
edges intense sadistic sexual interest. 

The Criterion A time frame, indicating that the signs or symptoms of sexual sadism 
must have persisted for at least 6 months, should also be understood as a general guide- 
line, not a strict threshold, to ensure that the sexual interest in inflicting pain and suffering 
on nonconsenting victims is not merely transient. However, the diagnosis may be met if 
there is a clearly sustained but shorter period of sadistic behaviors. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The extensive use of pornography involving the infliction of pain and suffering is some- 
times an associated feature of sexual sadism disorder. 


Prevalence 


The population prevalence of sexual sadism disorder is unknown and is largely based on 
individuals in forensic settings. Depending on the criteria for sexual sadism, prevalence 
varies widely, from 2% to 30%. Among civilly committed sexual offenders in the United 
States, less than 10% have sexual sadism. Among individuals who have committed sexu- 
ally motivated homicides, rates of sexual sadism disorder range from 37% to 75%. 


Pedophilic Disorder 697 


Development and Course 


Individuals with sexual sadism in forensic samples are almost exclusively male, but a rep- 
resentative sample of the population in Australia reported that 2.2% of men and 1.3% of 
women said they had been involved in bondage and discipline, “sadomasochism,” or dom- 
inance and submission in the previous year. Information on the development and course 
of sexual sadism disorder is extremely limited. One study reported that females became 
aware of their sadomasochistic interest as young adults, and another reported that the 
mean age at onset of sadism in a group of males was 19.4 years. Whereas sexual sadism per 
se is probably a lifelong characteristic, sexual sadism disorder may fluctuate according to 
the individual's subjective distress or his or her propensity to harm nonconsenting others. 
Advancing age is likely to have the same reducing effect on this disorder as it has on other 
paraphilic or normophilic sexual behavior. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Many of the conditions that could be differential diagnoses for sexual sadism disorder 
(e.g., antisocial personality disorder, sexual masochism disorder, hypersexuality, sub- 
stance use disorders) sometimes occur also as comorbid diagnoses. Therefore, it is neces- 
sary to carefully evaluate the evidence for sexual sadism disorder, keeping the possibility 
of other paraphilias or mental disorders as part of the differential diagnosis. The majority 
of individuals who are active in community networks that practice sadistic and masoch- 
istic behaviors do not express any dissatisfaction with their sexual interests, and their be- 
havior would not meet DSM-5 criteria for sexual sadism disorder. Sadistic interest, but not 
the disorder, may be considered in the differential diagnosis. 


Comorbidity 

Known comorbidities with sexual sadism disorder are largely based on individuals (al- 
most all males) convicted for criminal acts involving sadistic acts against nonconsenting 
victims. Hence, these comorbidities might not apply to all individuals who never engaged 
in sadistic activity with a nonconsenting victim but who qualify for a diagnosis of sexual 
sadism disorder based on subjective distress over their sexual interest. Disorders that are 
commonly comorbid with sexual sadism disorder include other paraphilic disorders. 


Pedophilic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.2 (F65.4) 


A. Over a period of at least 6 months, recurrent, intense sexually arousing fantasies, sex- 
ual urges, or behaviors involving sexual activity with a prepubescent child or children 
(generally age 13 years or younger). 

B. The individual has acted on these sexual urges, or the sexual urges or fantasies cause 
marked distress or interpersonal difficulty. 

C. The individual is at least age 16 years and at least 5 years older than the child or chil- 
dren in Criterion A. 

Note: Do not include an individual in late adolescence involved in an ongoing sexual 
relationship with a 12- or 13-year-old. 

Specify whether: 

Exclusive type (attracted only to children) 
Nonexclusive type 


698 Paraphilic Disorders 


Specify if: 
Sexually attracted to males 
Sexually attracted to females 
Sexually attracted to both 
Specity if: 
Limited to incest 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnostic criteria for pedophilic disorder are intended to apply both to individuals who 
freely disclose this paraphilia and to individuals who deny any sexual attraction to prepuber- 
tal children (generally age 13 years or younger), despite substantial objective evidence to the 
contrary. Examples of disclosing this paraphilia include candidly acknowledging an intense 
sexual interest in children and indicating that sexual interest in children is greater than or equal 
to sexual interest in physically mature individuals. If individuals also complain that their sex- 
ual attractions or preferences for children are causing psychosocial difficulties, they may be di- 
agnosed with pedophilic disorder. However, if they report an absence of feelings of guilt, 
shame, or anxiety about these impulses and are not functionally limited by their paraphilic im- 
pulses (according to self-report, objective assessment, or both), and their self-reported and le- 
gally recorded histories indicate that they have never acted on their impulses, then these 
individuals have a pedophilic sexual interest but not pedophilic disorder. 

Examples of individuals who deny attraction to children include individuals who are 
known to have sexually approached multiple children on separate occasions but who deny 
any urges or fantasies about sexual behavior involving children, and who may further claim 
that the known episodes of physical contact were all unintentional and nonsexual. Other indi- 
viduals may acknowledge past episodes of sexual behavior involving children but deny any 
significant or sustained sexual interest in children. Since these individuals may deny experi- 
ences impulses or fantasies involving children, they may also deny feeling subjectively dis- 
tressed. Such individuals may still be diagnosed with pedophilic disorder despite the absence 
of self-reported distress, provided that there is evidence of recurrent behaviors persisting for 
6 months (Criterion A) and evidence that the individual has acted on sexual urges or experi- 
enced interpersonal difficulties as a consequence of the disorder (Criterion B). 

Presence of multiple victims, as discussed above, is sufficient but not necessary for di- 
agnosis; that is, the individual can still meet Criterion A by merely acknowledging intense 
or preferential sexual interest in children. 

The Criterion A clause, indicating that the signs or symptoms of pedophilia have per- 
sisted for 6 months or longer, is intended to ensure that the sexual attraction to children is 
not merely transient. However, the diagnosis may be made if there is clinical evidence of 
sustained persistence of the sexual attraction to children even if the 6-month duration can- 
not be precisely determined. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The extensive use of pornography depicting prepubescent children is a useful diagnostic 
indicator of pedophilic disorder. This is a specific instance of the general case that individ- 
uals are likely to choose the kind of pornography that corresponds to their sexual interests. 


Prevalence 


The population prevalence of pedophilic disorder is unknown. The highest possible prev- 
alence for pedophilic disorder in the male population is approximately 3%-5%. The pop- 
ulation prevalence of pedophilic disorder in females is even more uncertain, but it is likely 
a small fraction of the prevalence in males. 


Pedophilic Disorder 699 


Development and Course 


Adult males with pedophilic disorder may indicate that they become aware of strong or 
preferential sexual interest in children around the time of puberty—the same time frame 
in which males who later prefer physically mature partners became aware of their sexual 
interest in women or men. Attempting to diagnose pedophilic disorder at the age at which 
it first manifests is problematic because of the difficulty during adolescent development in 
differentiating it from age-appropriate sexual interest in peers or from sexual curiosity. 
Hence, Criterion C requires for diagnosis a minimum age of 16 years and at least 5 years 
older than the child or children in Criterion A. 

Pedophilia per se appears to be a lifelong condition. Pedophilic disorder, however, 
necessarily includes other elements that may change over time with or without treatment: 
subjective distress (e.g., guilt, shame, intense sexual frustration, or feelings of isolation) or 
psychosocial impairment, or the propensity to act out sexually with children, or both. 
Therefore, the course of pedophilic disorder may fluctuate, increase, or decrease with age. 

Adults with pedophilic disorder may report an awareness of sexual interest in children 
that preceded engaging in sexual behavior involving children or self-identification as a pedo- 
phile. Advanced age is as likely to similarly diminish the frequency of sexual behavior involv- 
ing children as it does other paraphilically motivated and normophilic sexual behavior. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. There appears to be an interaction between pedophilia and antisocial- 
ity, such that males with both traits are more likely to act out sexually with children. Thus, 
antisocial personality disorder may be considered a risk factor for pedophilic disorder in 
males with pedophilia. 


Environmental. Adult males with pedophilia often report that they were sexually abused 
as children. It is unclear, however, whether this correlation reflects a causal influence of 
childhood sexual abuse on adult pedophilia. 


Genetic and physiological. Since pedophilia is a necessary condition for pedophilic dis- 
order, any factor that increases the probability of pedophilia also increases the risk of pe- 
dophilic disorder. There is some evidence that neurodevelopmental perturbation in utero 
increases the probability of development of a pedophilic interest. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Psychophysiological laboratory measures of sexual interest, which are sometimes useful in di- 
agnosing pedophilic disorder in males, are not necessarily useful in diagnosing this disorder in 
females, even when an identical procedure (e.g., viewing time) or analogous procedures (e.g., 
penile plethysmography and vaginal photoplethysmography) are available. 


Diagnostic Markers 


Psychophysiological measures of sexual interest may sometimes be useful when an indi- 
vidual’s history suggests the possible presence of pedophilic disorder but the individual 
denies strong or preferential attraction to children. The most thoroughly researched and 
longest used of such measures is penile plethysmography, although the sensitivity and spec- 
ificity of diagnosis may vary from one site to another. Viewing time, using photographs of 
nude or minimally clothed persons as visual stimuli, is also used to diagnose pedophilic 
disorder, especially in combination with self-report measures. Mental health professionals 
in the United States, however, should be aware that possession of such visual stimuli, even 
for diagnostic purposes, may violate American law regarding possession of child pornog- 
raphy and leave the mental health professional susceptible to criminal prosecution. 


700 Paraphilic Disorders 


Differential Diagnosis 


Many of the conditions that could be differential diagnoses for pedophilic disorder also 
sometimes occur as comorbid diagnoses. It is therefore generally necessary to evaluate the 
evidence for pedophilic disorder and other possible conditions as separate questions. 


Antisocial personality disorder. This disorder increases the likelihood that a person who 
is primarily attracted to the mature physique will approach a child, on one or a few occa- 
sions, on the basis of relative availability. The individual often shows other signs of this 
personality disorder, such as recurrent law-breaking. 


Alcohol and substance use disorders. The disinhibiting effects of intoxication may also 
increase the likelihood that a person who is primarily attracted to the mature physique will 
sexually approach a child. 


Obsessive-compulsive disorder. There are occasional individuals who complain about 
ego-dystonic thoughts and worries about possible attraction to children. Clinical inter- 
viewing usually reveals an absence of sexual thoughts about children during high states of 
sexual arousal (e.g., approaching orgasm during masturbation) and sometimes additional 
ego-dystonic, intrusive sexual ideas (e.g., concerns about homosexuality). 


Comorbidity 


Psychiatric comorbidity of pedophilic disorder includes substance use disorders; depres- 
sive, bipolar, and anxiety disorders; antisocial personality disorder; and other paraphilic 
disorders. However, findings on comorbid disorders are largely among individuals con- 
victed for sexual offenses involving children (almost all males) and may not be general- 
izable to other individuals with pedophilic disorder (e.g., individuals who have never 
approached a child sexually but who qualify for the diagnosis of pedophilic disorder on 
the basis of subjective distress). 


Fetishistic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.81 (F65.0) 


A. Over a period of at least 6 months, recurrent and intense sexual arousal from either 
the use of nonliving objects or a highly specific focus on nongenital body part(s), as 
manifested by fantasies, urges, or behaviors. 

B. The fantasies, sexual urges, or behaviors cause Clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

C. The fetish objects are not limited to articles of clothing used in cross-dressing (as in 
transvestic disorder) or devices specifically designed for the purpose of tactile genital 
stimulation (e.g., vibrator). 


Specify: 
Body part(s) 
Nonliving object(s) 
Other 

Specity if: 
In acontrolled environment: This specifier is primarily applicable to individuals living 
in institutional or other settings where opportunities to engage in fetishistic behaviors 
are restricted. 
In full remission: There has been no distress or impairment in social, occupational, 
or other areas of functioning for at least 5 years while in an uncontrolled environment. 


Fetishistic Disorder 701 


Specifiers 

Although individuals with fetishistic disorder may report intense and recurrent sexual 
arousal to inanimate objects or a specific body part, it is not unusual for non—mutually ex- 
clusive combinations of fetishes to occur. Thus, an individual may have fetishistic disorder 
associated with an inanimate object (e.g., female undergarments) or an exclusive focus on 
an intensely eroticized body part (e.g., feet, hair), or their fetishistic interest may meet cri- 
teria for various combinations of these specifiers (e.g., socks, shoes and feet). 


Diagnostic Features 


The paraphilic focus of fetishistic disorder involves the persistent and repetitive use of or de- 
pendence on nonliving objects or a highly specific focus on a (typically nongenital) body part 
as primary elements associated with sexual arousal (Criterion A). A diagnosis of fetishistic dis- 
order must include clinically significant personal distress or psychosocial role impairment 
(Criterion B). Common fetish objects include female undergarments, male or female footwear, 
rubber articles, leather clothing, or other wearing apparel. Highly eroticized body parts asso- 
ciated with fetishistic disorder include feet, toes, and hair. It is not uncommon for sexualized 
fetishes to include both inanimate objects and body parts (e.g., dirty socks and feet), and for 
this reason the definition of fetishistic disorder now re-incorporates partialism (i.e.,an exclusive 
focus on a body part) into its boundaries. Partialism, previously considered a paraphilia not 
otherwise specified disorder, had historically been subsumed in fetishism prior to DSM-III. 

Many individuals who self-identify as fetishist practitioners do not necessarily report 
clinical impairment in association with their fetish-associated behaviors. Such individuals 
could be considered as having a fetish but not fetishistic disorder. A diagnosis of fetishistic 
disorder requires concurrent fulfillment of both the behaviors in Criterion A and the clin- 
ically significant distress or impairment in functioning noted in Criterion B. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Fetishistic disorder can be a multisensory experience, including holding, tasting, rubbing, 
inserting, or smelling the fetish object while masturbating, or preferring that a sexual part- 
ner wear or utilize a fetish object during sexual encounters. Some individuals may acquire 
extensive collections of highly desired fetish objects. 


Development and Course 


Usually paraphilias have an onset during puberty, but fetishes can develop prior to ado- 
lescence. Once established, fetishistic disorder tends to have a continuous course that fluc- 
tuates in intensity and frequency of urges or behavior. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Knowledge of and appropriate consideration for normative aspects of sexual behavior are 
important factors to explore to establish a clinical diagnosis of fetishistic disorder and to 
distinguish a clinical diagnosis from a socially acceptable sexual behavior. 


Gender-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Fetishistic disorder has not been systematically reported to occur in females. In clinical 
samples, fetishistic disorder is nearly exclusively reported in males. 


Functional Consequences of Fetishistic Disorder 


Typical impairments associated with fetishistic disorder include sexual dysfunction 
during romantic reciprocal relationships when the preferred fetish object or body part is 


702 Paraphilic Disorders 


unavailable during foreplay or coitus. Some individuals with fetishistic disorder may pre- 
fer solitary sexual activity associated with their fetishistic preference(s) even while in- 
volved in a meaningful reciprocal and affectionate relationship. 

Although fetishistic disorder is relatively uncommon among arrested sexual offenders 
with paraphilias, males with fetishistic disorder may steal and collect their particular fe- 
tishistic objects of desire. Such individuals have been arrested and charged for nonsexual 
antisocial behaviors (e.g., breaking and entering, theft, burglary) that are primarily moti- 
vated by the fetishistic disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Transvestic disorder. The nearest diagnostic neighbor of fetishistic disorder is transves- 
tic disorder. As noted in the diagnostic criteria, fetishistic disorder is not diagnosed when 
fetish objects are limited to articles of clothing exclusively worn during cross-dressing (as 
in transvestic disorder), or when the object is genitally stimulating because it has been de- 
signed for that purpose (e.g., a vibrator). 


Sexual masochism disorder or other paraphilic disorders. Fetishes can co-occur with 
other paraphilic disorders, especially “sadomasochism” and transvestic disorder. When 
an individual fantasizes about or engages in “forced cross-dressing” and is primarily sex- 
ually aroused by the domination or humiliation associated with such fantasy or repetitive 
activity, the diagnosis of sexual masochism disorder should be made. 


Fetishistic behavior without fetishistic disorder. Use of a fetish object for sexual arousal 
without any associated distress or psychosocial role impairment or other adverse conse- 
quence would not meet criteria for fetishistic disorder, as the threshold required by Crite- 
rion B would not be met. For example, an individual whose sexual partner either shares or 
can successfully incorporate his interest in caressing, smelling, or licking feet or toes as an 
important element of foreplay would not be diagnosed with fetishistic disorder; nor 
would an individual who prefers, and is not distressed or impaired by, solitary sexual be- 
havior associated with wearing rubber garments or leather boots. 


Comorbidity 


Fetishistic disorder may co-occur with other paraphilic disorders as well as hypersexual- 
ity. Rarely, fetishistic disorder may be associated with neurological conditions. 


Transvestic Disorder 
Diagnostic Criteria 302.3 (F65.1) 


A. Over a period of at least 6 months, recurrent and intense sexual arousal from cross- 
dressing, as manifested by fantasies, urges, or behaviors. 
B. The fantasies, sexual urges, or behaviors cause Clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 
Specity if: 
With fetishism: If sexually aroused by fabrics, materials, or garments. 
With autogynephilia: If sexually aroused by thoughts or images of self as female. 
Specify if: 
In acontrolled environment: This specifier is primarily applicable to individuals living 
in institutional or other settings where opportunities to cross-dress are restricted. 
In full remission: There has been no distress or impairment in social, occupational, 
or other areas of functioning for at least 5 years while in an uncontrolled environment. 


Transvestic Disorder 703 


Specifiers 

The presence of fetishism decreases the likelihood of gender dysphoria in men with trans- 
vestic disorder. The presence of autogynephilia increases the likelihood of gender dyspho- 
ria in men with transvestic disorder. 


Diagnostic Features 


The diagnosis of transvestic disorder does not apply to all individuals who dress as the op- 
posite sex, even those who do so habitually. It applies to individuals whose cross-dressing 
or thoughts of cross-dressing are always or often accompanied by sexual excitement (Cri- 
terion A) and who are emotionally distressed by this pattern or feel it impairs social or in- 
terpersonal functioning (Criterion B). The cross-dressing may involve only one or two 
articles of clothing (e.g., for men, it may pertain only to women’s undergarments), or it 
may involve dressing completely in the inner and outer garments of the other sex and (in 
men) may include the use of women’s wigs and make-up. Transvestic disorder is nearly 
exclusively reported in males. Sexual arousal, in its most obvious form of penile erection, 
may co-occur with cross-dressing in various ways. In younger males, cross-dressing often 
leads to masturbation, following which any female clothing is removed. Older males often 
learn to avoid masturbating or doing anything to stimulate the penis so that the avoidance 
of ejaculation allows them to prolong their cross-dressing session. Males with female part- 
ners sometimes complete a cross-dressing session by having intercourse with their part- 
ners, and some have difficulty maintaining a sufficient erection for intercourse without 
cross-dressing (or private fantasies of cross-dressing). 

Clinical assessment of distress or impairment, like clinical assessment of transvestic 
sexual arousal, is usually dependent on the individual’s self-report. The pattern of behav- 
ior “purging and acquisition” often signifies the presence of distress in individuals with 
transvestic disorder. During this behavioral pattern, an individual (usually a man) who 
has spent a great deal of money on women’s clothes and other apparel (e.g., shoes, wigs) 
discards the items (i.e., purges them) in an effort to overcome urges to cross-dress, and 
then begins acquiring a woman’s wardrobe all over again. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Transvestic disorder in men is often accompanied by autogynephilia (i.e., a male’s para- 
philic tendency to be sexually aroused by the thought or image of himself as a woman). 
Autogynephilic fantasies and behaviors may focus on the idea of exhibiting female phys- 
iological functions (e.g., lactation, menstruation), engaging in stereotypically feminine be- 
havior (e.g., knitting), or possessing female anatomy (e.g., breasts). 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of transvestic disorder is unknown. Transvestic disorder is rare in males 
and extremely rare in females. Fewer than 3% of males report having ever been sexually 
aroused by dressing in women’s attire. The percentage of individuals who have cross- 
dressed with sexual arousal more than once or a few times in their lifetimes would be even 
lower. The majority of males with transvestic disorder identify as heterosexual, although 
some individuals have occasional sexual interaction with other males, especially when 
they are cross-dressed. 


Development and Course 


In males, the first signs of transvestic disorder may begin in childhood, in the form of 
strong fascination with a particular item of women’s attire. Prior to puberty, cross-dress- 
ing produces generalized feelings of pleasurable excitement. With the arrival of puberty, 
dressing in women’s clothes begins to elicit penile erection and, in some cases, leads di- 


704 Paraphilic Disorders 


rectly to first ejaculation. In many cases, cross-dressing elicits less and less sexual ex- 
citement as the individual grows older; eventually it may produce no discernible penile 
response at all. The desire to cross-dress, at the same time, remains the same or grows even 
stronger. Individuals who report such a diminution of sexual response typically report 
that the sexual excitement of cross-dressing has been replaced by feelings of comfort or 
well-being. 

In some cases, the course of transvestic disorder is continuous, and in others it is epi- 
sodic. It is not rare for men with transvestic disorder to lose interest in cross-dressing when 
they first fall in love with a woman and begin a relationship, but such abatement usually 
proves temporary. When the desire to cross-dress returns, so does the associated distress. 

Some cases of transvestic disorder progress to gender dysphoria. The males in these 
cases, who may be indistinguishable from others with transvestic disorder in adolescence 
or early childhood, gradually develop desires to remain in the female role for longer pe- 
riods and to feminize their anatomy. The development of gender dysphoria is usually ac- 
companied by a (self-reported) reduction or elimination of sexual arousal in association 
with cross-dressing. 

The manifestation of transvestism in penile erection and stimulation, like the manifesta- 
tion of other paraphilic as well as normophilic sexual interests, is most intense in adolescence 
and early adulthood. The severity of transvestic disorder is highest in adulthood, when the 
transvestic drives are most likely to conflict with performance in heterosexual intercourse 
and desires to marry and start a family. Middle-age and older men with a history of trans- 
vestism are less likely to present with transvestic disorder than with gender dysphoria. 


Functional Consequences of Transvestic Disorder 


Engaging in transvestic behaviors can interfere with, or detract from, heterosexual rela- 
tionships. This can be a source of distress to men who wish to maintain conventional mar- 
riages or romantic partnerships with women. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Fetishistic disorder. This disorder may resemble transvestic disorder, in particular, in 
men with fetishism who put on women’s undergarments while masturbating with them. 
Distinguishing transvestic disorder depends on the individual's specific thoughts during 
such activity (e.g., are there any ideas of being a woman, being like a woman, or being 
dressed as a woman?) and on the presence of other fetishes (e.g., soft, silky fabrics, whether 
these are used for garments or for something else). 


Gender dysphoria. Individuals with transvestic disorder do not report an incongruence be- 
tween their experienced gender and assigned gender nor a desire to be of the other gender; and 
they typically do not have a history of childhood cross-gender behaviors, which would be 
present in individuals with gender dysphoria. Individuals with a presentation that meets full 
criteria for transvestic disorder as well as gender dysphoria should be given both diagnoses. 


Comorbidity 


Transvestism (and thus transvestic disorder) is often found in association with other para- 
philias. The most frequently co-occurring paraphilias are fetishism and masochism. One 
particularly dangerous form of masochism, autoerotic asphyxia, is associated with transves- 
tism in a substantial proportion of fatal cases. 


Other Specified Paraphilic Disorder 705 


Other Specified Paraphilic Disorder 
302.89 (F65.89) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a paraphilic disor- 
der that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other im- 
portant areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of the disorders 
in the paraphilic disorders diagnostic class. The other specified paraphilic disorder category is 
used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific reason that the 
presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific paraphilic disorder. This is done by re- 
cording “other specified paraphilic disorder” followed by the specific reason (e.g., “Zoophilia”). 

Examples of presentations that can be specified using the “other specified” designation 
include, but are not limited to, recurrent and intense sexual arousal involving telephone 
scatologia (obscene phone calls), necrophilia (corpses), zoophilia (animals), coprophilia 
(feces), klismaphilia (enemas), or urophilia (urine) that has been present for at least 6 months 
and causes marked distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important ar- 
eas of functioning. Other specified paraphilic disorder can be specified as in remission 
and/or as occurring in a controlled environment. 


Unspecified Paraphilic Disorder 
302.9 (F65.9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a paraphilic 
disorder that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or 
other important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any of 
the disorders in the paraphilic disorders diagnostic class. The unspecified paraphilic dis- 
order category is used in situations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason 
that the criteria are not met for a specific paraphilic disorder, and includes presentations 
in which there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Other Mental 
Disorders 


Four diSorders are included in this chapter: other specified mental disorder due to 
another medical condition; unspecified mental disorder due to another medical condition; 
other specified mental disorder; and unspecified mental disorder. This residual category 
applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a mental disorder that cause 
clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or other important ar- 
eas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any other mental dis- 
order in DSM-5. For other specified and unspecified mental disorders due to another 
medical condition, it must be established that the disturbance is caused by the physiolog- 
ical effects of another medical condition. If other specified and unspecified mental disor- 
ders are due to another medical condition, it is necessary to code and list the medical 
condition first (e.g., 042 [B20] HIV disease), followed by the other specified or unspecified 
mental disorder (use appropriate code). 


Other Specified Mental Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


294.8 (F06.8) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a mental dis- 
order due to another medical condition that cause clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do 
not meet the full criteria for any specific mental disorder attributable to another medical 
condition. The other specified mental disorder due to another medical condition category 
is used in situations in which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific reason that 
the presentation does not meet the criteria for any specific mental disorder attributable to 
another medical condition. This is done by recording the name of the disorder, with the 
specific etiological medical condition inserted in place of “another medical condition,” fol- 
lowed by the specific symptomatic manifestation that does not meet the criteria for any 
specific mental disorder due to another medical condition. Furthermore, the diagnostic 
code for the specific medical condition must be listed immediately before the code for the 
other specified mental disorder due to another medical condition. For example, dissocia- 
tive symptoms due to complex partial seizures would be coded and recorded as 345.40 
(G40.209), complex partial seizures 294.8 (FO6.8) other specified mental disorder due to 
complex partial seizures, dissociative symptoms. 

An example of a presentation that can be specified using the “other specified” desig- 
nation is the following: 

Dissociative symptoms: This includes symptoms occurring, for example, in the con- 

text of complex partial seizures. 


707 


708 Other Mental Disorders 


Unspecified Mental Disorder 
Due to Another Medical Condition 


294.9 (FO9) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a mental dis- 
order due to another medical condition that cause clinically significant distress or impair- 
ment in social, occupational, or other important areas of functioning predominate but do 
not meet the full criteria for any specific mental disorder due to another medical condition. 
The unspecified mental disorder due to another medical condition category is used in sit- 
uations in which the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met 
for a specific mental disorder due to another medical condition, and includes presentations 
for which there is insufficient information to make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emer- 
gency room settings). This is done by recording the name of the disorder, with the specific 
etiological medical condition inserted in place of “another medical condition.” Furthermore, 
the diagnostic code for the specific medical condition must be listed immediately before 
the code for the unspecified mental disorder due to another medical condition. For exam- 
ple, dissociative symptoms due to complex partial seizures would be coded and recorded 
as 345.40 (G40.209) complex partial seizures, 294.9 (FO6.9) unspecified mental disorder 
due to complex partial seizures. 


Other Specified Mental Disorder 
300.9 (F99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a mental dis- 
order that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or oth- 
er important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any 
specific mental disorder. The other specified mental disorder category is used in situations 
in which the clinician chooses to communicate the specific reason that the presentation 
does not meet the criteria for any specific mental disorder. This is done by recording “other 
specified mental disorder” followed by the specific reason. 


Unspecified Mental Disorder 
300.9 (F99) 


This category applies to presentations in which symptoms characteristic of a mental dis- 
order that cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupational, or oth- 
er important areas of functioning predominate but do not meet the full criteria for any 
mental disorder. The unspecified mental disorder category is used in situations in which 
the clinician chooses not to specify the reason that the criteria are not met for a specific 
mental disorder, and includes presentations for which there is insufficient information to 
make a more specific diagnosis (e.g., in emergency room settings). 


Medication-Induced Movement 
Disorders and Other Adverse 
Effects of Medication 


Medication-indUuCed movement disorders are included in Section II because of 
their frequent importance in 1) the management by medication of mental disorders or oth- 
er medical conditions and 2) the differential diagnosis of mental disorders (e.g., anxiety 
disorder versus neuroleptic-induced akathisia; malignant catatonia versus neuroleptic 
malignant syndrome). Although these movement disorders are labeled “medication in- 
duced,” it is often difficult to establish the causal relationship between medication expo- 
sure and the development of the movement disorder, especially because some of these 
movement disorders also occur in the absence of medication exposure. The conditions 
and problems listed in this chapter are not mental disorders. 

The term neuroleptic is becoming outdated because it highlights the propensity of an- 
tipsychotic medications to cause abnormal movements, and it is being replaced with the 
term antipsychotic in many contexts. Nevertheless, the term neuroleptic remains appropri- 
ate in this context. Although newer antipsychotic medications may be less likely to cause 
some medication-induced movement disorders, those disorders still occur. Neuroleptic 
medications include so-called conventional, “typical,” or first-generation antipsychotic 
agents (e.g., chlorpromazine, haloperidol, fluphenazine); “atypical” or second-generation 
antipsychotic agents (e.g., clozapine, risperidone, olanzapine, quetiapine); certain dopa- 
mine receptor—blocking drugs used in the treatment of symptoms such as nausea and gas- 
troparesis (e.g., prochlorperazine, promethazine, trimethobenzamide, thiethylperazine, 
metoclopramide); and amoxapine, which is marketed as an antidepressant. 


Neuroleptic-Induced Parkinsonism 
Other Medication-Induced Parkinsonism 


332.1 (G21.11) Neuroleptic-Induced Parkinsonism 

332.1 (G21.19) Other Medication-Induced Parkinsonism 

Parkinsonian tremor, muscular rigidity, akinesia (i.e., loss of movement or difficulty ini- 
tiating movement), or bradykinesia (i.e., slowing movement) developing within a few 
weeks of starting or raising the dosage of a medication (e.g., a neuroleptic) or after reduc- 
ing the dosage of a medication used to treat extrapyramidal symptoms. 


Neuroleptic Malignant Syndrome 


333.92 (G21.0) Neuroleptic Malignant Syndrome 

Although neuroleptic malignant syndrome is easily recognized in its classic full-blown 
form, it is often heterogeneous in onset, presentation, progression, and outcome. The clin- 
ical features described below are those considered most important in making the diagno- 
sis of neuroleptic malignant syndrome based on consensus recommendations. 


709 


710 Medication-Induced Movement Disorders 


Diagnostic Features 


Patients have generally been exposed to a dopamine antagonist within 72 hours prior to 
symptom development. Hyperthermia (>100.4°F or >38.0°C on at least two occasions, 
measured orally), associated with profuse diaphoresis, is a distinguishing feature of neu- 
roleptic malignant syndrome, setting it apart from other neurological side effects of anti- 
psychotic medications. Extreme elevations in temperature, reflecting a breakdown in 
central thermoregulation, are more likely to support the diagnosis of neuroleptic malig- 
nant syndrome. Generalized rigidity, described as “lead pipe” in its most severe form and 
usually unresponsive to antiparkinsonian agents, is a cardinal feature of the disorder and 
may be associated with other neurological symptoms (e.g., tremor, sialorrhea, akinesia, 
dystonia, trismus, myoclonus, dysarthria, dysphagia, rhabdomyolysis). Creatine kinase 
elevation of at least four times the upper limit of normal is commonly seen. Changes in 
mental status, characterized by delirium or altered consciousness ranging from stupor to 
coma, are often an early sign. Affected individuals may appear alert but dazed and unre- 
sponsive, consistent with catatonic stupor. Autonomic activation and instability—mani- 
fested by tachycardia (rate>25% above baseline), diaphoresis, blood pressure elevation 
(systolic or diastolic >25% above baseline) or fluctuation (=>20 mmHg diastolic change or 
225 mmHg systolic change within 24 hours), urinary incontinence, and pallor—may be 
seen at any time but provide an early clue to the diagnosis. Tachypnea (rate >50% above 
baseline) is common, and respiratory distress—resulting from metabolic acidosis, hyper- 
metabolism, chest wall restriction, aspiration pneumonia, or pulmonary emboli—can oc- 
cur and lead to sudden respiratory arrest. 

A workup, including laboratory investigation, to exclude other infectious, toxic, met- 
abolic, and neuropsychiatric etiologies or complications is essential (see the section “Dif- 
ferential Diagnosis” later in this discussion). Although several laboratory abnormalities 
are associated with neuroleptic malignant syndrome, no single abnormality is specific to 
the diagnosis. Individuals with neuroleptic malignant syndrome may have leukocytosis, 
metabolic acidosis, hypoxia, decreased serum iron concentrations, and elevations in se- 
rum muscle enzymes and catecholamines. Findings from cerebrospinal fluid analysis and 
neuroimaging studies are generally normal, whereas electroencephalography shows gen- 
eralized slowing. Autopsy findings in fatal cases have been nonspecific and variable, de- 
pending on complications. 


Development and Course 


Evidence from database studies suggests incidence rates for neuroleptic malignant syn- 
drome of 0.01%-0.02% among individuals treated with antipsychotics. The temporal pro- 
gression of signs and symptoms provides important clues to the diagnosis and prognosis 
of neuroleptic malignant syndrome. Alteration in mental status and other neurological 
signs typically precede systemic signs. The onset of symptoms varies from hours to days 
after drug initiation. Some cases develop within 24 hours after drug initiation, most within 
the first week, and virtually all cases within 30 days. Once the syndrome is diagnosed and 
oral antipsychotic drugs are discontinued, neuroleptic malignant syndrome is self-limited 
in most cases. The mean recovery time after drug discontinuation is 7-10 days, with most 
individuals recovering within 1 week and nearly all within 30 days. The duration may be 
prolonged when long-acting antipsychotics are implicated. There have been reports of in- 
dividuals in whom residual neurological signs persisted for weeks after the acute hyper- 
metabolic symptoms resolved. Total resolution of symptoms can be obtained in most 
cases of neuroleptic malignant syndrome; however, fatality rates of 10%-20% have been 
reported when the disorder is not recognized. Although many individuals do not experi- 
ence a recurrence of neuroleptic malignant syndrome when rechallenged with antipsy- 
chotic medication, some do, especially when antipsychotics are reinstituted soon after an 
episode. 


Medication-Induced Movement Disorders 711 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Neuroleptic malignant syndrome is a potential risk in any individual after antipsychotic 
drug administration. It is not specific to any neuropsychiatric diagnosis and may occur in 
individuals without a diagnosable mental disorder who receive dopamine antagonists. 
Clinical, systemic, and metabolic factors associated with a heightened risk of neuroleptic 
malignant syndrome include agitation, exhaustion, dehydration, and iron deficiency. A 
prior episode associated with antipsychotics has been described in 15%-20% of index 
cases, suggesting underlying vulnerability in some patients; however, genetic findings 
based on neurotransmitter receptor polymorphisms have not been replicated consistently. 

Nearly all dopamine antagonists have been associated with neuroleptic malignant 
syndrome, although high-potency antipsychotics pose a greater risk compared with low- 
potency agents and newer atypical antipsychotics. Partial or milder forms may be associ- 
ated with newer antipsychotics, but neuroleptic malignant syndrome varies in severity 
even with older drugs. Dopamine antagonists used in medical settings (e.g., metoclopra- 
mide, prochlorperazine) have also been implicated. Parenteral administration routes, 
rapid titration rates, and higher total drug dosages have been associated with increased 
risk; however, neuroleptic malignant syndrome usually occurs within the therapeutic dos- 
age range of antipsychotics. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Neuroleptic malignant syndrome must be distinguished from other serious neurological 
or medical conditions, including central nervous system infections, inflammatory or au- 
toimmune conditions, status epilepticus, subcortical structural lesions, and systemic con- 
ditions (e.g., pheochromocytoma, thyrotoxicosis, tetanus, heat stroke). 

Neuroleptic malignant syndrome also must be distinguished from similar syndromes 
resulting from the use of other substances or medications, such as serotonin syndrome; 
parkinsonian hyperthermia syndrome following abrupt discontinuation of dopamine ag- 
onists; alcohol or sedative withdrawal; malignant hyperthermia occurring during anes- 
thesia; hyperthermia associated with abuse of stimulants and hallucinogens; and atropine 
poisoning from anticholinergics. 

In rare instances, individuals with schizophrenia or a mood disorder may present with 
malignant catatonia, which may be indistinguishable from neuroleptic malignant syn- 
drome. Some investigators consider neuroleptic malignant syndrome to be a drug- 
induced form of malignant catatonia. 


Medication-Induced Acute Dystonia 


333.72 (G24.02) Medication-Induced Acute Dystonia 

Abnormal and prolonged contraction of the muscles of the eyes (oculogyric crisis), head, 
neck (torticollis or retrocollis), limbs, or trunk developing within a few days of starting or 
raising the dosage of a medication (such as a neuroleptic) or after reducing the dosage of a 
medication used to treat extrapyramidal symptoms. 


Medication-Induced Acute Akathisia 


333.99 (G25.71) Medication-Induced Acute Akathisia 

Subjective complaints of restlessness, often accompanied by observed excessive move- 
ments (e.g., fidgety movements of the legs, rocking from foot to foot, pacing, inability to sit 
or stand still), developing within a few weeks of starting or raising the dosage of a medi- 
cation (such as a neuroleptic) or after reducing the dosage of a medication used to treat ex- 
trapyramidal symptoms. 


712 Medication-Induced Movement Disorders 


Tardive Dyskinesia 


333.85 (G24.01) Tardive Dyskinesia 

Involuntary athetoid or choreiform movements (lasting at least a few weeks) generally of 
the tongue, lower face and jaw, and extremities (but sometimes involving the pharyngeal, 
diaphragmatic, or trunk muscles) developing in association with the use of a neuroleptic 
medication for at least a few months. 

Symptoms may develop after a shorter period of medication use in older persons. In 
some patients, movements of this type may appear after discontinuation, or after change 
or reduction in dosage, of neuroleptic medications, in which case the condition is called 
neuroleptic withdrawal-emergent dyskinesia. Because withdrawal-emergent dyskinesia is 
usually time-limited, lasting less than 4-8 weeks, dyskinesia that persists beyond this win- 
dow is considered to be tardive dyskinesia. 


Tardive Dystonia 
Tardive Akathisia 


333.72 (G24.09) Tardive Dystonia 

333.99 (G25.71) Tardive Akathisia 

Tardive syndrome involving other types of movement problems, such as dystonia or 
akathisia, which are distinguished by their late emergence in the course of treatment and 
their potential persistence for months to years, even in the face of neuroleptic discontinu- 
ation or dosage reduction. 


Medication-Induced Postural Tremor 


333.1 (G25.1) Medication-Induced Postural Tremor 

Fine tremor (usually in the range of 8-12 Hz) occurring during attempts to maintain a pos- 
ture and developing in association with the use of medication (e.g., lithium, antidepres- 
sants, valproate). This tremor is very similar to the tremor seen with anxiety, caffeine, and 
other stimulants. 


Other Medication-Induced Movement Disorder 


333.99 (G25.79) Other Medication-Induced Movement Disorder 

This category is for medication-induced movement disorders not captured by any of the 
specific disorders listed above. Examples include 1) presentations resembling neuroleptic 
malignant syndrome that are associated with medications other than neuroleptics and 
2) other medication-induced tardive conditions. 


Antidepressant Discontinuation Syndrome 


995.29 (T43.205A) Initial encounter 
995.29 (T43.205D) Subsequent encounter 


995.29 (T43.205S) Sequelae 

Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome is a set of symptoms that can occur after an 
abrupt cessation (or marked reduction in dose) of an antidepressant medication that was 
taken continuously for at least 1 month. Symptoms generally begin within 2-4 days and 
typically include specific sensory, somatic, and cognitive-emotional manifestations. Fre- 


Medication-Induced Movement Disorders 713 


quently reported sensory and somatic symptoms include flashes of lights, “electric shock” 
sensations, nausea, and hyperresponsivity to noises or lights. Nonspecific anxiety and 
feelings of dread may also be reported. Symptoms are alleviated by restarting the same 
medication or starting a different medication that has a similar mechanism of action— 
for example, discontinuation symptoms after withdrawal from a serotonin-norepineph- 
rine reuptake inhibitor may be alleviated by starting a tricyclic antidepressant. To qualify 
as antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, the symptoms should not have been present 
before the antidepressant dosage was reduced and are not better explained by another 
mental disorder (e.g., manic or hypomanic episode, substance intoxication, substance 
withdrawal, somatic symptom disorder). 


Diagnostic Features 


Discontinuation symptoms may occur following treatment with tricyclic antidepressants 
(e.g., imipramine, amitriptyline, desipramine), serotonin reuptake inhibitors (e.g., fluox- 
etine, paroxetine, sertraline), and monoamine oxidase inhibitors (e.g., phenelzine, selegi- 
line, pargyline). The incidence of this syndrome depends on the dosage and half-life of the 
medication being taken, as well as the rate at which the medication is tapered. Short-acting 
medications that are stopped abruptly rather than tapered gradually may pose the great- 
est risk. The short-acting selective serotonin reuptake inhibitor (SSRI) paroxetine is the 
agent most commonly associated with discontinuation symptoms, but such symptoms oc- 
cur for all types of antidepressants. 

Unlike withdrawal syndromes associated with opioids, alcohol, and other substances 
of abuse, antidepressant discontinuation syndrome has no pathognomonic symptoms. In- 
stead, the symptoms tend to be vague and variable and typically begin 2-4 days after the 
last dose of the antidepressant. For SSRIs (e.g., paroxetine), symptoms such as dizziness, 
ringing in the ears, “electric shocks in the head,” an inability to sleep, and acute anxiety are 
described. The antidepressant use prior to discontinuation must not have incurred hypo- 
mania or euphoria (i.e., there should be confidence that the discontinuation syndrome is 
not the result of fluctuations in mood stability associated with the previous treatment). 
The antidepressant discontinuation syndrome is based solely on pharmacological factors 
and is not related to the reinforcing effects of an antidepressant. Also, in the case of stim- 
ulant augmentation of an antidepressant, abrupt cessation may result in stimulant with- 
drawal symptoms (see “Stimulant Withdrawal” in the chapter “Substance-Related and 
Addictive Disorders”) rather than the antidepressant discontinuation syndrome described 
here. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of antidepressant discontinuation syndrome is unknown but is thought to 
vary according to the dosage prior to discontinuation, the half-life and receptor-binding 
affinity of the medication, and possibly the individual’s genetically influenced rate of me- 
tabolism for this medication. 


Course and Development 


Because longitudinal studies are lacking, little is known about the clinical course of anti- 
depressant discontinuation syndrome. Symptoms appear to abate over time with very 
gradual dosage reductions. After an episode, some individuals may prefer to resume med- 
ication indefinitely if tolerated. 


Differential Diagnosis 


The differential diagnosis of antidepressant discontinuation syndrome includes anxiety 
and depressive disorders, substance use disorders, and tolerance to medications. 


714 Medication-Induced Movement Disorders 


Anxiety and depressive disorders. Discontinuation symptoms often resemble symptoms 
of a persistent anxiety disorder or a return of somatic symptoms of depression for which 
the medication was initially given. 


Substance use disorders. Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome differs from sub- 
stance withdrawal in that antidepressants themselves have no reinforcing or euphoric ef- 
fects. The medication dosage has usually not been increased without the clinician’s 
permission, and the individual generally does not engage in drug-seeking behavior to ob- 
tain additional medication. Criteria for a substance use disorder are not met. 


Tolerance to medications. Tolerance and discontinuation symptoms can occur as a 
normal physiological response to stopping medication after a substantial duration of 
exposure. Most cases of medication tolerance can be managed through carefully con- 
trolled tapering. 


Comorbidity 


Typically, the individual was initially started on the medication for a major depressive dis- 
order; the original symptoms may return during the discontinuation syndrome. 


Other Adverse Effect of Medication 


995.20 (T50.905A) Initial encounter 
995.20 (T50.905D) Subsequent encounter 


995.20 (T50.905S) Sequelae 

This category is available for optional use by clinicians to code side effects of medication 
(other than movement symptoms) when these adverse effects become a main focus of clin- 
ical attention. Examples include severe hypotension, cardiac arrhythmias, and priapism. 


Other Conditions That May Be 
a Focus of Clinical Attention 


This GiSCUSSION covers other conditions and problems that may be a focus of clini- 
cal attention or that may otherwise affect the diagnosis, course, prognosis, or treatment of 
a patient’s mental disorder. These conditions are presented with their corresponding 
codes from ICD-9-CM (usually V codes) and ICD-10-CM (usually Z codes). A condition 
or problem in this chapter may be coded if it is a reason for the current visit or helps to 
explain the need for a test, procedure, or treatment. Conditions and problems in this chap- 
ter may also be included in the medical record as useful information on circumstances that 
may affect the patient’s care, regardless of their relevance to the current visit. 

The conditions and problems listed in this chapter are not mental disorders. Their in- 
clusion in DSM-5 is meant to draw attention to the scope of additional issues that may be 
encountered in routine clinical practice and to provide a systematic listing that may be 
useful to clinicians in documenting these issues. 


Relational Problems 


Key relationships, especially intimate adult partner relationships and parent/caregiver- 
child relationships, have a significant impact on the health of the individuals in these re- 
lationships. These relationships can be health promoting and protective, neutral, or detri- 
mental to health outcomes. In the extreme, these close relationships can be associated with 
maltreatment or neglect, which has significant medical and psychological consequences 
for the affected individual. A relational problem may come to clinical attention either as 
the reason that the individual seeks health care or as a problem that affects the course, 
prognosis, or treatment of the individual’s mental or other medical disorder. 


Problems Related to Family Upbringing 


V61.20 (262.820) Parent-Child Relational Problem 

For this category, the term parent is used to refer to one of the child’s primary caregivers, 
who may be a biological, adoptive, or foster parent or may be another relative (such as a 
grandparent) who fulfills a parental role for the child. This category should be used when 
the main focus of clinical attention is to address the quality of the parent-child relationship 
or when the quality of the parent-child relationship is affecting the course, prognosis, or 
treatment of a mental or other medical disorder. Typically, the parent-child relational 
problem is associated with impaired functioning in behavioral, cognitive, or affective do- 
mains. Examples of behavioral problems include inadequate parental control, supervision, 
and involvement with the child; parental overprotection; excessive parental pressure; ar- 
guments that escalate to threats of physical violence; and avoidance without resolution of 
problems. Cognitive problems may include negative attributions of the other’s intentions, 
hostility toward or scapegoating of the other, and unwarranted feelings of estrangement. 
Affective problems may include feelings of sadness, apathy, or anger about the other in- 
dividual in the relationship. Clinicians should take into account the developmental needs 
of the child and the cultural context. 


715 


716 Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 


V61.8 (262.891) Sibling Relational Problem 

This category should be used when the focus of clinical attention is a pattern of interaction 
among siblings that is associated with significant impairment in individual or family function- 
ing or with development of symptoms in one or more of the siblings, or when a sibling relational 
problem is affecting the course, prognosis, or treatment of a sibling’s mental or other medical 
disorder. This category can be used for either children or adults if the focus is on the sibling re- 
lationship. Siblings in this context include full, half-, step-, foster, and adopted siblings. 


V61.8 (262.29) Upbringing Away From Parents 

This category should be used when the main focus of clinical attention pertains to issues 
regarding a child being raised away from the parents or when this separate upbringing af- 
fects the course, prognosis, or treatment of a mental or other medical disorder. The child 
could be one who is under state custody and placed in kin care or foster care. The child 
could also be one who is living in a nonparental relative’s home, or with friends, but whose 
out-of-home placement is not mandated or sanctioned by the courts. Problems related to a 
child living in a group home or orphanage are also included. This category excludes issues 
related to V60.6 (Z59.3) children in boarding schools. 


V61.29 (Z62.898) Child Affected by Parental Relationship Distress 

This category should be used when the focus of clinical attention is the negative effects of 
parental relationship discord (e.g., high levels of conflict, distress, or disparagement) on a 
child in the family, including effects on the child’s mental or other medical disorders. 


Other Problems Related to Primary Support Group 


V61.10 (Z63.0) Relationship Distress With Spouse or Intimate Partner 

This category should be used when the major focus of the clinical contact is to address the 
quality of the intimate (spouse or partner) relationship or when the quality of that rela- 
tionship is affecting the course, prognosis, or treatment of a mental or other medical dis- 
order. Partners can be of the same or different genders. Typically, the relationship distress 
is associated with impaired functioning in behavioral, cognitive, or affective domains. Ex- 
amples of behavioral problems include conflict resolution difficulty, withdrawal, and 
overinvolvement. Cognitive problems can manifest as chronic negative attributions of the 
other’s intentions or dismissals of the partner’s positive behaviors. Affective problems 
would include chronic sadness, apathy, and/or anger about the other partner. 


Note: This category excludes clinical encounters for V61.1x (Z69.1x) mental health ser- 
vices for spousal or partner abuse problems and V65.49 (Z70.9) sex counseling. 


V61.03 (Z63.5) Disruption of Family by Separation or Divorce 
This category should be used when partners in an intimate adult couple are living apart 
due to relationship problems or are in the process of divorce. 


V61.8 (263.8) High Expressed Emotion Level Within Family 

Expressed emotion is a construct used as a qualitative measure of the “amount” of emo- 
tion—in particular, hostility, emotional overinvolvement, and criticism directed toward a 
family member who is an identified patient—displayed in the family environment. This 
category should be used when a family’s high level of expressed emotion is the focus of 
clinical attention or is affecting the course, prognosis, or treatment of a family member’s 
mental or other medical disorder. 


V62.82 (Z63.4) Uncomplicated Bereavement 

This category can be used when the focus of clinical attention is a normal reaction to the 
death of a loved one. As part of their reaction to such a loss, some grieving individuals 
present with symptoms characteristic of a major depressive episode—for example, feel- 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 717 


ings of sadness and associated symptoms such as insomnia, poor appetite, and weight 
loss. The bereaved individual typically regards the depressed mood as “normal,” al- 
though the individual may seek professional help for relief of associated symptoms such 
as insomnia or anorexia. The duration and expression of “normal” bereavement vary con- 
siderably among different cultural groups. Further guidance in distinguishing grief from 
a major depressive episode is provided in the criteria for major depressive episode. 


Abuse and Neglect 


Maltreatment by a family member (e.g., caregiver, intimate adult partner) or by a nonrel- 
ative can be the area of current clinical focus, or such maltreatment can be an important 
factor in the assessment and treatment of patients with mental or other medical disorders. 
Because of the legal implications of abuse and neglect, care should be used in assessing 
these conditions and assigning these codes. Having a past history of abuse or neglect can 
influence diagnosis and treatment response in a number of mental disorders, and may also 
be noted along with the diagnosis. 

For the following categories, in addition to listings of the confirmed or suspected event 
of abuse or neglect, other codes are provided for use if the current clinical encounter is to 
provide mental health services to either the victim or the perpetrator of the abuse or ne- 
glect. A separate code is also provided for designating a past history of abuse or neglect. 


Coding Note for ICD-10-CM Abuse and Neglect Conditions 
For T codes only, the 7th character should be coded as follows: 


A (initial encounter)—Use while the patient is receiving active treatment for 
the condition (e.g., surgical treatment, emergency department encounter, eval- 
uation and treatment by a new clinician); or 

D (subsequent encounter)—Use for encounters after the patient has received 
active treatment for the condition and when he or she is receiving routine care 
for the condition during the healing or recovery phase (e.g., cast change or re- 
moval, removal of external or internal fixation device, medication adjustment, 
other aftercare and follow-up visits). 


Child Maltreatment and Neglect Problems 
Child Physical Abuse 


Child physical abuse is nonaccidental physical injury to a child—ranging from minor bruises 
to severe fractures or death—occurring as a result of punching, beating, kicking, biting, 
shaking, throwing, stabbing, choking, hitting (with a hand, stick, strap, or other object), 
burning, or any other method that is inflicted by a parent, caregiver, or other individual who 
has responsibility for the child. Such injury is considered abuse regardless of whether the 
caregiver intended to hurt the child. Physical discipline, such as spanking or paddling, is not 
considered abuse as long as it is reasonable and causes no bodily injury to the child. 


Child Physical Abuse, Confirmed 
995.54 (T74.12XA) Initial encounter 
995.54 (T74.12XD) Subsequent encounter 


Child Physical Abuse, Suspected 
995.54 (T76.12XA) Initial encounter 
995.54 (T76.12XD) Subsequent encounter 


718 Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 


Other Circumstances Related to Child Physical Abuse 
V61.21 (Z69.010) Encounter for mental health services for victim of child abuse by parent 


V61.21 (Z69.020) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child 
abuse 


V15.41 (Z62.810) Personal history (past history) of physical abuse in childhood 
V61.22 (Z69.011) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child 
abuse 


V62.83 (Z69.021) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental 
child abuse 


Child Sexual Abuse 


Child sexual abuse encompasses any sexual act involving a child that is intended to pro- 
vide sexual gratification to a parent, caregiver, or other individual who has responsibility 
for the child. Sexual abuse includes activities such as fondling a child’s genitals, penetra- 
tion, incest, rape, sodomy, and indecent exposure. Sexual abuse also includes noncontact 
exploitation of a child by a parent or caregiver—for example, forcing, tricking, enticing, 
threatening, or pressuring a child to participate in acts for the sexual gratification of others, 
without direct physical contact between child and abuser. 


Child Sexual Abuse, Confirmed 
995.53 (T74.22XA) Initial encounter 
995.53 (T74.22XD) Subsequent encounter 


Child Sexual Abuse, Suspected 
995.53 (T76.22XA) Initial encounter 
995.53 (T76.22XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Child Sexual Abuse 


V61.21 (Z69.010) Encounter for mental health services for victim of child sexual abuse 
by parent 


V61.21 (Z69.020) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child 
sexual abuse 
V15.41 (Z62.810) Personal history (past history) of sexual abuse in childhood 


V61.22 (Z69.011) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child 
sexual abuse 

V62.83 (Z69.021) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental 
child sexual abuse 


Child Neglect 


Child neglect is defined as any confirmed or suspected egregious act or omission by a 
child’s parent or other caregiver that deprives the child of basic age-appropriate needs and 
thereby results, or has reasonable potential to result, in physical or psychological harm to 
the child. Child neglect encompasses abandonment; lack of appropriate supervision; fail- 
ure to attend to necessary emotional or psychological needs; and failure to provide neces- 
sary education, medical care, nourishment, shelter, and/or clothing. 


Child Neglect, Confirmed 
995.52 (T74.02XA) Initial encounter 
995.52 (T74.02XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 719 


Child Neglect, Suspected 
995.52 (T76.02XA) Initial encounter 
995.52 (T76.02XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Child Neglect 

V61.21 (Z69.010) Encounter for mental health services for victim of child neglect by 
parent 

V61.21 (Z69.020) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child 
neglect 

V15.42 (Z62.812) Personal history (past history) of neglect in childhood 

V61.22 (Z69.011) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child 
neglect 


V62.83 (Z69.021) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental 
child neglect 


Child Psychological Abuse 


Child psychological abuse is nonaccidental verbal or symbolic acts by a child’s parent or 
caregiver that result, or have reasonable potential to result, in significant psychological 
harm to the child. (Physical and sexual abusive acts are not included in this category.) Ex- 
amples of psychological abuse of a child include berating, disparaging, or humiliating 
the child; threatening the child; harming /abandoning—or indicating that the alleged 
offender will harm/abandon—people or things that the child cares about; confining the 
child (as by tying a child’s arms or legs together or binding a child to furniture or another 
object, or confining a child to a small enclosed area [e.g., a closet]); egregious scapegoating 
of the child; coercing the child to inflict pain on himself or herself; and disciplining the 
child excessively (i.e., at an extremely high frequency or duration, even if not at a level of 
physical abuse) through physical or nonphysical means. 


Child Psychological Abuse, Confirmed 
995.51 (T74.32XA) Initial encounter 
995.51 (T74.32XD) Subsequent encounter 


Child Psychological Abuse, Suspected 
995.51 (T76.32XA) Initial encounter 
995.51 (T76.32XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Child Psychological Abuse 


V61.21 (Z69.010) Encounter for mental health services for victim of child psychological 
abuse by parent 


V61.21 (Z69.020) Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child 
psychological abuse 


V15.42 (Z62.811) Personal history (past history) of psychological abuse in childhood 


V61.22 (Z69.011) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child 
psychological abuse 


V62.83 (Z69.021) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental 
child psychological abuse 


720 Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 


Adult Maltreatment and Neglect Problems 
Spouse or Partner Violence, Physical 


This category should be used when nonaccidental acts of physical force that result, or have 
reasonable potential to result, in physical harm to an intimate partner or that evoke signif- 
icant fear in the partner have occurred during the past year. Nonaccidental acts of physical 
force include shoving, slapping, hair pulling, pinching, restraining, shaking, throwing, 
biting, kicking, hitting with the fist or an object, burning, poisoning, applying force to the 
throat, cutting off the air supply, holding the head under water, and using a weapon. Acts 
for the purpose of physically protecting oneself or one’s partner are excluded. 


Spouse or Partner Violence, Physical, Confirmed 
995.81 (T74.11XA) Initial encounter 
995.81 (T74.11XD) Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or Partner Violence, Physical, Suspected 
995.81 (T76.11XA) Initial encounter 
995.81 (T76.11XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Spouse or Partner Violence, Physical 


V61.11 (Z69.11) | Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner 
violence, physical 


V15.41 (Z91.410) Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, physical 


V61.12 (Z69.12) | Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or 
partner violence, physical 


Spouse or Partner Violence, Sexual 


This category should be used when forced or coerced sexual acts with an intimate partner 
have occurred during the past year. Sexual violence may involve the use of physical force 
or psychological coercion to compel the partner to engage in a sexual act against his or her 
will, whether or not the act is completed. Also included in this category are sexual acts 
with an intimate partner who is unable to consent. 


Spouse or Partner Violence, Sexual, Confirmed 
995.83 (T74.21XA) Initial encounter 
995.83 (T74.21XD) Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or Partner Violence, Sexual, Suspected 
995.83 (T76.21XA) Initial encounter 
995.83 (T76.21XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Spouse or Partner Violence, Sexual 


V61.11 (Z69.81) | Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner 
violence, sexual 


V15.41 (Z91.410) Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, sexual 


V61.12 (Z69.12) | Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or 
partner violence, sexual 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 721 


Spouse or Partner Neglect 


Partner neglect is any egregious act or omission in the past year by one partner that de- 
prives a dependent partner of basic needs and thereby results, or has reasonable potential 
to result, in physical or psychological harm to the dependent partner. This category is used 
in the context of relationships in which one partner is extremely dependent on the other 
partner for care or for assistance in navigating ordinary daily activities—for example, a 
partner who is incapable of self-care owing to substantial physical, psychological /intel- 
lectual, or cultural limitations (e.g., inability to communicate with others and manage ev- 
eryday activities due to living in a foreign culture). 


Spouse or Partner Neglect, Confirmed 
995.85 (T74.01XA) Initial encounter 
995.85 (T74.01XD) Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or Partner Neglect, Suspected 
995.85 (T76.01XA) Initial encounter 
995.85 (T76.01XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Spouse or Partner Neglect 

V61.11 (Z69.11) | Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner 
neglect 

V15.42 (Z91.412) Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner neglect 


V61.12 (Z69.12) | Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or 
partner neglect 


Spouse or Partner Abuse, Psychological 


Partner psychological abuse encompasses nonaccidental verbal or symbolic acts by one 
partner that result, or have reasonable potential to result, in significant harm to the other 
partner. This category should be used when such psychological abuse has occurred during 
the past year. Acts of psychological abuse include berating or humiliating the victim; inter- 
rogating the victim; restricting the victim’s ability to come and go freely; obstructing the vic- 
tim’s access to assistance (e.g., law enforcement; legal, protective, or medical resources); 
threatening the victim with physical harm or sexual assault; harming, or threatening to 
harm, people or things that the victim cares about; unwarranted restriction of the victim’s ac- 
cess to or use of economic resources; isolating the victim from family, friends, or social sup- 
port resources; stalking the victim; and trying to make the victim think that he or she is crazy. 


Spouse or Partner Abuse, Psychological, Confirmed 
995.82 (T74.31XA) Initial encounter 
995.82 (T74.31XD) Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or Partner Abuse, Psychological, Suspected 
995.82 (T76.31XA) Initial encounter 
995.82 (T76.31XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Spouse or Partner Abuse, Psychological 


V61.11 (Z69.11) | Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner 
psychological abuse 


722 Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 


V15.42 (291.411) Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner psychological abuse 

V61.12 (Z69.12) | Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or part- 
ner psychological abuse 

Adult Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner 


These categories should be used when an adult has been abused by another adult who is 
not an intimate partner. Such maltreatment may involve acts of physical, sexual, or emo- 
tional abuse. Examples of adult abuse include nonaccidental acts of physical force (e.g., 
pushing /shoving, scratching, slapping, throwing something that could hurt, punching, 
biting) that have resulted—or have reasonable potential to result—in physical harm or 
have caused significant fear; forced or coerced sexual acts; and verbal or symbolic acts 
with the potential to cause psychological harm (e.g., berating or humiliating the person; 
interrogating the person; restricting the person’s ability to come and go freely; obstructing 
the person’s access to assistance; threatening the person; harming or threatening to harm 
people or things that the person cares about; restricting the person’s access to or use of eco- 
nomic resources; isolating the person from family, friends, or social support resources; 
stalking the person; trying to make the person think that he or she is crazy). Acts for the 
purpose of physically protecting oneself or the other person are excluded. 


Adult Physical Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Confirmed 
995.81 (T74.11XA) Initial encounter 
995.81 (T74.11XD) Subsequent encounter 


Adult Physical Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Suspected 
995.81 (T76.11XA) Initial encounter 
995.81 (T76.11XD) Subsequent encounter 


Adult Sexual Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Confirmed 
995.83 (T74.21XA) Initial encounter 
995.83 (T74.21XD) Subsequent encounter 


Adult Sexual Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Suspected 
995.83 (T76.21XA) Initial encounter 
995.83 (T76.21XD) Subsequent encounter 


Adult Psychological Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Confirmed 
995.82 (T74.31XA) Initial encounter 
995.82 (T74.31XD) Subsequent encounter 


Adult Psychological Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner, Suspected 
995.82 (T76.31XA) Initial encounter 
995.82 (T76.31XD) Subsequent encounter 


Other Circumstances Related to Adult Abuse by Nonspouse or Nonpartner 


V65.49 (Z69.81) |= Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonspousal or non- 
partner adult abuse 


V62.83 (Z69.82) Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonspousal or 
nonpartner adult abuse 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 723 


Educational and Occupational Problems 


Educational Problems 


V62.3 (Z55.9) Academic or Educational Problem 

This category should be used when an academic or educational problem is the focus of 
clinical attention or has an impact on the individual’s diagnosis, treatment, or prognosis. 
Problems to be considered include illiteracy or low-level literacy; lack of access to school- 
ing owing to unavailability or unattainability; problems with academic performance (e.g., 
failing school examinations, receiving failing marks or grades) or underachievement (be- 
low what would be expected given the individual’s intellectual capacity); discord with 
teachers, school staff, or other students; and any other problems related to education and/ 
or literacy. 


Occupational Problems 


V62.21 (Z56.82) Problem Related to Current Military Deployment Status 

This category should be used when an occupational problem directly related to an indi- 
vidual’s military deployment status is the focus of clinical attention or has an impact on the 
individual's diagnosis, treatment, or prognosis. Psychological reactions to deployment are 
not included in this category; such reactions would be better captured as an adjustment 
disorder or another mental disorder. 


V62.29 (Z56.9) Other Problem Related to Employment 

This category should be used when an occupational problem is the focus of clinical atten- 
tion or has an impact on the individual’s treatment or prognosis. Areas to be considered 
include problems with employment or in the work environment, including unemploy- 
ment; recent change of job; threat of job loss; job dissatisfaction; stressful work schedule; 
uncertainty about career choices; sexual harassment on the job; other discord with boss, 
supervisor, co-workers, or others in the work environment; uncongenial or hostile work 
environments; other psychosocial stressors related to work; and any other problems re- 
lated to employment and/or occupation. 


Housing and Economic Problems 


Housing Problems 


V60.0 (Z59.0) Homelessness 

This category should be used when lack of a regular dwelling or living quarters has an im- 
pact on an individual’s treatment or prognosis. An individual is considered to be homeless 
if his or her primary nighttime residence is a homeless shelter, a warming shelter, a do- 
mestic violence shelter, a public space (e.g., tunnel, transportation station, mall), a build- 
ing not intended for residential use (e.g., abandoned structure, unused factory), a 
cardboard box or cave, or some other ad hoc housing situation. 


V60.1 (259.1) Inadequate Housing 

This category should be used when lack of adequate housing has an impact on an individ- 
ual’s treatment or prognosis. Examples of inadequate housing conditions include lack of 
heat (in cold temperatures) or electricity, infestation by insects or rodents, inadequate 
plumbing and toilet facilities, overcrowding, lack of adequate sleeping space, and exces- 
sive noise. It is important to consider cultural norms before assigning this category. 


V60.89 (Z59.2) Discord With Neighbor, Lodger, or Landlord 
This category should be used when discord with neighbors, lodgers, or a landlord is a fo- 
cus of clinical attention or has an impact on the individual's treatment or prognosis. 


724 Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 


V60.6 (259.3) Problem Related to Living in a Residential Institution 

This category should be used when a problem (or problems) related to living in a residen- 
tial institution is a focus of clinical attention or has an impact on the individual’s treatment 
or prognosis. Psychological reactions to a change in living situation are not included in this 
category; such reactions would be better captured as an adjustment disorder. 


Economic Problems 


V60.2 (259.4) Lack of Adequate Food or Safe Drinking Water 
V60.2 (259.5) Extreme Poverty 
V60.2 (259.6) Low Income 


V60.2 (259.7) Insufficient Social Insurance or Welfare Support 

This category should be used for individuals who meet eligibility criteria for social or wel- 
fare support but are not receiving such support, who receive support that is insufficient to 
address their needs, or who otherwise lack access to needed insurance or support pro- 
grams. Examples include inability to qualify for welfare support owing to lack of proper 
documentation or evidence of address, inability to obtain adequate health insurance be- 
cause of age or a preexisting condition, and denial of support owing to excessively strin- 
gent income or other requirements. 


V60.9 (Z59.9) Unspecified Housing or Economic Problem 
This category should be used when there is a problem related to housing or economic cir- 
cumstances other than as specified above. 


Other Problems Related to the Social Environment 


V62.89 (Z60.0) Phase of Life Problem 

This category should be used when a problem adjusting to a life-cycle transition (a partic- 
ular developmental phase) is the focus of clinical attention or has an impact on the indi- 
vidual’s treatment or prognosis. Examples of such transitions include entering or 
completing school, leaving parental control, getting married, starting a new career, be- 
coming a parent, adjusting to an “empty nest” after children leave home, and retiring. 


V60.3 (Z60.2) Problem Related to Living Alone 

This category should be used when a problem associated with living alone is the focus of 
clinical attention or has an impact on the individual's treatment or prognosis. Examples of 
such problems include chronic feelings of loneliness, isolation, and lack of structure in car- 
rying out activities of daily living (e.g., irregular meal and sleep schedules, inconsistent 
performance of home maintenance chores). 


V62.4 (Z60.3) Acculturation Difficulty 

This category should be used when difficulty in adjusting to a new culture (e.g., following 
migration) is the focus of clinical attention or has an impact on the individual’s treatment 
or prognosis. 


V62.4 (260.4) Social Exclusion or Rejection 

This category should be used when there is an imbalance of social power such that there is 
recurrent social exclusion or rejection by others. Examples of social rejection include bul- 
lying, teasing, and intimidation by others; being targeted by others for verbal abuse and 
humiliation; and being purposefully excluded from the activities of peers, workmates, or 
others in one’s social environment. 


V62.4 (260.5) Target of (Perceived) Adverse Discrimination or Persecution 
This category should be used when there is perceived or experienced discrimination 
against or persecution of the individual based on his or her membership (or perceived 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 725 


membership) in a specific category. Typically, such categories include gender or gender 
identity, race, ethnicity, religion, sexual orientation, country of origin, political beliefs, dis- 
ability status, caste, social status, weight, and physical appearance. 


V62.9 (Z60.9) Unspecified Problem Related to Social Environment 
This category should be used when there is a problem related to the individual's social en- 
vironment other than as specified above. 


Problems Related to Crime or Interaction 
With the Legal System 


V62.89 (Z65.4) Victim of Crime 


V62.5 (Z65.0) Conviction in Civil or Criminal Proceedings Without Imprisonment 
V62.5 (Z65.1) Imprisonment or Other Incarceration 

V62.5 (Z65.2) Problems Related to Release From Prison 

V62.5 (265.3) Problems Related to Other Legal Circumstances 


Other Health Service Encounters for 
Counseling and Medical Advice 


V65.49 (Z70.9) Sex Counseling 

This category should be used when the individual seeks counseling related to sex educa- 
tion, sexual behavior, sexual orientation, sexual attitudes (embarrassment, timidity), oth- 
ers’ sexual behavior or orientation (e.g., spouse, partner, child), sexual enjoyment, or any 
other sex-related issue. 


V65.40 (Z71.9) Other Counseling or Consultation 

This category should be used when counseling is provided or advice/consultation is 
sought for a problem that is not specified above or elsewhere in this chapter. Examples in- 
clude spiritual or religious counseling, dietary counseling, and counseling on nicotine use. 


Problems Related to Other Psychosocial, Personal, 
and Environmental Circumstances 


V62.89 (Z65.8) Religious or Spiritual Problem 

This category can be used when the focus of clinical attention is a religious or spiritual 
problem. Examples include distressing experiences that involve loss or questioning of 
faith, problems associated with conversion to a new faith, or questioning of spiritual val- 
ues that may not necessarily be related to an organized church or religious institution. 


V61.7 (Z64.0) Problems Related to Unwanted Pregnancy 
V61.5 (Z64.1) Problems Related to Multiparity 


V62.89 (Z64.4) Discord With Social Service Provider, Including Probation Officer, 
Case Manager, or Social Services Worker 


V62.89 (Z65.4) Victim of Terrorism or Torture 
V62.22 (Z65.5) Exposure to Disaster, War, or Other Hostilities 
V62.89 (Z65.8) Other Problem Related to Psychosocial Circumstances 


V62.9 (Z65.9) Unspecified Problem Related to Unspecified Psychosocial Circum- 
stances 


726 Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 


Other Circumstances of Personal History 


V15.49 (Z91.49) Other Personal History of Psychological Trauma 
V15.59 (291.5) Personal History of Self-Harm 

V62.22 (Z91.82) Personal History of Military Deployment 
V15.89 (Z91.89) | Other Personal Risk Factors 


V69.9 (Z72.9) Problem Related to Lifestyle 

This category should be used when a lifestyle problem is a specific focus of treatment or di- 
rectly affects the course, prognosis, or treatment of a mental or other medical disorder. Ex- 
amples of lifestyle problems include lack of physical exercise, inappropriate diet, high-risk 
sexual behavior, and poor sleep hygiene. A problem that is attributable to a symptom of a 
mental disorder should not be coded unless that problem is a specific focus of treatment or 
directly affects the course, prognosis, or treatment of the individual. In such cases, both the 
mental disorder and the lifestyle problem should be coded. 


V71.01 (Z72.811) Adult Antisocial Behavior 

This category can be used when the focus of clinical attention is adult antisocial behavior 
that is not due to a mental disorder (e.g., conduct disorder, antisocial personality disor- 
der). Examples include the behavior of some professional thieves, racketeers, or dealers in 
illegal substances. 


V71.02 (Z72.810) Child or Adolescent Antisocial Behavior 

This category can be used when the focus of clinical attention is antisocial behavior in a 
child or adolescent that is not due to a mental disorder (e.g., intermittent explosive disor- 
der, conduct disorder). Examples include isolated antisocial acts by children or adoles- 
cents (not a pattern of antisocial behavior). 


Problems Related to Access to Medical 
and Other Health Care 


V63.9 (Z75.3) Unavailability or Inaccessibility of Health Care Facilities 
V63.8 (275.4) Unavailability or Inaccessibility of Other Helping Agencies 


Nonadherence to Medical Treatment 


V15.81 (Z91.19) Nonadherence to Medical Treatment 

This category can be used when the focus of clinical attention is nonadherence to an im- 
portant aspect of treatment for a mental disorder or another medical condition. Reasons 
for such nonadherence may include discomfort resulting from treatment (e.g., medication 
side effects), expense of treatment, personal value judgments or religious or cultural be- 
liefs about the proposed treatment, age-related debility, and the presence of a mental dis- 
order (e.g., schizophrenia, personality disorder). This category should be used only when 
the problem is sufficiently severe to warrant independent clinical attention and does not 
meet diagnostic criteria for psychological factors affecting other medical conditions. 


278.00 (E66.9) Overweight or Obesity 
This category may be used when overweight or obesity is a focus of clinical attention. 


V65.2 (Z76.5) Malingering 

The essential feature of malingering is the intentional production of false or grossly exag- 
gerated physical or psychological symptoms, motivated by external incentives such as 
avoiding military duty, avoiding work, obtaining financial compensation, evading crimi- 
nal prosecution, or obtaining drugs. Under some circumstances, malingering may repre- 


Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention 727 


sent adaptive behavior—for example, feigning illness while a captive of the enemy during 
wartime. Malingering should be strongly suspected if any combination of the following is 
noted: 


1. Medicolegal context of presentation (e.g., the individual is referred by an attorney to 
the clinician for examination, or the individual self-refers while litigation or criminal 
charges are pending). 

2. Marked discrepancy between the individual’s claimed stress or disability and the ob- 
jective findings and observations. 

3. Lack of cooperation during the diagnostic evaluation and in complying with the pre- 
scribed treatment regimen. 

4. The presence of antisocial personality disorder. 


Malingering differs from factitious disorder in that the motivation for the symptom 
production in malingering is an external incentive, whereas in factitious disorder external 
incentives are absent. Malingering is differentiated from conversion disorder and somatic 
symptom-related mental disorders by the intentional production of symptoms and by the 
obvious external incentives associated with it. Definite evidence of feigning (such as clear 
evidence that loss of function is present during the examination but not at home) would 
suggest a diagnosis of factitious disorder if the individual’s apparent aim is to assume the 
sick role, or malingering if it is to obtain an incentive, such as money. 


V40.31 (Z91.83) Wandering Associated With a Mental Disorder 

This category is used for individuals with a mental disorder whose desire to walk about 
leads to significant clinical management or safety concerns. For example, individuals with 
major neurocognitive or neurodevelopmental disorders may experience a restless urge to 
wander that places them at risk for falls and causes them to leave supervised settings with- 
out needed accompaniment. This category excludes individuals whose intent is to escape 
an unwanted housing situation (e.g., children who are running away from home, patients 
who no longer wish to remain in the hospital) or those who walk or pace as a result of med- 
ication-induced akathisia. 


Coding note: First code associated mental disorder (e.g., major neurocognitive disor- 
der, autism spectrum disorder), then code V40.31 (Z91.83) wandering associated with 
[specific mental disorder]. 


V62.89 (R41.83) Borderline Intellectual Functioning 

This category can be used when an individual’s borderline intellectual functioning is the fo- 
cus of clinical attention or has an impact on the individual’s treatment or prognosis. Differ- 
entiating borderline intellectual functioning and mild intellectual disability (intellectual 
developmental disorder) requires careful assessment of intellectual and adaptive functions 
and their discrepancies, particularly in the presence of co-occurring mental disorders that 
may affect patient compliance with standardized testing procedures (e.g., schizophrenia or 
attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder with severe impulsivity). 


This page intentionally left blank 


SECTION Ill 


Emerging Measures and Models 


Assessment MeasureS ........-..-- 000 e cece eee eee eee eee 733 
Cross-Cutting Symptom Measures ...........000 cee eee ee eee 734 
DSM-5 Self-Rated Level 1 Cross-Cutting 
Symptom Measure—Adult......... 2.00 eee eee 738 
Parent/Guardian-Rated DSM-5 Level 1 Cross-Cutting 
Symptom Measure—Child Age 6-17 .............000 0 eee 740 
Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom Severity ...... 742 
World Health Organization Disability Assessment Schedule 2.0 
(WHODAS 2:0) oc acele eictnsh gS acest drier ak AMS tne N a eS aca ae real as 745 
Cultural Formulation. ........... 0.0000 749 
Cultural Formulation Interview (CFl)...........00.-0 cece eee eee 750 
Cultural Formulation Interview (CFl)—Informant Version .......... 755 
Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders...............- 761 
Conditions for Further Study .................0000 ee eee eee eee 783 
Attenuated Psychosis Syndrome..............-2.--.2+2+2+-2525. 783 
Depressive Episodes With Short-Duration Hypomania ........... 786 
Persistent Complex Bereavement Disorder .............0000005 789 
Caffeine Use Disorder............00 cee eee eee eee 792 
Internet Gaming Disorder .............---00-0 eee eee eee 795 
Neurobehavioral Disorder Associated With 
Prenatal Alcohol Exposure ........-0000 eee eee eee eee eee 798 
Suicidal Behavior Disorder...........-0- 0000 ee ee eee eee eee 801 


Nonsuicidal Self-Injury ............ 0.0020 e eee eee 803 


This page intentionally left blank 


ThiS Section contains tools and techniques to enhance the clinical deci- 
sion-making process, understand the cultural context of mental disorders, and 
recognize emerging diagnoses for further study. It provides strategies to en- 
hance clinical practice and new criteria to stimulate future research, represent- 
ing a dynamic DSM-5 that will evolve with advances in the field. 

Among the tools in Section Ill is a Level 1 cross-cutting self/informant-rated 
measure that serves as a review of systems across mental disorders. A clini- 
cian-rated severity scale for schizophrenia and other psychotic disorders also 
is provided, as well as the World Health Organization Disability Assessment 
Schedule, Version 2 (WHODAS 2.0). Level 2 severity measures are available 
online (www.psychiatry.org/dsm5) and may be used to explore significant re- 
sponses to the Level 1 screen. A comprehensive review of the cultural context 
of mental disorders, and the Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI) for clinical use, 
are provided. 

Proposed disorders for future study are provided, which include a new 
model for the diagnosis of personality disorders as an alternative to the estab- 
lished diagnostic criteria; the proposed model incorporates impairments in per- 
sonality functioning as well as pathological personality traits. Also included are 
new conditions that are the focus of active research, such as attenuated psy- 
chosis syndrome and nonsuicidal self-injury. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Assessment 
Measures 


A Qg rowi Ng body of scientific evidence favors dimensional concepts in the diagnosis 
of mental disorders. The limitations of a categorical approach to diagnosis include the fail- 
ure to find zones of rarity between diagnoses (i.e., delineation of mental disorders from one 
another by natural boundaries), the need for intermediate categories like schizoaffective dis- 
order, high rates of comorbidity, frequent not-otherwise-specified (NOS) diagnoses, relative 
lack of utility in furthering the identification of unique antecedent validators for most men- 
tal disorders, and lack of treatment specificity for the various diagnostic categories. 

From both clinical and research perspectives, there is a need for a more dimensional 
approach that can be combined with DSM’s set of categorical diagnoses. Such an approach 
incorporates variations of features within an individual (e.g., differential severity of indi- 
vidual symptoms both within and outside of a disorder’s diagnostic criteria as measured 
by intensity, duration, or number of symptoms, along with other features such as type and 
severity of disabilities) rather than relying on a simple yes-or-no approach. For diagnoses 
for which all symptoms are needed for a diagnosis (a monothetic criteria set), different se- 
verity levels of the constituent symptoms may be noted. If a threshold endorsement of 
multiple symptoms is needed, such as at least five of nine symptoms for major depressive 
disorder (a polythetic criteria set), both severity levels and different combinations of the 
criteria may identify more homogeneous diagnostic groups. 

A dimensional approach depending primarily on an individual's subjective reports of 
symptom experiences along with the clinician’s interpretation is consistent with current 
diagnostic practice. It is expected that as our understanding of basic disease mechanisms 
based on pathophysiology, neurocircuitry, gene-environment interactions, and laboratory 
tests increases, approaches that integrate both objective and subjective patient data will be 
developed to supplement and enhance the accuracy of the diagnostic process. 

Cross-cutting symptom measures modeled on general medicine’s review of systems can 
serve as an approach for reviewing critical psychopathological domains. The general med- 
ical review of systems is crucial to detecting subtle changes in different organ systems that 
can facilitate diagnosis and treatment. A similar review of various mental functions can 
aid in a more comprehensive mental status assessment by drawing attention to symptoms 
that may not fit neatly into the diagnostic criteria suggested by the individual’s presenting 
symptoms, but may nonetheless be important to the individual’s care. The cross-cutting 
measures have two levels: Level 1 questions are a brief survey of 13 symptom domains for 
adult patients and 12 domains for child and adolescent patients. Level 2 questions provide 
a more in-depth assessment of certain domains. These measures were developed to be 
administered both at initial interview and over time to track the patient’s symptom status 
and response to treatment. 

Severity measures are disorder-specific, corresponding closely to the criteria that consti- 
tute the disorder definition. They may be administered to individuals who have received 
a diagnosis or who have a clinically significant syndrome that falls short of meeting full 
criteria for a diagnosis. Some of the assessments are self-completed by the individual, 
while others require a clinician to complete. As with the cross-cutting symptom measures, 
these measures were developed to be administered both at initial interview and over time 
to track the severity of the individual’s disorder and response to treatment. 


733 


734 Assessment Measures 


The World Health Organization Disability Assessment Schedule, Version 2.0 (WHODAS 2.0) 
was developed to assess a patient’s ability to perform activities in six areas: understanding 
and communicating; getting around; self-care; getting along with people; life activities 
(e.g., household, work/school); and participation in society. The scale is self-administered 
and was developed to be used in patients with any medical disorder. It corresponds to 
concepts contained in the WHO International Classification of Functioning, Disability 
and Health. This assessment can also be used over time to track changes in a patient’s dis- 
abilities. 

This chapter focuses on the DSM-5 Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure (adult 
self-rated and parent/guardian versions); the Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis 
Symptom Severity; and the WHODAS 2.0. Clinician instructions, scoring information, 
and interpretation guidelines are included for each. These measures and additional 
dimensional assessments, including those for diagnostic severity, can be found online at 
www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 


Cross-Cutting Symptom Measures 
Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure 


The DSM-5 Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure is a patient- or informant-rated mea- 
sure that assesses mental health domains that are important across psychiatric diagnoses. 
It is intended to help clinicians identify additional areas of inquiry that may have signifi- 
cant impact on the individual’s treatment and prognosis. In addition, the measure may be 
used to track changes in the individual’s symptom presentation over time. 

The adult version of the measure consists of 23 questions that assess 13 psychiatric do- 
mains, including depression, anger, mania, anxiety, somatic symptoms, suicidal ideation, 
psychosis, sleep problems, memory, repetitive thoughts and behaviors, dissociation, per- 
sonality functioning, and substance use (Table 1). Each domain consists of one to three 
questions. Each item inquires about how much (or how often) the individual has been 
bothered by the specific symptom during the past 2 weeks. If the individual is of impaired 
capacity and unable to complete the form (e.g., an individual with dementia), a knowl- 
edgeable adult informant may complete this measure. The measure was found to be clin- 
ically useful and to have good reliability in the DSM-5 field trials that were conducted in 
adult clinical samples across the United States and in Canada. 

The parent/guardian-rated version of the measure (for children ages 6-17) consists of 
25 questions that assess 12 psychiatric domains, including depression, anger, irritability, 
mania, anxiety, somatic symptoms, inattention, suicidal ideation/attempt, psychosis, 
sleep disturbance, repetitive thoughts and behaviors, and substance use (Table 2). Each 
item asks the parent or guardian to rate how much (or how often) his or her child has been 
bothered by the specific psychiatric symptom during the past 2 weeks. The measure was 
also found to be clinically useful and to have good reliability in the DSM-5 field trials that 
were conducted in pediatric clinical samples across the United States. For children ages 
11-17, along with the parent/guardian rating of the child’s symptoms, the clinician may 
consider having the child complete the child-rated version of the measure. The child-rated 
version of the measure can be found online at www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 


Scoring and interpretation. On the adult self-rated version of the measure, each item is 
rated on a 5-point scale (O=none or not at all; 1=slight or rare, less than a day or two; 2=mild 
or several days; 3=moderate or more than half the days; and 4=severe or nearly every day). 
The score on each item within a domain should be reviewed. However, a rating of mild (ie., 
2) or greater on any item within a domain, except for substance use, suicidal ideation, and 
psychosis, may serve as a guide for additional inquiry and follow-up to determine if a more 
detailed assessment is necessary, which may include the Level 2 cross-cutting symptom as- 
sessment for the domain (see Table 1). For substance use, suicidal ideation, and psychosis, a 


Assessment Measures 735 


TABLE 1 Adult DSM-5 Self-Rated Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure: 
13 domains, thresholds for further inquiry, and associated DSM-5 
Level 2 measures 


Threshold to guide DSM-5 Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom 


Domain Domain name further inquiry Measure® 
I. Depression Mild or greater Level 2—Depression—Adult (PROMIS 
Emotional Distress—Short Form) 
I. Anger Mild or greater Level 2—Anger—Adult (PROMIS Emo- 
tional Distress—Anger—Short Form) 
Il. Mania Mild or greater Level 2—Mania—Adult (Altman Self-Rating 
Mania Scale [ASRM]) 
IV. Anxiety Mild or greater Level 2—Anxiety—Adult (PROMIS 
Emotional Distress—Anxiety—Short 
Form) 
V. Somatic symptoms Mild or greater Level 2—Somatic Symptom—Adult (Patient 


Health Questionnaire-15 
[PHQ-15] Somatic Symptom Severity 


Scale) 
VI. Suicidal ideation Slight or greater | None 
VIL. Psychosis Slight or greater None 
VII. Sleep problems Mild or greater Level 2—Sleep Disturbance—Adult 
(PROMIS Sleep Disturbance—Short Form) 
Ix. Memory Mild or greater None 
X. Repetitive thoughts Mild or greater Level 2—Repetitive Thoughts and 
and behaviors Behaviors—Adult (Florida Obsessive- 
Compulsive Inventory [FOCI] Severity 
Scale) 
XI. Dissociation Mild or greater None 
XII. Personality Mild or greater None 
functioning 
XI. Substance use Slight or greater Level 2—Substance Use—Adult (adapted 


from the NIDA-Modified ASSIST) 


Note. NIDA=National Institute on Drug Abuse. 
“Available at www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 


rating of slight (i.e., 1) or greater on any item within the domain may serve as a guide for ad- 
ditional inquiry and follow-up to determine if a more detailed assessment is needed. As 
such, indicate the highest score within a domain in the “Highest domain score” column. 
Table 1 outlines threshold scores that may guide further inquiry for the remaining domains. 

On the parent/guardian-rated version of the measure (for children ages 6-17), 19 of the 25 
items are each rated on a 5-point scale (O=none or not at all; 1=slight or rare, less than a day or 
two; 2=mild or several days; 3=moderate or more than half the days; and 4=severe or nearly 
every day). The suicidal ideation, suicide attempt, and substance abuse items are each rated 
ona “Yes, No, or Don’t Know” scale. The score on each item within a domain should be re- 
viewed. However, with the exception of inattention and psychosis, a rating of mild (ie., 2) or 
greater on any item within a domain that is scored on the 5-point scale may serve as a guide 
for additional inquiry and follow-up to determine if a more detailed assessment is necessary, 
which may include the Level 2 cross-cutting symptom assessment for the domain (see 
Table 2). For inattention or psychosis, a rating of slight or greater (i.e., 1 or greater) may be 


736 Assessment Measures 


TABLE 2 Parent/guardian-rated DSM-5 Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure 
for child age 6-17: 12 domains, thresholds for further inquiry, and 
associated Level 2 measures 


Threshold to guide DSM-5 Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom 
Domain Domain name further inquiry Measure# 


I. Somatic symptoms Mild or greater Level 2—Somatic Symptoms—Parent/Guard- 

ian of Child Age 6-17 (Patient Health 
Questionnaire—15 Somatic Symptom Sever- 
ity Scale [PHQ-15]) 

Il. Sleep problems Mild or greater Level 2—Sleep Disturbance—Parent/Guard- 
ian of Child Age 6-17 (PROMIS Sleep 
Disturbance—Short Form) 

Il. Inattention Slight or greater Level 2—Inattention—Parent/Guardian of 


Child Age 6-17 (Swanson, Nolan, and Pel- 
ham, Version IV [SNAP-IV]) 


IV. Depression Mild or greater Level 2—Depression—Parent/Guardian of 
Child Age 6-17 (PROMIS Emotional Dis- 
tress—Depression—Parent Item Bank) 

V. Anger Mild or greater Level 2—Anger—Parent/Guardian of Child 
(PROMIS Calibrated Anger Measure—Parent) 
VI. Irritability Mild or greater Level 2—Irritability—Parent /Guardian of 
Child (Affective Reactivity Index [ARI]) 
VIL. Mania Mild or greater Level 2—Mania—Parent/Guardian of Child 
Age 6-17 (Altman Self-Rating Mania Scale 
[ASRM]) 
VU. Anxiety Mild or greater Level 2—Anxiety—Parent/ Guardian of Child 


Age 6-17 (PROMIS Emotional Distress— 
Anxiety—Parent Item Bank) 


IX. Psychosis Slight or greater None 


x. Repetitive thoughts Mild or greater None 
and behaviors 


XI. Substance use Yes Level 2—Substance Use—Parent/ Guardian of 
Child Age 6-17 (adapted from the NIDA- 
modified ASSIST) 

Don’t Know NIDA-modified ASSIST (adapted)— 
Child-Rated (age 11-17 years) 
XI. Suicidal ideation/ Yes None 


suicide attempts 
Don’t Know None 


Note. NIDA=National Institute on Drug Abuse. 
“Available at www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 


used as an indicator for additional inquiry. A parent or guardian’s rating of “Don’t Know” on 
the suicidal ideation, suicide attempt, and any of the substance use items, especially for chil- 
dren ages 11-17 years, may result in additional probing of the issues with the child, including 
using the child-rated Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure for the relevant domain. Be- 
cause additional inquiry is made on the basis of the highest score on any item within a do- 
main, clinicians should indicate that score in the “Highest Domain Score” column. Table 2 
outlines threshold scores that may guide further inquiry for the remaining domains. 


Assessment Measures 737 


Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measures 


Any threshold scores on the Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure (as noted in Tables 
1 and 2 and described in “Scoring and Interpretation” indicate a possible need for detailed 
clinical inquiry. Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measures provide one method of obtain- 
ing more in-depth information on potentially significant symptoms to inform diagnosis, 
treatment planning, and follow-up. They are available online at www.psychiatry.org / 
dsm5. Tables 1 and 2 outline each Level 1 domain and identify the domains for which 
DSM-5 Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measures are available for more detailed assess- 
ments. Adult and pediatric (parent and child) versions are available online for most Level 
1 symptom domains at www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 


Frequency of Use of the Cross-Cutting 
Symptom Measures 


To track change in the individual’s symptom presentation over time, the Level 1 and rel- 
evant Level 2 cross-cutting symptom measures may be completed at regular intervals as 
clinically indicated, depending on the stability of the individual’s symptoms and treat- 
ment status. For individuals with impaired capacity and for children ages 6-17 years, it is 
preferable for the measures to be completed at follow-up appointments by the same 
knowledgeable informant and by the same parent or guardian. Consistently high scores 
on a particular domain may indicate significant and problematic symptoms for the indi- 
vidual that might warrant further assessment, treatment, and follow-up. Clinical judg- 
ment should guide decision making. 


DSM-5 Self-Rated Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure—Adult 


Name: Age: Sex: [ ] Male [ ] Female Date: 


If the measure is being completed by an informant, what is your relationship with the individual?: 


In a typical week, approximately how much time do you spend with the individual? hours/week 


Instructions: The questions below ask about things that might have bothered you. For each question, circle the number that best describes how much (or how 
often) you have been bothered by each problem during the past TWO (2) WEEKS. 


Slight Mild Moderate Severe Highest 
During the past TWO (2) WEEKS, how much (or how often) Rare, lessthan | Several More than Nearly Domain Score 


have you been bothered by the following problems? a day or two half the days | every day (clinician) 


.| Feeling more irritated, grouchy, angry than usual? alae 


Il. [4 Sleeping less than usual, but still have alot of energy? | less than usual, but still have a lot of energy? ee 
te Starting 2 more projects than usual or doing more risky eae 
than usual? 
es pez nervous, anxious, ee worried, or on edge? Es i ye | 


Ce a | Avoiding situations that make you anxious? situations that make you anxious? 


a Unexplained aches and pains (e.g., head, back, joints, abdomen, eee 
legs)? 


Feeling that your illnesses are not being taken seriously enough? Et aes) 
Thoughts of actually hurting yourself? | 0 | 


sel 


soinses|| JUeLUSSESsSV 


Problems with memory (e.g., learning new information) or with 
location (e.g., finding your way home)? 


17.| Feeling driven to perform certain behaviors or mental acts over 1 
and over again? 


Feeling detached or distant from yourself, your body, your phys- 


ical surroundings, or your memories? 


XII. Not knowing who you really are or what you want out of life? | 0 | 


20.| Not feeling close to other people or enjoying your relationships 1 
with them? 


; Drink at least 4 drinks of any kind of alcohol in a single day? es ee 
2 


2.| Smoke any cigarettes, a cigar, or pipe, or use snuff or chewing 1 2. 3 
tobacco? 


23.| Use any of the following medicines ON YOUR OWN, that is, 1 2 3 
without a doctor’s prescription, in greater amounts or longer 
than prescribed [e.g., painkillers (like Vicodin), stimulants (like 
Ritalin or Adderall), sedatives or tranquilizers (like sleeping 
pills or Valium), or drugs like marijuana, cocaine or crack, club 
drugs (like ecstasy), hallucinogens (like LSD), heroin, inhalants 
or solvents (like glue), or methamphetamine (like speed)]? 


soinses|| }UBLUSSOSSVV 


6E2 


Parent/Guardian-Rated DSM-5 Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure—Child Age 6-17 


Child’s Name: Age: Sex: [ ] Male [ ] Female Date: 


Relationship to the child: 


Instructions (to parent or guardian of child): The questions below ask about things that might have bothered your child. For each question, circle the number that 
best describes how much (or how often) your child has been bothered by each problem during the past TWO (2) WEEKS. 


Mild Moderate Severe Highest 
During the past TWO (2) WEEKS, how much (or how often) has your Rare,lessthan | Several More than Domain Score 
child... a day or two half the days | every day (clinician) 


I.| 1.) Complained of stomachaches, headaches, or other aches and 
pains? 
Said he/she was worried about his/her health or about getting 
sick? 


II.) 3.} Had problems sleeping—that is, trouble falling asleep, staying 
asleep, or waking up too early? 


III.) 4.) Had problems paying attention when he/she was in class or 
doing his/her homework or reading a book or playing a game? 


ic Seemed sad or depressed for several hours? 

Seemed mote irritated or easily annoyed than usual? 
ee S| Semetinanrowtirieremeer | Seemed angry or lost his/her pe eee arerag 
VI. 


VIL. Starting lots more projects than usual or doing more risky adie 
than usual? 


descr less than usual for him/her but still has lots of energy? a |; 8 | 
[ee] 


12.| Not been able to stop |Not been able to stop worrying? = 


13.| Said he/she couldn’t do ee he/she wanted to or should aes — 
done because they made him/her feel nervous? 


soinses|| JUsluUSSEsSsV 


IX.| 14.} Said that he/she heard voices—when there was no one there— 
speaking about him/her or telling him/her what to do or say- 
ing bad things to him/her? 


15.] Said that he/she had a vision when he/she was completely awake— 
that is, saw something or someone that no one else could see? 


.| Said that he/she had thoughts that kept coming into his/her 
mind that he/she would do something bad or that something 
bad would happen to him/her or to someone else? 


again, like whether a door was locked or whether the stove was 
turned off? 


18.| Seemed to worry a lot about things he/she touched being dirty or 
having germs or being poisoned? 


.| Said that he/she had to do things in a certain way, like counting 
or saying special things out loud, in order to keep something 
bad from happening? 


In the past TWO (2) WEEKS, has your child.. 
| 20.| Had an alcoholic | Had an alcoholic beverage (beer, wine, liquor, etc)? | (beer, wine, liquor, etc.)? 


2 ae a cigarette, a cigar, or pipe, or used snuff or ee a rece | 
ee a rece | 


Used drugs like marijuana, cocaine or crack, club drugs (like 
ecstasy), hallucinogens (like LSD), heroin, inhalants or solvents 
(like glue), or social eae (like a 


[like Vicodin], stimulants [like Ritalin or Adderall], sedatives or 
tranquilizers [like sleeping pills or Valium], or steroids)? 


24.| In the past TWO (2) WEEKS, has he/she talked about wanting to 
kill himself/herself or about wanting to commit suicide? 
2, 


| 25. Has he/she EVER tried to kill himself/herself? 


QO) Don’t Know 


QO) Don’t Know 


No QO) Don’t Know 


No QO) Don’t Know 


soinses|| }UBLUSSOSSVV 


bpd 


742 Assessment Measures 


Clinician-Rated Dimensions of 
Psychosis Symptom Severity 


As described in the chapter “Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders,” 
psychotic disorders are heterogeneous, and symptom severity can predict important as- 
pects of the illness, such as the degree of cognitive and/or neurobiological deficits. Dimen- 
sional assessments capture meaningful variation in the severity of symptoms, which may 
help with treatment planning, prognostic decision-making, and research on pathophysi- 
ological mechanisms. The Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom Severity 
provides scales for the dimensional assessment of the primary symptoms of psychosis, in- 
cluding hallucinations, delusions, disorganized speech, abnormal psychomotor behavior, 
and negative symptoms. A scale for the dimensional assessment of cognitive impairment 
is also included. Many individuals with psychotic disorders have impairments in a range 
of cognitive domains, which predict functional abilities. In addition, scales for dimensional 
assessment of depression and mania are provided, which may alert clinicians to mood pa- 
thology. The severity of mood symptoms in psychosis has prognostic value and guides 
treatment. 

The Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom Severity is an 8-item measure 
that may be completed by the clinician at the time of the clinical assessment. Each item asks 
the clinician to rate the severity of each symptom as experienced by the individual during 
the past 7 days. 


Scoring and Interpretation 


Each item on the measure is rated on a 5-point scale (0=none; 1=equivocal; 2=present, but 
mild; 3=present and moderate; and 4=present and severe) with a symptom-specific defi- 
nition of each rating level. The clinician may review all of the individual's available infor- 
mation and, based on clinical judgment, select (with checkmark) the level that most 
accurately describes the severity of the individual’s condition. The clinician then indicates 
the score for each item in the “Score” column provided. 


Frequency of Use 


To track changes in the individual’s symptom severity over time, the measure may be 
completed at regular intervals as clinically indicated, depending on the stability of the in- 
dividual’s symptoms and treatment status. Consistently high scores on a particular do- 
main may indicate significant and problematic areas for the individual that might warrant 
further assessment, treatment, and follow-up. Clinical judgment should guide decision 
making. 


Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis Symptom Severity 


Name: Age: Sex: [] Male[] Female Date: 


Instructions: Based on all the information you have on the individual and using your clinical judgment, please rate (with checkmark) the presence and severity 


of the following symptoms as experienced by the individual in the past seven (7) days. 


I. Hallucinations QO) Not present 


II. Delusions 


Q) Not present 


III. Disorganized speech 


QO) Not present 
IV. Abnormal psychomo- | 0 Not present 
tor behavior 
V. Negative symptoms QO) Not present 
(restricted emotional 
expression or avolition) 


duration not sufficient 
to be considered psy- 
chosis) 


QO) Equivocal (severity or 


duration not sufficient 
to be considered psy- 
chosis) 


OEquivocal (severity or 


duration not sufficient 
to be considered dis- 
organization) 


QO) Equivocal (severity or 


duration not sufficient 
to be considered 
abnormal psychomo- 
tor behavior) 


QO) Equivocal decrease in 


facial expressivity, 
prosody, gestures, or 
self-initiated behavior 


OEquivocal (severity or | O Present, but mild (lit- 


tle pressure to act 
upon voices, not very 
bothered by voices) 


Q Present, but mild (lit- 
tle pressure to act 
upon delusional 
beliefs, not very both- 
ered by beliefs) 


QO Present, but mild 
(some difficulty fol- 
lowing speech) 


O Present, but mild 
(occasional abnormal 
or bizarre motor 
behavior or catatonia) 


QO Present, but mild 
decrease in facial 
expressivity, pros- 
ody, gestures, or self- 
initiated behavior 


O Present and moderate 
(some pressure to 
respond to voices, or 
is somewhat bothered 
by voices) 


QO Present and moderate 
(some pressure to act 
upon beliefs, or is 
somewhat bothered 
by beliefs) 


QO) Present and moderate 
(speech often difficult 
to follow) 


O Present and moderate 
(frequent abnormal or 
bizarre motor behav- 
ior or catatonia) 


O Present and moderate 
decrease in facial 
expressivity, pros- 
ody, gestures, or self- 
initiated behavior 


O Present and severe 
(severe pressure to 
respond to voices, or 
is very bothered by 
voices) 


QO) Present and severe 
(severe pressure to act 
upon beliefs, or is very 
bothered by beliefs) 


QO) Present and severe 
(speech almost impos- 
sible to follow) 


QO Present and severe 
(abnormal or bizarre 
motor behavior or 
catatonia almost con- 
stant) 


O Present and severe 
decrease in facial 
expressivity, pros- 
ody, gestures, or self- 
initiated behavior 


soinses|| }UBLUSSOSSVV 


evl 


VI. Impaired cognition 


VII. Depression 


_ 


Note. SD=standard deviation; SES=socioeconomic status. 


QO) Not present 


QO) Not present 


Q) Equivocal (cognitive 
function not clearly 
outside the range 
expected for age or 
SES; i.e., within 0.5 SD 
of mean) 


QO Equivocal (occasion- 
ally feels sad, down, 
depressed, or hope- 
less; concerned about 
having failed some- 
one or at something 
but not preoccupied) 


OQ Equivocal (occasional 
elevated, expansive, 
or irritable mood or 
some restlessness) 


QO Present, but mild 
(some reduction in 
cognitive function; 
below expected for 
age and SES, 0.5-1 SD 
from mean) 


O Present, but mild (fre- 
quent periods of feel- 
ing very sad, down, 
moderately 
depressed, or hope- 
less; concerned about 
having failed some- 
one or at something, 
with some preoccupa- 
tion) 


QO Present, but mild (fre- 
quent periods of 
somewhat elevated, 
expansive, or irritable 
mood or restlessness) 


O Present and moderate 
(clear reduction in 
cognitive function; 
below expected for 
age and SES, 1-2 SD 
from mean) 


QO) Present and moderate 
(frequent periods of 
deep depression or 
hopelessness; preoc- 
cupation with guilt, 
having done wrong) 


QO) Present and moderate 
(frequent periods of 
extensively elevated, 
expansive, or irritable 
mood or restlessness) 


O Present and severe 
(severe reduction in 
cognitive function; 
below expected for 
age and SES, >2 SD 
from mean) 


O Present and severe 
(deeply depressed or 
hopeless daily; delu- 
sional guilt or unrea- 
sonable self-reproach 
grossly out of propor- 
tion to circumstances) 


QO Present and severe 
(daily and extensively 
elevated, expansive, 
or irritable mood or 
restlessness) 


soinses|| JUsLUSSESsSV 


Assessment Measures 745 


World Health Organization 
Disability Assessment Schedule 2.0 


The adult self-administered version of the World Health Organization Disability Assessment 
Schedule 2.0 (WHODAS 2.0) is a 36-item measure that assesses disability in adults age 18 
years and older. It assesses disability across six domains, including understanding and 
communicating, getting around, self-care, getting along with people, life activities (i.e., 
household, work, and/or school activities), and participation in society. If the adult indi- 
vidual is of impaired capacity and unable to complete the form (e.g., a patient with demen- 
tia), a knowledgeable informant may complete the proxy-administered version of the 
measure, which is available at www.psychiatry.org /dsm5. Each item on the self-administered 
version of the WHODAS 2.0 asks the individual to rate how much difficulty he or she has 
had in specific areas of functioning during the past 30 days. 


WHODAS 2.0 Scoring Instructions Provided by WHO 


WHODAS 2.0 summary scores. There are two basic options for computing the summary 
scores for the WHODAS 2.0 36-item full version. 

Simple: The scores assigned to each of the items—“none” (1), “mild” (2), “moderate” (3), 
“severe” (4), and “extreme” (5)—are summed. This method is referred to as simple scoring 
because the scores from each of the items are simply added up without recoding or collaps- 
ing of response categories; thus, there is no weighting of individual items. This approach is 
practical to use as a hand-scoring approach, and may be the method of choice in busy clin- 
ical settings or in paper-and-pencil interview situations. As a result, the simple sum of the 
scores of the items across all domains constitutes a statistic that is sufficient to describe the 
degree of functional limitations. 

Complex: The more complex method of scoring is called “item-response-theory” 
(IRT)-based scoring. It takes into account multiple levels of difficulty for each WHODAS 
2.0 item. It takes the coding for each item response as “none,” “mild,” “moderate,” “se- 
vere,” and “extreme” separately, and then uses a computer to determine the summary 
score by differentially weighting the items and the levels of severity. The computer pro- 
gram is available from the WHO Web site. The scoring has three steps: 


WM 
S 


¢ Step 1—Summing of recoded item scores within each domain. 

¢ Step 2—Summing of all six domain scores. 

¢ Step 3—Converting the summary score into a metric ranging from 0 to 100 
(where 0=no disability; 100=full disability). 


WHODAS 2.0 domain scores. WHODAS 2.0 produces domain-specific scores for six 
different functioning domains: cognition, mobility, self-care, getting along, life activities 
(household and work/school), and participation. 


WHODAS 2.0 population norms. For the population norms for IRT-based scoring of the 
WHODAS 2.0 and for the population distribution of IRT-based scores for WHODAS 2.0, 
please see www.who.int/classifications /icf/Pop_norms_distrib_IRT_scores.pdf. 


Additional Scoring and Interpretation Guidance for 
DSM-5 Users 


The clinician is asked to review the individual’s response on each item on the measure 
during the clinical interview and to indicate the self-reported score for each item in the sec- 
tion provided for “Clinician Use Only.” However, if the clinician determines that the score 
on an item should be different based on the clinical interview and other information avail- 


746 Assessment Measures 


able, he or she may indicate a corrected score in the raw item score box. Based on findings 
from the DSM-5 Field Trials in adult patient samples across six sites in the United States 
and one in Canada, DSM-5 recommends calculation and use of average scores for each domain 
and for general disability. The average scores are comparable to the WHODAS 5-point scale, 
which allows the clinician to think of the individual's disability in terms of none (1), mild 
(2), moderate (3), severe (4), or extreme (5). The average domain and general disability 
scores were found to be reliable, easy to use, and clinically useful to the clinicians in the 
DSM-5 Field Trials. The average domain score is calculated by dividing the raw domain score 
by the number of items in the domain (e.g., if all the items within the “understanding and 
communicating” domain are rated as being moderate then the average domain score 
would be 18/6=3, indicating moderate disability). The average general disability score is cal- 
culated by dividing the raw overall score by number of items in the measure (i.e., 36). The 
individual should be encouraged to complete all of the items on the WHODAS 2.0. If no re- 
sponse is given on 10 or more items of the measure (i.e., more than 25% of the 36 total 
items), calculation of the simple and average general disability scores may not be helpful. 
If 10 or more of the total items on the measure are missing but the items for some of the do- 
mains are 75%-100% complete, the simple or average domain scores may be used for those 
domains. 


Frequency of use. To track change in the individual’s level of disability over time, the 
measure may be completed at regular intervals as clinically indicated, depending on the 
stability of the individual’s symptoms and treatment status. Consistently high scores on a 
particular domain may indicate significant and problematic areas for the individual that 
might warrant further assessment and intervention. 


Assessment Measures 


Patient Name: Age: 


WHODAS 2.0 


World Health Organization Disability Assessment Schedule 2.0 
36-item version, self-administered 


Sex: UL) Male O Female Date: 


This questionnaire asks about difficulties due to health/mental health conditions. Health conditions include diseases or 
illnesses, other health problems that may be short or long lasting, injuries, mental or emotional problems, and problems 
with alcohol or drugs. Think back over the past 30 days and answer these questions thinking about how much difficulty you 
had doing the following activities. For each question, please circ 


e only one response. 


747 


Clinician Use 


Only 
Numeric scores assigned to each of the items: il 2 3 4 5 = ie One 
_ - - Gelss eles ye 
In the last 30 days, how much difficulty did you have in: = le = alas 3 
Bu ale oa 
Understanding and communicating ig Son 
& ; ‘ ‘ : Extreme or 
D1.1 |Concentrating on doing something for ten minutes?| None | Mi Moderate | Severe | oo ot do 
2 as . Ext 
D1.2 |Remembering to do important things? None | Mi Moderate | Severe reas: 
Analyzing and finding solutions to problems in day- 
[DyL 3) ¥ 18 7 B y None Mi Moderate | Severe ey 
to-day life? cannot do 
Learning a new task, for example, learning how to 30 5 
D1.4 . Mes 8 None Mi Moderate | Severe spehagiiatel 
get to a new place? cannot do 
a Fi Extreme or 
D1.5 |Generally understanding what people say? None | Mi Moderate | Severe sara 
D1.6 |Starting and maintaining a conversation? None | Mi Moderate | Severe ee 
Getting around 
R - ‘ . Extr fo) 
D2.1 |Standing for long periods, such as 30 minutes? None | Mi Moderate | Severe cae ck 
D2.2 |Standing up from sitting down? None | Mi Moderate | Severe | Extreme or 
cannot do 
A eters A Extreme or 
D2.3 |Moving around inside your home? None | Mi Moderate | Severe | —~'°™® ee 
cannot do D5 5 
D2.4 |Getting out of your home? None Mi Moderate | Severe | Extreme or 
oe cannot do 
Walking a long distance, such as a kilometer (or 
D2.5 ; B & i ( None Mi Moderate | severe || EXttem= cr 
equivalent)? cannot do 
Self-care 
5 Ext 
D3.1 |Washing your whole body? None | Mi Moderate | Severe eet 
cannot do 
D3.2 |Getting dressed? None Mi Moderate | Severe pene 
Ss 2 ee cannot do 
5 . Extreme or 20 5 
? 
D3.3 |Eating? None Mi Moderate | Severe year 
- H Ext 
D3.4 |Staying by yourself for a few days? None | Mild | Moderate} Severe | “reme OF 
cannot do 
Getting along with people 
A i A Extreme or 
D4.1 |Dealing with people you do not know? None | Mild | Moderate | Severe pene 
D4.2 |Maintaining a friendship? None Mi Moderate | Severe Extreme. or 
cannot do 
i j Extreme or 
D4.3 |Getting along with people who are close to you? None | Mi Moderate | Severe Aen Secale 
=~ cannot do 25 5 
D4.4 |Making new friends? None Mi Moderate | Severe Exiremeso, 
cannot do 
D4.5 |Sexual activities? None | Mild | Moderate | severe | "xtreme or 
ers cannot do 


748 Assessment Measures 


Clinician Use 
Only 
Numeric scores assigned to each of the items: at 2 3 4 5 ea a ae 
nee : : Seles vl Ps LY 
In the last 30 days, how much difficulty did you have in: Ssl€ 5 gles & 
Fa) “als 7) 
Life activities—Household « Boos 
E acer 7 Extreme or 
D5.1 {Taking care of your household responsibilities? None | Mild | Moderate | Severe | 7 49 
‘ % ‘ Ext 
D5.2 |Doing most important household tasks well? None | Mild | Moderate | Severe acinar 
Getting all of the household work done that you 
D5.3 8 =e y None Mild Moderate | Severe Sine 20 5 
needed to do? cannot do 
Getting your household work done as quickly as 
D5.4 By quickly None Mild Moderate | Severe Extreme of 
needed? cannot do 
Life activities—School/Work 
If you work (paid, non-paid, self-employed) or go to school, complete questions D5.5—D5.8, below. 
Otherwise, skip to D6.1. 
Because of your health condition, in the past 30 days, how much difficulty did you have in: 
D5.5 lYour day-to-day work/school? None | Mild. || Moderate | Severe | Extemecr 
cannot do 
‘ 2 . Extreme or 
D5.6 [Doing your most important work/school tasks well?| None | Mild | Moderate | Severe cannotde 
D5.7 |Getting all of the work done that you need to do? None | Mild | Moderate | Severe pale 2) 3 
Fi * - Extreme or 
D5.8 |Getting your work done as quickly as needed? None | Mild | Moderate | Severe | oo. 
Participation in society 
In the past 30 days: 
How much of a problem did you have in joining in 
community activities (for example, festivities F 
D6.1 = ( oes. pre, ; None Mild Moderate | Severe EATS 
religious, or other activities) in the same way as cannot do 
lanyone else can? 
6.2 How much of a problem did you have because of Extreme or 
“ Ibarriers or hindrances around you? None Mild Moderate | Severe | cannot do 
How much of a problem did you have living with é 
ise i a ‘a 
D6.3 |dignity because of the attitudes and actions of None | Mild | Moderate | Severe abies 
lothers? 
How much time did you spend on your health 
D6.4 ae Sony you sp y None Some | Moderate | A Lot Extreme: Of 40 5 
condition or its consequences? cannot do 
How much have you been emotionally affected b 
D6.5 ¥ 5 y y None Mild Moderate | Severe SAITO 
lyour health condition? cannot do 
How much has your health been a drain on the 
D6.6 |. " y ree Oe None Mild Moderate | Severe ExtremeOF 
financial resources of you or your family? cannot do 
How much of a problem did your family have 
D6.7 P y family None Mild | Moderate | Severe Beene ol 
because of your health problems? cannot do 
How much of a problem did you have in doin 
D6.8 L y 8 None Mild Moderate | Severe Extreme or 
things by yourself for relaxation or pleasure? cannot do 
G | Disability S Total): |i eee 
eneral Disability Score (Total) 180 5 


© World Health Organization, 2012. All rights reserved. Measuring health and disability: manual for WHO Disability 
Assessment Schedule (WHODAS 2.0), World Health Organization, 2010, Geneva. 


The World Health Organization has granted the Publisher permission for the reproduction of this instrument. This material can 
be reproduced without permission by clinicians for use with their own patients. Any other use, including electronic use, 
requires written permission from WHO. 


Cultural 
Formulation 


Understandin Qg the Cultural context of illness experience is essential for effec- 
tive diagnostic assessment and clinical management. Culture refers to systems of knowl- 
edge, concepts, rules, and practices that are learned and transmitted across generations. 
Culture includes language, religion and spirituality, family structures, life-cycle stages, 
ceremonial rituals, and customs, as well as moral and legal systems. Cultures are open, 
dynamic systems that undergo continuous change over time; in the contemporary world, 
most individuals and groups are exposed to multiple cultures, which they use to fashion 
their own identities and make sense of experience. These features of culture make it cru- 
cial not to overgeneralize cultural information or stereotype groups in terms of fixed cul- 
tural traits. 

Race is a culturally constructed category of identity that divides humanity into groups 
based on a variety of superficial physical traits attributed to some hypothetical intrinsic, 
biological characteristics. Racial categories and constructs have varied widely over history 
and across societies. The construct of race has no consistent biological definition, but it is 
socially important because it supports racial ideologies, racism, discrimination, and social 
exclusion, which can have strong negative effects on mental health. There is evidence that 
racism can exacerbate many psychiatric disorders, contributing to poor outcome, and that 
racial biases can affect diagnostic assessment. 

Ethnicity is a culturally constructed group identity used to define peoples and communi- 
ties. It may be rooted in a common history, geography, language, religion, or other shared 
characteristics of a group, which distinguish that group from others. Ethnicity may be self- 
assigned or attributed by outsiders. Increasing mobility, intermarriage, and intermixing of 
cultures has defined new mixed, multiple, or hybrid ethnic identities. 

Culture, race, and ethnicity are related to economic inequities, racism, and discrimina- 
tion that result in health disparities. Cultural, ethnic, and racial identities can be sources of 
strength and group support that enhance resilience, but they may also lead to psycholog- 
ical, interpersonal, and intergenerational conflict or difficulties in adaptation that require 
diagnostic assessment. 


Outline for Cultural Formulation 


The Outline for Cultural Formulation introduced in DSM-IV provided a framework for as- 
sessing information about cultural features of an individual’s mental health problem and 
how it relates to a social and cultural context and history. DSM-5 not only includes an up- 
dated version of the Outline but also presents an approach to assessment, using the Cul- 
tural Formulation Interview (CFI), which has been field-tested for diagnostic usefulness 
among clinicians and for acceptability among patients. 

The revised Outline for Cultural Formulation calls for systematic assessment of the fol- 
lowing categories: 


¢ Cultural identity of the individual: Describe the individual's racial, ethnic, or cultural 
reference groups that may influence his or her relationships with others, access to re- 


749 


750 Cultural Formulation 


sources, and developmental and current challenges, conflicts, or predicaments. For im- 
migrants and racial or ethnic minorities, the degree and kinds of involvement with both 
the culture of origin and the host culture or majority culture should be noted separately. 
Language abilities, preferences, and patterns of use are relevant for identifying difficul- 
ties with access to care, social integration, and the need for an interpreter. Other clini- 
cally relevant aspects of identity may include religious affiliation, socioeconomic 
background, personal and family places of birth and growing up, migrant status, and 
sexual orientation. 

¢ Cultural conceptualizations of distress: Describe the cultural constructs that influence 
how the individual experiences, understands, and communicates his or her symptoms 
or problems to others. These constructs may include cultural syndromes, idioms of dis- 
tress, and explanatory models or perceived causes. The level of severity and meaning of 
the distressing experiences should be assessed in relation to the norms of the individ- 
ual’s cultural reference groups. Assessment of coping and help-seeking patterns should 
consider the use of professional as well as traditional, alternative, or complementary 
sources of care. 

¢ Psychosocial stressors and cultural features of vulnerability and resilience: Identify 
key stressors and supports in the individual's social environment (which may include 
both local and distant events) and the role of religion, family, and other social networks 
(e.g., friends, neighbors, coworkers) in providing emotional, instrumental, and infor- 
mational support. Social stressors and social supports vary with cultural interpreta- 
tions of events, family structure, developmental tasks, and social context. Levels of 
functioning, disability, and resilience should be assessed in light of the individual’s cul- 
tural reference groups. 

¢ Cultural features of the relationship between the individual and the clinician: Iden- 
tify differences in culture, language, and social status between an individual and clini- 
cian that may cause difficulties in communication and may influence diagnosis and 
treatment. Experiences of racism and discrimination in the larger society may impede 
establishing trust and safety in the clinical diagnostic encounter. Effects may include 
problems eliciting symptoms, misunderstanding of the cultural and clinical signifi- 
cance of symptoms and behaviors, and difficulty establishing or maintaining the rap- 
port needed for an effective clinical alliance. 

¢ Overall cultural assessment: Summarize the implications of the components of the cul- 
tural formulation identified in earlier sections of the Outline for diagnosis and other 
clinically relevant issues or problems as well as appropriate management and treat- 
ment intervention. 


Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI) 


The Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI) is a set of 16 questions that clinicians may use to 
obtain information during a mental health assessment about the impact of culture on key 
aspects of an individual’s clinical presentation and care. In the CFI, culture refers to 


¢ The values, orientations, knowledge, and practices that individuals derive from mem- 
bership in diverse social groups (e.g., ethnic groups, faith communities, occupational 
groups, veterans groups). 

¢ Aspects of an individual’s background, developmental experiences, and current social 
contexts that may affect his or her perspective, such as geographical origin, migration, 
language, religion, sexual orientation, or race/ethnicity. 

e The influence of family, friends, and other community members (the individual’s social 
network) on the individual's illness experience. 


Cultural Formulation 751 


The CFI is a brief semistructured interview for systematically assessing cultural factors 
in the clinical encounter that may be used with any individual. The CFI focuses on the in- 
dividual’s experience and the social contexts of the clinical problem. The CFI follows a per- 
son-centered approach to cultural assessment by eliciting information from the individual 
about his or her own views and those of others in his or her social network. This approach 
is designed to avoid stereotyping, in that each individual’s cultural knowledge affects how 
he or she interprets illness experience and guides how he or she seeks help. Because the 
CFI concerns the individual’s personal views, there are no right or wrong answers to these 
questions. The interview follows and is available online at www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 

The CFI is formatted as two text columns. The left-hand column contains the instruc- 
tions for administering the CFI and describes the goals for each interview domain. The 
questions in the right-hand column illustrate how to explore these domains, but they are 
not meant to be exhaustive. Follow-up questions may be needed to clarify individuals’ an- 
swers. Questions may be rephrased as needed. The CFI is intended as a guide to cultural as- 
sessment and should be used flexibly to maintain a natural flow of the interview and rapport 
with the individual. 

The CFI is best used in conjunction with demographic information obtained prior to 
the interview in order to tailor the CFI questions to address the individual’s background 
and current situation. Specific demographic domains to be explored with the CFI will vary 
across individuals and settings. A comprehensive assessment may include place of birth, 
age, gender, racial/ethnic origin, marital status, family composition, education, language 
fluencies, sexual orientation, religious or spiritual affiliation, occupation, employment, in- 
come, and migration history. 

The CFI can be used in the initial assessment of individuals in all clinical settings, regard- 
less of the cultural background of the individual or of the clinician. Individuals and clini- 
cians who appear to share the same cultural background may nevertheless differ in ways 
that are relevant to care. The CFI may be used in its entirety, or components may be incor- 
porated into a clinical evaluation as needed. The CFI may be especially helpful when there is 


¢ Difficulty in diagnostic assessment owing to significant differences in the cultural, re- 
ligious, or socioeconomic backgrounds of clinician and the individual. 

¢ Uncertainty about the fit between culturally distinctive symptoms and diagnostic criteria. 

¢ Difficulty in judging illness severity or impairment. 

¢ Disagreement between the individual and clinician on the course of care. 

e Limited engagement in and adherence to treatment by the individual. 


The CFI emphasizes four domains of assessment: Cultural Definition of the Problem 
(questions 1-3); Cultural Perceptions of Cause, Context, and Support (questions 4-10); Cul- 
tural Factors Affecting Self-Coping and Past Help Seeking (questions 11-13); and Cultural 
Factors Affecting Current Help Seeking (questions 14-16). Both the person-centered process 
of conducting the CFI and the information it elicits are intended to enhance the cultural va- 
lidity of diagnostic assessment, facilitate treatment planning, and promote the individual's 
engagement and satisfaction. To achieve these goals, the information obtained from the CFI 
should be integrated with all other available clinical material into a comprehensive clinical 
and contextual evaluation. An Informant version of the CFI can be used to collect collateral 
information on the CFI domains from family members or caregivers. 

Supplementary modules have been developed that expand on each domain of the CFI 
and guide clinicians who wish to explore these domains in greater depth. Supplementary 
modules have also been developed for specific populations, such as children and adoles- 
cents, elderly individuals, and immigrants and refugees. These supplementary modules 
are referenced in the CFI under the pertinent subheadings and are available online at 
www.psychiatry.org/dsm5. 


752 Cultural Formulation 


Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI) 


Supplementary modules used to expand each CFI subtopic are noted in parentheses. 
INSTRUCTIONS TO THE INTERVIEWER ARE 
GUIDE TO INTERVIEWER ITALICIZED. 


The following questions aim to clarify key aspects of |. INTRODUCTION FOR THE INDIVIDUAL: 
the presenting clinical problem from the point of | would like to understand the problems that 


view of the individual and other members of the bring you here so that I can help you more 
individual's social network (i.e., family, friends, or effectively. I want to know about your experi- 
others involved in current problem). This includes ence and ideas. I will ask some questions 

the problem's meaning, potential sources of help, about what is going on and how you are deal- 
and expectations for services. ing with it. Please remember there are no 


right or wrong answers. 
CULTURAL DEFINITION OF THE PROBLEM 


CULTURAL DEFINITION OF THE PROBLEM 
(Explanatory Model, Level of Functioning) 
Elicit the individual's view of core problemsandkey 1. What brings you here today? 


concerns. IF INDIVIDUAL GIVES FEW DETAILS OR 

Focus on the individual’s own way of understand- ONLY MENTIONS SYMPTOMS OR A 
ing the problem. MEDICAL DIAGNOSIS, PROBE: 

Use the term, expression, or brief description elicited People often understand their problems in 
in question 1 to identify the problem in subsequent their own way, which may be similar to or 
questions (e.g., “your conflict with your son”). different from how doctors describe the 

problem. How would you describe your 
problem? 


Ask how individual frames the problem for members 2. Sometimes people have different ways of 
of the social network. describing their problem to their family, 
friends, or others in their community. How 
would you describe your problem to them? 


Focus on the aspects of the problem that matter most 3. What troubles you most about your prob- 
to the individual. lem? 


CULTURAL PERCEPTIONS OF CAUSE, CONTEXT, AND SUPPORT 


CAUSES 
(Explanatory Model, Social Network, Older Adults) 
This question indicates the meaning of the condition 4. Why do you think this is happening to 


for the individual, which may be relevant for clin- you? What do you think are the causes of 
ical care. your [PROBLEM]? 

Note that individuals may identify multiple causes, PROMPT FURTHER IF REQUIRED: 
depending on the facet of the problem they are con- Some people may explain their problem as 
sidering. the result of bad things that happen in their 


life, problems with others, a physical ill- 
ness, a spiritual reason, or many other 


causes. 
Focus on the views of members of the individual's 5. What do others in your family, your 
social network. These may be diverse and vary from friends, or others in your community think 


the individual's. is causing your [PROBLEM]? 


Cultural Formulation 753 


Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI) (continued) 
Supplementary modules used to expand each CFI subtopic are noted in parentheses. 


INSTRUCTIONS TO THE INTERVIEWER ARE 
GUIDE TO INTERVIEWER ITALICIZED. 


STRESSORS AND SUPPORTS 


(Social Network, Caregivers, Psychosocial Stressors, Religion and Spirituality, Immigrants and 
Refugees, Cultural Identity, Older Adults, Coping and Help Seeking) 


Elicit information on the individual's life context, 6. Are there any kinds of support that make 
focusing on resources, social supports, and resil- your [PROBLEM] better, such as support 
ience. May also probe other supports (e.g., from co- from family, friends, or others? 
workers, from participation in religion or spiritu- 
ality). 

Focus on stressful aspects of the individual’s envi- 7. Are there any kinds of stresses that make 
ronment. Can also probe, e.g., relationship prob- your [PROBLEM] worse, such as difficul- 
lems, difficulties at work or school, or ties with money, or family problems? 


discrimination. 
ROLE OF CULTURAL IDENTITY 


(Cultural Identity, Psychosocial Stressors, Religion and Spirituality, Immigrants and Refugees, 
Older Adults, Children and Adolescents) 


Sometimes, aspects of people’s back- 
ground or identity can make their [PROB- 
LEM] better or worse. By background or 
identity, I mean, for example, the commu- 
nities you belong to, the languages you 
speak, where you or your family are from, 
your race or ethnic background, your gen- 
der or sexual orientation, or your faith or 


religion. 
Ask the individual to reflect on the most salient ele- 8. For you, what are the most important 
ments of his or her cultural identity. Use this aspects of your background or identity? 


information to tailor questions 9-10 as needed. 
Elicit aspects of identity that make the problem bet- 9. Are there any aspects of your background 
ter or worse. or identity that make a difference to your 
Probe as needed (e.g., clinical worsening as a result [PROBLEM]? 
of discrimination due to migration status, race/ 
ethnicity, or sexual orientation). 
Probe as needed (e.g., migration-related problems; 10. Are there any aspects of your background 
conflict across generations or due to gender roles). or identity that are causing other concerns 
or difficulties for you? 


CULTURAL FACTORS AFFECTING SELF-COPING AND PAST HELP SEEKING 


SELF-COPING 
(Coping and Help Seeking, Religion and Spirituality, Older Adults, Caregivers, 
Psychosocial Stressors) 
Clarify self-coping for the problem. 11. Sometimes people have various ways of 
dealing with problems like [PROBLEM]. 
What have you done on your own to cope 
with your [PROBLEM]? 


754 Cultural Formulation 


Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI) (continued) 
Supplementary modules used to expand each CFI subtopic are noted in parentheses. 


INSTRUCTIONS TO THE INTERVIEWER ARE 
GUIDE TO INTERVIEWER ITALICIZED. 


PAST HELP SEEKING 


(Coping and Help Seeking, Religion and Spirituality, Older Adults, Caregivers, Psychosocial 
Stressors, Immigrants and Refugees, Social Network, Clinician-Patient Relationship) 


Elicit various sources of help (e.g., medical care, 12. Often, people look for help from many dif- 
mental health treatment, support groups, work- ferent sources, including different kinds of 
based counseling, folk healing, religious or spiri- doctors, helpers, or healers. In the past, 
tual counseling, other forms of traditional or alter- what kinds of treatment, help, advice, or 
native healing). healing have you sought for your [PROB- 

Probe as needed (e.g., “What other sources of help LEM]? 
have you used?”). PROBE IF DOES NOT DESCRIBE USE- 

Clarify the individual's experience and regard for FULNESS OF HELP RECEIVED: 
previous help. What types of help or treatment were most 

useful? Not useful? 
BARRIERS 


(Coping and Help Seeking, Religion and Spirituality, Older Adults, Psychosocial Stressors, Immi- 
grants and Refugees, Social Network, Clinician-Patient Relationship) 


Clarify the role of social barriers to help seeking, 13. Has anything prevented you from getting 
access to care, and problems engaging in previous the help you need? 
treatment. PROBE AS NEEDED: 
Probe details as needed (e.g., “What got in the For example, money, work or family com- 
way?”). mitments, stigma or discrimination, or lack 
of services that understand your language 
or background? 
CULTURAL FACTORS AFFECTING CURRENT HELP SEEKING 
PREFERENCES 
(Social Network, Caregivers, Religion and Spirituality, Older Adults, Coping and Help Seeking) 
Clarify individual's current perceived needs and Now let’s talk some more about the help 
expectations of help, broadly defined. you need. 
Probe if individual lists only one source of help (e.g., 14. What kinds of help do you think would be 
“What other kinds of help would be useful to you most useful to you at this time for your 
at this time?”). [PROBLEM]? 
Focus on the views of the social network regarding 15. Are there other kinds of help that your fam- 
help seeking. ily, friends, or other people have suggested 


would be helpful for you now? 
CLINICIAN-PATIENT RELATIONSHIP 
(Clinician-Patient Relationship, Older Adults) 


Elicit possible concerns about the clinic or the clini- Sometimes doctors and patients misunder- 
cian-patient relationship, including perceived rac- stand each other because they come from 
ism, language barriers, or cultural differences that different backgrounds or have different 
may undermine goodwill, communication, or care expectations. 
delivery. 16. Have you been concerned about this and is 

Probe details as needed (e.g., “In what way?”). there anything that we can do to provide 

Address possible barriers to care or concerns about you with the care you need? 


the clinic and the clinician-patient relationship 
raised previously. 


Cultural Formulation 755 


Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI) —Informant Version 


The CFI-Informant Version collects collateral information from an informant who is 
knowledgeable about the clinical problems and life circumstances of the identified indi- 
vidual. This version can be used to supplement information obtained from the core CFI or 
can be used instead of the core CFI when the individual is unable to provide information— 
as might occur, for example, with children or adolescents, floridly psychotic individuals, 


or persons with cognitive impairment. 


Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI)—Informant Version 


GUIDE TO INTERVIEWER 


The following questions aim to clarify key aspects of 


the presenting clinical problem from the infor- 
mant's point of view. This includes the problem's 
meaning, potential sources of help, and expecta- 
tions for services. 


INSTRUCTIONS TO THE INTERVIEWER ARE 
ITALICIZED. 


INTRODUCTION FOR THE INFORMANT: 


I would like to understand the problems that 
bring your family member/friend here so 
that I can help you and him/her more effec- 
tively. I want to know about your experience 
and ideas. I will ask some questions about 
what is going on and how you and your fam- 
ily member/friend are dealing with it. There 
are no right or wrong answers. 


RELATIONSHIP WITH THE PATIENT 


Clarify the informant’s relationship with the indi- 
vidual and/or the individual's family. 


1. How would you describe your relationship 
to [INDIVIDUAL OR TO FAMILY]? 


PROBE IF NOT CLEAR: 
How often do you see [INDIVIDUAL]? 


CULTURAL DEFINITION OF THE PROBLEM 


Elicit the informant’s view of core problems and key 
concerns. 

Focus on the informant’s way of understanding the 
individual's problem. 

Use the term, expression, or brief description elicited 
in question 1 to identify the problem in subsequent 
questions (e.g., “her conflict with her son”). 


Ask how informant frames the problem for members 
of the social network. 


Focus on the aspects of the problem that matter most 
to the informant. 


2. What brings your family member/friend 
here today? 
IF INFORMANT GIVES FEW DETAILS OR 
ONLY MENTIONS SYMPTOMS OR A 
MEDICAL DIAGNOSIS, PROBE: 


People often understand problems in their 
own way, which may be similar or differ- 
ent from how doctors describe the prob- 
lem. How would you describe 
[INDIVIDUAL’S] problem? 

3. Sometimes people have different ways of 
describing the problem to family, friends, 
or others in their community. How would 
you describe [INDIVIDUAL'S] problem to 
them? 

4. What troubles you most about [INDIVID- 
UAL’S] problem? 


756 


Cultural Formulation 


Cultural Formulation Interview (CFl)—Informant Version (continued) 


GUIDE TO INTERVIEWER 


INSTRUCTIONS TO THE INTERVIEWER ARE 
ITALICIZED. 


CULTURAL PERCEPTIONS OF CAUSE, CONTEXT, AND SUPPORT 
CAUSES 


This question indicates the meaning of the condition 
for the informant, which may be relevant for clini- 
cal care. 


Note that informants may identify multiple causes 
depending on the facet of the problem they are con- 
sidering. 


Focus on the views of members of the individual's 
social network. These may be diverse and vary 
from the informant’s. 


5. Why do you think this is happening to 
[INDIVIDUAL]? What do you think are the 
causes of his/her [PROBLEM]? 

PROMPT FURTHER IF REQUIRED: 

Some people may explain the problem as the 
result of bad things that happen in their life, 
problems with others, a physical illness, a 
spiritual reason, or many other causes. 

6. What do others in [INDIVIDUAL’S] fam- 
ily, his/her friends, or others in the com- 
munity think is causing [INDIVIDUAL’S] 
[PROBLEM]? 


STRESSORS AND SUPPORTS 


Elicit information on the individual's life context, 
focusing on resources, social supports, and resil- 
ience. May also probe other supports (e.g., from co- 
workers, from participation in religion or spiritu- 
ality). 

Focus on stressful aspects of the individual's environ- 
ment. Can also probe, e.g., relationship problems, dif- 
ficulties at work or school, or discrimination. 


7. Are there any kinds of supports that make 
his/her [PROBLEM] better, such as from 
family, friends, or others? 


8. Are there any kinds of stresses that make 
his/her [PROBLEM] worse, such as diffi- 
culties with money, or family problems? 


ROLE OF CULTURAL IDENTITY 


Ask the informant to reflect on the most salient ele- 
ments of the individual’s cultural identity. Use this 
information to tailor questions 10-11 as needed. 

Elicit aspects of identity that make the problem bet- 
ter or worse. 

Probe as needed (e.g., clinical worsening as a result 
of discrimination due to migration status, race/ 
ethnicity, or sexual orientation). 

Probe as needed (e.g., migration-related problems; 
conflict across generations or due to gender roles). 


Sometimes, aspects of people’s background 
or identity can make the [PROBLEM] better 
or worse. By background or identity, I mean, 
for example, the communities you belong to, 
the languages you speak, where you or your 
family are from, your race or ethnic back- 
ground, your gender or sexual orientation, 
and your faith or religion. 

9. For you, what are the most important 
aspects of [INDIVIDUALS] background or 
identity? 

10. Are there any aspects of INDIVIDUAL’S] 
background or identity that make a differ- 
ence to his/her [PROBLEM]? 


11. Are there any aspects of INDIVIDUAL’S] 
background or identity that are causing 
other concerns or difficulties for him/her? 


Cultural Formulation 757 


Cultural Formulation Interview (CFl)—Informant Version (continued) 


INSTRUCTIONS TO THE INTERVIEWER ARE 


GUIDE TO INTERVIEWER ITALICIZED. 


CULTURAL FACTORS AFFECTING SELF-COPING AND PAST HELP SEEKING 
SELF-COPING 


Clarify individual's self-coping for the problem. 


12. Sometimes people have various ways of 
dealing with problems like [PROBLEM]. 
What has [INDIVIDUAL] done on his/her 
own to cope with his/her [PROBLEM]? 


PAST HELP SEEKING 


Elicit various sources of help (e.g., medical care, 
mental health treatment, support groups, work- 
based counseling, folk healing, religious or spiri- 
tual counseling, other alternative healing). 

Probe as needed (e.g., “What other sources of help 
has he/she used?”). 

Clarify the individual's experience and regard for 
previous help. 


13. Often, people also look for help from many 
different sources, including different kinds 
of doctors, helpers, or healers. In the past, 
what kinds of treatment, help, advice, or 
healing has [INDIVIDUAL] sought for his/ 
her [PROBLEM]? 

PROBE IF DOES NOT DESCRIBE USE- 
FULNESS OF HELP RECEIVED: 


What types of help or treatment were most 
useful? Not useful? 


BARRIERS 


Clarify the role of social barriers to help-seeking, 
access to care, and problems engaging in previous 
treatment. 

Probe details as needed (e.g., “What got in the 
way?”). 


14. Has anything prevented [INDIVIDUAL] 
from getting the help he/she needs? 


PROBE AS NEEDED: 


For example, money, work or family com- 
mitments, stigma or discrimination, or lack 
of services that understand his/her lan- 
guage or background? 


CULTURAL FACTORS AFFECTING CURRENT HELP SEEKING 
PREFERENCES 


Clarify individual's current perceived needs and 
expectations of help, broadly defined, from the 
point of view of the informant. 

Probe if informant lists only one source of help (e.g., 
“What other kinds of help would be useful to 
[INDIVIDUAL] at this time?”). 

Focus on the views of the social network regarding 
help seeking. 


Now let’s talk about the help [INDIVID- 
UAL] needs. 

15. What kinds of help would be most useful to 
him/her at this time for his/her [PROB- 
LEM]? 


16. Are there other kinds of help that [INDI- 
VIDUAL’S] family, friends, or other people 
have suggested would be helpful for him/ 
her now? 


CLINICIAN-PATIENT RELATIONSHIP 


Elicit possible concerns about the clinic or the clini- 
cian-patient relationship, including perceived rac- 
ism, language barriers, or cultural differences that 
may undermine goodwill, communication, or care 
delivery. 

Probe details as needed (e.g., “In what way?”). 
Address possible barriers to care or concerns about 
the clinic and the clinician-patient relationship 

raised previously. 


Sometimes doctors and patients misunder- 
stand each other because they come from 
different backgrounds or have different 
expectations. 

17. Have you been concerned about this, and is 
there anything that we can do to provide 
[INDIVIDUAL] with the care he/she 
needs? 


758 Cultural Formulation 


Cultural Concepts of Distress 


Cultural concepts of distress refers to ways that cultural groups experience, understand, and 
communicate suffering, behavioral problems, or troubling thoughts and emotions. Three 
main types of cultural concepts may be distinguished. Cultural syndromes are clusters of 
symptoms and attributions that tend to co-occur among individuals in specific cultural 
groups, communities, or contexts and that are recognized locally as coherent patterns of 
experience. Cultural idioms of distress are ways of expressing distress that may not involve 
specific symptoms or syndromes, but that provide collective, shared ways of experiencing 
and talking about personal or social concerns. For example, everyday talk about “nerves” 
or “depression” may refer to widely varying forms of suffering without mapping onto a 
discrete set of symptoms, syndrome, or disorder. Cultural explanations or perceived causes 
are labels, attributions, or features of an explanatory model that indicate culturally recog- 
nized meaning or etiology for symptoms, illness, or distress. 

These three concepts—syndromes, idioms, and explanations—are more relevant to 
clinical practice than the older formulation culture-bound syndrome. Specifically, the term 
culture-bound syndrome ignores the fact that clinically important cultural differences often 
involve explanations or experience of distress rather than culturally distinctive configura- 
tions of symptoms. Furthermore, the term culture-bound overemphasizes the local partic- 
ularity and limited distribution of cultural concepts of distress. The current formulation 
acknowledges that all forms of distress are locally shaped, including the DSM disorders. 
From this perspective, many DSM diagnoses can be understood as operationalized proto- 
types that started out as cultural syndromes, and became widely accepted as a result of 
their clinical and research utility. Across groups there remain culturally patterned differ- 
ences in symptoms, ways of talking about distress, and locally perceived causes, which are 
in turn associated with coping strategies and patterns of help seeking. 

Cultural concepts arise from local folk or professional diagnostic systems for mental 
and emotional distress, and they may also reflect the influence of biomedical concepts. 
Cultural concepts have four key features in relation to the DSM-5 nosology: 


¢ There is seldom a one-to-one correspondence of any cultural concept with a DSM diag- 
nostic entity; the correspondence is more likely to be one-to-many in either direction. 
Symptoms or behaviors that might be sorted by DSM-5 into several disorders may be 
included in a single folk concept, and diverse presentations that might be classified by 
DSM-5 as variants of a single disorder may be sorted into several distinct concepts by an 
indigenous diagnostic system. 

¢ Cultural concepts may apply to a wide range of severity, including presentations that 
do not meet DSM criteria for any mental disorder. For example, an individual with acute 
grief or a social predicament may use the same idiom of distress or display the same 
cultural syndrome as another individual with more severe psychopathology. 

¢ In common usage, the same cultural term frequently denotes more than one type of 
cultural concept. A familiar example may be the concept of “depression,” which may 
be used to describe a syndrome (e.g., major depressive disorder), an idiom of distress 
(e.g., as in the common expression “I feel depressed”), or a perceived cause (similar to 
“stress”). 

¢ Like culture and DSM itself, cultural concepts may change over time in response to both 
local and global influences. 


Cultural concepts are important to psychiatric diagnosis for several reasons: 


¢ To avoid misdiagnosis: Cultural variation in symptoms and in explanatory models as- 
sociated with these cultural concepts may lead clinicians to misjudge the severity of a 


Cultural Formulation 759 


problem or assign the wrong diagnosis (e.g., unfamiliar spiritual explanations may be 
misunderstood as psychosis). 

¢ To obtain useful clinical information: Cultural variations in symptoms and attribu- 
tions may be associated with particular features of risk, resilience, and outcome. 

¢ To improve clinical rapport and engagement: “Speaking the language of the patient,” 
both linguistically and in terms of his or her dominant concepts and metaphors, can re- 
sult in greater communication and satisfaction, facilitate treatment negotiation, and 
lead to higher retention and adherence. 

¢ To improve therapeutic efficacy: Culture influences the psychological mechanisms of 
disorder, which need to be understood and addressed to improve clinical efficacy. For 
example, culturally specific catastrophic cognitions can contribute to symptom escala- 
tion into panic attacks. 

¢ To guide clinical research: Locally perceived connections between cultural concepts 
may help identify patterns of comorbidity and underlying biological substrates. 

¢ To clarify the cultural epidemiology: Cultural concepts of distress are not endorsed 
uniformly by everyone in a given culture. Distinguishing syndromes, idioms, and ex- 
planations provides an approach for studying the distribution of cultural features of ill- 
ness across settings and regions, and over time. It also suggests questions about cultural 
determinants of risk, course, and outcome in clinical and community settings to en- 
hance the evidence base of cultural research. 


DSM-5 includes information on cultural concepts in order to improve the accuracy of 
diagnosis and the comprehensiveness of clinical assessment. Clinical assessment of indi- 
viduals presenting with these cultural concepts should determine whether they meet 
DSM-5 criteria for a specified disorder or an other specified or unspecified diagnosis. Once the 
disorder is diagnosed, the cultural terms and explanations should be included in case for- 
mulations; they may help clarify symptoms and etiological attributions that could other- 
wise be confusing. Individuals whose symptoms do not meet DSM criteria for a specific 
mental disorder may still expect and require treatment; this should be assessed on a case- 
by-case basis. In addition to the CFI and its supplementary modules, DSM-5 contains the 
following information and tools that may be useful when integrating cultural information 
in clinical practice: 


¢ Data in DSM-5 criteria and text for specific disorders: The text includes information 
on cultural variations in prevalence, symptomatology, associated cultural concepts, 
and other clinical aspects. It is important to emphasize that there is no one-to-one cor- 
respondence at the categorical level between DSM disorders and cultural concepts. Dif- 
ferential diagnosis for individuals must therefore incorporate information on cultural 
variation with information elicited by the CFI. 

¢ Other Conditions That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention: Some of the clinical con- 
cerns identified by the CFI may correspond to V codes or Z codes—for example, accul- 
turation problems, parent-child relational problems, or religious or spiritual problems. 

¢ Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress: Located in the Appendix, this glossary pro- 
vides examples of well-studied cultural concepts of distress that illustrate the relevance 
of cultural information for clinical diagnosis and some of the interrelationships among 
cultural syndromes, idioms of distress, and causal explanations. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for 
Personality Disorders 


The current approach to personality disorders appears in Section II of DSM-5, 
and an alternative model developed for DSM-5 is presented here in Section III. The inclu- 
sion of both models in DSM-5 reflects the decision of the APA Board of Trustees to pre- 
serve continuity with current clinical practice, while also introducing a new approach that 
aims to address numerous shortcomings of the current approach to personality disorders. 
For example, the typical patient meeting criteria for a specific personality disorder fre- 
quently also meets criteria for other personality disorders. Similarly, other specified or un- 
specified personality disorder is often the correct (but mostly uninformative) diagnosis, in 
the sense that patients do not tend to present with patterns of symptoms that correspond 
with one and only one personality disorder. 

In the following alternative DSM-5 model, personality disorders are characterized by 
impairments in personality functioning and pathological personality traits. The specific 
personality disorder diagnoses that may be derived from this model include antisocial, 
avoidant, borderline, narcissistic, obsessive-compulsive, and schizotypal personality dis- 
orders. This approach also includes a diagnosis of personality disorder—trait specified 
(PD-TS) that can be made when a personality disorder is considered present but the crite- 
ria for a specific disorder are not met. 


General Criteria for Personality Disorder 


General Criteria for Personality Disorder 


The essential features of a personality disorder are 

A. Moderate or greater impairment in personality (self/interpersonal) functioning. 

B. One or more pathological personality traits. 

C. The impairments in personality functioning and the individual’s personality trait expres- 
sion are relatively inflexible and pervasive across a broad range of personal and social 
situations. 

D. The impairments in personality functioning and the individual’s personality trait expres- 
sion are relatively stable across time, with onsets that can be traced back to at least 
adolescence or early adulthood. 

E. The impairments in personality functioning and the individual’s personality trait expres- 
sion are not better explained by another mental disorder. 

F. The impairments in personality functioning and the individual’s personality trait expres- 
sion are not solely attributable to the physiological effects of a substance or another 
medical condition (e.g., severe head trauma). 

G. The impairments in personality functioning and the individual’s personality trait expres- 
sion are not better understood as normal for an individual’s developmental stage or so- 
ciocultural environment. 


761 


762 Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 


A diagnosis of a personality disorder requires two determinations: 1) an assessment of 
the level of impairment in personality functioning, which is needed for Criterion A, and 2) 
an evaluation of pathological personality traits, which is required for Criterion B. The im- 
pairments in personality functioning and personality trait expression are relatively inflex- 
ible and pervasive across a broad range of personal and social situations (Criterion C); 
relatively stable across time, with onsets that can be traced back to at least adolescence or 
early adulthood (Criterion D); not better explained by another mental disorder (Criterion 
E); not attributable to the effects of a substance or another medical condition (Criterion F); 
and not better understood as normal for an individual’s developmental stage or sociocul- 
tural environment (Criterion G). All Section III personality disorders described by criteria 
sets, as well as PD-TS, meet these general criteria, by definition. 


Criterion A: Level of Personality Functioning 


Disturbances in self and interpersonal functioning constitute the core of personality psy- 
chopathology and in this alternative diagnostic model they are evaluated on a continuum. 
Self functioning involves identity and self-direction; interpersonal functioning involves 
empathy and intimacy (see Table 1). The Level of Personality Functioning Scale (LPFS; see 
Table 2, pp. 775-778) uses each of these elements to differentiate five levels of impairment, 
ranging from little or no impairment (i.e., healthy, adaptive functioning; Level 0) to some 
(Level 1), moderate (Level 2), severe (Level 3), and extreme (Level 4) impairment. 


TABLE 1 Elements of personality functioning 
Self: 


1. Identity: Experience of oneself as unique, with clear boundaries between self and others; sta- 
bility of self-esteem and accuracy of self-appraisal; capacity for, and ability to regulate, a 
range of emotional experience. 

2. Self-direction: Pursuit of coherent and meaningful short-term and life goals; utilization of 
constructive and prosocial internal standards of behavior; ability to self-reflect productively. 


Interpersonal: 


1. Empathy: Comprehension and appreciation of others’ experiences and motivations; tolerance 
of differing perspectives; understanding the effects of one’s own behavior on others. 

2. Intimacy: Depth and duration of connection with others; desire and capacity for closeness; 
mutuality of regard reflected in interpersonal behavior. 


Impairment in personality functioning predicts the presence of a personality disorder, 
and the severity of impairment predicts whether an individual has more than one person- 
ality disorder or one of the more typically severe personality disorders. A moderate level 
of impairment in personality functioning is required for the diagnosis of a personality dis- 
order; this threshold is based on empirical evidence that the moderate level of impairment 
maximizes the ability of clinicians to accurately and efficiently identify personality disor- 
der pathology. 


Criterion B: Pathological Personality Traits 


Pathological personality traits are organized into five broad domains: Negative A ffectiv- 
ity, Detachment, Antagonism, Disinhibition, and Psychoticism. Within the five broad trait 
domains are 25 specific trait facets that were developed initially from a review of existing 
trait models and subsequently through iterative research with samples of persons who 
sought mental health services. The full trait taxonomy is presented in Table 3 (see pp. 779- 
781). The B criteria for the specific personality disorders comprise subsets of the 25 trait 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 763 


facets, based on meta-analytic reviews and empirical data on the relationships of the traits 
to DSM-IV personality disorder diagnoses. 


Criteria C and D: Pervasiveness and Stability 


Impairments in personality functioning and pathological personality traits are relatively per- 
vasive across a range of personal and social contexts, as personality is defined as a pattern of 
perceiving, relating to, and thinking about the environment and oneself. The term relatively 
reflects the fact that all except the most extremely pathological personalities show some de- 
gree of adaptability. The pattern in personality disorders is maladaptive and relatively inflex- 
ible, which leads to disabilities in social, occupational, or other important pursuits, as 
individuals are unable to modify their thinking or behavior, even in the face of evidence that 
their approach is not working. The impairments in functioning and personality traits are also 
relatively stable. Personality traits—the dispositions to behave or feel in certain ways—are 
more stable than the symptomatic expressions of these dispositions, but personality traits can 
also change. Impairments in personality functioning are more stable than symptoms. 


Criteria E, F, and G: Alternative Explanations for 
Personality Pathology (Differential Diagnosis) 


On some occasions, what appears to be a personality disorder may be better explained by 
another mental disorder, the effects of a substance or another medical condition, or a nor- 
mal developmental stage (e.g., adolescence, late life) or the individual’s sociocultural en- 
vironment. When another mental disorder is present, the diagnosis of a personality 
disorder is not made, if the manifestations of the personality disorder clearly are an ex- 
pression of the other mental disorder (e.g., if features of schizotypal personality disorder 
are present only in the context of schizophrenia). On the other hand, personality disorders 
can be accurately diagnosed in the presence of another mental disorder, such as major de- 
pressive disorder, and patients with other mental disorders should be assessed for comor- 
bid personality disorders because personality disorders often impact the course of other 
mental disorders. Therefore, it is always appropriate to assess personality functioning and 
pathological personality traits to provide a context for other psychopathology. 


Specific Personality Disorders 


Section III includes diagnostic criteria for antisocial, avoidant, borderline, narcissistic, ob- 
sessive-compulsive, and schizotypal personality disorders. Each personality disorder is 
defined by typical impairments in personality functioning (Criterion A) and characteristic 
pathological personality traits (Criterion B): 


¢ Typical features of antisocial personality disorder are a failure to conform to lawful 
and ethical behavior, and an egocentric, callous lack of concern for others, accompanied 
by deceitfulness, irresponsibility, manipulativeness, and/or risk taking. 

¢ Typical features of avoidant personality disorder are avoidance of social situations and 
inhibition in interpersonal relationships related to feelings of ineptitude and inade- 
quacy, anxious preoccupation with negative evaluation and rejection, and fears of rid- 
icule or embarrassment. 

¢ Typical features of borderline personality disorder are instability of self-image, per- 
sonal goals, interpersonal relationships, and affects, accompanied by impulsivity, risk 
taking, and/or hostility. 

¢ Typical features of narcissistic personality disorder are variable and vulnerable self- 
esteem, with attempts at regulation through attention and approval seeking, and either 
overt or covert grandiosity. 


764 Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 


¢ Typical features of obsessive-compulsive personality disorder are difficulties in estab- 
lishing and sustaining close relationships, associated with rigid perfectionism, inflexi- 
bility, and restricted emotional expression. 

¢ Typical features of schizotypal personality disorder are impairments in the capacity 
for social and close relationships, and eccentricities in cognition, perception, and behav- 
ior that are associated with distorted self-image and incoherent personal goals and ac- 
companied by suspiciousness and restricted emotional expression. 


The A and B criteria for the six specific personality disorders and for PD-TS follow. All 
personality disorders also meet criteria C through G of the General Criteria for Personality 
Disorder. 


Antisocial Personality Disorder 


Typical features of antisocial personality disorder are a failure to conform to lawful and 
ethical behavior, and an egocentric, callous lack of concern for others, accompanied by de- 
ceitfulness, irresponsibility, manipulativeness, and/or risk taking. Characteristic difficul- 
ties are apparent in identity, self-direction, empathy, and/or intimacy, as described below, 
along with specific maladaptive traits in the domains of Antagonism and Disinhibition. 


Proposed Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Moderate or greater impairment in personality functioning, manifested by characteristic 
difficulties in two or more of the following four areas: 


1. Identity: Egocentrism; self-esteem derived from personal gain, power, or pleasure. 

2. Self-direction: Goal setting based on personal gratification; absence of prosocial 
internal standards, associated with failure to conform to lawful or culturally norma- 
tive ethical behavior. 

3. Empathy: Lack of concern for feelings, needs, or suffering of others; lack of re- 
morse after hurting or mistreating another. 

4. Intimacy: Incapacity for mutually intimate relationships, as exploitation is a primary 
means of relating to others, including by deceit and coercion; use of dominance or 
intimidation to control others. 


B. Six or more of the following seven pathological personality traits: 


1. Manipulativeness (an aspect of Antagonism): Frequent use of subterfuge to in- 
fluence or control others; use of seduction, charm, glibness, or ingratiation to 
achieve one’s ends. 

2. Callousness (an aspect of Antagonism): Lack of concern for feelings or problems 
of others; lack of guilt or remorse about the negative or harmful effects of one’s ac- 
tions on others; aggression; sadism. 

3. Deceitfulness (an aspect of Antagonism): Dishonesty and fraudulence; misrepre- 
sentation of self; embellishment or fabrication when relating events. 

4. Hostility (an aspect of Antagonism): Persistent or frequent angry feelings; anger or 
irritability in response to minor slights and insults; mean, nasty, or vengeful behavior. 

5. Risk taking (an aspect of Disinhibition): Engagement in dangerous, risky, and poten- 
tially self-damaging activities, unnecessarily and without regard for consequences; 
boredom proneness and thoughtless initiation of activities to counter boredom; lack of 
concern for one’s limitations and denial of the reality of personal danger. 

6. Impulsivity (an aspect of Disinhibition): Acting on the spur of the moment in re- 
sponse to immediate stimuli; acting on a momentary basis without a plan or consid- 
eration of outcomes; difficulty establishing and following plans. 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 765 


7. Irresponsibility (an aspect of Disinhibition): Disregard for—and failure to honor— 
financial and other obligations or commitments; lack of respect for—and lack of fol- 
low-through on—agreements and promises. 


Note. The individual is at least 18 years of age. 
Specify if: 
With psychopathic features. 


Specifiers. A distinct variant often termed psychopathy (or “primary” psychopathy) is 
marked by a lack of anxiety or fear and by a bold interpersonal style that may mask mal- 
adaptive behaviors (e.g., fraudulence). This psychopathic variant is characterized by low 
levels of anxiousness (Negative Affectivity domain) and withdrawal (Detachment do- 
main) and high levels of attention seeking (Antagonism domain). High attention seeking 
and low withdrawal capture the social potency (assertive /dominant) component of psy- 
chopathy, whereas low anxiousness captures the stress immunity (emotional stability /re- 
silience) component. 

In addition to psychopathic features, trait and personality functioning specifiers may be 
used to record other personality features that may be present in antisocial personality dis- 
order but are not required for the diagnosis. For example, traits of Negative Affectivity (e.g., 
anxiousness), are not diagnostic criteria for antisocial personality disorder (see Criterion B) 
but can be specified when appropriate. Furthermore, although moderate or greater impair- 
ment in personality functioning is required for the diagnosis of antisocial personality disor- 
der (Criterion A), the level of personality functioning can also be specified. 


Avoidant Personality Disorder 


Typical features of avoidant personality disorder are avoidance of social situations and in- 
hibition in interpersonal relationships related to feelings of ineptitude and inadequacy, 
anxious preoccupation with negative evaluation and rejection, and fears of ridicule or em- 
barrassment. Characteristic difficulties are apparent in identity, self-direction, empathy, 
and/or intimacy, as described below, along with specific maladaptive traits in the do- 
mains of Negative Affectivity and Detachment. 


Proposed Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Moderate or greater impairment in personality functioning, manifest by characteristic 
difficulties in two or more of the following four areas: 


1. Identity: Low self-esteem associated with self-appraisal as socially inept, person- 
ally unappealing, or inferior; excessive feelings of shame. 

2. Self-direction: Unrealistic standards for behavior associated with reluctance to 
pursue goals, take personal risks, or engage in new activities involving interper- 
sonal contact. 

3. Empathy: Preoccupation with, and sensitivity to, criticism or rejection, associated 
with distorted inference of others’ perspectives as negative. 

4. Intimacy: Reluctance to get involved with people unless being certain of being 
liked; diminished mutuality within intimate relationships because of fear of being 
shamed or ridiculed. 


B. Three or more of the following four pathological personality traits, one of which must 
be (1) Anxiousness: 


1. Anxiousness (an aspect of Negative Affectivity): Intense feelings of nervous- 
ness, tenseness, or panic, often in reaction to social situations; worry about the 
negative effects of past unpleasant experiences and future negative possibilities; 


766 Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 


feeling fearful, apprehensive, or threatened by uncertainty; fears of embarrass- 
ment. 

2. Withdrawal (an aspect of Detachment): Reticence in social situations; avoidance 
of social contacts and activity; lack of initiation of social contact. 

3. Anhedonia (an aspect of Detachment): Lack of enjoyment from, engagement in, 
or energy for life’s experiences; deficits in the capacity to feel pleasure or take in- 
terest in things. 

4. Intimacy avoidance (an aspect of Detachment): Avoidance of close or romantic 
relationships, interpersonal attachments, and intimate sexual relationships. 


Specifiers. Considerable heterogeneity in the form of additional personality traits is 
found among individuals diagnosed with avoidant personality disorder. Trait and level of 
personality functioning specifiers can be used to record additional personality features 
that may be present in avoidant personality disorder. For example, other Negative Affec- 
tivity traits (e.g., depressivity, separation insecurity, submissiveness, suspiciousness, hos- 
tility) are not diagnostic criteria for avoidant personality disorder (see Criterion B) but can 
be specified when appropriate. Furthermore, although moderate or greater impairment in 
personality functioning is required for the diagnosis of avoidant personality disorder (Cri- 
terion A), the level of personality functioning also can be specified. 


Borderline Personality Disorder 


Typical features of borderline personality disorder are instability of self-image, personal 
goals, interpersonal relationships, and affects, accompanied by impulsivity, risk taking, 
and/or hostility. Characteristic difficulties are apparent in identity, self-direction, empa- 
thy, and/or intimacy, as described below, along with specific maladaptive traits in the do- 
main of Negative Affectivity, and also Antagonism and/or Disinhibition. 


Proposed Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Moderate or greater impairment in personality functioning, manifested by characteristic 
difficulties in two or more of the following four areas: 


1. Identity: Markedly impoverished, poorly developed, or unstable self-image, often 
associated with excessive self-criticism; chronic feelings of emptiness; dissociative 
states under stress. 

2. Self-direction: |nstability in goals, aspirations, values, or career plans. 

3. Empathy: Compromised ability to recognize the feelings and needs of others asso- 
ciated with interpersonal hypersensitivity (i.e., prone to feel slighted or insulted); per- 
ceptions of others selectively biased toward negative attributes or vulnerabilities. 

4. Intimacy: Intense, unstable, and conflicted close relationships, marked by mistrust, 
neediness, and anxious preoccupation with real or imagined abandonment; close 
relationships often viewed in extremes of idealization and devaluation and alternat- 
ing between overinvolvement and withdrawal. 


B. Four or more of the following seven pathological personality traits, at least one of which 
must be (5) Impulsivity, (6) Risk taking, or (7) Hostility: 

1. Emotional lability (an aspect of Negative Affectivity): Unstable emotional expe- 
riences and frequent mood changes; emotions that are easily aroused, intense, 
and/or out of proportion to events and circumstances. 

2. Anxiousness (an aspect of Negative Affectivity): Intense feelings of nervous- 
ness, tenseness, or panic, often in reaction to interpersonal stresses; worry about 
the negative effects of past unpleasant experiences and future negative possibili- 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 767 


ties; feeling fearful, apprehensive, or threatened by uncertainty; fears of falling 
apart or losing control. 

3. Separation insecurity (an aspect of Negative Affectivity): Fears of rejection by— 
and/or separation from—significant others, associated with fears of excessive de- 
pendency and complete loss of autonomy. 

4. Depressivity (an aspect of Negative Affectivity): Frequent feelings of being down, 
miserable, and/or hopeless; difficulty recovering from such moods; pessimism 
about the future; pervasive shame; feelings of inferior self-worth; thoughts of sui- 
cide and suicidal behavior. 

5. Impulsivity (an aspect of Disinhibition): Acting on the spur of the moment in re- 
sponse to immediate stimuli; acting on a momentary basis without a plan or consid- 
eration of outcomes; difficulty establishing or following plans; a sense of urgency 
and self-harming behavior under emotional distress. 

6. Risk taking (an aspect of Disinhibition): Engagement in dangerous, risky, and po- 
tentially self-damaging activities, unnecessarily and without regard to conse- 
quences; lack of concern for one’s limitations and denial of the reality of personal 
danger. 

7. Hostility (an aspect of Antagonism): Persistent or frequent angry feelings; anger 
or irritability in response to minor slights and insults. 


Specifiers. Trait and level of personality functioning specifiers may be used to record ad- 
ditional personality features that may be present in borderline personality disorder but are 
not required for the diagnosis. For example, traits of Psychoticism (e.g., cognitive and per- 
ceptual dysregulation) are not diagnostic criteria for borderline personality disorder (see 
Criterion B) but can be specified when appropriate. Furthermore, although moderate or 
greater impairment in personality functioning is required for the diagnosis of borderline 
personality disorder (Criterion A), the level of personality functioning can also be specified. 


Narcissistic Personality Disorder 


Typical features of narcissistic personality disorder are variable and vulnerable self-esteem, 
with attempts at regulation through attention and approval seeking, and either overt or 
covert grandiosity. Characteristic difficulties are apparent in identity, self-direction, em- 
pathy, and/or intimacy, as described below, along with specific maladaptive traits in the 
domain of Antagonism. 


Proposed Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Moderate or greater impairment in personality functioning, manifested by characteristic 
difficulties in two or more of the following four areas: 


1. Identity: Excessive reference to others for self-definition and self-esteem regula- 
tion; exaggerated self-appraisal inflated or deflated, or vacillating between extremes; 
emotional regulation mirrors fluctuations in self-esteem. 

2. Self-direction: Goal setting based on gaining approval from others; personal stan- 
dards unreasonably high in order to see oneself as exceptional, or too low based 
on a sense of entitlement; often unaware of own motivations. 

3. Empathy: Impaired ability to recognize or identify with the feelings and needs of 
others; excessively attuned to reactions of others, but only if perceived as relevant 
to self; over- or underestimate of own effect on others. 

4. Intimacy: Relationships largely superficial and exist to serve self-esteem regula- 
tion; mutuality constrained by little genuine interest in others’ experiences and pre- 
dominance of a need for personal gain. 


768 Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 


B. Both of the following pathological personality traits: 


1. Grandiosity (an aspect of Antagonism): Feelings of entitlement, either overt or co- 
vert; self-centeredness; firmly holding to the belief that one is better than others; 
condescension toward others. 

2. Attention seeking (an aspect of Antagonism): Excessive attempts to attract and 
be the focus of the attention of others; admiration seeking. 


Specifiers. Trait and personality functioning specifiers may be used to record additional 
personality features that may be present in narcissistic personality disorder but are not re- 
quired for the diagnosis. For example, other traits of Antagonism (e.g., manipulativeness, de- 
ceitfulness, callousness) are not diagnostic criteria for narcissistic personality disorder (see 
Criterion B) but can be specified when more pervasive antagonistic features (e.g., “malignant 
narcissism”) are present. Other traits of Negative Affectivity (e.g., depressivity, anxiousness) 
can be specified to record more “vulnerable” presentations. Furthermore, although moderate 
or greater impairment in personality functioning is required for the diagnosis of narcissistic 
personality disorder (Criterion A), the level of personality functioning can also be specified. 


Obsessive-Compulsive Personality Disorder 


Typical features of obsessive-compulsive personality disorder are difficulties in establish- 
ing and sustaining close relationships, associated with rigid perfectionism, inflexibility, 
and restricted emotional expression. Characteristic difficulties are apparent in identity, 
self-direction, empathy, and/or intimacy, as described below, along with specific mal- 
adaptive traits in the domains of Negative Affectivity and/or Detachment. 


Proposed Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Moderate or greater impairment in personality functioning, manifested by characteristic 
difficulties in two or more of the following four areas: 


1. Identity: Sense of self derived predominantly from work or productivity; constricted 
experience and expression of strong emotions. 

2. Self-direction: Difficulty completing tasks and realizing goals, associated with rigid 
and unreasonably high and inflexible internal standards of behavior; overly consci- 
entious and moralistic attitudes. 

3. Empathy: Difficulty understanding and appreciating the ideas, feelings, or behav- 
iors of others. 

4. Intimacy: Relationships seen as secondary to work and productivity; rigidity and 
stubbornness negatively affect relationships with others. 


B. Three or more of the following four pathological personality traits, one of which must 
be (1) Rigid perfectionism: 


1. Rigid perfectionism (an aspect of extreme Conscientiousness [the opposite pole 
of Disinhibition]): Rigid insistence on everything being flawless, perfect, and without 
errors or faults, including one’s own and others’ performance; sacrificing of timeli- 
ness to ensure correctness in every detail; believing that there is only one right way 
to do things; difficulty changing ideas and/or viewpoint; preoccupation with details, 
organization, and order. 

2. Perseveration (an aspect of Negative Affectivity): Persistence at tasks long after 
the behavior has ceased to be functional or effective; continuance of the same be- 
havior despite repeated failures. 

3. Intimacy avoidance (an aspect of Detachment): Avoidance of close or romantic 
relationships, interpersonal attachments, and intimate sexual relationships. 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 769 


4. Restricted affectivity (an aspect of Detachment): Little reaction to emotionally 
arousing situations; constricted emotional experience and expression; indifference 
or coldness. 


Specifiers. Trait and personality functioning specifiers may be used to record additional 
personality features that may be present in obsessive-compulsive personality disorder but are 
not required for the diagnosis. For example, other traits of Negative Affectivity (e.g., anxious- 
ness) are not diagnostic criteria for obsessive-compulsive personality disorder (see Criterion B) 
but can be specified when appropriate. Furthermore, although moderate or greater impair- 
ment in personality functioning is required for the diagnosis of obsessive-compulsive person- 
ality disorder (Criterion A), the level of personality functioning can also be specified. 


Schizotypal Personality Disorder 


Typical features of schizotypal personality disorder are impairments in the capacity for so- 
cial and close relationships and eccentricities in cognition, perception, and behavior that 
are associated with distorted self-image and incoherent personal goals and accompanied 
by suspiciousness and restricted emotional expression. Characteristic difficulties are ap- 
parent in identity, self-direction, empathy, and/or intimacy, along with specific maladap- 
tive traits in the domains of Psychoticism and Detachment. 


Proposed Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Moderate or greater impairment in personality functioning, manifested by characteristic 
difficulties in two or more of the following four areas: 


1. Identity: Confused boundaries between self and others; distorted self-concept; 
emotional expression often not congruent with context or internal experience. 

2. Self-direction: Unrealistic or incoherent goals; no clear set of internal standards. 

3. Empathy: Pronounced difficulty understanding impact of own behaviors on others; 
frequent misinterpretations of others’ motivations and behaviors. 

4. Intimacy: Marked impairments in developing close relationships, associated with 
mistrust and anxiety. 


B. Four or more of the following six pathological personality traits: 


1. Cognitive and perceptual dysregulation (an aspect of Psychoticism): Odd or 
unusual thought processes; vague, circumstantial, metaphorical, overelaborate, or 
stereotyped thought or speech; odd sensations in various sensory modalities. 

2. Unusual beliefs and experiences (an aspect of Psychoticism): Thought content 
and views of reality that are viewed by others as bizarre or idiosyncratic; unusual 
experiences of reality. 

3. Eccentricity (an aspect of Psychoticism): Odd, unusual, or bizarre behavior or 
appearance; saying unusual or inappropriate things. 

4. Restricted affectivity (an aspect of Detachment): Little reaction to emotionally 
arousing situations; constricted emotional experience and expression; indifference 
or coldness. 

5. Withdrawal (an aspect of Detachment): Preference for being alone to being with 
others; reticence in social situations; avoidance of social contacts and activity; lack 
of initiation of social contact. 

6. Suspiciousness (an aspect of Detachment): Expectations of—and heightened 
sensitivity to—signs of interpersonal ill-intent or harm; doubts about loyalty and fi- 
delity of others; feelings of persecution. 


770 Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 


Specifiers. Trait and personality functioning specifiers may be used to record additional 
personality features that may be present in schizotypal personality disorder but are not re- 
quired for the diagnosis. For example, traits of Negative Affectivity (e.g., depressivity, 
anxiousness) are not diagnostic criteria for schizotypal personality disorder (see Criterion 
B) but can be specified when appropriate. Furthermore, although moderate or greater im- 
pairment in personality functioning is required for the diagnosis of schizotypal personal- 
ity disorder (Criterion A), the level of personality functioning can also be specified. 


Personality Disorder—Trait Specified 


Proposed Diagnostic Criteria 


A. Moderate or greater impairment in personality functioning, manifested by difficulties in 
two or more of the following four areas: 


1. Identity 
2. Self-direction 
3. Empathy 
4. Intimacy 


B. One or more pathological personality trait domains OR specific trait facets within do- 
mains, considering ALL of the following domains: 


1. Negative Affectivity (vs. Emotional Stability): Frequent and intense experiences 
of high levels of a wide range of negative emotions (e.g., anxiety, depression, guilt/ 
shame, worry, anger), and their behavioral (e.g., self-harm) and interpersonal (e.g., 
dependency) manifestations. 

2. Detachment (vs. Extraversion): Avoidance of socioemotional experience, includ- 
ing both withdrawal from interpersonal interactions, ranging from casual, daily in- 
teractions to friendships to intimate relationships, as well as restricted affective 
experience and expression, particularly limited hedonic capacity. 

3. Antagonism (vs. Agreeableness): Behaviors that put the individual at odds with 
other people, including an exaggerated sense of self-importance and a concomi- 
tant expectation of special treatment, as well as a callous antipathy toward others, 
encompassing both unawareness of others’ needs and feelings, and a readiness 
to use others in the service of self-enhancement. 

4. Disinhibition (vs. Conscientiousness): Orientation toward immediate gratification, 
leading to impulsive behavior driven by current thoughts, feelings, and external 
stimuli, without regard for past learning or consideration of future consequences. 

5. Psychoticism (vs. Lucidity): Exhibiting a wide range of culturally incongruent odd, 
eccentric, or unusual behaviors and cognitions, including both process (e.g., per- 
ception, dissociation) and content (e.g., beliefs). 


Subtypes. Because personality features vary continuously along multiple trait dimen- 
sions, a comprehensive set of potential expressions of PD-TS can be represented by DSM- 
5’s dimensional model of maladaptive personality trait variants (see Table 3, pp. 779-781). 
Thus, subtypes are unnecessary for PD-TS, and instead, the descriptive elements that con- 
stitute personality are provided, arranged in an empirically based model. This arrange- 
ment allows clinicians to tailor the description of each individual’s personality disorder 
profile, considering all five broad domains of personality trait variation and drawing on 
the descriptive features of these domains as needed to characterize the individual. 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 771 


Specifiers. The specific personality features of individuals are always recorded in eval- 
uating Criterion B, so the combination of personality features characterizing an individual 
directly constitutes the specifiers in each case. For example, two individuals who are both 
characterized by emotional lability, hostility, and depressivity may differ such that the 
first individual is characterized additionally by callousness, whereas the second is not. 


Personality Disorder Scoring Algorithms 


The requirement for any two of the four A criteria for each of the six personality disorders 
was based on maximizing the relationship of these criteria to their corresponding person- 
ality disorder. Diagnostic thresholds for the B criteria were also set empirically to minimize 
change in prevalence of the disorders from DSM-IV and overlap with other personality 
disorders, and to maximize relationships with functional impairment. The resulting diag- 
nostic criteria sets represent clinically useful personality disorders with high fidelity, in 
terms of core impairments in personality functioning of varying degrees of severity and 
constellations of pathological personality traits. 


Personality Disorder Diagnosis 


Individuals who have a pattern of impairment in personality functioning and maladaptive 
traits that matches one of the six defined personality disorders should be diagnosed with 
that personality disorder. If an individual also has one or even several prominent traits that 
may have clinical relevance in addition to those required for the diagnosis (e.g., see narcis- 
sistic personality disorder), the option exists for these to be noted as specifiers. Individuals 
whose personality functioning or trait pattern is substantially different from that of any of 
the six specific personality disorders should be diagnosed with PD-TS. The individual may 
not meet the required number of A or B criteria and, thus, have a subthreshold presentation 
of a personality disorder. The individual may have a mix of features of personality disorder 
types or some features that are less characteristic of a type and more accurately considered 
a mixed or atypical presentation. The specific level of impairment in personality function- 
ing and the pathological personality traits that characterize the individual’s personality can 
be specified for PD-TS, using the Level of Personality Functioning Scale (Table 2) and the 
pathological trait taxonomy (Table 3). The current diagnoses of paranoid, schizoid, histri- 
onic, and dependent personality disorders are represented also by the diagnosis of PD-TS; 
these are defined by moderate or greater impairment in personality functioning and can be 
specified by the relevant pathological personality trait combinations. 


Level of Personality Functioning 


Like most human tendencies, personality functioning is distributed on a continuum. Cen- 
tral to functioning and adaptation are individuals’ characteristic ways of thinking about 
and understanding themselves and their interactions with others. An optimally function- 
ing individual has a complex, fully elaborated, and well-integrated psychological world 
that includes a mostly positive, volitional, and adaptive self-concept; a rich, broad, and ap- 
propriately regulated emotional life; and the capacity to behave as a productive member of 
society with reciprocal and fulfilling interpersonal relationships. At the opposite end of 
the continuum, an individual with severe personality pathology has an impoverished, dis- 
organized, and/or conflicted psychological world that includes a weak, unclear, and mal- 
adaptive self-concept; a propensity to negative, dysregulated emotions; and a deficient 
capacity for adaptive interpersonal functioning and social behavior. 


772 Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 


Self- and Interpersonal Functioning 


Dimensional Definition 


Generalized severity may be the most important single predictor of concurrent and pro- 
spective dysfunction in assessing personality psychopathology. Personality disorders are 
optimally characterized by a generalized personality severity continuum with additional 
specification of stylistic elements, derived from personality disorder symptom constella- 
tions and personality traits. At the same time, the core of personality psychopathology is 
impairment in ideas and feelings regarding self and interpersonal relationships; this no- 
tion is consistent with multiple theories of personality disorder and their research bases. The 
components of the Level of Personality Functioning Scale—identity, self-direction, empa- 
thy, and intimacy (see Table 1)—are particularly central in describing a personality func- 
tioning continuum. 

Mental representations of the self and interpersonal relationships are reciprocally in- 
fluential and inextricably tied, affect the nature of interaction with mental health pro- 
fessionals, and can have a significant impact on both treatment efficacy and outcome, 
underscoring the importance of assessing an individual's characteristic self-concept as 
well as views of other people and relationships. Although the degree of disturbance in the 
self and interpersonal functioning is continuously distributed, it is useful to consider the 
level of impairment in functioning for clinical characterization and for treatment planning 
and prognosis. 


Rating Level of Personality Functioning 


To use the Level of Personality Functioning Scale (LPFS), the clinician selects the level that 
most closely captures the individual’s current overall level of impairment in personality func- 
tioning. The rating is necessary for the diagnosis of a personality disorder (moderate or greater 
impairment) and can be used to specify the severity of impairment present for an individual 
with any personality disorder at a given point in time. The LPFS may also be used as a global 
indicator of personality functioning without specification of a personality disorder diagnosis, 
or in the event that personality impairment is subthreshold for a disorder diagnosis. 


Personality Traits 
Definition and Description 


Criterion B in the alternative model involves assessments of personality traits that are 
grouped into five domains. A personality trait is a tendency to feel, perceive, behave, and 
think in relatively consistent ways across time and across situations in which the trait may 
manifest. For example, individuals with a high level of the personality trait of anxiousness 
would tend to feel anxious readily, including in circumstances in which most people 
would be calm and relaxed. Individuals high in trait anxiousness also would perceive sit- 
uations to be anxiety-provoking more frequently than would individuals with lower lev- 
els of this trait, and those high in the trait would tend to behave so as to avoid situations that 
they think would make them anxious. They would thereby tend to think about the world as 
more anxiety provoking than other people. 

Importantly, individuals high in trait anxiousness would not necessarily be anxious at 
all times and in all situations. Individuals’ trait levels also can and do change throughout 
life. Some changes are very general and reflect maturation (e.g., teenagers generally are 
higher on trait impulsivity than are older adults), whereas other changes reflect individ- 
uals’ life experiences. 


Dimensionality of personality traits. All individuals can be located on the spectrum of 
trait dimensions; that is, personality traits apply to everyone in different degrees rather 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 773 


than being present versus absent. Moreover, personality traits, including those identified 
specifically in the Section III model, exist on a spectrum with two opposing poles. For ex- 
ample, the opposite of the trait of callousness is the tendency to be empathic and kind- 
hearted, even in circumstances in which most persons would not feel that way. Hence, al- 
though in Section III this trait is labeled callousness, because that pole of the dimension is 
the primary focus, it could be described in full as callousness versus kind-heartedness. More- 
over, its opposite pole can be recognized and may not be adaptive in all circumstances 
(e.g., individuals who, due to extreme kind-heartedness, repeatedly allow themselves to 
be taken advantage of by unscrupulous others). 


Hierarchical structure of personality. Some trait terms are quite specific (e.g., “talkative”) 
and describe a narrow range of behaviors, whereas others are quite broad (e.g., Detach- 
ment) and characterize a wide range of behavioral propensities. Broad trait dimensions 
are called domains, and specific trait dimensions are called facets. Personality trait domains 
comprise a spectrum of more specific personality facets that tend to occur together. For ex- 
ample, withdrawal and anhedonia are specific trait facets in the trait domain of Detachment. 
Despite some cross-cultural variation in personality trait facets, the broad domains they 
collectively comprise are relatively consistent across cultures. 


The Personality Trait Model 


The Section III personality trait system includes five broad domains of personality trait 
variation—Negative Affectivity (vs. Emotional Stability), Detachment (vs. Extraversion), 
Antagonism (vs. Agreeableness), Disinhibition (vs. Conscientiousness), and Psychoticism 
(vs. Lucidity)—comprising 25 specific personality trait facets. Table 3 provides definitions 
of all personality domains and facets. These five broad domains are maladaptive variants 
of the five domains of the extensively validated and replicated personality model known 
as the “Big Five”, or Five Factor Model of personality (FFM), and are also similar to the do- 
mains of the Personality Psychopathology Five (PSY-5). The specific 25 facets represent a 
list of personality facets chosen for their clinical relevance. 

Although the Trait Model focuses on personality traits associated with psychopathol- 
ogy, there are healthy, adaptive, and resilient personality traits identified as the polar 
opposites of these traits, as noted in the parentheses above (i.e., Emotional Stability, Ex- 
traversion, Agreeableness, Conscientiousness, and Lucidity). Their presence can greatly 
mitigate the effects of mental disorders and facilitate coping and recovery from traumatic 
injuries and other medical illness. 


Distinguishing Traits, Symptoms, and Specific Behaviors 
Although traits are by no means immutable and do change throughout the life span, they 
show relative consistency compared with symptoms and specific behaviors. For example, 
a person may behave impulsively at a specific time for a specific reason (e.g., a person who 
is rarely impulsive suddenly decides to spend a great deal of money on a particular item 
because of an unusual opportunity to purchase something of unique value), but it is only 
when behaviors aggregate across time and circumstance, such that a pattern of behavior 
distinguishes between individuals, that they reflect traits. Nevertheless, it is important to 
recognize, for example, that even people who are impulsive are not acting impulsively all 
of the time. A trait is a tendency or disposition toward specific behaviors; a specific behav- 
ior is an instance or manifestation of a trait. 

Similarly, traits are distinguished from most symptoms because symptoms tend to 
wax and wane, whereas traits are relatively more stable. For example, individuals with 
higher levels of depressivity have a greater likelihood of experiencing discrete episodes of a 
depressive disorder and of showing the symptoms of these disorders, such difficulty con- 
centrating. However, even patients who have a trait propensity to depressivity typically cy- 
cle through distinguishable episodes of mood disturbance, and specific symptoms such as 


774 Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 


difficulty concentrating tend to wax and wane in concert with specific episodes, so they do 
not form part of the trait definition. Importantly, however, symptoms and traits are both 
amenable to intervention, and many interventions targeted at symptoms can affect the 
longer term patterns of personality functioning that are captured by personality traits. 


Assessment of the DSM-5 Section III 
Personality Trait Model 


The clinical utility of the Section III multidimensional personality trait model lies in its ability 
to focus attention on multiple relevant areas of personality variation in each individual patient. 
Rather than focusing attention on the identification of one and only one optimal diagnostic 
label, clinical application of the Section III personality trait model involves reviewing all five 
broad personality domains portrayed in Table 3. The clinical approach to personality is similar 
to the well-known review of systems in clinical medicine. For example, an individual's pre- 
senting complaint may focus on a specific neurological symptom, yet during an initial 
evaluation clinicians still systematically review functioning in all relevant systems (e.g., car- 
diovascular, respiratory, gastrointestinal), lest an important area of diminished functioning 
and corresponding opportunity for effective intervention be missed. 

Clinical use of the Section III personality trait model proceeds similarly. An initial in- 
quiry reviews all five broad domains of personality. This systematic review is facilitated 
by the use of formal psychometric instruments designed to measure specific facets and do- 
mains of personality. For example, the personality trait model is operationalized in the 
Personality Inventory for DSM-5 (PID-5), which can be completed in its self-report form by 
patients and in its informant-report form by those who know the patient well (e.g., a 
spouse). A detailed clinical assessment would involve collection of both patient- and in- 
formant-report data on all 25 facets of the personality trait model. However, if this is not 
possible, due to time or other constraints, assessment focused at the five-domain level is an 
acceptable clinical option when only a general (vs. detailed) portrait of a patient’s person- 
ality is needed (see Criterion B of PD-TS). However, if personality-based problems are the 
focus of treatment, then it will be important to assess individuals’ trait facets as well as do- 
mains. 

Because personality traits are continuously distributed in the population, an approach 
to making the judgment that a specific trait is elevated (and therefore is present for diag- 
nostic purposes) could involve comparing individuals’ personality trait levels with pop- 
ulation norms and/or clinical judgment. If a trait is elevated—that is, formal psychometric 
testing and/or interview data support the clinical judgment of elevation—then it is con- 
sidered as contributing to meeting Criterion B of Section III personality disorders. 


Clinical Utility of the Multidimensional Personality 
Functioning and Trait Model 


Disorder and trait constructs each add value to the other in predicting important anteced- 
ent (e.g., family history, history of child abuse), concurrent (e.g., functional impairment, 
medication use), and predictive (e.g., hospitalization, suicide attempts) variables. DSM-5 
impairments in personality functioning and pathological personality traits each contrib- 
ute independently to clinical decisions about degree of disability; risks for self-harm, vio- 
lence, and criminality; recommended treatment type and intensity; and prognosis—all 
important aspects of the utility of psychiatric diagnoses. Notably, knowing the level of an 
individual's personality functioning and his or her pathological trait profile also provides 
the clinician with a rich base of information and is valuable in treatment planning and in 
predicting the course and outcome of many mental disorders in addition to personality 
disorders. Therefore, assessment of personality functioning and pathological personality 
traits may be relevant whether an individual has a personality disorder or not. 


TABLE 2 Level of Personality Functioning Scale 


Level of 
impairment 


0—Little or no 
impairment 


1—Some 
impairment 


SELF 


Identity 


Has ongoing awareness of a 
unique self; maintains role- 
appropriate boundaries. 

Has consistent and self-regulated 
positive self-esteem, with accu- 
rate self-appraisal. 

Is capable of experiencing, toler- 
ating, and regulating a full 
range of emotions. 


Has relatively intact sense of self, 
with some decrease in clarity of 
boundaries when strong emo- 
tions and mental distress are 
experienced. 

Self-esteem diminished at times, 
with overly critical or some- 
what distorted self-appraisal. 

Strong emotions may be distress- 
ing, associated with a restric- 
tion in range of emotional 
experience. 


Self-direction 


Sets and aspires to reasonable 
goals based on a realistic 
assessment of personal 
capacities. 

Utilizes appropriate stan- 
dards of behavior, attaining 
fulfillment in multiple 
realms. 

Can reflect on, and make con- 
structive meaning of, inter- 
nal experience. 

Is excessively goal-directed, 
somewhat goal-inhibited, or 
conflicted about goals. 


May have an unrealistic or 
socially inappropriate set of 
personal standards, limiting 
some aspects of fulfillment. 


Is able to reflect on internal 
experiences, but may over- 
emphasize a single (e.g., 
intellectual, emotional) type 
of self-knowledge. 


INTERPERSONAL 


Empathy 


Is capable of accurately under- 
standing others’ experiences 
and motivations in most situ- 
ations. 

Comprehends and appreciates 
others’ perspectives, even if 
disagreeing. 

Is aware of the effect of own 
actions on others. 


Is somewhat compromised in 
ability to appreciate and 
understand others’ experi- 
ences; may tend to see others 
as having unreasonable 
expectations or a wish for 
control. 

Although capable of consider- 
ing and understanding dif- 
ferent perspectives, resists 
doing so. 

Has inconsistent awareness of 
effect of own behavior on 
others. 


Intimacy 


Maintains multiple satisfying and 
enduring relationships in personal 
and community life. 

Desires and engages in a number of 
caring, close, and reciprocal rela- 
tionships. 

Strives for cooperation and mutual 
benefit and flexibly responds to a 
range of others’ ideas, emotions, 
and behaviors. 


Is able to establish enduring rela- 
tionships in personal and commu- 
nity life, with some limitations on 
degree of depth and satisfaction. 

Is capable of forming and desires to 
form intimate and reciprocal rela- 
tionships, but may be inhibited in 
meaningful expression and some- 
times constrained if intense emo- 
tions or conflicts arise. 

Cooperation may be inhibited by 
unrealistic standards; somewhat 
limited in ability to respect or 
respond to others’ ideas, emo- 
tions, and behaviors. 


siapsosiq Ailfeuosieg JO} [EPO S-INSG SeAITEUELY 


GZZ 


2—Moderate 


TABLE 2 Level of Personality Functioning Scale (continued) 


SELF 


Identity 


Depends excessively on others 
for identity definition, with 
compromised boundary delin- 
eation. 

Has vulnerable self-esteem con- 
trolled by exaggerated concern 
about external evaluation, with 
a wish for approval. Has sense 
of incompleteness or inferior- 
ity, with compensatory 
inflated, or deflated, 
self-appraisal. 

Emotional regulation depends 
on positive external appraisal. 
Threats to self-esteem may 
engender strong emotions such 
as rage or shame. 


Self-direction 


Goals are more often a means 
of gaining external approval 
than self-generated, and 
thus may lack coherence 
and/or stability. 

Personal standards may be 
unreasonably high (e.g., a 
need to be special or please 
others) or low (e.g., not con- 
sonant with prevailing 
social values). Fulfillment is 
compromised by a sense of 
lack of authenticity. 

Has impaired capacity to 
reflect on internal experi- 
ence. 


INTERPERSONAL 


Empathy 


Is hyperattuned to the experi- 
ence of others, but only with 
respect to perceived rele- 
vance to self. 

Is excessively self-referential; 
significantly compromised 
ability to appreciate and 
understand others’ experi- 
ences and to consider alterna- 
tive perspectives. 

Is generally unaware of or 
unconcerned about effect of 
own behavior on others, or 
unrealistic appraisal of own 
effect. 


Intimacy 


Is capable of forming and desires to 
form relationships in personal and 


community life, but connections 
may be largely superficial. 


Intimate relationships are predomi- 
nantly based on meeting self-regu- 
latory and self-esteem needs, with 
an unrealistic expectation of being 


perfectly understood by others. 


Tends not to view relationships in 


reciprocal terms, and cooperates 


predominantly for personal gain. 


9LL 


Slapsosiq Allyeuosieg JO} [EPO S-INSG eANeWAly 


TABLE 2 Level of Personality Functioning Scale (continued) 


SELF 


Level of 

impairment Identity 

3—Severe Has a weak sense of autonomy/ 
impairment agency; experience of a lack of 


identity, or emptiness. Bound- 
ary definition is poor or rigid: 
may show overidentification 
with others, overemphasis on 
independence from others, or 
vacillation between these. 

Fragile self-esteem is easily influ- 
enced by events, and self-image 
lacks coherence. Self-appraisal 
is un-nuanced: self-loathing, 
self-aggrandizing, or an illogi- 
cal, unrealistic combination. 

Emotions may be rapidly shifting 
or a chronic, unwavering feel- 
ing of despair. 


Self-direction 


Has difficulty establishing 
and/or achieving personal 
goals. 

Internal standards for behav- 
ior are unclear or contradic- 
tory. Life is experienced as 
meaningless or dangerous. 

Has significantly compro- 
mised ability to reflect on 
and understand own mental 
processes. 


INTERPERSONAL 


Empathy 


Ability to consider and under- 
stand the thoughts, feelings, 
and behavior of other people 
is significantly limited; may 
discern very specific aspects 


of others’ experience, particu- 


larly vulnerabilities and suf- 
fering. 

Is generally unable to consider 
alternative perspectives; 
highly threatened by differ- 
ences of opinion or alterna- 
tive viewpoints. 

Is confused about or unaware 
of impact of own actions on 
others; often bewildered 
about peoples’ thoughts and 
actions, with destructive 
motivations frequently 
misattributed to others. 


Intimacy 


Has some desire to form relation- 


ships in community and personal 
life is present, but capacity for pos- 
itive and enduring connections is 
significantly impaired. 


Relationships are based on a strong 


belief in the absolute need for the 
intimate other(s), and/or expecta- 
tions of abandonment or abuse. 
Feelings about intimate involve- 
ment with others alternate 
between fear/rejection and des- 
perate desire for connection. 

Little mutuality: others are concep- 
tualized primarily in terms of how 
they affect the self (negatively or 
positively); cooperative efforts are 
often disrupted due to the percep- 
tion of slights from others. 


siapsosiq Ailyeuosieg JO} [EPO S-INSG eAITEUELY 


ZLL 


TABLE 2 Level of Personality Functioning Scale (continued) 


SELF 


Level of 

impairment Identity 

4—Extreme Experience of a unique self and 
impairment sense of agency /autonomy are 


virtually absent, or are orga- 
nized around perceived exter- 
nal persecution. Boundaries 
with others are confused or 
lacking. 

Has weak or distorted self-image 
easily threatened by interac- 
tions with others; significant 
distortions and confusion 
around self-appraisal. 


Emotions not congruent with 
context or internal experience. 
Hatred and aggression may be 
dominant affects, although they 
may be disavowed and attrib- 
uted to others. 


Self-direction 


Has poor differentiation of 
thoughts from actions, so 
goal-setting ability is 
severely compromised, with 
unrealistic or incoherent 
goals. 

Internal standards for behav- 
ior are virtually lacking. 
Genuine fulfillment is virtu- 
ally inconceivable. 

Is profoundly unable to con- 
structively reflect on own 
experience. Personal moti- 
vations may be unrecog- 
nized and/or experienced 
as external to self. 


INTERPERSONAL 


Empathy Intimacy 


Desire for affiliation is limited 
because of profound disinterest or 
expectation of harm. Engagement 
with others is detached, disorga- 
nized, or consistently negative. 


Has pronounced inability to 
consider and understand 
others’ experience and 
motivation. 

Attention to others’ perspec- 
tives is virtually absent 
(attention is hypervigilant, 
focused on need fulfillment 
and harm avoidance). 


Relationships are conceptualized 
almost exclusively in terms of 
their ability to provide comfort or 
inflict pain and suffering. 

Social /interpersonal behavior is not 
reciprocal; rather, it seeks fulfill- 
ment of basic needs or escape from 
pain. 


Social interactions can be 
confusing and disorienting. 


8ZZ 


Slapsosiq Allyeuosieg JO} [EPO S-INSG eANeUWAly 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 779 


TABLE 3 Definitions of DSM-5 personality disorder trait domains 
and facets 


DOMAINS (Polar Opposites) 


and Facets Definitions 


NEGATIVEAFFECTIVITY Frequent and intense experiences of high levels of a wide range of 
(vs. Emotional Stability) negative emotions (e.g., anxiety, depression, guilt/ shame, worry, 


Emotional lability 


Anxiousness 


Separation insecurity 


Submissiveness 


Hostility 


Perseveration 


Depressivity 
Suspiciousness 


Restricted affectivity 
(lack of) 


DETACHMENT 
(vs. Extraversion) 


Withdrawal 


Intimacy avoidance 


Anhedonia 


Depressivity 


Restricted affectivity 


Suspiciousness 


anger) and their behavioral (e.g., self-harm) and interpersonal (e.g., 
dependency) manifestations. 

Instability of emotional experiences and mood; emotions that are 
easily aroused, intense, and/or out of proportion to events and cir- 
cumstances. 

Feelings of nervousness, tenseness, or panic in reaction to diverse situa- 
tions; frequent worry about the negative effects of past unpleasant 
experiences and future negative possibilities; feeling fearful and 
apprehensive about uncertainty; expecting the worst to happen. 

Fears of being alone due to rejection by—and/or separation from— 
significant others, based in a lack of confidence in one’s ability to 
care for oneself, both physically and emotionally. 

Adaptation of one’s behavior to the actual or perceived interests and 
desires of others even when doing so is antithetical to one’s own 
interests, needs, or desires. 

Persistent or frequent angry feelings; anger or irritability in response 
to minor slights and insults; mean, nasty, or vengeful behavior. See 
also Antagonism. 

Persistence at tasks or in a particular way of doing things long after the 
behavior has ceased to be functional or effective; continuance of the 
same behavior despite repeated failures or clear reasons for stopping. 

See Detachment. 

See Detachment. 


The lack of this facet characterizes low levels of Negative A ffectivity. 
See Detachment for definition of this facet. 


Avoidance of socioemotional experience, including both withdrawal 
from interpersonal interactions (ranging from casual, daily interac- 
tions to friendships to intimate relationships) and restricted affective 
experience and expression, particularly limited hedonic capacity. 

Preference for being alone to being with others; reticence in social sit- 
uations; avoidance of social contacts and activity; lack of initiation 
of social contact. 

Avoidance of close or romantic relationships, interpersonal attach- 
ments, and intimate sexual relationships. 


Lack of enjoyment from, engagement in, or energy for life’s experiences; 
deficits in the capacity to feel pleasure and take interest in things. 

Feelings of being down, miserable, and/or hopeless; difficulty recov- 
ering from such moods; pessimism about the future; pervasive 
shame and/or guilt; feelings of inferior self-worth; thoughts of sui- 
cide and suicidal behavior. 

Little reaction to emotionally arousing situations; constricted emo- 
tional experience and expression; indifference and aloofness in nor- 
matively engaging situations. 

Expectations of—and sensitivity to—signs of interpersonal ill- 
intent or harm; doubts about loyalty and fidelity of others; feelings 
of being mistreated, used, and/or persecuted by others. 


780 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 


TABLE 3 Definitions of DSM-5 personality disorder trait domains 
and facets (continued) 


DOMAINS (Polar Opposites) 


and Facets 


Definitions 


Behaviors that put the individual at odds with other people, includ- 


ANTAGONISM (vs. 
Agreeableness) 


Manipulativeness 
Deceitfulness 


Grandiosity 


Attention seeking 


Callousness 


Hostility 


DISINHIBITION 
(vs. Conscientiousness) 


Irresponsibility 


Impulsivity 


Distractibility 


Risk taking 


Rigid perfectionism (lack of) 


ing an exaggerated sense of self-importance and a concomitant 
expectation of special treatment, as well as a callous antipathy 
toward others, encompassing both an unawareness of others’ 
needs and feelings and a readiness to use others in the service of 
self-enhancement. 


Use of subterfuge to influence or control others; use of seduction, 
charm, glibness, or ingratiation to achieve one’s ends. 


Dishonesty and fraudulence; misrepresentation of self; embellish- 
ment or fabrication when relating events. 


Believing that one is superior to others and deserves special treat- 
ment; self-centeredness; feelings of entitlement; condescension 
toward others. 


Engaging in behavior designed to attract notice and to make oneself 
the focus of others’ attention and admiration. 


Lack of concern for the feelings or problems of others; lack of guilt 
or remorse about the negative or harmful effects of one’s actions 
on others. 


See Negative Affectivity. 


Orientation toward immediate gratification, leading to impulsive 
behavior driven by current thoughts, feelings, and external stim- 
uli, without regard for past learning or consideration of future 
consequences. 


Disregard for—and failure to honor—financial and other obliga- 
tions or commitments; lack of respect for—and lack of follow- 
through on—agreements and promises; carelessness with others’ 
property. 

Acting on the spur of the moment in response to immediate stimuli; 
acting on a momentary basis without a plan or consideration of 
outcomes; difficulty establishing and following plans; a sense of 
urgency and self-harming behavior under emotional distress. 


Difficulty concentrating and focusing on tasks; attention is easily 
diverted by extraneous stimuli; difficulty maintaining goal- 
focused behavior, including both planning and completing tasks. 


Engagement in dangerous, risky, and potentially self-damaging 
activities, unnecessarily and without regard to consequences; lack 
of concern for one’s limitations and denial of the reality of per- 
sonal danger; reckless pursuit of goals regardless of the level of 
risk involved. 


Rigid insistence on everything being flawless, perfect, and without 
errors or faults, including one’s own and others’ performance; sac- 
rificing of timeliness to ensure correctness in every detail; believ- 
ing that there is only one right way to do things; difficulty 
changing ideas and/or viewpoint; preoccupation with details, 
organization, and order. The lack of this facet characterizes low 
levels of Disinhibition. 


Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders 781 


TABLE 3 Definitions of DSM-5 personality disorder trait domains 
and facets (continued) 


DOMAINS (Polar Opposites) 
and Facets Definitions 


PSYCHOTICISM Exhibiting a wide range of culturally incongruent odd, eccentric, or 

(vs. Lucidity) unusual behaviors and cognitions, including both process (e.g., 
perception, dissociation) and content (e.g., beliefs). 

Belief that one has unusual abilities, such as mind reading, telekine- 


sis, thought-action fusion, unusual experiences of reality, includ- 
ing hallucination-like experiences. 


Unusual beliefs and 
experiences 


Eccentricit Odd, unusual, or bizarre behavior, appearance, and/or speech; 
y PP Pp 


having strange and unpredictable thoughts; saying unusual or 
inappropriate things. 
Cognitive and perceptual 


Odd or unusual thought processes and experiences, including 
dysregulation 


depersonalization, derealization, and dissociative experiences; 
mixed sleep-wake state experiences; thought-control experiences. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Conditions for 
Further Study 


Proposed Criteria sets are presented for conditions on which future research is en- 
couraged. The specific items, thresholds, and durations contained in these research crite- 
ria sets were set by expert consensus—informed by literature review, data reanalysis, and 
field trial results, where available—and are intended to provide a common language for 
researchers and clinicians who are interested in studying these disorders. It is hoped that 
such research will allow the field to better understand these conditions and will inform 
decisions about possible placement in forthcoming editions of DSM. The DSM-5 Task 
Force and Work Groups subjected each of these proposed criteria sets to a careful empir- 
ical review and invited wide commentary from the field as well as from the general public. 
The Task Force determined that there was insufficient evidence to warrant inclusion of 
these proposals as official mental disorder diagnoses in Section II. These proposed criteria 
sets are not intended for clinical use; only the criteria sets and disorders in Section II of 
DSM-5 are officially recognized and can be used for clinical purposes. 


Attenuated Psychosis Syndrome 


Proposed Criteria 


A. Atleast one of the following symptoms is present in attenuated form, with relatively in- 
tact reality testing, and is of sufficient severity or frequency to warrant clinical attention: 
1. Delusions. 
2. Hallucinations. 
3. Disorganized speech. 


. Symptom(s) must have been present at least once per week for the past month. 

. Symptom(s) must have begun or worsened in the past year. 

. Symptom (s) is sufficiently distressing and disabling to the individual to warrant clinical 

attention. 

E. Symptom(s) is not better explained by another mental disorder, including a depressive 
or bipolar disorder with psychotic features, and is not attributable to the physiological 
effects of a substance or another medical condition. 

F. Criteria for any psychotic disorder have never been met. 


00 W 


Diagnostic Features 


Attenuated psychotic symptoms, as defined in Criterion A, are psychosis-like but below the 
threshold for a full psychotic disorder. Compared with psychotic disorders, the symptoms 
are less severe and more transient, and insight is relatively maintained. A diagnosis of atten- 
uated psychosis syndrome requires state psychopathology associated with functional 
impairment rather than long-standing trait pathology. The psychopathology has not pro- 
gressed to full psychotic severity. Attenuated psychosis syndrome is a disorder based on the 
manifest pathology and impaired function and distress. Changes in experiences and behav- 


783 


784 Conditions for Further Study 


iors are noted by the individual and/or others, suggesting a change in mental state (i.e., the 
symptoms are of sufficient severity or frequency to warrant clinical attention) (Criterion A). 
Attenuated delusions (Criterion A1) may have suspiciousness/persecutory ideational con- 
tent, including persecutory ideas of reference. The individual may have a guarded, distrust- 
ful attitude. When the delusions are moderate in severity, the individual views others as 
untrustworthy and may be hypervigilant or sense ill will in others. When the delusions are 
severe but still within the attenuated range, the individual entertains loosely organized be- 
liefs about danger or hostile intention, but the delusions do not have the fixed nature that is 
necessary for the diagnosis of a psychotic disorder. Guarded behavior in the interview can 
interfere with the ability to gather information. Reality testing and perspective can be elic- 
ited with nonconfirming evidence, but the propensity for viewing the world as hostile and 
dangerous remains strong. Attenuated delusions may have grandiose content presenting as 
an unrealistic sense of superior capacity. When the delusions are moderate, the individual 
harbors notions of being gifted, influential, or special. When the delusions are severe, the in- 
dividual has beliefs of superiority that often alienate friends and worry relatives. Thoughts 
of being special may lead to unrealistic plans and investments, yet skepticism about these at- 
titudes can be elicited with persistent questioning and confrontation. 

Attenuated hallucinations (Criterion A2) include alterations in sensory perceptions, 
usually auditory and/or visual. When the hallucinations are moderate, the sounds and 
images are often unformed (e.g., shadows, trails, halos, murmurs, rumbling), and they are 
experienced as unusual or puzzling. When the hallucinations are severe, these experiences 
become more vivid and frequent (i.e., recurring illusions or hallucinations that capture at- 
tention and affect thinking and concentration). These perceptual abnormalities may dis- 
rupt behavior, but skepticism about their reality can still be induced. 

Disorganized communication (Criterion A3) may manifest as odd speech (vague, meta- 
phorical, overelaborate, stereotyped), unfocused speech (confused, muddled, too fast or too 
slow, wrong words, irrelevant context, off track), or meandering speech (circumstantial, tan- 
gential). When the disorganization is moderately severe, the individual frequently gets into 
irrelevant topics but responds easily to clarifying questions. Speech may be odd but under- 
standable. At the moderately severe level, speech becomes meandering and circumstantial, 
and when the disorganization is severe, the individual fails to get to the point without 
external guidance (tangential). At the severe level, some thought blocking and/or loose as- 
sociations may occur infrequently, especially when the individual is under pressure, but re- 
orienting questions quickly return structure and organization to the conversation. 

The individual realizes that changes in mental state and/or in relationships are taking 
place. He or she maintains reasonable insight into the psychotic-like experiences and gen- 
erally appreciates that altered perceptions are not real and magical ideation is not compel- 
ling. The individual must experience distress and/or impaired performance in social or role 
functioning (Criterion D), and the individual or responsible others must note the changes 
and express concern, such that clinical care is sought (Criterion A). 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


The individual may experience magical thinking, perceptual aberrations, difficulty in con- 
centration, some disorganization in thought or behavior, excessive suspiciousness, anxi- 
ety, social withdrawal, and disruption in sleep-wake cycle. Impaired cognitive function 
and negative symptoms are often observed. Neuroimaging variables distinguish cohorts 
with attenuated psychosis syndrome from normal control cohorts with patterns similar to, 
but less severe than, that observed in schizophrenia. However, neuroimaging data is not 
diagnostic at the individual level. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of attenuated psychosis syndrome is unknown. Symptoms in Criterion A 
are not uncommon in the non-help-seeking population, ranging from 8%-13% for hallu- 


Conditions for Further Study 785 


cinatory experiences and delusional thinking. There appears to be a slight male prepon- 
derance for attenuated psychosis syndrome. 


Development and Course 


Onset of attenuated psychosis syndrome is usually in mid-to-late adolescence or early 
adulthood. It may be preceded by normal development or evidence for impaired cogni- 
tion, negative symptoms, and/or impaired social development. In help-seeking cohorts, 
approximately 18% in 1 year and 32% in 3 years may progress symptomatically and met 
criteria for a psychotic disorder. In some cases, the syndrome may transition to a depres- 
sive or bipolar disorder with psychotic features, but development to a schizophrenia spec- 
trum disorder is more frequent. It appears that the diagnosis is best applied to individuals 
ages 15-35 years. Long-term course is not yet described beyond 7-12 years. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Temperamental. Factors predicting prognosis of attenuated psychosis syndrome have 
not been definitively characterized, but the presence of negative symptoms, cognitive im- 
pairment, and poor functioning are associated with poor outcome and increase risk of 
transition to psychosis. 


Genetic and physiological. A family history of psychosis places the individual with at- 
tenuated psychosis syndrome at increased risk for developing a full psychotic disorder. 
Structural, functional, and neurochemical imaging data are associated with increased risk 
of transition to psychosis. 


Functional Consequences of 
Attenuated Psychosis Syndrome 


Many individuals may experience functional impairments. Modest-to-moderate impair- 
ment in social and role functioning may persist even with abatement of symptoms. A sub- 
stantial portion of individuals with the diagnosis will improve over time; many continue 
to have mild symptoms and impairment, and many others will have a full recovery. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Brief psychotic disorder. When symptoms of attenuated psychosis syndrome initially 
manifest, they may resemble symptoms of brief psychotic disorder. However, in attenu- 
ated psychosis syndrome, the symptoms do not cross the psychosis threshold and reality 
testing /insight remains intact. 


Schizotypal personality disorder. Schizotypal personality disorder, although having 
symptomatic features that are similar to those of attenuated psychosis syndrome, is a rel- 
atively stable trait disorder not meeting the state-dependent aspects (Criterion C) of atten- 
uated psychosis syndrome. In addition, a broader array of symptoms is required for 
schizotypal personality disorder, although in the early stages of presentation it may re- 
semble attenuated psychosis syndrome. 


Depressive or bipolar disorders. Reality distortions that are temporally limited to an 
episode of a major depressive disorder or bipolar disorder and are descriptively more 
characteristic of those disorders do not meet Criterion E for attenuated psychosis syn- 
drome. For example, feelings of low self-esteem or attributions of low regard from others 
in the context of major depressive disorder would not qualify for comorbid attenuated 
psychosis syndrome. 


Anxiety disorders. Reality distortions that are temporally limited to an episode of an 
anxiety disorder and are descriptively more characteristic of an anxiety disorder do not 


786 Conditions for Further Study 


meet Criterion E for attenuated psychosis syndrome. For example, a feeling of being the 
focus of undesired attention in the context of social anxiety disorder would not qualify for 
comorbid attenuated psychosis syndrome. 


Bipolar II disorder. Reality distortions that are temporally limited to an episode of ma- 
nia or hypomania and are descriptively more characteristic of bipolar disorder do not meet 
Criterion E for attenuated psychosis syndrome. For example, inflated self-esteem in the 
context of pressured speech and reduced need for sleep would not qualify for comorbid at- 
tenuated psychosis syndrome. 


Borderline personality disorder. Reality distortions that are concomitant with border- 
line personality disorder and are descriptively more characteristic of it do not meet Crite- 
rion E for attenuated psychosis syndrome. For example, a sense of being unable to 
experience feelings in the context of an intense fear of real or imagined abandonment and 
recurrent self-mutilation would not qualify for comorbid attenuated psychosis syndrome. 


Adjustment reaction of adolescence. Mild, transient symptoms typical of normal de- 
velopment and consistent with the degree of stress experienced do not qualify for attenu- 
ated psychosis syndrome. 


Extreme end of perceptual aberration and magical thinking in the non-ill population. 
This diagnostic possibility should be strongly entertained when reality distortions are not 
associated with distress and functional impairment and need for care. 


Substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder. Substance use is common among 
individuals whose symptoms meet attenuated psychosis syndrome criteria. When other- 
wise qualifying characteristic symptoms are strongly temporally related to substance use 
episodes, Criterion E for attenuated psychosis syndrome may not be met, and a diagnosis 
of substance /medication-induced psychotic disorder may be preferred. 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. A history of attentional impairment does not 
exclude a current attenuated psychosis syndrome diagnosis. Earlier attentional impair- 
ment may bea prodromal condition or comorbid attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. 


Comorbidity 


Individuals with attenuated psychosis syndrome often experience anxiety and/or depres- 
sion. Some individuals with an attenuated psychosis syndrome diagnosis will progress to 
another diagnosis, including anxiety, depressive, bipolar, and personality disorders. In such 
cases, the psychopathology associated with the attenuated psychosis syndrome diagnosis is 
reconceptualized as the prodromal phase of another disorder, not a comorbid condition. 


Depressive Episodes With Short-Duration Hypomania 


Proposed Criteria 


Lifetime experience of at least one major depressive episode meeting the following 

criteria: 

A. Five (or more) of the following criteria have been present during the same 2-week pe- 
riod and represent a change from previous functioning; at least one of the symptoms 
is either (1) depressed mood or (2) loss of interest or pleasure. (Note: Do not include 
symptoms that are clearly attributable to a medical condition.) 


1. Depressed mood most of the day, nearly every day, as indicated by either subjec- 
tive report (e.g., feels sad, empty, or hopeless) or observation made by others (e.g., 
appears tearful). (Note: In children and adolescents, can be irritable mood.) 

2. Markedly diminished interest or pleasure in all, or almost all, activities most of the 
day, nearly every day (as indicated by either subjective account or observation). 


Conditions for Further Study 787 


3. Significant weight loss when not dieting or weight gain (e.g., a change of more than 
5% of body weight in a month), or decrease or increase in appetite nearly every 
day. (Note: In children, consider failure to make expected weight gain.) 

4. Insomnia or hypersomnia nearly every day. 

5. Psychomotor agitation or retardation nearly every day (observable by others, not 
merely subjective feelings of restlessness or being slowed down). 

6. Fatigue or loss of energy nearly every day. 

7. Feelings of worthlessness or excessive or inappropriate guilt (which may be delu- 
sional) nearly every day (not merely self-reproach or guilt about being sick). 

8. Diminished ability to think or concentrate, or indecisiveness, nearly every day (ei- 
ther by subjective account or as observed by others). 

9. Recurrent thoughts of death (not just fear of dying), recurrent suicidal ideation with- 
out a specific plan, or a suicide attempt or a specific plan for committing suicide. 


. The symptoms cause clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 


tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

The disturbance is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance or an- 
other medical condition. 

The disturbance is not better explained by schizoaffective disorder and is not superim- 
posed on schizophrenia, schizophreniform disorder, delusional disorder, or other spec- 
ified or unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder. 


At least two lifetime episodes of hypomanic periods that involve the required crite- 
rion symptoms below but are of insufficient duration (at least 2 days but less than 
4 consecutive days) to meet criteria for a hypomanic episode. The criterion symp- 
toms are as follows: 


A. 


B. 


A distinct period of abnormally and persistently elevated, expansive, or irritable mood 

and abnormally and persistently increased goal-directed activity or energy. 

During the period of mood disturbance and increased energy and activity, three (or more) 

of the following symptoms have persisted (four if the mood is only irritable), represent a no- 

ticeable change from usual behavior, and have been present to a significant degree: 

Inflated self-esteem or grandiosity. 

Decreased need for sleep (e.g., feels rested after only 3 hours of sleep). 

More talkative than usual or pressured to keep talking. 

Flight of ideas or subjective experience that thoughts are racing. 

Distractibility (i.e., attention too easily drawn to unimportant or irrelevant external 

stimuli), as reported or observed. 

6. Increase in goal-directed activity (either socially, at work or school, or sexually) or 
psychomotor agitation. 

7. Excessive involvement in activities that have a high potential for painful conse- 
quences (e.g., the individual engages in unrestrained buying sprees, sexual indis- 
cretions, or foolish business investments). 


1 On Na 


The episode is associated with an unequivocal change in functioning that is uncharac- 
teristic of the individual when not symptomatic. 

The disturbance in mood and the change in functioning are observable by others. 
The episode is not severe enough to cause marked impairment in social or occupa- 
tional functioning or to necessitate hospitalization. If there are psychotic features, the 
episode is, by definition, manic. 

The episode is not attributable to the physiological effects of a substance (e.g., a drug 
of abuse, a medication or other treatment). 


788 Conditions for Further Study 


Diagnostic Features 


Individuals with short-duration hypomania have experienced at least one major depres- 
sive episode as well as at least two episodes of 2-3 days’ duration in which criteria for a hy- 
pomanic episode were met (except for symptom duration). These episodes are of sufficient 
intensity to be categorized as a hypomanic episode but do not meet the 4-day duration re- 
quirement. Symptoms are present to a significant degree, such that they represent a no- 
ticeable change from the individual’s normal behavior. 

An individual with a history of a syndromal hypomanic episode and a major depres- 
sive episode by definition has bipolar II disorder, regardless of current duration of hypo- 
manic symptoms. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Individuals who have experienced both short-duration hypomania and a major depres- 
sive episode, with their increased comorbidity with substance use disorders and a greater 
family history of bipolar disorder, more closely resemble individuals with bipolar disor- 
der than those with major depressive disorder. 

Differences have also been found between individuals with short-duration hypomania 
and those with syndromal bipolar disorder. Work impairment was greater for individuals 
with syndromal bipolar disorder, as was the estimated average number of episodes. Indi- 
viduals with short-duration hypomania may exhibit less severity than individuals with 
syndromal hypomanic episodes, including less mood lability. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of short-duration hypomania is unclear, since the criteria are new as of this 
edition of the manual. Using somewhat different criteria, however, it has been estimated 
that short-duration hypomania occurs in 2.8% of the population (compared with hypoma- 
nia or mania in 5.5% of the population). Short-duration hypomania may be more common 
in females, who may present with more features of atypical depression. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. A family history of mania is two to three times more common in 
individuals with short-duration hypomania compared with the general population, but less 
than half as common as in individuals with a history of syndromal mania or hypomania. 


Suicide Risk 


Individuals with short-duration hypomania have higher rates of suicide attempts than 
healthy individuals, although not as high as the rates in individuals with syndromal bipo- 
lar disorder. 


Functional Consequences of Short-Duration Hypomania 


Functional impairments associated specifically with short-duration hypomania are as yet 
not fully determined. However, research suggests that individuals with this disorder have 
less work impairment than individuals with syndromal bipolar disorder but more comor- 
bid substance use disorders, particularly alcohol use disorder, than individuals with major 
depressive disorder. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Bipolar II disorder. Bipolar II disorder is characterized by a period of at least 4 days of 
hypomanic symptoms, whereas short-duration hypomania is characterized by periods of 


Conditions for Further Study 789 


2-3 days of hypomanic symptoms. Once an individual has experienced a hypomanic ep- 
isode (4 days or more), the diagnosis becomes and remains bipolar II disorder regardless 
of future duration of hypomanic symptom periods. 


Major depressive disorder. Major depressive disorder is also characterized by at least 
one lifetime major depressive episode. However, the additional presence of at least two life- 
time periods of 2-3 days of hypomanic symptoms leads to a diagnosis of short-duration hy- 
pomania rather than to major depressive disorder. 


Major depressive disorder with mixed features. Both major depressive disorder with 
mixed features and short-duration hypomania are characterized by the presence of some 
hypomanic symptoms and a major depressive episode. However, major depressive disor- 
der with mixed features is characterized by hypomanic features present concurrently with 
a major depressive episode, while individuals with short-duration hypomania experience 
subsyndromal hypomania and fully syndromal major depression at different times. 


Bipolar | disorder. Bipolar I disorder is differentiated from short-duration hypomania 
by at least one lifetime manic episode, which is longer (at least 1 week) and more severe 
(causes more impaired social functioning) than a hypomanic episode. An episode (of any 
duration) that involves psychotic symptoms or necessitates hospitalization is by definition 
a manic episode rather than a hypomanic one. 


Cyclothymic disorder. While cyclothymic disorder is characterized by periods of de- 
pressive symptoms and periods of hypomanic symptoms, the lifetime presence of a major 
depressive episode precludes the diagnosis of cyclothymic disorder. 


Comorbidity 

Short-duration hypomania, similar to full hypomanic episodes, has been associated with 
higher rates of comorbid anxiety disorders and substance use disorders than are found in 
the general population. 


Persistent Complex Bereavement Disorder 


Proposed Criteria 


A. The individual experienced the death of someone with whom he or she had a close re- 
lationship. 

B. Since the death, at least one of the following symptoms is experienced on more days 
than not and to a clinically significant degree and has persisted for at least 12 months 
after the death in the case of bereaved adults and 6 months for bereaved children: 


1. Persistent yearning/longing for the deceased. In young children, yearning may be 
expressed in play and behavior, including behaviors that reflect being separated 
from, and also reuniting with, a caregiver or other attachment figure. 

2. Intense sorrow and emotional pain in response to the death. 

Preoccupation with the deceased. 

4. Preoccupation with the circumstances of the death. In children, this preoccupation 
with the deceased may be expressed through the themes of play and behavior and 
may extend to preoccupation with possible death of others close to them. 


w 


C. Since the death, at least six of the following symptoms are experienced on more days 
than not and to a clinically significant degree, and have persisted for at least 12 months 
after the death in the case of bereaved adults and 6 months for bereaved children: 


790 Conditions for Further Study 


Reactive distress to the death 


1. Marked difficulty accepting the death. In children, this is dependent on the child’s 

capacity to comprehend the meaning and permanence of death. 

Experiencing disbelief or emotional numbness over the loss. 

Difficulty with positive reminiscing about the deceased. 

Bitterness or anger related to the loss. 

Maladaptive appraisals about oneself in relation to the deceased or the death (e.g., 

self-blame). 

6. Excessive avoidance of reminders of the loss (e.g., avoidance of individuals, 
places, or situations associated with the deceased; in children, this may include 
avoidance of thoughts and feelings regarding the deceased). 


Social/identity disruption 


OV ON 


7. A desire to die in order to be with the deceased. 
8. Difficulty trusting other individuals since the death. 
9. Feeling alone or detached from other individuals since the death. 
10. Feeling that life is meaningless or empty without the deceased, or the belief that 
one cannot function without the deceased. 
11. Confusion about one’s role in life, or a diminished sense of one’s identity (e.g., feel- 
ing that a part of oneself died with the deceased). 
12. Difficulty or reluctance to pursue interests since the loss or to plan for the future 
(e.g., friendships, activities). 


D. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, occupa- 
tional, or other important areas of functioning. 

E. The bereavement reaction is out of proportion to or inconsistent with cultural, religious, 
or age-appropriate norms. 

Specity if: 
With traumatic bereavement: Bereavement due to homicide or suicide with persis- 
tent distressing preoccupations regarding the traumatic nature of the death (often in re- 
sponse to loss reminders), including the deceased’s last moments, degree of suffering 
and mutilating injury, or the malicious or intentional nature of the death. 


Diagnostic Features 


Persistent complex bereavement disorder is diagnosed only if at least 12 months (6 months 
in children) have elapsed since the death of someone with whom the bereaved had a close 
relationship (Criterion A). This time frame discriminates normal grief from persistent 
grief. The condition typically involves a persistent yearning /longing for the deceased 
(Criterion B1), which may be associated with intense sorrow and frequent crying (Crite- 
rion B2) or preoccupation with the deceased (Criterion B3). The individual may also be 
preoccupied with the manner in which the person died (Criterion B4). 

Six additional symptoms are required, including marked difficulty accepting that the in- 
dividual has died (Criterion C1) (e.g. preparing meals for them), disbelief that the individual is 
dead (Criterion C2), distressing memories of the deceased (Criterion C3), anger over the loss 
(Criterion C4), maladaptive appraisals about oneself in relation to the deceased or the death 
(Criterion C5), and excessive avoidance of reminders of the loss (Criterion C6). Individuals 
may also report a desire to die because they wish to be with the deceased (Criterion C7); be dis- 
trustful of others (Criterion C8); feel isolated (Criterion C9); believe that life has no meaning or 
purpose without the deceased (Criterion C10); experience a diminished sense of identity in 
which they feel a part of themselves has died or been lost (Criterion C11); or have difficulty en- 
gaging in activities, pursuing relationships, or planning for the future (Criterion C12). 


Conditions for Further Study 791 


Persistent complex bereavement disorder requires clinically significant distress or im- 
pairment in psychosocial functioning (Criterion D). The nature and severity of grief must 
be beyond expected norms for the relevant cultural setting, religious group, or develop- 
mental stage (Criterion E). Although there are variations in how grief can manifest, the 
symptoms of persistent complex bereavement disorder occur in both genders and in di- 
verse social and cultural groups. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Some individuals with persistent complex bereavement disorder experience hallucina- 
tions of the deceased (auditory or visual) in which they temporarily perceive the deceased’s 
presence (e.g., seeing the deceased sitting in his or her favorite chair). They may also ex- 
perience diverse somatic complaints (e.g., digestive complaints, pain, fatigue), including 
symptoms experienced by the deceased. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of persistent complex bereavement disorder is approximately 2.4%—4.8%. 
The disorder is more prevalent in females than in males. 


Development and Course 


Persistent complex bereavement disorder can occur at any age, beginning after the age of 
1 year. Symptoms usually begin within the initial months after the death, although there 
may be a delay of months, or even years, before the full syndrome appears. Although grief 
responses commonly appear immediately following bereavement, these reactions are not 
diagnosed as persistent complex bereavement disorder unless the symptoms persist be- 
yond 12 months (6 months for children). 

Young children may experience the loss of a primary caregiver as traumatic, given the 
disorganizing effects the caregiver’s absence can have ona child’s coping response. In chil- 
dren, the distress may be expressed in play and behavior, developmental regressions, and 
anxious or protest behavior at times of separation and reunion. Separation distress may be 
predominant in younger children, and social/identity distress and risk for comorbid de- 
pression can increasingly manifest in older children and adolescents. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Risk for persistent complex bereavement disorder is heightened by in- 
creased dependency on the deceased person prior to the death and by the death of a child. 
Disturbances in caregiver support increase the risk for bereaved children. 


Genetic and physiological. Risk for the disorder is heightened by the bereaved individ- 
ual being female. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 

The symptoms of persistent complex bereavement disorder are observed across cultural 
settings, but grief responses may manifest in culturally specific ways. Diagnosis of the dis- 
order requires that the persistent and severe responses go beyond cultural norms of grief 
responses and not be better explained by culturally specific mourning rituals. 


Suicide Risk 


Individuals with persistent complex bereavement disorder frequently report suicidal 
ideation. 


792 Conditions for Further Study 


Functional Consequences of 
Persistent Complex Bereavement Disorder 


Persistent complex bereavement disorder is associated with deficits in work and social func- 
tioning and with harmful health behaviors, such as increased tobacco and alcohol use. It is also 
associated with marked increases in risks for serious medical conditions, including cardiac dis- 
ease, hypertension, cancer, immunological deficiency, and reduced quality of life. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Normal grief. Persistent complex bereavement disorder is distinguished from normal 
grief by the presence of severe grief reactions that persist at least 12 months (or 6 months in 
children) after the death of the bereaved. It is only when severe levels of grief response per- 
sist at least 12 months following the death and interfere with the individual’s capacity to 
function that persistent complex bereavement disorder is diagnosed. 


Depressive disorders. Persistent complex bereavement disorder, major depressive dis- 
order, and persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia) share sadness, crying, and suicidal 
thinking. Whereas major depressive disorder and persistent depressive disorder can share 
depressed mood with persistent complex bereavement disorder, the latter is characterized 
by a focus on the loss. 


Posttraumatic stress disorder. Individuals who experience bereavement as a result of trau- 
matic death may develop both posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD) and persistent complex 
bereavement disorder. Both conditions can involve intrusive thoughts and avoidance. 
Whereas intrusions in PTSD revolve around the traumatic event, intrusive memories in per- 
sistent complex bereavement disorder focus on thoughts about many aspects of the relation- 
ship with the deceased, including positive aspects of the relationship and distress over the 
separation. In individuals with the traumatic bereavement specifier of persistent complex be- 
reavement disorder, the distressing thoughts or feelings may be more overtly related to the 
manner of death, with distressing fantasies of what happened. Both persistent complex be- 
reavement disorder and PTSD can involve avoidance of reminders of distressing events. 
Whereas avoidance in PTSD is characterized by consistent avoidance of internal and external 
reminders of the traumatic experience, in persistent complex bereavement disorder, there is 
also a preoccupation with the loss and yearning for the deceased, which is absent in PTSD. 
Separation anxiety disorder. Separation anxiety disorder is characterized by anxiety 
about separation from current attachment figures, whereas persistent complex bereavement 
disorder involves distress about separation from a deceased individual. 


Comorbidity 


The most common comorbid disorders with persistent complex bereavement disorder are 
major depressive disorder, PTSD, and substance use disorders. PTSD is more frequently 
comorbid with persistent complex bereavement disorder when the death occurred in trau- 
matic or violent circumstances. 


Caffeine Use Disorder 


Proposed Criteria 


A problematic pattern of caffeine use leading to clinically significant impairment or distress, as 

manifested by at least the first three of the following criteria occurring within a 12-month period: 

1. A persistent desire or unsuccessful efforts to cut down or control caffeine use. 

2. Continued caffeine use despite knowledge of having a persistent or recurrent physical 
or psychological problem that is likely to have been caused or exacerbated by caffeine. 


Conditions for Further Study 793 


3. Withdrawal, as manifested by either of the following: 


a. The characteristic withdrawal syndrome for caffeine. 
b. Caffeine (or a closely related) substance is taken to relieve or avoid withdrawal 
symptoms. 


4. Caffeine is often taken in larger amounts or over a longer period than was intended. 

5. Recurrent caffeine use resulting in a failure to fulfill major role obligations at work, 
school, or home (e.g., repeated tardiness or absences from work or school related to 
caffeine use or withdrawal). 

6. Continued caffeine use despite having persistent or recurrent social or interpersonal 
problems caused or exacerbated by the effects of caffeine (e.g., arguments with 
spouse about consequences of use, medical problems, cost). 

7. Tolerance, as defined by either of the following: 


a. Aneed for markedly increased amounts of caffeine to achieve desired effect. 
b. Markedly diminished effect with continued use of the same amount of caffeine. 


8. A great deal of time is spent in activities necessary to obtain caffeine, use caffeine, or 
recover from its effects. 
9. Craving or a strong desire or urge to use caffeine. 


A diagnosis of substance dependence due to caffeine is recognized by the World Health 
Organization in ICD-10. Since the publication of DSM-IV in 1994, considerable research on 
caffeine dependence has been published, and several recent reviews provide a current 
analysis of this literature. There is now sufficient evidence to warrant inclusion of caffeine 
use disorder as a research diagnosis in DSM-5 to encourage additional research. The work- 
ing diagnostic algorithm proposed for the study of caffeine use disorder differs from that 
of the other substance use disorders, reflecting the need to identify only cases that have 
sufficient clinical importance to warrant the labeling of a mental disorder. A key goal of in- 
cluding caffeine use disorder in this section of DSM-5 is to stimulate research that will 
determine the reliability, validity, and prevalence of caffeine use disorder based on the 
proposed diagnostic schema, with particular attention to the association of the diagnosis 
with functional impairments as part of validity testing. 

The proposed criteria for caffeine use disorder reflect the need for a diagnostic thresh- 
old higher than that used for the other substance use disorders. Such a threshold is in- 
tended to prevent overdiagnosis of caffeine use disorder due to the high rate of habitual 
nonproblematic daily caffeine use in the general population. 


Diagnostic Features 


Caffeine use disorder is characterized by the continued use of caffeine and failure to con- 
trol use despite negative physical and/or psychological consequences. In a survey of the 
general population, 14% of caffeine users met the criterion of use despite harm, with most 
reporting that a physician or counselor had advised them to stop or reduce caffeine use 
within the last year. Medical and psychological problems attributed to caffeine included 
heart, stomach, and urinary problems, and complaints of anxiety, depression, insomnia, 
irritability, and difficulty thinking. In the same survey, 45% of caffeine users reported de- 
sire or unsuccessful efforts to control caffeine use, 18% reported withdrawal, 8% reported 
tolerance, 28% used more than intended, and 50% reported spending a great deal of time 
using caffeine. In addition, 19% reported a strong desire for caffeine that they could not re- 
sist, and less than 1% reported that caffeine had interfered with social activities. 

Among those seeking treatment for quitting problematic caffeine use, 88% reported 
having made prior serious attempts to modify caffeine use, and 43% reported having been 
advised by a medical professional to reduce or eliminate caffeine. Ninety-three percent 
endorsed signs and symptoms meeting DSM-IV criteria for caffeine dependence, with the 


794 Conditions for Further Study 


most commonly endorsed criteria being withdrawal (96%), persistent desire or unsuccess- 
ful efforts to control use (89%), and use despite knowledge of physical or psychological 
problems caused by caffeine (87%). The most common reasons for wanting to modify caf- 
feine use were health-related (59%) and a desire to not be dependent on caffeine (35%). 
The DSM-5 discussion of caffeine withdrawal in the Section II chapter “Substance- 
Related and Addictive Disorders” provides information on the features of the withdrawal 
criterion. It is well documented that habitual caffeine users can experience a well-defined 
withdrawal syndrome upon acute abstinence from caffeine, and many caffeine-dependent 
individuals report continued use of caffeine to avoid experiencing withdrawal symptoms. 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of caffeine use disorder in the general population is unclear. Based on all 
seven generic DSM-IV-TR criteria for dependence, 30% of current caffeine users may have 
met DSM-IV criteria for a diagnosis of caffeine dependence, with endorsement of three or 
more dependence criteria, during the past year. When only four of the seven criteria (the 
three primary criteria proposed above plus tolerance) are used, the prevalence appears to 
drop to 9%. Thus, the expected prevalence of caffeine use disorder among regular caffeine 
users is likely less than 9%. Given that approximately 75%-80% of the general population 
uses caffeine regularly, the estimated prevalence would be less than 7%. Among regular 
caffeine drinkers at higher risk for caffeine use problems (e.g., high school and college stu- 
dents, individuals in drug treatment, and individuals at pain clinics who have recent his- 
tories of alcohol or illicit drug misuse), approximately 20% may have a pattern of use that 
meets all three of the proposed criteria in Criterion A. 


Development and Course 


Individuals whose pattern of use meets criteria for a caffeine use disorder have shown a 
wide range of daily caffeine intake and have been consumers of various types of caffein- 
ated products (e.g., coffee, soft drinks, tea) and medications. A diagnosis of caffeine use 
disorder has been shown to prospectively predict a greater incidence of caffeine reinforce- 
ment and more severe withdrawal. 

There has been no longitudinal or cross-sectional lifespan research on caffeine use dis- 
order. Caffeine use disorder has been identified in both adolescents and adults. Rates of 
caffeine consumption and overall level of caffeine consumption tend to increase with age 
until the early to mid-30s and then level off. Age-related factors for caffeine use disorder 
are unknown, although concern is growing related to excessive caffeine consumption 
among adolescents and young adults through use of caffeinated energy drinks. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Genetic and physiological. Heritabilities of heavy caffeine use, caffeine tolerance, and 
caffeine withdrawal range from 35% to 77%. For caffeine use, alcohol use, and cigarette 
smoking, a common genetic factor (polysubstance use) underlies the use of these three 
substances, with 28%-41% of the heritable effects of caffeine use (or heavy use) shared 
with alcohol and smoking. Caffeine and tobacco use disorders are associated and substan- 
tially influenced by genetic factors unique to these licit drugs. The magnitude of heritabil- 
ity for caffeine use disorder markers appears to be similar to that for alcohol and tobacco 
use disorder markers. 


Functional Consequences of Caffeine Use Disorder 


Caffeine use disorder may predict greater use of caffeine during pregnancy. Caffeine with- 
drawal, a key feature of caffeine use disorder, has been shown to produce functional im- 


Conditions for Further Study 795 


pairment in normal daily activities. Caffeine intoxication may include symptoms of 
nausea and vomiting, as well as impairment of normal activities. Significant disruptions in 
normal daily activities may occur during caffeine abstinence. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Nonproblematic use of caffeine. The distinction between nonproblematic use of caf- 
feine and caffeine use disorder can be difficult to make because social, behavioral, or psy- 
chological problems may be difficult to attribute to the substance, especially in the context of 
use of other substances. Regular, heavy caffeine use that can result in tolerance and with- 
drawal is relatively common, which by itself should not be sufficient for making a diagnosis. 


Other stimulant use disorder. Problems related to use of other stimulant medications 
or substances may approximate the features of caffeine use disorder. 


Anxiety disorders. Chronic heavy caffeine use may mimic generalized anxiety disorder, 
and acute caffeine consumption may produce and mimic panic attacks. 


Comorbidity 

There may be comorbidity between caffeine use disorder and daily cigarette smoking, a 
family or personal history of alcohol use disorder. Features of caffeine use disorder (e.g., 
tolerance, caffeine withdrawal) may be positively associated with several diagnoses: ma- 
jor depression, generalized anxiety disorder, panic disorder, adult antisocial personality 
disorder, and alcohol, cannabis, and cocaine use disorders. 


Internet Gaming Disorder 


Proposed Criteria 


Persistent and recurrent use of the Internet to engage in games, often with other players, 
leading to clinically significant impairment or distress as indicated by five (or more) of the 
following in a 12-month period: 

1. Preoccupation with Internet games. (The individual thinks about previous gaming 
activity or anticipates playing the next game; Internet gaming becomes the dominant 
activity in daily life). 

Note: This disorder is distinct from Internet gambling, which is included under gam- 
bling disorder. 

2. Withdrawal symptoms when Internet gaming is taken away. (These symptoms are typ- 

ically described as irritability, anxiety, or sadness, but there are no physical signs of 

pharmacological withdrawal.) 

Tolerance—the need to spend increasing amounts of time engaged in Internet games. 

Unsuccessful attempts to control the participation in Internet games. 

5. Loss of interests in previous hobbies and entertainment as a result of, and with the ex- 
ception of, Internet games. 

6. Continued excessive use of Internet games despite knowledge of psychosocial problems. 

7. Has deceived family members, therapists, or others regarding the amount of Internet 
gaming. 

8. Use of Internet games to escape or relieve a negative mood (e.g., feelings of helpless- 
ness, guilt, anxiety). 

9. Has jeopardized or lost a significant relationship, job, or educational or career oppor- 
tunity because of participation in Internet games. 


Fo 


796 Conditions for Further Study 


Note: Only nongambling Internet games are included in this disorder. Use of the Internet 
for required activities in a business or profession is not included; nor is the disorder intend- 
ed to include other recreational or social Internet use. Similarly, sexual Internet sites are 
excluded. 


Specify current severity: 
Internet gaming disorder can be mild, moderate, or severe depending on the degree 
of disruption of normal activities. Individuals with less severe Internet gaming disorder 
may exhibit fewer symptoms and less disruption of their lives. Those with severe Inter- 
net gaming disorder will have more hours spent on the computer and more severe loss 
of relationships or career or school opportunities. 


Subtypes 


There are no well-researched subtypes for Internet gaming disorder to date. Internet gam- 
ing disorder most often involves specific Internet games, but it could involve non-Internet 
computerized games as well, although these have been less researched. It is likely that pre- 
ferred games will vary over time as new games are developed and popularized, and it is 
unclear if behaviors and consequence associated with Internet gaming disorder vary by 
game type. 


Diagnostic Features 


Gambling disorder is currently the only non-substance-related disorder proposed for in- 
clusion with DSM-5 substance-related and addictive disorders. However, there are other 
behavioral disorders that show some similarities to substance use disorders and gambling 
disorder for which the word addiction is commonly used in nonmedical settings, and the 
one condition with a considerable literature is the compulsive playing of Internet games. 
Internet gaming has been reportedly defined as an “addiction” by the Chinese govern- 
ment, and a treatment system has been set up. Reports of treatment of this condition have 
appeared in medical journals, mostly from Asian countries and some in the United States. 

The DSM-5 work group reviewed more than 240 articles and found some behavioral 
similarities of Internet gaming to gambling disorder and to substance use disorders. The 
literature suffers, however, from lack of a standard definition from which to derive prev- 
alence data. An understanding of the natural histories of cases, with or without treatment, 
is also missing. The literature does describe many underlying similarities to substance ad- 
dictions, including aspects of tolerance, withdrawal, repeated unsuccessful attempts to cut 
back or quit, and impairment in normal functioning. Further, the seemingly high preva- 
lence rates, both in Asian countries and, to a lesser extent, in the West, justified inclusion of 
this disorder in Section III of DSM-5. 

Internet gaming disorder has significant public health importance, and additional re- 
search may eventually lead to evidence that Internet gaming disorder (also commonly re- 
ferred to as Internet use disorder, Internet addiction, or gaming addiction) has merit as an 
independent disorder. As with gambling disorder, there should be epidemiological stud- 
ies to determine prevalence, clinical course, possible genetic influence, and potential bio- 
logical factors based on, for example, brain imaging data. 

Internet gaming disorder is a pattern of excessive and prolonged Internet gaming that re- 
sults in a cluster of cognitive and behavioral symptoms, including progressive loss of control 
over gaming, tolerance, and withdrawal symptoms, analogous to the symptoms of sub- 
stance use disorders. As with substance-related disorders, individuals with Internet gaming 
disorder continue to sit at a computer and engage in gaming activities despite neglect of 
other activities. They typically devote 8-10 hours or more per day to this activity and at least 
30 hours per week. If they are prevented from using a computer and returning to the game, 
they become agitated and angry. They often go for long periods without food or sleep. Nor- 


Conditions for Further Study 797 


mal obligations, such as school or work, or family obligations are neglected. This condition is 
separate from gambling disorder involving the Internet because money is not at risk. 

The essential feature of Internet gaming disorder is persistent and recurrent participa- 
tion in computer gaming, typically group games, for many hours. These games involve 
competition between groups of players (often in different global regions, so that duration 
of play is encouraged by the time-zone independence) participating in complex structured 
activities that include a significant aspect of social interactions during play. Team aspects 
appear to bea key motivation. Attempts to direct the individual toward schoolwork or in- 
terpersonal activities are strongly resisted. Thus personal, family, or vocational pursuits 
are neglected. When individuals are asked, the major reasons given for using the com- 
puter are more likely to be “avoiding boredom” rather than communicating or searching 
for information. 

The description of criteria related to this condition is adapted from a study in China. Un- 
til the optimal criteria and threshold for diagnosis are determined empirically, conserva- 
tive definitions ought to be used, such that diagnoses are considered for endorsement of 
five or more of nine criteria. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


No consistent personality types associated with Internet gaming disorder have been iden- 
tified. Some authors describe associated diagnoses, such as depressive disorders, atten- 
tion-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD), or obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD). 
Individuals with compulsive Internet gaming have demonstrated brain activation in spe- 
cific regions triggered by exposure to the Internet game but not limited to reward system 
structures 


Prevalence 


The prevalence of Internet gaming disorder is unclear because of the varying question- 
naires, criteria and thresholds employed, but it seems to be highest in Asian countries and 
in male adolescents 12-20 years of age. There is an abundance of reports from Asian coun- 
tries, especially China and South Korea, but fewer from Europe and North America, from 
which prevalence estimates are highly variable. The point prevalence in adolescents (ages 
15-19 years) in one Asian study using a threshold of five criteria was 8.4% for males and 
4.5% for females. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Environmental. Computer availability with Internet connection allows access to the 
types of games with which Internet gaming disorder is most often associated. 


Genetic and physiological. Adolescent males seem to be at greatest risk of developing 


Internet gaming disorder, and it has been speculated that Asian environmental and/or ge- 
netic background is another risk factor, but this remains unclear. 


Functional Consequences of Internet Gaming Disorder 
Internet gaming disorder may lead to school failure, job loss, or marriage failure. The com- 
pulsive gaming behavior tends to crowd out normal social, scholastic, and family activities. 
Students may show declining grades and eventually failure in school. Family responsibil- 
ities may be neglected. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Excessive use of the Internet not involving playing of online games (e.g., excessive use of 
social media, such as Facebook; viewing pornography online) is not considered analogous 


798 Conditions for Further Study 


to Internet gaming disorder, and future research on other excessive uses of the Internet 
would need to follow similar guidelines as suggested herein. Excessive gambling online 
may qualify for a separate diagnosis of gambling disorder. 


Comorbidity 


Health may be neglected due to compulsive gaming. Other diagnoses that may be associ- 
ated with Internet gaming disorder include major depressive disorder, ADHD, and OCD. 


Neurobehavioral Disorder Associated 
With Prenatal Alcohol Exposure 


Proposed Criteria 


A. More than minimal exposure to alcohol during gestation, including prior to pregnancy 
recognition. Confirmation of gestational exposure to alcohol may be obtained from ma- 
ternal self-report of alcohol use in pregnancy, medical or other records, or clinical ob- 
servation. 

B. Impaired neurocognitive functioning as manifested by one or more of the following: 


1. Impairment in global intellectual performance (i.e., |Q of 70 or below, or a standard 
score of 70 or below on a comprehensive developmental assessment). 

2. Impairment in executive functioning (e.g., poor planning and organization; inflexi- 
bility; difficulty with behavioral inhibition). 

3. Impairment in learning (e.g., lower academic achievement than expected for intel- 
lectual level; specific learning disability). 

4. Memory impairment (e.g., problems remembering information learned recently; 
repeatedly making the same mistakes; difficulty remembering lengthy verbal in- 
structions). 

5. Impairment in visual-spatial reasoning (e.g., disorganized or poorly planned draw- 
ings or constructions; problems differentiating left from right). 


C. Impaired self-regulation as manifested by one or more of the following: 


1. Impairment in mood or behavioral regulation (e.g., mood lability; negative affect or 
irritability; frequent behavioral outbursts). 
2. Attention deficit (e.g., difficulty shifting attention; difficulty sustaining mental effort). 
3. Impairment in impulse control (e.g., difficulty waiting turn; difficulty complying with 
rules). 
D. Impairment in adaptive functioning as manifested by two or more of the following, one 
of which must be (1) or (2): 


1. Communication deficit (e.g., delayed acquisition of language; difficulty understand- 
ing spoken language). 

2. Impairment in social communication and interaction (e.g., overly friendly with strang- 
ers; difficulty reading social cues; difficulty understanding social consequences). 

3. Impairment in daily living skills (e.g., delayed toileting, feeding, or bathing; difficulty 
managing daily schedule). 

4. Impairment in motor skills (e.g., poor fine motor development; delayed attainment 
of gross motor milestones or ongoing deficits in gross motor function; deficits in co- 
ordination and balance). 


E. Onset of the disorder (symptoms in Criteria B, C, and D) occurs in childhood. 


Conditions for Further Study 799 


F. The disturbance causes clinically significant distress or impairment in social, aca- 
demic, occupational, or other important areas of functioning. 

G. The disorder is not better explained by the direct physiological effects associated with 
postnatal use of a substance (e.g., a medication, alcohol or other drugs), a general 
medical condition (e.g., traumatic brain injury, delirium, dementia), another known te- 
ratogen (e.g., fetal hydantoin syndrome), a genetic condition (e.g., Williams syndrome, 
Down syndrome, Cornelia de Lange syndrome), or environmental neglect. 


Alcohol is a neurobehavioral teratogen, and prenatal alcohol exposure has teratogenic 
effects on central nervous system (CNS) development and subsequent function. Neurobe- 
havioral disorder associated with prenatal alcohol exposure (ND-PAE) is a new clarifying term, 
intended to encompass the full range of developmental disabilities associated with expo- 
sure to alcohol in utero. The current diagnostic guidelines allow ND-PAE to be diagnosed 
both in the absence and in the presence of the physical effects of prenatal alcohol exposure 
(e.g., facial dysmorphology required for a diagnosis of fetal alcohol syndrome). 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential features of ND-PAE are the manifestation of impairment in neurocognitive, 
behavioral, and adaptive functioning associated with prenatal alcohol exposure. Impair- 
ment can be documented based on past diagnostic evaluations (e.g., psychological or ed- 
ucational assessments) or medical records, reports by the individual or informants, and/ 
or observation by a clinician. 

A clinical diagnosis of fetal alcohol syndrome, including specific prenatal alcohol- 
related facial dysmorphology and growth retardation, can be used as evidence of signifi- 
cant levels of prenatal alcohol exposure. Although both animal and human studies have 
documented adverse effects of lower levels of drinking, identifying how much prenatal 
exposure is needed to significantly impact neurodevelopmental outcome remains chal- 
lenging. Data suggest that a history of more than minimal gestational exposure (e.g., more 
than light drinking) prior to pregnancy recognition and/or following pregnancy recogni- 
tion may be required. Light drinking is defined as 1-13 drinks per month during preg- 
nancy with no more than 2 of these drinks consumed on any 1 drinking occasion. Identifying 
a minimal threshold of drinking during pregnancy will require consideration of a variety 
of factors known to affect exposure and/or interact to influence developmental outcomes, 
including stage of prenatal development, gestational smoking, maternal and fetal genet- 
ics, and maternal physical status (i.e., age, health, and certain obstetric problems). 

Symptoms of ND-PAE include marked impairment in global intellectual performance 
(IQ) or neurocognitive impairments in any of the following areas: executive functioning, 
learning, memory, and/or visual-spatial reasoning. Impairments in self-regulation are pres- 
ent and may include impairment in mood or behavioral regulation, attention deficit, or 
impairment in impulse control. Finally, impairments in adaptive functioning include com- 
munication deficits and impairment in social communication and interaction. Impairment 
in daily living (self-help) skills and impairment in motor skills may be present. As it may be 
difficult to obtain an accurate assessment of the neurocognitive abilities of very young chil- 
dren, it is appropriate to defer a diagnosis for children 3 years of age and younger. 


Associated Features Supporting Diagnosis 


Associated features vary depending on age, degree of alcohol exposure, and the individ- 
ual’s environment. An individual can be diagnosed with this disorder regardless of socio- 
economic or cultural background. However, ongoing parental alcohol/substance misuse, 
parental mental illness, exposure to domestic or community violence, neglect or abuse, 
disrupted caregiving relationships, multiple out-of-home placements, and lack of conti- 
nuity in medical or mental health care are often present. 


800 Conditions for Further Study 


Prevalence 


The prevalence rates of ND-PAE are unknown. However, estimated prevalence rates of clini- 
cal conditions associated with prenatal alcohol exposure are 2%-5% in the United States. 


Development and Course 


Among individuals with prenatal alcohol exposure, evidence of CNS dysfunction varies 
according to developmental stage. Although about one-half of young children prenatally 
exposed to alcohol show marked developmental delay in the first 3 years of life, other chil- 
dren affected by prenatal alcohol exposure may not exhibit signs of CNS dysfunction until 
they are preschool- or school-age. Additionally, impairments in higher order cognitive 
processes (i.e., executive functioning), which are often associated with prenatal alcohol ex- 
posure, may be more easily assessed in older children. When children reach school age, 
learning difficulties, impairment in executive function, and problems with integrative lan- 
guage functions usually emerge more clearly, and both social skills deficits and challeng- 
ing behavior may become more evident. In particular, as school and other requirements 
become more complex, greater deficits are noted. Because of this, the school years repre- 
sent the ages at which a diagnosis of ND-PAE would be most likely. 


Suicide Risk 


Suicide is a high-risk outcome, with rates increasing significantly in late adolescence and 
early adulthood. 


Functional Consequences of Neurobehavioral Disorder 


Associated With Prenatal Alcohol Exposure 


The CNS dysfunction seen in individuals with ND-PAE often leads to decrements in adap- 
tive behavior and to maladaptive behavior with lifelong consequences. Individuals 
affected by prenatal alcohol exposure have a higher prevalence of disrupted school expe- 
riences, poor employment records, trouble with the law, confinement (legal or psychiat- 
ric), and dependent living conditions. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Disorders that are attributable to the physiological effects associated with postnatal use 
of a substance, another medical condition, or environmental neglect. Other consid- 
erations include the physiological effects of postnatal substance use, such as a medication, 
alcohol, or other substances; disorders due to another medical condition, such as traumatic 
brain injury or other neurocognitive disorders (e.g., delirium, major neurocognitive dis- 
order [dementia]); or environmental neglect. 


Genetic and teratogenic conditions. Genetic conditions such as Williams syndrome, 
Down syndrome, or Cornelia de Lange syndrome and other teratogenic conditions such as 
fetal hydantoin syndrome and maternal phenylketonuria may have similar physical and 
behavioral characteristics. A careful review of prenatal exposure history is needed to clar- 
ify the teratogenic agent, and an evaluation by a clinical geneticist may be needed to dis- 
tinguish physical characteristics associated with these and other genetic conditions. 


Comorbidity 


Mental health problems have been identified in more than 90% of individuals with histo- 
ries of significant prenatal alcohol exposure. The most common co-occurring diagnosis is 
attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, but research has shown that individuals with 
ND-PAE differ in neuropsychological characteristics and in their responsiveness to phar- 


Conditions for Further Study 801 


macological interventions. Other high- probability co-occurring disorders include oppo- 
sitional defiant disorder and conduct disorder, but the appropriateness of these diagnoses 
should be weighed in the context of the significant impairments in general intellectual and 
executive functioning that are often associated with prenatal alcohol exposure. Mood 
symptoms, including symptoms of bipolar disorder and depressive disorders, have been 
described. History of prenatal alcohol exposure is associated with an increased risk for 
later tobacco, alcohol, and other substance use disorders. 


Suicidal Behavior Disorder 


Proposed Criteria 


A. Within the last 24 months, the individual has made a suicide attempt. 

Note: A suicide attempt is a self-initiated sequence of behaviors by an individual who, 
at the time of initiation, expected that the set of actions would lead to his or her own 
death. The “time of initiation” is the time when a behavior took place that involved ap- 
plying the method.) 

B. The act does not meet criteria for nonsuicidal self-injury—that is, it does not involve 
self-injury directed to the surface of the body undertaken to induce relief from a nega- 
tive feeling/cognitive state or to achieve a positive mood state. 

C. The diagnosis is not applied to suicidal ideation or to preparatory acts. 

D. The act was not initiated during a state of delirium or confusion. 

E. The act was not undertaken solely for a political or religious objective. 


Specify if: 
Current: Not more than 12 months since the last attempt. 
In early remission: 12—24 months since the last attempt. 


Specifiers 

Suicidal behavior is often categorized in terms of violence of the method. Generally, over- 
doses with legal or illegal substances are considered nonviolent in method, whereas jump- 
ing, gunshot wounds, and other methods are considered violent. Another dimension for 
classification is medical consequences of the behavior, with high-lethality attempts being 
defined as those requiring medical hospitalization beyond a visit to an emergency depart- 
ment. An additional dimension considered includes the degree of planning versus impul- 
siveness of the attempt, a characteristic that might have consequences for the medical 
outcome of a suicide attempt. 

If the suicidal behavior occurred 12-24 months prior to evaluation, the condition is 
considered to be in early remission. Individuals remain at higher risk for further suicide at- 
tempts and death in the 24 months after a suicide attempt, and the period 12-24 months af- 
ter the behavior took place is specified as “early remission.” 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential manifestation of suicidal behavior disorder is a suicide attempt. A suicide at- 
tempt is a behavior that the individual has undertaken with at least some intent to die. The 
behavior might or might not lead to injury or serious medical consequences. Several fac- 
tors can influence the medical consequences of the suicide attempt, including poor plan- 
ning, lack of knowledge about the lethality of the method chosen, low intentionality or 
ambivalence, or chance intervention by others after the behavior has been initiated. These 
should not be considered in assigning the diagnosis. 


802 Conditions for Further Study 


Determining the degree of intent can be challenging. Individuals might not acknowl- 
edge intent, especially in situations where doing so could result in hospitalization or cause 
distress to loved ones. Markers of risk include degree of planning, including selection of a 
time and place to minimize rescue or interruption; the individual’s mental state at the time 
of the behavior, with acute agitation being especially concerning; recent discharge from 
inpatient care; or recent discontinuation of a mood stabilizer such as lithium or an anti- 
psychotic such as clozapine in the case of schizophrenia. Examples of environmental “trig- 
gers” include recently learning of a potentially fatal medical diagnosis such as cancer, 
experiencing the sudden and unexpected loss of a close relative or partner, loss of employ- 
ment, or displacement from housing. Conversely, features such as talking to others about 
future events or preparedness to sign a contract for safety are less reliable indicators. 

In order for the criteria to be met, the individual must have made at least one suicide at- 
tempt. Suicide attempts can include behaviors in which, after initiating the suicide attempt, 
the individual changed his or her mind or someone intervened. For example, an individual 
might intend to ingest a given amount of medication or poison, but either stop or be stopped 
by another before ingesting the full amount. If the individual is dissuaded by another or 
changes his or her mind before initiating the behavior, the diagnosis should not be made. 
The act must not meet criteria for nonsuicidal self-injury—that is, it should not involve re- 
peated (at least five times within the past 12 months) self-injurious episodes undertaken to 
induce relief from a negative feeling / cognitive state or to achieve a positive mood state. The 
act should not have been initiated during a state of delirium or confusion. If the individual 
deliberately became intoxicated before initiating the behavior, to reduce anticipatory anxi- 
ety and to minimize interference with the intended behavior, the diagnosis should be made. 


Development and Course 


Suicidal behavior can occur at any time in the lifespan but is rarely seen in children under 
the age of 5. In prepubertal children, the behavior will often consist of a behavior (e.g., sit- 
ting ona ledge) that a parent has forbidden because of the risk of accident. Approximately 
25%-30% of persons who attempt suicide will go on to make more attempts.There is sig- 
nificant variability in terms of frequency, method, and lethality of attempts. However, this 
is not different from what is observed in other illnesses, such as major depressive disorder, 
in which frequency of episode, subtype of episode, and impairment for a given episode can 
vary significantly. 


Culture-Related Diagnostic Issues 


Suicidal behavior varies in frequency and form across cultures. Cultural differences might 
be due to method availability (e.g., poisoning with pesticides in developing countries; 
gunshot wounds in the southwestern United States) or the presence of culturally specific 
syndromes (e.g., ataques de nervios, which in some Latino groups might lead to behaviors 
that closely resemble suicide attempts or might facilitate suicide attempts). 


Diagnostic Markers 


Laboratory abnormalities consequent to the suicidal attempt are often evident. Suicidal 
behavior that leads to blood loss can be accompanied by anemia, hypotension, or shock. 
Overdoses might lead to coma or obtundation and associated laboratory abnormalities 
such as electrolyte imbalances. 


Functional Consequences of Suicidal Behavior Disorder 
Medical conditions (e.g., lacerations or skeletal trauma, cardiopulmonary instability, in- 
halation of vomit and suffocation, hepatic failure consequent to use of paracetamol) can 
occur as a consequence of suicidal behavior. 


Conditions for Further Study 803 


Comorbidity 


Suicidal behavior is seen in the context of a variety of mental disorders, most commonly bipo- 
lar disorder, major depressive disorder, schizophrenia, schizoaffective disorder, anxiety dis- 
orders (in particular, panic disorders associated with catastrophic content and PTSD 
flashbacks), substance use disorders (especially alcohol use disorders), borderline personality 
disorder, antisocial personality disorder, eating disorders, and adjustment disorders. It is 
rarely manifested by individuals with no discernible pathology, unless it is undertaken be- 
cause of a painful medical condition with the intention of drawing attention to martyrdom for 
political or religious reasons, or in partners in a suicide pact, both of which are excluded from 
this diagnosis, or when third-party informants wish to conceal the nature of the behavior. 


Nonsuicidal Self-Injury 


Proposed Criteria 


A. In the last year, the individual has, on 5 or more days, engaged in intentional self-inflicted 
damage to the surface of his or her body of a sort likely to induce bleeding, bruising, or pain 
(e.g., cutting, burning, stabbing, hitting, excessive rubbing), with the expectation that the 
injury will lead to only minor or moderate physical harm (i.e., there is no suicidal intent). 
Note: The absence of suicidal intent has either been stated by the individual or can be 
inferred by the individual’s repeated engagement in a behavior that the individual 
knows, or has learned, is not likely to result in death. 

B. The individual engages in the self-injurious behavior with one or more of the following 
expectations: 


1. To obtain relief from a negative feeling or cognitive state. 
2. To resolve an interpersonal difficulty. 
3. To induce a positive feeling state. 


Note: The desired relief or response is experienced during or shortly after the self- 
injury, and the individual may display patterns of behavior suggesting a dependence 
on repeatedly engaging in it. 

C. The intentional self-injury is associated with at least one of the following: 


1. Interpersonal difficulties or negative feelings or thoughts, such as depression, anx- 
iety, tension, anger, generalized distress, or self-criticism, occurring in the period 
immediately prior to the self-injurious act. 

2. Prior to engaging in the act, a period of preoccupation with the intended behavior 
that is difficult to control. 

3. Thinking about self-injury that occurs frequently, even when it is not acted upon. 


D. The behavior is not socially sanctioned (e.g., body piercing, tattooing, part of a religious 
or cultural ritual) and is not restricted to picking a scab or nail biting. 

E. The behavior or its consequences cause clinically significant distress or interference in 
interpersonal, academic, or other important areas of functioning. 

F. The behavior does not occur exclusively during psychotic episodes, delirium, sub- 
stance intoxication, or substance withdrawal. In individuals with a neurodevelopmental 
disorder, the behavior is not part of a pattern of repetitive stereotypies. The behavior 
is not better explained by another mental disorder or medical condition (e.g., psychotic 
disorder, autism spectrum disorder, intellectual disability, Lesch-Nyhan syndrome, ste- 
reotypic movement disorder with self-injury, trichotillomania [hair-pulling disorder], ex- 
coriation [skin-picking] disorder). 


804 Conditions for Further Study 


Diagnostic Features 


The essential feature of nonsuicidal self-injury is that the individual repeatedly inflicts 
shallow, yet painful injuries to the surface of his or her body. Most commonly, the purpose 
is to reduce negative emotions, such as tension, anxiety, and self-reproach, and/or to re- 
solve an interpersonal difficulty. In some cases, the injury is conceived of as a deserved 
self-punishment. The individual will often report an immediate sensation of relief that oc- 
curs during the process. When the behavior occurs frequently, it might be associated with 
a sense of urgency and craving, the resultant behavioral pattern resembling an addiction. 
The inflicted wounds can become deeper and more numerous. 

The injury is most often inflicted with a knife, needle, razor, or other sharp object. Com- 
mon areas for injury include the frontal area of the thighs and the dorsal side of the forearm. 
A single session of injury might involve a series of superficial, parallel cuts—separated by 
1 or 2 centimeters—on a visible or accessible location. The resulting cuts will often bleed and 
will eventually leave a characteristic pattern of scars. 

Other methods used include stabbing an area, most often the upper arm, with a needle 
or sharp, pointed knife; inflicting a superficial burn with a lit cigarette end; or burning the 
skin by repeated rubbing with an eraser. Engagement in nonsuicidal self-injury with mul- 
tiple methods is associated with more severe psychopathology, including engagement in 
suicide attempts. 

The great majority of individuals who engage in nonsuicidal self-injury do not seek 
clinical attention. It is not known if this reflects frequency of engagement in the disorder, 
because accurate reporting is seen as stigmatizing, or because the behaviors are experi- 
enced positively by the individual who engages in them, who is unmotivated to receive 
treatment. Young children might experiment with these behaviors but not experience re- 
lief. In such cases, youths often report that the procedure is painful or distressing and 
might then discontinue the practice. 


Development and Course 


Nonsuicidal self-injury most often starts in the early teen years and can continue for many 
years. Admission to hospital for nonsuicidal self-injury reaches a peak at 20-29 years of 
age and then declines. However, research that has examined age at hospitalization did not 
provide information on age at onset of the behavior, and prospective research is needed to 
outline the natural history of nonsuicidal self-injury and the factors that promote or in- 
hibit its course. Individuals often learn of the behavior on the recommendation or observa- 
tion of another. Research has shown that when an individual who engages in nonsuicidal 
self-injury is admitted to an inpatient unit, other individuals may begin to engage in the 
behavior. 


Risk and Prognostic Factors 


Male and female prevalence rates of nonsuicidal self-injury are closer to each other than in 
suicidal behavior disorder, in which the female-to-male ratio is about 3:1 or 4:1. 

Two theories of psychopathology—based on functional behavioral analyses—have been 
proposed: In the first, based on learning theory, either positive or negative reinforcement 
sustains the behavior. Positive reinforcement might result from punishing oneself in a way 
that the individual feels is deserved, with the behavior inducing a pleasant and relaxed state 
or generating attention and help from a significant other, or as an expression of anger. Neg- 
ative reinforcement results from affect regulation and the reduction of unpleasant emotions 
or avoiding distressing thoughts, including thinking about suicide. In the second theory, 
nonsuicidal self-injury is thought to be a form of self-punishment, in which self-punitive ac- 
tions are engaged in to make up for acts that caused distress or harm to others. 


Conditions for Further Study 805 


Functional Consequences of Nonsuicidal Self-Injury 


The act of cutting might be performed with shared implements, raising the possibility of 
blood-borne disease transmission. 


Differential Diagnosis 


Borderline personality disorder. As indicated, nonsuicidal self-injury has long been re- 
garded as a “symptom” of borderline personality disorder, even though comprehensive 
clinical evaluations have found that most individuals with nonsuicidal self-injury have 
symptoms that also meet criteria for other diagnoses, with eating disorders and substance 
use disorders being especially common. Historically, nonsuicidal self-injury was regarded 
as pathognomonic of borderline personality disorder. Both conditions are associated with 
several other diagnoses. Although frequently associated, borderline personality disorder 
is not invariably found in individuals with nonsuicidal self-injury. The two conditions dif- 
fer in several ways. Individuals with borderline personality disorder often manifest dis- 
turbed aggressive and hostile behaviors, whereas nonsuicidal self-injury is more often 
associated with phases of closeness, collaborative behaviors, and positive relationships. At 
amore fundamental level, there are differences in the involvement of different neurotrans- 
mitter systems, but these will not be apparent on clinical examination. 


Suicidal behavior disorder. The differentiation between nonsuicidal self-injury and sui- 
cidal behavior disorder is based either on the stated goal of the behavior being a wish to 
die (suicidal behavior disorder) or, in nonsuicidal self-injury, to experience relief as de- 
scribed in the criteria. Depending on the circumstances, individuals may provide reports 
of convenience, and several studies report high rates of false intent declaration. Individu- 
als with a history of frequent nonsuicidal self-injury episodes have learned that a session 
of cutting, while painful, is, in the short-term, largely benign. Because individuals with 
nonsuicidal self-injury can and do attempt and commit suicide, it is important to check 
past history of suicidal behavior and to obtain information from a third party concerning 
any recent change in stress exposure and mood. Likelihood of suicide intent has been as- 
sociated with the use of multiple previous methods of self-harm. 

Ina follow-up study of cases of “self-harm” in males treated at one of several multiple 
emergency centers in the United Kingdom, individuals with nonsuicidal self-injury were 
significantly more likely to commit suicide than other teenage individuals drawn from the 
same cohort. Studies that have examined the relationship between nonsuicidal self-injury 
and suicidal behavior disorder are limited by being retrospective and failing to obtain ver- 
ified accounts of the method used during previous “attempts.” A significant proportion of 
those who engage in nonsuicidal self-injury have responded positively when asked if they 
have ever engaged in self-cutting (or their preferred means of self-injury) with an intention 
to die. It is reasonable to conclude that nonsuicidal self-injury, while not presenting a high 
risk for suicide when first manifested, is an especially dangerous form of self-injurious 
behavior. 

This conclusion is also supported by a multisite study of depressed adolescents who had 
previously failed to respond to antidepressant medication, which noted that those with pre- 
vious nonsuicidal self-injury did not respond to cognitive-behavioral therapy, and by a study 
that found that nonsuicidal self-injury is a predictor of substance use/misuse. 


Trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder). Trichotillomania is an injurious behavior con- 
fined to pulling out one’s own hair, most commonly from the scalp, eyebrows, or eyelashes. 
The behavior occurs in “sessions” that can last for hours. It is most likely to occur during a 
period of relaxation or distraction. 


806 Conditions for Further Study 


Stereotypic self-injury. Stereotypic self-injury, which can include head banging, self- 
biting, or self-hitting, is usually associated with intense concentration or under conditions 
of low external stimulation and might be associated with developmental delay. 


Excoriation (skin-picking) disorder. Excoriation disorder occurs mainly in females and 
is usually directed to picking at an area of the skin that the individual feels is unsightly or 
a blemish, usually on the face or the scalp. As in nonsuicidal self-injury, the picking is often 
preceded by an urge and is experienced as pleasurable, even though the individual real- 
izes that he or she is harming himself or herself. It is not associated with the use of any im- 
plement. 


APPENDIX 


Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5 ................05. 809 
Glossary of Technical Terms ............00 0c e eee eee eee 817 
Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress ..................-2-+-- 833 
Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes 

(ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM)...........00 cece eee eee 839 
Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) ...... 863 
Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) ..... 877 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors. ..........0.00 0c eee eens 897 


This page intentionally left blank 


Highlights of Changes From 
DSM-IV to DSM-5 


Chan gesm ade to DSM-5 diagnostic criteria and texts are outlined in this chapter 
in the same order in which they appear in the DSM-5 classification. This abbreviated descrip- 
tion is intended to orient readers to only the most significant changes in each disorder cate- 
gory. An expanded description of nearly all changes (e.g., except minor text or wording 
changes needed for clarity) is available online (www.psychiatry.org/dsm5). It should also be 
noted that Section I contains a description of changes pertaining to the chapter organization 
in DSM-5, the multiaxial system, and the introduction of dimensional assessments. 


Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


The term mental retardation was used in DSM-IV. However, intellectual disability (intel- 
lectual developmental disorder) is the term that has come into common use over the past 
two decades among medical, educational, and other professionals, and by the lay public 
and advocacy groups. Diagnostic criteria emphasize the need for an assessment of both 
cognitive capacity (IQ) and adaptive functioning. Severity is determined by adaptive func- 
tioning rather than IQ score. 

The communication disorders, which are newly named from DSM-IV phonological dis- 
order and stuttering, respectively, include language disorder (which combines the previous 
expressive and mixed receptive-expressive language disorders), speech sound disorder (pre- 
viously phonological disorder), and childhood-onset fluency disorder (previously stutter- 
ing). Also included is social (pragmatic) communication disorder, a new condition involving 
persistent difficulties in the social uses of verbal and nonverbal communication. 

Autism spectrum disorder is anew DSM-5 disorder encompassing the previous DSM- 
IV autistic disorder (autism), Asperger’s disorder, childhood disintegrative disorder, 
Rett’s disorder, and pervasive developmental disorder not otherwise specified. It is char- 
acterized by deficits in two core domains: 1) deficits in social communication and social in- 
teraction and 2) restricted repetitive patterns of behavior, interests, and activities. 

Several changes have been made to the diagnostic criteria for attention-deficit/hyperactiv- 
ity disorder (ADHD). Examples have been added to the criterion items to facilitate application 
across the life span; the age at onset description has been changed (from “some hyperactive- 
impulsive or inattentive symptoms that caused impairment were present before age 7 years” 
to “Several inattentive or hyperactive-impulsive symptoms were present prior to age 12”); 
subtypes have been replaced with presentation specifiers that map directly to the prior sub- 
types; a comorbid diagnosis with autism spectrum disorder is now allowed; and a symptom 
threshold change has been made for adults, to reflect the substantial evidence of clinically sig- 
nificant ADHD impairment, with the cutoff for ADHD of five symptoms, instead of six re- 
quired for younger persons, both for inattention and for hyperactivity and impulsivity. 

Specific learning disorder combines the DSM-IV diagnoses of reading disorder, math- 
ematics disorder, disorder of written expression, and learning disorder not otherwise 
specified. Learning deficits in the areas of reading, written expression, and mathematics 
are coded as separate specifiers. Acknowledgment is made in the text that specific types of 
reading deficits are described internationally in various ways as dyslexia and specific types 
of mathematics deficits as dyscalculia. 


809 


810 Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5 


The following motor disorders are included in DSM-5: developmental coordination disor- 
der, stereotypic movement disorder, Tourette’s disorder, persistent (chronic) motor or vocal 
tic disorder, provisional tic disorder, other specified tic disorder, and unspecified tic disorder. 
The tic criteria have been standardized across all of these disorders in this chapter. 


Schizophrenia Spectrum and Other Psychotic Disorders 


Two changes were made to Criterion A for schizophrenia: 1) the elimination of the special at- 
tribution of bizarre delusions and Schneiderian first-rank auditory hallucinations (e.g., two or 
more voices conversing), leading to the requirement of at least two Criterion A symptoms for 
any diagnosis of schizophrenia, and 2) the addition of the requirement that at least one of the 
Criterion A symptoms must be delusions, hallucinations, or disorganized speech. The DSM-IV 
subtypes of schizophrenia were eliminated due to their limited diagnostic stability, low reli- 
ability, and poor validity. Instead, a dimensional approach to rating severity for the core symp- 
toms of schizophrenia is included in DSM-5 Section III to capture the important heterogeneity 
in symptom type and severity expressed across individuals with psychotic disorders. 
Schizoaffective disorder is reconceptualized as a longitudinal instead of a cross-sectional di- 
agnosis—more comparable to schizophrenia, bipolar disorder, and major depressive disorder, 
which are bridged by this condition—and requires that a major mood episode be present for a 
majority of the total disorder’s duration after Criterion A has been met. Criterion A for delu- 
sional disorder no longer has the requirement that the delusions must be nonbizarre; a spec- 
ifier is now included for bizarre type delusions to provide continuity with DSM-IV. Criteria for 
catatonia are described uniformly across DSM-5. Furthermore, catatonia may be diagnosed 
with a specifier (for depressive, bipolar, and psychotic disorders, including schizophrenia), in 
the context of a known medical condition, or as an other specified diagnosis. 


Bipolar and Related Disorders 


Diagnostic criteria for bipolar disorders now include both changes in mood and changes in 
activity or energy. The DSM-IV diagnosis of bipolar I disorder, mixed episodes—requiring 
that the individual simultaneously meet full criteria for both mania and major depressive ep- 
isode—is replaced with a new specifier “with mixed features.” Particular conditions can 
now be diagnosed under other specified bipolar and related disorder, including categori- 
zation for individuals with a past history of a major depressive disorder whose symptoms 
meet all criteria for hypomania except the duration criterion is not met (i.e., the episode lasts 
only 2 or 3 days instead of the required 4 consecutive days or more). A second condition con- 
stituting an other specified bipolar and related disorder variant is that too few symptoms of 
hypomania are present to meet criteria for the full bipolar II syndrome, although the dura- 
tion, at least 4 consecutive days, is sufficient. Finally, in both this chapter and in the chapter 
“Depressive Disorders,” an anxious distress specifier is delineated. 


Depressive Disorders 


To address concerns about potential overdiagnosis and overtreatment of bipolar disorder in 
children, a new diagnosis, disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, is included for children 
up to age 18 years who exhibit persistent irritability and frequent episodes of extreme behav- 
ioral dyscontrol. Premenstrual dysphoric disorder is now promoted from Appendix B, “Cri- 
teria Sets and Axes Provided for Further Study,” in DSM-IV to the main body of DSM-5. What 
was referred to as dysthymia in DSM-IV now falls under the category of persistent depressive 
disorder, which includes both chronic major depressive disorder and the previous dysthymic 
disorder. The coexistence within a major depressive episode of at least three manic symp- 
toms (insufficient to satisfy criteria for a manic episode) is now acknowledged by the specifier 


Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5 811 


“with mixed features.” In DSM-IV, there was an exclusion criterion for a major depressive ep- 
isode that was applied to depressive symptoms lasting less than 2 months following the death 
of a loved one (i.e., the bereavement exclusion). This exclusion is omitted in DSM-5 for several 
reasons, including the recognition that bereavement is a severe psychosocial stressor that can 
precipitate a major depressive episode in a vulnerable individual, generally beginning soon 
after the loss, and can add an additional risk for suffering, feelings of worthlessness, suicidal 
ideation, poorer medical health, and worse interpersonal and work functioning. It was critical 
to remove the implication that bereavement typically lasts only 2 months, when both physi- 
cians and grief counselors recognize that the duration is more commonly 1-2 years. A detailed 
footnote has replaced the more simplistic DSM-IV exclusion to aid clinicians in making the 
critical distinction between the symptoms characteristic of bereavement and those of a major 
depressive disorder. Finally, a new specifier to indicate the presence of mixed symptoms has 
been added across both the bipolar and the depressive disorders. 


Anxiety Disorders 


The chapter on anxiety disorders no longer includes obsessive-compulsive disorder (which 
is in the new chapter “Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders”) or posttraumatic 
stress disorder (PTSD) and acute stress disorder (which are in the new chapter “Trauma- 
and Stressor-Related Disorders”). Changes in criteria for specific phobia and social anxiety 
disorder (social phobia) include deletion of the requirement that individuals over age 18 
years recognize that their anxiety is excessive or unreasonable. Instead, the anxiety must be 
out of proportion to the actual danger or threat in the situation, after cultural contextual fac- 
tors are taken into account. In addition, the 6-month duration is now extended to all ages. 
Panic attacks can now be listed as a specifier that is applicable to all DSM-5 disorders. Panic 
disorder and agoraphobia are unlinked in DSM-5. Thus, the former DSM-IV diagnoses of 
panic disorder with agoraphobia, panic disorder without agoraphobia, and agoraphobia 
without history of panic disorder are now replaced by two diagnoses, panic disorder and ag- 
oraphobia, each with separate criteria. The “generalized” specifier for social anxiety disor- 
der has been deleted and replaced with a “performance only” specifier. Separation anxiety 
disorder and selective mutism are now classified as anxiety disorders. The wording of the 
criteria is modified to more adequately represent the expression of separation anxiety symp- 
toms in adulthood. Also, in contrast to DSM-IV, the diagnostic criteria no longer specify that 
onset must be before age 18 years, and a duration statement—"typically lasting for 6 months 
or more”—has been added for adults to minimize overdiagnosis of transient fears. 


Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders 


The chapter “Obsessive-Compulsive and Related Disorders” is new in DSM-5. New disor- 
ders include hoarding disorder, excoriation (skin-picking) disorder, substance/medica- 
tion-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, and obsessive-compulsive and 
related disorder due to another medical condition. The DSM-IV diagnosis of trichotillo- 
mania is now termed trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder) and has been moved from a 
DSM-IV classification of impulse-control disorders not elsewhere classified to obsessive- 
compulsive and related disorders in DSM-5. The DSM-IV “with poor insight” specifier for 
obsessive-compulsive disorder has been refined to allow a distinction between individuals 
with good or fair insight, poor insight, and “absent insight/delusional” obsessive-compul- 
sive disorder beliefs (i-e., complete conviction that obsessive-compulsive disorder beliefs 
are true). Analogous “insight” specifiers have been included for body dysmorphic disorder 
and hoarding disorder. A “tic-related” specifier for obsessive-compulsive disorder has also 
been added, because presence of a comorbid tic disorder may have important clinical im- 
plications. A “muscle dysmorphia” specifier for body dysmorphic disorder is added to re- 
flect a growing literature on the diagnostic validity and clinical utility of making this 


812 Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5 


distinction in individuals with body dysmorphic disorder. The delusional variant of body 
dysmorphic disorder (which identifies individuals who are completely convinced that their 
perceived defects or flaws are truly abnormal appearing) is no longer coded as both delu- 
sional disorder, somatic type, and body dysmorphic disorder; in DSM-5, this presentation is 
designated only as body dysmorphic disorder with the absent insight/ delusional specifier. 
Individuals can also be diagnosed with other specified obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder, which can include conditions such as body-focused repetitive behavior disorder 
and obsessional jealousy, or unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder. 


Trauma- and Stressor-Related Disorders 


For a diagnosis of acute stress disorder, qualifying traumatic events are now explicit as to 
whether they were experienced directly, witnessed, or experienced indirectly. Also, the 
DSM-IV Criterion A2 regarding the subjective reaction to the traumatic event (e.g., expe- 
riencing “fear, helplessness, or horror”) has been eliminated. Adjustment disorders are 
reconceptualized as a heterogeneous array of stress-response syndromes that occur after 
exposure to a distressing (traumatic or nontraumatic) event, rather than as a residual cat- 
egory for individuals who exhibit clinically significant distress but whose symptoms do 
not meet criteria for a more discrete disorder (as in DSM-IV). 

DSM-5 criteria for PTSD differ significantly from the DSM-IV criteria. The stressor cri- 
terion (Criterion A) is more explicit with regard to events that qualify as “traumatic” ex- 
periences. Also, DSM-IV Criterion A2 (subjective reaction) has been eliminated. Whereas 
there were three major symptom clusters in DSM-[V—reexperiencing, avoidance /numb- 
ing, and arousal—there are now four symptom clusters in DSM-5, because the avoidance / 
numbing cluster is divided into two distinct clusters: avoidance and persistent negative al- 
terations in cognitions and mood. This latter category, which retains most of the DSM-IV 
numbing symptoms, also includes new or reconceptualized symptoms, such as persistent 
negative emotional states. The final cluster—alterations in arousal and reactivity—retains 
most of the DSM-IV arousal symptoms. It also includes irritable behavior or angry out- 
bursts and reckless or self-destructive behavior. PTSD is now developmentally sensitive in 
that diagnostic thresholds have been lowered for children and adolescents. Furthermore, 
separate criteria have been added for children age 6 years or younger with this disorder. 

The DSM-IV childhood diagnosis reactive attachment disorder had two subtypes: 
emotionally withdrawn/ inhibited and indiscriminately social/disinhibited. In DSM-5, 
these subtypes are defined as distinct disorders: reactive attachment disorder and disin- 
hibited social engagement disorder. 


Dissociative Disorders 


Major changes in dissociative disorders in DSM-5 include the following: 1) derealization is 
included in the name and symptom structure of what previously was called depersonali- 
zation disorder (depersonalization/derealization disorder); 2) dissociative fugue is now a 
specifier of dissociative amnesia rather than a separate diagnosis, and 3) the criteria for 
dissociative identity disorder have been changed to indicate that symptoms of disruption 
of identity may be reported as well as observed, and that gaps in the recall of events may 
occur for everyday and not just traumatic events. Also, experiences of pathological pos- 
session in some cultures are included in the description of identity disruption. 


Somatic Symptom and Related Disorders 


In DSM-5, somatoform disorders are now referred to as somatic symptom and related dis- 
orders. The DSM-5 classification reduces the number of these disorders and subcategories to 
avoid problematic overlap. Diagnoses of somatization disorder, hypochondriasis, pain dis- 
order, and undifferentiated somatoform disorder have been removed. Individuals previ- 


Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5 813 


ously diagnosed with somatization disorder will usually have symptoms that meet DSM-5 
criteria for somatic symptom disorder, but only if they have the maladaptive thoughts, feel- 
ings, and behaviors that define the disorder, in addition to their somatic symptoms. Because 
the distinction between somatization disorder and undifferentiated somatoform disorder 
was arbitrary, they are merged in DSM-5 under somatic symptom disorder. Individuals pre- 
viously diagnosed with hypochondriasis who have high health anxiety but no somatic symp- 
toms would receive a DSM-5 diagnosis of illness anxiety disorder (unless their health 
anxiety was better explained by a primary anxiety disorder, such as generalized anxiety dis- 
order). Some individuals with chronic pain would be appropriately diagnosed as having so- 
matic symptom disorder, with predominant pain. For others, psychological factors affecting 
other medical conditions or an adjustment disorder would be more appropriate. 

Psychological factors affecting other medical conditions is a new mental disorder in 
DSM-5, having formerly been listed in the DSM-IV chapter “Other Conditions That May 
Be a Focus of Clinical Attention.” This disorder and factitious disorder are placed among 
the somatic symptom and related disorders because somatic symptoms are predominant 
in both disorders, and both are most often encountered in medical settings. The variants of 
psychological factors affecting other medical conditions are removed in favor of the stem 
diagnosis. Criteria for conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder) 
have been modified to emphasize the essential importance of the neurological examina- 
tion, and in recognition that relevant psychological factors may not be demonstrable at the 
time of diagnosis. Other specified somatic symptom disorder, other specified illness anx- 
iety disorder, and pseudocyesis are now the only exemplars of the other specified somatic 
symptom and related disorder classification. 


Feeding and Eating Disorders 


Because of the elimination of the DSM-IV-TR chapter “Disorders Usually First Diagnosed 
During Infancy, Childhood, or Adolescence,” this chapter describes several disorders found in 
the DSM-IV section “Feeding and Eating Disorders of Infancy or Early Childhood,” such as 
pica and rumination disorder. The DSM-IV category feeding disorder of infancy or early 
childhood has been renamed avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder, and the criteria are 
significantly expanded. The core diagnostic criteria for anorexia nervosa are conceptually un- 
changed from DSM-IV with one exception: the requirement for amenorrhea is eliminated. As 
in DSM-IV, individuals with this disorder are required by Criterion A to be at a significantly 
low body weight for their developmental stage. The wording of the criterion is changed for 
clarification, and guidance regarding how to judge whether an individual is at or below a sig- 
nificantly low weight is provided in the text. In DSM-5, Criterion B is expanded to include not 
only overtly expressed fear of weight gain but also persistent behavior that interferes with 
weight gain. The only change in the DSM-IV criteria for bulimia nervosa is a reduction in the 
required minimum average frequency of binge eating and inappropriate compensatory be- 
havior frequency from twice to once weekly. The extensive research that followed the prom- 
ulgation of preliminary criteria for binge-eating disorder in Appendix B of DSM-IV 
documented the clinical utility and validity of binge-eating disorder. The only significant dif- 
ference from the preliminary criteria is that the minimum average frequency of binge eating re- 
quired for diagnosis is once weekly over the last 3 months, identical to the frequency criterion 
for bulimia nervosa (rather than at least 2 days a week for 6 months in DSM-IV). 


Elimination Disorders 


There have been no significant changes in this diagnostic class from DSM-IV to DSM-5. 
The disorders in this chapter were previously classified under disorders usually first di- 
agnosed in infancy, childhood, or adolescence in DSM-IV and exist now as an independent 
classification in DSM-5. 


814 Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5 


Sleep-Wake Disorders 


In DSM-5, the DSM-IV diagnoses named sleep disorder related to another mental disorder 
and sleep disorder related to another medical condition have been removed, and instead 
greater specification of coexisting conditions is provided for each sleep-wake disorder. The 
diagnosis of primary insomnia has been renamed insomnia disorder to avoid the differen- 
tiation between primary and secondary insomnia. DSM-5 also distinguishes narcolepsy— 
now known to be associated with hypocretin deficiency—from other forms of hypersomno- 
lence (hypersomnolence disorder). Finally, throughout the DSM-5 classification of sleep- 
wake disorders, pediatric and developmental criteria and text are integrated where existing 
science and considerations of clinical utility support such integration. Breathing-related 
sleep disorders are divided into three relatively distinct disorders: obstructive sleep apnea 
hypopnea, central sleep apnea, and sleep-related hypoventilation. The subtypes of circadian 
rhythm sleep disorders are expanded to include advanced sleep phase type and irregular 
sleep-wake type, whereas the jet lag type has been removed. The use of the former “not oth- 
erwise specified” diagnoses in DSM-IV have been reduced by elevating rapid eye move- 
ment sleep behavior disorder and restless legs syndrome to independent disorders. 


Sexual Dysfunctions 


In DSM-5, some gender-specific sexual dysfunctions have been added, and, for females, 
sexual desire and arousal disorders have been combined into one disorder: female sexual 
interest/arousal disorder. All of the sexual dysfunctions (except substance/medication-in- 
duced sexual dysfunction) now require a minimum duration of approximately 6 months and 
more precise severity criteria. Genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder has been added to 
DSM-5 and represents a merging of vaginismus and dyspareunia, which were highly co- 
morbid and difficult to distinguish. The diagnosis of sexual aversion disorder has been re- 
moved due to rare use and lack of supporting research. 

There are now only two subtypes for sexual dysfunctions: lifelong versus acquired 
and generalized versus situational. To indicate the presence and degree of medical and 
other nonmedical correlates, the following associated features have been added to the text: 
partner factors, relationship factors, individual vulnerability factors, cultural or religious 
factors, and medical factors. 


Gender Dysphoria 


Gender dysphoria is a new diagnostic class in DSM-5 and reflects a change in conceptual- 
ization of the disorder’s defining features by emphasizing the phenomenon of “gender in- 
congruence” rather than cross-gender identification per se, as was the case in DSM-IV gender 
identity disorder. Gender dysphoria includes separate sets of criteria: for children and for 
adults and adolescents. For the adolescents and adults criteria, the previous Criterion A 
(cross-gender identification) and Criterion B (aversion toward one’s gender) are merged. In 
the wording of the criteria, “the other sex” is replaced by “the other gender” (or “some alter- 
native gender”).” Gender instead of sex is used systematically because the concept “sex” is in- 
adequate when referring to individuals with a disorder of sex development. In the child 
criteria, “strong desire to be of the other gender” replaces the previous “repeatedly stated de- 
sire to be...the other sex” to capture the situation of some children who, in a coercive envi- 
ronment, may not verbalize the desire to be of another gender. For children, Criterion A1 (“a 
strong desire to be of the other gender or an insistence that he or she is the other gender...)” 
is now necessary (but not sufficient), which makes the diagnosis more restrictive and conser- 
vative. The subtyping on the basis of sexual orientation is removed because the distinction is 
no longer considered clinically useful. A posttransition specifier has been added to identify 


Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5 815 


individuals who have undergone at least one medical procedure or treatment to support the 
new gender assignment (e.g., cross-sex hormone treatment). Although the concept of post- 
transition is modeled on the concept of full or partial remission, the term remission has impli- 
cations in terms of symptom reduction that do not apply directly to gender dysphoria. 


Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders 


The chapter “Disruptive, Impulse-Control, and Conduct Disorders” is new to DSM-5 and 
combines disorders that were previously included in the chapter “Disorders Usually First Di- 
agnosed in Infancy, Childhood, or Adolescence” (i.e., oppositional defiant disorder; conduct 
disorder; and disruptive behavior disorder not otherwise specified, now categorized as other 
specified and unspecified disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorders) and the chap- 
ter “Impulse-Control Disorders Not Elsewhere Classified” (i.e., intermittent explosive disor- 
der, pyromania, and kleptomania). These disorders are all characterized by problems in 
emotional and behavioral self-control. Notably, ADHD is frequently comorbid with the dis- 
orders in this chapter but is listed with the neurodevelopmental disorders. Because of its 
close association with conduct disorder, antisocial personality disorder is listed both in this 
chapter and in the chapter “Personality Disorders,” where it is described in detail. 

The criteria for oppositional defiant disorder are now grouped into three types: an- 
gry /irritable mood, argumentative/defiant behavior, and vindictiveness. Additionally, 
the exclusionary criterion for conduct disorder has been removed. The criteria for conduct 
disorder include a descriptive features specifier for individuals who meet full criteria for 
the disorder but also present with limited prosocial emotions. The primary change in in- 
termittent explosive disorder is in the type of aggressive outbursts that should be consid- 
ered: DSM-IV required physical aggression, whereas in DSM-5 verbal aggression and 
nondestructive /noninjurious physical aggression also meet criteria. DSM-5 also provides 
more specific criteria defining frequency needed to meet the criteria and specifies that the 
aggressive outbursts are impulsive and/or anger based in nature, and must cause marked 
distress, cause impairment in occupational or interpersonal functioning, or be associated 
with negative financial or legal consequences. Furthermore, a minimum age of 6 years (or 
equivalent developmental level) is now required. 


Substance-Related and Addictive Disorders 


An important departure from past diagnostic manuals is that the chapter on substance-related 
disorders has been expanded to include gambling disorder. Another key change is that 
DSM- 5 does not separate the diagnoses of substance abuse and dependence as in DSM-IV. Rather 
criteria are provided for substance use disorder, accompanied by criteria for intoxication, 
withdrawal, substance-induced disorders, and unspecified substance-related disorders, 
where relevant. Within substance use disorders, the DSM-IV recurrent substance-related legal 
problems criterion has been deleted from DSM-5, and a new criterion—craving, or a strong de- 
sire or urge to use a substance—has been added. In addition, the threshold for substance use 
disorder diagnosis in DSM-5 is set at two or more criteria, in contrast to a threshold of one or 
more criteria for a diagnosis of DSM-IV substance abuse and three or more for DSM-IV depen- 
dence. Cannabis withdrawal and caffeine withdrawal are new disorders (the latter was in 
DSM-IV Appendix B, “Criteria Sets and Axes Provided for Further Study”). 

Severity of the DSM-5 substance use disorders is based on the number of criteria en- 
dorsed. The DSM-IV specifier for a physiological subtype is eliminated in DSM-5, as is the 
DSM-IV diagnosis of polysubstance dependence. Early remission from a DSM-5 substance 
use disorder is defined as at least 3 but less than 12 months without meeting substance use 
disorder criteria (except craving), and sustained remission is defined as at least 12 months 
without meeting criteria (except craving). Additional new DSM-5 specifiers include “in a 
controlled environment” and “on maintenance therapy” as the situation warrants. 


816 Highlights of Changes From DSM-IV to DSM-5 


Neurocognitive Disorders 


The DSM-IV diagnoses of dementia and amnestic disorder are subsumed under the newly 
named entity major neurocognitive disorder (NCD). The term dementia is not precluded from 
use in the etiological subtypes where that term is standard. Furthermore, DSM-5 now recog- 
nizes a less severe level of cognitive impairment, mild NCD, which is a new disorder that per- 
mits the diagnosis of less disabling syndromes that may nonetheless be the focus of concern 
and treatment. Diagnostic criteria are provided for both of these disorders, followed by diag- 
nostic criteria for different etiological subtypes. In DSM-IV, individual diagnoses were desig- 
nated for dementia of the Alzheimer’s type, vascular dementia, and substance-induced 
dementia, whereas the other neurodegenerative disorders were classified as dementia due to 
another medical condition, with HIV, head trauma, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s disease, 
Pick’s disease, Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease, and other medical conditions specified. In DSM-5, 
major or mild NCD due to Alzheimer’s disease and major or mild vascular NCD have been re- 
tained, while new separate criteria are now presented for major or mild frontotemporal NCD, 
NCD with Lewy bodies, and NCDs due to traumatic brain injury, a substance /medication, 
HIV infection, prion disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s disease, another medical con- 
dition, and multiple etiologies, respectively. Unspecified NCD is also included as a diagnosis. 


Personality Disorders 


The criteria for personality disorders in Section Il of DSM-5 have not changed from those in 
DSM-IV. An alternative approach to the diagnosis of personality disorders was developed 
for DSM-5 for further study and can be found in Section III (see “Alternative DSM-5 Model 
for Personality Disorders”). For the general criteria for personality disorder, presented in 
Section III, a revised personality functioning criterion (Criterion A) has been developed 
based on a literature review of reliable clinical measures of core impairments central to per- 
sonality pathology. A diagnosis of personality disorder—trait specified, based on moderate 
or greater impairment in personality functioning and the presence of pathological personal- 
ity traits, replaces personality disorder not otherwise specified and provides a much more in- 
formative diagnosis for individuals who are not optimally described as having a specific 
personality disorder. A greater emphasis on personality functioning and trait-based criteria 
increases the stability and empirical bases of the disorders. Personality functioning and per- 
sonality traits also can be assessed whether or not the individual has a personality disor- 
der—a feature that provides clinically useful information about all individuals. 


Paraphilic Disorders 


An overarching change from DSM-IV is the addition of the course specifiers “in a controlled 
environment” and “in remission” to the diagnostic criteria sets for all the paraphilic disor- 
ders. These specifiers are added to indicate important changes in an individual’s status. In 
DSM-5, paraphilias are not ipso facto mental disorders. There is a distinction between paraphil- 
ias and paraphilic disorders. A paraphilic disorder is a paraphilia that is currently causing dis- 
tress or impairment to the individual or a paraphilia whose satisfaction has entailed personal 
harm, or risk of harm, to others. A paraphilia is a necessary but not a sufficient condition for 
having a paraphilic disorder, and a paraphilia by itself does not automatically justify or require 
clinical intervention. The distinction between paraphilias and paraphilic disorders was im- 
plemented without making any changes to the basic structure of the diagnostic criteria as they 
had existed since DSM-III-R. The change proposed for DSM-5 is that individuals who meet 
both Criterion A and Criterion B would now be diagnosed as having a paraphilic disorder. A 
diagnosis would not be given to individuals whose symptoms meet Criterion A but not Cri- 
terion B—that is, to individuals who have a paraphilia but not a paraphilic disorder. 


Glossary of 
Technical Terms 


affect A pattern of observable behaviors that is the expression of a subjectively experi- 
enced feeling state (emotion). Examples of affect include sadness, elation, and anger. In 
contrast to mood, which refers to a pervasive and sustained emotional “climate,” affect 
refers to more fluctuating changes in emotional “weather.” What is considered the nor- 
mal range of the expression of affect varies considerably, both within and among dif- 
ferent cultures. Disturbances in affect include 


blunted Significant reduction in the intensity of emotional expression. 
flat Absence or near absence of any sign of affective expression. 


inappropriate Discordance between affective expression and the content of speech 
or ideation. 


labile Abnormal variability in affect with repeated, rapid, and abrupt shifts in af- 
fective expression. 


restricted or constricted Mild reduction in the range and intensity of emotional ex- 
pression. 


affective blunting See AFFECT. 
agitation (psychomotor) See PSYCHOMOTOR AGITATION. 


agnosia Loss of ability to recognize objects, persons, sounds, shapes, or smells that occurs 
in the absence of either impairment of the specific sense or significant memory loss. 


alogia An impoverishment in thinking that is inferred from observing speech and lan- 
guage behavior. There may be brief and concrete replies to questions and restriction in 
the amount of spontaneous speech (termed poverty of speech). Sometimes the speech is 
adequate in amount but conveys little information because it is overconcrete, overab- 
stract, repetitive, or stereotyped (termed poverty of content). 


amnesia An inability to recall important autobiographical information that is inconsis- 
tent with ordinary forgetting. 


anhedonia Lack of enjoyment from, engagement in, or energy for life’s experiences; def- 
icits in the capacity to feel pleasure and take interest in things. Anhedonia is a facet of 
the broad personality trait domain DETACHMENT. 


anosognosia A condition in which a person with an illness seems unaware of the exis- 
tence of his or her illness. 


antagonism Behaviors that put an individual at odds with other people, such as an ex- 
aggerated sense of self-importance with a concomitant expectation of special treat- 
ment, as well as a callous antipathy toward others, encompassing both unawareness of 
others’ needs and feelings, and a readiness to use others in the service of self-enhance- 
ment. Antagonism is one of the five broad PERSONALITY TRAIT DOMAINS defined in Sec- 
tion III “Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders.” 


SMALL CAPS indicate term found elsewhere in this glossary. Glossary definitions were informed by 
DSM-5 Work Groups, publicly available Internet sources, and previously published glossaries for 
mental disorders (World Health Organization and American Psychiatric Association). 


817 


818 Glossary of Technical Terms 


antidepressant discontinuation syndrome A set of symptoms that can occur after 
abrupt cessation, or marked reduction in dose, of an antidepressant medication that 
had been taken continuously for at least 1 month. 


anxiety The apprehensive anticipation of future danger or misfortune accompanied by 
a feeling of worry, distress, and/or somatic symptoms of tension. The focus of antici- 
pated danger may be internal or external. 


anxiousness Feelings of nervousness or tenseness in reaction to diverse situations; frequent 
worry about the negative effects of past unpleasant experiences and future negative possi- 
bilities; feeling fearful and apprehensive about uncertainty; expecting the worst to happen. 
Anxiousness is a facet of the broad personality trait domain NEGATIVE AFFECTIVITY. 


arousal The physiological and psychological state of being awake or reactive to stimuli. 
asociality A reduced initiative for interacting with other people. 


attention The ability to focus in a sustained manner on a particular stimulus or activity. 
A disturbance in attention may be manifested by easy DISTRACTIBILITY or difficulty in 
finishing tasks or in concentrating on work. 


attention seeking Engaging in behavior designed to attract notice and to make oneself 
the focus of others’ attention and admiration. Attention seeking is a facet of the broad 
personality trait domain ANTAGONISM. 


autogynephilia Sexual arousal of a natal male associated with the idea or image of being 
a woman. 


avoidance The act of keeping away from stress-related circumstances; a tendency to cir- 
cumvent cues, activities, and situations that remind the individual of a stressful event 
experienced. 


avolition An inability to initiate and persist in goal-directed activities. When severe enough 
to be considered pathological, avolition is pervasive and prevents the person from com- 
pleting many different types of activities (e.g., work, intellectual pursuits, self-care). 


bereavement The state of having lost through death someone with whom one has had 
a close relationship. This state includes a range of grief and mourning responses. 


biological rhythms See CIRCADIAN RHYTHMS. 


callousness Lack of concern for the feelings or problems of others; lack of guilt or re- 
morse about the negative or harmful effects of one’s actions on others. Callousness is a 
facet of the broad personality trait domain ANTAGONISM. 


catalepsy Passive induction of a posture held against gravity. Compare with WAXY FLEX- 
IBILITY. 


cataplexy Episodes of sudden bilateral loss of muscle tone resulting in the individual 
collapsing, often occurring in association with intense emotions such as laughter, an- 
ger, fear, or surprise. 


circadian rhythms Cyclical variations in physiological and biochemical function, level 
of sleep-wake activity, and emotional state. Circadian rhythms have a cycle of about 24 
hours, ultradian rhythms have a cycle that is shorter than 1 day, and infradian rhythms 
have a cycle that may last weeks or months. 


cognitive and perceptual dysregulation Odd or unusual thought processes and experi- 
ences, including DEPERSONALIZATION, DEREALIZATION, and DISSOCIATION; mixed sleep- 
wake state experiences; and thought-control experiences. Cognitive and perceptual 
dysregulation is a facet of the broad personality trait domain PSYCHOTICISM. 


coma State of complete loss of consciousness. 


Glossary of Technical Terms 819 


compulsion Repetitive behaviors (e.g., hand washing, ordering, checking) or mental 
acts (e.g., praying, counting, repeating words silently) that the individual feels driven 
to perform in response to an obsession, or according to rules that must be applied rig- 
idly. The behaviors or mental acts are aimed at preventing or reducing anxiety or dis- 
tress, or preventing some dreaded event or situation; however, these behaviors or 
mental acts are not connected in a realistic way with what they are designed to neutral- 
ize or prevent or are clearly excessive. 


conversion symptom A loss of, or alteration in, voluntary motor or sensory functioning, 
with or without apparent impairment of consciousness. The symptom is not fully ex- 
plained by a neurological or another medical condition or the direct effects of a sub- 
stance and is not intentionally produced or feigned. 


deceitfulness Dishonesty and fraudulence; misrepresentation of self; embellishment or 
fabrication when relating events. Deceitfulness is a facet of the broad personality trait 
domain ANTAGONISM. 


defense mechanism Mechanisms that mediate the individual’s reaction to emotional 
conflicts and to external stressors. Some defense mechanisms (e.g., projection, splitting, 
acting out) are almost invariably maladaptive. Others (e.g., suppression, denial) may 
be either maladaptive or adaptive, depending on their severity, their inflexibility, and 
the context in which they occur. 


delusion A false belief based on incorrect inference about external reality that is firmly 
held despite what almost everyone else believes and despite what constitutes incontro- 
vertible and obvious proof or evidence to the contrary. The belief is not ordinarily ac- 
cepted by other members of the person’s culture or subculture (i.e., it is not an article of 
religious faith). When a false belief involves a value judgment, it is regarded as a delusion 
only when the judgment is so extreme as to defy credibility. Delusional conviction can 
sometimes be inferred from an overvalued idea (in which case the individual has an un- 
reasonable belief or idea but does not hold it as firmly as is the case with a delusion). De- 
lusions are subdivided according to their content. Common types are listed below: 


bizarre A delusion that involves a phenomenon that the person’s culture would re- 
gard as physically impossible. 

delusional jealousy A delusion that one’s sexual partner is unfaithful. 

erotomanic A delusion that another person, usually of higher status, is in love with 
the individual. 

grandiose A delusion of inflated worth, power, knowledge, identity, or special re- 
lationship to a deity or famous person. 


mixed type Delusions of more than one type (e.g., EROTOMANIC, GRANDIOSE, PERSE- 
CUTORY, SOMATIC) in which no one theme predominates. 


mood-congruent See MOOD-CONGRUENT PSYCHOTIC FEATURES. 
mood-incongruent See MOOD-INCONGRUENT PSYCHOTIC FEATURES. 


of being controlled A delusion in which feelings, impulses, thoughts, or actions 
are experienced as being under the control of some external force rather than be- 
ing under one’s own control. 

of reference A delusion in which events, objects, or other persons in one’s immedi- 
ate environment are seen as having a particular and unusual significance. These 
delusions are usually of a negative or pejorative nature but also may be grandiose 
in content. A delusion of reference differs from an idea of reference, in which the 
false belief is not as firmly held nor as fully organized into a true belief. 

persecutory A delusion in which the central theme is that one (or someone to whom 
one is close) is being attacked, harassed, cheated, persecuted, or conspired against. 


820 Glossary of Technical Terms 


somatic A delusion whose main content pertains to the appearance or functioning 
of one’s body. 


thought broadcasting A delusion that one’s thoughts are being broadcast out loud 
so that they can be perceived by others. 


thought insertion A delusion that certain of one’s thoughts are not one’s own, but 
rather are inserted into one’s mind. 


depersonalization The experience of feeling detached from, and as if one is an outside 
observer of, one’s mental processes, body, or actions (e.g., feeling like one is in a dream; 
asense of unreality of self, perceptual alterations; emotional and/or physical numbing; 
temporal distortions; sense of unreality). 


depressivity Feelings of being intensely sad, miserable, and/or hopeless. Some patients 
describe an absence of feelings and/or dysphoria; difficulty recovering from such 
moods; pessimism about the future; pervasive shame and/or guilt; feelings of inferior 
self-worth; and thoughts of suicide and suicidal behavior. Depressivity is a facet of the 
broad personality trait domain DETACHMENT. 


derealization The experience of feeling detached from, and as if one is an outside ob- 
server of, one’s surroundings (e.g., individuals or objects are experienced as unreal, 
dreamlike, foggy, lifeless, or visually distorted). 


detachment Avoidance of socioemotional experience, including both WITHDRAWAL from 
interpersonal interactions (ranging from casual, daily interactions to friendships and inti- 
mate relationships [i.e., INTIMACY AVOIDANCE]) and RESTRICTED AFFECTIVITY, particularly 
limited hedonic capacity. Detachment is one of the five pathological PERSONALITY TRAIT 
DOMAINS defined in Section III “Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders.” 


disinhibition Orientation toward immediate gratification, leading to impulsive behav- 
ior driven by current thoughts, feelings, and external stimuli, without regard for past 
learning or consideration of future consequences. RIGID PERFECTIONISM, the opposite 
pole of this domain, reflects excessive constraint of impulses, risk avoidance, hyper- 
responsibility, hyperperfectionism, and rigid, rule-governed behavior. Disinhibition 
is one of the five pathological PERSONALITY TRAIT DOMAINS defined in Section III “Al- 
ternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders.” 


disorder of sex development Condition of significant inborn somatic deviations of the 
reproductive tract from the norm and/or of discrepancies among the biological indica- 
tors of male and female. 


disorientation Confusion about the time of day, date, or season (time); where one is 
(place); or who one is (person). 


dissociation The splitting off of clusters of mental contents from conscious awareness. 
Dissociation is a mechanism central to dissociative disorders. The term is also used to 
describe the separation of an idea from its emotional significance and affect, as seen in 
the inappropriate affect in schizophrenia. Often a result of psychic trauma, dissociation 
may allow the individual to maintain allegiance to two contradictory truths while re- 
maining unconscious of the contradiction. An extreme manifestation of dissociation is 
dissociative identity disorder, in which a person may exhibit several independent per- 
sonalities, each unaware of the others. 


distractibility Difficulty concentrating and focusing on tasks; attention is easily divert- 
ed by extraneous stimuli; difficulty maintaining goal-focused behavior, including both 
planning and completing tasks. Distractibility is a facet of the broad personality trait 
domain DISINHIBITION. 


dysarthria A disorder of speech sound production due to structural or motor impair- 
ment affecting the articulatory apparatus. Such disorders include cleft palate, muscle 


Glossary of Technical Terms 821 


disorders, cranial nerve disorders, and cerebral palsy affecting bulbar structures (i.e., 
lower and upper motor neuron disorders). 


dyskinesia Distortion of voluntary movements with involuntary muscle activity. 


dysphoria (dysphoric mood) A condition in which a person experiences intense feelings 
of depression, discontent, and in some cases indifference to the world around them. 


dyssomnias Primary disorders of sleep or wakefulness characterized by INSOMNIA or 
HYPERSOMNIA as the major presenting symptom. Dyssomnias are disorders of the 
amount, quality, or timing of sleep. Compare with PARASOMNIAS. 


dysthymia Presence, while depressed, of two or more of the following: 1) poor appetite 
or overeating, 2) insomnia or hypersomnia, 3) low energy or fatigue, 4) low self-esteem, 
5) poor concentration or difficulty making decisions, or 6) feelings of hopelessness. 


dystonia Disordered tonicity of muscles. 


eccentricity Odd, unusual, or bizarre behavior, appearance, and/or speech having 
strange and unpredictable thoughts; saying unusual or inappropriate things. Eccentric- 
ity is a facet of the broad personality trait domain PSYCHOTICISM. 


echolalia The pathological, parrotlike, and apparently senseless repetition (echoing) of 
a word or phrase just spoken by another person. 


echopraxia Mimicking the movements of another. 


emotional lability Instability of emotional experiences and mood; emotions that are 
easily aroused, intense, and/or out of proportion to events and circumstances. Emo- 
tional lability is a facet of the broad personality trait domain NEGATIVE AFFECTIVITY. 


empathy Comprehension and appreciation of others’ experiences and motivations; tol- 
erance of differing perspectives; understanding the effects of own behavior on others. 


episode (episodic) A specified duration of time during which the patient has developed or 
experienced symptoms that meet the diagnostic criteria for a given mental disorder. De- 
pending on the type of mental disorder, episode may denote a certain number of symptoms 
or a specified severity or frequency of symptoms. Episodes may be further differentiated 
as a single (first) episode or a recurrence or relapse of multiple episodes if appropriate. 


euphoria A mental and emotional condition in which a person experiences intense feel- 
ings of well-being, elation, happiness, excitement, and joy. 


fatigability Tendency to become easily fatigued. See also FATIGUE. 


fatigue A state (also called exhaustion, tiredness, lethargy, languidness, languor, lassi- 
tude, and listlessness) usually associated with a weakening or depletion of one’s phys- 
ical and/or mental resources, ranging from a general state of lethargy to a specific, 
work-induced burning sensation within one’s muscles. Physical fatigue leads to an in- 
ability to continue functioning at one’s normal level of activity. Although widespread 
in everyday life, this state usually becomes particularly noticeable during heavy exer- 
cise. Mental fatigue, by contrast, most often manifests as SOMNOLENCE (sleepiness). 


fear An emotional response to perceived imminent threat or danger associated with 
urges to flee or fight. 


flashback A dissociative state during which aspects of a traumatic event are reexperi- 
enced as though they were occurring at that moment. 


flight of ideas A nearly continuous flow of accelerated speech with abrupt changes 
from topic to topic that are usually based on understandable associations, distracting 
stimuli, or plays on words. When the condition is severe, speech may be disorganized 
and incoherent. 


822 Glossary of Technical Terms 


gender The public (and usually legally recognized) lived role as boy or girl, man or 
woman. Biological factors are seen as contributing in interaction with social and psy- 
chological factors to gender development. 


gender assignment The initial assignment as male or female, which usually occurs at 
birth and is subsequently referred to as the “natal gender.” 


gender dysphoria Distress that accompanies the incongruence between one’s experi- 
enced and expressed gender and one’s assigned or natal gender. 


gender experience The unique and personal ways in which individuals experience their 
gender in the context of the gender roles provided by their societies. 


gender expression The specific ways in which individuals enact gender roles provided 
in their societies. 


gender identity A category of social identity that refers to an individual's identification 
as male, female or, occasionally, some category other than male or female. 


gender reassignment A change of gender that can be either medical (hormones, sur- 
gery) or legal (government recognition), or both. In case of medical interventions, often 
referred to as sex reassignment. 


geometric hallucination See HALLUCINATION. 


grandiosity Believing that one is superior to others and deserves special treatment; self- 
centeredness; feelings of entitlement; condescension toward others. Grandiosity is a 
facet of the broad personality trait domain ANTAGONISM. 


grimace (grimacing) Odd and inappropriate facial expressions unrelated to situation 
(as seen in individuals with CATATONIA). 


hallucination A perception-like experience with the clarity and impact of a true percep- 
tion but without the external stimulation of the relevant sensory organ. Hallucinations 
should be distinguished from ILLUSIONS, in which an actual external stimulus is 
misperceived or misinterpreted. The person may or may not have insight into the non- 
veridical nature of the hallucination. One hallucinating person may recognize the false 
sensory experience, whereas another may be convinced that the experience is grounded 
in reality. The term hallucination is not ordinarily applied to the false perceptions that 
occur during dreaming, while falling asleep (hypnagogic), or upon awakening (hypno- 
pompic). Transient hallucinatory experiences may occur without a mental disorder. 


auditory A hallucination involving the perception of sound, most commonly of 
voice. 

geometric Visual hallucinations involving geometric shapes such as tunnels and 
funnels, spirals, lattices, or cobwebs. 

gustatory A hallucination involving the perception of taste (usually unpleasant). 

mood-congruent See MOOD-CONGRUENT PSYCHOTIC FEATURES. 

mood-incongruent See MOOD-INCONGRUENT PSYCHOTIC FEATURES. 

olfactory A hallucination involving the perception of odor, such as of burning rub- 
ber or decaying fish. 

somatic A hallucination involving the perception of physical experience localized 
within the body (e.g., a feeling of electricity). A somatic hallucination is to be dis- 
tinguished from physical sensations arising from an as-yet-undiagnosed general 
medical condition, from hypochondriacal preoccupation with normal physical 
sensations, or from a tactile hallucination. 

tactile A hallucination involving the perception of being touched or of something 
being under one’s skin. The most common tactile hallucinations are the sensation 


Glossary of Technical Terms 823 


of electric shocks and formication (the sensation of something creeping or crawl- 
ing on or under the skin). 


visual A hallucination involving sight, which may consist of formed images, such as of 
people, or of unformed images, such as flashes of light. Visual hallucinations should 
be distinguished from ILLUSIONS, which are misperceptions of real external stimuli. 


hostility Persistent or frequent angry feelings; anger or irritability in response to minor 
slights and insults; mean, nasty, or vengeful behavior. Hostility is a facet of the broad 
personality trait domain ANTAGONISM. 


hyperacusis Increased auditory perception. 
hyperorality A condition in which inappropriate objects are placed in the mouth. 
hypersexuality A stronger than usual urge to have sexual activity. 


hypersomnia Excessive sleepiness, as evidenced by prolonged nocturnal sleep, difficul- 
ty maintaining an alert awake state during the day, or undesired daytime sleep epi- 
sodes. See also SOMNOLENCE. 


hypervigilance An enhanced state of sensory sensitivity accompanied by an exaggerated 
intensity of behaviors whose purpose is to detect threats. Hypervigilance is also accompa- 
nied by a state of increased anxiety which can cause exhaustion. Other symptoms include 
abnormally increased arousal, a high responsiveness to stimuli, and a continual scanning 
of the environment for threats. In hypervigilance, there is a perpetual scanning of the envi- 
ronment to search for sights, sounds, people, behaviors, smells, or anything else that is rem- 
iniscent of threat or trauma. The individual is placed on high alert in order to be certain 
danger is not near. Hypervigilance can lead to a variety of obsessive behavior patterns, as 
well as producing difficulties with social interaction and relationships. 


hypomania An abnormality of mood resembling mania but of lesser intensity. See also 
MANIA. 


hypopnea_ Episodes of overly shallow breathing or an abnormally low respiratory rate. 


ideas of reference The feeling that causal incidents and external events have a particu- 
lar and unusual meaning that is specific to the person. An idea of reference is to be dis- 
tinguished from a DELUSION OF REFERENCE, in which there is a belief that is held with 
delusional conviction. 


identity Experience of oneself as unique, with clear boundaries between self and others; 
stability of self-esteem and accuracy of self-appraisal; capacity for, and ability to regu- 
late, a range of emotional experience. 


illusion A misperception or misinterpretation of a real external stimulus, such as hear- 
ing the rustling of leaves as the sound of voices. See also HALLUCINATION. 


impulsivity Acting on the spur of the moment in response to immediate stimuli; acting 
ona momentary basis without a plan or consideration of outcomes; difficulty establish- 
ing and following plans; a sense of urgency and self-harming behavior under emotion- 
al distress. Impulsivity is a facet of the broad personality trait domain DISINHIBITION. 


incoherence Speech or thinking that is essentially incomprehensible to others because 
word or phrases are joined together without a logical or meaningful connection. This 
disturbance occurs within clauses, in contrast to derailment, in which the disturbance 
is between clauses. This has sometimes been referred to a “word salad” to convey the 
degree of linguistic disorganization. Mildly ungrammatical constructions or idiomatic 
usages characteristic of a particular regional or cultural backgrounds, lack of educa- 
tion, or low intelligence should not be considered incoherence. The term is generally 
not applied when there is evidence that the disturbance in speech is due to an aphasia. 


insomnia A subjective complaint of difficulty falling or staying asleep or poor sleep quality. 


824 Glossary of Technical Terms 


intersex condition A condition in which individuals have conflicting or ambiguous bi- 
ological indicators of sex. 


intimacy Depth and duration of connection with others; desire and capacity for close- 
ness; mutuality of regard reflected in interpersonal behavior. 


intimacy avoidance Avoidance of close or romantic relationships, interpersonal attach- 
ments, and intimate sexual relationships. Intimacy avoidance is a facet of the broad 
personality trait domain DETACHMENT. 


irresponsibility Disregard for—and failure to honor—financial and other obligations or 
commitments; lack of respect for—and lack of follow-through on—agreements and 
promises; carelessness with others’ property. Irresponsibility is a facet of the broad per- 
sonality trait domain DISINHIBITION. 


language pragmatics The understanding and use of language in a given context. For 
example, the warning “Watch your hands” when issued to a child who is dirty is in- 
tended not only to prompt the child to look at his or her hands but also to communicate 
the admonition “Don’t get anything dirty.” 

lethargy A state of decreased mental activity, characterized by sluggishness, drowsi- 
ness, inactivity, and reduced alertness. 


macropsia The visual perception that objects are larger than they actually are. Compare 
with MICROPSIA. 


magical thinking The erroneous belief that one’s thoughts, words, or actions will cause 
or prevent a specific outcome in some way that defies commonly understood laws of 
cause and effect. Magical thinking may be a part of normal child development. 


mania A mental state of elevated, expansive, or irritable mood and persistently in- 
creased level of activity or energy. See also HYPOMANIA. 


manipulativeness Use of subterfuge to influence or control others; use of seduction, 
charm, glibness, or ingratiation to achieve one’s ends. Manipulativeness is a facet of the 
broad personality trait domain ANTAGONISM. 


mannerism A peculiar and characteristic individual style of movement, action, thought, 
or speech. 


melancholia (melancholic) A mental state characterized by very severe depression. 


micropsia The visual perception that objects are smaller than they actually are. Com- 
pare with MACROPSIA. 


mixed symptoms The specifier “with mixed features” is applied to mood episodes during 
which subthreshold symptoms from the opposing pole are present. Whereas these con- 
current “mixed” symptoms are relatively simultaneous, they may also occur closely 
juxtaposed in time as a waxing and waning of individual symptoms of the opposite 
pole (i.e., depressive symptoms during hypomanic or manic episodes, and vice versa). 


mood _ A pervasive and sustained emotion that colors the perception of the world. Com- 
mon examples of mood include depression, elation, anger, and anxiety. In contrast to 
affect, which refers to more fluctuating changes in emotional “weather,” mood refers to 
a pervasive and sustained emotional “climate.” Types of mood include 


dysphoric An unpleasant mood, such as sadness, anxiety, or irritability. 


elevated An exaggerated feeling of well-being, or euphoria or elation. A person 
with elevated mood may describe feeling “high,” “ecstatic,” “on top of the world,” 
or “up in the clouds.” 


euthymic Mood in the “normal” range, which implies the absence of depressed or 
elevated mood. 


Glossary of Technical Terms 825 


expansive Lack of restraint in expressing one’s feelings, frequently with an over- 
valuation of one’s significance or importance. 


irritable Easily annoyed and provoked to anger. 


mood-congruent psychotic features Delusions or hallucinations whose content is en- 
tirely consistent with the typical themes of a depressed or manic mood. If the mood is 
depressed, the content of the delusions or hallucinations would involve themes of per- 
sonal inadequacy, guilt, disease, death, nihilism, or deserved punishment. The content 
of the delusion may include themes of persecution if these are based on self-derogatory 
concepts such as deserved punishment. If the mood is manic, the content of the delusions 
or hallucinations would involve themes of inflated worth, power, knowledge, or iden- 
tity, or a special relationship to a deity or a famous person. The content of the delusion 
may include themes of persecution if these are based on concepts such as inflated 
worth or deserved punishment. 


mood-incongruent psychotic features Delusions or hallucinations whose content is not 
consistent with the typical themes of a depressed or manic mood. In the case of depres- 
sion, the delusions or hallucinations would not involve themes of personal inadequacy, 
guilt, disease, death, nihilism, or deserved punishment. In the case of mania, the delu- 
sions or hallucinations would not involve themes of inflated worth, power, knowledge, 
or identity, or a special relationship to a deity or a famous person. 


multiple sleep latency test Polysomnographic assessment of the sleep-onset period, 
with several short sleep-wake cycles assessed during a single session. The test repeat- 
edly measures the time to daytime sleep onset (“sleep latency”) and occurrence of and 
time to onset of the rapid eye movement sleep phase. 


mutism No, or very little, verbal response (in the absence of known aphasia). 


narcolepsy Sleep disorder characterized by periods of extreme drowsiness and frequent 
daytime lapses into sleep (sleep attacks). These must have been occurring at least three 
times per week over the last 3 months (in the absence of treatment). 


negative affectivity Frequent and intense experiences of high levels of a wide range of 
negative emotions (e.g., anxiety, depression, guilt/shame, worry, anger), and their be- 
havioral (e.g., self-harm) and interpersonal (e.g., dependency) manifestations. Nega- 
tive Affectivity is one of the five pathological PERSONALITY TRAIT DOMAINS defined in 
Section III “Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders.” 


negativism Opposition to suggestion or advice; behavior opposite to that appropriate to 
a specific situation or against the wishes of others, including direct resistance to efforts 
to be moved. 


night eating syndrome Recurrent episodes of night eating, as manifested by eating after 
awakening from sleep or excessive food consumption after the evening meal. There is 
awareness and recall of the eating. The night eating is not better accounted for by ex- 
ternal influences such as changes in the individual’s sleep-wake cycle or by local social 
norms. 


nightmare disorder Repeated occurrences of extended, extremely dysphoric, and well- 
remembered dreams that usually involve efforts to avoid threats to survival, security 
or physical integrity and that generally occur during the second half of the major sleep 
episode. On awakening from the dysphoric dreams, the individual rapidly becomes 
oriented and alert. 


nonsubstance addiction(s) Behavioral disorder (also called behavioral addiction) not re- 
lated to any substance of abuse that shares some features with substance-induced 
addiction. 


826 Glossary of Technical Terms 


obsession Recurrent and persistent thoughts, urges, or images that are experienced, at 
some time during the disturbance, as intrusive and unwanted and that in most individ- 
uals cause marked anxiety or distress. The individual attempts to ignore or suppress 
such thoughts, urges, or images, or to neutralize them with some other thought or ac- 
tion (i.e., by performing a compulsion). 


overeating Eating too much food too quickly. 


overvalued idea An unreasonable and sustained belief that is maintained with less than 
delusional intensity (i.e., the person is able to acknowledge the possibility that the be- 
lief may not be true). The belief is not one that is ordinarily accepted by other members 
of the person’s culture or subculture. 


panic attacks Discrete periods of sudden onset of intense fear or terror, often associated 
with feelings of impending doom. During these attacks there are symptoms such as 
shortness of breath or smothering sensations; palpitations, pounding heart, or acceler- 
ated heart rate; chest pain or discomfort; choking; and fear of going crazy or losing con- 
trol. Panic attacks may be unexpected, in which the onset of the attack is not associated 
with an obvious trigger and instead occurs “out of the blue,” or expected, in which the 
panic attack is associated with an obvious trigger, either internal or external. 


paranoid ideation Ideation, of less than delusional proportions, involving suspicious- 
ness or the belief that one is being harassed, persecuted, or unfairly treated. 


parasomnias Disorders of sleep involving abnormal behaviors or physiological events 
occurring during sleep or sleep-wake transitions. Compare with DYSSOMNIAS. 


perseveration Persistence at tasks or in particular way of doing things long after the be- 
havior has ceased to be functional or effective; continuance of the same behavior de- 
spite repeated failures or clear reasons for stopping. Perseveration is a facet of the 
broad personality trait domain NEGATIVE AFFECTIVITY. 


personality Enduring patterns of perceiving, relating to, and thinking about the envi- 
ronment and oneself. PERSONALITY TRAITS are prominent aspects of personality that are 
exhibited in relatively consistent ways across time and across situations. Personality 
traits influence self and interpersonal functioning. Depending on their severity, im- 
pairments in personality functioning and personality trait expression may reflect the 
presence of a personality disorder. 


personality disorder—trait specified In Section III “Alternative DSM-5 Model for Per- 
sonality Disorders,” a proposed diagnostic category for use when a personality disor- 
der is considered present but the criteria for a specific disorder are not met. Personality 
disorder—trait specified (PD-TS) is defined by significant impairment in personality 
functioning, as measured by the Level of Personality Functioning Scale and one or 
more pathological PERSONALITY TRAIT DOMAINS or PERSONALITY TRAIT FACETS. PD-TS is 
proposed in DSM-5 Section III for further study as a possible future replacement for 
other specified personality disorder and unspecified personality disorder. 


personality functioning Cognitive models of self and others that shape patterns of emo- 
tional and affiliative engagement. 


personality trait A tendency to behave, feel, perceive, and think in relatively consistent 
ways across time and across situations in which the trait may be manifest. 


personality trait facets Specific personality components that make up the five broad per- 
sonality trait domains in the dimensional taxonomy of Section III “Alternative DSM-5 
Model for Personality Disorders.” For example, the broad domain antagonism has the 
following component facets: MANIPULATIVENESS, DECEITFULNESS, GRANDIOSITY, ATTEN- 
TION SEEKING, CALLOUSNESS, and HOSTILITY. 


Glossary of Technical Terms 827 


personality traitdomains In the dimensional taxonomy of Section III “Alternative DSM- 
5 Model for Personality Disorders,” personality traits are organized into five broad do- 
mains: NEGATIVE AFFECTIVITY, DETACHMENT, ANTAGONISM, DISINHIBITION, and Psy- 
CHOTICISM. Within these five broad trait domains are 25 specific personality trait facets 
(e.g. , IMPULSIVITY, RIGID PERFECTIONISM). 


phobia A persistent fear of a specific object, activity, or situation (i.e., the phobic stimu- 
lus) out of proportion to the actual danger posed by the specific object or situation that 
results in a compelling desire to avoid it. If it cannot be avoided, the phobic stimulus is 
endured with marked distress. 


pica Persistent eating of nonnutritive nonfood substances over a period of at least 1 month. 
The eating of nonnutritive nonfood substances is inappropriate to the developmental 
level of the individual (a minimum age of 2 years is suggested for diagnosis). The eat- 
ing behavior is not part of a culturally supported or socially normative practice. 


polysomnography Polysomnography (PSG), also known as a sleep study, is a multipa- 
rametric test used in the study of sleep and as a diagnostic tool in sleep medicine. The 
test result is called a polysomnogram, also abbreviated PSG. PSG monitors many body 
functions, including brain (electroencephalography), eye movements (electro-oculog- 
raphy), muscle activity or skeletal muscle activation (electromyography), and heart 
rhythm (electrocardiography). 


posturing Spontaneous and active maintenance of a posture against gravity (as seen in 
CATATONIA). Abnormal posturing may also be a sign of certain injuries to the brain or 
spinal cord, including the following: 
decerebrate posture The arms and legs are out straight and rigid, the toes point 
downward, and the head is arched backward. 
decorticate posture The body is rigid, the arms are stiff and bent, the fists are tight, 
and the legs are straight out. 


opisthotonus The back is rigid and arching, and the head is thrown backward. 


An affected person may alternate between different postures as the condition changes. 


pressured speech Speech that is increased in amount, accelerated, and difficult or impossi- 
ble to interrupt. Usually it is also loud and emphatic. Frequently the person talks without 
any social stimulation and may continue to talk even though no one is listening. 


prodrome An early or premonitory sign or symptom of a disorder. 


pseudocyesis A false belief of being pregnant that is associated with objective signs and 
reported symptoms of pregnancy. 


psychological distress A range of symptoms and experiences of a person’s internal life 
that are commonly held to be troubling, confusing, or out of the ordinary. 


psychometric measures Standardized instruments such as scales, questionnaires, tests, 
and assessments that are designed to measure human knowledge, abilities, attitudes, 
or personality traits. 


psychomotor agitation Excessive motor activity associated with a feeling of inner tension. 
The activity is usually nonproductive and repetitious and consists of behaviors such as pac- 
ing, fidgeting, wringing of the hands, pulling of clothes, and inability to sit still. 


psychomotor retardation Visible generalized slowing of movements and speech. 


psychotic features Features characterized by delusions, hallucinations, and formal thought 
disorder. 


psychoticism Exhibiting a wide range of culturally incongruent odd, eccentric, or un- 
usual behaviors and cognitions, including both process (e.g., perception, dissociation) 


828 Glossary of Technical Terms 


and content (e.g., beliefs). Psychoticism is one of the five broad PERSONALITY TRAIT DO- 
MAINS defined in Section III “Alternative DSM-5 Model for Personality Disorders.” 


purging disorder Eating disorder characterized by recurrent purging behavior to influ- 
ence weight or shape, such as self-induced vomiting, misuse of laxatives, diuretics, or 
other medications, in the absence of binge eating. 


racing thoughts A state in which the mind uncontrollably brings up random thoughts 
and memories and switches between them very quickly. Sometimes the thoughts are 
related, with one thought leading to another; other times they are completely random. 
A person experiencing an episode of racing thoughts has no control over them and is 
unable to focus on a single topic or to sleep. 


rapid cycling Term referring to bipolar disorder characterized by the presence of at least 
four mood episodes in the previous 12 months that meet the criteria for a manic, hypo- 
manic, or major depressive episode. Episodes are demarcated either by partial or full 
remissions of at least 2 months or by a switch to an episode of the opposite polarity 
(e.g., major depressive episode to manic episode). The rapid cycling specifier can be ap- 
plied to bipolar I or bipolar II disorder. 


rapid eye movement (REM) A behavioral sign of the phase of sleep during which the 
sleeper is likely to be experiencing dreamlike mental activity. 


repetitive speech Morphologically heterogeneous iterations of speech. 


residual phase Period after an episode of schizophrenia that has partly or completed re- 
mitted but in which some symptoms may remain, and symptoms such as listlessness, 
problems with concentrating, and withdrawal from social activities may predominate. 


restless legs syndrome An urge to move the legs, usually accompanied or caused by 
uncomfortable and unpleasant sensations in the legs (for pediatric restless legs syn- 
drome, the description of these symptoms should be in the child’s own words). The 
symptoms begin or worsen during periods of rest or inactivity. Symptoms are partially 
or totally relieved by movement. Symptoms are worse in the evening or at night than 
during the day or occur only in the night/evening. 


restricted affectivity Little reaction to emotionally arousing situations; constricted 
emotional experience and expression; indifference and aloofness in normatively engaging 
situations. Restricted affectivity is a facet of the broad personality trait domain DETACH- 
MENT. 


rigid perfectionism Rigid insistence on everything being flawless, perfect, and without 
errors or faults, including one’s own and others’ performance; sacrificing of timeliness 
to ensure correctness in every detail; believing that there is only one right way to do 
things; difficulty changing ideas and/or viewpoint; preoccupation with details, orga- 
nization, and order. Lack of rigid perfectionism is a facet of the broad personality trait 
domain DISINHIBITION. 


risk taking Engagement in dangerous, risky, and potentially self-damaging activities, un- 
necessarily and without regard to consequences; lack of concern for one’s limitations and 
denial of the reality of personal danger; reckless pursuit of goals regardless of the level of 
risk involved. Risk taking is a facet of the broad personality trait domain DISINHIBITION. 


rumination (rumination disorders) Repeated regurgitation of food over a period of at 
least 1 month. Regurgitated food may be re-chewed, re-swallowed, or spit out. In 
rumination disorders, there is no evidence that an associated gastrointestinal or an- 
other medical condition (e.g., gastroesophageal reflux) is sufficient to account for the 
repeated regurgitation. 


Glossary of Technical Terms 829 


seasonal pattern A pattern of the occurrence of a specific mental disorder in selected 
seasons of the year. 


self-directedness, self-direction Pursuit of coherent and meaningful short-term and life 
goals; utilization of constructive and prosocial internal standards of behavior; ability to 
self-reflect productively. 


separation insecurity Fears of being alone due to rejection by and/or separation from 
significant others, based in a lack of confidence in one’s ability to care for oneself, both 
physically and emotionally. Separation insecurity is a facet of the broad personality 
trait domain NEGATIVE AFFECTIVITY. 


sex Biological indication of male and female (understood in the context of reproductive 
capacity), such as sex chromosomes, gonads, sex hormones, and nonambiguous inter- 
nal and external genitalia. 


sign An objective manifestation of a pathological condition. Signs are observed by the 
examiner rather than reported by the affected individual. Compare with SYMPTOM. 


sleep-onset REM Occurrence of the rapid eye movement (REM) phase of sleep within 
minutes after falling asleep. Usually assessed by a polysomnographic MULTIPLE SLEEP 
LATENCY TEST. 


sleep terrors Recurrent episodes of abrupt terror arousals from sleep, usually occurring 
during the first third of the major sleep episode and beginning with a panicky scream. 
There is intense fear and signs of autonomic arousal, such as mydriasis, tachycardia, 
rapid breathing, and sweating, during each episode. 


sleepwalking Repeated episodes of rising from bed during sleep and walking about, 
usually occurring during the first third of the major sleep episode. While sleepwalking, 
the person has a blank, staring face, is relatively unresponsive to the efforts of others to 
communicate with him or her, and can be awakened only with great difficulty. 


somnolence (or “drowsiness”) A state of near-sleep, a strong desire for sleep, or sleep- 
ing for unusually long periods. It has two distinct meanings, referring both to the usual 
state preceding falling asleep and to the chronic condition that involves being in that 
state independent of a circadian rhythm. Compare with HYPERSOMNIA. 


specific food cravings Irresistible desire for special types of food. 


startle response (or “startle reaction”) An involuntary (reflexive) reaction to a sudden 
unexpected stimulus, such as a loud noise or sharp movement. 


stereotypies, stereotyped behaviors/movements Repetitive, abnormally frequent, non- 
goal-directed movements, seemingly driven, and nonfunctional motor behavior (e.g., 
hand shaking or waving, body rocking, head banging, self-biting). 


stress The pattern of specific and nonspecific responses a person makes to stimulus 
events that disturb his or her equilibrium and tax or exceed his or her ability to cope. 


stressor Any emotional, physical, social, economic, or other factor that disrupts the nor- 
mal physiological, cognitive, emotional, or behavioral balance of an individual. 


stressor, psychological Any life event or life change that may be associated temporally 
(and perhaps causally) with the onset, occurrence, or exacerbation of a mental disorder. 


stupor Lack of psychomotor activity, which may range from not actively relating to the 
environment to complete immobility. 


submissiveness Adaptation of one’s behavior to the actual or perceived interests and 
desires of others even when doing so is antithetical to one’s own interests, needs, or 
desires. Submissiveness is a facet of the broad personality trait domain NEGATIVE AF- 
FECTIVITY. 


830 Glossary of Technical Terms 


subsyndromal Below a specified level or threshold required to qualify for a particular 
condition. Subsyndromal conditions (formes frustes) are medical conditions that do not 
meet full criteria for a diagnosis—for example, because the symptoms are fewer or less 
severe than a defined syndrome—but that nevertheless can be identified and related to 
the “full-blown” syndrome. 


suicidal ideas (suicidal ideation) Thoughts about self-harm, with deliberate consider- 
ation or planning of possible techniques of causing one’s own death. 


suicide The act of intentionally causing one’s own death. 
suicide attempt An attempt to end one’s own life, which may lead to one’s death. 


suspiciousness Expectations of—and sensitivity to—signs of interpersonal ill intent or 
harm; doubts about loyalty and fidelity of others; feelings of being mistreated, used, 
and/or persecuted by others. Suspiciousness is a facet of the broad personality trait do- 
main DETACHMENT. 


symptom A subjective manifestation of a pathological condition. Symptoms are reported 
by the affected individual rather than observed by the examiner. Compare with SIGN. 


syndrome A grouping of signs and symptoms, based on their frequent co-occurrence 
that may suggest a common underlying pathogenesis, course, familial pattern, or treat- 
ment selection. 


synesthesias A condition in which stimulation of one sensory or cognitive pathway 
leads to automatic, involuntary experiences in a second sensory or cognitive pathway. 


temper outburst An emotional outburst (also called a “tantrum”), usually associated 
with children or those in emotional distress, and typically characterized by stubborn- 
ness, crying, screaming, defiance, angry ranting, a resistance to attempts at pacifica- 
tion, and in some cases hitting. Physical control may be lost, the person may be unable 
to remain still, and even if the “goal” of the person is met, he or she may not be calmed. 


thought-action fusion The tendency to treat thoughts and actions as equivalent. 


tic An involuntary, sudden, rapid, recurrent, nonrhythmic motor movement or vocal- 
ization. 


tolerance A situation that occurs with continued use of a drug in which an individual 
requires greater dosages to achieve the same effect. 


transgender The broad spectrum of individuals who transiently or permanently identify 
with a gender different from their natal gender. 


transsexual An individual who seeks, or has undergone, a social transition from male to 
female or female to male, which in many, but not all cases may also involve a somatic 
transition by cross-sex hormone treatment and genital surgery (“sex reassignment 
surgery”). 

traumatic stressor Any event (or events) that may cause or threaten death, serious injury, 
or sexual violence to an individual, a close family member, or a close friend. 


unusual beliefs and experiences Belief that one has unusual abilities, such as mind 
reading, telekinesis, or THOUGHT-ACTION FUSION; unusual experiences of reality, in- 
cluding hallucinatory experiences. In general, the unusual beliefs are not held at the 
same level of conviction as DELUSIONS. Unusual beliefs and experiences are a facet of 
the personality trait domain PSYCHOTICISM. 


waxy flexibility Slight, even resistance to positioning by examiner. Compare with CAT- 
ALEPSY. 


Glossary of Technical Terms 831 


withdrawal, social Preference for being alone to being with others; reticence in social 
situations; AVOIDANCE of social contacts and activity; lack of initiation of social contact. 
Social withdrawal is a facet of the broad personality trait domain DETACHMENT. 


worry Unpleasant or uncomfortable thoughts that cannot be consciously controlled by 
trying to turn the attention to other subjects. The worrying is often persistent, repeti- 
tive, and out of proportion to the topic worried about (it can even be about a triviality). 


This page intentionally left blank 


Glossary of Cultural 
Concepts of Distress 


Ataque de nervios 


Ataque de nervios (“attack of nerves”) is a syndrome among individuals of Latino descent, 
characterized by symptoms of intense emotional upset, including acute anxiety, anger, or 
grief; screaming and shouting uncontrollably; attacks of crying; trembling; heat in the chest 
rising into the head; and becoming verbally and physically aggressive. Dissociative experi- 
ences (e.g., depersonalization, derealization, amnesia), seizure-like or fainting episodes, and 
suicidal gestures are prominent in some ataques but absent in others. A general feature of an 
ataque de nervios is a sense of being out of control. Attacks frequently occur as a direct result 
of a stressful event relating to the family, such as news of the death of a close relative, con- 
flicts with a spouse or children, or witnessing an accident involving a family member. For a 
minority of individuals, no particular social event triggers their ataques; instead, their vul- 
nerability to losing control comes from the accumulated experience of suffering. 

No one-to-one relationship has been found between ataque and any specific psychiatric dis- 
order, although several disorders, including panic disorder, other specified or unspecified dis- 
sociative disorder, and conversion disorder, have symptomatic overlap with ataque. 

In community samples, ataque is associated with suicidal ideation, disability, and out- 
patient psychiatric utilization, after adjustment for psychiatric diagnoses, traumatic expo- 
sure, and other covariates. However, some ataques represent normative expressions of 
acute distress (e.g., at a funeral) without clinical sequelae. The term ataque de nervios may 
also refer to an idiom of distress that includes any “fit’”-like paroxysm of emotionality (e.g., 
hysterical laughing) and may be used to indicate an episode of loss of control in response 
to an intense stressor. 

Related conditions in other cultural contexts: Indisposition in Haiti, blacking out in 
the Southern United States, and falling out in the West Indies. 

Related conditions in DSM-5: Panic attack, panic disorder, other specified or unspec- 
ified dissociative disorder, conversion (functional neurologic symptom) disorder, inter- 
mittent explosive disorder, other specified or unspecified anxiety disorder, other specified 
or unspecified trauma and stressor-related disorder. 


Dhat syndrome 


Dhat syndrome is a term that was coined in South Asia little more than half a century ago to 
account for common clinical presentations of young male patients who attributed their 
various symptoms to semen loss. Despite the name, it is not a discrete syndrome but rather 
a cultural explanation of distress for patients who refer to diverse symptoms, such as anx- 
iety, fatigue, weakness, weight loss, impotence, other multiple somatic complaints, and 
depressive mood. The cardinal feature is anxiety and distress about the loss of dhat in the 
absence of any identifiable physiological dysfunction. Dhat was identified by patients as 
a white discharge that was noted on defecation or urination. Ideas about this substance 
are related to the concept of dhatu (semen) described in the Hindu system of medicine, 


Ayurveda, as one of seven essential bodily fluids whose balance is necessary to maintain 
health. 


833 


834 Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress 


Although dhat syndrome was formulated as a cultural guide to local clinical practice, related 
ideas about the harmful effects of semen loss have been shown to be widespread in the general 
population, suggesting a cultural disposition for explaining health problems and symptoms 
with reference to dhat syndrome. Research in health care settings has yielded diverse estimates 
of the syndrome’s prevalence (e.g., 64% of men attending psychiatric clinics in India for sexual 
complaints; 30% of men attending general medical clinics in Pakistan). Although dhat syndrome 
is most commonly identified with young men from lower socioeconomic backgrounds, mid- 
dle-aged men may also be affected. Comparable concerns about white vaginal discharge (leu- 
korrhea) have been associated with a variant of the concept for women. 

Related conditions in other cultural contexts: koro in Southeast Asia, particularly Sin- 
gapore and shen-k’uei (“kidney deficiency”) in China. 

Related conditions in DSM-5: Major depressive disorder, persistent depressive disor- 
der (dysthymia), generalized anxiety disorder, somatic symptom disorder, illness anxiety 
disorder, erectile disorder, early (premature) ejaculation, other specified or unspecified 
sexual dysfunction, academic problem. 


Khyal cap 


“Khyéal attacks” (khyal cap), or “wind attacks,” is a syndrome found among Cambodians in 
the United States and Cambodia. Common symptoms include those of panic attacks, such 
as dizziness, palpitations, shortness of breath, and cold extremities, as well as other symp- 
toms of anxiety and autonomic arousal (e.g., tinnitus and neck soreness). Khyfil attacks in- 
clude catastrophic cognitions centered on the concern that khydl (a windlike substance) 
may rise in the body—along with blood—and cause a range of serious effects (e.g., com- 
pressing the lungs to cause shortness of breath and asphyxia; entering the cranium to 
cause tinnitus, dizziness, blurry vision, and a fatal syncope). Khyél attacks may occur with- 
out warning, but are frequently brought about by triggers such as worrisome thoughts, 
standing up (i.e., orthostasis), specific odors with negative associations, and agoraphobic- 
type cues like going to crowded spaces or riding ina car. Khyfil attacks usually meet panic 
attack criteria and may shape the experience of other anxiety and trauma- and stressor- 
related disorders. Khyfl attacks may be associated with considerable disability. 

Related conditions in other cultural contexts: Laos (pen lom), Tibet (srog rlung gi nad), 
Sri Lanka (vata), and Korea (hwa byung). 

Related conditions in DSM-5: Panic attack, panic disorder, generalized anxiety disor- 
der, agoraphobia, posttraumatic stress disorder, illness anxiety disorder. 


Kufungisisa 


Kufungisisa (“thinking too much” in Shona) is an idiom of distress and a cultural explana- 
tion among the Shona of Zimbabwe. As an explanation, it is considered to be causative of 
anxiety, depression, and somatic problems (e.g., “my heart is painful because I think too 
much”). As an idiom of psychosocial distress, it is indicative of interpersonal and social 
difficulties (e.g., marital problems, having no money to take care of children). Kufungisisa 
involves ruminating on upsetting thoughts, particularly worries. 

Kufungisisa is associated with a range of psychopathology, including anxiety symp- 
toms, excessive worry, panic attacks, depressive symptoms, and irritability. In a study of a 
random community sample, two-thirds of the cases identified by a general psychopathol- 
ogy measure were of this complaint. 

In many cultures, “thinking too much” is considered to be damaging to the mind and 
body and to cause specific symptoms like headache and dizziness. “Thinking too much” 
may also be a key component of cultural syndromes such as “brain fag” in Nigeria. In the 
case of brain fag, “thinking too much” is primarily attributed to excessive study, which is 
considered to damage the brain in particular, with symptoms including feelings of heat or 
crawling sensations in the head. 


Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress 835 


Related conditions in other cultural contexts: “Thinking too much” is a common id- 
iom of distress and cultural explanation across many countries and ethnic groups. It has 
been described in Africa, the Caribbean and Latin America, and among East Asian and 
Native American groups. 

Related conditions in DSM-5: Major depressive disorder, persistent depressive disorder 
(dysthymia), generalized anxiety disorder, posttraumatic stress disorder, obsessive-compul- 
sive disorder, persistent complex bereavement disorder (see “Conditions for Further Study”). 


Maladi moun 


Maladi moun (literally “humanly caused illness,” also referred to as “sent sickness”) is a 
cultural explanation in Haitian communities for diverse medical and psychiatric disor- 
ders. In this explanatory model, interpersonal envy and malice cause people to harm their 
enemies by sending illnesses such as psychosis, depression, social or academic failure, and 
inability to perform activities of daily living. The etiological model assumes that illness 
may be caused by others’ envy and hatred, provoked by the victim’s economic success as 
evidenced by a new job or expensive purchase. One person’s gain is assumed to produce 
another person’s loss, so visible success makes one vulnerable to attack. Assigning the la- 
bel of sent sickness depends on mode of onset and social status more than presenting 
symptoms. The acute onset of new symptoms or an abrupt behavioral change raises sus- 
picions of a spiritual attack. Someone who is attractive, intelligent, or wealthy is perceived 
as especially vulnerable, and even young healthy children are at risk. 

Related conditions in other cultural contexts: Concerns about illness (typically, phys- 
ical illness) caused by envy or social conflict are common across cultures and often ex- 
pressed in the form of “evil eye” (e.g. in Spanish, mal de ojo, in Italian, mal’occhiu). 

Related conditions in DSM-5: Delusional disorder, persecutory type; schizophrenia 
with paranoid features. 


Nervios 


Nervios (“nerves”) is a common idiom of distress among Latinos in the United States and 
Latin America. Nervios refers to a general state of vulnerability to stressful life experiences 
and to difficult life circumstances. The term nervios includes a wide range of symptoms of 
emotional distress, somatic disturbance, and inability to function. The most common 
symptoms attributed to nervios include headaches and “brain aches” (occipital neck ten- 
sion), irritability, stomach disturbances, sleep difficulties, nervousness, easy tearfulness, 
inability to concentrate, trembling, tingling sensations, and mareos (dizziness with occa- 
sional vertigo-like exacerbations). Nervios is a broad idiom of distress that spans the range 
of severity from cases with no mental disorder to presentations resembling adjustment, 
anxiety, depressive, dissociative, somatic symptom, or psychotic disorders. “Being ner- 
vous since childhood” appears to be more of a trait and may precede social anxiety disor- 
der, while “being ill with nerves” is more related than other forms of nervios to psychiatric 
problems, especially dissociation and depression. 

Related conditions in other cultural contexts: Nevra among Greeks in North America, 
nierbi among Sicilians in North America, and nerves among whites in Appalachia and 
Newfoundland. 

Related conditions in DSM-5: Major depressive disorder, peristent depressive disor- 
der (dysthymia), generalized anxiety disorder, social anxiety disorder, other specified or 
unspecified dissociative disorder, somatic symptom disorder, schizophrenia. 


Shenjing shuairuo 


Shenjing shuairuo (“weakness of the nervous system” in Mandarin Chinese) is a cultural 
syndrome that integrates conceptual categories of traditional Chinese medicine with the 


836 Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress 


Western diagnosis of neurasthenia. In the second, revised edition of the Chinese Classifica- 
tion of Mental Disorders (CCMD-2-R), shenjing shuairuo is defined as a syndrome composed 
of three out of five nonhierarchical symptom clusters: weakness (e.g., mental fatigue), 
emotions (e.g., feeling vexed), excitement (e.g., increased recollections), nervous pain (e.g., 
headache), and sleep (e.g., insomnia). Fan nao (feeling vexed) is a form of irritability mixed 
with worry and distress over conflicting thoughts and unfulfilled desires. The third edi- 
tion of the CCMD retains shenjing shuairuo as a somatoform diagnosis of exclusion. Salient 
precipitants of shenjing shuairuo include work- or family-related stressors, loss of face 
(mianzi, lianzi), and an acute sense of failure (e.g., in academic performance). Shenjing sh- 
uairuo is related to traditional concepts of weakness (xu) and health imbalances related to 
deficiencies of a vital essence (e.g., the depletion of qi [vital energy] following overstrain- 
ing or stagnation of qi due to excessive worry). In the traditional interpretation, shenjing 
shuairuo results when bodily channels (jing) conveying vital forces (shen) become dysreg- 
ulated as a result of various social and interpersonal stressors, such as the inability to 
change a chronically frustrating and distressing situation. Various psychiatric disorders 
are associated with shenjing shuairuo, notably mood, anxiety, and somatic symptom disor- 
ders. In medical clinics in China, however, up to 45% of patients with shenjing shuairuo do 
not meet criteria for any DSM-IV disorder. 

Related conditions in other cultural contexts: Neurasthenia-spectrum idioms and 
syndromes are present in India (ashaktapanna) and Japan (shinkei-suijaku), among other set- 
tings. Other conditions, such as brain fag syndrome, burnout syndrome, and chronic fa- 
tigue syndrome, are also closely related. 

Related conditions in DSM-5: Major depressive disorder, persistent depressive disor- 
der (dysthymia), generalized anxiety disorder, somatic symptom disorder, social anxiety 
disorder, specific phobia, posttraumatic stress disorder. 


Susto 


Susto (“fright”) is a cultural explanation for distress and misfortune prevalent among 
some Latinos in the United States and among people in Mexico, Central America, and 
South America. It is not recognized as an illness category among Latinos from the Carib- 
bean. Susto is an illness attributed to a frightening event that causes the soul to leave the 
body and results in unhappiness and sickness, as well as difficulties functioning in key 
social roles. Symptoms may appear any time from days to years after the fright is experi- 
enced. In extreme cases, susto may result in death. There are no specific defining symp- 
toms for susto; however, symptoms that are often reported by people with susto include 
appetite disturbances, inadequate or excessive sleep, troubled sleep or dreams, feelings of 
sadness, low self-worth or dirtiness, interpersonal sensitivity, and lack of motivation to do 
anything. Somatic symptoms accompanying susto may include muscle aches and pains, 
cold in the extremities, pallor, headache, stomachache, and diarrhea. Precipitating events 
are diverse, and include natural phenomena, animals, interpersonal situations, and super- 
natural agents, among others. 

Three syndromic types of susto (referred to as cibih in the local Zapotec language) have 
been identified, each having different relationships with psychiatric diagnoses. An interper- 
sonal susto characterized by feelings of loss, abandonment, and not being loved by family, 
with accompanying symptoms of sadness, poor self-image, and suicidal ideation, seemed to 
be closely related to major depressive disorder. When susto resulted from a traumatic event 
that played a major role in shaping symptoms and in emotional processing of the experience, 
the diagnosis of posttraumatic stress disorder appeared more appropriate. Susto character- 
ized by various recurrent somatic symptoms—for which the person sought health care from 
several practitioners—was thought to resemble a somatic symptom disorder. 

Related conditions in other cultural contexts: Similar etiological concepts and symp- 
tom configurations are found globally. In the Andean region, susto is referred to as espanto. 


Glossary of Cultural Concepts of Distress 837 


Related conditions in DSM-5: Major depressive disorder, posttraumatic stress disor- 
der, other specified or unspecified trauma and stressor-related disorder, somatic symp- 
tom disorders. 


Taijin kyofusho 


Taijin kyofusho (“interpersonal fear disorder” in Japanese) is a cultural syndrome charac- 
terized by anxiety about and avoidance of interpersonal situations due to the thought, feel- 
ing, or conviction that one’s appearance and actions in social interactions are inadequate 
or offensive to others. In the United States, the variant involves having an offensive body 
odor and is termed olfactory reference syndrome. Individuals with taijin kyofusho tend to focus 
on the impact of their symptoms and behaviors on others. Variants include major concerns 
about facial blushing (erythrophobia), having an offensive body odor (olfactory reference 
syndrome), inappropriate gaze (too much or too little eye contact), stiff or awkward facial 
expression or bodily movements (e.g., stiffening, trembling), or body deformity. 

Taijin kyofusho is a broader construct than social anxiety disorder in DSM-5. In addition 
to performance anxiety, taijin kyofusho includes two culture-related forms: a “sensitive type,” 
with extreme social sensitivity and anxiety about interpersonal interactions, and an “of- 
fensive type,” in which the major concern is offending others. As a category, taijin kyofusho 
thus includes syndromes with features of body dysmorphic disorder as well as delusional 
disorder. Concerns may have a delusional quality, responding poorly to simple reassurance 
or counterexample. 

The distinctive symptoms of taijin kyofusho occur in specific cultural contexts and, to 
some extent, with more severe social anxiety across cultures. Similar syndromes are found 
in Korea and other societies that place a strong emphasis on the self-conscious mainte- 
nance of appropriate social behavior in hierarchical interpersonal relationships. Taijin kyo- 
fusho-like symptoms have also been described in other cultural contexts, including the 
United States, Australia, and New Zealand. 

Related conditions in other cultural contexts: Taein kong po in Korea. 

Related conditions in DSM-5: Social anxiety disorder, body dysmorphic disorder, de- 
lusional disorder, obsessive-compulsive disorder, olfactory reference syndrome (a type of 
other specified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder). Olfactory reference syndrome 
is related specifically to the jikoshu-kyofu variant of taijin kyofusho, whose core symptom is 
the concern that the person emits an offensive body odor. This presentation is seen in var- 
ious cultures outside Japan. 


This page intentionally left blank 


Alphabetical Listing of 
DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes 
(ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM codes are to be used for coding purposes in the United States through 
September 30, 2014. ICD-10-CM codes are to be used starting October 1, 2014. 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


V62.3 255.9 Academic or educational problem 
V62.4 260.3 Acculturation difficulty 
308.3 F43.0 Acute stress disorder 
Adjustment disorders 
309.24 F43.22 With anxiety 
309.0 F43.21 With depressed mood 
309.3 F43.24 With disturbance of conduct 
309.28 F43.23 With mixed anxiety and depressed mood 
309.4 F43.25 With mixed disturbance of emotions and conduct 
309.9 F43.20 Unspecified 
V71.01 272.811 Adult antisocial behavior 
307.0 F98.5 Adult-onset fluency disorder 


Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed 
995.81 T74.11XA Initial encounter 
995.81 T74.11XD Subsequent encounter 

Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected 
995.81 T76.11XA Initial encounter 
995.81 T76.11XD Subsequent encounter 

Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, 

Confirmed 

995.82 T74.31XA Initial encounter 
995.82 T74.31XD Subsequent encounter 

Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected 
995.82 T76.31XA Initial encounter 
995.82 T76.31XD Subsequent encounter 

Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed 
995.83 T74.21XA Initial encounter 
995.83 T74.21XD Subsequent encounter 

Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected 
995.83 T76.21XA Initial encounter 
995.83 T76.21XD Subsequent encounter 


839 


840 Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


300.22 F40.00 Agoraphobia 

291.89 Alcohol-induced anxiety disorder 
F10.180 With mild use disorder 
F10.280 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.980 Without use disorder 

291.89 Alcohol-induced bipolar and related disorder 
F10.14 With mild use disorder 
F10.24 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.94 Without use disorder 

291.89 Alcohol-induced depressive disorder 
F10.14 With mild use disorder 
F10.24 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.94 Without use disorder 

291.1 Alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Amnestic 

confabulatory type 

F10.26 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.96 Without use disorder 

291.2 Alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Nonamnestic 

confabulatory type 

F10.27 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.97 Without use disorder 

291.89 Alcohol-induced mild neurocognitive disorder 
F10.288 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.988 Without use disorder 

291.9 Alcohol-induced psychotic disorder 
F10.159 With mild use disorder 
F10.259 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.959 Without use disorder 

291.89 Alcohol-induced sexual dysfunction 
F10.181 With mild use disorder 
F10.281 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.981 Without use disorder 

291.82 Alcohol-induced sleep disorder 
F10.182 With mild use disorder 
F10.282 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.982 Without use disorder 

303.00 Alcohol intoxication 
F10.129 With mild use disorder 
F10.229 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F10.929 Without use disorder 

291.0 Alcohol intoxication delirium 
F10.121 With mild use disorder 
F10.221 With moderate or severe use disorder 


F10.921 Without use disorder 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 841 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


305.00 
303.90 
303.90 
291.81 


291.0 


292.89 


292.84 


292.84 


292.89 


292.9 


292.89 


292.85 


292.89 


F10.10 
F10.20 
F10.20 


F10.232 
F10.239 
F10.231 


F15.180 
F15.280 
F15.980 


F15.14 
F15.24 
F15.94 
F15.921 


F15.14 
F15.24 
F15.94 


F15.188 
F15.288 
F15.988 


F15.159 
F15.259 
F15.959 


F15.181 
F15.281 
F15.981 


F15.182 
F15.282 
F15.982 


F15.122 
F15.222 
F15.922 


Alcohol use disorder 
Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 
Alcohol withdrawal 
With perceptual disturbances 
Without perceptual disturbances 
Alcohol withdrawal delirium 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced anxiety disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced bipolar and related 
disorder 


With mild use disorder 

With moderate or severe use disorder 

Without use disorder 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced delirium 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced depressive disorder 

With mild use disorder 

With moderate or severe use disorder 

Without use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced obsessive-compulsive 
and related disorder 


With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced psychotic disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sexual dysfunction 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sleep disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication 


Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication, With perceptual 
disturbances 


With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 


842 Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication, Without perceptual 


disturbances 
F15.129 With mild use disorder 
F15.229 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F15.929 Without use disorder 
292.81 Amphetamine (or other stimulant) intoxication delirium 
F15.121 With mild use disorder 
F15.221 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F15.921 Without use disorder 
292.0 F15.23 Amphetamine or other stimulant withdrawal 
Amphetamine-type substance use disorder 
305.70 F15.10 Mild 
304.40 F15.20 Moderate 
304.40 F15.20 Severe 
307.1 Anorexia nervosa 
F50.02 Binge-eating/ purging type 
F50.01 Restricting type 
Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome 
995.29 T43.205A Initial encounter 
995.29 T43.205S Sequelae 
995.29 T43.205D Subsequent encounter 
301.7 F60.2 Antisocial personality disorder 
293.84 F06.4 Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition 
Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder 
314.01 F90.2 Combined presentation 
314.01 F90.1 Predominantly hyperactive/impulsive presentation 
314.00 F90.0 Predominantly inattentive presentation 
299.00 F84.0 Autism spectrum disorder 
301.82 F60.6 Avoidant personality disorder 
307.59 F50.8 Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder 
307.51 F50.8 Binge-eating disorder 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed 
296.56 F31.76 In full remission 
296.55 F31.75 In partial remission 
296.51 F31.31 Mild 
296.52 F31.32 Moderate 
296.53 F31.4 Severe 
296.54 F31.5 With psychotic features 
296.50 F31.9 Unspecified 
296.40 F31.0 Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic 
296.46 F31.72 In full remission 
296.45 F31.71 In partial remission 


296.40 F31.9 Unspecified 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 843 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


296.46 
296.45 
296.41 
296.42 
296.43 
296.44 
296.40 
296.7 

296.89 
293.83 


300.7 
V62.89 
301.83 
298.8 
307.51 
292.89 


292.85 


305.90 
292.0 
292.89 


292.9 


292.85 


292.89 


F31.74 
F31.73 
F31.11 
F31.12 
F31.13 
F31.2 
F31.9 
F31.9 
F31.81 


F06.33 
F06.33 
F06.34 
F45.22 
R41.83 
F60.3 
F23 
F50.2 


F15.180 
F15.280 
F15.980 


F15.182 
F15.282 
F15.982 
F15.929 
F15.93 


F12.180 
F12.280 
F12.980 


F12.159 
F12.259 
F12.959 


F12.188 
F12.288 
F12.988 


Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic 
In full remission 
In partial remission 
Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 
With psychotic features 
Unspecified 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode unspecified 
Bipolar II disorder 
Bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition 
With manic features 
With manic- or hypomanic-like episodes 
With mixed features 
Body dysmorphic disorder 
Borderline intellectual functioning 
Borderline personality disorder 
Brief psychotic disorder 
Bulimia nervosa 
Caffeine-induced anxiety disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Caffeine-induced sleep disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Caffeine intoxication 
Caffeine withdrawal 
Cannabis-induced anxiety disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cannabis-induced psychotic disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cannabis-induced sleep disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cannabis intoxication 


844 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.81 


305.20 
304.30 
304.30 
292.0 

293.89 


293.89 


780.57 
786.04 
327.21 
V61.29 


995.52 
995.52 


995.52 
995.52 
V71.02 


995.54. 
995.54 


995.54. 
995.54 


995.51 
995.51 


995.51 
995.51 


F12.122 
F12.222 
F12.922 


F12.129 
F12.229 
F12.929 


F12.121 
F12.221 
F12.921 


F12.10 
F12.20 
F12.20 
F12.288 
F06.1 


F06.1 


G47.37 
RO6.3 
G47.31 
Z62.898 


T74.02XA 
T74.02XD 


T76.02XA 
T76.02XD 
272.810 


T74.12XA 
T74.12XD 


T76.12XA 
T76.12XD 


T74.32XA 
T74.32XD 


T76.32XA 
T76.32XD 


Cannabis intoxication, With perceptual disturbances 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cannabis intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cannabis intoxication delirium 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cannabis use disorder 
Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 
Cannabis withdrawal 
Catatonia associated with another mental disorder (catatonia 
specifier) 
Catatonic disorder due to another medical condition 
Central sleep apnea 
Central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid use 
Cheyne-Stokes breathing 
Idiopathic central sleep apnea 
Child affected by parental relationship distress 
Child neglect, Confirmed 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 
Child neglect, Suspected 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 
Child or adolescent antisocial behavior 
Child physical abuse, Confirmed 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 
Child physical abuse, Suspected 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 
Child psychological abuse, Confirmed 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 
Child psychological abuse, Suspected 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


845 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


995.53 
995.53 


995.53 
995.53 
315.35 
307.45 
307.45 
307.45 
307.45 
307.45 


307.45 
292.89 


292.84 


292.84 


292.89 


292.9 


292.89 


292.85 


T74.22XA 
T74.22XD 


T76.22XA 
T76.22XD 
F80.81 


G47.22 
G47.21 
G47.23 
G47.24 
G47.26 
G47.20 


F14.180 
F14.280 
F14.980 


F14.14 
F14.24 
F14.94 


F14.14 
F14.24 
F14.94 


F14.188 
F14.288 
F14.988 


F14.159 
F14.259 
F14.959 


F14.181 
F14.281 
F14.981 


F14.182 
F14.282 
F14.982 


Child sexual abuse, Confirmed 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 
Child sexual abuse, Suspected 
Initial encounter 
Subsequent encounter 
Childhood-onset fluency disorder (stuttering) 
Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders 
Advanced sleep phase type 
Delayed sleep phase type 
Irregular sleep-wake type 
Non-24-hour sleep-wake type 
Shift work type 
Unspecified type 
Cocaine-induced anxiety disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced bipolar and related disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced depressive disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced psychotic disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced sexual dysfunction 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced sleep disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 


846 Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.89 Cocaine intoxication 
Cocaine intoxication, With perceptual disturbances 
F14.122 With mild use disorder 
F14.222 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F14.922 Without use disorder 
Cocaine intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances 
F14.129 With mild use disorder 
F14.229 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F14.929 Without use disorder 
292.81 Cocaine intoxication delirium 
F14.121 With mild use disorder 
F14.221 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F14.921 Without use disorder 
Cocaine use disorder 
305.60 F14.10 Mild 
304.20 F14.20 Moderate 
304.20 F14.20 Severe 
292.0 F14.23 Cocaine withdrawal 
Conduct disorder 
312.82 F91.2 Adolescent-onset type 
312.81 F91.1 Childhood-onset type 
312.89 F91.9 Unspecified onset 
300.11 Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder) 
F44.4 With abnormal movement 
F44.6 With anesthesia or sensory loss 
F44.5 With attacks or seizures 
F44.7 With mixed symptoms 
F44.6 With special sensory symptoms 
F444 With speech symptoms 
F44.4 With swallowing symptoms 
F44.4 With weakness/ paralysis 
V62.5 Z65.0 Conviction in civil or criminal proceedings without imprisonment 
301.13 F34.0 Cyclothymic disorder 
302.74 F52.32 Delayed ejaculation 
Delirium 
293.0 FO5 Delirium due to another medical condition 
293.0 FO5 Delirium due to multiple etiologies 
292.81 Medication-induced delirium (for ICD-10-CM codes, see specific 
substances) 


Substance intoxication delirium (see specific substances for codes) 
Substance withdrawal delirium (see specific substances for codes) 
297.1 F22 Delusional disorder 
301.6 F60.7 Dependent personality disorder 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 847 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


300.6 F48.1 Depersonalization/derealization disorder 
293.83 Depressive disorder due to another medical condition 
F06.31 With depressive features 
F06.32 With major depressive—like episode 
F06.34 With mixed features 
315.4 F82 Developmental coordination disorder 
V60.89 259.2 Discord with neighbor, lodger, or landlord 
V62.89 264.4 Discord with social service provider, including probation officer, 
case manager, or social services worker 
313.89 F94.2 Disinhibited social engagement disorder 
V61.03 263.5 Disruption of family by separation or divorce 
296.99 F34.8 Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder 
300.12 F44.0 Dissociative amnesia 
300.13 F44.1 Dissociative amnesia, with dissociative fugue 
300.14 F44.81 Dissociative identity disorder 
307.7 F98.1 Encopresis 
307.6 F98.0 Enuresis 
302.72 F52.21 Erectile disorder 
698.4 L98.1 Excoriation (skin-picking) disorder 
302.4 F65.2 Exhibitionistic disorder 
V62.22 Z65.5 Exposure to disaster, war, or other hostilities 
V60.2 259.5 Extreme poverty 
300.19 F68.10 Factitious disorder 
302.73 F52.31 Female orgasmic disorder 
302.72 F52.22 Female sexual interest/arousal disorder 
302.81 F65.0 Fetishistic disorder 
302.89 F65.81 Frotteuristic disorder 
312.31 F63.0 Gambling disorder 
302.85 F64.1 Gender dysphoria in adolescents and adults 
302.6 F64.2 Gender dysphoria in children 
300.02 F41.1 Generalized anxiety disorder 
302.76 F52.6 Genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder 
315.8 F88 Global developmental delay 
292.89 F16.983 Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder 
V61.8 263.8 High expressed emotion level within family 
301.50 F60.4 Histrionic personality disorder 
300.3 F42 Hoarding disorder 
V60.0 259.0 Homelessness 
307.44 F51.11 Hypersomnolence disorder 
300.7 F45.21 Illness anxiety disorder 
V62.5 Z65.1 Imprisonment or other incarceration 


V60.1 259.1 Inadequate housing 


848 Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.89 Inhalant-induced anxiety disorder 
F18.180 With mild use disorder 
F18.280 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F18.980 Without use disorder 
292.84 Inhalant-induced depressive disorder 
F18.14 With mild use disorder 
F18.24 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F18.94 Without use disorder 
292.82 Inhalant-induced major neurocognitive disorder 
F18.17 With mild use disorder 
F18.27 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F18.97 Without use disorder 
292.89 Inhalant-induced mild neurocognitive disorder 
F18.188 With mild use disorder 
F18.288 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F18.988 Without use disorder 
292.9 Inhalant-induced psychotic disorder 
F18.159 With mild use disorder 
F18.259 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F18.959 Without use disorder 
292.89 Inhalant intoxication 
F18.129 With mild use disorder 
F18.229 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F18.929 Without use disorder 
292.81 Inhalant intoxication delirium 
F18.121 With mild use disorder 
F18.221 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F18.921 Without use disorder 
Inhalant use disorder 
305.90 F18.10 Mild 
304.60 F18.20 Moderate 
304.60 F18.20 Severe 
307.42 F51.01 Insomnia disorder 
V60.2 259.7 Insufficient social insurance or welfare support 
Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) 
317 F70 Mild 
318.0 F71 Moderate 
318.1 F72 Severe 
318.2 F73 Profound 
312.34 F63.81 Intermittent explosive disorder 
312.32 F63.2 Kleptomania 
V60.2 259.4 Lack of adequate food or safe drinking water 
315.32 F80.2 Language disorder 


V60.2 259.6 Low income 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 849 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode 


296.36 F33.42 In full remission 
296.35 F33.41 In partial remission 
296.31 F33.0 Mild 
296.32 F33.1 Moderate 
296.33 F33.2 Severe 
296.34 F33.3 With psychotic features 
296.30 F33.9 Unspecified 
Major depressive disorder, Single episode 
296.26 F32.5 In full remission 
296.25 F32.4 In partial remission 
296.21 F32.0 Mild 
296.22 F32.1 Moderate 
296.23 F32.2 Severe 
296.24 F32.3 With psychotic features 
296.20 F32.9 Unspecifed 
331.9 G31.9 Major frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder, Possible 


Major frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder, Probable (code first 
331.19 [G31.09] frontotemporal disease) 


294.11 FO2.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 
331.9 G31.9 Major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, Possible 


Major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, 
Probable (code first 331.0 [G30.9] Alzheimer’s disease) 


294.11 FO2.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 
Major neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition 
294.11 FO2.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 


Major neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection (code first 042 
[B20] HIV infection) 
294.11 F02.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 


Major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease (code 
first 333.4 [G10] Huntington’s disease) 


294.11 F02.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 
331.9 G31.9 Major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, Possible 


Major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, Probable (code 
first 331.82 [G31.83] Lewy body disease) 


294.11 F02.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies 
294.11 F02.81 With behavioral disturbance 


294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 


850 = Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


331.9 G31.9 Major neurocognitive disorder due to Parkinson’s disease, Possible 


Major neurocognitive disorder due to Parkinson’s disease, 
Probable (code first 332.0 [G20] Parkinson’s disease) 


294.11 F02.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 
Major neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease (code first 
046.79 [A81.9] prion disease) 
294.11 F02.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 


Major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury (code 
first 907.0 late effect of intracranial injury without skull fracture 
[S06.2X9S diffuse traumatic brain injury with loss of conscious- 
ness of unspecified duration, sequela]) 


294.11 F02.81 With behavioral disturbance 
294.10 F02.80 Without behavioral disturbance 
331.9 G31.9 Major vascular neurocognitive disorder, Possible 
Major vascular neurocognitive disorder, Probable 
290.40 F01.51 With behavioral disturbance 
290.40 F01.50 Without behavioral disturbance 
302.71 F52.0 Male hypoactive sexual desire disorder 
V65.2 276.5 Malingering 
333.99 G25.71 Medication-induced acute akathisia 
333.72 G24.02 Medication-induced acute dystonia 
292.81 Medication-induced delirium (for ICD-10-CM codes, see specific 
substances) 
333.1 G25.1 Medication-induced postural tremor 
331.83 G31.84 Mild frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Parkinson’s disease 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury 
331.83 G31.84 Mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies 
331.83 G31.84 Mild vascular neurocognitive disorder 
301.81 F60.81 Narcissistic personality disorder 
Narcolepsy 
347.00 G47.419 Autosomal dominant cerebellar ataxia, deafness, and 
narcolepsy 
347.00 G47.419 Autosomal dominant narcolepsy, obesity, and type 2 diabetes 
347.10 G47.429 Narcolepsy secondary to another medical condition 
347.01 G47.411 Narcolepsy with cataplexy but without hypocretin deficiency 
347.00 G47.419 Narcolepsy without cataplexy but with hypocretin deficiency 


332.1 G21.11 Neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


333.92 G21.0 Neuroleptic malignant syndrome 
307.47 F51.5 Nightmare disorder 
V15.81 291.19 Nonadherence to medical treatment 
Non-rapid eye movement sleep arousal disorders 
307.46 F51.4 Sleep terror type 
307.46 F51.3 Sleepwalking type 
300.3 F42 Obsessive-compulsive disorder 
301.4 F60.5 Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder 
294.8 F06.8 Obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to another 
medical condition 
327.23 G47.33 Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea 
292.89 Opioid-induced anxiety disorder 
F11.188 With mild use disorder 
F11.288 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F11.988 Without use disorder 
F11.921 Opioid-induced delirium 
292.84 Opioid-induced depressive disorder 
F11.14 With mild use disorder 
F11.24 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F11.94 Without use disorder 
292.89 Opioid-induced sexual dysfunction 
F11.181 With mild use disorder 
F11.281 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F11.981 Without use disorder 
292.85 Opioid-induced sleep disorder 
F11.182 With mild use disorder 
F11.282 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F11.982 Without use disorder 
292.89 Opioid intoxication 
Opioid intoxication, With perceptual disturbances 
F11.122 With mild use disorder 
F11.222 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F11.922 Without use disorder 
Opioid intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances 
F11.129 With mild use disorder 
F11.229 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F11.929 Without use disorder 
292.81 Opioid intoxication delirium 
F11.121 With mild use disorder 
F11.221 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F11.921 Without use disorder 
Opioid use disorder 
305.50 F11.10 Mild 
304.00 F11.20 Moderate 


304.00 F11.20 Severe 


851 


852 Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.0 F11.23 Opioid withdrawal 
292.0 F11.23 Opioid withdrawal delirium 
313.81 F91.3 Oppositional defiant disorder 


Other adverse effect of medication 
995.20 T50.905A Initial encounter 
995.20 T50.905S Sequelae 
995.20 T50.905D Subsequent encounter 
Other circumstances related to adult abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner 


V62.83 269.82 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonspousal adult abuse 


V65.49 269.81 Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonspousal 
adult abuse 


Other circumstances related to child neglect 


V62.83 Z69.021 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonparental child neglect 

V61.22 269.011 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental 
child neglect 

V61.21 Z69.010 Encounter for mental health services for victim of child neglect by 
parent 

V61.21 Z69.020 Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental 
child neglect 

V15.42 Z62.812 Personal history (past history) of neglect in childhood 

Other circumstances related to child physical abuse 

V62.83 Z69.021 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonparental child abuse 

V61.22 Z69.011 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental 
child abuse 

V61.21 Z69.010 Encounter for mental health services for victim of child abuse by 
parent 

V61.21 269.020 Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental 
child abuse 

V15.41 Z62.810 Personal history (past history) of physical abuse in childhood 

Other circumstances related to child psychological abuse 

V62.83 Z69.021 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonparental child psychological abuse 

V61.22 Z69.011 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental 
child psychological abuse 

V61.21 Z69.010 Encounter for mental health services for victim of child 
psychological abuse by parent 

V61.21 269.020 Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental 
child psychological abuse 

V15.42 262.811 Personal history (past history) of psychological abuse in childhood 


Other circumstances related to child sexual abuse 
V62.83 Z69.021 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of 
nonparental child sexual abuse 
V61.22 Z69.011 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental 
child sexual abuse 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 853 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


V61.21 


V61.21 


V15.41 


V61.12 


V61.11 


V15.42 


V61.12 


V61.11 


V15.42 


V61.12 


V61.11 


V15.41 


V61.12 


V61.11 


V15.41 


V65.40 
292.89 


292.84 


292.84 


Z69.010 


Z69.020 


Z62.810 


Z69.12 


Z69.11 


Z91.411 


Z69.12 


Z69.11 


Z91.412 


Z69.12 


Z69.11 


Z91.410 


Z69.12 


Z69.81 


Z91.410 


Z71.9 


F16.180 
F16.280 
F16.980 


F16.14 
F16.24 
F16.94 


F16.14 
F16.24 
F16.94 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of child sexual 
abuse by parent 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental 
child sexual abuse 


Personal history (past history) of sexual abuse in childhood 
Other circumstances related to spouse or partner abuse, Psychological 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or 
partner psychological abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or 
partner psychological abuse 


Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner 
psychological abuse 
Other circumstances related to spouse or partner neglect 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or 
partner neglect 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or 
partner neglect 


Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner neglect 
Other circumstances related to spouse or partner violence, Physical 
Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or 
partner violence, Physical 
Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or 
partner violence, Physical 
Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, 
Physical 
Other circumstances related to spouse or partner violence, Sexual 
Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or 
partner violence, Sexual 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or 
partner violence, Sexual 


Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, 
Sexual 


Other counseling or consultation 

Other hallucinogen—induced anxiety disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced bipolar and related disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced depressive disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 


854 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.9 


292.89 


292.81 


305.30 
304.50 
304.50 
333.99 
332.1 
V15.49 
V15.89 
V62.29 
V62.89 
300.09 
314.01 
296.89 
780.09 
311 
312.89 
300.15 


787.60 
788.39 
307.59 
302.6 
780.54 
780.52 
300.9 
294.8 
315.8 
300.3 
302.89 
301.89 
298.8 
302.79 


F16.159 
F16.259 
F16.959 


F16.129 
F16.229 
F16.929 


F16.121 
F16.221 
F16.921 


F16.10 
F16.20 
F16.20 
G25.79 
G21.19 
Z91.49 
Z91.89 
Z56.9 
Z65.8 
F41.8 
F90.8 
F31.89 
R41.0 
F32.8 
F91.8 
F44.89 


R15.9 
N39.498 
F50.8 
F64.8 
G47.19 
G47.09 
F99 
F06.8 
F88 
P42 
F65.89 
F60.89 
F28 
F52.8 


Other hallucinogen—induced psychotic disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Other hallucinogen intoxication 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Other hallucinogen intoxication delirium 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Other hallucinogen use disorder 
Mild 
Moderate 
Severe 
Other medication-induced movement disorder 
Other medication-induced parkinsonism 
Other personal history of psychological trauma 
Other personal risk factors 
Other problem related to employment 
Other problem related to psychosocial circumstances 
Other specified anxiety disorder 
Other specified attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder 
Other specified bipolar and related disorder 
Other specified delirium 
Other specified depressive disorder 
Other specified disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder 
Other specified dissociative disorder 
Other specified elimination disorder 
With fecal symptoms 
With urinary symptoms 
Other specified feeding or eating disorder 
Other specified gender dysphoria 
Other specified hypersomnolence disorder 
Other specified insomnia disorder 
Other specified mental disorder 
Other specified mental disorder due to another medical condition 
Other specified neurodevelopmental disorder 
Other specified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
Other specified paraphilic disorder 
Other specified personality disorder 
Other specified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder 
Other specified sexual dysfunction 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 855 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


780.59 
300.89 
307.20 
309.89 
292.89 


292.84 


292.84 


292.82 


292.89 


292.89 


292.9 


292.89 


292.85 


G47.8 
F45.8 
F95.8 
F43.8 


F19.180 
F19.280 
F19.980 


F19.14 
F19.24 
F19.94 
F19.921 


F19.14 
F19.24 
F19.94 


F19.17 
F19.27 
F19.97 


F19.188 
F19.288 
F19.988 


F19.188 
F19.288 
F19.988 


F19.159 
F19.259 
F19.959 


F19.181 
F19.281 
F19.981 


F19.182 
F19.282 
F19.982 


Other specified sleep-wake disorder 
Other specified somatic symptom and related disorder 
Other specified tic disorder 
Other specified trauma- and stressor-related disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced anxiety disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced bipolar and related disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance—induced delirium 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced depressive disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced major neurocognitive 
disorder 


With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced mild neurocognitive 
disorder 


With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced obsessive-compulsive 
and related disorder 


With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance—-induced psychotic disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced sexual dysfunction 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced sleep disorder 
With mild use disorder 
With moderate or severe use disorder 
Without use disorder 


856 Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.89 Other (or unknown) substance intoxication 
F19.129 With mild use disorder 
F19.229 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F19.929 Without use disorder 
292.81 Other (or unknown) substance intoxication delirium 
F19.121 With mild use disorder 
F19.221 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F19.921 Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance use disorder 
305.90 F19.10 Mild 
304.90 F19.20 Moderate 
304.90 F19.20 Severe 
292.0 F19.239 Other (or unknown) substance withdrawal 
292.0 F19.231 Other (or unknown) substance withdrawal delirium 
Other or unspecified stimulant use disorder 
305.70 F15.10 Mild 
304.40 F15.20 Moderate 
304.40 F15.20 Severe 
278.00 E66.9 Overweight or obesity 
Panic attack specifier 
300.01 F41.0 Panic disorder 
301.0 F60.0 Paranoid personality disorder 
V61.20 262.820 Parent-child relational problem 
302.2 F65.4 Pedophilic disorder 
307.22 F95.1 Persistent (chronic) motor or vocal tic disorder 
300.4 F34.1 Persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia) 
V62.22 291.82 Personal history of military deployment 
V15.59 291.5 Personal history of self-harm 
310.1 F0O7.0 Personality change due to another medical condition 
V62.89 Z60.0 Phase of life problem 
292.89 Phencyclidine-induced anxiety disorder 
F16.180 With mild use disorder 
F16.280 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F16.980 Without use disorder 
292.84 Phencyclidine-induced bipolar and related disorder 
F16.14 With mild use disorder 
F16.24 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F16.94 Without use disorder 
292.84 Phencyclidine-induced depressive disorder 
F16.14 With mild use disorder 
F16.24 With moderate or severe use disorder 


F16.94 Without use disorder 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.9 Phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder 

F16.159 With mild use disorder 

F16.259 With moderate or severe use disorder 

F16.959 Without use disorder 
292.89 Phencyclidine intoxication 

F16.129 With mild use disorder 

F16.229 With moderate or severe use disorder 

F16.929 Without use disorder 
292.81 Phencyclidine intoxication delirium 

F16.121 With mild use disorder 

F16.221 With moderate or severe use disorder 

F16.921 Without use disorder 

Phencyclidine use disorder 

305.90 F16.10 Mild 
304.60 F16.20 Moderate 
304.60 F16.20 Severe 
307.52 Pica 

F50.8 In adults 

F98.3 In children 
309.81 F43.10 Posttraumatic stress disorder 
302.75 F52.4 Premature (early) ejaculation 
625.4 N94.3 Premenstrual dysphoric disorder 
V62.21 256.82 Problem related to current military deployment status 
V69.9 272.9 Problem related to lifestyle 
V60.3 Z60.2 Problem related to living alone 
V60.6 259.3 Problem related to living in a residential institution 
V61.5 264.1 Problems related to multiparity 
V62.5 265.3 Problems related to other legal circumstances 
V62.5 Z65.2 Problems related to release from prison 
V61.7 264.0 Problems related to unwanted pregnancy 
307.21 F95.0 Provisional tic disorder 
316 F54 Psychological factors affecting other medical conditions 

Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition 

293.81 F06.2 With delusions 
293.82 F06.0 With hallucinations 
312.33 F63.1 Pyromania 
327.42 G47.52 Rapid eye movement sleep behavior disorder 
313.89 F94.1 Reactive attachment disorder 
V61.10 Z63.0 Relationship distress with spouse or intimate partner 
V62.89 265.8 Religious or spiritual problem 
333.94 G25.81 Restless legs syndrome 


307.53 F98.21 Rumination disorder 


857 


858 Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


Schizoaffective disorder 


295.70 F25.0 Bipolar type 
295.70 F25.1 Depressive type 
301.20 F60.1 Schizoid personality disorder 
295.90 F20.9 Schizophrenia 
295.40 F20.81 Schizophreniform disorder 
301.22 F21 Schizotypal personality disorder 
292.89 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder 
F13.180 With mild use disorder 
F13.280 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.980 Without use disorder 
292.84 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced bipolar and related 
disorder 
F13.14 With mild use disorder 
F13.24 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.94 Without use disorder 
F13.921 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced delirium 
292.84 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder 
F13.14 With mild use disorder 
F13.24 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.94 Without use disorder 
292.82 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced major neurocognitive 
disorder 
F13.27 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.97 Without use disorder 
292.89 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced mild neurocognitive 
disorder 
F13.288 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.988 Without use disorder 
292.9 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced psychotic disorder 
F13.159 With mild use disorder 
F13.259 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.959 Without use disorder 
292.89 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sexual dysfunction 
F13.181 With mild use disorder 
F13.281 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.981 Without use disorder 
292.85 Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sleep disorder 
F13.182 With mild use disorder 
F13.282 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.982 Without use disorder 
292.89 Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication 
F13.129 With mild use disorder 
F13.229 With moderate or severe use disorder 


F13.929 Without use disorder 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.81 Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication delirium 
F13.121 With mild use disorder 
F13.221 With moderate or severe use disorder 
F13.921 Without use disorder 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder 
305.40 F13.10 Mild 
304.10 F13.20 Moderate 
304.10 F13.20 Severe 
292.0 Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal 
F13.232 With perceptual disturbances 
F13.239 Without perceptual disturbances 
292.0 F13.231 Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal delirium 
313.23 F94.0 Selective mutism 
309.21 F93.0 Separation anxiety disorder 
V65.49 270.9 Sex counseling 
302.83 F65.51 Sexual masochism disorder 
302.84 F65.52 Sexual sadism disorder 
V61.8 262.891 Sibling relational problem 
Sleep-related hypoventilation 
327.26 G47.36 Comorbid sleep-related hypoventilation 
327.25 G47.35 Congenital central alveolar hypoventilation 
327.24 G47.34 Idiopathic hypoventilation 
300.23 F40.10 Social anxiety disorder (social phobia) 
V62.4 Z60.4 Social exclusion or rejection 
315.39 F80.89 Social (pragmatic) communication disorder 
300.82 F45.1 Somatic symptom disorder 
Specific learning disorder 
315.1 F81.2 With impairment in mathematics 
315.00 F81.0 With impairment in reading 
315.2 F81.81 With impairment in written expression 
Specific phobia 
300.29 F40.218 Animal 
300.29 Blood-injection-injury 
F40.230 Fear of blood 
F40.231 Fear of injections and transfusions 
F40.233 Fear of injury 
F40.232 Fear of other medical care 
300.29 F40.228 Natural environment 
300.29 F40.298 Other 
300.29 F40.248 Situational 
315.39 F80.0 Speech sound disorder 


Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Confirmed 
995.82 T74.31XA Initial encounter 
995.82 T74.31XD Subsequent encounter 


859 


860 Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Suspected 
995.82 T76.31XA Initial encounter 
995.82 T76.31XD Subsequent encounter 
Spouse or partner neglect, Confirmed 
995.85 T74.01XA Initial encounter 
995.85 T74.01XD Subsequent encounter 
Spouse or partner neglect, Suspected 
995.85 T76.01XA Initial encounter 
995.85 T76.01XD Subsequent encounter 
Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Confirmed 
995.81 T74.11XA Initial encounter 
995.81 T74.11XD Subsequent encounter 
Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Suspected 
995.81 T76.11XA Initial encounter 
995.81 T76.11XD Subsequent encounter 
Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Confirmed 
995.83 T74.21XA Initial encounter 
995.83 T74.21XD Subsequent encounter 
Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Suspected 
995.83 T76.21XA Initial encounter 
995.83 T76.21XD Subsequent encounter 
307.3 F98.4 Stereotypic movement disorder 
Stimulant intoxication (see amphetamine or cocaine intoxication for 
specific codes) 
Stimulant use disorder (see amphetamine or cocaine use disorder for 
specific codes) 
Stimulant withdrawal (see amphetamine or cocaine withdrawal for 
specific codes) 
Substance intoxication delirium (see specific substances for codes) 
Substance withdrawal delirium (see specific substances for codes) 
Substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder (see specific 
substances for codes) 
Substance/medication-induced bipolar and related disorder (see 
specific substances for codes) 
Substance/medication-induced depressive disorder (see specific 
substances for codes) 
Substance/medication-induced major or mild neurocognitive 
disorder (see specific substances for codes) 
Substance/medication-induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder (see specific substances for codes) 
Substance/medication-induced psychotic disorder (see specific 
substances for codes) 
Substance/medication-induced sexual dysfunction (see specific 
substances for codes) 
Substance/medication-induced sleep disorder (see specific 
substances for codes) 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 861 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


333.99 G25.71 Tardive akathisia 
333.85 G24.01 Tardive dyskinesia 
333.72 G24.09 Tardive dystonia 
V62.4 Z60.5 Target of (perceived) adverse discrimination or persecution 
292.85 Tobacco-induced sleep disorder 

F17.208 With moderate or severe use disorder 

Tobacco use disorder 

305.1 272.0 Mild 
305.1 F17.200 Moderate 
305.1 F17.200 Severe 
292.0 F17.203 Tobacco withdrawal 
307.23 F95.2 Tourette’s disorder 
302.3 F65.1 Transvestic disorder 
312.39 F63.3 Trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder) 
V63.9 275.3 Unavailability or inaccessibility of health care facilities 
V63.8 275.4 Unavailability or inaccessibility of other helping agencies 
V62.82 263.4 Uncomplicated bereavement 
291.9 F10.99 Unspecified alcohol-related disorder 
300.00 F41.9 Unspecified anxiety disorder 
314.01 F90.9 Unspecified attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder 
296.80 F31.9 Unspecified bipolar and related disorder 
292.9 F15.99 Unspecified caffeine-related disorder 
292.9 F12.99 Unspecified cannabis-related disorder 


293.89 F06.1 Unspecified catatonia (code first 781.99 [R29.818] other symptoms 
involving nervous and musculoskeletal systems) 


307.9 F80.9 Unspecified communication disorder 
780.09 R41.0 Unspecified delirium 
311 F32.9 Unspecified depressive disorder 
312.9 F91.9 Unspecified disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder 
300.15 F44.9 Unspecified dissociative disorder 
Unspecified elimination disorder 
787.60 R15.9 With fecal symptoms 
788.30 R32 With urinary symptoms 
307.50 F50.9 Unspecified feeding or eating disorder 
302.6 F64.9 Unspecified gender dysphoria 
292.9 F16.99 Unspecified hallucinogen-related disorder 
V60.9 Z59.9 Unspecified housing or economic problem 
780.54 G47.10 Unspecified hypersomnolence disorder 
292.9 F18.99 Unspecified inhalant-related disorder 
780.52 G47.00 Unspecified insomnia disorder 
319 B79 Unspecified intellectual disability (intellectual developmental 
disorder) 
300.9 F99 Unspecified mental disorder 
294.9 FO9 Unspecified mental disorder due to another medical condition 


799.59 R41.9 Unspecified neurocognitive disorder 


862 


Alphabetical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM and ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-9-CM ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


315.9 
300.3 
292.9 
292.9 
302.9 
301.9 
292.9 
V62.9 
V62.9 


298.9 
292.9 
302.70 
780.59 
300.82 
292.9 


307.20 
292.9 
309.9 
V61.8 
V62.89 
V62.89 
302.82 
V40.31 


F89 
F42 
F11.99 
F19.99 
F65.9 
F60.9 
F16.99 
Z60.9 
Z65.9 


F29 
F13.99 
F52.9 
G47.9 
F45.9 


F15.99 
F14.99 
F95.9 
F17.209 
F43.9 
Z62.29 
Z65.4 
Z65.4 
F65.3 
Z91.83 


Unspecified neurodevelopmental disorder 

Unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
Unspecified opioid-related disorder 

Unspecified other (or unknown) substance-related disorder 
Unspecified paraphilic disorder 

Unspecified personality disorder 

Unspecified phencyclidine-related disorder 

Unspecified problem related to social environment 


Unspecified problem related to unspecified psychosocial 
circumstances 


Unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder 
Unspecified sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-related disorder 
Unspecified sexual dysfunction 

Unspecified sleep-wake disorder 


Unspecified somatic symptom and related disorder 

Unspecified stimulant-related disorder 
Unspecified amphetamine or other stimulant-related disorder 
Unspecified cocaine-related disorder 

Unspecified tic disorder 

Unspecified tobacco-related disorder 

Unspecified trauma- and stressor-related disorder 

Upbringing away from parents 

Victim of crime 

Victim of terrorism or torture 

Voyeuristic disorder 

Wandering associated with a mental disorder 


Numerical Listing of 


DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes 


(iICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM codes are to be used for coding purposes in the United States through 


September 30, 2014. 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


278.00 
290.40 
290.40 


291.0 
291.0 
291.1 
291.2 
291.81 
291.82 
291.89 
291.89 
291.89 
291.89 
291.89 
291.9 
291.9 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.0 
292.81 
292.81 
292.81 


Overweight or obesity 
Probable major vascular neurocognitive disorder, With behavioral disturbance 


Probable major vascular neurocognitive disorder, Without behavioral 
disturbance 


Alcohol intoxication delirium 

Alcohol withdrawal delirium 

Alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Amnestic confabulatory type 
Alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Nonamnestic confabulatory type 
Alcohol withdrawal 

Alcohol-induced sleep disorder 

Alcohol-induced anxiety disorder 

Alcohol-induced bipolar and related disorder 
Alcohol-induced depressive disorder 

Alcohol-induced mild neurocognitive disorder 
Alcohol-induced sexual dysfunction 

Alcohol-induced psychotic disorder 

Unspecified alcohol-related disorder 

Amphetamine or other stimulant withdrawal 

Caffeine withdrawal 

Cannabis withdrawal 

Cocaine withdrawal 

Opioid withdrawal 

Opioid withdrawal delirium 

Other (or unknown) substance withdrawal 

Other (or unknown) substance withdrawal delirium 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal delirium 
Tobacco withdrawal 

Amphetamine (or other stimulant) intoxication delirium 
Cannabis intoxication delirium 

Cocaine intoxication delirium 


863 


864 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.81 
292.81 
292.81 
292.81 
292.81 
292.81 
292.81 
292.82 
292.82 
292.82 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.84 
292.85 
292.85 
292.85 
292.85 
292.85 
292.85 
292.85 
292.85 
292.89 
292.89 


292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 


Inhalant intoxication delirium 

Medication-induced delirium 

Opioid intoxication delirium 

Other hallucinogen intoxication delirium 

Other (or unknown) substance intoxication delirium 

Phencyclidine intoxication delirium 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication delirium 
Inhalant-induced major neurocognitive disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance-induced major neurocognitive disorder 
Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced major neurocognitive disorder 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced bipolar and related disorder 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced depressive disorder 
Cocaine-induced bipolar and related disorder 

Cocaine-induced depressive disorder 

Inhalant-induced depressive disorder 

Opioid-induced depressive disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced bipolar and related disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced depressive disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance-induced bipolar and related disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced depressive disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced bipolar and related disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced depressive disorder 

Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced bipolar and related disorder 
Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sleep disorder 
Caffeine-induced sleep disorder 

Cannabis-induced sleep disorder 

Cocaine-induced sleep disorder 

Opioid-induced sleep disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance-induced sleep disorder 

Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sleep disorder 
Tobacco-induced sleep disorder 

Amphetamine (or other stimulant)-induced anxiety disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sexual dysfunction 
Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication 
Caffeine-induced anxiety disorder 

Cannabis-induced anxiety disorder 

Cannabis intoxication 

Cocaine-induced anxiety disorder 

Cocaine-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
Cocaine-induced sexual dysfunction 

Cocaine intoxication 

Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 865 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.89 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
292.9 
293.0 
293.0 
293.81 
293.82 
293.83 
293.83 
293.84 
293.89 


Inhalant-induced anxiety disorder 

Inhalant-induced mild neurocognitive disorder 

Inhalant intoxication 

Opioid-induced anxiety disorder 

Opioid-induced sexual dysfunction 

Opioid intoxication 

Other hallucinogen—induced anxiety disorder 

Other hallucinogen intoxication 

Other (or unknown) substance-induced anxiety disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced mild neurocognitive disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance—induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced sexual dysfunction 
Other (or unknown) substance intoxication 
Phencyclidine-induced anxiety disorder 

Phencyclidine intoxication 

Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder 
Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced mild neurocognitive disorder 
Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sexual dysfunction 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication 

Amphetamine (or other stimulant)-induced psychotic disorder 
Cannabis-induced psychotic disorder 

Cocaine-induced psychotic disorder 

Inhalant-induced psychotic disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced psychotic disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance-induced psychotic disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder 

Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced psychotic disorder 
nspecified caffeine-related disorder 

nspecified cannabis-related disorder 

nspecified hallucinogen-related disorder 

nspecified inhalant-related disorder 

nspecified opioid-related disorder 

nspecified other (or unknown) substance-related disorder 
nspecified phencyclidine-related disorder 

nspecified sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-related disorder 
nspecified stimulant-related disorder 


U 
U 
U 
U 
U 
U 
U 
U 
U 
U 


nspecified tobacco-related disorder 

Delirium due to another medical condition 

Delirium due to multiple etiologies 

Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition, With delusions 
Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition, With hallucinations 
Bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition 
Depressive disorder due to another medical condition 

Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition 

Catatonia associated with another mental disorder (catatonia specifier) 


866 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


293.89 
293.89 


294.10 


294.10 


294.10 


294.10 


294.10 


294.10 


294.10 


294.10 


294.10 


294.10 


294.11 


294.11 


294.11 


294.11 


294.11 


294.11 


294.11 


294.11 


294.11 


294.11 


294.8 
294.8 
294.9 


Catatonic disorder due to another medical condition 

Unspecified catatonia (code first 781.99 other symptoms involving nervous and 
musculoskeletal systems) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition, Without 

behavioral disturbance 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection, Without behavioral 

disturbance (code first 042 HIV infection) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, Without 

behavioral disturbance (code first 333.4 Huntington’s disease) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies, Without behavioral 

disturbance 

Major neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s disease, Without 

behavioral disturbance (code first 332.0 Parkinson’s disease) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease, Without behavioral 

disturbance (code first 046.79 prion disease) 


Major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, Without 
behavioral disturbance (code first 907.0 late effect of intracranial injury without 
skull fracture) 

Probable major frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder, Without behavioral 
disturbance (code first 331.19 frontotemporal disease) 

Probable major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, Without 
behavioral disturbance (code first 331.0 Alzheimer’s disease) 

Probable major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, Without behavioral 
disturbance (code first 331.82 Lewy body disease) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition, With 

behavioral disturbance 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection, With behavioral 

disturbance (code first 042 HIV infection) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, With behavioral 

disturbance (code first 333.4 Huntington’s disease) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies, With behavioral 

disturbance 

Major neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s disease, With 

behavioral disturbance (code first 332.0 Parkinson’s disease) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease, With behavioral 

disturbance (code first 046.79 prion disease) 


Major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first 907.0 late effect of intracranial injury without skull 
fracture) 


Probable major frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first 331.19 frontotemporal disease) 


Probable major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, With 
behavioral disturbance (code first 331.0 Alzheimer’s disease) 


Probable major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first 331.82 Lewy body disease) 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to another medical condition 
Other specified mental disorder due to another medical condition 
Unspecified mental disorder due to another medical condition 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 867 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


295.40 
295.70 
295.70 
295.90 
296.20 
296.21 
296.22 
296.23 
296.24 
296.25 
296.26 
296.30 
296.31 
296.32 
296.33 
296.34 
296.35 
296.36 
296.40 
296.40 
296.40 
296.41 
296.42 
296.43 
296.44 
296.45 
296.45 
296.46 
296.46 
296.50 
296.51 
296.52 
296.53 
296.54 


296.55 
296.56 
296.7 
296.80 
296.89 
296.89 
296.99 
297.1 
298.8 
298.8 


Schizophreniform disorder 

Schizoaffective disorder, Bipolar type 

Schizoaffective disorder, Depressive type 

Schizophrenia 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, Unspecifed 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, Mild 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, Moderate 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, Severe 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, With psychotic features 
Major depressive disorder, Single episode, In partial remission 
Major depressive disorder, Single episode, In full remission 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, Unspecified 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, Mild 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, Moderate 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, Severe 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, With psychotic features 
Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, In partial remission 


Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, In full remission 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic, Unspecified 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, Unspecified 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, Mild 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, Moderate 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, Severe 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, With psychotic features 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic, In partial remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, In partial remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic, In full remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, In full remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, Unspecified 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, Mild 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, Moderate 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, Severe 


Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, With psychotic 
features 


Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, In partial remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, In full remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode unspecified 

Unspecified bipolar and related disorder 

Bipolar II disorder 

Other specified bipolar and related disorder 

Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder 

Delusional disorder 

Brief psychotic disorder 

Other specified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder 


868 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


298.9 
299.00 
300.00 
300.01 
300.02 
300.09 
300.11 
300.12 
300.13 
300.14 
300.15 
300.15 
300.19 
300.22 
300.23 
300.29 
300.29 
300.29 
300.29 
300.29 
300.3 
300.3 
300.3 
300.3 
300.4 
300.6 
300.7 
300.7 
300.82 
300.82 
300.89 
300.9 
300.9 
301.0 
301.13 
301.20 
301.22 
301.4 
301.50 
301.6 
301.7 
301.81 
301.82 
301.83 
301.89 


Unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder 
Autism spectrum disorder 

Unspecified anxiety disorder 

Panic disorder 

Generalized anxiety disorder 

Other specified anxiety disorder 

Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder) 
Dissociative amnesia 

Dissociative amnesia, With dissociative fugue 
Dissociative identity disorder 

Other specified dissociative disorder 

Unspecified dissociative disorder 

Factitious disorder 

Agoraphobia 

Social anxiety disorder (social phobia) 

Specific phobia, Animal 

Specific phobia, Blood-injection-injury 

Specific phobia, Natural environment 

Specific phobia, Other 

Specific phobia, Situational 

Hoarding disorder 

Obsessive-compulsive disorder 

Other specified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
Unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
Persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia) 
Depersonalization/derealization disorder 

Body dysmorphic disorder 

Illness anxiety disorder 

Somatic symptom disorder 

Unspecified somatic symptom and related disorder 
Other specified somatic symptom and related disorder 
Other specified mental disorder 

Unspecified mental disorder 

Paranoid personality disorder 

Cyclothymic disorder 

Schizoid personality disorder 

Schizotypal personality disorder 
Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder 

Histrionic personality disorder 

Dependent personality disorder 

Antisocial personality disorder 

Narcissistic personality disorder 

Avoidant personality disorder 

Borderline personality disorder 

Other specified personality disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


301.9 

302.2 

302.3 

302.4 

302.6 

302.6 

302.6 

302.70 
302.71 
302.72 
302.72 
302.73 
302.74. 
302.75 
302.76 
302.79 
302.81 
302.82 
302.83 
302.84 
302.85 
302.89 
302.89 
302.9 

303.00 
303.90 
303.90 
304.00 
304.00 
304.10 
304.10 
304.20 
304.20 
304.30 
304.30 
304.40 
304.40 
304.40 
304.40 
304.50 
304.50 
304.60 
304.60 
304.60 
304.60 


Unspecified personality disorder 

Pedophilic disorder 

Transvestic disorder 

Exhibitionistic disorder 

Gender dysphoria in children 

Other specified gender dysphoria 

Unspecified gender dysphoria 

Unspecified sexual dysfunction 

Male hypoactive sexual desire disorder 

Erectile disorder 

Female sexual interest/arousal disorder 

Female orgasmic disorder 

Delayed ejaculation 

Premature (early) ejaculation 

Genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder 

Other specified sexual dysfunction 

Fetishistic disorder 

Voyeuristic disorder 

Sexual masochism disorder 

Sexual sadism disorder 

Gender dysphoria in adolescents and adults 
Frotteuristic disorder 

Other specified paraphilic disorder 

Unspecified paraphilic disorder 

Alcohol intoxication 

Alcohol use disorder, Moderate 

Alcohol use disorder, Severe 

Opioid use disorder, Moderate 

Opioid use disorder, Severe 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, Moderate 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, Severe 
Cocaine use disorder, Moderate 

Cocaine use disorder, Severe 

Cannabis use disorder, Moderate 

Cannabis use disorder, Severe 

Amphetamine-type substance use disorder, Moderate 
Amphetamine-type substance use disorder, Severe 
Other or unspecified stimulant use disorder, Moderate 
Other or unspecified stimulant use disorder, Severe 
Other hallucinogen use disorder, Moderate 

Other hallucinogen use disorder, Severe 

Inhalant use disorder, Moderate 

Inhalant use disorder, Severe 

Phencyclidine use disorder, Moderate 
Phencyclidine use disorder, Severe 


869 


870 Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


304.90 Other (or unknown) substance use disorder, Moderate 

304.90 Other (or unknown) substance use disorder, Severe 

305.00 Alcohol use disorder, Mild 

305.1 Tobacco use disorder, Mild 

305.1 Tobacco use disorder, Moderate 

305.1 Tobacco use disorder, Severe 

305.20 Cannabis use disorder, Mild 

305.30 Other hallucinogen use disorder, Mild 

305.40 Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, Mild 

305.50 Opioid use disorder, Mild 

305.60 Cocaine use disorder, Mild 

305.70 Amphetamine-type substance use disorder, Mild 

305.70 Other or unspecified stimulant use disorder, Mild 

305.90 Caffeine intoxication 

305.90 Inhalant use disorder, Mild 

305.90 Other (or unknown) substance use disorder, Mild 

305.90 Phencyclidine use disorder, Mild 

307.0 Adult-onset fluency disorder 

307.1 Anorexia nervosa 

307.20 Other specified tic disorder 

307.20 Unspecified tic disorder 

307.21 Provisional tic disorder 

307.22 Persistent (chronic) motor or vocal tic disorder 

307.23 Tourette’s disorder 

307.3 Stereotypic movement disorder 

307.42 Insomnia disorder 

307.44 Hypersomnolence disorder 

307.45 Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Advanced sleep phase type 
307.45 Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Delayed sleep phase type 
307.45 Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Irregular sleep-wake type 
307.45 Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Non-24-hour sleep-wake type 
307.45 Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Shift work type 

307.45 Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Unspecified type 

307.46 Non-rapid eye movement sleep arousal disorders, Sleep terror type 
307.46 Non-rapid eye movement sleep arousal disorders, Sleepwalking type 
307.47 Nightmare disorder 

307.50 Unspecified feeding or eating disorder 

307.51 Binge-eating disorder 

307.51 Bulimia nervosa 

307.52 Pica 

307.53 Rumination disorder 

307.59 Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder 

307.59 Other specified feeding or eating disorder 

307.6 Enuresis 

307.7 Encopresis 


307.9 Unspecified communication disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 871 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


308.3 
309.0 
309.21 
309.24. 
309.28 
309.3 
309.4 
309.81 
309.89 
309.9 
309.9 
310.1 
311 
311 
312.31 
312.32 
312.33 
312.34 
312.39 
312.81 
312.82 
312.89 
312.89 
312.9 
313.23 
313.81 
313.89 
313.89 
314.00 
314.01 
314.01 


314.01 
314.01 
315.00 
315.1 
315.2 
315.32 
315.35 
315.39 
315.39 
315.4 
315.8 
315.8 
315.9 
316 


Acute stress disorder 

Adjustment disorders, With depressed mood 

Separation anxiety disorder 

Adjustment disorders, With anxiety 

Adjustment disorders, With mixed anxiety and depressed mood 
Adjustment disorders, With disturbance of conduct 

Adjustment disorders, With mixed disturbance of emotions and conduct 
Posttraumatic stress disorder 

Other specified trauma- and stressor-related disorder 
Adjustment disorders, Unspecified 

Unspecified trauma- and stressor-related disorder 

Personality change due to another medical condition 

Other specified depressive disorder 

Unspecified depressive disorder 

Gambling disorder 

Kleptomania 

Pyromania 

Intermittent explosive disorder 

Trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder) 

Conduct disorder, Childhood-onset type 

Conduct disorder, Adolescent-onset type 

Conduct disorder, Unspecified onset 

Other specified disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder 
Unspecified disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder 
Selective mutism 

Oppositional defiant disorder 

Disinhibited social engagement disorder 

Reactive attachment disorder 

Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, Predominantly inattentive presentation 
Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, Combined presentation 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, Predominantly hyperactive/ 
impulsive presentation 


Other specified attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder 
Unspecified attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder 
Specific learning disorder, With impairment in reading 
Specific learning disorder, With impairment in mathematics 
Specific learning disorder, With impairment in written expression 
Language disorder 

Childhood-onset fluency disorder (stuttering) 

Social (pragmatic) communication disorder 

Speech sound disorder 

Developmental coordination disorder 

Global developmental delay 

Other specified neurodevelopmental disorder 

Unspecified neurodevelopmental disorder 

Psychological factors affecting other medical conditions 


872 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


317 
318.0 
318.1 
318.2 
319 
327.21 
327.23 
327.24 
327.25 
327.26 
327.42 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.83 
331.9 
331.9 
331.9 
331.9 
331.9 
333.1 
332.1 
332.1 
333.72 
333.72 
333.85 
333.92 
333.94 
333.99 
333.99 
333.99 
347.00 
347.00 
347.00 
347.01 
347.10 
625.4 
698.4 


Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), Mild 
Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), Moderate 
Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), Severe 
Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), Profound 
Unspecified intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) 
Central sleep apnea, Idiopathic central sleep apnea 

Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea 

Sleep-related hypoventilation, Idiopathic hypoventilation 
Sleep-related hypoventilation, Congenital central alveolar hypoventilation 
Sleep-related hypoventilation, Comorbid sleep-related hypoventilation 
Rapid eye movement sleep behavior disorder 

Mild frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease 

Mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Parkinson’s disease 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury 

Mild vascular neurocognitive disorder 


Major neurocognitive disorder possibly due to Parkinson’s disease 
Possible major frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder 

Possible major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease 
Possible major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies 
Possible major vascular neurocognitive disorder 
Medication-induced postural tremor 

Neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism 

Other medication-induced parkinsonism 

Medication-induced acute dystonia 

Tardive dystonia 

Tardive dyskinesia 

Neuroleptic malignant syndrome 

Restless legs syndrome 

Medication-induced acute akathisia 

Other medication-induced movement disorder 

Tardive akathisia 

Autosomal dominant cerebellar ataxia, deafness, and narcolepsy 
Autosomal dominant narcolepsy, obesity, and type 2 diabetes 
Narcolepsy without cataplexy but with hypocretin deficiency 
Narcolepsy with cataplexy but without hypocretin deficiency 
Narcolepsy secondary to another medical condition 
Premenstrual dysphoric disorder 

Excoriation (skin-picking) disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 873 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


780.09 
780.09 
780.52 
780.52 
780.54 
780.594 
780.57 
780.59 
780.59 
786.04 
787.60 
787.60 
788.30 
788.39 
799.59 
995.20 
995.20 
995.20 
995.29 
995.29 
995.29 
995.51 
995.51 
995.51 
995.51 
995.52 
995.52 
995.52 
995.52 
995.53 
995.53 
995.53 
995.53 
995.54 
995.54. 
995.54 
995.54 
995.81 
995.81 


995.81 
995.81 


Other specified delirium 

Unspecified delirium 

Other specified insomnia disorder 

Unspecified insomnia disorder 

Other specified hypersomnolence disorder 

Unspecified hypersomnolence disorder 

Central sleep apnea, Central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid use 
Other specified sleep-wake disorder 

Unspecified sleep-wake disorder 

Central sleep apnea, Cheyne-Stokes breathing 


Other specified elimination disorder, With fecal symptoms 

Unspecified elimination disorder, With fecal symptoms 

Unspecified elimination disorder, With urinary symptoms 

Other specified elimination disorder, With urinary symptoms 

Unspecified neurocognitive disorder 

Other adverse effect of medication, Initial encounter 

Other adverse effect of medication, Sequelae 

Other adverse effect of medication, Subsequent encounter 

Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, Initial encounter 

Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, Sequelae 

Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, Subsequent encounter 

Child psychological abuse, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Child psychological abuse, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

Child psychological abuse, Suspected, Initial encounter 

Child psychological abuse, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

Child neglect, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Child neglect, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

Child neglect, Suspected, Initial encounter 

Child neglect, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

Child sexual abuse, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Child sexual abuse, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

Child sexual abuse, Suspected, Initial encounter 

Child sexual abuse, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

Child physical abuse, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Child physical abuse, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

Child physical abuse, Suspected, Initial encounter 

Child physical abuse, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Subsequent 
encounter 

Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Initial encounter 

Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Subsequent 
encounter 


874 Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


995.81 Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

995.81 Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

995.81 Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Suspected, Initial encounter 

995.81 Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

995.82 Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Initial 
encounter 

995.82 Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, 
Subsequent encounter 

995.82 Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Initial 
encounter 

995.82 Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, 
Subsequent encounter 

995.82 Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

995.82 Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

995.82 Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Suspected, Initial encounter 

995.82 Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

995.83 Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

995.83 Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Subsequent 
encounter 

995.83 Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Initial encounter 

995.83 Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Subsequent 
encounter 

995.83 Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

995.83 Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

995.83 Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Suspected, Initial encounter 

995.83 Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

995.85 Spouse or partner neglect, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

995.85 Spouse or partner neglect, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

995.85 Spouse or partner neglect, Suspected, Initial encounter 

995.85 Spouse or partner neglect, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

V15.41 Personal history (past history) of physical abuse in childhood 

V15.41 Personal history (past history) of sexual abuse in childhood 

V15.41 Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, Physical 

V15.41 Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, Sexual 


V15.42 Personal history (past history) of neglect in childhood 

V15.42 Personal history (past history) of psychological abuse in childhood 
V15.42 Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner neglect 

V15.42 Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner psychological abuse 
V15.49 Other personal history of psychological trauma 

V15.59 Personal history of self-harm 


V15.81 Nonadherence to medical treatment 

V15.89 Other personal risk factors 

V40.31 Wandering associated with a mental disorder 
V60.0 Homelessness 

V60.1 Inadequate housing 


V60.2 Extreme poverty 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 875 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


V60.2 Insufficient social insurance or welfare support 

V60.2 Lack of adequate food or safe drinking water 

V60.2 Low income 

V60.3 Problem related to living alone 

V60.6 Problem related to living in a residential institution 

V60.89 Discord with neighbor, lodger, or landlord 

V60.9 Unspecified housing or economic problem 

V61.03 Disruption of family by separation or divorce 

V61.10 Relationship distress with spouse or intimate partner 

V61.11 Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner neglect 

V61.11 Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner 
psychological abuse 

V61.11 Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner violence, 
Physical 

V61.11 Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner violence, 
Sexual 

V61.12 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or partner 
neglect 

V61.12 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or partner 
psychological abuse 

V61.12 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or partner 


violence, Physical 


V61.12 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or partner 
violence, Sexual 


V61.20 Parent-child relational problem 


V61.21 Encounter for mental health services for victim of child abuse by parent 

V61.21 Encounter for mental health services for victim of child neglect by parent 

V61.21 Encounter for mental health services for victim of child psychological abuse by 
parent 

V61.21 Encounter for mental health services for victim of child sexual abuse by parent 

V61.21 Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child abuse 

V61.21 Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child neglect 

V61.21 Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child 
psychological abuse 

V61.21 Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child sexual 
abuse 

V61.22 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child abuse 

V61.22 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child neglect 

V61.22 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child 
psychological abuse 

V61.22 Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child sexual 
abuse 

V61.29 Child affected by parental relationship distress 

V61.5 Problems related to multiparity 

V61.7 Problems related to unwanted pregnancy 

V61.8 High expressed emotion level within family 


V61.8 Sibling relational problem 


876 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-9-CM) 


ICD-9-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


V61.8 
V62.21 
V62.22 
V62.22 
V62.29 
V62.3 
V62.4 
V62.4 
V62.4 
V62.5 
V62.5 
V62.5 
V62.5 
V62.82 
V62.83 
V62.83 


V62.83 


V62.83 


V62.83 
V62.89 
V62.89 


V62.89 
V62.89 
V62.89 
V62.89 
V62.89 
V62.9 
V62.9 
V63.8 
V63.9 
V65.2 
V65.40 
V65.49 
V65.49 
V69.9 
V71.01 
V71.02 


Upbringing away from parents 

Problem related to current military deployment status 

Exposure to disaster, war, or other hostilities 

Personal history of military deployment 

Other problem related to employment 

Academic or educational problem 

Acculturation difficulty 

Social exclusion or rejection 

Target of (perceived) adverse discrimination or persecution 
Conviction in civil or criminal proceedings without imprisonment 
Imprisonment or other incarceration 

Problems related to other legal circumstances 

Problems related to release from prison 

Uncomplicated bereavement 

Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental child abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental child 
neglect 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental child 
psychological abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental child 
sexual abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonspousal adult abuse 
Borderline intellectual functioning 


Discord with social service provider, including probation officer, case manager, 
or social services worker 


Other problem related to psychosocial circumstances 

Phase of life problem 

Religious or spiritual problem 

Victim of crime 

Victim of terrorism or torture 

Unspecified problem related to social environment 

Unspecified problem related to unspecified psychosocial circumstances 
Unavailability or inaccessibility of other helping agencies 
Unavailability or inaccessibility of health care facilities 

Malingering 

Other counseling or consultation 

Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonspousal adult abuse 
Sex counseling 

Problem related to lifestyle 

Adult antisocial behavior 

Child or adolescent antisocial behavior 


Numerical Listing of 
DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes 
(ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM codes are to be used for coding purposes in the United States starting 
October 1, 2014. 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


E66.9 Overweight or obesity 

F01.50 Probable major vascular neurocognitive disorder, Without behavioral disturbance 

F01.51 Probable major vascular neurocognitive disorder, With behavioral disturbance 

F02.80 Major neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition, Without 
behavioral disturbance 

F02.80 Major neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection, Without behavioral 
disturbance (code first B20 HIV infection) 

F02.80 Major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, Without 
behavioral disturbance (code first G10 Huntington’s disease) 

F02.80 Major neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies, Without behavioral 
disturbance 

F02.80 Major neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s disease, Without 


behavioral disturbance (code first G20 Parkinson’s disease) 


F02.80 Major neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease, Without behavioral 
disturbance (code first A81.9 prion disease) 


F02.80 Major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, Without 
behavioral disturbance (code first S06.2X9S diffuse traumatic brain injury 
with loss of consciousness of unspecified duration, sequela) 


F02.80 Probable major frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder, Without behavioral 
disturbance (code first G31.09 frontotemporal disease) 

F02.80 Probable major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, Without 
behavioral disturbance (code first G30.9 Alzheimer’s disease) 

F02.80 Probable major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, Without 
behavioral disturbance (code first G31.83 Lewy body disease) 

F02.81 Major neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition, With 
behavioral disturbance 

F02.81 Major neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first B20 HIV infection) 

F02.81 Major neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first G10 Huntington’s disease) 

F02.81 Major neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies, With behavioral 
disturbance 


877 


878 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F02.81 


F02.81 


F02.81 


F02.81 


F02.81 


F02.81 


FO5 
FO5 
F06.0 
F06.1 
F06.1 
F06.1 


F06.2 
F06.31 
F06.32 


F06.33 
F06.33 


F06.34 


F06.34 
F06.4 
F06.8 
F06.8 
F07.0 
FO9 
F10.10 
F10.121 
F10.129 
F10.14 
F10.14 
F10.159 
F10.180 
F10.181 
F10.182 
F10.20 
F10.20 
F10.221 


Major neurocognitive disorder probably due to Parkinson’s disease, With 
behavioral disturbance (code first G20 Parkinson’s disease) 

Major neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first A81.9 prion disease) 


Major neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first S06.2X9S diffuse traumatic brain injury with loss of 
consciousness of unspecified duration, sequela) 


Probable major frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first G31.09 frontotemporal disease) 


Probable major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease, With 
behavioral disturbance (code first G30.9 Alzheimer’s disease) 


Probable major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies, With behavioral 
disturbance (code first G31.83 Lewy body disease) 


Delirium due to another medical condition 

Delirium due to multiple etiologies 

Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition, With hallucinations 
Catatonia associated with another mental disorder (catatonia specifier) 
Catatonic disorder due to another medical condition 


Unspecified catatonia (code first R29.818 other symptoms involving nervous 
and musculoskeletal systems) 


Psychotic disorder due to another medical condition, With delusions 

Depressive disorder due to another medical condition, With depressive features 

Depressive disorder due to another medical condition, With major 
depressive-like episode 

Bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition, With manic features 

Bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition, With manic- or 
hypomanic-like episodes 

Bipolar and related disorder due to another medical condition, With mixed 
features 

Depressive disorder due to another medical condition, With mixed features 

Anxiety disorder due to another medical condition 

Obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to another medical condition 

Other specified mental disorder due to another medical condition 

Personality change due to another medical condition 

Unspecified mental disorder due to another medical condition 

Alcohol use disorder, Mild 

Alcohol intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 

Alcohol intoxication, With mild use disorder 

Alcohol-induced bipolar and related disorder, With mild use disorder 

Alcohol-induced depressive disorder, With mild use disorder 

Alcohol-induced psychotic disorder, With mild use disorder 

Alcohol-induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 

Alcohol-induced sexual dysfunction, With mild use disorder 

Alcohol-induced sleep disorder, With mild use disorder 

Alcohol use disorder, Moderate 

Alcohol use disorder, Severe 

Alcohol intoxication delirium, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 879 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F10.229 Alcohol intoxication, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F10.231 Alcohol withdrawal delirium 

F10.232 Alcohol withdrawal, With perceptual disturbances 

F10.239 Alcohol withdrawal, Without perceptual disturbances 

F10.24 Alcohol-induced bipolar and related disorder, With moderate or severe use 
disorder 

F10.24 Alcohol-induced depressive disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F10.259 Alcohol-induced psychotic disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F10.26 Alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Amnestic confabulatory 
type, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F10.27 Alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Nonamnestic confabulatory 
type, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F10.280 Alcohol-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F10.281 Alcohol-induced sexual dysfunction, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F10.282 Alcohol-induced sleep disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F10.288 Alcohol-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, With moderate or severe use 
disorder 

F10.921 Alcohol intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 

F10.929 Alcohol intoxication, Without use disorder 

F10.94 Alcohol-induced bipolar and related disorder, Without use disorder 

F10.94 Alcohol-induced depressive disorder, Without use disorder 

F10.959 Alcohol-induced psychotic disorder, Without use disorder 

F10.96 Alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Amnestic confabulatory 
type, Without use disorder 

F10.97 Alcohol-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Nonamnestic confabulatory 
type, Without use disorder 

F10.980 Alcohol-induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 

F10.981 Alcohol-induced sexual dysfunction, Without use disorder 

F10.982 Alcohol-induced sleep disorder, Without use disorder 

F10.988 Alcohol-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, Without use disorder 

F10.99 Unspecified alcohol-related disorder 

F11.10 Opioid use disorder, Mild 

F11.121 Opioid intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 

F11.122 Opioid intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, With mild use disorder 

F11.129 Opioid intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, With mild use disorder 

F11.14 Opioid-induced depressive disorder, With mild use disorder 

F11.181 Opioid-induced sexual dysfunction, With mild use disorder 

F11.182 Opioid-induced sleep disorder, With mild use disorder 

F11.188 Opioid-induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 

F11.20 Opioid use disorder, Moderate 

F11.20 Opioid use disorder, Severe 

F11.221 Opioid intoxication delirium, With moderate or severe use disorder 

F11.222 Opioid intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, With moderate or severe 


use disorder 


F11.229 Opioid intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


F11.23 Opioid withdrawal 


880 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F11.23 

F11.24 

F11.281 
F11.282 
F11.288 
F11.921 
F11.921 
F11.922 
F11.929 
F11.94 

F11.981 
F11.982 
F11.988 
F11.99 

F12.10 

F12.121 
F12.122 
F12.129 
F12.159 
F12.180 
F12.188 
F12.20 

F12.20 

F12.221 
F12.222 


F12.229 


F12.259 
F12.280 
F12.288 
F12.288 
F12.921 
F12.922 
F12.929 
F12.959 
F12.980 
F12.988 
F12.99 

F13.10 

F13.121 
F13.129 
F13.14 


F13.14 


Opioid withdrawal delirium 

Opioid-induced depressive disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Opioid-induced sexual dysfunction, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Opioid-induced sleep disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Opioid-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Opioid-induced delirium 

Opioid intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 

Opioid intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, Without use disorder 
Opioid intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, Without use disorder 
Opioid-induced depressive disorder, Without use disorder 

Opioid-induced sexual dysfunction, Without use disorder 

Opioid-induced sleep disorder, Without use disorder 

Opioid-induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 

Unspecified opioid-related disorder 

Cannabis use disorder, Mild 

Cannabis intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 

Cannabis intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, With mild use disorder 
Cannabis intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, With mild use disorder 
Cannabis-induced psychotic disorder, With mild use disorder 
Cannabis-induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 
Cannabis-induced sleep disorder, With mild use disorder 

Cannabis use disorder, Moderate 

Cannabis use disorder, Severe 

Cannabis intoxication delirium, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Cannabis intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, With moderate or severe 
use disorder 


Cannabis intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Cannabis-induced psychotic disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 

Cannabis-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 

Cannabis-induced sleep disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 

Cannabis withdrawal 

Cannabis intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 

Cannabis intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, Without use disorder 

Cannabis intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, Without use disorder 

Cannabis-induced psychotic disorder, Without use disorder 

Cannabis-induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 

Cannabis-induced sleep disorder, Without use disorder 

Unspecified cannabis-related disorder 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, Mild 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication, With mild use disorder 

Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced bipolar and related disorder, With 
mild use disorder 

Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder, With mild use 
disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 881 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F13.159 


F13.180 


F13.181 


F13.182 
F13.20 
F13.20 
F13.221 


F13.229 
F13.231 
F13.232 
F13.239 
F13.24 


F13.24 


F13.259 


F13.27 


F13.280 


F13.281 


F13.282 


F13.288 


F13.921 
F13.921 
F13.929 
F13.94 


F13.94 


F13.959 


F13.97 


F13.980 
F13.981 


F13.982 
F13.988 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced psychotic disorder, With mild use 
disorder 

Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder, With mild use 
disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sexual dysfunction, With mild use 
disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sleep disorder, With mild use disorder 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, Moderate 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, Severe 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication delirium, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal delirium 

Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal, With perceptual disturbances 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal, Without perceptual disturbances 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced bipolar and related disorder, With 
moderate or severe use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder, With 
moderate or severe use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced psychotic disorder, With moderate 
or severe use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced major neurocognitive disorder, 
With moderate or severe use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sexual dysfunction, With moderate 
or severe use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sleep disorder, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, 
With moderate or severe use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced delirium 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 
Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication, Without use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced bipolar and related disorder, 
Without use disorder 

Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced depressive disorder, Without use 
disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced psychotic disorder, Without use 
disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced major neurocognitive disorder, 
Without use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sexual dysfunction, Without use 
disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced sleep disorder, Without use disorder 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, 
Without use disorder 


882 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F13.99 
F14.10 
F14.121 
F14.122 
F14.129 
F14.14 
F14.14 
F14.159 
F14.180 
F14.181 
F14.182 
F14.188 


F14.20 
F14.20 
F14.221 
F14.222 


F14.229 


F14.23 
F14.24 


F14.24 

F14.259 
F14.280 
F14.281 
F14.282 
F14.288 


F14.921 
F14.922 
F14.929 
F14.94 
F14.94 
F14.959 
F14.980 
F14.981 
F14.982 
F14.988 
F14.99 
F15.10 
F15.10 
F15.121 
F15.122 


Unspecified sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-related disorder 

Cocaine use disorder, Mild 

Cocaine intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 

Cocaine intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, With mild use disorder 
Cocaine intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, With mild use disorder 
Cocaine-induced bipolar and related disorder, With mild use disorder 
Cocaine-induced depressive disorder, With mild use disorder 
Cocaine-induced psychotic disorder, With mild use disorder 
Cocaine-induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 
Cocaine-induced sexual dysfunction, With mild use disorder 
Cocaine-induced sleep disorder, With mild use disorder 


Cocaine-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, With mild use 
disorder 


Cocaine use disorder, Moderate 
Cocaine use disorder, Severe 
Cocaine intoxication delirium, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Cocaine intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, With moderate or severe 
use disorder 


Cocaine intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Cocaine withdrawal 


Cocaine-induced bipolar and related disorder, With moderate or severe use 
disorder 


Cocaine-induced depressive disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Cocaine-induced psychotic disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Cocaine-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Cocaine-induced sexual dysfunction, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Cocaine-induced sleep disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Cocaine-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, With moderate 
or severe use disorder 


Cocaine intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 

Cocaine intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, Without use disorder 
Cocaine intoxication, Without perceptual disturbances, Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced bipolar and related disorder, Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced depressive disorder, Without use disorder 
Cocaine-induced psychotic disorder, Without use disorder 

Cocaine-induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 

Cocaine-induced sexual dysfunction, Without use disorder 

Cocaine-induced sleep disorder, Without use disorder 

Cocaine-induced obsessive-compulsive and related disorder, Without use disorder 
Unspecified stimulant-related disorder, Unspecified Cocaine-related disorder 
Amphetamine-type substance use disorder, Mild 

Other or unspecified stimulant use disorder, Mild 

Amphetamine (or other stimulant) intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 


Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, 
With mild use disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 883 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F15.129 


F15.14 


F15.14 


F15.159 


F15.180 


F15.180 
F15.181 


F15.182 
F15.182 
F15.188 


F15.20 
F15.20 
F15.20 
F15.20 
F15.221 


F15.222 


F15.229 


F15.23 
F15.24 


F15.24 


F15.259 


F15.280 


F15.280 
F15.281 


F15.282 


F15.282 
F15.288 


F15.921 
F15.921 
F15.922 


Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication, Without perceptual 
disturbances, With mild use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced bipolar and related disorder, 
With mild use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced depressive disorder, With mild 
use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced psychotic disorder, With mild use 
disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced anxiety disorder, With mild use 
disorder 


Caffeine-induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sexual dysfunction, With mild 
use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sleep disorder, With mild use disorder 
Caffeine-induced sleep disorder, With mild use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)-induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder, With mild use disorder 


Amphetamine-type substance use disorder, Moderate 
Amphetamine-type substance use disorder, Severe 
Other or unspecified stimulant use disorder, Moderate 
Other or unspecified stimulant use disorder, Severe 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant) intoxication delirium, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, 
With moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication, Without perceptual 
disturbances, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine or other stimulant withdrawal 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced bipolar and related disorder, 
With moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced depressive disorder, With 
moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced psychotic disorder, With 
moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate 
or severe use disorder 


Caffeine-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sexual dysfunction, With 
moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sleep disorder, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Caffeine-induced sleep disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)-induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced delirium 
Amphetamine (or other stimulant) intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 


Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication, With perceptual disturbances, 
Without use disorder 


884 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F15.929 


F15.929 
F15.93 
F15.94 


F15.94 


F15.959 


F15.980 


F15.980 
F15.981 


F15.982 
F15.982 
F15.988 


F15.99 
F15.99 
F16.10 
F16.10 
F16.121 
F16.121 
F16.129 
F16.129 
F16.14 
F16.14 
F16.14 
F16.14 
F16.159 
F16.159 
F16.180 
F16.180 
F16.20 
F16.20 
F16.20 
F16.20 
F16.221 
F16.221 
F16.229 
F16.229 
F16.24 


Amphetamine or other stimulant intoxication, Without perceptual 
disturbances, Without use disorder 


Caffeine intoxication 
Caffeine withdrawal 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced bipolar and related disorder, 
Without use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced depressive disorder, Without use 
disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced psychotic disorder, Without use 
disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced anxiety disorder, Without use 
disorder 


Caffeine-induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—induced sexual dysfunction, Without use 
disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)—-induced sleep disorder, Without use disorder 
Caffeine-induced sleep disorder, Without use disorder 


Amphetamine (or other stimulant)-induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder, Without use disorder 


Unspecified amphetamine or other stimulant-related disorder 

Unspecified caffeine-related disorder 

Other hallucinogen use disorder, Mild 

Phencyclidine use disorder, Mild 

Other hallucinogen intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 
Phencyclidine intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 

Other hallucinogen intoxication, With mild use disorder 

Phencyclidine intoxication, With mild use disorder 

Other hallucinogen-induced bipolar and related disorder, With mild use disorder 
Other hallucinogen—induced depressive disorder, With mild use disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced bipolar and related disorder, With mild use disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced depressive disorder, With mild use disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced psychotic disorder, With mild use disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder, With mild use disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 

Other hallucinogen use disorder, Moderate 

Other hallucinogen use disorder, Severe 

Phencyclidine use disorder, Moderate 

Phencyclidine use disorder, Severe 

Other hallucinogen intoxication delirium, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Phencyclidine intoxication delirium, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Other hallucinogen intoxication, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Phencyclidine intoxication, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Other hallucinogen—induced bipolar and related disorder, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 885 


ICD-10-CM_ Disorder, condition, or problem 


F16.24 


F16.24 


F16.24 
F16.259 


F16.259 
F16.280 


F16.280 
F16.921 
F16.921 
F16.929 
F16.929 
F16.94 
F16.94 
F16.94 
F16.94 
F16.959 
F16.959 
F16.980 
F16.980 
F16.983 
F16.99 
F16.99 
F17.200 
F17.200 
F17.203 
F17.208 
F17.209 
F18.10 
F18.121 
F18.129 
F18.14 
F18.159 
F18.17 
F18.180 
F18.188 
F18.20 
F18.20 
F18.221 
F18.229 
F18.24 
F18.259 


Other hallucinogen—induced depressive disorder, With moderate or severe 
use disorder 


Phencyclidine-induced bipolar and related disorder, With moderate or severe 
use disorder 


Phencyclidine-induced depressive disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Other hallucinogen—induced psychotic disorder, With moderate or severe use 
disorder 


Phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Other hallucinogen—induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or severe use 
disorder 


Phencyclidine-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Other hallucinogen intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 
Phencyclidine intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 

Other hallucinogen intoxication, Without use disorder 

Phencyclidine intoxication, Without use disorder 

Other hallucinogen-induced bipolar and related disorder, Without use disorder 
Other hallucinogen—induced depressive disorder, Without use disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced bipolar and related disorder, Without use disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced depressive disorder, Without use disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced psychotic disorder, Without use disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced psychotic disorder, Without use disorder 

Other hallucinogen—induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 
Phencyclidine-induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 
Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder 

Unspecified hallucinogen-related disorder 

Unspecified phencyclidine-related disorder 

Tobacco use disorder, Moderate 

Tobacco use disorder, Severe 

Tobacco withdrawal 

Tobacco-induced sleep disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Unspecified tobacco-related disorder 

Inhalant use disorder, Mild 

Inhalant intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 

Inhalant intoxication, With mild use disorder 

Inhalant-induced depressive disorder, With mild use disorder 
Inhalant-induced psychotic disorder, With mild use disorder 
Inhalant-induced major neurocognitive disorder, With mild use disorder 
Inhalant-induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 
Inhalant-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, With mild use disorder 
Inhalant use disorder, Moderate 

Inhalant use disorder, Severe 

Inhalant intoxication delirium, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Inhalant intoxication, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Inhalant-induced depressive disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 
Inhalant-induced psychotic disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


886 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F18.27 


F18.280 
F18.288 


F18.921 
F18.929 
F18.94 
F18.959 
F18.97 
F18.980 
F18.988 
F18.99 
F19.10 
F19.121 
F19.129 
F19.14 


F19.14 


F19.159 


F19.17 


F19.180 
F19.181 


F19.182 
F19.188 


F19.188 


F19.20 
F19.20 
F19.221 


F19.229 
F19.231 
F19.239 
F19.24 


F19.24 


F19.259 


F19.27 


Inhalant-induced major neurocognitive disorder, With moderate or severe use 
disorder 


Inhalant-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Inhalant-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, With moderate or severe use 
disorder 


Inhalant intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 

Inhalant intoxication, Without use disorder 

Inhalant-induced depressive disorder, Without use disorder 
Inhalant-induced psychotic disorder, Without use disorder 
Inhalant-induced major neurocognitive disorder, Without use disorder 
Inhalant-induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 
Inhalant-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, Without use disorder 
Unspecified inhalant-related disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance use disorder, Mild 

Other (or unknown) substance intoxication delirium, With mild use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance intoxication, With mild use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced bipolar and related disorder, With 
mild use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced depressive disorder, With mild use 
disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced psychotic disorder, With mild use 
disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance—induced major neurocognitive disorder, With 
mild use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance—induced anxiety disorder, With mild use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced sexual dysfunction, With mild use 
disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced sleep disorder, With mild use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, With 
mild use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder, With mild use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance use disorder, Moderate 
Other (or unknown) substance use disorder, Severe 


Other (or unknown) substance intoxication delirium, With moderate or severe 
use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance intoxication, With moderate or severe use disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance withdrawal delirium 

Other (or unknown) substance withdrawal 

Other (or unknown) substance-induced bipolar and related disorder, With 
moderate or severe use disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance-induced depressive disorder, With moderate 
or severe use disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance—induced psychotic disorder, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 

Other (or unknown) substance-induced major neurocognitive disorder, With 
moderate or severe use disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 887 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F19.280 


F19.281 


F19.282 


F19.288 


F19.288 


F19.921 
F19.921 
F19.929 
F19.94 


F19.94 
F19.959 
F19.97 


F19.980 
F19.981 
F19.982 
F19.988 


F19.988 


F19.99 
F20.81 
F20.9 
P21 
P22 
F23 
F25.0 
F25.1 
F28 
F29 
F31.0 
F31.11 
F31.12 
F31.13 
F31.2 
F31.31 
F31.32 
F31.4 
F31.5 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced anxiety disorder, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced sexual dysfunction, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced sleep disorder, With moderate or 
severe use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, With 
moderate or severe use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder, With moderate or severe use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance—induced delirium 
Other (or unknown) substance intoxication delirium, Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance intoxication, Without use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced bipolar and related disorder, Without 
use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced depressive disorder, Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced psychotic disorder, Without use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced major neurocognitive disorder, 
Without use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance—induced anxiety disorder, Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced sexual dysfunction, Without use disorder 
Other (or unknown) substance-induced sleep disorder, Without use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced mild neurocognitive disorder, 
Without use disorder 


Other (or unknown) substance-induced obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder, Without use disorder 


Unspecified other (or unknown) substance-related disorder 
Schizophreniform disorder 

Schizophrenia 

Schizotypal personality disorder 

Delusional disorder 

Brief psychotic disorder 

Schizoaffective disorder, Bipolar type 

Schizoaffective disorder, Depressive type 

Other specified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder 
Unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic disorder 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, Mild 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, Moderate 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, Severe 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, With psychotic features 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, Mild 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, Moderate 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, Severe 


Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, With psychotic 
features 


888 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F31.71 
F31.72 
F31.73 
F31.74 
F31.75 
F31.76 
F31.81 
F31.89 
F31.9 
F31.9 
F31.9 
F31.9 
F31.9 
F32.0 
F32.1 
F32.2 
F32.3 
F32.4 
F32.5 
F32.8 
F32.9 
F32.9 
F33.0 
F33.1 
F33.2 
F33.3 
F33.41 
F33.42 
F33.9 
F34.0 
F34.1 
F34.8 
F40.00 
F40.10 
F40.218 
F40.228 
F40.230 
F40.231 
F40.232 
F40.233 
F40.248 
F40.298 
F41.0 
F41.1 
F41.8 


Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic, In partial remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic, In full remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, In partial remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, In full remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, In partial remission 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, In full remission 
Bipolar II disorder 

Other specified bipolar and related disorder 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode depressed, Unspecified 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode hypomanic, Unspecified 
Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode manic, Unspecified 

Bipolar I disorder, Current or most recent episode unspecified 

Unspecified bipolar and related disorder 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, Mild 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, Moderate 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, Severe 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, With psychotic features 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, In partial remission 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, In full remission 

Other specified depressive disorder 

Major depressive disorder, Single episode, Unspecifed 

Unspecified depressive disorder 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, Mild 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, Moderate 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, Severe 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, With psychotic features 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, In partial remission 

Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, In full remission 


Major depressive disorder, Recurrent episode, Unspecified 
Cyclothymic disorder 

Persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia) 
Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder 
Agoraphobia 

Social anxiety disorder (social phobia) 

Specific phobia, Animal 

Specific phobia, Natural environment 

Specific phobia, Fear of blood 

Specific phobia, Fear of injections and transfusions 
Specific phobia, Fear of other medical care 

Specific phobia, Fear of injury 

Specific phobia, Situational 

Specific phobia, Other 

Panic disorder 

Generalized anxiety disorder 

Other specified anxiety disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 889 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F41.9 
P42 
P42 
P42 
P42 
F43.0 
F43.10 
F43.20 
F43.21 
F43.22 
F43.23 
F43.24 
F43.25 
F43.8 
F43.9 
F44.0 
F44.1 
F44.4 


F44.4 


F44.4 


F44.4 


F44.5 


F44.6 


F44.6 


F44.7 


F44.81 
F44.89 
F44.9 
F45.1 
F45.21 
F45.22 
F45.8 
F45.9 
F48.1 
F50.01 
F50.02 
F50.2 
F50.8 


Unspecified anxiety disorder 

Hoarding disorder 

Obsessive-compulsive disorder 

Other specified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
Unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 

Acute stress disorder 

Posttraumatic stress disorder 

Adjustment disorders, Unspecified 

Adjustment disorders, With depressed mood 

Adjustment disorders, With anxiety 

Adjustment disorders, With mixed anxiety and depressed mood 
Adjustment disorders, With disturbance of conduct 

Adjustment disorders, With mixed disturbance of emotions and conduct 
Other specified trauma- and stressor-related disorder 
Unspecified trauma- and stressor-related disorder 

Dissociative amnesia 

Dissociative amnesia, With dissociative fugue 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), With 
abnormal movement 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), With 
speech symptoms 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), With 
swallowing symptoms 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), With 
weakness / paralysis 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), With 
attacks or seizures 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), With 
anesthesia or sensory loss 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), With 
special sensory symptoms 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological symptom disorder), With mixed 
symptoms 

Dissociative identity disorder 

Other specified dissociative disorder 

Unspecified dissociative disorder 

Somatic symptom disorder 

Illness anxiety disorder 

Body dysmorphic disorder 

Other specified somatic symptom and related disorder 

Unspecified somatic symptom and related disorder 

Depersonalization/derealization disorder 

Anorexia nervosa, Restricting type 

Anorexia nervosa, Binge-eating/ purging type 

Bulimia nervosa 

Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder 


890 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F50.8 
F50.8 
F50.8 
F50.9 
F51.01 
F51.11 
F51.3 
F51.4 
F51.5 
F52.0 
F52.21 
F52.22 
F52.31 
F52.32 
F52.4 
F52.6 
F52.8 
F52.9 
F54 
F60.0 
F60.1 
F60.2 
F60.3 
F60.4 
F60.5 
F60.6 
F60.7 
F60.81 
F60.89 
F60.9 
F63.0 
F63.1 
F63.2 
F63.3 
F63.81 
F64.1 
F64.2 
F64.8 
F64.9 
F65.0 
F65.1 
F65.2 
F65.3 
F65.4 
F65.51 
F65.52 


Binge-eating disorder 

Other specified feeding or eating disorder 
Pica, in adults 

Unspecified feeding or eating disorder 
Insomnia disorder 

Hypersomnolence disorder 

Non-rapid eye movement sleep arousal disorders, Sleepwalking type 
Non-rapid eye movement sleep arousal disorders, Sleep terror type 
Nightmare disorder 

Male hypoactive sexual desire disorder 
Erectile disorder 

Female sexual interest/arousal disorder 
Female orgasmic disorder 

Delayed ejaculation 

Premature (early) ejaculation 
Genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder 
Other specified sexual dysfunction 
Unspecified sexual dysfunction 
Psychological factors affecting other medical conditions 
Paranoid personality disorder 

Schizoid personality disorder 

Antisocial personality disorder 

Borderline personality disorder 

Histrionic personality disorder 
Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder 
Avoidant personality disorder 

Dependent personality disorder 
Narcissistic personality disorder 

Other specified personality disorder 
Unspecified personality disorder 
Gambling disorder 

Pyromania 

Kleptomania 

Trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder) 
Intermittent explosive disorder 

Gender dysphoria in adolescents and adults 
Gender dysphoria in children 

Other specified gender dysphoria 
Unspecified gender dysphoria 

Fetishistic disorder 

Transvestic disorder 

Exhibitionistic disorder 

Voyeuristic disorder 

Pedophilic disorder 

Sexual masochism disorder 

Sexual sadism disorder 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 891 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F65.81 
F65.89 
F65.9 
F68.10 
F70 
F71 
B72 
F73 
F79 
F80.0 
F80.2 
F80.81 
F80.89 
F80.9 
F81.0 
F81.2 
F81.81 
F82 
F84.0 
F88 
F88 
F89 
F90.0 
F90.1 


F90.2 
F90.8 
F90.9 
F91.1 
F91.2 
F913 
F91.8 
F91.9 
F91.9 
F93.0 
F94.0 
F94.1 
F94.2 
F95.0 
F95.1 
F95.2 
F95.8 
F95.9 
F98.0 
F98.1 
F98.21 


Frotteuristic disorder 

Other specified paraphilic disorder 

Unspecified paraphilic disorder 

Factitious disorder 

Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), Mild 
Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), Moderate 
Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), Severe 
Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder), Profound 
Unspecified intellectual disability (intellectual developmental disorder) 
Speech sound disorder 

Language disorder 

Childhood-onset fluency disorder (stuttering) 

Social (pragmatic) communication disorder 

Unspecified communication disorder 

Specific learning disorder, With impairment in reading 

Specific learning disorder, With impairment in mathematics 

Specific learning disorder, With impairment in written expression 
Developmental coordination disorder 

Autism spectrum disorder 

Global developmental delay 

Other specified neurodevelopmental disorder 

Unspecified neurodevelopmental disorder 
Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, Predominantly inattentive presentation 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, Predominantly hyperactive/ 
impulsive presentation 


Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, Combined presentation 
Other specified attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder 
Unspecified attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder 

Conduct disorder, Childhood-onset type 

Conduct disorder, Adolescent-onset type 

Oppositional defiant disorder 

Other specified disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder 
Conduct disorder, Unspecified onset 

Unspecified disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct disorder 
Separation anxiety disorder 

Selective mutism 

Reactive attachment disorder 

Disinhibited social engagement disorder 

Provisional tic disorder 

Persistent (chronic) motor or vocal tic disorder 

Tourette’s disorder 

Other specified tic disorder 

Unspecified tic disorder 

Enuresis 

Encopresis 

Rumination disorder 


892 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


F98.3 
F98.4 
F98.5 
F99 
F99 
G21.0 
G21.11 
G21.19 
G24.01 
G24.02 
G24.09 
G25.1 
G25.71 
G25.71 
G25.79 
G25.81 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.84 
G31.9 
G31.9 
G31.9 
G31.9 
G31.9 
G47.00 
G47.09 
G47.10 
G47.19 
G47.20 
G47.21 
G47.22 
G47.23 
G47.24 
G47.26 
G47.31 


Pica, in children 

Stereotypic movement disorder 

Adult-onset fluency disorder 

Other specified mental disorder 

Unspecified mental disorder 

Neuroleptic malignant syndrome 

Neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism 

Other medication-induced parkinsonism 

Tardive dyskinesia 

Medication-induced acute dystonia 

Tardive dystonia 

Medication-induced postural tremor 

Medication-induced acute akathisia 

Tardive akathisia 

Other medication-induced movement disorder 

Restless legs syndrome 

Mild frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease 
Mild neurocognitive disorder due to another medical condition 
Mild neurocognitive disorder due to HIV infection 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Huntington’s disease 
Mild neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to multiple etiologies 
Mild neurocognitive disorder due to Parkinson’s disease 
Mild neurocognitive disorder due to prion disease 

Mild neurocognitive disorder due to traumatic brain injury 
Mild vascular neurocognitive disorder 


Major neurocognitive disorder possibly due to Parkinson’s disease 
Possible major frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder 

Possible major neurocognitive disorder due to Alzheimer’s disease 
Possible major neurocognitive disorder with Lewy bodies 

Possible major vascular neurocognitive disorder 

Unspecified insomnia disorder 

Other specified insomnia disorder 

Unspecified hypersomnolence disorder 

Other specified hypersomnolence disorder 

Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Unspecified type 

Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Delayed sleep phase type 
Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Advanced sleep phase type 
Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Irregular sleep-wake type 
Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Non-24-hour sleep-wake type 
Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, Shift work type 

Central sleep apnea, Idiopathic central sleep apnea 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 893 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


G47.33 
G47.34 
G47.35 
G47.36 
G47.37 
G47.411 
G47.419 
G47.419 
G47.419 
G47.429 
G47.52 
G47.8 
G47.9 
L98.1 
N39.498 
N94.3 
RO06.3 
R15.9 
R15.9 

R32 

R41.0 
R41.0 
R41.83 
R41.9 
T43.205A 
T43.205D 
T43.2055 
T50.905A 
T50.905D 
T50.905S 
T74.01XA 
T74.01XD 
T74.02XA 
T74.02XD 
T74.11XA 
T74.11XA 
T74.11XD 


T74.11XD 
T74.12XA 
T74.12XD 
T74.21XA 
T74.21XA 
T74.21XD 


Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea 

Sleep-related hypoventilation, Idiopathic hypoventilation 
Sleep-related hypoventilation, Congenital central alveolar hypoventilation 
Sleep-related hypoventilation, Comorbid sleep-related hypoventilation 
Central sleep apnea comorbid with opioid use 

Narcolepsy with cataplexy but without hypocretin deficiency 
Autosomal dominant cerebellar ataxia, deafness, and narcolepsy 
Autosomal dominant narcolepsy, obesity, and type 2 diabetes 
Narcolepsy without cataplexy but with hypocretin deficiency 
Narcolepsy secondary to another medical condition 

Rapid eye movement sleep behavior disorder 

Other specified sleep-wake disorder 

Unspecified sleep-wake disorder 

Excoriation (skin-picking) disorder 

Other specified elimination disorder, With urinary symptoms 
Premenstrual dysphoric disorder 

Central sleep apnea, Cheyne-Stokes breathing 

Other specified elimination disorder, With fecal symptoms 
Unspecified elimination disorder, With fecal symptoms 
Unspecified elimination disorder, With urinary symptoms 

Other specified delirium 

Unspecified delirium 

Borderline intellectual functioning 

Unspecified neurocognitive disorder 

Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, Initial encounter 
Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, Subsequent encounter 
Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, Sequelae 

Other adverse effect of medication, Initial encounter 

Other adverse effect of medication, Subsequent encounter 

Other adverse effect of medication, Sequelae 

Spouse or partner neglect, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Spouse or partner neglect, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 
Child neglect, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Child neglect, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Initial encounter 
Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Confirmed, Initial encounter 


Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Subsequent 
encounter 


Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 
Child physical abuse, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Child physical abuse, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Initial encounter 
Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Confirmed, Initial encounter 


Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Subsequent 
encounter 


894 


ICD-10-CM 


T74.21XD 
T74.22XA 
T74.22XD 
T74.31XA 


T74.31XA 
T74.31XD 


T74.31XD 
T74.32XA 
T74.32XD 
T76.01XA 
T76.01XD 
T76.02XA 
T76.02XD 
T76.11XA 
T76.11XA 
T76.11XD 


T76.11XD 
T76.12XA 
T76.12XD 
T76.21XA 
T76.21XA 
T76.21XD 


T76.21XD 
T76.22XA 
T76.22XD 
T76.31XA 


T76.31XA 
T76.31XD 


T76.31XD 
T76.32XA 
T76.32XD 
Z55.9 
Z56.82 
Z56.9 
Z59.0 
Z59.1 
Z59.2 
Z59.3 
Z59.4 
Z59.5 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


Disorder, condition, or problem 


Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 
Child sexual abuse, Confirmed, Initial encounter 
Child sexual abuse, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 


Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, Initial 
encounter 


Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Confirmed, Initial encounter 


Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Confirmed, 
Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 
Child psychological abuse, Confirmed, Initial encounter 

Child psychological abuse, Confirmed, Subsequent encounter 

Spouse or partner neglect, Suspected, Initial encounter 

Spouse or partner neglect, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

Child neglect, Suspected, Initial encounter 

Child neglect, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Initial encounter 
Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Suspected, Initial encounter 


Adult physical abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Subsequent 
encounter 


Spouse or partner violence, Physical, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

Child physical abuse, Suspected, Initial encounter 

Child physical abuse, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 

Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Initial encounter 
Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Suspected, Initial encounter 


Adult sexual abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Subsequent 
encounter 


Spouse or partner violence, Sexual, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 
Child sexual abuse, Suspected, Initial encounter 
Child sexual abuse, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 


Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, Initial 
encounter 


Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Suspected, Initial encounter 


Adult psychological abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, Suspected, 
Subsequent encounter 


Spouse or partner abuse, Psychological, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 
Child psychological abuse, Suspected, Initial encounter 
Child psychological abuse, Suspected, Subsequent encounter 
Academic or educational problem 

Problem related to current military deployment status 

Other problem related to employment 

Homelessness 

Inadequate housing 

Discord with neighbor, lodger, or landlord 

Problem related to living in a residential institution 

Lack of adequate food or safe drinking water 

Extreme poverty 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


Z59.6 
Z59.7 
Z59.9 
Z60.0 
Z60.2 
Z60.3 
Z60.4 
Z60.5 
Z60.9 
Z62.29 
Z62.810 
Z62.810 
Z62.811 
Z62.812 
Z62.820 
Z62.891 
Z62.898 
Z63.0 
Z63.4 
Z63.5 
Z63.8 
Z64.0 
Z64.1 
Z64.4 


Z65.0 
Z65.1 
Z65.2 
Z65.3 
Z65.4 
Z65.4 
Z65.5 
Z65.8 
Z65.8 
Z65.9 
Z69.010 
Z69.010 
Z69.010 


Z69.010 
Z69.011 
Z69.011 
Z69.011 


Z69.011 
Z69.020 


Low income 

Insufficient social insurance or welfare support 

Unspecified housing or economic problem 

Phase of life problem 

Problem related to living alone 

Acculturation difficulty 

Social exclusion or rejection 

Target of (perceived) adverse discrimination or persecution 

Unspecified problem related to social environment 

Upbringing away from parents 

Personal history (past history) of physical abuse in childhood 

Personal history (past history) of sexual abuse in childhood 

Personal history (past history) of psychological abuse in childhood 

Personal history (past history) of neglect in childhood 

Parent-child relational problem 

Sibling relational problem 

Child affected by parental relationship distress 

Relationship distress with spouse or intimate partner 

Uncomplicated bereavement 

Disruption of family by separation or divorce 

High expressed emotion level within family 

Problems related to unwanted pregnancy 

Problems related to multiparity 

Discord with social service provider, including probation officer, case 
manager, or social services worker 

Conviction in civil or criminal proceedings without imprisonment 

Imprisonment or other incarceration 

Problems related to release from prison 

Problems related to other legal circumstances 

Victim of crime 

Victim of terrorism or torture 

Exposure to disaster, war, or other hostilities 

Other problem related to psychosocial circumstances 

Religious or spiritual problem 


Unspecified problem related to unspecified psychosocial circumstances 
Encounter for mental health services for victim of child abuse by parent 
Encounter for mental health services for victim of child neglect by parent 


895 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of child psychological abuse by 


parent 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of child sexual abuse by parent 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child neglect 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child 
psychological abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of parental child sexual abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child abuse 


896 


Numerical Listing of DSM-5 Diagnoses and Codes (ICD-10-CM) 


ICD-10-CM Disorder, condition, or problem 


Z69.020 
Z69.020 


Z69.020 
Z69.021 
Z69.021 
Z69.021 


Z69.021 


Z69.11 
Z69.11 


Z69.11 


Z69.12 
Z69.12 


Z69.12 


Z69.12 


Z69.81 
Z69.81 


Z69.82 
Z70.9 
Z71.9 
Z72.0 
272.810 
272.811 
Z72.9 
Z75.3 
Z75.4 
Z76.5 
Z91.19 
Z91.410 
Z91.410 
Z91.411 
Z91.412 
Z91.49 
Z91.5 
Z91.82 
Z91.83 
Z91.89 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child neglect 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child psycho- 
logical abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonparental child sexual abuse 
Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental child abuse 
Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental child neglect 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental child 
psychological abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonparental child 
sexual abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner neglect 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner 
psychological abuse 

Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner violence, 
Physical 

Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or partner neglect 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or partner 
psychological abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or partner 
violence, Physical 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of spouse or partner 
violence, Sexual 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of nonspousal adult abuse 


Encounter for mental health services for victim of spouse or partner violence, 
Sexual 


Encounter for mental health services for perpetrator of nonspousal adult abuse 
Sex counseling 

Other counseling or consultation 

Tobacco use disorder, mild 

Child or adolescent antisocial behavior 

Adult antisocial behavior 

Problem related to lifestyle 

Unavailability or inaccessibility of health care facilities 

Unavailability or inaccessibility of other helping agencies 

Malingering 

Nonadherence to medical treatment 

Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, Physical 
Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner violence, Sexual 
Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner psychological abuse 
Personal history (past history) of spouse or partner neglect 

Other personal history of psychological trauma 

Personal history of self-harm 

Personal history of military deployment 

Wandering associated with a mental disorder 

Other personal risk factors 


DSM-5 Advisors and 
Other Contributors 


APA Board of Trustees DSM-5 Review Committees 


Scientific Review Committee (SRC) 
Kenneth S. Kendler, M.D. (Chair) 

Robert Freedman, M.D. (Co-chair) 

Dan G. Blazer, M.D., Ph.D., M.P.H. 

David Brent, M.D. (2011-) 

Ellen Leibenluft, M.D. 

Sir Michael Rutter, M.D. (-2011) 

Paul S. Summergrad, M.D. 

Robert J. Ursano, M.D. (-2011) 

Myrna Weissman, Ph.D. (2011-) 

Joel Yager, M.D. 

Jill L. Opalesky M.S. (Administrative Support) 


Clinical and Public Health Review 
Committee (CPHC) 


John S. McIntyre, M.D. (Chair) 

Joel Yager, M.D. (Co-chair) 

Anita Everett M.D. 

Cathryn A. Galanter, M.D. 

Jeffrey M. Lyness, M.D. 

James E. Nininger, M.D. 

Victor I. Reus, M.D. 

Michael J. Vergare, M.D. 

Ann Miller (Administrative Support) 


Oversight Committee 
Carolyn Robinowitz, M.D. (Chair) 
Mary Badaracco, M.D. 

Ronald Burd, M.D. 

Robert Freedman, M.D. 

Jeffrey A. Lieberman, M.D. 

Kyla Pope, M.D. 

Victor I. Reus, M.D. 

Daniel K. Winstead, M.D. 

Joel Yager, M.D. 


APA Assembly DSM-5 Review 

Committee 

Glenn A. Martin, M.D. (Chair) 

R. Scott Benson, M.D. (Speaker of the 
Assembly) 

William Cardasis, M.D. 

John M. de Figueiredo, M.D. 

Lawrence S. Gross, M.D. 

Brian S. Hart, M.D. 


Stephen A. McLeod Bryant, M.D. 
Gregory A. Miller, M.D. 

Roger Peele, M.D. 

Charles S. Price, M.D. 

Deepika Sastry, M.D. 

John P.D. Shemo, M.D. 

Eliot Sorel, M.D. 


DSM-5 Summit Group 
Dilip V. Jeste, M.D. (Chair) 

R. Scott Benson, M.D. 

Kenneth S. Kendler, M.D. 

Helena C. Kraemer, Ph.D. 

David J. Kupfer, M.D. 

Jeffrey A. Lieberman, M.D. 

Glenn A. Martin, M.D. 

John S. McIntyre, M.D. 

John M. Oldham, M.D. 

Roger Peele, M.D. 

Darrel A. Regier, M.D., M.P.H. 
James H. Scully Jr., M.D. 

Joel Yager, M.D. 

Paul S. Appelbaum, M.D. (Consultant) 
Michael B. First, M.D. (Consultant) 


DSM-5 Field Trials Review 


Robert D. Gibbons, Ph.D. 
Craig Nelson, M.D. 


DSM-5 Forensic Review 


Paul S. Appelbaum, M.D. 
Lama Bazzi, M.D. 

Alec W. Buchanan, M.D., Ph.D. 
Carissa Caban Aleman, M.D. 
Michael Champion, M.D. 
Jeffrey C. Eisen, M.D. 
Elizabeth Ford, M.D. 

Daniel T. Hackman, M.D. 
Mark Hauser, M.D. 

Steven K. Hoge, M.D., M.B.A. 
Debra A. Pinals, M.D. 
Guillermo Portillo, M.D. 
Patricia Recupero, M.D., J.D. 
Robert Weinstock, M.D. 
Cheryl Wills, M.D. 

Howard V. Zonana, M.D. 


898 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Past DSM-5 APA Staff 


Erin J. Dalder-Alpher 
Kristin Edwards 
Leah I. Engel 


Lenna Jawdat 
Elizabeth C. Martin 
Rocio J. Salvador 


Work Group Advisors 


ADHD and Disruptive Behavior 
Disorders 


Emil F. Coccaro, M.D. 
Deborah Dabrick, Ph.D. 
Prudence W. Fisher, Ph.D. 
Benjamin B. Lahey, Ph.D. 
Salvatore Mannuzza, Ph.D. 
Mary Solanto, Ph.D. 

J. Blake Turner, Ph.D. 

Eric Youngstrom, Ph.D. 


Anxiety, Obsessive-Compulsive 
Spectrum, Posttraumatic, and 
Dissociative Disorders 
Lynn E. Alden, Ph.D. 

David B. Arciniegas, M.D. 
David H. Barlow, Ph.D. 

Katja Beesdo-Baum, Ph.D. 
Chris R. Brewin, Ph.D. 
Richard J. Brown, Ph.D. 
Timothy A. Brown, Ph.D. 
Richard A. Bryant, Ph.D. 
Joan M. Cook, Ph.D. 

Joop de Jong, M.D., Ph.D. 
Paul F. Dell, Ph.D. 

Damiaan Denys, M.D. 

Bruce P. Dohrenwend, Ph.D. 
Brian A. Fallon, M.D., M.P.H. 
Edna B. Foa, Ph.D. 

Martin E. Franklin, Ph.D. 
Wayne K. Goodman, M.D. 
Jon E. Grant, J.D., M.D. 
Bonnie L. Green, Ph.D. 
Richard G. Heimberg, Ph.D. 
Judith L. Herman, M.D. 
Devon E. Hinton, M.D., Ph.D. 
Stefan G. Hofmann, Ph.D. 
Charles W. Hoge, M.D. 
Terence M. Keane, Ph.D. 
Nancy J. Keuthen, Ph.D. 
Dean G. Kilpatrick, Ph.D. 
Katharina Kircanski, Ph.D. 
Laurence J. Kirmayer, M.D. 
Donald F. Klein, M.D., D.Sc. 
Amaro J. Laria, Ph.D. 
Richard T. LeBeau, M.A. 
Richard J. Loewenstein, M.D. 
David Mataix-Cols, Ph.D. 
Thomas W. McAllister, M.D. 


Harrison G. Pope, M.D., M.P.H. 
Ronald M. Rapee, Ph.D. 
Steven A. Rasmussen, M.D. 
Patricia A. Resick, Ph.D. 
Vedat Sar, M.D. 

Sanjaya Saxena, M.D. 

Paula P. Schnurr, Ph.D. 

M. Katherine Shear, M.D. 
Daphne Simeon, M.D. 
Harvey S. Singer, M.D. 
Melinda A. Stanley, Ph.D. 
James J. Strain, M.D. 

Kate Wolitzky Taylor, Ph.D. 
Onno van der Hart, Ph.D. 
Eric Vermetten, M.D., Ph.D. 
John T. Walkup, M.D. 
Sabine Wilhelm, Ph.D. 
Douglas W. Woods, Ph.D. 
Richard E. Zinbarg, Ph.D. 
Joseph Zohar, M.D. 


Childhood and Adolescent 
Disorders 


Adrian Angold, Ph.D. 
Deborah Beidel, Ph.D. 
David Brent, M.D. 

John Campo, M.D. 
Gabrielle Carlson, M.D. 
Prudence W. Fisher, Ph.D. 
David Klonsky, Ph.D. 
Matthew Nock, Ph.D. 

J. Blake Turner, Ph.D. 


Eating Disorders 
Michael J. Devlin, M.D. 
Denise E. Wilfley, Ph.D. 
Susan Z. Yanovski, M.D. 


Mood Disorders 


Boris Birmaher, M.D. 

Yeates Conwell, M.D. 

Ellen B. Dennehy, Ph.D. 

S. Ann Hartlage, Ph.D. 

Jack M. Hettema, M.D., Ph.D. 
Michael C. Neale, Ph.D. 
Gordon B. Parker, M.D., Ph.D., D.Sc. 
Roy H. Perlis, M.D. M.Sc. 
Holly G. Prigerson, Ph.D. 
Norman E. Rosenthal, M.D. 
Peter J. Schmidt, M.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Mort M. Silverman, M.D. 

Meir Steiner, M.D., Ph.D. 

Mauricio Tohen, M.D., Dr.P.H., M.B.A. 
Sidney Zisook, M.D. 


Neurocognitive Disorders 


Jiska Cohen-Mansfield, Ph.D. 
Vladimir Hachinski, M.D., C.M., D.Sc. 
Sharon Inouye, M.D., M.P.H. 
Grant Iverson, Ph.D. 

Laura Marsh, M.D. 

Bruce Miller, M.D. 

Jacobo Mintzer, M.D., M.B.A. 
Bruce Pollock, M.D., Ph.D. 
George Prigatano, Ph.D. 

Ron Ruff, Ph.D. 

Ingmar Skoog, M.D., Ph.D. 
Robert Sweet, M.D. 

Paula Trzepacz, M.D. 


Neurodevelopmental Disorders 


Ari Ne’eman 

Nickola Nelson, Ph.D. 
Diane Paul, Ph.D. 

Eva Petrova, Ph.D. 
Andrew Pickles, Ph.D. 
Jan Piek, Ph.D. 

Helene Polatajko, Ph.D. 
Alya Reeve, M.D. 
Mabel Rice, Ph.D. 
Joseph Sergeant, Ph.D. 
Bennett Shaywitz, M.D. 
Sally Shaywitz, M.D. 
Audrey Thurm, Ph.D. 
Keith Widaman, Ph.D. 
Warren Zigman, Ph.D. 


Personality and Personality 
Disorders 

Eran Chemerinski, M.D. 

Thomas N. Crawford, Ph.D. 

Harold W. Koenigsberg, M.D. 
Kristian E. Markon, Ph.D. 

Rebecca L. Shiner, Ph.D. 

Kenneth R. Silk, M.D. 

Jennifer L. Tackett, Ph.D. 

David Watson, Ph.D. 


Psychotic Disorders 


Kamaldeep Bhui, M.D. 
Manuel J. Cuesta, M.D., Ph.D. 
Richard Douyon, M.D. 

Paolo Fusar-Poli, Ph.D. 

John H. Krystal, M.D. 
Thomas H. McGlashan, M.D. 
Victor Peralta, M.D., Ph.D. 
Anita Riecher-Réssler, M.D. 
Mary V. Seeman, M.D. 


Sexual and Gender Identity 
Disorders 


Stan E. Althof, Ph.D. 

Richard Balon, M.D. 

John H.J. Bancroft, M.D., M.A., D.P.M. 
Howard E. Barbaree, Ph.D., M.A. 
Rosemary J. Basson, M.D. 
Sophie Bergeron, Ph.D. 

Anita L. Clayton, M.D. 

David L. Delmonico, Ph.D. 
Domenico Di Ceglie, M.D. 
Esther Gomez-Gil, M.D. 
Jamison Green, Ph.D. 

Richard Green, M.D, J.D. 

R. Karl Hanson, Ph.D. 
Lawrence Hartmann, M.D. 
Stephen J. Hucker, M.B. 

Eric S. Janus, J.D. 

Patrick M. Jern, Ph.D. 

Megan S. Kaplan, Ph.D. 
Raymond A. Knight, Ph.D. 
Ellen T.M. Laan, Ph.D. 

Stephen B. Levine, M.D. 
Christopher G. McMahon, M.B. 
Marta Meana, Ph.D. 

Michael H. Miner, Ph.D., M.A. 
William T. O’Donohue, Ph.D. 
Michael A. Perelman, Ph.D. 
Caroline F. Pukall, Ph.D. 
Robert E. Pyke, M.D., Ph.D. 
Vernon L. Quinsey, Ph.D. M.Sc. 
David L. Rowland, Ph.D., M.A. 
Michael Sand, Ph.D., M.P.H. 
Leslie R. Schover, Ph.D., M.A. 
Paul Stern, B.S, J.D. 

David Thornton, Ph.D. 

Leonore Tiefer, Ph.D. 

Douglas E. Tucker, M.D. 
Jacques van Lankveld, Ph.D. 
Marcel D. Waldinger, M.D., Ph.D. 


Sleep-Wake Disorders 


Donald L. Bliwise, Ph.D. 

Daniel J. Buysse, M.D. 

Vishesh K. Kapur, M.D., M.P.H. 
Sanjeeve V. Kothare, M.D. 
Kenneth L. Lichstein, Ph.D. 
Mark W. Mahowald, M.D. 
Rachel Manber, Ph.D. 
Emmanuel Mignot, M.D., Ph.D. 
Timothy H. Monk, Ph.D., D.Sc. 
Thomas C. Neylan, M.D. 
Maurice M. Ohayon, M.D., D.Sc., Ph.D. 
Judith Owens, M.D., M.P.H. 
Daniel L. Picchietti, M.D. 

Stuart F. Quan, M.D. 

Thomas Roth, Ph.D. 

Daniel Weintraub, M.D. 


899 


900 


Theresa B. Young, Ph.D. 
Phyllis C. Zee, M.D., Ph.D. 


Somatic Symptom Disorders 


Brenda Bursch, Ph.D. 

Kurt Kroenke, M.D. 

W. Curt LaFrance, Jr., M.D., M.P.H. 
Jon Stone, M.B., Ch.B., Ph.D. 

Lynn M. Wegner, M.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Substance-Related Disorders 
Raymond F. Anton, Jr., M.D. 
Deborah A. Dawson, Ph.D. 
Roland R. Griffiths, Ph.D. 
Dorothy K. Hatsukami, Ph.D. 
John E. Helzer, M.D. 

Marilyn A. Huestis, Ph.D. 
John R. Hughes, M.D. 

Laura M. Juliano, Ph.D. 
Thomas R. Kosten, M.D. 
Nora D. Volkow, M.D. 


DSM-5 Study Group and Other DSM-5 Group Advisors 


Lifespan Developmental 
Approaches 


Christina Bryant, Ph.D. 
Amber Gum, Ph.D. 
Thomas Meeks, M.D. 
Jan Mohlman, Ph.D. 
Steven Thorp, Ph.D. 
Julie Wetherell, Ph.D. 


Gender and Cross-Cultural Issues 


Neil K. Aggarwal, M.D., M.B.A., M.A. 
Sofie Baarnhielm, M.D., Ph.D. 

José J. Bauermeister, Ph.D. 

James Boehnlein, M.D., M.Sc. 

Jaswant Guzder, M.D. 

Alejandro Interian, Ph.D. 

Sushrut S. Jadhav, M.B.B.S., M.D., Ph.D. 
Laurence J. Kirmayer, M.D. 

Alex J. Kopelowicz, M.D. 

Amaro J. Laria, Ph.D. 

Steven R. Lopez, Ph.D. 

Kwame J. McKenzie, M.D. 

John R. Peteet, M.D. 


Hans (J.G.B.M.) Rohlof, M.D. 
Cecile Rousseau, M.D. 
Mitchell G. Weiss, M.D., Ph.D. 


Psychiatric/General Medical 
Interface 

Daniel L. Coury, M.D. 

Bernard P. Dreyer, M.D. 


Danielle Laraque, M.D. 
Lynn M. Wegner, M.D. 


Impairment and Disability 
Prudence W. Fisher, Ph.D. 

Martin Prince, M.D., M.Sc. 
Michael R. Von Korff, Sc.D. 


Diagnostic Assessment 
Instruments 

Prudence W. Fisher, Ph.D. 
Robert D. Gibbons, Ph.D. 
Ruben Gur, Ph.D. 

John E. Helzer, M.D. 

John Houston, M.D., Ph.D. 
Kurt Kroenke, M.D. 


Other Contributors/Consultants 


ADHD and Disruptive Behavior 
Disorders 


Patrick E. Shrout, Ph.D. 
Erik Willcutt, Ph.D. 


Anxiety, Obsessive-Compulsive 
Spectrum, Posttraumatic, and 
Dissociative Disorders 


Etzel Cardena, Ph.D. 

Richard J. Castillo, Ph.D. 

Eric Hollander, M.D. 

Charlie Marmar, M.D. 

Alfonso Martinez-Taboas, Ph.D. 
Mark W. Miller, Ph.D. 

Mark H. Pollack, M.D. 

Heidi S. Resnick, Ph.D. 


Childhood and Adolescent 
Disorders 


Grace T. Baranek, Ph.D. 
Colleen Jacobson, Ph.D. 
Maria Oquendo, M.D. 

Sir Michael Rutter, M.D. 


Eating Disorders 
Nancy L. Zucker, Ph.D. 


Mood Disorders 
Keith Hawton, M.D., Ph.D. 
David A. Jobes, Ph.D. 
Maria A. Oquendo, M.D. 
Alan C. Swann, M.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Neurocognitive Disorders 
J. Eric Ahlskog, M.D., Ph.D. 
Allen J. Aksamit, M.D. 
Marilyn Albert, Ph.D. 

Guy Mckhann, M.D. 

Bradley Boeve, M.D. 

Helena Chui, M.D. 

Sureyya Dikmen, Ph.D. 
Douglas Galasko, M.D. 
Harvey Levin, Ph.D. 

Mark Lovell, Ph.D. 

Jeffery Max, M.B.B.Ch. 

Tan McKeith, M.D. 

Cynthia Munro, Ph.D. 
Marlene Oscar-Berman, Ph.D. 
Alexander Troster, Ph.D. 


Neurodevelopmental Disorders 
Anna Barnett, Ph.D. 
Martha Denckla, M.D. 
Jack M. Fletcher, Ph.D. 
Dido Green, Ph.D. 
Stephen Greenspan, Ph.D. 
Bruce Pennington, Ph.D. 
Ruth Shalev, M.D. 

Larry B. Silver, M.D. 
Lauren Swineford, Ph.D. 
Michael Von Aster, M.D. 


Personality and Personality 
Disorders 


Patricia R. Cohen, Ph.D. 
Jaime L. Derringer, Ph.D. 
Lauren Helm, M.D. 
Christopher J. Patrick, Ph.D. 
Anthony Pinto, Ph.D. 


Psychotic Disorders 
Scott W. Woods, M.D. 


Sexual and Gender Identity 
Disorders 


Alan J. Riley, M.Sc. 
Ray C. Rosen, Ph.D. 


Sleep-Wake Disorders 
Jack D. Edinger, Ph.D. 

David Gozal, M.D. 

Hochang B. Lee, M.D. 

Tore A. Nielsen, Ph.D. 
Michael J. Sateia, M.D. 

Jamie M. Zeitzer, Ph.D. 


Somatic Symptom Disorders 


Chuck V. Ford, M.D. 
Patricia I. Rosebush, M.Sc.N., M.D. 


901 


Substance-Related Disorders 


Sally M. Anderson, Ph.D. 

Julie A. Kable, Ph.D. 
Christopher Martin, Ph.D. 

Sarah N. Mattson, Ph.D. 
Edward V. Nunes, Jr., M.D. 
Mary J. O’Connor, Ph.D. 
Heather Carmichael Olson, Ph.D. 
Blair Paley, Ph.D. 

Edward P. Riley, Ph.D. 

Tulshi D. Saha, Ph.D. 

Wim van den Brink, M.D., Ph.D. 
George E. Woody, M.D. 


Diagnostic Spectra and DSM/ICD 
Harmonization 
Bruce Cuthbert, Ph.D. 


Lifespan Developmental 
Approaches 


Aartjan Beekman Ph.D. 
Alistair Flint, M.B. 
David Sultzer, M.D. 
Ellen Whyte, M.D. 


Gender and Cross-Cultural Issues 


Sergio Aguilar-Gaxiola, M.D., Ph.D. 
Kavoos G. Bassiri, M.S. 
Venkataramana Bhat, M.D. 

Marit Boiler, M.P.H. 

Denise Canso, M.Sc. 

Smita N. Deshpande, M.D., D.P.M. 
Ravi DeSilva, M.D. 

Esperanza Diaz, M.D. 

Byron J. Good, Ph.D. 

Simon Groen, M.A. 

Ladson Hinton, M.D. 

Lincoln I. Khasakhala, Ph.D. 
Francis G. Lu, M.D. 

Athena Madan, M.A. 

Anne W. Mbwayo, Ph.D. 

Oanh Meyer, Ph.D. 

Victoria N. Mutiso, Ph.D., D.Sc. 
David M. Ndetei, M.D. 

Andel V. Nicasio, M.S.Ed. 
Vasudeo Paralikar, M.D., Ph.D. 
Kanak Patil, M.A. 

Filipa I. Santos, H.B.Sc. 

Sanjeev B. Sarmukaddam, Ph.D., M.Sc. 
Monica Z. Scalco, M.D., Ph.D. 
Katie Thompson, M.A. 

Hendry Ton, M.D., M.Sc. 

Rob C.J. van Dijk, M.Sc. 

William A. Vega, Ph.D. 

Johann M. Vega-Dienstmaier, M.D. 
Joseph Westermeyer, M.D., Ph.D. 


902 


Psychiatric/General Medical 
Interface 


Daniel J. Balog, M.D. 
Charles C. Engel, M.D., M.P.H. 
Charles D. Motsinger, M.D. 


Impairment and Disability 
Cille Kennedy, Ph.D. 


Diagnostic Assessment 
Instruments 
Paul J. Pikonis, Ph.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Other Conditions That May Be 

a Focus of Clinical Attention 

William E. Narrow, M.D., M.P.H., Chair 

Roger Peele, M.D. 

Lawson R. Wulsin, M.D. 

Charles H. Zeanah, M.D. 

Prudence W. Fisher, Ph.D., Advisor 

Stanley N. Caroff, M.D., Contributor/Consultant 
James B. Lohr, M.D., Contributor/Consultant 
Marianne Wambolt, Ph.D., Contributor/Consultant 


DSM-5 Research Group 
Allan Donner, Ph.D. 


CPHC Peer Reviewers 


Kenneth Altshuler, M.D. 
Pedro G. Alvarenga, M.D. 
Diana J. Antonacci, M.D. 
Richard Balon, M.D. 

David H. Barlow, Ph.D. 

L. Jarrett Barnhill, M.D. 
Katja Beesdo-Baum, Ph.D. 
Marty Boman, Ed.D. 
James Bourgeois, M.D. 
David Braff, M.D. 

Harry Brandt, M.D. 

Kirk Brower, M.D. 

Rachel Bryant-Waugh, Ph.D. 
Jack D. Burke Jr., M.D., M.P.H. 
Brenda Bursch, Ph.D. 
Joseph Camilleri, M.D. 
Patricia Casey, M.D. 

F. Xavier Castellanos, M.D. 
Eran Chemerinski, M.D. 
Wai Chen, M.D. 

Elie Cheniaux, M.D., D.Sc. 
Cheryl Chessick, M.D, 

J. Richard Ciccone, M.D. 
Anita H. Clayton, M.D. 
Tihalia J. Coleman, Ph.D. 
John Csernansky, M.D. 
Manuel J. Cuesta M.D., Ph.D. 
Joanne L. Davis, M.D. 
David L. Delmonico, Ph.D. 
Ray J. DePaulo, M.D. 
Dimitris Dikeos, M.D. 

Ina E. Djonlagic, M.D. 

C. Neill Epperson, M.D. 
Javier I. Escobar, M.D., M.Sc. 
Spencer Eth, M.D. 

David Fassler, M.D. 
Giovanni A. Fava, M.D. 
Robert Feinstein, M.D. 
Molly Finnerty, M.D. 
Mark H. Fleisher, M.D. 
Alessio Florentini, M.D. 


Laura Fochtmann, M.D. 
Marshal Forstein, M.D. 
William French, M.D. 
Maximillian Gahr, M.D. 
Cynthia Geppert, M.D. 

Ann Germaine, Ph.D. 
Marcia Goin, M.D. 

David A. Gorelick, M.D., Ph.D. 
David Graeber, M.D. 
Cynthia A. Graham, Ph.D. 
Andreas Hartmann, M.D. 
Victoria Hendrick, M.D. 
Merrill Herman, M.D. 

David Herzog, M.D. 

Mardi Horowitz, M.D. 
Ya-fen Huang, M.D. 
Anthony Kales, M.D 
Niranjan S. Karnik, M.D., Ph.D. 
Jeffrey Katzman, M.D. 
Bryan King, M.D. 

Cecilia Kjellgren, M.D. 
Harold W. Koenigsberg, M.D. 
Richard B. Krueger, M.D. 
Steven Lamberti, M.D. 

Ruth A. Lanius, M.D. 

John Lauriello, M.D. 
Anthony Lehman, M.D. 
Michael Linden, M.D. 

Mark W. Mahowald, M.D. 
Marsha D. Marcus, Ph.D. 
Stephen Marder, M.D. 
Wendy Marsh, M.D. 
Michael S. McCloskey, Ph.D. 
Jeffrey Metzner, M.D. 
Robert Michels, M.D. 

Laura Miller, M.D. 

Michael C. Miller, M.D. 
Frederick Moeller, M.D. 
Peter T. Morgan, M.D., Ph.D. 
Madhav Muppa, M.D. 
Philip Muskin, M.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Joachim Nitschke, M.D. 
Abraham Nussbaum, M.D. 
Ann Olincy, M.D. 

Mark Onslow, Ph.D. 

Sally Ozonoff, Ph.D. 

John R. Peteet, M.D. 
Ismene L. Petrakis, M.D. 
Christophe M. Pfeiffer, M.D. 
Karen Pierce, M.D. 

Belinda Plattner, M.D. 
Franklin Putnam, M.D. 
Stuart F. Quan, M.D. 

John Racy, M.D. 

Phillip Resnick, M.D. 
Michele Riba, M.D. 

Jerold Rosenbaum, M.D. 
Stephen Ross, M.D. 
Lawrence Scahill, M.S.N., Ph.D. 
Daniel Schechter, M.D. 
Mary V. Seeman, M.D. 
Alessandro Serretti, M.D. 
Jianhua Shen, M.D. 


903 


Ravi Kumar R. Singareddy, M.D. 
Ingmar Skoog, M.D., Ph.D. 
Gary Small, M.D. 

Paul Soloff, M.D. 

Christina Stadler, M.D., Ph.D. 
Nada Stotland, M.D. 

Neil Swerdlow, M.D. 

Kim Tillery, Ph.D. 

David Tolin, Ph.D. 

Jayne Trachman, M.D. 

Luke Tsai, M.D. 

Ming T. Tsuang, M.D., Ph.D. 
Richard Tuch, M.D. 

Johan Verhulst, M.D. 

B. Timothy Walsh, M.D. 
Michael Weissberg, M.D. 
Godehard Weniger, M.D. 
Keith Widaman, Ph.D. 
Thomas Wise, M.D. 

George E. Woods, M.D. 
Kimberly A. Yonkers, M.D. 
Alexander Young, M.D. 


DSM-5 Field Trials in Academic Clinical Centers— 
Adult Samples 


David Geffen School of Medicine, University of California, Los Angeles 


Investigator 
Helen Lavretsky, M.D., Principal Investigator 


Referring and Interviewing 
Clinicians 

Jessica Brommelhoff, Ph.D. 

Xavier Cagigas, Ph.D. 

Paul Cernin, Ph.D. 

Linda Ercoli, Ph.D. 

Randall Espinoza, M.D. 


Helen Lavretsky, M.D. 
Jeanne Kim, Ph.D. 

David Merrill, M.D. 
Karen Miller, Ph.D. 
Christopher Nunez, Ph.D. 


Research Coordinators 
Natalie St. Cyr, M.A., Lead Research 
Coordinator 


Nora Nazarian, B.A. 
Colin Shinn, M.A. 


Centre for Addiction and Mental Health, Toronto, Ontario, Canada 


Investigators 


Bruce G. Pollock, M.D., Ph.D., Lead Principal 
Investigator 

R. Michael Bagby, Ph.D., Principal Investigator 

Kwame J. McKenzie, M.D., Principal 
Investigator 

Tony P. George, M.D., Co-investigator 

Lena C. Quilty, Ph.D., Co-investigator 

Peter Voore, M.D., Co-investigator 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 


Donna E. Akman, Ph.D. 
R. Michael Bagby, Ph.D. 
Wayne C. V. Baici, M.D. 
Crystal Baluyut, M.D. 


Eva W. C. Chow, M.D., J.D., M.P.H. 
Z. J. Daskalakis, M.D., Ph.D. 

Pablo Diaz-Hermosillo, M.D. 
George Foussias, M.Sc., M.D. 

Paul A. Frewen, Ph.D. 

Ariel Graff-Guerrero, M.D., M.Sc., Ph.D. 
Margaret K. Hahn, M.D. 

Lorena Hsu, Ph.D. 

Justine Joseph, Ph.D. 

Sean Kidd, Ph.D. 

Kwame J. McKenzie, M.D. 

Mahesh Menon, Ph.D. 

Romina Mizrahi, M.D., Ph.D. 
Daniel J. Mueller, M.D., Ph.D. 

Lena C. Quilty, Ph.D. 

Anthony C. Ruocco, Ph.D. 


904 


Jorge Soni, M.D. 

Aristotle N. Voineskos, M.D., Ph.D. 
George Voineskos, M.D. 

Peter Voore, Ph.D. 

Chris Watson, Ph.D. 


Referring Clinicians 


Ofer Agid, M.D. 

Ash Bender, M.D. 
Patricia Cavanagh, M.D. 
Sarah Colman, M.D. 
Vincenzo Deluca, M.D. 
Justin Geagea, M.D. 
David S. Goldbloom, M.D. 
Daniel Greben, M.D. 
Malati Gupta, M.D. 

Ken Harrison, M.D. 
Imraan Jeeva, M.D. 

Joel Jeffries, M.B. 

Judith Laposa, Ph.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Jan Malat, M.D. 

Shelley McMain, Ph.D. 

Bruce Pollock, M.D., Ph.D. 

Andriy V. Samokhvalov, M.D., Ph.D. 
Martin Strassnig, M.D. 

Albert H. C. Wong, M.D., Ph.D. 


Research Coordinators 

Gloria I. Leo, M.A., Lead Research Coordinator 
Anissa D. Bachan, B.A. 

Bahar Haji-Khamneh, M.A. 

Olga Likhodi, M.Sc. 

Eleanor J. Liu, Ph.D. 

Sarah A. McGee Ng, B.B.A. 


Other Research Staff 


Susan E. Dickens, M.A., Clinical Research 
Manager 

Sandy Richards, B.Sc.N., Schizophrenia 
Research Manager 


Dallas VA Medical Center, Dallas, Texas 


Investigators 


Carol S. North, M.D., M.P.E., Principal 
Investigator 

Alina Suris, Ph.D., A.B.P.P., Principal 
Investigator 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 


Barry Ardolf, Psy.D. 

Abila Awan, M.D. 

Joel Baskin, M.D. 

John Black, Ph.D. 

Jeffrey Dodds, Ph.D. 

Gloria Emmett, Ph.D. 

Karma Hudson, M.D. 

Jamylah Jackson, Ph.D., A.B.P.P. 
Lynda Kirkland-Culp, Ph.D., A.B.P.P. 
Heidi Koehler, Ph.D., A.B.P.P. 
Elizabeth Lewis, Psy.D. 

Aashish Parikh, M.D. 

Reed Robinson, Ph.D. 

Jheel Shah, M.D. 

Geetha Shivakumar, M.D. 

Sarah Spain, Ph.D., A.B.P.P. 


Lisa Thoman, Ph.D. 

Lia Thomas, M.D. 

Jamie Zabukovec, Psy.D. 
Mustafa Zaidi, M.D. 
Andrea Zartman, Ph.D. 


General Referral Sources 
Robert Blake, L.M.S.W. 

Evelyn Gibbs, L.M.S.W. 

Michelle King-Thompson, L.M.S.W. 


Research Coordinators 


Jeannie B. Whitman, Ph.D., Lead Research 
Coordinator 
Sunday Adewuyi, M.D. 
Elizabeth Anderson, B.A. 
Solaleh Azimipour, B.S. 
Carissa Barney, B.S. 
Kristie Cavazos, B.A. 
Robert Devereaux, B.S. 
Dana Downs, M.S., M.S.W. 
Sharjeel Farooqui, M.D. 
Julia Smith, Psy.D. 
Kun-Ying H. Sung, B.S. 


School of Medicine, The University of Texas San Antonio, 
San Antonio, Texas 


Investigator 

Mauricio Tohen, M.D., Dr.P.H., M.B.A., 
Principal Investigator 

Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 


Suman Baddam, Psy.D. 
Charles L. Bowden, M.D. 


Nancy Diazgranados, M.D., MLS. 
Craig A. Dike, Psy.D. 

Dianne E. Dunn, Psy.D., M.P.H. 
Elena Gherman, M.D. 

Jodi M. Gonzalez, Ph.D. 

Pablo Gonzalez, M.D. 

Phillip Lai, Psy.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Natalie Maples-Aguilar, M.A., L.P.A. 
Marlon P. Quinones, M.D. 

Jeslina J. Raj, Psy.D. 

David L. Roberts, Ph.D. 

Nancy Sandusky, R.N., F.P.M.H.N.P.-B.C., 
D.N.P.-C. 

Donna S. Stutes, M.S., L.P.C. 

Mauricio Tohen, M.D., Dr.PH, M.B.A. 
Dawn I. Velligan, Ph.D. 

Weiran Wu, M.D., Ph.D. 


Referring Clinicians 
Albana Dassori, M.D. 
Megan Frederick, M.A. 


905 


Robert Gonzalez, M.D. 
Uma Kasinath, M.D. 
Camis Milam, M.D. 
Vivek Singh, M.D. 
Peter Thompson, M.D. 


Research Coordinators 

Melissa Hernandez, B.A., Lead Research 
Coordinator 

Fermin Alejandro Carrizales, B.A. 

Martha Dahl, R.N., B.S.N. 

Patrick M. Smith, B.A. 

Nicole B. Watson, M.A. 


Michael E. DeBakey VA Medical Center and the Menninger Clinic, 
Houston, Texas (Joint Study Site) 


Michael E. DeBakey VA Medical Center 


Investigator 
Laura Marsh, M.D., Principal Investigator 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 


Shalini Aggarwal, M.D. 
Su Bailey, Ph.D. 

Minnete (Helen) Beckner, Ph.D. 
Crystal Clark, M.D. 
Charles DeJohn, M.D. 
Robert Garza, M.D. 

Aruna Gottumakkla, M.D. 
Janet Hickey, M.D. 

James Ireland, M.D. 

Mary Lois Lacey, A.P.R.N. 
Wendy Leopoulos, M.D. 
Laura Marsh, M.D. 
Deleene Menefee, Ph.D. 
Brian I. Miller, Ph.D. 
Candy Smith, Ph.D. 

Avila Steele, Ph.D. 

Jill Wanner, Ph.D. 

Rachel Wells, Ph.D. 

Kaki York-Ward, Ph.D. 


Referring Clinicians 
Sara Allison, M.D. 

Leonard Denney, L.C.S.W. 
Catherine Flores, L.C.S.W. 
Nathalie Marie, M.D. 
Christopher Martin, M.D. 
Sanjay Mathew, M.D. 

Erica Montgomery, M.D. 
Gregory Scholl, P.A. 

Jocelyn Ulanday, M.D., M.P.H. 


Research Coordinators 

Sarah Neely Torres, B.S., Lead Research 
Coordinator 

Kathleen Grout, M.A. 

Lea Kiefer, M.P.H. 

Jana Tran, M.A. 


Volunteer Research Assistants 


Catherine Clark 
Linh Hoang 


Menninger Clinic 


Investigator 
Efrain Bleiberg, M.D., Principal Investigator 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 
Jennifer Baumgardner, Ph.D. 

Elizabeth Dodd Conaway, L.C.S.W., B.C.D. 
Warren Christianson, D.O. 

Wesley Clayton, L.M.S.W. 

J. Christopher Fowler, Ph.D. 

Michael Groat, Ph.D. 

Edythe Harvey, M.D. 

Denise Kagan, Ph.D. 

Hans Meyer, L.C.S.W. 


Segundo Robert-Ibarra, M.D. 
Sandhya Trivedi, M.D. 
Rebecca Wagner, Ph.D. 
Harrell Woodson, Ph.D. 
Amanda Yoder, L.C.S.W. 


Referring Clinicians 
James Flack, M.D. 

David Ness, M.D. 

Research Coordinators 


Steve Herrera, B.S., M.T., Lead Research 
Coordinator 
Allison Kalpakci, B.A. 


906 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Mayo Clinic, Rochester, Minnesota 


Investigators 

Mark A. Frye, M.D., Principal Investigator 

Glenn E. Smith, Ph.D., Principal Investigator 

Jeffrey P. Staab M.D., MLS., Principal 
Investigator 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 
Osama Abulseoud, M.D. 
Jane Cerhan, Ph.D. 

Julie Fields, Ph.D. 

Mark A. Frye, M.D. 
Manuel Fuentes, M.D. 
Yonas Geda, M.D. 

Maria Harmandayan, M.D. 
Reba King, M.D. 

Simon Kung, M.D. 

Mary Machuda, Ph.D. 
Donald McAlpine, M.D. 
Alastair McKean, M.D. 
Juliana Moraes, M.D. 
Teresa Rummans, M.D. 


James R. Rundell, M.D. 
Richard Seime, Ph.D. 
Glenn E. Smith, Ph.D. 
Christopher Sola, D.O. 
Jeffrey P. Staab M.D., MLS. 
Marin Veldic, M.D. 

Mark D. Williams, M.D. 
Maya Yustis, Ph.D. 


Research Coordinators 

Lisa Seymour, B.S., Lead Research Coordinator 
Scott Feeder, M.S. 

Lee Gunderson, B.S. 

Sherrie Hanna, M.A., L.P. 

Kelly Harper, B.A. 

Katie Mingo, B.A. 

Cynthia Stoppel, A.S. 


Other Study Staff 


Anna Frye 
Andrea Hogan 


Perelman School of Medicine, University of Pennsylvania, 
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 


Investigators 


Mahendra T. Bhati, M.D., Principal Investigator 
Marna S. Barrett, Ph.D., Co-investigator 
Michael E. Thase, M.D., Co-investigator 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 


Peter B. Bloom, M.D. 

Nicole K Chalmers L.C.S.W. 
Torrey A. Creed, Ph.D. 
Mario Cristancho, M.D. 
Amy Cunningham, Psy.D. 
John P. Dennis, Ph.D. 
Josephine Elia, M.D. 

Peter Gariti, Ph.D., L.C.S.W. 
Philip Gehrman, Ph.D. 
Laurie Gray, M.D. 

Emily A.P. Haigh, Ph.D. 
Nora J. Johnson, M.B.A., M.S., Psy.D. 
Paulo Knapp, M.D. 
Yong-Tong Li, M.D. 

Bill Mace, Ph.D. 

Kevin S. McCarthy, Ph.D. 
Dimitri Perivoliotis, Ph.D. 
Luke Schultz, Ph.D. 

Tracy Steen, Ph.D. 

Chris Tjoa, M.D. 

Nancy A. Wintering, L.C.S.W. 


Referring Clinicians 


Eleanor Ainslie, M.D. 
Kelly C. Allison, Ph.D. 


Rebecca Aspden, M.D. 
Claudia F. Baldassano, M.D. 
Vijayta Bansal, M.D. 
Rachel A. Bennett, M.D. 
Richard Bollinger, Ph.D. 
Andrea Bowen, M.D. 
Karla Campanella, M.D. 
Anthony Carlino, M.D. 
Noah Carroll, M.S.S. 
Alysia Cirona, M.D. 
Samuel Collier, M.D. 
Andreea Crauciuc, L.C.S.W. 
Pilar Cristancho, M.D. 
Traci D'Almeida, M.D. 
Kathleen Diller, M.D. 
Benoit Dubé, M.D. 

Jon Dukes, M.S.W. 

Lauren Elliott, M.D. 

Mira Elwell, B.A. 

Mia Everett, M.D. 

Lucy F. Faulconbridge, Ph.D. 
Patricia Furlan, Ph.D. 
Joanna Goldstein, L.C.S.W. 
Paul Grant, Ph.D. 

Jillian Graves, L.C.S.W. 
Tamar Gur, M.D., Ph.D. 
Alisa Gutman, M.D., Ph.D. 
Nora Hymowitz, M.D. 
Sofia Jensen, M.D. 

Tiffany King, M.S.W. 
Katherine Levine, M.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Alice Li, M.D. 

Janet Light, L.C.S.W. 

John Listerud, M.D., Ph.D. 
Emily Malcoun, Ph.D. 
Donovan Maust, M.D. 
Adam Meadows, M.D. 
Michelle Moyer, M.D. 
Rebecca Naugle, L.C.S.W. 
Cory Newman, Ph.D. 

John Northrop, M.D., Ph.D. 
Elizabeth A. Ellis Ohr, Psy.D. 
John O'Reardon, M.D. 
Abraham Pachikara, M.D. 
Andrea Perelman, M.S.W. 
Diana Perez, M.S.W. 
Bianca Previdi, M.D. 

J. Russell Ramsay, Ph.D. 
Jorge Rivera-Colon, M.D. 
Jan Smedley, L.C.S.W. 
Katie Struble, M.S.W. 

Aita Susi, M.D. 

Yekaterina Tatarchuk, M.D. 
Ellen Tarves, M.A. 

Allison Tweedie, M.D. 
Holly Valerio, M.D. 


907 


Thomas A. Wadden, Ph.D. 
Joseph Wright, Ph.D. 

Yan Xuan, M.D. 

David Yusko, Psy.D. 


Research Coordinators 

Jordan A. Coello, B.A., Lead Research 
Coordinator 

Eric Wang, B.S.E. 


Volunteer Research Assistants/ 
Interns 


Jeannine Barker, M.A., A.T.R. 
Jacqueline Baron 
Kelsey Bogue 
Alexandra Ciomek 
Martekuor Dodoo, B.A. 
Julian Domanico 

Laura Heller, B.A. 

Leah Hull-Rawson, B.A. 
Jacquelyn Klehm, B.A. 
Christina Lam 

Dante Proetto, B.S. 
Molly Roy 

Casey Shannon 


Stanford University School of Medicine, Stanford, Califomia 


Investigators 


Carl Feinstein, M.D., Principal Investigator 
Debra Safer, M.D., Principal Investigator 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 


Kari Berquist, Ph.D. 
Eric Clausell, Ph.D. 
Danielle Colborn, Ph.D. 
Whitney Daniels, M.D. 
Alison Darcy, Ph.D. 
Krista Fielding, M.D. 
Mina Fisher, M.D. 

Kara Fitzpatrick, Ph.D. 
Wendy Froehlich, M.D. 
Grace Gengoux, Ph.D. 
Anna Cassandra Golding, Ph.D. 
Lisa Groesz, Ph.D. 

Kyle Hinman, M.D. 
Rob Holaway, Ph.D. 
Matthew Holve, M.D. 
Rex Huang, M.D. 

Nina Kirz, M.D. 

Megan Klabunde, Ph.D. 
John Leckie, Ph.D. 
Naomi Leslie, M.D. 
Adrianne Lona, M.D. 
Ranvinder Rai, M.D. 
Rebecca Rialon, Ph.D. 
Beverly Rodriguez, M.D., Ph.D. 
Debra Safer, M.D. 

Mary Sanders, Ph.D. 


Jamie Scaletta, Ph.D. 

Norah Simpson, Ph.D. 
Manpreet Singh, M.D. 
Maria-Christina Stewart, Ph.D. 
Melissa Vallas, M.D. 

Patrick Whalen, Ph.D. 

Sanno Zack, Ph.D. 


Referring Clinicians 
Robin Apple, Ph.D. 
Victor Carrion, M.D. 
Carl Feinstein, M.D. 
Christine Gray, Ph.D. 
Antonio Hardan, M.D. 
Megan Jones, Psy.D. 
Linda Lotspeich, M.D. 
Lauren Mikula, Psy.D. 
Brandyn Street, Ph.D. 
Violeta Tan, M.D. 
Heather Taylor, Ph.D. 
Jacob Towery, M.D. 
Sharon Williams, Ph.D. 


Research Coordinators 

Kate Arnow, B.A., Lead Research Coordinator 
Nandini Datta, B.S. 

Stephanie Manasse, B.A. 

Volunteer Research Assistants/ 
Interns 


Arianna Martin, M.S. 
Adriana Nevado, B.A. 


908 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Children’s Hospital Colorado, Aurora, Colorado 


Investigator 


Marianne Wamboldt, M.D., Principal 


Investigator 


Referring and Interviewing 


Clinicians 

Galia Abadi, M.D. 

Steven Behling, Ph.D. 
Jamie Blume, Ph.D. 
Adam Burstein, M.D. 
Debbie Carter, M.D. 
Kelly Caywood, Ph.D. 
Meredith Chapman, M.D. 


Paulette Christian, A.P.P.M.H.N. 


Mary Cook, M.D. 
Anthony Cordaro, M.D. 
Audrey Dumas, M.D. 
Guido Frank, M.D. 
Karen Frankel, Ph.D. 
Darryl Graham, Ph.D. 
Yael Granader, Ph.D. 
Isabelle Guillemet, M.D. 
Patrece Hairston, Ph.D. 
Charles Harrison, Ph.D. 
Tammy Herckner, L.C.S.W. 
Cassie Karlsson, M.D. 
Kimberly Kelsay, M.D. 
David Kieval, Ph.D. 
Megan Klabunde, Ph.D. 
Jaimelyn Kost, L.C.S.W. 
Harrison Levine, M.D. 
Raven Lipmanson, M.D. 
Susan Lurie, M.D. 

Asa Marokus, M.D. 
Idalia Massa, Ph.D. 
Christine McDunn, Ph.D. 
Scot McKay, M.D. 
Marissa Murgolo, L.C.S.W. 
Alyssa Oland, Ph.D. 
Lina Patel, Ph.D. 

Rheena Pineda, Ph.D. 
Gautam Rajendran, M.D. 
Diane Reichmuth, Ph.D 
Michael Rollin, M.D. 


Marlena Romero, L.C.S.W. 
Michelle Roy, Ph.D. 
Celeste St. John-Larkin, M.D. 
Elise Sannar, Ph.D. 

Daniel Savin, M.D. 

Claire Dean Sinclair, Ph.D. 
Ashley Smith, L.C.S.W. 
Mindy Solomon, Ph.D. 
Sally Tarbell, Ph.D. 

Helen Thilly, L.C.S.W. 
Sara Tlustos-Carter, Ph.D. 
Holly Vause, A.P.P.M.H.N 
Marianne Wamboldt, M.D. 
Angela Ward, L.C.S.W. 
Jason Williams, Ph.D. 
Jason Willoughby, Ph.D. 
Brennan Young, Ph.D. 


Referring Clinicians 
Kelly Bhatnagar, Ph.D. 
Jeffery Dolgan, Ph.D. 
Jennifer Eichberg, L.C.S.W. 
Jennifer Hagman, M.D. 
James Masterson, L.C.S.W. 
Hy Gia Park, M.D. 

Tami Roblek, Ph.D. 
Wendy Smith, Ph.D. 
David Williams, M.D. 


Research Coordinators 

Laurie Burnside, M.S.M., C.C.R.C., Lead 
Research Coordinator 

Darci Anderson, B.A., C.C.R.C. 

Heather Kennedy, M.P.H. 

Amanda Millar, B.A. 

Vanessa Waruinge, B.S. 

Elizabeth Wallace, B.A. 


Volunteer Research Assistants/ 
Interns 

Wisdom Amouzou 

Ashley Anderson 

Michael Richards 

Mateya Whyte 


Baystate Medical Center, Springfield, Massachusetts 


Investigators 


Bruce Waslick, M.D., Principal Investigator 
Cheryl Bonica, Ph.D., Co-investigator 

John Fanton, M.D., Co-investigator 

Barry Sarvet, M.D., Co-investigator 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 


Julie Bermant, R.N., M.S.N., N.P. 
Cheryl Bonica, Ph.D. 

Jodi Devine, L.I.C.S.W. 

William Fahey, Ph.D. 

John Fanton, M.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Stephane Jacobus, Ph.D. 
Barry Sarvet, M.D. 
Peter Thunfors, Ph.D. 
Bruce Waslick, M.D. 
Vicki Weld, L.I.C.S.W. 
Sara Wiener, L.I.C.S.W. 
Shadi Zaghloul, M.D. 


Referring Clinicians 

Sarah Detenber, L.I.C.S.W. 
Gordon Garrison, L.I.C.S.W. 
Jacqueline Humpreys, L.LC.S.W. 
Noreen McGirr, L.-C.S.W. 


909 


Sarah Marcotte, L.C.S.W. 
Patricia Rogowski, R.N., C.N.S. 


Research Coordinators 


Julie Kingsbury, C.C.R.P., Lead Research 
Coordinator 
Brenda Martin, B.A. 


Volunteer Research Assistant/ 
Intern 
Liza Detenber 


New York State Psychiatric Institute, New York, N.Y., Weill Cornell 
Medical College, Payne Whitney and Westchester Divisions, New York 
and White Plains, N.Y., and North Shore Child and Family Guidance 
Center, Roslyn Heights, N.Y. (Joint Study Site) 


Investigator 


Prudence W. Fisher, Ph.D., Principal 
Investigator 


Research Coordinators 


Julia K. Carmody, B.A., Lead Research 
Coordinator 

Zvi R. Shapiro, B.A., Lead Research 
Coordinator 


Volunteers 

Preeya Desai 

Samantha Keller 
Jeremy Litfin, M.A. 
Sarah L. Pearlstein, B.A. 
Cedilla Sacher 


New York State Psychiatric Institute 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 
Michele Cohen, L.C.S.W. 

Eduvigis Cruz-Arrieta, Ph.D. 
Miriam Ehrensaft, Ph.D. 

Laurence Greenhill, M.D. 

Schuyler Henderson, M.D., M.P.H. 
Sharlene Jackson, Ph.D. 

Lindsay Moskowitz, M.D. 

Sweene C. Oscar, Ph.D. 

Xenia Protopopescu, M.D. 

James Rodriguez, Ph.D. 

Gregory Tau, M.D. 

Melissa Tebbs, L.C.S.W. 

Carolina Velez-Grau, L.C.S.W. 
Khadijah Booth Watkins, M.D. 


Referring Clinicians 
George Alvarado, M.D. 

Alison Baker, M.D. 

Elena Baron, Psy.D. 

Lincoln Bickford, M.D., Ph.D. 
Zachary Blumkin, Psy.D. 
Colleen Cullen, L.C.S.W. 
Chyristianne DeAlmeida, Ph.D. 
Matthew Ehrlich, M.D. 


Eve Friedl, M.D. 

Clare Gaskins, Ph.D. 
Alice Greenfield, L.C.S.W. 
Liora Hoffman, M.D. 
Kathleen Jung, M.D. 
Karimi Mailutha, M.D., M.P.H. 
Valentina Nikulina, Ph.D. 
Tal Reis, Ph.D. 

Moira Rynn, M.D. 
Jasmine Sawhney, M.D. 
Sarajbit Singh, M.D. 
Katherine Stratigos, M.D. 
Oliver Stroeh, M.D. 
Russell Tobe, M.D. 
Meghan Tomb, Ph.D. 
Michelle Tricamo, M.D. 


Research Coordinators 
Angel A. Caraballo, M.D. 

Erica M. Chin, Ph.D. 

Daniel T. Chrzanowski, M.D. 
Tess Dougherty, B.A. 
Stephanie Hundt, M.A. 

Moira A. Rynn, M.D. 

Deborah Stedge, R.N. 


910 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Weill Cornell Medical College, Payne Whitney and Westchester Divisions 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 
Archana Basu, Ph.D. 

Shannon M. Bennett, M.D. 

Maria De Pena-Nowak, M.D. 

Jill Feldman, L.M.S.W. 

Dennis Gee, M.D. 

Jo R. Hariton, Ph.D. 

Lakshmi P. Reddy, M.D. 

Margaret Yoon, M.D. 


Referring Clinicians 


Margo Benjamin, M.D. 

Vanessa Bobb, M.D. 

Elizabeth Bochtler, M.D. 

Katie Cave, L.C.S.W. 

Maalobeeka Gangopadhyay, M.D. 


Jodi Gold, M.D. 

Tejal Kaur, M.D. 

Aaron Krasner, M.D. 
Amy Miranda, L.C.S.W. 
Cynthia Pfeffer, M.D. 
James Rebeta, Ph.D. 
Sharon Skariah, M.D. 
Jeremy Stone, Ph.D. 
Dirk Winter, M.D. 


Research Coordinators 

Alex Eve Keller, B.S., Lead Research Coordinator 
Nomi Bodner (volunteer) 

Barbara L. Flye, Ph.D. 

Jamie S. Neiman (volunteer) 

Rebecca L. Rendleman, M.D. 


North Shore Child and Family Guidance Center 


Referring and Interviewing Clinicians 
Casye Brachfeld-Launer, L.C.S.W. 
Susan Klein Cohen, Ph.D. 

Amy Gelb, L.C.S.W.-R. 

Jodi Glasser, L.C.S.W. 

Elizabeth Goulding-Tag, L.C.S.W. 
Deborah B. Kassimir, L.C.S.W. 
Margo Posillico Messina, L.C.S.W. 
Andréa Moullin-Heddle, L.M.S.W. 
Lisa Pineda, L.C.S.W. 

Elissa Smilowitz, L.C.S.W. 


Referring Clinicians 

Regina Barros-Rivera, L.C.S.W.-R. Assistant 
Executive Director 

Maria Christiansen, B.S. 

Amy Davies-Hollander, L.M.S.W. 

Eartha Hackett, M.S.Ed., M.Sc., B.Sc. 


Bruce Kaufstein, L.C.S.W.-R, Director of 
Clinical Services 

Kathy Knaust, L.C.S.W. 

John Levinson, L.C.S.W.-R, B.C.D. 

Andrew Maleckoff, L.C.S.W., Executive 
Director /CEO 

Sarah Rosen, L.C.S.W.-R, A.C.S.W. 

Abigail Rothenberg, L.M.S.W. 

Christine Scotten, A.C.S.W. 

Michelle Spatano, L.C.S.W.-R. 

Diane Straneri, M.S., R.N., C.S. 

Rosara Torrisi, L.M.S.W. 

Rob Vichnis, L.C.S.W. 


Research Coordinators 
Toni Kolb-Papetti, L.C.S.W. 
Sheena M. Dauro (volunteer) 


DSM-5 Field Trials Pilot Study, 
Johns Hopkins Medical Institution, Baltimore, Maryland 


Adult Sample 


Community Psychiatry Outpatient Program, Department of Psychiatry 
and Behavioral Sciences Main Campus 


Investigators 


Bernadette Cullen, M.B., B.Ch., B.A.O., 
Principal Investigator 
Holly C. Wilcox, Ph.D., Principal Investigator 


Referring and Interviewing 
Clinicians 

Bernadette Cullen, M.B., B.Ch., B.A.O. 
Shane Grant, L.C.S.W.-C. 

Charee Green, L.C.P.C. 


Emily Lorensen, L.C.S.W.-C. 
Kathleen Malloy, L.C.P.C. 

Gary Pilarchik, L.C.S.W.-C 

Holly Slater, L.C.P.C. 

Stanislav Spivak, M.D. 

Tarcia Spencer Turner, L.C.P.C. 
Nicholas Seldes Windt, L.C.S.W.-C. 


Research Coordinators 


Mellisha McKitty, B.A. 
Alison Newcomer, M.H.S. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


911 


Pediatric Sample 


Child and Adolescent Outpatient Program, Department of Psychiatry and 
Behavioral Sciences Bayview Medical Center 


Investigators 

Joan P. Gerring, M.D., Principal Investigator 
Leslie Miller, M.D., Principal Investigator 
Holly C. Wilcox, Ph.D., Co-investigator 


Referring and Interviewing 
Clinicians 

Shannon Barnett, M.D. 

Gwen Condon, L.C.P.C. 

Brijan Fellows, L.C.S.W.-C. 
Heather Garner, L.C.S.W.-C. 

Joan P. Gerring, M.D. 


Anna Gonzaga, M.D. 

Debra Jenkins, L.C.S.W.-C. 
Paige N. Johnston, L.C.P.C. 
Brenda Memel, D.N.P., R.N. 
Leslie Miller, M.D. 

Ryan Moore, L.C.S.W.-C. 
Shauna Reinblatt, M.D. 
Monique Vardi, L.C.P.C. 


Research Coordinators 


Mellisha McKitty, B.A. 
Alison Newcomer, M.H.S. 


DSM-5 Field Trials in Routine Clinical Practice Settings: 
Collaborating Investigators 


Archil Abashidze, M.D. 

Francis R. Abueg, Ph.D. 

Jennifer Louise Accuardi, M.S. 

Balkozar S. Adam, M.D. 

Miriam E. Adams, Sc.D., M.S.W., L.LC.S.W. 

Suzanna C. Adams, M.A. 

Lawrence Adler, M.D. 

Rownak Afroz, M.D. 

Khalid I. Afzal, M.D. 

Joseph Alimasuya, M.D. 

Emily Allen, M.S. 

Katherine A. Allen, L.M.F.T., M.A. 

William D. Allen, M.S. 

Jafar AlMashat, M.D. 

Anthony T. Alonzo, D.M.F.T. 

Guillermo Alvarez, B.A., M.A. 

Angela Amoia-Lutz, L.M.F.T. 

Krista A. Anderson, M.A., L.M.F.T. 

Lisa R. Anderson, M.Ed., L.C.P.C. 

Pamela M. Anderson, L.M.F.T. 

Shannon N. Anderson, M.A., L.P.C., N.C.C. 

Eric S. Andrews, M.A. 

Vicki Arbuckle, M.S., Nursing(N.P.) 

Namita K. Arora, M.D. 

Darryl Arrington, M.A. 

Bearlyn Y. Ash, M.S. 

Wylie J. Bagley, Ph.D. 

Kumar D. Bahl, M.D. 

Deborah C. Bailey, M.A., M.S., Ph.D. 

Carolyn Baird, D.N.P., M.B.A., R.N.-B.C., 
C.A.R.N.-A.P., LC.C.D.P.D. 

Joelle Bangsund M.S.W. 

Maria Baratta, M.S.W., Ph.D. 

Stan Barnard, M.S.W. 

Deborah Barnes, M.S. 


Margaret L. Barnes, Ph.D. 

David Barnum, Ph.D. 

Raymond M. Baum, M.D. 

Edward Wescott Beal, M.D. 

Michelle Beaudoin, M.A. 

Ernest E. Beckham, Ph.D. 

Lori L. Beckwith, M.Ed 

Emmet Bellville, M.A. 

Randall E. Bennett, M.A. 

Lynn Benson, Ph.D. 

Robert Scott Benson, M.D. 

Linda Benton, M.S.W. 

Ditza D. Berger, Ph.D. 

Louise I. Bertman, Ph.D. 

Robin Bieber, M.S., L.M.F.T. 

Diana M. Bigham, M.A. 

David R. Blackburn, Ph.D. 

Kelley Blackwell, L.M.F.T. 

Lancia Blatchley, B.A., L.M.F.T. 
Stacey L. Block, L.M.S.W., A.C.S.W. 
Karen J. Bloodworth, M.S., N.C.C., L.P.C. 
Lester Bloomenstiel, M.S. 

Christine M. Blue, D.O. 

Marina Bluvshtein, Ph.D. 

Callie Gray Bobbitt, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Moses L. Boone, Jr., L.M.S.W., B.C.D. 
Steffanie Boudreau-Thomas, M.A.-L.P.C. 
Jay L. Boulter, M.A. 

Aaron Daniel Bourne, M.A. 

Helen F. Bowden, Ph.D. 

Aryn Bowley-Safranek, B.S., M.S. 
Elizabeth Boyajian, Ph.D. 

Beth K. Boyarsky, M.D. 

Gail M. Boyd, Ph.D. 

Jeffrey M. Brandler, Ed.S., C.A.S.,S.A.P. 


912 


Sandra L. Branton, Ed.D. 

Karen J. Brocco-Kish, M.D. 
Kristin Brooks, P.M.H.N.P. 
Ann Marie Brown, M.S.W. 
Philip Brown, M.S.W. 

Kellie Buckner, Ed.S. 

Richard Bunt, M.D. 

Neil F. Buono, D.Min. 

Janice Bureau, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Kimlee Butterfield, M.S.W. 
Claudia Byrne, Ph.D. 

Quinn Callicott, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Alvaro Camacho, M.D., M.P.H. 
Sandra Cambra, Ph.D. 

Heather Campbell, M.A. 

Nancy Campbell, Ph.D., M.S.W. 
Karen Ranee Canada, L.M.F.T. 
Joseph P. Cannavo, M.D. 
Catherine F. Caporale, Ph.D. 
Frederick Capps, Ph.D., M.S. 


Rebecca J. Carney, M.B.A., M.A., L.M.H.C. 


Kelly J. Carroll, M.S.W. 


Richard W. Carroll, Ph.D., L.P.C., A.C.S. 


Sherry Casper, Ph.D. 


Joseph A. Catania, L.I.S.W.S., L.C.D.C. II 


Manisha P. Cavendish, Ph.D. 

Kenneth M. Certa, M.D. 

Shambhavi Chandraiah, M.D. 

Calvin Chatlos, M.D. 

Daniel C. Chen, M.D. 

Darlene Cheryl, M.S.W. 

Matthew R. Chirman, M.S. 

Carole A. Chisholm, M.S.W. 

Shobha A. Chottera, M.D. 

Joseph Logue Christenson, M.D. 

Pamela Christy, Psy.D. 

Sharon M. Freeman Clevenger, Ph.D., 
P.M.H.C.N.S.-B.C. 

Mary Ann Cohen, M.D. 

Mitchell J. Cohen, M.D. 

Diego L. Coira, M.D. 

Melinda A. Lawless Coker, Psy.D. 

Carol Cole, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 

Caron Collins, M.A., L.M.F.T. 

Wanda Collins, M.S.N. 

Linda Cook Cason, M.A. 

Ayanna Cooke-Chen, M.D., Ph.D. 

Heidi B. Cooperstein, D.O. 

Ileana Corbelle, M.S.W. 

Kimberly Corbett, Psy.D. 

Angelina Cordova, M.A.Ed. 

Jennifer Carol Cox, L.P.C. 

Sheree Cox, M.A., R.N., N.C.C., D.C.C., 
L.M.H.C. 

William Frederick Cox, M.D. 

Sally M. Cox, M.S.Ed. 

Debbie Herman Crane, M.S.W. 

Arthur Ray Crawford, III, Ph.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Roula Creighton, M.D. 

John R. Crossfield, L.M.H.C. 

Sue Cutbirth, R.N., M.S.N, C.S., P.M.H.N.P. 

Marco Antonio Cuyar, M.S. 

Rebecca Susan Daily, M.D. 

Lori S. Danenberg, Ph.D. 

Chan Dang-Vu, M.D. 

Mary Hynes Danielak, Psy.D. 

Cynthia A. Darby, M.Ed., Ed.S. 

Douglas Darnall, Ph.D. 

Christopher Davidson, M.D. 

Doreen Davis, Ph.D., L.C.S.W. 

Sandra Davis, Ph.D., L.M.H.C., N.C.C. 

Walter Pitts Davis, M.Th. 

Christian J. Dean, Ph.D. 

Kent Dean, Ph.D. 

Elizabeth Dear, M.A. 

Shelby DeBause, M.A. 

Rebecca B. DeLaney, M.S.S.W., L.C.S.W., B.C.D. 

John R. Delatorre, M.A. 

Frank DeLaurentis, M.D. 

Eric Denner, M.A., M.B.A. 

Mary Dennihan, L.M.F.T. 

Kenny Dennis, M.A. 

Pamela L. Detrick, Ph.D., M.S., F.N.P.-B.C., 
P.M.H.N.P.-B.C., R.N.-B.C., C.A.P., 
G.C.A.C. 

Robert Detrinis, M.D. 

Daniel A. Deutschman, M.D. 

Tania Diaz, Psy.D. 

Sharon Dobbs, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 

David Doreau, M.Ed. 

Gayle L. Dosher, M.A. 

D'Ann Downey, Ph.D., M.S.W. 

Beth Doyle, M.A. 

Amy J. Driskill, M.S., L.C.M.F.T. 

James Drury, M.D. 

Brenda-Lee Duarte, M.Ed. 

Shane E. Dulemba, M.S.N. 

Nancy R. G. Dunbar, M.D. 

Cathy Duncan, M.A. 

Rebecca S. Dunn, M.S.N., A.R.N.P. 

Debbie Earnshaw, M.A. 

Shawna Eddy-Kissell, M.A. 

Momen El Nesr, M.D. 

Jeffrey Bruce Elliott, Psy.D. 

Leslie Ellis, Ph.D. 

Donna M. Emfield, L.C.P.C. 

Gretchen S. Enright, M.D. 

John C. Espy, Ph.D. 

Renuka Evani, M.B.B.S., M.D. 

Heather Evans, M.S.Ed, L.P.C.N.C.C. 

Cesar A. Fabiani, M.D. 

Fahim Fahim, M.D. 

Samuel Fam, M.D. 

Edward H. Fankhanel, Ph.D., Ed.D. 

Tamara Farmer, M.S.N, A.R.N.P. 

Farida Farzana, M.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Philip Fast, M.S. 

Patricia Feltrup-Exum, M.A.M.F.T. 

Hector J. Fernandez-Barillas, Ph.D. 

Julie Ferry, M.S.W., L.LC.S.W. 

Jane Fink, Ph.D., M.S.S.A. 

Kathy Finkle, L.P.C.M.H. 

Steven Finlay, Ph.D. 

Rik Fire, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 

Ann Flood, Ph.D. 

Jeanine Lee Foreman, M.S. 

Thyra Fossum, Ph.D. 

Karen S. Franklin, L.I.C.S.W. 

Sherre K. Franklin, M.A. 

Helen R. Frey, M.A., E.D. 

Michael L. Freytag, B.S., M.A. 

Beth Gagnon, M.S.W. 

Patrice L.R. Gallagher, Ph.D. 

Angela J. Gallien, M.A. 

Robert Gallo, M.S.W. 

Mario Galvarino, M.D. 

Vladimir I. Gasca, M.D. 

Joshua Gates, Ph.D. 

Anthony Gaudioso, Ph.D. 

Michelle S. Gauthier, A.P.R.N., M.S.N, 
P.M.H.N.P.-B.C. 

Rachel E. Gearhart, L.C.S.W. 

Stephen D. Gelfond, M.D. 

Nancy S. Gerow, M.S. 

Michael J. Gerson, Ph.D. 

Susan M. A. Geyer, L.M.S.W. 

Lorrie Gfeller-Strouts, Ph.D. 

Shubu Ghosh, M.D. 

Richard Dorsey Gillespie, M.Div. 

Stuart A. Gitlin, M.S.S.A. 

Jeannette E. Given, Ph.D. 

Frances Gizzi, L.C.S.W. 

Stephen I. Glicksman, Ph.D. 

Martha Glisky, Ph.D. 

Sonia Godbole, M.D. 

Howard M. Goldfischer, Psy.D. 

Mary Jane Gonzalez-Huss, Ph.D. 

Michael I. Good, M.D. 

Dawn Goodman-Martin, M.A.-L.M.H.C. 

Robert Gorkin, Ph.D., M.D. 

Jeff Gorski, M.S.W. 

Linda O. Graf, M.Ed., L.C.P.C. 

Ona Graham, Psy.D. 

Aubrie M. Graves, L.M.S.W., C.A.S.A.C. 

Howard S. Green, M.D. 

Karen Torry Green, M.S.W. 

Gary Greenberg, Ph.D. 

Marjorie Greenhut, M.A. 

James L. Greenstone, Ed.D., J.D. 

Raymond A. Griffin, Ph.D. 

Joseph Grillo, Ph.D. 

Janeane M. Grisez, A.A., B.A. 

Lawrence S. Gross, M.D. 

Robert J. Gross, M.D. 


913 


Sally J. Grosscup, Ph.D. 

Philip A. Grossi, M.D. 

Gabrielle Guedet, Ph.D. 

Nicholas Guenzel, B.A., B.S., M.S.N. 

Mary G. Hales, M.A. 

Tara C. Haley, M.S., L.M.F.T. 

John D. Hall, M.D. 

Amy Hammer, M.S.W. 

Michael S. Hanau, M.D. 

Linda K.W. Hansen, M.A., L.P. 

Genevieve R. Hansler, M.S.W. 

Mary T. Harrington, L.C.S.W. 

Lois Hartman, Ph.D. 

Steven Lee Hartsock, Ph.D., M.S.W. 

Victoria Ann Harwood, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 

Rossi A. Hassad, Ph.D., M.P.H. 

Erin V. Hatcher, M.S.N. 

Richard L. Hauger, M.D. 

Kimberly M. Haverly, M.A. 

Gale Eisner Heater, M.S., M.F.T. 

Katlin Hecox, M.A. 

Brenda Heideman, M.S.W. 

Melinda Heinen, M.Sc. 

Marie-Therese Heitkamp, MLS. 

Melissa B. Held, M.A. 

Jessica Hellings, M.D. 

Bonnie Helmick-O'Brien, M.A., L.M.F.T. 

MaLinda T. Henderson, M.S.N, F.P.M.H.N.P. 

Gwenn Herman, M.S.W. 

Martha W. Hernandez, M.S.N, A.P.R.N., 
P.M.H.C.N.S. 

Robin L. Hewitt, M.S. 

Kenneth Hoffman, Ph.D. 

Patricia E. Hogan, D.O. 

Peggy Holcomb, Ph.D. 

Garland H. Holloman, Jr., M.D. 

Kimberly Huegel, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 

Jason Hughes, L.P.C.-S., N.C.C. 

Jennifer C. Hughes, Ph.D., M.S.W., L.1.S.W.-S. 

Michelle K. Humke, M.A. 

Judith G. Hunt, L.M.F.T. 

Tasneem Hussainee, M.D. 

Sharlene J. Hutchinson, M.S.N. 

Muhammad Ikram, M.D. 

Sunday Ilechukwu, M.D., D.Psy. Cli. 

Douglas H. Ingram, M.D. 

Marilynn Irvine, Ph.D. 

Marjorie Isaacs, Psy.D. 

Raymond Isackila, Ed.S., P.C.C.-S., L.I-C.D.C. 

Mohammed A. Issa, M.D. 

John L. Jankord, M.A. 

Barbara P. Jannah, L.C.S.W. 

C. Stuart Johnson, M.S. 

Dawn M. Johnson, M.A. 

Deanna V. Johnson, M.S., A.P.R.N., B.C. 

Eric C. Johnson, M.F.T. 

Joy Johnson, Ph.D., L.C.S.W. 

Willard Johnson, Ph.D. 


914 


Xenia Johnson-Bhembe, M.D. 
Vann S. Joines, Ph.D. 

Margaret Jones, Psy.D. 

Patricia Jorgenson, M.S.W. 
Steven M. Joseph, M.D. 
Taylere Joseph, M.A. 

Jeanette M. Joyner-Craddock, M.S.S.W. 
Melissa Kachapis, M.A. 
Charles T. Kaelber, M.D. 
Aimee C. Kaempf, M.D. 

Peter Andrew Kahn, M.D. 
Robert P. Kahn-Rose, M.D. 
Maher Karam-Hage, M.D. 
Todd H. Kasdan, M.D. 

Karen Kaufman, M.S., L.M.F.T. 
Rhesa Kaulia, M.A., M.F.T. 
Debbie Lynn Kelly, M.S.N, P.M.H.N.P.-B.C. 
W. Stephen Kelly, Ph.D. 

Selena Kennedy, M.A. 

Judith A. Kenney, M.S., L.P.C. 
Mark Patrick Kerekes, M.D. 


Alyse Kerr, M.S., N.C.C., N.A.D.D.-C.C., L.P.C. 


Karen L. Kerschmann, L.C.S.W. 
Marcia Kesner, M.S. 

Ashan Khan, Ph.D. 

Shaukat Khan, M.D. 

Audrey Khatchikian, Ph.D. 

Laurie B. Kimmel, M.S.W. 

Jason H. King, Ph.D. 

Nancy Leigh King, M.S.W., L.C.S.W., L.C.A.S. 
Kyle Kinne, M.S.C 

Cassandra M. Klyman, M.D. 
David R. Knapp, L.C.S.W. 
Margaret Knerr, M.S. 

Michael R. Knox, Ph.D. 

Carolyn Koblin, M.S. 

Valerie Kolbert, M.S., A.R.N.P.-B.C. 
Heather Koontz, M.S.W. 

Faye Koop, Ph.D., L.C.M.F.T. 

Fern M. Kopakin, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Joel Kotin, M.D. 

Sharlene K. Kraemer, M.S.E. 
Marjorie Vego Krausz, M.A., Ed.D. 
Nancy J. Krell, M.S.W. 

Mindy E. Kronenberg, Ph.D. 
Dwayne Kruse, M.S., M.F.T. 

Ajay S. Kuchibhatla, M.D. 

Shubha N. Kumar, M.D. 

Helen H. Kyomen, M.D., M.S. 
Rebecca M. Lachut, M.Ed., Ed.S. 
Alexis Lake, M.S.S. 

Ramaswamy Lakshmanan, M.D. 
Brigitta Lalone, L.C.S.W.-R 

John W. Lancaster, Ph.D. 

Patience R. Land, L.I.C.S.W., M.S.W., M.P.A. 
Amber Lange, M.A., Ph.D. 

Jeff K. Larsen, M.A. 

Nathan E. Lavid, M.D. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Michelle Leader, Ph.D. 

Stephen E. Lee, M.D. 

Cathryn L. Leff, Ph.D., L.M.F.T. 
Rachael Kollar Leombruno, L.M.F.T. 
Arlene I. Lev, M.S.W., L.C.S.W.-R 
Gregory K. Lewis, M.A.-L.M.F.T. 

Jane Hart Lewis, M.S. 

Melissa S. Lewis, M.S.W., L.L.C.S.W. 
Norman Gerald Lewis, F.R.A.N.Z.C.P. 
Robin Joy Lewis, Ph.D. 

Ryan Michael Ley, M.D. 

Tammy R. Lias, M.A. 

Russell F. Lim, M.D. 

Jana Lincoln, M.D. 

Ted Lindberg, L.M.S.W., L.M.F.T., M.S.W. 
Peggy Solow Liss, M.S.W. 

Andrea Loeb, Psy.D. 

William David Lohr, M.D. 

Mary L. Ludy, M.A., L.M.H.C., L.M.F.T. 
Nathan Lundin, M.A., L.P.C. 

Veena Luthra, M.D. 

Patti Lyerly, L.C.S.W. 

Denise E. Maas, M.A. 

Silvia MacAllister, L.M.F.T. 

Nicola MacCallum, M.S., M.F.C. Therapy 
Colin N. MacKenzie, M.D. 

Cynthia Mack-Ernsdorff, Ph.D. 

John R. Madsen-Bibeau, M.S., M.Div 
Christopher J. Maglio, Ph.D. 

Deepak Mahajan, M.D. 

Debra Majewski, M.A. 

Harish Kumar Malhotra, M.D. 

Pamela Marcus, R.N., M.S. 

Mary P. Marshall, Ph.D. 

Flora Lynne Martin, M.A., L.P.C., A.D.C. 
Robert S. Martin, M.D. 

Jennifer L. Martinez, M.S. 

Ninfa Martinez-Aguilar, M.A., M.F.T. 
Emily Martinsen, M.S.W. 

Farhan A. Matin, M.D. 

Janus Maybee, P.M.H.N.P. 

Karen Mazarin-Stanek, M.A. 

Eben L. McClenahan, M.D., M.S. 
Jerlyn C. McCleod, M.D. 

Susan E. McCue, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Kent D. McDonald, M.S. 

Daniel McDonnell, M.S.N, P.M.H.-N.P. 
Robert McElhose, Ph.D. 

Lisa D. McGrath, Ph.D. 

Mark McGrosky, M.S.W. 

Katherine M. McKay, Ph.D. 

Darren D. McKinnis, M.S.W. 

Mona McNelis-Broadley, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Rick McQuistion, Ph.D. 

Susan Joy Mendelsohn, Psy.D. 

Barbara S. Menninga, M.Ed. 

Hindi Mermelstein, M.D., F.A.P.M. 
Rachel B. Michaelsen, M.S.W. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Thomas F. Micka, M.D. 
Tonya Miles, Psy.D. 

Matthew Miller, M.S. 

Michael E. Miller, M.D. 

Noel Miller, L.M.S.W., M.B.A., M.P.S. 
Kalpana Miriyala, M.D. 
Sandra Moenssens, M.S. 

Erin Mokhtar, M.A. 

Robert E. Montgomery, M.Ed. 
Susan Moon, M.A. 

Theresa K. Moon, M.D. 


David B. Moore, B.A., M.Div., M.S.S.W., Ph.D. 


Joanne M. Moore, M.S. 

Peter I. M. Moran, M.B.B.Ch. 
Anna Moriarty, M.P.S., L.P.C., L.M.H.C. 
Richard Dean Morris, M.A. 
Michael M. Morrison, M.A. 
Carlton E. Munson, Ph.D. 
Timothy A. Murphy, M.D. 

Beth L. Murphy, Psy.D. 

Melissa A. Myers, M.D. 

Stefan Nawab, M.D. 

Allyson Matney Neal, D.N.P. 
Steven Nicholas, M.A. 

Aurelian N. Niculescu, M.D. 

Earl S. Nielsen, Ph.D. 

Terry Oleson, Ph.D. 

Julianne R. Oliver, B.S., M.S., Ph.D. 
Robert O. Olsen, M.D. 

Amy O'Neill, M.D. 

Oscar H. Oo, Psy.D., A.B.P.P. 
Laurie Orlando, J.D., M.A. 

Jill Osborne, MLS., Ed.S. 

Kimberly Overlie, MLS. 

L. Kola Oyewumi, Ph.D. 

Zachary J. Pacha, M.S.W. 

Suzette R. Papadakis, M.S. 
Amanda C. Parsons, M.A., L.P.C.C. 
Lee R. Pate, B.A., M.A. 

Eric L. Patterson, L.P.C. 

Sherri Paulson, M.Ed., L.S.C.W. 
Peter Dennis Pautz, B.A., M.S.W. 
Malinda J. Perkins, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Eleanor F. Perlman, M.S.W. 
Deborah K. Perry, M.S.W. 
Amanda Peterman, L.M.F.T. 
Shawn Pflugardt, Psy.D. 

Robert J. Dean Phillips, M.S. 
Laura Pieper, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Lori D. Pink, M.S.W., B.C.D 
Michael G. Pipich, M.S., L.M.F.T. 
Cynthia G. Pizzulli, M.S.W., Ph.D. 
Kathy C. Points, M.A. 

Marya E. Pollack, M.D., M.P.H. 
Sanford E. Pomerantz, M.D. 

Eva Ponder, M.S.W., Psy.D. 
Ernest Poortinga, M.D. 

David Post, M.D. 


915 


Laura L. Post, M.D., Ph.D., J.D. 

Patrick W. Powell, Ed.D. 

Beth M. Prewett, Psy.D. 

Robert Price, D.C.C., M.Ed. 

John Pruett, M.D. 

Aneita S. Radov, M.A. 

Dawn M. Raffa, Ph.D. 

Kavitha Raja, M.D. 

Ranjit Ram, M.D. 

Mohamed Ibrahim Ramadan, M.D., M.S. 

Christopher S. Randolph, M.D. 

Nancy Rappaport, M.Ed. 

John Moir Rauenhorst, M.D. 

Laurel Jean Rebenstock, L.M.S.W. 

Edwin Renaud, Ph.D. 

Heather J. Rhodes, M.A. 

Jennifer S. Ritchie-Goodline, Psy.D. 

Daniel G. Roberts, M.A. 

Brenda Rohren, M.A., M.F.S., L.I.M.H.P., 
L.A.D.C., M.A.C. 

Donna G. Rolin-Kenny, Ph.D., A.P.R.N., 
P.M.H.C.N.S.-B.C. 

Sylvia E. Rosario, M.Ed. 

Mindy S. Rosenbloom, M.D. 

Harvey A. Rosenstock, M.D. 

Thalia Ross, M.S.S.W. 

Fernando Rosso, M.D. 

Barry H. Roth, M.D. 

Thomas S. Rue, M.A., L.M.H.C. 

Elizabeth Ruegg, L.C.S.W. 

Diane Rullo, Ph.D. 

Angie Rumaldo, Ph.D. 

Eric Rutberg, M.A., D.H.Ed. 

Joseph A. Sabella, L.M.H.C. 

Kemal Sagduyu, M.D. 

Adam H. Saltz, M.S.W. 

Jennifer A. Samardak, L.I.S.W.-S. 

George R. Samuels, M.A., M.S.W. 

Carmen Sanjurjo, M.A. 

John S. Saroyan, Ed.D. 

Brigid Kathleen Sboto, M.A., M.F.T. 

Lori Cluff Schade, M.S. 

Joan E. Schaper, M.S.N. 

Rae J. Schilling, Ph.D. 

Larry Schor, Ph.D. 

Donna J. Schwartz, M.S.W., L.L.C.S.W. 

Amy J. Schwarzenbart, P.M.H.-C.N.S., B.C., 
A.P.N.P. 

John V. Scialli, M.D. 

Chad Scott, Ph.D., L.P.C.C. 

Sabine Sell, M.F.T. 

Minal Shah, N.S., N.C.C., L.P.C. 

Lynn Shell, M.S.N. 

Dharmesh Navin Sheth, M.D. 

S. Christopher Shim, M.D. 

Marta M. Shinn, Ph.D. 

Andreas Sidiropoulos, M.D., Ph.D. 

Michael Siegell, M.D. 


916 


Michael G. Simonds, Psy.D. 
Gagandeep Singh, M.D. 

Melissa Rae Skrzypchak, M.S.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Paula Slater, M.D. 

William Bill Slaughter, M.D., M.A. 
Aki Smith, Ph.D. 

Deborah L. Smith, Ed.M. 

Diane E. Smith, M.A., L.M.F.T. 
James S. Sommer, MLS. 

J. Richard Spatafora, M.D. 

Judy Splittgerber, M.S.N., C.S., N.P. 
Thiruneermalai T.G. Sriram, M.D. 
Martha W. St. John, M.D. 

Sybil Stafford, Ph.D. 

Timothy Stambaugh, M.A. 

Laura A. Stamboni, M.S.W. 

Carol L. R. Stark, M.D. 

Stephanie Steinman, M.S. 

Claudia M. Stevens, M.S.W. 
Jennifer Boyer Stevens, Psy.D. 
Dominique Stevens-Young, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 
Kenneth Stewart, Ph.D. 

Daniel Storch, M.D. 

Suzanne Straebler, A.P.R.N. 
Dawn Stremel, M.A., L.M.F.T. 
Emel Stroup, Psy.D. 

John W. Stump, M.S., L.M.F.T. 
Thomas G. Suk, M.A. 

Elizabeth Sunzeri, M.S. 

Linnea Swanson, M.A., Psy.D. 
Patricia Swanson, M.A. 

Fereidoon Taghizadeh, M.D. 


Bonnie L. Tardif, L.M.H.C., N.C.C., B.C.P.C.C. 


Joan Tavares, M.S.W. 

Ann Taylor, M.S.W. 

Dawn O'Dwyer Taylor, Ph.D. 

Chanel V. Tazza, L.M.H.C. 

Martha H. Teater, M.A. 

Clark D. Terrell, M.D. 

Mark R. Thelen, Psy.D. 

Norman E. Thibault, M.S., Ph.D. 

Tojuana L. Thomason, Ph.D. 

Paula Thomson, Psy.D. 

D. Chadwick Thompson, M.A. 

Susan Thorne-Devin, A.M. 

Jean Eva Thumm, M.A.P.C., M.A.T., L.M.F.T., 
B.C.C. 

James E. Tille, Ph.D., D.Min. 

Jacalyn G. Tippey, Ph.D. 

Saraswathi Tirumalasetty, M.D. 

Jacqueline A. Torrance, M.S. 

Terrence Trobaugh, M.S. 

Louisa V. Troemel, Psy.D., L.M.F.T. 


DSM-5 Advisors and Other Contributors 


Susan Ullman, M.S.W. 

Jennifer M. Underwood, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 

Rodney Dale Veldhuizen, M.A. 

Michelle Voegels, B.S.N., M.S.N., B.C. 

Wess Vogt, M.D. 

R. Christopher Votolato, Psy.D. 

John W. Waid, Ph.D. 

Christa A. Wallis, M.A. 

Dominique Walmsley, M.A. 

Bhupinder Singh Waraich, M.D. 

Joseph Ward, N.C.C., L.P.C. M.Ed. 

Robert Ward, M.S.W. 

Marilee L. M. Wasell, Ph.D. 

Gannon J. Watts, L.P.C.-S., L.A.C., N.C.C., 
N.C.S.C., A.A.D.C., L.C.A.A.D.C. 

Sheila R. Webster, M.A., M.S.S.A. 

Burton Weiss, M.D. 

Dennis V. Weiss, M.D. 

Jonathan S. Weiss, M.D. 

Richard Wendel, Ph.D. 

Paul L. West, Ed.D. 

Kris Sandra Wheatley, M.A., L.P.C., N.C.C. 

Leneigh White, M.A. 

Danny R. Whitehead, L.I.C.S.W. 

Jean Whitinger, M.A. 

Peter D. Wilk, M.D. 

Vanessa Wilkinson, L.P.C. 

Tim F. Willia, M.S., M.A.Ed., L.P.C. 

Cathy E. Willis, M.A., L.M.F.T., C.A.D.C. 

Jeffery John Wilson, M.D. 

Jacquie Wilson, M.Ed. 

David D. Wines, M.S.W. 

Barbara A. Wirebaugh, M.S.W. 

Daniel L. Wise, Ph.D. 

Christina Wong, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 

Susanna Wood, M.S.W., L.C.S.W. 

Linda L. Woodall, M.D. 

Leoneen Woodard-Faust, M.D. 

Sheryl E. Woodhouse, L.M.F.T. 

Gregory J. Worthington, Psy.D. 

Tanya Wozniak, M.D. 

Kimberly Isaac Wright, M.A. 

Peter Yamamoto, M.D. 

Maria Ruiza Ang Yee, M.D. 

Michael B. Zafrani, M.D. 

Jafet E. Gonzalez Zakarchenco, M.D. 

John Zibert, Ph.D. 

Karen Zilberstein, M.S.W. 

Cathi Zillmann, C.P.N.P., N.P.P. 

Gerald A. Zimmerman, Ph.D. 


Michele Zimmerman, M.A., P.M.H.C.N.S.-B.C. 


Judith A. Zink, M.A. 


Vanderbilt University REDCap Team 


Paul Harris, Ph.D. 
Sudah Kashyap, B.E. 
Brenda Minor 


Jon Scherdin, M.A. 
Rob Taylor, M.A. 
Janey Wang, MLS. 


index 


Page numbers printed in boldface type refer to tables. 


Abuse and neglect, 22, 717-722 
adult maltreatment and neglect problems, 
720-722 
child maltreatment and neglect problems, 
717-719 
Access to medical and other health care, problems 
related to, 726 
Acute dissociative reactions to stressful events, 
306-307 
Acute stress disorder, 265, 280-286 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
283-284 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 285 
development and course of, 284 
diagnostic criteria for, 280-281 
diagnostic features of, 281-283 
differential diagnosis of, 285-286 
functional consequences of, 285 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 285 
prevalence of, 284 
risk and prognostic factors for, 284-285 
Addiction. See Substance-related and addictive 
disorders 
ADHD. See Attention-deficit/hyperactivity 
disorder 
Adjustment disorders, 265, 286-289 
comorbidity with, 289 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 288 
development and course of, 287 
diagnostic criteria for, 286-287 
diagnostic features of, 287 
differential diagnosis of, 288-289 
functional consequences of, 288 
prevalence of, 287 
risk and prognostic factors for, 288 
Adjustment-like disorders, 289 
Adult maltreatment and neglect problems, 720- 
722 
adult abuse by nonspouse or nonpartner, 722 
spouse or partner abuse, psychological, 721— 
722 
spouse or partner neglect, 721 
spouse or partner violence, physical, 720 
spouse or partner violence, sexual, 720 


Agoraphobia, 190, 217-221 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
219 

comorbidity with, 221 

development and course of, 219-220 

diagnostic criteria for, 217-218 

diagnostic features of, 218-219 

differential diagnosis of, 220-221 

functional consequences of, 220 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 220 

prevalence of, 219 

risk and prognostic factors for, 220 


Akathisia, medication-induced, 22 


acute, 711 
tardive, 712 


Alcohol intoxication, 497-499 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
497-498 

comorbidity with, 499 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 498 

development and course of, 498 

diagnostic criteria for, 497 

diagnostic features of, 497 

diagnostic markers for, 499 

differential diagnosis of, 499 

functional consequences of, 499 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 498 

prevalence of, 498 

risk and prognostic factors for, 498 


Alcohol-related disorders, 481, 490-503 


alcohol intoxication, 497-499 

alcohol use disorder, 490-497 

alcohol withdrawal, 484, 499-501 

diagnoses associated with, 482 

other alcohol-induced disorders, 502-503 
development and course of, 502-503 
features of, 502 

unspecified alcohol-related disorder, 503 


Alcohol use disorder, 490-497 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
492-493 

comorbidity with, 496-497 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 494-495 

development and course of, 493-494 


918 


Alcohol use disorder (continued) 
diagnostic criteria for, 490-491 
diagnostic features of, 492 
diagnostic markers for, 495-496 
differential diagnosis of, 496 
functional consequences of, 496 
prevalence of, 493 
risk and prognostic factors for, 494 
specifiers for, 492 

Alcohol withdrawal, 499-501 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 500 


comorbidity with, 501 
development and course of, 501 
diagnostic criteria for, 499-500 
diagnostic features of, 500 
diagnostic markers for, 501 
differential diagnosis of, 501 
functional consequences of, 501 
prevalence of, 501 
risk and prognostic factors for, 501 
specifiers for, 500 
Alzheimer’s disease, major or mild 
neurocognitive disorder due to, 591, 603, 
611-614 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 612 


comorbidity with, 614 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 613 

development and course of, 612-613 

diagnostic criteria for, 611-612 

diagnostic features of, 612 

diagnostic markers for, 613 

differential diagnosis of, 614 

functional consequences of, 614 

prevalence of, 612 

risk and prognostic factors for, 613 
American Psychiatric Association (APA), 5-7 
Anorexia nervosa, 329, 338-345 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 341 


atypical, 353 
comorbidity with, 344-345 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 342 
development and course of, 341-342 
diagnostic criteria for, 338-339 
diagnostic features of, 339-340 
diagnostic markers for, 342-343 
differential diagnosis of, 344 
functional consequences of, 343 
prevalence of, 341 
risk and prognostic factors for, 342 
subtypes of, 339 
suicide risk in, 343 

Antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, 22, 

712-714 

comorbidity with, 714 
course and development of, 713 


Index 


diagnostic features of, 713 
differential diagnosis of, 713-714 
prevalence of, 713 


Antisocial personality disorder, 461, 476, 645, 646, 


659-663 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
660-661 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 662 

development and course of, 661 

diagnostic criteria for, 659 

diagnostic features of, 659-660 

differential diagnosis of, 662-663 

features and criteria in alternative DSM-5 
model for personality disorders, 763, 
764-765 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 662 

prevalence of, 661 

risk and prognostic factors for, 661-662 


Anxiety disorder due to another medical 


condition, 190, 230-232 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
231 
development and course of, 231 
diagnostic criteria for, 230 
diagnostic features of, 230-231 
diagnostic markers for, 231 
differential diagnosis of, 231-232 
prevalence of, 231 


Anxiety disorders, 189-264 


agoraphobia, 190, 217-221 

anxiety disorder due to another medical 
condition, 190, 230-232 

generalized anxiety disorder, 190, 222-226 

highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
811 

other specified anxiety disorder, 233 

panic attack specifier, 214-217 

panic disorder, 190, 208-214 

selective mutism, 189, 195-197 

separation anxiety disorder, 189, 190-195 

social anxiety disorder (social phobia), 190, 
202-208 

specific phobia, 189-190, 197-202 

substance/medication-induced anxiety 
disorder, 190, 226-230 

unspecified anxiety disorder, 233 


APA (American Psychiatric Association), 5-7 
Assessment measures, 23-24, 733-748 


cross-cutting symptom measures, 733-741 
DSM-5 Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom 
Measure, 734-736, 738-741 
DSM-5 Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom 
Measures, 734, 735, 736, 737 
frequency of use of, 737 
severity measures, 733, 742 


Index 


Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis 
Symptom Severity, 742-744 
frequency of use of, 742 
scoring and interpretation of, 742 
WHO Disability Assessment Schedule 
(WHODAS), 16, 21, 734, 745-748 


Ataque de nervios, 14, 211-212, 233, 833 
Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder 


(ADHD), 11, 32, 59-66 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 61 

comorbidity with, 65 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 62 

development and course of, 61 

diagnostic criteria for, 59-61 

diagnostic features of, 61 

differential diagnosis of, 63-65 

functional consequences of, 63 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 63 

medication-induced symptoms of, 65 

other specified attention-deficit/hyperactivity 
disorder, 65-66 

prevalence of, 61 

risk and prognostic factors for, 62 

unspecified attention-deficit /hyperactivity 
disorder, 66 


Attenuated psychosis syndrome, 122, 783-786 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 784 
comorbidity with, 786 

development and course of, 785 

diagnostic features of, 783-784 

differential diagnosis of, 785-786 

functional consequences of, 785 

prevalence of, 784-785 

proposed criteria for, 783 

risk and prognostic factors for, 785 


Autism spectrum disorder, 31-32, 50-59 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 55 
comorbidity with, 58-59 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 57 
development and course of, 55-56 
diagnostic criteria for, 50-51 
diagnostic features of, 53-55 
differential diagnosis of, 57-58 
functional consequences of, 57 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 57 
prevalence of, 55 

recording procedures for, 51 

risk and prognostic factors for, 56-57 
specifiers for, 51-53, 52 


Avoidant personality disorder, 645, 646, 672-675 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
673-674 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 674 

development and course of, 674 

diagnostic criteria for, 672-673 


919 


diagnostic features of, 673 

differential diagnosis of, 674-675 

features and criteria in alternative DSM-5 
model for personality disorders, 763, 
765-766 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 674 

prevalence of, 674 


Avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder, 329, 


334-338 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 335 
comorbidity with, 338 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 336 
development and course of, 335-336 
diagnostic criteria for, 334 
diagnostic features of, 334-335 
diagnostic markers for, 336 
differential diagnosis of, 336-338 
functional consequences of, 336 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 336 
risk and prognostic factors for, 336 


Bereavement, 125-126, 134, 155, 161, 194 


persistent complex, 289, 789-792 


Binge-eating disorder, 329, 350-353 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 351 
comorbidity with, 353 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 352 
development and course of, 352 

diagnostic criteria for, 350 

diagnostic features of, 350-351 

differential diagnosis of, 352-353 

functional consequences of, 352 

of low frequency and/or limited duration, 353 
prevalence of, 351 

risk and prognostic factors for, 352 


Bipolar I disorder, 123-132 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 129 
comorbidity with, 132 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 130 
development and course of, 130 
diagnostic criteria for, 123-127 
diagnostic features of, 127-129 
differential diagnosis of, 131-132 
functional consequences of, 131 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 130 
prevalence of, 130 

risk and prognostic factors for, 130 
suicide risk and, 131 


Bipolar II disorder, 123, 132-139 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 136 
comorbidity with, 139 

development and course of, 136-137 
diagnostic criteria for, 132-135 

diagnostic features of, 135-136 

differential diagnosis of, 138-139 


920 


Bipolar II disorder (continued) 
functional consequences of, 138 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 137 
prevalence of, 136 
risk and prognostic factors for, 137 
suicide risk in, 138 
Bipolar and related disorder due to another 
medical condition, 123, 145-147 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 146 
comorbidity with, 147 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 147 
development and course of, 146-147 
diagnostic criteria for, 145-146 
diagnostic features of, 146 
diagnostic markers for, 147 
differential diagnosis of, 147 
functional consequences of, 147 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 147 
Bipolar and related disorders, 123-154 
bipolar I disorder, 123-132 
bipolar II disorder, 123, 132-139 
bipolar and related disorder due to another 
medical condition, 123, 145-147 
cyclothymic disorder, 123, 139-141 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
810 
other specified bipolar and related disorder, 
123, 148 
specifiers for, 149-154 
substance/medication-induced bipolar and 
related disorder, 123, 142-145 
unspecified bipolar and related disorder, 149 
Body dysmorphic disorder, 235, 236, 242-247 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 244 
comorbidity with, 247 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 245 
development and course of, 244 
diagnostic criteria for, 242-243 
diagnostic features of, 243-244 
differential diagnosis of, 245-247 
functional consequences of, 245 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 245 
prevalence of, 244 
risk and prognostic factors for, 245 
suicide risk and, 245 
Body dysmorphic-like disorder with actual flaws, 
263 
Body dysmorphic-like disorder without repetitive 
behaviors, 263 
Body-focused repetitive behavior disorder, 235, 
263-264 
Borderline personality disorder, 645, 646, 663-666 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 665 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 665-666 
development and course of, 665 


Index 


diagnostic criteria for, 663 

diagnostic features of, 663-664 

differential diagnosis of, 666 

features and criteria in alternative DSM-5 
model for personality disorders, 763, 
766-767 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 666 

prevalence of, 665 

risk and prognostic factors for, 665 


Breathing-related sleep disorders, 361, 378-390 


central sleep apnea, 383-386 
obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, 378-383 
sleep-related hypoventilation, 387-390 


Brief illness anxiety disorder, 327 
Brief psychotic disorder, 94-96 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 95 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 95 
development and course of, 95 

diagnostic criteria for, 94 

diagnostic features of, 94-95 

differential diagnosis of, 96 

duration of, 89, 94, 99 

functional consequences of, 95 

prevalence of, 95 

risk and prognostic factors for, 95 


Brief somatic symptom disorder, 327 
Bulimia nervosa, 329, 345-350 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 347 
comorbidity with, 349-350 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 348 
development and course of, 347-348 
diagnostic criteria for, 345 

diagnostic features of, 345-347 

diagnostic markers for, 348 

differential diagnosis of, 349 

functional consequences of, 349 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 348 

of low frequency and/or limited duration, 353 
prevalence of, 347 

risk and prognostic factors for, 348 

suicide risk in, 349 


Caffeine intoxication, 503-506 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 504 
comorbidity with, 506 

development and course of, 505 

diagnostic criteria for, 503-504 

diagnostic features of, 504 

differential diagnosis of, 505 

functional consequences of, 505 

prevalence of, 505 

risk and prognostic factors for, 505 


Caffeine-related disorders, 481, 503-509 


caffeine intoxication, 503-506 
caffeine withdrawal, 506-508 


Index 


diagnoses associated with, 482 
other caffeine-induced disorders, 508 
unspecified caffeine-related disorder, 509 
Caffeine use disorder, 792-795 
comorbidity with, 795 
development and course of, 794 
diagnostic features of, 793-794 
differential diagnosis of, 795 
functional consequences of, 794-795 
prevalence of, 794 
proposed criteria for, 792-793 
risk and prognostic factors for, 794 
Caffeine withdrawal, 506-508 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 507 
comorbidity with, 508 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 508 
development and course of, 507 
diagnostic criteria for, 506 
diagnostic features of, 506-507 
differential diagnosis of, 508 
functional consequences of, 508 
prevalence of, 507 
risk and prognostic factors for, 507-508 
Cannabis intoxication, 516-517 
diagnostic criteria for, 516 
diagnostic features of, 516-517 
differential diagnosis of, 517 
functional consequences of, 517 
prevalence of, 517 
specifiers for, 516 
Cannabis-related disorders, 481, 509-519 
cannabis intoxication, 516-517 
cannabis use disorder, 509-516 
cannabis withdrawal, 484, 517-519 
diagnoses associated with, 482 
other cannabis-induced disorders, 519 
unspecified cannabis-related disorder, 519 
Cannabis use disorder, 509-516 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 512 
comorbidity with, 515-516 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 514 
development and course of, 513 
diagnostic criteria for, 509-510 
diagnostic features of, 510-512 
diagnostic markers for, 514 
functional consequences of, 514-515 
prevalence of, 512 
risk and prognostic factors for, 513-514 
specifiers for, 510 
Cannabis withdrawal, 517-519 
development and course of, 518 
diagnostic criteria for, 517-518 
diagnostic features of, 518 
differential diagnosis of, 519 
risk and prognostic factors for, 519 


921 


Case formulation, 19-20 
cultural, 749-759 (See also Cultural 
formulation) 
Catatonia, 89, 119-121 
associated with another mental disorder 
(catatonia specifier), 119-120 
diagnostic criteria for, 119-120 
diagnostic features of, 120 
unspecified, 89, 121 
Catatonic disorder due to another medical 
condition, 120-121 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 121 
diagnostic criteria for, 120-121 
diagnostic features of, 121 
differential diagnosis of, 121 
Central sleep apnea, 383-386 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 385 
comorbidity with, 386 
development and course of, 385 
diagnostic criteria for, 383-384 
diagnostic features of, 384-385 
diagnostic markers for, 385 
differential diagnosis of, 386 
functional consequences of, 386 
prevalence of, 385 
risk and prognostic factors for, 385 
specifiers for, 384 
subtypes of, 384 
CFI. See Cultural Formulation Interview 
Cheyne-Stokes breathing, 383-386. See also Central 
sleep apnea 
Childhood-onset fluency disorder (stuttering), 31, 
45-47 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 46 
development and course of, 46-47 
diagnostic criteria for, 45-46 
diagnostic features of, 46 
differential diagnosis of, 47 
functional consequences of, 47 
risk and prognostic factors for, 47 
Child maltreatment and neglect problems, 717-719 
child neglect, 718-719 
child physical abuse, 717-718 
child psychological abuse, 719 
child sexual abuse, 718 
Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, 361, 
390-398 
advanced sleep phase type, 393-394 
associated features supporting diagnosis 
of, 393 
comorbidity with, 394 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 394 
development and course of, 393 
diagnostic features of, 393 
diagnostic markers for, 394 


922 Index 


Circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders Coding and reporting procedures, 12, 16, 22, 23, 
(continued) 29 
advanced sleep phase type (continued) Cognitive disorders. See Neurocognitive disorders 
differential diagnosis of, 394 Communication disorders, 31, 41-49 
functional consequences of, 394 childhood-onset fluency disorder (stuttering), 


prevalence of, 393 
risk and prognostic factors for, 394 
specifiers for, 393 
delayed sleep phase type, 391-392 
associated features supporting diagnosis 
of, 391 
comorbidity with, 392 
development and course of, 391 
diagnostic features of, 391 
diagnostic markers for, 392 
differential diagnosis of, 392 
functional consequences of, 392 
prevalence of, 391 
risk and prognostic factors for, 392 
diagnostic criteria for, 390-391 
irregular sleep-wake type, 394-396 
associated features supporting diagnosis 
of, 395 
comorbidity with, 396 
development and course of, 395 
diagnostic features of, 394-395 
diagnostic markers for, 395 
differential diagnosis of, 395 
functional consequences of, 395 
prevalence of, 395 
risk and prognostic factors for, 395 
non-24-hour sleep-wake type, 396-397 
associated features supporting diagnosis 
of, 396 
comorbidity with, 397 
development and course of, 396 
diagnostic features of, 396 
diagnostic markers for, 397 
differential diagnosis of, 397 
functional consequences of, 397 
prevalence of, 396 
risk and prognostic factors for, 396-397 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 398 
shift work type, 397-398 
comorbidity with, 398 
development and course of, 398 
diagnostic features of, 397 
diagnostic markers for, 398 
differential diagnosis of, 398 
functional consequences of, 398 
prevalence of, 397 
risk and prognostic factors for, 398 


Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis 


Symptom Severity, 742-744 


45-47 

language disorder, 42-44 

social (pragmatic) communication disorder, 
47-49 

speech sound disorder, 44—45 

unspecified communication disorder, 49 


Comorbidity, 5 
Compulsions, 235-236, 239. See also Obsessive- 


compulsive and related disorders 


Conditions for further study, 7, 11, 24, 783-806 


attenuated psychosis syndrome, 783-786 

caffeine use disorder, 792-795 

depressive episodes with short-duration 
hypomania, 786-789 

Internet gaming disorder, 795-798 

neurobehavioral disorder associated with 
prenatal alcohol exposure, 798-801 

nonsuicidal self-injury, 803-805 

persistent complex bereavement disorder, 
789-792 

suicidal behavior disorder, 801-803 


Conduct disorder, 32, 461, 469-475 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
472-473 

comorbidity with, 475 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 474 

development and course of, 473 

diagnostic criteria for, 469-471 

diagnostic features of, 472 

differential diagnosis of, 474-475 

functional consequences of, 474 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 474 

prevalence of, 473 

risk and prognostic factors for, 473-474 

specifiers for, 471-472 

subtypes of, 471 


Conversion disorder (functional neurological 


symptom disorder), 309, 310, 318-321 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
319-320 

comorbidity with, 321 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 320 
development and course of, 320 
diagnostic criteria for, 318-319 
diagnostic features of, 319 
differential diagnosis of, 321 
functional consequences of, 321 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 320 
prevalence of, 320 
risk and prognostic factors for, 320 


Index 


Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease. See Prion disease, 
major or mild neurocognitive disorder due to 
Crime or interaction with the legal system, 
problems related to, 725 
Criterion for clinical significance, 21 
Cross-cutting symptom measures, 733-741 
DSM-5 Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom 
Measure, 734-736, 738-741 
DSM-5 Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom 
Measures, 734, 735, 736, 737 
frequency of use of, 737 
Cultural concepts of distress, 750, 758, 759, 833-837 
Cultural explanations or perceived causes, 14, 758 
Cultural formulation, 749-759 
definitions related to, 749 
diagnostic importance of, 758-759 
outline for, 749-750 
relationship to DSM-5 nosology, 758 
Cultural Formulation Interview (CFI), 17, 24, 749, 
750-757 
domains of assessment, 751 
indications for, 751 
Informant Version, 755-757 
supplementary modules of, 751 
Cultural idioms of distress, 14, 758 
Cultural issues, 14-15, 749-759 
in anxiety disorders 
generalized anxiety disorder, 224 
panic attacks, 216 
panic disorder, 211-212 
selective mutism, 196 
separation anxiety disorder, 193 
social anxiety disorder (social phobia), 
205-206 
specific phobia, 201 
in bipolar and related disorders 
bipolar I disorder, 130 
bipolar and related disorder due to another 
medical condition, 147 
in depressive disorders 
major depressive disorder, 166 
premenstrual dysphoric disorder, 173 
in disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct 
disorders 
conduct disorder, 474 
intermittent explosive disorder, 468 
oppositional defiant disorder, 465 
in dissociative disorders 
depersonalization/derealization disorder, 
304 
dissociative amnesia, 300 
dissociative identity disorder, 295 
in enuresis, 357 
in feeding and eating disorders 
anorexia nervosa, 342 


923 


avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder, 
336 
binge-eating disorder, 352 
bulimia nervosa, 348 
pica, 331 
in fetishistic disorder, 701 
in gender dysphoria, 457 
in neurocognitive disorders, 609 
due to Alzheimer’s disease, 613 
in neurodevelopmental disorders 
attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, 
62 
autism spectrum disorder, 57 
developmental coordination disorder, 76 
intellectual disability (intellectual 
developmental disorder), 39 
specific learning disorder, 72-73 
stereotypic movement disorder, 79 
tic disorders, 83 
in obsessive-compulsive and related disorders 
body dysmorphic disorder, 245 
hoarding disorder, 250 
obsessive-compulsive disorder, 240 
trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder), 
253 
in personality disorders, 648 
antisocial personality disorder, 662 
avoidant personality disorder, 674 
borderline personality disorder, 665-666 
dependent personality disorder, 677 
histrionic personality disorder, 668 
obsessive-compulsive personality disorder, 
681 
paranoid personality disorder, 651 
schizoid personality disorder, 654 
schizotypal personality disorder, 657 
in schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic 
disorders 
brief psychotic disorder, 95 
delusional disorder, 93 
schizoaffective disorder, 108-109 
schizophrenia, 103 
in sexual dysfunctions, 423 
delayed ejaculation, 425 
erectile disorder, 428 
female orgasmic disorder, 432 
female sexual interest/arousal disorder, 
435-436 
genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder, 
439 
male hypoactive sexual desire disorder, 
442 
premature (early) ejaculation, 445 
substance/medication-induced sexual 
dysfunction, 449 


924 


Cultural issues (continued) 
in sleep-wake disorders 
central sleep apnea hypopnea, 381 
circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, 
advanced sleep phase type, 394 
narcolepsy, 376 
nightmare disorder, 406 
substance/medication-induced sleep 
disorder, 418 
in somatic symptoms and related disorders 
conversion disorder (functional 
neurological symptom disorder), 320 
illness anxiety disorder, 317 
psychological factors affecting other 
medical conditions, 323 
somatic symptom disorder, 313 
in substance-related and addictive disorders 
alcohol intoxication, 498 
alcohol use disorder, 495 
caffeine withdrawal, 508 
cannabis use disorder, 514 
gambling disorder, 588 
inhalant use disorder, 536 
opioid use disorder, 544 
other hallucinogen use disorder, 526 
other (or unknown) substance use 
disorder, 580 


other (or unknown) substance withdrawal, 


580 
phencyclidine use disorder, 522 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use 
disorder, 554 
stimulant use disorder, 565 
tobacco use disorder, 574 
in suicidal behavior disorder, 802 
in trauma- and stressor-related disorders 
acute stress disorder, 285 
adjustment disorders, 288 
posttraumatic stress disorder, 278 
reactive attachment disorder, 267 
Cultural syndromes, 14, 758 
Culture-bound syndromes, 14, 758 
Cyclothymic disorder, 123, 139-141 
comorbidity with, 141 
development and course of, 140-141 
diagnostic criteria for, 139-140 
diagnostic features of, 140 
differential diagnosis of, 141 
prevalence of, 140 
risk and prognostic factors for, 141 


Definition of a mental disorder, 20 
Delayed ejaculation, 423, 424-426 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
424-425 


Index 


comorbidity with, 426 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 425 
development and course of, 425 
diagnostic criteria for, 424 

diagnostic features of, 424 

differential diagnosis of, 425-426 
functional consequences of, 425 
prevalence of, 425 

risk and prognostic factors for, 425 


Delirium, 591, 596-602 


due to another medical condition, 597 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 600 
development and course of, 600-601 
diagnostic criteria for, 596-598 
diagnostic features of, 599-600 
diagnostic markers for, 601 
differential diagnosis of, 601 
functional consequences of, 601 
medication-induced, 597, 599 

due to multiple etiologies, 597 

other specified, 602 

prevalence of, 600 

recording procedures for, 598-599 
risk and prognostic factors for, 601 
specifiers for, 599 

substance intoxication, 596-597, 598 
substance withdrawal, 597, 598-599 
unspecified, 602 


Delusional disorder, 89, 90-93 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 92 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 93 

delusional symptoms in partner of individual 
with, 122 

development and course of, 92-93 

diagnostic criteria for, 90-91 

diagnostic features of, 92 

functional consequences of, 93 

prevalence of, 92 

subtypes of, 91-92 


Delusions, 87, 89, 90-93 


bizarre, 87, 91 

of control, 87 

erotomanic, 87, 90 

grandiose, 87, 90 

jealous, 90, 91 

mixed type, 91 

nihilistic, 87 

nonbizarre, 87 

persecutory, 87, 90-91 

referential, 87 

with significant overlapping mood episodes, 
122 

somatic, 87, 90, 92 

unspecified type, 91 


Dementia, 591. See also Neurocognitive disorders 


Index 


Dependent personality disorder, 645, 646, 675-678 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 677 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 677 
development and course of, 677 

diagnostic criteria for, 675 

diagnostic features of, 675-677 

differential diagnosis of, 677-678 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 677 
prevalence of, 677 


Depersonalization/derealization disorder, 291, 


302-306 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 303 
comorbidity with, 306 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 304 
development and course of, 303-304 
diagnostic criteria for, 302 
diagnostic features of, 302-303 
differential diagnosis of, 305-306 
functional consequences of, 304-305 
prevalence of, 303 
risk and prognostic factors for, 304 


Depressive disorder due to another medical 


condition, 155, 180-183 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 181 
comorbidity with, 183 
development and course of, 181-182 
diagnostic criteria for, 180-181 
diagnostic features of, 181 
diagnostic markers for, 182 
differential diagnosis of, 182-183 
functional consequences of, 182 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 182 
risk and prognostic factors for, 182 
suicide risk in, 182 


Depressive disorders, 155-188 


depressive disorder due to another medical 
condition, 155, 180-183 

disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, 155, 
156-160 

highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
810-811 

major depressive disorder, 155, 160-168 

other specified depressive disorder, 155, 
183-184 

persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia), 
155, 168-171 

premenstrual dysphoric disorder, 155, 171-175 

specifiers for, 184-188 

substance/medication-induced depressive 
disorder, 155, 175-180 

unspecified depressive disorder, 155, 184 


Depressive episode or symptoms in bipolar and 


related disorders 
bipolar I disorder, 125-126, 129 
bipolar II disorder, 133-134, 135-136 


925 


cyclothymic disorder, 139, 140 
other specified bipolar and related disorder, 
148 
Depressive episodes with short-duration 
hypomania, 786-789 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
788 
comorbidity with, 789 
diagnostic features of, 788 
differential diagnosis of, 788-789 
functional consequences of, 788 
prevalence of, 788 
proposed criteria for, 786-787 
risk and prognostic factors for, 788 
suicide risk in, 788 
Developmental coordination disorder, 32, 74-77 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 75 
comorbidity with, 76 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 76 
development and course of, 75-76 
diagnostic criteria for, 74 
diagnostic features of, 74-75 
differential diagnosis of, 76-77 
functional consequences of, 76 
prevalence of, 75 
risk and prognostic factors for, 76 
Dhat syndrome, 833-834 
Diagnosis, 5-6 
assessment and monitoring measures for, 
23-24, 733-748 
categorical, 5, 8, 12, 13, 19, 20 
clinical utility of, 20 
coding and reporting procedures for, 12, 16, 
22, 23, 29 
criterion for clinical significance, 21 
culture and, 14-15, 749-759 
definition of a mental disorder, 20 
diagnostic criteria and descriptors, 21 
dimensional approach to, 5, 8, 9, 12-13, 17 
elements of, 21-24 
in forensic settings, 25 
of medication-induced movement disorders, 
20, 22, 29, 709-714 
of other conditions that may be a focus of 
clinical attention, 20, 22, 29, 715-727 
principal, 22-23 
provisional, 23 
Diagnostic criteria, 21, 29 
case formulation and, 19 
proposed criteria for conditions for further 
study, 11, 783 
revisions of, 6-10 
subtypes and specifiers for, 21-22 
validators for, 5,9, 11, 12, 20 
Diagnostic spectra, 6, 9, 12 


926 


Disinhibited social engagement disorder, 265, 
268-270 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
269 
development and course of, 269-270 
diagnostic criteria for, 268-269 
diagnostic features of, 269 
differential diagnosis of, 270 
functional consequences of, 270 
prevalence of, 269 
risk and prognostic factors for, 270 
Disorganized thinking (speech), 88 
Disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct 
disorders, 461-480 
antisocial personality disorder, 461, 476, 645, 
646, 659-663 
conduct disorder, 461, 469-475 


highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 


815 

intermittent explosive disorder, 461, 466-469 

kleptomania, 461, 478-479 

oppositional defiant disorder, 461, 462-466 

other specified disruptive, impulse-control, 
and conduct disorder, 461, 479 

pyromania, 461, 476-477 

unspecified disruptive, impulse-control, and 
conduct disorder, 480 

Disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, 155, 
156-160 

comorbidity with, 160 

development and course of, 157 

diagnostic criteria for, 156 

diagnostic features of, 156-157 

differential diagnosis of, 158-160 

functional consequences of, 158 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 158 

prevalence of, 157 

risk and prognostic factors for, 157-158 

suicide risk in, 158 

Dissociative amnesia, 291, 298-302 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 299 


comorbidity with, 302 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 300 
development and course of, 299 
diagnostic criteria for, 298 
diagnostic features of, 298-299 
differential diagnosis of, 300-302 
functional consequences of, 300 
prevalence of, 299 
risk and prognostic factors for, 299-300 
suicide risk in, 300 

Dissociative disorders, 291-307 


depersonalization/derealization disorder, 291, 


302-306 
dissociative amnesia, 291, 298-302 


Index 


dissociative identity disorder, 291-298 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
812 
other specified dissociative disorder, 292, 
306-307 
unspecified dissociative disorder, 307 
Dissociative identity disorder, 291-298 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
294 
comorbidity with, 297-298 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 295 
development and course of, 294 
diagnostic criteria for, 292 
diagnostic features of, 292-294 
differential diagnosis of, 296-297 
functional consequences of, 295-296 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 295 
prevalence of, 294 
risk and prognostic factors for, 294-295 
suicide risk in, 295 
Dissociative reactions to stressful events, acute, 
306-307 
Dissociative stupor or coma, 292 
Dissociative trance, 292, 307 
Down syndrome, 38, 40, 44, 53 
DSM, history of, 5, 6 
DSM-5 
cultural issues in, 14-15, 749-759 
developmental and lifespan considerations in, 
13 
forensic use of, 25 
gender differences in, 15 
glossary of technical terms in, 817-831 
harmonization with ICD-11, 11-12 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to, 809-817 
anxiety disorders, 811 
bipolar and related disorders, 810 
depressive disorders, 810-811 
disruptive, impulse-control, and conduct 
disorders, 815 
dissociative disorders, 812 
elimination disorders, 813 
feeding and eating disorders, 813 
gender dysphoria, 814-815 
neurodevelopmental disorders, 809-810 
obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorders, 811-812 
paraphilic disorders, 816 
personality disorders, 816 
schizophrenia spectrum and other 
psychotic disorders, 810 
sexual dysfunctions, 814 
sleep-wake disorders, 814 
somatic symptom and related disorders, 
812-813 


Index 


substance-related and addictive disorders, 
815-816 
trauma- and stressor-related disorders, 812 
multiaxial system and, 16 
online enhancements of, 17 
organizational structure of, 10-11, 13 
other specified and unspecified mental 
disorders in, 15-16, 19-20, 707-708 
revision process for, 5, 6-10 
expert review, 8-10 
field trials, 7-8 
proposals for revisions, 7 
public and professional review, 8 
use of, 19-24 
assessment and monitoring tools, 23-24, 
733-748 
case formulation, 19-20 
coding and reporting procedures, 12, 16, 
22, 23, 29 
definition of a mental disorder, 20-21 
elements of a diagnosis, 21-24 
DSM-5 Level 1 Cross-Cutting Symptom Measure, 
734-736 
adult self-rated version, 734, 735, 738-739 
parent/guardian-rated version, 734, 736, 
740-741 
scoring and interpretation of, 734-736 
DSM-5 Level 2 Cross-Cutting Symptom 
Measures, 734, 735, 736, 737 
Dysthymia. See Persistent depressive disorder 
(dysthymia) 
Dystonia, medication-induced, 22 
acute, 711 
tardive, 712 


Eating disorders. See Feeding and eating disorders 
Economic problems, 724 
Educational problems, 723 
Ejaculation 
delayed, 423, 424-426 
premature (early), 423, 443-446 
Elements of diagnosis, 21-24 
Elimination disorders, 355-360 
encopresis, 355, 357-359 
enuresis, 355-357 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
813 
other specified elimination disorder, 359 
unspecified elimination disorder, 360 
Encopresis, 355, 357-359 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 358 
comorbidity with, 359 
development and course of, 359 
diagnostic criteria for, 357-358 
diagnostic features of, 358 


927 


diagnostic markers for, 359 
differential diagnosis of, 359 
prevalence of, 359 
risk and prognostic factors for, 359 
subtypes of, 358 
Enuresis, 355-357 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 356 
comorbidity with, 356 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 356 
development and course of, 356 
diagnostic criteria for, 355 
diagnostic features of, 355-356 
differential diagnosis of, 356 
functional consequences of, 356 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 356 
prevalence of, 356 
risk and prognostic factors for, 356 
subtypes of, 355 
Erectile disorder, 423, 426-429 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 427 
comorbidity with, 429 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 428 
development and course of, 427-428 
diagnostic criteria for, 426-427 
diagnostic features of, 427 
diagnostic markers for, 428 
differential diagnosis of, 428-429 
functional consequences of, 428 
prevalence of, 427 
risk and prognostic factors for, 428 
Excoriation (skin-picking) disorder, 235, 236, 
254-257 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 255 
comorbidity with, 257 
development and course of, 255 
diagnostic criteria for, 254 
diagnostic features of, 254-255 
diagnostic markers for, 255 
differential diagnosis of, 256 
functional consequences of, 256 
prevalence of, 255 
risk and prognostic factors for, 255 
Exhibitionistic disorder, 685, 689-691 
comorbidity with, 691 
development and course of, 690 
diagnostic criteria for, 689 
diagnostic features of, 689-690 
differential diagnosis of, 691 
functional consequences of, 691 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 691 
prevalence of, 690 
risk and prognostic factors for, 690-691 
specifiers for, 689 
subtypes of, 689 
Externalizing disorders, 13 


928 


Factitious disorder, 309, 310, 324-326 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
325-326 

development and course of, 326 

diagnostic criteria for, 324-325 

diagnostic features of, 325 

differential diagnosis of, 326 


Index 


development and course of, 701 
diagnostic criteria for, 700 

diagnostic features of, 701 

differential diagnosis of, 702 
functional consequences of, 701-702 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 701 
specifiers for, 701 


imposed on another, 310, 325-325, 338 
prevalence of, 326 
recording procedures for, 325 
Family upbringing, problems related to, 715-716 
Feeding and eating disorders, 329-354 


Forensic settings, 25 
Formal thought disorder, 88 
Frontotemporal neurocognitive disorder, major or 
mild, 591, 603, 614-618 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 


anorexia nervosa, 329, 338-345 

avoidant/restrictive food intake disorder, 329, 
334-338 

binge-eating disorder, 329, 350-353 

bulimia nervosa, 329, 345-350 

highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
813 

other specified feeding or eating disorder, 
353-354 

pica, 329-331 

rumination disorder, 329, 332-333 

unspecified feeding or eating disorder, 354 


Female orgasmic disorder, 423, 429-432 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
430-431 

comorbidity with, 432 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 432 

development and course of, 431 

diagnostic criteria for, 429-430 

diagnostic features of, 430 

diagnostic markers for, 432 

differential diagnosis of, 432 

functional consequences of, 432 

prevalence of, 431 

risk and prognostic factors for, 431-432 


Female sexual interest /arousal disorder, 423, 


433-437 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
434-435 
comorbidity with, 436-437 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 435-436 
development and course of, 435 
diagnostic criteria for, 433 
diagnostic features of, 433-434 
differential diagnosis of, 436 
functional consequences of, 436 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 436 


616 
development and course of, 616 
diagnostic criteria for, 614-615 
diagnostic features of, 615-616 
diagnostic markers for, 616-617 
differential diagnosis of, 617-618 
functional consequences of, 617 
prevalence of, 616 
risk and prognostic factors for, 616 


Frotteuristic disorder, 685, 691-694 


comorbidity with, 693-694 
development and course of, 693 
diagnostic criteria for, 691-692 
diagnostic features of, 692 

differential diagnosis of, 693 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 693 
prevalence of, 692-693 

risk and prognostic factors for, 693 
specifiers for, 692 


Functional neurological symptom disorder. See 


Conversion disorder 


GAF (Global Assessment of Functioning) scale, 16 
Gambling disorder, 481, 585-589 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
587 

comorbidity with, 589 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 588 

development and course of, 587-588 

diagnostic criteria for, 585-586 

diagnostic features of, 586-587 

differential diagnosis of, 589 

functional consequences of, 589 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 588 

prevalence of, 587 

risk and prognostic factors for, 588 

specifiers for, 586 


prevalence of, 435 Gender differences, 15 


risk and prognostic factors for, 435 Gender dysphoria, 451-459 
Fetishistic disorder, 685, 700-702 associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 701 454 
comorbidity with, 702 comorbidity with, 458-459 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 701 culture-related diagnostic issues in, 457 


Index 


development and course of, 454-456 
in association with a disorder of sex 
development, 456 
without a disorder of sex development, 
455-456 
diagnostic criteria for, 452-453 
diagnostic features of, 453-454 
diagnostic markers for, 457 
differential diagnosis of, 458 
functional consequences of, 457-458 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
814-815 
other specified, 459 
prevalence of, 454 
risk and prognostic factors for, 456-457 
specifiers for, 453 
unspecified, 459 
Generalized anxiety disorder, 190, 222-226 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 223 
comorbidity with, 226 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 224 
development and course of, 223-224 
diagnostic criteria for, 222 
diagnostic features of, 222-223 
differential diagnosis of, 225-226 
functional consequences of, 225 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 224-225 
prevalence of, 223 
risk and prognostic factors for, 224 
Genito-pelvic pain/ penetration disorder, 423, 
437-440 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
438 
comorbidity with, 440 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 439 
development and course of, 439 
diagnostic criteria for, 437 
diagnostic features of, 437-438 
differential diagnosis of, 440 
functional consequences of, 439 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 439 
prevalence of, 438 
risk and prognostic factors for, 439 
Global Assessment of Functioning (GAF) scale, 16 
Global developmental delay, 31, 41 
Glossary of technical terms, 817-831 


Hair pulling. See Trichotillomania (hair-pulling 
disorder) 
Hallucinations, 87-88 
auditory, 87, 103, 116, 122 
gustatory, 116 
hypnagogic, 87 
hypnopompic, 88 
olfactory, 116, 118 


929 


tactile, 116 
visual, 102, 103, 104, 116, 118 


Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder, 


531-532 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 531 
comorbidity with, 532 
development and course of, 532 
diagnostic criteria for, 531 
diagnostic features of, 531 
differential diagnosis of, 532 
functional consequences of, 532 
prevalence of, 531 
risk and prognostic factors for, 532 


Hallucinogen-related disorders, 481, 520-533 


diagnoses associated with, 482 

hallucinogen persisting perception disorder, 
531-532 

other hallucinogen-induced disorders, 
532-533 

other hallucinogen intoxication, 529-530 

other hallucinogen use disorder, 523-527 

other phencyclidine-induced disorders, 532 

phencyclidine intoxication, 527-529 

phencyclidine use disorder, 520-523 

unspecified hallucinogen-related disorder, 533 

unspecified phencyclidine-related disorder, 533 


Histrionic personality disorder, 645, 646, 667-669 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
668 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 668 

diagnostic criteria for, 667 

diagnostic features of, 667-668 

differential diagnosis of, 669 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 668 

prevalence of, 668 


HIV infection, major or mild neurocognitive 


disorder due to, 591, 604, 632-634 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 633 
comorbidity with, 634 
development and course of, 633 
diagnostic criteria for, 632 
diagnostic features of, 632 
diagnostic markers for, 634 
differential diagnosis of, 634 
functional consequences of, 634 
prevalence of, 633 
risk and prognostic factors for, 633 


Hoarding disorder, 235, 236, 247-251 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 249 
comorbidity with, 251 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 250 
development and course of, 249 

diagnostic criteria for, 247 

diagnostic features of, 248-249 

differential diagnosis of, 250-251 


930 


Hoarding disorder (continued) 
functional consequences of, 250 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 250 
prevalence of, 249 
risk and prognostic factors for, 249 
specifiers for, 248 

Housing problems, 723-724 

Huntington’s disease, 81, 117, 181, 182 


major or mild neurocognitive disorder due to, 


591, 604, 638-641 
associated features supporting diagnosis 
of, 639 
development and course of, 639-640 
diagnostic criteria for, 638-639 
diagnostic features of, 639 
diagnostic markers for, 640 
differential diagnosis of, 640-641 
functional consequences of, 640 
prevalence of, 639 
risk and prognostic factors for, 640 
Hypersomnolence disorder, 361, 368-372 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
370 
comorbidity with, 372 
development and course of, 370 
diagnostic criteria for, 368-369 
diagnostic features of, 369-370 
diagnostic markers for, 371 
differential diagnosis of, 371-372 
functional consequences of, 371 
other specified, 421 
prevalence of, 370 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 372 
risk and prognostic factors for, 370-371 
unspecified, 421 
Hypochondriasis, 310, 315-316, 318. See also 
Illness anxiety disorder 
Hypomanic episode or symptoms in bipolar and 
related disorders 
bipolar I disorder, 124-125, 129 
bipolar II disorder, 132-133, 135-136 
bipolar and related disorder due to another 
medical condition, 146 
cyclothymic disorder, 139, 140 
depressive episodes with short-duration 
hypomania, 786-789 
other specified bipolar and related disorder, 
148 


ICD. See International Classification of Diseases 

ICF (International Classification of Functioning, 
Disability and Health), 21, 734 

ICSD-2. See International Classification of Sleep 
Disorders, 2nd Edition 


Index 


Identity disturbance due to prolonged and intense 


coercive persuasion, 306 


Illness anxiety disorder, 309, 310, 315-318 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 316 

brief, 327 

comorbidity with, 318 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 317 

diagnostic criteria for, 315 

diagnostic features of, 315-316 

differential diagnosis of, 317-318 

functional consequences of, 317 

prevalence of, 316 

risk and prognostic factors for, 316-317 

without excessive health-related behaviors, 
327 


Inhalant intoxication, 538-540 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
539 

diagnostic criteria for, 538 

diagnostic features of, 538 

differential diagnosis of, 539-540 

functional consequences of, 539 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 539 

prevalence of, 539 


Inhalant-related disorders, 481, 533-540 


diagnoses associated with, 482 

inhalant intoxication, 538-540 

inhalant use disorder, 533-538 

other inhalant-induced disorders, 540 
unspecified inhalant-related disorder, 540 


Inhalant use disorder, 533-538 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
535 

comorbidity with, 538 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 536 

development and course of, 536 

diagnostic criteria for, 533-534 

diagnostic features of, 535 

diagnostic markers for, 536-537 

differential diagnosis of, 537 

functional consequences of, 537 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 536 

prevalence of, 535-536 

risk and prognostic factors for, 536 

specifiers for, 535 


Insomnia disorder, 361, 362-368 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
364 

brief, 420 

comorbidity with, 368 

development and course of, 365 

diagnostic criteria for, 362-363 

diagnostic features of, 363-364 

diagnostic markers for, 366-367 

differential diagnosis of, 367-368 


Index 


functional consequences of, 367 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 366 
other specified, 420 
prevalence of, 364-365 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 368 
restricted to nonrestorative sleep, 420 
risk and protective factors for, 366 
unspecified, 420-421 
Intellectual disability (intellectual developmental 
disorder), 31, 33-41 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 38 
coding and reporting for, 33 
comorbidity with, 40 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 39 
development and course of, 38-39 
diagnostic criteria for, 33 
diagnostic features of, 37-38 
diagnostic markers for, 39 
differential diagnosis of, 39-40 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 39 
global developmental delay, 31, 41 
prevalence of, 38 
relationship to other classifications, 40-41 
risk and prognostic factors for, 39 
specifiers for levels of severity of, 33, 34-36 
unspecified intellectual disability, 41 
Intermittent explosive disorder, 461, 466-469 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
467 
comorbidity with, 469 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 468 
development and course of, 467 
diagnostic criteria for, 466 
diagnostic features of, 466-467 
differential diagnosis of, 468-469 
functional consequences of, 468 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 468 
prevalence of, 467 
risk and prognostic factors for, 467-468 
Internalizing disorders, 13 
International Classification of Diseases (ICD), 21 
revision process for ICD-11, 6, 10, 11-12 
use of ICD-9-CM and ICD-10 codes, 12, 16, 22, 
23,29 
International Classification of Functioning, 
Disability and Health (ICF), 21, 734 
International Classification of Sleep Disorders, 2nd 
Edition (ICSD-2), relationship of DSM-5 to, 
361-362 
circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, 398 
hypersomnolence disorder, 372 
insomnia disorder, 368 
narcolepsy, 378 
nightmare disorder, 407 


931 


obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, 383 

rapid eye movement sleep behavior disorder, 
410 

restless legs syndrome, 413 

sleep-related hypoventilation, 390 

substance/medication-induced sleep disorder, 
420 

Internet gaming disorder, 795-798 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
797 

comorbidity with, 798 

diagnostic features of, 796-797 

differential diagnosis of, 797-798 

functional consequences of, 797 

prevalence of, 797 

proposed criteria for, 795-796 

risk and prognostic factors for, 797 

subtypes of, 796 

Intoxication, 481, 485-487 

alcohol, 497-499 

associated with use of multiple substances, 486 

caffeine, 503-506 

cannabis, 516-517 

delirium due to, 598 

development and course of, 487 

duration of effects and, 486 

inhalant, 538-540 

laboratory findings associated with, 486-487 

opioid, 546-547 

other hallucinogen, 529-530 

other (or unknown) substance, 581-582 

phencyclidine, 527-529 

recording procedures for, 487 

related to route of administration and speed of 
substance effects, 486 

sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic, 556-557 

stimulant, 567-569 


Jealousy, obsessional, 264 
Jikoshu-kyofu, 264 


Khyéal cap, 211, 212, 233, 834 
Kleptomania, 461, 478-479 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
478 
comorbidity with, 478 
development and course of, 478 
diagnostic criteria for, 478 
diagnostic features of, 478 
differential diagnosis of, 478 
functional consequences of, 478 
prevalence of, 478 
risk and prognostic factors for, 478 
Koro, 264 
Kufungisisa, 14, 834-835 


932 


Language disorder, 31, 42-44 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 43 
comorbidity with, 44 
development and course of, 43 
diagnostic criteria for, 42 
diagnostic features of, 42 
differential diagnosis of, 43 
risk and prognostic factors for, 43 
Learning disorder. See Specific learning disorder 
Level of Personality Functioning Scale (LPFS), 
772, 775-778 
Lewy bodies, major or mild neurocognitive 
disorder with, 591, 603, 618-621 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 619 
comorbidity with, 621 
development and course of, 619-620 
diagnostic criteria for, 618-619 
diagnostic features of, 619 
diagnostic markers for, 620 
differential diagnosis of, 620 
functional consequences of, 620 
prevalence of, 619 
risk and prognostic factors for, 620 
LPFS (Level of Personality Functioning Scale), 
772, 775-778 


Major depressive disorder, 155, 160-168 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
164-165 
comorbidity with, 168 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 166 
development and course of, 165-166 
diagnostic criteria for, 160-162 
diagnostic features of, 162-164 
differential diagnosis of, 167-168 
functional consequences of, 167 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 167 
prevalence of, 165 
risk and prognostic factors for, 166 
suicide risk in, 164, 167 
Major depressive episode in bipolar and related 
disorders 
bipolar I disorder, 125-126, 129 
bipolar II disorder, 133-134, 135-136 
other specified bipolar and related disorder, 
148 
Maladi moun, 14, 835 
Male hypoactive sexual desire disorder, 423, 
440-443 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
441-442 
comorbidity with, 443 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 442 
development and course of, 442 
diagnostic criteria for, 440-441 


Index 


diagnostic features of, 441 
differential diagnosis of, 443 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 442-443 
prevalence of, 442 
risk and prognostic factors for, 442 
Manic episode 
in bipolar I disorder, 124, 127-129 
in bipolar and related disorder due to another 
medical condition, 146 
Medication-induced delirium, 597, 599 
Medication-induced movement disorders and 
other adverse effects of medication, 20, 22, 
29, 709-714 
antidepressant discontinuation syndrome, 22, 
712-714 
medication-induced acute akathisia, 22, 711 
medication-induced acute dystonia, 711 
medication-induced postural tremor, 712 
neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism, 709 
neuroleptic malignant syndrome, 22, 709-711 
other adverse effect of medication, 712-714 
other medication-induced movement 
disorder, 712 
other medication-induced parkinsonism, 709 
tardive akathisia, 712 
tardive dyskinesia, 22, 712 
tardive dystonia, 712 
Mental disorder(s) 
culture and, 14-15, 749-759 
definition of, 20 
criterion for clinical significance, 21 
in forensic settings, 25 
gender and, 15 
Motor disorders, neurodevelopmental, 32, 74-85 
developmental coordination disorder, 74-77 
stereotypic movement disorder, 77-80 
tic disorders, 81-85 
Movement disorders, medication-induced. See 
Medication-induced movement disorders 
and other adverse effects of medication 
Muscle dysmorphia, 236, 243, 245 


Narcissistic personality disorder, 645, 646, 
669-672 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
671 

development and course of, 671 

diagnostic criteria for, 669-670 

diagnostic features of, 670-671 

differential diagnosis of, 671-672 

features and criteria in alternative DSM-5 
model for personality disorders, 763, 
767-768 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 671 

prevalence of, 671 


Index 


Narcolepsy, 361, 372-378 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
374-375 
comorbidity with, 377-378 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 376 
development and course of, 375 
diagnostic criteria for, 372-373 
diagnostic features of, 374 
diagnostic markers for, 376 
differential diagnosis of, 376-377 
functional consequences of, 376 
prevalence of, 375 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 378 
risk and prognostic factors for, 375-376 
subtypes of, 373-374 
NCDs. See Neurocognitive disorders 
Neglect 
child, 718-719 
spouse or partner, 721 
Nervios, 835 
Neurobehavioral disorder associated with 
prenatal alcohol exposure, 798-801 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 799 
comorbidity with, 800-801 
development and course of, 800 
diagnostic features of, 799 
differential diagnosis of, 800 
functional consequences of, 800 
prevalence of, 800 
proposed criteria for, 798-799 
suicide risk in, 800 
Neurocognitive disorders (NCDs), 591-643 
delirium, 591, 596-602 
other specified delirium, 602 
unspecified delirium, 602 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
816 
major and mild neurocognitive disorders, 591, 
602-611, 611-643 
associated features supporting diagnosis 
of, 608 
comorbidity with, 610-611 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 609 
development and course of, 608-609 
diagnostic criteria for, 602-606 
diagnostic features of, 607-608 
diagnostic markers for, 609-610 
differential diagnosis of, 610 
functional consequences of, 610 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 609 
prevalence of, 608 
risk and prognostic factors for, 609 
specifiers for, 606-607 
subtypes of, 591, 603-604, 606, 611-643 


933 


major or mild frontotemporal neuro- 
cognitive disorder, 591, 603, 614-618 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
due to Alzheimer’s disease, 591, 603, 
611-614 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
due to another medical condition, 
591, 604, 641-642 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
due to HIV infection, 591, 604, 632- 
634 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
due to Huntington’s disease, 591, 
604, 638-641 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
with Lewy bodies, 591, 603, 618-621 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
due to multiple etiologies, 591, 604, 
642-643 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
due to Parkinson’s disease, 591, 604, 
636-638 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
due to prion disease, 591, 604, 634— 
636 

major or mild neurocognitive disorder 
due to traumatic brain injury, 591, 
603, 624-627, 626 

major or mild substance /medication- 
induced neurocognitive disorder, 
591, 603, 627-632 

unspecified neurocognitive disorder, 
591, 604, 643 

vascular neurocognitive disorder, 591, 
603, 621-624 

neurocognitive domains, 592, 593-595 


Neurodevelopmental disorders, 11, 13, 31-86 


attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder, 11, 
32, 59-66 

autism spectrum disorders, 31-32, 50-59 

communication disorders, 31, 41-49 

highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
809-810 

intellectual disabilities, 31, 33-41 

motor disorders, 32, 74-85 

other specified neurodevelopmental disorder, 
86 

specific learning disorder, 32, 66-74 

specifiers for, 32-33 

tic disorders, 32, 81-85 

unspecified neurodevelopmental disorder, 86 


Neurodevelopmental motor disorders, 32, 74-85 


developmental coordination disorder, 74-77 
stereotypic movement disorder, 77-80 
tic disorders, 81-85 


934 


Neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism, 709 
Neuroleptic malignant syndrome, 22, 709-711 
development and course of, 710 
diagnostic features of, 710 
differential diagnosis of, 711 
risk and prognostic factors for, 711 
Night eating syndrome, 354 
Nightmare disorder, 361, 404-407 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 405 
comorbidity with, 407 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 406 
development and course of, 405 
diagnostic criteria for, 404 
diagnostic features of, 404-405 
diagnostic markers for, 406 
differential diagnosis of, 406-407 
functional consequences of, 406 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 406 
prevalence of, 405 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 407 
risk and prognostic factors for, 405 
Nonadherence to medical treatment, 22, 726-727 
Non-rapid eye movement sleep arousal 
disorders, 361, 399-404 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
400-401 
comorbidity with, 403 
development and course of, 401 
diagnostic criteria for, 399 
diagnostic features of, 400 
diagnostic markers for, 402 
differential diagnosis of, 402-403 
functional consequences of, 402 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 401 
prevalence of, 401 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 404 
risk and prognostic factors for, 401 
Nonsuicidal self-injury, 803-805 
development and course of, 804 
diagnostic features of, 804 
differential diagnosis of, 805-806 
functional consequences of, 805 
proposed criteria for, 803 
risk and prognostic factors for, 804 


Obesity, 22 
feeding and eating disorders and, 329, 344, 
348, 351-353 

sleep-wake disorders and, 413 
hypersomnia, 372, 373, 375, 376, 377 
obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, 

379-380, 382 

sleep-related hypoventilation, 387-388, 389 


Index 


Obsessional jealousy, 264 
Obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD), 235-236, 


237-242 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
238-239 

comorbidity with, 243 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 240 
development and course of, 239 
diagnostic criteria for, 237 
diagnostic features of, 238 
differential diagnosis of, 242-243 
functional consequences of, 241-242 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 239, 240 
prevalence of, 239 
risk and prognostic factors for, 239-240 
specifiers for, 236, 238 
suicide risk in, 240 


Obsessive-compulsive personality disorder, 645, 


646, 678-682 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
680-681 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 681 

diagnostic criteria for, 678-679 

diagnostic features of, 679-680 

differential diagnosis of, 681-682 

features and criteria in alternative DSM-5 
model for personality disorders, 764, 
768-769 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 681 

prevalence of, 681 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorder due to 


another medical condition, 235, 236, 260-263 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
262 
development and course of, 262 
diagnostic criteria for, 260-261 
diagnostic features of, 261-262 
diagnostic markers for, 262 
differential diagnosis of, 262-263 


Obsessive-compulsive and related disorders, 


235-264 

body dysmorphic disorder, 235, 236, 242-247 

excoriation (skin-picking) disorder, 235, 236, 
254-257 

highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
811-812 

hoarding disorder, 235, 236, 247-251 

obsessions and compulsions in, 235-236, 239 

obsessive-compulsive disorder, 235-236, 
237-242 

obsessive-compulsive and related disorder 
due to another medical condition, 
235.236, 260-263 

other specified obsessive-compulsive and 
related disorder, 235, 236, 263-264 


Index 


substance/medication-induced obsessive- 
compulsive and related disorder, 235, 
236, 257-260 
trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder), 235, 
236, 251-254 
unspecified obsessive-compulsive and related 
disorder, 235, 236 
Obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, 378-383 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
379 
comorbidity with, 383 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 381 
development and course of, 379-380 
diagnostic criteria for, 378 
diagnostic features of, 379 
diagnostic markers for, 381 
differential diagnosis of, 381-383 
functional consequences of, 381 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 381 
prevalence of, 379 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 383 
risk and prognostic factors for, 380-381 
specifiers for, 378-379 
Occupational problems, 723 
OCD. See Obsessive-compulsive disorder 
Olfactory reference syndrome, 246, 264, 837 
Online enhancements, 17 
Opioid intoxication, 546-547 
diagnostic criteria for, 546-547 
diagnostic features of, 547 
differential diagnosis of, 547 
specifiers for, 547 
Opioid-related disorders, 481, 540-550 
diagnoses associated with, 482 
opioid intoxication, 546-547 
opioid use disorder, 541-546 
opioid withdrawal, 484, 547-549 
other opioid-induced disorders, 549 
unspecified opioid-related disorder, 550 
Opioid use disorder, 541-546 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 543 
comorbidity with, 546 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 544 
development and course of, 543 
diagnostic criteria for, 541-542 
diagnostic features of, 542 
diagnostic markers for, 544 
differential diagnosis of, 545-546 
functional consequences of, 544-545 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 544 
prevalence of, 543 
risk and prognostic factors for, 543-544 
specifiers for, 542 
suicide risk in, 544 


935 


Opioid withdrawal, 484, 547-549 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 549 
development and course of, 549 

diagnostic criteria for, 547-548 

diagnostic features of, 548 

differential diagnosis of, 549 

prevalence of, 549 


Oppositional defiant disorder, 32, 461, 462-466 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
464 

comorbidity with, 466 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 465 

development and course of, 464 

diagnostic criteria for, 462-463 

diagnostic features of, 463 

differential diagnosis of, 465 

functional consequences of, 465 

prevalence of, 464 

risk and prognostic factors for, 464 

specifiers for, 463 


Other circumstances of personal history, 726 
Other conditions that may be a focus of clinical 


attention, 20, 22, 29, 715-727 
abuse and neglect, 717-722 
adult maltreatment and neglect problems, 
720-722 
child maltreatment and neglect problems, 
717-719 
educational and occupational problems, 723 
housing and economic problems, 723-724 
nonadherence to medical treatment, 726-727 
other circumstances of personal history, 726 
other health service encounters for counseling 
and medical advice, 725 
other problems related to the social 
environment, 724-725 
problems related to access to medical and 
other health care, 726 
problems related to crime or interaction with 
the legal system, 725 
problems related to other psychosocial, 
personal, and environmental 
circumstances, 725 
relational problems, 715-717 
other problems related to primary support 
group, 716-717 
problems related to family upbringing, 
715-716 


Other hallucinogen intoxication, 529-530 


diagnostic criteria for, 529 
diagnostic features of, 529 
differential diagnosis of, 530 
functional consequences of, 530 
prevalence of, 530 

suicide risk in, 530 


936 


Other hallucinogen use disorder, 523-527 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
525 
comorbidity with, 527 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 526 
development and course of, 525-526 
diagnostic criteria for, 523-524 
diagnostic features of, 524-525 
diagnostic markers for, 526 
differential diagnosis of, 527 
functional consequences of, 527 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 526 
prevalence of, 525 
risk and prognostic factors for, 526 
specifiers for, 524 
Other health service encounters for counseling 
and medical advice, 725 
Other mental disorders, 707-708 
other specified mental disorder, 15-16, 19, 
708 
other specified mental disorder due to another 
medical condition, 707 
unspecified mental disorder, 15-16, 19-20, 708 
unspecified mental disorder due to another 
medical condition, 708 
Other problems related to primary support group, 
716-717 
Other problems related to social environment, 
724-725 
Other psychosocial, personal, and environmental 
circumstances, problems related to, 725 
Other specified mental disorder, 15-16, 19, 708 
due to another medical condition, 707 
Other (or unknown) substance intoxication, 
581-582 
comorbidity with, 582 
development and course of, 581-582 
diagnostic criteria for, 581 
diagnostic features of, 581 
differential diagnosis of, 582 
functional consequences of, 582 
prevalence of, 581 
Other (or unknown) substance-related disorders, 
577-585 
diagnoses associated with, 482 
other (or unknown) substance-induced 
disorders, 584-585 
other (or unknown) substance intoxication, 
581-582 
other (or unknown) substance use disorder, 
577-580 
other (or unknown) substance withdrawal, 
583-584 
unspecified other (or unknown) substance- 
related disorder, 585 


Index 


Other (or unknown) substance use disorder, 


577-580 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 579 
comorbidity with, 580 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 580 
development and course of, 580 
diagnostic criteria for, 577-578 
diagnostic features of, 579 
diagnostic markers for, 580 
differential diagnosis of, 580 
prevalence of, 579 
risk and prognostic factors for, 580 
specifiers for, 578 


Other (or unknown) substance withdrawal, 


583-584 
comorbidity with, 584 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 583 
development and course of, 583 
diagnostic criteria for, 583 
diagnostic features of, 583 
differential diagnosis of, 584 
functional consequences of, 584 
prevalence of, 583 


Panic attacks, 189, 190, 208-209, 214-217 


associated features with, 215 
comorbidity with, 217 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 216 
development and course of, 215-216 
diagnostic markers for, 216 

differential diagnosis of, 217 

expected vs. unexpected, 215 

features of, 214-215 

functional consequences of, 217 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 216 
nocturnal, 209, 215 

in older adults, 210-211, 215-216 
prevalence of, 215 

risk and prognostic factors for, 216 
specifier for, 214-217 

suicide risk and, 215 

symptoms of, 214 


Panic disorder, 190, 208-214 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 210 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 211-212 
development and course of, 210-211 
diagnostic criteria for, 208-209 

diagnostic features of, 209 

diagnostic markers for, 212 

differential diagnosis of, 212-213 

functional consequences of, 212 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 210.212 
prevalence of, 210 

risk and prognostic factors for, 211 

suicide risk in, 212 


Index 


Paranoid personality disorder, 645, 646, 649-652 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
650-651 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 651 

development and course of, 651 

diagnostic criteria for, 649 

diagnostic features of, 649-650 

differential diagnosis of, 652 

prevalence of, 651 

risk and prognostic factors for, 651 


Paraphilic disorders, 685-705 


exhibitionistic disorder, 685, 689-691 
fetishistic disorder, 685, 700-702 
frotteuristic disorder, 685, 691-694 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
816 
other specified paraphilic disorder, 705 
pedophilic disorder, 685, 697-700 
sexual masochism disorder, 685, 694-695 
sexual sadism disorder, 685, 695-697 
transvestic disorder, 685, 702-704 
unspecified paraphilic disorder, 705 
voyeuristic disorder, 685, 686-688 


Parasomnias, 361, 399-410 


nightmare disorder, 361, 404-407 

non-rapid eye movement sleep arousal 
disorders, 361, 399-404 

rapid eye movement sleep behavior disorder, 
361, 407-410 


Parkinsonism 


neuroleptic-induced, 709 
other medication-induced, 709 


Parkinson’s disease 


anxiety disorders and, 203, 205, 207, 218, 221 
depressive disorders and, 181, 182 
major or mild neurocognitive disorder due to, 
591, 604, 636-638 
associated features supporting diagnosis 
of, 637 
comorbidity with, 638 
development and course of, 637 
diagnostic criteria for, 636-637 
diagnostic features of, 637 
diagnostic markers for, 637-638 
differential diagnosis of, 638 
prevalence of, 637 
risk and prognostic factors for, 637 
sleep-wake disorders and, 372, 383, 395, 413, 
421 
REM sleep behavior disorder, 361, 408, 410 


Pedophilic disorder, 685, 697-700 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 698 
comorbidity with, 700 

development and course of, 699 

diagnostic criteria for, 697-698 


937 


diagnostic features of, 698 

diagnostic markers for, 699 

differential diagnosis of, 700 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 699 
prevalence of, 698 

risk and prognostic factors for, 699 


Persistent complex bereavement disorder, 289, 


789-792 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
791 

comorbidity with, 792 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 791 
development and course of, 791 
diagnostic features of, 790-791 
differential diagnosis of, 792 
functional consequences of, 792 
prevalence of, 791 
proposed criteria for, 789-790 
risk and prognostic factors for, 791 
suicide risk in, 791 


Persistent depressive disorder (dysthymia), 155, 


168-171 
comorbidity with, 171 
development and course of, 170 
diagnostic criteria for, 168-169 
diagnostic features of, 169-170 
differential diagnosis of, 170-171 
functional consequences of, 170 
prevalence of, 170 
risk and prognostic factors for, 170 


Personality change due to another medical 


condition, 645, 682-684 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
683 
diagnostic criteria for, 682 
diagnostic features of, 683 
differential diagnosis of, 683-684 
subtypes of, 683 


Personality disorders, 645-684 


Cluster A, 646, 649-659 
paranoid personality disorder, 645, 646, 
649-652 
schizoid personality disorder, 645, 646, 
652-655 
schizotypal personality disorder, 87, 89, 90, 
645, 646, 655-659 
Cluster B, 646, 659-672 
antisocial personality disorder, 461, 476, 
645, 646, 659-663 
borderline personality disorder, 645, 646, 
663-666 
histrionic personality disorder, 645, 646, 
667-669 
narcissistic personality disorder, 645, 646, 
669-672 


938 


Personality disorders (continued) 


Cluster C, 646, 672-682 
avoidant personality disorder, 645, 646, 
672-675 
dependent personality disorder, 645, 646, 
675-678 
obsessive-compulsive personality disorder, 
645, 646, 678-682 
general personality disorder, 646-649 
criteria for, 646-647 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 648 
development and course of, 647-648 
diagnostic features of, 647 
differential diagnosis of, 648-649 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 648 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
816 
other specified personality disorder, 645-646, 
684 
personality change due to another medical 
condition, 645, 682-684 
unspecified personality disorder, 645-646, 684 


Personality disorders: alternative DSM-5 model, 


761-781 
diagnosis of, 771 
general criteria for personality disorder, 
761-763 
Criterion A: level of personality 
functioning, 762, 762 
Criterion B: pathological personality traits, 
762-763 
Criteria C and D: pervasiveness and 
stability, 763 
Criteria E, F, and G: alternative 
explanations for personality 
pathology, 763 
level of personality functioning, 762, 762, 
771-772 
Level of Personality Functioning Scale for 
rating of, 772, 775-778 
self- and interpersonal functioning 
dimensional definition, 772 
personality traits, 772-774 
assessment of Personality Trait Model, 774 
clinical utility of multidimensional 
personality functioning and trait 
model, 774 
definition and description of, 772-773 
definitions of personality disorder trait 
domains and facets, 779-781 
dimensionality of, 772-773 
distinguishing traits, symptoms, and 
specific behaviors, 773-774 
hierarchical structure of personality, 773 
Personality Trait Model, 773 


Index 


scoring algorithms for, 771 
specific personality disorders, 763-771 
antisocial personality disorder, 763, 764-765 
avoidant personality disorder, 763, 765-766 
borderline personality disorder, 763, 766— 
767 
narcissistic personality disorder, 763, 
767-768 
obsessive-compulsive personality disorder, 
764, 768-769 
personality disorder—trait specified, 761, 
770-771 
schizotypal personality disorder, 764, 
769-770 


Phencyclidine intoxication, 527-529 


diagnostic criteria for, 527-528 
diagnostic features of, 528 
diagnostic markers for, 528 
differential diagnosis of, 528-529 
functional consequences of, 528 
prevalence of, 528 


Phencyclidine-related disorders, 481 


diagnoses associated with, 482 

other phencyclidine-induced disorders, 532 
phencyclidine intoxication, 527-529 
phencyclidine use disorder, 520-523 
unspecified phencyclidine-related disorder, 533 


Phencyclidine use disorder, 520-523 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 522 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 522 
diagnostic criteria for, 520-521 
diagnostic features of, 521-522 
diagnostic markers for, 522 

differential diagnosis of, 523 

functional consequences of, 522 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 522 
prevalence of, 522 

risk and prognostic factors for, 522 
specifiers for, 521 


Phobic disorders 


agoraphobia, 190, 217-221 

social anxiety disorder (social phobia), 190, 
202-208 

specific phobia, 189-190, 197-202 


Physical abuse 


child, 717-718 
nonspouse or nonpartner, 722 
spouse or partner, 720 


Pica, 329-331 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
330 

comorbidity with, 331 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 331 

development and course of, 330 

diagnostic criteria for, 329-330 


Index 


diagnostic features of, 330 
diagnostic markers for, 331 
differential diagnosis of, 331 
functional consequences of, 331 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 331 
prevalence of, 330 
risk and prognostic factors for, 330 
Posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD), 265, 271-280 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
276 
comorbidity with, 280 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 278 
development and course of, 276-277 
diagnostic criteria for, 271-274 
diagnostic features of, 274-276 
differential diagnosis of, 279-280 
functional consequences of, 278-279 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 278 
prevalence of, 276 
risk and prognostic factors for, 277-278 
suicide risk in, 278 
Postural tremor, medication-induced, 712 
Premature (early) ejaculation, 423, 443-446 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
444 
comorbidity with, 446 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 445 
development and course of, 444-445 
diagnostic criteria for, 443-444 
diagnostic features of, 444 
diagnostic markers for, 445 
differential diagnosis of, 445-446 
functional consequences of, 445 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 445 
prevalence of, 444 
risk and prognostic factors for, 445 
Premenstrual dysphoric disorder, 155, 171-175 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 173 
comorbidity with, 175 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 173 
development and course of, 173 
diagnostic criteria for, 171-172 
diagnostic features of, 172-173 
diagnostic markers for, 173-174 
differential diagnosis of, 174-175 
functional consequences of, 174 
prevalence of, 173 
recording procedures for, 172 
risk and prognostic factors for, 173 
Principal diagnosis, 22-23 
Prion disease, major or mild neurocognitive 
disorder due to, 591, 604, 634-636 
development and course of, 635 
diagnostic criteria for, 634-635 
diagnostic features of, 635 


939 


diagnostic markers for, 636 
differential diagnosis of, 636 
prevalence of, 635 
risk and prognostic factors for, 636 
Problems related to access to medical and other 
health care, 726 
Problems related to crime or interaction with the 
legal system, 725 
Problems related to family upbringing, 715-716 
Problems related to other psychosocial, personal, 
and environmental circumstances, 725 
Provisional diagnosis, 23 
Pseudocyesis, 310, 327 
Psychological abuse 
child, 719 
nonspouse or nonpartner, 722 
spouse or partner abuse, 721-722 
Psychological factors affecting other medical 
conditions, 309, 310, 322-324 
comorbidity with, 324 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 323 
development and course of, 323 
diagnostic criteria for, 322 
diagnostic features of, 322-323 
differential diagnosis of, 323-324 
functional consequences of, 323 
prevalence of, 323 
Psychotic disorder due to another medical 
condition, 89, 115-118 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 116 
comorbidity with, 118 
development and course of, 117 
diagnostic criteria for, 115-116 
diagnostic features of, 116 
diagnostic markers for, 117 
differential diagnosis of, 118 
functional consequences of, 118 
prevalence of, 116-117 
risk and prognostic factors for, 117 
specifiers for, 116 
suicide risk in, 118 
Psychotic disorders. See Schizophrenia spectrum 
and other psychotic disorders 
PTSD. See Posttraumatic stress disorder 
Purging disorder, 353 
Pyromania, 461, 476-477 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
476-477 
comorbidity with, 477 
development and course of, 477 
diagnostic criteria for, 476 
diagnostic features of, 476 
differential diagnosis of, 477 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 477 
prevalence of, 477 


940 


Rapid eye movement (REM) sleep behavior 
disorder, 361, 407-410 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 408 
comorbidity with, 410 
development and course of, 408-409 
diagnostic criteria for, 407-408 
diagnostic features of, 408 
diagnostic markers for, 409 
differential diagnosis of, 409-410 
functional consequences of, 409 
prevalence of, 408 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 410 
risk and prognostic factors for, 409 
Reactive attachment disorder, 265-268 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 266 
comorbidity with, 268 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 267 
development and course of, 266 
diagnostic criteria for, 265-266 
diagnostic features of, 266 
differential diagnosis of, 267-268 
functional consequences of, 267 
prevalence of, 266 
risk and prognostic factors for, 267 
Recurrent brief depression, 183 
Relational problems, 22, 715-717 
other problems related to primary support 
group, 716-717 
problems related to family upbringing, 715-716 
REM sleep behavior disorder. See Rapid eye 
movement sleep behavior disorder 
Restless legs syndrome (RLS), 361, 410-413 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
411 
comorbidity with, 413 
development and course of, 411-412 
diagnostic criteria for, 410 
diagnostic features of, 411 
diagnostic markers for, 412 
differential diagnosis of, 413 
functional consequences of, 412-413 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 412 
prevalence of, 411 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 413 
risk and prognostic factors for, 412 
Rett syndrome, 33, 38, 51, 53, 56, 57, 79, 80 
RLS. See Restless legs syndrome 
Rumination disorder, 329, 332-333 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
332-333 
comorbidity with, 333 
development and course of, 333 
diagnostic criteria for, 332 


Index 


diagnostic features of, 332 
differential diagnosis of, 333 
functional consequences of, 333 
prevalence of, 333 

risk and prognostic factors for, 333 


Schizoaffective disorder, 89-90, 105-110 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 107 
comorbidity with, 110 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 108-109 
development and course of, 108 

diagnostic criteria for, 105-106 

diagnostic features of, 106-107 

differential diagnosis of, 109-110 

functional consequences of, 109 

prevalence of, 107-108 

risk and prognostic factors for, 108 

suicide risk in, 109 


Schizoid personality disorder, 645, 646, 652-655 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
653-654 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 654 

development and course of, 654 

diagnostic criteria for, 652-653 

diagnostic features of, 653 

differential diagnosis of, 654-655 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 654 

prevalence of, 654 

risk and prognostic factors for, 654 


Schizophrenia, 87, 99-105 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
101-102 

with catatonia, 88, 100 

comorbidity with, 105 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 103 

development and course of, 102-103 

diagnostic features of, 87-88, 100-101 

differential diagnosis of, 104-105 

functional consequences of, 104 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 103-104 

prevalence of, 102 

risk and prognostic factors for, 103 

suicide risk in, 104 


Schizophrenia spectrum and other psychotic 


disorders, 87-122 
brief psychotic disorder, 89, 94-96 
catatonia, 88, 89, 119-121 
clinician-rated assessment of symptoms and 
related clinical phenomena in, 89-90 
delusional disorder, 89, 90-93 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
810 
key features of, 87-88 
delusions, 87 
disorganized thinking (speech), 88 


Index 


grossly disorganized or abnormal motor 
behavior (including catatonia), 88 
hallucinations, 87-88 
negative symptoms, 88 
other specified schizophrenia spectrum and 
other psychotic disorder, 122 
psychotic disorder due to another medical 
condition, 89, 115-118 
schizoaffective disorder, 89-90, 105-110 
schizophrenia, 87, 99-105 
schizophreniform disorder, 89, 96-99 
schizotypal (personality) disorder, 87, 89, 90 
substance/medication-induced psychotic 
disorder, 89, 110-115 
unspecified schizophrenia spectrum and other 
psychotic disorder, 122 


Schizophreniform disorder, 89, 96-99 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 98 
development and course of, 98 

diagnostic criteria for, 96-97 

diagnostic features of, 97-98 

differential diagnosis of, 98-99 

functional consequences of, 98 

prevalence of, 98 

provisional diagnosis of, 97 

risk and prognostic factors for, 98 


Schizotypal personality disorder, 87, 89, 90, 645, 


646, 655-659 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
657 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 657 

development and course of, 657 

diagnostic criteria for, 655-656 

diagnostic features of, 656-657 

differential diagnosis of, 658-659 

features and criteria in alternative DSM-5 
model for personality disorders, 764, 
769-770 

gender-related diagnostic issues in, 658 

prevalence of, 657 

risk and prognostic factors for, 657 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication, 


556-557 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 557 
diagnostic criteria for, 556 
diagnostic features of, 556-557 
differential diagnosis of, 557 
prevalence of, 557 


Sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-related 


disorders, 481, 550-560 
diagnoses associated with, 482 
other sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic- 
induced disorders, 560 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic intoxication, 
556-557 


941 


sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, 
550-556 

sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal, 
484, 557-560 

unspecified sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic- 
related disorder, 560 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, 


550-556 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
553 

comorbidity with, 555-556 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 554 
development and course of, 553-554 
diagnostic criteria for, 550-552 
diagnostic features of, 552-553 
diagnostic markers for, 554-555 
differential diagnosis of, 555 
functional consequences of, 555 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 554 
prevalence of, 553 
risk and prognostic factors for, 554 
specifiers for, 552 


Sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic withdrawal, 484, 


557-560 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 559 
diagnostic criteria for, 557-558 
diagnostic features of, 558 
diagnostic markers for, 559 
differential diagnosis of, 559-560 
prevalence of, 559 


Selective mutism, 189, 195-197 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
195-196 

comorbidity with, 197 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 196 

development and course of, 196 

diagnostic criteria for, 195 

diagnostic features of, 195 

differential diagnosis of, 197 

functional consequences of, 196-197 

prevalence of, 196 

risk and prognostic factors for, 196 


Separation anxiety disorder, 189, 190-195 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 192 
comorbidity with, 195 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 193 
development and course of, 192-193 
diagnostic criteria for, 190-191 
diagnostic features of, 191-192 
differential diagnosis of, 194-195 
functional consequences of, 193-194 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 193 
prevalence of, 192 

risk and prognostic factors for, 193 
suicide risk in, 193 


942 


Severity measures, 733, 742 
Clinician-Rated Dimensions of Psychosis 
Symptom Severity, 742-744 
frequency of use of, 742 
scoring and interpretation of, 742 
Sexual abuse 
child, 718 
nonspouse or nonpartner, 722 
spouse or partner, 720 
Sexual dysfunctions, 423-450 
delayed ejaculation, 423, 424-426 
erectile disorder, 423, 426-429 
female orgasmic disorder, 423, 429-432 
female sexual interest/arousal disorder, 423, 
433-437 
genito-pelvic pain/penetration disorder, 423, 
437-440 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
814 
male hypoactive sexual desire disorder, 423, 
440-443 
other specified sexual dysfunction, 423, 450 
premature (early) ejaculation, 423, 443-446 
substance/medication-induced sexual 
dysfunction, 423, 446-450 
subtypes of, 423 
unspecified sexual dysfunction, 423, 450 
Sexual masochism disorder, 685, 694-695 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 694 
comorbidity with, 695 
development and course of, 695 
diagnostic criteria for, 694 
diagnostic features of, 694 
differential diagnosis of, 695 
functional consequences of, 695 
prevalence of, 694 
Sexual sadism disorder, 685, 695-697 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 696 
comorbidity with, 697 
development and course of, 697 
diagnostic criteria for, 695 
diagnostic features of, 696 
differential diagnosis of, 697 
prevalence of, 696 
Shenjing shuairuo, 835-836 
Shubo-kyofu, 264 
Skin picking. See Excoriation (skin-picking) 
disorder 
Sleep-related hypoventilation, 387-390 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
387-388 
comorbidity with, 389-390 
development and course of, 388 
diagnostic criteria for, 387 
diagnostic features, 387 


Index 


diagnostic markers for, 389 
differential diagnosis of, 389 
functional consequences of, 389 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 389 
prevalence of, 388 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 390 
risk and prognostic factors for, 388 
subtypes of, 387 
Sleep terrors, 399-403. See also Non-rapid eye 
movement sleep arousal disorders 
Sleep-wake disorders, 361-422 
breathing-related sleep disorders, 361, 378-390 
central sleep apnea, 383-386 
obstructive sleep apnea hypopnea, 378-383 
sleep-related hypoventilation, 387-390 
circadian rhythm sleep-wake disorders, 361, 
390-398 
advanced sleep phase type, 393-394 
delayed sleep phase type, 391-392 
irregular sleep-wake type, 394-396 
non-24-hour sleep-wake type, 396-397 
shift work type, 397-398 
highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
814 
hypersomnolence disorder, 361, 368-372 
other specified, 421 
unspecified, 421 
insomnia disorder, 361, 362-368 
other specified, 420 
unspecified, 420-421 
narcolepsy, 361, 372-378 
other specified sleep-wake disorder, 421 
parasomnias, 399-410 
nightmare disorder, 361, 404-407 
non-rapid eye movement sleep arousal 
disorders, 361, 399-404 
rapid eye movement sleep behavior 
disorder, 361, 407-410 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 361-362 (See also specific 
sleep-wake disorders) 
restless legs syndrome, 361, 410-413 
substance/medication-induced sleep disorder, 
413-420 
unspecified sleep-wake disorder, 422 
Sleepwalking, 399-403. See also Non-rapid eye 
movement sleep arousal disorders 
Smoking. See Tobacco-related disorders 
Social anxiety disorder (social phobia), 190, 
202-208 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
204 
comorbidity with, 208 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 205-206 


Index 


development and course of, 205 

diagnostic criteria for, 202-203 

diagnostic features of, 203-204 

differential diagnosis of, 206-207 

functional consequences of, 206 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 204, 206 
prevalence of, 204 

risk and prognostic factors for, 205 
specifiers for, 203 


Social (pragmatic) communication disorder, 31, 


47-49 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 48 
development and course of, 48 
diagnostic criteria for, 47-48 
diagnostic features of, 48 
differential diagnosis of, 49 
risk and prognostic factors for, 48 


Somatic symptom disorder, 309, 310, 311-315 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
312 

comorbidity with, 314-315 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 313 

development and course of, 312-313 

diagnostic criteria for, 311 

diagnostic features of, 311-312 

differential diagnosis of, 314 

prevalence of, 312 

risk and prognostic factors for, 313 


Somatic symptoms and related disorders, 309-327 


conversion disorder (functional neurological 
symptom disorder), 309, 310, 318-321 

factitious disorder, 309, 310, 324-326 

highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
812-813 

illness anxiety disorder, 309, 310, 315-318 

other specified somatic symptom and related 
disorder, 309, 310, 327 

psychological factors affecting other medical 
conditions, 309, 310, 322-324 

somatic symptom disorder, 309, 310, 311-315 

unspecified somatic symptom and related 
disorder, 309, 310, 327 


Specific learning disorder, 32, 66-74 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 70 
comorbidity with, 72, 74 

culture-related diagnostic issues in, 72-73 
development and course of, 70-72 
diagnostic criteria for, 66-68 

diagnostic features of, 68-70 

differential diagnosis of, 73-74 

functional consequences of, 73 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 73 
prevalence of, 70 

recording procedures for, 68 

risk and prognostic factors for, 72 


943 


Specific phobia, 189-190, 197-202 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 199 
comorbidity with, 202 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 201 
development and course of, 199-200 
diagnostic criteria for, 197-198 
diagnostic features of, 198-199 
differential diagnosis of, 201-202 
functional consequences of, 201 
prevalence of, 199 
risk and prognostic factors for, 200 
specifiers for, 198 
suicide risk in, 201 
Specifiers, 21-22 
Specifiers for bipolar and related disorders, 
149-154 
Specifiers for depressive disorders, 184-188 
Speech sound disorder, 31, 44-45 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 44 
development and course of, 44-45 
diagnostic criteria for, 44 
diagnostic features of, 44 
differential diagnosis of, 45 
Spouse or partner abuse, psychological, 721-722 
Spouse or partner neglect, 721 
Spouse or partner violence 
physical, 720 
sexual, 720 
Stereotypic movement disorder, 32, 77-80 
comorbidity with, 80 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 79 
development and course of, 79 
diagnostic criteria for, 77-78 
diagnostic features of, 78-79 
differential diagnosis of, 79-80 
prevalence of, 79 
recording procedures for, 78 
risk and prognostic factors for, 79 
specifiers for, 78 
Stimulant intoxication, 567-569 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 568 
diagnostic criteria for, 567-568 
diagnostic features of, 568 
differential diagnosis of, 568-569 
Stimulant-related disorders, 481, 561-570 
diagnoses associated with, 482 
other stimulant-induced disorders, 570 
stimulant intoxication, 567-569 
stimulant use disorder, 561-567 
stimulant withdrawal, 484, 569-570 
unspecified stimulant-related disorder, 570 
Stimulant use disorder, 561-567 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
563-564 
comorbidity with, 566-567 


944 


Stimulant use disorder (continued) 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 565 
development and course of, 564-565 
diagnostic criteria for, 561-562 
diagnostic features of, 563 
diagnostic markers for, 565-566 
differential diagnosis of, 566 
functional consequences of, 566 
prevalence of, 564 
risk and prognostic factors for, 565 
specifiers for, 563 

Stimulant withdrawal, 484, 569-570 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 570 
diagnostic criteria for, 569 
differential diagnosis of, 570 

Stroke, 46, 73, 117 
bipolar disorder and, 146, 147 
depressive disorders and, 164, 167, 181-182 

Stuttering. See Childhood-onset fluency disorder 

(stuttering) 
Substance-induced disorders, 481, 485-490. See 
also specific substances of abuse 
alcohol-related, 497-503 
caffeine-related, 503-508 
cannabis-related, 516-519 
hallucinogen-related, 527-533 
inhalant-related, 538-540 
opioid-related, 546-549 
other (or unknown) substance-related, 581-585 
sedative-, hypnotic-, or anxiolytic-related, 
556-560 
substance intoxication and withdrawal, 481, 
485-487 (See also Intoxication; 
Withdrawal from substance) 
associated with use of multiple substances, 
486 
development and course of, 487 
duration of effects and, 486 
laboratory findings associated with, 
486-487 
recording procedures for, 487 
related to route of administration and 
speed of substance effects, 486 
substance /medication-induced mental 
disorders, 481, 487-490 
development and course of, 489 
features of, 488-489 
functional consequences of, 490 
recording procedures for, 490 
tobacco-related, 575-576 
Substance intoxication delirium, 596-597, 598 
Substance/medication-induced anxiety disorder, 
190, 226-230 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
228-229 


Index 


diagnostic criteria for, 226-227 
diagnostic features of, 228 
diagnostic markers for, 229 
differential diagnosis of, 229-230 
prevalence of, 229 

recording procedures for, 227-228 


Substance/medication-induced bipolar and 


related disorder, 123, 142-145 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 144 
comorbidity with, 146 
development and course of, 144-145 
diagnostic criteria for, 142-143 
diagnostic features of, 144 
diagnostic markers for, 145 
differential diagnosis of, 145 
prevalence of, 144 
recording procedures for, 143-144 


Substance/medication-induced depressive 


disorder, 155, 175-180 
comorbidity with, 180 
development and course of, 178 
diagnostic criteria for, 175-176 
diagnostic features of, 177-178 
diagnostic markers for, 179 
differential diagnosis of, 179-180 
prevalence of, 178 
recording procedures for, 176-177 
risk and prognostic factors for, 178-179 
suicide risk in, 179 


Substance/medication-induced neurocognitive 


disorder, 591, 603, 627-632 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 630 
comorbidity with, 632 
development and course of, 631 
diagnostic criteria for, 627-629 
diagnostic features of, 629-630 
diagnostic markers for, 631 
differential diagnosis of, 631 
functional consequences of, 631 
prevalence of, 630 
recording procedures for, 629 
risk and prognostic factors for, 631 


Substance /medication-induced obsessive- 


compulsive and related disorder, 235, 236, 
257-260 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 259 

diagnostic criteria for, 257-258 

diagnostic features of, 259 

differential diagnosis of, 259-260 

prevalence of, 259 

recording procedures for, 258-259 


Substance/medication-induced psychotic 


disorder, 89, 110-115 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 113 
development and course of, 114 


Index 


diagnostic criteria for, 110-111 
diagnostic features of, 112-113 
diagnostic markers for, 114 
differential diagnosis of, 114-115 
functional consequences of, 114 
prevalence of, 113 
recording procedures for, 112 
Substance /medication-induced sexual 
dysfunction, 423, 446-450 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
448-449 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 449 
development and course of, 449 
diagnostic criteria for, 446-447 
diagnostic features of, 448 
differential diagnosis of, 450 
functional consequences of, 450 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 449 
prevalence of, 449 
recording procedures for, 447-448 
Substance /medication-induced sleep disorder, 
413-420 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
416-418 
comorbidity with, 420 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 418 
development and course of, 418 
diagnostic criteria for, 413-415 
diagnostic features of, 416 
diagnostic markers for, 419 
differential diagnosis of, 419-420 
functional consequences of, 419 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 418 
recording procedures for, 415-416 
relationship to International Classification of 
Sleep Disorders, 420 
risk and prognostic factors for, 418 
Substance-related and addictive disorders, 
481-589 
gambling disorder, 481, 585-589 


highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 


815 


substance-related disorders, 481-585 (See also 


specific substances of abuse) 
alcohol-related disorders, 490-503 
caffeine-related disorders, 503-509 
cannabis-related disorders, 509-519 


diagnoses associated with substance class, 


482 
drug classes in, 481 
hallucinogen-related disorders, 520-533 
inhalant-related disorders, 533-540 
opioid-related disorders, 540-550 
other (or unknown) substance-related 
disorders, 577-585 


945 


sedative-, hypnotic- or anxiolytic-related 
disorders, 550-560 
stimulant-related disorders, 561-570 
substance-induced disorders, 481, 485-490 
substance use disorders, 481, 483-485, 
490-585 
tobacco-related disorders, 571-577 
Substance use disorders, 481, 483-485 
alcohol use disorder, 490-497 
caffeine use disorder, 792-795 
cannabis use disorder, 509-516 
features of, 483-484 
inhalant use disorder, 533-538 
opioid use disorder, 541-546 
other hallucinogen use disorder, 523-527 
other (or unknown) substance use disorder, 
577-580 
phencyclidine use disorder, 520-523 
recording procedures for, 485 
sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic use disorder, 
550-556 
severity and specifiers for, 484 
stimulant use disorder, 561-567 
tobacco use disorder, 571-574 
tolerance and withdrawal in, 484 
Substance withdrawal delirium, 597, 598-599 
Suicidal behavior disorder, 801-803 
comorbidity with, 803 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 802 
development and course of, 802 
diagnostic features of, 801-802 
diagnostic markers for, 802 
functional consequences of, 802 
proposed criteria for, 801 
specifiers for, 801 
Suicide risk 
anorexia nervosa and, 343 
bipolar I disorder and, 131 
bipolar II disorder and, 138 
body dysmorphic disorder and, 245 
bulimia nervosa and, 349 
depressive disorder due to another medical 
condition and, 182 
depressive episodes with short-duration 
hypomania and, 788 
disruptive mood dysregulation disorder and, 
158 
dissociative amnesia and, 300 
dissociative identity disorder and, 295 
major depressive disorder and, 164, 167 
neurobehavioral disorder associated with 
prenatal alcohol exposure and, 800 
obsessive-compulsive disorder and, 240 
opioid use disorder and, 544 
other hallucinogen intoxication and, 530 


946 


Suicide risk (continued) 
panic attacks and, 215 
panic disorder and, 212 


persistent complex bereavement disorder and, 


791 
posttraumatic stress disorder and, 278 
psychotic disorder due to another medical 
condition and, 118 
schizoaffective disorder and, 109 
schizophrenia and, 104 
separation anxiety disorder and, 193 
specific phobia and, 201 
substance/medication-induced depressive 
disorder and, 180 
Susto, 836-837 


Taijin kyofusho, 205, 837 

Tardive akathisia, 712 

Tardive dyskinesia, 22, 712 

Tardive dystonia, 712 

Technical terms, glossary of, 817-831 

Tic disorders, 32, 81-85 
comorbidity with, 83, 85 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 83 
development and course of, 83 
diagnostic criteria for, 81 
diagnostic features of, 81-82 
differential diagnosis of, 84 
functional consequences of, 84 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 83, 84 
other specified tic disorder, 85 
prevalence of, 83 
risk and prognostic factors for, 83 
specifiers for, 81 
unspecified tic disorder, 85 

Tobacco-related disorders, 481, 571-577 
diagnoses associated with, 482 
other tobacco-induced disorders, 576 
tobacco use disorder, 571-574 
tobacco withdrawal, 484, 575-576 
unspecified tobacco-related disorder, 577 

Tobacco use disorder, 571-574 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 573 


comorbidity with, 574 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 574 
development and course of, 573 
diagnostic criteria for, 571-572 
diagnostic features of, 572-573 
diagnostic markers for, 574 
functional consequences of, 574 
prevalence of, 573 
risk and prognostic factors for, 573-574 
specifiers for, 572 

Tobacco withdrawal, 484, 575-576 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 575 


Index 


development and course of, 576 
diagnostic criteria for, 575 
diagnostic features of, 575 
diagnostic markers for, 576 
differential diagnosis of, 576 
functional consequences of, 576 
prevalence of, 576 

risk and prognostic factors for, 576 


Tolerance to substance effects, 484 
Tourette’s disorder, 32. See also Tic disorders 


diagnostic criteria for, 81 
diagnostic features of, 81-82 
functional consequences of, 84 
prevalence of, 83 

risk and prognostic factors for, 83 


Transvestic disorder, 685, 702-704 


associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
703 

comorbidity with, 704 

development and course of, 703-704 

diagnostic criteria for, 702 

diagnostic features of, 703 

differential diagnosis of, 704 

functional consequences of, 704 

prevalence of, 703 

specifiers for, 703 


Trauma- and stressor-related disorders, 265-290 


acute stress disorder, 265, 280-286 

adjustment disorders, 265, 286-289 

disinhibited social engagement disorder, 265, 
268-270 

highlights of changes from DSM-IV to DSM-5, 
812 

other specified trauma- and stressor-related 
disorder, 289 

posttraumatic stress disorder, 265, 271-280 

reactive attachment disorder, 265-268 

unspecified trauma- and stressor-related 
disorder, 290 


Traumatic brain injury 


bipolar disorder and, 146 
depressive disorders and, 181 
dissociative amnesia and, 298, 299, 301 
hoarding disorder and, 247, 250 
major or mild neurocognitive disorder due to, 
591, 603, 624-627, 626 
associated features supporting diagnosis 
of, 625 
comorbidity with, 627 
development and course of, 625-626 
diagnostic criteria for, 624 
diagnostic features of, 625 
diagnostic markers for, 627 
differential diagnosis of, 627 
functional consequences of, 627 


Index 


prevalence of, 625 
risk and prognostic factors for, 626-627 
specifiers for, 625 


neurodevelopmental disorders and, 38, 39, 44, 


73 
psychotic disorders and, 99, 117 
severity ratings for, 625, 626 
trauma- and stressor-related disorders and, 
280, 281, 284, 286 
Tremor, medication-induced, 712 


Trichotillomania (hair-pulling disorder), 235, 236, 


251-254 
associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
252 
comorbidity with, 254 
culture-related diagnostic issues in, 253 
development and course of, 253 
diagnostic criteria for, 251 
diagnostic features of, 251-252 
diagnostic markers for, 253 
differential diagnosis of, 253-254 
functional consequences of, 253 
prevalence of, 252 
risk and prognostic factors for, 253 
Trung gid, 211, 212 


Unspecified mental disorder, 15-16, 19-20, 708 
due to another medical condition, 708 


Vascular neurocognitive disorder, major or mild, 


591, 603, 621-624 

associated features supporting diagnosis of, 
622 

comorbidity with, 624 
development and course of, 623 
diagnostic criteria for, 621 
diagnostic features of, 621-622 
diagnostic markers for, 623 
differential diagnosis of, 623-624 
functional consequences of, 623 
prevalence of, 622-623 
risk and prognostic factors for, 623 


947 


Voyeuristic disorder, 685, 686-688 


comorbidity with, 688 

development and course of, 688 
diagnostic criteria for, 686-687 
diagnostic features of, 687 

differential diagnosis of, 688 
gender-related diagnostic issues in, 688 
prevalence of, 687-688 

risk and prognostic factors for, 688 
specifiers for, 687 


Withdrawal from substance, 481, 485-487 


alcohol, 499-501 

caffeine, 506-508 

cannabis, 517-519 

delirium due to, 598 

development and course of, 487 

duration of effects and, 486 

laboratory findings associated with, 486-487 

multiple substances, 486 

opioids, 484, 547-549 

other (or unknown) substance, 583-584 

recording procedures for, 487 

related to route of administration and speed of 
substance effects, 486 

sedative, hypnotic, or anxiolytic, 484, 557-560 

stimulant, 484, 569-570 

tobacco, 484, 575-576 


World Health Organization (WHO), 6, 23 


International Classification of Diseases (ICD), 21 
revision process for ICD-11, 6, 10, 11-12 
use of ICD-9-CM and ICD-10 codes, 12, 16, 

22, 23, 29 
International Classification of Functioning, 
Disability and Health (ICF), 21, 734 


World Health Organization Disability Assessment 


Schedule 2.0 (WHODAS), 16, 21, 734, 
745-748 
additional scoring and interpretation guidance 
for DSM-5 users, 745-746 
frequency of use of, 746 
scoring instructions provided by WHO for, 745